Concept and Theories in Nursing 8
This week, you will develop a PowerPoint presentation reviewing the theories from each module. Please select one theory from each module (1-8) and answer the following questions. You should have two slides per theory:
- Describe the theory
- Provide 3 examples of how the theory applies to current practice (Obstetrics)
- Provide 3 positive patient outcomes resulting from utilizing the theory
- Explain 3 benefits to nursing satisfaction when utilizing the theory
- Describe two barriers to using the theory in practice and at least one method for overcoming each barrier (support methods with sources)
- Support from literature clearly noted throughout
The PowerPoint presentation should include at least two outside references and the textbook. The presentation should contain 2 to 4 slides per theory, for a total of 16 to 32 slides.
Mod 1 – Nightingale
Module 2- peplau, Henderson and orem
Module 3- Johnson and Orlando
Module 4- King and Rogers
Module 5- Roy and Neuman
Module 6- Leininger, Newman and Watson
Module 7- Parse, Erickson and Swain
Module 8- Theories of 1980’s and 1990’s
Nursing Theories & Nursing Practice
Fourth Edition
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page i
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page ii
Nursing Theories & Nursing Practice
Fourth Edition
Marlaine C. Smith, PhD, RN, AHN-BC, FAAN
Marilyn E. Parker, PhD, RN, FAAN
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page iii
F. A. Davis Company
1915 Arch Street
Philadelphia, PA 19103
www.fadavis.com
Copyright © 2015 by F. A. Davis Company
Copyright © 2015 by F. A. Davis Company. All rights reserved. This book is protected by copyright. No part
of it may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic,
mechanical, photocopying, recording, or otherwise, without written permission from the publisher.
Printed in the United States of America
Last digit indicates print number: 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
Publisher, Nursing: Joanne Patzek DaCunha, RN, MSN; Susan Rhyner
Developmental Editor: Marcia Kelley
Director of Content Development: Darlene D. Pedersen
Content Project Manager: Echo K. Gerhart
Manager of Art and Design: Carolyn O’Brien
As new scientific information becomes available through basic and clinical research, recommended treatments
and drug therapies undergo changes. The author(s) and publisher have done everything possible to make this book
accurate, up to date, and in accord with accepted standards at the time of publication. The author(s), editors, and
publisher are not responsible for errors or omissions or for consequences from application of the book, and make
no warranty, expressed or implied, in regard to the contents of the book. Any practice described in this book
should be applied by the reader in accordance with professional standards of care used in regard to the unique
circumstances that may apply in each situation. The reader is advised always to check product information (package
inserts) for changes and new information regarding dose and contraindications before administering any drug.
Caution is especially urged when using new or infrequently ordered drugs.
Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data
Nursing theories and nursing practice.
Nursing theories & nursing practice / [edited by] Marlaine C. Smith, Marilyn E. Parker. — Fourth edition.
p. ; cm.
Preceded by Nursing theories and nursing practice / [edited by] Marilyn E. Parker, Marlaine C. Smith.
3rd ed. c2010.
Includes bibliographical references and index.
ISBN 978-0-8036-3312-4 (alk. paper)
I. Smith, Marlaine C. (Marlaine Cappelli), editor. II. Parker, Marilyn E., editor. III. Title.
[DNLM: 1. Nursing Theory—Biography. 2. Nurses—Biography. WY 86]
RT84.5
610.7301—dc23
2014047296
Authorization to photocopy items for internal or personal use, or the internal or personal use of specific
clients, is granted by F. A. Davis Company for users registered with the Copyright Clearance Center
(CCC) Transactional Reporting Service, provided that the fee of $.25 per copy is paid directly to CCC, 222
Rosewood Drive, Danvers, MA 01923. For those organizations that have been granted a photocopy license
by CCC, a separate system of payment has been arranged. The fee code for users of the Transactional
Reporting Service is: 8036-3312-4/15 0 + $.25.
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page iv
Preface to the Fourth Edition
v
This book offers the perspective that nursing is
a professional discipline with a body of knowl-
edge that guides its practice. Nursing theories
are an important part of this body of knowl-
edge, and regardless of complexity or abstrac-
tion, they reflect phenomena central to the
discipline, and should be used by nurses to
frame their thinking, action, and being in the
world. As guides, nursing theories are practical
in nature and facilitate communication with
those we serve as well as with colleagues, stu-
dents, and others practicing in health-related
services. We hope this book illuminates for the
readers the interrelationship between nursing
theories and nursing practice, and that this un-
derstanding will transform practice to improve
the health and quality of life of people who are
recipients of nursing care.
This very special book is intended to honor
the work of nursing theorists and nurses who
use these theories in their day-to-day practice.
Our foremost nursing theorists have written
for this book, or their theories have been de-
scribed by nurses who have comprehensive
knowledge of the theorists’ ideas and who have
a deep respect for the theorists as people,
nurses, and scholars. To the extent possible,
contributing authors have been selected by
theorists to write about their work. Three
middle-range theories have been added to this
edition of the book, bringing the total number
of middle-range theories to twelve. Obviously,
it was not possible to include all existing
middle-range theories in this volume; how-
ever, the expansion of this section illustrates
the recent growth in middle-range theory de-
velopment in nursing. Two chapters from the
third edition, including Levine’s conservation
theory and Paterson & Zderad’s humanistic
nursing have been moved to supplementary on-
line resources at http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
This book is intended to help nursing stu-
dents in undergraduate, masters, and doctoral
nursing programs explore and appreciate nurs-
ing theories and their use in nursing practice
and scholarship. In addition, and in response
to calls from practicing nurses, this book is in-
tended for use by those who desire to enrich
their practice by the study of nursing theories
and related illustrations of nursing practice.
The contributing authors describe theory de-
velopment processes and perspectives on the
theories, giving us a variety of views for the
twenty-first century and beyond. Each chapter
of the book includes descriptions of a theory,
its applications in both research and practice,
and an example that reflects how the theory
can guide practice. We anticipate that this
overview of the theory and its applications will
lead to deeper exploration of the theory, lead-
ing students to consult published works by the
theorists and those working closely with the
theory in practice or research.
There are six sections in the book. The first
provides an overview of nursing theory and a
focus for thinking about evaluating and choos-
ing a nursing theory for use in practice. For
this edition, the evolution of nursing theory
was added to Chapter 1. Section II introduces
the work of early nursing scholars whose ideas
provided a foundation for more formal theory
development. The nursing conceptual models
and grand theories are clustered into three
parts in Sections III, IV, and V. Section III
contains those theories classified within the
interactive-integrative paradigm, and those in
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page v
the unitary-transformative paradigm are in-
cluded in Section IV. Grand theories that are
focused on the phenomena of care or caring
appear in Section V. The final section contains
a selection of middle-range theories.
An outline at the beginning of each chapter
provides a map for the contents. Major points
are highlighted in each chapter. Since this
book focuses on the relationship of nursing
theory to nursing practice, we invited the
authors to share a practice exemplar. You will
notice that some practice exemplars were writ-
ten by someone other than the chapter author.
In this edition the authors also provided
content about research based on the theory.
Because of page limitations you can find
additional chapter content online at http://
davisplus.fadavis.com. While every attempt
was made to follow a standard format for each
of the chapters throughout the book, some of
the chapters vary from this format; for exam-
ple, some authors chose not to include practice
exemplars.
The book’s website features materials that
will enrich the teaching and learning of these
nursing theories. Materials that will be helpful
for teaching and learning about nursing theo-
ries are included as online resources. For exam-
ple, there are case studies, learning activities,
and PowerPoint presentations included on
both the instructor and student websites. Other
online resources include additional content,
more extensive bibliographies and longer biog-
raphies of the theorists. Dr. Shirley Gordon
and a group of doctoral students from Florida
Atlantic University developed these ancillary
materials for the third edition. For this edition,
the ancillary materials for students and faculty
were updated by Diane Gullett, a PhD candi-
date at Florida Atlantic University. She devel-
oped all materials for the new chapters as well
as updating ancillary materials for chapters that
appeared in the third edition. We are so grate-
ful to Diane and Shirley for their creativity and
leadership and to the other doctoral students for
their thoughtful contributions to this project .
We hope that this book provides a useful
overview of the latest theoretical advances of
many of nursing’s finest scholars. We are
grateful for their contributions to this book. As
editors we’ve found that continuing to learn
about and share what we love nurtures our
growth as scholars, reignites our passion and
commitment, and offers both fun and frustra-
tion along the way. We continue to be grateful
for the enthusiasm for this book shared by
many nursing theorists and contributing
authors and by scholars in practice and
research who bring theories to life. For us, it
has been a joy to renew friendships with col-
leagues who have contributed to past editions
and to find new friends and colleagues whose
theories enriched this edition.
Nursing Theories and Nursing Practice, now
in the fourth edition, has roots in a series of
nursing theory conferences held in South
Florida, beginning in 1989 and ending when
efforts to cope with the aftermath of Hurricane
Andrew interrupted the energy and resources
needed for planning and offering the Fifth
South Florida Nursing Theory Conference.
Many of the theorists in this book addressed
audiences of mostly practicing nurses at these
conferences. Two books stimulated by those
conferences and published by the National
League for Nursing are Nursing Theories in
Practice (1990) and Patterns of Nursing Theories
in Practice (1993).
For me (Marilyn), even deeper roots of this
book are found early in my nursing career,
when I seriously considered leaving nursing for
the study of pharmacy. In my fatigue and frus-
tration, mixed with youthful hope and desire
for more education, I could not answer the
question “What is nursing?” and could not dis-
tinguish the work of nursing from other tasks
I did every day. Why should I continue this
work? Why should I seek degrees in a field
that I could not define? After reflecting on
these questions and using them to examine my
nursing, I could find no one who would con-
sider the questions with me. I remember being
asked, “Why would you ask that question? You
are a nurse; you must surely know what nurs-
ing is.” Such responses, along with a drive for
serious consideration of my questions, led me
to the library. I clearly remember reading se –
veral descriptions of nursing that, I thought,
could just as well have been about social work
or physical therapy. I then found nursing
vi Preface to the Fourth Edition
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page vi
defined and explained in a book about educa-
tion of nurses written by Dorothea Orem.
During the weeks that followed, as I did my
work of nursing in the hospital, I explored
Orem’s ideas about why people need nursing,
nursing’s purposes, and what nurses do. I
found a fit between her ideas, as I understood
them, with my practice, and I learned that I
could go even further to explain and design
nursing according to these ways of thinking
about nursing. I discovered that nursing shared
some knowledge and practices with other serv-
ices, such as pharmacy and medicine, and I
began to distinguish nursing from these related
fields of practice. I decided to stay in nursing
and made plans to study and work with
Dorothea Orem. In addition to learning about
nursing theory and its meaning in all we do, I
learned from Dorothea that nursing is a unique
discipline of knowledge and professional prac-
tice. In many ways, my earliest questions about
nursing have guided my subsequent study and
work. Most of what I have done in nursing has
been a continuation of my initial experience of
the interrelations of all aspects of nursing
scholarship, including the scholarship that is
nursing practice. Over the years, I have been
privileged to work with many nursing scholars,
some of whom are featured in this book.
My love for nursing and my respect for our
discipline and practice have deepened, and
knowing now that these values are so often
shared is a singular joy.
Marlaine’s interest in nursing theory had
similar origins to Marilyn’s. As a nurse pursu-
ing an interdisciplinary master’s degree in pub-
lic health, I (Marlaine) recognized that while
all the other public health disciplines had some
unique perspective to share, public health
nursing seemed to lack a clear identity. In
search of the identity of nursing I pursued a
second master’s in nursing. At that time nurs-
ing theory was beginning to garner attention,
and I learned about it from my teachers and
mentors Sr. Rosemary Donley, Rosemarie
Parse, and Mary Jane Smith. This discovery was
the answer I was seeking, and it both expanded
and focused my thinking about nursing. The
question of “What is nursing?” was answered
for me by these theories and I couldn’t get
enough! It led to my decision to pursue my
PhD in Nursing at New York University
where I studied with Martha Rogers. During
this same time I taught at Duquesne University
with Rosemarie Parse and learned more about
Man-Living-Health, which is now humanbe-
coming. I conducted several studies based on
Rogers’ conceptual system and Parse’s theory.
At theory conferences I was fortunate to
dialogue with Virginia Henderson, Hildegard
Peplau, Imogene King, and Madeleine
Leininger. In 1988 I accepted a faculty posi-
tion at the University of Colorado when Jean
Watson was Dean. The School of Nursing was
guided by a caring philosophy and framework
and I embraced caring as a central focus of the
discipline of nursing. As a unitary scholar, I
studied Newman’s theory of health as expand-
ing consciousness and was intrigued by it, so
for my sabbatical I decided to study it further
as well as learn more about the unitary appre-
ciative inquiry process that Richard Cowling
was developing.
We both have been fortunate to hold faculty
appointments in universities where nursing the-
ory has been valued, and we are fortunate today
to hold positions at the Christine E. Lynn Col-
lege of Nursing at Florida Atlantic University,
where faculty and students ground their teach-
ing scholarship and practice on caring theories,
including nursing as caring, developed by Dean
Anne Boykin and a previous faculty member at
the College, Savina Schoenhofer. Many faculty
colleagues and students continue to help us
study nursing and have contributed to this book
in ways we would never have adequate words to
acknowledge. We are grateful to our knowl-
edgeable colleagues who reviewed and offered
helpful suggestions for chapters of this book,
and we sincerely thank those who contributed
to the book as chapter authors. It is also our
good fortune that many nursing theorists and
other nursing scholars live in or visit our lovely
state of Florida. Since the first edition of this
book was published, we have lost many nursing
theorists. Their work continues through those
refining, modifying, testing, and expanding the
theories. The discipline of nursing is expanding
as research and practice advances existing theories
and as new theories emerge. This is especially
Preface to the Fourth Edition vii
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page vii
important at a time when nursing theory can
provide what is missing and needed most in
health care today.
All four editions of this book have been nur-
tured by Joanne DaCunha, an expert nurse and
editor for F. A. Davis Company, who has shep-
herded this project and others because of her
love of nursing. Near the end of this project
Joanne retired, and Susan Rhyner, our new ed-
itor, led us to the finish line. We are both grate-
ful for their wisdom, kindness, patience and
understanding of nursing. We give special
thanks to Echo Gerhart, who served as our con-
tact and coordinator for this project. Marilyn
thanks her husband, Terry Worden, for his
abiding love and for always being willing to help,
and her niece, Cherie Parker, who represents
many nurses who love nursing practice and
scholarship and thus inspire the work of this
book. Marlaine acknowledges her husband
Brian and her children, Kirsten, Alicia, and
Brady, and their spouses, Jonathan Vankin and
Tori Rutherford, for their love and understand-
ing. She honors her parents, Deno and Rose
Cappelli, for instilling in her the love of learning,
the value of hard work, and the importance of
caring for others, and dedicates this book to her
granddaughter Iyla and the new little one who
is scheduled to arrive as this book is released.
Marilyn E. Parker, Marlaine C. Smith,
Olathe, Kansas Boca Raton, Florida
viii Preface to the Fourth Edition
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page viii
Nursing Theorists
ix
Elizabeth Ann Manhart Barrett, PhD, RN, FAAN
Professor Emerita
Hunter College
City University of New York
New York, New York
Charlotte D. Barry, PhD, RN, NCSN, FAAN
Professor of Nursing
Christine E. Lynn College of Nursing
Florida Atlantic University
Boca Raton, Florida
Anne Boykin, PhD, RN*
Dean and Professor Emerita
Christine E. Lynn College of Nursing
Florida Atlantic University
Boca Raton, Florida
Barbara Montgomery Dossey, PhD, RN, AHN-BC, FAAN,
HWNC-BC
Co-Director, International Nurse Coach
Association
Core Faculty, Integrative Nurse Coach
Certificate Program
Miami, Florida
Joanne R. Duffy, PhD, RN, FAAN
Endowed Professor of Research and
Evidence-based Practice and Director
of the PhD Program
West Virginia University
Morgantown, West Virginia
Helen L. Erickson*
Professor Emerita
University of Texas at Austin
Austin, Texas
Lydia Hall†
Virginia Henderson†
Dorothy Johnson†
Imogene King†
Katharine Kolcaba, PhD, RN
Associate Professor Emeritus Adjunct
The University of Akron
Akron, Ohio
Madeleine M. Leininger†
Patricia Liehr, PhD, RN
Professor
Christine E. Lynn College of Nursing
Florida Atlantic University
Boca Raton, Florida
Rozzano C. Locsin, PhD, RN
Professor Emeritus
Christine E. Lynn College of Nursing
Florida Atlantic University
Boca Raton, Florida
Afaf I. Meleis, PhD, DrPS(hon), FAAN
Professor of Nursing and Sociology
University of Pennsylvania
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania
Betty Neuman, PhD, RN, PLC, FAAN
Beverly, Ohio
Margaret Newman, RN, PhD, FAAN
Professor Emerita
University of Minnesota College of Nursing
Saint Paul, Minnesota
Dorothea E. Orem†
Ida Jean Orlando (Pelletier)†
Marilyn E. Parker, PhD, RN, FAAN
Professor Emerita
Christine E. Lynn College of Nursing
Florida Atlantic University
Boca Raton, Florida
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page ix
Rosemarie Rizzo Parse, PhD, FAAN
Distinguished Professor Emeritus
Marcella Niehoff School of Nursing
Loyola University Chicago
Chicago, Illinois
Hildegard Peplau†
Marilyn Anne Ray, PhD, RN, CTN
Professor Emerita
Christine E. Lynn College of Nursing
Florida Atlantic University
Boca Raton, Florida
Pamela G. Reed, PhD, RN, FAAN
Professor
University of Arizona
Tucson, Arizona
Martha E. Rogers†
Sister Callista Roy, PhD, RN, FAAN
Professor and Nurse Theorist
William F. Connell School of Nursing
Boston College
Chestnut Hill, Massachusetts
Savina O. Schoenhofer, PhD, RN
Professor of Nursing
University of Mississippi
Oxford, Mississippi
Marlaine C. Smith, PhD, RN, AHN-BC, FAAN
Dean and Helen K. Persson Eminent Scholar
Christine E. Lynn College of Nursing
Florida Atlantic University
Boca Raton, Florida
Mary Jane Smith, PhD, RN
Professor
West Virginia University
Morgantown, West Virginia
Mary Ann Swain, PhD
Professor and Director, Doctoral Program
Decker School of Nursing
Binghamton University
Binghamton, New York
Kristen M. Swanson, PhD, RN, FAAN
Dean
Seattle University
Seattle, Washington
Evelyn Tomlin*
Joyce Travelbee†
Meredith Troutman-Jordan, PhD, RN
Associate Professor
University of North Carolina
Chapel Hill, North Carolina
Jean Watson, PhD, RN, AHN-BC, FAAN
Distinguished Professor Emeritus
University of Colorado at Denver—Anschutz
Campus
Aurora, Colorado
Ernestine Wiedenbach†
x Nursing Theorists
*Retired
†Deceased
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page x
Contributors
xi
Patricia Deal Aylward, MSN, RN, CNS
Assistant Professor
Santa Fe Community College
Gainesville, Florida
Howard Karl Butcher, PhD, RN, PMHCNS-BC
Associate Professor
University of Iowa
Iowa City, Iowa
Lynne M. Hektor Dunphy, PhD, APRN-BC
Associate Dean for Practice and Community
Engagement
Christine E. Lynn College of Nursing
Florida Atlantic University
Boca Raton, Florida
Laureen M. Fleck, PhD, FNP-BC, FAANP
Associate Faculty
Christine E. Lynn College of Nursing
Florida Atlantic University
Boca Raton, Florida
Maureen A. Frey, PhD, RN*
Shirley C. Gordon, PhD, RN
Professor and Assistant Dean Graduate Practice
Programs
Christine E. Lynn College of Nursing
Florida Atlantic University
Boca Raton, Florida
*Retired.
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page xi
xii Contributors
Diane Lee Gullett, RN, MSN, MPH
Doctoral Candidate
Christine E. Lynn College of NursingFlorida
Atlantic University
Boca Raton, Florida
Donna L. Hartweg, PhD, RN
Professor Emerita and Former Director
Illinois Wesleyan University
Bloomington, Illinois
Bonnie Holaday, PhD, RN, FAAN
Professor
Clemson University
Clemson, South Carolina
Beth M. King, PhD, RN, PMHCNS-BC
Assistant Professor and RN-BSN Coordinator
Christine E. Lynn College of Nursing
Florida Atlantic University
Boca Raton, Florida
Lois White Lowry, DNSc, RN*
Professor Emerita
East Tennessee State University
Johnson City, Tennessee
Violet M. Malinski, PhD, MA, RN
Associate Professor
College of New Rochelle
New Rochelle, New York
Mary B. Killeen, PhD, RN, NEA-BC
Consultant
Evidence Based Practice Nurse Consultants,
LLC
Howell, Michigan
Ann R. Peden, RN, CNS, DSN
Professor and Chair
Capital University
Columbus, Ohio
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page xii
Contributors xiii
Margaret Dexheimer Pharris, PhD, RN, CNE, FAAN
Associate Dean for Nursing
St. Catherine University
St. Paul, Minnesota
Maude Rittman, PhD, RN
Associate Chief of Nursing Service for Research
Gainesville Veteran’s Administration
Medical Center
Gainesville, Florida
Christina L. Sieloff, PhD, RN
Associate Professor
Montana State University
Billings, Montana
Jacqueline Staal, MSN, ARNP, FNP-BC
PhD Candidate
Christine E. Lynn College of Nursing
Florida Atlantic University
Boca Raton, Florida
Marian C. Turkel, PhD, RN, NEA-BC, FAAN
Director of Professional Nursing Practice
Holy Cross Medical Center
Fort Lauderdale, Florida
Pamela Senesac, PhD, SM, RN
Assistant Professor
University of Massachusetts
Shrewsbury, Massachusetts
Hiba Wehbe-Alamah, PhD, RN, FNP-BC, CTN-A
Associate Professor
University of Michigan-Flint
Flint, Michigan
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page xiii
xiv Contributors
Terri Kaye Woodward, MSN, RN, CNS, AHN-BC, HTCP
Founder
Cocreative Wellness
Denver, Colorado
Kelly White, RN, PhD, FNP-BC
Assistant Professor
South University
West Palm Beach, Florida
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page xiv
Reviewers
xv
Ferrona Beason, PhD, ARNP
Assistant Professor in Nursing
Barry University – Division of Nursing
Miami Shores, Florida
Abimbola Farinde, PharmD, MS
Clinical Pharmacist Specialist
Clear Lake Regional Medical Center
Webster, Texas
Lori S. Lauver, PhD, RN, CPN, CNE
Associate Professor
Jefferson School of Nursing
Thomas Jefferson University
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania
Elisheva Lightstone, BScN, MSc
Professor
Department of Nursing
Seneca College
King City, Ontario, Canada
Carol L. Moore, PhD, APRN, CNS
Assistant Professor of Nursing, Coordinator,
Graduate Nursing Studies
Fort Hays State University
Hays, Kansas
Kathleen Spadaro, PhD, PMHCNS, RN
MSN Program Co-coordinator & Assistant
Professor of Nursing
Chatham University
Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page xv
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page xvi
Contents
xvii
Section I An Introduction to Nursing Theory, 1
Chapter 1 Nursing Theory and the Discipline of Nursing, 3
Marlaine C. Smith and Marilyn E. Parker
Chapter 2 A Guide for the Study of Nursing Theories for Practice, 19
Marilyn E. Parker and Marlaine C. Smith
Chapter 3 Choosing, Evaluating, and Implementing Nursing Theories
for Practice, 23
Marilyn E. Parker and Marlaine C. Smith
Section II Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing
Theory, 35
Chapter 4 Florence Nightingale’s Legacy of Caring and Its Applications, 37
Lynne M. Hektor Dunphy
Chapter 5 Early Conceptualizations About Nursing, 55
Shirley C. Gordon
Chapter 6 Nurse-Patient Relationship Theories, 67
Ann R. Peden, Jacqueline Staal, Maude Rittman, and Diane Lee Gullett
Section III Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-
Interactive Paradigm, 87
Chapter 7 Dorothy Johnson’s Behavioral System Model and Its
Applications, 89
Bonnie Holaday
Chapter 8 Dorothea Orem’s Self-Care Deficit Nursing Theory, 105
Donna L. Hartweg
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page xvii
Chapter 9 Imogene King’s Theory of Goal Attainment, 133
Christina L. Sieloff and Maureen A. Frey
Chapter 10 Sister Callista Roy’s Adaptation Model, 153
Pamela Sensac and Sister Callista Roy
Chapter 11 Betty Neuman’s Systems Model, 165
Lois White Lowry and Patricia Deal Aylward
Chapter 12 Helen Erickson, Evelyn Tomlin, and Mary Ann Swain’s
Theory of Modeling and Role Modeling, 185
Helen L. Erickson
Chapter 13 Barbara Dossey’s Theory of Integral Nursing, 207
Barbara Montgomery Dossey
Section IV Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the
Unitary–Transformative Paradigm, 235
Chapter 14 Martha E. Rogers Science of Unitary Human Beings, 237
Howard Karl Butcher and Violet M. Malinski
Chapter 15 Rosemarie Rizzo Parse’s Humanbecoming Paradigm, 263
Rosemarie Rizzo Parse
Chapter 16 Margaret Newman’s Theory of Health as Expanding
Consciousness, 279
Margaret Dexheimer Pharris
Section V Grand Theories about Care or Caring, 301
Chapter 17 Madeleine Leininger’s Theory of Culture Care Diversity
and Universality, 303
Hiba Wehbe-Alamah
Chapter 18 Jean Watson’s Theory of Human Caring, 321
Jean Watson
Chapter 19 Theory of Nursing as Caring, 341
Anne Boykin and Savina O. Schoenhofer
Section VI Middle-Range Theories, 357
Chapter 20 Transitions Theory, 361
Afaf I. Meleis
xviii Contents
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page xviii
Chapter 21 Katharine Kolcaba’s Comfort Theory, 381
Katharine Kolcaba
Chapter 22 Joanne Duffy’s Quality-Caring Model©, 393
Joanne R. Duffy
Chapter 23 Pamela Reed’s Theory of Self-Transcendence, 411
Pamela G. Reed
Chapter 24 Patricia Liehr and Mary Jane Smith’s Story Theory, 421
Patricia Liehr and Mary Jane Smith
Chapter 25 The Community Nursing Practice Model, 435
Marilyn E. Parker, Charlotte D. Barry. and Beth M. King
Chapter 26 Rozzano Locsin’s Technological Competency as Caring
in Nursing, 449
Rozzano C. Locsin
Chapter 27 Marilyn Anne Ray’s Theory of Bureaucratic Caring, 461
Marilyn Anne Ray and Marian C. Turkel
Chapter 28 Troutman-Jordan’s Theory of Successful Aging, 483
Meredith Troutman-Jordan
Chapter 29 Barrett’s Theory of Power as Knowing Participation
in Change, 495
Elizabeth Ann Manhart Barrett
Chapter 30 Marlaine Smith’s Theory of Unitary Caring, 509
Marlaine C. Smith
Chapter 31 Kristen Swanson’s Theory of Caring, 521
Kristen M. Swanson
Index, 533
Contents xix
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page xix
3312_FM_i-xx 26/12/14 5:51 PM Page xx
Section I
An Introduction to Nursing Theory
1
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:35 AM Page 1
2
In this first section of the book, you will be introduced to the purpose of nursing
theory and shown how to study, analyze, and evaluate it for use in nursing
practice. If you are new to the idea of theory in nursing, the chapters in this section
will orient you to what theory is, how it fits into the evolution and context of nursing
as a professional discipline, and how to approach its study and evaluation. If
you have studied nursing theory in the past, these chapters will provide you with
additional knowledge and insight as you continue your study.
Nursing is a professional discipline focused on the study of human health and
healing through caring. Nursing practice is based on the knowledge of nursing,
which consists of its philosophies, theories, concepts, principles, research findings,
and practice wisdom. Nursing theories are patterns that guide the thinking about
nursing. All nurses are guided by some implicit or explicit theory or pattern of
thinking as they care for their patients. Too often, this pattern of thinking is implicit
and is colored by the lens of diseases, diagnoses, and treatments. This does not
reflect practice from the disciplinary perspective of nursing. The major reason for
the development and study of nursing theory is to improve nursing practice and,
therefore, the health and quality of life of those we serve.
The first chapter in this section focuses on nursing theory within the context of
nursing as an evolving professional discipline. We examine the relationship of
nursing theory to the characteristics of a discipline. You’ll learn new words that
describe parts of the knowledge structure of the discipline of nursing, and we’ll
speculate about the future of nursing theory as nursing, health care, and our global
society change. Chapter 2 is a guide to help you study the theories in this book.
Use this guide as you read and think about how nursing theory fits in your prac-
tice. Nurses embrace theories that fit with their values and ways of thinking. They
choose theories to guide their practice and to create a practice that is meaningful
to them. Chapter 3 focuses on the selection, evaluation, and implementation of
theory for practice. Students often get the assignment of evaluating or critiquing
a nursing theory. Evaluation is coming to some judgment about value or worth
based on criteria. Various sets of criteria exist for you to use in theory evaluation.
We introduce some that you can explore further. Finally, we offer reflections on
the process of implementing theory-guided practice models.
Section
I An Introduction to Nursing Theory
2
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:35 AM Page 2
Chapter 1Nursing Theory and the
Discipline of Nursing
MARLAINE C. SMITH AND
MARILYN E. PARKER
The Discipline of Nursing
Definitions of Nursing Theory
The Purpose of Theory in a Professional
Discipline
The Evolution of Nursing Science
The Structure of Knowledge in the
Discipline of Nursing
Nursing Theory and the Future
Summary
References
Marilyn E. ParkerMarlaine C. Smith
3
What is nursing? At first glance, the question
may appear to be one with an obvious an-
swer, but when it is posed to nurses, many
define nursing by providing a litany of func-
tions and activities. Some answer with the
elements of the nursing process: assessing,
planning, implementing, and evaluating. Oth-
ers might answer that nurses coordinate a
patient’s care.
Defining nursing in terms of the nursing
process or by functions or activities nurses per-
form is problematic. The phases of the nursing
process are the same steps we might use to
solve any problem we encounter, from a bro-
ken computer to a failing vegetable garden.
We assess the situation to determine what is
going on and then identify the problem; we
plan what to do about it, implement our plan,
and then evaluate whether it works. The nurs-
ing process does nothing to define nursing.
Defining ourselves by tasks presents other
problems. What nurses do—that is, the func-
tions associated with practice—differs based
on the setting. For example, a nurse might
start IVs, administer medications, and per-
form treatments in an acute care setting. In a
community-based clinic, a nurse might teach
a young mother the principles of infant feeding
or place phone calls to arrange community
resources for a child with special needs. Mul-
tiple professionals and nonprofessionals may
perform the same tasks as nurses, and persons
with the ability and authority to perform cer-
tain tasks change based on time and setting.
For example, both physicians and nurses may
listen to breath sounds and recognize the pres-
ence of rales. Both nurses and social workers
might do discharge planning. Both nurses
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:35 AM Page 3
and family members might change dressings,
monitor vital signs, and administer medications,
so defining nursing based solely on functions or
activities performed is not useful.
To answer the question “What is nursing?”
we must formulate nursing’s unique identity
as a field of study or discipline. Florence
Nightingale is credited as the founder of mod-
ern nursing, the one who articulated its dis-
tinctive focus. In her book Notes on Nursing:
What It Is and What It Is Not (Nightingale,
1859/1992), she differentiated nursing from
medicine, stating that the two were distinct
practices. She defined nursing as putting the
person in the best condition for nature to act,
insisting that the focus of nursing was on
health and the natural healing process, not on
disease and reparation. For her, creating an
environment that provided the conditions for
natural healing to occur was the focus of nurs-
ing. Her beginning conceptualizations were
the seeds for the theoretical development of
nursing as a professional discipline.
In this chapter, we situate the understand-
ing of nursing theory within the context of
the discipline of nursing. We define the dis-
cipline of nursing, describe the purpose of
theory for the discipline of nursing, review
the evolution of nursing science, identify the
structure of the discipline of nursing, and
speculate on the future place of nursing the-
ory in the discipline.
The Discipline of Nursing
Every discipline has a unique focus that directs
the inquiry within it and distinguishes it from
other fields of study (Smith, 2008, p. 1). Nurs-
ing knowledge guides its professional practice;
therefore, it is classified as a professional disci-
pline. Donaldson and Crowley (1978) stated
that a discipline “offers a unique perspective, a
distinct way of viewing . . . phenomena, which
ultimately defines the limits and nature of its
inquiry” (p. 113). Any discipline includes net-
works of philosophies, theories, concepts, ap-
proaches to inquiry, research findings, and
practices that both reflect and illuminate its dis-
tinct perspective. The discipline of nursing is
formed by a community of scholars, including
nurses in all nursing venues, who share a
commitment to values, knowledge, and
processes to guide the thought and work of
the discipline.
The classic work of King and Brownell
(1976) is consistent with the thinking of nurs-
ing scholars (Donaldson & Crowley, 1978;
Meleis, 1977) about the discipline of nursing.
These authors have elaborated attributes that
characterize all disciplines. As you will see in
the discussion that follows, the attributes of
King and Brownell provide a framework that
contextualizes nursing theory within the dis-
cipline of nursing.
Expression of Human Imagination
Members of any discipline imagine and create
structures that offer descriptions and explana-
tions of the phenomena that are of concern to
that discipline. These structures are the theories
of that discipline. Nursing theory is dependent
on the imagination of nurses in practice, ad-
ministration, research, and teaching, as they
create and apply theories to improve nursing
practice and ultimately the lives of those they
serve. To remain dynamic and useful, the dis-
cipline requires openness to new ideas and in-
novative approaches that grow out of members’
reflections and insights.
Domain
A professional discipline must be clearly
defined by a statement of its domain—the
boundaries or focus of that discipline. The do-
main of nursing includes the phenomena of in-
terest, problems to be addressed, main content
and methods used, and roles required of the
discipline’s members (Kim, 1997; Meleis,
2012). The processes and practices claimed by
members of the disciplinary community grow
out of these domain statements. Nightingale
provided some direction for the domain of the
discipline of nursing. Although the discipli-
nary focus has been debated, there is some
degree of consensus. Donaldson and Crowley
(1978, p. 113) identified the following as the
domain of the discipline of nursing:
1. Concern with principles and laws that
govern the life processes, well-being, and
4 SECTION I • An Introduction to Nursing Theory
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:35 AM Page 4
optimal functioning of human beings, sick
or well
2. Concern with the patterning of human
behavior in interactions with the environ-
ment in critical life situations
3. Concern with the processes through
which positive changes in health status
are affected
Fawcett (1984) described the metapara-
digm as a way to distinguish nursing from
other disciplines. The metaparadigm is very
general and intended to reflect agreement
among members of the discipline about the
field of nursing. This is the most abstract level
of nursing knowledge and closely mirrors be-
liefs held about nursing. By virtue of being
nurses, all nurses have some awareness of
nursing’s metaparadigm. However, because
the term may not be familiar, it offers no di-
rect guidance for research and practice (Kim,
1997; Walker & Avant, 1995). The metapara-
digm consists of four concepts: persons, envi-
ronment, health, and nursing. According to
Fawcett, nursing is the study of the interrela-
tionship among these four concepts.
Modifications and alternative concepts for
this framework have been explored throughout
the discipline (Fawcett, 2000). For example,
some nursing scholars have suggested that
“caring” replace “nursing” in the metaparadigm
(Stevenson & Tripp-Reimer, 1989). Kim
(1987, 1997) set forth four domains: client,
client–nurse encounters, practice, and environ-
ment. In recent years, increasing attention has
been directed to the nature of nursing’s rela-
tionship with the environment (Kleffel, 1996;
Schuster & Brown, 1994).
Others have defined nursing as the study
of “the health or wholeness of human beings
as they interact with their environment”
(Donaldson & Crowley, 1978, p. 113), the life
process of unitary human beings (Rogers,
1970), care or caring (Leininger, 1978; Watson,
1985), and human–universe–health interrela-
tionships (Parse, 1998). A widely accepted focus
statement for the discipline was published
by Newman, Sime, and Corcoran-Perry
(1991): “Nursing is the study of caring in the
human health experience” (p. 3). A consensus
statement of philosophical unity in the disci-
pline was published by Roy and Jones (2007).
Statements include the following:
• The human being is characterized by
wholeness, complexity, and consciousness.
• The essence of nursing involves the nurse’s
true presence in the process of human-
to-human engagement.
• Nursing theory expresses the values and be-
liefs of the discipline, creating a structure to
organize knowledge and illuminate nursing
practice.
• The essence of nursing practice is the nurse–
patient relationship.
In 2008, Newman, Smith, Dexheimer-
Pharris, and Jones revisited the disciplinary
focus asserting that relationship was central
to the discipline, and the convergence of
seven concepts—health, consciousness, car-
ing, mutual process, presence, patterning, and
meaning—specified relationship in the pro-
fessional discipline of nursing. Willis, Grace,
and Roy (2008) posited that the central uni-
fying focus for the discipline is facilitating
humanization, meaning, choice, quality of
life, and healing in living and dying (p. E28).
Finally, Litchfield and Jondorsdottir (2008)
defined the discipline as the study of human-
ness in the health circumstance. Smith (1994)
defined the domain of the discipline of nurs-
ing as “the study of human health and healing
through caring” (p. 50). For Smith (2008),
“nursing knowledge focuses on the wholeness
of human life and experience and the
processes that support relationship, integra-
tion, and transformation” (p. 3). Nursing
conceptual models, grand theories, middle-
range theories, and practice theories explicate
the phenomena within the domain of nurs-
ing. In addition, the focus of the nursing dis-
cipline is a clear statement of social mandate
and service used to direct the study and prac-
tice of nursing (Newman et al., 1991).
Syntactical and Conceptual Structures
Syntactical and conceptual structures are
essential to any discipline and are inherent
in nursing theories. The conceptual structure
CHAPTER 1 • Nursing Theory and the Discipline of Nursing 5
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:35 AM Page 5
delineates the proper concerns of nursing,
guides what is to be studied, and clarifies ac-
cepted ways of knowing and using content of
the discipline. This structuṙe is grounded in the
focus of the discipline. The conceptual struc-
ture relates concepts within nursing theories.
The syntactical structures help nurses and
other professionals to understand the talents,
skills, and abilities that must be developed
within the community. This structure directs
descriptions of data needed from research, as
well as evidence required to demonstrate the
effect on nursing practice. In addition, these
structures guide nursing’s use of knowledge in
research and practice approaches developed by
related disciplines. It is only by being thor-
oughly grounded in the discipline’s concepts,
substance, and modes of inquiry that the bound-
aries of the discipline can be understood and
possibilities for creativity across disciplinary
borders can be created and explored.
Specialized Language and Symbols
As nursing theory has evolved, so has the need
for concepts, language, and forms of data that
reflect new ways of thinking and knowing spe-
cific to nursing. The complex concepts used in
nursing scholarship and practice require lan-
guage that can be specific and understood. The
language of nursing theory facilitates commu-
nication among members of the discipline.
Expert knowledge of the discipline is often
required for full understanding of the meaning
of these theoretical terms.
Heritage of Literature and
Networks of Communication
This attribute calls attention to the array
of books, periodicals, artifacts, and aesthetic
expressions, as well as audio, visual, and elec-
tronic media that have developed over cen-
turies to communicate the nature of nursing
knowledge and practice. Conferences and fo-
rums on every aspect of nursing held through-
out the world are part of this network. Nursing
organizations and societies also provide critical
communication links. Nursing theories are
part of this heritage of literature, and those
working with these theories present their work
at conferences, societies, and other communi-
cation networks of the nursing discipline.
Tradition
The tradition and history of the discipline is ev-
ident in the study of nursing over time. There
is recognition that theories most useful today
often have threads of connection with ideas
originating in the past. For example, many the-
orists have acknowledged the influence of
Florence Nightingale and have acclaimed her
leadership in influencing nursing theories of
today. In addition, nursing has a rich heritage
of practice. Nursing’s practical experience and
knowledge have been shared and transformed
as the content of the discipline and are evident
in many nursing theories (Gray & Pratt, 1991).
Values and Beliefs
Nursing has distinctive views of persons and
strong commitments to compassionate and
knowledgeable care of persons through nurs-
ing. Fundamental nursing values and beliefs
include a holistic view of person, the dignity
and uniqueness of persons, and the call to care.
There are both shared and differing values and
beliefs within the discipline. The metapara-
digm reflects the shared beliefs, and the para-
digms reflect the differences.
Systems of Education
A distinguishing mark of any discipline is the
education of future and current members of
the community. Nursing is recognized as a
professional discipline within institutions of
higher education because it has an identifiable
body of knowledge that is studied, advanced,
and used to underpin its practice. Students of
any professional discipline study its theories
and learn its methods of inquiry and practice.
Nursing theories, by setting directions for the
substance and methods of inquiry for the dis-
cipline, should provide the basis for nursing
education and the framework for organizing
nursing curricula.
Definitions of Nursing Theory
A theory is a notion or an idea that explains
experience, interprets observation, describes
6 SECTION I • An Introduction to Nursing Theory
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:35 AM Page 6
relationships, and projects outcomes. Parsons
(1949), often quoted by nursing theorists,
wrote that theories help us know what we
know and decide what we need to know. The-
ories are mental patterns or frameworks cre-
ated to help understand and create meaning
from our experience, organize and articulate
our knowing, and ask questions leading to new
insights. As such, theories are not discovered
in nature but are human inventions.
Theories are organizing structures of our re-
flections, observations, projections, and infer-
ences. Many describe theories as lenses because
they color and shape what is seen. The same
phenomena will be seen differently depending
on the theoretical perspective assumed. For
these reasons, “theory” and related terms have
been defined and described in a number of
ways according to individual experience and
what is useful at the time. Theories, as reflec-
tions of understanding, guide our actions, help
us set forth desired outcomes, and give evi-
dence of what has been achieved. A theory, by
traditional definition, is an organized, coherent
set of concepts and their relationships to each
other that offers descriptions, explanations,
and predictions about phenomena.
Early writers on nursing theory brought
definitions of theory from other disciplines to
direct future work within nursing. Dickoff and
James (1968, p. 198) defined theory as a “con-
ceptual system or framework invented for
some purpose.” Ellis (1968, p. 217) defined
theory as “a coherent set of hypothetical, con-
ceptual, and pragmatic principles forming a
general frame of reference for a field of in-
quiry.” McKay (1969, p. 394) asserted that
theories are the capstone of scientific work and
that the term refers to “logically interconnected
sets of confirmed hypotheses.” Barnum (1998,
p. 1) later offered a more open definition of
theory as a “construct that accounts for or or-
ganizes some phenomenon” and simply stated
that a nursing theory describes or explains
nursing.
Definitions of theory emphasize its various
aspects. Those developed in recent years are
more open and conform to a broader concep-
tion of science. The following definitions of the-
ory are consistent with general ideas of theory
in nursing practice, education, administration,
or research:
• Theory is a set of concepts, definitions, and
propositions that project a systematic view
of phenomena by designating specific inter-
relationships among concepts for purposes
of describing, explaining, predicting, and/or
controlling phenomena (Chinn & Jacobs,
1987, p. 71).
• Theory is a creative and rigorous structuring
of ideas that projects a tentative, purposeful,
and systematic view of phenomena (Chinn
& Kramer, 2004, p. 268).
• Nursing theory is a conceptualization
of some aspect of reality (invented or
discovered) that pertains to nursing. The
conceptualization is articulated for the
purpose of describing, explaining, predict-
ing, or prescribing nursing care (Meleis,
1997, p. 12).
• Nursing theory is an inductively and/or de-
ductively derived collage of coherent, cre-
ative, and focused nursing phenomena that
frame, give meaning to, and help explain
specific and selective aspects of nursing re-
search and practice (Silva, 1997, p. 55).
• A theory is an imaginative grouping of
knowledge, ideas, and experience that are rep –
resented symbolically and seek to illuminate
a given phenomenon.” (Watson, 1985, p. 1).
The Purpose of Theory in
a Professional Discipline
All professional disciplines have a body of
knowledge consisting of theories, research, and
methods of inquiry and practice. They organize
knowledge, guide inquiry to advance science,
guide practice and enhance the care of patients.
Nursing theories addre ss the phenomena of in-
terest to nursing, human beings, health, and
caring in the context of the nurse–person rela-
tionship1. On the basis of strongly held values
and beliefs about nursing, and within con-
texts of various worldviews, theories are pat-
terns that guide the thinking about, being,
and doing of nursing.
CHAPTER 1 • Nursing Theory and the Discipline of Nursing 7
1Person refers to individual, family, group, or community.
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:35 AM Page 7
Theories provide structures for making
sense of the complexities of reality for both
practice and research. Research based in nurs-
ing theory is needed to explain and predict
nursing outcomes essential to the delivery of
nursing care that is both humane and cost-
effective (Gioiella, 1996). Some conceptual
structure either implicitly or explicitly directs
all avenues of nursing, including nursing edu-
cation and administration. Nursing theories
provide concepts and designs that define the
place of nursing in health care. Through
theories, nurses are offered perspectives for
relating with professionals from other disci-
plines, who join with nurses to provide
human services. Nursing has great expecta-
tions of its theories. At the same time, the-
ories must provide structure and substance
to ground the practice and scholarship of
nursing and must also be flexible and dynamic
to keep pace with the growth and changes in
the discipline and practice of nursing.
The major reason for structuring and
advancing nursing knowledge is for the sake
of nursing practice. The primary purpose
of nursing theories is to further the develop-
ment and understanding of nursing practice.
Because nursing theory exists to improve prac-
tice, the test of nursing theory is a test of its
usefulness in professional practice (Colley,
2003; Fitzpatrick, 1997). The work of nursing
theory is moving from academia into the
realm of nursing practice. Chapters in the re-
maining sections of this book highlight the
use of nursing theories in nursing practice.
Nursing practice is both the source and the
goal of nursing theory. From the viewpoint of
practice, Gray and Forsstrom (1991) suggested
that theory provides nurses with different ways
of looking at and assessing phenomena, ratio-
nales for their practice, and criteria for evalu-
ating outcomes. Many of the theories in this
book have been used to guide nursing practice,
stimulate creative thinking, facilitate commu-
nication, and clarify purposes and processes in
practice. The practicing nurse has an ethical re-
sponsibility to use the discipline’s theoretical
knowledge base, just as it is the nurse scholar’s
ethical responsibility to develop the knowledge
base specific to nursing practice (Cody, 1997,
2003). Engagement in practice generates the
ideas that lead to the development of nursing
theories.
At the empirical level of theory, abstract
concepts are operationalized, or made concrete,
for practice and research (Fawcett, 2000; Smith
& Liehr, 2013). Empirical indicators provide
specific examples of how the theory is experi-
enced in reality; they are important for bringing
theoretical knowledge to the practice level.
These indicators include procedures, tools, and
instruments to determine the effects of nursing
practice and are essential to research and man-
agement of outcomes of practice (Jennings &
Staggers, 1998). The resulting data form the
basis for improving the quality of nursing care
and influencing health-care policy. Empirical
indicators, grounded carefully in nursing con-
cepts, provide clear demonstration of the utility
of nursing theory in practice, research, admin-
istration, and other nursing endeavors (Allison
& McLaughlin-Renpenning, 1999; Hart &
Foster, 1998).
Meeting the challenges of systems of care
delivery and interprofessional work demands
practice from a theoretical perspective. Nurs-
ing’s disciplinary focus is important within
the interprofessional health-care environment
(Allison & McLaughlin-Renpenning, 1999);
otherwise, its unique contribution to the in-
terprofessional team is unclear. Nursing ac-
tions reflect nursing concepts from a nursing
perspective. Careful, reflective, and critical
thinking are the hallmarks of expert nursing,
and nursing theories should undergird these
processes. Appreciation and use of nursing
theory offer opportunities for successful col-
laboration with colleagues from other disci-
plines and provide definition for nursing’s
overall contribution to health care. Nurses
must know what they are doing, why they are
doing it, and what the range of outcomes of
nursing may be, as well as indicators for doc-
umenting nursing’s effects. These theoretical
frameworks serve as powerful guides for ar-
ticulating, reporting, and recording nursing
thought and action.
One of the assertions referred to most often
in the nursing-theory literature is that theory is
born of nursing practice and, after examination
8 SECTION I • An Introduction to Nursing Theory
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:35 AM Page 8
and refinement through research, must be re-
turned to practice (Dickoff, James, & Wieden-
bach, 1968). Nursing theory is stimulated by
questions and curiosities arising from nursing
practice. Development of nursing knowledge
is a result of theory-based nursing inquiry. The
circle continues as data, conclusions, and rec-
ommendations of nursing research are evalu-
ated and developed for use in practice. Nursing
theory must be seen as practical and useful to
practice, and the insights of practice must in
turn continue to enrich nursing theory.
The Evolution of
Nursing Science
Disciplines can be classified as belonging to
the sciences or humanities. In any science,
there is a search for an understanding about
specified phenomena through creating some
organizing frameworks (theories) about the
nature of those phenomena. These organizing
frameworks (theories) are evaluated for their
empirical accuracy through research. So sci-
ence is composed of theories developed and
tested through research (Smith, 1994).
The evolution of nursing as a science has
occurred within the past 70 years; however,
before nursing became a discipline or field
of study, it was a healing art. Throughout
the world, nursing emerged as a healing min-
istry to those who were ill or in need of sup-
port. Knowledge about caring for the sick,
injured, and those birthing, dying, or expe-
riencing normal developmental transitions
was handed down, frequently in oral tradi-
tions, and comprised folk remedies and prac-
tices that were found to be effective through
a process of trial and error. In most societies,
the responsibility for nursing fell to women,
members of religious orders, or those with
spiritual authority in the community. With
the ascendency of science, those who were
engaged in the vocations of healing lost their
authority over healing to medicine. Tradi-
tional approaches to healing were marginal-
ized, as the germ theory and the development
of pharmaceuticals and surgical procedures
were legitimized because of their grounding
in science.
Although there were healers from other
countries who can be acknowledged for their
importance to the history of nursing, Florence
Nightingale holds the title of the “mother of
modern nursing” and the person responsible
for setting Western nursing on a path toward
scientific advancement. She not only defined
nursing as “putting the person in the best con-
dition for nature to act,” she also established a
phenomenological focus of nursing as caring
for and about the human–environment rela-
tionship to health. While nursing soldiers dur-
ing the Crimean War, Nightingale began to
study the distribution of disease by gathering
data, so she was arguably the first nurse-scientist
in that she established a rudimentary theory
and tested that theory through her practice and
research.
Nightingale schools were established in the
West at the turn of the 20th century, but
Nightingale’s influence on the nursing profes-
sion waned as student nurses in hospital-based
training schools were taught nursing primarily
by physicians. Nursing became strongly influ-
enced by the “medical model” and for some
time lost its identity as a distinct profession.
Slowly, nursing education moved into in-
stitutions of higher learning where students
were taught by nurses with higher degrees. By
1936, 66 colleges and universities had bac-
calaureate programs (Peplau, 1987). Graduate
programs began in the 1940s and grew signifi-
cantly from the 50s through the 1970s.
The publication of the journal Nursing Re-
search in 1952 was a milestone, signifying the
birth of nursing as a fledgling science (Peplau,
1987). But well into the 1940s, “many text-
books for nurses, often written by physicians,
clergy or psychologists, reminded nurses that
theory was too much for them, that nurses did
not need to think but rather merely to follow
rules, be obedient, be compassionate, do their
‘duty’ and carry out medical orders” (Peplau,
1987, p. 18). We’ve come a long way in a mere
70 years.
The development of nursing curricula stim-
ulated discussion about the nature of nursing
as distinct from medicine. In the 1950s, early
nursing scholars such as Hildegard Peplau,
Virginia Henderson, Dorothy Johnson, and
CHAPTER 1 • Nursing Theory and the Discipline of Nursing 9
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:35 AM Page 9
Lydia Hall established the distinct character-
istics of nursing as a profession and field
of study. Faye Abdellah, Ida Jean Orlando,
Joyce Travelbee, Ernestine Wiedenbach, Myra
Levine, and Imogene King followed during
the 1960s, elaborating their conceptualizations
of nursing. During the early 1960s, the federally-
funded Nurse Scientist Program was initiated
to educate nurses in pursuit of doctoral degrees
in the basic sciences. Through this program
nurses received doctorates in education, soci-
ology, physiology, and psychology. These grad-
uates brought the scientific traditions of these
disciplines into nursing as they assumed faculty
positions in schools of nursing.
By the 1970s, nursing theory development
became a priority for the profession and the
discipline of nursing was becoming estab-
lished. Martha Rogers, Callista Roy, Dorothea
Orem, Betty Newman, and Josephine Pater-
son and Loraine Zderad published their theo-
ries and graduate students began studying and
advancing these theories through research.
During this time, the National League for
Nursing required a theory-based curriculum as
a standard for accreditation, so schools of nurs-
ing were expected to select, develop, and im-
plement a conceptual framework for their
curricula. This propelled the advancement of
theoretical thinking in nursing. (Meleis, 1992).
A national conference on nursing theory and
the Nursing Theory Think Tanks were formed
to engage nursing leaders in dialogue about the
place of theory in the evolution of nursing sci-
ence. The linkages between theory, research,
and philosophy were debated in the literature,
and Advances in Nursing Science, the premiere
journal for publishing theoretical articles, was
launched.
In the 1980s additional grand theories such
as Parse’s man-living-health (later changed
to human becoming); Newman’s health as
expanding consciousness; Leininger’s tran-
scultural nursing; Erickson, Tomlinson, and
Swain’s modeling and role modeling; and
Watson’s transpersonal caring were dissemi-
nated. Nursing theory conferences were con-
vened, frequently attracting large numbers of
participants. Those scholars working with the
published theories in research and practice
formalized networks into organizations and
held conferences. For example the Society for
Rogerian Scholars held the first Rogerian
Conference; the Transcultural Nursing Society
was formed, and the International Association
for Human Caring was formed. Some of these
organizations developed journals publishing
the work of scholars advancing these concep-
tual models and grand theories. Metatheorists
such as Jacqueline Fawcett, Peggy Chinn, and
Joyce Fitzpatrick and Ann Whall published
books on nursing theory, making nursing
theories more accessible to students. Theory
courses were established in graduate programs
in nursing. The Fuld Foundation supported a
series of videotaped interviews of many theo-
rists, and the National League for Nursing dis-
seminated videos promoting theory within
nursing. Nursing Science Quarterly, a journal
focused exclusively on advancing extant nurs-
ing theories, published its first issue in 1988.
During the 1990s, the expansion of con-
ceptual models and grand theories in nursing
continued to deepen, and forces within nurs-
ing both promoted and inhibited this expan-
sion. The theorists and their students began
conducting research and developing practice
models that made the theories more visible.
Regulatory bodies in Canada required that
every hospital be guided by some nursing the-
ory. This accelerated the development of nurs-
ing theory–guided practice within Canada and
the United States. The accrediting bodies of
nursing programs pulled back on their require-
ment of a specified conceptual framework
guiding nursing curricula. Because of this,
there were fewer programs guided by specific
conceptualizations of nursing, and possibly
fewer students had a strong grounding in the
theoretical foundations of nursing. Fewer
grand theories emerged; only Boykin and
Schoenhofer’s nursing as caring grand theory
was published during this time. Middle-range
theories emerged to provide more descriptive,
explanatory, and predictive models around
circumscribed phenomena of interest to nurs-
ing. For example, Meleis’s transition theory,
Mishel’s uncertainty theory, Barrett’s power
10 SECTION I • An Introduction to Nursing Theory
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:35 AM Page 10
theory, and Pender’s health promotion model
were generating interest.
From 2000 to the present, there has been
accelerated development of middle-range the-
ories with less interest in conceptual models
and grand theories. There seems to be a de-
valuing of nursing theory; many graduate pro-
grams have eliminated their required nursing
theory courses, and baccalaureate programs
may not include the development of concep-
tualizations of nursing into their curricula. This
has the potential for creating generations of
nurses who have no comprehension of the im-
portance of theory for understanding the focus
of the discipline and the diverse, rich legacy
of nursing knowledge from these theoretical
perspectives.
On the other hand, health-care organiza-
tions have been more active in promoting at-
tention to theoretical applications in nursing
practice. For example, those hospitals on the
magnet journey are required to select a guiding
nursing framework for practice. Watson’s the-
ory of caring is guiding nursing practice in a
group of acute care hospitals. These hospitals
have formed a consortium so that best prac-
tices can be shared across settings.
Although nursing research is advancing and
making a difference in people’s lives, the re-
search may not be linked explicitly to theory,
and probably not linked to nursing theory. This
compromises the advancement of nursing sci-
ence. All other disciplines teach their founda-
tional theories to their students, and their
scientists test or develop their theories through
research.
There is a trend toward valuing theories
from other disciplines over nursing theories.
For example, motivational interviewing is a
practice theory out of psychology that nurse re-
searchers and practitioners are gravitating to in
large numbers. Arguably, there are several sim-
ilar nursing theoretical approaches to engaging
others in health promotion behaviors that pre-
ceded motivational interviewing, yet these
have not been explored. Interprofessional prac-
tice and interdisciplinary research are essential
for the future of health care, but we do not do
justice to this concept by abandoning the rich,
distinguishing features of nursing science over
others.
If nursing is to advance as a science in its
own right, future generations of nurses must re-
spect and advance the theoretical legacy of our
discipline. Scientific growth happens through
cumulative knowledge development with cur-
rent research building on previous findings. To
survive and thrive, nursing theories must be
used in nursing practice and research.
The Structure of Knowledge
in the Discipline of Nursing
Theories are part of the knowledge structure
of any discipline. The domain of inquiry (also
called the metaparadigm or focus of the disci-
pline) is the foundation of the structure. The
knowledge of the discipline is related to its
general domain or focus. For example, knowl-
edge of biology relates to the study of living
things; psychology is the study of the mind;
sociology is the study of social structures and
behaviors. Nursing’s domain was discussed
earlier and relates to the disciplinary focus
statement or metaparadigm. Other levels of
the knowledge structure include paradigms,
conceptual models or grand theories, middle-
range theories, practice theories, and research
and practice traditions. These levels of nursing
knowledge are interrelated; each level of devel-
opment is influenced by work at other levels.
Theoretical work in nursing must be dynamic;
that is, it must be continually in process and
useful for the purposes and work of the disci-
pline. It must be open to adapting and extend-
ing to guide nursing endeavors and to reflect
development within nursing. Although there
is diversity of opinion among nurses about the
terms used to describe the levels of theory, the
following discussion of theoretical develop-
ment in nursing is offered as a context for
further understanding nursing theory.
Paradigm
Paradigm is the next level of the disciplinary
structure of nursing. The notion of paradigm can
be useful as a basis for understanding nursing
CHAPTER 1 • Nursing Theory and the Discipline of Nursing 11
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:35 AM Page 11
knowledge. A paradigm is a global, general
framework made up of assumptions about
aspects of the discipline held by members to
be essential in development of the discipline.
Paradigms are particular perspectives on the
metaparadigm or disciplinary domain. The
concept of paradigm comes from the work of
Kuhn (1970, 1977), who used the term to
describe models that guide scientific activity
and knowledge development in disciplines.
Because paradigms are broad, shared perspec-
tives held by members of the discipline, they
are often called “worldviews.” Kuhn set forth
the view that science does not always evolve as
a smooth, regular, continuing path of knowl-
edge development over time, but that period-
ically there are times of revolution when
traditional thought is challenged by new ideas,
and “paradigm shifts” occur.
Kuhn’s ideas provide a way for us to think
about the development of science. Before any
discipline engages in the development of theory
and research to advance its knowledge, it is
in a preparadigmatic period of development.
Typically, this is followed by a period of time
when a single paradigm emerges to guide
knowledge development. Research activities
initiated around this paradigm advance its the-
ories. This is a time during which knowledge
advances at a regular pace. At times, a new par-
adigm can emerge to challenge the worldview
of the existing paradigm. It can be revolution-
ary, overthrowing the previous paradigm, or
multiple paradigms can coexist in a discipline,
providing different worldviews that guide the
scientific development of the discipline.
Kuhn’s work has meaning for nursing and
other scientific disciplines because of his recog-
nition that science is the work of a community
of scholars in the context of society. Paradigms
and worldviews of nursing are subtle and pow-
erful, reflecting different values and beliefs
about the nature of human beings, human–en-
vironment relationships, health, and caring.
Kuhn’s (1970, 1977) description of scientific
development is particularly relevant to nursing
today as new perspectives are being articulated,
some traditional views are being strengthened,
and some views are taking their places as part
of our history. As we continue to move away
from the historical conception of nursing as
a part of biomedical science, developments
in the nursing discipline are directed by at
least two paradigms, or worldviews, outside
the medical model. These are now described.
Several nursing scholars have named the ex-
isting paradigms in the discipline of nursing
(Fawcett, 1995; Newman et al., 1991; Parse,
1987). Parse (1987) described two paradigms:
the totality and the simultaneity. The totality
paradigm reflects a worldview that humans are
integrated beings with biological, psychological,
sociocultural, and spiritual dimensions. Humans
adapt to their environments, and health and ill-
ness are states on a continuum. In the simultane-
ity paradigm, humans are unitary, irreducible,
and in continuous mutual process with the
environment (Rogers, 1970, 1992). Health is
subjectively defined and reflects a process of
becoming or evolving. In contrast to Parse,
Newman and her colleagues (1991) identi-
fied three paradigms in nursing: particulate–
deterministic, integrative–interactive, and unitary–
transformative. From the perspective of the
particulate–deterministic paradigm, humans are
known through parts; health is the absence
of disease; and predictability and control
are essential for health management. In the
integrative–interactive paradigm, humans are
viewed as systems with interrelated dimensions
interacting with the environment, and change
is probabilistic. The worldview of the unitary–
transformative paradigm describes humans as
patterned, self-organizing fields within larger
patterned, self-organizing fields. Change
is characterized by fluctuating rhythms of
organization–disorganization toward more
complex organization. Health is a reflection of
this continuous change. Fawcett (1995, 2000)
provided yet another model of nursing para-
digms: reaction, reciprocal interaction, and si-
multaneous action. In the reaction paradigm,
humans are the sum of their parts, reaction is
causal, and stability is valued. In the reciprocal
interaction worldview, the parts are seen within
the context of a larger whole, there is a reciprocal
nature to the relationship with the environment,
and change is based on multiple factors. Finally,
the simultaneous-action worldview includes a
belief that humans are known by pattern and are
12 SECTION I • An Introduction to Nursing Theory
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:35 AM Page 12
in an open ever-changing process with the
environment. Change is unpredictable and
evolving toward greater complexity (Smith,
2008, pp. 4–5).
It may help you to think of theories being
clustered within these nursing paradigms.
Many theories share the worldview established
by a particular paradigm. At present, multiple
paradigms coexist within nursing.
Grand Theories and
Conceptual Models
Grand theories and conceptual models are at
the next level in the structure of the discipline.
They are less abstract than the focus of the dis-
cipline and paradigms but more abstract than
middle-range theories. Conceptual models and
grand theories focus on the phenomena of con-
cern to the discipline such as persons as adaptive
systems, self-care deficits, unitary human be-
ings, human becoming, or health as expanding
consciousness. The grand theories, or concep-
tual models, are composed of concepts and re-
lational statements. Relational statements on
which the theories are built are called assump-
tions and often reflect the foundational philoso-
phies of the conceptual model or grand theory.
These philosophies are statements of enduring
values and beliefs; they may be practical guides
for the conduct of nurses applying the theory
and can be used to determine the compatibility
of the model or theory with personal, profes-
sional, organizational, and societal beliefs and
values. Fawcett (2000) differentiated conceptual
models and grand theories. For her, conceptual
models, also called conceptual frameworks or
conceptual systems, are sets of general concepts
and propositions that provide perspectives on
the major concepts of the metaparadigm: per-
son, environment, health, and nursing. Fawcett
(1993, 2000) pointed out that direction for re-
search must be described as part of the concep-
tual model to guide development and testing of
nursing theories. We do not differentiate be-
tween conceptual models and grand theories
and use the terms interchangeably.
Middle-Range Theories
Middle-range theories comprise the next level
in the structure of the discipline. Robert Merton
(1968) described this level of theory in the field
of sociology, stating that they are theories
broad enough to be useful in complex situa-
tions and appropriate for empirical testing.
Nursing scholars proposed using this level of
theory because of the difficulty in testing grand
theory (Jacox, 1974). Middle-range theories
are narrower in scope than grand theories and
offer an effective bridge between grand theo-
ries and the description and explanation of
specific nursing phenomena. They present con-
cepts and propositions at a lower level of ab-
straction and hold great promise for increasing
theory-based research and nursing practice
strategies (Smith & Liehr, 2008). Several
middle-range theories are included in this
book. Middle-range theories may have their
foundations in a particular paradigmatic per-
spective or may be derived from a grand theory
or conceptual model. The literature presents a
growing number of middle-range theories.
This level of theory is expanding most rapidly
in the discipline and represents some of the
most exciting work published in nursing today.
Some of these new theories are synthesized
from knowledge from related disciplines and
transformed through a nursing lens (Eakes,
Burke, & Hainsworth, 1998; Lenz, Suppe,
Gift, Pugh, & Milligan, 1995; Polk, 1997).
The literature also offers middle-range nursing
theories that are directly related to grand the-
ories of nursing (Ducharme, Ricard, Duquette,
Levesque, & Lachance, 1998; Dunn, 2004;
Olson & Hanchett, 1997). Reports of nursing
theory developed at this level include implica-
tions for instrument development, theory test-
ing through research, and nursing practice
strategies.
Practice-Level Theories
Practice-level theories have the most limited
scope and level of abstraction and are developed
for use within a specific range of nursing situa-
tions. Theories developed at this level have a
more direct effect on nursing practice than do
more abstract theories. Nursing practice theories
provide frameworks for nursing interventions/
activities and suggest outcomes and/or the effect
of nursing practice. Nursing actions may be
described or developed as nursing practice
CHAPTER 1 • Nursing Theory and the Discipline of Nursing 13
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:35 AM Page 13
theories. Ideally, nursing practice theories are
interrelated with concepts from middle-range
theories or developed under the framework of
grand theories. A theory developed at this level
has been called a prescriptive theory (Crowley,
1968; Dickoff, James, & Wiedenbach, 1968), a
situation-specific theory (Meleis, 1997), and a
micro-theory (Chinn & Kramer, 2011). The
day-to-day experience of nurses is a major
source of nursing practice theory.
The depth and complexity of nursing
practice may be fully appreciated as nursing
phenomena and relations among aspects of
particular nursing situations are described and
explained. Dialogue with expert nurses in
practice can be fruitful for discovery and de-
velopment of practice theory. Research find-
ings on various nursing problems offer data
to develop nursing practice theories. Nursing
practice theory has been articulated using
multiple ways of knowing through reflective
practice (Johns & Freshwater, 1998). The
process includes quiet reflection on practice,
remembering and noting features of nursing
situations, attending to one’s own feelings,
reevaluating the experience, and integrating
new knowing with other experience (Gray
& Forsstrom, 1991). The LIGHT model
(Andersen & Smereck, 1989) and the atten-
dant nurse caring model (Watson & Foster,
2003) are examples of the development of
practice level theories.
Associated Research and
Practice Traditions
Research traditions are the associated meth-
ods, procedures, and empirical indicators that
guide inquiry related to the theory. For exam-
ple, the theories of health as expanding con-
sciousness, human becoming, and cultural care
diversity and universality have specific associ-
ated research methods. Other theories have
specific tools that have been developed to
measure constructs related to the theories. The
practice tradition of the theory consists of the
activities, protocols, processes, tools, and prac-
tice wisdom emerging from the theory. Several
conceptual models and grand theories have
specific associated practice methods.
Nursing Theory and the Future
Nursing theory is essential to the continuing
evolution of the discipline of nursing. Several
trends are evident in the development and use
of nursing theory. First, there seems to be
more agreement on the focus of the discipline
of nursing that provides a meaningful direction
for our study and inquiry. This disciplinary di-
alogue has extended beyond the confines of
Fawcett’s metaparadigm and explicates the im-
portance of caring and relationship as central
to the discipline of nursing (Newman et al.,
2008; Roy & Jones, 2007; Willis et al., 2008).
The development of new grand theories and
conceptual models has decreased. Dossey’s
(2008) theory of integral nursing, included in
this book, is the only new theory at this level
that has been developed in nearly 20 years. In-
stead, the growth in theory development is at
the middle-range and practice levels. There has
been a significant increase in middle-range
theories, and many practice scholars are work-
ing on developing and implementing practice
models based on grand theories or conceptual
models.
Several changes in the teaching and learning
of nursing theory are troubling. Many bac-
calaureate programs include little nursing the-
ory in their curricula. Similarly, some graduate
programs are eliminating or decreasing their
emphasis on nursing theory. This alarming
trend deserves our attention. If nursing is to
continue to thrive and to make a difference
in the lives of people, our practitioners and
researchers need to practice and expand knowl-
edge within the structure of the discipline.
As health care becomes more interprofessional,
the focus of nursing becomes even more im-
portant. If nurses do not learn and practice
based on the knowledge of their discipline, they
may be co-opted into the practice of another
discipline. Even worse, another discipline could
emerge that will assume practices associated
with the discipline of nursing. For example,
health coaching is emerging as an area of prac-
tice focused on providing people with help
as they make health-related changes in their
lives. However, this is the practice of nursing,
as articulated by many nursing theories.
14 SECTION I • An Introduction to Nursing Theory
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:35 AM Page 14
On a positive note, nursing theories are
being embraced by health-care organizations
to structure nursing practice. For example,
organizations embarking on the journey to-
ward magnet status (www.nursecredentialing
.org/magnet) are required to identify a theo-
retical perspective that guides nursing practice,
and many are choosing existing nursing mod-
els. This work has great potential to refine and
extend nursing theories.
The use of nursing theory in research is in-
consistent at best. Often, outcomes research
is not contextualized within any theoretical
perspective; however, reviewers of proposals
for most funding agencies request theoretical
frameworks, and scoring criteria give points for
having one. This encourages theoretical think-
ing and organizing findings within a broader
perspective. Nurses often use theories from
other disciplines instead of their own and this
expands the knowledge of another discipline.
We are hopeful about the growth, continu-
ing development, and expanded use of nursing
theory. We hope that there will be continued
growth in the development of all levels of nurs-
ing theory. The students of all professional dis-
ciplines study the theories of their disciplines
in their courses of study. We must continue to
include the study of nursing theories within our
baccalaureate, master’s, and doctoral programs.
Baccalaureate students need to understand the
foundations for the discipline, our historical de-
velopment, and the place of nursing theory in
its history and future. They should learn about
conceptual models and grand theories. Didactic
and practice courses should reflect theoretical
values and concepts so that students learn to
practice nursing from a theoretical perspective.
Middle-range theories should be included in
the study of particular phenomena such as self-
transcendence, sorrow, and uncertainty. As they
prepare to become practice leaders of the disci-
pline, doctor of nursing practice students should
learn to develop and test nursing theory-guided
models. PhD students will learn to develop and
extend nursing theories in their research. New
and expanded nursing specialties, such as nurs-
ing informatics, call for development and use
of nursing theory (Effken, 2003). New, more
open and inclusive ways to theorize about nurs-
ing will be developed. These new ways will ac-
knowledge the history and traditions of nursing
but will move nursing forward into new realms
of thinking and being. Reed (1995) noted
the “ground shifting” with the reforming of
philosophies of nursing science and called for
a more open philosophy, grounded in nursing’s
values, which connects science, philosophy, and
practice. Gray and Pratt (1991, p. 454) pro-
jected that nursing scholars will continue to de-
velop theories at all levels of abstraction and
that theories will be increasingly interdepend-
ent with other disciplines such as politics, eco-
nomics, and ethics. These authors expect a
continuing emphasis on unifying theory and
practice that will contribute to the validation of
the nursing discipline. Theorists will work in
groups to develop knowledge in an area of con-
cern to nursing, and these phenomena of inter-
est, rather than the name of the author, will
define the theory (Meleis, 1992). Newman
(2003) called for a future in which we transcend
competition and boundaries that have been
constructed between nursing theories and in-
stead appreciate the links among theories, thus
moving toward a fuller, more inclusive, and
richer understanding of nursing knowledge.
Nursing’s philosophies and theories must
increasingly reflect nursing’s values for under-
standing, respect, and commitment to health
beliefs and practices of cultures throughout
the world. It is important to question to what
extent theories developed and used in one
major culture are appropriate for use in other
cultures. To what extent must nursing theory
be relevant in multicultural contexts? Despite
efforts of many international scholarly soci-
eties, how relevant are American nursing the-
ories for the global community? Can nursing
theories inform us about how to stand with
and learn from peoples of the world? Can we
learn from nursing theory how to come to
know those we nurse, how to be with them, to
truly listen and hear? Can these questions be
recognized as appropriate for scholarly work
and practice for graduate students in nursing?
Will these issues offer direction for studies
of doctoral students? If so, nursing theory
CHAPTER 1 • Nursing Theory and the Discipline of Nursing 15
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:35 AM Page 15
will prepare nurses for humane leadership in
national and global health policy. Perspec-
tives of various times and worlds in relation to
present nursing concerns were described by
Schoenhofer (1994). Abdellah (McAuliffe,
1998) proposed an international electronic
“think tank” for nurses around the globe to di-
alogue about nursing theory. Such opportuni-
ties could lead nurses to truly listen, learn, and
adapt theoretical perspectives to accommodate
cultural variations.
16 SECTION I • An Introduction to Nursing Theory
■ Summary
This chapter focused on the place of nursing
theory within the discipline of nursing. The re-
lationship and importance of nursing theory
to the characteristics of a professional disci-
pline were reviewed. A variety of definitions of
theory were offered, and the evolution and
structure of knowledge in the discipline was
outlined. Finally, we reviewed trends and spec-
ulated about the future of nursing theory de-
velopment and application. One challenge of
nursing theory is that theory is always in the
process of developing and that, at the same
time, it is useful for the purposes and work of
the discipline. This paradox may be seen as
ambiguous or as full of possibilities. Continu-
ing students of the discipline are required to
study and know the basis for their contribu-
tions to nursing and to those we serve; at the
same time, they must be open to new ways
of thinking, knowing, and being in nursing.
Exploring structures of nursing knowledge and
understanding the nature of nursing as a pro-
fessional discipline provide a frame of refer-
ence to clarify nursing theory.
References
Allison, S. E., & McLaughlin-Renpenning, K. E.
(1999). Nursing administration in the 21st century: A
self-care theory approach. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Andersen, M. D., & Smereck, G. A. D. (1989). Per-
sonalized nursing LIGHT model. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 2, 120–130.
Barnum, B. S. (1998). Nursing theory: Analysis, applica-
tion, evaluation (5th ed.). Philadelphia: Lippincott,
Williams & Wilkins.
Chinn, P., & Jacobs, M. (1987). Theory and nursing:
A systematic approach. St. Louis, MO: Mosby.
Chinn, P., & Kramer, M. (2004). Integrated knowledge
development in nursing. St. Louis, MO: Mosby.
Chinn, P., & Kramer, M. (2011). Integrated theory and
knowledge development in nursing (8th ed.). St. Louis,
MO: Mosby.
Cody, W. K. (1997). Of tombstones, milestones, and
gemstones: A retrospective and prospective on nurs-
ing theory. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 10(1), 3–5.
Cody, W. K. (2003). Nursing theory as a guide to
practice. Nursing Science Quarterly, 16(3), 225–231.
Colley, S. (2003). Nursing theory: Its importance to
practice. Nursing Standard, 17(56), 33–37.
Crowley, D. (1968). Perspectives of pure science.
Nursing Research, 17(6), 497–501.
Dickoff, J., & James, P. (1968). A theory of theories:
A position paper. Nursing Research, 17(3), 197–203.
Dickoff, J., James, P., & Wiedenbach, E. (1968). Theory in
a practice discipline. Nursing Research, 17(5), 415–435.
Donaldson, S. K., & Crowley, D. M. (1978). The disci-
pline of nursing. Nursing Outlook, 26(2), 113–120.
Dossey, B. (2008). Theory of integral nursing. Advances
in Nursing Science, 31(1), E52–E73.
Ducharme, F., Ricard, N., Duquette, A., Levesque, L.,
& Lachance, L. (1998). Empirical testing of a longi-
tudinal model derived from the Roy adaptation
model. Nursing Science Quarterly, 11(4), 149–159.
Dunn, K. S. (2004). Toward a middle-range theory
of adaptation to chronic pain. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 17(1), 78–84.
Eakes, G., Burke, M., & Hainsworth, M. (1998).
Middle-range theory of chronic sorrow. Image:
Journal of Nursing Scholarship, 30(2), 179–184.
Effken, J. A. (2003). An organizing framework for
nursing informatics research. Computers Informatics
Nursing, 21(6), 316–325.
Ellis, R. (1968). Characteristics of significant theories.
Nursing Research, 17(3), 217–222.
Fawcett, J. (1984). The metaparadigm of nursing: Cur-
rent status and future refinements. Image: Journal
of Nursing Scholarship, 16, 84–87.
Fawcett, J. (1993). Analysis and evaluation of nursing
theory. Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Fawcett, J. (1995). Analysis and evaluation of conceptual
models of nursing (3rd ed.). Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:36 AM Page 16
Fawcett, J. (2000). Analysis and evaluation of contempo-
rary nursing knowledge: Nursing models and nursing
theories. Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Fitzpatrick, J. (1997). Nursing theory and metatheory.
In I. King & J. Fawcett (Eds.), The language of nurs-
ing theory and metatheory. Indianapolis, IN: Center
Nursing Press.
Gioiella, E. C. (1996). The importance of theory-guided
research and practice in the changing health care
scene. Nursing Science Quarterly, 9(2), 47.
Gray, J., & Forsstrom, S. (1991). Generating theory
for practice: The reflective technique. In J. Gray &
R. Pratt (Eds.), Towards a discipline of nursing.
Melbourne: Churchill Livingstone.
Gray, J., & Pratt, R. (Eds.). (1991). Towards a discipline
of nursing. Melbourne: Churchill Livingstone.
Hart, M., & Foster, S. (1998). Self-care agency in two
groups of pregnant women. Nursing Science Quarterly,
11(4), 167–171.
Jacox, A. (1974). Theory construction in nursing: An
overview. Nursing Research, 23(1), 4–13.
Jennings, B. M., & Staggers, N. (1998). The language of
outcomes. Advances in Nursing Science, 20(4), 72–80.
Johns, C., & Freshwater, D. (1998). Transforming
nursing through reflective practice. London: Oxford
University Press.
Kim, H. (1987). Structuring the nursing knowledge sys-
tem: A typology of four domains. Scholarly Inquiry
for Nursing Practice: An International Journal, 1(1),
99–110.
Kim, H. (1997). Terminology in structuring and devel-
oping nursing knowledge. In I. King & J. Fawcett
(Eds.), The language of nursing theory and metatheory.
Indianapolis, IN: Center Nursing Press.
King, A. R., & Brownell, J. A. (1976). The curriculum and
the disciplines of knowledge. Huntington, NY: Robert
E. Krieger.
Kleffel, D. (1996). Environmental paradigms: Moving
toward an ecocentric perspective. Advances in
Nursing Science, 18(4), 1–10.
Kuhn, T. (1970). The structure of scientific revolutions
(2nd ed.). Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Kuhn, T. (1977). The essential tension: Selected studies in
scientific tradition and change. Chicago: University
of Chicago Press.
Leininger, M. (1987). Transcultural nursing. New York:
Wiley.
Lenz, E. R, Suppe, F., Gift, A. G., Pugh, L. C., &
Milligan, R. A. (1995). Collaborative development
of middle-range theories: Toward a theory of
unpleasant symptoms. Advances in Nursing Science,
17(3), 1–13.
Litchfield, M., & Jondorsdottir, H. (2008). The practice
discipline that’s here and now. Advances in Nursing
Science, 31(1), E79–91.
McAuliffe, M. (1998). Interview with Faye G. Abdellah
on nursing research and health policy. Image: Journal
of Nursing Scholarship, 30(3), 215–219.
McKay, R. (1969). Theories, models and systems for
nursing. Nursing Research, 18(5), 393–399.
Meleis, A. (1992). Directions for nursing theory develop-
ment in the 21st century. Nursing Science Quarterly, 5,
112–117.
Meleis, A. (1997). Theoretical nursing: Development and
progress. Philadelphia: Lippincott.
Meleis, A. (2012). Theoretical nursing: Development and
progress (5th ed.). Philadelphia: Lippincott, Williams
and Wilkins.
Merton, R. (1968). Social theory and social structure.
New York: The Free Press.
Newman, M. (2003). A world of no boundaries.
Advances in Nursing Science, 26(4), 240–245.
Newman, M., Sime, A., & Corcoran-Perry, S. (1991).
The focus of the discipline of nursing. Advances in
Nursing Science, 14(1), 1–6.
Newman, M., Smith, M. C., Dexheimer-Pharris, M., &
Jones, D. (2008). The focus of the discipline of
nursing revisited. Advances in Nursing Science, 31(1),
E16–E27.
Nightingale, F. (1859/1992). Notes on nursing: What it is
and what it is not. Philadelphia: Lippincott.
Olson, J., & Hanchett, E. (1997). Nurse-expressed
empathy, patient outcomes, and development of a
middle-range theory. Image: Journal of Nursing
Scholarship, 29(1), 71–76.
Parse, R. (1987). Nursing science: Major paradigms,
theories and critiques. Philadelphia: W. B. Saunders.
Parse, R. (1997). Nursing and medicine: Two different
disciplines. Nursing Science Quarterly, 6(3), 109.
Parse, R. (1998). The human becoming school of thought:
A perspective for nurses and other health professionals.
Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Parsons, T. (1949). Structure of social action. Glencoe, IL:
The Free Press.
Peplau, H. E. (1987). Nursing science: A historical
perspective. In R. R. Parse (Ed.), Nursing science:
Major paradigms, theories and critiques (pp. 13–29).
Philadelphia: Saunders.
Polk, L. (1997). Toward a middle-range theory of re-
silience. Advances in Nursing Science, 19(3), 1–13.
Reed, P. (1995). A treatise on nursing knowledge
development for the 21st century: Beyond postmod-
ernism. Advances in Nursing Science, 17(3), 70–84.
Rogers, M. E. (1970). An introduction to the theoretical
basis of nursing. Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Rogers, M. E. (1992). Nursing science and the space
age. Nursing Science Quarterly, 5, 27–34.
Roy, C., & Jones, D. (Eds). (2007). Nursing knowledge
development and clinical practice. New York: Springer.
Schoenhofer, S. (1994). Transforming visions for nurs-
ing in the timeworld of Einstein’s Dreams. Advances
in Nursing Science, 16(4), 1–8.
Schuster, E., & Brown, C. (1994). Exploring our envi-
ronmental connections. New York: National League
for Nursing.
CHAPTER 1 • Nursing Theory and the Discipline of Nursing 17
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:36 AM Page 17
Silva, M. (1997). Philosophy, theory, and research in
nursing: A linguistic journey to nursing practice. In
I. King & J. Fawcett (Eds.), The language of nursing
theory and metatheory. Indianapolis, IN: Center
Nursing Press.
Smith, M. C. (1994). Arriving at a philosophy of
nursing: In J. F. Kikuchi & H. Simmons (Eds.),
Developing a philosophy of nursing (pp. 43–60).
Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Smith, M. C. (2008). Disciplinary perspectives linked
to middle range theory. In M. J. Smith & P. R.
Liehr (Eds.), Middle range theory for nursing (2nd ed.,
pp. 1–12). New York: Springer.
Smith, M. J., & Liehr, P. R. (2013). Middle range theory
for nursing (3rd ed.). New York: Springer.
Stevenson, J. S., & Tripp-Reimer, T. (Eds.). (1990).
Knowledge about care and caring. In Proceedings of a
Wingspread Conference (February 1–3, 1989). Kansas
City, MO: American Academy of Nursing, 1990.
Walker, L., & Avant, K. (1995). Strategies for theory
construction in nursing. Norwalk, CT: Appleton-
Century-Crofts.
Watson, J. (1985). Nursing: Human science and human
care. Norwalk, CT: Appleton-Century-Crofts.
Watson, J., & Foster, R. (2003). The attending nurse
caring model: Integrating theory, evidence and ad-
vanced caring-healing therapeutics for transforming
professional practice. Journal of Clinical Nursing, 12,
360–365.
Willis, D., Grace, P., & Roy, C. (2008). A central unify-
ing focus for the discipline: Facilitating humaniza-
tion, meaning, quality of life and healing in living and
dying. Advances in Nursing Science, 31(1), E28–E40.
18 SECTION I • An Introduction to Nursing Theory
3312_Ch01_001-018 26/12/14 9:36 AM Page 18
Chapter 2A Guide for the Study of
Nursing Theories for Practice
MARILYN E. PARKER AND
MARLAINE C. SMITH
Study of Theory for Nursing Practice
A Guide for Study of Nursing Theory for
Use in Practice
Summary
References
Marlaine C. SmithMarilyn E. Parker
19
Nursing is a professional discipline, a field of
study focused on human health and healing
through caring (Smith, 1994). The knowledge
of the discipline includes nursing science, art,
philosophy, and ethics. Nursing science in-
cludes the conceptual models, theories, and re-
search specific to the discipline. As in other
sciences such as biology, psychology, or soci-
ology, the study of nursing science requires a
disciplined approach. This chapter offers a
guide to this disciplined approach in the form
of a set of questions that facilitate reflection,
exploration, and a deeper study of the selected
nursing theories.
As you read the chapters in this book, use
the questions in the guide to facilitate your
study. These chapters offer you an introduction
to a variety of nursing theories, which we hope
will ignite interest in deeper exploration of
some of the theories through reading the
books written by the theorists and other pub-
lished articles related to the use of the theories
in practice and research. This book’s online re-
sources can provide additional materials as you
continue your exploration.1 The questions in
this guide can lead you toward this deeper
study of the selected nursing theories.
Rapid and dramatic changes are affecting
nurses everywhere. Health-care delivery
systems are in crisis and in need of real
change. Hospitals continue to be the largest
employers of nurses, and some hospitals
are recognizing the need to develop nursing
theory–guided practice models. A criterion for
hospitals seeking magnet hospital designation
1For additional information please go to bonus chapter
content available at FA Davis http://davisplus.fadavis.com
3312_Ch02_019-022 26/12/14 10:04 AM Page 19
by the American Nurses Credentialing Cen-
ter (www.nursecredentialing.org/magnet) in-
cludes the selection of a theoretical model for
practice. The list of questions in this chapter
can be useful to nurses as they select theories
to guide practice.
Increasingly, nurses are practicing in diverse
settings and often develop organized nursing
practices through which accessible health care
to communities can be provided. Community
members may be active participants in select-
ing, designing, and evaluating the nursing
they receive. In these situations, it is important
for nurses and the communities they serve to
identify the approach to nursing that is most
consistent with the community’s values. The
questions in this chapter can be helpful in the
mutual exploration of theoretical approaches
to practice.
In the current health-care environment, in-
terprofessional practice is the desired standard.
This does not mean that practicing from a
nursing-theoretical base is any less important.
Interprofessional practice means that each dis-
cipline brings its own lens or perspective to the
patient care situation. Nursing’s lens is essen-
tial for a complete picture of the person’s
health and for the goals of caring and healing.
The nursing theory selected will provide this
lens, and the questions in this chapter can as-
sist nurses in selecting the theory or theories
that will guide their unique contribution to the
interprofessional team.
Theories and practices from a variety of dis-
ciplines inform the practice of nursing. The
scope of nursing practice is continually being
expanded to include additional knowledge
and skills from related disciplines, such as
medicine and psychology. Again, this does
not diminish the need for practice based on a
nursing theory, and these guiding questions
help to differentiate the knowledge and prac-
tice of nursing from those of other disciplines.
For example, nurse practitioners may draw on
their knowledge of pathophysiology, pharma-
cology, and psychology as they provide primary
care. Nursing theories will guide the way of
viewing the person,2 inform the way of relating
with the person, and direct the goals of prac-
tice with the person.
Groups of nurses working together as col-
leagues to provide care often realize that they
share the same values and beliefs about nurs-
ing. The study of nursing theories can clarify
the purposes of nursing and facilitate build-
ing a cohesive practice to meet them. Re-
gardless of the setting of nursing practice,
nurses may choose to study nursing theories
together to design and articulate theory-
guided practice.
The study of nursing theory precedes the
activities of analysis and evaluation. The eval-
uation of a theory involves preparation, judg-
ment, and justification (Smith, 2013). In the
preparation phase, the student of the theory
spends time coming to know it by reading and
reflecting on it. The best approach involves
intellectual empathy, curiosity, honesty, and
responsibility (Smith, 2013). Through reading
and dwelling with the theory, the student tries
to understand it from the point of view of the
theorist. Curiosity leads to raising questions in
the quest for greater understanding. It involves
imagining ways the theory might work in prac-
tice, as well as the challenges it might present.
Honesty involves knowing oneself and being
true to one’s own values and beliefs in the
process of understanding. Some theories may
resonate with deeply held values; others may
conflict with them. It is important to listen to
these inner messages of comfort or discomfort,
for they will be important in the selection of
theories for practice.
Each member of a professional discipline
has a responsibility to take the time and put in
the effort to understand the theories of that dis-
cipline. In nursing, there is an even greater re-
sponsibility to understand and be true to those
that are selected to guide nursing practice.
Responses to questions offered and points
summarized in the guides may be found in
nursing literature, as well as in audiovisual
and electronic resources. Primary source ma-
terial, including the work of nurses who are
recognized authorities in specific nursing the-
ories and the use of nursing theory, should
be used.
20 SECTION I • An Introduction to Nursing Theory
2“Person” refers to individual, family, groups and com-
munities throughout the chapter.
3312_Ch02_019-022 26/12/14 10:04 AM Page 20
Study of Theory for Nursing
Practice
Four main questions (described in the next
section) have been developed and refined to
facilitate the study of nursing theories for use
in nursing practice (Parker, 1993). They focus
on concepts within the theories, as well as on
points of interest and general information
about each theory. This guide was developed
for use by practicing nurses and students in un-
dergraduate and graduate nursing education
programs. Many nurses and students have used
these questions and contributed to their con-
tinuing development. As you study each the-
ory, answer the questions and address the
points in the following guide. You will find the
information you need in the chapters of this
book; other literature, such as books and jour-
nal articles authored by the theorists and other
scholars working with the theories; and audio-
visual and electronic resources.
A Guide for Study of Nursing
Theory for Use in Practice
1. How is nursing conceptualized in the
theory?
Is the focus of nursing stated?
• What does the nurse attend to when
practicing nursing?
• What guides nursing observations,
reflections, decisions, and actions?
• What illustrations or examples show
how the theory is used to guide
practice?
What is the purpose of nursing?
• What do nurses do when they are
practicing nursing based on the theory?
• What are exemplars of nursing assess-
ments, designs, plans, and evaluations?
• What indicators give evidence of the
quality of nursing practice?
• Is the richness and complexity of nursing
practice evident?
What are the boundaries or limits for nursing?
• How is nursing distinguished from other
health-related professions?
• How is nursing related to other disci-
plines and services?
• What is the place of nursing in interpro-
fessional practice?
• What is the range of nursing situations
in which the theory is useful?
How can nursing situations be described?
• What are the attributes of the recipient
of nursing care?
• What are characteristics of the nurse?
• How can interactions between the
nurse and the recipient of nursing be
described?
• Are there environmental requirements
for the practice of nursing? If so, what
are they?
2. What is the context of the theory development?
Who is the nursing theorist as person and as nurse?
• Why did the theorist develop the
theory?
• What is the background of the theorist
as a nursing scholar?
• What central values and beliefs does the
theorist set forth?
What are major theoretical influences on this theory?
• What previous knowledge influenced
the development of this theory?
• What are the relationships between this
theory and other theories?
• What nursing-related theories and
philosophies influenced this theory?
What were major external influences on development of the
theory?
• What were the social, economic, and
political influences that informed the
theory?
• What images of nurses and nursing
influenced the development of the
theory?
• What was the status of nursing as a dis-
cipline and profession at the time of the
theory’s development?
3. Who are authoritative sources for information about
development, evaluation, and use of this theory?
Which nursing authorities speak about, write about, and use
the theory?
• What are the professional attributes of
these persons?
• What are the attributes of authorities,
and how does one become one?
• Which others can be considered
authorities?
CHAPTER 2 • A Guide for the Study of Nursing Theories for Practice 21
3312_Ch02_019-022 26/12/14 10:04 AM Page 21
What major resources are authoritative sources on the theory?
• What books, articles, and audiovisual
and electronic media exist to elucidate
the theory?
• What nursing organizations share and
support work related to the theory?
• What service and academic programs are
authoritative sources for practicing and
teaching the theory?
4. How can the overall significance of the nursing theory
be described?
What is the importance of the nursing theory over time?
• What are exemplars of the theory’s use
that structure and guide individual
practice?
• How has the theory been used to guide
programs of nursing education?
• How has the theory been used to
guide nursing administration and
organizations?
• How does published nursing scholarship
reflect the significance of the theory?
What is the experience of nurses who report consistent use of
the theory?
• What is the range of reports from
practice?
• Has nursing research led to further
theoretical formulations?
• Has the theory been used to develop
new nursing practices?
• Has the theory influenced the design of
methods of nursing inquiry?
• What has been the influence of the
theory on nursing and health policy?
What are projected influences of the theory on nursing’s
future?
• How has the theory influenced the com-
munity of scholars?
• In what ways has nursing as a professional
practice been strengthened by the theory?
• What future possibilities for nursing
have been opened because of this theory?
• What will be the continuing social value
of the theory?
22 SECTION I • An Introduction to Nursing Theory
References
Parker, M. (1993). Patterns of nursing theories in practice.
New York: National League for Nursing.
Smith, M. C. (1994). Arriving at a philosophy of nursing:
Discovering? Constructing? Evolving? In J. Kikuchi &
H. Simmons (Eds.), Developing a philosophy of nursing
(pp. 43–60). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Smith, M. C. (2013). Evaluation of middle range theo-
ries for the discipline of nursing. In M. J. Smith
& P. Liehr (Eds.), Middle range theory for nursing
(3rd ed., pp. 3–14). New York: Springer.
■ Summary
This chapter contains a guide designed for the
study of nursing theory for use in practice. As
members of the professional discipline of nurs-
ing, nurses must engage in the serious study of
the theories of nursing. The implementation of
theory-guided practice models is important for
nursing practice in all settings. The guide pre-
sented in this chapter can lead students on a
journey from a beginning to a deeper under-
standing of nursing theory. The study of nursing
theory precedes its analysis and evaluation. Stu-
dents should approach the study of nursing the-
ory with intellectual empathy, curiosity, honesty,
and responsibility. This guide is composed of
four main questions to foster reflection and fa-
cilitate the study of nursing theory for practice.
3312_Ch02_019-022 26/12/14 10:04 AM Page 22
Chapter 3Choosing, Evaluating, and
Implementing Nursing
Theories for Practice
MARILYN E. PARKER AND
MARLAINE C. SMITH
Significance of Nursing Theory
for Practice
Responses to Questions from Practicing
Nurses About Using Nursing Theory
Choosing a Nursing Theory to Study
A Reflective Exercise for Choosing
a Nursing Theory for Practice
Evaluation of Nursing Theory
Implementing Theory-Guided Practice
Summary
References
Marlaine C. SmithMarilyn E. Parker
23
The primary purpose of nursing theory is
to improve nursing practice and, therefore,
the health and quality of life of the persons, fam-
ilies, and communities served. Nursing theories
provide coherent ways of viewing and approach-
ing the care of persons in their environment.
When a theoretical model is used to organize
care in any setting, it strengthens the nursing
focus of care and provides consistency to the
communication and activities related to nursing
care. The development of nursing theories and
theory-guided practice models advances the dis-
cipline and professional practice of nursing.
One of the most important issues facing
the discipline of nursing is the artificial sepa-
ration of nursing theory and practice. Nursing
can no longer afford to see these dimensions as
disconnected territories, belonging to either
scholars or practitioners. The examination and
use of nursing theories are essential for closing
the gap between nursing theory and nursing
practice. Nurses in practice have a responsibility
to study and value nursing theories, just as
nursing theory scholars must understand and
appreciate the day-to-day practice of nurses.
Nursing theory informs and guides the practice
of nursing, and nursing practice informs and
guides the process of developing theory.
The theories of any professional discipline
are useless if they have no effect on practice.
Just as psychotherapists, educators, and econ-
omists base their approaches and decisions on
particular theories, so should nurses be guided
by selected nursing theories.
When practicing nurses and nurse scholars
work together, both the discipline and practice
3312_Ch03_023-034 26/12/14 10:08 AM Page 23
of nursing benefit, and nursing service to our
clients is enhanced. There are many examples
throughout this book of how nursing theories
have been, or can be, used to guide nursing
practice. Many of the nursing theorists in this
book developed or refined their theories based
on dialogue with nurses who shared descrip-
tions of their practice. This kind of work must
continue for nursing theories to be relevant
and meaningful to the discipline.
The need to bridge the gap between nurs-
ing theory and practice is highlighted by con-
sidering the following brief encounter during
a question-and-answer period at a conference.
A nurse in practice, reflecting her experience,
asked a nurse theorist, “What is the meaning
of this theory to my practice? I’m in the real
world! I want to connect—but how can con-
nections be made between your ideas and my
reality?” The nurse theorist responded by de-
scribing the essential values and assumptions
of her theory. The nurse said, “Yes, I know
what you are talking about. I just didn’t know
I knew it, and I need help to use it in my prac-
tice” (Parker, 1993, p. 4). To remain current
in the discipline, all nurses must join in com-
munity to advance nursing knowledge in prac-
tice and must accept their obligations to
engage in the continuing study of nursing the-
ories. Today, many health-care organizations
that employ nurses adopt a nursing theory as
a guiding framework for nursing practice. This
decision provides an excellent opportunity for
nurses in practice and in administration to
study, implement, and evaluate nursing theo-
ries for use in practice. Communicating the
outcomes of this process with the community
of scholars advancing the theories is a useful
way to initiate dialogue among nurses and to
form new bridges between the theory and
practice of nursing.
The purpose of this chapter is to describe
the processes leading to implementation of
nursing theory-guided practice models. These
processes include choosing possible theories
for use in practice, analyzing and evaluating
these theories, and implementing theory-
guided practice models. The chapter begins
with responses to the questions: Why study
nursing theory? What do practicing nurses
gain from nursing theory? Then, methods of
analysis and evaluation of nursing theory set
forth in the literature are presented. Finally,
steps in implementing nursing theory in prac-
tice are described.
Significance of Nursing
Theory for Practice
Nursing practice is essential for developing,
testing, and refining nursing theory. The devel-
opment of many nursing theories has been en-
hanced by reflection and dialogue about actual
nursing situations. The everyday practice of
nursing enriches nursing theories. When nurses
think about nursing, they consider the content
and structure of the discipline of nursing. Even
if nurses do not conceptualize these elements
theoretically, their values and perspectives are
often consistent with particular nursing theo-
ries. Making these values and perspectives ex-
plicit through the use of a nursing theory results
in a more scholarly, professional practice.
Creative nursing practice is the direct
result of ongoing theory-based thinking,
decision-making, and action. Nursing prac-
tice must continue to contribute to thinking
and theorizing in nursing, just as nursing theory
must be used to advance practice.
Nursing practice and nursing theory often
reflect the same abiding values and beliefs.
Nurses in practice are guided by their values
and beliefs, as well as by knowledge. These val-
ues, beliefs, and knowledge often are reflected
in the literature about nursing’s metaparadigm,
philosophies, and theories. In addition, nurs-
ing theorists and nurses in practice think about
and work with the same phenomena, including
the person, the actions and relationships in the
nurse–person (family/community) relation-
ship, and the context of nursing. It is no won-
der that nurses often sense a connection and
familiarity with many of the concepts in nurs-
ing theories. They often say, “I knew this, but
I didn’t have the words for it.” This is another
value of nursing theory. It provides a vehicle
for us to share and communicate the important
concepts within nursing practice.
It is not possible to practice without some
theoretical frame of reference. The question is
24 SECTION I • An Introduction to Nursing Theory
3312_Ch03_023-034 26/12/14 10:08 AM Page 24
what frame of reference is being used in prac-
tice. As stated in Chapter 1, theories are ways
to organize our thinking about the complexi-
ties of any situation. Theories are lenses we se-
lect that will color the way that we view reality.
In the case of nursing, the theories we choose
to use will frame the way we think about a par-
ticular person and his or her health situation.
It will inform the ways that we approach the
person, how we relate, and what we do. Many
nurses practice according to ideas and direc-
tions from other disciplines, such as medicine,
psychology, and public health. If your approach
to a person is framed by his or her medical di-
agnosis, you are influenced by the medical
model that focuses your attention on diagnosis,
treatment, and cure. If you are thinking about
disease prevention as you work with a commu-
nity group, you are influenced by public health
theory and approaches. Although we use this
knowledge in practice, nursing theory focuses
us on the distinctive perspective of the disci-
pline, which is more than, and different from,
these approaches.
Historically, nursing practice has been
deeply rooted in the medical model, and this
model continues today. The depth and scope
of the practice of nurses who follow notions
about nursing held by other disciplines are lim-
ited to practices understood and accepted by
those disciplines. Nurses who learn to practice
from nursing perspectives are awakened to the
challenges and opportunities of practicing
nursing more fully and with a greater sense of
autonomy, respect, and satisfaction for them-
selves. Hopefully, they also provide different
and more expansive opportunities for health
and healing for those they serve. Nurses who
practice from a nursing perspective approach
clients and families in ways unique to nursing.
They ask questions, receive and process infor-
mation about needs for nursing differently, and
create nursing responses that are more holistic
and client-focused. These nurses learn to re-
frame their thinking about nursing knowledge
and practice and are then able to bring knowl-
edge from other disciplines within the context
of their practice—not to direct, their practice.
Nurses who practice from a nursing theo-
retical base see beyond immediate facts and
delivery systems; they can integrate other
health sciences and technologies as the back-
ground or context and not the essence of their
practice. Nurses who study nursing theory
realize that although no group actually owns
ideas, professional disciplines do claim a unique
perspective that defines their practice. In the
same way, no group actually owns the tech-
nologies of practice, although disciplines do
claim them for their practice. For example, be-
fore World War II, nurses rarely took blood
pressure readings and did not give intramus-
cular injections. This was not because nurses
lacked the skill, but because they did not claim
the use of these techniques within nursing
practice. Such a realization can also lead to un-
derstanding that the things nurses do that are
often called nursing are not nursing at all. The
skills and technologies used by nurses, such as
taking blood pressure readings, giving injec-
tions, and auscultating heart sounds, are actu-
ally activities that are part of the context, but
not the essence, of nursing practice. Nursing
theories provide an organizing framework that
directs nurses to the essence of their purpose
and places the use of knowledge from other
disciplines in their proper perspective.
If nursing theory is to be useful—or
practical—it must be brought into practice. At
the same time, nurses can be guided by nursing
theory in a full range of nursing situations.
Nursing theory can change nursing practice: It
provides direction for new ways of being pres-
ent with clients, helps nurses realize ways of
expressing caring, and provides approaches to
understanding needs for nursing and designing
care to address these needs. The chapters of
this book affirm the use of nursing theory in
practice and the study and assessment of the-
ory to ultimately use in practice.
Responses to Questions from
Practicing Nurses about Using
Nursing Theory
Study of nursing theory may either precede or
follow selection of a nursing theory for use in
nursing practice. Analysis and evaluation of
nursing theory follow the study of a nursing
CHAPTER 3 • Choosing, Evaluating, and Implementing Nursing Theories for Practice 25
3312_Ch03_023-034 26/12/14 10:08 AM Page 25
theory. These activities are demanding and
deserve the full commitment of nurses who
undertake the work. Because it is understood
that the study of nursing theory is not a simple,
short-term endeavor, nurses often question
doing such work. The following questions about
studying and using nursing theory have been
collected from many conversations with nurses
about nursing theory. These queries also identify
specific issues that are important to nurses who
consider the study of nursing theory.
My Nursing Practice
• Does this theory reflect nursing practice as
I know it? Can it be understood in relation
to my nursing practice? Will it support what
I believe to be excellent nursing practice?
Conceptual models and grand theories can
guide practice in any setting and situation.
Middle-range theories address circumscribed
phenomena in nursing that are directly related
to practice. These levels of theory can enrich
perspectives on practice and should foster an
excellent professional level of practice.
• Is the theory specific to my area of nursing?
Can the language of the theory help me ex-
plain, plan, and evaluate my nursing? Will I
be able to use the terms to communicate
with others?
• Can this theory be considered in relation to
a wide range of nursing situations? How
does it relate to more general views of
nursing people in other settings?
• Will my study and use of this theory support
nursing in my interprofessional setting?
• Will those from other disciplines be able
to understand, facilitating cooperation?
• Will my work meet the expectations of
those I serve? Will other nurses find my
work helpful and challenging?
Conceptual models and grand theories are
not specific to any nursing specialty. Theories
in any discipline introduce new terminology
that is not part of general language. For exam-
ple, the id, ego, and superego are familiar terms
in a particular psychological theory but were
unknown at the time of the theory’s introduc-
tion. The language of the theory facilitates
thinking differently through naming new con-
cepts or ideas. Members of disciplines do share
specific language that may be less familiar to
members outside the discipline. In interprofes-
sional communication, new terms should be
defined and explained to facilitate communica-
tion as needed. Nursing’s unique perspective
needs to be represented clearly within the in-
terprofessional team. The diversity of each dis-
cipline’s perspective is important to provide the
best care possible for patients. People deserve
and expect high-quality care. Nursing theory
has the potential to bring to bear the impor-
tance of relationship and caring in the process
of health and healing; the interrelationship of
the environment and health; an understanding
of the wholeness of persons in their life situa-
tions; and an appreciation of the person’s expe-
riences, values, and choices in care. These are
essential contributions to a multidisciplinary
perspective.
My Personal Interests, Abilities,
and Experiences
• Is the study of nursing theories consistent
with my talents, interests, and goals? Is this
something I want to do?
• Will I be stimulated by thinking about and
trying to use this theory? Will my study of
nursing be enhanced by use of this theory?
• What will it be like to think about nursing
theory in nursing practice?
• Will my work with nursing theory be worth
the effort?
The study of nursing theory does take an in-
vestment in time and attention. It is a respon-
sibility of a professional nurse who engages in
a scholarly level of practice. Learning about
nursing theory is a conceptual activity that can
be challenging and intellectually stimulating.
We need nurses who will invest in these activ-
ities so that knowledgeable theory-guided prac-
tice is the standard in all health-care settings.
Resources and Support
• Will this be useful to me outside the
classroom?
• What resources will I need to understand
fully the terms of the theory?
26 SECTION I • An Introduction to Nursing Theory
3312_Ch03_023-034 26/12/14 10:08 AM Page 26
• Will I be able to find the support I need to
study and use the theory in my practice?
The purpose of nursing theory goes beyond
its study within courses. Nursing theory be-
comes alive when the ideas are brought to prac-
tice. The usefulness of theory in practice is one
way that we judge its value and worth. It is
helpful to read about the theory from primary
sources or the most notable scholars and prac-
titioners who have studied the theory. Nurses
interested in particular theories can join online
discussion groups where issues related to the
theory are discussed. Many of the theory groups
have formed professional societies and hold
conferences that support lifelong learning and
growing with those applying the theory in prac-
tice, administration, research, and education.
The Theorist, Evidence, and Opinion
• Who is the author of this theory? What
background of nursing education and experi-
ence does the theorist bring to this work? Is
the author an authoritative nursing scholar?
• How is the theorist’s background of nursing
education and experience brought to this
work?
• What is the evidence that use of the theory
may lead to improved nursing care? Has the
theory been useful to guide nursing organi-
zations and administrations? What about
influencing nursing and health-care policy?
• What is the evidence that this nursing the-
ory has led to nursing research, including
questions and methods of inquiry? Did
the theory grow out of research findings
or out of practice issues and concerns?
• Does the theory reflect the latest thinking
in nursing? Has the theory kept pace with
the times in nursing? Is this a nursing
theory for the future?
Approaching the study of nursing theory
with openness, curiosity, imagination, and
skepticism is important. Evaluation of any the-
ory should include evidence that practicing
based on the theory makes a difference in the
lives of people. Theories must have pragmatic
value; that is, they need to generate research
questions and provide models that can be ap-
plied in practice. In the nursing literature, you
will find examples of how a theory has been
used in research and in practice. In some cases,
especially with newly formed theories, this ev-
idence may be unavailable. In these situations,
you will need to imagine how the theory might
work in practice. Theories have heuristic, or
problem-solving, value in that they can lead to
new ways of thinking about situations. Con-
sider the heuristic value of the theory as you
read it. The theory should ignite your passion
about nursing.
Choosing a Nursing Theory
to Study
It is important to give adequate attention to
the selection of theories. Results of this deci-
sion will have lasting influences on your nurs-
ing practice. It is not unusual for nurses who
begin to work with nursing theory to realize
that their practice is changing and that their
future efforts in the discipline and practice of
nursing are markedly altered.
There is always some measure of hope mixed
with anxiety as nurses seriously explore nursing
theory for the first time. Individual nurses who
practice with a group of colleagues often won-
der how to select and study nursing theories.
Nurses in practice and nursing students in the-
ory courses have similar questions. Nurses in
new practice settings designed and developed
by nurses have the same concerns about getting
started as do nurses in hospital organizations
who want more from their practice.
The following exercise is grounded in the
belief that the study and use of nursing theory
in nursing practice must have roots in the
practice of the nurses involved. Moreover, the
nursing theory used by particular nurses must
reflect elements of practice that are essential
to those nurses, while at the same time bring-
ing focus and freshness to that practice. This
exercise calls on the nurse to think about the
major components of nursing and bring forth
the values and beliefs most important to
nurses. In these ways, the exercise begins to
parallel knowledge development reflected in
the nursing metaparadigm (focus of the disci-
pline) and nursing philosophies described in
Chapter 1. Throughout the rest of this book,
CHAPTER 3 • Choosing, Evaluating, and Implementing Nursing Theories for Practice 27
3312_Ch03_023-034 26/12/14 10:08 AM Page 27
the reader is guided to connect nursing theory
and nursing practice in the context of nursing
situations.
A Reflective Exercise for
Choosing a Nursing Theory
for Practice
Select a comfortable, private, and quiet place
to reflect and write. Relax by taking some
deep, slow breaths. Think about the reasons
you went into nursing in the first place. Bring
your nursing practice into focus. Consider your
practice today. Continue to reflect and, while
avoiding distractions, make notes to record
your thoughts and feelings. When you have
been thinking for a time and have taken the
opportunity to reflect on your practice, pro-
ceed with the following questions. Continue
to reflect and to make notes as you consider
each one.
Enduring Values
• What are the enduring values and beliefs
that brought me to nursing?
• What beliefs and values keep me in nursing
today?
• What are the personal values that I hold
most dear?
• How do my personal and nursing values
connect with what is important to society?
Reflect on an instance of nursing in which
you interacted with a person, family, or com-
munity for nursing purposes. This can be a sit-
uation from your current practice or may be
from your nursing in years past. Consider the
purpose or hoped-for outcome.
Nursing Situations
• Who was this person, family, or commu-
nity? How did I come to know him, her,
or them as unique?
• What were the person’s, family’s, or com-
munity’s hopes and dreams for their own
health and healing?
• Who was I as a person in the nursing
situation?
• Who was I as a nurse in the situation?
• What was the relationship between
the person, family, or community and
myself?
• What nursing actions emerged in the
context of the relationship?
• What other nursing actions might have
been possible?
• What was the environment of the nursing
situation?
• What about the environment was impor-
tant to the person, family or community’s
hopes and dreams for health and healing
and my nursing actions?
Nursing can change when we consciously
connect values and beliefs to nursing situa-
tions. Consider that values and beliefs are the
basis for our nursing. Briefly describe the con-
nections of your values and beliefs with your
chosen nursing situation.
Connecting Values and the
Nursing Situation
• How are my values and beliefs reflected in
any nursing situation?
• Are my values and beliefs in conflict or
frustrated in this situation?
• Do my values come to life in the nursing
situation?
Cultivating Awareness
and Appreciation
In reflecting and writing about values and
nursing situations that are important to us,
we often come to a fuller awareness and ap-
preciation of our practice. Make notes about
your insights. You might consider these ini-
tial notes the beginning of a journal in which
you record your study of nursing theories and
their use in nursing practice. This is a valu-
able way to follow your progress and is a
source of nursing questions for future study.
You may want to share this process and ex-
perience with your colleagues. Sharing is a
way to explore and clarify views about nursing
and to seek and offer support for nursing val-
ues and situations that are critical to your
practice. If you are doing this exercise in a
group, share your essential values and beliefs
with your colleagues.
28 SECTION I • An Introduction to Nursing Theory
3312_Ch03_023-034 26/12/14 10:08 AM Page 28
Multiple Ways of Knowing and
Reflecting on Nursing Theory
Multiple ways of knowing are used in theory-
guided nursing practice. Carper (1978) studied
the nursing literature and described four essen-
tial patterns of knowing in nursing. Using the
Phenix (1964) model of realms of meaning,
Carper described personal, empirical, ethical,
and aesthetic ways of knowing in nursing.
Chinn and Kramer (2011) use Carper’s pat-
terns of knowing and a fifth pattern, called
emancipatory knowing, to develop an inte-
grated framework for nursing knowledge de-
velopment. Additional patterns of knowing in
nursing have been explored and described, and
the initial four patterns have been the focus
of much consideration in nursing (Boykin,
Parker, & Schoenhofer, 1994; Leight, 2002;
Munhall, 1993; Parker, 2002; Pierson, 1999;
Ruth-Sahd, 2003; Thompson, 1999; White,
1995). Each of the patterns of knowing and
its relationship to theory-guided practice are
articulated in the following paragraphs.
Empirical knowing is the most familiar of
the ways of knowing in nursing. Empirical
knowing is how we come to know the science
of nursing and other disciplines that are used
in nursing practice. This includes knowing the
actual theories, concepts, principles, and re-
search findings from nursing, pathophysiology,
pharmacology, psychology, sociology, epidemi-
ology, and other fields. Nursing theory is within
the pattern of empirical knowing. The theoret-
ical framework for practice integrates the con-
cepts, principles, laws, and facts essential for
practice.
Personal knowing is about striving to know
the self and to actualize authentic relationships
between the nurse and person. Using this pat-
tern of knowing in nursing, the client is not
seen as an object but as a person moving to-
ward fulfillment of potential (Carper, 1978).
The nurse is recognized as continuously learn-
ing and growing as a person and practitioner.
Reflecting on a person as a client and a person
as a nurse in the nursing situation can enhance
understanding of nursing practice and the cen-
trality of relationships in nursing. These in-
sights are useful for choosing and studying
nursing theory. Knowing the self is essential in
selecting a nursing theory to guide practice.
Ultimately, the choice of theoretical perspec-
tive reflects personal values and beliefs.
Ethical knowing is increasingly important to
the study and practice of nursing today. Ac-
cording to Carper (1978), ethics in nursing is
the moral component guiding choices within
the complexity of health care. Ethical knowing
informs us of what is right, what is obligatory,
and what is desirable in any nursing situation.
Ethical knowing is essential in every action of
the nurse in day-to-day practice.
Aesthetic knowing is described by Carper
(1978) as the art of nursing; it is the creative
and imaginative use of nursing knowledge in
practice (Rogers, 1988). Although nursing is
often referred to as art, this aspect of nursing
may not be as highly valued as the science and
ethics of nursing. Each nurse is an artist, ex-
pressing and interpreting the guiding theory
uniquely in his or her practice. Reflecting on
the experience of nursing is primary in under-
standing aesthetic knowing. Through such re-
flection, the nurse understands that nursing
practice has in fact been created, that each in-
stance of nursing is unique, and that outcomes
of nursing cannot be precisely predicted. Be-
sides the art of nursing, knowing through artis-
tic forms is part of aesthetic knowing. Often
human experiences and relationships can best
be appreciated and understood through art
forms such as stories, paintings, music, or po-
etry. Some assert that aesthetic knowing allows
for understanding the wholeness of experience.
Examples of this most complete knowing are
frequent in nursing situations in which even
momentary connection and genuine presence
between the nurse and the person, family, or
community is realized.
Emancipatory knowing as described by
Chinn and Kramer (2011 ) is realized in praxis,
the integration of knowing, doing and being.
Paulo Freire’s (1970) definition of praxis is si-
multaneous reflection and action intended to
transform the world. In this pattern knowing
is inseparable from action and is integral to the
being of the nurse. The transformative action
alters the power dynamics that maintain dis-
advantage for some and privilege for others,
CHAPTER 3 • Choosing, Evaluating, and Implementing Nursing Theories for Practice 29
3312_Ch03_023-034 26/12/14 10:08 AM Page 29
and is directed toward goals for social justice
(Kagan, Smith, & Chinn, 2014). The nurse
using this pattern cultivates awareness of how
social, political and economic forces shape
assumptions and opinions about knowledge
and truth. Unveiling the dynamics that sustain
inequity creates freedom to see and act in a
way that improves the health of all. Emanci-
patory knowing reminds us of the contextual
nature of knowing, and that through praxis
(reflection and action) all patterns of knowing
are integrated.
Using Insights to Choose Theory
The notes describing your experience will help
in selecting a nursing theory to study and con-
sider for guiding practice. You will want to
answer these questions:
• What nursing theory seems consistent
with the values and beliefs that guide my
practice?
• What theories are consistent with my
personal values and beliefs?
• What do I hope to achieve from the use of
nursing theory?
• Given my reflection on a nursing situation,
how can I use theory to support this descrip-
tion of my practice?
• How can I use nursing theory to improve
my practice for myself and for my patients?
Evaluation of Nursing Theory
Evaluation of nursing theory follows its study
and analysis and is the process of making a
determination about its value, worth, and sig-
nificance (Smith, 2013). There are many sets
of criteria for evaluating conceptual models
and grand theories (Chinn & Kramer, 2007;
Fawcett, 2004; Fitzpatrick & Whall, 2004;
Parse, 1987; Stevens, 1998). Smith (2013)
has published criteria for evaluating middle-
range theories. After reading and studying
the primary sources of the theory, the re-
search and practice applications of the theory,
and other critiques and evaluations of the the-
ory, it is important for the evaluator to come
to his or her own judgments supported by
logical analysis and examples from the theory.
The whole theory must be studied. Parts of
the theory without the whole will not be fully
meaningful and may lead to misunderstanding.
Before selecting a guide for theory evalua-
tion, consider the level and scope of the theory.
Is the theory a conceptual model or grand nurs-
ing theory? A middle-range nursing theory? A
practice theory? Not all aspects of theory de-
scribed in an evaluation guide will be evident
in all levels of theory. Whall (2004) recognized
this in offering particular guides for analysis
and evaluation that vary according to three
types of nursing theory: models, middle-range
theories, and practice theories. Fawcett’s (2004;
Fawcett & DeSanto-Madeya, 2012) criteria for
analysis and evaluation pertain to conceptual
models and grand theories. Smith’s (2013)
criteria specifically address the evaluation of
middle-range theories.
Theory analysis and evaluation may be
thought of as one process or as a two-step
sequence. It may be helpful to think of analy-
sis of theory as necessary for in-depth study
of a nursing theory and evaluation of theory
as the assessment of a theory’s significance,
structure, and utility. Guides for theory eval-
uation are intended as tools to inform us
about theories and to encourage further
development, refinement, and use of theory.
No guide for theory analysis and evaluation
is adequate and appropriate for every nursing
theory.
Johnson (1974) wrote about three basic cri-
teria to guide evaluation of nursing theory.
These have continued in use over time and
offer direction today. These criteria state that
the theory should:
• Define the congruence of nursing practice
with societal expectations of nursing
decisions and actions
• Clarify the social significance of nursing,
or the effect of nursing on persons receiving
nursing
• Describe social utility, or usefulness, of the
theory in practice, research, and education
Following are summaries of the most fre-
quently used guides for theory evaluation.
These guides are components of the entire
work about nursing theory of the individual
30 SECTION I • An Introduction to Nursing Theory
3312_Ch03_023-034 26/12/14 10:08 AM Page 30
nursing scholar and offer various interesting
approaches to theory evaluation. Each guide
should be studied in more detail than is offered
in this introduction and should be examined
in context of the whole work of the individual
nurse scholar.
The approach to theory evaluation set forth
by Chinn and Kramer (2011) is to use guide-
lines for describing nursing theory that are
based on their definition of theory as “a cre-
ative and rigorous structuring of ideas that
projects a tentative, purposeful, and systematic
view of phenomena” (p. 58). The guidelines
set forth questions that clarify the facts about
aspects of theory: purpose, concepts, defini-
tions, relationships and structure, and as-
sumptions. These authors suggest that the
next step in the evaluation process is critical
reflection about whether and how the nursing
theory works. Questions are posed to guide
this reflection:
• How clear is this theory?
• How simple is this theory?
• How general is this theory?
• How accessible is this theory?
• How important is this theory?
Fawcett (2004; Fawcett & DeSanto-
Madeya, 2012) developed two frameworks for
the analysis and evaluation of conceptual mod-
els and theories. The questions for analysis of
conceptual models address:
• Origins of the nursing model
• Unique focus of the nursing model
• Content of the nursing model
The questions for evaluation of conceptual
models address:
• Explication of origins
• Comprehensiveness of content
• Logical congruence
• Generation of theory
• Credibility of nursing model
The framework for analysis of grand and
middle-range theories includes:
• Theory scope
• Theory context
• Theory content
The questions for evaluation of grand and
middle-range theories address:
• Significance
• Internal consistency
• Parsimony
• Testability
• Empirical adequacy
• Pragmatic adequacy
Meleis (2011) stated that the structural
and functional components of a theory should
be studied before evaluation. The structural
components are assumptions, concepts, and
propositions of the theory. Functional com-
ponents include descriptions of the following:
focus, client, nursing, health, nurse–client
interactions, environment, nursing problems,
and interventions. After studying these dimen-
sions of the theory, critical examination of
these elements may take place, summarized
as follows:
• Relations between structure and function
of the theory, including clarity, consistency,
and simplicity
• Diagram of theory to elucidate the theory
by creating a visual representation
• Contagiousness, or adoption of the theory by
a wide variety of students, researchers, and
practitioners, as reflected in the literature
• Usefulness in practice, education, research,
and administration
• External components of personal, profes-
sional, social values, and significance
Smith (2013) developed a framework for
the evaluation of middle-range theories that
includes the following criteria:
Substantive foundation relates to meaning or
how the theory corresponds to existing
knowledge in the discipline. The questions
for evaluation ask about its fit with the
disciplinary focus of nursing; its specifica-
tion of assumptions; its substantive mean-
ing of a phenomenon; and its origins in
practice and/or research.
Structural integrity relates to the structure or
internal organization of the theory. Ques-
tions for evaluation ask about the clarity of
definitions of concepts, the consistency of
CHAPTER 3 • Choosing, Evaluating, and Implementing Nursing Theories for Practice 31
3312_Ch03_023-034 26/12/14 10:08 AM Page 31
level of abstraction, the simplicity of the
theory, and the logical representation of
relationships among concepts.
Functional adequacy refers to the ability of the
theory to be used in practice and research.
Questions are related to its applicability to
practice and client groups, the identifica-
tion of empirical indicators, the presence
of published examples of practice and re-
search using the theory and the evolution
of the theory through inquiry (p. 41 x).
Implementing Theory-Guided
Practice
Every nurse should develop a practice that is
guided by nursing theory. Most conceptual
models or grand theories have actual practice
methods or processes that can be adopted. The
scope and generality of middle-range theories
makes them less appropriate to guide nursing
practice within a unit or hospital. Instead, they
can be used to understand and respond to phe-
nomena that are encountered in nursing situa-
tions. For example, Boykin and Schoenhofer’s
Nursing as Caring theory has been adopted as
a practice model by several hospitals (Boykin,
Schoenhofer & Valentine, 2013). Reed’s middle-
range theory of self-transcendence can be used
to guide a nurse who is leading a support group
for women with breast cancer. Hospital units
or entire nursing departments may adopt a
model that guides nursing practice within their
unit or organization. The following are sugges-
tions that can facilitate this process of adoption
and implementation of theory-guided practice
within units or organizations:
Gaining administrative support. Organiza-
tional leaders need to support the initiative to
begin the process of implementing nursing
theory-guided practice. Although the impetus
to begin this initiative might not originate in
formal leadership, the organizational leaders
and managers need to be on board. If it is to
succeed, the implementation of a model for
practice requires the support of administration
at the highest levels.
Selecting the theory or model to be used in prac-
tice. The entire nursing staff should be fully
involved and invested in the process of decid-
ing on the theoretical model that will guide
practice. This can be done is several ways. An
organization’s governance structure can be
used to develop the most appropriate selection
process. As stated previously, the selection of
a nursing theory or model is based on values.
Some nursing organizations have used their
mission, values, and vision statements as a
blueprint that helps them select nursing theo-
ries that are most consistent with these values.
Another approach is to survey all nurses about
the practice models they would like to see im-
plemented. The nursing staff can then study the
top three or four in greater detail so that an in-
formed decision can be made. Staff develop-
ment can be involved in planning educational
offerings related to the models. A process of
voting or gaining consensus can be used for the
final selection.
Launching the initiative. Once the model
has been selected, the leaders (formal and in-
formal) begin to plan for its implementation.
This involves creating a timeline, planning the
phases and stages of implementation including
activities, and using all methods of communi-
cation to be sure that all are informed of these
plans. Unit champions, informal leaders who
are enthusiastic and positive about the initia-
tive, can be key to the building excitement for
the initiative. A structure to lead and manage
the implementation is essential. Consultants
who are experts in the theory itself or who
have experience in implementing the theory-
guided practice model can be very helpful.
For example, Watson’s International Caritas
Consortium1 consists of hospitals that have
experience implementing the theory in prac-
tice. New hospitals can join the consortium for
consultation and support as they launch initia-
tives. A kickoff event, such as an inspirational
presentation, can build excitement and visibility
for the initiative.
Creating a plan for evaluation. It is impor-
tant to build in a systematic plan for evaluation
of the new model from the beginning. An
evaluation study should be designed to track
32 SECTION I • An Introduction to Nursing Theory
For additional information, visit http://watsoncaring-
science.org.
3312_Ch03_023-034 26/12/14 10:08 AM Page 32
process and outcome indicators. Consultation
from an evaluation researcher is essential.
For example, outcomes of nurse satisfaction,
patient satisfaction, nurse retention, and core
measures might be considered as outcomes to
be measured before and after the implementa-
tion of the model. Focus groups might be held
at intervals to identify nurses’ experiences and
attitudes related to implementation of the
model.
Consistent and constant support and educa-
tion. As the model is implemented, a process
to support continuing learning and growth
with the theory needs to be in place. The
nurses implementing the model will have
questions and suggestions, so resident experts
should be available for this education and sup-
port. Those working with the model will grow
in their expertise, and their experiences need
to be recorded and shared with the commu-
nity of scholars advancing the theory in prac-
tice. Ways to foster staying on track must be
developed. Some hospitals have created unit
bulletin boards, newsletters, or signage to pre-
vent reverting to old behaviors and to cement
new ones. Staff members need opportunities
to dialogue about their experiences: what is
working and what is not. They need the free-
dom to develop new ways of implementing
the model so that their scholarship and cre-
ativity flourish.
Periodic feedback on outcomes and oppor-
tunities for reenergizing is essential. Planned
change involves anticipating the ebb and flow
of enthusiasm. In the stressful health-care
environment, it is important to find opportu-
nities to provide feedback on how the project
is going, to reward and celebrate the successes,
and to fan any dying embers of enthusiasm for
the project. This can be accomplished by invit-
ing study champions to attend regional or
national conferences, bringing in speakers, or
holding recognition events.
Revisioning of the theory-guided practice
model based on feedback. Any theory-guided
practice model will become richer through its
testing in practice. The nurses working with
the model will help to modify and revise the
model based on evaluation data. This revision-
ing should be done in partnership with theo-
rists and other practice scholars working with
the model.
CHAPTER 3 • Choosing, Evaluating, and Implementing Nursing Theories for Practice 33
■ Summary
This chapter focused on the important con-
nection between nursing theory and nursing
practice and the processes of choosing, eval-
uating, and implementing theory for prac-
tice. The selection of a nursing theory for
practice is based on values and beliefs, and a
reflective process can help to identify the
most important qualities of practice that
need to be present in a chosen theory. Eval-
uation of nursing theory is a judgment of its
value or worth. Several models of theory eval-
uation are available for use. Implementing a
theory-based practice model in a health-care
setting can be challenging and rewarding.
Suggestions for successful implementation
were offered.
References
Boykin, A., Parker, M., & Schoenhofer, S. (1994). Aes-
thetic knowing grounded in an explicit conception of
nursing. Nursing Science Quarterly, 7(4), 158–161.
Boykin, A., Schoenhofer, S. & Valentine, K. (2013.
Transformation for Nursing and Healthcare Leaders:
Implementing a Culture of Caring. New York, NY:
Springer.
Carper, B. A. (1978). Fundamental patterns of knowing
in nursing. Advances in Nursing Science, 1(1), 13–23.
Chinn, P., & Jacobs, M. (2007). Integrated theory and
knowledge development in nursing. (7th edition).
St. Louis, MO: Mosby.
Chinn, P., & Kramer, M. (2007). Integrated knowledge
development in nursing (7th ed.). St. Louis,
MO: Mosby.
Chinn, P., & Kramer, M. (2011). Integrated theory
and knowledge development in nursing (8th ed.).
St. Louirs, MO: Mosby.
3312_Ch03_023-034 26/12/14 10:08 AM Page 33
Fawcett, J. (2004). Analysis and evaluation of contempo-
rary nursing knowledge. Philadelphia: F.A. Davis.
Fawcett, J. & DeSanto-Madeya . (2012). Analysis
and evaluation of contemporary nursing knowledge
(3rd ed.). Philadelphia, PA: F.A. Davis.
Fitzpatrick, J., & Whall, A. (2004). Conceptual models
of nursing. Stamford, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Friere, Paulo. (1970). Pedagogy of the oppressed. New York,
NY: Herder and Herder.
Johnson, D. (1974). Development of theory: A requisite
for nursing as a primary health profession. Nursing
Research, 23(5), 372–377.
Kagan, P., Smith, M., & Chinn, P. (Eds). (2014).
Philosophies and practices of emancipatory nursing:
Social justice as praxis. New York, NY: Routledge.
Leight, S. B. (2002). Starry night: Using story to inform
aesthetic knowing in women’s health nursing.
Journal of Advanced Nursing, 37(1), 108–114.
Meleis, A. (2011). Theoretical nursing: Development and
progress (5th ed.). Philadelphia: Lippincott.
Meleis, A. (2004). Theoretical nursing: Development and
progress (3rd ed.). Philadelphia: Lippincott.
Munhall, P. (1993). Unknowing: Toward another
pattern of knowing in nursing. Nursing Outlook, 41,
125–128.
Parker, M. (1993). Patterns of nursing theories in practice.
New York: National League for Nursing.
Parker, M. E. (2002). Aesthetic ways in day-to-day
nursing. In D. Freshwater (Ed.), Therapeutic nursing:
Improving patient care through self-awareness and
reflection (pp. 100–120). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Parse, R. R. (1987). Nursing science: Major paradigms,
theories and critiques. Philadelphia: W. B. Saunders.
Phenix, P. H. (1964). Realms of meaning. New York:
McGraw-Hill.
Pierson, W. (1999). Considering the nature of intersub-
jectivity within professional nursing. Journal of
Advanced Nursing, 30(2), 294–302.
Rogers, M. E. (1988). Nursing science and art: A
prospective. Nursing Science Quarterly, 1(3), 99–102.
Ruth-Sahd, L. A. (2003). Intuition: A critical way of
knowing in a multicultural nursing curriculum.
Nursing Education Perspectives, 24(3), 129–134.
Smith, M. C. (2013). Evaluation of middle range theo-
ries for the discipline of nursing. In M. J. Smith &
P. R. Liehr (Eds.), Middle range theory for nursing
(pp. 35–50). New York, NY: Springer.
Stevens, B. (1998). Nursing theory: Analysis, application,
evaluation. Boston: Little, Brown.
Thompson, C. (1999). A conceptual treadmill: The need
for “middle ground” in clinical decision making
theory in nursing. Journal of Advanced Nursing, 30(5),
1222–1229.
Whall, A. (2004). The structure of nursing knowledge:
Analysis and evaluation of practice, middle-range,
and grand theory. In J. Fitzpatrick & A. Whall
(Eds.), Conceptual models of nursing: Analysis and
application (4th ed., pp. 5–20). Stamford, CT:
Appleton & Lange.
White, J. (1995). Patterns of knowing: Review, critique
and update. Advances in Nursing Science, 17(4), 73–86.
34 SECTION I • An Introduction to Nursing Theory
3312_Ch03_023-034 26/12/14 10:08 AM Page 34
Section II
Conceptual Influences on
the Evolution of Nursing Theory
35
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 35
36
The second section of the book has three chapters that describe conceptual in-
fluences on the development of nursing theory. Thomas Kuhn calls the stage of
scientific development before formal theories are structured the “preparadigm
stage.” These scholars were working in this stage of our development, planting
the seeds that grew into nursing theories. Nursing theorists today have stood on
the shoulders of these “giants,” building on their brilliant conceptualizations of
the nature of nursing and the nurse–patient relationship. In Chapter 4, Dr. Lynne
Dunphy, a noted historian and Nightingale scholar, illuminates the core ideas
from Nightingale’s work that have been essential foundations for the development
of nursing theories. Although Nightingale did not develop a theory of nursing,
she did provide a direction for the development of the profession and discipline.
She believed in the natural or inherent healing ability of human beings and that
the goal of nursing was to facilitate the emergence of health and healing by at-
tending to the person–environment relationship. She said that the goal of nursing
was to put the patient in the best condition for nature to act, and she identified
five environmental components essential to health. Nightingale saw nursing and
medicine as separate fields and emphasized the importance of systematic inquiry.
Her spiritual nature and vision of nursing as an art continue to influence practice
today. The emphasis on optimal healing environments in today’s health-care sys-
tems can be related to Nightingale’s ideas. The quality of the human–environment
relationship is related to health and healing.
In Chapter 5, Dr. Shirley Gordon summarized the work of Ernestine
Wiedenbach, Virginia Henderson, and Lydia Hall. Wiedenbach emphasized
the importance of reverence for life, respect for dignity, autonomy, worth, and
uniqueness of each person, and a commitment to act on these values as the
essence of a personal philosophy of nursing. Henderson described nursing as
“getting into the skin” of the patient so that nurses would be able to provide
the strength, will, or knowledge the patient needed to heal or maintain health.
Lydia Hall is an inspiration to all who envision nursing as an autonomous dis-
cipline and practice. She created a model of nursing consisting of “the core,
the cure, and the care” and implemented that model in the Loeb Center for
Nursing and Rehabilitation. Physicians referred their patients to the Center,
and nurses admitted the patients for nursing care. Nurses worked independ-
ently with patients to foster learning, growth, and healing.
Chapter 6, written by a group of authors, focused on three nursing leaders who
described the nurse–patient relationship: Hildegard Peplau, Ida Jean Orlando, and
Joyce Travelbee. A psychiatric nurse, Peplau viewed the purpose of nursing as help-
ing the patient gain the intellectual and interpersonal competencies necessary to
heal. She articulated stages of the nurse–patient relationship, a framework for anxiety
and nursing interventions to decrease anxiety. Travelbee emphasized the human-
to-human relationship between nurse and person and spoke of the purpose of nursing
as assisting the person(s) to prevent or cope with the experience of illness and suf-
fering. Orlando described attributes of the nurse–patient relationship. She valued re-
lationship as central to the practice of nursing and was the first to describe nursing
process as identifying and responding to needs.
Section
II Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
36
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 36
Chapter 4Florence Nightingale’s Legacy
of Caring and Its Applications
LYNNE M. HEKTOR DUNPHY
Introducing the Theorist
Early Life and Education
Spirituality
War
Introducing the Theory
The Medical Milieu
The Feminist Context of Nightingale’s
Caring
Ideas About Nursing
Nightingale’s Legacy for 21st Century
Nursing Practice
Summary
References
Florence Nightingale
37
Introducing the Theorist
Florence Nightingale, the acknowledged founder
of modern nursing, remains a compelling and
transformative figure. Not a year goes by in
which new scholarship on Nightingale does
not emerge. Florence Nightingale and the Health
of the Raj was published in 2003 documenting
Nightingale’s 40-year-long interest and in-
volvement in Indian affairs, a previously not
well explored area of scholarship (Gourley,
2003). In 2004, a new biography of Nightingale,
Nightingales: The Extraordinary Upbringing and
Curious Life of Miss Florence Nightingale by
Gillian Gill, was published. In 2008, another
new biography, Florence Nightingale: The Mak-
ing of an Icon by Mark Bostridge, was pub-
lished. 2013 saw yet another biography, very
finely written and presented, Florence Nightingale,
Feminist by Judith Lissauer Cromwell. Squarely
in the camp of viewing Nightingale as a
“feminist”—a term that was non-existent dur-
ing the years that Nightingale was alive—it is
a fine work, told from a post-feminist perspec-
tive. Lynn McDonald’s prodigious, ambitious,
and long overdue Collected Works of Florence
Nightingale consists of 16 volumes. In 2005,
the American Nurses Association published
Florence Nightingale Today: Healing, Leader-
ship, Global Action, an ambitious casting of
Nightingale as 21st century nursing’s inspira-
tion and savior. At the time you are perusing
this chapter, it will be more than a century
since the death of Florence Nightingale in
1910 and almost 200 hundred years since her
birth on May 12 in 1820.
Nightingale transformed a “calling from
God” and an intense spirituality into a new so-
cial role for women: that of nurse. Her caring
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 37
was a public one. “Work your true work,” she
wrote, “and you will find God within you”
(Woodham-Smith, 1983, p. 74). A reflection
on this statement appears in a well-known
quote from Notes on Nursing (Nightingale,
1859/1992): “Nature [i.e., the manifestation of
God] alone cures . . . what nursing has to
do . . . is put the patient in the best condition
for nature to act upon him” (Macrae, 1995,
p. 10). Although Nightingale never defined
human care or caring in Notes on Nursing, there
is no doubt that her life in nursing exemplified
and personified an ethos of caring. Jean Watson
(1992, p. 83), in the 1992 commemorative edi-
tion of Notes on Nursing, observed, “Although
Nightingale’s feminine-based caring-healing
model has transcended time and is prophetic for
this century’s health reform, the model is yet to
truly come of age in nursing or the health
care system.” In a reflective essay, Boykin and
Dunphy (2002) extended this thinking and
related Nightingale’s life, rooted in compassion
and caring, as an exemplar of justice making
(p. 14). Justice making is understood as a mani-
festation of compassion and caring, “for it is our
actions that bring about justice” (p. 16).
This chapter reiterates Nightingale’s life
from the years 1820 to 1860, delineating the
formative influences on her thinking and pro-
viding historical context for her ideas about
nursing as we recall them today. Part of what
follows is a well-known tale, yet it remains one
that is irresistible, casting an age-old spell on
the reader, like the flickering shadow of
Nightingale and her famous lamp in the dark
and dreary halls of the Barrack Hospital, Scu-
tari, on the outskirts of Constantinople, circa
1854 to 1856. It is a tale that carries even more
relevance for nursing practice today.
Early Life and Education
A profession, a trade, a necessary occupation,
something to fill and employ all my faculties, I
have always felt essential to me, I have always
longed for, consciously or not. . . . The first thought
I can remember, and the last, was nursing work.
—FLORENCE NIGHTINGALE, CITED IN COOK
(1913, p. 106)
Nightingale was born in 1820 in Florence,
Italy—the city she was named for. The
Nightingales were on an extended European
tour, begun in 1818 shortly after their mar-
riage. This was a common journey for those of
their class and wealth. Their first daughter,
Parthenope, had been born in the city of that
name in the previous year.
A legacy of humanism, liberal thinking, and
love of speculative thought was bequeathed
to Nightingale by her father. His views on the
education of women were far ahead of his time.
W. E. N., as her father, William, was called,
undertook the education of both his daughters.
Florence and her sister studied music; gram-
mar; composition; modern languages; classical
Greek and Latin; constitutional history and
Roman, Italian, German, and Turkish history;
and mathematics (Barritt, 1973).
From an early age, Florence exhibited in-
dependence of thought and action. The sketch
(Fig. 4-1) of W. E. N. and his daughters was
38 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
Fig 4 • 1 A sketch of W. E. N. and his daughters
by one of his wife Fanny’s sisters, Julia Smith.
Source: Woodham-Smith (1983), p. 9, with permission of
Sir Henry Verney, Bart.
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 38
done by Nightingale’s beloved aunt, Julia
Smith. It is Parthenope, the older sister, who
clutches her father’s hand and Florence who,
as described by her aunt, “independently
stumps along by herself” (Woodham-Smith,
1983, p. 7).
Travel also played a part in Nightingale’s
education. Eighteen years after Florence’s
birth, the Nightingales and both daughters
made an extended tour of France, Italy, and
Switzerland between the years of 1837 and
1838 and later Egypt and Greece (Sattin,
1987). From there, Nightingale visited
Germany, making her first acquaintance with
Kaiserswerth, a Protestant religious commu-
nity that contained the Institution for the
Training of Deaconesses, with a hospital
school, penitentiary, and orphanage. A Protes-
tant pastor, Theodore Fleidner, and his young
wife had established this community in 1836,
in part to provide training for women dea-
conesses (Protestant “nuns”) who wished to
nurse. Nightingale was to return there in 1851
against much family opposition to stay from
July through October, participating in a period
of “nurse’s training” (Cook, Vol. I, 1913;
Woodham-Smith, 1983).
Life at Kaiserswerth was spartan. The
trainees were up at 5 A.M., ate bread and
gruel, and then worked on the hospital wards
until noon. Then they had a 10-minute break
for broth with vegetables. Three P.M. saw an-
other 10-minute break for tea and bread.
They worked until 7 P.M., had some broth,
and then Bible lessons until bed. What the
Kaiserswerth training lacked in expertise it
made up for in a spirit of reverence and dedi-
cation. Florence wrote, “The world here fills
my life with interest and strengthens me in
body and mind” (Huxley, 1975, p. 24).
In 1852, Nightingale visited Ireland, touring
hospitals and keeping notes on various institu-
tions along the way. Nightingale took two trips
to Paris in 1853; hospital training again was the
goal, this time with the sisters of St. Vincent de
Paul, an order of nursing nuns. In August 1853,
she accepted her first “official” nursing post
as superintendent of an “Establishment for
Gentlewomen in Distressed Circumstances
during Illness,” located at 1 Harley Street,
London. After 6 months at Harley Street,
Nightingale wrote in a letter to her father: “I
am in the hey-day of my power” (Nightingale,
cited in Woodham-Smith, 1983, p. 77).
By October 1854, larger horizons beckoned.
Spirituality
Today I am 30—the age Christ began his Mis-
sion. Now no more childish things, no more vain
things, no more love, no more marriage. Now,
Lord let me think only of Thy will, what Thou
willest me to do. O, Lord, Thy will, Thy will.
—FLORENCE NIGHTINGALE, PRIVATE NOTE,
1850, CITED IN WOODHAM-SMITH (1983, p. 130)
By all accounts, Nightingale was an intense
and serious child, always concerned with the
poor and the ill, mature far beyond her years.
A few months before her 17th birthday,
Nightingale recorded in a personal note dated
February 7, 1837, that she had been called to
God’s service. What that service was to be was
unknown at that point in time. This was to be the
first of four such experiences that Nightingale
documented.
The fundamental nature of her religious
convictions made her service to God, through
service to humankind, a driving force in her
life. She wrote: “The kingdom of Heaven is
within; but we must make it without”
(Nightingale, private note, cited in Woodham-
Smith, 1983).
It would take 16 long and torturous years,
from 1837 to 1853, for Nightingale to actualize
her calling to the role of nurse. This was a revo-
lutionary choice for a woman of her social stand-
ing and position, and her desire to nurse met
with vigorous family opposition for many years.
Along the way, she turned down proposals of
marriage, potentially, in her mother’s view, “bril-
liant matches,” such as that of Richard Monckton
Milnes. However, her need to serve God and to
demonstrate her caring through meaningful ac-
tivity proved stronger. She did not think that she
could be married and also do God’s will.
Calabria and Macrae (1994) noted that for
Nightingale, there was no conflict between
CHAPTER 4 • Florence Nightingale’s Legacy of Caring and Its Applications 39
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 39
science and spirituality; actually, in her view,
science is necessary for the development of a
mature concept of God. The development of
science allows for the concept of one perfect
God Who regulates the universe through uni-
versal laws as opposed to random happenings.
Nightingale referred to these laws, or the or-
ganizing principles of the universe, as
“Thoughts of God” (Macrae, 1995, p. 9). As
part of God’s plan of evolution, it was the re-
sponsibility of human beings to discover the
laws inherent in the universe and apply them
to achieve well-being. In Notes on Nursing
(1860/1969, p. 25), she wrote:
God lays down certain physical laws. Upon his car-
rying out such laws depends our responsibility (that
much abused word). . . . Yet we seem to be contin-
ually expecting that He will work a miracle—i.e.
break his own laws expressly to relieve us of respon-
sibility.
Influenced by the Unitarian ideas of her
father and her extended family, as well as by
the more traditional Anglican Church she at-
tended, Nightingale remained for her entire
life a searcher of religious truth, studying a
variety of religions and reading widely. She
was a devout believer in God. Nightingale
wrote: “I believe that there is a Perfect Being,
of whose thought the universe in eternity is
the incarnation” (Calabria & Macrae, 1994,
p. 20). Dossey (1998) recast Nightingale in
the mode of “religious mystic.” However, to
Nightingale, mystical union with God was
not an end in itself but was the source of
strength and guidance for doing one’s work
in life. For Nightingale, service to God was
service to humanity (Calabria & Macrae,
1994, p. xviii).
In Nightingale’s view, nursing should be a
search for the truth; it should be a discovery of
God’s laws of healing and their proper appli-
cation. This is what she was referring to in
Notes on Nursing when she wrote about the
Laws of Health, as yet unidentified. It was the
Crimean War that provided the stage for her
to actualize these foundational beliefs, rooting
forever in her mind certain “truths.” In the
Crimea, she was drawn closer to those suffer-
ing injustice. It was in the Barracks Hospital
of Scutari that Nightingale acted justly and re-
sponded to a call for nursing from the pro-
longed cries of the British soldiers (Boykin &
Dunphy, 2002, p. 17).
War
I stand at the altar of those murdered men and
while I live I fight their cause.
—NIGHTINGALE, CITED IN WOODHAM-SMITH
(1951, P. 182)
Nightingale had powerful friends and had
gained prominence through her study of hos-
pitals and health matters during her travels.
When Great Britain became involved in the
Crimean War in 1854, Nightingale was en-
sconced in her first official nursing post at 1
Harley Street. Britain had joined France and
Turkey to ward off an aggressive Russian ad-
vance in the Crimea (Fig. 4-2). A successful
advance of Russia through Turkey could
threaten the peace and stability of the Euro-
pean continent.
The first actual battle of the war, the Battle
of Alma, was fought in September 1854. It
was written of that battle that it was a “glorious
and bloody victory.” The best communication
technology of the times, the telegraph, was to
have an effect on what was to follow. In previ-
ous wars, news from the battlefields trickled
home slowly. However, the telegraph enabled
war correspondents to transmit reports home
with rapid speed. The horror of the battlefields
was relayed to a concerned citizenry. Descrip-
tions of wounded men, disease, and illness
abounded. Who was to care for these men?
The French had the Sisters of Charity to care
for their sick and wounded. What were the
British to do (Goldie, 1987; Woodham-
Smith, 1951)?
The minister of war was Sidney Herbert,
Lord Herbert of Lea, who was the husband of
Liz Herbert; both were close friends of
Nightingale. Herbert had an innovative solu-
tion: appoint Miss Nightingale and charge her
to head a contingent of nurses to the Crimea
40 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 40
to provide help and organization to the dete-
riorating battlefield situation. It was a brave
move on the part of Herbert. Medicine and
war were exclusively male domains. To send a
woman into these hitherto uncharted waters
was risky at best. But, as is well known,
Nightingale was no ordinary woman, and she
more than rose to the occasion. In a passionate
letter to Nightingale, requesting her to accept
this post, Herbert wrote:
Your own personal qualities, your knowledge and
your power of administration, and among greater
things, your rank and position in society, give you
advantages in such a work that no other person pos-
sesses. (Dolan, 1971, p. 2)
At the same time, such that their letters actu-
ally crossed, Nightingale wrote to Herbert, offer-
ing her services. Accompanied by 38 handpicked
CHAPTER 4 • Florence Nightingale’s Legacy of Caring and Its Applications 41
Fig 4 • 2 The Crimea and the Black Sea, 1854 to 1856. Source: Huxley, E. (1975). Designed by Manuel
Lopez Parras.
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 41
“nurses” who had no formal training, she
arrived on November 4, 1854 to “take
charge” and did not return to England until
August 1856.
Biographer Woodham-Smith and Nightin-
gale’s own correspondence, as cited in a num-
ber of sources (Cook, 1913; Goldie, 1987;
Huxley, 1975; Summers, 1988; Vicinus &
Nergaard, 1990), paint the most vivid picture
of the experiences that Nightingale sustained
there, experiences that cemented her views on
disease and contagion, as well as her commit-
ment to an environmental approach to health
and illness:
The filth became indescribable. The men in the cor-
ridors lay on unwashed floors crawling with vermin.
As the Rev. Sidney Osborne knelt to take down
dying messages, his paper became thickly covered
with lice. There were no pillows, no blankets; the
men lay, with their heads on their boots, wrapped
in the blanket or greatcoat stiff with blood and filth
which had been their sole covering for more than a
week . . . [S]he [Miss Nightingale] estimated . . . .
there were more than 1000 men suffering from
acute diarrhea and only 20 chamber pots. . . .
[T]here was liquid filth which floated over the floor
an inch deep. Huge wooden tubs stood in the halls
and corridors for the men to use. In this filth lay the
men’s food—Miss Nightingale saw the skinned car-
cass of a sheep lie in a ward all night . . . the stench
from the hospital could be smelled outside the walls.
(Woodham-Smith, 1983)
On her arrival in the Crimea, the immedi-
ate priority of Nightingale and her small band
of nurses was not in the sphere of medical or
surgical nursing as currently known; rather,
their order of business was domestic manage-
ment. This is evidenced in the following ex-
change between Nightingale and one of her
party as they approached Constantinople: “Oh,
Miss Nightingale, when we land don’t let there
be any red-tape delays, let us get straight to
nursing the poor fellows!” Nightingale’s reply:
“The strongest will be wanted at the wash tub”
(Cook, 1913; Dolan, 1971).
Although the bulk of this work continued to
be done by orderlies after Nightingale’s arrival
(with the laundry farmed out to the soldiers’
wives), it was accomplished under Nightingale’s
eagle eye: “She insisted on the huge wooden
tubs in the wards being emptied, standing
[obstinately] by the side of each one, sometimes
for an hour at a time, never scolding, never rais-
ing her voice, until the orderlies gave way
and the tub was emptied” (Woodham-Smith,
1951, p. 116).
Nightingale set up her own extra “diet
kitchen.” Small portions, helpings of such
things as arrowroot, port wine, lemonade, rice
pudding, jelly, and beef tea, whose purpose was
to tempt and revive the appetite, were provided
to the men. It was therefore a logical sequence
from cooking to feeding, from administering
food to administering medicines. Because no
antidote to infection existed at this time, the
provision—by Nightingale and her nurses—of
cleanliness, order, encouragement to eat, feed-
ing, clean bed linen, clean bodies, and clean
wards was essential to recovery (Summers,
1988).
Mortality rates at the Barrack Hospital in
Scutari fell. In February, at Nightingale’s in-
sistence, the prime minister had sent to the
Crimea a sanitary commission to investigate
the high mortality rates. Beginning their work
in March, they described the conditions at the
Barrack Hospital as “murderous.” Setting to
work immediately, they opened the channel
through which the water supplying the hospi-
tal flowed, where a dead horse was found. The
commission cleared “556 handcarts and large
baskets full of rubbish . . . 24 dead animals and
2 dead horses buried.” In addition, they
flushed and cleansed sewers, lime-washed
walls, tore out shelves that harbored rats, and
got rid of vermin. The commission, Nightin-
gale said, “saved the British Army.” Miss
Nightingale’s anti-contagionism was sealed as
the mortality rates began showing dramatic
declines (Rosenberg, 1979).
Figure 4-3 illustrates Nightingale’s own
hand-drawn “coxcombs” (as they were referred
to), as Nightingale, always aware of the neces-
sity of documenting outcomes of care, kept
copious records of all sorts (Cook, 1913;
Rosenberg, 1979; Woodham-Smith, 1951).
42 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 42
Florence Nightingale possessed moral author-
ity, so firm because it was grounded in caring
and was in a larger mission that came from her
spirituality. For Miss Nightingale, spirituality
was a much broader, more unifying concept than
that of religion. Her spirituality involved the
sense of a presence higher than humanity, the
divine intelligence that creates, sustains, and or-
ganizes the universe, and an awareness of our
inner connection to this higher reality. Through
this inner connection flows creative endeavors
and insight, a sense of purpose and direction.
For Miss Nightingale, spirituality was intrinsic
to human nature and was the deepest, most po-
tent resource for healing. In Suggestions for
Thought (Calabria & Macrae, 1994, p. 58),
Nightingale wrote that “human consciousness is
tending to become what God’s consciousness
is—to become One with the consciousness of
God.” This progression of consciousness to unity
with the divine was an evolutionary view and not
typical of either the Anglican or Unitarian views
of the time (Calabria & Macrae, 1994; Macrae,
1995; Rosenberg, 1979; Slater, 1994; Welch,
1986; Widerquist, 1992).
There were 4 miles of beds in the Barrack
Hospital at Scutari, a suburb of Constantino-
ple. A letter to the London Times dated
February 24, 1855, reported the following:
“When all the medical officers have retired for
the night and silence and darkness have settled
upon those miles of prostrate sick, she may be
observed, alone with a little lamp in her hand,
making her solitary rounds” (Kalisch &
Kalisch, 1987, p. 46).
In April 1855, after having been in Scutari
for 6 months, Florence wrote to her mother,
“[A]m in sympathy with God, fulfilling the
purpose I came into the world for” (Woodham-
Smith, 1983, p. 97). Henry Wadsworth
Longfellow authored “Santa Filomena” to
commemorate Miss Nightingale.
Lo! In That House of Misery
A lady with a lamp I see
Pass through the glimmering gloom
And flit from room to room
And slow as if in a dream of bliss
The speechless sufferer turns to kiss
Her shadow as it falls
Upon the darkening walls
As if a door in heaven should be
Opened and then closed suddenly
The vision came and went
The light shone and was spent.
A lady with a lamp shall stand
In the great history of the land
A noble type of good
Heroic womanhood (Longfellow, cited in Dolan,
1971, p. 5)
Miss Nightingale slipped home quietly, ar-
riving at Lea Hurst in Derbyshire on August
7, 1856, after 22 months in the Crimea and
after sustained illness from which she was
never to recover, after ceaseless work and after
witnessing suffering, death, and despair that
would haunt her for the remainder of her life.
Her hair was shorn; she was pale and drawn
(Fig. 4-4). She took her family by surprise. The
CHAPTER 4 • Florence Nightingale’s Legacy of Caring and Its Applications 43
Diagram Representing the Mortality in the Hospitals
at Scutari and Kulali from Oct. 1st 1854 to Sept. 30th 1855
Oct. 1 to Oct.10
Oct. 15 to Nov. 11
Nov. 12 to Dec. 9
Dec. 10 to Jan. 6, 1855
Jan. 7 to Jan. 31
Feb. 1 to Feb. 28
Feb. 25 to Mar. 17
Mar. 18 to Apr.7
Apr. 8 to Apr. 28
Apr. 29 to May 19
May 20 to June 9
June 10 to June 30
July 1 to Sept. 30, 1855
1854
22 per 100
85 per 100
155 per 100
179 per 100
321 per 100
427 per 100
315 per 100
144 per 100
107 per 100
52 per
100
48 per
100 22
per
100
22 per 100
Commencement of Sanitary Improvements
Fig 4 • 3 Diagram by Florence Nightingale
showing declining mortality rates. Source:
Cohen (1981).
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 43
next morning, a peal of the village church bells
and a prayer of Thanksgiving were, her sister
wrote, “‘all the innocent greeting’ except for
those provided by the spoils of war that had
proceeded her—a one-legged sailor boy, a
small Russian orphan, and a large puppy found
in some rocks near Balaclava. All England was
ringing with her name, but she had left her heart
on the battlefields of the Crimea and in the
graveyards of Scutari” (Huxley, 1975, p. 147).
Introducing the Theory
In watching disease, both in private homes and
public hospitals, the thing which strikes the ex-
perienced observer most forcefully is this, that the
symptoms or the sufferings generally considered
to be inevitable and incident to the disease are
very often not symptoms of the disease at all, but
of something quite different—of the want of
fresh air, or light, or of warmth, or of quiet, or
of cleanliness, or of punctuality and care in the
administration of diet, of each or of all of these.
—FLORENCE NIGHTINGALE, NOTES ON
NURSING (1860/1969, p. 8)
The Medical Milieu
To gain a better understanding of Nightin-
gale’s ideas on nursing, one must enter the par-
ticular world of 19th-century medicine and its
views on health and disease. Considerable new
medical knowledge had been gained by 1800.
Gross anatomy was well known; chemistry
promised to shed light on various body
processes. Vaccination against smallpox ex-
isted. There were some established drugs in the
pharmacopoeia: cinchona bark, digitalis, and
mercury. Certain major diseases, such as lep-
rosy and the bubonic plague, had almost dis-
appeared. The crude death rate in western
Europe was falling, largely related to decreas-
ing infant mortality as a result of improvement
in hygiene and standard of living (Ackernecht,
1982; Shyrock, 1959).
Yet, in 1800, physicians still had only the
vaguest notion of diagnosis. Speculative
philosophies continued to dominate medical
thought, although inroads continued to be
made that eventually gave way to a new out-
look on the nature of disease: from belief in
general states common to all illnesses to an
understanding of disease-specificity symp-
toms. It was this shift in thought—a para-
digm shift of the first order—that gave us the
triumph of 20th-century medicine, with all
its attendant glories and concurrent sterility.
The 18th century was host to two major tra-
ditions or paradigms in the healing arts: one
based on “empirics” or “experience,” trial and
error, with an emphasis on curative remedies;
the other based on Hippocratic notions and
learning. Evidence of both these trends per-
sisted into the 19th century and can be found
in Nightingale’s philosophy.
Consistent with the philosophical nature
of her superior education (Barritt, 1973),
Nightingale, like many of the physicians of her
time, continued to emphatically disavow the
44 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
Fig 4 • 4 A rare photograph of Florence taken on
her return from the Crimea. Although greatly
weakened by her illness, she refused to accept her
friends’ advice to rest, and pressed on relentlessly
with her plans to reform the army medical serv-
ices. Source: Huxley (1975), p. 139.
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 44
reality of specific states of disease. She insisted
on a view of sickness as an “adjective,” not a
substantive noun. Sickness was not an “entity”
somehow separable from the body. Consistent
with her more holistic view, sickness was an
aspect or quality of the body as a whole. Some
physicians, as she phrased it, taught that dis-
eases were like cats and dogs, distinct species
necessarily descended from other cats and
dogs. She found such views misleading
(Nightingale, 1860/1969).
At this point in time, in the mid-19th cen-
tury, there were two competing theories re-
garding the nature and origin of disease. One
view was known as “contagionism,” postulating
that some diseases were communicable, spread
via commerce and population migration. A
strategic consequence of this explanatory model
was quarantine, and its attendant bureaucracy
aimed at shutting down commerce and trade
to keep disease away from noninfected areas.
To the new and rapidly emerging merchant
classes, quarantine represented government
interference and control (Ackernecht, 1982;
Arnstein, 1988).
The second school of thought on the nature
and origin of disease, of which Nightingale
was an ardent champion, was known as “anti-
contagionism.” It postulated that disease re-
sulted from local environmental sources and
arose out of “miasmas”—clouds of rotting filth
and matter, activated by a variety of things
such as meteorological conditions (note the
similarity to elements of water, fire, air, and
earth on humors); the filth must be eliminated
from local areas to prevent the spread of dis-
ease. Commerce and “infected” individuals
were left alone (Rosenberg, 1979).
William Farr, another Nightingale associate
and avid anti-contagionist, was Britain’s statis-
tical superintendent of the General Register
Office. Farr categorized epidemic and infec-
tious diseases as zygomatic, meaning pertaining
to or caused by the process of fermentation.
The debate as to whether fermentation was a
chemical process or a “vitalistic” one had been
raging for some time (Swazey & Reed, 1978).
The familiarity of the process of fermentation
helps to explain its appeal. Anyone who
had seen bread rise could immediately grasp
how a minute amount of some contaminating
substance could in turn “pollute” the entire at-
mosphere, the very air that was breathed. What
was at issue was the specificity of the contami-
nating substance. Nightingale, and the anti-
contagionists, endorsed the position that a
“sufficiently intense level of atmospheric con-
tamination could induce both endemic and
epidemic ills in the crowded hospital wards
[with particular configurations of environ-
mental circumstances determining which]”
(Rosenberg, 1979).
Anti-contagionism reached its peak be-
fore the political revolutions of 1848; the re-
sulting wave of conservatism and reaction
brought contagionism back into dominance,
where it remained until its reformulation into
the germ theory in the 1870s. Leaders of the
contagionists were primarily high-ranking
military physicians, politically united. These
divergent worldviews accounted in some
part for Nightingale’s clashes with the mili-
tary physicians she encountered during the
Crimean War.
Given the intellectual and social milieu in
which Nightingale was raised and educated, her
stance on contagionism seems preordained and
logically consistent (Rosenberg, 1979). Likewise,
the eclectic religious philosophy she evolved
contained attributes of the philosophy of Uni-
tarianism with the fervor of Evangelicalism, all
based on an organic view of humans as part of
nature. The treatment of disease and dysfunction
was inseparable from the nature of man as a
whole, and likewise, the environment. And all
were linked to God.
The emphasis on “atmosphere” (or “environ-
ment”) in the Nightingale model is consistent
with the views of the “anti-contagionists” of her
time. This worldview was reinforced by
Nightingale’s Crimean experiences, as well as
her liberal and progressive political thought. In
addition, she viewed all ideas as being distilled
through a distinctly moral lens (Rosenberg,
1979). As such, Nightingale was typical of a
number of her generation’s intellectuals. These
thinkers struggled to come to grips with an in-
creasingly complex and changing world order
and frequently combined a language of two dis-
parate realms of authority: the moral realm and
CHAPTER 4 • Florence Nightingale’s Legacy of Caring and Its Applications 45
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 45
the emerging scientific paradigm that has as-
sumed dominance in the 20th century. Tradi-
tional religious and moral assumptions were
garbed in a mantle of “scientific objectivity,”
often spurious at best, but more in keeping with
the increasingly rationalized and bureaucratic
society accompanying the growth of science.
The Feminist Context of
Nightingale’s Caring
I have an intellectual nature which requires sat-
isfaction and that would find it in him. I have a
passionate nature which requires satisfaction and
that would find it in him. I have a moral, an ac-
tive nature which requires satisfaction and that
would not find it in his life.
—FLORENCE NIGHTINGALE, PRIVATE NOTE,
1849, CITED IN WOODHAM-SMITH (1983, p. 51)
Florence Nightingale wrote the following
tortured note upon her final refusal of Richard
Monckton Milnes’s proposal of marriage: “I
know I could not bear his life,” she wrote,
“that to be nailed to a continuation, an exag-
geration of my present life without hope of
another would be intolerable to me—that vol-
untarily to put it out of my power ever to be
able to seize the chance of forming for myself
a true and rich life would seem to be like sui-
cide” (Nightingale, personal note cited in
Woodham-Smith, 1983, p. 52). For Miss
Nightingale there was no compromise. Mar-
riage and pursuit of her “mission” were not
compatible. She chose the mission, a clear re-
pudiation of the mores of her time, which
were rooted in the time-honored role of fam-
ily and “female duty.”
The census of 1851 revealed that there were
365,159 “excess women” in England, meaning
women who were not married. These women
were viewed as redundant, as described in an
essay about the census titled “Why Are Women
Redundant?” (Widerquist, 1992, p. 52). Many
of these women had no acceptable means of
support, and Nightingale’s development of a
suitable occupation for women, that of nursing,
was a significant historical development and a
major contribution by Nightingale to women’s
plight in the 19th century. However, in other
ways, her views on women and the question of
women’s rights were quite mixed.
Notes on Nursing: What It Is and What It Is
Not (1859/1969) was written not as a manual
to teach nurses to nurse but rather to help all
women to learn how to nurse.
Nightingale believed all women required
this knowledge to take proper care of their
families during times of sickness and to pro-
mote health—specifically what Nightingale re-
ferred to as “the health of houses,” that is, the
“health” of the environment, which she es-
poused. Nursing, to her, was clearly situated
within the context of female duty.
In Ordered to Care: The Dilemma of American
Nursing, historian Susan Reverby (1987) traces
contemporary conflicts within the nursing pro-
fession back to Nightingale herself. She asserts
that Nightingale’s ideas about female duty and
authority, along with her views on disease
causality, brought about an independent
field—that of nursing—that was separate, and
in the view of Nightingale, equal, if not supe-
rior, to that of medicine. But this field was
dominated by a female hierarchy and insisted
on both deference and loyalty to the physi-
cian’s authority. Reverby (1987) sums it up as
follows: “Although Nightingale sought to free
women from the bonds of familial demand, in
her nursing model she rebound them in a new
context.” (p. 43)
Does the record support this evidence? Was
Nightingale a champion for women’s rights or
a regressive force? As noted earlier, the answer
is far from clear.
The shelter for all moral and spiritual values,
threatened by the crass commercialism that was
flourishing in the land, as well as the spirit of
critical inquiry that accompanied this age of ex-
panding scientific progress, was agreed upon:
the home. All considered this to be a “sacred
place, a Temple” (Houghton, 1957, p. 343).
And who was the head of this home? Woman.
Although the Victorian family was patriarchal
in nature in that women had virtually no eco-
nomic and/or legal rights, they nonetheless
yielded a major moral authority (Arnstein,
1988; Houghton, 1957; Perkins, 1987).
46 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 46
There was hostility on the part of men as
well as some women toward women’s emanci-
pation. Many intelligent women—for exam-
ple, Beatrice Webb, George Eliot, and, at
times, Nightingale herself—viewed their gen-
der’s emancipation with apprehension. In
Nightingale’s case, the best word might be
“ambivalence.” There was a fear of weakening
women’s moral influence, coarsening the fem-
inine nature itself.
This stance is best equated with cultural
feminism, defined as a belief in inherent gen-
der differences. Women, in contrast to men,
are viewed as morally superior, the holders of
family values and continuity; they are refined,
delicate, and in need of protection. This
school of thought, important in the 19th cen-
tury, used arguments for women’s suffrage
such as the following: “[W]omen must make
themselves felt in the public sphere because
their moral perspective would improve cor-
rupt masculine politics.” In the case of
Nightingale, these cultural feminist attitudes
“made her impatient with the idea of women
seeking rights and activities just because men
valued these entities” (Bunting & Campbell,
1990, p. 21).
Nightingale had chafed at the limitations
and restrictions placed on women, especially
“wealthy” women with nothing to do: “What
these [women] suffer—even physically—
from the want of such work no one can tell.
The accumulation of nervous energy, which
has had nothing to do during the day, makes
them feel every night, when they go to bed,
as if they were going mad.” Despite these
vivid words, authored by Nightingale
(1852/1979) in the fiery polemic “Cassan-
dra,” which was used as a rallying cry in
many feminist circles, her view of the solu-
tion was measured. Her own resolution,
painfully arrived at, was to break from her
family and actualize her caring mission, that
of nurse. One of the many results of this was
that a useful occupation for other women to
pursue was founded. Although Nightingale
approved of this occupation outside of the
home for other women, certain other occu-
pations—that of doctor, for example—she
viewed with hostility and as inappropriate
for women. Why should these women not
be nurses or nurse midwives, a far superior
calling in Nightingale’s view than that of a
medicine “man” (Monteiro, 1984)?
Welch (1990) termed Nightingale a
“Christian feminist” on the eve of her depar-
ture to the Crimea. She returned even more
skeptical of women. Writing to her close
friend Mary Clarke Mohl, she described
women whom she worked with in the Crimea
as being incompetent and incapable of inde-
pendent thought (Welch, 1990; Woodham-
Smith, 1983). According to Palmer (1977), by
this time in her life, the concerns of the British
people and the demands of service to God took
precedence over any concern she had ever had
about women’s rights.
In other words, Nightingale, despite the
clear freedom in which she lived her own life,
nonetheless genderized the nursing role, leaving
it rooted in 19th-century morality. Nightingale
is seen constantly trying to improve the exist-
ing order and to work within that order; she
was above all a reformer, seeking to improve
the existing order, not to change the terrain
radically.
In Nightingale’s mind, the specific “scien-
tific” activity of nursing—hygiene—was the
central element in health care, without which
medicine and surgery would be ineffective:
The Life and Death, recovery or invaliding of patients
generally depends not on any great and isolated
act, but on the unremitting and thorough perform-
ance of every minute’s practical duty. (Nightingale,
1860/1969)
This “practical duty” was the work of
women, and the conception of the proper di-
vision of labor resting on work demands inter-
nal to each respective “science,” nursing and
medicine, obscured the professional inequality.
The later successes of medical science height-
ened this inequity. The scientific grounding
espoused by Nightingale for nursing was
ephemeral at best, as later 19th-century dis-
coveries proved much of her analysis wrong,
although nonetheless powerful. Much of her
CHAPTER 4 • Florence Nightingale’s Legacy of Caring and Its Applications 47
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 47
strength was in her rhetoric; if not always log-
ically consistent, it certainly was morally reso-
nant (Rosenberg, 1979).
Despite exceptional anomalies, such as
women physicians, what Nightingale effec-
tively accomplished was a genderization of
the division of labor in health care: male
physicians and female nurses. This appears to
be a division that Nightingale supported. Be-
cause this “natural” division of labor was
rooted in the family, women’s work outside
the home ought to resemble domestic tasks
and complement the “male principle” with
the “female.” Thus, nursing was left on the
shifting sands of a soon-outmoded “science”;
the main focus of its authority grounded in
an equally shaky moral sphere, also subject to
change and devaluation in an increasingly
secularized, rationalized, and technological
20th century.
Nightingale failed to provide institution-
alized nursing with an autonomous future, on
an equal parity with medicine. She did, how-
ever, succeed in providing women’s work in
the public sphere, establishing for numerous
women an identity and source of employ-
ment. Although that public identity grew out
of women’s domestic and nurturing roles in
the family, the conditions of a modern society
required public as well as private forms of
care. It is questionable whether more could
have been achieved at that point in time
(King, 1988).
A woman, Queen Victoria, presided over
the age: “Ironically, Queen Victoria, that
panoply of family happiness and stubborn ad-
versary of female independence, could not help
but shed her aura upon single women.” The
queen’s early and lengthy widowhood, her “re-
lentlessly spreading figure and commensurately
increasing empire, her obstinate longevity
which engorged generations of men and the
collective shocks of history, lent an epic quality
to the lives of solitary women” (Auerbach,
1982, pp. 120–121). Both Nightingale and the
queen saw themselves as working through
men, yet their lives added new, unexpected,
and powerful dimensions to the myth of
Victorian womanhood, particularly that of a
woman alone and in command (Auerbach,
1982, pp. 120–121).
Nightingale’s clearly chosen spinsterhood
repudiated the Victorian family. Her unmar-
ried life provides a vision of a powerful life
lived on her own terms. This is not the spin-
sterhood of convention—one to be pitied, one
of broken hearts—but a radically new image.
She is freed from the trivia of family com-
plaints and scorns the feminist collectivity; yet
in this seemingly solitary life, she finds union
not with one man but with all men, personified
by the British soldier.
Lytton Strachey’s well-known evocation of
Nightingale, iconoclastic and bold, is perhaps
closest to the decidedly masculine imagery she
selected to describe herself, as evidenced in
this imaginary speech to her mother written
in 1852:
Well, my dear, you don’t imagine with my “talents,”
and my “European reputation” and my “beautiful let-
ters” and all that, I’m going to stay dangling around
my mother’s drawing room all my life! . . . [Y]ou must
look upon me as your vagabond son . . . I shan’t
cost you nearly as much as a son would have done,
or had I married. You must consider me married or
a son. (Woodham-Smith, 1983, p. 66)
Ideas About Nursing
Every day sanitary knowledge, or the knowledge
of nursing, or in other words, of how to put the
constitution in such a state as that it will have
no disease, or that it can recover from disease,
takes a higher place.
—FLORENCE NIGHTINGALE, NOTES ON
NURSING (1860/1969), PREFACE
Evelyn R. Barritt, professor of nursing and
Nightingale scholar, suggested that nursing
became a science when Nightingale identified
the laws of nursing, also referred to as the laws
of health, or nature (Barritt, 1973; Nightin-
gale, 1860/1969). The remainder of all nursing
theory may be viewed as mere branches and
“acorns,” all fruit of the roots of Nightingale’s
ideas. Early writings of Nightingale, compiled
48 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 48
in Notes on Nursing: What It Is and What It Is
Not (1860/1969), provided the earliest system-
atic perspective for defining nursing. Accord-
ing to Nightingale, analysis and application of
universal “laws” would promote well-being and
relieve the suffering of humanity. This was the
goal of nursing.
As noted by the caring theorist Madeline
Leininger, Nightingale never defined human
care or caring in Nightingale’s Notes on Nursing
(1859/1992, p. 31), and she goes on to wonder
if Nightingale considered “components of care
such as comfort, support, nurturance, and
many other care constructs and characteristics
and how they would influence the reparative
process.” Although Nightingale’s conceptual-
izations of nursing, hygiene, the laws of health,
and the environment never explicitly identify
the construct of caring, an underlying ethos of
care and commitment to others echoes in her
words and, most importantly, resides in her ac-
tions and the drama of her life.
Nightingale did not theorize in the way to
which we are accustomed today. Patricia
Winstead-Fry (1993), in a review of the 1992
commemorative edition of Nightingale’s
Notes on Nursing (1859/1992, p. 161), states:
“Given that theory is the interrelationship of
concepts which form a system of propositions
that can be tested and used for predicting
practice, Nightingale was not a theorist.
None of her major biographers present her as
a theorist. She was a consummate politician
and health care reformer.” And our emerging
21st century has never been more in need of
nurses who are consummate politicians and
health-care reformers. Her words and ideas,
contextualized in the earlier portion of this
chapter, ring differently than those of the
other nursing theorists you will study in this
book. However, her underlying ideas con-
tinue to be relevant and, some would argue,
prescient.
Lynn McDonald, Canadian professor of
sociology and editor of the Collected Works of
Florence Nightingale, a 16-volume collection,
places Nightingale among the most promi-
nent “Women Methodologists” identified in
The Women Founders of the Social Sciences
(McDonald, 1994). McDonald notes that
Nightingale was firmly committed to “a deter-
mined, probabilistic social science” and goes
on to state that “Indeed, she [Nightingale] de-
scribed the laws of social science as God’s laws
for the right operation of the world” (p. 186).
Nightingale was convinced of the necessity for
evaluative statistics to underpin rational ap-
proaches to public administrations. Consis-
tently she used the presentation of statistical
data to prove her case that the costs of disease,
crime, and excess mortality was greater than the
cost of sanitary improvements. In later life,
Nightingale endeavored to establish a chair
or readership at Oxford University to teach
Quetelet’s statistical approaches and probability
theory. In today’s world, this would translate to
a commitment to evidence-based practice as
justification for nursing’s value.
Karen Dennis and Patricia Prescott (1985)
noted that including Nightingale among the
nurse theorists has been a recent development.
They make the case that nurses today continue
to incorporate in their practice the insight,
foresight, and, most important, the clinical
acumen of Nightingale’s more than century
and a half vision of nursing. As part of a larger
study, they collected a large base of descrip-
tions from both nurses and physicians describ-
ing “good” nursing practice. More than 300
individual interviews were subjected to content
analysis; categories were named inductively
and validated separately by four members of
the project staff.
Noting no marked differences in the de-
scriptions obtained from either the nurses or
physicians, the authors report that despite
their independent derivation, the categories
that emerged during the study bore a striking
resemblance to nursing practice as described
by Nightingale: prevention of illness and pro-
motion of health, observation of the sick, and
attention to the physical environment. Also
referred to by Nightingale as the “health of
houses,” this physical environment included
ventilation of both the patient’s rooms and the
larger environment of the “house”: light,
cleanliness, and the taking of food; attention
to the interpersonal milieu, which included
CHAPTER 4 • Florence Nightingale’s Legacy of Caring and Its Applications 49
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 49
variety; and not indulging in superficialities with
the sick or giving them false encouragement.
The authors noted that “the words change
but the concepts do not” (Dennis & Prescott,
1985, p. 80). In keeping with the tradition
established by Nightingale, they noted that
nurses continue to foster an interpersonal
milieu that focuses on the person while ma-
nipulating and mediating the environment
to “put the patient in the best condition for
nature to act upon him” (Nightingale, 1860/
1969, p. 133).
Afaf I. Meleis (1997), nurse scholar, does
not compare Nightingale to contemporary
nurse theorists; nonetheless, she refers to her fre-
quently. Meleis stated that it was Nightingale’s
conceptualization of environment as the
focus of nursing activity and her de-emphasis
of pathology, emphasizing instead the “laws
of health” (which she said were yet to be
identified), that were the earliest differenti-
ation of nursing and medicine. Meleis (1997,
pp. 114–116) described Nightingale’s con-
cept of nursing as including “the proper use
of fresh air, light, warmth, cleanliness, quiet,
and the proper selection and administration
of diet, all with the least expense of vital
power to the patient.” These ideas clearly had
evolved from Nightingale’s observations and
experiences. The art of observation was iden-
tified as an important nursing function in the
Nightingale model. And this observation was
what should form the basis for nursing ideas.
Meleis speculates on how differently the the-
oretical base of nursing might have evolved
if we had continued to consider extant nurs-
ing practice as a source of ideas.
Pamela Reed and Tamara Zurakowski
(1983/1989, p. 33) called the Nightingale
model “visionary.” They stated: “At the core of
all theory development activities in nursing
today is the tradition of Florence Nightingale.”
They also suggest four major factors that influ-
enced her model of nursing: religion, science,
war, and feminism, all of which are discussed
in this chapter.
The following assumptions were identified
by Victoria Fondriest and Joan Osborne
(1994).
Nightingale’s Assumptions
1. Nursing is separate from medicine.
2. Nurses should be trained.
3. The environment is important to the
health of the patient.
4. The disease process is not important to
nursing.
5. Nursing should support the environment
to assist the patient in healing.
6. Research should be used through observa-
tion and empirics to define the nursing
discipline.
7. Nursing is both an empirical science and
an art.
8. Nursing’s concern is with the person in
the environment.
9. The person is interacting with the
environment.
10. Sickness and wellness are governed by the
same laws of health.
11. The nurse should be observant and
confidential.
The goal of nursing as described by
Nightingale is assisting the patient in his or her
retention of “vital powers” by meeting his or
her needs, and thus, putting the patient in the
best condition for nature to act upon
(Nightingale, 1860/1969). This must not be in-
terpreted as a “passive state” but rather one that
reflects the patient’s capacity for self-healing
facilitated by nurses’ ability to create an envi-
ronment conducive to health. The focus of this
nursing activity was the proper use of fresh air,
light, warmth, cleanliness, quiet, proper selec-
tion and administration of diet, monitoring the
patient’s expenditure of energy, and observing.
This activity was directed toward the environ-
ment and the patient (see Nightingale’s
Assumptions).
Health was viewed as an additive process—
the result of environmental, physical, and psy-
chological factors, not just the absence of
disease. Disease was the reparative process of
the body to correct a problem and could pro-
vide an opportunity for spiritual growth. The
laws of health, as defined by Nightingale, were
those to do with keeping the person, and the
population, healthy. They were dependent on
50 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 50
proper environmental control, for example,
sanitation. The environment was what the
nurse manipulated; it included the physical
elements external to the patient.
Nightingale isolated five environmental
components essential to an individual’s health:
clean air, pure water, efficient drainage, clean-
liness, and light.
The patient is at the center of the
Nightingale model, which incorporates a ho-
listic view of the person as someone with
psychological, intellectual, and spiritual com-
ponents. This is evidenced in her acknowl-
edgment of the importance of “variety.” For
example, she wrote of “the degree . . . to
which the nerves of the sick suffer from see-
ing the same walls, the same ceiling, the same
surroundings” (Nightingale, 1860/1969). Like-
wise, her chapter on “chattering hopes and
advice” illustrates an astute grasp of human
nature and of interpersonal relationships. She
remarked on the spiritual component of dis-
ease and illness, and she felt they could pres-
ent an opportunity for spiritual growth. In
this, all persons were viewed as equal.
A nurse was defined as any woman who
had “charge of the personal health of some-
body,” whether well, as in caring for babies
and children, or sick, as an “invalid”
(Nightingale, 1860/1969). It was assumed
that all women, at one time or another in
their lives, would nurse. Thus, all women
needed to know the laws of health. Nursing
proper, or “sick” nursing, was both an art and
a science and required organized, formal ed-
ucation to care for those suffering from dis-
ease. Above all, nursing was “service to God
in relief of man”; it was a “calling” and
“God’s work” (Barritt, 1973). Nursing activ-
ities served as an “art form” through which
spiritual development might occur (Reed &
Zurakowski, 1983/1989). All nursing actions
were guided by the nurses’ caring, which was
guided by underlying ideas about God.
Consistent with this caring base is
Nightingale’s views on nursing as an art and a
science. Again, this was a reflection of the mar-
riage, essential to Nightingale’s underlying
worldview, of science and spirituality. On the
surface, these might appear to be odd bedfel-
lows; however, this marriage flows directly
from Nightingale’s underlying religious and
philosophic views, which were operational-
ized in her nursing practice. Nightingale was
an empiricist, valuing the “science” of obser-
vation with the intent of using that knowl-
edge to better the life of humankind. The
application of that knowledge required an
artist’s skill, far greater than that of the
painter or sculptor:
Nursing is an art; and if it is to be made an art, it re-
quires as exclusive a devotion, as hard a prepara-
tion, as any painter’s or sculptor’s work; for what is
the having to do with dead canvas or cold marble,
compared with having to do with the living body—
the Temple of God’s spirit? It is one of the Fine Arts;
I had almost said, the finest of the Fine Arts. (Florence
Nightingale, cited in Donahue, 1985, p. 469)
Nightingale’s ideas about nursing health,
the environment, and the person were
grounded in experience; she regarded one’s
sense observations as the only reliable means
of obtaining and verifying knowledge. The-
ory must be reformulated if inconsistent with
empirical evidence. This experiential knowl-
edge was then to be transformed into empir-
ically based generalizations, an inductive
process, to arrive at, for example, the laws
of health. Regardless of Nightingale’s com-
mitment to empiricism and experiential
knowledge, her early education and religious
experience also shaped this emerging knowl-
edge (Hektor, 1992).
According to Nightingale’s model, nursing
contributes to the ability of persons to maintain
and restore health directly or indirectly through
managing the environment. The person has a
key role in his or her own health, and this
health is a function of the interaction among
person, nurse, and environment. However, nei-
ther the person nor the environment is dis-
cussed as influencing the nurse (Fig. 4-5).
Although it is difficult to describe the inter-
relationship of the concepts in the Nightingale
model, Figure 4-6 is a schema that attempts
to delineate this. Note the prominence of
CHAPTER 4 • Florence Nightingale’s Legacy of Caring and Its Applications 51
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 51
52 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
Health of houses
Cleanliness of rooms
Ventilation and warming
Bed and bedding
Taking food
What food?
Noise
Chattering hopes
and advices
Variety
Observation
Personal cleanliness
Petty management
Light
Order
of
significance
Fig 4 • 5 Perspective on Nightingale’s 13 canons.
Illustration developed by V. Fondriest, RN, BSN, and
J. Osborne, RN, C BSN in October 1994.
Observation
Management
Ventilation & warming
Health of houses (pure air, water & light)
“Nursing”
“Environment”
Cleanliness
of rooms &
walls
Taking food
What food ?
Personal
cleanliness
Bed &
bedding
Light,
noise &
variety
Chattering
hopes &
advices
Fig 4 • 6 Nightingale’s model of nursing and the environment. Illustration developed by V. Fondriest, RN, BSN,
and J. Osborne, RN, C BSN.
“observation” on the outer circle (important to
all nursing functions) and the interrelationship
of the specifics of the interventions, such as
“bed and bedding” and “cleanliness of rooms
and walls,” that go into making up the “health
of houses” (Fondriest & Osborne, 1994).
Nightingale’s Legacy for 21st
Century Nursing Practice
Philip Kalisch and Beatrice Kalisch (1987,
p. 26) described the popular and glorified im-
ages that arose out of the portrayals of Florence
Nightingale during and after the Crimean
War—that of nurse as self-sacrificing, refined,
virginal, and an “angel of mercy,” a far less
threatening image than one of educated and
skilled professional nurses. They attribute
nurses’ low pay to the perception of nursing as
a “calling,” a way of life for devoted women
with private means, such as Florence Nightingale
(Kalisch & Kalisch, 1987, p. 20). Well over
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 52
100 years later, the amount of scholarship on
Nightingale provides a more realistic portrait
of a complex and brilliant woman. To quote
Auerbach (1982) and Strachey (1918), she was
“a demon, a rebel.”
Florence Nightingale’s legacy of caring and
the activism it implies is carried on in nursing
today. There is a resurgence and inclusion of
concepts of spirituality in current nursing
practice and a delineation of nursing’s caring
base that in essence began with the nursing
life of Florence Nightingale. Nightingale’s
caring, as demonstrated in this chapter, ex-
tended beyond the individual patient, beyond
the individual person. She herself said that the
specific business of nursing was the least im-
portant of the functions into which she had
been forced in the Crimea. Her caring encom-
passed a broadened sphere—that of the
British Army and, indeed, the entire British
Commonwealth.
Themes in contemporary nursing practice
focusing on evidence-based practice and cur-
ricula championing cultures of safety and qual-
ity are all found in the life and works of
Florence Nightingale. I would venture to say
that almost all contemporary nursing practice
settings echo some aspect of the ideas—and
ideals—of Nightingale. Themes of Nightin-
gale, the environmentalist, are critical to nurs-
ing practice for the individual, the community,
and global health. An exemplar of practice
personifying Nightingale’s approach and prac-
tice would be a larger-than-life nurse hero or
heroine championing current health-care re-
form by designing health-care systems that are
truly responsive to the needs of the populace
and that extend cross-culturally and globally.
CHAPTER 4 • Florence Nightingale’s Legacy of Caring and Its Applications 53
■ Summary
The unique aspects of Florence Nightingale’s
personality and social position, combined with
historical circumstances, laid the groundwork
for the evolution of the modern discipline of
nursing. Are the challenges and obstacles that
we face today any more daunting than what
confronted Nightingale when she arrived in
the Crimea in 1854? Nursing for Florence
Nightingale was what we might call today her
“centering force.” It allowed her to express her
spiritual values as well as enabled her to fulfill
her needs for leadership and authority. As his-
torian Susan Reverby noted, today we are chal-
lenged with the dilemma of how to practice our
integral values of caring in an unjust health-care
system that does not value caring. Let us look
again to Florence Nightingale for inspiration,
for she remains a role model par excellence on
the transformation of values of caring into an
activism that could potentially transform our
current health-care system into a more human-
istic and just one. Her activism situates her in
the context of justice making. Justice making is
understood as a manifestation of compassion
and caring, for it is actions that bring about jus-
tice (Boykin & Dunphy, 2002, p. 16). Florence
Nightingale’s legacy of connecting caring with
activism can then truly be said to continue.
References
Ackernecht, E. (1982). A short history of medicine.
Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press.
Arnstein, W. (1988). Britain: Yesterday and today.
Lexington, MA: Heath.
Auerbach, N. (1982). Women and the demon: The life of a
Victorian myth. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University
Press.
Barritt, E. R. (1973). Florence Nightingale’s values and
modern nursing education. Nursing Forum, 12, 7–47.
Boykin, A., & Dunphy, L. M. (2002). Justice-making:
Nursing’s call. Policy, Politics, & Nursing Practice, 3,
14–19.
Bunting, S., & Campbell, J. (1990). Feminism and nurs-
ing: An historical perspective. Advances in Nursing
Science, 12, 11–24.
Calabria, M., & Macrae, J. (Eds.). (1994). Suggestions
for thought by Florence Nightingale: Selections and
commentaries. Philadelphia: University of
Pennsylvania Press.
Cohen, I. B. (1981). Florence Nightingale: The passion-
ate statistician. Scientific American, 250(3), 128–137.
Cook, E. T. (1913). The life of Florence Nightingale
(vols. 1–2). London: Macmillan.
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 53
Cromwell, Judith Lissauer (2013). Florence Nightingale,
Feminist. London: McFarland & Co., Inc., Publishers.
Dennis, K. E., & Prescott, P. A. (1985). Florence
Nightingale: Yesterday, today and tomorrow.
Advances in Nursing Science, 7(2), 66–81.
Dolan, J. (1971). The grace of the great lady. Chicago:
Medical Heritage Society.
Donahue, P. (1985). Nursing: The finest art. St. Louis,
MO: Mosby.
Dossey, B. (1998). Florence Nightingale: A 19th century
mystic. Journal of Holistic Nursing, 16(2), 111–164.
Fondriest, V., & Osborne, J. (1994). A theorist before
her time? Presentation, NGR Nursing Graduate
Course 5110, Nursing Theory and Advanced
Practice Nursing, School of Nursing, Florida
International University, North Miami, FL.
Goldie, S. (1987). I have done my duty: Florence Nightin-
gale in the Crimean War, 1854–1856. Iowa City:
University of Iowa Press.
Gourley, J. (2003). Florence Nightingale and the health of
the Raj. Cornwall, England: MPG Books.
Hektor, L. M. (1992). Nursing, science, and gender:
Florence Nightingale and Martha E. Rogers. Unpub-
lished doctoral dissertation, University of Miami.
Houghton, W. (1957). The Victorian frame of mind.
New Haven, CT: Yale University Press.
Huxley, E. (1975). Florence Nightingale. New York:
Putnam.
Kalisch, P. A., & Kalisch, B. J. (1987). The changing
image of the nurse. Menlo Park, CA: Addison-
Wesley.
King, M. G. (1988). Gender: A hidden issue in nurs-
ing’s professionalizing reform movement. Boston:
Boston University School of Nursing. In Strategies
for Theory Development V, March 10–12.
Macrae, J. (1995). Nightingale’s spiritual philosophy and
its significance for modern nursing. Image: Journal of
Nursing Scholarship, 27, 8–10.
McDonald, L. (1994). The women founders of the social
sciences. Quebec, Canada: Carleton University Press.
McDonald, L. (Ed.). (2002–2012). The collected works of
Florence Nightingale Series (Vols. 1-3, 5-7, 11-16).
Ontario, Canada: Wilfrid Laurier University Press.
Meleis, A. I. (1997). Theoretical nursing: Development and
progress (3rd ed.). Philadelphia: Lippincott.
Monteiro, L. (1984). On separate roads: Florence
Nightingale and Elizabeth Blackwell. Signs: Journal
of Women in Culture & Society, 9, 520–533.
Nightingale, F. (1852/1979). Cassandra, with an intro-
duction by Myra Stark. Westbury, NY: Feminist
Press.
Nightingale, F. (1859/1992). Notes on nursing: Commem-
orative edition with commentaries by contemporary
nursing leaders. Philadelphia: J. B. Lippincott.
Nightingale, F. (1860). Suggestions for thought to searchers
after religious truths (vols. 2–3). London: George E.
Eyre & William Spottiswoode.
Nightingale, F. (1860/1969). Notes on nursing: What it is
and what it is not. New York: Dover.
Palmer, I. S. (1977). Florence Nightingale: Reformer,
reactionary, research. Nursing Research, 26, 84–89.
Perkins, J. (1987). Women and marriage in nineteenth
century England. Chicago: Lyceum Books.
Reed, P. G., & Zurakowski, T. L. (1983/1989).
Nightingale: A visionary model for nursing. In J.
Fitzpatrick & A. Whall (Eds.), Conceptual models of
nursing: Analysis and application. Bowie, MD: Robert
J. Brady.
Reverby, S. M. (1987). Ordered to care: The dilemma of
American nursing (1865–1945). New York:
Cambridge University Press.
Rosenberg, C. (1979). Healing and history. New York:
Science History Publications.
Sattin, A. (Ed.). (1987). Florence Nightingale’s letters from
Egypt: A journey on the Nile, 1849–1850. New York:
Weidenfeld & Nicolson.
Shyrock, R. (1959). The history of nursing. Philadelphia:
Saunders.
Slater, V. E. (1994). The educational and philosophical
influences on Florence Nightingale, an enlightened
conductor. Nursing History Review, 2, 137–152.
Strachey, L. (1918). Eminent Victorians: Cardinal
Manning, Florence Nightingale, Dr. Arnold, General
Gordon. London: Chatto & Windus.
Summers, A. (1988). Angels and citizens: British women
as military nurses, 1854–1914. London: Routledge &
Kegan Paul.
Swazey, J., & Reed, K. (1978). Louis Pasteur: Science
and the application of science. In J. Swazey & K.
Reed (Eds.), Today’s medicine, tomorrow’s science
(DHEW Pub. No. NIH 78–244). Washington, DC:
U.S. Government Printing Office.
Valle, G. (Ed.). (2003–2007). The collected works of
Florence Nightingale Series (Vols. 4, 9-10). Ontario,
Canada: Wilfrid Laurier University Press.
Vicinus, M., & Nergaard, B. (Eds.). (1990). Ever yours,
Florence Nightingale: Selected letters. Cambridge, MA:
Harvard University Press.
Watson, J. (1992). Commentary. In Notes on nursing:
What it is and what it is not (pp. 80–85). Commemo-
rative edition. Philadelphia: Lippincott.
Welch, M. (1986). Nineteenth-century philosophic
influences on Nightingale’s concept of the person.
Journal of Nursing History, 1(2), 3–11.
Welch, M. (1990). Florence Nightingale: The social
construction of a Victorian feminist. Western Journal
of Nursing Research, 12, 404–407.
Widerquist, J. G. (1992). The spirituality of Florence
Nightingale. Nursing Research, 41, 49–55.
Winstead-Fry, P. (1993). Book review: Notes on nursing:
What it is and what it is not. Commemorative
edition. Nursing Science Quarterly, 6(3), 161–162.
Woodham-Smith, C. (1951). Florence Nightingale.
New York: McGraw-Hill Book Company
54 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch04_035-054 26/12/14 2:28 PM Page 54
Virginia Henderson
Chapter 5Early Conceptualizations
About Nursing
Ernestine Wiedenbach, Virginia
Henderson, and Lydia Hall
SHIRLEY C. GORDON
Introducing the Theorists
Overview of Wiedenbach, Henderson,
and Hall’s Conceptualizations of Nursing
Practice Applications
Practice Exemplars
Summary
References
Ernestine Wiedenbach
55
Introducing the Theorists
Ernestine Wiedenbach, Virginia Henderson,
and Lydia Hall are three of the most important
influences on nursing theory development of
the 20th century. Indeed, their work continues
to ground nursing thought in the new century.
The work of each of these nurse scholars was
based on nursing practice, and today some of
this work might be referred to as practice theo-
ries. Concepts and terms they first used are
heard today around the globe.
This chapter provides a brief introduction to
Wiedenbach, Henderson, and Hall; an overview
of their nursing conceptualizations; and sections
on practice applications and practice exemplars
based on their published works. The content of
this chapter is partially based on work from
scholars who have studied or worked with these
theorists and who wrote chapters for the first,
second and/or third editions of Nursing Theories
and Nursing Practice (Gesse, Dombro, Gordon,
& Rittman, 2006, 2010; Gordon, 2001; Touhy
& Birnbach, 2006, 2010).1
Ernestine Wiedenbach
Wiedenbach was born in 1900 in Germany to
an American mother and a German father,
who immigrated to the United States when
Ernestine was a child. She received a bachelor
of arts degree from Wellesley College in 1922
and graduated from Johns Hopkins School of
Nursing in 1925 (Nickel, Gesse, & MacLaren,
Lydia Hall
1For additional information please see the bonus chapter
content available at http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
3312_Ch05_055-066 26/12/14 2:41 PM Page 55
1992). After completing a master of arts at
Columbia University in 1934, she became a
professional writer for the American Journal of
Nursing and played a critical role in the recruit-
ment of nursing students and military nurses
during World War II. At age 45, she began
her studies in nurse-midwifery. Wiedenbach’s
roles as practitioner, teacher, author, and the-
orist were consolidated as a member of the
Yale University School of Nursing, where Yale
colleagues William Dickoff and Patricia James
encouraged her development of prescriptive
theory (Dickoff, James, & Wiedenbach, 1968).
Even after her retirement in 1966, she and her
lifelong friend Caroline Falls offered informal
seminars in Miami, always reminding students
and faculty of the need for clarity of purpose,
based on reality. She even continued to use her
gift for writing to transcribe books for the
blind, including a Lamaze childbirth manual,
which she prepared on her Braille typewriter.
Ernestine Wiedenbach died in April 1998 at
age 98.
Virginia Henderson
Born in Kansas City, Missouri, in 1897, Virginia
Avenel Henderson was the fifth of eight chil-
dren. With two of her brothers serving in the
armed forces during World War I and in antic-
ipation of a critical shortage of nurses, Virginia
Henderson entered the Army School of Nursing
at Walter Reed Army Hospital. It was there
that she began to question the regimentation
of patient care and the concept of nursing as
ancillary to medicine (Henderson, 1991).
As a member of society during a war, Hen-
derson considered it a privilege to care for sick
and wounded soldiers (Henderson, 1960).
This wartime experience forever influenced
her ethical understanding of nursing and her
appreciation of the importance and complexity
of the nurse–patient relationship.
After a summer spent with the Henry Street
Visiting Nurse Agency in New York City,
Henderson began to appreciate the importance
of getting to know the patients and their envi-
ronments. She enjoyed the less formal visiting
nurse approach to patient care and became skep-
tical of the ability of hospital regimes to alter
patients’ unhealthy ways of living upon returning
home (Henderson, 1991). She entered Teachers
College at Columbia University, earning her
baccalaureate degree in 1932 and her master’s
degree in 1934. She continued at Teachers Col-
lege as an instructor and associate professor of
nursing for the next 20 years.
Virginia Henderson presented her definition
of the nature of nursing in an era when few
nurses had ventured into describing the complex
phenomena of modern nursing. Henderson
wrote about nursing the way she lived it: focus-
ing on what nurses do, how nurses function, and
nursing’s unique role in health care. Henderson
has been heralded as the greatest advocate for
nursing libraries worldwide. Of all her contribu-
tions to nursing, Virginia Henderson’s work
on the identification and control of nursing
literature is perhaps her greatest. In the 1950s,
there was an increasing interest on the part of
the profession to establish a research basis for
the nursing practice. After the completion of
her revised text in 1955, Henderson moved to
Yale University and began what would become
a distinguished career in library science research.
In 1990, the Sigma Theta Tau International
Library was named in her honor.
Lydia Hall
Lydia Hall, born in 1906, was a visionary, risk
taker, and consummate professional. She in-
spired commitment and dedication through
her unique conceptual framework.
A 1927 graduate of the York Hospital
School of Nursing in Pennsylvania, Hall held
various nursing positions during the early years
of her career. In the mid-1930s, she enrolled at
Teachers College, Columbia University, where
she earned a Bachelor of Science degree in
1937, and a Master of Arts degree in 1942. She
worked with the Visiting Nurse Service of New
York from 1941 to 1947 and was a member of
the nursing faculty at Fordham Hospital
School of Nursing from 1947 to 1950. Hall was
subsequently appointed to a faculty position at
Teachers College, where she developed and
implemented a program in nursing consulta-
tion and joined a community of nurse leaders.
At the same time, she was involved in research
activities for the U.S. Public Health Service
(Birnbach, 1988).
Hall’s most significant contribution to
nursing practice was the practice model she
56 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch05_055-066 26/12/14 2:41 PM Page 56
designed and put into place in the Loeb Center
for Nursing and Rehabilitation at Montefiore
Medical Center in Bronx, New York. The Loeb
Center, which opened in 1963, was the culmi-
nation of 5 years of planning and construction
under Hall’s direction in collaboration with
Dr. Martin Cherkasky.
As a visiting nurse, Hall had frequent
contact through the Montefiore home care
program. Hall and Cherkasky discovered
they shared similar philosophies regarding
health care and the delivery of quality service
(Birnbach, 1988). In 1950, Cherkasky was
appointed director of the Montefiore Medical
Center. Convalescent treatment was undergo-
ing rapid change owing largely to medical
advances, new pharmaceuticals, and techno-
logical developments. The emerging trends led
to the closing of the Solomon and Betty Loeb
Memorial Home in Westchester County, New
York, and Cherkasky and Hall convinced the
board to join with Montefiore in founding
the Loeb Center for Nursing and Rehabilita-
tion. A unique feature of the center was a
separate board of trustees that interrelated
with the Montefiore board. As a result, Hall
had considerable autonomy in developing the
center’s policies and procedures.
Hall increased the role of nurses in decision
making. For example, nurses selected patients
for the Loeb Center based on a nursing assess-
ment of an individual patient’s potential for
rehabilitation. In addition, qualified profes-
sional nurses provided direct care to patients
and coordinated needed services. Hall fre-
quently described the center as “a halfway house
on the road home” (Hall, 1963, p. 2), where
the nurse worked with the patients as active par-
ticipants in achieving desired outcomes that
were meaningful to the patients. Over time, the
effectiveness of Hall’s practice model was vali-
dated by the significant decline in the number
of readmissions among former Loeb patients
compared with those who received other types
of posthospital care (“Montefiore cuts,” 1966).
Hall died in 1969, and in 1984 she was
posthumously inducted into the American
Nurses’ Association Hall of Fame. Hall is
remembered by her colleagues as a force for
change; she successfully implemented a pro-
fessional patient-centered framework at a time
when task-oriented team nursing was the
preferred practice model in most institutions.
Overview of Wiedenbach,
Henderson, and Hall’s
Conceptualizations of Nursing
Virginia Henderson, sometimes known as the
modern-day Florence Nightingale, developed
the definition of nursing that is most well
known internationally. Ernestine Wiedenbach
gave us new ways to think about nursing prac-
tice and nursing scholarship, introducing us to
the ideas of (1) nursing as a professional prac-
tice discipline and (2) nursing practice theory.
Lydia Hall challenged us to think conceptually
about the key role of professional nursing.
Each of these nurse scholars helped us focus
on the patient, instead of on the tasks to be
done, and to plan care to meet needs of the
person. Each emphasized caring based on the
perspective of the individual being cared for—
through observing, communicating, designing,
and reporting. Each was concerned with the
unique aspects of nursing practice and schol-
arship and with the essential question of
“What is nursing?”
Wiedenbach’s Conceptualizations of
Nursing
Initial work on Wiedenbach’s prescriptive theory
is presented in her article in the American Journal
of Nursing (1963) and her book Meeting the
Realities in Clinical Teaching (1969).
Her explanation of prescriptive theory is
that “Account must be taken of the motivating
factors that influence the nurse not only in
doing what she [sic] does, but also in doing
it the way she [sic] does it with the realities
that exist in the situation in which she [sic] is
functioning” (Wiedenbach, 1970, p. 2). Three
ingredients essential to the prescriptive theory
are as follows:
1. The nurse’s central purpose in nursing is
the nurse’s professional commitment. For
Wiedenbach, the central purpose in nursing is
to motivate the individual and/or facilitate
efforts to overcome the obstacles that may
interfere with the ability to respond capably
CHAPTER 5 • Early Conceptualizations About Nursing 57
3312_Ch05_055-066 26/12/14 2:41 PM Page 57
to the demands made by the realities within
the situation (Wiedenbach, 1970, p. 4). She
emphasized that the nurse’s goals are grounded
in the nurse’s philosophy, “those beliefs and
values that shape her [sic] attitude toward
life, toward fellow human beings and toward
herself [sic].” The three concepts that epitomize
the essence of such a philosophy are (1) rever-
ence for the gift of life; (2) respect for the dig-
nity, autonomy, worth, and individuality of
each human being; and (3) resolution to act
dynamically in relation to one’s beliefs
(Wiedenbach, 1970, p. 4).
She recognized that nurses have different
values and various commitments to nurs-
ing and that to formulate one’s purpose in
nursing is a “soul-searching experience.”
She encouraged each nurse to undergo
this experience and be “willing and ready
to present your central purpose in nursing
for examination and discussion when ap-
propriate” (Wiedenbach, 1970, p. 5).
2. The prescription indicates the broad
general action that the nurse deems
appropriate to fulfillment of his or her
central purpose. The nurse will have thought
through the kind of results to be sought and
will take action to obtain these results, accept-
ing accountability for what he/she does and for
the outcomes of any action. Nursing action,
then, is deliberate action that is mutually
understood and agreed on and that is both
patient-directed and nurse-directed
(Wiedenbach, 1970, p. 5).
3. The realities are the aspects of the immediate
nursing situation that influence the results
the nurse achieves through what he or she
does (Wiedenbach, 1970, p. 3). These include
the physical, psychological, emotional, and
spiritual factors in which nursing action occurs.
Within the situation are these components:
• The agent, who is the nurse supplying the
nursing action
• The recipient, or the patient receiving
this action or on whose behalf the action
is taken
• The framework, comprising situational
factors that affect the nurse’s ability to
achieve nursing results
• The goal, or the end to be attained through
nursing activity on behalf of the patient
• The means, the actions and devices
through which the nurse is enabled to
reach the goal
Henderson’s Definition of Nursing and
Components of Basic Nursing Care
While working on the 1955 revision of the
Textbook of the Principles and Practice of Nursing,
Henderson focused on the need to be clear
about the function of nurses. She opened the
first chapter with the following questions:
What is nursing and what is the function of
the nurse? (Harmer & Henderson, 1955, p. 1).
Henderson believed these questions were fun-
damental to anyone choosing to pursue the
study and practice of nursing.
Definition of Nursing
Henderson’s often-quoted definition of nurs-
ing first appeared in the fifth edition of Text-
book of the Principles and Practice of Nursing
(Harmer & Henderson, 1955, p. 4):
Nursing is primarily assisting the individual (sick or
well) in the performance of those activities contributing
to health or its recovery (or to a peaceful death), that
he [sic] would perform unaided if he [sic] had the nec-
essary strength, will, or knowledge. It is likewise the
unique contribution of nursing to help people be in-
dependent of such assistance as soon as possible.
In presenting her definition of nursing,
Henderson hoped to encourage others to de-
velop their own working concept of nursing and
nursing’s unique function in society. She be-
lieved the definitions of the day were too general
and failed to differentiate nurses from other
members of the health team, which led to the
following questions: “What is nursing that is not
also medicine, physical therapy, social work,
etc.?” and “What is the unique function of the
nurse?” (Harmer & Henderson, 1955, p. 4).
Based on her definition and after coining
the term basic nursing care, Henderson identi-
fied 14 components of basic nursing care that
reflect needs pertaining to personal hygiene
58 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch05_055-066 26/12/14 2:41 PM Page 58
and healthful living, including helping the pa-
tient carry out the physician’s therapeutic plan
(Henderson, 1960; 1966, pp. 16–17):
1. Breathe normally.
2. Eat and drink adequately.
3. Eliminate bodily wastes.
4. Move and maintain desirable postures.
5. Sleep and rest.
6. Select suitable clothes—dress and undress.
7. Maintain body temperature within normal
range by adjusting clothing and modifying
the environment.
8. Keep the body clean and well groomed
and protect the integument.
9. Avoid dangers in the environment and
avoid injuring others.
10. Communicate with others in expressing
emotions, needs, fears, or opinions.
11. Worship according to one’s faith.
12. Work in such a way that there is a sense
of accomplishment.
13. Play or participate in various forms of
recreation.
14. Learn, discover, or satisfy the curiosity that
leads to normal development and health
and use the available health facilities.
Hall’s Care, Cure, and Core Model
Hall enumerated three aspects of the person as
patient: the person, the body, and the disease
(Hall, 1965). She envisioned these aspects as
overlapping circles of care, core, and cure that
influence each other. It was her belief that
[e]veryone in the health professions either neglects
or takes into consideration any or all of these, but
each profession, to be a profession, must have an
exclusive area of expertness with which it practices,
creates new practices, new theories, and introduces
newcomers to its practice. (Hall, 1965, p. 4)
Hall believed that medicine’s exclusive area
of expertness was disease, which includes pathol-
ogy and treatment. The area of person, which,
according to Hall, had been sadly neglected,
belongs to a number of professions, including
psychiatry, social work, and the ministry, among
others. In contrast, she saw nursing’s expertise
as the area of the body. Hall clearly stated that
the focus of nursing is the provision of intimate
bodily care. She reflected that the public has
long recognized this as belonging exclusively to
nursing (Hall, 1958, 1964, 1965). In Hall’s
opinion, to be expert, the nurse must know how
to modify the care depending on the pathology
and treatment while considering the patient’s
unique needs and personality.
Based on her view of the person as patient,
Hall conceptualized nursing as having three
aspects, and she delineated the area that is the
specific domain of nursing and those areas that
are shared with other professions (Hall, 1955,
1958, 1964, 1965; Fig. 5-1). Hall believed that
this model reflected the nature of nursing as a
professional interpersonal process. She visual-
ized each of the three overlapping circles as an
“aspect of the nursing process related to the
patient, to the supporting sciences and to the
underlying philosophical dynamics” (Hall,
1958, p. 1). The circles overlap and change in
size as the patient progresses through a med-
ical crisis to the rehabilitative phase of the ill-
ness. In the acute care phase, the cure circle is
the largest. During the evaluation and follow-
up phase, the care circle is predominant. Hall’s
framework for nursing has been described as
the Care, Core, and Cure Model.
CHAPTER 5 • Early Conceptualizations About Nursing 59
The Person
Social sciences
Therapeutic use of self—
aspects of nursing
“The Core”
The Disease
Pathological and
therapeutic sciences
Seeing the patient and
family through the
medical care—
aspects of nursing
“The Cure”
The Body
Natural and biological
sciences
Intimate bodily care—
aspects of nursing
“The Care”
Fig 5 • 1 Care, core, and cure model. (From Hall, L.
[1964, February]. Nursing: What is it? The Canadian
Nurse, 60[2], 151. Reproduced with permission from
The Canadian Nurse.)
3312_Ch05_055-066 26/12/14 2:41 PM Page 59
Care
Hall suggested that the part of nursing that is
concerned with intimate bodily care (e.g.,
bathing, feeding, toileting, positioning, moving,
dressing, undressing, and maintaining a health-
ful environment) belongs exclusively to nursing.
From her perspective, nursing is required when
people are not able to undertake bodily care
activities for themselves. Care provided the
opportunity for closeness and required seeing the
nursing process as an interpersonal relationship
(Hall, 1958). For Hall, the intent of bodily care
was to comfort the patient. Through comforting,
the patient as a person, as well as his or her body,
responds to the physical care. Hall cautioned
against viewing intimate bodily care as a task
that can be performed by anyone:
To make the distinction between a trade and a pro-
fession, let me say that the laying on of hands to wash
around a body is an activity, it is a trade; but if you
look behind the activity for the rationale and intent,
look beyond it for the opportunities that the activity
opens up for something more enriching in growth,
learning and healing production on the part of the pa-
tient—you have got a profession. Our intent when we
lay hands on the patient in bodily care is to comfort.
While the patient is being comforted, he [sic] feels
close to the comforting one. At this time, his [sic] per-
son talks out and acts out those things that concern
him [sic]—good, bad, and indifferent. If nothing more
is done with these, what the patient gets is ventilation
or catharsis, if you will. This may bring relief of anxiety
and tension but not necessarily learning. If the individ-
ual who is in the comforting role has in her [sic] prepa-
ration all of the sciences whose principles she [sic]
can offer a teaching-learning experience around his
[sic] concerns, the ones that are most effective in
teaching and learning, then the comforter proceeds
to something beyond—to what I call “nurturer”—
someone who fosters learning, someone who fosters
growing up emotionally, someone who even fosters
healing. (Hall, 1969, p. 86)
Cure
Hall (1958) viewed cure as being shared with
medicine and asserted that this aspect of nursing
may be viewed as the nurse assisting the doctor
by assuming medical tasks/functions or as the
nurse helping the patient through his or her
medical, surgical, and rehabilitative care in
the role of comforter and nurturer. Hall was
concerned that the nursing profession was
assuming more and more of the medical
aspects of care while at the same time relin-
quishing the nurturing process of nursing to
less well-prepared persons. She expressed this
concern by stating:
Interestingly enough, physicians do not have practical
doctors. They don’t need them . . . they have nurses.
Interesting, too, is the fact that most nurses show by
their delegation of nurturing to others, that they prefer
being second class doctors to being first class nurses.
This is the prerogative of any nurse. If she [sic] feels
better in this role, why not? One good reason why
not for more and more nurses is that with this increas-
ing trend, patients receive from professional nurses
second class doctoring; and from practical nurses,
second class nursing. Some nurses would like the
public to get first class nursing. Seeing the patient
through [his or her] medical care without giving up
the nurturing will keep the unique opportunity that per-
sonal closeness provides to further [the] patient’s
growth and rehabilitation. (Hall, 1958, p. 3)
Core
The third area, which Hall believed nursing
shared with all of the helping professions, was
the core. Hall defined the core as using rela-
tionships for therapeutic effect. This area em-
phasized the social, emotional, spiritual, and
intellectual needs of the patient in relation to
family, institution, community, and the world
(Hall, 1955, 1958, 1965). Knowledge that is
foundational to the core is based on the social
sciences and on therapeutic use of self.
Through the closeness offered by the provision
of intimate bodily care, the patient will feel
comfortable enough to explore with the nurse
“who he [sic] is, where he [sic] is, where he [sic]
wants to go, and will take or refuse help in get-
ting there—the patient will make amazingly
more rapid progress toward recovery and reha-
bilitation” (Hall, 1958, p. 3). Hall believed that
60 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch05_055-066 26/12/14 2:41 PM Page 60
through this process, the patient would emerge
as a whole person.
Knowledge and skills the nurse needs to use
self therapeutically include knowing self and
learning interpersonal skills. The goals of the
interpersonal process are to help patients to
understand themselves as they participate in
problem focusing and problem-solving. Hall
discussed the importance of nursing with the
patient as opposed to nursing at, to, or for the
patient. Hall reflected on the value of the ther-
apeutic use of self by the professional nurse
when she stated:
The nurse who knows self by the same token can
love and trust the patient enough to work with him
[sic] professionally, rather than for him technically,
or at him vocationally.
Her [sic] goals cease being tied up with “where can
I throw my nursing stuff around,” or “how can I explain
my nursing stuff to get the patient to do what we want
him to do,” or “how can I understand my patient so
that I can handle him better.” Instead her goals are
linked up with “what is the problem?” and “how can
I help the patient understand himself?” as he partici-
pates in problem facing and solving. In this way, the
nurse recognizes that the power to heal lies in the
patient and not in the nurse, unless she is healing
herself. She takes satisfaction and pride in her ability
to help the patient tap this source of power in his
continuous growth and development. She becomes
comfortable working cooperatively and consistently
with members of other professions, as she meshes her
contributions with theirs in a concerted program of
care and rehabilitation. (Hall, 1958, p. 5)
Hall believed that the role of professional
nursing was enacted through the provision of
care that facilitates the interpersonal process
and invites the patient to learn to reach the core
of his difficulties while seeing him through the
cure that is possible. Through the professional
nursing process, the patient has the opportu-
nity to see the illness as a learning experience
from which he or she may emerge even health-
ier than before the illness (Hall, 1965).
Practice Applications
The practice of clinical nursing is goal directed,
deliberately carried out, and patient centered.
—WIEDENBACH (1964, P. 23)
Wiedenbach
Figure 5-2 represents a spherical model that
depicts the “experiencing individual” as the
central focus (Wiedenbach, 1964). This model
and detailed charts were later edited and pub-
lished in Clinical Nursing: A Helping Art
(Wiedenbach, 1964).
In a paper titled “A Concept of Dynamic
Nursing,” Wiedenbach (1962, p. 7), described
the model as follows:
In its broadest sense, Practice of Dynamic Nursing
may be envisioned as a set of concentric circles,
with the experiencing individual in the circle at its
core. Direct service, with its three components,
identification of the individual’s experienced need
for help, ministration of help needed, and valida-
tion that the help provided fulfilled its purpose, fills
the circle adjacent to the core. The next circle holds
CHAPTER 5 • Early Conceptualizations About Nursing 61
Adm
inistra
tio
n
Validation
I
d
e
n
t i
f i
ca
t io
n
Exper iencing
indiv idua l
C
o
-o
rdination
C
on
st
ru
ct
io
n
Col
labora t ion
Nurs ing A
dm
in
is t r a
tio
n
N
u
rs
in
g
ed
uc
at
ion
Nursing Organiz
ati
on
s
A
d
va
n
ced study
Research
P
ub
lic
at
io
n
Fig 5 • 2 Professional nursing practice focus and
components. (Reprinted with permission from the
Wiedenbach Reading Room [1962], Yale University
School of Nursing.)
3312_Ch05_055-066 26/12/14 2:41 PM Page 61
the essential concomitants of direct service: coordi-
nation, i.e., charting, recording, reporting, and
conferring; consultation, i.e., conferencing, and
seeking help or advice; and collaboration, i.e., giv-
ing assistance or cooperation with members of
other professional or nonprofessional groups con-
cerned with the individual’s welfare. The content of
the fourth circle represents activities which are es-
sential to the ultimate well-being of the experiencing
individual, but only indirectly related to him [sic]:
nursing education, nursing administration, and nurs-
ing organizations. The outermost circle comprises
research in nursing, publication, and advanced
study, the key ways to progress in every area of
practice.
Application of Wiedenbach’s prescriptive
theory was evident in her practice examples and
often related to general basic nursing procedures
and to maternity nursing practice. The most
recent application of Wiedenbach’s theory in the
literature is a description by VandeVusse (1997)
of an educational project designed to guide
the nurse midwife in articulating a professional
philosophy of nursing.
Henderson
Based on the assumption that nursing has a
unique function, Henderson believed that
nursing independently initiates and controls
activities related to basic nursing care. Relating
the conceptualization of basic care components
with the unique functions of nursing provided
the initial groundwork for introducing the
concept of independent nursing practice. In
her 1966 publication The Nature of Nursing,
Henderson stated:
It is my contention that the nurse is, and should be
legally, an independent practitioner and able to
make independent judgments as long as he, or she,
is not diagnosing, prescribing treatment for disease,
or making a prognosis, for these are the physician’s
functions. (Henderson, 1966, p. 22)
Furthermore, Henderson believed that func-
tions pertaining to patient care could be catego-
rized as nursing and nonnursing. She believed
that limiting nursing activities to “nursing care”
was a useful method of conserving professional
nurse power (Harmer & Henderson, 1955). She
defined nonnursing functions as those that are
not a service to the person (mind and body)
(Harmer & Henderson, 1955). For Henderson,
examples of nonnursing functions included
ordering supplies, cleaning and sterilizing equip-
ment, and serving food (Harmer & Henderson,
1955).
At the same time, Henderson was not in
favor of the practice of assigning patients to
lesser trained workers on the basis of complexity
level. For Henderson, “all ‘nursing care’ is essen-
tially complex because it involves constant adap-
tation of procedures to the needs of the
individual” (Harmer & Henderson, 1955, p. 9).
As the authority on basic nursing care,
Henderson believed that the nurse has the
responsibility to assess the needs of the indi-
vidual patient, help individuals meet their
health needs, and/or provide an environment
in which the individual can perform activities
unaided. It is the nurse’s role, according to
Henderson, “to ‘get inside the patient’s skin’
and supplement his [sic] strength, will or
knowledge according to his needs” (Harmer
& Henderson, 1955, p. 5). Conceptualizing
the nurse as a substitute for the patient’s lack
of necessary will, strength, or knowledge to
attain good health and to complete or make
the patient whole, highlights the complexity
and uniqueness of nursing.
Based on the success of Textbook of the Prin-
ciples and Practice of Nursing (fifth edition),
Henderson was asked by the International
Council of Nurses to prepare a short essay
that could be used as a guide for nursing in any
part of the world. Despite Henderson’s belief
that it was difficult to promote a universal defi-
nition of nursing, Basic Principles of Nursing
Care (Henderson, 1960) became an interna-
tional sensation. To date, it has been published
in 29 languages and is referred to as the 20th-
century equivalent of Florence Nightingale’s
Notes on Nursing. After visiting countries
worldwide, Henderson concluded that nursing
varied from country to country and that rigor-
ous attempts to define it have been unsuccess-
ful, leaving the “nature of nursing” largely an
unanswered question (Henderson, 1991).
Henderson’s definition of nursing has had a
lasting influence on the way nursing is practiced
around the globe. She was one of the first nurses
62 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch05_055-066 26/12/14 2:41 PM Page 62
to articulate that nursing had a unique function
yielding a valuable contribution to the health
care of individuals. In writing reflections on the
nature of nursing, Henderson (1966) stated that
her concept of nursing anticipates universally
available health care and a partnership among
doctors, nurses, and other health-care workers.
The sixth edition of Principles and Practice
of Nursing (Henderson & Nite, 1978) is
considered “the most important single profes-
sional document written in the 20th century”
(Halloran, 1996, p. 17). In this book, the syn-
thesis of nursing practice, education, theory, and
research clearly demonstrated the functions of
professional nursing practice.
Henderson was a lifelong supporter of
nursing research. In 1964, she published an
influential review of nursing research that high-
lighted the need to increase research studies
focusing on the effect of nursing practice on
patients (Simmons & Henderson, 1964). This
publication resulted in a renewed interest in
research studies that focused on the effects of
nursing on patient outcomes and the need for
research guided by nursing theory (Halloran,
1996). Most recently, Henderson’s theory has
been applied to the management of the care of
patients who donate organs after brain death and
their families (Nicely & Delario, 2011).
Hall
In 1963, Lydia Hall was able to actualize her
vision of nursing through the creation of the
Loeb Center for Nursing and Rehabilitation
at Montefiore Medical Center. The center’s
major orientation was rehabilitation and subse-
quent discharge to home or to a long-term care
institution if further care was needed. Doctors
referred patients to the center, and a professional
nurse made admission decisions. Criteria for
admission were based on the patient’s need for
rehabilitation nursing. What made the Loeb
Center unique was the model of professional
nursing that was implemented under Lydia
Hall’s guidance. The center’s guiding philosophy
was Hall’s belief that during the rehabilitation
phase of an illness experience, professional
nurses were the best prepared to foster the reha-
bilitation process, decrease complications and
recurrences, and promote health and prevent
new illnesses. Hall saw these outcomes being
accomplished by the special and unique way
nurses work with patients in a close interpersonal
process with the goal of fostering learning,
growth, and healing.
PRACTICE EXEMPLARS
Wiedenbach
The focus of practice is the individual for whom
the nurse is caring and the way this person per-
ceives his or her condition or situation. Mrs. A
was experiencing a red vaginal discharge on her
first postpartum day. The doctor recognized it as
lochia, a normal concomitant of the phenome-
non of involution, and had left an order for her
to be up and move about. Instead of trying to get
up, Mrs. A remained immobile in her bed. The
nurse, who wanted to help her out of bed, ex-
pressed surprise at Mrs. A’s unwillingness to get
up. Mrs. A explained to the nurse that her sister
had had a red discharge the day after giving birth
2 years ago and had almost died of hemorrhage.
Therefore, to Mrs. A, a red discharge was evi-
dence of the onset of a potentially lethal hemor-
rhage. The nurse expressed her understanding of
the mother’s fear and encouraged her to compare
her current experience with that of her sister.
When the mother did this, she recognized gross
differences between her experience and that of
her sister and accepted the nurse’s explanation
that the discharge was normal. The mother
voiced her relief and validated it by getting
out of bed without further encouragement
(Wiedenbach, 1962, pp. 6–7). Wiedenbach
considered nursing a “practical phenomenon”
that involved action. She believed that this
was necessary to understand the theory that
underlies the “nurse’s way of nursing.” This
involved “knowing what the nurse wanted to ac-
complish, how she [sic] went about accomplish-
ing it, and in what context she did what she did”
(Wiedenbach, 1970, p. 1058).
Henderson
Henderson’s definition of nursing and the
14 components of basic nursing care can be use-
ful in guiding the assessment and care of patients
preparing for surgical procedures. For example,
in assessing Mr. G’s preoperative vital signs,
CHAPTER 5 • Early Conceptualizations About Nursing 63
3312_Ch05_055-066 26/12/14 2:41 PM Page 63
the nurse noticed he seemed anxious. The nurse
encouraged Mr. G to express his concerns
about the surgery. Mr. G told the nurse that he
had a fear of not being able to control his body
and that he felt general anesthesia represented
the extreme limit of loss of bodily control. The
nurse recognized this concern as being directly
related to Henderson’s fourth component of
basic nursing care: Move and maintain desirable
postures. The nurse explained to Mr. G that her
role was to “perform those acts he would do for
himself if he was not under the influence of
anesthesia” (Gillette, 1996, p. 267) and that she
would be responsible for maintaining his body
in a comfortable and dignified position. She ex-
plained how he would need to be positioned dur-
ing the surgical procedure, what part of his body
would be exposed, and how long the procedure
was expected to take. Mr. G also told the nurse
about an experience he had after an earlier surgical
procedure in which he experienced pain in his
right shoulder. Mr. G expressed concern that
being in one position too long during the surgery
would damage his shoulder and result in waking
up with shoulder pain again. Together they dis-
cussed positions that would be most comfortable
for his shoulder during the upcoming procedure,
and she assured Mr. G that she would be assess-
ing his position throughout the procedure.
Hall
Hall envisioned that outcomes were accom-
plished by the special and unique way nurses
work with patients in a close interpersonal
process with the goal of fostering learning,
growth, and healing. Her work at the Loeb
Center serves as an administrative exemplar
of the application of her theory. At the Loeb
Center, nursing was the chief therapy, with
medicine and the other disciplines ancillary to
nursing. In this new model of organization of
nursing services, nursing was in charge of the
total health program for the patient and was
responsible for integrating all aspects of care.
Only registered professional nurses were hired.
The 80-bed unit was staffed with 44 professional
nurses employed around the clock. Professional
nurses gave direct patient care and teaching, and
each nurse was responsible for eight patients and
their families. Senior staff nurses were available
on each ward as resources and mentors for staff
nurses. For every two professional nurses, there
was one nonprofessional worker called a “mes-
senger-attendant.” The messenger-attendants
did not provide hands-on care to the patients.
Instead, they performed such tasks as getting
linen and supplies, thus freeing the nurse to
nurse the patient (Hall, 1964). In addition, there
were four ward secretaries. Morning and evening
shifts were staffed at the same ratio. Night-shift
staffing was less; however, Hall (1965) noted
that there were “enough nurses at night to make
rounds every hour and to nurse those patients
who are awake around the concerns that may be
keeping them awake” (p. 2). In most institutions
of that time, the number of nurses was decreased
during the evening and night shifts because it
was felt that larger numbers of nurses were
needed during the day to get the work done.
Hall took exception to the idea that nursing
service was organized around work to be done
rather than the needs of the patients.
The patient was the center of care at Loeb
and actively participated in all care decisions.
Families were free to visit at any hour of the day
or night. Rather than strict adherence to insti-
tutional routines and schedules, patients at the
Loeb Center were encouraged to maintain their
own usual patterns of daily activities, thus
promoting independence and an easier transi-
tion to home. There was no chart section labeled
“Doctor’s Orders.” Hall believed that to order a
patient to do something violated the right of
the patient to participate in his or her treatment
plan. Instead, nurses shared the treatment plan
with the patient and helped him or her to discuss
his or her concerns and become an active learner
in the rehabilitation process. In addition, there
were no doctor’s progress notes or nursing notes.
Instead, all charting was done on a form titled
“Patient’s Progress Notes.” These notes included
patients’ reaction to care, their concerns and
feelings, their understanding of the problems,
the goals they have identified, and how they see
their progress toward those goals. Patients were
also encouraged to keep their own notes to share
with their caregivers.
64 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch05_055-066 26/12/14 2:41 PM Page 64
Staff conferences were held at least twice
weekly as forums to discuss concerns, problems,
or questions. A collaborative practice model
between physicians and nurses evolved, and
the shared knowledge of the two professions
led to more effective team planning (Isler,
1964). The nursing stories published by nurses
who worked at Loeb describe nursing situa-
tions that demonstrate the effect of professional
nursing on patient outcomes. In addition,
they reflect the satisfaction derived from
practicing in a truly professional role (Alfano,
1971; Bowar, 1971; Bowar-Ferres, 1975;
Englert, 1971).
CHAPTER 5 • Early Conceptualizations About Nursing 65
■ Summary
Among other theorists featured in Section II of this book, Wiedenbach, Henderson, and Hall
introduced nursing theory to us in the mid-20th century. Each of the nurse theorists presented
in this chapter began by reflecting on her personal practice experience to explore the definition of
nursing and the importance of nurse–patient interactions. These nurse scholars challenged us to
think about nursing in new ways. Their contributions significantly influenced the way nursing was
practiced and researched, both in the United States and in other countries around the world. Perhaps
most important, each of these scholars stated and responded to the question, “What is nursing?”
Their responses helped all who followed to understand that the individual being nursed is a person,
not an object, and that the relationship of nurse and patient is valuable to all.
References
Alfano, G. (1971). Healing or caretaking—which will it
be? Nursing Clinics of North America, 6, 273–280.
Birnbach, N. (1988). Lydia Eloise Hall, 1906–1969. In:
V. L. Bullough, O. M. Church, & A. P. Stein
(Eds.), American nursing: A biographical dictionary
(pp. 161–163). New York: Garland.
Bowar, S. (1971). Enabling professional practice
through leadership skills. Nursing Clinics of North
America, 6, 293–301.
Bowar-Ferres, S. (1975). Loeb Center and its philosophy
of nursing. American Journal of Nursing, 75, 810–815.
Chinn, P. L., & Jacobs, M. K. (1987). Theory and nursing.
St. Louis, MO: C. V. Mosby.
Dickoff, J., James, P., & Wiedenbach, E. (1968). Theory
in a practice discipline. Nursing Research, 14(5),
415–437.
Englert, B. (1971). How a staff nurse perceives her role
at Loeb Center. Nursing Clinics of North America,
6(2), 281–292.
Gesse, T., Dombro, M., Gordon, S. C. & Rittman, M.
R. (2006). Twentieth-Century nursing: Wieden-
bach, Henderson, and Orlando’s theories and their
applications. In: M. Parker (Ed.), Nursing theories
and nursing practice (2nd ed., pp. 70–78). Philadel-
phia: F. A. Davis.
Gillette, V. A. (1996). Applying nursing theory to peri-
operative nursing practice. AORN, 64(2), 261–270.
Gordon, S. C. (2001). Virginia Avenel Henderson
definition of nursing. In: M. Parker (Ed.), Nursing
theories and nursing practice (pp. 143–149). Philadel-
phia: F. A. Davis.
Hall, L. E. (1955). Quality of nursing care. Manuscript
of an address before a meeting of the Department
of Baccalaureate and Higher Degree Programs of the
New Jersey League for Nursing, February 7, 1955,
at Seton Hall University, Newark, New Jersey.
Montefiore Medical Center Archives, Bronx,
New York.
Hall, L. E. (1958). Nursing: What is it? Manuscript. Mon-
tefiore Medical Center Archives, Bronx, New York.
Hall, L. E. (1963, March). Summary of project report:
Loeb Center for Nursing and Rehabilitation. Unpub-
lished report. Montefiore Medical Center Archives,
Bronx, New York.
Hall, L. E. (1964). Nursing—what is it? Canadian
Nurse, 60, 150–154.
Hall, L. E. (1965). Another view of nursing care and quality.
Address delivered at Catholic University, Washington,
DC. Unpublished report. Montefiore Medical Center
Archives, Bronx, New York.
Halloran, E. J. (1996). Virgina Hendeson and her timeless
writings. Journal of Advanced Nursing, 23, 17–23.
Harmer, B., & Henderson, V. A. (1955). Textbook of the
principles and practice of nursing. New York: Macmillan.
3312_Ch05_055-066 26/12/14 2:41 PM Page 65
66 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
Henderson, V. A. (1960). Basic principles of nursing care.
Geneva: International Council of Nurses.
Henderson, V. A. (1966). The nature of nursing. New
York: The National League for Nursing Press.
Henderson, V. A. (1991). The nature of nursing: Reflec-
tions after 25 years. New York: The National League
for Nursing Press.
Henderson, V. A., & Nite, G. (1978). Principles and prac-
tice of nursing (6th ed.). New York, NY: Macmillan.
Isler, C. (June, 1964). New concept in nursing therapy:
Care as the patient improves. RN, 58–70.
Montefiore cuts readmissions 80%. (1966, February 23).
The New York Times.
Nicely, B. & Delario, G. (2011). Virginia Henderson’s
principles and practice of nursing applied to organ
donation after brain death. Progress in Transplantation,
21, 72–77
Nickel, S., Gesse, T., & MacLaren, A. (1992). Her pro-
fessional legacy. Journal of Nurse Midwifery, 3, 161.
Simmons, L., & Henderson, V. (1964). Nursing research: A
survey and assessment. New York: Appleton-Century-
Crofts.
Touhy, T., & Birnbach, N. (2006). Lydia Hall: The
care, core, and cure model and its applications. In:
M. Parker (Ed.), Nursing theories and nursing practice
(2nd ed., pp. 113–124). Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
VandeVusse, L. (1997). Education exchange. Sculpting
a nurse-midwifery philosophy: Ernestine Wieden-
back’s Influence. Journal of Nurse-Midwifery, 42(1),
43–48.
Wiedenbach, E. (1962). A concept of dynamic nursing:
Philosophy, purpose, practice and process. Paper pre-
sented at the Conference on Maternal and Child
Nursing, Pittsburgh, PA. Archives, Yale University
School of Nursing, New Haven, CT.
Wiedenbach, E. (1963). The helping art of nursing.
American Journal of Nursing, 63(11), 54–57.
Wiedenbach, E. (1964). Clinical nursing: A helping art.
New York: Springer.
Wiedenbach, E. (1969). Meeting the realities in clinical
teaching. New York: Springer.
Wiedenbach, E. (1970). A systematic inquiry: Application
of theory to nursing practice. Paper presented at Duke
University, Durham, NC (author’s personal files).
3312_Ch05_055-066 26/12/14 2:41 PM Page 66
Chapter 6Nurse–Patient Relationship
Theories
Hildegard Peplau, Joyce Travelbee, and
Ida Jean Orlando
ANN R. PEDEN, JACQUELINE STAAL,
MAUDE RITTMAN, AND DIANE
LEE GULLETT
Part One Hildegard Peplau’s
Nurse–Patient Relationship
and Its Applications
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of Peplau’s Nurse–Patient
Relationship Theory
Practice Applications
Practice Exemplar
References
67
Part Two Joyce Travelbee’s
Human-to-Human Relationship
Model and Its Applications
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of Travelbee’s Human-to-
Human Relationship Model Theory
Practice Applications
Practice Exemplar
References
Part Three Ida Jean Orlando’s
Dynamic Nurse–Patient
Relationship
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of Orlando’s Theory of the
Dynamic Nurse–Patient Relationship
Practice Applications
Practice Exemplar
References
Hildegard Peplau Joyce Travelbee
Ida Jean Orlando
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 67
After graduating, Peplau remained at
Columbia to teach in their master’s program.
At that time, there was no direction for what
to include in graduate nursing programs.
Taking educational experiences from psychi-
atry and psychology, she adapted them to
her conceptualization of nursing. Peplau
described this as a time of “innovation or
nothing.”
Peplau arranged clinical experiences at
Brooklyn State Hospital so that her students
met twice weekly with the same patient for a
session lasting 1 hour. Using carbon paper, the
students took verbatim notes during the session.
Students then met individually with Peplau to
review the interaction in detail. Through this
process, both Peplau and her students began to
learn what was helpful and what was harmful in
the interaction.
In 1955, Peplau left Columbia for Rutgers,
where she began the clinical nurse specialist
program in psychiatric–mental health nursing.
Students were prepared as nurse psychothera-
pists, developing expertise in individual, group,
and family therapies. Peplau required her
students to examine their own verbal and non-
verbal communication and its effects on the
nurse–patient relationship.
In addition to being an educator, re-
searcher, and clinician, Peplau is the only per-
son to serve as both executive director and
president of the American Nurses Association.
Holding 11 honorary degrees, in 1994, she
was inducted into the American Academy of
Nursing’s (ANA) Living Legends Hall of
Fame. She was named one of the 50 great
Americans by Marquis Who’s Who in 1995. In
1997, Peplau received the Christiane Reiman
Prize. In 1998, she was inducted into the
ANA Hall of Fame. Hildegard Peplau died
in March 1999 at her home in Sherman
Oaks, California.
Overview of Peplau’s Nurse–
Patient Relationship Theory
Peplau (1952) defined nursing as a “signifi-
cant, therapeutic, interpersonal process” that
is an “educative instrument, a maturing
The nurse–patient relationship was a signif-
icant focus of early conceptualizations
of nursing. Hildegard Peplau, Joyce Travel-
bee, and Ida Jean Orlando were three early
nursing scholars who explicated the nature of
this relationship. Their work shifted the
focus of nursing from performance of tasks
to engagement in a therapeutic relationship
designed to facilitate health and healing.
Each of these conceptualizations will be de-
scribed in Parts One, Two, and Three of the
chapter.
Part One Peplau’s Nurse–Patient Relationship
ANN R. PEDEN1
Introducing the Theorist
Hildegard Peplau (1909–1999) was an out-
standing leader and pioneer in psychiatric
nursing whose career spanned 7 decades. A
review of the events in her life also serves as
an introduction to the history of modern psy-
chiatric nursing. With the publication of In-
terpersonal Relations in Nursing in 1952,
Peplau provided a framework for the practice
of psychiatric nursing that would result in a
paradigm shift in this specialty. Before this,
patients were viewed as objects to be ob-
served. Peplau taught that psychiatric nurses
must participate with the patients, engaging
in the nurse–patient relationship. Although
Interpersonal Relations in Nursing was not
well received when first published, the book’s
influence later became widespread. It was
reprinted in 1988 and has been translated
into at least six languages.
During World War II, Peplau serving in the
Army Nurse Corps, was assigned to the School
of Military Neuropsychiatry in England. This
experience introduced her to the psychiatric
problems of soldiers at war. After the war,
Peplau attended Columbia University on the
GI Bill, earning her master’s degree in psychi-
atric–mental health nursing.
1The author would like to acknowledge the contributions
of Kennetha Curtis who assisted in updating the literature.
68 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 68
force, that aims to promote forward move-
ment of personality in the direction of cre-
ative, constructive, productive, personal, and
community living” (p. 16). Peplau was the
first nursing theorist to identify the nurse–
patient relationship as being central to all
nursing care. In fact, nursing cannot occur
if there is no relationship, or connection,
between the patient and the nurse. Her
work, although written for all nursing spe-
cialties, provides specific guidelines for the
psychiatric nurse.
The nurse brings to the relationship pro-
fessional expertise, which includes clinical
knowledge. Peplau valued knowledge, believ-
ing that the psychiatric nurse must possess
extensive knowledge about the potential
problems that emerge during a nurse–patient
interaction. The nurse must understand
psychiatric illnesses and their treatments
(Peplau, 1987). The nurse interacts with the
patients as both a resource person and a
teacher (Peplau, 1952). Through education
and supervision, the nurse develops the
knowledge base required to select the most
appropriate nursing intervention. To engage
fully in the nurse–patient relationship, the
nurse must possess intellectual, interpersonal,
and social skills. These are the same skills
often diminished or lacking in psychiatric
patients. For nurses to promote growth in
patients, they must themselves use these
skills competently (Peplau, 1987).
There are four components of the nurse–
patient relationship: two individuals (nurse
and patient), professional expertise, and pa-
tient need (Peplau, 1992). The goal of the
nurse–patient relationship is to further the
personal development of the patient (Peplau,
1960). Nurse and patient meet as “strangers”
who interact differently than friends would.
The role of stranger implies respect and pos-
itive interest in the patient as an individual.
The nurse “accepts the patients as they are
and interacts with them as emotionally
able strangers and relating on this basis until
evidence shows otherwise” (Peplau, 1992,
p. 44). Peplau valued therapeutic communi-
cation as a key component of nurse–patient
interactions. She advised strongly against the
use of “social chit-chat.” In fact, she would
view this as wasting valuable time with your
patient. Every interaction must focus on
being therapeutic. Even something as simple
as sharing a meal with psychiatric patients
can be a therapeutic encounter.
The nurse–patient relationship, viewed as
growth-promoting with forward movement,
is enhanced when nurses are aware of how
their own behavior affects the patient. The
“behavior of the nurse-as-a-person interact-
ing with the patient-as-a person has signifi-
cant effect on the patient’s well-being and the
quality and outcome of nursing care” (Peplau,
1992, p. 14). An essential component of this
relationship is the continuing process of the
nurse becoming more self-aware. This occurs
via supervision.
Peplau (1989) recommended that nurses
participate in weekly supervision meetings with
an expert nurse clinician. The focus of the
supervisory meetings is on the nurses’ interac-
tions with patients. The primary purpose is to
review observations and interpersonal patterns
that the nurse has made or used. The goal
is always to develop the nurse’s skills as an ex-
pert in interpersonal relations. Peplau (1989)
emphasized “the slow but sure growth of
nurses” (p. 166) as they developed their com-
petencies in working with patients. Not only
are patient problems reviewed but treatment
options and the nurses’ own pattern of re-
sponding to the patient are explored. If an in-
teraction between a nurse and a patient has not
gone well, the nurse’s response is to examine
his or her own behaviors first. Asking questions
such as, “Did my own anxiety interfere with
this interaction?” or “Is there something in my
experiences that influenced how I interacted
with this patient?” leads to continual growth
and development as a skilled clinician. This
process also ensures the delivery of quality care
in psychiatric settings. Supervision continues to
be an important aspect in advanced practice
psychiatric nursing and is a requirement for
certification as a psychiatric clinical specialist or
nurse practitioner. Supervision is essential as
the nurse assumes the role of counselor. In this
CHAPTER 6 • Nurse–Patient Relationship Theories 69
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 69
role, the nurse assists the patient in integrating
the thoughts and feelings associated with the
illness into the patient’s own life experiences
(Lakeman, 1999).
The nurse–patient relationship is objec-
tive, and its focus is on the needs of the
patient. To focus on the patient’s needs, the
nurse must be a skilled listener and able to
respond in ways that foster the patient’s
growth and return to health. Active listening
facilitates the nurse–patient relationship. As
Peplau wrote in 1960, nursing is an “oppor-
tunity to further the patient’s learning about
himself [sic], the focus in the nurse–patient
relationship will be upon the patient —his
[sic] needs, difficulties, lack in interpersonal
competence, interest in living” (p. 966).
Within the nurse–patient relationship, the
nurse works “to create a mood that encour-
ages clients to reflect, to restructure percep-
tions and views of situations as needed, to get
in touch with their feelings, and to connect
interpersonally with other people” (Peplau,
1988, p. 10). Although the nurse–patient re-
lationship is “time-limited in both duration
and frequency, the aim is to create an inter-
personally intimate encounter, however brief,
as if two whole persons are involved in a pur-
posive, enduring relationship; this requires
discipline and skill on the part of the nurse”
(p. 11). Peplau continued to emphasize that
nurses must possess “well-developed intellec-
tual competencies, and disciplined attention
to the work at hand” (p. 13).
Communication, both verbal and nonver-
bal, is an essential component of the nurse–
patient relationship. However, in Peplau’s
view, verbal communication is required for the
nurse–patient relationship to develop. She
wrote, “[A]nything clients act out with nurses
will most probably not be talked about, and
that which is not discussed cannot be under-
stood” (Peplau, 1989, p. 197). One objective
of the nurse–patient relationship is to talk
about the problem or need that has resulted in
the patient interacting with the nurse. Peplau
provided descriptions of phrases commonly
used by patients that require clarification on
the part of the nurse. These included referring
to “they,” using the phrase “you know,” and
overgeneralizing responses to situations. The
nurse clarifies who “they” are, responds that
she or he does not know and needs further in-
formation, and assists patients to be more spe-
cific as they describe their experiences
(Forchuk, 1993).
Phases of the Nurse–Patient
Relationship
Peplau (1952) introduced the phases of the
nurse–patient relationship in her interpersonal
relations theory. This time-limited relationship
is interpersonal in nature and has a starting
point, proceeds through identifiable phases,
and ends. Initially, Peplau (1952) included
four phases in the relationship: orientation,
identification, exploitation, and resolution.
In 1991, Forchuk, a Canadian researcher who
has tested and refined some of Peplau’s work,
proposed three phases: orientation, working,
and resolution (Peplau, 1992). Forchuk’s rec-
ommendation of a three-phase nurse–patient
relationship resolves the lack of easy differen-
tiation between the identification and exploita-
tion stages. These two phases were collapsed
into the working phase. By renaming these
two phases the working phase, a more accurate
reflection of what actually occurs in this im-
portant aspect of the nurse–patient relation-
ship is provided. Although the nurse–patient
relationship is time limited in nature, much of
this relationship is spent “working.”
Orientation Phase
The relationship begins with the orientation
phase (Peplau, 1952). This phase is particularly
important because it sets the stage for the de-
velopment of the relationship. During the
orientation period, the nurse and patient’s re-
lationship is still new and unfamiliar. Nurse
and patient get to know each other as people;
their expectations and roles are understood.
During this first phase, the patient expresses a
“felt need” and seeks professional assistance
from the nurse. In reaction to this need, the
nurse helps the individual by recognizing and
assessing his or her situation. It is during the as-
sessment that the patient’s needs are evaluated
70 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 70
by the patient and nurse working together as
a team. Through this process, trust develops
between the patient and the nurse. Also, the
parameters for the relationship are clarified.
Nursing diagnoses, goals, and outcomes for
the patient are created based on the assessment
information. Nursing interventions are imple-
mented, and the evaluations of the patient’s
goals are also incorporated (Peplau, 1992).
Working Phase
The working phase incorporates identification
and exploitation. The focus of the working
phase is twofold: first is the patient, who “ex-
ploits” resources to improve health; second is
the nurse, who enacts the roles of “resource
person, counselor, surrogate, and teacher in fa-
cilitating . . . development toward well-being”
(Fitzpatrick & Wallace, 2005, p. 460). This
phase of the relationship is meant to be flexible
so that the patient is able to function “depen-
dently, independently, or interdependently
with the nurse, based on . . . developmental
capacity, level of anxiety, self-awareness, and
needs” (Fitzpatrick & Wallace, 2005, p. 460).
A balance between independence and depend-
ence must exist here, and it is the nurse
who must aid the patient in its development
(Lakeman, 1999).
During the exploitation phase of the working
phase, the client assumes an active role on the
health team by taking advantage of available
services and determining the degree to which
they are used (Erci, 2008). Within this phase,
the client begins to develop responsibility and
independence, becoming better able to face new
challenges in the future (Erci, 2008). Peplau
(1992) wrote that “[e]xploiting what a situation
offers gives rise to new differentiations of the
problem and the development and improvement
of skill in interpersonal relations” (pp. 41–42).
Resolution Phase
The resolution phase is the last phase and in-
volves the patient’s continual movement from
dependence to independence, based on both a
distancing from the nurse and a strengthening
of individual’s ability to manage care (Peplau,
1952). According to Peplau, resolution can
take place only when the patient has gained
the ability to be free from nursing assistance
and act independently (Lloyd, Hancock, &
Campbell, 2007). At this point, old needs
are abandoned, and new goals are adopted
(Lakeman, 1999). The completion of the res-
olution phase results in the mutual termination
of the nurse–patient relationship and involves
planning for future sources of support (Peplau,
1952). Completion of this final phase “is one
measure of the success of . . . all the other
phases” (Lloyd et al., 2007, p. 50).
Applications of the Theory
Almost all of the research that has tested
Peplau’s nurse–patient relationship has been
conducted by Forchuk (1994, 1995) and col-
leagues (Forchuk & Brown, 1989; Forchuk
et al., 1998; Forchuk et al., 1998). Much of
Forchuk’s work has focused on the orientation
phase. Forchuk and Brown (1989) emphasized
the importance of being able to identify the
orientation phase and not rush movement
into the working phase. To assist in this, they
developed a one-page instrument, the Rela-
tionship Form, which they have used to deter-
mine the current phase of the relationship and
overall progression from phase to phase.2
Peplau first wrote about the nurse–patient
relationship in 1952. She hoped that through
this work, nurses would change how they inter-
acted with their patients. She wanted nurses to
“do with” clients rather than “do to” (Forschuk,
1993). The majority of the work that has tested
Peplau’s nurse–patient relationship has been
conducted with individuals with severe mental
illness, many of them in psychiatric hospitals.
In these studies, patients did move through the
phases of the nurse–patient relationship.
As psychiatric nurses have changed the
location of their practice from hospital to com-
munity, they have carried Peplau’s work to this
new arena. Unfortunately, there has been lim-
ited testing of the nurse–patient relationship
in community settings. Parrish, Peden, and
CHAPTER 6 • Nurse–Patient Relationship Theories 71
2For additional information, please visit DavisPlus at
http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 71
Staten (2008) explored strategies used by ad-
vanced practice psychiatric nurses treating in-
dividuals with depression. All the participants
in this study practiced in community settings.
When describing the strategies used, the
nurse–patient relationship was the primary ve-
hicle by which strategies were delivered. These
strategies included active listening, partnering
with the client, and a holistic view of the client.
This work supports the integration of Peplau’s
nurse–patient relationship into the work of the
psychiatric nurse.
Moving beyond application of Peplau’s
theory in psychiatric settings with psychiatric
patients, Merritt and Proctor (2010) used
Peplau’s four phases of the nurse–patient rela-
tionship to guide their practice as mental
health consultation liaison nurses. Working
with patients experiencing psychiatric symp-
toms but who did not have a psychiatric dis-
order, these practitioners were guided by
Peplau’s four phases of the nurse–patient
relationship. This clinical application led to
better engagement with patients, provided
patients with the tools needed to address life
changes that precipitated their illness, and fi-
nally resulted in movement toward health that
included meaningful, productive living. They
concluded that Peplau’s work provided a
model to ensure successful engagement with
patients requiring consultation liaison nursing
interventions.
Peplau’s theoretical work on the nurse–
patient relationship continues to be essential
to nursing practice. To increase patient satis-
faction with care received in health-care set-
tings, relationship-based care has become an
important component in the delivery of nursing
care. Large institutions are educating their
workforce on the importance of having a rela-
tionship, a connection with those with whom
the nurse interacts and to whom he or she pro-
vides care. The premise is that by putting the
patient and his or her family at the center of
care, patient satisfaction and outcomes will im-
prove. In response to this and other changes in
health care, Jones (2012) wrote a thoughtful
editorial encouraging nurse leaders and educa-
tors to reclaim the structure of the nurse–
patient relationship as defined by Peplau. He
raised the question: Isn’t relationship-based care
what Peplau described as early as the 1950s?
One such institution, St. Mary’s located in
Evansville, Indiana, has developed a model of
relationship-based care. It is defined as “health-
care achieved through collaborative relation-
ships. Relationship-Based Care takes place in
a caring, competent and healing environment
organized around the needs and priorities of the
patients and their families who are at the center
of the care team” (www.stmarys.org/relation-
shipbasedcare; retrieved February 5, 2013).
Some of the principles of this type of care
include developing a therapeutic relationship,
being knowledgeable of self, experiencing
change that occurs over time, and believing that
everyone has a valuable contribution to make.
As literature describing relationship-based care
is reviewed (Campbell, 2009; Small & Small,
2011), citations of Peplau’s work are notably
lacking. Their absence may be attributed to how
thoroughly Peplau’s writings have become in-
tegral to nursing practice—as if they belong to
nursing, are a part of nursing’s language and
culture, and are no longer recognizable as being
separate from what is nursing.
Not only is nursing practice enhanced when
Peplau’s work is reviewed and applied, it also
may provide guidance in maintaining profes-
sional roles. In a more informal society with its
consequent easing of professional behaviors in
registered nurses, boundary violations reported
to boards of nursing are increasing (Jones,
Fitzpatrick, & Drake, 2008). A return to the
structure of the nurse–patient relationship and
revisiting the roles as defined by Peplau may
be needed (Jones, 2012). Peplau clearly artic-
ulated the roles of the nurse. At the time when
she was writing about this, nursing was moving
from hospital-based educational systems into
university settings. The focus of nursing was on
becoming a profession. With this movement,
more autonomy in nursing practice was needed.
To provide a framework for this, Peplau devel-
oped, primarily for psychiatric-mental health
nurses, six roles that were integral in the nurse–
patient relationship. These were described
earlier in this chapter.
The stranger role has particular relevance
to establishing professional boundaries. All
72 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 72
nurse–patient relationships begin with meet-
ing the patient. The nurse enters into this
relationship as a nurse, not as a friend. The
nurse is respectful of the patient and values his
or her privacy. When a nurse moves from pro-
fessional to friend, boundary issues have been
violated. If this is not recognized or even raised
as a concern, nursing care deteriorates. If every
interaction is therapeutic, as described by
Peplau, then in the nurse–patient relationship
there is no time for social chit-chat or devel-
oping friendships. The work of nursing is to
engage the patient in therapeutic relationships
that move them toward greater health. This
was as vital to nursing in the 1950s as it
is today.
CHAPTER 6 • Nurse–Patient Relationship Theories 73
Practice Exemplar
Karen Thomas is a 49-year-old married woman
who has a scheduled appointment with an ad-
vanced practice psychiatric nurse (APPN). She
appears anxious and uncomfortable in the en-
counter with the APPN. In an effort to help
Ms. Thomas feel more comfortable, the APPN
offers her a glass of water or cup of coffee.
Ms. Thomas announces that she has not eaten
all day and would like something to drink. The
APPN provides a cup of water and several
crackers for Ms. Thomas to eat. Once they are
both seated, the APPN asks Ms. Thomas about
the reason for the appointment (what brought
her here today). Ms. Thomas replies that she
does not know; her husband made the appoint-
ment for her. To more fully understand the rea-
son for her husband making the appointment,
the APPN asks Ms. Thomas to tell her what
aspects of her behavior were viewed by her
husband as calling for attention. Once again,
Ms. Thomas shares that she does not know.
Continuing to focus on getting acquainted and
enhancing Ms. Thomas’s comfort in this begin-
ning relationship, the APPN asks Ms. Thomas
to tell her about herself. Ms. Thomas shares
that she has been depressed in the past and was
treated by a psychiatric nurse practitioner, who
prescribed an antidepressant medication. Be-
coming tearful, she also shares that she left her
husband several days ago and has moved in
with her oldest son, stating that she “just needs
some time to think.” For the next 15 minutes,
Ms. Thomas talks about her marriage, her love
for her husband, and her lack of trust in him.
She also shares symptoms of depression that are
present. Ms. Thomas speaks tangentially and
is a poor historian when recalling events in
the marriage that have caused her pain. Her
responses are guarded as she alludes to marital
infidelity on the part of her husband. Inter-
spersed throughout the conversation are state-
ments about her dislike of medications. The
APPN then begins to ask more pointed assess-
ment questions related to depressive symptoms.
Ms. Thomas shares that she has very poor sleep,
cannot concentrate, is isolating herself, has dif-
ficulties making decisions, and feels hopeless
about her future. At this point, Ms. Thomas
also shares that she had never taken the antide-
pressant prescribed for her. By sharing this,
Ms. Thomas indicates the beginning of a trust-
ing relationship with the APPN. Once the
initial assessment is complete, a preliminary di-
agnosis is determined, and client and nurse are
ready to move into the working phase.
The working phase is initiated with problem
identification. For Ms. Thomas, the primary
problem is major depression with a secondary
problem, partner-relational issues. The APPN,
acting as a resource person, provides education
about the illness, major depression. Included is
information about the biological causes of the
illness, genetic predisposition, and explanations
about the symptoms. A partnership is formed as
the APPN and Ms. Thomas discuss treatment
options. Although Ms. Thomas shares that she
does not like to take medications, she agrees to
an appointment with a psychiatric nurse practi-
tioner, who will conduct a medication evalua-
tion. That appointment is scheduled later in the
week. Ms. Thomas also shares that she really
wants to talk about her relationship with her
husband and come to some decision about the
future of their marriage. Marital counseling is
mentioned as a possible treatment option, but
the APPN suggests that this be delayed until
Continued
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 73
74 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
Practice Exemplar cont.
Ms. Thomas’s depressive symptoms have
decreased. The first session ends with both
client and nurse committed to working to de-
crease Ms. Thomas’s depressive symptoms.
Ms. Thomas is reminded about her appoint-
ment for a medication evaluation, and a second
therapy appointment is made with the APPN.
At the second visit, Ms. Thomas reports that
she has started taking an antidepressant but as
of yet has not seen any relief of her symptoms.
The APPN provides information about the
usual length of time required for results to
occur. Although Ms. Thomas does not see no-
ticeable results from the medication, the APPN
shares that Ms. Thomas looks more relaxed
and seems less anxious. Ms. Thomas states that
she would like to spend this session talking
about her relationship with her husband. She
describes what was once a very happy mar-
riage. The APPN listens, asks for clarification
when needed, and encourages Ms. Thomas to
share her perceptions of her marriage. The
APPN asks Ms. Thomas again to talk about
what might have caused her husband to call
and make the therapy appointment for her.
Ms. Thomas shares that her husband does not
want their marriage to end; however, she is not
sure yet about their future. Her perception is
that her husband thinks she is the one with the
problem and once she is “fixed” that their mar-
riage will return to its former state of happi-
ness. The session ends with the APPN asking
Ms. Thomas to focus on her own physical and
mental health. Possible interventions include
beginning an exercise program, practicing stress
reduction strategies, and reconnecting with in-
dividuals who have been supportive in the past.
At the next session, Ms. Thomas is notice-
ably improved. She states that she is sleeping,
not crying as much, concentrating better, and
feeling more hopeful about her marriage. She
also shares that she and her husband have met
for dinner several times and that he is willing to
come with her for marital counseling. However,
she shares that she is not yet ready for this,
preferring to spend time focusing on her own
mental health. Over the course of several
months, Ms. Thomas and the APPN meet. In
these sessions, Ms. Thomas explores her child-
hood, talks about the recent death of her
mother, decides to begin a new exercise pro-
gram, and reconnects with childhood friends.
Through this work, Ms. Thomas grows more
secure in who she is and in how she wants to
live. During this same time period, she contin-
ues to meet her husband regularly for dinner and
sometimes a movie.
At their final session, Ms. Thomas shares
that she is ready to go with her husband to
marital counseling. As a result of antidepres-
sant medication and therapy, the problem of
major depression has been resolved. However,
the focus of this last session returns to depres-
sion. This is done to help Ms. Thomas recog-
nize the early symptoms of depression to
prevent a relapse. Ms. Thomas shares that her
first symptoms were not sleeping well and
withdrawing from friends and family. The
APPN emphasizes the importance of monitor-
ing this and calling for an appointment if these
early symptoms occur. The focus now is on
the secondary problem of partner-relationship
issues. With this, the APPN makes a referral
to a marital and family therapist.
■ Summary
Peplau is considered the first modern-day
nurse theorist. Her clinical work provided di-
rection for the practice of psychiatric-mental
health nursing. This occurred at a time when
there were few innovations in the care of the
mentally ill. She valued education, believing
that attaining advanced degrees would move
the nursing profession forward. She also be-
lieved that nursing research should be
grounded in clinical problems. She worked
tirelessly to advance the profession of nursing,
as both an educator and a leader at the national
and international levels. Her contributions
continue to have an influence today.
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 74
CHAPTER 6 • Nurse–Patient Relationship Theories 75
References
Campbell, M. P. (2009). Relationship based Care is
here! The Journal of Lancaster General Hospital, 4 (3),
87–89.
Erci, B. (2008). Nursing theories applied to vulnerable
populations: Examples from Turkey. In: M. de
Chesney & B. A. Anderson (Eds.), Caring for the
vulnerable: Perspectives in nursing theory, practice
and research (2nd ed., pp. 45–60). Sudbury, MA:
Jones and Bartlett.
Fitzpatrick, J. J., & Wallace, M. (2005). Encyclopedia of
nursing research. New York: Springer.
Forchuk, C. (1991). Peplau’s theory: Concepts and their
relations. Nursing Science Quarterly, 4(2), 64–80. doi:
10.1177/089431849100400205
Forchuk, C. (1993). Hildegard E. Peplau: Interpersonal
nursing. Newbury Park, CA: Sage.
Forchuk, C. (1994). The orientation phase of the nurse–
client relationship: Testing Peplau’s theory. Journal
of Advanced Nursing, 20(3), 532–537.
Forchuk, C. (1995). Development of nurse-client rela-
tionship: What helps? Journal of the American Psychi-
atric Nurses Association, 1, 146–151.
Forchuk, C., & Brown, B. (1989). Establishing a nurse–
client relationship. Journal of Psychosocial Nursing,
27(2), 30–34.
Forchuk, C., Jewell, J., Schofield, R., Sircelj, M., &
Valledor, T. (1998). From hospital to community:
Bridging therapeutic relationships. Journal of Psychi-
atric and Mental Health Nursing, 5, 197–202.
Forchuk, C., Westwell, J., Martin, A., Azzapardi, W.
B., Kosterewa-Tolman, D., & Hux, M. (1998). Fac-
tors influencing movement of chronic psychiatric pa-
tients from the orientation to the working phase of
the nurse-client relationship on an inpatient unit.
Perspectives in Psychiatric Care, 34, 36–44.
Jones, J. (2012). Has anybody seen my old friend Pe-
plau? The absence of interpersonal curricula in pro-
grams of nursing? Archives of Psychiatric Nursing, 26,
167–168.
Jones, J., Fitzpatrick, J.J., & Drake, V. (2008). Frequency
of post-licensure registered nurse boundary violations
with patients in the State of Ohio: A comparison
based on type of pre-licensure registered nurse
education. Archives of Psychiatric Nursing, 22,
356–363.
Lakeman, R. (1999). Remembering Hildegard Peplau.
Vision, 5(8), 29–31.
Lloyd, H., Hancock, H., & Campbell, S. (2007).
Principles of care. London: Blackwell.
Merritt, M.K. & Procter, N. (2010). Conceptualising
the functional role of mental health consultation-
liaison nursing in multi-morbidity using Peplau’s
nursing theory. Contemporary Nurse, 34, 158–166.
Parrish, E., Peden, A. R., & Staten, R. R. (2008).
Strategies used by advanced practice psychiatric
nurses in treating adults with depression. Perspectives
in Psychiatric Care, 44, 232–240.
Peplau, H. E. (1952). Interpersonal relations in nursing.
New York: G. P. Putnam’s Sons. (English edition
reissued as a paperback in 1988 by Macmillan
Education, London.)
Peplau, H. E. (1960). Talking with patients. American
Journal of Nursing, 60, 964–967.
Peplau, H. E. (1962). The crux of psychiatric nursing.
American Journal of Nursing, 62, 50–54.
Peplau, H. E. (1987). Tomorrow’s world. Nursing
Times, 83, 29–33.
Peplau, H. E. (1988). The art and science of nursing:
Similarities, differences and relations. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 1, 8–15.
Peplau, H. E. (1989). Clinical supervision of staff
nurses. In A. O’Toole, & S. R. Welt (Eds.),
Interpersonal theory in nursing practice: Selected works
of Hildegard Peplau (pp. 164–167). New York:
Springer.
Peplau, H. E. (1992). Interpersonal relations: A theoret-
ical framework for application in nursing practice.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 5(1), 13–18.
Peplau, H. E. (1998). Life of an angel: Interview with
Hildegard Peplau (1998). Hatherleigh Co. Audio-
tape available from the American Psychiatric Nurses
Association: www.apna.org/items.htm
Small, D. C., & Small, R.M. (2011). Patients first!
Engaging the hearts and minds of nurses with a
patient-centered practice model. Online Journal of
Issues in Nursing, 16 (2), 1091–3734.
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 75
Part Two Joyce Travelbee’s Human-to-Human
Relationship Model and Its Applications
JACQUELINE STAAL
Introducing the Theorist
Joyce Travelbee (1926–1973) practiced psychi-
atric/mental health nursing for more than
30 years in both the clinical setting and as a
nurse educator. She is best known for her
human-to-human relationship model, a mid-
dle-range theory that guides the nurse–patient
interaction with emphasis on helping the
patient find hope and meaning in the illness
experience (Travelbee, 1971). The human-to-
human relationship model provided an early
framework for delivering patient-centered
care, as promoted today by the Agency for
Healthcare Research and Quality with the
U.S. Department of Health and Human Serv-
ices and as noted in the Institute of Medicine’s
(2001) report, “Crossing the Quality Chasm:
A New Health System for the 21st Century.”
Travelbee graduated from the diploma nurs-
ing program at Charity Hospital School of
Nursing in New Orleans, Louisiana, in 1943.
Her early clinical practice at Charity Hospital,
combined with her faith, spirituality, and reli-
gious background, influenced her view on nurs-
ing and later the development of her theoretical
model. She received her bachelor of science de-
gree in nursing from Louisiana State University
in 1956 and later her master of science degree in
nursing with a focus on psychiatric/mental
health nursing in 1959 from Yale University.
Travelbee taught psychiatric and mental
health nursing at Louisiana State University,
New Orleans; the Department of Nursing Ed-
ucation at New York University; the University
of Mississippi School of Nursing in Jackson; and
at the Hotel Dieu School of Nursing in New
Orleans, Louisiana (Meleis, 1997; Travelbee,
1971). As a clinical instructor and later a profes-
sor of nursing, Travelbee (1972) incorporated
her philosophy of caring into her teaching meth-
ods, challenging students to learn not only from
their textbooks and nursing colleagues but rather
from the patients and their relatives themselves.
She later served as a nursing consultant for the
Veteran’s Administration Hospital in MS and
was enrolled in doctoral study at the time of her
death at age 47. Travelbee was Director of
Graduate Education at the Louisiana State
University School of Nursing when she died.
Travelbee’s first book, Interpersonal Aspects
of Nursing (1966), identified the purpose of
nursing and the roles of the nurse in achieving
this purpose. The delicate balance between
scientific knowledge and the ability to apply
evidence-based interventions with the thera-
peutic use of self in effecting change was de-
scribed and the ultimate goal of helping the
patient find hope and meaning in the illness
experience was identified. In Travelbee’s sec-
ond book, Intervention in Psychiatric Nursing:
Process in the One-to-One Relationship (1969),
the role of the psychiatric nurse in patient care
is described, the concept of communication
in the human-to-human relationship is exam-
ined, and the process of establishing, maintain-
ing, and terminating a relationship is described.
Overview of Travelbee’s
Conceptualization
Travelbee’s human-to-human relationship
model was based on the work of nurse theorists
Hildegard Peplau and Ida Jean Orlando
(Tomey & Alligood, 2006). Viktor E. Frankl’s
logotherapy guided Travelbee’s (1971) concept
of nursing intervention and the role of the
nurse in helping patients and their families
find meaning in the illness experience.
Caring, in the human-to-human relation-
ship model, involves the dynamic, reciprocal,
interpersonal connection between the nurse
and patient, developed through communica-
tion and the mutual commitment to perceive
self and other as unique and valued. Through
the therapeutic use of self and the integration
of evidence-based knowledge, the nurse pro-
vides quality patient care that can foster the
patient’s trust and confidence in the nurse
(Travelbee, 1971). The meaning of the illness
experience becomes self-actualizing for the
patient as the nurse helps the patient find
meaning in the experience. The purpose of the
nurse is to “enable (the individual) to help
themselves . . . in prevention of illness and
promotion of health, and in assisting those
76 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 76
who are incapable, or unable, to help them-
selves” (Travelbee, 1969, p. 7).
The human-to-human relationship “refers
to an experience or series of experiences be-
tween the human being who is nurse and an ill
person,” culminating in the nurse meeting the
ill person’s unique needs (Travelbee, 1971,
pp. 16–17). The term patient is not used
in Travelbee’s model, because patient refers to
a label or category of people, rather than a
unique individual in need of nursing care. The
purpose of nursing, according to Travelbee
(1971), is “to assist an individual, family or
community to prevent or cope with the expe-
rience of illness and suffering and, if necessary,
to find meaning in these experiences” (p. 16).
Simply caring about an individual is not suffi-
cient for providing quality care but rather the
integration of a broad knowledge base with the
therapeutic use of self is needed. To effect
change in the human relationship, the nurse
must transcend her sense of self to focus on the
recipient of care (Travelbee, 1969).
Transcendence of the traditional titles of
nurse and patient is necessary to prevent dehu-
manization of the ill person. With the rapid
expansion of health technology, combined with
financial constraints leading to restructuring of
nurse–patient ratios, competing demands are
placed on the nurse’s time and attention. An
emotional detachment between the nurse and
ill person is created when the nurse views the
ill person as simply “patient,” rather than as a
unique individual with his own understanding
of the illness experience. By performing nurs-
ing tasks without an emotional investment in
the nurse–patient relationship, the ill person’s
physical needs are met. However, the ill person
recognizes the lack of caring in the transaction
and is left alone to suffer with the symptoms of
illness. Dehumanization occurs when the ill
person is left alone to find meaning in his
illness experience.
Many ill persons and their family members
may ask questions such as “why me?” or “why
my loved one?” By inquiring into the individ-
ual’s perception of his illness and how he has
derived meaning from his illness experience,
the nurse can assess his coping ability and pro-
vide nursing interventions to prevent suffering
and despair. Hope and motivation are impor-
tant nursing tasks in caring for an ill person in
despair. However, the nurse “cannot ‘give’
hope to another person; she can, however,
strive to provide some ways and means for an
ill person to experience hope” (Travelbee,
1971, p. 83).
All human beings endure suffering, al-
though the experience of suffering differs from
one individual to another (Travelbee, 1971).
Suffering may be inevitable, but one’s attitude
toward it affects how an individual copes with
any illness. If the patient’s needs are not met
in his suffering, he may develop “despairful
not-caring,” in which he does not care if he
dies or recovers, or “apathetic indifference,” in
which he has “lost the will to live” (Travelbee,
1971, pp. 180–181). Hope helps the suffer-
ing person to cope, and it is an assumption
of Travelbee’s (1971) that “the role of the
nurse . . . [is] to assist the ill person [to] ex-
perience hope in order to cope with the stress
of illness and suffering” (p. 77).
To relieve the patient’s suffering and to
foster hope, the nurse provides care based on
the individual’s unique needs. Nursing care,
according to Travelbee (1971), is delivered
through five stages: observation, interpreta-
tion, decision making, action (or nursing
intervention), and appraisal (or evaluation).
The nursing intervention is designed to achieve
the purpose of nursing and is communicated
to the patient. The goals of communication in
the nursing process are “to know (the) person,
(to) ascertain and meet the nursing needs of ill
persons, and (to) fulfill the purpose of nursing”
(Travelbee, 1971, p. 96).
In the observation stage of nursing care, the
nurse “does not observe signs of illness” but
rather collects sensory data to identify a prob-
lem or need (Travelbee, 1971, p. 99). The
nurse validates her interpretation of the prob-
lem or need with the ill person and decides
whether or not to act upon her interpretation.
A nursing intervention is developed in align-
ment with the purpose of nursing, and requires
the nurse to “assist ill persons to find meaning
in the experience of illness, suffering, and pain”
(Travelbee, 1971, p. 158). However, the nurse
may not assume she understands the meaning
CHAPTER 6 • Nurse–Patient Relationship Theories 77
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 77
of the illness experience to the ill person with-
out first inquiring into this meaning. To do so
would communicate to the ill person that his
or her experience is not of value to the nurse,
resulting in dehumanization. The nurse evalu-
ates the outcomes of her nursing intervention
based on objectives developed before the phase
of appraisal.
In meeting the ill person’s needs through
the human-to-human relationship, the nurse
employs a disciplined intellectual approach
or a logical approach consistent with nursing
standards and clinical practice guidelines to
identify, manage, and evaluate the ill person’s
problem (Travelbee, 1971). Each stage in the
nursing process may be employed without
the establishment of a human-to-human
relationship. An acute medical need may be
met, but the patient’s deeper spiritual and
emotional needs are neglected. These spiri-
tual and emotional needs are addressed in the
human-to-human relationship in the pro-
gression through five phases: the original
encounter, emerging identities, empathy,
sympathy, and rapport.
In the phase of the original encounter, the
nurse and ill person form judgments about
each other that will guide and shape future
nurse–person interactions. Past experiences,
the media, and stereotypes may influence one’s
perception of another, blocking the develop-
ment of a human-to-human relationship. In
the phase of emerging identities, a bond begins
to form between nurse and person as each
individual begins to “appreciate the uniqueness
of the other” (Travelbee, 1971, p. 132). The
bond is created and shaped through each
nurse–person interaction and is facilitated by
the therapeutic use of self, combined with
nursing knowledge. The nurse must recognize
how she perceives the person to create a foun-
dation of empathy.
In the phase of empathy, the nurse begins
to see the individual “beyond outward behavior
and sense accurately another’s inner experience
at a given point in time” (Travelbee, 1971,
p. 136). Empathy enables the nurse to pre-
dict what the person is experiencing and re-
quires acceptance because empathy involves
the “intellectual and . . . emotional comprehen-
sion of another person” (Travelbee, 1964).
Empathy is the precursor to sympathy, or the
“desire, almost an urge, to help or aid an individ-
ual in order to relieve his distress” (Travelbee,
1964). Sympathy is not pity, but rather a demon-
stration to the person that he is not carrying the
burden of illness alone. Trust develops between
the nurse and person in the phase of sympathy,
and the person’s distress is diminished.
Rapport is essential in the nurse–patient
relationship. Travelbee (1971) defined rapport
as “a process, a happening, and experience, or
series of experiences, undergone simultane-
ously by nurse and the recipient of her care”
(p. 150). Rapport “is composed of a cluster of
interrelated thoughts and feelings: interest in
and concern for, others; empathy, compassion,
and sympathy; a non-judgmental attitude, and
respect for each individual as a unique human
being” (Travelbee, 1963). Through the estab-
lishment of rapport, the nurse is able to foster
a meaningful relationship with the ill person
during multiple points of contact in the care
setting. Rapport is not established in every
nurse–person encounter; however, emotional
involvement is required from the nurse. To
establish this emotional bond with one’s pa-
tient, the nurse must first ensure her own emo-
tional needs are met.
In Travelbee’s second book, Intervention in
Psychiatric Nursing, implementation of the
human-to-human relationship model is ex-
plained through the stages of selecting and es-
tablishing a patient relationship, the process of
maintaining the relationship, and ultimate ter-
mination of the relationship. Patients in the
acute care facility are typically assigned to a
nurse based on acuity, skill level and experience
of the nurse. However, nurses can select a pa-
tient to develop a one-on-one relationship
with based on availability and willingness of
the nurse and patient.
During the preinteraction phase, the nurse
and patient relationship is chosen or assigned.
The nurse may have preconceived thoughts and
feelings toward the patient she is entering the
relationship with and must identify these preju-
dices before the next phase of their relationship.
78 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 78
Goals and objectives for the interaction are es-
tablished before the first meeting and may
evolve over time (Travelbee, 1969, p. 143).
Once the nurse and patient are acquainted,
both the nurse and patient begin to assess each
other and make an assumption about the
other. The nurse should clarify to the patient
that she is not there simply to collect data but
rather to get to “know” the patient (p. 151).
Data should be collected in a manner that is
sensitive to the patient’s privacy and comfort
level. The nurse’s own thoughts and feelings of
the interaction must be considered following a
one-on-one interaction to determine whether
her own behavior may have affected the patient
interaction (Travelbee, 1969, p. 132). Like-
wise, the nurse must evaluate whether the in-
teraction met previously established objectives
and set goals for future interactions. The nurse
and patient affect each other’s thoughts and
feelings during each encounter, based on “the
nurse’s knowledge and her ability to use it, the
ill person’s willingness or capacity to respond
to the nurse’s effort, and the kind of problem
experienced by the ill person” (Travelbee,
1969, p. 139).
The phase of emerging identities occurs
when the nurse and the patient have overcome
their own anxieties about the interaction,
stereotypes, and past experiences. The nurse
and patient come to see each other as unique,
and the nurse works to transcend her view of
the situation. The nurse helps the patient to
identify problems and helps the patient change
his own behaviors. During this stage of devel-
opment, the nurse helps the patient find
meaning in the illness experience “whether this
suffering be predominately mental, physical, or
spiritual in origin” (Travelbee, 1969, p 157).
Eventually, the relationship is terminated, and
preparation for termination of the relationship
should begin early in the Phase of Emerging
Identities. Patients may feel abandoned or
angry regarding the termination if remaining
in the facility. In some cases, the nurse may be
able to elicit their thoughts and feelings. Those
to be discharged from the facility should be en-
couraged to express their fears and be assisted
in problem-solving solutions.
Practice Applications
Cook (1989) used Travelbee’s nursing con-
cepts to design a support group for nurses
facing organizational restructuring at a
New York hospital. The purpose of the sup-
port group was to help nurses develop more
meaningful perceptions of their roles during
a nursing shortage created during a financial
crisis that resulted in a restructuring of
patient care delivery and nurse/patient ratios.
Group morale was low in the beginning, and
nurses were frustrated with higher nurse/
patient ratios. The support group met over
2 weeks, and the group intervention was
designed by incorporating Hoff’s theory on
crisis intervention with Travelbee’s phases of
observation and communication. Travelbee’s
human-to-human relationship was used to
guide supportive discussions and problem-
solving as nurses struggled to regain a sense
of meaning and purpose related to their pro-
fessional identity.
Participants shared their perceptions of their
work environment during the initial encounter.
Support group members discussed the similar-
ities and differences in their work perceptions
during the phase of emerging identities. Empa-
thy and trust developed as nurses became more
accepting and nonjudgmental of each other’s
perceptions, culminating in the establishment
of rapport as group members were able to “re-
capture” the meaning of nursing (Cook, 1989).
Cook (1989) found that nurses who had
threatened to quit earlier had remained in the
system by the end of the support group. Nurse
productivity had increased over time, and the
number of sick days taken by the nurses had
diminished over the 6-month period after pro-
gram cessation. Nurses regained a sense of
meaning of their work and reported increased
job satisfaction after completion of the pro-
gram. Travelbee’s ideas hold potential as an ef-
fective nursing intervention for improving
nurse retention rates. However, further re-
search is necessary because the exact number
of nurses recruited into the support group and
the actual number of nurses who completed
the program are unknown.
CHAPTER 6 • Nurse–Patient Relationship Theories 79
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 79
80 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
Practice Exemplar
Luciana came into nurse practitioner Janice’s
office for her annual well-woman examina-
tion. A 53-year-old mother of three without
insurance, Luciana had delayed her visit for
several months due to lack of money. Despite
a nagging feeling that the pain in her breasts
might be serious, Luciana waited until she
could no longer tolerate the pain and the red-
ness and swelling of the breasts that had since
developed.
When Janice explained to Luciana that she
was a nurse practitioner and would be per-
forming her examination today and address-
ing any concerns she may have. Luciana sat
silently, looking slightly below Janice’s eyes as
she spoke. She avoided eye contact until asked
if something was wrong. Unable to wait for
Janice to complete the history, Luciana lifted
her shirt and showed the nurse practitioner
her erythematous, swollen breasts. The most
significant swelling noted was located in the
upper left quadrant, where Janice’s own
mother-in-law had experienced her most sig-
nificant swelling and lesions from her breast
cancer 5 years earlier—a cancer she hid from
her family until it was too late to intervene.
“What do you think this means?” Luciana
asked. Stunned by her bluntness, Janice took
a closer look at the swelling and warm, red
skin across Luciana’s chest. Dread filled
quickly inside Janice. “Do you think this is
cancer?” she asked. Trying to think back to
what she had been taught to say in her nursing
education, her mind drew a blank and honesty
was the only thought to come to mind. “Yes,”
Janice replied softly. “I do.” Tears began to fall
from Luciana’s calm face, as though she knew
she had breast cancer all along. Janice gave her
a big hug and whispered softly into her left ear,
“It will be alright. I am going to help you.” Lu-
ciana explained that she did not work
and did not have either health insurance or
Medicaid. Janice explained that programs
were available to help provide financial assis-
tance and that she would help her contact a
representative from a state-run breast cancer
program. Janice carefully finished performing
her physical examination, taking care to doc-
ument the extent of her swelling and the size,
shape, smoothness, mobility, and location of
any lumps palpated during the clinical breast
examination.
Once the examination was finished, Janice
excused herself and sought out the office man-
ager. She pulled Sophia aside in private and ex-
plained the situation. They contacted their local
representative from the health department in
charge of a grant that allocated money for
diagnostic mammography and arranged for the
patient to obtain the mammography through
the program. Janice returned to the examina-
tion room with the referral form, prescription
for the diagnostic imaging, and contact infor-
mation for the program representative. The
patient began to cry softly as she expressed
concern for her three children and wondered
who would take care of them? Janice hugged
Luciana as she cried and shared her story of
working as a stay-at-home mom while her
husband worked for low wages. She felt lonely
and missed her family who lived abroad. She
had not shared her breast pain with any one,
wanting to protect her family from worrying
about her. Tears began to fall from Janice’s
own eyes, as she remembered her mother-
in-law lying in a hospice bed when she finally
shared the gaping wounds where her own
breast cancer had eaten away at her skin. Dread
had filled inside Janice then, too, as she knew
she was powerless to help her. As Janice
hugged Luciana, a shimmer of hope radiated
from somewhere in that examination room as
she realized she could actually do something to
help Luciana. Even though she did not have a
background in oncology, Janice knew how to
connect her with providers that could further
evaluate and manage her breast cancer. Janice
showed Luciana the documents that she had
carried into the examination room and ex-
plained how she could obtain the mammogram
at no charge. Janice described the program
being offered through the health department
and gave her the name of the woman who
would now help facilitate the care she needed.
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 80
CHAPTER 6 • Nurse–Patient Relationship Theories 81
Practice Exemplar cont.
Luciana looked her in the eyes, hopefully em-
powered by the information Janice had given
her, and said “thank you.”
Several days later, Janice received the radi-
ologist’s report from Luciana’s diagnostic
mammography. The report confirmed that
Luciana did indeed have breast cancer. Fortu-
nately, Sophia, the assistant office manager,
had spoken with Jan at the health department
and learned Luciana had received Medicaid
and was now under the care of an oncologist
with experience in treating breast cancer. Lu-
ciana returned to the clinic a couple weeks
later and expressed her gratitude for their help
in getting her the health care she needed. She
had started chemotherapy treatment and her
mother had come to stay with her to help take
care of her children.
Travelbee’s concepts are evident in this
exemplar. Janice, the nurse practitioner, col-
lected the preliminary patient history and ex-
amination findings needed to formulate a
diagnosis during the Stage of Observation.
However, Janice’s interpretation of nonspoken
cues and body language led her to the purpose
of Luciana’s visit and to identify Luciana’s
fear related to the breast cancer. By identi-
fying barriers to care and existing sources of
support for the patient (Concept of Decision-
Making), Janice developed a care plan that in-
volved a referral to the health department for
access to a state grant available to fund Lu-
ciana’s mammogram and to a representative
with the state Medicaid program for financial
assistance with breast cancer treatment (Con-
cept of Action, or Nursing Intervention). By
caring for her as a person, Luciana was able to
express her story freely and let go of her feel-
ings of powerlessness and fear that had built
up inside her since she first noticed her breast
pain. The barrier between Janice-as-clinician
and Luciana-as-patient blurred as they con-
nected in that examination room, their stories
intertwining as they came together as woman-
to-woman each affected by breast cancer dif-
ferently and yet somehow the same (concept
of appraisal).
■ Summary
Travelbee’s conceptualizations of the human-
to-human relationship guide the nurse–patient
interaction with an emphasis on helping the
patient find hope and meaning in the illness
experience. Scientific knowledge and clinical
competence are incorporated into Travelbee’s
concept of therapeutic use of self to effect
change in patient-centered care. Patients are
viewed as unique, and nursing care is delivered
over five stages: observation, interpretation,
decision making, action (or nursing interven-
tion), and appraisal (or evaluation).
References
Cook, L. (1989). Nurses in crisis: A support group based
on Travelbee’s nursing theory. Nursing and Health
Care, 10(4), 203–205.
Institute of Medicine. (2001). Crossing the quality
chasm: A new health system for the 21st Century.
Available at: www.iom.edu/Reports/2001/Crossing-
the-Quality-Chasm-A-New-Health-System-for-
the-21st-Century.aspx
Meleis, A. I. (1997). Theoretical nursing: Development &
progress (3rd ed.). New York: Lippincott.
Tomey, A. M., & Alligood, M. R. (2006). Nursing theo-
rists and their work (6th ed.). St. Louis, MO: Mosby
Elsevier.
Travelbee, J. (1963). What do we mean by rapport?
American Journal of Nursing, 63(2), 70–72.
Travelbee, J. (1964). What’s wrong with sympathy?
American Journal of Nursing, 64(1), 68–71.
Travelbee, J. (1966). Interpersonal aspects of nursing.
Philadelphia, PA: F. A. Davis.
Travelbee, J. (1969). Intervention in psychiatric nursing:
Process in the one-to-one relationship. Philadelphia:
F.A. Davis.
Travelbee, J. (1971). Interpersonal aspects of nursing
(2nd ed.). Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Travelbee, J. (1972). Speaking out: To find meaning in
illness. Nursing, 2(12), 6–8.
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 81
Part Three Ida Jean Orlando’s Dynamic Nurse–
Patient Relationship
MAUDE RITTMAN AND DIANE GULLETT
Introducing the Theorist
Ida Jean Orlando was born in 1926 in
New York. Her nursing education began at
New York Medical College School of Nursing
where she received a diploma in nursing. In
1951, she received a bachelor of science degree
in public health nursing from St. John’s
University in Brooklyn, New York, and in
1954, she completed a master’s degree in nurs-
ing from Columbia University. Orlando’s early
nursing practice experience included obstetrics,
medicine, and emergency room nursing.
Her first book, The Dynamic Nurse–Patient
Relationship: Function, Process and Principles
(1961/1990), was based on her research and
blended nursing practice, psychiatric–mental
health nursing, and nursing education. It was
published when she was director of the gradu-
ate program in mental health and psychiatric
nursing at Yale University School of Nursing.
Ida Jean Orlando passed away November 28,
2007.
Orlando’s theoretical work is both practice
and research based. She received funding from
the National Institute of Mental Health to
improve education of nurses about interper-
sonal relationships. As a consultant at McLean
Hospital in Belmont, Massachusetts, Orlando
continued to study nursing practice and devel-
oped an educational program and nursing serv-
ice department based on her theory. From
evaluation of this program, she published her
second book, The Discipline and Teaching of
Nursing Process (Orlando, 1972; Rittman,
1991).
Overview of Orlando’s Theory
of the Dynamic Nurse–Patient
Relationship
Nursing is responsive to individuals who suffer
or anticipate a sense of helplessness; it is fo-
cused on the process of care in an immediate
experience; it is concerned with providing
direct assistance to individuals in whatever set-
ting they are found for the purpose of avoid-
ing, relieving, diminishing or curing the
individual’s sense of helplessness (Orlando,
1972).
The essence of Orlando’s theory, the dy-
namic nurse–patient relationship, reflects her
beliefs that practice should be based on needs
of the patient and that communication with
the patient is essential to understanding needs
and providing effective nursing care. Following
is an overview of the major components of
Orlando’s work:
1. The nursing process includes identifying the
needs of patients, responses of the nurse,
and nursing action. The nursing process,
as envisioned and practiced by Orlando, is
not the linear model often taught today
but is more reflexive and circular and
occurs during encounters with patients.
2. Understanding the meaning of patient be-
havior is influenced by the nurse’s percep-
tions, thoughts, and feelings. It may be
validated through communication between
the nurse and the patient. Patients experi-
ence distress when they cannot cope with
unmet needs. Nurses use direct and indi-
rect observations of patient behavior to
discover distress and meaning.
3. Nurse–patient interactions are unique, com-
plex, and dynamic processes. Nurses help
patients express and understand the mean-
ing of behavior. The basis for nursing
action is the distress experienced and
expressed by the patient.
4. Professional nurses function in an independ-
ent role from physicians and other health-
care providers.
Practice Applications
Orlando’s theoretical work was based on
analysis of thousands of nurse–patient interac-
tions to describe major attributes of the rela-
tionship. Based on this work, her later book
provided direction for understanding and
using the nursing process (Orlando, 1972).
This has been known as the first theory of
nursing process and has been widely used in
82 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 82
nursing education and practice in the United
States and across the globe. Orlando consid-
ered her overall work to be a theoretical frame-
work for the practice of professional nursing,
emphasizing the essentiality of the nurse–
patient relationship. Orlando’s theoretical
work reveals and bears witness to the essence
of nursing as a practice discipline.
Orlando’s work has been used as a founda-
tion for master’s theses (Grove, 2008; Hendren,
2012). Reinforcing Orlando’s theory as a prac-
tice and conceptual framework continues to be
relevant and applicable to nursing situations in
today’s healthcare environment.
Laurent (2000) proposed a dynamic leader–
follower relationship model using Orlando’s
dynamic nurse–patient relationship. The dy-
namic leader-follower relationship model re-
focuses the nature of “control” through shared
responsibility and meaning making, thereby
granting the employee or patient the ability
to actively engage in resolving the issue or
problem at hand. The emphasis is on recog-
nizing in both patient care and management
that the person who knows most about the
situation is the person himself or herself. To
be truly effective in resolving a problem or
situation involves engaging in a dynamic re-
lationship of shared responsibility and active
participation on the part of both parties
(i.e., nurse–patient/nurse manager–employee)
without which the true nature of the issue at
hand may go unresolved. Laurant (2000) sug-
gested that engaging in a dynamic relation-
ship with the other provides a means by
which management of care and/or employees
becomes a process of providing direction
rather than control, thereby generating nurs-
ing leaders in roles of authority rather than
just nurse managers of care.
Aponte (2009) employed Orlando’s
Dynamic Nurse–Patient Relationship as a
conceptual framework for the Influenza Initia-
tive in New York City to address the linguistic
disparities within communities. A needs survey
identified unmet linguistic needs and gaps ex-
isting within the city; nursing students, many
of whom were bilingual, served as translators
for non-English speaking Spanish, Chinese,
Russian, and Ukraine residents. Orlando’s
theoretical framework was used to describe the
communication among the nursing students,
homecare nurses, and city residents (Aponte,
2009, p. 326). Dufault et al. (2010) developed
a cost-effective, easy-to-use, best practice
protocol for nurse-to-nurse shift handoffs at
Newport Hospital, using specific components
of Orlando’s theory of deliberative nursing
process. Abraham (2011) proposed addressing
fall risk in hospitals using Orlando’s concep-
tualizations. The author asserts that three
elements (patient’s behavior, nurse’s reaction,
and anything the nurse does to alleviate the
distress) can effectively act as a roadmap for
decreasing fall risk.
The New Hampshire Hospital, a university-
affiliated psychiatric facility, adopted Orlando’s
framework for nursing practice (Potter, Vitale-
Nolen, & Dawson, 2005; Potter, Williams, &
Constanzo, 2004). Two nursing interventions
stemmed directly from the adoption of Or-
lando’s ideas. Potter, Williams, and Constanzo
(2004) developed a structured group curriculum
for nurse-led psychoeducational groups in an
inpatient setting. Both nurses and patients
demonstrated improved comfort, active involve-
ment and learning from combining Orlando’s
dynamic nurse–patient relationship and a psy-
choeducational curriculum with training in
group leadership.
Potter, Vitale-Nolen, and Dawson (2005)
conducted a quasi-experimental study to
determine the effectiveness of implementing
a safety agreement tool among patients who
threaten self-harm. Orlando’s concepts were
used to guide the creation of the safety agree-
ment. Results demonstrated that RNs per-
ceived the safety agreements as promoting
a more positive and effective nurse–patient
relationship related to the risk of self-harm
and believed the safety agreements increased
their comfort in helping patients at risk for
self-harm. The nurses were divided, however,
about whether the safety agreements en-
hanced their relationships with patients, and
the majority did not feel the safety agreements
decreased self-harming incidents. The rate of
self-harm incidents was not statistically sig-
nificant but the authors report the findings as
clinically significant citing no increase in
CHAPTER 6 • Nurse–Patient Relationship Theories 83
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 83
self-harming rates despite higher acuity levels
and shorter hospital stays during post imple-
mentation stages.
Sheldon and Ellington (2008) conducted a
pilot study to expand Orlando’s process into se-
quential steps that further define the deliberative
nursing process. The authors used cognitive in-
terviews with a convenience sample of five ex-
perienced nurses to gain insight into the process
of nurse communication with patients and the
strategies nurses use when responding to patient
concerns.
84 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
Practice Exemplar
Krystal, a 23-year-old woman with a history
of asthma, presents to the emergency depart-
ment with her boyfriend. She states, “I just
can’t seem to catch my breath, I just can’t seem
to relax”; appearing extremely agitated. Avoid-
ing eye contact, Krystal fearfully explains to
the nurse that she has not been able to obtain
any of her regular medications for approxi-
mately 4 months. The nurse obtains vital signs
including a blood pressure of 113/68; pulse of
98; respiratory rate of 22; an oral temperature
of 37.0 degrees Celsius; and an oxygen satu-
ration of 95% on room air. Assessment reveals
no increased work of breathing with slight, bi-
lateral, expiratory wheezing. The nurse, em-
ploying standing orders, places the patient on
2L of oxygen per nasal cannula and initiates a
respiratory treatment.
Seeking privacy with the patient, the nurse
kindly asks the boyfriend to wait in the patient
lounge. He becomes argumentative and reluc-
tant to leave, the nurse calmly states that she
simply needs to complete her assessment with
the patient and again asks again for him to
wait in the lounge; this time he complies. Fur-
ther investigation by the nurse reveals that
Krystal normally uses albuterol and Advair to
control her asthma, but she has been unable to
obtain her medications over the past 4 months
because of “personal problems.”
In this example, the nurse formulates an
immediate hypothesis based on direct and in-
direct observations and attempts to validate
this hypothesis by collecting additional data
(questioning the patient about her normal
medications, observing the boyfriend’s reluc-
tance to leave the room, assessing the patient’s
agitated state and refusal to make eye contact,
and obtaining vital signs). From the patient
data, the nurse formulates several additional
hypotheses about the patient. The nurse may
hypothesize that Krystal needs financial assis-
tance in obtaining her medications and addi-
tional education about asthma and the role of
medications in managing the disease. A nurse
not using Orlando’s theory might administer
the necessary asthma medications; provide
asthma education and resources for obtaining
free or low cost medications. A nurse using
Orlando’s theoretical framework, however,
understands that no nursing action should be
taken without first validating each hypothesis
with the patient as a means of determining the
patient’s immediate needs. The nurse in this
situation validates with the patient the source
of her anxiety and inability to catch her breath.
In doing so, the nurse learns that the patient’s
concern now is not with her wheezing or ob-
taining her asthma medication but rather with
her boyfriend.
The nurse hypothesizes that Krystal is a vic-
tim of intimate partner violence. Again, the
nurse seeks to validate this with the patient,
asking Krystal if her boyfriend is physically or
emotionally harming her. Krystal continues to
look fearfully at the door and states, “He is
going to kill me if I tell you anything.” The
nurse assures Krystal that she is in a safe place
right now, that she is not alone and that there
are safety measures that can be taken to re-
move the boyfriend from the premises if that
would make Krystal feel safer. Krystal requests
the nurse to do this and begins crying, telling
the nurse she had a fight with her boyfriend
today and he hit her. “He always makes sure
to hit me where people can’t see, and he is al-
ways sorry.” The nurse asks if Krystal is injured
in any way right now. Krystal pulls up her shirt
to reveal extensive bruising at various stages of
healing to her torso and what looks like several
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 84
CHAPTER 6 • Nurse–Patient Relationship Theories 85
Practice Exemplar cont.
fresh cigarette burns to both her breasts. The
nurse asks Krystal if it would be okay to per-
form some additional assessmentsto ensure no
further internal injury has occurred. Krystal
nods her head yes, and the nurse asks if this
has happened before. Krystal tells the nurse
that these days it happens almost daily but that
she deserves it because she doesn’t have a job
and he is the only one who loves her. “I want
to leave. I really do, but I am afraid he will kill
me, and I don’t have anywhere else to go.” The
nurse acknowledges Krystal’s distress, clarify-
ing that Krystal does not deserve this type of
treatment and that she fears for her safety,
emphasizing abuse is a crime and only worsens
over time.
At this point, the nurse discusses how the
patient wishes to address this concern ensuring
there is a dynamic interaction occurring be-
tween the patient and the nurse. Offering the
patient the resources and opportunity to ex-
press and understand the meaning of her own
behavior inspires Krystal to find meaning in
the experience and ownership in the choices
needed to address these concerns. Using her
nursing knowledge of domestic abuse, the
nurse engages Krystal in a conversation about
the cycle of violence and empowers Krystal by
providing her with choices and resources to
address her current situation. After the nurse–
patient interaction, Krystal decides to go to a
local domestic abuse shelter for women (the
nurse makes arrangements by calling the shel-
ter and providing transportation), to file a po-
lice report (the nurse arranges for an officer to
come to the hospital), and allow for photos
and documentation of her injuries to be
charted (documentation follows the guidelines
needed to be admissible in a court of law if
necessary). The nurse also provides Krystal
with the number for the National Resource
Center on Domestic Violence, and with two
websites one for Violence Against Women
Network (www.vawnet.org) and the Florida
Coalition Against Domestic Violence
(www.fcadv.org). The nurse calls the shelter a
few days later to check that Krystal is safe and
learns that Krystal will be remaining at the
shelter and has not had any further correspon-
dence with her boyfriend.
Through mutual engagement, the patient
and nurse were able to create a dynamic envi-
ronment that fostered effective communica-
tion and the ability to address the immediate
needs of the patient. Providing asthma educa-
tion and financial resources would not have
addressed Krystal’s need for physical safety re-
lated to domestic abuse because the plan
would have been based on an invalid hypoth-
esis. The nurse in this situation used her
perception and knowledge of the nursing
situation to explore the meaning of Krystal’s
behavior. Through communication and vali-
dation with the patient of the nurses’ hypothe-
ses, perceptions and supporting data, the nurse
was able to elicit the nature of the patient’s
problem and mutually engage the patient in
identifying what help was needed. After mutual
decision making, the nurse took deliberative
nursing actions to meet Krystal’s immediate
needs including initiating safety protocols, pro-
viding resources, gathering additional data, and
creating a supportive and encouraging environ-
ment for the patient.
■ Summary
The most important contribution of Orlando’s
theoretical work is the primacy of the nurse–
client relationship. Inherent in this theory is a
strong statement: What transpires between the
patient and the nurse is of the highest value.
The true worth of her ideas is that it clearly
states what nursing is or should be today.
Regardless of the changes in the health-care
system, the human transaction between the
nurse and the patient in any setting holds the
greatest value —not only for nursing, but also
for society at large. Orlando’s writings can
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 85
86 SECTION II • Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
serve as a philosophy as well as a theory,
because it is the foundation on which our pro-
fession has been built. With all of the benefits
that modern technology and modern health
care bring—and there are many—we need to
pause and ask the question, What is at risk in
health care today? The answer to that question
may lead to reconsideration of the value of
Orlando’s theory as perhaps the critical link for
enhancing relationships between nursing and
patient today (Rittman, 1991).
References
Abraham, S. (2011). Fall prevention conceptual frame-
work. The Health Care Manager, 30(2), 179–184. doi:
10.1097/HCM.0b013e31826fb74
Aponte, J. (2009). Meeting the linguistic needs of urban
communities. Home Health Nurse, 27(5), 324–329.
Dufault, M., Duquette, C. E., Ehmann, J., Hehl, R.,
Lavin, M., Martin, V., Moore, M. A., Sargent, S.,
Stout, P., Willey, C. (2010). Translating an evi-
dence-based protocol for nurse-to-nurse shift hand-
offs. Worldviews on Evidence-Based Nursing, 7(2),
59–75.
Grove, C. (2008). Staff intervention to improve patient
satisfaction (master’s thesis). Retrieved from Pro-
Quest Dissertations and Theses database. (UMI
1454183)
Hendren, D. W. (2012). Emergency departments and
STEMI care, are the guidelines being followed? (mas-
ter’s thesis). Retrieved from ProQuest Dissertations
and Theses database. (UMI 1520156)
Laurent, C. L. (2000). A nursing theory of nursing lead-
ership. Journal of Nursing Management, 8, 83–87.
Orlando, I. J. (1990). The dynamic nurse–patient relation-
ship: Function, process and principles. New York: Na-
tional League for Nursing New York: G. P.
Putnam’s Sons. (Original work published 1961)
Orlando, I. J. (1972). The discipline and teaching of nurs-
ing process: An evaluative study. New York: G. P.
Putnam’s Sons.
Potter, M. L., Vitale-Nolen, R., & Dawson, A. M.
(2005). Implementation of safety agreements in an
acute psychiatric facility. Journal of the American
Psychiatric Nurses Association, 11(3), 144–155. doi:
10.1177/1078390305277443
Potter, M. L., Williams, R. B. & Costanzo, R. (2004).
Using nursing theory and structured psychoeduca-
tional curriculum with inpatient groups. Journal of
the American Psychiatric Nurses Association, 10(3),
122–128. doi: 10.1177/1078390304265212
Rittman, M. R. (1991). Ida Jean Orlando (Pelletier)—
the dynamic nurse–patient relationship. In: M.
Parker (Ed.), Nursing theories and nursing practice
(pp. 125–130). Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Sheldon, L. K., & Ellington, L. (2008). Application
of a model of social information processing to nurs-
ing theory: How nurses respond to patients. Journal
of Advanced Nursing 64(4), 388–398. doi:
10.111/j.1365-2648.2008.04795.x
3312_Ch06_067-086 26/12/14 11:18 AM Page 86
Section III
Conceptual Models/Grand
Theories in the Integrative-
Interactive Paradigm
87
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 87
88
Section III includes seven chapters on the conceptual models or grand theories
situated in the integrative-interactive nursing paradigm. These chapters are
written by either the theorist or an author designated as an authority on the
theory by the theorist or the community of scholars advancing that theory. The-
ories in the integrative-interactive paradigm view persons1 as integrated
wholes or integrated systems interacting with the larger environmental system.
The integrated dimensions of the person are influenced by environmental fac-
tors leading to some change that impacts health or well-being. The subjectivity
of the person and the multidimensional nature of any outcome are considered.
Most of the theories are based explicitly on a systems perspective.
In Chapter 7, Johnson’s behavioral systems model is described. It includes
principles of wholeness and order, stabilization, reorganization, hierarchic in-
teraction, and dialectic contradiction. The person is viewed as a compilation
of subsystems. According to Johnson, the goal of nursing is to restore, maintain,
or attain behavioral system balance and stability at the highest possible level.
Chapter 8 features Orem’s self-care deficit nursing theory, a conceptual model
with four interrelated theories associated with it: theory of nursing systems, theory of
self-care deficit, and the theory of self-care and theory of dependent care. According
to Orem, when requirements for self-care exceed capacity for self-care, self-care
deficits occur. Nursing systems are designed to address these self-care deficits.
King’s theory of goal attainment presented in Chapter 9 offers a view that the
goal of nursing is to help persons maintain health or regain health. This is accom-
plished through a transaction,setting a mutually agreed-upon goal with the patient.
In Chapter 10, Pamela Senesac and Sr. Callista Roy describe the Roy adap-
tation model and its applications. In this model, the person is viewed as a holistic
adaptive system with coping processes to maintain adaptation and promote
person–environment transformations. The adaptive system can be integrated,
compensatory, or compromised depending on the level of adaptation. Nurses
promote coping and adaptation within health and illness.
Lois White Lowry and Patricia Deal Aylward authored Chapter 12 on Neuman’s
systems model. The model includes the client–client system with a basic structure
protected from stressors by lines of defense and resistance. The concern of nursing
is to keep the client stable by assessing the actual or potential effects of stressors
and assisting client adjustments for optimal wellness.
In Chapter 13, Erickson, Tomlin, and Swain’s modeling and role modeling
theory is presented by Helen Erickson. Modeling and role modeling theory pro-
vides a guide for the practice or process of nursing. The theory integrates a holistic
philosophy with concepts from a variety of theoretical perspectives such as adap-
tation, need status, and developmental task resolution.
The final chapter in this section is Dossey’s theory of integral nursing, a relatively
new grand theory that posits an integral worldview and body–mind–spirit connect-
edness. The theory is informed by a variety of ideas including Nightingale’s tenets,
holism, multidimensionality, spiral dynamics, chaos theory, and complexity. It includes
the major concepts of healing, the metaparadigm of nursing, patterns of knowing,
and Wilber’s integral theory and Wilber’s all quadrants, all levels, all lines.
Section
III
88
1 Person refers to individuals, families, groups or communities.
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 88
Chapter 7Dorothy Johnson’s Behavioral
System Model and Its
Applications
BONNIE HOLADAY
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of Johnson’s Behavioral
System Model
Applications of the Model
Practice Exemplar by Kelly White
Summary
References
Dorothy Johnson
89
Introducing the Theorist
Dorothy Johnson’s earliest publications per-
tained to the knowledge base nurses needed for
nursing care (Johnson, 1959, 1961). Through-
out her career, Johnson (1919–1999) stressed
that nursing had a unique, independent con-
tribution to health care that was distinct from
“delegated medical care.” Johnson was one of
the first “grand theorists” to present her views
as a conceptual model. Her model was the first
to provide a guide to both understanding and
action. These two ideas—understanding seen
first as a holistic, behavioral system process me-
diated by a complex framework and second as
an active process of encounter and response—
are central to the work of other theorists who
followed her lead and developed conceptual
models for nursing practice.
Dorothy Johnson received her associate of
arts degree from Armstrong Junior College in
Savannah, Georgia, in 1938 and her bachelor
of science in nursing degree from Vanderbilt
University in 1942. She practiced briefly as a
staff nurse at the Chatham-Savannah Health
Council before attending Harvard University,
where she received her master of public health
in 1948. She began her academic career at
Vanderbilt University School of Nursing. A
call from Lulu Hassenplug, Dean of the
School of Nursing, enticed her to the Univer-
sity of California at Los Angeles in 1949. She
served there as an assistant, associate, and pro-
fessor of pediatric nursing until her retirement
in 1978. Johnson is recognized as one of the
founders of modern systems-based nursing
theory (Glennister, 2011; Meleis, 2011).
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 89
During her academic career, Dorothy Johnson
addressed issues related to nursing practice, ed-
ucation, and science. While she was a pediatric
nursing advisor at the Christian Medical College
School of Nursing in Vellare, South India, she
wrote a series of clinical articles for the Nursing
Journal of India (Johnson, 1956, 1957). She
worked with the California Nurses’ Association,
the National League for Nursing, and the
American Nurses’ Association to examine the
role of the clinical nurse specialist, the scope of
nursing practice, and the need for nursing re-
search. She also completed a Public Health
Service–funded research project (“Crying as a
Physiologic State in the Newborn Infant”) in
1963 (Johnson & Smith, 1963). The founda-
tions of her model and her beliefs about nursing
are clearly evident in these early publications.
Overview of Johnson’s
Behavioral System Model
Johnson noted that her theory, the Johnson be-
havioral system model (JBSM), evolved from
philosophical ideas, theory, and research; her
clinical background; and many years of thought,
discussions, and writing (Johnson, 1968). She
cited a number of sources for her theory. From
Florence Nightingale came the belief that nurs-
ing’s concern is a focus on the person rather than
the disease. Systems theorists (Buckley, 1968;
Chin, 1961; Parsons & Shils, 1951; Rapoport,
1968; Von Bertalanffy, 1968) were all sources for
her model. Johnson’s background as a pediatric
nurse is also evident in the development of her
model. In her papers, Johnson cited developmen-
tal literature to support the validity of a behavioral
system model (Ainsworth, 1964; Crandal, 1963;
Gerwitz, 1972; Kagan, 1964; Sears, Maccoby, &
Levin, 1954). Johnson also noted that a number
of her subsystems had biological underpinnings.
Johnson’s theory and her related writings
reflect her knowledge about both development
and general systems theories. The combination
of nursing, development, and general systems
introduces some of the specifics into the rhet-
oric about nursing theory development that
make it possible to test hypotheses and con-
duct critical experiments.
Five Core Principles
Johnson’s model incorporates five core principles
of system thinking: wholeness and order, stabi-
lization, reorganization, hierarchic interaction,
and dialectical contradiction. Each of these gen-
eral systems principles has analogs in develop-
mental theories that Johnson used to verify the
validity of her model (Johnson, 1980, 1990).
Wholeness and order provide the basis for con-
tinuity and identity, stabilization for develop-
ment, reorganization for growth and/or change,
hierarchic interaction for discontinuity, and di-
alectical contradiction for motivation. Johnson
conceptualized a person as an open system with
organized, interrelated, and interdependent sub-
systems. By virtue of subsystem interaction and
independence, the whole of the human organism
(system) is greater than the sum of its parts (sub-
systems). Wholes and their parts create a system
with dual constraints: Neither has continuity and
identity without the other.
The overall representation of the model can
also be viewed as a behavioral system within an
environment. The behavioral system and the
environment are linked by interactions and
transactions. We define the person (behavioral
system) as comprising subsystems and the en-
vironment as comprising physical, interpersonal
(e.g., father, friend, mother, sibling), and soci-
ocultural (e.g., rules and mores of home, school,
country, and other cultural contexts) compo-
nents that supply the sustenal imperatives
(Grubbs, 1980; Holaday, 1997; Johnson, 1990;
Meleis, 2011). Sustenal imperatives are the nec-
essary prerequisites for the optimal functioning
of the behavioral system. The environment must
supply the sustenal imperatives of protection,
nurturance, and stimulation to all subsystems to
allow them to develop and to maintain stability.
Some examples of conditions that protect, stim-
ulate, and nurture related to achievement would
include encouragement from parents and peers;
enriched, stimulating environments, awards
and recognition; and increased autonomy and
responsibility.
Wholeness and Order
The developmental analogy of wholeness and
order is continuity and identity. Given the
90 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 90
behavioral system’s potential for plasticity, a
basic feature of the system is that both conti-
nuity and change can exist across the life span.
The presence of or potentiality for at least some
plasticity means that the key way of casting the
issue of continuity is not a matter of deciding
what exists for a given process or function of a
subsystem. Instead, the issue should be cast in
terms of determining patterns of interactions
among levels of the behavioral system that may
promote continuity for a particular subsystem
at a given point in time. Johnson’s work im-
plies that continuity is in the relationship of
the parts rather than in their individuality.
Johnson (1990) noted that at the psychological
level, attachment (affiliation) and dependency
are examples of important specific behaviors
that change over time, although the represen-
tation (meaning) may remain the same. Johnson
stated: “[D]evelopmentally, dependence be-
havior in the socially optimum case evolves
from almost total dependence on others to a
greater degree of dependence on self, with a
certain amount of interdependence essential to
the survival of social groups” (1990, p. 28). In
terms of behavioral system balance, this pat-
tern of dependence to independence may be
repeated as the behavioral system engages in
new situations during the course of a lifetime.
Stabilization
Stabilization or behavioral system balance is
another core principle of the JBSM. Dynamic
systems respond to contextual changes by ei-
ther a homeostatic or homeorhetic process.
Systems have a set point (like a thermostat)
that they try to maintain by altering internal
conditions to compensate for changes in exter-
nal conditions. Human thermoregulation is an
example of a homeostatic process that is pri-
marily biological but is also behavioral (turning
on the heater). The use of attribution of ability
or effort is a behavioral homeostatic process we
use to interpret activities so that they are con-
sistent with our mental organization.
From a behavioral system perspective,
homeorrhesis is a more important stabilizing
process than is homeostasis. In homeorrhesis,
the system stabilizes around a trajectory rather
than a set point. A toddler placed in a body
cast may show motor lags when the cast is re-
moved but soon show age-appropriate motor
skills. An adult newly diagnosed with asthma
who does not receive proper education until a
year after diagnosis can successfully incorpo-
rate the material into her daily activities. These
are examples of homeorhetic processes or self-
righting tendencies that can occur over time.
What nurses observe as development or
adaptation of the behavioral system is a product
of stabilization. When a person is ill or threat-
ened with illness, he or she is subject to biopsy-
chosocial perturbations. The nurse, according
to Johnson (1980, 1990), acts as the external
regulator and monitors patient response, look-
ing for successful adaptation to occur. If behav-
ioral system balance returns, there is no need
for intervention. If not, the nurse intervenes to
help the patient restore behavioral system bal-
ance. It is hoped that the patient matures and
with additional hospitalizations, the previous
patterns of response have been assimilated, and
there are few disturbances.
Reorganization
Adaptive reorganization occurs when the behav-
ioral system encounters new experiences in the
environment that cannot be balanced by existing
system mechanisms. Adaptation is defined as
change that permits the behavioral system to
maintain its set points best in new situations. To
the extent that the behavioral system cannot as-
similate the new conditions with existing regu-
latory mechanisms, accommodation must occur
either as a new relationship between subsystems
or by the establishment of a higher order or dif-
ferent cognitive schema (set, choice). The nurse
acts to provide conditions or resources essential
to help the accommodation process, may impose
regulatory or control mechanisms to stimulate
or reinforce certain behaviors, or may attempt to
repair structural components (Johnson, 1980). If
the focus is on a structural part of the subsystem,
then the nurse will focus on the goal, set, choice,
or action of a specific subsystem. The nurse
might provide an educational intervention to
alter the client’s set and broaden the range of
choices available.
CHAPTER 7 • Dorothy Johnson’s Behavioral System Model and Its Applications 91
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 91
The difference between stabilization and re-
organization is that the latter involves change
or evolution. A behavioral system is embedded
in an environment, but it is capable of oper-
ating independently of environmental con-
straints through the process of adaptation. The
diagnosis of a chronic illness, the birth of a
child, or the development of a healthy lifestyle
regimen to prevent problems in later years are
all examples in which accommodation not only
promotes behavioral system balance but also
involves a developmental process that results
in the establishment of a higher order or more
complex behavioral system.
Hierarchic Interaction
Each behavioral system exists in a context of
hierarchical relationships and environmental
relationships. From the perspective of general
systems theory, a behavioral system that has
the properties of wholeness and order, stabi-
lization, and reorganization will also demon-
strate a hierarchic structure (Buckley, 1968).
Hierarchies, or a pattern of relying on particular
subsystems, lead to a degree of stability. A dis-
ruption or failure will not destroy the whole
system but instead will lead to decomposition
to the next level of stability.
The judgment that a discontinuity has oc-
curred is typically based on a lack of correlation
between assessments at two points of time. For
example, one’s lifestyle before surgery is not a
good fit postoperatively. These discontinuities
can provide opportunities for reorganization
and development.
Dialectical Contradiction
The last core principle is the motivational force
for behavioral change. Johnson (1980) de-
scribed these as drives and noted that these re-
sponses are developed and modified over time
through maturation, experience, and learning.
A person’s activities in the environment lead to
knowledge and development. However, by act-
ing on the world, each person is constantly
changing it and his or her goals, and therefore
changing what he or she needs to know. The
number of environmental domains that the
person is responding to includes the biological,
psychological, cultural, familial, social, and
physical setting. The person needs to resolve
(maintain behavioral system balance of) a cas-
cade of contradictions between goals related to
physical status, social roles, and cognitive status
when faced with illness or the threat of illness.
Nurses’ interventions during these periods can
make a significant difference in the lives of the
persons involved because the nurse can help
clients compare opposing propositions and
make decisions. Dealing with these contradic-
tions can be viewed as the “driving force” of de-
velopment as resolution brings about a higher
level of understanding of the issue at hand. This
may also alter the persons set, choice and ac-
tion. Behavioral system balance is restored and
a new level of development is attained.
Johnson’s model is unique in part because it
takes from both general systems and develop-
mental theories. One may analyze the patient’s
response in terms of behavioral system balance
and, from a developmental perspective, ask,
“Where did this come from, and where is it
going?” The developmental component neces-
sitates that we identify and understand the
processes of stabilization and sources of distur-
bances that lead to reorganization. These need
to be evaluated by age, gender, and culture. The
combination of systems theory and develop-
ment identifies “nursing’s unique social mission
and our special realm of original responsibility
in patient care” (Johnson, 1990, p. 32).
Major Concepts of the Model
Next, we review the model as a behavioral sys-
tem within an environment.
Person
Johnson conceptualized a nursing client as a
behavioral system. The behavioral system is or-
derly, repetitive, and organized with interre-
lated and interdependent biological and
behavioral subsystems. The client is seen as a
collection of behavioral subsystems that inter-
relate to form the behavioral system. The sys-
tem may be defined as “those complex, overt
actions or responses to a variety of stimuli pres-
ent in the surrounding environment that are
purposeful and functional” (Auger, 1976, p. 22).
These ways of behaving form an organized
and integrated functional unit that determines
92 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 92
CHAPTER 7 • Dorothy Johnson’s Behavioral System Model and Its Applications 93
Achievement Subsystem
Goal
Function
Affiliative Subsystem
Goal
Function
Aggressive/Protective Subsystem
Goal
Function
Dependency Subsystem
Goal
Function
Eliminative Subsystem
Goal
Function
Table 7 • 1 The Subsystems of Behavior
Mastery or control of self or the environment
To set appropriate goals
To direct behaviors toward achieving a desired goal
To perceive recognition from others
To differentiate between immediate goals and long-term goals
To interpret feedback (input received) to evaluate the achievement of goals
To relate or belong to someone or something other than oneself; to
achieve intimacy and inclusion
To form cooperative and interdependent role relationships within human
social systems
To develop and use interpersonal skills to achieve intimacy and inclusion
To share
To be related to another in a definite way
To use narcissistic feelings in an appropriate way
To protect self or others from real or imagined threatening objects, per-
sons, or ideas; to achieve self-protection and self-assertion
To recognize biological, environmental, or health systems that are po-
tential threats to self or others
To mobilize resources to respond to challenges identified as threats
To use resources or feedback mechanisms to alter biological, environ-
mental, or health input or human responses in order to diminish threats
to self or others
To protect one’s achievement goals
To protect one’s beliefs
To protect one’s identity or self-concept
To obtain focused attention, approval, nurturance, and physical assis-
tance; to maintain the environmental resources needed for assistance; to
gain trust and reliance
To obtain approval, reassurance about self
To make others aware of self
To induce others to care for physical needs
To evolve from a state of total dependence on others to a state of in-
creased dependence on the self
To recognize and accept situations requiring reversal of self-dependence
(dependence on others)
To focus on another or oneself in relation to social, psychological, and
cultural needs and desires
To expel biological wastes; to externalize the internal biological
environment
To recognize and interpret input from the biological system that signals
readiness for waste excretion
To maintain physiological homeostasis through excretion
To adjust to alterations in biological capabilities related to waste excre-
tion while maintaining a sense of control over waste excretion
To relieve feelings of tension in the self
To express one’s feelings, emotions, and ideas verbally or nonverbally
Continued
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 93
94 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Ingestive Subsystem
Goal
Function
Restorative Subsystem
Goal
Function
Sexual Subsystem
Goal
Function
Sources: Based on J. Grubbs (1980). An interpretation of the Johnson behavioral system model. In J. P. Riehl & C. Roy
(Eds.), Conceptual models for nursing practice (2nd ed., pp. 217–254). New York: Appleton-Century-Crofts; D. E. Johnson
(1980). The behavioral system model for nursing. In J. P. Riehl & C. Roy (Eds.), Conceptual models for nursing practice
(2nd ed., pp. 207–216). New York: Appleton-Century-Crofts; D. Wilkie (1987). Operationalization of the JBSM. Unpub-
lished paper, University of California, San Francisco; and B. Holaday (1972). Operationalization of the JBSM. Unpub-
lished paper, University of California, Los Angeles.
Table 7 • 1 The Subsystems of Behavior—cont’d
To take in needed resources from the environment to maintain the in-
tegrity of the organism or to achieve a state of pleasure; to internalize
the external environment
To sustain life through nutritive intake
To alter ineffective patterns of nutritive intake
To relieve pain or other psychophysiological subsystems
To obtain knowledge or information useful to the self
To obtain physical and/or emotional pleasure from intake of nutritive or
nonnutritive substances
To relieve fatigue and/or achieve a state of equilibrium by reestablish-
ing or replenishing the energy distribution among the other subsystems;
to redistribute energy
To maintain and/or return to physiological homeostasis
To produce relaxation of the self system
To procreate, to gratify or attract; to fulfill expectations associated with
one’s gender; to care for others and to be cared about by them
To develop a self-concept or self-identity based on gender
To project an image of oneself as a sexual being
To recognize and interpret biological system input related to sexual grat-
ification and/or procreation
To establish meaningful relationships in which sexual gratification
and/or procreation may be obtained
and limits the interaction between the person
and environment and establishes the relation-
ship of the person to the objects, events, and
situations in the environment. Johnson (1980,
p. 209) considered such “behavior to be or-
derly, purposeful and predictable; that is, it is
functionally efficient and effective most of the
time, and is sufficiently stable and recurrent to
be amenable to description and exploration.”
Subsystems
The parts of the behavioral system are called
subsystems. They carry out specialized tasks or
functions needed to maintain the integrity of
the whole behavioral system and manage its re-
lationship to the environment. Each of these
subsystems has a set of behavioral responses that
is developed and modified through motivation,
experience, and learning.
Johnson identified seven subsystems. How-
ever, in this author’s operationalization of the
model, as in Grubbs (1980), I have included
eight subsystems. These eight subsystems and their
goals and functions are described in Table 7-1.
Johnson noted that these subsystems are found
cross-culturally and across a broad range of the
phylogenetic scale. She also noted the signifi-
cance of social and cultural factors involved in
the development of the subsystems. She did
not consider the seven subsystems as complete,
because “the ultimate group of response systems
to be identified in the behavioral system will
undoubtedly change as research reveals new
subsystems or indicated changes in the struc-
ture, functions, or behavioral groupings in the
original set” (Johnson, 1980, p. 214).
Each subsystem has functions that serve to
meet the conceptual goal. Functional behaviors
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 94
are the activities carried out to meet these
goals. These behaviors may vary with each in-
dividual, depending on the person’s age, sex,
motives, cultural values, social norms, and
self-concepts. For the subsystem goals to be
accomplished, behavioral system structural
components must meet functional require-
ments of the behavioral system.
Each subsystem is composed of at least four
structural components that interact in a spe-
cific pattern: goal, set, choice, and action. The
goal of a subsystem is defined as the desired
result or consequence of the behavior. The
basis for the goal is a universal drive that can
be shown to exist through scientific research.
In general, the drive of each subsystem is the
same for all people, but there are variations
among individuals (and within individuals over
time) in the specific objects or events that are
drive-fulfilling, in the value placed on goal at-
tainment, and in drive strength. With drives
as the impetus for the behavior, goals can be
identified and are considered universal.
The behavioral set is a predisposition to act
in a certain way in a given situation. The be-
havioral set represents a relatively stable and
habitual behavioral pattern of responses to par-
ticular drives or stimuli. It is learned behavior
and is influenced by knowledge, attitudes, and
beliefs. The set contains two components: per-
severation and preparation. The perseveratory
set refers to a consistent tendency to react to
certain stimuli with the same pattern of behav-
ior. The preparatory set is contingent on the
function of the perseveratory set. The prepara-
tory set functions to establish priorities for
attending or not attending to various stimuli.
The conceptual set is an additional com-
ponent to the model (Holaday, 1982). It is a
process of ordering that serves as the mediat-
ing link between stimuli from the preparatory
and perseveratory sets. Here attitudes, beliefs,
information, and knowledge are examined
before a choice is made. There are three levels
of processing—an inadequate conceptual set,
a developing conceptual set, and a sophisti-
cated conceptual set.
The third and fourth components of each
subsystem are choice and action. Choice refers
to the individual’s repertoire of alternative
behaviors in a situation that will best meet the
goal and attain the desired outcome. The larger
the behavioral repertoire of alternative behav-
iors in a situation, the more adaptable is the
individual. The fourth structural component of
each subsystem is the observable action of the
individual. The concern is with the efficiency
and effectiveness of the behavior in goal attain-
ment. Actions are any observable responses
to stimuli.
For the eight subsystems to develop and
maintain stability, each must have a constant
supply of functional requirements (sustenal
imperatives). The concept of functional re-
quirements tends to be confined to conditions
of the system’s survival, and it includes biolog-
ical as well as psychosocial needs. The prob-
lems are related to establishing the types of
functional requirements (universal vs. highly
specific) and finding procedures for validating
the assumptions of these requirements. It also
suggests a classification of the various states or
processes on the basis of some principle and
perhaps the establishment of a hierarchy
among them. The Johnson model proposes
that for the behavior to be maintained, it must
be protected, nurtured, and stimulated: It re-
quires protection from noxious stimuli that
threaten the survival of the behavioral system;
nurturance, which provides adequate input to
sustain behavior; and stimulation, which con-
tributes to continued growth of the behavior
and counteracts stagnation. A deficiency in any
or all of these functional requirements threat-
ens the behavioral system as a whole, or the ef-
fective functioning of the particular subsystem
with which it is directly involved.
Environment
In systems theory, the term environment is de-
fined as the set of all objects for which a change
in attributes will affect the system as well as
those objects whose attributes are changed by
the behavior of the system (von Bertalanffy,
1968). Johnson referred to the internal and
external environment of the system. She also
referred to the interaction between the person
and the environment and to the objects, events,
and situations in the environment. She further
noted that there are forces in the environment
CHAPTER 7 • Dorothy Johnson’s Behavioral System Model and Its Applications 95
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 95
that impinge on the person and to which the
person adjusts. Thus, the JBSM environment
consists of all elements that are not a part of the
individual’s behavioral system but that influ-
ence the system and can also serve as a source
of sustenal imperatives. Some of these elements
can be manipulated by the nurse to achieve
health (behavioral system balance or stability)
for the patient. Johnson provided no other spe-
cific definition of the environment, nor did she
identify what she considered internal versus ex-
ternal environment. But much can be inferred
from her writings, and system theory also pro-
vides additional insights into the environment
component of the model.
The external environment may include peo-
ple, objects, and phenomena that can poten-
tially permeate the boundary of the behavioral
system. This external stimulus forms an organ-
ized or meaningful pattern that elicits a re-
sponse from the individual. The behavioral
system attempts to maintain equilibrium in re-
sponse to environmental factors by assimilating
and accommodating to the forces that impinge
on it. Areas of external environment of interest
to nurses include the physical settings, people,
objects, phenomena, and psychosocial–cultural
attributes of an environment.
Johnson provided detailed information
about the internal structure and how it func-
tions. She also noted that “[i]llness or other
sudden internal or external environmental
change is most frequently responsible for sys-
tem malfunction” (Johnson, 1980, p. 212).
Such factors as physiology; temperament; ego;
age; and related developmental capacities, at-
titudes, and self-concept are general regulators
that may be viewed as a class of internalized
intervening variables that influence set, choice,
and action. They are key areas for nursing as-
sessment. For example, a nurse attempting to
respond to the needs of an acutely ill hospital-
ized 6-year-old would need to know some-
thing about the developmental capacities of a
6-year-old and about self-concept and ego de-
velopment to understand the child’s behavior.
Health
Johnson viewed health as efficient and effective
functioning of the system and as behavioral
system balance and stability. Behavioral system
balance and stability are demonstrated by ob-
served behavior that is purposeful, orderly, and
predictable. Such behavior is maintained when
it is efficient and effective in managing the
person’s relationship to the environment.
Behavior changes when efficiency and ef-
fectiveness are no longer evident or when a
more optimal level of functioning is per-
ceived. Individuals are said to achieve effi-
cient and effective behavioral functioning
when their behavior is commensurate with
social demands, when they are able to modify
their behavior in ways that support biological
imperatives, when they are able to benefit to
the fullest extent during illness from the
physician’s knowledge and skill, and when
their behavior does not reveal unnecessary
trauma as a consequence of illness (Johnson,
1980, p. 207).
Behavior system imbalance and instability
are not described explicitly but can be inferred
from the following statement to be a malfunc-
tion of the behavioral system:
The subsystems and the system as a
whole tend to be self-maintaining and
self-perpetuating so long as conditions
in the internal and external environment
of the system remain orderly and pre-
dictable, the conditions and resources nec-
essary to their functional requirements are
met, and the interrelationships among the
subsystems are harmonious. If these con-
ditions are not met, malfunction becomes
apparent in behavior that is in part disor-
ganized, erratic, and dysfunctional. Illness
or other sudden internal or external envi-
ronmental change is most frequently re-
sponsible for such malfunctions. (Johnson,
1980, p. 212)
Thus, Johnson equated behavioral system
imbalance and instability with illness. How-
ever, as Meleis (2011) has pointed out, we
must consider that illness may be separate
from behavioral system functioning. Johnson
also referred to physical and social health but
did not specifically define wellness. Just as the
inference about illness may be made, it may
be inferred that wellness is behavioral system
96 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 96
balance and stability, as well as efficient and
effective behavioral functioning.
Nursing and Nursing Therapeutics
Nursing is viewed as “a service that is com-
plementary to that of medicine and other
health professions, but which makes its own
distinctive contribution to the health and
well-being of people” (Johnson, 1980, p. 207).
She distinguished nursing from medicine by
noting that nursing views the patient as a
behavioral system, and medicine views the
patient as a biological system. In her view,
the specific goal of nursing action is “to re-
store, maintain, or attain behavioral system
balance and stability at the highest possible
level for the individual” (Johnson, 1980,
p. 214). This goal may be expanded to in-
clude helping the person achieve an optimal
level of balance and functioning when this is
possible and desired.
The goal of the system’s action is behavioral
system balance. For the nurse, the area of con-
cern is a behavioral system threatened by the
loss of order and predictability through illness
or the threat of illness. The goal of a nurse’s ac-
tion is to maintain or restore the individual’s
behavioral system balance and stability or to
help the individual achieve a more optimal
level of balance and functioning.
Johnson did not specify the steps of the
nursing process but clearly identified the role
of the nurse as an external regulatory force. She
also identified questions to be asked when an-
alyzing system functioning, and she provided
diagnostic classifications to delineate distur-
bances and guidelines for interventions.
Johnson (1980) expected the nurse to base
judgments about behavioral system balance
and stability on knowledge and an explicit
value system. One important point she made
about the value system is that
given that the person has been provided with
an adequate understanding of the potential
for and means to obtain a more optimal level
of behavioral functioning than is evident at
the present time, the final judgment of the
desired level of functioning is the right of the
individual. (Johnson, 1980, p. 215)
The source of difficulty arises from structural
and functional stresses. Structural and func-
tional problems develop when the system is un-
able to meet its own functional requirements.
As a result of the inability to meet functional
requirements, structural impairments may take
place. In addition, functional stress may be
found as a result of structural damage or from
the dysfunctional consequences of the behavior.
Other problems develop when the system’s
control and regulatory mechanisms fail to
develop or become defective.
Four diagnostic classifications to delineate
these disturbances are differentiated in the
model. A disorder originating within any one
subsystem is classified as either an insuffi-
ciency, which exists when a subsystem is not
functioning or developed to its fullest capacity
due to inadequacy of functional requirements,
or as a discrepancy, which exists when a be-
havior does not meet the intended conceptual
goal. Disorders found between more than one
subsystem are classified either as an incompat-
ibility, which exists when the behaviors of two
or more subsystems in the same situation con-
flict with each other to the detriment of the in-
dividual, or as dominance, which exists when
the behavior of one subsystem is used more
than any other, regardless of the situation or
to the detriment of the other subsystems. This
is also an area where Johnson believed addi-
tional diagnostic classifications would be de-
veloped. Nursing therapeutics address these
three areas.
The next critical element is the nature of the
interventions the nurse would use to respond
to the behavioral system imbalance. The first
step is a thorough assessment to find the source
of the difficulty or the origin of the problem.
There are at least three types of interventions
that the nurse can use to bring about change.
The nurse may attempt to repair damaged
structural units by altering the individual’s set
and choice. The second would be for the nurse
to impose regulatory and control measures. The
nurse acts outside the patient environment to
provide the conditions, resources, and controls
necessary to restore behavioral system balance.
The nurse also acts within and upon the exter-
nal environment and the internal interactions
CHAPTER 7 • Dorothy Johnson’s Behavioral System Model and Its Applications 97
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 97
of the subsystem to create change and restore
stability. The third, and most common, treat-
ment modality is to supply or to help the client
find his or her own supplies of essential func-
tional requirements. The nurse may provide
nurturance (resources and conditions necessary
for survival and growth; the nurse may train the
client to cope with new stimuli and encourage
effective behaviors), stimulation (provision of
stimuli that brings forth new behaviors or in-
creases behaviors, provides motivation for a
particular behavior, and provides opportunities
for appropriate behaviors), and protection
(safeguarding from noxious stimuli, defending
from unnecessary threats, and coping with a
threat on the individual’s behalf). The nurse
and the client negotiate the treatment plan.
Applications of the Model
Fundamental to any professional discipline is
the development of a scientific body of knowl-
edge that can be used to guide its practice.
JBSM has served as a means for identifying,
labeling, and classifying phenomena important
to the nursing discipline. Nurses have used the
JBSM model since the early 1970s, and the
model has demonstrated its ability to provide
a medium for theoretical growth; organization
for nurses’ thinking, observations, and inter-
pretations of what was observed; a systematic
structure and rationale for activities; direction
to the search for relevant research questions;
solutions for patient care problems; and, fi-
nally, criteria to determine whether a problem
has been solved.
Practice-Focused Research
Stevenson and Woods (1986) stated: “Nursing
science is the domain of knowledge concerned
with the adaptation of individuals and groups
to actual or potential health problems, the en-
vironments that influence health in humans
and the therapeutic interventions that promote
health and affect the consequences of illness”
(1986, p. 6). This position focuses efforts in
nursing science on the expansion of knowledge
about clients’ health problems and nursing
therapeutics. Nurse researchers have demon-
strated the usefulness of Johnson’s model in a
clinical practice in a variety of ways. The ma-
jority of the research focuses on clients’ func-
tioning in terms of maintaining or restoring
behavioral system balance, understanding the
system and/or subsystems by focusing on the
basic sciences, or focusing on the nurse as an
agent of action who uses the JBSM to gather
diagnostic data or to provide care that influ-
ences behavioral system balance.
Derdiarian (1990, 1991) examined the
nurse as an action agent within the practice
domain. She focused on the nurses’ assess-
ment of the patient using the JBSM and the
effect of using this instrument on the quality
of care (Derdiarian, 1990, 1991). This ap-
proach expanded the view of nursing knowl-
edge from exclusively client-based to knowledge
about the context and practice of nursing that
is model-based. The results of these studies
found a significant increase in patient and
nurse satisfaction when the JBSM was used.
Derdiarian (1983, 1988; Derdiarian & Forsythe,
1983) also found that a model-based, valid,
and reliable instrument could improve the
comprehensiveness and the quality of assess-
ment data; the method of assessment; and the
quality of nursing diagnosis, interventions,
and outcome. Derdiarian’s body of work re-
flects the complexity of nursing’s knowledge
as well as the strategic problem-solving capa-
bilities of the JBSM. Her 1991 article in Nurs-
ing Administration Quarterly demonstrated the
clear relationship between Johnson’s theory
and nursing practice.
Others have demonstrated the utility of
Johnson’s model for clinical practice. Tamilarasi
and Kanimozhi (2009) used the JBSM to de-
velop interventions to improve the quality of
life of breast cancer survivors. Oyedele (2010)
used the JBSM to develop and test nursing in-
terventions to prevent teen pregnancy in South
African teens. Box 7-1 highlights other JBSM
research. Talerico (1999) found that the JBSM
demonstrated utility in accounting for differ-
ences in the expression of aggressive behavioral
actions in elders with dementia in a way that
the biomedical model has proved unable.
Wang and Palmer (2010) used the JBSM to
gain a better understanding of women’s toilet-
ing behavior, and Colling, Owen, McCreedy,
98 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 98
and Newman (2003) used it to study the effec-
tiveness of a continence program for frail eld-
ers. Poster, Dee, and Randell (1997) found the
JBSM was an effective framework to evaluate
patient outcomes.
Education
Johnson’s model was used as the basis for un-
dergraduate education at the UCLA School of
Nursing. The curriculum was developed by the
faculty; however, no published material is
available that describes this process. Texts by Wu
(1973) and Auger (1976) extended Johnson’s
model and provided some idea of the content
of that curriculum. Later, in the 1980s, Harris
(1986) described the use of Johnson’s theory
as a framework for UCLA’s curriculum. The
Universities of Hawaii, Alaska, and Colorado
also used the JBSM as a basis for their under-
graduate curricula.
Loveland-Cherry and Wilkerson (1983)
analyzed Johnson’s model and concluded that
the model could be used to develop a curricu-
lum. The primary focus of the program would
be the study of the person as a behavioral sys-
tem. The student would need a background in
systems theory and in the biological, psycho-
logical, sociological sciences, and genetics. The
mapping of the human genome and clinical
exome and genome sequencing has provided
evidence that genes serve as general regulators
of behavioral system activity.
Nursing Practice and Administration
Johnson has influenced nursing practice be-
cause she enabled nurses to make statements
about the links between nursing input and
health outcomes for clients. The model has
been useful in practice because it identifies an
end product (behavioral system balance),
which is nursing’s goal. Nursing’s specific ob-
jective is to maintain or restore the person’s
behavioral system balance and stability, or to
help the person achieve a more optimum level
of functioning. The model provides a means
for identifying the source of the problem in
the system. Nursing is seen as the external
regulatory force that acts to restore balance
(Johnson, 1980).
One of the best examples of the model’s
use in practice has been at the University of
California, Los Angeles, Neuropsychiatric
Institute. Auger and Dee (1983) designed a
patient classification system using the JBSM.
Each subsystem of behavior was operational-
ized in terms of critical adaptive and maladap-
tive behaviors. The behavioral statements were
designed to be measurable, relevant to the
clinical setting, observable, and specific to the
subsystem. The use of the model has had a
major effect on all phases of the nursing
process, including a more systematic assess-
ment process, identification of patient strengths
and problem areas, and an objective means for
evaluating the quality of nursing care (Dee &
Auger, 1983).
The early works of Dee and Auger led to
further refinement in the patient classification
system. Behavioral indices for each subsystem
have been further operationalized in terms of
critical adaptive and maladaptive behaviors.
Behavioral data is gathered to determine the
effectiveness of each subsystem (Dee, 1990;
Dee & Randell, 1989).
The scores serve as an acuity rating system
and provide a basis for allocating resources.
These resources are allocated based on the as-
signed levels of nursing intervention, and re-
source needs are calculated based on the total
number of patients assigned according to levels
of nursing interventions and the hours of nurs-
ing care associated with each of the levels (Dee
& Randell, 1989). The development of this
system has provided nursing administration
with the ability to identify the levels of staff
needed to provide care (licensed vocational
CHAPTER 7 • Dorothy Johnson’s Behavioral System Model and Its Applications 99
Box 7-1 Bonnie Holaday’s Research Highlighted
My program of research has examined nor-
mal and atypical patterns of behavior of chil-
dren with a chronic illness and the behavior
of their parents and the interrelationship be-
tween the children and the environment. My
goal was to determine the causes of instability
within and between subsystems (e.g., break-
down in internal regulatory or control mecha-
nisms) and to identify the source of problems
in behavioral system balance.
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 99
nurse vs. registered nurse), bill patients for ac-
tual nursing care services, and identify nursing
services that are absolutely necessary in times
of budgetary restraint. Recent research has
demonstrated the importance of a model-
based nursing database in medical records
(Poster et al., 1997) and the effectiveness of
using a model to identify the characteristics of
a large hospital’s managed behavioral health
population in relation to observed nursing care
needs, level of patient functioning on admis-
sion and discharge, and length of stay (Dee,
Van Servellen, & Brecht, 1998).1
The work of Vivien Dee and her colleagues
has demonstrated the validity and usefulness
of the JBSM as a basis for clinical practice
within a health care setting. From the findings
of their work, it is clear that the JBSM estab-
lished a systematic framework for patient as-
sessment and nursing interventions, provided
a common frame of reference for all practition-
ers in the clinical setting, provided a frame-
work for the integration of staff knowledge
about the clients, and promoted continuity in
the delivery of care. These findings should be
generalizable to a variety of clinical settings.
100 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
1 For additional information please see the bonus chap-
ter content available at http://davisplus.fadavis.com
Practice Exemplar
Provided by Kelly White
During the change-of-shift report that morn-
ing, I was told that a new patient had just been
wheeled onto the floor at 7:00 a.m. As a result,
it was my responsibility to complete the ad-
mission paperwork and organize the patient’s
day. He was a 49-year-old man who was ad-
mitted through the emergency department to
our oncology floor for fever and neutropenia
secondary to recent chemotherapy for lung
cancer.
Immediately after my initial rounds, to en-
sure all my patients were stable and comfort-
able, I rolled the computer on wheels into his
room to begin the nursing admission process.
Jim explained to me that he was diagnosed
with small cell lung carcinoma 2 months ear-
lier after he was admitted to another hospital
for coughing, chest pain, and shortness of
breath. He went on to explain that a recent
magnetic resonance imaging scan showed
metastasis to the liver and brain.
His past health history revealed that he ir-
regularly visited his primary health care
provider. He is 6 feet 3 inches tall and weighs
168 pounds (76.4 kg). He states that he has
lost 67 pounds in the past 6 months. His ap-
petite has significantly diminished because
“everything tastes like metal.” He has a history
of smoking three packs per day of cigarettes
for 30 years. He states he quit when he began
his chemotherapy.
Jim, a high school graduate, is married to
his high school sweetheart, Ellen. He lives
with his wife and three children in their
home. He and his wife are currently unem-
ployed secondary to recent layoffs at the fac-
tory where they both worked. He explained
that Ellen has been emotionally pushing him
away and occasionally disappears from the
home for hours at a time without explaining
her whereabouts. He informs me that before
his diagnosis, they were the best of friends
and inseparable.
He has tolerated his treatments well until
now, except for having frequent, burning, un-
controlled diarrhea for days at a time after
his chemotherapy treatments. These episodes
have caused raw, tender patches of skin
around his rectal area that become increas-
ingly more painful and irritated with each
bowel movement.
Jim is exceptionally tearful this morning as
he expresses concerns about his own future
and the future of his family. He informs me
that Ellen’s mother is flying in from out
of state to care for the children while he is
hospitalized.
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 100
CHAPTER 7 • Dorothy Johnson’s Behavioral System Model and Its Applications 101
Practice Exemplar cont.
Assessment
Johnson’s behavioral systems model guided
the assessment process. The significant behav-
ioral data are as follows:
Achievement subsystem
Jim is losing control of his life and of the re-
lationships that matter most to him as a
person—his family.
He is a high school graduate.
Affiliative protective subsystem
Jim is married but states that his wife is dis-
tancing herself from him. He feels he is
losing his “best friend” at a time when he
really needs this support.
Aggressive protective subsystem
Jim is protective of his health now (he quit
smoking when he began chemotherapy)
but has a long history of neglecting it
(smoking for 30 years, unexplained weight
loss for 4 months, irregular visits to his
primary health-care provider).
Dependency subsystem
Jim is realizing his ability to care for self and
family is diminishing and will continue to
diminish as his health deteriorates. He
questions who he can depend on because
his wife is not emotionally available to him.
Eliminative subsystem
Jim is experiencing frequent, burning, un-
controlled diarrhea for days at a time
after his chemotherapy treatments. These
episodes have caused raw, tender patches
of skin around his rectal area that become
increasingly more painful and irritated
with each bowel movement.
Ingestive subsystem
Jim has lost 67 pounds in 6 months and
has decreased appetite secondary to the
chemotherapy side effects.
Restorative subsystem
Jim currently experiences shortness of breath,
pain, and fatigue.
Sexual subsystem
Jim has shortness of breath and possible pain
on exertion, which may be leading to con-
cerns about his sexual abilities.
Jim’s wife, Ellen, is distant these days,
which would have an effect on the
couple’s intimacy.
The environmental assessment is as follows:
Internal/external
After the admission process was completed, I
had several concerns for my new patient. I
recognized that Jim was a middle-aged man
whose developmental stage was compro-
mised regarding his productivity with fam-
ily and career due to his illness. Mental and
physical abilities could be impaired as this
disease process advances. In addition, this
may create further strain on his relationship
with his wife, as she attempts to deal with
her own feelings about his diagnosis. Fam-
ily support would be essential as Jim’s jour-
ney continued. Lastly, Jim needed to be
educated on the expectations of his diagno-
sis, participate in a plan for treatment dur-
ing his hospital stay, and assist in the
development of goals for his future.
Diagnostic Analysis
Jim is likely uncertain about his future as a hus-
band, father, employee, and friend. Realizing
this, I encouraged Jim to verbalize his concerns
regarding these four areas of his life while I
completed my physical assessment and assisted
him in settling into his new environment. At
first he was hesitant to speak about his family
concerns but soon opened up to me after I sat
down in a chair at his bedside and simply made
him my complete focus for 5 minutes. As a re-
sult of this brief interaction, together we were
able to develop short-term goals related to his
hospitalization and home life throughout the
rest of my shift with him that day. In addition,
he acquiesced and allowed me to order a social
work consult, recognizing that he would no
longer be able to adequately meet his family’s
needs independently at this time.
We also addressed the skin impairment is-
sues in his rectal area. I was able to offer him
ideas on how to keep the area from experiencing
further breakdown. Lastly, the wound care nurse
was consulted.
Continued
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 101
102 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Practice Exemplar cont.
Evaluation
During his 10-day hospitalization, Jim and
his wife agreed to speak to a counselor regard-
ing their thoughts on Jim’s diagnosis and
prognosis upon his discharge. Jim’s rectal
area healed because he did not receive any
chemotherapy/radiation during his stay. He
received tips on how to prevent breakdown in
that area from the wound care nurse who took
care of him on a daily basis. Jim gained 3
pounds during his stay and maintained that he
would continue drinking nutrition supple-
ments daily, regardless of his appetite changes
during his cancer treatment. Jim’s stamina and
thirst for life grew stronger as his body grew
physically stronger. As he was being dis-
charged, he whispered to me that he was
thankful for the care he had received while on
our floor, and he believed that the nurses had
brought him and his wife closer than they had
been in months. He stated that they were talk-
ing about the future and that Ellen had ac-
knowledged her fears to him the previous
evening. Jim was wheeled out of the hospital
because he continued to have shortness of
breath on extended exertion. As his wife drove
away from the hospital, Jim waved to me with
a genuine smile and a sparkle in his eye.
Epilogue
Jim passed away peacefully 3 months later at
home, with his wife and children at his side.
His wife contacted me soon afterward to let
me know that the nursing care Jim received
during his first stay on our unit opened the
doors to allow them both to recognize that
they needed to modify their approach to the
course of his disease. In the end, they flour-
ished as a couple and a family, creating a sup-
portive transition for Jim and the entire family.
■ Summary
The Johnson Behavioral System Model cap-
tures the richness and complexity of nursing.
It also addresses the interdependent functional
biological, psychological, and sociological
components within the behavioral system and
locates this within a larger social system. The
JBSM focuses on the person as a whole, as well
as on the complex interrelationships among its
constituent parts. Once the diagnosis has been
made, the nurse can proceed inward to the
subsystem and outward to the environment. It
also asks nurses to be systems thinkers as they
formulate their assessment plan, make their di-
agnosis of the problem, and plan interventions.
The JBSM provides nurses with a clear con-
ception of their goal and of their mission as an
integral part of the health-care team.
Johnson expected the theory’s further devel-
opment in the future and that it would uncover
and shape significant research problems that
have both theoretical and practical value to the
discipline. Some examples include examining
the levels of integration (biological, psycholog-
ical, and sociocultural) within and between the
subsystems. For example, a study could examine
the way a person deals with the transition from
health to illness with the onset of asthma. There
is concern with the relations between one’s bi-
ological system (e.g., unstable, problems breath-
ing), one’s psychological self (e.g., achievement
goals, need for assistance, self-concept), self in
relation to the physical environment (e.g., aller-
gens, being away from home), and transactions
related to the sociocultural context (e.g., attitudes
and values about the sick). The study of transi-
tions (e.g., the onset of puberty, menopause,
death of a spouse, onset of acute illness) also rep-
resents a treasury of open problems for research
with the JBSM. Findings obtained from these
studies will provide not only an opportunity to
revise and advance the theoretical conceptual-
ization of the JBSM, but also information about
nursing interventions. The JBSM approach
leads us to seek common organizational param-
eters in every scientific explanation and does
so using a shared language about nursing and
nursing care.
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 102
CHAPTER 7 • Dorothy Johnson’s Behavioral System Model and Its Applications 103
References
Ainsworth, M. (1964). Patterns of attachment behavior
shown by the infant in interactions with mother.
Merrill-Palmer Quarterly, 10, 51–58.
Auger, J. (1976). Behavioral systems and nursing. Engle-
wood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Auger, J., & Dee, V. (1983). A patient classification sys-
tem based on the behavioral systems model of nurs-
ing: Part 1. Journal of Nursing Administration, 13(4),
38–43.
Buckley, W. (Ed.). (1968). Modern systems research for the
behavioral scientist. Chicago: Aldine.
Chin, R. (1961). The utility of system models and devel-
opmental models for practitioners. In K. Benne,
W. Bennis, & R. Chin (Eds.), The planning of change.
New York: Holt.
Colling, J., Owen, T. R., McCreedy, M., & Newman,
D. (2003). The effects of a continence program on
frail community-dwelling elderly persons. Urologic
Nursing, 23(2), 117–131.
Crandal, V. (1963). Achievement. In H. W. Stevenson
(Ed.), Child psychology. Chicago: University of
Chicago Press.
Dee, V. (1990). Implementation of the Johnson model:
One hospital’s experience. In: M. Parker (Ed.),
Nursing theories in practice (pp. 33–63). New York:
National League for Nursing.
Dee, V., & Auger, J. (1983). A patient classification sys-
tem based on the Behavioral System Model of Nurs-
ing: Part 2. Journal of Nursing Administration, 13(5),
18–23.
Dee, V., & Randell, B. P. (1989). NPH patient classifica-
tion system: A theory based nursing practice model for
staffing. Paper presented at the UCLA Neuropsychi-
atric Institute, Los Angeles, CA.
Dee, V., Van Servellen, G., & Brecht, M. (1998).
Managed behavioral health care patients and their
nursing care problems, level of functioning and
impairment on discharge. Journal of the American
Psychiatric Nurses Association, 4(2), 57–66.
Derdiarian, A. K. (1983). An instrument for theory and
research development using the behavioral systems
model for nursing: The cancer patient. Nursing
Research, 32, 196–201.
Derdiarian, A. K. (1988). Sensitivity of the Derdiarian
Behavioral Systems Model Instrument to age, site
and type of cancer: A preliminary validation study.
Scholarly Inquiring for Nursing Practice, 2, 103–121.
Derdiarian, A. K. (1990). The relationships among the
subsystems of Johnson’s behavioral system model.
Image, 22, 219–225.
Derdiarian, A. K. (1991). Effects of using a nursing
model-based instrument on the quality of nursing
care. Nursing Administration Quarterly, 15(3), 1–16.
Derdiarian, A. K., & Forsythe, A. B. (1983). An instru-
ment for theory and research development using the
behavioral systems model for nursing: The cancer
patient. Part II. Nursing Research, 3, 260–266.
Gerwitz, J. (Ed.). (1972). Attachment and dependency.
Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Glennister, D. (2011). Towards a general systems theory
of nursing: A literature review. Proceedings of the
55th Annual Meetings of the ISSS (International Soci-
ety for Systems Sciences). Retrieved February 20, 2013,
at www.journals.isss.org/index.php/proceedings55th/
article/view1717/569
Grubbs, J. (1980). An interpretation of the Johnson be-
havioral system model. In J. P. Riehl & C. Roy (Eds.),
Conceptual models for nursing practice (pp. 217–254).
New York: Appleton-Century-Crofts.
Harris, R. B. (1986). Introduction of a conceptual model
into a fundamental baccalaureate course. Journal of
Nursing Education, 25, 66–69.
Holaday, B. (1972). Unpublished operationalization of
the Johnson Model. University of California, Los
Angeles.
Holaday, B. (1981). Maternal response to their chroni-
cally ill infants’ attachment behavior of crying.
Nursing Research, 30, 343–348.
Holaday, B. (1982). Maternal conceptual set develop-
ment: Identifying patterns of maternal response to
chronically ill infant crying. Maternal Child Nursing
Journal, 11, 47–59.
Holaday, B. (1987). Patterns of interaction between
mothers and their chronically ill infants. Maternal
Child Nursing Journal, 16, 29–45.
Holaday, B. (1997). Johnson’s behavioral system model in
nursing practice. In M. Alligood & A. Marriner-
Tomey (Eds.), Nursing theory: Utilization and applica-
tion (pp. 49–70). St. Louis, MO: Mosby-Year Book.
Holaday, B., Turner-Henson, A., & Swan, J. (1997).
The Johnson behavioral system model: Explaining
activities of chronically ill children. In P. Hinton-
Walker & B. Newman (Eds.), Blueprint for use of
nursing models: Education, research, practice, and ad-
ministration (pp. 33–63). New York: National
League for Nursing.
Johnson, D. E. (1956). A story of three children. The
Nursing Journal of India, XLVII(9), 313–322.
Johnson, D. E. (1957). Nursing care of the ill child. The
Nursing Journal of India, XLVIII(1), 12–14.
Johnson, D. E. (1959). The nature and science of nurs-
ing. Nursing Outlook, 7, 291–294.
Johnson, D. E. (1961). The significance of nursing care.
American Journal of Nursing, 61, 63–66.
Johnson, D. E. (1968). One conceptual model of nursing.
Unpublished lecture. Vanderbilt University.
Johnson, D. E. (1980). The behavioral system model for
nursing. In J. P. Riehl & C. Roy (Eds.), Conceptual
models for nursing practice (2nd ed., pp. 207–216).
New York: Appleton-Century-Crofts.
Johnson, D. E. (1990). The behavioral system model for
nursing. In M. E. Parker (Ed.), Nursing theories in
practice (pp. 23–32). New York: National League for
Nursing.
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 103
Johnson, D. E., & Smith, M. M. (1963). Crying as a
physiologic state in the newborn infant. Unpublished
research report, PHS Grant NV-00055-01 (formerly
GS–9768).
Kagan, J. (1964). Acquisition and significance of sex role
identity. In R. Hoffman & G. Hoffman (Eds.), Re-
view of child development research. New York: Russell
Sage Foundation.
Loveland-Cherry, C., & Wilkerson, S. (1983). Dorothy
Johnson’s behavioral system model. In J. Fitzpatrick
& A. Whall (Eds.), Conceptual models of nursing:
Analysis and application. Bowie, MD: Robert J.
Brady.
Meleis, A. I. (2011). Theoretical nursing: Development and
progress (5th ed.). Philadelphia: Lippincott,
Williams & Wilkins.
Oyedele, O.A. (2010). Guidelines to prevent teenage preg-
nancy based on the Johnson Behavioural Systems Model.
Doctoral dissertation from the Adelaide Tambo
School of Nursing Science, Tshwane University of
Technology, South Africa.
Parsons, T., & Shils, E. A. (Eds.). (1951). Toward a
general theory of action: Theoretical foundations for the
social sciences. New York: Harper & Row.
Poster, E. C., Dee, V., & Randell, B. P. (1997). The
Johnson behavioral systems model as a framework for
patient outcome evaluation. Journal of the American
Psychiatric Nurses Association, 3(3), 73–80.
Rapoport, A. (1968). Forward to modern systems re-
search for the behavior scientist. In W. Buckley
(Ed.), Modern systems research for the behavioral
scientist. Chicago: Aldine.
Sears, R., Maccoby, E., & Levin, H. (1954). Patterns of
child rearing. White Plains, NY: Row & Peterson.
Stevenson, J. S., & Woods, N. F. (1986). Nursing sci-
ence and contemporary science: Emerging para-
digms. In Setting the agenda for year 2000: Knowledge
development in nursing (pp. 6–20). Kansas City, MO:
American Academy of Nursing.
Talerico, K. A. (1999). Correlates of aggressive behavioral
actions of older adults with dementia. Doctoral disserta-
tion, School of Nursing, University of Pennsylvania.
Tamilarasi, B., & Kanimozhi, M. (2009). Improving
quality of life in breast cancer survivors: Theoretical
approach. The Nursing Journal of India, C(12).
Retrieved Feburary 20, 2013, from http://www
.tnaionline.org/dec-09/7.htm
von Bertalanffy, L. (1968). General systems theory: Foun-
dations, development, application. New York: George
Braziller.
Wang, K., & Palmer, M. H. (2010). Women’s toileting
behaviour related to urinary elimination: Concept
analysis. Journal of Advanced Nursing, 66(8),
1874–1884.
Wilkie, D. (1987). Unpublished operationalization of
the Johnson model. University of California, San
Francisco.
Wu, R. (1973). Behavior and illness. Englewood Cliffs,
NJ: Prentice-Hall.
104 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch07_087-104 26/12/14 2:43 PM Page 104
Chapter 8Dorothea Orem’s Self-Care
Deficit Nursing Theory
DONNA L. HARTWEG
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Theory
Applications of the Theory
Practice Applications
Practice Exemplar by Laureen Fleck
Summary
References
105
Introducing the Theorist
Dorothea E. Orem (1914–2007) dedicated her
life to creating and developing a theoretical
structure to improve nursing practice. As a
voracious reader and extraordinary thinker, she
framed her ideas in both theoretical and the
practical terms. She viewed nursing knowledge
as theoretical, with conceptual structure and
elements as exemplified in her self-care deficit
nursing theory (SCDNT), and as “practically
practical,” with knowledge, rules, and defined
roles for practice situations (Orem, 2001).
Orem’s personal life experiences, formal
education, employment, and her reading of
philosophers such as Aristotle, Aquinas, Harre
(1970), and Wallace (1983) directed her think-
ing (Orem, 2006). She sought to understand
the phenomena she observed, creating concep-
tualizations of nursing education, disciplinary
knowledge, and finally, a general theory of
nursing or SCDNT.
Orem worked independently and then col-
laboratively until her death at age 93. For a
lifetime of contributions to nursing science and
practice, Orem received honors from organiza-
tions such as Sigma Theta Tau, the American
Academy of Nursing, the National League for
Nursing, and Catholic University of America
as well as four honorary doctorates.
Orem received her initial nursing education
at Providence Hospital School of Nursing
in Washington, DC. After her 1934 gradua-
tion, Orem quickly moved into hospital staff/
supervisory positions in operating and emer-
gency areas. Her BSN Ed from Catholic
University of America (1939) led to a faculty
position there. After completing her MSN Ed
at Catholic University (1946), Orem became
Dorothea E. Orem
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 105
Director of Nursing Service and Education
at Provident Hospital School of Nursing in
Detroit (Taylor, 2007).
Orem’s early formulations on the nature of
nursing occurred while she was working for
the Indiana State Board of Health between
1949 and 1957 (Hartweg, 1991). She became
aware of nurses’ ability to “do nursing,” but
their inability to “describe nursing.” Without
this understanding, Orem believed nurses
could not improve practice. She made an ini-
tial effort to define nursing in a report titled
“The Art of Nursing in Hospital Service: An
Analysis” (Orem, 1956). The language of the
patient doing-for-self or the nurse helping to-
do-for-self appears in the report as antecedent
language for the concept of self-care.
During her tenure at the Office of Educa-
tion, Vocational Section in Washington, DC,
Orem generated a simple yet important ques-
tion: Why do people need nursing? In Guides
for Developing Curriculum for the Education of
Practical Nurses (Orem, 1959), she expanded
the question to what she termed “the proper
object of nursing”: “What condition exists in a
person when judgments are made that a
nurse(s) should be brought into the situation?”
(Orem, 2001, p. 20). Her answer was the in-
ability of persons to provide continuously for them-
selves the amount and quality of required self-care
because of situations of personal health.
Although Orem worked independently,
two groups contributed to the theory’s early
development (Taylor, 2007). The first group
was the Nursing Model Committee at
Catholic University of America. In 1968, the
Nursing Development Conference Group
(NDCG) was formed and continued the work
of the Nursing Model committee. The collab-
orative process and outcomes were published
in Concept Formalization: Process and Product
(NDCG, 1973, 1979), edited by Orem. Con-
current with group work, Orem published the
first of six editions of Nursing: Concepts of
Practice (1971), which has been translated into
many languages.
By 1989, the global impact of Orem’s work
was evident when the First International self-
care deficit nursing theory Conference was
held in Kansas City (Hartweg, 1991). These
conferences encouraged international collabo-
ration among institutions.
In 1991, the International Orem Society
(IOS) for Nursing Science and Scholarship was
founded by a group of international scholars.
The IOS’s mission is “To disseminate informa-
tion related to development of nursing science
and its articulation with the science of self-care”
(www.scdnt.com). This mission has been real-
ized through the publication of newsletters
(1993–2001) and a peer-reviewed journal,
Self-Care, Dependent Care & Nursing begun in
2002 (www.scdnt.com/ja/jarchive.html). Twelve
biennial Orem congresses have been held
throughout the world (Berbiglia, Hohmann, &
Bekel, 2012; www.ioscongress2012.lu).
In 1995, Orem convened the Orem Study
Group. This international group of scholars met
regularly at her home in Savannah, GA, for im-
mersion in areas of SCDNT needing further
development. Several publications resulted from
this group work (Denyes, Orem, & Bekel,
2001; Taylor, Renpenning, Geden, Neuman, &
Hart, 2001). Work groups continue today to re-
fine or develop concepts such as the universal
requisite of normalcy (personal communication,
Taylor & Renpenning, January, 20, 2014).
Many of Orem’s original papers are pub-
lished in Self-Care Theory in Nursing: Selected
Papers of Dorothea Orem (Renpenning &
Taylor, 2003) and are also available in the
Mason Chesney Archives of the Johns
Hopkins Medical Institutions for the Orem
Collection (www.medicalarchives.jhmi.edu/
papers/orem.html) and in the archives of the
IOS website. Audios and videos of the theo-
rist’s lectures are available through the Helene
Fuld Health Trust (1988) and the National
League for Nursing (1987). Self-Care Science,
Nursing Theory, and Evidence-based Practice
(Taylor & Renpenning, 2011) is the most
recent theory development and practice publi-
cation. Orem’s 50-year influence on nursing
science and practice is also summarized in
recent works by Clarke, Allison, Berbiglia, and
Taylor (2009) and by Taylor (2011).1
106 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
1For additional information please see the bonus chapter
content available at http://davisplus.fadavis.com
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 106
Overview of the Theory
As noted earlier, Orem’s general theory of
nursing is correctly referred to as self-care
deficit nursing theory. Orem believed a general
model or theory created for a practical science
such as nursing encompasses not only the
What and Why, but also the Who and How
(Orem, 2006). This action theory therefore in-
cludes clear specifications for nurse and patient
roles. The grand theory originally comprised
three interrelated theories: the theory of self-
care, the theory of self-care deficit, and the
theory of nursing systems. A fourth, the theory
of dependent care, emerged over time to ad-
dress the complexity not only of the individual
in need of care but also of the caregivers whose
requisites and capabilities influence the design
of the nursing system (Taylor & Renpenning,
2011). The building blocks of these theories
are six major concepts, with parallel concepts
from the theory of dependent care, and one
peripheral concept. The following is a brief
overview of each theory and concept. Readers
are encouraged to study relevant sections in
Orem’s Concepts of Practice (2001) or other
citations to enhance understanding.
Foundational to learning any theory is explo-
ration of its underlying assumptions, the key to
conceptual understanding. Many principles
emerged from Orem’s independent work as well
as from discussions within the Nursing Develop-
ment Conference Group and the Nursing Study
Group. Five general assumptions/principles
about humans provided guidance to Orem’s
conceptualizations (Orem, 2001, p. 140). When
thinking about humans within the context of the
theory, Orem viewed two types: those who need
nursing care and those who produce it (Orem,
2006). In the simplest terms, this is the patient
and the nurse, respectively. These assumptions
also reveal human powers and properties neces-
sary for self-care. Consistent with most Orem
writings, the term patient is used to refer to the
recipient of care.
Four Constituent Theories Within
Self-Care Deficit Nursing Theory
Each theory includes a central idea, presuppo-
sitions, and propositions. The central idea
presents the general focus of the theory, the
presuppositions are assumptions specific to this
theory, and the propositions are statements
about the concepts and their interrelationships.
The propositions have changed over time with
SCDNT refinement. These occurred in part
through theory testing that validated or inval-
idated hypotheses generated from the relation-
ships. As Orem used terminology at various
levels of abstraction within constituent theo-
ries, the reader is advised to thoroughly study
SCDNT concepts, including the synonyms.
For example, agency is also called capability,
ability and/or power.
1. Theory of Self-Care (TSC)
The central idea describes self-care in contrast
to other forms of care. Self-care, or care for
oneself, must be learned and be deliberately
performed for life, human functioning, and
well-being. Six presuppositions articulate
Orem’s notions about necessary resources, ca-
pabilities for learning, and motivation for self-
care. However, there are situational variations
that affect self-care such as culture.
Orem (2001) expanded two sets of propo-
sitions from previous writings. She introduced
requirements necessary for life, health, and
well-being and explained the complexity of a
self-care system. A person performing self-care
must first estimate or investigate what can and
should be done. This is a complex action of
knowing and seeking information on specific
care measures. The self-care sequence contin-
ues by deciding what can be done and finally pro-
ducing the care (see Orem, 2001, pp. 143–145).
2. Theory of Dependent Care
Taylor and others (2001) formalized the the-
ory of dependent care as a corollary theory to
the theory of self-care. Concepts within the
theory of dependent care (TDC) parallel those
in the theory of self-care. Assumptions relate
to the nature of interpersonal action systems
and social dependency. Within a particular so-
cial unit such as a family, the self-care agent
(the patient) is in a socially dependent rela-
tionship with the person or persons providing
care, such as a parent (the dependent-care
agent). The presence of a self-care deficit of
CHAPTER 8 • Dorothea Orem’s Self-Care Deficit Nursing Theory 107
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 107
the dependent also gives rise to the need for
nursing (Taylor & Renpenning, 2011; Taylor,
Renpenning, Geden, Neuman, & Hart, 2001).
3. Theory of Self-Care Deficit
The central idea describes why people need nurs-
ing (Orem, 2001, pp. 146–147). Requirements
for nursing are health-related limitations for
knowing, deciding, and producing care to self.
Orem presents two sets of presuppositions that
articulate this theory with the theory of self-
care and what she calls the idea of social de-
pendency. To engage in self-care, persons must
have values and capabilities to learn (to know),
to decide, and to manage self (to produce and
regulate care). The second set presents the con-
text of nursing as a health service when people
are in a state of social dependency.
The theory of self-care deficit (TSCD) in-
cludes nine propositions called principles or
guides for future development and theory test-
ing. These statements are essential ideas of the
larger, SCDNT. Orem describes the situations
that affect legitimate nursing. Nursing is legit-
imate or needed when the individual’s self-care
capabilities and care demands are equal to, less
than, or more than at a point in time. With the
existence of this inequity, a self-care deficit ex-
ists, and nursing is needed. In a dependent-
care system, a self-care deficit exists in the
patient as well as a dependent-care deficit in a
caregiver. The latter is an inequity between the
dependent-care demand and agency (abilities)
to care for the person in need of health care.
Legitimate nursing also occurs when a future
deficit relationship is predicted such as an up-
coming surgery.
4. Theory of Nursing Systems
The fourth theory, the theory of nursing sys-
tems (TNS), encompasses the three others.
The central focus is the product of nursing,
establishing both structure and content for
nursing practice as well as the nursing role (see
Orem, 2001, pp. 111, 147–149). The four pre-
suppositions direct the nurse to major com-
plexities of nursing practice. For example,
Orem stated that “Nursing has results-achieving
operations that must be articulated with the in-
terpersonal and societal features of nursing”
(Orem, 2001, p. 147). Although much of the
theory relates to diagnosis, actions, and out-
comes based on a deficit relationship between
self-care capabilities and self-care demand,
Orem also presents theoretical work related to
the interpersonal relationship between nurse
and person(s) receiving nursing and a social
contract between the nurse and patient(s)
(Orem, 2001, pp. 314–317). These compo-
nents are often overlooked when studying the
SCDNT and are important antecedents and
concurrent actions in the process of nursing.
The theory of nursing systems includes
seven propositions related to most SCDNT
concepts but adds nursing agency (capabilities
of the nurse) and nursing systems (complex ac-
tions). Nursing agency and nursing systems are
linked to the concepts of the person receiving
care or dependent care, such as self-care capa-
bilities (agency), self-care demands (therapeu-
tic self-care demand), and limitations (deficits)
for self-care. Through this, the general theory
or SCDNT becomes concrete to the practicing
nurse. Although the language is implicit,
Orem proposes that nursing systems are deter-
mined by the person’s (or dependent-care
agent’s) self-care limitations (capabilities in
relationship to health-related self-care or
dependent-care demand). Nursing systems
therefore vary by the amount of care the nurse
must provide, such as a total care system, or
wholly compensatory system (e.g., unconscious
critical care patient); partial care, or partially
compensatory system (e.g., patient in rehabil-
itation); or supportive-educative system (e.g.,
patient needing teaching).
Theoretical development by Orem scholars
and others continues as nursing practice
evolves. The addition of the theory of depend-
ent care is a major example and extends basic
concepts, such as adding “dependent-care sys-
tem” (Taylor & Renpenning, 2011). Other
concepts such as self-care and self-care requi-
sites, their processes and core operations, con-
tinue to be explicated (Denyes, Orem & Bekel,
2001). Some researchers or theorists develop
the subconcepts of basic concepts such as self-
care agency through exploration of congruent
theories. For example, Pickens (2012) proposed
exploration of motivation, a foundational
108 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 108
capability and power component of self-care
agency, through examination of several theories
including self-determination theory (Ryan,
Patrick, Deci, & Williams, 2008). Others cre-
ate new concepts, such as spiritual self-care
(White, Peters, & Schim, 2011) or extend gen-
eral concepts such as environment (Banfield,
2011).
Concepts
SCDNT is constructed from six basic con-
cepts and a peripheral concept. Four concepts
are patient related: self-care/dependent care,
self-care agency/dependent-care agency, ther-
apeutic self-care demand/dependent-care de-
mand, and self-care deficit/dependent-care
deficit. Two concepts relate to the nurse:
nursing agency and nursing system. Basic
conditioning factors, the peripheral concept,
is related to both the self-care agent (person
receiving care)/dependent-care agent (family
member/friend providing care) and also to
the nurse (nurse agent). Orem defines agent
as the person who engages in a course of action
or has the power to do so (Orem, 2001,
p. 514). Hence there is a self-care agent, a
dependent-care agent, and a nurse agent.
The unit of service is a person(s), whether
that is the individual (self-care agent) or
another on whom the person is socially de-
pendent (dependent-care agent). Orem also
addresses multiperson situations and multi-
person units such as entire families, groups,
or communities.
Each concept is defined and presented with
levels of abstraction. Varied constructs within
each concept allow theoretical testing at the
level of middle-range theory or at the practice
application level whether with the individual
or multiperson situations. All constructs and
concepts build on decades of Orem’s inde-
pendent and collaborative work. A “kite-like”
model provides a visual guide for the six con-
cepts and their interrelationships (Fig. 8-1).
For a model of concepts and relationships of
dependent care, the reader is referred to Taylor
and Renpenning (2011, p. 112). For a model
of multiperson structure, the reader is referred
to Taylor and Renpenning (2001).
Basic Conditioning Factors
A peripheral concept, basic conditioning factors
(BCFs), is related to three major concepts. For
simplicity, only the patient component is pre-
sented rather than the parallel dependent-care
components. In general, basic conditioning fac-
tors relate to the patient concepts (self-care
agency and therapeutic self-care demand) and
CHAPTER 8 • Dorothea Orem’s Self-Care Deficit Nursing Theory 109
Self-care
Self-care
demands
Conditioning
factors
Conditioning
factors
Conditioning
factors
Self-care
agency
Deficit
Nursing
agency
RR
R
R
R
Fig 8 • 1 Structure of SCDNT.
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 109
one nurse concept (nursing agency). These
conditioning factors are values that affect the
constructs: age, gender, developmental state,
health state, sociocultural orientation, health-
care system factors, family system factors, pat-
tern of living, environmental factors, and
resource availability and adequacy (Orem, 2001,
p. 245). For example, the family system factor
such as living alone or with others may affect
the person’s ability (self-care agency) to care
for self after hospital discharge. The self-care
demand (care requirements) of a person taking
insulin for type 2 diabetes will vary based
on availability of resources and health system
services (e.g., access to medications and care
services). These same BCFs apply to nursing
agency, such as health state. A nurse with recent
back surgery may have limitations in nursing
capabilities (nurse agency) in relationship to
specific care demands of the patient.
These BCF categories have many subfactors
that have not been explicitly defined and con-
tinue in development. For example, sociocul-
tural orientation refers to culture with its
various components such as values and prac-
tices. Sociocultural includes economic condi-
tions as well as others. The BCFs related to
nursing agency include those such as age but
expand to include nursing experience and ed-
ucation. A clinical specialist in diabetes usually
has more capabilities in caring for the self-care
agent with type 2 diabetes than one without
such credentials. All these affect the parame-
ters of the nurse’s capability to provide care.
Self-Care (Dependent Care)
Orem (2001) defined self-care as the practice of
activities that individuals initiate and perform on
their own behalf in maintaining life, health, and
well-being (p. 43). Self-care is purposeful ac-
tion performed in sequence and with a pattern.
Although engagement in purposeful self-care
may not improve health or well-being, a posi-
tive outcome is assumed. Dependent care is
performed by mature, responsible persons on
behalf of socially dependent individuals or self-
care agents such as an infant, child, or cognitively
impaired person. The purpose is to meet the
person’s health-related demands (dependent-
care demand) and/or to develop their self-care
capabilities (self-care agency; Taylor et al.,
2001; Taylor & Renpenning, 2011).
Although the practice of maintaining life is
self-explanatory, Orem (2001) viewed outcomes
of health and well-being as related but different.
Health is a state of physical–psychological,
structural–functional soundness and wholeness.
In contrast, well-being is conceived as experi-
ences of contentment, pleasure, and kinds of happi-
ness; by spiritual experiences; by movement toward
fulfilment of one’s self-ideal; and by continuing
personalization (Orem, 2001, p. 186). Self-care
performed deliberately for well-being versus
structural–functional health was conceptualized
and developed as health promotion self-care by
Hartweg (1990, 1993) and Hartweg and
Berbiglia (1996). Exploration of the relation-
ship between self-care and well-being was later
conducted by Matchim, Armer, and Stewart
(2008).
Key to understanding self-care and depend-
ent care is the concept of deliberate action, a
voluntary behavior to achieve a goal. Deliberate
action is preceded by investigating and deciding
what choice to make (Orem, 2001). In practice,
the nurse’s understanding of each of these
phases of investigating, deciding, and produc-
ing self-care is essential for positive health
outcomes. Take two situations: A pregnant
woman avoids alcohol for her fetus’s health
and a woman with breast cancer requires
chemotherapy for life and health. Each woman
must first know and understand the relation-
ship of self-care to life, health, and well-being.
Decision making follows, such as deciding to
avoid alcohol or choosing to engage in
chemotherapy. Finally, the individual must
take action, such as not drinking when offered
alcohol or accepting chemotherapy treatment.
Without each phase, self-care does not occur.
The pregnant woman may know the dangers to
her fetus and decide not to drink but engage in
drinking when pressured to do so. The woman
with cancer may understand the health out-
come without treatment, decide to have
treatment, then not follow through because
transportation to chemotherapy sessions dis-
rupts her husband’s employment. Because each
phase of the action sequence has many compo-
nents, nurses often provide partial support to
110 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 110
patients and self-care action does not occur. If
skills related to the operation to avoid alcohol
when pressured or the operations necessary for
transportation to a cancer center are not antic-
ipated by the nurse for these patients, the self-
care action sequences may not be completed.
Then outcomes related to life, health, and well-
being are affected.
Self-Care Agency (Dependent
Care Agency)
Orem (2001) defined self-care agency (SCA)
as complex acquired capability to meet one’s con-
tinuing requirements for care of self that regulates
life processes, maintains or promotes integrity of
human structure and functioning [health] and
human development, and promotes well-being
(p. 254). Capability, ability, and power are all
terms used to express agency. Self-care agency
is therefore the mature or maturing individ-
ual’s capability for deliberate action to care for
self. Dependent care agency is a complex ac-
quired ability of mature or maturing persons to
know and meet some or all of the self-care requi-
sites of persons who have health-derived or health
associated limitations of self-care agency, which
places them in socially dependent relationships for
care (Taylor & Renpenning, 2011, p. 108).
Viewed as the summation of all human capabil-
ities needed for performing self-care, these range
from a very basic ability, such as memory, to
capability for a specific action in a sequence to
meet a specific self-care demand or require-
ment. At this concrete level, the capabilities of
knowing, deciding, and acting or producing
self-care are necessary. If these capabilities do
not exist, then the abilities of others are nec-
essary, such as the family member or the nurse.
A three-part, hierarchical model of self-care
agency provides a visualization of this structure
(Fig. 8-2). Understanding these elements is
necessary to determine the self-care agent role,
dependent-care agent role, and the nurse role.
Foundational Capabilities
and Dispositions
Foundational capabilities and dispositions are
at the most basic level (Orem, 2001, pp. 262–
263). These are capabilities for all types of
deliberate action, not just self-care. Included
are abilities related to perception, memory,
and orientation. One example is the deliberate
act of repairing a car. One must have perception
of the concept of the car and its parts, memory
of methods of repair, and orientation of self to
the equipment and vehicle. If these founda-
tional abilities are not present, then actions
cannot occur.
Power Components
At the midlevel of the hierarchy are the power
components, or 10 powers or types of abilities
necessary for self-care. Examples are the valu-
ing of health, ability to acquire knowledge
about self-care resources, and physical energy
for self-care. At a very general level, these ca-
pabilities relate to knowledge, motivation, and
skills to produce self-care. If a mature person
becomes comatose, the abilities to maintain at-
tention, to reason, to make decisions, to phys-
ically carry out the actions are not functioning.
The self-care actions necessary for life, health,
and well-being must then be performed by the
dependent-care agent or the nurse agent.
Capabilities for Estimative,
Transitional, and Productive
Operations
The most concrete level of self-care agency is
one specific to the individual’s detailed com-
ponents of self-care demand or requirements.
Capabilities related to estimative operations
are those necessary to determine what self-care
CHAPTER 8 • Dorothea Orem’s Self-Care Deficit Nursing Theory 111
Capabilities
for self-care
operations
Power components
(enabling capabilities
for self-care)
Foundational capabilities
and disposition
Fig 8 • 2 Structure of self-care agency.
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 111
actions are needed in a specific nursing situa-
tion at one point in time—in other words, ca-
pabilities of investigating and estimating what
needs to be done. This includes capabilities of
learning in situations related to health and
well-being. For example, does the person
newly diagnosed with asthma have the capa-
bility to learn about regular exercise activities
and rescue medication? Does the person know
how to obtain the necessary resources? Tran-
sitional operations relate to abilities necessary
for decision making, such as reflecting on the
course of action and making an appropriate
decision. The patient may have the capabilities
to learn and obtain resources but not the ability
to make the decision. The asthma patient has
the capability to learn about exercise and med-
ication but not the capability to make the
decision to follow through on directions.
Capabilities for productive operations are
those necessary for preparing the self for the
action, carrying out the action, monitoring the
effects, and evaluating the action’s effective-
ness. If the person decides to use the inhaler,
does the person have the ability to take time to
engage in the necessary self-care, to physically
push the device, to monitor the changes, and
determine the effectiveness of the action? Just
as the action sequence is important in the self-
care concept, these types of capabilities reveal
the complexity of human capability.
At the concrete practice level, self-care
agency also varies by development and oper-
ability. For example, the nurse must determine
whether capabilities for learning are fully de-
veloped at the level necessary to understand
and retain information about the required ac-
tions. For example, a mature adult with late
stage Alzheimer’s disease is not able to retain
new information. The self-care agency is there-
fore developed but declining, creating the possi-
ble need for dependent-care agency or nursing
agency. A second determination is the oper-
ability of agency. Is agency not operative, par-
tially operative, or fully operative? A comatose
patient may have fully developed capabilities
before a motor vehicle accident, but the trauma
results in inoperable cognitive functioning.
SCA is therefore developed, but not operative at
that moment in time. In this situation, the
nurse agent must provide care. Similar varia-
tions of development and operability occur
with dependent-care agency and must be con-
sidered by the nurse when developing the self-
care or dependent-care system.
Therapeutic Self-Care Demand
(Dependent-Care Demand)
Therapeutic self-care demand (TSCD) is a
complex theoretical concept that summarizes
all actions that should be performed over time
for life, health, and well-being. When first de-
veloped, the concept was referred to as action
demand or self-care demand (Orem, 2001).
Readers will therefore see these terms used in
Orem’s writings and in the literature. Dependent
care demand is the summation of all care actions
for meeting the dependent caregiver’s therapeutic
self-care demand when his or her agency is not ade-
quate or operational (Taylor & Renpenning,
2011, p. 108).
The word therapeutic is essential to one’s un-
derstanding of the concept. Consideration is
always on a therapeutic outcome of life, health,
and well-being. A Haitian mother in a remote
village may expect to apply horse or cow dung
to the severed umbilical cord to facilitate dry-
ing, a culturally adjusted self-care measure for
a newborn. With horse/cow dung as the major
carrier of Clostridium tetanus, this dependent-
care action may lead to disease and infant
death, not a therapeutic outcome.
Constructing or calculating a TSCD re-
quires extensive nursing knowledge of evi-
denced-based practice, communication, and
interpersonal skills. Both scientific nursing
knowledge and knowledge of the person and
environment are merged to formulate what
needs to be done in a particular nursing situation
(NDCG, 1979). The process of calculating the
TSCD includes adjusting values by the basic
conditioning factors. For example, a mental
health patient will have different needs based
on the type of mental health condition (health
state), family system factors, and health-care
resources.
Self-Care Requisites
To provide the framework for determining the
TSCD, Orem developed three types of self-care
112 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 112
requisites (or requirements): universal, develop-
mental, and health deviation. These are the pur-
poses or goals for which actions are performed for
life, health, and well-being. The individual
sleeps once each day and engages in daily activ-
ities to meet the requisite or goal of maintaining
a balance of activity and rest. Without rest, a
human cannot survive. Therefore, these are gen-
eral statements within a three-part framework
that provide a level of abstraction similar to the
power components of self-care agency. Denyes
et al. (2001) explicated the self-care requisite to
maintain an adequate intake of water. Their work
demonstrates the complexity of actions neces-
sary to meet a basic human need. Without con-
sideration of this complexity, analysis and
diagnosis of patient requirements is not com-
plete. This scholarly contribution by Denyes and
others (2001) can serve as a model for structur-
ing information regarding all other requisites
(personal communication, Dr. Susan G. Taylor,
March 12, 2013).
Universal Self-Care Requisites
The eight universal self-care requisites (USCR)
are necessary for all human beings of all ages
and in all conditions, such as air, food, activity
and rest, solitude, and social interaction. The
BCFs influence the quality and quantity of the
action necessary to achieve the purpose. Ac-
tions to be performed over time that meet the
requisite, prevention of hazards to human life,
human functioning, and human well-being (the
purpose), will vary for an infant (e.g., keeping
crib rails up) versus an adult (e.g., ambulation
safety). Some requisites are very general yet
provide important concepts necessary for all
humans. One example is the concept of nor-
malcy, the eighth USCR. The goal is promotion
of human functioning and development within
social groups in accord with human potential,
human limitations, and the human desire to be
normal (Orem, 2001, p. 225). Practice exam-
ples in the literature have emerged, such as the
importance of normalcy to individuals with
learning disabilities (Horan, 2004). These two
requisites, prevention of hazards and promo-
tion of normalcy, also relate to the other six
USCRs. For example, when maintaining a
sufficient intake of food, one must consider
hazards to ingestion of food such as avoiding
pesticides.
Developmental Self-Care Requisites
Orem (2001) identified three types of devel-
opmental self-care requisites (DSCRs). The
first refers to actions necessary for general
human developmental processes throughout
the life span. These requisites are often met by
dependent-care agents when caring for devel-
oping infants and children or when disaster and
serious physical or mental illness affects adults.
Engagement in self-development, the second
DSCR, refers to demands for action by indi-
viduals in positive roles and in positive mental
health. Examples include self-reflection,
goal-setting, and responsibility in one’s roles.
The third DSCR, interferences with develop-
ment, expresses goals achieved by actions that
are necessary in situational crises such as loss
of friends and relatives, loss of job, or terminal
illness. Originally subsumed under USCRs,
Orem created the developmental self-care
requisite category to indicate the importance
of human development to life, health, and
well-being.
Health Deviation Self-Care Requisites
Health deviation self-care requisites (HDSCR)
are situation-specific requisites or goals when
people have disease, injuries, or are under pro-
fessional medical care. These six requisites
guide actions when pathology exists or when
medical interventions are prescribed. The first
HDSCR refers in part to a patient purpose: to
seek and secure appropriate medical assistance for
genetic, physiological, or psychological conditions
known to produce or be associated with human
pathology (Orem, 2001, p. 235). For a person
with history of breast cancer, seeking regular
diagnostic tests is a goal to preserve life, health,
and well-being. A teenager in treatment for se-
vere acne takes action to meet HDSCR 5: to
modify the self-concept (and self-image) in ac-
cepting oneself as being in a particular state of
health and in need of a specific form of health care
(Orem, p. 235).
Each TSCD, through the three types of
self-care requisites, is individualized and ad-
justed by the basic conditioning factors (BCFs)
CHAPTER 8 • Dorothea Orem’s Self-Care Deficit Nursing Theory 113
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 113
such as age, health state, and sociocultural ori-
entation. Once adjusted to the specific patient
in a unique situation, the purposes are specific
for the patient or type of patient. These are
called “particularized self-care requisites.”
Dennis and Jesek-Hale (2003) proposed a list
of particularized self-care requisites for a nurs-
ing population of newborns. Although created
for nursery newborns, a group particularized
by age, the individual patient adjustments are
then made. For example, a newborn’s sucking
needs may vary, necessitating variation in feed-
ing methods. More recent nursing literature
continues to expand the types of requisites var-
ied by specific diseases or illnesses that provide
a basis for application to specific patients and
caregivers.
Self-Care Deficit (Dependent-Care
Deficit)
As a theoretical concept, self-care deficit ex-
presses the value of the relationship between
two other concepts: self-care agency and ther-
apeutic self-care demand (Orem, 2001). When
the person’s self-care agency is not adequate to
meet all self-care requisites (TSCD), a self-
care deficit exists. This qualitative and quanti-
tative relationship at the conceptual level of
abstraction is expressed as “equal to,” “more
than,” or “less than” (see Fig. 8-1). A deficit
relationship is also described as complete or
partial; a complete deficit suggests no capabil-
ity to engage in self-care or dependent care.
An example of a complete deficit may exist in
a premature infant in a neonatal intensive care
unit. A partial self-care deficit may exist in a
patient recovering from a routine bowel resec-
tion 1 day after surgery. This person is able to
provide some self-care.
Understanding self-care deficit is necessary
to appreciate Orem’s concept of legitimate nurs-
ing. If a nurse determines a patient has self-care
agency (estimative, transitional, and productive
capabilities) to carry out a sequence of actions
to meet the self-care requisites, then nursing is
not necessary. A self-care deficit or anticipated
self-care deficit must exist before a nursing sys-
tem is designed and implemented. The nurse
reflects with the patient: Is self-care agency
(and/or dependent-care agency) adequate to
meet the therapeutic self-care demand? If ade-
quate, there is no need for nursing.
A dependent-care deficit is a statement of
the relationship between the dependent-care
demand and the powers and capabilities of the
dependent-care agent to meet the self-care
deficit of the socially dependent person, the
self-care agent (Taylor & Renpenning, 2011).
When this deficit occurs, then a need for nurs-
ing exists. When a parent has the capabilities
to meet all health-related self-care requisites
of an ill child, then no nursing is needed.
When an existing or potential self-care deficit
is identified and legitimate nursing is needed, an
analysis by the nurse/patient/dependent-care
agents results in identification of types of limi-
tations in relationship to the particularized self-
care requisites. These are generally described as
limitations of knowing, limitations or restric-
tions of decision-making, and limitations in
ability to engage in result-achieving courses of
action. Orem classified these into sets of limi-
tations (Orem, 2001, pp. 279–282).
Nursing System (Dependent-Care
System)
Orem describes a nursing system as an “action
system,” an action or a sequence of actions per-
formed for a purpose. This is a composite of all
the nurse’s concrete actions completed or to be
completed for or with a self-care agent to pro-
mote life, health, and well-being. The compos-
ite of actions and their sequence produced by
the dependent-care agent to meet the thera-
peutic dependent self-care demand is termed
a dependent-care system (Taylor et al., 2001).
These actions relate to three types of subsys-
tems: interpersonal, social/contractual, and
professional-technological.
The interpersonal subsystem includes all
necessary actions or operations such as enter-
ing into and maintaining effective relation-
ships with the patient and/or family or others
involved in care. The social/contractual subsys-
tem relates to all nursing actions/operations to
reach agreements with the patient and others
related to information necessary to determine
the therapeutic self-care demand and self-care
agency of an individual and caregivers. Within
this subsystem, the nurse, in collaboration with
114 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 114
the patient or dependent-caregiver, determines
roles for all care participants (Orem, 2001).
These are based on social norms and other
variables such as basic conditioning factors.
Although other nursing theories emphasize in-
terpersonal interactions, Orem’s general theory
clearly specifies details of interpersonal and
contractual operations as necessary antecedents
and concurrent components of care. This ele-
ment of Orem’s model is often overlooked and
clarifies the decision-making process and col-
laborative relationship within the nurse–
patient–family/multiperson roles.
The professional–technological subsystem
comprises actions/operations that are diagnostic,
prescriptive, regulatory, evaluative, and case
management. The latter involves placing all
operations within a system that uses resources
effectively and efficiently with a positive pa-
tient outcome. Orem views the professional–
technological subsystem as the process of
nursing, a nonlinear one that integrates all
operations of this subsystem with those of the
interpersonal and the social–contractual. This
involves collecting data to determine existing
and projected universal, developmental, and
health-deviation self-care requisites, and meth-
ods to meet these requisites as adjusted by the
basic conditioning factors. Using the interper-
sonal and social–contractual subsystems, the
nurse incorporates modifications of her or his
diagnosis and prescriptions in collaboration with
the patient and family on what is possible. The
nurse also identifies the patient’s usual self-care
practices and assesses the person’s estimative,
transitional, and productive capabilities for
knowledge, skills, and motivation in relationship
to the known self-care requisites. That is, are the
capabilities (self-care agency/dependent-care
agency) needed to meet the self-care requisites
developed, operable, and adequate? Are there
limitations in knowing, deciding, or producing
self-care? If no limitations exist, then there is no
need for nursing and no nursing system is devel-
oped. If there is a self-care deficit or dependent-
care deficit, then the nurse and patient or
caregivers reach agreement about the patient’s
role, the family’s role, and/or the nurse’s role.
Orem (2001) charted the progression of these
steps by subsystems (pp. 311, 314–317).
With determination of a real or potential
self-care deficit or dependent-care deficit, the
nurse develops one of three types of nursing
systems: wholly compensatory, partly compen-
satory, or supportive-educative (developmen-
tal). The nurse then continues the query: Who
can or should perform actions that require move-
ment in space and controlled manipulation?
(Orem, 2001, p. 350). If the answer is only the
nurse, then a wholly compensatory system is
designed. If the patient has some capabilities
to perform operations or actions, then the
nurse and patient share responsibilities. If the
patient can perform all actions that control
movement in space and controlled manipula-
tion, but nurse actions are required for support
(physical or psychological), then the system is
supportive–educative. Note, in all systems, the
self-care deficit is the necessary element that
leads to the design of a nursing system. Using
the interpersonal and social–contractual oper-
ations, the nurse first enters into an interper-
sonal relationship and an agreement to
determine a real or potential self-care deficit,
prescribe roles, and implement productive
operations of self-care and/or dependent
care. Regulation or treatment operations are
designed or planned and then produced or
performed. Control operations are used to
appraise and evaluate the effectiveness of
nursing actions and to determine whether
adjustments should be made. These ap-
praisals emphasize validity of operations or
actions in relationship to standards. Selecting
valid operations in the plan and in evaluation
incorporate evidence-based practices. These
processes, including diagnosis, prescription,
designing, planning, regulating, and control-
ling, can be viewed as elements of Orem’s
steps in the process of nursing (Fig. 8-3).
Orem’s language of the nursing process
varies from the standard language of assess-
ment, diagnosis, planning, implementation,
and evaluation. The interaction of the three
aforementioned subsystems creates a model for
true collaboration with the recipient of care or
the caregiver.
The three steps of Orem’s process of nurs-
ing are as follows: (1) diagnosis and prescrip-
tion, (2) design and plan, and (3) produce and
CHAPTER 8 • Dorothea Orem’s Self-Care Deficit Nursing Theory 115
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 115
control. For example, Orem considers the term
“assessment” too limiting. Within Orem’s
process, assessments are made throughout the
iterative social–contractual and professional-
technological operations. During the first step
of diagnosis, data are collected on the basic
conditioning factors and a determination is
made about their relationship to the self-care
requisites and to self-care agency. How does
health state (e.g., type 2 diabetes) affect the
individual’s universal, developmental, and
health-deviation self-care requirements? How
does the basic conditioning factor, or health
state, affect the individual’s self-care agency
(capabilities)? What, if any, are limitations
for deliberate action related to the estimative
(investigative–knowing), transitional (decision
making), and productive (performing) phases
of self-care? (Orem, 2001, p. 312). The nurse
collects information, analyses it, and makes
judgments about the information within the
limits of nursing agency (capabilities of the
nurse, such as expertise).
Orem describes nursing as a specialized
helping service and identifies five helping
methods to overcome self-care limitations or
regulate functioning and development of pa-
tients or their dependents. Nurses employ one
or more of these methods throughout the
process of nursing, including acting for or
doing for another, guiding another, supporting
another, providing for a developmental envi-
ronment, and teaching another (Orem, 2001,
pp. 56–60). Acting for or doing for another in-
cludes physical assistance such as positioning
the patient. Assuming self-care agency that is
developed and operable, the nurse replaces this
method with others that focus on cognitive de-
velopment, such as guiding and teaching.
These methods are not unique to nursing, but
are used by most health professionals. Through
their unique role functions, nurses perform a
specific sequence of actions in relationship to
the identified patient and/or dependent-care
agent’s self-care limitations in combination
with other health professionals to meet the
self-care requirements.
Although comparisons are made between
these steps and those of the general nursing
process, Orem’s complexity is unique in ad-
dressing an integration of interpersonal, social–
contractual, and professional–technological
subsystems. The intricacy of her steps is also ev-
ident in the complexity of the diagnostic and
prescriptive components. The practice exemplar
in this chapter provides one simplified example
of this process.
Nursing Agency
Nursing agency is the power or ability to nurse.
The agency or capabilities are necessary to know
and meet patients’ therapeutic self-care demands
and to protect and to regulate the exercise of devel-
opment of patient’s self-care agency (Orem, 2001,
116 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Accomplishes patient’s
therapeutic self-care
Accomplishes self-care
Regulates the exercise
and development of
self-care agency
Compensates for patient’s
inability to engage in
self-care
Nurse
action
Patient
action
Patient
action
Nurse
action
Nurse
action
Supports and protects
patient
Performs some self-care
measures for patient
Compensates for self-care
limitations of patient
Assists patient as required
Performs some self-care
measures
Regulated self-care
agency
Accepts care and
assistance from nurse
Wholly compensatory system
Partly compensatory system
Supportive-educative system
Fig 8 • 3 Basic nursing system.
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 116
p. 290). Nursing agency is analogous to self-
care agency but with capabilities performed on
behalf of “legitimate patients.” Similar to self-
care agency, nursing agency is affected by basic
conditioning factors. The nurse’s family system,
as well as nursing education and experience,
may affect his or her ability to nurse.
Orem categorizes nursing capabilities
(agency) as interpersonal, social–contractual,
and professional-technological. That is, the
nurse must have capabilities within each of the
subsystems described in the nursing system.
Capabilities that result in desirable interper-
sonal nurse characteristics include effective
communication skills and ability to form rela-
tionships with patients and significant others.
Social–contractual characteristics require
the ability to apply knowledge of variations in
patients to nursing situations and to form con-
tracts with patients and others for clear
role boundaries. Desirable professional–
technologic characteristics require the ability
to perform techniques related to the process of
nursing: diagnosis of therapeutic self-care de-
mand of an assigned patient with considera-
tion of all self-care requisites (universal,
developmental, and health deviation) and a
concomitant diagnosis of a patient’s self-care
agency. Other desired nurse characteristics in-
clude the ability to prescribe roles: Assuming
a self-care deficit (and therefore a legitimate
patient), what are the roles and related respon-
sibilities of the nurse, the patient, the aide, and
the family? Nurses must also have the ability
to know and apply care measures such as gen-
eral helping techniques (teaching, guiding) and
specialized interventions and technologies
such as those identified with evidence-based
practice. These necessary nursing capabilities
also have implications for nursing education
and nursing administration. Knowledge of all
components of nursing agency will direct nurs-
ing curricula for successful development of
nursing abilities. Likewise, knowledge related
to nursing administration is critical to oper-
ability of nursing agency (Banfield, 2011).
Multiperson Situations and Units
Taylor and Renpenning (2001) extended ap-
plication of Orem’s concepts to families,
groups, and communities, where the recipient
of nursing care is more than a single individual
with a self-care deficit. They distinguished
among types of multiperson units, such as
community groups and family or residential
group units. These authors present categories
of multiperson care systems, create family and
community as basic conditioning factors, and
present a model of community as aggregate.
This model appropriately incorporates addi-
tional basic conditioning factors such as public
policy, health-care system changes, and com-
munity development. Other frameworks such
as a community participation model have been
developed (Isaramalai, 2002).
Community groups have a selected number
of common self-care requisites and/or limita-
tions of knowledge, decision making, and pro-
ducing care. These can be based on requirements
of entire communities, groups within the com-
munities, or to other situations when groups
have common needs. For example, the focus of
a student health nurse at a university may be a
group of first-year students and the self-care req-
uisite, prevention of the hazards of alcohol poi-
soning. The self-care limitations of the group
may be knowledge of binge drinking outcomes
and the skills to resist peer pressure at parties.
This environment and situation, the college mi-
lieu and new independence, creates the common
set of self-care requisites. The action system de-
signed by the college health nurse is to develop
the knowledge, decision-making, and result-
producing skills of new students collectively so
life, health, and well-being are enhanced for the
group, as well as the college community.
Family or others in a communal living
arrangement are another type of multiperson
unit of service. Because of the interrelationship
of the individuals in the living unit, the purpose
of nursing varies from that for a community
group. In this situation, the focus is often an
individual, as well as the family as a unit. The
health-related requirements of one individual
trigger the need for nursing but also affect the
unit as a whole. In one situation, an elderly par-
ent moves into the family home. Not only is
the therapeutic self-care demand of the parent
involved, but also the needs of family members
as it affects their self-care requisites. The health
CHAPTER 8 • Dorothea Orem’s Self-Care Deficit Nursing Theory 117
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 117
of the unit is therefore established and main-
tained by meeting the therapeutic self-care de-
mands of all members and facilitating the
development and exercise of self-care agency
for each group member (Taylor & Renpen-
ning, 2011).
Applications of the Theory
Nursing Education Applications
Many educational programs used Orem’s con-
ceptualizations to frame the curriculum and to
guide nursing practice (Hartweg, 2001; Ransom,
2008). Taylor and Hartweg (2002) found
Orem’s conceptualization was the most fre-
quently used nursing theory in U.S. programs.
Examples of Orem-based schools included
Morris Harvey College in Charleston, West
Virginia, Georgetown University, the University
of Missouri—Columbia, and Illinois Wesleyan
University (Taylor, 2007). Current application
of Orem’s theory in nursing education ranges
from application to pedagogy in a hybrid
RN-BSN course in the United States (Davidson,
2012) to use as a general framework for nursing
education in Germany (Hintze, 2011).
Research Applications
The use of SCDNT as a framework for re-
search continues to increase with application
to specific populations and conditions. Studies
range from those with general reference to
Orem’s theory to more sophisticated explo-
ration of concepts and their relationships.
Early Orem studies concentrated on theory
development and testing, including creation of
theory-derived research instruments (Gast et al.,
1989), a necessary process in theory building.
Examples of widely used concept-based instru-
ments include those by Denyes (1981, 1988)
on self-care practices and self-care agency. The
Appraisal of Self-care Agency (ASA scale) was
an early tool used in international research (van
Achterberg et al., 1991) and later modified for
specific populations (West & Isenberg, 1997).
More recent instruments derive from structural
components of SCDNT but are applicable in
more specific situations: Self-Care for Adults
on Dialysis Tool (Costantini, Beanlands, &
Horsburgh, 2011); Spanish Version of the
Child and Adolescent Self-Care Performance
Questionnaire (Jaimovich, Campos, Campos
& Moore, 2009); The Nutrition Self-Care
Inventory (Fleck, 2012); and Self-Care
Outcomes (Valente, Saunders, & Uman,
2011).
A few Orem scholars continue with devel-
opment of theoretical elements through well-
designed programs of research with specific
populations. For example, Armer et al. (2009)
studied select power components (elements
of self-care agency) to describe those important
in developing supportive-educative nursing
systems with postmastectomy breast cancer
patients. A secondary analysis of this study
contributed to identification of the types of
self-care limitations experienced by this popula-
tion. The results have potential to promote effec-
tive nursing interventions (Armer, Brooks, &
Steward, 2011). Research is needed on actions
and methods to meet health deviation self-care
requisites in a variety of specific health situations
(Casida, Peters, Peters, & Magnan, 2009).
Many studies use SCDNT as a framework
for research and reference select concepts but
with limited application (Lundberg & Thrakul,
2011). For example, Carthron and others
(2010) used Orem’s SCDNT to guide research
related to specific concepts such as therapeutic
self-care demand and self-care agency. How-
ever, a family system factor (the primary care
role of grand-mothering) on type 2 diabetes
self-management was the primary emphasis
within the study. Other studies combine ele-
ments from SCDNT with other theories with-
out consideration of the congruence of
underlying assumptions. For example, Single-
ton, Bienemy, Hutchinson, Dellinger, and
Rami (2011) framed their study in part within
Orem’s theory of self-care as well as in the
health belief model and the concept of self-
efficacy. This combination of concepts and
theories in research studies is common. Fur-
ther, Klainin and Ounnapiruk (2010) summa-
rized research findings from 20 studies of
Thai elderly guided by Orem’s SCDNT. Al-
though their analysis revealed two of six major
concepts and one peripheral concept were
evident in the research, many studies explored
other non–SCDNT-specific concepts such as
118 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 118
self-concept, self-efficacy, and locus of control.
The authors suggest that SCDNT should be
revisited to include additional concepts to
strengthen the theory.
Table 8-1 provides examples of domestic
and international theory development and
practice-related research conducted in the past
5 years at the time of this writing.
CHAPTER 8 • Dorothea Orem’s Self-Care Deficit Nursing Theory 119
Author (Year), Population/ SCDNT
Country Purpose Settings Concept(s) Methods Results
Table 8 • 1 Examples of Research Applications
Identified types
of self-care limi-
tations in rela-
tionship to sets
of limitations,
e.g., “know-
ing.” Most limi-
tations were not
related to lack
of knowledge
but to energy,
patterns of liv-
ing, etc. Em-
phasized the
“supportive”
element in this
nursing system.
Perspectives re-
vealed that SC
requires dia-
logues with the
body and envi-
ronment, power
struggles with
the disease,
and making
choices to fight
the disease. SC
was viewed as
a way of life.
SCA predicted
SC. Education,
employment,
and health sta-
tus facilitated
SC practices;
smoking and
chronic condi-
tions were
barriers.
Before and
after beginning
caregiving:
GMs were sta-
tistically differ-
ent with fewer
days of eating
Armer, Brooks, &
Steward (2011),
USA
Arvidsson,
Bergman,
Arvidsson,
Fridlund, & Tops
(2011), Sweden
Burdette (2012),
USA
Carthron,
Johnson, Hubbart,
Strickland, &
Nance (2010),
USA
To examine
patient per-
ceptions of
SC limitations
to meet TSCD
to reduce
lymphedema
To describe
the meaning
of health-
promoting
SC in pa-
tients with
rheumatic
diseases
To examine
relationship
among SCA,
SC, and
obesity
To compare
diabetes self-
management
activities of
primary care-
giving grand-
mothers (GM)
Breast cancer
survivors,
postsurgery
(N = 14)
Rheumatic
disease
patients
(N = 12)
Rural midlife
women
(N = 224)
African
American
GMs with
type 2
diabetes
(N = 68, 34
per group)
SCA,
especially
estimative,
transi-
tional, and
productive
phases of
self-care
necessary
to de-
crease
risk of lym-
phedema;
supportive-
educative
nursing
system
Health-
promoting
SC
BCFs,
SCA, and
SC prac-
tices; com-
plemented
with rural
nursing
theory
BCF (fam-
ily system
factor of
grand-
mother
role;
patterns of
Secondary
analysis of
qualitative
data from
pilot study
(Armer
et al.,
2009)
Phenome-
nology
Predictive
correla-
tional
design
was used.
Nonexper-
imental,
compara-
tive design
Continued
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 119
120 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
a healthy diet
and fewer per-
formed self-
management
blood glucose
tests. Fewer self-
management
blood glucose
tests and fewer
eye examina-
tions were per-
formed by GMs
providing pri-
mary care to
grandchildren.
Significant dif-
ference was
found between
self-care
agency and
quality of life in
treatment
group vs con-
trol group at
8 weeks after
prostatectomy.
Four themes
emerged on self-
management:
daily life prac-
tices (dietary, ex-
ercise, medicine,
doctor follow-up,
blood sugar
self-monitoring,
use of herbal
remedies), af-
fect of illness,
family support
and need for
everyday life
as before
diagnosis (e.g.,
maintaining
religious prac-
tices during
Ramadan).
For patients
with RA, pa-
tients with
higher disabil-
ity and pain
had lower self-
care agency.
The potential for
development of
Kim (2011),
Korea
Lundberg &
Thrakul (2011),
Sweden &
Thailand
Ovayolu,
Ovayolu, &
Karadag (2011),
Turkey
before and
after begin-
ning caregiv-
ing activities;
to compare
these GMs’
self-manage-
ment activi-
ties with
those of GMs
not providing
primary care
To determine
effectiveness
of a program
to develop
SCA based
on SC needs
specific to
prostatectomy
To explore
Thai Muslim
women’s self-
management
of type 2
diabetes
To explore re-
lationship
among SCA,
disability lev-
els, and other
factors
Prostate can-
cer patients
(N = 69)
Thai Muslim
women living
in Bangkok
(N = 29)
Turkish pa-
tients with
rheumatoid
arthritis (RA)
(N = 467)
living);
TSCD;
SCA,
especially
power
compo-
nents
SCA;
quality
of life
Orem’s
SCDNT
was used
as frame-
work
SCA;
Factors re-
lated to
health-
care, such
as pain
and dis-
ability
level.
Quasi-
experimen-
tal; non-
equivalent
control
group using
pre–post
test design
Ethno-
graphic
study using
participant
observation
Cross-
sectional;
descriptive–
correla-
tional
Table 8 • 1 Examples of Research Applications—cont’d
Author (Year), Population/ SCDNT
Country Purpose Settings Concept(s) Methods Results
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 120
CHAPTER 8 • Dorothea Orem’s Self-Care Deficit Nursing Theory 121
knowledge,
skills, and re-
sources neces-
sary for SC
were identified.
Patients in treat-
ment group
had higher
knowledge of
self-care de-
mands and self-
care ability
regarding med-
ication, dietary,
physical activity,
self-monitoring.
Both systolic
and diastolic
readings of
treatment group
were lower
than control
group.
Demonstrated
improvement in
health indica-
tors after design
of a nursing sys-
tem directed at
deficits in SCA
related to
HDSCR.
51% of patients
had the re-
quired hepatitis
B SC knowl-
edge, espe-
cially need for
exercise, rest,
and methods of
prevention of
transmission
through sexual
activity. There
was a knowl-
edge deficit re-
lated to diet and
management/
monitoring of
disease.
Level of educa-
tion, type of
occupation,
previous health
education, and
Rujiwatthanakorn,
Panpakdee,
Malathum, &
Tanomsup (2011),
Thailand
Surucu & Kizilci
(2012), Turkey
Thi (2012), South
Vietnam
To examine
effectiveness
of a SC man-
agement
program
To explore
the use of
SCDNT in di-
abetes self-
management
education
To describe
levels of SC
knowledge in
patients
Thais with
essential
hypertension
(N = 96)
Type 2 dia-
betes patients
Hepatitis B in-
patients and
outpatients
(N = 230)
SC de-
mands,
self-care
ability
and
blood
pressure
control
TSCD,
HDSCR,
SCA
SCA (SC
knowl-
edge),
SCR,
BCFs
Quasi-
experimen-
tal
Descriptive
case study
Descriptive/
compara-
tive
Table 8 • 1 Examples of Research Applications—cont’d
Author (Year), Population/ SCDNT
Country Purpose Settings Concept(s) Methods Results
Continued
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 121
122 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
health-care set-
ting affected
levels of SC
knowledge.
Knowledge
about radiation
side effect man-
agement var-
ied by literacy
level despite
low literacy
level of pam-
phlets. Sup-
ported premise
that founda-
tional capaci-
ties for self-care
include skills
for reading,
writing, com-
munication per-
ception and
reasoning.
Wilson,
Mood,
Nordstrom
(2012), USA
To determine
whether
reading low
literacy pam-
phlets on
radiation
side effects
affect patient
knowledge
Urban radia-
tion oncology
clinic pa-
tients,
(N = 47)
SCA: SC
knowledge
of radia-
tion side
effects
Nonexperi-
mental,
exploratory
Note. BCF = basic conditioning factors; HDSCR = health deviation self-care requisites; SC = self-care or self-care practices;
SCA = self-care agency; SCDNT = self-care deficit nursing theory; SCR = self-care requisites; TSCD = therapeutic self-care demand.
Practice Applications
Nursing practice has informed development
of SCDNT as SCDNT has guided nursing
practice and research. Biggs (2008) con-
ducted a review of nursing literature from
1999 to 2007. The results revealed more
than 400 articles, including those in Inter-
national Orem Society Newsletters and Self-
Care, Dependent-Care, and Nursing, the
official journal of the International Orem
Society. Although Biggs noted a tremendous
increase in publications during that period,
the author observed that SCDNT research
has not always contributed to theory progres-
sion and development or to nursing practice.
She identified deficient areas such as those
related to concepts such as therapeutic self-
care demand, self-care deficit, nursing sys-
tems, and the methods of helping or
assisting. Recent publications on Orem based
practice address areas identified by Biggs.
Table 8-2 provides examples of specific prac-
tice applications in the past 5 years at the
time of this writing.
One theoretical application to nursing prac-
tice exemplifies the continued scholarly work
necessary for practice models and addresses
one deficit area noted by Biggs (2008). Casida
and colleagues (2009) applied Orem’s general
theoretical framework to formulate and de-
velop the health-deviation self-care requisites
of patients with left ventricular assist devices.
This article specifies not only the self-care
requisites for this population but also the nec-
essary subsystems unique to practice applica-
tions. This work illustrates the complexity of
SCDNT and also the utility of SCDNT for
patients with all types of technology assisted
living.
One change in the past few years has been
an emphasis on self-management rather than or
in conjunction with self-care (Ryan, Aloe, &
Table 8 • 1 Examples of Research Applications—cont’d
Author (Year), Population/ SCDNT
Country Purpose Settings Concept(s) Methods Results
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 122
CHAPTER 8 • Dorothea Orem’s Self-Care Deficit Nursing Theory 123
Editorial
demonstrating
use of theoreti-
cal framework
to design a
brief checklist
An exemplar
for the six HD-
SCRs specific
health situation
and model for
developing
other condi-
tions using
multifaceted
technological
care
An example of
types of nurs-
ing systems
One hospital’s
goal to im-
prove quality
care and de-
crease length
of stay by mov-
ing to theory
based practice
An example of
application or
SCDNT to ar-
teriovenous
fistula SC
Alspach
(2011), USA
Casida,
Peters, Peters,
& Magnan
(2009), USA
Green
(2012), USA
Hohdorf
(2010),
Germany
Hudson &
Macdonald
(2010),
Canada
Hypertension/
heart failure
in elderly
Left-ventricular
assist devices
(LVAD)
Children with
special needs
Hospitalized
patients
Adults with
hemodialysis
arteriovenous
fistula self-
cannulation
Critical care
unit
Acute care
School setting
Acute care
settings
Community
dialysis unit
SC
HDSCR, in-
cluding SC
systems
SCR; SCD;
BCF; SCA;
DCA; SCS
SCDNT
SCDNT as
framework;
all concepts
including NA
Development
of checklist
tool to meas-
ure SC at
home after
critical care
discharge
Reformulation
of HDSCR
common to
patients with
LVAD using
five guidelines
described by
Orem (2001)
to validate
form and
adequacy
Demonstration
of utility of
SCDNT
through two
case studies:
wholly com-
pensatory sys-
tem for child
with cerebral
palsy; partly
compensatory
for child with
asthma; and
supportive-
educative sys-
tem for diabetic.
Exemplified
change of
focus to
theory-based
nursing
practice
Demonstration
of SCDNT as
guide to de-
velop and
update patient-
teaching re-
sources in
preparation for
home care; as-
sisted nurses
with role
clarification
Table 8 • 2 Examples of Practice Applications
Patient or Practice
Author (Year), Health or SCDNT Focus (Selected
Country Illness Focus Settings Concept(s) Examples) Other
Continued
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 123
124 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Theoretical
paper incorpo-
rating elements
of other theo-
ries to expand
supportive-
developmental
technologies in
patients with
serious mental
illness
Demonstrates
use of SCDNT
toward partner-
based relation-
ships for
recovery from
mental illness
This case study
provides an ex-
emplar for self-
management of
type 2 diabetes
SCDNT as
component of
health system
practice model
Pickens
(2012), USA
Seed &
Torkelson
(2012), USA
Surucu &
Kizilci,
(2012),
Turkey
Swanson &
Tidwell
(2011), USA
Wanchai,
Armer, &
Stewart
(2010), USA,
Canada,
Germany
Adults with
schizophrenia
Acute psychi-
atric care
Use of
SCDNT in
type 2 dia-
betes self-
management
education
Integration
model of
shared gover-
nance using
magnet com-
ponents to
promote pa-
tient safety
Breast cancer
survivors
Psychiatric
nursing care
Recovery
principles
University set-
ting; diabetes
education
center
Orem’s self-
care deficit
theory as
general prac-
tice frame-
work
Multiple
settings
based on
review of 11
studies from
1990
through
2009
SCA:
motivation
component
SCDNT con-
cepts in align-
ment with
recovery can
be used to
structure inter-
ventions and
research in
acute psychi-
atric settings
BCFs; SCA;
SCD; TSCD,
with empha-
sis on HDSCR
SCA; SCD;
helping
methods
SCA
Explored vari-
ous theories
of motivation
to develop
SCDNT’s
foundational
capability
and power
component of
motivation
SCDNT pro-
vided a com-
prehensive
framework
for delivering
interventions
that empower
individuals to
make choices
in care and
treatment
through part-
nerships and
education
Implemented
steps of gen-
eral nursing
process using
Orem-specific
concepts
Demonstrates
incorporation
of SCDNT as
the theoreti-
cal guide to
professional
practice at
one institution
and its com-
bination
shared gover-
nance to en-
hance patient
safety
SC agency
enhancement
through use
of comple-
mentary or
alternative
therapies to
meet HDSCR,
specifically to
Table 8 • 2 Examples of Practice Applications—cont’d
Patient or Practice
Author (Year), Health or SCDNT Focus (Selected
Country Illness Focus Settings Concept(s) Examples) Other
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 124
CHAPTER 8 • Dorothea Orem’s Self-Care Deficit Nursing Theory 125
maintain
physical and
emotional
well-being
and to man-
age side ef-
fects of
treatment
BCFs = basic conditioning factors; DCA = dependent-care agency; HDSCR = health deviation self-care requisites; NA =
nursing agency; SC = self-care; SCA = self-care agency; SCD = self-care deficit; SCR = self-care requisites; SCS = self-care
systems; TSCD = therapeutic self-care demand.
Mason-Johnson, 2009; Sürücu & Kizilci,
2012; Swanlund, Scherck, Metcalfe, & Jesek-
Hale, 2008; Wilson, Mood, & Nordstrom,
2012). Orem (2001) introduced the term
self-management in her final book, defining the
concept as the ability to manage self in stable or
changing environments and ability to manage one’s
personal affairs (p. 111). This definition relates
to continuity of contacts and interactions one
would expect over time with nursing, especially
when caring for people with chronic conditions
such as diabetes. By nature, chronic disease vari-
ations over time are collaboratively managed
by the self-care agent, dependent-care agent,
the nurse agent, and others. The dependent-
care theory enhances the self-management
component, a uniqueness of SCDNT (Casida
et al., 2009). With increases in chronic illness
and treatment, especially in relationship to
allocation of health-care dollars, countries such
as Thailand now emphasize self-management
versus self-care in health policy decisions
(personal communication, Prof. Dr. Somchit
Hanucharurnkul, January 15, 2013). Taylor and
Renpenning (2011) presented diverse perspec-
tives on self-management, describing it first
as a subset of self-care with emphasis on creat-
ing a sense of order in life using all available
resources, social and other. Another perspective
relates to controlling and directing actions in
a particular situation at a particular time. This
includes incorporating standardized models for
self-management in specific health situations
such as diabetes.
In addition to creating models for specific
health-care conditions, Orem’s SCDNT is
also used as a general framework for nursing
practice in health care institutions. For ex-
ample, Cedars Sinai Medical Center in Los
Angeles, California, integrates SCDNT with
its shared governance model to promote pa-
tient safety (Swanson & Tidwell, 2011).
However, most practice applications use the
general theory or elements of the theory with
specific populations. Table 8-2 includes di-
verse examples from English publications.
However, the reader is also directed to non-
English publications including examples
from practitioners or researchers in Brazil
(Herculano, De Souse, Galvão, Caetano, &
Damasceno, 2011) and China (Su & Jueng,
2011).
To further develop the sciences of self-
care related to specific self-care systems and
to nursing systems for diverse populations
around the globe, collaboration will be nec-
essary between reflective practitioners and
scholars (Taylor & Renpenning, 2011).
Orem’s wise approach to theory develop-
ment, combining independent work with
formal collaboration among practitioners,
administrators, educators, and researchers
will determine the future of self-care deficit
nursing theory. The International Orem So-
ciety for Nursing Science and Scholarship
continues as an important avenue for collab-
orative work among expert and novice
SCDNT scholars around the globe.
Table 8 • 2 Examples of Practice Applications—cont’d
Patient or Practice
Author (Year), Health or SCDNT Focus (Selected
Country Illness Focus Settings Concept(s) Examples) Other
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 125
126 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Practice Exemplar
Provided by Laureen M. Fleck, PhD,
FNP-BC, CDE
Marion W. presents to a primary care office
seeking care for recent fatigue. She is assigned
to the nurse practitioner. The nurse explains
the need for information to determine what
needs to be done and by whom to promote
Marion’s life, health, and well-being. Infor-
mation regarding Marion is gathered in part
using Orem’s conceptualizations as a guide.
First, the nurse introduces herself and then de-
scribes the information she will seek to help
her with the health situation. Marion agrees
to provide information to the best of her
knowledge. As the nurse and Marion have en-
tered into a professional relationship and
agreed to the roles of nurse and patient, the
nurse initiates the three steps of Orem’s
process of nursing:
Step 1: Diagnosis and Prescription
I. Basic Conditioning Factors
As basic conditioning factors affect the value
of therapeutic self-care demand and self-care
agency, the nurse seeks information regarding
the following: age, gender, developmental
state, patterns of living, family system factors,
sociocultural factors, health state, health-care
system factors, availability and adequacy of re-
sources, and external environmental factors
such as the physical or biological.
Marion is 42, female, in a developmental
stage of adulthood where she carries out tasks
of family and work responsibilities as a produc-
tive member of society. The history related to
patterns of living and family system reveals em-
ployment as a school crossing guard, a role that
allows time after school with her children, ages
5, 7, and 9. Her husband works for “the city”
but recently had hours cut to 4 days per week.
Therefore, money is tight. They pay bills on
time, but no money remains at the end of the
month. She has learned to stretch their money
by shopping at the local discount store for
clothes and food and cooking “one-pot meals”
so that they have leftovers to stretch through-
out the week. As an African American, she
worships in a community-based black church,
a source of spiritual strength and social support.
Marion has a high school education.
Questions about health state and health
system reveal Marion has type 2 diabetes that
was diagnosed more than 5 years ago. Except
for periodic fatigue, she believes she has man-
aged this chronic condition by following the
treatment plan, faithfully taking oral medica-
tion, and checking blood sugar once per day.
The morning reading was 230 mg/dL. Al-
though the family has no health insurance,
Marion has access to the community health
care clinic and free oral medications. There is
a small co-pay for her blood glucose testing
strips, which is now a concern. The children
receive health care through the State Chil-
dren’s Health Insurance Program. The neigh-
borhood Marion lives in has a safe, outdoor
environment. The latter has been a comfort
because she works as a crossing guard and
walks her children to school. Although she en-
joys this exercise, her increasing fatigue dis-
courages additional exercise.
When asked about her perception of her
current condition, Marion expressed concern
for her weight and considers this a partial ex-
planation for the fatigue. She desires to lose
weight but admits she has no willpower,
snacks late at night, and finds “healthy foods”
too expensive. At 205 lbs (93 kg) and 5 feet
3 inches (1.6 m), Marion is classified as obese
with a body mass index of 38 kg/m2.
II. Calculating the Therapeutic Self-Care Demand
With Marion, the nurse identifies many ac-
tions that should be performed to meet the
universal, developmental, and health devia-
tion self-care requisites. Her health state and
health system factors (including previous
treatment modalities) are major conditioners
of two universal self-care requisites: maintain
a sufficient intake of food and maintain a
balance between activity and rest. Throughout
the interview, the nurse determines that
Marion is clear about her chronic condition
and has accepted herself in need of continued
monitoring and care, including quarterly
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 126
CHAPTER 8 • Dorothea Orem’s Self-Care Deficit Nursing Theory 127
Practice Exemplar cont.
hemoglobin A1C and lipid blood tests
(American Diabetes Association [ADA],
2013)
Two health deviation self-care requisites also
emerge as the primary focus for seeking helping
services: being aware and attending to effects
and results of pathological conditions; and
effectively carrying out medically prescribed
diagnostic and therapeutic measures. Without
additional self-care actions beyond the pre-
scribed medication, short walks, and daily blood
glucose testing, the risks of uncontrolled dia-
betes may lead to diabetic retinopathy,
nephropathy, neuropathy, and cardiovascular
disease (ADA, 2013).
One particularized self-care requisite
(PSCRs) is presented as an example, with
the related actions Marion should perform to
improve her health and well-being. Once the
actions to be performed and concomitant meth-
ods are identified, then the nurse determines
Marion’s self-care agency: the capabilities of
knowing (estimative operations), deciding
(transitional operations), and performing these
actions (productive operations).
PSCR: Reduce and maintain blood glucose
level within normal parameters through in-
creased blood glucose monitoring, appropriate
healthy food choices, and increased activity. If
this PSCR is achieved, Marion’s weight will be
decreased, a related purpose that provides mo-
tivation to engage in self-care. The methods to
achieve the PSCR include detailed actions:
A. Increase blood glucose monitoring to twice
per day; set goals for 100–110 mg/dL fasting
and <140 mg/dL at 2 hours after a main meal.
1. Obtain discounted glucose monitoring
strips from ABC drug company.
2. Obtain assistance from community clinic
for monthly replacement request to ABC
drug company.
3. Monitor glucose level through testing two
times per day, with one test before break-
fast and one test 2 hours after a main meal.
Add more testing when needed for symp-
toms of high or low blood sugar (ADA,
2013).
4. Seek assistance from health professional
when levels are below 60 mg/dL and not
responsive to sugar intake or higher than
300 mg/dL with feelings of fatigue, thirst,
or visual disturbances.
5. Adjust activity and meal planning/portion
sizes when levels are not within parameters.
B. Make healthy food choices.
6. Seek knowledge of healthy food choices
for family meal planning from dietitian at
clinic.
7. Review family expenses with health pro-
fessional to adjust grocery budget to pur-
chase affordable but healthy foods.
8. Eat three balanced meals per day including
midmorning, afternoon, and evening
snack as desired. These meals and snacks
will have portion sizes established between
Marion and the nurse.
9. All meals will have a selection of protein,
fats, and carbohydrates, and the snacks
will be limited to 15 grams of carbohy-
drate or less (ADA, 2013).
C. Increase physical activity to 150 minutes/
week of moderate intensity exercise (ADA,
2013).
10. Gain knowledge regarding step-walking
program to increase activity. Discuss
community options for safe walking areas.
11. Explore budget to include properly fitting
footwear. Tennis shoes with socks are to
be worn for each walk. Obtain free pe-
dometer from clinic to measure perform-
ance of steps and walking.
12. Review pedometer measures three times a
week. Increase steps by 10% each week if
natural increase in steps has not occurred.
For example, if walking 2000 steps/walk
increase next walk by 200 steps as a goal.
Maintain goals until 10,000 step/day is
achieved (ADA, 2013).
III. Determining Self-Care Agency
The nurse and Marion then seek information
about self-care agency or the capabilities
related to knowledge, decision making, and
Continued
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 127
128 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Practice Exemplar cont.
performance necessary to meet this PSCR.
This includes the ability to seek and obtain re-
quired resources important to each action.
What capabilities are necessary to increase
blood glucose testing? Does Marion have the
knowledge about access to drug company re-
sources (testing strips) available to persons
with their income level? Does she have the
communication skills to seek resources from
the community center? Does she have the
knowledge regarding blood glucose parame-
ters and methods to adjust exercise and diet to
maintain the levels? The nurse and Marion to-
gether determine capabilities for each of these
components of each action necessary to meet
her particularized self-care requisite.
After collecting and analyzing data about
her abilities in relationship to the required
actions, the nurse determines the absence or
existence of a self-care deficit—that is, is self-
agency adequate to meet the therapeutic self-
care demand? The nurse quickly determines
throughout the data collection period that
Marion’s foundational and disposition capa-
bilities (necessary for any deliberate action)
and the power components (necessary for self-
care) are developed and operable. The question
is the adequacy of self-care agency in relation-
ship to this PSCR.
1. Blood glucose monitoring: The nurse
learns that Marion possesses necessary ca-
pabilities of knowing, deciding, and per-
forming to obtain additional testing strips
from ABC drug company and to increase
her blood glucose testing to two times per
day. After questioning, the nurse deter-
mines Marion is aware of norms and in
general the effect of food and exercise. In
addition to verbalizing available time for
testing, Marion also recalls that the school
nurse where she works agreed to be a re-
source if blood glucose readings are not
within the required range. She agreed to
seek out this resource if adjustment in ex-
ercise or food intake is needed. The nurse
practitioner concludes Marion’s self-care
capabilities of knowing, deciding, and
performing the necessary actions is intact
to meet the particularized self-care requi-
site, maintain blood glucose level at 100–
110 mg/dL fasting and <140 mg/dL at
2 hours after a main meal.
2. Dietary practices: The nurse seeks infor-
mation from Marion on her knowledge of
effective dietary practices and healthy
foods, including flexibility in the family
budget, shopping practices, and family
cultural practices that may influence her
food purchases. The nurse learns Marion
has misinformation about her selected
foods and is aware of resources, such as the
local health department that offers free
classes by a registered dietitian. However,
transportation to dietary classes is not pos-
sible because her husband uses the only car
to drive to work. Although Marion under-
stands the relationship of her high blood
glucose levels to the resulting fatigue, she
seems to focus on losing weight, a possible
motivational asset. Marion maintains the
ability to shop, cook, use the stove safely,
and ingest all food types.
3. The nurse assesses that Marion enjoys
walking and generally feels safe in the sur-
rounding environment. She also has time
while the children are at school to take
walks. The nurse discovers that Marion is
not aware of proper foot care or the step
program for increasing exercise. Marion
does not believe the family budget can
manage both changes in food purchases as
well as the purchase of good walking shoes.
IV. Self-Care Limitations
Marion has self-care limitations in the area of
knowledge and decision making about re-
quired dietary actions. The limitations of
knowing are related to healthy dietary prac-
tices. This includes the use of carbohydrate
counting. She lacks knowledge about purchas-
ing options for healthier foods and methods to
incorporate these into her meal effort. Al-
though interested, she is unable to enroll in di-
etary classes at the health department due to
transportation issues. Marion has knowledge
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 128
CHAPTER 8 • Dorothea Orem’s Self-Care Deficit Nursing Theory 129
Practice Exemplar cont.
and decision-making authority for managing
the family budget but has no experience incor-
porating healthier foods into the planning.
Marion also has self-care limitations in rela-
tionship to knowledge of the step program,
proper footwear, and related foot care. No re-
sources exist to purchase the necessary walking
shoes. Major capabilities include Marion’s
ability to learn, availability of time, and her
motivation to lose weight, and hence have less
fatigue. If Marion decides to make healthier
food choices that are affordable and also in-
crease her general activity, she will need mon-
itoring, counseling, and support from a health
professional related to the blood glucose levels,
access to resources for classes, budgeting, and
purchase of equipment.
With analysis of self-care agency in rela-
tionship to the particularized self-care requi-
site, the nurse and patient establish the
presence of a self-care deficit. Now that legit-
imate nursing has been established, a nursing
system is designed.
Step 2: Design and Plan of Nursing System
Now that the self-care limitations of knowing
are identified, the nurse will use helping
methods of guiding and supporting by de-
signing a supportive-educative nursing sys-
tem. The design involves planning Marion’s
activities to meet the particularized self-care
requisite with nurse guidance and monitoring
and also to establishing the nurse’s role.
Together they agree on communication
methods to work together to monitor progress
as Marion attends classes to learn healthy
dietary practices and increase activity. Marion
agrees to share information related to blood
glucose testing with the school nurse and the
pharmacist at the community clinic when
refilling medication and supplies.
The nurse agrees to seek out resources for
transportation to the health department for
dietary classes, purchase of footwear, assis-
tance to fill out forms, and also to meet with
Marion every 2 weeks to review food con-
sumption and activity records. Although the
goal is to maintain blood glucose levels at
100–110 mg/dL fasting and <140 mg/dL at
2 hours after a main meal, the priority actions
relate to dietary changes, followed by slow,
incremental changes in activity. The nurse
expects it will take 1 month to obtain the
necessary footwear. Objectives will be re-
viewed at 1 month. Marion knows that
weight loss is her objective, but she must
start changes in dietary practices. The goal
for weight loss will be set at the first
month’s meeting after attendance at the di-
etary sessions and initial experience with
changing the family’s food purchases and
meal planning. Marion and the nurse prac-
titioner begin implementing their roles as
prescribed.
Step 3: Treatment, Regulation, Case Management,
Control/Evaluation
Marion and the nurse begin implementing
their agreed-on actions as they collaborate
within the nursing system. The nurse practi-
tioner maintains contact via phone with Marion
as she completes actions, such as seeking
resources for the dietary classes and footwear.
Marion contacts the school nurse where she
works to see if she will be a resource for
weekly reports on blood glucose levels. She
also seeks out additional testing strips and
calls the clinic to obtain the routine forms for
monthly renewal requests. They proceed
through each of these actions as agreed on as
social–contractual operations. Throughout
this step, the interpersonal operations are
essential as the nurse evaluates Marion’s
progress and new roles are determined and
agreed on. This continues over time, with
continued review of the design, the role pre-
scriptions, until Marion’s therapeutic self-
care demand is decreased or self-care agency
is developed so no self-care deficit exists, and
nursing is no longer required.
Throughout the process, nursing agency
was evident. The capabilities related to inter-
personal, social–contractual, and professional–
technological operations were evident.
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 129
130 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
■ Summary
This chapter provided an overview of Orem’s
self-care deficit nursing theory. Orem created
this general theory of nursing to address the
proper objective of nursing through the ques-
tion, What condition exists in a person when
judgments are made that a nurse(s) should be
brought into the situation (i.e., that a person
should be under nursing care; Orem, 2001,
p. 20)? The grand theory comprises four inter-
related theories: the theory of self-care, theory
of dependent care, theory of self-care deficit,
and theory of nursing systems. The building
blocks of these theories are six major concepts
and one peripheral concept. Orem’s SCDNT
has been applied extensively in nursing practice
throughout the United States and internation-
ally in diverse settings and with diverse popu-
lations. SCDNT continues to be used as a
framework for research with specific patient
populations throughout the world. Collabora-
tion among scholars, researchers, and practi-
tioners is necessary to provide the science of
self-care useful to improve nursing practice
into the future (Taylor & Renpenning, 2011).
References
Alspach, J. (2011). Editorial: The patient’s capacity for
self-care: Advocating for pre-discharge assessment.
Critical Care Nurse, 31(2), 10–14. doi:10.4037/
ccn2011419
American Diabetes Association. (2013). Clinical prac-
tice recommendations 2013. Diabetes Care 36(1),
s12–s66.
Armer, J. M., Brooks, C. W., & Stewart, B. R. (2011).
Limitations of self-care in reducing the risk of lym-
phedema: Supportive–educative systems. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 24(1), 57–63.
Armer, J. M., Shook, R. P., Schneider, M. K., Brooks,
C. W., Peterson, J., & Stewart, B. R. (2009). En-
hancing supportive-educative nursing systems to
reduce risk of post-breast cancer lymphedema. Self-
Care, Dependent-Care, & Nursing, 17(1), 6–17.
Arvidsson, S., Bergman, S., Arvidsson, B., Fridlund, B.,
& Tops, A. B. (2011). Experiences of health-promoting
self-care in people living with rheumatic diseases.
Journal of Advanced Nursing, 67(6), 1264–1272.
Banfield, B. E. (2011). Environment: A perspective of
the self-care deficit nursing theory. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 24(2), 96–100.
Berbiglia, V. A., Hohmann, J., & Bekel, G. (Eds.).
(2012). World Congress on Future Nursing Systems:
New approaches, new evidence for 2020. Bulletin
luxembourgeios des questions sociales (Vol. 29).
Luxembourg: ALOSS.
Biggs, A. J. (2008). Orem’s self-care deficit nursing
theory: Update on the state of the art and science.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 21(3), 200–206.
Burdette, L. (2012). Relationship between self-care
agency, self-care practices, and obesity among rural
midlife women. In V. Berbiglia, J. Hohmann, &
G. Bekel (Eds.), World Congress on Future Nursing
Systems: New approaches, new evidence for 2020.
Bulletin luxembourgeois des questions sociales (Vol. 29,
pp. 111–130). Luxembourg: ALOSS.
Carthron, D. L., Johnson, T. M., Hubbart, T. D.,
Strickland, C., & Nance, K. (2010). “Give me some
sugar!” The diabetes self-management activities of
African-American primary caregiving grandmothers.
Journal of Nursing Scholarship, 42(3), 330–337.
Casida, J. M., Peters, R. M., & Magnan, M. A. (2009).
Self-care demands of persons living with an im-
plantable left-ventricular assist device. Research and
Theory in Nursing Practice: An International Journal,
23(4), 279–293.
Clark, P. N., Allison, S. E., Berbiglia, V. A., & Taylor,
S. G. (2009). The impact of Dorothea E. Orem’s life
and work: An interview with Orem scholars. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 22, 41–46.
Costantini, L., Beanlands, H., & Horsburgh, M. E. (2011).
Development of the Self-Care for Adults on Dialysis
Tool (SCAD). The CANNT Journal, 21(2), 38–43.
Davidson, S. (2012). Challenging RN-BSN students to
apply Orem’s Theory to practice. In V. Berbiglia,
J. Hohmann, & G. Bekel (Eds.), World Congress on
Future Nursing Systems New Approaches, New Evi-
dence for 2020: Bulletin luxembourgeois des questions so-
ciales (Vol. 29, pp. 131–138). Luxembourg: ALOSS.
Dennis, C. M., & Jesek-Hale, S. M. (2003). Calculating
the therapeutic self-care demand for a nursing popu-
lation of nursery newborns’ particularized self-care
requisites. Self-Care, Dependent-Care, & Nursing,
11(1), 3–10.
Denyes, M. J. (1981). Development of an instrument to
measure self-care agency in adolescents. Doctoral disser-
tation, University of Michigan, 1980. Dissertation
Abstract International, 41, 1716B.
Denyes, M. J. (1988). Orem’s model used for health
promotion: Directions from research. Advances in
Nursing Science, 11, p. 13.
Denyes, M. J., Orem, D. E., & Bekel, G. (2001).
Self-care: A foundational science. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 14(2), 48–54.
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 130
Fleck, L. M. (2012). The Nutrition Self Care Inventory.
In V. A. Berbiglia, J. Hohmann, J., & G. Bekel
(Eds.), World Congress on Future Nursing Systems:
New approaches, new evidence for 2020. Bulletin lux-
embourgeios des questions sociales (Vol. 29, pp. 139–
154). Luxembourg: ALOSS.
Gast, H., Denyes, M. J., Campbell, J. C., Hartweg,
D. L., Schott-Baer, D., & Isenberg, M. (1989). Self-
care agency: Conceptualizations and operationaliza-
tions. Advances in Nursing Science, 12(1), 26–38.
Green, R. (2012). Application of the self-care deficit
nursing theory to the care of children with special
health care needs in the school setting. Self-Care,
Dependent-Care, & Nursing, 19(1), 35–40.
Harre, R. (1970). The principles of scientific thinking.
Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Hartweg, D. L. (1990). Health promotion self-care
within Orem’s general theory of nursing. Journal of
Advanced Nursing, 15(1), 35–41.
Hartweg, D. L. (1991). Dorothea Orem: Self-care deficit
nursing theory. Newbury Park, CA: Sage.
Hartweg, D. L. (1993). Self-care actions of healthy,
middle-aged women to promote well-being. Nursing
Research, 42(4), 221–227.
Hartweg, D. L. (2001). Use of Orem’s conceptualizations
in a baccalaureate nursing program (1980–2000). In-
ternational Orem Society Newsletter, 8(1), 5–7.
Hartweg, D. L., & Berbiglia, V. A. (1996). Determining
the adequacy of a health promotion self-care inter-
view guide with healthy, middle-aged Mexican-
American women: A pilot study. Health Care for
Women International, 17(1), 57–68.
Helene Fuld Health Trust. (1988). The nurse theorists:
Portraits of excellence: Dorothea Orem. Oakland,
CA: Studio III.
Herculano, M. M. S., de Sousa, V. E. C., Galvão, M. R.
G., Caetano, J.A., & Damasceno, A. K. C. (2011).
Nursing process application in a patient with gesta-
tional hypertension based in Orem. Revista de Rede
de Enfermagem do Nordeste, 12(2), 401–408.
Hintze, A. (2011). Orem-based nursing education in
Germany. Nursing Science Quarterly, 24(1), 66–70.
Hohdorf, M. (2010). Self-care deficit nursing theory in
Ingolstadt—An approach to practice development in
nursing care. Self-Care, Dependent-Care, and Nursing,
18(1), 19–25.
Horan, P. (2004). Exploring Orem’s self-care deficit
nursing theory in learning disability nursing: Philo-
sophical parity paper, part 1. Learning Disability
Practice, 7(4), 28–33.
Hudson, S., & MacDonald, M. (2010). Hemodialysis
arteriovenous fistula self-cannulation: Moving theory
to practice in developing patient-teaching resources.
Clinical Nursing Specialist, 24(6), 304–312.
Isaramalai, S. (2002). Developing a cross-cultural measure
of the self-as-career inventory questionnaire for the Thai
population. Unpublished doctoral dissertation, Uni-
versity of Missouri.
Jaimovich, S., Campos, M. S., Campos, M. C., &
Moore, J. B. (2009). Spanish version of the Child
and Adolescent Self-Care Performance Question-
naire: Psychometric Testing. Pediatric Nursing,
35(2), 109–114.
Kim, H. S. (2011). Development and evaluation of self-
care agency promoting programme for prostatectomy
patients. International Journal of Urological Nursing,
5(1), 34–44.
Klainin, P., & Ounnapiruk, L. (2010). A meta-analysis
of self-care behaviour research on elders in Thailand:
An update. Nursing Science Quarterly, 23(2), 156–163.
Lundberg, P. C., & Thrakul, S. (2011). Diabetes type 2
self-management among Thai Muslim women.
Nursing and Healthcare in Chronic Illness, 3, 52-60
doi: 10.1111/j.1752-9824.2011.01079.x
Matchim, Y. M., Armer, J. M., & Stewart, B. R. (2008).
A qualitative study of participants’ perceptions of ef-
fect of mindfulness meditation practice on self-care
and overall well-being. Self-Care, Dependent-Care, &
Nursing, 16(2), 45–53.
National League for Nursing. (1987). Nursing theory: A
circle of knowledge. New York: Author.
Nursing Development Conference Group. (1973). Con-
cept formalization: Process and product. Boston: Little,
Brown.
Nursing Development Conference Group. (1979).
Concept formalization: Process and product (2nd Ed.).
Boston: Little, Brown.
Orem, D. E. (1956). The art of nursing in hospital nurs-
ing service: An analysis. In K. M. Renpenning &
S. G. Taylor (Eds.), Self-Care Theory in Nursing: Se-
lected Papers of Dorothea Orem. New York: Springer.
Orem, D. E. (1959). Guides for developing curricular for
the education of practical nurses. Washington, DC:
U.S. Government Printing Office.
Orem, D. E. (1971). Nursing: Concept of practice.
New York: McGraw-Hill.
Orem, D. E. (2001). Nursing: Concept of practice
(6th ed.). St. Louis, MO: Mosby.
Orem, D. E. (2006). Dorothea E. Orem’s self-care nurs-
ing theory. In M. E. Parker (Ed.), Nursing theories and
nursing practice (2nd ed., pp. 141–149). Philadelphia:
F. A Davis.
Ovayolu, O. U., Ovayolu, N., & Karadag, G. (2011).
The relationship between self-care agency, disability
levels, and factors regarding situations among pa-
tients with rheumatoid arthritis. Journal of Clinical
Nursing, 21, 101–110.
Pickens, J. (2012). Development of self-care agency
through enhancement of motivation in people with
schizophrenia. In V. Berbiglia, J. Hohmann, & G.
Bekel (Eds.), World Congress on Future Nursing
Systems. New approaches, new evidence for 2020.
Bulletin luxembourgeois des questions sociales (Vol. 29,
pp. 237–248). Luxembourg: ALOSS.
Ransom, J. E. (2008). Facilitating emerging nursing
agency in undergraduate nursing students. Self-Care,
Dependent Care, & Nursing, 16(2), 39–45.
Renpenning, K. Mc., & Taylor, S. G. (Eds.). (2003).
Self-care theory in nursing: Selected papers of Dorothea
Orem. New York: Springer.
CHAPTER 8 • Dorothea Orem’s Self-Care Deficit Nursing Theory 131
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 131
Ryan, M., Aloe, K., & Mason-Johnson, J. (2009). Im-
proving self-management and reducing hospital
readmission in heart failure patients. Clinical Nurse
Specialist, 23(4), 216–221.
Ryan, R. M., Patrick, H., Deci, E. L., & Williams, G. C.
(2008). Facilitating health behaviour change
and its maintenance: Interventions based on self-
determination theory. The European Health
Psychologist, 10, 2–5.
Rujiwatthanakorn, D., Panpakdee, O., Malathum, P., &
Tanomsup. S. (2011). Thais with essential hyperten-
sion. Pacific Rim Int J Nurs Res, 15(2), 97–110.
Singleton, E. K., Bienemy, C., Hutchinson, S. W.,
Dellinger, A., & Rami, J. S. (2011, Fall). A pilot
study: A descriptive correctional study of factors as-
sociated with weight in college nursing students. The
ABNF Journal, 89–95
Sürücü, H. A., & Kizilci, S. (2012). Use of Orem’s self-
care deficit nursing theory in the self-management ed-
ucation of patients with type 2 diabetes: A case study.
Self-Care, Dependent Care, and Nursing, 19(1), 53–59.
Su, H., & Jueng, R. (2011). A nursing experience of ap-
plying Orem’s theory to the care of an acute pancre-
atitis patient [in Chinese]. Tzu Chi Nursing Journal,
10(4), 1.
Swanlund, S. L., Scherck, K. A., Metcalfe, S. A., &
Jesek-Hale, S. R. (2008). Keys to successful self-
management of medications. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 21(3), 238–246.
Swanson, J. W. & Tidwell, C. A. (2011). Improving the
culture of patient safety through the Magnet journey.
OJIN: The Online Journal of Issues in Nursing 16(3).
doi:10.3912/OJIN.Vol16No03Man01
Taylor, S. G. (2001). Orem’s general theory of nursing
and families. Nursing Science Quarterly, 14(1), 7–9.
Taylor, S. G. (2007). The development of self-care
deficit nursing theory: A historical analysis. Self-
Care, Dependent Care, & Nursing, 15(1), 22–25.
Taylor, S. G. (2011). Dorothea Orem’s legacy. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 24(5), 5–6. doi:
10.1177/0894318410389064.
Taylor, S. G., & Hartweg, D. L. (2002). Nursing theory
use in baccalaureate programs in the United States
(#27). Proceedings of the Seventh International Self-
Care Deficit Nursing Theory Conference: The Prac-
tice of Nursing: Using and Extending self-care
deficit nursing theory, Atlanta, Georgia.
Taylor, S. G., & Renpenning, K. Mc. (2001). The prac-
tice of nursing in multiperson situations, family and
community. In D. E. Orem (Ed.), Nursing: Concepts
of practice (6th ed., pp. 394–433). St. Louis, MO: C.
V. Mosby.
Taylor, S. G., & Renpenning, K. (2011). Self-care science,
nursing theory and evidence-based practice. New York:
Springer.
Taylor, S. G., Renpenning, K. Mc., Geden, E. A.,
Neuman, B. M., & Hart, M. A. (2001). A theory of
dependent-care: A corollary theory to Orem’s theory
of self-care. Nursing Science Quarterly, 14(1), 39–47.
Thi, T. L. (2012). An analysis of self-care knowledge of
hepatitis B patients. In V. Berbiglia, J. Hohmann, &
G. Bekel (Eds.), World Congress on Future Nursing
Systems. New approaches, new evidence for 2020. Bul-
letin luxembourgeois des questions sociales (Vol. 29,
pp. 224–236). Luxembourg: ALOSS.
Valente, S. M., Saunders, J. M., & Uman, G. (2011,
Dec.). Self-care outcomes: Instrument development.
Journal of Chi Eta Phi Sorority.
van Achterberg, T., Lorensen, M., Isenberg, M. A.,
Evers, G., Levin, E., & Philipsen, H. (1991). The
Norwegian, Danish and Dutch version of the Ap-
praisal of Self-care Agency scale; Comparing relia-
bility aspects. Scandinavian Journal of Caring Sciences,
5(2), 101–108.
Wallace, W. A. (1983). From a realist point of view:
Essays on the philosophy of science. Washington, DC:
University Press of America.
Wanchai, A., Armer, J. M., & Stewart, B. R. (2010).
Self-care agency using complementary and alterna-
tive medicine (CAM) among breast cancer survivors.
Self-Care, Dependent-Care, & Nursing, 18(01), 8–18.
West, P., & Isenberg, M. (1997). Instrument develop-
ment: The Mental Health-Related Self-Care Agency
Scale. Archives of Psychiatric Nursing, 11(3), 126–132.
White, M. L. Peters, R., & Schim, S. M. (2011). Spiri-
tuality and spiritual self-care: Expanding self-care
deficit nursing theory. Nursing Science Quarterly,
24(1), 48–56.
Wilson, F. L., Mood, D., & Nordstrom, C. K. (2010).
The influence of easy-to read pamphlets about self-
care management of radiation side effects on pa-
tients’ knowledge. Oncology Nursing Forum, 37(6),
774–781.
132 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch08_105-132 26/12/14 5:50 PM Page 132
Chapter 9Imogene King’s Theory
of Goal Attainment
CHRISTINA L. SIELOFF AND
MAUREEN A. FREY
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Conceptual System
(King’s Conceptual System and Theory of
Goal Attainment)
Applications of the Theory In Practice
Practice Exemplar by Mary B. Killeen
Summary
References
133
Introducing the Theorist
Imogene M. King was born on January 30,
1923, in West Point, Iowa. She received a
diploma in nursing from St. John’s Hospital
School of Nursing, St. Louis, Missouri (1945);
a bachelor of science in nursing education
(1948); a master of science in nursing from
St. Louis University (1957); and a doctor of
education (EdD) from Teachers College,
Columbia University, New York (1961). She
held educational, administrative, and leader-
ship positions at St. John’s Hospital School
of Nursing, the Ohio State University, Loyola
University, the Division of Nursing in the
U.S. Department of Health, Education, and
Welfare, and the University of South Florida.
King’s hallmark theory publications include:
“A Conceptual Frame of Reference for Nurs-
ing” (1968), Towards a Theory for Nursing:
General Concepts of Human Behaviour (1971),
and A Theory for Nursing: Systems, Concepts,
Process (1981). Since 1981, King has clarified
and expanded her conceptual system, her
middle-range theory of goal attainment, and
the transaction process model in multiple book
chapters, articles in professional journals, and
presentations. After retiring as professor
emerita from the University of South Florida
in 1990, King remained an active contributor
to nursing’s theoretical development and
worked with individuals and groups in devel-
oping additional middle range theories, apply-
ing her theoretical formulations to various
populations and settings and implementing
the theory of goal attainment in clinical prac-
tice. King received recognition and numerous
Imogene M. King
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 133
awards for her distinguished career in nursing
from the American Nurses Association, the
Florida Nurses Association, the American
Academy of Nursing, and Sigma Theta Tau
International. King died in December 2007.
Her theoretical formulations for nursing con-
tinue to be taught at all levels of nursing edu-
cation and applied and extended by national
and international scholars.1
Overview of the Conceptual
System (King’s Conceptual
System and Theory of Goal
Attainment)
Theoretical Evolution in King’s
Own Words
My first theory publication pronounced the
problems and prospect of knowledge devel-
opment in nursing (King, 1964). More than
30 years ago, the problems were identified as
(1) lack of a professional nursing language,
(2) a theoretical nursing phenomena, and
(3) limited concept development. Today, the-
ories and conceptual frameworks have iden-
tified theoretical approaches to knowledge
development and utilization of knowledge in
practice. Concept development is a continu-
ous process in the nursing science movement
(King, 1988).
My rationale for developing a schematic
representation of nursing phenomena was in-
fluenced by the Howland systems model
(Howland, 1976) and the Howland and
McDowell conceptual framework (Howland
& McDowell, 1964). The levels of interaction
in those works influenced my ideas relative to
organizing a conceptual frame of reference for
nursing. Because concepts offer one approach
to structure knowledge for nursing, a thorough
review of nursing literature provided me with
ideas to identify five comprehensive concepts
as a basis for a conceptual system for nursing.
The overall concept is a human being, com-
monly referred to as an “individual” or a “per-
son.” Initially, I selected abstract concepts of
perception, communication, interpersonal re-
lations, health, and social institutions (King,
1968). These ideas forced me to review my
knowledge of philosophy relative to the nature
of human beings (ontology) and to the nature
of knowledge (epistemology).
Philosophical Foundation
In the late 1960s, while auditing a series of
courses in systems research, I was introduced
to a philosophy of science called general system
theory (von Bertalanffy, 1968). This philoso-
phy of science gained momentum in the
1950s, although its roots date to an earlier pe-
riod. This philosophy refuted logical positivism
and reductionism and proposed the idea of iso-
morphism and perspectivism in knowledge
development. Von Bertalanffy, credited with
originating the idea of general system theory,
defined this philosophy of science movement
as a “general science of wholeness: systems of
elements in mutual interaction” (von Bertalanffy,
1968, p. 37).
My philosophical position is rooted in gen-
eral system theory, which guides the study of
organized complexity as whole systems. This
philosophy gave me the impetus to focus on
knowledge development as an information-
processing, goal-seeking, and decision-making
system. General system theory provides a ho-
listic approach to study nursing phenomena as
an open system and frees one’s thinking from
the parts-versus-whole dilemma. In any dis-
cussion of the nature of nursing, the central
ideas revolve around the nature of human be-
ings and their interaction with internal and ex-
ternal environments. During this journey, I
began to conceptualize a theory for nursing.
However, because a manuscript was due in the
publisher’s office, I organized my ideas into a
conceptual system (formerly called a “concep-
tual framework”), and the result was the pub-
lication of a book titled Toward a Theory of
Nursing (King, 1971).
134 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
For additional information about the theorist, publica-
tions and research using King’s conceptual model and
the theory of goal attainment (Tables 9-1 to 9-15),
please go to bonus chapter content available at
http://davisplus.fadavis.com. Some tables are specifically
referenced throughout the text to further guide the
reader.
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 134
Design of a Conceptual System
A conceptual system provides structure for or-
ganizing multiple ideas into meaningful wholes.
From my initial set of ideas in 1968 and 1971,
my conceptual framework was refined to show
some unity and relationships among the con-
cepts. The conceptual system consists of indi-
vidual systems, interpersonal systems, and social
systems and concepts that are important for un-
derstanding the interactions within and be-
tween the systems (Fig. 9-1).
The next step in this process was to review
the research literature in the discipline in
which the concepts had been studied. For ex-
ample, the concept of perception has been
studied in psychology for many years. The lit-
erature indicated that most of the early studies
dealt with sensory perception. Around the
1950s, psychologists began to study interper-
sonal perception, which related to my ideas
about interactions. From this research literature,
I identified the characteristics of perception and
defined the concept for my framework. I con-
tinued searching literature for knowledge of
each of the concepts in my framework. An up-
date on my conceptual system was published
in 1995 (King, 1995).
Process for Development of Concepts
“Searching for scientific knowledge in nursing
is an ongoing dynamic process of continuous
identification, development, and validation of
relevant concepts” (King, 1975, p. 25). What
is a concept? A concept is an organization of
reference points. Words are the verbal symbols
used to explain events and things in our envi-
ronment and relationships to past experiences.
Northrop (1969) noted: “[C]oncepts fall into
different types according to the different
sources of their meaning. . . . A concept is a
term to which meaning has been assigned.”
Concepts are the categories in a theory.
The concept development and validation
process is as follows:
1. Review, analyze, and synthesize research
literature related to the concept.
2. From the review, identify the characteris-
tics (attributes) of the concept.
3. From the characteristics, write a concep-
tual definition.
4. Review literature to select an instrument
or develop an instrument.
5. Design a study to measure the character-
istics of the concept.
6. Select the population to be sampled.
7. Collect data.
8. Analyze and interpret data.
9. Write results of findings and conclusions.
10. State implications for adding to nursing
knowledge.
Concepts that represent phenomena in
nursing are structured within a framework and
theory to show relationships.
Multiple concepts were identified from my
analysis of nursing literature (King, 1981). The
concepts that provided substantive knowledge
about human beings (self, body image, percep-
tion, growth and development, learning, time,
and personal space) were placed within the
personal system, those related to small groups
(interaction, communication, role, transac-
tions, and stress) were placed within the inter-
personal system, and those related to large
groups that make up a society (decision mak-
ing, organization, power, status, and authority)
were placed within the social system (King,
1995). However, knowledge from all of the
CHAPTER 9 • Imogene King’s Theory of Goal Attainment 135
Social systems
(society)
Interpersonal systems
(group)
Personal
systems
(individuals)
Fig 9 • 1 King’s conceptual system.
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 135
concepts is used in nurses’ interactions with in-
dividuals and groups within social organiza-
tions, such as the family, the educational
system, and the political system. Knowledge of
these concepts came from my synthesis of re-
search in many disciplines. Concepts, when
defined from research literature, give nurses
knowledge that can be applied in the concrete
world of nursing. The concepts represent basic
knowledge that nurses use in their role and
functions either in practice, education, or ad-
ministration. In addition, the concepts provide
ideas for research in nursing.
One of my goals was to identify what I call
the essence of nursing. That brought me back
to the question: What is the nature of human
beings? A vicious circle? Not really! Because
nurses are first and foremost human beings who
give nursing care to other human beings, my
philosophy of the nature of human beings
has been presented along with assumptions I
have made about individuals (King, 1989a).
Recognizing that a conceptual system repre-
sents structure for a discipline, the next step in
the process of knowledge development was to
derive one or more theories from this structure.
Lo and behold, a theory of goal attainment was
developed (King, 1981, 1992). More recently,
others have derived theories from my conceptual
system (Frey & Sieloff, 1995).
Theory of Goal Attainment
Generally speaking, nursing care’s goal is to
help individuals maintain health or regain
health (King, 1990). Concepts are essential
elements in theories. When a theory is derived
from a conceptual system, concepts are se-
lected from that system. Remember my ques-
tion: What is the essence of nursing? The
concepts of self, perception, communication,
interaction, transaction, role, growth and de-
velopment, stress, time, and personal space
were selected for the theory of goal attainment.
Transaction Process Model
A transaction model, shown in Figure 9-2, was
developed that represented the process in
which individuals interact to set goals that re-
sult in goal attainment (King, 1981, 1995).
The model is a human process that can be
observed in many situations when two or more
people interact, such as in the family and in
136 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Feedback
REACTION INTERACTION TRANSACTION
PERCEPTION
JUDGMENT
ACTION
NURSE
PATIENT
ACTION
JUDGMENT
PERCEPTION
Feedback
Fig 9 • 2 Transaction process model. (From King, I. M. [1981]. A theory for nursing: Systems, concepts, process
[p. 145]. New York: Wiley.)
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 136
social events (King, 1996). As nurses, we bring
knowledge and skills that influence our percep-
tions, communications, and interactions in per-
forming the functions of the role. In your role
as a nurse, after interacting with a patient, sit
down and write a description of your behavior
and that of the patient. It is my belief that you
can identify your perceptions, mental judg-
ments, mental action, and reaction (negative or
positive). Did you make a transaction? That is,
did you exchange information and set a goal
with the patient? Did you explore the means
for the patient to use to achieve the goal? Was
the goal achieved? If not, why? It is my opinion
that most nurses use this process but are not
aware that it is based in a nursing theory. With
knowledge of the concepts and of the process,
nurses have a scientific base for practice that
can be clearly articulated and documented to
show quality care. How can a nurse document
this transaction model in practice?
Documentation System
A documentation system was designed to im-
plement the transaction process that leads to
goal attainment (King, 1984). Most nurses use
the nursing process to assess, diagnose, plan,
implement, and evaluate, which I call a
method. My transaction process provides the
theoretical knowledge base to implement this
method. For example, as one assesses the
patient and the environment and makes a
nursing diagnosis, the concepts of perception,
communication, and interaction represent
knowledge the nurse uses to gather informa-
tion and make a judgment. A transaction is
made when the nurse and patient decide mu-
tually on the goals to be attained, agree on the
means to attain goals that represent the plan
of care, and then implement the plan. Evalua-
tion determines whether or not goals were
attained. If not, you ask why, and the process
begins again. The documentation is recorded
directly in the patient’s chart. The patient’s
record indicates the process used to achieve
goals. On discharge, the summary indicates
goals set and goals achieved. One does not
need multiple forms when this documentation
system is in place, and the quality of nursing
care is recorded. Why do nurses insist on
designing critical paths, various care plans, and
other types of forms when, with knowledge of
this system, the nurse documents nursing care
directly on the patient’s chart? Why do we use
multiple forms to complicate a process that is
knowledge-based and also provides essential
data to demonstrate outcomes and to evaluate
quality nursing care?
Federal laws have been passed that indicate
that patients must be involved in decisions
about their care and about dying. This trans-
action process provides a scientifically based
process to help nurses implement federal laws
such as the Patient Self-Determination Act
(Federal Register, 1995).
Goal Attainment Scale
Analysis of nursing research literature in the
1970s revealed that few instruments were de-
signed for nursing research. In the late 1980s,
the faculty at the University of Maryland, ex-
perts in measurement and evaluation, applied
for and received a grant to conduct conferences
to teach nurses to design reliable and valid in-
struments. I had the privilege of participating
in this 2-year continuing education confer-
ence, where I developed a Goal Attainment
Scale (King, 1989b). This instrument may be
used to measure goal attainment. It may also
be used as an assessment tool to provide pa-
tient data to plan and implement nursing care.
Vision for the Future
My vision for the future of nursing is that
nursing will provide access to health care for
all citizens. The United States’ health-care sys-
tem will be structured using my conceptual
system. Entry into the system will be via
nurses’ assessment so that individuals are di-
rected to the right place in the system for
nursing care, medical care, social services in-
formation, health teaching, or rehabilitation.
My transaction process will be used by every
practicing nurse so that goals can be achieved
to demonstrate quality care that is cost-effective.
My conceptual system, theory of goal attain-
ment, and transaction process model will con-
tinue to serve a useful purpose in delivering
professional nursing care. The relevance of
evidence-based practice, using my theory, joins
CHAPTER 9 • Imogene King’s Theory of Goal Attainment 137
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 137
the art of nursing of the 20th century to the
science of nursing in the 21st century.
Concepts and Middle-Range Theory
Development Within King’s
Conceptual System or the Theory
of Goal Attainment
Concept development within a conceptual
framework is particularly valuable, as it
often explicates concepts more clearly than
a theorist may have done in his or her origi-
nal work. Concept development may also
demonstrate how other concepts of interest
to nursing can be examined through a nurs-
ing lens. Such explication further assists
the development of nursing knowledge by
enabling the nurse to better understand the
application of the concept within specific
practice situations. Examples of concepts
developed from within King’s work include
the following: collaborative alliance relation-
ship (Hernandez, 2007); decision making
(Ehrenberger, Alligood, Thomas, Wallace, &
Licavoli, 2007), empathy (May, 2007), holis-
tic nursing (Li, Li, & Xu, 2010), managerial
coaching (Batson & Yoder, 2012), patient
satisfaction with nursing care (Killeen,
2007), sibling closeness (Lehna, 2009), and
whole person care (Joseph, Laughon, &
Bogue, 2011).2
Applications of the Theory
in Practice
Since the first publication of King’s work
(1971), nursing’s interest in the application of
her work to practice has grown. The fact that
she was one of the few theorists who generated
both a framework and a middle range theory
further expanded her work. Today, new pub-
lications related to King’s work are a frequent
occurrence. Additional middle-range theories
have been generated and tested, and applica-
tions to practice have expanded. After her re-
tirement, King continued to publish and
examine new applications of the theory. The
purpose of this part of the chapter is to provide
an updated review of the state of the art in
terms of the application of King’s conceptual
system (KCS) and middle-range theory in a
variety of areas: practice, administration, edu-
cation, and research. Publications, identified
from a review of the literature, are summarized
and briefly discussed. Finally, recommenda-
tions are made for future knowledge develop-
ment in relation to KCS and middle-range
theory, particularly in relation to the impor-
tance of their application within an evidence-
based practice environment.
In conducting the literature review, the
authors began with the broadest category
of application—application within KCS to
nursing care situations. Because a conceptual
framework is, by nature, very broad and
abstract, it can serve only to guide, rather than
to prescriptively direct, nursing practice.
Development of middle-range theories is a
natural extension of a conceptual framework.
Middle-range theories, clearly developed from
within a conceptual framework, accomplish two
goals: (1) Such theories can be directly applied
to nursing situations, whereas a conceptual
framework is usually too abstract for such direct
application, and (2) validation of middle-range
theories, clearly developed within a particular
conceptual framework, lends validation to the
conceptual framework itself. King (1981) stated
that individuals act to maintain their own
health. Although not explicitly stated, the
converse is probably true as well: Individuals
often do things that are not good for their
health. Accordingly, it is not surprising that the
KCS and related middle-range theory are often
directed toward patient and group behaviors
that influence health.
In addition to the middle-range theory of
goal attainment (King, 1981), several other mid-
dle-range theories have been developed from
within King’s interacting systems framework. In
terms of the personal system, Brooks and
Thomas (1997) used King’s framework to derive
a theory of perceptual awareness. The focus was
to develop the concepts of judgment and action
as core concepts in the personal system. Other
concepts in the theory included communication,
perception, and decision making.
138 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
2See Table 9-2 in the bonus chapter content available at
http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 138
In relation to the interpersonal system,
several middle-range theories have been
developed regarding families. Doornbos
(2007), using her family health theory, ad-
dressed family health in terms of families of
adults with persistent mental illness. Thoma-
son and Lagowski (2008) used concepts from
King along with other nursing theorists to
develop a model for collaboration through
reciprocation in health-care organizations.
In relation to social systems, Sieloff and
Bularzik (2011) revised the “theory of group
power within organizations” to the “theory
of group empowerment within organiza-
tions” to assist in explaining the ability
of groups to empower themselves within
organizations.3
Review of the literature identified instru-
ments specifically designed within King’s
framework. King (1988) developed the Health
Goal Attainment instrument, designed to de-
tail the level of attainment of health goals by
individual clients. The Nurse Performance
Goal Attainment (NPGA) was developed by
Kameoka, Funashima, and Sugimori (2007).
Applications in Nursing Practice
There have been many applications of King’s
middle-range theory to nursing practice be-
cause the theory focuses on concepts relevant
to all nursing situations—the attainment of
client goals. The application of the middle-
range theory of goal attainment (King, 1981)
is documented in several categories: (1) general
application of the theory, (2) exploring a par-
ticular concept within the context of the theory
of goal attainment, (3) exploring a particular
concept related to the theory of goal attain-
ment, and (4) application of the theory in non-
clinical nursing situations. For example, King
(1997) described the use of the theory of goal
attainment in nursing practice. Short-term
group psychotherapy was the focus of theory
application for Laben, Sneed, and Seidel (1995).
D’Souza, Somayaji, and Subrahmanya (2011)
used the theory to “examine determinants of
reproductive health and related quality of life
among Indian women in mining communities”
(p. 1963).
Nursing Process and Nursing
Terminologies, Including
Standardized Nursing Languages
Within the nursing profession, the nursing
process has consistently been used as the basis
for nursing practice. King’s framework and
middle-range theory of goal attainment (1981)
have been clearly linked to the process of nurs-
ing. Although many published applications
have broad reference to the nursing process,
several deserve special recognition. First, King
herself (1981) clearly linked the theory of goal
attainment to nursing process as theory and to
nursing process as method. Application of
King’s work to nursing curricula further
strengthened this link.
In addition, the steps of the nursing process
have long been integrated within the KCS
and the middle-range theory of goal attain-
ment (Daubenmire & King, 1973; D’Souza,
Somayaji, & Suybrahmanya, 2011; Woods,
1994). In these process applications, assess-
ment, diagnosis, and goal-setting occur, fol-
lowed by actions based on the nurse–client
goals. The evaluation component of the nurs-
ing process consistently refers back to the orig-
inal goal statement(s). In related research, Frey
and Norris (1997) also drew parallels between
the processes of critical thinking, nursing, and
transaction.
Over time, nursing has developed nursing
terminologies that are used to assist the pro-
fession to improve communication both
within, and external to, the profession. These
terminologies include the nursing diagnoses,
nursing interventions, and nursing outcomes.
With the use of these standardized nursing
languages (SNLs), the nursing process is fur-
ther refined. Standardized terms for diagnoses,
interventions, and outcomes also potentially
improve communication among nurses.
Using SNLs also enables the development
of middle-range theory by building on con-
cepts unique to nursing, such as those concepts
of King that can be directly applied to the
nursing process: action, reaction, interaction,
CHAPTER 9 • Imogene King’s Theory of Goal Attainment 139
See Table 9-5 in the bonus chapter content available at
http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 139
transaction, goal setting, and goal attainment.
Biegen and Tripp-Reimer (1997) suggested
middle-range theories be constructed from the
concepts in the taxonomies of the nursing lan-
guages focusing on outcomes. Alternatively,
King’s framework and theory may be used as a
theoretical basis for these phenomena and may
assist in knowledge development in nursing in
the future.
With the advent of SNLs, “outcome
identification” is identified as a step in the
nursing process after assessment and diagnosis
(McFarland & McFarland, 1997, p. 3). King’s
(1981) concept of mutual goal setting is anal-
ogous to the outcomes identification step,
because King’s concept of goal attainment
is congruent with the evaluation of client
outcomes.
In addition, King’s concept of perception
(1981) lends itself well to the definition of
client outcomes. Moorhead, Johnson, and
Maas (2013) define a nursing-sensitive patient
outcome as “an individual, family or commu-
nity state, behaviour or perception that is
measured along a continuum in response to
nursing intervention(s)” (p. 2). This is fortu-
itous because the development of nursing
knowledge requires the use of client outcome
measurement. The use of standardized client
outcomes as study variables increases the ease
with which research findings can be compared
across settings and contributes to knowledge
development. Therefore, King’s concept of
mutually set goals may be studied as “expected
outcomes.” Also, by using SNLs, King’s
(1981) middle-range theory of goal attainment
can be conceptualized as the “attainment of ex-
pected outcomes” as the evaluation step in the
application of the nursing process.
In summary, although these terminologies,
including SNLs, were developed after many of
the original nursing theorists had completed
their works, nursing frameworks such as the
KCS (1981) can still find application and use
within the terminologies. In addition, it is this
type of application that further demonstrates
the framework’s utility across time. For exam-
ple, Chaves and Araujo (2006), Ferreira De
Sourza, Figueiredo De Martino, and Daena
De Morais Lopes (2006), Goyatá, Rossi, and
Dalri (2006), and Palmer (2006) implemented
nursing diagnoses within the context of King’s
framework.4
Applications in Client Systems
KCS and middle-range theory of goal attain-
ment have a long history of application with
large groups or social systems (organizations,
communities). The earliest applications in-
volved the use of the framework and theory to
guide continuing education (Brown & Lee,
1980) and nursing curricula (Daubenmire,
1989; Gulitz & King, 1988). More contempo-
rary applications address a variety of organiza-
tional settings. For example, the framework
served as the basis for the development of a
middle-range theory relating to practice in a
nursing home (Zurakowski, 2007). Nwinee
(2011) used King’s work, along with Peplau’s,
to develop the sociobehavioral self-care man-
agement nursing model (p. 91). In addition,
the theory of goal attainment has been pro-
posed as the practice model for case manage-
ment (Hampton, 1994; Tritsch, 1996). These
latter applications are especially important be-
cause they may be the first use of the frame-
work by other disciplines.
Applicable to administration and manage-
ment in a variety of settings, a middle-range
theory of group power within organizations
has been developed and revised to the theory
of group empowerment within organizations
(Sieloff, 1995, 2003, 2007; Sieloff & Dunn,
2008; Sieloff & Bularzik, 2011). Educational
settings, also considered as social systems,
have been the focus of application of King’s
work (George, Roach, & Andfrade, 2011;
Greef, Strydom, Wessels, & Schutte, 2009;
Ritter, 2008).5
Multidisciplinary Applications
Because of King’s emphasis on the attainment
of goals and the relevancy of goal attainment
to many disciplines, both within and external
to health care, it is reasonable to expect that
140 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
4See Table 9-4 in the bonus chapter content available at
http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
5See Table 9-8 in the bonus chapter content available at
http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 140
King’s work can find application beyond
nursing-specific situations. Two specific ex-
amples of this include the application of
King’s work to case management (Hampton,
1994; Sowell & Lowenstein, 1994) and to
managed care (Hampton, 1994). Both case
management and managed care incorporate
multiple disciplines as they work to improve
the overall quality and cost-efficiency of the
health care provided. These applications also
address the continuum of care, a priority in
today’s health-care environment. Specific re-
searchers (Fewster-Thuente & Velsor-
Friedrich, 2008; Khowaja, 2006) detailed
their research related to multidisciplinary ac-
tivities and interdisciplinary collaborations,
respectively.6
Multicultural Applications
Multicultural applications of KCS and re-
lated theories are many. Such applications
are particularly critical because many theo-
retical formulations are limited by their
culture-bound nature. Several authors specif-
ically addressed the utility of King’s frame-
work and theory for transcultural nursing.
Spratlen (1976) drew heavily from King’s
framework and theory to integrate ethnic
cultural factors into nursing curricula and
to develop a culturally oriented model for
mental health care. Key elements derived
from King’s work were the focus on percep-
tions and communication patterns that mo-
tivate action, reaction, interaction, and
transaction. Rooda (1992) derived proposi-
tions from the midrange theory of goal
attainment as the framework for a conceptual
model for multicultural nursing.
Cultural relevance has also been demon-
strated in reviews by Frey, Rooke, Sieloff,
Messmer, and Kameoka (1995) and Husting
(1997). Although Husting identified that cul-
tural issues were implicit variables throughout
King’s framework, particular attention was
given to the concept of health, which, accord-
ing to King (1990), acquires meaning from
cultural values and social norms.
Undoubtedly, the strongest evidence for the
cultural utility of King’s conceptual framework
and midrange theory of goal attainment (1981)
is the extent of work that has been done in
other cultures. Applications of the framework
and related theories have been documented in
the following countries beyond the United
States: Brazil (Firmino, Cavalcante, & Celia,
2010), Canada (Plummer & Molzahn, 2009),
China (Li, Li, & Xu, 2010), India (D’Souza,
Somayaji, & Subrahmanya, 2011; George
et al., 2011), Japan (Kameoka et al., 2007),
Portugal (Chaves & Araujo, 2006; Goyatá
et al., 2006; Pelloso & Tavares, 2006), Slovenia
(Harih & Pajnkihar, 2009), Sweden (Rooke,
1995a, 1995b), and West Africa (Nwinee,
2011). In Japan, a culture very different from
the United States with regard to communica-
tion style, Kameoka (1995) used the classifica-
tion system of nurse–patient interactions
identified within the theory of goal attainment
(King, 1981) to analyze nurse–patient interac-
tions. In addition to research and publications
regarding the application of King’s work to
nursing practice internationally, publications by
and about King have been translated into other
languages, including Japanese (King, 1976,
1985; Kobayashi, 1970). Therefore, perception
and the influence of culture on perception were
identified as strengths of King’s theory.
Research Applications in Varied
Settings and Populations
KCS has been used to guide nursing practice
and research in multiple settings and with
multiple populations. For example, Harih and
Pajnkihar (2009) applied King’s model in
treating elderly diabetes patients. Joseph et al.
(2011) examined the implementation of
whole-person care.7 As stated previously, dis-
eases or diagnoses are often identified as the
focus for the application of nursing knowledge.
Maloni (2007) and Nwinee (2011) conducted
research with patients with diabetes, and
women with breast cancer were the focus of
the work of Funghetto, Terra, and Wolff
(2003). In addition, clients with chronic
CHAPTER 9 • Imogene King’s Theory of Goal Attainment 141
6See Table 9-14 in the bonus chapter content available
at http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
7See Table 9-11 in the bonus chapter content available
at http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 141
obstructive pulmonary disease were involved in
research by Wicks, Rice, and Talley (2007).
Clients experiencing a variety of psychiatric
concerns have also been the focus of work,
using King’s conceptualizations (Murray &
Baier, 1996; Schreiber, 1991). Clients’ con-
cerns ranged from psychotic symptoms
(Kemppainen, 1990) to families experiencing
chronic mental illness (Doornbos, 2007), to
clients in short-term group psychotherapy
(Laben, Sneed, & Seidel, 1995).8 The theory
has also been applied in nonclinical nursing
situations. Secrest, Iorio, and Martz (2005)
used the theory in examining the empower-
ment of nursing assistants. Li et al. (2010) ex-
plored the “development of the concept of
holistic nursing” (p. 33).9
Research Applications with Clients Across
the Life Span
Additional evidence of the scope and usefulness
of King’s framework and theory is its use with
clients across the life span. Several applications
have targeted high-risk infants (Frey & Norris,
1997; Syzmanski, 1991). Frey (1993, 1995,
1996) developed and tested relationships among
multiple systems with children, youth, and
young adults. Lehna (2009) explicated the con-
cept of sibling closeness in a study of siblings
experiencing a major burn trauma. Interestingly,
these studies considered personal systems (in-
fants), interpersonal systems (parents, families),
and social systems (the nursing staff and hospi-
tal environment). Clearly, a strength of King’s
framework and theory is its utility in encom-
passing complex settings and situations.
KCS and the midrange theory of goal at-
tainment have also been used to guide practice
with adults (young adults, adults, mature
adults) with a broad range of concerns. Goyatá
et al. (2006) used King’s work in their study of
adults experiencing burns. Additional exam-
ples of applications focusing on adults include
individuals with hypertension (Firmino et al.,
2010) and perceptions of students toward
obesity (Ongoco, 2012). Gender-specific work
included Sharts-Hopko’s (2007) use of a middle-
range theory of health perception to study the
health status of women during menopause
transition and Martin’s (1990) application
of the framework toward cancer awareness
among males.
Several of the applications with adults have
targeted the mature adult, thus demonstrating
contributions to the nursing specialty of geron-
tology. Reed (2007) used a middle-range the-
ory to examine the relationship of social
support and health in older adults. Harih and
Pajnkihar (2009) applied “King’s model in the
treatment of elderly diabetes patients” (p. 201).
Clearly, these applications, and others, show
how the complexity of King’s framework and
midrange theory increases its usefulness for
nursing.10
Research Applications to Client Systems
In addition to discussing client populations
across the life span, client populations can be
identified by focus of care (client system)
and/or focus of health problem (phenomenon
of concern). The focus of care, or interest, can
be an individual (personal system) or group
(interpersonal or social system). Thus, applica-
tion of King’s work, across client systems, can
be divided into the three systems identified
within the KCS (1981): personal (the individ-
ual), interpersonal (small groups), and social
(large groups/society).
Use with personal systems has included
both patients and nurses. LaMar (2008) exam-
ined nurses in a tertiary acute care organization
as the personal system of interest. Nursing stu-
dents as personal systems were the focus of
Lockhart and Goodfellow’s research (2009).
When the focus of interest moves from an in-
dividual to include interaction between two
people, the interpersonal system is involved.
Interpersonal systems often include clients and
nurses. An example of an application to a
nurse–client dyad is Langford’s (2008) study
of the perceptions of transactions with nurse
practitioners and obese adolescents. In relation
142 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
8See Table 9-8 and 9-11 in the bonus chapter content
available at http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
9See Table 9-3 in the bonus chapter content available at
http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
10 See Table 9-7 in the bonus chapter content available
at http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 142
to interpersonal systems, or small groups,
many publications focus on the family. Frey
and Norris (1997) used both KCS and the the-
ory of goal attainment in planning care with
families of premature infants. Alligood (2010)
described “family health care with King’s the-
ory of goal attainment” (p. 99).
Research Applications Focusing on
Phenomena of Concern to Clients
Within King’s work, it is critically important
for the nurse to focus on, and address, the
phenomenon of concern to the client. With-
out this emphasis on the client’s perspective,
mutual goal setting cannot occur. Hence, a
client’s phenomenon of concern was selected
as neutral terminology that clearly demon-
strated the broad application of King’s work
to a wide variety of practice situations. A topic
that frequently divides nurses is their area of
specialty. However, by using a consistent
framework across specialties, nurses may be
able to focus more clearly on their common-
alities, rather than highlighting their differ-
ences.11 A review of the literature clearly
demonstrates that King’s framework and re-
lated theories have application within a variety
of nursing specialties.12 This application is ev-
ident whether one is reviewing a “traditional”
specialty, such as surgical nursing (Bruns,
Norwood, Bosworth, & Gill, 2009; Lockhart
& Goodfellow, 2009; Sivaramalingam, 2008),
or the nontraditional specialties of forensic
nursing (Laben et al., 1991) and/or nursing
administration (Gianfermi & Buchholz, 2011;
Joseph et al., 2011).
Health is one area that certainly binds
clients and nurses. Improved health is clearly
the desired end point, or outcome, of nursing
care and something to which clients aspire.
Review of the outcome of nursing care, as
addressed in published applications, tends to
support the goal of improved health directly
and/or indirectly, as the result of the applica-
tion of King’s work. Health status is explicitly
the outcome of concern in practice applications
by Smith (1988). Several applications used
health-related terms. For example, DeHowitt
(1992) studied well-being, and D’Souza et al.
(2011) examined the determinants of health.
Health promotion has also been an em-
phasis for the application of King’s ideas.
Sexual counseling was the focus of work by
Villeneuve and Ozolins (1991). Health be-
haviors were Hanna’s (1995) focus of study,
and Plummer and Molzahn (2009) explored
the “quality of life in contemporary nursing
theory” (p. 134). Frey (1996, 1997) examined
both health behaviors and illness manage-
ment behaviors in several groups of children
with chronic conditions as well as risky
behaviors (1996). Recently, researchers have
explored weight loss and obesity (Langford,
2008; Ongoco, 2012).
Research Applications in Varied Work
Settings
An additional potential source of division
within the nursing profession is the work sites
where nursing is practiced and care is deliv-
ered. As the delivery of health care moves from
the acute care hospital to community-based
agencies and clients’ homes, it is important to
highlight commonalities across these settings,
and it is important to identify that King’s
framework and middle-range theory of goal
attainment continue to be applicable. Al-
though many applications tend to be with
nurses and clients in traditional settings, suc-
cessful applications have been shown across
other, including newer and nontraditional set-
tings. From hospitals (Bogue, Jospeh, &
Sieloff, 2009; Firmino et al., 2010; Kameoka
et al., 2007) to nursing homes (Zurakowski,
2007), King’s framework and related theories
provide a foundation on which nurses can
build their practice interventions. In addition,
the use of the KCS and related theories are ev-
ident within quality improvement projects
(Anderson & Mangino, 2006; Durston, 2006;
Khowaja, 2006).13 Nurses also use the theory
CHAPTER 9 • Imogene King’s Theory of Goal Attainment 143
11See Table 9-9 in the bonus chapter content available at
http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
12See Table 9-10 in the bonus chapter content available
at http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
13See Table 9-11 in the bonus chapter content available
at http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 143
of goal attainment (King, 1981) to examine
concepts related to the theory. This application
was demonstrated by Smith (2003), by Jones
and Bugge (2006), by Sivaramalingam (2008)
in a study of patients’ perceptions of nurses’
roles and responsibilities, and by Mardis
(2012) in a study of patients’ perceptions of
minimal lift equipment.
Relationship to Evidence-Based Practice
From an evidence-based practice and King
perspective, the profession must implement
three strategies to apply theory-based research
findings effectively. First, nursing as a disci-
pline must agree on rules of evidence in evalu-
ation of quality research that reflect the unique
contribution of nursing to health care. Second,
the nursing rules of evidence must include
heavier weight for research that is derived
from, or adds to, nursing theory. Third, the
nursing rules of evidence must reflect higher
scores when nursing’s central beliefs are af-
firmed in the choice of variables. This third
strategy, for the use of concepts central to
nursing, has clear relevance for evidence-based
practice when using King’s (1981) concepts as
reformulated within interventions or out-
comes. Outcomes, as in King’s concept of goal
attainment, provide data for evidence-based
practice.
Currently, safety and quality initiatives in
organizations, with evidence-based practice
as the innovation, use many concepts initially
defined by King and found in middle-range
theories (Sieloff & Frey, 2007). King’s
(1981) work on the concepts of client and
nurse perceptions, and the achievement of
mutual goals has been assimilated and ac-
cepted as core beliefs of the discipline of
nursing. Research conducted with a King
theoretical base is well positioned for appli-
cation by nurse caregivers (Bruns et al.,
2009; Gemmill et al., 2011; Mardis, 2011),
nurse administrators (Sieloff & Bularzik,
2011), and client-consumers (Killeen, 2007)
as part of evolving evidence-based nursing
practice.14
Recommendations for Future
Applications Related to King’s
Framework and Theory
Obviously, new nursing knowledge has resulted
from applications of King’s framework and the-
ory. However, nursing is evolving as a science.
Additional work continues to be needed. On
the basis of a review of the applications previ-
ously discussed, recommendations for future
applications continue to focus on (1) the need
for evidence-based nursing practice that is the-
oretically derived; (2) the integration of King’s
work in evidence-based nursing practice; (3) the
integration of King’s concepts within SNLs;
(4) analysis of the future effect of managed care,
continuous quality improvement, and technol-
ogy on King’s concepts; (5) identification, or de-
velopment and implementation, of additional
relevant instruments; and (6) clarification of ef-
fective nursing interventions, including identi-
fication of relevant Nursing Interventions
Classifications, based on King’s work.
As part of its mission, the King International
Nursing Group (KING) (www.kingnursing
.org) continuously monitors the latest publica-
tions and research based on King’s work and
related theories, providing updates to mem-
bers. To further assist in the dissemination of
such research, KING also conducts a biannual
research conference. The following Exemplar
illustrates the application of the theory of goal
attainment to an interdisciplinary team, quality
improvement, and evidence-based practice.
144 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
14See Table 9-12 in the bonus chapter content available
at http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 144
CHAPTER 9 • Imogene King’s Theory of Goal Attainment 145
Practice Exemplar
Provided by Mary B. Killeen, PhD,
RN, NEA-BC
Claire Smith, RN, BSN, is a recent nursing
graduate in her first position on a medical in-
tensive care unit in a suburban community
hospital. Claire’s manager suggests that she
should join the unit’s interdisciplinary quality
improvement committee to develop her lead-
ership skills. The goal of the committee is to
improve patient care by using the best avail-
able evidence to develop and implement prac-
tice protocols.
At the first meeting, Claire was asked if
she had any burning clinical questions as a
new graduate. She stated that she was taught
to avoid use of normal saline for tracheal suc-
tioning. However, she noticed many respira-
tory therapists and some nurses routinely
using normal saline with suctioning. When
asked about this practice, she was told
that normal saline was useful to break up se-
cretions and aid in their removal. The com-
mittee affirmed Claire’s observation of
contradictory practices between what is
taught and what is done in practice. After
discussion, the group formulated the follow-
ing clinical question: Does instilling normal
saline decrease favorable patient outcomes
among patients with endotracheal tubes or
tracheostomies?
Claire suggests to the committee that
King’s theory of goal attainment might be
useful as a theoretical guide for this project
because the question is focused on patient
outcomes, or according to King’s theory,
goals. The nursing members are familiar
with King’s theory, and all members value
using theory to guide practice. Claire’s pro-
posal is accepted. Claire experienced work-
ing on EBP group projects as a student, so
she feels comfortable volunteering to develop
a draft of the theoretical foundation for the
project. Two other committee members
agree to work on the plan and present it at
the next meeting.
The following are the questions and the
conclusions that Claire and her colleagues
discussed:
1. How does King’s theory of goal attainment help
the unit’s quality improvement (QI) committee?
Goal attainment theory is derived from
KCS, which includes personal, interpersonal,
and social systems. The QI committee is a
type of interpersonal system. An interpersonal
system encompasses individuals in groups in-
teracting to achieve goals. The QI committee
is engaged in the committee’s goal attainment
for the benefit of patients. “Role expectations
and role performance of nurses and clients in-
fluence transactions” (King, 1981, p. 147).
When used in interdisciplinary teams, the
transaction process in King’s theory facilitates
mutual goal setting with nurses, and ulti-
mately patients, based on each member of the
team’s specific knowledge and functions.
Multidisciplinary care conferences, an ex-
ample of a situation where goal-setting
among professionals occurs, is a label for an
indirect nursing intervention within the
Nursing Interventions Classification (NIC;
Bulechek, Butcher, & Dochterman, 2008).
Some of the activities listed under this NIC
reflect King’s (1981) concepts: “establish mu-
tually agreeable goals; solicit input for patient
care planning; revise patient care plan, as
necessary; discuss progress toward goals; and
provide data to facilitate evaluation of patient
care plan” (p. 501).
2. How does King define goals and goal attain-
ment and how are these related to quality
patient outcomes?
According to King’s theory of goal at-
tainment (1981), goals are mutually agreed
upon, and through a transaction process,
are attained. Goals are similar to outcomes
that are achieved after agreement on the
definitions and measurement of the out-
comes. Quality improvement has shown
agreement that evaluation of care must in-
clude process and outcomes. Outcomes are
Continued
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 145
146 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Practice Exemplar cont.
the results of interventions or processes.
The term “outcome” assumes that a process is
central to effective care. An outcome is de-
fined as a change in a patient’s health status.
Effectiveness of care can be measured by
whether the patient goals (i.e., outcomes)
have been attained. The QI Committee en-
gages in goal attainment through communi-
cation by setting goals, exploring means, and
agreeing on means to achieve goals. In this
example, members will gather information,
examine data and evidence, interpret the in-
formation, and participate in developing a
protocol for patients to achieve quality patient
outcomes, that is, goals.
3. How does King’s theory of goal attainment
provide a theoretical foundation for the clini-
cal problem of using normal saline with
suctioning?
First, the use of King’s theory will help
guide the literature search to include studies
that address interventions or processes that
lead to favorable patient outcomes or goals
among patients similar to the population on
the unit. Claire’s subgroup enlisted the help
of the hospital librarian in searching the
literature using the elements of the clinical
question and the theoretical concepts as key
words. Second, the theoretical formulation of
the study helps organize the implementation
and evaluation plans so they are attainable.
4. What key words would you use for the search con-
sidering the clinical question and King’s theory?
Key words used are endotracheal tubes,
tracheostomies, normal saline, suctioning, out-
comes, King’s theory of goal attainment, and
goal attainment.
5. How does a theoretical foundation, such as
King’s theory of goal attainment, apply to a
quality improvement or EBP project?
Claire used these criteria from her nurs-
ing program to develop a theoretical foun-
dation for the project.
The theoretical foundation for the proj-
ect was presented to the committee and
accepted (Fig. 9–3).
6. What were the results of the committee’s
work?
The search strategy included MEDLINE,
CINAHL, Cochrane Library, Joanna Briggs
Institute, and TRIP databases. All types of
evidence (nonexperimental, experimental,
qualitative studies, systematic reviews) were
Clinical Problem
Elements
King’s
Concepts
Application to
the Project
Members of the
Interdisciplinary
Committee
Clinical problem
formulated and relevance
to unit discussed.
Evidence sought and
examined to select
measurable goals/
outcomes.
Implementation plan
devised.
Implementation plan
accepted by members.
Intervention: normal
saline with suctioning
Outcomes
Outcomes
Outcomes
Population: patients
with endotracheal
tubes or tracheostomies
Clients and nurses
Transaction
process:
Disturbance
Goals explored
Explore means to
achieve goals
Agree on means
to achieve goals
Fig 9 • 3 Theoretical foundation for a quality improvement project using
Imogene King’s theory of goal attainment derived from King’s conceptual
system (1981).
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 146
CHAPTER 9 • Imogene King’s Theory of Goal Attainment 147
Practice Exemplar cont.
included. The evidence was evaluated by the
QI committee and included physiological
and psychological effects of instillation of
normal saline. The collective evidence, rele-
vant to their unit’s practice problem, did not
support the routine use of normal saline with
suctioning (similar to Halm & Kriski-
Hagel, 2008). From the evidence, the com-
mittee selected the specific outcomes to track
for the project: sputum recovery, oxygena-
tion, and subjective symptoms of pain, anx-
iety, and dyspnea. Owing to anticipated
small samples, hemodynamic alterations and
infections were not selected as outcomes.
The committee devised a theory-based im-
plementation plan to discontinue normal
saline for suctioning using the five Ws (who,
what, where, when, why) and how as the
outline for the plan. Change processes were
employed in the plan. Evaluation of the at-
tainment of outcomes will address the effec-
tiveness of the plan using the measurable
outcomes and the degree to which they were
attained.
■ Summary
An essential component in the analysis of con-
ceptual frameworks and theories is the consid-
eration of their adequacy (Ellis, 1968).
Adequacy depends on the three interrelated
characteristics of scope, usefulness, and com-
plexity. Conceptual frameworks are broad in
scope and sufficiently complex to be useful for
many situations. Theories, on the other hand,
are narrower in scope, usually addressing less
abstract concepts, and are more specific in
terms of the nature and direction of relation-
ships and focus.
King fully intended her conceptual system
for nursing to be useful in all nursing situa-
tions. Likewise, the middle-range theory of
goal attainment (King, 1981) has broad scope
because interaction is a part of every nursing
encounter. Although previous evaluations of
the scope of King’s framework and middle-
range theory have resulted in mixed reviews
(Austin & Champion, 1983; Carter &
Dufour, 1994; Frey, 1996; Jonas, 1987;
Meleis, 2012), the nursing profession has
clearly recognized their scope and usefulness.
In addition, the variety of practice applications
evident in the literature clearly attests to the
complexity of King’s work. As researchers con-
tinue to integrate King’s theory and framework
with the dynamic health-care environment, fu-
ture applications involving evidence-based
practice will continue to demonstrate the ade-
quacy of King’s work in nursing practice.
References
Alligood, M. (2010). Family healthcare with King’s the-
ory of goal attainment. Nursing Science Quarterly,
23(2), 99–104. doi:10.1177/0894318410362553
Anderson, C. D., & Mangino, R. R. (2006). Nurse shift
report: Who says you can’t talk in front of the
patient? Nursing Administration Quarterly, 30(2),
112–122.
Austin, J. K., & Champion, V. L. (1983). King’s theory
for nursing: Explication and evaluation. In P. L.
Chinn (Ed.), Advances in nursing theory development
(pp. 49–61). Rockville, MD: Aspen.
Batson, V. D., & Yoder, L. H. (2012). Managerial
coaching: A concept analysis. Journal of Advanced
Nursing, 68(7), 1658–1669. doi:10.1111/j.1365-
2648.2011.05840.x
Biegen, M. A., & Tripp-Reimer, T. (1997). Implications
of nursing taxonomies for middle-range theory devel-
opment. Advances in Nursing Science, 19(3), 37–49.
Bogue, R., Joseph, M., & Sieloff, C. (2009). Shared
governance as vertical alignment of nursing group
power and nurse practice council effectiveness. Jour-
nal of Nursing Management, 17(1), 4–14.
Brooks, E. M., & Thomas, S. (1997). The perception
and judgment of senior baccalaureate student nurses
in clinical decision making. Advances in Nursing
Science, 19(3), 50–69.
Brown, S. T., & Lee, B. T. (1980). Imogene King’s con-
ceptual framework: A proposed model for continu-
ing nursing education. Journal of Advanced Nursing,
5, 467–473.
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 147
Bruns, A., Norwood, B., Bosworth, G., & Hill, L.
(2009). The cerebral oximeter: What is the efficacy?
AANA Journal, 77(2), 137–144.
Bulechek, G. M., Butcher, H. K., & Dochterman, J. M.
(2008). Nursing interventions classification (NIC)
(5th ed.). St. Louis, MO: C. V. Mosby.
Carter, K. F., & Dufour, L. T. (1994). King’s theory: A
critique of the critiques. Nursing Science Quarterly,
7(3), 128–133.
Chaves, E. S., & Araujo, T. L. (2006). Nursing care for
an adolescent with cardiovascular risk [in Por-
tuguese]. Ciencia Cuidado e Saude, 5(1), 82–87.
Daubenmire, M. J. (1989). A baccalaureate nursing cur-
riculum based on King’s conceptual framework. In
J. P. Riehl-Sisca (Ed.), Conceptual models for nursing
practice (3rd ed., pp. 167–178). Norwalk, CT:
Appleton & Lange.
Daubenmire, M. J., & King, I. M. (1973). Nursing
process models: A systems approach. Nursing
Outlook, 21, 512–517.
DeHowitt, M. C. (1992). King’s conceptual model and
individual psychotherapy. Perspectives in Psychiatric
Care, 28(4), 11–14.
Doornbos, M. M. (2007). King’s conceptual system and
family health theory in the families of adults with
persistent mental illness—An evolving conceptual-
ization. In C. L. Sieloff & M. A. Frey (Eds.), Middle
range theory development using King’s conceptual system
(pp. 31–49). New York: Springer.
D’Souza, M., Somayaji, G., & Subrahmanya, N. K.
(2011). Determinants of reproductive health and re-
lated quality of life among Indian women in mining
communities. Journal of Advanced Nursing, 67(9),
1963–1975. doi:10.1111/j.1365-2648.2011.05641.x
Durston, P. (2006, April). Partners in caring: A partner-
ship for healing. Nursing Administration Quarterly,
30(2), 105–111. Retrieved August 22, 2008, from
CINAHL with Full Text database.
Ehrenberger, H. E., Alligood, M. R., Thomas, S. P.,
Wallace, D. C., & Licavoli, C. M. (2007). Testing a
theory of decision making derived from King’s sys-
tems framework in women eligible for a cancer clini-
cal trial. In C. L. Sieloff & M. A. Frey (Eds.),
Middle range theory development using King’s concep-
tual system (pp. 75–91). New York: Springer.
Ellis, R. (1968). Characteristics of significant theories.
Nursing Research, 17, 217–222.
Fawcett, J. (2008). The added value of nursing concep-
tual model-based research. Journal of Advanced
Nursing, 61(6), 583.
Federal Register. (1995). Final Revisions: 60(123),
Tuesday. June 27, 1995, p. 33294 forward.
Ferreira De Souza, E., Figueiredo De Martino, M. M.,
& Daena De Morais Lopes, M. H. (2006, January–
March). Analyzing nursing diagnoses in chronic
renal clients using Imogene King’s conceptual sys-
tem. International Journal of Nursing Terminologies &
Classifications, 17(1), 53–54.
Fewster-Thuente, L., & Velsor-Friedrich, B. (2008).
Interdisciplinary collaboration for healthcare
professionals. Nursing Administration Quarterly,
32(1), 40–48.
Firmino, de Fatima, L., Cavalcante, & Celia. (2010).
Perceptions of people about hypertension and con-
cepts of Imogene King [Portuguese]. Revista Gaucha
De Enfermagem, 31(3), 499–507.
doi:10.1590/S1983-14472010000300013
Frey, M. A. (1993). A theoretical perspective of family
and child health derived from King’s conceptual
framework of nursing: A deductive approach to the-
ory building. In S. L. Feetham, S. B. Meister, J. M.
Bell, & C. L. Gillis (Eds.), The nursing of families:
Theory/research/education/practice (pp. 30–37). New-
bury Park, CA: Sage.
Frey, M. A. (1995). Toward a theory of families, chil-
dren, and chronic illness. In M. A. Frey & C. L.
Sieloff (Eds.), Advancing King’s systems framework
and theory of nursing (pp. 109–125). Thousand Oaks,
CA: Sage.
Frey, M. A. (1996). Behavioral correlates of health and
illness in youths with chronic illness. Advanced Nurs-
ing Research, 9(4), 167–176.
Frey, M. A. (1997). Health promotion in youth with
chronic illness: Are we on the right track? Quality
Nursing, 3(5), 13–18.
Frey, M. A., & Norris, D. M. (1997). King’s systems
framework and theory in nursing practice. In A.
Marriner-Tomey (Ed.), Nursing theory utilization
and application (pp. 71–88). St. Louis, MO: C. V.
Mosby.
Frey, M. A., Rooke, L., Sieloff, C. L., Messmer, P., &
Kameoka, T. (1995). King’s framework and theory
in Japan, Sweden, and the United States. Image:
Journal of Nursing Scholarship, 27(2), 127–130.
Frey, M. A., & Sieloff, C. L. (1995). Advancing King’s
systems framework and theory of nursing. Thousand
Oaks, CA: Sage.
Funghetto, S. S., Terra, M. G., & Wolff, L. R. (2003).
Woman [sic] with breast cancer: Perception about
the disease, family and society [in Portuguese].
Revista Brasileira de Enfermagem, 56(5), 528–532.
Gemmill, R., Kravits, K., Ortiz, M., Anderson, C., Lai,
L., & Grant, M. (2011). What do surgical oncology
staff nurses know about colorectal cancer ostomy
care? Journal of Continuing Education In Nursing,
42(2), 81–88. doi:10.3928/00220124-20101101-04
George, A., Roach, E., & Andrade, M. (2011). Nursing
education: Opportunities and challenges [online].
Nursing Journal of India, 102(6).
http://tnaionline.org/thenursing.htm
Gianfermi, R. E., & Buchholz, S. W. (2011). Exploring
the relationship between job satisfaction nursing
group outcome attainment capability in nurse ad-
ministrators. Journal of Nursing Management, 19(8),
1012–1019. doi:10.1111/j.1365-2834.2011.01328.x
Goyatá, S., Rossi, L., & Dalri, M. (2006, January–
February). Nursing diagnoses for family members of
adult burned patients near hospital discharge [in
Portuguese]. Revista Latino-Americana de Enfer-
magem, 14(1), 102–109.
148 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 148
Greeff, M., E, E., Strydom, C., Wessels, C., & Schutte,
P. (2009, March). Students’ community health serv-
ice delivery: Experiences of involved parties. Curatio-
nis, 32(1), 33–44.
Gulitz, E. A., & King, I. M. (1988). King’s general sys-
tems model: Application to curriculum development.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 1, 128–132.
Halm, M. A., & Kriski-Hagel, K. (2008). Instilling nor-
mal saline with suctioning: Beneficial technique or
potentially harmful sacred cow? American Journal of
Critical Care, 17(5), 469–472.
Hampton, D. C. (1994). King’s theory of goal attain-
ment as a framework for managed care implementa-
tion in a hospital setting. Nursing Science Quarterly,
7(4), 170–173.
Hanna, K. M. (1995). Use of King’s theory of goal at-
tainment to promote adolescents’ health behavior.
In M. A. Frey & C. L. Sieloff (Eds.), Advancing
King’s systems framework and theory of nursing
(pp. 239–250). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Harih, M., & Pajnkihar, M. (2009). Application of
Imogene M. King’s nursing model in the treatment
of elderly diabetes patients. Slovenian Nursing Re-
view: Journal of the Nurses and Midwives Association of
Slovenia, 43(3), 201–208.
Hernandez, C. A. (2007). The theory of integration:
Congruency with King’s conceptual system. In C. L.
Sieloff & M. A. Frey (Eds.), Middle range theory
development using King’s conceptual system
(pp. 105–124). New York: Springer.
Howland, D., & McDowell, W. (1964). A measurement
of patient care: A conceptual framework. Nursing
Research, 13(4), 320–324.
Husting, P. M. (1997). A transcultural critique of Imo-
gene King’s theory of goal attainment. Journal of
Multicultural Nursing & Health, 3(3), 15–20.
Jonas, C. M. (1987). King’s goal attainment theory: Use
in gerontological nursing practice. Perspectives: Journal
of the Gerontological Nursing Association, 11(4), 9–12.
Joseph, M., Laughon, D., & Bogue, R. J. (2011). An
examination of the sustainable adoption of whole-
person care (WPC). Journal of Nursing
Management, 19(8), 989–997. doi:10.1111/
j.1365-2834.2011.01317.x
Kameoka, T. (1995). Analyzing nurse-patient interac-
tions in Japan. In M. A. Frey & C. L. Sieloff (Eds.),
Advancing King’s systems framework and theory of goal
attainment (pp. 251–260). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Kameoka, T., Funashima, N., & Sugimori, M. (2007). If
goals are attained, satisfaction will occur in nurse-
patient interaction: An empirical test. In C. L. Sieloff
& M. A. Frey (Eds.), Middle range theory development
using King’s conceptual system (pp. 261–272).
New York: Springer.
Kemppainen, J. K. (1990). Imogene King’s theory: A
nursing case study of a psychotic client with human
immunodeficiency virus infection. Archives of Psychi-
atric Nursing, 4(6), 384–388.
Khowaja, D. (2006). Utilization of King’s interacting
systems framework and theory of goal attainment
with new multidisciplinary model: Clinical pathway.
Australian Journal of Advanced Nursing, 24(2), 44–50.
Killeen, M. B. (2007). Development and initial testing
of a theory of patient satisfaction with nursing care.
In C. L. Sieloff & M. A. Frey (Eds.), Middle range
theory development using King’s conceptual system
(pp. 138–163). New York: Springer.
King, I. M. (1964). Nursing theory: Problems and
prospect. Nursing Science, 2(5), 294.
King, I. M. (1968). A conceptual frame of reference for
nursing. Nursing Research, 17, 27–31.
King, I. M. (1971). Toward a theory for nursing: General
concepts of human behavior. New York: Wiley.
King, I. M. (1975). A process for developing concepts for
nursing through research. In P. J. Verhonick (Ed.),
Nursing research (p. 25). Boston: Little, Brown.
King, I. M. (1976). Toward a theory of nursing: General
concepts of human behavior (M. Sugimori, trans.).
Tokyo: Igaku-Shoin.
King, I. M. (1981). A theory of goal attainment: Systems,
concepts, process. New York: Wiley.
King, I. M. (1984). Effectiveness of nursing care: Use of
a goal oriented nursing record in end stage renal dis-
ease. American Association of Nephrology Nurses and
Technicians Journal, 11(2), 11–17, 60.
King, I. M. (1985). A theory for nursing: Systems, concepts,
process (M. Sugimori, trans.). Tokyo: Igaku-Shoin.
King, I. M. (1988). Concepts: Essential elements of the-
ories. Nursing Science Quarterly, 1(1), 22–24.
King, I. M. (1989a). King’s general systems framework
and theory. In J. P. Riehl-Sisca (Ed.), Conceptual
models for nursing practice (pp. 149–158). Norwalk,
CT: Appleton & Lang.
King, I. M. (1989b). King’s systems framework for nurs-
ing administration. In B. Henry (Ed.), Dimensions of
nursing administration: Theory, research, education
(p. 35). Cambridge, England: Blackwell Scientific.
King, I. M. (1990). Health as a goal for nursing. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 3, 123–128.
King, I. M. (1992). King’s theory of goal attainment.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 5, 19–26.
King, I. M. (1995). The theory of goal attainment. In M.
A. Frey & C. L. Sieloff (Eds.), Advancing King’s
systems framework and theory of goal attainment
(pp. 23–32). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
King, I. M. (1996). The theory of goal attainment in
research and practice. Nursing Science Quarterly, 9,
61–66.
King, I. M. (1997). King’s theory of goal attainment in
practice. Nursing Science Quarterly, 10(4), 180–185.
Kobayashi, F. T. (1970). A conceptual frame of refer-
ence for nursing. Japanese Journal of Nursing Research,
3(3), 199–204.
Laben, J. K., Dodd, D., & Sneed, L. (1991). King’s the-
ory of goal attainment applied in group therapy for
inpatient juvenile offenders, maximum security state
offenders, and community parolees, using visual aids.
Issues in Mental Health Nursing, 12(1), 51–64.
Laben, J. K., Sneed, L. D., & Seidel, S. L. (1995). Goal
attainment in short-term group psychotherapy
CHAPTER 9 • Imogene King’s Theory of Goal Attainment 149
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 149
settings: Clinical implications for practice. In M. A.
Frey & C. L. Sieloff (Eds.), Advancing King’s systems
framework and theory of nursing (pp. 261–277).
Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
LaMar, K. (2008). Compass: the direction for professional
nursing development at a tertiary care facility. Journal
for Nurses in Staff Development, 24(4), 155–161.
Langford, R. (2008). Perceptions of transactions with
nurse practitioners and weight loss in obese adoles-
cents. Southern Online Journal of Nursing Research,
8(2). http://www.resourcenter.net/images/SNRS/
Files/SOJNR_articles2/Vol08Num02Main.html
Lehna, C. (2009). “Sibling closeness,” a concept explica-
tion using the hybrid model, in siblings experiencing
a major burn trauma. Southern Online Journal Of
Nursing Research, 9(4).
Li, H., Li, C., & Xu, C. (2010). Review of the develop-
ment of the concept of holistic nursing. Yi Shi Za
Zhi , 40(1), 33-37.
Lockhart, J., & Goodfellow, L. (2009). The effect of a
5-week head & neck surgical oncology on nursing
students’ perceptions of facial disfigurement: Part I.
ORL-Head & Neck Nursing, 27(3), 7–12.
Maloni, H. W. (2007). An intervention to effect hyperten-
sion, glycemic control, diabetes self-management, self-
efficacy, and satisfaction with care in type 2 diabetic VA
health care users with inadequate functional health liter-
acy skills. Doctoral dissertation, the Catholic Univer-
sity of America, Washington, DC. ProQuest
Dissertations and Theses, 258-n/a. Retrieved from
http://search.proquest.com/docview/304885625?
accountid=28148. (304885625)
Mardis, S. (2010). Patients’ perceptions of minimal lift
equipment. Doctoral dissertation, Northern Kentucky
University, Highland Heights. ProQuest Disserta-
tions and Theses, 61. Retrieved from
http://search.proquest.com/docview/251125913?
accountid=28148. (251125913)
Martin, J. P. (1990). Male cancer awareness: Impact of
an employee education program. Oncology Nursing
Forum, 17, 59–64.
May, B. A. (2007). Relationships among basic empathy,
self-awareness, and learning styles of baccalaureate
prenursing students within King’s personal system.
In C. L. Sieloff & M. A. Frey (Eds.), Middle range
theory development using King’s conceptual system
(pp. 164–177). New York: Springer.
McFarland, G. K., & McFarland, E. A. (1997). Nursing
diagnosis and intervention: Planning for patient care.
St. Louis, MO: Mosby-Year Book.
Meleis, A. (2012). Theoretical nursing: Developments and
progress (5th ed.). Philadelphia: Wolters/Kluwer
Health/Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Moorhead, S., Johnson, M., & Maas, M. L. (2013).
Nursing outcomes classification: Measurement of health
outcomes (5th ed.). St. Louis, MO: Mosby.
Murray, R. L. E., & Baier, M. (1996). King’s conceptual
framework applied to a transitional living program.
Perspectives in Psychiatric Care, 32(1), 15–19.
Northrop, F. C. S. (1969). The logic of the sciences and the
humanities. Cleveland, OH: Meridian.
Nwinee, J. (2011). Nwinee Socio-Behavioural Self-Care
Management Nursing Model. West African Journal of
Nursing, 22(1), 91–98.
Ongoco, E. K. P. (2012). Comparison of attitudes and be-
liefs toward obesity of student nurse and non-nursing
students. Doctoral dissertation, California State Uni-
versity, Long Beach). ProQuest Dissertations and
Theses. Retrieved from http://search.proquest.com/
docview/1011639370?accountid=28148
Palmer, J. A. (2006). Nursing implications for older
adult patient education. Plastic Surgical Nursing,
26(4), 189–194.
Pelloso, S. M., & Tavares, M. S. G. (2006). Family
problems and mother’s death [in Portuguese].
Ciencia Cuidado e Saude, 5(Suppl.), 19–25.
Plummer, M., & Molzahn, A. (2009, April). Quality of
life in contemporary nursing theory: A concept
analysis. Nursing Science Quarterly, 22(2), 134–140.
Reed, J. E. F. (2007). Social support and health of older
adults. In C. L. Sieloff & M. A. Frey (Eds.), Middle
range theory development using King’s conceptual system
(pp. 92–104). New York: Springer.
Ritter, K. W. (2008). The benefits of a peer-based
mentor/tutor program for undergraduate students in a
four-year traditional baccalaureate in nursing program.
Northern Kentucky University, Highland Heights).
ProQuest Dissertations and Theses, 56. Retrieved
from http://search.proquest.com/docview/
304829420?accountid=28148 (304829420)
Rooda, L. A. (1992). The development of a conceptual
model for multicultural nursing. Journal of Holistic
Nursing, 10(4), 337–347.
Rooke, L. (1995a). The concept of space in King’s sys-
tems framework: Its implications for nursing. In
M. A. Frey & C. L. Sieloff (Eds.), Advancing King’s
systems framework and theory of nursing (pp. 79–96).
Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Rooke, L. (1995b). Focusing on King’s theory and sys-
tems framework in education by using an experiential
learning model: A challenge to improve the quality of
nursing care. In M. A. Frey & C. L. Sieloff (Eds.),
Advancing King’s systems framework and theory of nurs-
ing (pp. 278–293). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Schreiber, R. (1991). Psychiatric assessment—“A la
King.” Nursing Management, 22(5), 90, 92, 94.
Secrest, J., Iorio, D. H., & Martz, W. (2005). The
meaning of work for nursing assistants who stay in
long-term care. International Journal of Older People
Nursing, 14(8b), 90–97.
Sharts-Hopko, N. C. (2007). A theory of health percep-
tion: Understanding the menopause transition. In
C. L. Sieloff & M. A. Frey (Eds.), Middle range
theory development using King’s conceptual system
(pp. 178–195). New York: Springer.
Sieloff, C. L. (1995). Development of a theory of de-
partmental power. In M. A. Frey & C. L. Sieloff
150 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 150
(Eds.), Advancing King’s systems framework and theory
of nursing (pp. 46–65). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Sieloff, C. L. (2003). Measuring nursing power within
organizations. Journal of Nursing Scholarship, 35(2),
183–187.
Sieloff, C. L. (2007). The theory of group power within
organizations—Evolving conceptualization within
King’s conceptual system. In C. L. Sieloff & M. A.
Frey (Eds.), Middle range theory development using
King’s conceptual system (pp. 196–214). New York:
Springer.
Sieloff, C. L., & Bularzik, A. M. (2011). Group power
through the lens of the 21st century and beyond: fur-
ther validation of the Sieloff-King Assessment of
Group Power within Organizations. Journal Of
Nursing Management, 19(8), 1020–1027.
doi:10.1111/j.1365-2834.2011.01314.x
Sieloff, C., & Dunn, K. (2008, September). Factor vali-
dation of an instrument measuring group power.
Journal of Nursing Measurement, 16(2), 113–124.
Sieloff, C. L., & Frey, M. (2007). Middle range theories
for nursing practice using King’s interacting systems
framework. New York: Springer.
Sivaramalingam, S. (2008). Surgical patients’ percep-
tions of nurse’s roles and responsibilities. Doctoral
dissertation, D’Youville College, Buffalo, NY. Pro-
Quest Dissertations and Theses, 85. Retrieved from
http://search.proquest.com/docview/304324687?
accountid=28148. (304324687)
Smith, M. C. (1988). King’s theory in practice. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 1, 145–146.
Sowell, R. L., & Lowenstein, A. (1994). King’s theory:
A framework for quality; linking theory to practice.
Nursing Connections, 7(2), 19–31.
Spratlen, L. P. (1976). Introducing ethnic-cultural
factors in models of nursing: Some mental health
care applications. Journal of Nursing Education, 15(2),
23–29.
Syzmanski, M. E. (1991). Use of nursing theories in the
care of families with high-risk infants: Challenges
for the future. Journal of Perinatal and Neonatal
Nursing, 4(4), 71–77.
Thomason, D., & Lagowski, L. (2008, December).
Business and leadership. Sustaining a healthy work
force in the 21st century—a model for collaborating
through reciprocation. AAOHN Journal, 56(12),
503–513.
Tritsch, J. M. (1996). Application of King’s theory of
goal attainment and the Carondelet St. Mary’s case
management model. Nursing Science Quarterly, 11(2),
69–73.
Villeneuve, M. J., & Ozolins, P. H. (1991). Sexual
counselling in the neuroscience setting: Theory and
practical tips for nurses. AXON, 12(3), 63–67.
Von Bertalanffy, L. (1968). General system theory.
New York: Braziller.
Wicks, M. N., Rice, M. C., & Talley, C. H. (2007).
Further exploration of family health within the con-
text of chronic obstructive pulmonary disease. In
C. L. Sieloff & M. A. Frey (Eds.), Middle range
theory development using King’s conceptual system
(pp. 215–236). New York: Springer.
Woods, E. C. (1994). King’s theory in practice with
elders. Nursing Science Quarterly, 7(2), 65–69.
Zurakowski, T. L. (2007). Theory of social and interper-
sonal influences on health. In C. L. Sieloff & M. A.
Frey (Eds.), Middle range theory development using
King’s conceptual system (pp. 237–257). New York:
Springer.
CHAPTER 9 • Imogene King’s Theory of Goal Attainment 151
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 151
3312_Ch09_133-152 26/12/14 2:50 PM Page 152
Chapter 10Sister Callista Roy’s
Adaptation Model
PAMELA SENESAC AND
SISTER CALLISTA ROY
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Roy Adaptation Model
Applications of the Theory
Practice Exemplar
Summary
References
153
Introducing the Theorist
Sister Callista Roy is a highly respected nurse
theorist, writer, lecturer, researcher, and
teacher. She is currently Professor and Nurse
Theorist at the Connell School of Nursing at
Boston College. Roy holds concurrent ap-
pointments as Research Professor in Nursing
at her alma mater, Mt. Saint Mary’s College,
Los Angeles, CA, and as Faculty Senior Sci-
entist, Yvonne L. Munn Center for Nursing
Research, Massachusetts General Hospital,
Boston, MA. Roy has been a member of the
Sisters of St. Joseph of Carondolet for more
than 50 years.
Roy is recognized worldwide in the field of
nursing and considered to be among nursing’s
great living thinkers. As a theorist, Roy often
emphasizes her primary commitment to define
and develop nursing knowledge and regards
her work with the Roy adaptation model as a
rich source of knowledge for improving nurs-
ing practice for individuals and for groups.
In the first decade of the 21st century, Roy
provided an expanded, values-based concept
of adaptation based on insights related to the
place of the person in the universe and in so-
ciety. A prolific thinker, educator, and writer,
she has welcomed the contributions of others
in the development of the work; she notes that
her best work is yet to come and likely will be
done by one of her students.
Roy credits the major influences of her fam-
ily, her religious commitment, and her teachers
and mentors in her personal and professional
growth. Born in Los Angeles, California, in
1939, Roy is the oldest daughter of a family of
seven boys and seven girls. A deep spirit of
faith, hope, love, commitment to God, and
Sister Callista Roy
3312_Ch10_153-164 26/12/14 2:53 PM Page 153
service to others was central in the family. Her
mother was a licensed vocational nurse and in-
stilled the values of always seeking to know
more about people and their care and of selfless
giving as a nurse.
Roy was awarded a bachelor of arts degree
with a major in nursing from Mount St. Mary’s
College, Los Angeles; a master’s degree in pe-
diatric nursing and a master’s degree and a PhD
in sociology from the University of California,
Los Angeles. Roy completed a 2-year postdoc-
toral program as a clinical nurse scholar in neu-
roscience nursing at the University of California,
San Francisco. She was a Senior Fulbright
Scholar in Australia. Important mentors in
her life have included Dorothy E. Johnson,
Ruth Wu, Connie Robinson, and Barbara
Smith Moran.
Roy is best known for developing and con-
tinually updating the Roy adaptation model as
a framework for theory, practice, and research
in nursing. Books on the model have been
translated into many languages, including
French, Italian, Spanish, Finnish, Chinese,
Korean, and Japanese. Two publications that
Roy considers significant are The Roy Adapta-
tion Model (Roy, 2009) and Nursing Knowledge
Development and Clinical Practice (Roy &
Jones, 2007). Another important work is a
two-part project analyzing research based on
the Roy adaptation model and using the find-
ings for knowledge development. The first was
a critical analysis of 25 years of model-based
literature, which included 163 studies pub-
lished in 46 English-speaking journals, as well
as dissertations and theses. It was published as
a research monograph by Sigma Theta Tau In-
ternational and entitled The Roy Adaptation
Model-based Research: Twenty-five Years of Con-
tributions to Nursing Science (Boston-Based
Adaptation Research in Nursing Society, 1999).
The research literature of the next 15 years was
analyzed and used to create middle range theo-
ries as evidence for practice. Including 172 stud-
ies and currently in press, this work is entitled
Generating Middle Range Theory: Evidence for
Practice (Buckner & Hayden, in press).
Roy was honored as a Living Legend by the
American Academy of Nursing and the Mas-
sachusetts Association of Registered Nurses.
She has received many other awards, including
the National League for Nursing Martha
Rogers Award for advancing nursing science;
the Sigma Theta Tau International Founders
Award for contributions to professional prac-
tice; and four honorary doctorates. Sigma
Theta Tau International, Honor Society of
Nursing included Roy as an inaugural inductee
to the Nurse Researcher Hall of Fame.1
Overview of the Roy Adaption
Model
The Roy adaptation model (Roy, 1970, 1984,
1988a, 1988b, 2009, 2011a, 2011b, 2014; Roy
& Andrews, 1991, 1999; Roy & Roberts,
1981; Roy, Whetzell & Fredrickson, 2009) has
been in use for more than 40 years, providing
direction for nursing practice, education, and
research. Extensive implementation efforts
around the world and continuing philosophical
and scientific developments by the theorist
have contributed to model-based knowledge
for nursing practice. The purpose of this chap-
ter is to describe the model as the foundation
for knowledge-based practice. The develop-
ments of the model, including assumptions
and major concepts are described. The reader
is introduced to the knowledge that the model
provides as the basis for planning nursing care
along with applications in practice and three
practice exemplars.
Historical Development
Under the mentorship of Dorothy E. Johnson,
Roy first developed a description of the adap-
tation model while a master’s student at the
University of California at Los Angeles. The
first publication on the model appeared in 1970
(Roy, 1970) while Roy was on the faculty of the
baccalaureate nursing program of a small liberal
arts college. There, she had the opportunity to
lead the implementation of this model of nurs-
ing as the basis of the nursing curriculum. Dur-
ing the next decade, more than 1500 faculty
and students at Mount St. Mary’s College
154 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
1For additional information please see the bonus chapter
content available at http://davisplus.fadavis.com
3312_Ch10_153-164 26/12/14 2:53 PM Page 154
helped to clarify, refine, and develop this ap-
proach to nursing. The constant influence of
practice was important during this develop-
ment. One example of data from practice used
in model development was the derivation of
four adaptive modes from 500 samples of pa-
tient behaviors described by nursing students.
The mid-1970s to the mid-1980s saw the
expansion of the use of the model in nursing
education. Roy and the faculty at her home
institution consulted on curriculum in more
than 30 schools across the United States and
Canada. By 1987, it was estimated that more
than 100,000 students had graduated from
curricula based on the Roy model. Theory de-
velopment was also a focus during this time,
and 91 propositions based on the model were
identified. These described relationships be-
tween and among concepts of the regulator
and the cognator and the four adaptive modes
(Roy & Roberts, 1981). In the 1980s, Roy also
was influenced by postdoctoral work in neu-
roscience nursing and an increasing number
of commitments in other countries. Roy fo-
cused on contemporary movements in nursing
knowledge and the continued integration of
spirituality with an understanding of nursing’s
role in promoting adaptation. The first decade
of the 21st century included a greater focus on
philosophy, knowledge for practice, and global
concerns.
Philosophical, Scientific, and Cultural
Assumptions
Assumptions provide the beliefs, values, and
accepted knowledge that form the basis for the
work. For the Roy adaptation model, the con-
cept of adaptation rests on scientific and philo-
sophic assumptions that Roy has developed
over time. The scientific assumptions initially
reflected von Bertalanffy’s (1968) general sys-
tems theory and Helson’s (1964) adaptation-
level theory. Later beliefs about the unity and
meaningfulness of the created universe were in-
cluded (Young, 1986). Early identification of
the philosophic assumptions for the model
named humanism and veritivity. In 1988, Roy
introduced the concept of veritivity as an option
to total relativity. Veritivity was a term coined
by Roy, based on the Latin word veritas. For
Roy, the word offered the notion of the root-
edness of all knowledge being one. Veritivity is
the principle within the Roy Adaptation Model
of human nature that affirms a common pur-
posefulness of human existence. Veritivity is
the affirmation that human beings are viewed
in the context of the purposefulness of their ex-
istence, unity of purpose of humankind, activity
and creativity for the common good, and the
value and meaning of life.
Currently, Roy views the 21st century as a
time of transition, transformation, and need
for spiritual vision. The further development
of the philosophic assumptions focuses on
people’s mutuality with others, the world, and
a God-figure. The development and expansion
of the major concepts of the model show the
influence of the theorist’s scientific and philo-
sophic background and global experiences.
For nursing in the 21st century, Roy (1997)
provided a redefinition of adaptation and a re-
statement of the assumptions that are founda-
tional to the model, which led to expanded
philosophical and scientific assumptions in
contemporary society and to adding cultural
assumptions. These assumptions are listed in
Table 10-1 and further described in the basic
work on the model (Roy, 2009). Roy also uses
the idea of cosmic unity that stresses her vision
for the future and emphasizes the principle
that people and Earth have common patterns
and integral relationships. Rather than the sys-
tem acting to maintain itself, the emphasis
shifts to the purposefulness of human existence
in a creative universe.
Model Concepts
The underlying assumptions of the Roy adap-
tation model are the basis for and are evident
in the specific description of the major con-
cepts of the model. The major concepts include
people as adaptive systems (both individuals
and groups), the environment, health, and the
goal of nursing.
People as Adaptive Systems
Roy describes people, both individually and in
groups, as holistic adaptive systems, complete
with coping processes acting to maintain adap-
tation and to promote person and environment
CHAPTER 10 • Sister Callista Roy’s Adaptation Model 155
3312_Ch10_153-164 26/12/14 2:53 PM Page 155
156 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Philosophic Assumptions
Persons have mutual relationships with the world and the God-figure.
Human meaning is rooted in an omega point convergence of the universe.
God is intimately revealed in the diversity of creation and is the common destiny of creation.
Persons use human creative abilities of awareness, enlightenment, and faith.
Persons are accountable for entering the process of deriving, sustaining, and transforming the
universe.
Scientific Assumptions
Systems of matter and energy progress to higher levels of complex self-organization.
Consciousness and meaning are consistent of person and environment integration.
Awareness of self and environment is rooted in thinking and feeling.
Human decisions are accountable for the integration of creative processes.
Thinking and feeling mediate human action.
System relationships include acceptance, protection, and fostering interdependence.
Persons and the Earth have common patterns and integral relations.
Person and environment transformations created human consciousness.
Integration of human and environment meanings result in adaptation.
Cultural Assumptions
Experiences within a specific culture will influence how each element of the Roy adaptation
model is expressed.
Within a culture, there may be a concept that is central to the culture and will influence some or
all of the elements of the Roy adaptation model to a greater or lesser extent.
Cultural expressions of the elements of the Roy adaptation model may lead to changes in prac-
tice activities such as nursing assessment.
As Roy adaptation model elements evolve within a cultural perspective, implications for educa-
tion and research may differ from experience in the original culture.
Table 10 • 1 Assumptions of the Roy Adaptation Model for the 21st Century
transformations. As with any type of system,
people have internal processes that act to
maintain the integrity of the individual or
group. These processes have been broadly cat-
egorized as a regulator subsystem and a cognator
subsystem for the person related to a stabilizer
subsystem and an innovator subsystem for
the group. The regulator uses physiological
processes such as chemical, neurological, and
endocrine responses to cope with the changing
environment. For example, when an individual
sees a sudden threat, such as an oncoming car
approaching when stepping off the curb, an in-
crease of adrenal hormones provides immedi-
ate energy enabling him or her to escape harm.
The cognator subsystem involves the cognitive
and emotional processes that interact with the
environment. In the example of the individual
who escapes from an oncoming car, the cogna-
tor acts to process the emotion of fear. The per-
son also processes perceptions of the situation
and comes to a new decision about where and
how to cross the street safely.
The coping processes for the group relate to
stability and change. The stabilizer subsystem
has structures, values, and daily activities to
accomplish the primary purpose of the group.
Thus a family group is structured to earn a
living and to provide for the nurturance and ed-
ucation of children. Family values also influence
how the members respond to the environment
to fulfill their responsibilities to maintain the
family. Groups also have processes to respond
to the environment with innovation and change
by way of the innovator subsystem. For exam-
ple, organizations use strategic planning activi-
ties and team-building sessions. When the
innovator is functioning well, the group creates
new goals and growth, achieving new mastery
and transformation. Nurses can use innovator
subsystems to create organizational change in
practice.
3312_Ch10_153-164 26/12/14 2:53 PM Page 156
Both the cognator-regulator and stabilizer-
innovator coping processes are manifested in
four particular ways of adapting in each indi-
vidual and in groups of people. These four
ways of categorizing the effects of coping
activity are called adaptive modes. These four
modes, initially developed for human systems
as individuals, were expanded to encompass
groups. These are termed the physiological–
physical, self-concept–group identity, role func-
tion, and interdependence modes. These four
major categories describe responses to and
interaction with the environment and are how
adaptation can be observed.
For individuals, the physiological mode in the
Roy adaptation model is associated with the
way people as individuals interact as physical
beings with the environment. Behavior in this
mode is the manifestation of the physiological
activities of all the cells, tissues, organs, and
systems comprising the human body. The
physiological mode has nine components: the
five basic needs of oxygenation, nutrition,
elimination, activity and rest, and protection
and four complex processes that are involved
in physiological adaptation, including the
senses; fluid, electrolyte, and acid–base bal-
ance; neurological function; and endocrine
function. The underlying need for the physio-
logical mode is physiological integrity.
The category of behavior related to the
personal aspects of individuals is termed the
self-concept. The basic need underlying the self-
concept mode has been identified as psychic and
spiritual integrity; one needs to know who one
is to be or exist with a sense of unity. Self-
concept is defined as the composite of beliefs
and feelings that a person holds about him- or
herself at a given time. Formed from internal
perceptions and perceptions of others, self-
concept directs one’s behavior. Components of
the self-concept mode are the physical self, in-
cluding body sensation and body image; and
the personal self, including self-consistency,
self-ideal, and moral–ethical–spiritual self.
Processes in the mode are the developing self,
perceiving self, and focusing self.
Behavior relating to positions in society is
termed the role function mode for both the in-
dividual and the group. From the perspective
of the individual, the role function mode focuses
on the roles that the individual occupies in so-
ciety. A role, as the functioning unit of society,
is defined as a set of expectations about how a
person occupying one position behaves toward
a person occupying another position. The basic
need underlying the role function mode for the
individual has been identified as social in-
tegrity, the need to know who one is in rela-
tion to others in order to act. The underlying
processes include developing roles and role
taking.
Behavior related to interdependent rela-
tionships of individuals and groups is the
interdependence mode, the final adaptive mode
Roy describes. For the individual, the mode
focuses on interactions related to the giving
and receiving of love, respect, and value. The
basic need of this mode is termed relational
integrity, the feeling of security in nurturing re-
lationships. Two specific relationships are the
focus within the interdependence mode for the
individual: significant others, persons who are
the most important to the individual, and
support systems, others contributing to meet-
ing interdependence needs. Interdependence
processes include affectional adequacy and de-
velopmental adequacy.
For people in groups it is more appropriate
to use the term physical in referring to the first
adaptive mode. At the group level, this mode
relates to the manner in which the human
adaptive system of the group manifests adap-
tation relative to basic operating resources, that
is, participants, physical facilities, and fiscal re-
sources. The basic need associated with the
physical mode for the group is resource ade-
quacy, or wholeness achieved by adapting to
change in physical resource needs. Processes in
this mode for groups include resource manage-
ment and strategic planning.
Group identity is the relevant term used for
the second mode related to groups. Identity in-
tegrity is the need underlying this group adap-
tive mode. The mode comprises interpersonal
relationships, group self-image, social milieu,
and culture.
A nurse can have a self-concept of seeing self
as physically capable of the work involved. In
addition, the nurse feels comfortable meeting
CHAPTER 10 • Sister Callista Roy’s Adaptation Model 157
3312_Ch10_153-164 26/12/14 2:53 PM Page 157
self-expectations of being a caring professional.
In a social system, such as a nursing care unit,
an associated culture can be described. There is
a social environment experienced by the nurses,
administrators, and other staff that is reflected
by those who are part of the nursing care group.
The group feels shared values and counts on
each other. As such, the self-concept–group iden-
tity mode can reflect adaptive or ineffective be-
haviors associated with an individual nurse or
the nursing care unit as an adaptive system. As
we note later in the chapter, two processes iden-
tified in this mode are group shared identity and
family coherence.
Roles within a group are the vehicles
through which the goals of the social system
are actually accomplished. They are the action
components associated with group infrastruc-
ture. Roles are designed to contribute to the
accomplishment of the group’s mission, or the
tasks or functions associated with the group.
The role function mode includes the functions
of administrators and staff, the management
of information, and systems for decision mak-
ing and maintaining order. The basic need as-
sociated with the group role function mode is
termed role clarity, the need to understand and
commit to fulfil expected tasks, to achieve
common goals. Processes involve socializing
for role expectations, reciprocating roles, and
integrating roles.
For groups, the interdependence mode per-
tains to the social context in which the group
operates. It involves private and public contacts
both within the group and with those outside
the group. The components of group interde-
pendence include context, infrastructure, and
resources. The processes for group interde-
pendence include relational integrity, develop-
mental adequacy, and resource adequacy.
The four adaptive modes are interrelated,
which can be illustrated by drawing the modes
as overlapping circles. The physiological–physical
mode is intersected by each of the other three
modes. Behavior in the physiological–physical
mode can have an effect on or act as a stimulus
for one or all of the other modes. In addition,
a given stimulus can affect more than one
mode, or a particular behavior can be indicative
of adaptation in more than one mode. Such
complex relationships among modes further
demonstrate the holistic nature of humans as
adaptive systems. The adaptive modes and
coping processes for individuals and groups of
individuals are described by the Roy adapta-
tion model (Roy, 2009).
Environment
The Roy adaptation model defines environ-
ment as all the conditions, circumstances, and
influences surrounding and affecting the de-
velopment and behavior of individuals and
groups. Given the model’s view of the place of
the person in the evolving universe, environ-
ment is a biophysical community of beings
with complex patterns of interaction, feedback,
growth, and decline, constituting periodic and
long-term rhythms. Individual and environ-
mental interactions are input for the individual
or group as adaptive systems. This input in-
volves both internal and external factors. Roy
used the work of Helson (1964), a physiolog-
ical psychologist, to categorize these factors as
focal, contextual, and residual stimuli.
The focal is the stimulus most immediately
confronting the individual and holding the
focus of attention; contextual stimuli are those
factors also acting in the situation; and resid-
ual are possible factors that as yet have an
unknown affect. A specific internal input
stimulus is an adaptation level that represents
the individual’s or group’s coping capacities.
This changing level of ability has an internal
effect on adaptive behaviors. Roy defined
three levels of adaptation: integrated, com-
pensatory, and compromised. Integrated adap-
tation occurs when the structures and functions
of the adaptive modes are working as a whole
to meet human needs. The compensatory adap-
tation level occurs when the cognator and
regulator or stabilizer and innovator are acti-
vated by a challenge. Compromised adaptation
occurs when integrated and compensatory
processes are inadequate, creating an adapta-
tion problem.
Health
Roy’s concept of health is related to the con-
cept of adaptation and the idea that adaptive
responses promote integrity. Individuals and
158 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch10_153-164 26/12/14 2:53 PM Page 158
groups are viewed as adaptive systems that
interact with the environment and grow,
change, develop, and flourish. Health is the re-
flection of personal and environmental inter-
actions that are adaptive. According to the Roy
adaptation model, health is defined as (1) a
process, (2) a state of being, and (3) becoming
whole and integrated in a way that reflects in-
dividual and environment mutuality.
Goal of Nursing
When Roy began her theoretical work, the
goal of nursing was the first major concept of
her nursing model to be described. She began
by attempting to identify the unique function
of nursing in promoting health. As a number
of health-care workers have the goal of pro-
moting health, it seemed important to iden-
tify a unique goal for nursing. While she was
working as a staff nurse in pediatric settings,
Roy noted the great resiliency of children in
responding to major physiological and psy-
chological changes. Yet nursing intervention
was needed to support and promote this pos-
itive coping. It seemed, then, that the con-
cept of adaptation, or positive coping, might
be used to describe the goal or function of
nursing. From this initial notion, Roy devel-
oped a description of the goal of nursing: the
promotion of adaptation for individuals and
groups in each of the four adaptive modes,
thus contributing to health, quality of life,
and dying with dignity.
Basis for Practice—Theory and Process
The assumptions and concepts of the model
provide the basis for theory building for
nursing practice, as well as a specific ap-
proach to the nursing process. As early as
the 1970s, human life processes and patterns
were identified as the common focus of
nursing knowledge (Donaldson & Crowley,
1978). In a more recent article, a central uni-
fying focus of nursing has extended this view
to include nursing concepts categorized as fa-
cilitating humanization, meaning, choice,
quality of life, and healing, living, and dying
(Willis, Grace, & Roy, 2008). Adaptation is
a significant life process that leads to these
ideals.
Theory Development for Practice
To lead to middle-range theories within the
model, Roy identified the major life processes
within each adaptive mode. For example, in
the physiological mode, there are processes
and patterns for the need for oxygenation that
include ventilation, patterns of gas exchange,
transport of gases, and compensation for inad-
equate oxygenation. Similarly, the self-concept
mode has three processes identified to meet the
person’s need for psychic and spiritual in-
tegrity: the developing self, the perceiving self,
and the focusing self. On the group level, two
examples of processes identified to meet the
need for a shared self-image are group shared
identity and family coherence. The group iden-
tity mode reflects how people in groups perceive
themselves based on environmental feedback
about the group. Persons in a group have per-
ceptions about their shared relations, goals,
and values. The social milieu and the culture
provide feedback for the group. The social mi-
lieu refers to the human-made environment in
which the group is embedded, including eco-
nomic, political, religious, and family struc-
tures. Ethnicity and socioeconomic status in
particular make up the social culture, a specific
part of the milieu or environment of the group.
The belief systems of the milieu and social
culture act as stimuli for the group and also affect
other groups with which the group interacts. The
family is most often the first group with which a
person identifies. The group self-image and
shared responsibility for goal achievement is
central to group identity. Identity integrity is the
basic need underlying the group identity mode.
Nursing care uses the understanding of these
processes to evaluate the adaptation level and to
provide care to promote integrated processes at
the highest level of adaptation possible.
To develop knowledge for practice from the
grand theory, Roy described a five-step process
for developing middle or practice level theory
and nursing knowledge:
1. Select a life process.
2. Study the life process in the literature and
in people.
3. Develop an intervention strategy to en-
hance the life process.
CHAPTER 10 • Sister Callista Roy’s Adaptation Model 159
3312_Ch10_153-164 26/12/14 2:53 PM Page 159
4. Derive a proposition for practice.
5. Test the proposition in research.
Processes can also be identified by using
qualitative research to identify and describe
human experiences.
Nursing Process for Care
The nursing process based on the model stems
from the assumptions and concepts of the
model. First-level assessment of behavior in-
volves gathering data about the behavior of the
person or group as an adaptive system in each
of the adaptive modes. Second-level assess-
ment is the assessment of stimuli, that is, the
identification of internal and external stimuli
that influence the adaptive behaviors. Stimuli
are classified as focal, contextual, and residual.
The nurse uses the first- and second-level as-
sessment to make a nursing judgment called a
nursing diagnosis. In collaboration with the
person or group, the data are interpreted in
statements about the adaptation status of the
person, including behavior and most relevant
stimuli. The adaptation level is then classified
as integrated, compensatory, or compromised.
Also, in collaboration with the person or
group, the nurse sets goals, establishing clear
statements of the behavioral outcomes for nurs-
ing care. Interventions then involve the deter-
mination of how best to assist the person in
attaining the established goals. These may in-
volve changing stimuli or strengthening coping
ability. The aim is to promote an integrated
adaptation level. Evaluation involves judging the
effectiveness of the nursing intervention in rela-
tion to the resulting behavior in comparison with
the goal established. The steps of the nursing
process have been given in sequential order;
however, the process is ongoing and the steps
can be simultaneous. For example, the nurse
may be intervening in one adaptive mode and
assessing in another at the same time.
Applications of the Theory
Senesac (2003) reviewed published projects
that have implemented the Roy adaptation
model in institutional practice settings and
identified seven distinct projects ranging from
an ideology basis for a single unit to hospital-
wide projects. In some cases the published proj-
ect developed from a unit implementation to a
full agency implementation, as in one of the
early projects reported by Mastal et al. (1982).
Gray (1991) discussed involvement in five proj-
ects. She reported that not all implementation
projects were completed due to changes in hos-
pital management, philosophy, or direction.
Gray’s initial work was at a 132-bed acute
care, not-for-profit children’s hospital. Other
projects varied from a 100-bed proprietary hos-
pital to a 248-bed nonprofit, community-owned
hospital. The main focus of the implementation
projects was to improve patient care through
quality nursing care plans and in some cases to
develop performance standards. Two implemen-
tation projects in Colombia were reported on by
Moreno-Ferguson and Alvarado-Garcia (2009).
One project was in an ambulatory rehabilitation
service (Moreno-Ferguson, 2001) and the other
a pediatric intensive care unit of a cardiology in-
stitute (Monroy, 2003). As hospitals in the
United States work toward certification of Mag-
net Status, more nursing groups are requesting
information about application of the Roy adap-
tation model in institutional health-care settings.
160 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Practice Exemplar
Family coherence is an indicator of positive
adaptation and refers to a state of unity or a
consistent sequence of thought that connects
family members who share group identity,
goals, and values (Roy, 2009). When interact-
ing with families of other cultures, health-care
providers need to assess cultural norms and be-
liefs that determine patterns of interaction with
the health and social services system, health-
care decision making, the availability of social
support for caregivers, and may have implica-
tions for the psychosocial experience of family
caregivers and the clients. Roy’s group identity
mode provides a useful conceptual framework
that guides health-care providers working with
families of diverse ethnic backgrounds.
3312_Ch10_153-164 26/12/14 2:53 PM Page 160
CHAPTER 10 • Sister Callista Roy’s Adaptation Model 161
Practice Exemplar cont.
Introduction to the Practice
Exemplar—the Wang Family
The Wang family includes David Wang; his
wife, Teresa Wang; their 7-year old daughter,
Vivian Wang; and extended family including
David’s mother, Uncle Frank Wang; his
daughter Lisa Wang, 32; and her husband
and their 5-year-old son (Zhan, 2003).
David’s parents immigrated to the United
States when he was ten years old. The Wang
family opened a small Chinese restaurant,
which David has managed since his father’s
retirement. David’s parents participate regu-
larly in activities organized by Chinatown’s
Council on Aging.
David and his parents have a shared self-
image as Chinese immigrants and a shared
group identity as the Wang family. The Wang
family shares a strong cultural commitment to
the value of filial piety. To family members,
this means to be good to one’s parents and
take care of them; to engage in good conduct
and bring a good name to parents and ances-
tors; to perform one’s job well to support par-
ents and carry out sacrifices to the ancestors;
and to show love, respect, and support. The
term filial denotes the respect and obedience
that a child, primarily a son, should show to
his parents, especially to his father.
David’s father suffered a stroke and died at
the age of 78. His mother began to show de-
cline in memory, experiencing difficulty find-
ing her way in familiar places, misplacing
objects, becoming disoriented and easily irri-
tated. David took his mother for a physical
examination; she was diagnosed as having
dementia and referred to a specialist. Recog-
nizing that his mother was unable to live
independently, David arranged for her to live
with his family. David and his wife took on
the family caregiver role while trying to keep
their respective jobs. David’s cousin visited
them regularly and helped with household
chores. David was glad that he was able to
keep the family together despite the passing of
his father and the cognitive impairment of his
mother.
David provides primary financial support
for his family. As his mother’s cognitive func-
tion deteriorated, David became overwhelmed
by caring for his mother while being respon-
sible for managing the restaurant. His wife
quit her job to attend to her mother-in-law’s
care. When David and his wife tried to find
someone in the Chinese community to pro-
vide respite care for their mother, they heard
some strong negative reactions. Some consid-
ered his mother’s dementia as “insanity” or “a
mental disorder.” Some talked about dementia
as contagious or believed his mother’s demen-
tia was being caused by bad Feng Shui, an an-
cient Chinese belief in which Feng (the force
of wind) and Shui (the flow of water) are
viewed as living energies that flow around
one’s home and affect one’s life and well-
being. If Feng Shui flows gently and peacefully,
it brings happiness and health to one’s family.
If Feng Shui stagnates, one can be ill, poor, and
unfortunate (Beattie, 2000). The perception
of dementia triggered a strong negative re-
sponse from the Chinese community, and his
mother’s friends stopped visiting her. David’s
daughter began to miss school, and her grades
were declining. Both David and his wife were
feeling overwhelmed and depressed.
Analysis of the Practice Exemplar
In the case of the Wang family, the focus of
nursing practice is on the relational system of
the family. To begin planning nursing care,
the family is addressed as an adaptive system.
Assessment of behaviors
The nurse met with David and Teresa to assess
family structure, function, relationships, and
consistency, and their employment status, liv-
ing arrangements, and the division of family
caregiving responsibilities. The nurse assessed
how decisions are made in the family, from
small daily decisions to larger, health-care-
related decisions. The nurse observed that
David and his wife show love, respect, and
loyalty to David’s mother and to each other.
Although the mother’s needs for care are met,
individual needs of both David and his wife,
Continued
3312_Ch10_153-164 26/12/14 2:53 PM Page 161
162 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Practice Exemplar cont.
Teresa are unmet. Alternating care for David’s
mother, maintaining their jobs, and attending
to Vivian’s schoolwork and growth needs is
challenging. The nurse finds out that the
Wang family holds a strong Chinese tradition
of filial piety and that they feel a moral obliga-
tion to take care of their mother. The strong
stigma attached to dementia in the Chinese
community takes an emotional toll on them.
Assessment of stimuli
The nurse conducts a second level of assess-
ment by meeting with the extended Wang
family to identify influencing factors, or stim-
uli, related to group identity and family coher-
ence. The major stimuli are the demands they
face and the problems posed for them to solve.
David’s mother requires medical and personal
care. David needs to work to ensure health in-
surance for his family and to secure income
to pay for the cost of personal care. Finding
Chinese-speaking home health aides is chal-
lenging. The social stigma toward dementia is
strong in the Chinese community, bringing
shame to the Wang family and isolating
David’s mother from her ethnic community.
The Wang family agrees that the stigma and
reaction from the external social environment
have become stressors to family caregiving.
Nursing diagnosis
The nurse identifies three tentative diagnoses.
First, the Wang family has a strong ethnic her-
itage related to the group’s responsibility to
maintain values and goals. Second, family con-
flict exists as the demands of family caregiving
for the mother increase. Third, strong stigma
attached to dementia in the Chinese commu-
nity creates prejudice against the Wang family
and causes some family members to feel dis-
tressed and ambivalent.
The nurse continues to assess behaviors of
shared identity and cohesion in the Wang
family, looking for common perceptions, feel-
ings, and experiences of caregiving for the
loved one with dementia. The nurse learns that
David, as the only son, has a moral responsi-
bility to care for his mother and considers
himself solely responsible. The nurse asks each
member of the Wang family to find common
orientations by sharing their thinking and feel-
ings. David and his wife openly share their
feelings and frustrations. Lisa and her father
express their willingness to share responsibility
and help out.
Goal setting
At the next meeting, the nurse helps the
Wang family set up attainable short-term
goals based on shared cognitive and emotional
orientations and common values. Attaining
goals requires shared responsibilities and some
division of labor. Their goals include (1) work-
ing together with home health aides; (2) sup-
porting each other through shared feelings and
thoughts and the shared responsibilities of
caregiving based on each individual’s desire,
skill, and availability; and (3) communicating
with the Chinese community about the stigma
toward dementia and finding ways to demys-
tify dementia.
The Wang family decides to have Lisa
Chang, a social worker in a community hospi-
tal, lead the search for home health aides.
David Wang convenes family meetings as
needed, and Frank Wang leads the talk with
key players in the Chinese community. Despite
the stressors they have encountered, family
members feel a sense of unity through com-
pensatory adaptation process.
Intervention
Nursing intervention involves focusing on the
stimuli affecting the behavior and managing
the stimuli by altering, increasing, or decreas-
ing, removing, or maintaining stimuli. The
nurse (1) assesses the Wang family with re-
spect to shared values, shared goals, shared re-
lations, group identify, and social environment
and stimuli; (2) works with the Wang family
to write down shared goals, values, and expec-
tations; and (3) encourages the family to ex-
plore additional resources. The nurse also helps
the Wang family to use effective coping strate-
gies to strengthen compensatory processes by
acknowledging that the family is transcending
the crisis, identifying additional resources in
support of family caregiving, and by reinforc-
ing their shared goals, values, relations, and
group identity.
3312_Ch10_153-164 26/12/14 2:53 PM Page 162
CHAPTER 10 • Sister Callista Roy’s Adaptation Model 163
Practice Exemplar cont.
Evaluation
The nurse evaluates the effectiveness of the
nursing intervention. Lisa Chang called her
social work network and found appropriate
home health aides to provide personal care to
David’s mother. This allows David to attend
to his work and allows his wife to spend more
time with their daughter, attending to her
schoolwork and personal needs. Vivian has not
been absent from school again.
David Wang hired a manager to help op-
erate the restaurant so that he has time to take
his mother to appointments and to maintain
a stable income. David’s mother’s old friend
visited her briefly. Frank Wang, an activist in
the Chinese community, began to talk with
other Chinese about dementia.
The strong stigma attached to dementia
in the Chinese community influenced the
adaptation problem experienced by the
Wang family. Social stigma can be pervasive,
distorting the perceptions of individuals,
affecting the perception of a disease and how
a dementia diagnosis and services are sought,
and how caregiving is supported. To reduce
stigma in promotion of effective adaptation
of family caregivers and health-care providers,
families and the community need to work
together toward better understanding of
dementia, its diagnosis, treatment, and care
options. Educational and service outreach is
the first step to reduce the stigma in the
Chinese community. Educational materials
and service need to be linguistically appropri-
ate and adaptable to Chinese patients and
their families. Elderly Chinese immigrants
often read Chinese newspapers to connect
themselves to their culture and people. Pub-
lishing dementia information and related
educational articles in widely circulated
Chinese newspapers is a way to reach out to
Chinese families. Bilingual professional staff
and linguistically appropriate oral and written
instructions on dementia are helpful (Valle,
1998).
Reprinted from: Roy, C. & Zhan, l. (2010).
Sister Callista Roy’s Adaptation Model. In Nurs-
ing Theories and Nursing Practice (3rd. Ed.).
■ Summary
This chapter focused on the Roy adaptation
model as a foundation for knowledge-based
practice. The background of the theorist and
the historical development of the model were
presented briefly. Roy’s most recent theoretical
developments were the main focus of the de-
scription of the model assumptions and major
concepts (. The process for theory becoming
the basis for developing knowledge for practice
was introduced by outlining how to develop
middle- and practice-level theory that is tested
in research. In particular, the effects of the Roy
adaptation model on practice were articulated
from a general summary of major practice
projects and through a practice exemplar. The
exemplar illustrates the use of the self-identity
adaptive mode as an example of using theory-
based knowledge to provide care for a Chinese
family dealing with a parent diagnosed with
dementia.
References
Beattie, A. (2000). Using Feng Shui. Vancouver:
Raincoast Books.
Boston-Based Adaptation Research in Nursing Society.
(1999). Roy adaptation model-based research: 25 years
of contributions to nursing science. Indianapolis, IN:
Centre Nursing Press.
Buckner, E. B., & Hayden, S. (2014). Synthesis of
middle range theory of adapting in chronic health
conditions. In C. Roy with the Roy Adaptation
Association, Generating middle range theory: Evidence
for practice (pp. 277–308). New York, NY: Springer
Publishing Company.
3312_Ch10_153-164 26/12/14 2:53 PM Page 163
Donaldson, S. K., & Crowley, D. (1978). The discipline
of nursing. Nursing Outlook, 26, 113–120.
Gray, J. (1991). The Roy adaptation model in nursing
practice. In C. Roy & H. A. Andrews (Eds.),
The Roy adaptation model: The definitive statement
(pp. 429–443). Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Helson, H. (1964). Adaptation level theory. New York:
Harper & Row.
Mastal, M. F., Hammond, H., & Roberts, M. P.
(1982). Theory into hospital practice: A pilot imple-
mentation. The Journal of Nursing Administration, 12,
9–15.
Monroy, P. (2003). Aproximación a la experiencia de
aplicación del Modelo de Callista Roy en la Unidad
de cuidado intensivo pediátrico. Enfermería Hoy,
1(1), 17–20.
Moreno-Ferguson, M. E. (2001). Aplicacion del modelo
de adaptacion en un servicio de rehabilitacion ambu-
latoria, Aquichan, 1(1), 14–17.
Moreno-Ferguson, M. E., & Alvardo-Garcia, A. M.
(2009). Aplicacion del modelo de adaptacion de
Callista Roy en Latinoamerica: Revision de la
literatura. Aquichan, 9(1), 62–72.
Roy, C. (1970). Adaptation: A conceptual framework
for nursing. Nursing Outlook, 18, 42–45.
Roy, C. (1984). Introduction to nursing: An adaptation
model (2nd ed.). Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-
Hall.
Roy, C. (1988a). Altered cognition: An information
processing approach. In P. H. Mitchell, L. C.
Hodges, M. Muwaswes, & C. A. Walleck (Eds.),
AANN’s neuroscience nursing, phenomenon and practice:
Human responses to neurological health problems (pp.
185–211). Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Roy, C. (1988b). Human information processing. In J. J.
Fitzpatrick, R. L. Taunton, & J. Q. Benoliel (Eds.),
Annual review of nursing research (pp. 237–261).
New York: Springer.
Roy, C. (1997). Knowledge as universal cosmic imperative.
Proceedings of nursing knowledge impact conference
1996 (pp. 95–118). Chestnut Hill, MA: Boston
College Press.
Roy, C. (2009). The Roy adaptation model (3rd ed.).
Upper Saddle River, NJ: Prentice-Hall Health.
Roy, S. C. (2011a). Extending the Roy adaptation model
to meet changing global needs. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 24(4), 345–351. nsq.sagepub.com
Roy, S. C. (2011b). Research based on the Roy adapta-
tion model: Last 25 years. Nursing Science Quarterly,
24(4), 312–320. nsq.sagepub.com
Roy, C.with the RAA. (Ed.). (2014). Generating middle
range theory: Evidence for practice. New York, NY:
Springer Publishing Company.
Roy, C., & Andrews, H. A. (1991). The Roy adaptation
model: The definitive statement. East Norwalk, CT:
Appleton & Lange.
Roy, C., & Andrews, H. A. (1999). The Roy adaptation
model (2nd ed.). Stamford, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Roy, C., & Jones, D. (Eds.). (2007). Nursing knowledge
development and clinical practice. New York: Springer.
Roy, C., & Roberts, S. (1981). Theory construction in
nursing: An adaptation model. Englewood Cliffs, NJ:
Prentice-Hall.
Roy, C., Whetsell, M.V., & Frederickson, K. (2009).The
Roy adaptation model and research: Global Perspec-
tive Nursing Science Quarterly, 22(3), 209–211.
Senesac, P. (2003). Implementing the Roy adaptation
model: From theory to practice. Roy Adaptation
Association Review, 4(2), 5.
Valle, R. (1998). Caregiving across cultures: Working with
dementing illness and ethnically diverse populations.
Boca Raton, FL: Taylor & Francis.
von Bertalanffy, L. (1968). General system theory: Foun-
dations, development, applications. New York: George
Braziller.
Willis, D., Grace, P., & Roy, C. (2008). A central uni-
fying focus for the discipline: Facilitating humaniza-
tion, meaning, choice, quality of life and healing in
living and dying. Advances in Nursing Science, 31(1),
E28–40. Retrieved from www.advancesinnursing-
science.com
Young, L. B. (1986). The unfinished universe. New York:
Simon & Schuster.
Zhan, L. (2003). Asian Americans: Vulnerable population,
model intervention, and clarifying agendas. Sudbury,
MA: Jones and Bartlett.
164 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch10_153-164 26/12/14 2:53 PM Page 164
Chapter 11Betty Neuman’s Systems
Model
LOIS WHITE LOWRY AND
PATRICIA DEAL AYLWARD
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Neuman Systems Model
Applications of the Theory
Practice Exemplar
Summary
References
165
Introducing the Theorist
Betty Neuman developed the Neuman systems
model (NSM) in 1970 to “provide unity, or a
focal point, for student learning” (Neuman,
2002b, p. 327) at the School of Nursing, Uni-
versity of California at Los Angeles (UCLA).
Neuman recognized the need for educators
and practitioners to have a framework to view
nursing comprehensively within various con-
texts. Although she developed the model
strictly as a teaching aid, it is now used globally
as a nursing conceptual model to guide cur-
riculum development, research studies, and
clinical practice in the full array of health-care
disciplines.
Neuman’s autobiography, touched on
briefly here, is presented more fully in the lat-
est edition of her book focusing on the model
(Neuman & Fawcett, 2011). Neuman was
born in southeastern Ohio on a 100-acre fam-
ily farm on September 11, 1924. Her father
died at age 37 when she was 11, and she, her
mother, and two brothers worked hard to keep
the farm.
Neuman idealized nursing because her fa-
ther had praised nurses during his 6 years of
intermittent hospitalizations. In gratitude, she
developed a strong commitment to become an
excellent bedside nurse. She also attributed her
decisions about her life’s work to the important
influence of her mother’s charity experiences
as a self-taught rural midwife.
Betty Neuman graduated from high school
soon after the onset of World War II. Al-
though she had dreamed of attending nearby
Marietta College, she lacked the financial
means and instead became an aircraft instru-
ment repair technician. After the Cadet Nurse
Betty Neuman
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:57 PM Page 165
Corps Program became available, she entered
the 3-year diploma nurse program at People
Hospital, Akron, Ohio (currently General
Hospital Medical Center).
She completed her baccalaureate degree in
nursing and earned a master’s degree, with a
major in public health nursing, from UCLA.
During her master’s program, she worked on
special projects, as a relief psychiatric head
nurse and as a volunteer crisis counselor. Be-
cause of these experiences, Neuman became
one of the first California Nurse Licensed
Clinical Fellows of the American Association
of Marriage and Family Therapy.
In 1967, Neuman became a faculty member
at UCLA and assumed the role of chair of the
program from which she had graduated. She
expanded the master’s program, focusing on
interdisciplinary practice in community mental
health.
In 1970, she developed the NSM as a guide
for graduate nursing students. The model was
first published in the May–June 1972 issue of
Nursing Research. Since 1980, several impor-
tant changes have enhanced the model. A
nursing process format was designed, and in
1989, Neuman introduced the concepts of the
created environment and the spiritual variable.
In collaboration with Dr. Audrey Koertve-
lyessy, Neuman developed a theory of client
system stability. Along with the Neuman Sys-
tems Trustees Group, she continues to clarify
concepts and components of the model.
Neuman completed a doctoral degree in clin-
ical psychology in 1985 from Pacific Western
University. She received honorary doctorates
from Neumann College in Aston, Pennsylvania,
and Grand Valley State University in Allendale,
Michigan. She is an honorary fellow in the
American Academy of Nursing.
Overview of the Neuman
Systems Model
The philosophic base of the Neuman Systems
Model encompasses wholism, a wellness orienta-
tion, client perception and motivation, and a dy-
namic systems perspective of energy and variable
interaction with the environment to mitigate
possible harm from internal and external stres-
sors, while caregivers and clients form a partner-
ship relationship to negotiated desired outcome
goals for optimal health retention, restoration,
and maintenance. This philosophic base pervades
all aspects of the model.
—BETTY NEUMAN (2002c, p. 12)
As its name suggests, the Neuman systems
model is classified as a systems model or a sys-
tems category of knowledge. Neuman (1995)
defined system as a pervasive order that holds
together its parts. With this definition in
mind, she writes that nursing can be readily
conceptualized as a complete whole, with
identifiable smaller wholes or parts. The com-
plete whole structure is maintained by interre-
lationships among identifiable smaller wholes
or parts through regulations that evolve out of
the dynamics of the open system. In the system
there is dynamic energy exchange, moving ei-
ther toward or away from stability. Energy
moves toward negentropy, or evolution, as a
system absorbs energy to increase its organiza-
tion, complexity, and development when it
moves toward a steady or wellness state. An
open system of energy exchange is never at
rest. The open system tends to move cyclically
toward differentiation and elaboration for fur-
ther growth and survival of the organism.
With the dynamic energy exchange, the sys-
tem can also move away from stability. Energy
can move toward extinction (entropy) by grad-
ual disorganization, increasing randomness,
and energy dissipation.
The NSM illustrates a client–client system
and presents nursing as a discipline concerned
primarily with defining appropriate nursing
actions in stressor-related situations or in pos-
sible reactions of the client–client system. The
client and environment may be positively or
negatively affected by each other. There is a
tendency within any system to maintain a
steady state or balance among the various dis-
ruptive forces operating within or upon it.
Neuman has identified these forces as stressors
and suggests that possible reactions and actual
reactions with identifiable signs or symptoms
may be mitigated through appropriate early in-
terventions (Neuman, 1995).
166 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:57 PM Page 166
Unique Perspectives of the Neuman
Systems Model
Neuman (2002c, p. 14; 2011a, p. 14) has iden-
tified 10 unique perspectives inherent within
her model. They describe, define, and connect
concepts essential to understanding the con-
ceptual model that is presented in the next sec-
tion of this chapter.
1. Each individual client or group as a client
system is unique; each system is a compos-
ite of common known factors or innate
characteristics within a normal, given
range of response contained within a basic
structure.
2. The client as a system is in a dynamic, con-
stant energy exchange with the environment.
3. Many known, unknown, and universal en-
vironmental stressors exist. Each differs in
its potential for disturbing a client’s usual
stability level, or normal line of defense.
The particular interrelationships of client
variables—physiological, psychological, so-
ciocultural, developmental, and spiritual—
at any point in time can affect the degree
to which a client is protected by the flexi-
ble line of defense against possible reaction
to a single stressor or a combination of
stressors.
4. Each individual client–client system has
evolved a normal range of response to the
environment that is referred to as a normal
line of defense, or usual wellness/stability
state. It represents change over time through
coping with diverse stress encounters. The
normal line of defense can be used as a
standard from which to measure health
deviation.
5. When the cushioning, accordion-like ef-
fect of the flexible line of defense is no
longer capable of protecting the client–
client system against an environmental
stressor, the stressor breaks through the
normal line of defense. The interrelation-
ships of variables—physiological, psycho-
logical, sociocultural, developmental, and
spiritual—determine the nature and degree
of system reaction or possible reaction to
the stressor.
6. The client, whether in a state of wellness or
illness, is a dynamic composite of the inter-
relationships of variables—physiological,
psychological, sociocultural, developmental,
and spiritual. Wellness is on a continuum
of available energy to support the system in
an optimal state of system stability.
7. Implicit within each client system are in-
ternal resistance factors known as lines of
resistance, which function to stabilize and
return the client to the usual wellness
state (normal line of defense) or possibly
to a higher level of stability after an envi-
ronmental stressor reaction.
8. Primary prevention relates to general
knowledge that is applied in client assess-
ment and intervention in identification
and reduction or mitigation of possible
or actual risk factors associated with envi-
ronmental stressors to prevent possible
reaction. The goal of health promotion
is included in primary prevention.
9. Secondary prevention relates to sympto-
matology after a reaction to stressors,
appropriate ranking of intervention
priorities, and treatment to reduce their
noxious effects.
10. Tertiary prevention relates to the adaptive
processes taking place as reconstitution
begins and maintenance factors move the
client back in a circular manner toward
primary prevention.
The Conceptual Model
Neuman’s original diagram of her model is illus-
trated in Figure 11-1. The conceptual model was
developed to explain the client–client system as
an individual person for the discipline of nursing.
Neuman chose the term client to show respect for
collaborative relationships that exist between the
client and the caregiver in Neuman’s model, as
well as the wellness perspective of the model. The
model can be applied to an individual, a group,
a community, or a social issue and is appropri-
ate for nursing and other health disciplines
(Neuman, 1995, 2002c, 2011a, p.15).
The NSM provides a way of looking at the
domain of nursing: humans, environment,
health, and nursing.
CHAPTER 11 • Betty Neuman’s Systems Model 167
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 167
168 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Stressors
Identified
Classified as knowns
or possibilities, i.e.,
Loss
Pain
Sensory deprivation
Cultural change
Inter
Intra
Extra
Personal
factors
Stressors
More than one stressor
could occur
simultaneously*
Same stressors could vary
as to impact or reaction
Normal defense line varies
with age and development
Basic structure
Basic factors common to
all organisms, i.e.:
Normal temperature
range
Genetic structure
Response pattern
Organ strength or
weakness
Ego structure
Knowns or commonalities
StressorStressor
Reaction
BASIC
STRUCTURE
ENERGY
RESOURCES
Reconstitution
Could begin at any degree
or level of reaction
Range of possibility may
extend beyond normal line
of defense
Primary prevention
Reduce possibility of
encounter with stressors
Strengthen flexible line
of defense
Inter
Intra
Extra
Personal
factors
Inter
Intra
Extra
Personal
factors
Secondary prevention
Early case-finding and
Treatment of symptoms
Tertiary prevention
Readaptation
Reeducation to prevent
future occurrences
Maintenance of stability
Reaction
Individual intervening
variables, i.e.:
Basic structure
idiosyncrasies
Natural and learned
resistance
Time of encounter
with stressor
*Physiological, psychological,
sociocultural, developmental, and
spiritual variables are considered
simultaneously in each client
concentric circle.
NOTE:
Interventions
Can occur before or after resistance
lines are penetrated in both reaction
and reconstitution phases
Interventions are based on:
Degree of reaction
Resources
Goals
Anticipated outcome
Fle
xible Line of Defense
No
rmal Line of Defense
Li
nes of Resistance
Degree of
Reaction
R
econstitution
Fig 11 • 1 The Neuman systems model. (Original diagram copyright 1970 by Betty Neuman. A holistic
view of a dynamic open client–client system interacting with environmental stressors, along with client
and caregiver collaborative participation in promoting an optimum state of wellness.) (From Neuman, 1995,
p. 17, with permission.)
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 168
Client–Client System
The client–client system (see Fig. 11-1) con-
sists of the flexible line of defense, the nor-
mal line of defense, lines of resistance, and
the basic structure energy resources (shown
at the core of the concentric circles in
Fig. 11-2). Five client variables—physiological,
psychological, sociocultural, developmental, and
spiritual—occur and are considered simulta-
neously in each concentric circle that makes
up the client–client system (Neuman, 1995,
2002c, 2011a).
Flexible Line of Defense
Stressors must penetrate the flexible line of de-
fense before they are capable of penetrating the
rest of the client system. Neuman described
this line of defense as accordion-like in func-
tion. The flexible line of defense acts like a pro-
tective buffer system to help prevent stressor
invasion of the client system and protects the
normal line of defense. The client has more
protection from stressors when the flexible line
expands away from the normal line of defense.
The opposite is true when the flexible line
moves closer to the normal line of defense. The
effectiveness of the buffer system can be re-
duced by single or multiple stressors. The flex-
ible line of defense can be rapidly altered over
a relatively short time period by states of emer-
gency, or short-term conditions, such as loss of
sleep, poor nutrition, or dehydration (Neuman,
1995, 2002c; 2011a, p. 17). Consider the latter
examples. What are the effects of short-term
loss of sleep, poor nutrition, or dehydration on
a client’s normal state of wellness? Will these
situations increase the possibility for stressor
penetration? The answer is that the possibility
for stressor penetration may be increased. The
actual response depends on the accordion-like
function previously described, along with the
other components of the client system.
Normal Line of Defense
The normal line of defense represents what the
client has become over time, or the usual state
of wellness. The nurse should determine the
client’s usual level of wellness to recognize a
change. The normal line of defense is consid-
ered dynamic because it can expand or contract
over time. The usual wellness level or system
stability can decrease, remain the same, or im-
prove after treatment of a stressor reaction. The
normal line of defense is dynamic because of
its ability to become and remain stabilized with
life stressors over time, protecting the basic
structure and system integrity (Neuman, 1995,
2002c, 2011, p. 18).
Lines of Resistance
Neuman identified the series of concentric
broken circles that surround the basic structure
CHAPTER 11 • Betty Neuman’s Systems Model 169
Line
s of Resistance
Nor
mal Line of Defense
Flex
ible Line of Defense
Basic structure
Basic factors common to
all organisms, i.e.:
Normal temperature
range
Genetic structure
Response pattern
Organ strength or
weakness
Ego structure
Knowns or commonalities
Physiological, psychological, sociocultural,
developmental, and spiritual variables occur
and are considered simultaneously in each
client concentric circle.
NOTE:
BASIC
STRUCTURE
ENERGY
RESOURCES
Fig 11 • 2 Client–client system. The structure of
the client-client system, including the five vari-
ables that are occurring simultaneously in each
client concentric circle. (From Neuman, 1995, p. 26,
with permission.)
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 169
as lines of resistance for the client. When the
normal line of defense is penetrated by environ-
mental stressors, a degree of reaction, or signs
and/or symptoms, will occur. Each line of re-
sistance contains known and unknown internal
and external resource factors. These factors sup-
port the client’s basic structure and the normal
line of defense, resulting in protection of system
integrity. Examples of the factors that support
the basic structure and normal line of defense
include the body’s mobilization of white blood
cells and activation of the immune system
mechanisms. There is a decrease in the signs or
symptoms, or a reversal of the reaction to stres-
sors, when the lines of resistance are effective.
The system reconstitutes itself, and system sta-
bility is returned. The level of wellness may be
higher or lower than it was before the stressor
penetration. When the lines of resistance are in-
effective, energy depletion and death may occur
(Neuman, 1995, 2002c, 2011a, p. 18).
Basic Structure
The basic structure or central core consists
of factors that are common to the human
species. Neuman offered the following exam-
ples of basic survival factors: temperature
range, genetic structure, response pattern,
organ strength or weakness, ego structure, and
knowns or commonalities (Neuman, 1995,
2002c, 2011a, p. 16).
Five Client Variables
Neuman (1995, p. 28; 2002c, p. 17; 2011a,
p. 16) identified five variables that are con-
tained in all client systems: physiological, psy-
chological, sociocultural, developmental, and
spiritual. These variables are considered simul-
taneously in each client concentric circle. They
are present in varying degrees of development
and in a wide range of interactive styles and po-
tential. Neuman offers the following definitions
for each variable:
Physiological: Refers to bodily structure and
function
Psychological: Refers to mental processes and
relationships
Sociocultural: Refers to combined social and
cultural functions
Developmental: Refers to life-developmental
processes
Spiritual: Refers to spiritual beliefs and
influence
Neuman elaborated that the spiritual vari-
able is an innate component of the basic
structure. Although it may or may not be ac-
knowledged or developed by the client or client
system, Neuman views the spiritual variable as
being on a continuum of development that
penetrates all other client system variables and
supports the client’s optimal wellness. The
client–client system can have a complete lack of
awareness of the spiritual variable’s presence and
potential, deny its presence, or have a conscious
and highly developed spiritual understanding
that supports the client’s optimal wellness.
Neuman explained that the spirit controls
the mind, and the mind consciously or uncon-
sciously controls the body. She used an analogy
of a seed to clarify this idea.
It is assumed that each person is born with
a spiritual energy force, or “seed,” within the
spiritual variable, as identified in the basic struc-
ture of the client system. The seed or human
spirit with its enormous energy potential lies on
a continuum of dormant, unacceptable, or un-
developed to recognition, development, and
positive system influence. Traditionally, a seed
must have environmental catalysts, such as tim-
ing, warmth, moisture, and nutrients, to burst
forth with the energy that transforms into a liv-
ing form that then, in turn, as it becomes fur-
ther nourished and develops, offers itself as
sustenance, generating power as long as its own
source of nurture exists (Neuman, 2002c, p. 16;
2011, Box 1-1, p. 17).
The spiritual variable affects or is affected
by a condition and interacts with other vari-
ables in a positive or negative way. Neuman
gave the example of grief or loss (psychologi-
cal state), which may inactivate, decrease,
initiate, or increase spirituality. There can
be movement in either direction of a contin-
uum (Neuman, 1995, 2002c, 2011a, p. 17).
Neuman believes that spiritual variable con-
siderations are necessary for a truly holistic
perspective and for a truly caring concern for
the client–client system.
170 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 170
Fulton (1995) has studied the spiritual vari-
able in depth. She elaborated on research studies
that extend our understanding of the following
aspects of spirituality: spiritual well-being, spir-
itual needs, spiritual distress, and spiritual care.
She suggested that spiritual needs include (1) the
need for meaning and purpose in life, (2) the
need to receive love and give love, (3) the need
for hope and creativity, and (4) the need for for-
giving, trusting relationships with self, others,
and God or a deity or a guiding philosophy.
Environment
A second concept identified by Neuman is the
environment, as illustrated in Figure 11-3. She
defined environment broadly as “all internal
and external factors or influences surrounding
the identified client or client system” (Neu-
man, 1995, p. 30; 2002c, p. 18; 2011,
pp. 20–21), including:
• Internal environment: intrapersonal factors
• External environment: Inter- and extraper-
sonal factors
• Created environment: Intra-, inter-, and
extrapersonal factors (Neuman, 1995, p. 31;
2002c, pp. 18–19; 2011a, pp. 20–21)
The internal environment consists of all
forces or interactive influences contained
within the boundaries of the client–client
system. Examples of intrapersonal forces are
presented for each variable.
• Physiological variable: autoimmune re-
sponse, degree of mobility, range of body
function
• Psychological and sociocultural variables:
attitudes, values, expectations, behavior pat-
terns, coping patterns, conditioned responses
• Developmental variable: age, degree of nor-
malcy, factors related to the present situation
• Spiritual variable: hope, sustaining forces
(Neuman, 1995; 2002c; 2011, p. 17)
The external environment consists of all
forces or interactive influences existing out-
side the client–client system. Interpersonal
factors in the environment are forces between
CHAPTER 11 • Betty Neuman’s Systems Model 171
No
rmal L
ine of Defense
Stressors
Identified
Classified as knowns
or possibilities, i.e.:
Loss
Pain
Sensory deprivation
Cultural change
Inter
Intra
Extra
Personal
factors
Stressor Stressor
Lin
es of Resistance
Fle
xible Line of Defense
Basic structure
Basic factors common to
all organisms, i.e.:
Normal temperature
range
Genetic structure
Response pattern
Organ strength or
weakness
Ego structure
Knowns or commonalities
Stressors
More than one stressor
could occur simultaneously
Same stressors could vary
as to impact or reaction
Normal defense line varies
with age and development
BASIC
STRUCTURE
ENERGY
RESOURCES
Fig 11 • 3 Environment. Internal and external factors surrounding the client–client system. (From Neuman,
1995, p. 27, with permission.)
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 171
people or client systems. These factors
include the relationships and resources of
family, friends, or caregivers. Extrapersonal
factors include education, finances, employ-
ment, and other resources (Neuman, 1995,
2002c).
Neuman (1995, 2002c, 2011a, pp. 20–21)
identified a third environment as the “created
environment.” The client unconsciously mo-
bilizes all system variables, including the
basic structure of energy factors, toward sys-
tem integration, stability, and integrity to
create a safe environment. This safe, created
environment offers a protective perceptive
coping shield that helps the client to func-
tion. A major objective of this environment
is to stimulate the client’s health. Neuman
pointed out that what was originally created
to safeguard the health of the system may
have a negative effect because of the binding
of available energy. This environment repre-
sents an open system that exchanges energy
with the internal and external environments.
The created environment supersedes or goes
beyond the internal and external environ-
ments while encompassing both; it provides
an insulating effect to change the response
or possible response of the client to environ-
mental stressors. Neuman (1995, 2002c,
2011) gave the following examples of re-
sponses: use of denial or envy (psychological),
physical rigidity or muscle constraint (physi-
ological), life-cycle continuation of survival
patterns (developmental), required social
space range (sociocultural), and sustaining
hope (spiritual).
Neuman believes the caregiver, through as-
sessment, will need to determine (1) what has
been created (nature of the created environ-
ment), (2) the outcome of the created environ-
ment (extent of its use and client value), and
(3) the ideal that has yet to be created (the pro-
tection that is needed or possible, to a lesser or
greater degree). This assessment is necessary to
best understand and support the client’s created
environment (Neuman, 1995, 2002c, 2011a).
Neuman suggested that further research is
needed to understand the client’s awareness
of the created environment and its relationship
to health. She believes that as the caregiver
recognizes the value of the client-created
environment and purposefully intervenes, the
interpersonal relationship can become one of
important mutual exchange (Neuman, 1995,
2002c, 2011a). de Kuiper (2011) added her
perspective of the created environment and
guidelines for nursing practice.
Health
Health is a third concept in Neuman’s model.
She believes that health (or wellness) and ill-
ness are on opposite ends of the continuum.
Health is equated with optimal system stability
(the best possible wellness state at any given
time). Client movement toward wellness exists
when more energy is built and stored than ex-
pended. Client movement toward illness and
death exists when more energy is needed than
is available to support life. The degree of well-
ness depends on the amount of energy required
to return to and maintain system stability. The
system is stable when more energy is available
than is being used. Health is seen as varying
levels within a normal range, rising and falling
throughout the life span. These changes are in
response to basic structure factors and reflect
satisfactory or unsatisfactory adjustment by
the client system to environmental stressors
(Neuman, 1995, 2002c, 2011a, p. 23).
Nursing
Nursing is a fourth concept in Neuman’s model
and is depicted in Figure 11-4. Nursing’s major
concern is to keep the client system stable by
(1) accurately assessing the effects and possible
effects of environmental stressors and (2) as-
sisting client adjustments required for optimal
wellness. Nursing actions, which are called pre-
vention as intervention, are initiated to keep the
system stable. Neuman created a typology for
her prevention as intervention nursing actions
that includes primary prevention as interven-
tion, secondary prevention as intervention, and
tertiary prevention as intervention. All of these
actions are initiated to best retain, attain, and
maintain optimal client health or wellness.
Neuman (1995, 2002c) believes the nurse cre-
ates a linkage among the client, the environ-
ment, health, and nursing in the process of
keeping the system stable.
172 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 172
Prevention as Intervention
The nurse collaborates with the client to estab-
lish relevant goals. These goals are derived only
after validating with the client and synthesiz-
ing comprehensive client data and relevant
theory to determine an appropriate nursing di-
agnostic statement. With the nursing diagnos-
tic statement and goals in mind, appropriate
interventions can be planned and implemented
(Neuman, 1995, 2002c, 2011a, pp. 25–29).
Primary prevention as intervention involves
the nurse’s actions that promote client wellness
by stress prevention and reduction of risk fac-
tors. These interventions can begin at any point
a stressor is suspected or identified, before a re-
action has occurred. They protect the normal
line of defense by reducing the possibility of an
encounter with a stressor and strengthening
the flexible lines of defense. Health promotion
is a significant intervention. The goal of pri-
mary prevention as intervention is to retain op-
timal stability or wellness. Ideally, the nurse
should consider primary prevention along with
secondary and tertiary preventions as interven-
tions when actual client problems exist.
Once a reaction from a stressor occurs, the
nurse can use secondary prevention as inter-
vention to treat the symptoms within the
nurse’s scope of practice, reduce the degree of
reaction to the stressors, and protect the basic
structure by strengthening the lines of resist-
ance. The goal of secondary prevention as in-
tervention is to attain optimal client system
stability or wellness and energy conservation.
The nurse uses as much of the client’s existing
internal and external resources (lines of resist-
ance) as possible to stabilize the system.
Reconstitution represents the return and
maintenance of system stability after nursing
intervention for stressor reaction. The state of
wellness may be higher, the same, or lower
than the state of wellness before the system
was stabilized. Death occurs when secondary
prevention as intervention fails to protect the
basic structure and thus fails to reconstitute the
client (Neuman, 1995, 2002c).
Tertiary prevention as intervention can
begin at any point in the client’s reconstitu-
tion. This includes interventions that pro-
mote (1) readaptation, (2) reeducation to
CHAPTER 11 • Betty Neuman’s Systems Model 173
Inter
Intra
Extra
Personal
factors
Primary prevention
Reduce possibility of
encounter with stressors
Strengthen flexible line
of defense
Secondary prevention
Early case-finding and
Treatment of symptoms
Tertiary prevention
Readaptation
Reeducation to prevent
future occurrences
Maintenance of stability
Interventions
Can occur before or after resistance
lines are penetrated in both reaction
and reconstitution phases
Interventions are based on:
Degree of reaction
Resources
Goals
Anticipated outcome
Fig 11 • 4 Nursing. Accurately assessing the effects and possible effects of
environmental stressors (inter-, intra-, and extrapersonal factors) and using
appropriate prevention by interventions to assist with client adjustments for
an optimal level of wellness. (From Neuman, 1995, p. 29, with permission.)
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 173
prevent further occurrences, and (3) mainte-
nance of stability. These actions are designed
to maintain an optimal wellness level by sup-
porting existing strengths and conserving
client system energy. Tertiary prevention
tends to lead back toward primary prevention
in a circular fashion. Neuman pointed out
that one or all three of these prevention
modalities give direction to, or may be used
simultaneously for, nursing actions with pos-
sible synergistic benefits (Neuman, 1995,
2002, 2011, pp. 28–29).
Nursing Tools for Model
Implementation
Neuman designed the NSM nursing process
format and the NSM Assessment and Inter-
vention Tool: Client Assessment and Nursing
Diagnosis to facilitate implementation of the
Neuman model. These tools are presented in
all the editions of The Neuman Systems Model
(Neuman, 1982, 1989, 1995, 2002c; 2011a;
Neuman & Lowry, 2011).
The NSM nursing process format reflects a
process that guides information processing and
goal-directed activities. Neuman uses the nurs-
ing process within three categories: nursing di-
agnosis, nursing goals, and nursing outcomes. In
1982, doctoral students validated the Neuman
nursing process format. The format’s validity and
social utility have been supported in a wide
variety of nursing education and practice areas.
The Neuman Systems Model Assessment
and Intervention Tool
The Client Assessment and Nursing Diagnosis
tool is used to guide the nursing process. The
nurse collects holistic, comprehensive data to
determine the effect or possible effect of envi-
ronmental stressors on the client system then
validates the data with the client before formu-
lating a nursing diagnosis. Selected nursing
diagnoses are prioritized and related to rele-
vant knowledge. Nursing goals are determined
mutually with the caregiver–client–client sys-
tem, along with mutually agreed on prevention
as intervention strategies. Mutually agreed on
goals and interventions are consistent with cur-
rent mandates within the health-care system
for client rights related to health-care issues.
The Client Assessment and Nursing Diag-
nosis tool with primary, secondary, and tertiary
prevention as intervention was developed to
convey appropriate nursing actions with each
typology of prevention. There are clear instruc-
tions for writing appropriate nursing actions
(Neuman, 2002a, p. 354; 2011b, pp. 343–350),
which students are encouraged to review
before writing these nursing actions. Keep in
mind that the nature of stressors and their
threat to the client–client system are first de-
termined for each type of prevention before
any other nursing actions are initiated. The
same stressors could produce variable effects or
reactions. Nursing outcomes are determined
by the accomplishment of the interventions
and evaluation of goals after intervention.
Applications of the Theory
Because the model is flexible and adaptable to
a wide range of groups and situations, people
have used it globally for more than three
decades. Neuman’s first book, The Neuman
Systems Model: Application to Nursing Education
and Practice, was published in 1982 as a response
to requests for data and support in applying the
model in practice settings and as a guide for
entire nursing curricula. The second and third
editions (1989, 1995) present examples of the
use of the model in practice and education, pri-
marily. The fourth edition (2002c) includes
integrative reviews of practice, educational,
and research literature and discussions of prac-
tice and educational tools. The fifth edition
(Neuman & Fawcett, 2011) continues the tra-
dition of including contributions that reflect the
broad applicability of the model. Guidelines and
available tools for NSM-based practice, educa-
tional programs, and research are summarized.
Application of the Neuman Systems
Model to Nursing Practice
“The function of a conceptual model in nursing
practice is to provide a distinctive frame of ref-
erence that guides approaches to patient care”
(Amaya, 2002, p. 43). There is a critical need for
meaningful definitions and conceptual frames of
reference for nursing practice if the profession is
to be established as a science (Neuman, 2002c).
174 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 174
The NSM is being used in diverse practice
settings globally such as critical care nursing,
psychiatric mental health nursing, gerontolog-
ical nursing, perinatal nursing, community
nursing, occupational health nursing, rehabil-
itation, and advanced nursing practice (Amaya,
2002; Bueno & Sengin, 1995; Chiverton
& Flannery, 1995; McGee, 1995; Peirce &
Fulmer, 1995; Groesbeck, 2011; Merks, van
Tilburg, & Lowry, 2011; Russell, Hileman,
& Grant, 1995; Stuart & Wright, 1995;
Trepanier, Dunn, & Sprague, 1995; Ware &
Shannahan, 1995).
The model is used to guide practice in clients
with acute and chronic health-care problems
(e.g., hypertension, chronic obstructive pul-
monary disease, renal disease, cardiac surgery,
cognitive impairment, mental illness, multiple
sclerosis, pain, grief, pediatric cancers, perinatal
stressors); to meet family needs of clients in crit-
ical care; to provide stable support groups for
parents with infants in neonatal intensive care
units; and to meet the needs of home caregivers,
with emphasis on clients with cancer, HIV/
AIDS, and head trauma (Beddome, 1995;
Beynon, 1995; Craig, 1995; Damant, 1995;
Davies & Proctor, 1995; Engberg, Bjalming, &
Bertilson, 1995; Felix, Hinds, Wolfe, & Martin,
1995; Vaughan & Gough, 1995; Verberk,
1995). An excellent example of how the com-
prehensive NSM can be used to gather and
analyze individual client system data is found
in Tarko and Helewka (2011, pp. 37–69).
Ume-Nwangbo, DeWan, and Lowry (2006)
provided two examples of using the model to
provide care: first, for an individual client; sec-
ond, for a family client. “Nurses who conduct
their practice from a nursing theory base, while
assisting individuals and families to meet their
health needs, are more likely to provide com-
prehensive, individualized care that exemplifies
best practices” (p. 31).
Application of the Neuman Systems
Model to Nursing Education
Neuman originally designed the model “as a
focal point for student learning” (2011,
p. 332) because it considered four variables of
human experience: physiological, psychologi-
cal, sociocultural and developmental. Before
long, the potential of using the model for cur-
riculum development was recognized at all
levels of nursing education in the United
States, Canada, and globally. The NSM was
selected because it is a systems approach, com-
prehensive, and holistic and focuses on health
and prevention. Programs adopting the model
in the 1980s used it in its entirety. Through
the years, some programs moved to a more
eclectic approach that combines the model
concepts of stress, systems, and primary pre-
vention with concepts from other models.
Appendix F in Neuman and Fawcett (2011)
summarizes 28 programs currently using the
NSM at the time of publication. Two bac-
calaureate programs at Newberry College,
Newberry, SC, and Cedar Crest College,
Allentown, PA, adopted the model in 2007
and 2009, respectively. The department of
Psychiatric Nursing at Douglas College,
British Columbia, Canada, follows a Neuman-
based curriculum for advanced practice psychi-
atric nurses (Tarko & Helewka, pp. 216–220).
MacEwan University in Edmonton, Alberta,
Canada, is planning for the adoption of the
model for their curriculum in fall of 2011
(personal communication, Betty Neuman,
January, 2013).
Educators have developed tools with NSM
terminology to guide student learning and
examine student progress in courses within
Neuman-based nursing programs (Newman
et al., 2011). The Lowry-Jopp Neuman Model
Evaluation Instrument (LJNMEI) has been
used by two associate-degree nursing programs,
one at Cecil Community College and the other
at Indiana University—Ft. Wayne. The objec-
tive of the evaluation instrument is to assess the
efficacy of being educated within a Neuman-
based curriculum. Participants were assessed at
graduation and 7 months after graduation.
Findings indicate that graduates internalized
the Neuman concepts well and continued to
practice from the model perspective if they
were encouraged by their colleagues. Graduates
who were employed in institutions that did not
encourage use of the model for assessments
often did not continue to use it (Beckman,
Boxley-Harges, Bruick-Sorge, & Eichenauer,
1998; Lowry, 1998).
CHAPTER 11 • Betty Neuman’s Systems Model 175
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 175
The LJNMEI instrument was adapted for
use by the practicing nurses at the Emergis
Psychiatric Institute in Zeeland, Holland, in
2002. Data have been collected for a decade
to track the efficacy of using the NSM for de-
livering quality patient care within this psychi-
atric health-care system. Other disciplines in
the institution became interested in using the
model as well with no significant difference for
knowledge of the NSM among nurses, psychi-
atrists, and psychologists. Having all disciplines
practicing from one theoretical perspective en-
ables an integrated approach to motivate and
stimulate clients to reach their levels of opti-
mum stability (Merks et al., 2011).
Application of the Neuman Systems
Model to Nursing Administration
and Management
Although there is less evidence of the use of the
NSM in administration compared with prac-
tice and education, the available literature is in-
creasing and emphasizes how complex systems
are greatly benefitted by using a systems ap-
proach as a guide to management (Pew Health
Professions Commission, 1995; Sanders &
Kelley, 2002). For example, the purpose of the
Magnet recognition program is to promote
quality patient care within a culture that sup-
ports professional nursing practice (McClure,
2005). This is the gold standard for work envi-
ronments in health care. One of the attributes
of Magnet status is practicing from a profes-
sional model of care. Nurses and administrators
with knowledge of the NSM are poised to as-
sume leadership roles within these hospital sys-
tems. The model emphasizes comprehensive
patient care to facilitate the delivery of primary,
secondary and tertiary interventions, within a
culture supporting professional nursing prac-
tice. Some examples of magnet hospitals using
the NSM are Allegiance Health, Michigan
(Burnett & Johnson-Crisanti, 2011); Riverside
Methodist Hospital, Ohio (Kinder, Napier,
Rupertino, Surace, & Burkholder, 2011);
Abingdon Memorial Hospital, Philadelphia
(Breckenridge, 2011); and the South Jersey
Healthcare System (Boxer, 2008). These exem-
plars describe how nurses combine their pro-
fessional model of care (the NSM) with the
other Magnet criteria to achieve quality health
care and national recognition. Nursing research
in these institutions is reported in publications
and at the Biennial International Neuman
Systems Model Symposia.
Application of the Neuman Systems
Model to Nursing Research
Each edition of The Neuman Systems Model
from the second to the fifth (1989–2011) pro-
vides a chapter that summarizes the research
based on the model completed in the years be-
tween the editions. Through the years, the
growth of Neuman-based research is evident.
In the early years, most of the research was de-
scriptive, focusing on one concept from the
model, such as stressor reactions or primary
prevention interventions. Many of the early
studies were completed by master’s and doc-
toral students as fulfillment of their advanced
degrees (Fawcett, 2011, pp. 393–404). To date
there are 132 master’s theses, 110 doctoral dis-
sertations, and 109 Neuman-based studies
completed by researchers.
Neuman-based research has progressed
developmentally through the decades as re-
searchers become more sophisticated and in-
formed about processes that lead to sound
conceptual model-based studies. Conceptual
models provide the broad framework for or-
ganizing the phenomena to be studied through
research and are critical because they are pre-
cursors for theory development. The models
provide the concepts and propositions (con-
necting statements) that explain the model.
For example, the NSM provides the context
and structure for research. Because the con-
cepts are abstract, the model cannot be tested
in a single research study. Thus, midrange the-
ories must be derived from the NSM concepts,
and these theories can then be tested in indi-
vidual studies.
Fawcett (1989) developed a structure that is
used by researchers when developing a research
study from a conceptual model. This conceptual-
theoretical-empirical (CTE) framework pres-
ents the model concepts to be studied at the
upper level, then the more observable concepts
being studied at the second level, and the in-
struments that will be used to collect data
176 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 176
about the second level concepts at the third
level. This CTE diagram shows explicit vertical
linkages. Then a narrative explanation is neces-
sary to clarify the concepts and propositions dis-
played in the CTE diagram. Examples of studies
developed from CTE frameworks can be found
in research chapters in two editions of Neuman
and Fawcett (2002, 2011).
A second major contribution of Fawcett
to model-based research is the publishing of
guidelines for the development of research stud-
ies (Fawcett, 1995, table 32-1). These rules are
applicable to any health-care discipline and have
been refined over the years. The latest rendition
is given in Neuman and Fawcett (2011, p. 162,
table 10-1). These rules can apply to both quan-
titative and qualitative studies. An excellent
example of a CTE structure for a quantitative
study of multiple role stress in mothers at-
tending college (Gigliotti, 1997, 1999) is dis-
played in Neuman and Fawcett (2002, p. 290,
Figure 21-1). Note that the midrange theory
concepts are specific attributes of the NSM
concepts but do not include all model concepts.
An excellent example of a CTE for a qualitative
study is found in Neuman and Fawcett (2002,
p. 179, Figure 10-3). Note that this diagram
moves from the Neuman model concepts
(Level 1) to empirical research methods (Level 3),
from which Level 2 midrange theory concepts
have been derived from patient interviews. If the
guidelines for conducting model-based research
are followed, resulting studies will be logically
consistent and will advance nursing knowledge
by helping to explain the effects of using the
NSM (Louis, Gigliotti, Neuman, & Fawcett,
2011; Gigliotti). The ultimate goal of all re-
search is to develop conceptual model-based
middle-range theories (Fawcett & Garrity,
2009; Gigliotti, 2012).
The fourth step of the research guidelines
is research methodology. Appropriate re-
search instruments for data collection must
be selected. This means that the items in
each instrument are either derived from the
NSM or are compatible with concepts within
the NSM. For example, Loescher, Clark,
Atwood, Leigh, and Lamb (1990) created
the Cancer Survivors Questionnaire, which
collects data on the client’s perception of
physiological, psychological, and sociocultu-
ral stressors. Each item in each of these cat-
egories is a descriptor of something physical,
psychological, and sociocultural. A second
example is the “Client System Perception
Guides” for structured interviews. The items
listed in the guide were developed from the
NSM for measuring spirituality (Clark, Cross,
Deane, & Lowry, 1991), dialysis treatment
(Breckenridge, 1997), and elder abuse (Kottwitz
& Bowling, 2003). To date, 25 instruments
have been directly derived from the NSM and
can measure stressors, client systems percep-
tions, client system needs, the five system vari-
ables, coping strategies, the lines of defense and
resistance, and client system responses.
Four reviews of NSM-based studies from
the 1980s and 1990s focused on how the stud-
ies reflected the research rules. Gigliotti (2001)
presented an integrative review of 10 studies
to determine the extent of support for Neuman
propositions that link various concepts of the
model. Gigliotti reported her difficulty inter-
preting the results due to investigators’ failures
to link the research concepts to the NSM in
their designs. Fawcett and Giangrande (2002)
presented a full integrative-review project that
linked all the available NSM-based research.
The authors found that about one-half of pub-
lished research journal articles and book chap-
ters included conceptual linkages between
NSM propositions and the study variables.
Master’s theses and doctoral dissertations
(about two-thirds) did not make the concep-
tual linkages. Researchers are reminded to pay
more attention to conceptual aspects of their
studies and make explicit references to these so
that nursing theoretical knowledge is ad-
vanced. Throughout this chapter, one can find
the network of researchers who have con-
ducted model-based studies.
Fawcett and Giangrande (2002) presented a
literature review of 212 studies and identified the
instruments used for data collection that are
compatible with the NSM concepts and propo-
sitions as well as the middle-range theory meas-
ured by each instrument. Compatible with the
NSM concepts are 75 instruments, such as the
State-Trait Anxiety Inventory, used to measure
anxiety; the Beck Depression Inventory, used to
CHAPTER 11 • Betty Neuman’s Systems Model 177
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 177
measure depression; and the Norbeck Social
Support Questionnaire, used to measure client’s
perception of social support in their lives. When
using an instrument not deducted directly from
the model, researchers must describe the link-
ages between the concepts in the instruments
and those from the NSM to demonstrate logical
congruence between the NSM and the instru-
ment. The evidence of validity and reliability of
the instruments selected must be provided in the
study. The ultimate goal is to accumulate a group
of instruments that measure the complete spec-
trum of NSM concepts, such as the five vari-
ables; the central core; the four environments;
client system stability; reconstitution; variances
from wellness; primary, secondary, and tertiary
prevention interventions; and client perceptions.
Finally, Gigliotti and Manister (2012) presented
an article to guide novice researchers through
the writing of the conceptual model-based the-
oretical rationale. This is a must-read for every
beginning researcher.
Focus of Current Research
Neuman concepts of stressors, and the three pre-
ventions as intervention have been the foci most
frequently studied by descriptive methodology.
Gigliotti (1999, 2004, 2007) has a program of
research on the subject of women’s maternal-
student role stress in which she tests the NSM
flexible line of defense. Spirituality is the vari-
able that has been researched most recently.
Neuman (1989) claimed that spirituality is the
unifying variable of all personal systems. She
states that the “spirit controls the mind, and the
mind controls the body” (pp. 29–30). A spiritual
encounter occurs between clients and caregivers,
thus, nurses must assess spirituality as part of
their data collection. These beliefs have influ-
enced the development of spirituality studies.
Some of the studies focus on the development
of spirituality in students, and others aim to un-
derstand the concept of spirituality. Because
student nurses must learn to assess the spiritual
variable, it is imperative that they develop spir-
itually. A team of faculty from Indiana Purdue–
Ft. Wayne are studying the evolution of student
nurses’ awareness of the concept of spirituality
(Beckman, Boxley-Harges, Bruick-Sorge, &
Salmon, 2007; Beckman, Boxley-Harges, &
Kaskel, 2012; Bruick-Sorge, Beckman, Boxley-
Harges, & Salmon, 2010). If the NSM is to be
used for assessment of the spiritual variable,
then caregivers must be confident that the Neu-
man definition is congruent with client beliefs
(Lowry, 2012). Several studies have addressed
the importance of spirituality to quality care
(Clark, Cross, Deane & Lowry, 1991), to aging
persons (Lowry, 2002, 2012), and to adults liv-
ing with HIV (Cobb, 2012). Finally, Burkhart,
Schmidt, and Hogan (2012) published a new
spiritual care inventory instrument within the
context of the NSM to measure spiritual in-
terventions that facilitate health and wellness.
The Neuman Systems Model Research
Institute
At the 2003 Biennial International Neuman
Systems Model Symposium in Philadelphia,
PA, the NSM Trustees formally approved the
formation of a Research Institute to test and
generate midrange theories derived from the
NSM (Gigliotti & Fawcett, 2011). Activities
of this institute include the funding of two dis-
tinct types of fellowships for novice researchers:
the John Crawford Awards (up to 10 per bien-
nium) and the Patricia Chadwick Research
Grant (one per biennium). For more informa-
tion, see http://www.neumansystemsmodel
.org/NSMdocs/research_institute.htm.
Each biennium, the Neuman Systems Model
Trustees Group conducts an international sym-
posium where the recipients of the fellowships
can join other scholars and present their find-
ings. All researchers, educators, and nurses who
practice from the NSM perspective are welcome
to attend these events to share new insights and
to advance understanding of various model
concepts. The networking among these scholars
helps to integrate the growing body of knowl-
edge about the use of the model in education,
research, practice, and administration of nursing
services.
Value of the Neuman Systems Model
for the Future
Theory development is the hallmark of any pro-
fession. The NSM continues to be researched
and validated through studies; thus, it becomes
more valuable as the basis for quality patient care
178 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 178
and for the advancement of the nursing profes-
sion. The addition of the spiritual variable to the
client system in 1989 accentuated the impor-
tance of this dimension. The plethora of research
on spirituality and the recognition of the impor-
tance of the concept are increasingly being
recognized by the health-care community. The
development of middle-range theories from the
NSM is imperative because it is the integration
of theories from other disciplines that are com-
patible with Neuman concepts. The concepts of
holism, wellness, and prevention interventions
used to attain, retain, and maintain client system
stability are as viable today in our complex
health-care system as they were in 1970. Our
global colleagues find that these philosophical
beliefs are congruent with beliefs in their own
health-care systems. More than 12 countries
have been introduced to the model over two
decades, with Belgium being the most recent in
2012. Holland has adopted the model most
widely due to its translation into Dutch and
hosts the annual International Neuman Systems
Model Association symposium (Merks, Verberk,
de Kuiper, & Lowry, 2012).
Networking to Enhance Applications
of the Model
There are opportunities to network with others
using the model in a variety of applications and
settings. One way is to attend the Neuman
Systems Model International Symposium,
which is held every 2 years, in the odd year.
International scholars gather to share ideas,
insights, innovations, practice, and research
from the model. The Neuman Systems Model
website provides the latest information: www
.neumansystemsmodel.org.
The Neuman Archives were established
to preserve and protect the work of Betty
Neuman and others working with the model.
The archives, previously located at Newmann
University in Aston, PA, are now housed
in the Barbara Bates Center for the Study of
the History of Nursing at the University of
Pennsylvania (http://www.nursing.upenn
.edu/history/Pages/default.aspx). Contact
Gail Farr, MA, CA, for information and
an appointment to access the collection
(gfarr@nursing.upenn.edu).
CHAPTER 11 • Betty Neuman’s Systems Model 179
Practice Exemplar
A nurse guided by the Neuman systems model
met Gloria Washington while providing care
for her mother in Gloria’s home. Gloria’s
74-year-old mother has Alzheimer’s disease,
and Gloria has been her caregiver for 4 years.
The nurse was aware that, according to Neu-
man, the family client system includes Gloria
and her mother. This nurse uses practice-based
research to guide her work (best practice). She
recently read Jones-Cannon and Davis’s
(2005) research study that examined the cop-
ing strategies of African American daughters
who have functioned as caregivers. In their
study, African American caregivers of a family
member with dementia or a stroke believed
that attending support groups and knowing
that their parent needed them influenced their
caregiving experience positively. Most care-
givers identified that religion gave them a
strong tolerance for the caregiving situation
and served to mediate strain. Caregivers who
voiced a lack of support from family, especially
siblings, had much anger and resentment.
The nurse used this new knowledge to en-
hance the nursing process with Gloria. By
using the Neuman systems model Assessment
and Intervention Tool, she learned that Gloria
is a 52-year-old divorced African American
woman who is employed full-time by a com-
pany for which she enjoys working. She also
has a teenage daughter who lives with her and
a grown son who lives away from home. Glo-
ria attends the Baptist church in her neighbor-
hood 2 or 3 times a week and attributes this
experience to her ability to care for her mother.
The nurse assessed for stressors as they were
perceived by Gloria and by herself. The nurse
assessed for discrepancies between their
Continued
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 179
180 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Practice Exemplar cont.
perceptions and found none. She identified
the intrapersonal, interpersonal, and extraper-
sonal factors that made up Gloria’s environ-
ment. To ensure the assessment was holistic
and comprehensive, she identified the physi-
ological, psychological, sociocultural, develop-
mental, and spiritual variables for each of these
factors. Gloria identified caring for her mother
with Alzheimer’s disease as her major stressor.
Assessment
The nurse’s assessment of Gloria’s environ-
mental factors is identified below. Examples
of assessment data for each variable are
included.
Intrapersonal factors
Physiological: Gloria experiences occasional
signs and symptoms of increased anxiety
such as rapid heart rate and increased
blood pressure.
Psychological: Gloria occasionally worries
about the future, but she tries to focus on
the present and prides herself on her sense
of humor.
Sociocultural: Gloria values her belief that
African American families take care of
their elderly.
Developmental: Gloria is in Erickson’s
(1959) developmental stage of middle
adulthood with its crisis of generativity
versus stagnation. She strives to look out-
side of herself to care for others.
Spiritual: Gloria reports that religion, faith,
and prayer help her cope with caregiving
demands.
Interpersonal factors
Physiological: Gloria occasionally has inter-
rupted sleep when her mother awakens
and wanders during the night.
Psychological: Gloria reminds herself when
physically caring for her mother that this
is an expected part of her mother’s aging.
Sociocultural: Gloria is the full-time care-
giver of her mother, who has Alzheimer’s
disease. She works full-time with sup-
portive people but does not attend an
Alzheimer’s support group because she
didn’t know anything about them.
Developmental: Gloria has significant rela-
tionships with her co-workers.
Spiritual: Gloria is supported by her pastor
and friends at church.
Extrapersonal factors
Physiological: From a co-worker, Gloria re-
ceived the gift of a comfortable bed mat-
tress that promotes her sleep.
Psychological: Gloria shared that reading her
Bible helps her think positive thoughts.
Sociocultural: Gloria earns $35,000 per year.
Developmental: Gloria can feel “in charge of
the situation” with a comfortable house
for her mom.
Spiritual: Gloria attends church services in
her neighborhood 2 or 3 times a week.
The nurse applied the NSM nursing process
format (Neuman & Fawcett, 2011, p. 338) fo-
cusing on the following: (1) nursing diagnosis
(based on valid database), (2) nursing goals
negotiated with the client including appropri-
ate levels of prevention as interventions, and
(3) nursing outcomes.
The nurse prepared a comprehensive list of
nursing diagnoses based on her holistic and
comprehensive assessment and then priori-
tized the list. She validated her findings with
Gloria to ensure that their perceptions were in
agreement.
The nurse and Gloria identified Gloria’s
full-time role as a caregiver for her mother
with Alzheimer’s disease as a significant
stressor. The nurse considered the research
study by Jones-Cannon and Davis (2005),
which reported that caregivers of a family
member with dementia believed attendance
at a support group influenced their caregiving
in a positive way. One of the nursing diag-
noses they determined was “risk for caregiver
role strain.” Although this was identified as
a risk, they both agreed there was not a sup-
porting sign or symptom to validate the exis-
tence of caregiver role strain at this time.
However, it was important to prevent this
strain in the future.
The nurse recognized that their observa-
tions provided a glimpse of Gloria’s normal
line of defense; then they identified an
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 180
CHAPTER 11 • Betty Neuman’s Systems Model 181
Practice Exemplar cont.
immediate goal to strengthen her flexible
line of defense.
The goal is that Gloria will report that she
has participated in a monthly Alzheimer sup-
port group session by (date). They could have
identified intermediate and future goals at that
time. Together they planned nursing actions
for primary prevention as intervention.
The nurse also used the tool and nursing
process to provide holistic comprehensive care
for Gloria’s mother, and the family client
system was strengthened. By strengthening
Gloria’s lines of defense, the nurse helped
strengthen Gloria’s mother’s lines of defense.
The model is dynamic as the individual and
family client systems are assessed continu-
ously, leading to new diagnoses, goals, and in-
terventions that promote optimal holistic
comprehensive nursing care. The desired out-
come goal for Gloria in the case example was
optimal health retention.
If this had been an actual problem of care-
giver role strain, they would have identified
secondary prevention as interventions and
tertiary prevention as interventions that would
activate resource factors (lines of resistance)
to protect Gloria’s basic structure (organ
strength or ability to cope). An example of
each follows.
Secondary prevention as intervention: Assist
Gloria to schedule respite care for a deter-
mined period of time.
Tertiary prevention as intervention: Provide
ongoing education at each visit about
practical resources that will provide care-
giver support.
The nurse would have continued to use
the nursing process by implementing and
evaluating their plan; reassessing, as part of
evaluation, for a reduction or elimination of
caregiver role strain; and maintenance of
system stability. Neuman refers to this as
reconstitution.
Reconstitution represents the return and
maintenance of system stability after treatment
of a stressor reaction, which may result in a
higher or lower level of wellness than previously.
It represents successful mobilization of energy
resources (Neuman, 2002c, p. 324).
The desired outcome goals are for optimal
health retention, restoration, and mainte-
nance. In Neuman’s model, high importance
is placed on validating nurse and client per-
ceptions and validating data.
■ Summary
“The Neuman Systems Model is well positioned
as a contemporary and future guide for health
care practice, research, education and adminis-
tration far into the 21st century. The concepts
and processes of the model are so universal and
timeless that they are easily understood by all
members of the health care teams worldwide”
(Neuman and Fawcett, 2011, p. 317).
The NSM has been used for more than
three decades, first as a teaching tool and later
as a conceptual model to observe and interpret
the phenomena of nursing and health care
globally. The model is well accepted by
the nursing profession and is guided by the
Neuman Systems Model Trustees, Inc. The
Trustees are dedicated to the improvement of
health for people worldwide through develop-
ment and use of the NSM to guide practice,
education, research, and administration (www
.neumansystemsmodel.org/trustees).
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 181
182 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
References
Amaya, M. A. (2002). The Neuman systems model and
clinical practice: An integrative review 1974–2000.
In B. Neuman & J. Fawcett (Eds.), The Neuman
systems model (4th ed., pp. 216–243). Upper Saddle
River, NJ: Prentice-Hall. Archives of the Neuman
Systems
Beckman, S. J., Boxley-Harges, S., Bruik-Sorge, C., &
Echenauer, J. (1998). Evaluation modalities for as-
sessing student and program outcomes. In L. Lowry
(Ed.), Neuman systems model and nursing education:
Teaching strategies and outcomes (pp. 149–160).
Indianapolis, IN: Sigma Theta Tau International
Center Nursing Press.
Beckman, S. J., Boxley-Harges, S., Bruick-Sorge, C., &
Salmon, B. (2007). Five strategies that heighten
nurses’ awareness of spirituality to impact client care.
Holistic Nursing Practice, 21(3),135–139.
Beckman, S. J., Boxley-Harges, S., & Kaskel, B.L.
(2012) Experience informs: Spanning three decades
with the Neuman systems model. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 25(4), 341–346.
Beddome, G. (1995). Community-as-client assessment.
A Neuman-based guide for education and practice.
In B. Neuman, The Neuman systems model (3rd ed.,
pp. 567–579). Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Beynon, C. E. (1995). Neuman-based experiences of the
Middlesex-London Health Unit. In B. Neuman
(Ed.), The Neuman systems model (3rd ed., pp. 537–
547). Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Boxer, B. (2009). The Neuman systems model as a profes-
sional model of care for a magnet hospital health care
system. Unpublished manuscript.
Breckenridge, D. M. (1995). Nephrology practice and
directions for nursing research. In B. Neuman (Ed.),
The Neuman systems model (3rd ed., pp. 499–507).
Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Breckenridge, D. M. (1997). Patients’ perceptions of
why, how and by whom dialysis treatment modality
was chosen. American Nephrology Nurses Association
Journal, 24, 313–319.
Breckenridge, D. M. (2011). The Neuman systems
model and evidence-based practice. In B. Neuman &
J. Fawcett, (Eds.) The Neuman systems model (5th ed.
pp. 245–252). Upper Saddle River, NJ: Pearson.
Bruick-Sorge, C., Beckman, S. J., Boxley-Harges, S., &
Salmon, B. (2010). The evolution of student nurses
concepts of spirituality. Holistic Nursing Practice,
24(2), 73–78.
Bueno, M. M., & Sengin, K. K. (1995). The Neuman
systems model for critical care nursing. A framework
for practice. In B. Neuman (Ed.), The Neuman
systems model (3rd ed., pp. 275–291. Norwalk,
CT: Appleton & Lange.
Burkhart, L., Schmidt, L., & Hogan, N. (2011). Devel-
opment and psychometric testing of the spiritual care
inventory instrument. Journal of Advanced Nursing,
67, 2463–2472.
Burnett, H. M., & Johnson-Crisanti, K. J. (2011).
Nursing services at Allegiance Health. In B.
Neuman & J. Fawcett (Eds.), The Neuman systems
model (5th ed., pp. 267–275). Upper Saddle River,
NJ: Pearson.
Chiverton, P., & Flannery J. C. (1995). Cognitive im-
pairment. Use of the Neuman systems model. In:
B. Neuman, The Neuman systems model (3rd ed.,
pp. 249–259). Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Clark, C. C., Cross, J. R. Deane, D. M., & Lowry,
L. W. (1991). Spirituality: Integral to quality care.
Holistic Nursing Practice, 5(3), 67–76.
Cobb, R. K. ( 2012). How well does spirituality predict
health status in adults living with HIV-disease: A
Neuman systems model study. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 25(4), 347–355.
Craig, D. M. (1995). Community/public health nursing
in Canada. Use of the Neuman systems model in a
new paradigm. In B. Neuman (Ed.), The Neuman
systems model (3rd ed., pp. 529–535). Norwalk, CT:
Appleton & Lange.
Damant, M. (1995). Community nursing in the United
Kingdom. A case for reconciliation using the Neuman
Systems Model. In B. Neuman (Ed.), The Neuman
systems model (3rd ed., pp. 607–620). Norwalk, CT:
Appleton & Lange.
Davies, P., & Proctor, H. (1995). In Wales: Using the
model in community mental health. In B. Neuman
(Ed.), The Neuman systems model (3rd ed., pp. 621–
627). Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
de Kuiper, M. (2011). The created environment. In B.
Neuman & J. Fawcett. (Eds.), The Neuman systems
model (5th ed., pp. 100–104). Upper Saddle Creek,
NJ: Pearson.
Engberg, I. B., Bjalming, E., & Bertilson, B. (1995). A
structure for documenting primary health care in
Sweden using the Neuman systems model. In B.
Neuman (Ed.), The Neuman systems model (3rd ed.,
pp. 637–651). Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Erikson, E. H. (1959). Identity and the life cycle. New
York: International Universities Press.
Fawcett, J. (1989). Analysis and evaluation of Nueman’s
systems model. In B. Neuman (Ed.), The Neuman sys-
tems model. Application to nursing education and practice
(2nd ed., pp. 65–92). Norwalk, CT: Appleton and
Lange.
Fawcett, J. (1995). Constructing conceptual-theoretical-
empirical structures for research. Future implications
for use of the Neuman systems model. In B. Neuman
(Ed.), The Neuman systems model (3rd ed., pp. 459–
471). Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Fawcett, J. (2011). Neuman systems model bibliogra-
phy and web site information. In B. Neuman
& J. Fawcett (Eds.), The Neuman systems model
(5th ed., pp. 375–422). Upper Saddle Creek, NJ:
Pearson. Available at: http://www.neumansys-
temsmodel.org/Bibliography.
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 182
Fawcett, J. & Garrity, J. (2009). Evaluating research for
evidence-based nursing practice. Philadelphia, PA:
F.A. Davis.
Fawcett, J., & Giangrande, S. K. (2002). The Neuman
systems model and research: An integrative review.
In B. Neuman & J. Fawcett (Eds.), The Neuman
systems model (4th ed., pp. 120–149). Upper Saddle
River, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Felix, M., Hinds, C., Wolfe, C., & Martin, A. (1995).
The Neuman systems model in a chronic care facility:
A Canadian experience. In B. Neuman (Ed.), The
Neuman systems model (3rd ed., pp. 549–566).
Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Fulton, R. A. (1995). The spiritual variable. In
B. Neuman (Ed.), The Neuman systems model (3rd ed.,
pp. 77–91). Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Gigliotti, E. (1997). Use of Neuman’s lines of defense and
resistance in nursing research: Conceptual and empiri-
cal considerations. Nursing Science Quarterly, 10,
136–143.
Gigliotti, E. (1999). Women’s multiple role stress:
Testing Neuman’s flexible line of defense. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 12, 36–44.
Gigliotti, E. (2001). Empirical tests of the Neuman sys-
tems model: Relational statements analysis. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 14, 149–157.
Gigliotti, E., (2004). Etiology of maternal-student role
stress. Nursing Science Quarterly, 17, 156–164.
Gigliotti, E. (2007). Improving external and internal
validity of a model of midlife Women’s maternal-
student role stress. Nursing Science Quarterly, 20,
161–170.
Gigliotti, E. (2012). Deriving middle-range theories
from the Neuman systems model. In B. Neuman &
J. Fawcett (Eds.), The Neuman systems model (5th
ed., pp. 283–298). Upper Saddle Creek, NJ: Pearson.
Gigliotti, E. & Fawcett, J. (2011) The Neuman systems
model research institute. In B. Neuman & J. Fawcett
(Eds.) The Neuman systems model (5th ed., pp. 351–
354). Upper Saddle Creek, NJ: Pearson. http://
neumansystemsmodel.org/NSMdocs/research_
institute.htm.
Gigliotti, E., & Manister, N. N. (2011). A beginner’s
guide to writing the nursing conceptual model-based
theoretical rationale. Nursing Science Quarterly,25(4),
301–306.
Groesbeck, M. J. (2011). Reflections on Neuman sys-
tems model-based advanced psychiatric nursing
practice. In B. Neuman & Fawcett (Eds.) The Neu-
man systems model (5th ed., pp. 237-244). Upper
Saddle River, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Jones-Cannon, S., & Davis, B. (2005, November-
December). Coping among African-American
daughters caring for aging parents. The ABNF
Journal, 118–123.
Kinder, L., Napier, D., Rubertino, M., Surace, A., &
Burkholder, J. (2011). Utilizing the Neuman systems
model to maintain and enhance the health of a
nursing service: Riverside Methodist Hospital. In
B. Neuman & J. Fawcett (Eds.), The Neuman systems
model (5th ed., pp. 276–280). Upper Saddle Creek,
NJ: Pearson.
Kottwitz , D., & Bowling, S. (2003). A pilot study of
the elder abuse questionnaire. Kansas Nurse, 78(7),
4–6.
Loescher, L. J., Clark, L., Atwood, J.R., Leigh, S., &
Lamb, S. (1990). The impact of the cancer experi-
ence on long-term survivors. Oncology Nursing
Forum, 17, 223–229.
Louis, M., Gigliotti, E., Neuman, B., & Fawcett, J.
(2011). Neuman model-based research: Guidelines
and instruments. In B. Neuman & J. Fawcett (Eds.),
The Neuman systems model (5th ed., pp. 160–174.)
Upper Saddle Creek, NJ: Pearson.
Lowry, L., (1998). Efficacy of the Neuman systems
model as a curricular framework: A longitudinal
study. In L. Lowry (Ed.), The Neuman systems model
and nursing education: Teaching strategies and outcomes
(pp. 139–147). Indianapolis, IN: Sigma Theta Tau
International Center Nursing Press.
Lowry, L. (2002). The Neuman systems model and
education. An integrative review. In B. Neuman &
J. Fawcett (Eds.), The Neuman systems model (4th ed.,
pp. 216–237). Upper Saddle River, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Lowry, L.W. (2012). A qualitative descriptive study of
spirituality guided by the Neuman systems model.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 25(4), 356–361.
Lowry, L. W., & Conco, D. (2002). Exploring the
meaning of spirituality with aging adults in
Appalachia. Journal of Holistic Health, 20, 388–402.
McGee, M. (1995). Implications for use of the Neuman
systems model in occupational health nursing. In B.
Neuman (Ed.), The Neuman systems model (3rd ed.,
pp. 657–667). Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
McClure, M. (2005). Magnet hospitals insights and issues.
Nursing Administration Quarterly, 29(3), 158–161.
Merks, A., van Tilburg, C., & Lowry, L. (2011). Excel-
lence in practice. In B. Neuman & J. Fawcett (Eds.),
The Neuman systems model (5th ed. pp. 253–264).
Upper Saddle Creek, NJ: Pearson.
Merks, A., Verberk, F., de Kuiper, M., & Lowry, L. W.
(2012). Neuman systems model in Holland: An up-
date. Nursing Science Quarterly, 25(4), 364–368.
Neuman, B. (1982). The Neuman systems model: Applica-
tion to nursing education and practice. Norwalk, CT:
Appleton-Century-Crofts.
Neuman, B. (1989). The Neuman systems model (2nd ed.).
Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Neuman, B. (1995). The Neuman systems model (3rd ed.).
Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Neuman, B. (2002a). Assessment and intervention based
on the Neuman systems model. In B. Neuman &
J. Fawcett (Eds.), The Neuman systems model (4th ed.,
pp. 347–359). Upper Saddle River, NJ: Prentice-
Hall. Available at: http://neumansystemsmodel.org/
index.html
Neuman, B. (2002b). Betty Neuman’s autobiography
and chronology of the development and utilization
CHAPTER 11 • Betty Neuman’s Systems Model 183
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 183
of the Neuman systems model. In: B. Neuman &
J. Fawcett, The Neuman systems model (4th ed.,
pp. 325–346). Upper Saddle River, NJ: Prentice-
Hall.www.neumansystemsmodel.org/Autobiography
Neuman, B. (2002c). The Neuman systems model. In B.
Neuman & J. Fawcett (Eds.), The Neuman systems
model (4th ed., pp. 3–33). Upper Saddle River, NJ:
Prentice-Hall.
Neuman, B. (2011a). The Neuman systems model. In
B. Neuman & J. Fawcett (Eds.), The Neuman systems
model (5th ed., pp. 1–33). Upper Saddle River, NJ:
Prentice-Hall.
Neuman, B. (2011b). Assessment and intervention
based on the Neuman systems model. In B. Neuman
& J. Fawcett (Eds.). The Neuman systems model
(5th ed., pp. 343–350). Upper Saddle River, NJ:
Prentice-Hall.
Neuman, B., & Fawcett, J. (Eds.). (2002). The Neuman
systems model (4th ed.). Upper Saddle River, NJ:
Prentice-Hall.
Neuman, B., & Fawcett, J. (2011). The Neuman systems
model (5th ed.). Upper Saddle Creek, NJ: Pearson.
Neuman, B., & Lowry, L. (2011). The Neuman systems
model and the future. In B. Neuman & J. Fawcett
(Eds.), The Neuman systems model (5th ed., pp. 317–
326). Upper Saddle Creek, NJ: Pearson.
Newman, D. M. L., Gehring, K. R., Lowry, L., Taylor,
R., Neuman, B. & Fawcett, J. (2011). Neuman sys-
tems model-based education for the health professions:
Guidelines and educational tools. In B. Neuman
& J. Fawcett (Eds.), The Neuman systems model
(5th ed., pp. 117–135). Upper Saddle River, NJ:
Prentice-Hall.
Peirce, A. G., & Fulmer, T. T. (1995). Application of
the Neuman systems model to gerontological nurs-
ing. In B. Neuman (Ed.), The Neuman systems model
(3rd ed., pp. 293–308). Norwalk, CT: Appleton &
Lange.
Pew Health Professions Commission. (1995). Critical
challenges: Revitalizing the health professions for the
twenty-first century. San Francisco: UCSF Center
for the Health Professions.
Russell, J., Hileman, J. W., & Grant, J. S. (1995). As-
sessing and meeting the needs of home caregivers
using the Neuman systems model. In B. Neuman
(Ed.), The Neuman systems model (3rd ed., pp. 331–
341). Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Sanders, N. F., & Kelley, J. A. (2002). The Neuman
systems model and administrative nursing
services: An integrative review. In B. Neuman
& J. Fawcett (Ed.), The Neuman systems model
(4th ed., pp. 271–287). Upper Saddle River, NJ:
Prentice-Hall.
Stuart, G. W., & Wright, L. K. (1995). Applying the
Neuman systems model to psychiatric nursing prac-
tice. In B. Neuman (Eds.), The Neuman systems model
(3rd ed., pp. 263–273). Norwalk, CT: Appleton &
Lange.
Tarko, M. A., & Helewka, A. M. (2011). Psychiatric
nursing education at Douglas College. In B. Neu-
man & J. Fawcett (Eds.), The Neuman systems model
(5th ed., pp. 216–220). Upper Saddle River, NJ:
Pearson.
Trepanier, M., Dunn, S. I., & Sprague, A. E. (1995).
Application of the Neuman systems model to peri-
natal nursing. In B. Neuman (Eds.), The Neuman
systems model (3rd ed., pp. 309–320). Norwalk, CT:
Appleton & Lange.
Ume-Nwagbo, P. N., DeWan, S. A., & Lowry, L.
(2006). Using the Neuman systems model for best
practices. Nursing Science Quarterly, 19(1), 31–35.
Vaughan, B., & Gough, P. (1995). Use of the Neuman
systems model in England. In B. Neuman (Ed.), The
Neuman systems model (3rd ed., pp. 599–605). Norwalk,
CT: Appleton & Lange.
Verberk, F. (1995). In Holland: Application of the
Neuman model in psychiatric nursing. In
B. Neuman (Ed.), The Neuman systems model (3rd ed.,
pp. 629–636). Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Ware, L. A., & Shannahan, M. K. (1995). Using
Neuman for a stable parent support group in neona-
tal intensive care. In B. Neuman, The Neuman
systems model (3rd ed., pp. 321–330). Norwalk,
CT: Appleton & Lange.
184 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch11_165-184 26/12/14 2:58 PM Page 184
Chapter 12Helen Erickson, Evelyn Tomlin,
and Mary Ann Swain’s Theory
of Modeling and Role Modeling
HELEN L. ERICKSON
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of Modeling and Role-Modeling
Theory
Practice Applications
Practice Exemplar
Summary
References
185
Introducing the Theorist
My life journey, filled with challenges and
opportunities, helped me discover the essence
of my Self, understand my Reason for Being,
and uncover my Life Purpose (H. Erickson,
2006a). My Self is reflected in my values and
beliefs; my Reason for Being is to learn that
unconditional love is the key to human rela-
tionships; and my Life Purpose is to facilitate
growth in others. The following snippets of my
journey offer an occasional glimpse into my
Self and the underlying philosophy of model-
ing and role-modeling (MRM).
Born and raised in north-central Michigan
with one older brother and two younger sisters,
I learned that our early experiences affect who
we become. My father worked for the highway
department; our mother cared for the family
and worked part-time as a retail clerk. I learned
that family connections, caring about others,
positive attitudes, respect for the environment,
and hard work are essential.
I was 5 years old when World War II was
declared. Although too young to understand
the implications of the war, I learned that it
was important to stand up for our beliefs and
life principles.
I learned that anything is possible if we are
persistent, our goals have integrity, and we are
honest with others and ourselves. I started
working when I was about 10 years old. My
jobs included babysitting, keeping house for a
family in need, waitressing, and clerking. Each
was an opportunity to learn about myself, and
each was a step toward nursing school.
I enrolled in a diploma program for nurses,
and in my junior year, I met my future husband
and his family. His father, Milton Erickson,
Mary Ann SwainHelen L. Erickson
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 185
well known for his work with mind–body heal-
ing, taught me that people know more about
themselves than health-care providers do, that
their inner-knowing is essential to healing, and
that we can help them by attending to their
worldview. I committed to married life, moved
to Texas, and accepted the position of head
nurse in the emergency room of the Midland
Memorial Hospital.
Between 1959 and 1967, I worked in a va-
riety of settings in Texas, Michigan, and Puerto
Rico and welcomed four children into our fam-
ily. I learned valuable lessons about blind prej-
udice, discrimination, and staying true to self;
about how personal stories provide insight into
client needs; and about the uniqueness of peo-
ple and how limiting labels did not capture
their wholeness. I had opportunities to develop
a professional practice model.
In 1974, I completed my RN-BSN pro-
gram at the University of Michigan and was
recruited as a faculty member and consultant
at the University Hospital.
I enrolled in the master’s program in
medical–surgical and psychiatric nursing and
graduated in 1976. During this time, Evelyn
Tomlin and I talked freely about the nursing
model I had derived from practice. I labeled
and developed the adaptive potential assess-
ment model and worked with Mary Ann
Swain to test some of my hypotheses (H. Er-
ickson & Swain, 1982). I continued in my fac-
ulty position and advanced to chairman of the
undergraduate program and assistant dean.
Over the next 10 years, my model of nursing
acquired a life of its own. By the early 1980s, I
had speaking invitations but little had been
written (H. Erickson, 1976; H. Erickson &
Swain, 1982). Together Evelyn, Mary Ann, and
I further elaborated some of the concepts. The
term modeling and role-modeling (MRM), first
coined by Milton Erickson, was selected as the
best descriptor of this work. The original edition
was printed in November 1982 (H. Erickson,
Tomlin, & Swain, 2009), has had eight reprints,
and is now considered a classic by the Society
for the Advancement of Modeling and Role-
Modeling (SAMRM). I completed my PhD in
1984, left Michigan in 1986, spent 2 years at the
University of South Carolina School of Nursing
as associate dean of academic affairs and then
moved to the University of Texas, where I as-
sumed the role of professor and chair of adult
health nursing. When I retired in 1997, the
Helen L. Erickson Endowed Lectureship on
Holistic Nursing was established at the
University of Texas in Austin.
I have authored or coauthored chapters
on MRM and/or holistic nursing (Clayton,
Erickson, & Rogers, 2006; H. Erickson, 1996,
2002, 2006b, 2006c, 2006d, 2006e, 2007,
2008; M. Erickson, Erickson, & Jensen, 2006;
Walker & Erickson, 2006), some of which are
included in the second book on MRM, and
more recently, a book on the relationship be-
tween the philosophy and discipline of holistic
nursing. I know now that advancing holistic
health care is my mission, my life work; MRM
is a vehicle for that purpose.1
Overview of Modeling and
Role-Modeling Theory
MRM is based in several nursing principles
that guide the assessment, intervention, and
evaluation aspects of practice. These principles,
reflected in the data collection categories
(H. Erickson et al., 2009, pp. 148–168), are linked
to intervention aims and goals (H. Erickson
et al., 2009, pp. 168–201). Although both in-
tervention aims and goals involve nursing
actions, they differ in their purpose. Nursing
interventions should have intent; nurses should
aim to make something happen that facilitates
health and healing when they interact with
clients. There should also be markers that help
us evaluate the efficacy of our activities—
intervention goals. Table 12-1 shows the rela-
tions among MRM principles of nursing, data
needed to practice this model, the aims of
nursing actions, and specific goals.
Modeling
The modeling process involves assessment of a
client’s situation. It starts when we initiate an in-
teraction with an individual and concludes with
186 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
1For additional information, please see the bonus chapter
content available at http://davisplus.fadavis.com.
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 186
CHAPTER 12 • Helen Erickson, Evelyn Tomlin, and Mary Ann Swain’s Theory of Modeling 187
Principles Categories of Data Goals Aims
The nursing process
requires that a trusting
and functional relation-
ship exist between
nurse and client.
Affiliated-individuation
is contingent on the
individual’s perceiving
that he or she is an ac-
ceptable, respectable,
and worthwhile human
being.
Human development is
dependent on the indi-
vidual’s perceiving that
he or she has some
control over life while
concurrently sensing a
state of affiliation.
There is an innate drive
toward holistic health
that is facilitated by
consistent and system-
atic nurturance.
Human growth is de-
pendent on satisfaction
of basic needs and is fa-
cilitated by growth-need
satisfaction.
Adapted with permission from Erickson, H., Tomlin, E., & Swain, M. A. (Eds.). (2009). Modeling and role-modeling: A the-
ory and paradigm for nursing (p. 171). Cedar Park, TX: EST.
Table 12 • 1 Relations Among Principles, Data Categories, Intervention Goals,
and Aims
Description of the
situation
Expectation
(External) Resource
potential
(Internal) Resource
potential
(Internal) Resource
potential
Goal and life tasks
Develop a trusting
and functional rela-
tionship between self
and your client.
Facilitate a self-
projection that is
futuristic and positive.
Promote affiliated-
individuation with
the minimum degree
of ambivalence
possible.
Promote a dynamic,
adaptive, and holistic
state of health.
Promote (and nurture)
coping mechanisms
that satisfy basic needs
and permit growth-
need satisfaction.
Facilitate congruent
actual and chrono-
logical development
stages.
Build trust.
Promote client’s
positive orientation.
Promote client’s
control.
Affirm and promote
client’s strengths.
Set mutual goals that
are health directed.
an understanding of that person’s perspective of
their circumstances. We aim to learn how that in-
dividual describes the situation, what he or she
expects will happen, and his or her perceived re-
sources and life goals. As we listen and observe,
we interpret the information using the constructs
embedded in the theory. Stated simplistically,
modeling is the process we use to build a mirror image
of an individual’s worldview. This worldview helps
us understand what that person perceives to be im-
portant, what has caused his or her problems, what
will help, and how he or she wants to relate to others.
Table 12-2 shows the categories of data and
the type of information needed in the model-
ing process.
Table 12-3 shows the priority given to the
information we collect. Primary data are ac-
quired from the client; secondary data include
the nurse’s observations and information from
the family. Tertiary data include information
from medical records and other sources. Pri-
mary and secondary data are essential for pro-
fessional practice, whereas tertiary data are
added as needed.
Role-Modeling
The role-modeling process requires both objec-
tive and artistic actions. First, we analyze the
data using theoretical propositions in the MRM
model (Table 12-4; H. Erickson et al., 2009,
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 187
188 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Categories of Data Collection Purpose of Data Is to Obtain
Description of the
Situation
Expectations
Resource Potential
Goal and Life Tasks
Adapted with permission from Erickson, H., Tomlin, E., & Swain, M. A. (Eds.). (2009). Modeling and role-modeling: A the-
ory and paradigm for nursing (p. 119). Cedar Park, TX: EST.
Table 12 • 2 Categories of Data and Purpose for Obtaining Data
1. An overview of client’s perception of the problem
2. The etiology of the problem including stressors and distressors
3. Client’s perceived therapeutic needs
1. Immediate expectations
2. Long-term expectations
1. External: Social network, support system, and health-care
system
2. Internal: Self-strengths, adaptive potential, feeling states,
physiological states
1. Current goals
2. Plans for future
Primary Source Client’s self-care knowledge
Secondary Source
Tertiary Source
Table 12 • 3 Sources of Information
Information from family and nurses’ observations
Medical records and other information related to client’s case
1. Developmental task resolution is related to basic need status.
2. Growth depends on basic need status and is facilitated by growth need satisfaction.
3. Basic need satisfaction leads to object attachment.
4. Object loss leads to basic need deficits.
5. Affiliated-individuation is dependent on one’s perception of acceptance and worth.
6. Feelings of worth result in a sense of futurity.
7. Development of self-care resources is related to basic need satisfaction.
8. Ability to mobilize coping resources is related to need satisfaction.
9. Responses to stressors are mediated by internal and external resources.
10. Ability to mobilize appropriate and adequate resources determines resultant health status.
Table 12 • 4 Selected Theoretical Propositions in MRM Theory
pp. 148–167). We interpret the meaning of
what has been provided and search for linkages
among the data that will help us understand
the client’s worldview. As we analyze the data,
implications for nursing actions emerge (H.
Erickson et al., 2009, pp. 168–220). Nursing ac-
tions are then artistically designed with intent
(i.e., the aims of interventions) and specific out-
comes (i.e., intervention goals). Our overall ob-
jectives are to help people grow and heal and to
find meaning in their experiences. The following
sections elaborate each of these objectives. The
first section addresses the philosophical assump-
tions that underlie this model; theoretical under-
pinnings follow with implications for practice.
Finally, the global applications of MRM are
presented.
Philosophical Assumptions
Nursing has a metaparadigm that includes four
extant constructs: person, environment, health,
and nursing; sometimes social justice is added
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 188
as a fifth construct (Schim, Benkert, Bell,
Walker, & Danford, 2007). The operational
definitions of these constructs provide the con-
text necessary to clarify how an individual’s
actions are unique to nursing as opposed to the
actions of another profession. Although all
nursing theories are developed and articulated
within this context, our personal philosophy
affects how we define and operationalize the
constructs of nursing and therefore how we ar-
ticulate our models (H. Erickson, 2010). For
this reason, it is important to be clear about
our own philosophical beliefs and how they
affect our conceptual definitions and our the-
oretical models. Nurses can use clear philo-
sophical statements to determine whether
the underpinnings of a theoretical model are
consistent with their own belief systems
(H. Erickson, 2010). When they are not, dis-
crepancies among nursing’s philosophical be-
liefs, the nurse’s personal belief system, and the
theoretical propositions often create disso-
nance that impedes the nurses’ ability to use
the model (H. Erickson et al., 2009). The
philosophical assumptions underlying the
MRM theory and paradigm are described in
the text that follows. The first section presents
MRM’s orientation toward two of nursing’s
metaparadigm constructs: person and environ-
ment. Health, nursing, and social justice are
described in the following sections.
Person and Environment
Humans are inherently holistic. This means
that all aspects of the human are intercon-
nected and dynamically interactive; what af-
fects one part affects another. This is different
from the wholistic person, wherein the parts
are associated but not necessarily intercon-
nected or interactive (Fig. 12-1). When we ap-
proach people from a wholistic perspective, we
can break them down into systems, organs,
and other parts. When we view them as holis-
tic, we understand that all the dimensions of
the human being are interconnected; what af-
fects one part has the potential to affect other
parts. Our holistic nature is manifested
through our innate instincts and drives: in-
stincts and drives necessary for humans to
maneuver through the pathways of their life
journey. Table 12-5 provides examples of each
of these. Although some might argue that all
animals have an innate instinct to cope and
some have an innate ability to receive and in-
terpret stimuli, most would agree that not all
animals have an innate drive to receive stimuli
in a cognitive form, to acquire skills necessary
to perceive and understand stimuli, to give and
receive feedback, the freedom to speak, or the
CHAPTER 12 • Helen Erickson, Evelyn Tomlin, and Mary Ann Swain’s Theory of Modeling 189
Cognitive Psychological
Social
The Holistic model
Biophysical
G
en
et
ic
b
as
e
an
d
sp
iri
tu
al
D
.G
.P
.I.
CognitivePsychological
Social
The Wholistic model
Biophysical
Fig 12 • 1 Holism versus wholism.
A
B
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 189
190 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Instincts Inherent in
Human Nature
Drives That Motivate
Our Behavior
Table 12 • 5 Selected List of Human Instincts and Drives
To receive and interpret stimuli
To cope and adapt to stressors
To experience mind–body–spirit intraconnectedness, or holistic
well-being
To cognitively interpret stimuli
To acquire skills necessary to perceive and interpret stimuli
To give and receive feedback
To communicate freely
To choose and act freely
To experience balanced affiliated-individuation
To be self-actualized
freedom to choose. These latter characteristics
are unique to the human species, are innate,
and often motivate our behavior (Maslow,
1968, 1982). I have added one instinct—an
inherent instinct for holistic well-being—and
two human drives: the drive for healthy
affiliated-individuation and the drive for self-
actualization. These instincts and drives affect
how we function as holistic beings. The holistic
person is one in whom the whole is greater
than the sum of the parts, whereas a wholistic
person is one in whom the whole is equal to
the sum of the parts (H. Erickson et al., 2009,
pp. 45–46).
As holistic beings, our mind, body, and spirit
are inextricably interrelated with continuous
feedback loops. Cells in each dimension can
produce stimuli affecting responses in cells of
other dimensions. Cellular responses have the
potential to become new stimuli, moving the
chain reaction around and among the dimen-
sions of the human being. These interactions
are dynamic and ongoing. Because we have an
internal environment (i.e., within the confines
of our physical being) and an external environ-
ment (i.e., outside the confines of the biopsy-
chosocial being), external stimuli have the
potential to create multiple internal responses,
and vice versa. To agree that we are holistic is
to believe that we are human beings, living in
a context that includes all that is within us and
within our external environment—holistic be-
ings, constantly in process both internally and
externally. These dynamically interactive di-
mensions cannot be separated without a loss
of information about the person, a loss that
diminishes our ability to fully understand the
person’s situation.
Humans are inherently intuitive. We know
(at some level) what we need. We know what
has made us sick and what will help us get well,
grow, develop, and heal. We have instinctual
information about our own personhood and
our mind–body–spirit linkages. This informa-
tion is called self-care knowledge. Our percep-
tions of what we have available to help us are
called self-care resources. Self-care resources are
both internal and external. We have resources
within ourselves as well as resources within our
external environment. Our actions, thoughts,
biophysical responses, and behavior that help
us get our needs met are our self-care actions.
We are inherently social beings with an innate
drive to grow and develop, to become the most
that we can be, find meaning in our lives, fulfill
our potential, and self-actualize. However,
we are vulnerable. Our ability to grow and de-
velop is dependent on repeated satisfaction of
our needs. We want and need to be connected
or affiliated to others in some way. Simulta-
neously, we also need to perceive ourselves as
unique and individuated from these same
people. We call this affiliated-individuation
(Acton, 1992; H. Erickson et al., 2009, p. 47;
M. Erickson et al., 2006, pp. 182–207). Our
drive to be both affiliated and individuated at
the same time mandates a balance between
being connected while perceiving a sense of
one’s self as a unique human being, separate
from others. We achieve our drive for a bal-
anced affiliated-individuation through our in-
teractions with others. How well we achieve
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 190
this balance at any point in our life will deter-
mine how we relate to others in the following
years.
Although we are social beings with a drive
for affiliated-individuation with others, we are
also spiritual beings with an inherent drive to
be connected with our soul (H. Erickson et al.,
2009, 2006). More specifically, our drive for
individuation is to fulfill our psychosocial
needs while doing soul-work unique to our life
journey.
Health
Health is a matter of perception. It is a state
of well-being in the whole person, not just a
part of the person. It is not the presence, ab-
sence, or control of disease; one’s ability to
adapt; or one’s ability to perform social roles.
Instead, it is a eudemonistic health that incor-
porates all of these and more. It is a sense of
well-being in the holistic, social being. It in-
cludes one’s perceptions of her life quality,
her ability to find meaning in her existence,
and a capacity to enjoy a positive orientation
toward the future. As a result, personal per-
ceptions of health may differ from those of
others. It is possible for persons with no ob-
vious physical problem to perceive a low level
of health, while at the same time others, tak-
ing their last mortal breath, may perceive
themselves as very healthy. The perception of
health status is always related to perceived
balance of affiliated-individuation.
Nursing
Nursing is the unconditional acceptance of the
inherent worth of another human being.
When we have unconditional acceptance for
another person, we recognize that all humans
have an innate need to be loved, to belong, to
be respected, and to feel worthy. Uncondi-
tional acceptance of a person as a worthwhile
being is not the same as accepting all behaviors
without conditions. It does mean, however,
that we recognize that behaviors are motivated
by unmet needs. Our work, then, is to help
people find ways to get their needs met with-
out harming themselves or others.
We do this through nurturance and facili-
tation of the holistic person. Our goal is to help
people grow, develop, and, when necessary, to
heal. We use all of our skills acquired through
formal education as well as our own innate abil-
ity to connect with others to help them recover
from illnesses and to live meaningful lives. We
do this from the beginning of physical life to
the end, even as people are taking their last
breath. Within this context, our intent, or what
we aim to facilitate when we interact with an-
other human being, is important.
Social Justice
As professional nurses, we are committed to
live by the ethics of our profession, serve as ad-
vocates for our clients, and serve the public as
defined by our professional standards. For
nurses who use the MRM theory, this means
that we are committed to recognize the indi-
vidual’s worldview as valid information, to act
on that information with the intent of nurtur-
ing and facilitating growth and well-being in
our clients, and to practice within the context
of the Standards of Holistic Nursing as defined
by the American Holistic Nurses Association
(AHNA, 2013) and recognized by the American
Nurses Association (ANA, 2008).
Theoretical Constructs
People have an innate instinct to cope and
adapt to stressors and related stress responses
that confront us constantly. We adapt as
much as we are able to, given our life situa-
tion. We need oxygen, glucose, and protein to
maintain our physical systems; we also need
to feel safe and to be loved. When these needs
are perceived to be unmet, they create stres-
sors; stressors produce the stress response.
Stress responses can become new stressors
mandating still more responses, and so on
(Benson, 2006, pp. 240–266; H. Erickson,
1976; H. Erickson et al., 2009). Many of our
stress responses are instinctual, a part of our
human makeup; however, some have to be
learned and developed. As our needs are met,
the stressors decrease; and we are able to work
through the stress response.
Adaptive Potential
Our ability to mobilize resources at any mo-
ment in time can be identified as our Adaptive
CHAPTER 12 • Helen Erickson, Evelyn Tomlin, and Mary Ann Swain’s Theory of Modeling 191
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 191
Potential. The adaptive potential assessment
model (APAM; Fig. 12-2), first labeled in
1976 (H. Erickson, 1976; H. Erickson &
Swain, 1982; H. Erickson et al., 2009), was
derived by synthesizing Selye’s (1974, 1976,
1980, 1985) work with that of George Engel
(1964). Our adaptive potential has three states:
equilibrium, arousal, and impoverishment.
Equilibrium, a state of nonstress or eustress,
represents maximum ability to mobilize re-
sources. The individual in equilibrium is in a
healthy balance between need demands and
need resources.
Arousal and impoverishment are both stress
states; needs are unmet, creating stressors and
the related stress responses. However, people
in arousal are temporarily able to mobilize their
resources, whereas those in impoverishment are
not. Persons in the first group (arousal) need
help solving their problem, finding alternatives.
They tend to be tense and anxious but do not
demonstrate depleted resources through the ex-
pression of fatigue and sadness. On the other
hand, impoverished people show the wear and
tear of prolonged stress. They have diminished
physical resources and are fatigued and sad.
People in arousal are at risk for becoming
impoverished, and impoverished people are at
risk for depleting their resources, getting sick,
developing complications, and even dying
(Barnfather, 1987; Barnfather & Ronis, 2000;
Benson, 2006, pp. 242–254; H. Erickson,
1976; H. Erickson et al., 2009, pp. 75–83;
H. Erickson & Swain, 1982). As indicated, a
person’s ability to cope is related to how well
his or her needs are met at any given point in
time.
Human Needs
Human needs, classified as basic, social, and
growth needs, drive our behavior. They provide
motivation for our self-care actions and emerge
in a quasi-hierarchical order. Physiological
needs must be met to some degree before social
needs emerge. Growth or higher-level needs
emerge after the basic and social needs have
been met to some degree (for a more detailed
taxonomy of human needs, see H. Erickson,
2006a, pp. 484–485). Basic needs are related to
survival of the species. When they are unmet,
tension rises, motivating behavioral response(s)
necessary to decrease the tension. When self-
care actions decrease the tension, the need dis-
sipates. When the need is completely satisfied,
the tension disappears. When needs are met
repeatedly, need assets are built. Conversely,
when the need is not met, the tension rises, and
need deficits emerge. When the tension contin-
ues, need deprivation exists. Need status can
be classified on a 0 to 5 scale ranging from
deprivation to asset status (Fig. 12-3). Growth
needs are different. Because people have an in-
nate drive for self-actualization, growth needs
emerge when basic needs are met (to some de-
gree). Unmet growth needs do not create ten-
sion unless they are related to a basic need.
Instead, satisfaction of growth needs creates ten-
sion. The need increases in intensity. Until one
feels satiated, the need to continue to behave in
ways that will meet growth needs continues.
Need Satisfaction and the Object
Attachment Process
Objects that repeatedly meet humans needs
become attachment objects. These objects take
on significance unique to the individual, are
both human and nonhuman, have a physical
form (so they stimulate one of the five senses)
or are abstract (such as an idea), and are nec-
essary throughout life. When a person per-
ceives that the object is or will be lost, a
grieving response occurs. Loss is a subjective
192 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Equilibrium
Stressor
S
tressorS
tre
ss
or
C
op
in
g
C
oping
Stress ImpoverishmentArousal
Fig 12 • 2 The adaptive potential assessment
model.
Deprivation Deficit Unmet Met Satisfied Assets
0 1 2 3 4 5
Fig 12 • 3 The needs status scale, 0 to 5.
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 192
experience known by the individual; it can be
real, threatened, or perceived. Any loss pro-
duces a grieving process. One’s difficulty in re-
solving the loss depends on the significance of
the lost object. The grieving response is nor-
mal, occurs in a predetermined sequence, and
is self-limited. Normal grieving processes take
about 1 year (Fig. 12-4). Grief resolution oc-
curs as the individual finds new ways to view
the lost object or finds alternative objects
that meet their needs. Commonly accepted
processes of grief include sequential phases of
shock/disbelief, anger, bargaining, sadness,
and acceptance (Kübler-Ross, 1969). Other
models (Engel, 1964; Bowlby, 1973) indicate
slightly different phases (M. Erickson, 2006,
p. 229). Table 12-6 compares three of these
models. I believe that their differences are
based in the nature of the lost object, its mean-
ing to the individual, and the resources accrued
CHAPTER 12 • Helen Erickson, Evelyn Tomlin, and Mary Ann Swain’s Theory of Modeling 193
Satisfied
needs
Basic
needs
Unmet
needs
Secure
attachment
to object
meeting
needs
Positive
developmental
residual
Health-
promoting
behaviors
High-level
wellness
Negative
developmental
residual
Health-
impeding
behaviors
Physical and
psychological
problems
Resolution
of loss with
reattachment
and satisfied
needs
Nonresolution
of loss with
continued
unmet needs
Situational or
developmental
loss and grief
Holistic
well-being
Insecure
attachment
with continued
unmet needs
and morbid
grief
before the experienced loss. Resources are
based on one’s ability to work through the nor-
mal developmental tasks encountered during
the human journey. This issue is discussed fur-
ther in the text that follows.
Attachment to new objects is necessary for
continued growth and grief resolution. The new
object can be the same object, perceived in a
new way, or a completely new object. Some-
times transitional objects are used to facilitate
this process. Transitional objects are those
that symbolize the lost object and are never
human, but are almost always concrete. For
example, mothers attached to their children as
preschoolers often experience a loss when their
children start school and become increasingly
independent. It is common to see these moth-
ers attach to their child’s baby shoes, pictures,
or some other symbol of who they were in their
previous life stage.
Fig 12 • 4 The needs–attachment–development–loss–reattachment model.
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 193
194 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Engel Kübler-Ross Bowlby
Shock/disbelief
Awareness
Resolution
Loss resolution
Idealization
Italicized stages indicate unresolved loss with movement toward morbid grief.
Reprinted with permission from Erickson, H. (Ed.). (2006). Modeling and role-modeling: A view from the client’s world
(p. 229). Cedar Park, TX: Unicorns Unlimited.
Table 12 • 6 Stages of Grief According to Contributing Authors
Denial/shock
Anger/hostility
Bargaining
Depression
Acceptance
Protest
Despair
Detachment
Morbid grief emerges when the individual
is unable to find alternative objects that will
repeatedly meet their needs. Because we are
holistic beings, morbid grief has the potential
to result in physical symptoms, illness, and
over the long period, disease. What happens
in one part of the holistic person has the
potential of creating disease in another part,
disease that becomes distressful, mandates
mobilization of resources often not available,
and therefore producing alternative biophysi-
cal responses, depleting psychoneuroimmuno-
logical resources (Walker & Erickson, 2006
Behaviors that indicate emergence of mor-
bid grief include an inability to move on and
let go of the lost object, combined with vacil-
lation between anger and sadness (M. Erickson,
2006, pp. 209–239; Lindeman, 1944, pp. 141–
148). Initially individuals are able to focus their
anger and sadness, but with time, anger grows
into hostility and sadness into depression.
When this happens, people are less able to ar-
ticulate the focus of their feelings or recognize
the loss that produced the grieving response in
the beginning. They often use language that
describes giving up rather than letting go, and
sometimes express nostalgia for the lost object.
In contrast, those who have let go of the lost
object, worked through the normal grief re-
sponse, and reattached to a new object can
usually describe the importance of moving on.
Need Satisfaction and Life Orientation
The degree to which a person’s needs are met
repeatedly determines how he or she relates to
others; it affects his or her life orientation.
When needs are met repeatedly, people are
able to grow and develop, to integrate mind–
body–spirit, to perceive themselves as worthy
human beings, and to experience a healthy
balance of affiliated-individuation. When this
happens, they are interested in others as indi-
viduals who are unique and worthwhile. They
enjoy both a sense of connectedness and a
sense of individuation. Their life orientation is
called a being orientation because they are in-
terested in becoming all they can be and in
participating in the same way with others.
However, when needs are repeatedly unmet,
growth is limited, and people have difficulty
with their developmental processes. Their rela-
tionships with others exist within a context of
what can be obtained from the other. They are
not interested in the well-being of the other,
might be threatened by growth in significant
others, and are intolerant of the uniqueness of
others. More interested in what they can get
from someone than what they can give, these
people often view others as a source of getting
their basic needs met. As a result, often unable
to meet the needs of significant others, they are
perceived as “needy people.” Their life orienta-
tion is called a deficit orientation. Being and
deficit orientations exist on a scale; most people
have some of both. The balance between the
two is what determines one’s overriding traits
or personal attributes, one’s values and virtues,
and one’s ways of interacting with others.
Developmental Processes
People have an inherent drive for self-
actualization. This requires that they pass
through predetermined chronological develop-
mental stages—stages with tasks that mandate
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 194
attention as they emerge. Our ability to work on
these developmental tasks depends on our ability
to mobilize resources. Resources are derived by
getting our needs met at any given time as well
as our past experiences. Because our experiences
are always contextual, how we resolve our devel-
opmental tasks will determine the resources
we have to work on current tasks. As we work
through a stage-related task, a developmental
residual is produced. This residual includes
positive and negative attributes, strengths, and
virtues. In our original work, we followed Erik
Erikson’s (1994) work to define eight stages,
their tasks, and the associated residual. Our more
recent work has expanded the stages to include
one prebirth and another at the time of death
because the work of the soul affects the devel-
opmental processes during one’s physical life
(M. Erickson, 2006, pp. 121–181; Table 12-7).
Sequential Development
Development occurs as a series of predeter-
mined stages with specific tasks in each stage.
It is also chronological: unique, sequential
stages, and their related tasks emerge during a
specific time frame in our lives. During that
time, the task becomes predominate in our life
journey, drawing resources, focusing attention,
and motivating behaviors.
Epigenesis
Development is also epigenetic. Although we
have specific tasks that focus our attention at spe-
cific times in life, we also rework earlier life tasks
and set the framework for later tasks at the same
time. This later work is done within the context
of the appointed life task. Simply stated, we re-
peatedly work on all of the developmental tasks
at every stage of life, although we have a key task
that dominates at any given time. Our ability to
manage multiple tasks is dependent on the resid-
ual we have produced throughout the process and
our current ability to have our needs met.
Linkages
Three key theoretical linkages exist in the
MRM model. Relations exist between or
among (1) adaptive potential and need status;
CHAPTER 12 • Helen Erickson, Evelyn Tomlin, and Mary Ann Swain’s Theory of Modeling 195
Stages/Age Residual Virtue Strength(s)
Integration of Spirit
(pre–post birth)
Building Trust
(birth–15 months)
Acquiring
Autonomy
(12–36 months)
Taking Initiative
(2–7 years)
Developing Industry
(5–13 years)
Developing Identity
(11–30 years)
Building Intimacy
(20–50 years)
Developing Genera-
tivity (midlife to 60s)
Ego Integrity (60s to
transformation)
Transformation (end
of physical life)
Adapted with permission from Erickson, H. (Ed.). (2006). Modeling and role-modeling: A view from the client’s world
(Table 5.1, pp. 128–129). Cedar Park TX: Unicorns Unlimited.
Table 12 • 7 Developmental Stages, Residual, Virtues, and Strengths
Unity vs. duality
Trust vs. mistrust
Autonomy vs.
introspection
Initiative vs.
responsibility
Competency vs.
inferiority
Self-identity vs.
role confusion
Intimacy vs.
isolation
Generativity vs.
stagnation
Ego integrity vs.
despair
Reconnecting vs.
disconnecting
Groundedness
Hope
Willpower
Purpose
Competence
Fidelity
Love
Caring
Wisdom
Oneness
Awareness
Drive toward future
Self-control
Drive
Methodological
problem-solving
Devotion
Affiliation with
individuation
Production
Renunciation
Peace, cosmic under-
standing, compassion
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 195
(2) need status, object attachment, loss, and new
attachment status; and (3) developmental task
resolution and need satisfaction. Selected theo-
retical propositions, derived from these linkages,
are shown in Table 12-4. Others exist, limited
only by an understanding of MRM.
MRM Practice Strategies
Initiating the Relationship
Three sequential strategies are important for
those using the MRM model: (1) establishing
a mindset, (2) creating a nurturing space, and
(3) facilitating the story (H. Erickson, 2006b,
pp. 309–317; Table 12-8). Each can be done
in seconds once the essence of the strategy is
understood. However, before you can start, it
is necessary to reflect on your own beliefs
about human nature and nursing and to con-
sider how these affect your practice. This
helps you clarify how to get your needs met—a
prerequisite to meeting the needs of others.
Unless we know how to initiate our own self-
care, we have difficulty mobilizing the energy
necessary to focus on the needs of our clients.
Finally, we have to open ourselves to the
worth of each individual, to unconditionally
accept that each human has an inherent need
to be valued, to be treated with respect, and
to live with dignity.
Establishing a Mindset
Establishing a mindset involves three strate-
gies: centering, focusing, and opening. Center-
ing helps to organize our resources so that we
can connect energetically with our client. It re-
quires that we temporarily put aside other
thoughts, worries, or concerns and believe that
at some level we can discover what we need to
know to help our clients; it requires us to focus
on the other with the intent of nurturing their
growth and facilitating their healing. When
we focus on our client’s needs, we initiate an
energetic connection, necessary for a caring–
healing environment.
Creating a Nurturing Space
Creating a nurturing space follows naturally
when we have established a mind-set. Our
goal is to create a caring–healing environment.
Although one cannot force growth in others,
we can create environments that nurture
growth. We do this by decreasing adverse
stimuli while increasing positive ones. It is im-
portant to remember that you are entering the
client’s space and to respect it. Even though
you may think it is important to close the door,
turn on the radio, or fluff pillows, you will
want to assess whether your actions serve to
comfort the client. Each of these processes
helps you connect with your client in such a
196 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Establish a Mindset
Create a Nurturing
Space
Facilitate the Client’s
Story
Adapted with permission from Erickson, H. (Ed.). (2006). Modeling and role-modeling: A view from the client’s world
(pp. 307–317). Cedar Park, TX: Unicorns Unlimited.
Table 12 • 8 Three Strategies That Facilitate a Trusting–Functional Relationship
Self-care preliminaries
Moving forward
Reduce distracting
stimuli.
Respect client’s space.
Connect spirit to spirit.
Tap self-care
knowledge.
Enhance sense-of-self.
Center self.
Focus intent.
Open self to the essence of other.
Attend to sounds, lights, smells, and other
stimuli that are distracting and discomforting.
Recognize and respect client’s physical/
energetic space.
Use eye contact, soft tones, and gentle touch
to connect with client.
Address stimuli, encourage focus on
nurse–client linkage.
Relate to beliefs about client’s self-care
knowledge as primary.
Encourage client’s perceptions of the
situation.
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 196
way that you will initiate a trusting relationship
and create a caring–healing environment. Any
stimuli that affects the five senses has the pos-
sibility of being comforting, uncomfortable, or
discomforting. We can influence these by our
actions in the milieu and by our interactions
with our client. For example, a noisy hallway
or bright lights shining in our eyes are stimuli
that seem to drain energy from us, and no
doubt our clients experience the same thing.
Or consider a beautiful picture, the glimpse of
a fully leafed tree swaying in a gentle breeze,
soft music of our choice, clean sheets against
our skin, or the gentle touch of a loving person.
In thinking about how you respond to these
stimuli, you will understand that these have
the possibility of comforting another human
being. You will also understand that how you
touch, look, or speak to someone conveys a
message about your intent to comfort or not to
comfort. Of course, it is extremely important
that we consider the individual’s cultural per-
spectives and values as we consider how to cre-
ate a nurturing space; what works for one
person does not for another. The only way we
can know is to ask our clients or, when they
are unable to speak for themselves, to ask their
significant others.
Facilitating the Story
Facilitating the story is the third strategy that
MRM nurses use. Disclosure of our clients’
self-care knowledge provides basic information
needed before we can decide what nursing ac-
tions are required—information that provides
insight into their worldview. We learn about
their perceptions and beliefs, what they believe
about their current situation, what they expect
will happen, what resources they believe they
have, and what they would like to do to alter
the situation. It also allows them to “contextu-
alize life experiences and present them in a way
that softens associated feelings” (H. Erickson,
2006b, p. 315).
Our clients’ self-care knowledge is best ob-
tained by allowing them to tell their story in
their own way. We use active listening to fa-
cilitate our clients to tell their stories. This can
be done very quickly by initiating the discus-
sion with statements such as, “Tell me about
your situation” followed by “Why do you think
this has happened?” or “What do you think
has caused it?” and “How do you feel about
that?” and so forth (H. Erickson et al., 2009,
pp. 153–167). The data are then organized into
four distinct but interrelated categories: de-
scription of the situation, expectations, resource
potential, and goals (see Table 12-2). Informa-
tion provided by our clients has to be inter-
preted, aggregated, and analyzed before we can
use it to plan interventions (H. Erickson et al.,
2009, pp. 153–168).
Phases of Understanding the Data
There are three phases in understanding the in-
formation gained in MRM practice model. In
data interpretation, we use the philosophical
and theoretical underpinnings discussed earlier
as we attend to words, affects, and nonverbal
cues, searching for evidence of coping potential
(i.e., adaptive potential), needs status, and de-
velopmental residual. Sometimes it is necessary
to clarify what we observe to avoid superimpos-
ing our own interpretations on these data. For
example, clients might have a spouse or signifi-
cant other but not perceive this individual
as supportive. When this happens, they often
describe them as “draining” rather than invig-
orating. We cannot always make these dis-
tinctions without asking the client how they
perceive their relationship with their significant
other (H. Erickson et al., 2009, pp. 160–163).
A person’s story usually includes information
about interactions among the dimensions of
the holistic person, but nurses often have trou-
ble understanding the significance of what they
have heard. For example, when people say they
are sick because they are too stressed, our first
response might be to think about the cause and
effect of disease—for example, bacteria (not
stress) cause infections. However, the MRM
model supports a holistic perspective; we know
that mind and body are inextricably interactive.
Therefore, we recognize that psychosocial stress
stimulates the hypothalamic–pituitary–adrenal
axis interactions, compromising the immune
system. When this happens, we have more
difficulty fighting bacterial invasions. As a re-
sult, we know that psychosocial stress has the
potential of causing signs and symptoms of
physical illness and/or disease.
CHAPTER 12 • Helen Erickson, Evelyn Tomlin, and Mary Ann Swain’s Theory of Modeling 197
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 197
The second phase, data aggregation, some-
times occurs as we interpret data derived from
the primary source (i.e., the client), but not al-
ways. To aggregate data accurately, we need to
consider data derived from the secondary and
tertiary sources as well as the data derived from
the client. Although data can be aggregated
with only the client’s story and the nurse’s clin-
ical knowledge, it is also helpful to hear the
family’s perspective. Sometimes it is important
to include the information collected from ter-
tiary sources as well.
When aggregating data, we consider all the
information and look for consistencies as well
as inconsistencies across the sources of infor-
mation. Additional information may be nec-
essary to clarify perspectives. Usually, this
phase helps determine what needs to be done
when moving into the intervention phase of
the nursing process.
Data analysis is the next phase. Again, you
may be doing all three—interpreting, aggre-
gating, and analyzing—simultaneously. Dur-
ing the analysis phase, you look for theoretical
linkages among the data and make diagnoses.
Proactive Nursing Care
Often the process of assessing our clients’
worldview serves as a therapeutic intervention.
People in arousal commonly state that they feel
much better after talking. Some will ask for
minimal help, but some require more sophis-
ticated help. In any case, based on our diag-
noses, nursing care is planned within the
context of the MRM principles of care, aimed
at facilitating well-being in our clients, and de-
signed specifically to meet intervention goals.
We do this as we manage technical care such
as wound management, intravenous insertion,
and so forth. We use nonjudgmental language,
caring tones, and direct statements that relay
information needed to feel safe and cared
about. We also use Ericksonian hypnothera-
peutic techniques to promote growth and
facilitate healing (H. Erickson et al., 2009,
pp. 84–85, 145–147; H. Erickson, 2006b,
pp. 315–317; 372–374; Zeig, 1982).
We can also do this without ever touching
the person because we use ourselves as con-
duits of healing energy. Sometimes knowing
that someone cares about us will help us grow
and heal. We project these messages through
our actions when we unconditionally accept
the worth of another human being and set
intent to facilitate health and healing.
Watzlawick (1967) stated that “we cannot
not communicate.” Our attitudes, nonverbal
behaviors, and touch are often more important
than what we say when we convey our intent
to help others heal and grow; words are not al-
ways necessary. Our demeanor, the way we
look at the person, what we focus on first, and
how we touch our clients relays our intent.
When we enter a relationship with the intent
to comfort and nurture the other person, our
energy field connects with his; we convey pres-
ence and initiate a caring–healing environment
(H. Erickson, 2006b, pp. 300–324).
Practice Applications
MRM, recognized by AHNA as one of the
extant holistic nursing theories, is used in a va-
riety of settings including educational institu-
tions as a framework for entire programs or
specific courses, hospitals to guide practice,
and for independent practice (Table 12-9).
The Society for the Advancement of Mod-
eling and Role-Modeling (SAMRM; www
.mrmnursingtheory.org), established in 1985,
meets biennially with retreats in alternate
years. Selected publications (Table 12-10)
demonstrate how MRM has been applied
across populations and settings from pediatrics
to the elderly, chronically ill to the well, and
intensive care to home care. Others (such as
publications by Baas, Barnfather, Duke, Frisch,
Hertz, Kelly, and Perese; see Table 12-10)
describe MRM with those who have heart fail-
ure, undereducated adult learners, and/or
employed mothers with preschool children.
For example, Baas (2004) has tested relations
between self-care resources and activities and
quality of life and developed protocol for nurs-
ing practice. Baas, Past President of the Amer-
ican Association of Heart Failure (AAFH)
Nurses and Director of Nursing Research at
the University of Cincinnati Medical Center
(2009–2012), continues to be actively involved
in setting practice protocol for nurses working
198 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 198
CHAPTER 12 • Helen Erickson, Evelyn Tomlin, and Mary Ann Swain’s Theory of Modeling 199
Harding University, School of Nursing,
Searcy, Arkansas
Metro State University, School of Nursing,
St. Paul, Minnesota
The College of St. Catherine’s, School of
Nursing, St. Paul, Minnesota
The University of Texas at Austin, School of
Nursing
Contemporary Health Care, Austin, Texas
Table 12 • 9 Agencies Using or Teaching Modeling and Role-Modeling
Theoretical foundation for pediatric clinical course
Theoretical foundation, and student advising
Theoretical foundation, ADN Program
Theoretical foundation, the Alternate Entry Program
Independent Nurse Practice Agency
with people experiencing congestive heart fail-
ure. Duke, Professor of Nursing and Associate
Dean for Research, University of Texas at
Tyler, previously interested in the experiences
of single mothers (published in Weber, 1999),
is currently studying attitudes about and pref-
erences for end-of-life care in persons of
Jewish, Hindu, Muslim, Buddhist, and Bhai’I
faiths and living in Texas. Both Frisch &
Frisch (2010) and Perese (2012) have pub-
lished textbooks for mental health practition-
ers; Frisch & Frisch’s book is used as a
foundational book, whereas Perese’s was writ-
ten specifically for advanced practice nurses.
Hertz has developed and tested a midrange
theory derived from MRM that measures per-
ceived enactment of autonomy in the elderly.
Hertz, Professor and Director of Graduate
Studies, Northern Illinois University, is cur-
rently involved with mentoring graduate
students interested in advancing holistic care
for the elderly. Case studies are reported by
practitioners in each of the SAMRM
newsletters; these and additional publications
(Hertz, 2013; Hertz, Irving, & Bowman, 2010;
Hertz, Koren, Rossetti, & Robertson, 2008;
Jablonski & Duke, 2012; Mitty, Resnick,
Allen, Bakerjian, Hertz, Gardner et al., 2010)
can be found on the SAMRM website (www
.mrmnursingtheory.org).
Author Tested Source
Erickson, H. (1976)
Erickson, H., & Swain,
M. (1982)
Erickson, H. (1984)
Darling-Fisher, C., &
Kline-Leidy, N. (1988)
Walsh, K., Vanden
Bosch, T., & Boehm, S.
(1989)
Barnfather, J., Swain,
M. A. P., & Erickson,
H. (1989).
Erickson, H., & Swain,
M. (1990)
Table 12 • 10 Practice/Intervention Studies Related to Modeling and Role-
Modeling (MRM) Theory and Paradigm
Identification of states of
coping
MRM and well-being
Exploration of self-care
knowledge
Measuring Eriksonian devel-
opmental residual in the adult
MRM applied to two clinical
cases
Construct validity the APAM
MRM and hypertension
reduction
Unpublished master’s thesis, Univer-
sity of Michigan, Ann Arbor
Research in Nursing & Health, 5,
93–101
Dissertation Abstracts International,
45, 171. University Microfilms
No. AAD84–12136
Psychological Reports, 62,
747–754
Journal of Advanced Nursing,
14(9), 755–761
Issues in Mental Health Nursing,
10, 23–40
Issues in Mental Health Nursing,
11(3), 217–235
Continued
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 199
200 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Author Tested Source
Table 12 • 10 Practice/Intervention Studies Related to Modeling and Role-
Modeling (MRM) Theory and Paradigm—cont’d
Finch, D. (1990)
Kline-Leidy, N. (1990)
Erickson, H. (1990)
Acton, G., Irvin, B., &
Hopkins, B. (1991)
Barnfather, J. (1993)
Holl, R. (1993)
Baas, L., Deges-Curl,
E., Hertz, J., &
Robinson, K. (1994)
Webster, D., Vaughn,
K., Webb, M., &
Player, A. (1995)
Kline-Leidy, N., &
Travis, G. (1995)
Hertz, J. (1996)
Baldwin, C. (1996)
Erickson, M. (1996)
Sappington, J., &
Kelly, J. (1996)
Baas, L., Fontana, J.,
& Bhat, G. (1997)
Raudonis, B., & Acton,
G. (1997)
Acton, G., Mayhew,
P., Hopkins, B., &
Yauk, S. (1999)
Acton, G. (1997)
Irvin, B., & Acton,
G. (1997)
Jensen, B. (1997)
Baas, L., Berry, T.,
Fontana, J., & Wag-
oner, L. (1999)
Jensen, B. (1999)
Scheela, R. (1999)
Weber, G. (1999)
MRM nursing assessment
model
Relations among stress,
resources, and symptoms of
chronic illness
MRM with mind–body
problems
Theory testing research:
Building the science
Testing a theoretical
proposition of MRM
MRM vs. restricted visiting
Innovative approaches to
theory based measurement:
MRM research
MRM and brief solution-
focused therapy
Relations between
psychophysiological factors
and physical functioning
Perceived enactment of
autonomy (PEA)
Perceptions of hope
EMBAT and maternal
well-being
A case study
Self-care resources and the
quality of life
Theory-based nursing
practice
Communicating with persons
with dementia
The mediating effect of
affiliated-individuation
Stress, hope and well-being
Caring for the caregiver
Developmental growth in
adults with heart failure
Caregiver responses to MRM
Remodeling sex offenders
The meaning of well-being
(self-care knowledge)
Modeling and Role-Modeling:
Theory, Practice and Research,
1(1), 203–213
Nursing Research, 39, 230–236
In J.K. Zeig & Gilligan, S. (Eds.)
Brief Therapy: Myths, Methods, and
Metaphors. New York: Brunner/
Mazel, 473–491.
Advances in Nursing Science,
14(1), 52–61.
Issues in Mental Health Nursing,
14, 1–18.
Critical Care Nursing Quarterly,
16(2), 70–82
Advances in Nursing Science
Series: Advances in Methods of
Inquiry, 5, 147–159.
Issues in Mental Health
Nursing, 16(6), 505–518
Research in Nursing & Health, 18,
535–546
Issues in Mental Health Nursing,
17, 261–273
The Journal of Multicultural Nursing
& Health, 2(3), 41–45
Issues in Mental Health Nursing,
17, 185–200
Journal of Holistic Nursing, 14(2),
130–141
Progress in Cardiovascular Nursing,
12(1), 25–38
Journal of Advanced Nursing,
26(1), 138–145
Journal of Gerontological Nursing,
25(2), 6–13
Journal of Holistic Nursing, 15(4),
336–357
Holistic Nursing Practice, 11(2),
69–79
Home Care Provider, 2(6), 34–36
Journal of Holistic Nursing, 17(2),
117–138
Dissertation Abstracts International,
B 56/06, 3127
Journal of Psychosocial Nursing and
Mental Health Services, 37(9), 25–31
Western Journal of Nursing
Research, 21(6), 785–795
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 200
CHAPTER 12 • Helen Erickson, Evelyn Tomlin, and Mary Ann Swain’s Theory of Modeling 201
Author Tested Source
Table 12 • 10 Practice/Intervention Studies Related to Modeling and Role-
Modeling (MRM) Theory and Paradigm—cont’d
Barnfather, J., & Ronis,
D. (2000)
Timmerman, G., &
Acton, G. (2001)
Mayhew, P., Acton,
G., Yauk, S., &
Hopkins, B. (2001)
Berry, T., Baas, L.,
Fowler, C., & Allen, G.
(2002)
Perese, E. (2002)
Hertz, J., Anschutz, C.
(2002)
Baas, L. (2004)
Baas, L., Berry, T.,
Allen, G., Wizer, M.,
&Wagoner, L. (2004)
Lombardo, S. L., &
Roof, M. (2005)
Berry, T., Baas, L., &
Henthorn, C. (2007)
Psychosocial resources,
stress, and health
Relations between needs and
emotional eating
Communication, dementia,
and well-being
Spirituality in persons with
heart failure
Integrating psychiatric nurs-
ing into educational models
Relationships among PEA,
self-care, and holistic health
Self-care resources, activities
as predictors of quality of life
Awareness in persons with
heart failure or transplant
Application MRM to person
with morbid obesity
Self-reported adjustment to
implanted cardiac devices
Research in nursing & health, 23,
55–66.
Issues in Mental Health Nursing,
22(7), 691–701
Gerontological Nursing, 22,
106–110
Journal of Holistic Nursing, 20(1),
pp. 5–30
Journal of American Association of
Psychiatric Nurses, 8(5), 152–158
Journal of Holistic Nursing, 20,
166–186
Dimensions of Critical Care Nurs-
ing, 23(3), 131–138
Journal of Cardiovascular Nursing,
19(1), 32–40
Home Healthcare Nurse, 23(7),
425–428.
Journal of Cardiovascular Nursing,
22(6), 516–524
We cannot cure people, but we can help
them heal and grow, even as they are taking their
first or last breath. When people heal, they be-
come more fully connected with the multiple di-
mensions of their mind, body, and spirit, and as
a result, they become more fully actualized. A
caring–healing environment, created by the
nurses’ intent, fosters growth and well-being in
their clients. Because people have inherent in-
stincts and drives to grow, develop, and heal, all
nursing actions focus on facilitation and nurtu-
rance of these innate abilities. We use ourselves
to connect with our clients in such a way that
we can create trusting functional relationships
with them, relationships that have a purpose or
are aimed at some outcome. In the MRM
model, these relationships aim to affirm clients’
worth; to help them mobilize and build resources
needed to cope with their stressors/stress; foster
hope for the future; and promote a sense of
affiliated-individuation. When people have
these experiences, a sense of well-being follows.
Although we use every professional skill we have
acquired, these are secondary to using ourselves
as healing agents. As nurses, we nurture and
facilitate people to become the most that they
can be. We help them actualize their life roles
and find meaning in their existence. When this
happens, it affects not only our clients but also
those who are significant in their lives.
As nurses, every interaction with our clients
and their loved ones provides us with oppor -
tunities to affect the future; I call this the “long-
arm affect” (H. Erickson, 2006b, p. 390).
How we perceive our roles as nurses will de-
termine our intent. This in turn affects what
we do, how we interact, the focus of our work,
and the outcomes of our relationships. We
cannot always change what will happen in our
lives or those of others, but we can set the in-
tent to help people grow, heal, and move on.
J. M.’s letter (see Practice Exemplar 1) sug-
gests that I not only helped his family deal
with a life tragedy but also helped them dis-
cover ways to find meaning in the experience.
I helped them grow, heal, and move on.
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 201
202 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Practice Exemplar 1
A man who was the strong, dominant mem-
ber of his family was lying in bed, inconti-
nent, riddled with cancer, and feeling
hopeless. When I learned that he no longer
allowed his family to visit, I gently took his
hand and told him I was happy to be his
nurse that evening. He “looked at me with
very sad eyes . . . [and said] that he didn’t want
his family to see him in this condition. . . .
[H]e had always taken care of his family, and
now . . . he couldn’t take care of himself”
(H. Erickson, 2006a, p. 325). I rephrased his
words and then told him that although he
had been the breadwinner in the past and his
family members had enjoyed and appreciated
that, all they wanted now was to be with
him, to share his life, to show him that he
was important because he loved them and
they loved him. He agreed, and for the next
few days his family members took turns just
being with him. On the third day when he
quietly passed, he and his family were able
to grieve with dignity and peace.
Eight years later, I received a letter from his
son (only 16 at the time of his father’s death),
notifying me that his mother had died. He
knew I would want to know that because of
what they had learned from me, she was able
to pass at home with her family at her side,
singing her favorite songs and strumming on
the guitar. He went on to state:
In the year my Dad was with you people in
Ann Arbor, you were of incalculable aid and com-
fort to both my parents—you gave them confidence
in you and your staff, and the dignity and respect
which makes life worth living; no one else could,
or did, more genuinely have their gratitude and
respect. When I would come down and all seemed to
be lost, the one bright spot was that Mrs. Erickson
would be coming on, and we could breathe a little
more easily as Dad’s anxiety visibly receded. Your
kindness and humanity made the world a better
place at that time and without you the experience
would have been more difficult than you probably
believe. Thank you, J. M.
Practice Exemplar 2
Most data are easy to understand although
there are some that are symbolic of earlier
losses. A middle-aged man I worked with a
number of years ago had just been admitted
to the hospital for a “workup.” Mr. S. had
complained of chronic fatigue for the past 6
months. An hour or so before I saw him, he
had learned that he had acute leukemia.
When I asked him to tell me about his situ-
ation, he told me about his leukemia and
then launched into a story about his child-
hood. He described a time when he was
about 16 years old, had been told to watch his
younger sister and had let her ride a horse
without supervision. She fell off and was
killed. He remembered his father telling him
that he had not been responsible and that he
needed to grow-up and be a man.
Mr. S. looked surprised and said he didn’t
know what had made him think of that event
and hadn’t thought about it for years. When I
asked him what he expected to happen to him,
he said he guessed that he was going to die.
He went on to say that he thought he had de-
veloped leukemia because he hadn’t been re-
sponsible, and when he wasn’t responsible;
people died. As we explored his resources, he
explained that he had been promoted about
9 months earlier and that his new job required
skills he didn’t think he had. His conclusions
were that he was sick because he had “worried
himself to death.” He also stated that he didn’t
want his wife to come see him, that he needed
to decide what he wanted to do first, and how
he could take care of her now that he was sick?
When I asked if she or someone else could
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 202
CHAPTER 12 • Helen Erickson, Evelyn Tomlin, and Mary Ann Swain’s Theory of Modeling 203
Practice Exemplar 2 cont.
help him consider options, he said no, that it
was his responsibility to take care of himself.
To understand these data, I needed to recog-
nize the following:
• People who link new stressful experiences
to past experiences are usually dealing with
a loss related to the past experience. In his
case, it was not only the loss of his sister
but also the meaning of the loss. As a
16-year-old boy, he was learning about his
ability to make sound decisions, to be inde-
pendent, to determine who he was as a
unique human being in society. He had
learned that “when he wasn’t responsible,
people died.”
• Although he identified his wife as his sig-
nificant other, he was overindividuated. He
needed to decide how to “tell” his wife
about his problem—his problem of not
being responsible, not being a “man.” He
did not perceive that it was appropriate to
seek comfort from her or others.
• Mr. S. is in arousal with unmet safety and
belonging needs, unresolved loss with mor-
bid grief, and both positive and negative
residual from adolescence on. Strong posi-
tive residual from early childhood provides
some resources that could be mobilized
with assistance.
• Although Mr. S. is chronologically in the
stage of Intimacy versus Isolation, his stres-
sors are related to residuals from the stage
of Competency versus Limitations.
• Mr. S’s healthy affiliated–individuation has
been threatened due to overindividuation.
• Mr. S. wished to be “responsible” to “take
care of his wife.”
Specific interventions used in this case are
as follows:
• I centered myself and set intent to be ener-
getically connected, using myself as a con-
duit of healing energy from the universe.
Setting an intent to connect and serve as a
healing instrument is a prerequisite to facili-
tating a client’s storytelling. It is also an im-
portant strategy for helping people mobilize
resources needed to help themselves heal.
Centering, setting intent to connect, and to
serve as an energetic conduit were strategies
used throughout our time together, pur-
posefully initiated with each visit.
• When I asked him to tell me about his
situation, I also stated that he could talk
about anything that popped into his mind,
even if it didn’t seem to be related to his
current situation. This strategy is used
because people have state-dependent
memory, their current experiences are often
related to losses incurred in the past. Al-
though they are unaware of these relations,
it may be important to help them “uncover”
these experiences in their own time and
their own way so that they can begin to
heal—a prerequisite for mobilizing re-
sources needed to contend with the current
situation.
• I used active listening skills as he told his
story, using nonverbal communications to
encourage him to open up, staying energet-
ically connected, and remaining quiet when
he paused, allowing him an opportunity to
express his self-care knowledge.
• My question: What do you expect will hap-
pen? was used to assess self-care resources
and to allow him to identify associated
factors and express his worse fears. His re-
sponse indicated that he was depleted of
resources (i.e., impoverished), his definition
of being responsible no longer worked for
him, and he needed help reframing his be-
haviors and identifying new resources. I
further explored his resources with the
follow-up questions.
• Considering that the loss had occurred dur-
ing the age of adolescence and the task of
developing Identity and that healthy reso-
lution of Identify is important for the devel-
opment of healthy intimacy in the next
stage of life, follow-up interventions in-
cluded exploring alternative ways to think
about “being responsible”—the role he had
chosen for himself. Using open-ended
questions, I helped him consider his rela-
tionship with his family by thinking about
how he was like the 16-year-old boy and
how he was different; how he wanted to be
Continued
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 203
204 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Practice Exemplar 2 cont.
like that boy and how he wanted to be dif-
ferent; and how he wanted to relate to his
wife in the future and how he might start.
Rhetorical questions, stated as curiosities
rather than a demand for a response, were
used to stimulate growth. Examples include
statements such as I wonder how you are like
that 16-year-old boy now, and how you are
different? It might even be interesting to think
about how you want to be like that boy—or
different.
• Biophysical care was also offered and pro-
vided with consideration for his develop-
mental resources. Adolescents with healthy
developmental resources often vacillate in
their need to be independent in their activi-
ties of daily life and their needs to have care
consistent with earlier stages provided. The
only way to know is to offer care and follow
the client’s responses. Thus, when asked to
help with foot care, it was provided; when
told that he could manage making his own
outpatient appointments, he was given the
information needed to make his appoint-
ments and asked if he needed any other in-
formation after the appointments were
confirmed.
• As he prepared for discharge to the outpa-
tient clinic for chemotherapy, I explored his
perceptions of the effects of chemotherapy.
He stated that chemotherapy was a poison
and would make him sick, that he didn’t
look forward to that. I agreed that
chemotherapy was a poison, but that there
were several things he could do to help
himself. Aiming to reframe the perception
of chemotherapy outcomes, I suggested
that chemotherapy was designed to fight
with the bad cells, but he didn’t need to
have the chemotherapy fight with his good
cells, that he could protect them if he
wanted. When he expressed curiosity about
protecting his good cells, I helped him
learn how to use guided imagery so that the
chemotherapy would seek out bad cells and
attach them, but leave the others alone. We
then talked about ensuring that the
chemotherapy had a good chance of doing
its work by proactively getting sufficient
sleep, drinking fluids, seeking nurturing re-
lations, participating in activities that help
him laugh, and other activities that made
him feel loved, happy, and at peace.
• Upon discharge, I offered him a business
card as a transitional object. I explained
that it contained my name and contact in-
formation in the event that he wanted to
talk with me at any time. I also stated that
many people find they are able remember
our time together—what they felt, heard,
smelled, and saw—by holding the card
and/or even just by thinking about it.
I followed this gentleman for several weeks,
visiting him occasionally in the outpatient
clinic. He always had my business card with
him and often commented that it was magic
and that it helped him get through the bad
days. Two years later I received a letter thank-
ing me for helping him and stating that he was
in remission. He and his wife were planning a
trip to celebrate their anniversary.
■ Summary
Nurses who use modeling and role-modeling
believe the human is holistic with ongoing, dy-
namic mind–body–spirit interactions; clients
are the primary source of information; and
nurses are instruments of healing. Modeling is
the process used to gain an understanding of
their clients’ perceptions and understandings
of their conditions, health needs, and possible
therapeutic interventions. During the model-
ing process, nurses gain an understanding of
their clients perceptions of what has caused
their health problem, what impedes their heal-
ing, and what will facilitate healing and
growth. Modeling the client’s worldview also
helps nurses to understand their clients’ rela-
tionships and related roles, identify those that
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 204
CHAPTER 12 • Helen Erickson, Evelyn Tomlin, and Mary Ann Swain’s Theory of Modeling 205
impede health and wellness and those that are
meaningful and facilitate healing and growth.
Role-modeling is helping clients find alter-
native ways to fulfill their desired roles in life.
This requires interventions including biophys-
ical care as well as psychosocial strategies de-
signed to help people articulate their self-care
knowledge, mobilize resources, and participate
in healthy self-care actions. Strategies are de-
signed within the context of developmental
residual and with consideration for losses and
related attachment objects. Verbal and nonver-
bal communication and basic biophysical nurs-
ing skills are considered essential prerequisites
in the use of MRM.
References
Acton, G. (1992). The relationships among stressors, stress,
affiliated-individuation, burden, and well-being in
caregivers of adults with dementia: A test of the theory
and paradigm for nursing, modeling and role-modeling.
Doctoral dissertation, University of Texas at Austin.
Dissertation Abstracts International, AAT 9323314.
American Holistic Nurses Association (AHNA). (2007).
Holistic nursing: Scope and standards of practice. Silver
Spring, MD: American Holistic Nurses Association,
American Nurses Association.
American Nurses Association (ANA). Retrieved
June 3, 2008, from www.ahna.org/AboutUs/
ANASpecialtyRecognition/tabid/1167/Default.aspx
Baas, L. (2004). Self-care resources, activities as predic-
tors of quality of life. Dimensions of Critical Care
Nursing, 23(3), 131–138.
Barnfather, J. (1987). Mobilizing coping resources related
to basic need status in healthy, young adults. Doctoral
dissertation, University of Texas at Austin. Disserta-
tion Abstracts International, 49-02B (AAF8801275).
Barnfather, J., & Ronis, D. (2000). Test of a model of
psychosocial resources, stress, and health among un-
dereducated adults. Research in Nursing & Health,
23(1), 55–66.
Benson, D. (2006). Adaptation: Coping with stress. In:
H. Erickson (Ed.), Modeling and role-modeling: A
view from the client’s world (pp. 240–274). Cedar
Park, TX: Unicorns Unlimited.
Bowlby, J. (1973). Separation. New York: Basic Books.
Clayton, D., Erickson, H., & Rogers, S. (2006). Finding
meaning in our life journey. In: H. Erickson (Ed.),
Modeling and role-modeling: A view from the client’s
world (pp. 391–410). Cedar Park, TX: Unicorns
Unlimited.
Engel, G. (1964). Grief and grieving. American Journal of
Nursing, 64, 93.
Erikson, E. (1994). Identity and the life cycle. New York,
NY: Norton & Company.
Erickson, H. C. (1976). Identification of states of coping
utilization physiological and psychological data. Unpub-
lished master’s thesis, University of Michigan, Ann
Arbor, MI.
Erickson, H. (Guest ed.). (1996). Holistic healing:
Intra/inter relations of person and environment.
Issues of Mental Health Nursing, 17(3), vii–viii.
Erickson, H. (2002). Facilitating generativity and ego
integrity: Applying Ericksonian methods to the
aging population. In B. B. Geary & J. K. Zeig
(Eds.), The handbook of Ericksonian psychotherapy.
Phoenix, AZ: Zeig Tucker.
Erickson, H. (Ed.). (2006a). Modeling and role-modeling:
A view from the client’s world. Cedar Park, TX:
Unicorns Unlimited.
Erickson, H. (2006b). Connecting. In H. Erickson
(Ed.), Modeling and role-modeling: A view from the
client’s world (pp. 300–322). Cedar Park, TX:
Unicorns Unlimited.
Erickson, H. (2006c). Facilitating development. In: H.
Erickson (Ed.), Modeling and role-modeling: A view
from the client’s world (pp. 346–390). Cedar Park,
TX: Unicorns Unlimited.
Erickson, H. (2006d). Nurturing growth. In H. Erick-
son (Ed.), Modeling and role-modeling: A view from
the client’s world (pp. 324–345). Cedar Park, TX:
Unicorns Unlimited.
Erickson, H. (2006e). The healing process. In H.
Erickson (Ed.), Modeling and role-modeling: A view
from the client’s world (pp. 411–434). Cedar Park,
TX: Unicorns Unlimited.
Erickson, H. (2007). Philosophy and theory of holism.
Nursing Clinics of North America, 42, 140.
Erickson, H. (2008). Nursing of the body, mind &
spirit? Advance for Nurses, 6(20), 31–32.
Erickson, H. (2010). Paradigm choices: Implications for
nursing knowledge. In H. Erickson (Ed.), Exploring
the context and essence of holistic nursing: Modeling and
role-modeling for nurse educators. Cedar Park, TX:
Unicorns Unlimited. In press.
Erickson, H., Tomlin, E., & Swain, M. A. (2009).
Modeling and role-modeling: A theory and paradigm for
nursing. Cedar Park, TX: EST.
Erickson, H. C., & Swain, M. A. (1982). A model for
assessing potential adaptation to stress. Research in
Nursing and Health, 5, 93–101.
Erickson, M. (2006). Attachment, loss and reattach-
ment. In H. Erickson (Ed.), Modeling and role-
modeling: A view from the client’s world (pp. 208–
237). Cedar Park, TX: Unicorns Unlimited.
Erickson, M., Erickson, H., & Jensen, B. (2006).
Affiliated-individuation and self-actualization: Need
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 205
satisfaction as prerequisite. In H. Erickson (Ed.),
Modeling and role-modeling: A view from the client’s
world (pp. 182–207). Cedar Park, TX: Unicorns
Unlimited.
Frisch, N. C., & Frisch, L. E. (2010). Psychiatric mental
health nursing. (2nd ed.). Albany, NY: Delmar.
Jablonski, K. & Duke, G. (2012). Pain management in
persons who are terminally ill in rural acute care:
Barriers and facilitators. Journal of Hospice and
Palliative Nursing. 14(8), 533–540.
Hertz, J. E. (2013). Self-care. In I. M. Lubkin & P. D.
Larsen (Eds.), Chronic illness: Impact and intervention
(8th ed., chap. 14). Sudbury, MA: Jones and
Bartlett.
Hertz, J. E., Irving, B. L., & Bowman, S. S. (2010).
Issues for a culturally-diverse society. In H. L.
Erickson (Ed.), Exploring the interface between the
philosophy and discipline of holistic nursing: Modeling
and role-modeling at work (pp. 228-261). Cedar Park,
TX: Unicorns Unlimited.
Hertz, J. E., Koren, M. E., Rossetti, J., & Robertson, J. F.
(2008). Early identification of relocation risk in older
adult with critical illness. Critical Care Nursing Quar-
terly, 31(1), 59–64.
Kübler-Ross, E. (1969). On death and dying. London:
Tavistock.
Lach, H. W., Hertz, J. E., Pomeroy, S. H., Resnick, B.,
& Buckwalter, K. C. (2013). The challenges and
benefits of distance mentoring. Journal of Professional
Nursing, 29(1), 39–48.
Lindeman, E. (1944). Symptomatology and manage-
ment of acute grief. American Journal of Psychiatry,
101, 141–148.
Maslow, A. (1968). Toward a psychology of being (2nd
ed.). New York: D. Van Nostrand.
Maslow, A. (1982). The farthest reaches of human nature.
New York: D. Van Nostrand.
Mitty, E., Resnick, B., Allen, J., Bakerjian, D., Hertz, J.,
Gardner, W. et al. (2010). Nursing delegation and
medication administration in assisted living. Nursing
Administration Quarterly, 34(2), 162–171.
Perese, E. (2012). Psychiatric advanced practice nursing:
A biopsychosocial foundation for practice. Philadelphia:
F. A. Davis.
Schim, S., Benkert, R., Bell, S., Walker, D., & Danford, C.
(2007). Social justice: Added metaparadigm concept
for urban health nursing. Public Health Nursing,
24(1), 73–80.
Selye, H. (1974). Stress without distress. Philadelphia:
J. B. Lippincott.
Selye, H. (1976). The stress of life (rev. ed.). New York:
McGraw-Hill.
Selye, H. (1980). Selye’s guide to stress research (vol. 1).
New York: Van Nostrand Reinhold.
Selye, H. (1985). History and present status of the stress
concept. In A. Monat & R. S. Lazarus (Eds.), Stress
and coping: An anthology (pp. 17–29). New York:
Columbia University Press.
Walker, M., & Erickson, H. (2006). Mind, body and
spirit relations. In: H. Erickson (Ed.), Modeling and
role-modeling: A view from the client’s world (pp. 67–91).
Cedar Park, TX: Unicorns Unlimited.
Wazlawick, P. (1967). Pragmatics of human communica-
tion: A study of interactional patterns, pathologies, and
paradoxes. New York: W. W. Norton.
Weber, G.J. (1999). The experiential meaning of well-
being for employed mothers. Western Journal of
Nursing Research, 21(6), 785–795.
Zeig, J. (Ed.) (1982). Ericksonian approaches to hypnosis
and psychotherapy. New York: Brunner/Mazel.
206 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch12_185-206 26/12/14 2:59 PM Page 206
Chapter 13Barbara Dossey’s Theory of
Integral Nursing
BARBARA MONTGOMERY DOSSEY
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Theory
Applications to Practice
Practice Exemplar
Summary
References
207
Introducing the Theorist
Barbara Montgomery Dossey, PhD, RN,
AHN-BC, FAAN, HWNC-BC, is interna-
tionally recognized as a pioneer in the holistic
nursing movement and the integrative nurse
coach movement as well as a Florence
Nightingale scholar. She is Co-Director, In-
ternational Nurse Coach Association (INCA),
and Core Faculty, Integrative Nurse Coach
Certificate Program (INCCP); International
Co-Director, Nightingale Initiative for Global
Health (NIGH); and Director, Holistic Nurs-
ing Consultants. She is the author or coauthor
of 25 books. Her most recent books include
Nurse Coaching: Integrative Approaches for
Health and Wellbeing (2015), Holistic Nursing:
A Handbook for Practice (6th ed., 2013), The Art
and Science of Nurse Coaching: The Provider’s
Guide to Coaching Scope and Competencies (2013),
Florence Nightingale: Mystic, Visionary, Healer
(Commemorative Edition, 2010), and Florence
Nightingale Today: Healing, Leadership, Global
Action (2005).
B. M. Dossey’s theory of integral nursing
(2008, 2013) is considered a grand theory that
presents the science and art of nursing. Her
collaborative global nursing project, the
Nightingale Initiative for Global Health
(NIGH) and its initiative the Nightingale
Declaration Campaign (NDC), recognizes
the contributions of nurses worldwide as they
engage in the promotion of global health,
including the United Nations Millennium
Development Goals and the Post-2015 Sus-
tainable Development Goals. Dossey has re-
ceived many awards and recognitions. She is a
Fellow of the American Academy of Nursing,
Board Certified by the American Holistic
Nurses credentialing corporation as an advanced
Barbara Montgomery
Dossey
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 207
holistic nurse (AHN-BC), and a health and
wellness nurse coach (HWNC-BC). She is a
ten-time recipient of the prestigious American
Journal of Nursing Book of the Year Award.
Dossey received the 2014 Lifetime Achieve-
ment Award and was named the 1985 Holistic
Nurse of the Year by the American Holistic
Nurse’s Association. With her husband, Larry,
she received the 2003 Archon Award from
Sigma Theta Tau International, the Interna-
tional Honor Society of Nursing, honoring the
contribution that they have made to promote
global health. In 2004, Barbara and Larry also
received the Pioneer of Integrative Medicine
Award from the Aspen Center for Integrative
Medicine, Aspen, Colorado.
Overview of the Theory
As you begin to explore the theory of integral
nursing, I invite you to reflect on the following
questions: Why am I here? Are my personal
and professional actions sourced from my
soul’s purpose and wisdom? What is my call-
ing, mission, and vision for my work in the
world? How can I strengthen my passion in
nursing and in my life? What am I currently
doing to become more aware of my personal
health and the health of my home and work-
place? What am I doing locally that can affect
the health and well-being of humanity and our
Earth? How am I connected to my nursing
colleagues and concerned citizens in my com-
munity, in other cities, and nations? What is
my calling?
The theory of integral nursing is a grand
theory that guides the science and art of inte-
gral nursing practice, education, research, and
health-care policy. It incorporates physical,
mental, emotional, social, spiritual, cultural,
and environmental dimensions and an expan-
sive worldview. It invites nurses to think
widely and deeply about personal health and
client, patient, and family health, as well as
that of the local community and the global vil-
lage. This theory recognizes the philosophical
foundation and legacy of Florence Nightin-
gale (1820–1910; Dossey, 2010; Dossey,
Selanders, Beck, & Attewell, 2005) healing
and healing research, the metaparadigm of
nursing (nurse, person[s], health, and envi-
ronment [society]), six patterns of knowing
(personal, empirics, aesthetics, ethics, not
knowing, sociopolitical), integral theory, and
theories outside of the discipline of nursing.
It builds on the existing integral, integrative,
and holistic ultidimensional theoretical nurs-
ing foundations and has been informed by the
work of other nurse theorists; it is not a free-
standing theory. It incorporates concepts from
various philosophies and fields that include
holistic, multidimensionality, integral, chaos,
spiral dynamics, complexity, systems, and
many other paradigms. [Note: Concepts specific
to the theory of integral nursing are in italics
throughout this chapter. Please consider these
words as a frame of reference and a way to ex-
plain and explore what you have observed or ex-
perienced with yourself and others.]
Integral nursing is a comprehensive integral
worldview and process that includes integrative
and holistic theories and other paradigms; ho-
listic nursing is included (embraced) and tran-
scended (goes beyond); this integral process
and integral worldview enlarges our holistic
nursing knowledge and understanding of
body–mind–spirit connections and our know-
ing, doing, and being to more comprehensive
and deeper levels. To delete the word “inte-
gral” or to substitute the word “holistic” dimin-
ishes the impact of the expansiveness of the
integral process and integral worldview and its
implications.
The theory of integral nursing includes an
integral process, integral worldview, and inte-
gral dialogues that compose praxis—theory in
action (B. M. Dossey, 2008; 2013). An inte-
gral process is defined as a comprehensive way
to organize multiple phenomena of human
experience and reality from four perspectives:
(1) the individual interior (personal/inten-
tional), (2) individual exterior (physiology/
behavioral), (3) collective interior (shared/
cultural), and (4) collective exterior (systems/
structures). An integral worldview examines
values, beliefs, assumptions, meaning, purpose,
and judgments related to how individuals per-
ceive reality and relationships from the four
perspectives. Integral dialogues are transforma-
tive and visionary explorations of ideas and
208 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 208
possibilities across disciplines, where these four
perspectives are considered as equally impor-
tant to all exchanges, endeavors, and out-
comes. With an increased integral awareness
and an integral worldview, we are more likely
to raise our collective nursing voice and power
to engage in social action in our role and work
of service for society—local to global.
As you read this chapter, 35 million nurses
and midwives are engaged in nursing and
health care around the world (World Health
Organization [WHO], 2009). Together, we
are collectively addressing human health—of
individuals, of communities, of environments
(interior and exterior) and the world as our first
priority. We are educated and prepared—
physically, emotionally, socially, mentally, and
spiritually—to accomplish the required activi-
ties effectively—on the ground—to create a
healthy world. Nurses are key in mobilizing
new approaches in health education and
health-care delivery in all areas of the profes-
sion and society as a whole. Theories, solu-
tions, and evidence-based practice protocols
can be shared and implemented around the
world through dialogues, the Internet, and
publications.
We are challenged to “act locally and think
globally” and to address ways to create healthy
environments (B. M. Dossey, 2013; B. M.
Dossey et al., 2005). For example, we can ad-
dress global warming in our personal habits at
home as well as in our workplace (using green
products, turning off lights when not in the
room, using water efficiently) and simultane-
ously address our personal health and the
health of the communities where we live (Na-
tional Prevention Council, 2011). In 2000, the
United Nations Millennium Goals were rec-
ommended to articulate clearly how to achieve
health and decrease health disparities (United
Nations, 2000). As we expand our awareness
of individual and collective states of healing
consciousness and integral dialogues, we are
able to explore integral ways of knowing,
doing, and being. We can unite 35 million
nurses and midwives and concerned citizens
through the Internet to create a healthy world
through many endeavors such as the Nightingale
Declaration (B. M. Dossey et al., 2013; NIGH,
2013; WHO, 2009). You are invited to sign
the Nightingale Declaration at www.nightin-
galedeclaration.net. Our Nightingale nursing
legacy, as discussed in the next section, is foun-
dational to the theory of integral nursing
and to understanding our important roles as
21st-century nurses.
Philosophical Foundation: Florence
Nightingale’s Legacy
Florence Nightingale, the philosophical
founder of modern secular nursing and the first
recognized nurse theorist, was an integralist.
Her worldview focused on the individual and
the collective, the inner and outer, and human
and nonhuman concerns. She identified envi-
ronmental determinants (clean air, water, food,
houses, etc.) and social determinants (poverty,
education, family relationships, employ-
ment)—local to global. She also experienced
and recorded her personal understanding of
the connection with the Divine—that is,
awareness that something greater than she, the
Divine, was present in all aspects of her life.
Nightingale’s work was social action that
clearly articulated the science and art of an in-
tegral worldview for nursing, health care, and
humankind. Her social action was also sacred
activism (Harvey, 2007), the fusion of the
deepest spiritual knowledge with radical action
in the world. Nightingale was ahead of her
time; her dedicated and focused 50 years of
work and service still inform and affect the nurs-
ing profession and our global mission of health
and healing. In the 1880s, Nightingale began
to write in letters that it would take 100 to
150 years before sufficiently educated and ex-
perienced nurses would arrive to change the
health-care system. We are that generation of
21st-century Nightingales who can transform
health care and carry forth her vision to create
a healthy world (B. M. Dossey, 2013; B. M.
Dossey, Luck, & Schaub, 2015; Beck, Dossey,
& Rushton, 2011; McDonald, 2001–2012;
Mittelman et al., 2010).
Personal Journey Developing the
Theory of Integral Nursing
As a young nurse attending my first nursing
theory conference in the late 1960s, I was
CHAPTER 13 • Barbara Dossey’s Theory of Integral Nursing 209
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 209
captivated by nursing theory and the eloquent
visionary words of these theorists as they
spoke about the science and art of nursing.
This opened my heart and mind to explo-
ration and to the necessity to understand and
use nursing theory. Thus, I began my profes-
sional commitment to address theory in all
endeavors as well as to increase my knowl-
edge of other disciplines that could inform a
deeper understanding about the human expe-
rience. I realized that nursing was not either
“science” or “art,” but both. From the begin-
ning of my critical care and cardiovascular
nursing focus, I learned how to combine sci-
ence and technology with the art of nursing.
For example, for patients with severe pain
after an acute myocardial infarction, I gave
pain medication while simultaneously guid-
ing them in a relaxation or imagery practice
to enhance relaxation and release anxiety. I
also experienced a difference in myself when
I used this approach to combine the science
and art of nursing.
In the late 1960s, I began to study and
attend workshops on holistic and mind–
body-related ideas and to read in other disci-
plines, such as systems theory, quantum physics,
integral theory, Eastern and Western philoso-
phy, and mysticism. I was reading theorists
from nursing and other disciplines that in-
formed my knowing, doing, and being in car-
ing, healing, and holism. My husband, a
physician of internal medicine who was caring
for critically ill patients and their families, was
with me at the beginning of this journey of dis-
covery. As we cared for patients and families—
some of our greatest teachers—we reflected on
how to blend the art of caring–healing modal-
ities with the science of technology and tradi-
tional modalities. I discussed these ideas with
a critical care and cardiovascular nursing soul-
mate, Cathie Guzzetta. We began writing
teaching protocols and presenting in critical
care courses as well as writing textbooks and
articles with other contributors.
My husband and I both had health chal-
lenges—mine was postcorneal transplant re-
jection, and my husband’s challenge was
blinding migraine headaches. We both began
to take courses related to body–mind–spirit
therapies (biofeedback, relaxation, imagery,
music, meditation, and other reflective prac-
tices and touch therapies) and began to in-
corporate them into our daily lives. As we
strengthened our capacities with self-care and
self-regulation modalities, our personal and
professional philosophies and clinical practices
changed. As we integrated these modalities
into our own lives, we began to introduce
them into the traditional health-care setting
that today is called integrative and integral
health care.
As a founding member in 1980 of the
American Holistic Nurses Association (AHNA)
and with my AHNA colleagues, our collective
holistic nursing endeavors were recognized as
the specialty of holistic nursing by the American
Nurses Association (ANA) in November 2006
(AHNA & ANA, 2007, 2013). Holistic nurs-
ing can now be expanded by using an integral
lens. An integral perspective can also further our
endeavors in national health-care reform and
the implementation of Healthy People 2020 as
a national strategy. The emerging movement for
professional nurse coaching (Dossey, Luck, &
Schaub, 2015; Hess et al., 2013) and strategies
to increase patient engagement (Weil, 2013)
can be strengthened when considered from an
integral perspective.
Beginning in 1992 in London, my Florence
Nightingale primary, historical research of
studying and synthesizing her original letters,
army and public health documents, manu-
scripts, and books, deepened my understanding
of her relevance for nursing. My professional
mission now is to articulate and use the inte-
gral process and integral worldview in my
nursing, integrative nurse coaching, and inter-
professional endeavors, and to explore rituals
of healing with many. My sustained nursing
career focus with nursing colleagues on whole-
ness, unity, and healing and my Florence
Nightingale scholarship have resulted in
numerous protocols and standards for practice,
education, research, and health-care policy.
My integral focus since 2000 and my many
conversations with Ken Wilber and the inte-
gral team and other interdisciplinary integral
colleagues has led to my development of the
theory of integral nursing.
210 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 210
Theory of Integral Nursing
Developmental Process and Intentions
The theory of integral nursing advances the
evolutionary growth processes, stages, and lev-
els of human development and consciousness
toward a comprehensive integral philosophy
and understanding. It can assist nurses to map
human capacities that begin with healing and
evolve to the transpersonal self in connection
with the Divine, however defined or identified,
in their endeavors to create a healthy world.
The theory of integral nursing has three
intentions: (1) to embrace the unitary whole
person and the complexity of the nursing
profession and health care; (2) to explore the
direct application of an integral process and in-
tegral worldview that includes four perspec-
tives of realities—the individual interior and
exterior and the collective interior and exterior;
and (3) to expand nurses’ capacities as 21st-
century Nightingales, health diplomats, and
integral nurse coaches for integral health—
local to global.
Integral Foundation and the
Integral Model
The theory of integral nursing adapts the work
of Ken Wilber, one of the most significant
American new-paradigm philosophers, to
strengthen the central concept of healing. His
elegant, four-quadrant model was developed
over 35 years. In the eight-volume The Collected
Works of Ken Wilber (Wilber, 1999, 2000a),
Wilber synthesizes the best known and most
influential thinkers to show that no individual
or discipline can determine reality or lay claim
to all the answers. Many concepts within the
integral nursing theory have been researched
or are in formative stages of development
within integral medicine, integral health-care
administration, integral business, integral
health-care education, and integral psy-
chotherapy (Wilber, 2000a, 2000b, 2005a,
2005b, 2006). Within the nursing profession,
other nurses are exploring integral and related
theories and ideas. When nurses use an inte-
gral lens, they are more likely to expand nurses’
roles in transdisciplinary dialogues and to ex-
plore commonalities and differences across
disciplines (J. Baye, personal communication,
2007; Clark, 2006; Fiandt et al., 2003; Frisch,
2013; Jarrin, 2007; Quinn, Smith, Ritten-
baugh, Swanson, & Watson, 2003; Watson,
2005; Zahourek, 2013).
Content, Context, and Process
To present the theory of integral nursing, Bar-
bara Barnum’s (2005) framework to critique a
nursing theory—content, context, and process—
provides an organizing structure that is most
useful. The philosophical assumptions of the
theory of integral nursing are as follows:
1. An integral understanding recognizes
the individual as an energy field con-
nected to the energy fields of others and
the wholeness of humanity; the world is
open, dynamic, interdependent, fluid,
and continuously interacting with chang-
ing variables that can lead to greater
complexity and order.
2. An integral worldview is a comprehensive
way to organize multiple phenomena of
human experience from four perspectives
of reality: (a) individual interior (subjective,
personal); (b) individual exterior (objective,
behavioral); (c) collective interior (interob-
jective, cultural); and (d) collective exterior
(interobjective, systems/structures).
3. Healing is a process inherent in all living
things; it may occur with curing of
symptoms, but it is not synonymous
with curing.
4. Integral health is experienced by a per-
son as wholeness with development
toward personal growth and expanding
states of consciousness to deeper levels
of personal and collective understanding
of one’s physical, mental, emotional,
social, spiritual, cultural, environmental
dimensions.
5. Integral nursing is founded on an integral
worldview using integral language and
knowledge that integrates integral life
practices and skills each day.
6. Integral nursing is broadly defined to
include knowledge development and all
ways of knowing that also recognizes the
emergent patterns of not knowing.
CHAPTER 13 • Barbara Dossey’s Theory of Integral Nursing 211
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 211
7. An integral nurse is an instrument in the
healing process and facilitates healing
through her or his knowing, doing, and
being.
8. Integral nursing is applicable in practice,
education, research, and health-care policy.
Content Components
Content of a nursing theory includes the subject
matter and building blocks that give a theory
its form. It comprises the stable elements that
are acted on or that do the acting. In the theory
of integral nursing, the subject matter and
building blocks are (1) healing, (2) the meta-
paradigm of nursing, (3) patterns of knowing,
(4) the four quadrants that are adapted from
Wilber’s (2000a) integral theory (individual in-
terior [subjective, personal/intentional], indi-
vidual exterior [objective, behavioral], collective
interior [intersubjective, cultural], and collec-
tive exterior [interobjective, systems/struc-
tures]), and (5) Wilber’s “all quadrants, all
levels, all lines” (Wilber, 2000a, 2006).
Content Component 1: Healing. The first
content component in a theory of integral
nursing is healing, illustrated as a diamond
shape in Figure 13-1A. The theory of integral
nursing enfolds from the central core concept
of healing. Healing includes knowing, doing,
and being, and is a lifelong journey and process
of bringing together aspects of oneself at
deeper levels of harmony and inner knowing
leading toward integration. This healing
process places us in a space to face our fears, to
seek and express self in its fullness where we
can learn to trust life, creativity, passion, and
love. Each aspect of healing has equal impor-
tance and value that leads to more complex
levels of understanding and meaning.
Healing capacities are inherent in all living
things. No one can take healing away from life;
however, we often get “stuck” in our healing
or forget that we possess it due to life’s contin-
uing challenges and perceived barriers to
wholeness. Healing can take place at all levels
of human experience, but it may not occur si-
multaneously in every realm. In truth, healing
will most likely not occur simultaneously or
even in all realms, and yet the person may still
212 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Healing
Fig 13 • 1 A, Healing. Source: Copyright © Barbara
Dossey, 2007.
have a perception of healing having occurred
(B. M. Dossey, 2013; Gaydos, 2004, 2005).
Healing embraces the individual as an en-
ergy field that is connected with the energy
fields of all humanity and the world. Healing is
transformed when we consider four perspectives
of reality in any moment: (1) the individual
interior (personal/intentional), (2) individual
exterior (physiology/behavioral), (3) collective
interior (shared/cultural), and (4) collective ex-
terior (systems/structures). Using our reflective
integral lens of these four perspectives of reality
assists us to more likely experience a unitary
grasp within the complexity that emerges in
healing.
Healing is not predictable; it may occur with
curing of symptoms, but it is not synonymous
with curing. Curing may not always occur, but
the potential for healing is always present even
until one’s last breath. Intention and intention-
ality are key factors in healing (Barnum, 2004;
Engebretson, 1998; Zahourek, 2004; 2013).
Intention is the conscious determination to do
a specific thing or to act in a specific manner; it
is the mental state of being committed to, plan-
ning to, or trying to perform an action. Inten-
tionality is the quality of an intentionally
performed action.
Content Component 2: Metaparadigm of
Nursing. The second content component in the
theory of integral nursing is the recognition
of the metaparadigm in a nurse theory: nurse,
person/s, health, and environment (society;
Fig. 13-1B) (Fawcett, Watson, Neuman,
Walker, & Fitzpatrick, 2001). Starting with
healing at the center, a Venn diagram sur-
rounds healing and implies the interrelation,
interdependence, and effect of these domains
as each informs and influences the others; a
change in one will create a degree(s) of change
in the other(s), thus affecting healing at many
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 212
CHAPTER 13 • Barbara Dossey’s Theory of Integral Nursing 213
levels. These concepts are important to the the-
ory of integral nursing because they are en-
compassed within the quadrants of human
experience as seen in Content Component 4.
An integral nurse is defined as a 21st-
century Nightingale. Using terms coined by
Patricia Hinton Walker, PhD, RN, FAAN
(personal communication, May 15, 2007),
nurses’ endeavors of social action and sacred
activism engage “nurses as health diplomats”
and “integral nurse coaches” that are “coaching
for integral health.” As nurses strive to be in-
tegrally informed, they are more likely to move
to a deeper experience of a connection with the
Divine or Infinite, however defined or identi-
fied. Integral nursing provides a comprehensive
way to organize multiple phenomena of
human experience in the four perspectives of
reality as previously described. The nurse is an
instrument in the healing process, bringing her
or his whole self into relationship to the whole
self of another or a group of significant others
and thus reinforcing the meaning and experi-
ence of oneness and unity.
A person(s) is defined as an individual
(patient/client, family members, significant
others) who is engaged with a nurse who is re-
spectful of this person’s subjective experiences
about health, health beliefs, values, sexual
orientation, and personal preferences. It also
Environment
(society)
Person(s)
HealthNurse
Healing
Fig 13 • 1 B, Healing and Meta-Paradigm of
Nursing. Source: Copyright © Barbara Dossey, 2007.
includes an individual nurse who interacts with
a nursing colleague, other interprofessional
health-care team members, or a group of com-
munity members or other groups.
Integral health is the process through which
we reshape basic assumptions and worldviews
about well-being and see death as a natural
process of the cycle of life. Integral health may
be symbolically seen as a jewel with many
facets that is reflected as a “bright gem” or a
“rough stone” depending on one’s situation
and personal growth that influence states of
health, health beliefs, and values (Gaydos,
2004). The jewel may also be seen as a spiral
or as a symbol of transformation to higher
states of consciousness to more fully under-
stand the essential nature of our beingness as
energy fields and expressions of wholeness
(Newman, 2003). This includes evolving one’s
state of consciousness to higher levels of per-
sonal and collective understanding of one’s
physical, mental, emotional, social, and spiri-
tual dimensions. It acknowledges the individ-
ual’s interior and exterior experiences and the
shared collective interior and exterior experi-
ences with others, where authentic power is
recognized within each person. Disease and
illness at the physical level may manifest for
many reasons and variables. It is important not
to equate physical health, mental health, and
spiritual health, as they are not the same
thing. They are facets of the whole jewel of
integral health.
An integral environment(s) has both interior
and exterior aspects (Samueli Institute, 2013).
The interior environment includes the individ-
ual’s mental, emotional, and spiritual dimen-
sions, including feelings and meanings as well
as the brain and its components that constitute
the internal aspect of the exterior self. It in-
cludes patterns that may not be understood or
may manifest related to various situations or
relationships. These patterns may be related to
living and nonliving people and things—for
example, a deceased relative, a pet, lost pre-
cious object(s) that surface through flashes of
memories stimulated by a current situation
(e.g., a touch may bring forth past memories
of abuse, suffering). Insights gained through
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 213
dreams and other reflective practices that re-
veal symbols, images, and other connections
also influence one’s internal environment. The
exterior environment includes objects that can
be seen and measured that are related to the
physical and social in some form in any of the
gross, subtle, and causal levels that are ex-
panded later in Content Component 4.
Content Component 3: Patterns of Knowing.
The third content component in a theory of in-
tegral nursing is the recognition of the patterns
of knowing in nursing (Fig. 13-1C). These six
patterns of knowing are personal, empirics, aes-
thetics, ethics, not knowing, and sociopolitical.
As a way to organize nursing knowledge,
Carper (1978) in her now-classic 1978 article
identified the four fundamental patterns of
knowing (personal, empirics, ethics, aesthetics)
followed by the introduction of the pattern of
not knowing by Munhall (1993) and the pat-
tern of sociopolitical knowing by White
(1995). All of these patterns continue to be
refined and reframed with new applications
and interpretations (Averill & Clements,
2007; Barnum, 2003; Burkhardt & Najai-
Jacobson, 2013; Chinn & Kramer, 2010;
Cowling, 2004; Fawcett et al., 2001; Halifax,
Dossey, & Rushton, 2007; Koerner, 2011;
McElligott, 2013; McKivergin, 2008; Meleis,
2012; Newman, 2003). These patterns of
knowing assist nurses in bringing themselves
into a full presence in the moment, integrating
aesthetics with science, and developing the flow
of ethical experience with thinking and acting.
Personal knowing is the nurse’s dynamic
process of being whole that focuses on the syn-
thesis of perceptions and being with self. It
may be developed through art, meditation,
dance, music, stories, and other expressions of
the authentic and genuine self in daily life and
nursing practice.
Empirical knowing is the science of nursing
that focuses on formal expression, replication,
and validation of scientific competence in
nursing education and practice. It is expressed
in models and theories and can be integrated
into evidence-based practice. Empirical indi-
cators are accessed through the known senses
that are subject to direct observation, measure-
ment, and verification.
Aesthetic knowing is the art of nursing that
focuses on how to explore experiences and
meaning in life with self or another that in-
cludes authentic presence, the nurse as a facil-
itator of healing, and the artfulness of a healing
environment. It calls forth resources and inner
strengths from the nurse to be a facilitator in
the healing process. It is the integration and
214 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Not knowing Sociopolitical
EmpiricsPersonal
Aesthetics Ethics
Healing
Fig 13 • 1 C, Healing and
patterns of knowing in nurs-
ing. Source: Adapted from B.
Carper (1978). Copyright ©
Barbara Dossey, 2007.
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 214
expression of all the other patterns of knowing
in nursing praxis. By combining knowledge,
experience, instinct, and intuition, the nurse
connects with a patient/client to explore the
meaning of a situation about the human expe-
riences of life, health, illness, and death.
Ethical knowing is the moral knowledge in
nursing that focuses on behaviors, expressions,
and dimensions of both morality and ethics.
It includes valuing and clarifying situations to
create formal moral and ethical behaviors in-
tersecting with legally prescribed duties. It
emphasizes respect for the person, the family,
and the community that encourages connect-
edness and relationships that enhance atten-
tiveness, responsiveness, communication, and
moral action.
Not knowing is the capacity to use healing
presence, to be open spontaneously to the mo-
ment with no preconceived answers or goals to
be obtained. It engages authenticity, mindful-
ness, openness, receptivity, surprise, mystery,
and discovery with self and others in the sub-
jective space and the intersubjective space that
allows for new solutions, possibilities, and
insights to emerge.
Sociopolitical knowing addresses the impor-
tant contextual variables of social, economic,
geographic, cultural, political, historical, and
other key factors in theoretical, evidence-based
practice and research. This pattern includes in-
formed critique and social justice for the voices
of the underserved in all areas of society along
with protocols to reduce health disparities.
[Note: Because all patterns of knowing in the
theory of integral nursing are superimposed on
Wilber’s four quadrants, these patterns will be
primarily positioned as seen; however, they may
also appear in one, several, or all quadrants and
inform all other quadrants.]
Content Component 4: Quadrants. The
fourth content component in the theory of in-
tegral nursing examines four perspectives for
all known aspects of reality; expressed another
way, it is how we look at and/or describe any-
thing (Fig. 13-1D). Healing, the core concept
in the theory of integral nursing, is trans-
formed by adapting Ken Wilber’s (2000b) in-
tegral model. Starting with healing at the
center to represent our integral nursing philos-
ophy, human capacities, and global mission,
dotted horizontal and vertical lines illustrate
that each quadrant can be understood as per-
meable and porous, with each quadrant’s expe-
rience(s) integrally informing and empowering
all other quadrant experiences. Within each
quadrant, we see “I,” “We,” “It,” and “Its” to
represent four perspectives of realities that are
already part of our everyday language and
awareness.
Virtually all human languages use first-
person, second-person, and third-person pro-
nouns to indicate three basic dimensions of
reality (Wilber, 2000b). First-person is “the
person who is speaking,” which includes pro-
nouns like I, me, mine in the singular, and we,
us, ours in the plural (Wilber, 2000b, 2005a).
Second-person means “the person who is spo-
ken to,” which includes pronouns like you and
yours. Third-person is “the person or thing
being spoken about,” such as she, her, he, him,
or they, it, and its. For example, if I am speak-
ing about my new car, “I” am first-person, and
“you” are second-person, and the new car is
third-person. If you and I are communicating,
the word “we” is used to indicate that we un-
derstand each other. “We” is technically first
CHAPTER 13 • Barbara Dossey’s Theory of Integral Nursing 215
Q
u
alitative
Q
ua
nt
it
at
iv
e
M
easureable
I
n
te
rp
re
tiv
e It
objective
biological
behavioral
Its
interobjective
systems
structures
I
subjective
personal
intentional
We
intersubjective
cultural
shared values
Healing
Fig 13 • 1 D, Healing and the four quadrants
(I, We, It, Its). Source: Adapted with permission from
Ken Wilber. http://www.kenwilber.com. Copyright ©
Barbara Dossey, 2007.
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 215
person plural, but if you and I are communi-
cating, then you are second person and my first
person is part of this extraordinary “we.” So we
represent first-, second- and third-person as:
“I,” “We,” “It” and “Its.”
These four quadrants show the four primary
dimensions or perspectives of how we experience
the world; these are represented graphically as
the upper-left (UL), upper-right (UR), lower-
left (LL), and lower-right (LR) quadrants. It is
simply the inside and the outside of an individual
and the inside and outside of the collective. It
includes expanded states of consciousness where
one feels a connection with the Divine and the
vastness of the universe, the infinite that is be-
yond words. Integral nursing considers all of
these areas in our personal development and any
area of practice, education, research, and health-
care policy—local to global. Each quadrant,
which is intricately linked and bound to each
other, carries its own truths and language
(Wilber, 2000b). The specifics of the quadrants
are provided in Table 13-1.
• Upper-left (UL). In this “I” space (subjec-
tive), the world of the individual’s interior
experiences can be found. These are the
thoughts, emotions, memories, perceptions,
immediate sensations, and states of mind
(imagination, fears, feelings, beliefs, values,
esteem, cognitive capacity, emotional matu-
rity, moral development, and spiritual ma-
turity). Integral nursing starts with “I.”
(Note: When working with various cultures, it
is important to remember that within many
cultures, the “I” comes last or is never verbal-
ized or recognized as the focus is on the “We”
and relationships. However, this development
of the “I” and an awareness of one’s personal
value, beliefs, and ethics is critical.)
216 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Upper left Upper right
Individual interior
(intentional/personal)
“I” space includes self and consciousness
(self-care, fears, feelings, beliefs, values,
esteem, cognitive capacity, emotional
maturity, moral development, spiritual matu-
rity, personal communication skills, etc.)
I
We
Collective interior
(cultural/shared)
“We” space includes the relationship to
each other and the culture and worldview
(shared understanding, shared vision,
shared meaning, shared leadership
and other values, integral dialogues and
communication/morale, etc.)
Lower left
Source: Ken Wilber, Integral Psychology: Consciousness, Spirit, Psychology, Therapy (Boston: Shambhala, 2000). Table
adapted with permission from Ken Wilber. http://www.kenwilber.com. Copyright © by Barbara M. Dossey, 2007.
Table 13 • 1 Integral Model and Quadrants
Individual exterior
(behavioral/biological)
“It” space that includes brain and organisms
(physiology, pathophysiology [cells, mole-
cules, limbic system, neurotransmitters, phys-
ical sensations], biochemistry, chemistry,
physics, behaviors [skill development in
health, nutrition, exercise, etc.])
It
Its
Collective exterior
(systems/structures)
“Its” space includes the relation to social sys-
tems and environment, organizational struc-
tures and systems [in healthcare—financial
and billing systems], educational systems, in-
fomation technology, mechanical structures
and transportation, regulatory structures [en-
vironmental and governmental policies, etc.]
Lower right
• Subjective
• Interpretive
• Qualitative
• Objective
• Observable
• Quantitative
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 216
• Upper-right (UR). In this “It” (objective)
space, the world of the individual’s exterior
can be found. This includes the material
body (physiology [cells, molecules, neuro-
transmitters, limbic system], biochemistry,
chemistry, physics), integral patient care
plans, skill development (health, fitness, ex-
ercise, nutrition, etc.), behaviors, leadership
skills, and integral life practices and any-
thing that we can touch or observe scientifi-
cally in time and space. Integral nursing
with our nursing colleagues and health-care
team members includes the “It” of new be-
haviors, integral assessment and care plans,
leadership, and skills development.
• Lower-left (LL). In this “We” (intersubjec-
tive) space resides the interior collective of
how we can come together to share our cul-
tural background, stories, values, meanings,
vision, language, relationships, and to form
partnerships to achieve a healing mission.
This can decrease our fragmentation and
enhance collaborative practice and deep
dialogue around things that really matter.
Integral nursing is built on “We.”
• Lower-right (LR). In this “Its” space (in-
terobjective) the world of the collective,
exterior things can be found. This includes
social systems/structures, networks, organi-
zational structures, and systems (including
financial and billing systems in health care),
information technology, regulatory struc-
tures (environmental and governmental
policies, etc.), any aspect of the technologi-
cal environment, and the natural world.
Integral nursing identifies the “Its” in the
structure that can be enhanced to create
more integral awareness and integral
partnerships to achieve health and
healing—local to global.
We see that the left-hand quadrants (UL,
LL) describe aspects of reality as interpretive
and qualitative (see Fig. 13-1D). In contrast,
the right-hand quadrants (UR, LR) describe
aspects of reality as measurable and quantita-
tive. When we fail to consider these subjective,
intersubjective, objective, and interobjective
aspects of reality, our endeavors and initiatives
become fragmented and narrow, inhibiting our
ability to reach meaningful outcomes and
goals. The four quadrants are a result of the
differences and similarities in Wilber’s inves-
tigation of the many aspects of identified real-
ity. The model describes the territory of our
own awareness that is already present within
us and an awareness of things outside of us.
These quadrants help us connect the dots of
the actual process to more deeply understand
who we are, and how we are related to others
and all things.
Content Component 5: AQAL (All Quad-
rants, All Levels). The fifth content component
in the theory of integral nursing is the explo-
ration of Wilber’s “all quadrants, all levels, all
lines, all states, all types” or A-Q-A-L (pro-
nounced ah-qwul), as seen in Figure 13-1E.
These levels, lines, states, and types are impor-
tant elements of any comprehensive map of
reality. The integral model simply assists us in
further articulating and connecting all areas,
awareness, and depth in these four quadrants.
CHAPTER 13 • Barbara Dossey’s Theory of Integral Nursing 217
Fig 13 • 1 E, Theory of integral nursing (healing,
metaparadigm, patterns of knowing in nursing,
four quadrants, and AQAL). Source: Adapted with
permission from Ken Wilber. http://www.kenwilber.com.
Copyright © Barbara Dossey, 2007.
Healing
Spirit
Mind
Body
Casual
Subtle
Gross
Me
Us
All of us
Group
Nation
Global
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 217
Briefly stated, these levels, lines, states, and
types are as follows:
• Levels: Levels of development that become
permanent with growth and maturity (e.g.,
cognitive, relational, psychosocial, physical,
mental, emotional, spiritual) that represent a
level of increased organization or level of
complexity. These levels are also referred to as
waves and stages of development. Each indi-
vidual possesses both the masculine and the
feminine voice or energy. One is not superior
to the other; they are two equivalent types at
each level of consciousness and development.
• Lines: Developmental areas that are known
as multiple intelligences (e.g., cognitive line
[awareness of what is]; interpersonal line
[how I relate socially to others]; emo-
tional/affective line [the full spectrum of
emotions]; moral line [awareness of what
should be]; needs line [Maslow’s hierarchy
of needs]; aesthetics line [self-expression of
art, beauty, and full meaning]; self-identity
line [who am I?]; spiritual line [where
“spirit” is viewed as its own line of unfold-
ing, and not just as ground and highest
state], and values line [what a person
considers most important; studied by Clare
Graves and brought forward by Don Beck,
2007, in his spiral dynamics integral, which
is beyond the scope of this chapter]).
• States: Temporary changing forms of aware-
ness (e.g., waking, dreaming, deep sleep,
altered meditative states [such as occurs in
meditation, yoga, contemplative prayer, etc.];
altered states [due to mood swings, physiol-
ogy and pathophysiology shifts with
disease/illness, seizures, cardiac arrest, low or
high oxygen saturation, drug-induced]; peak
experiences [triggered by intense listening to
music, walks in nature, lovemaking, mystical
experiences such as hearing the voice of God
or of a deceased person, etc.].
• Types: Differences in personality and
masculine and feminine expressions and
development (e.g., cultural creative types,
personality types, enneagram).
This part of the theory of integral nursing
(see Fig. 13-1E) starts with healing at the
center surrounded by three increasing concen-
tric circles with dotted lines of the four quad-
rants. This part of the integral theory moves to
higher orders of complexity through personal
growth, development, expanded stages of con-
sciousness (permanent and actual milestones of
growth and development), and evolution. These
levels or stages of development can also be ex-
pressed as being self-absorbed (such as a child
or infant) to ethnocentric (centers on group,
community, tribe, nation) to world-centric (care
and concern for all peoples regardless of race or
national origin, color, sex, gender, sexual orien-
tation, creed, and to the global level).
In the UL, the “I” space, the emphasis is on
the unfolding “awareness” from body to mind
to spirit. Each increasing circle includes the
lower as it moves to the higher level.
In the UR, the “It” space, is the external of
the individual. Every state of consciousness has
a felt energetic component that is expressed
from the wisdom traditions as three recognized
bodies: gross, subtle, and causal (Wilber,
2000b, 2005). We can think of these three
bodies as the increasing capacities of a person
toward higher levels of consciousness. Each
level is a specific vehicle that provides the actual
support for any state of awareness. The gross
body is the individual physical, material, sen-
sorimotor body that we experience in our daily
activities. The subtle body occurs when we are
not aware of the gross body of dense matter,
but of a shifting to a light, energy, emotional
feelings, and fluid and flowing images. Exam-
ples might be in our shift during a dream, dur-
ing different types of bodywork, walks in
nature, or other experiences that move us to a
profound state of bliss. The causal body is the
body of the infinite that is beyond space and
time. Causal also includes nonlocality in which
minds of individuals are not separate in space
and time (L. Dossey, 1989; 2013). When this
is applied to consciousness, separate minds be-
have as if they are linked, regardless of how far
apart in space and time they may be. Nonlocal
consciousness may underlie phenomena such
as remote healing, intercessory prayer, telepa-
thy, premonitions, as well as so-called miracles.
Nonlocality also implies that the soul does not
218 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 218
die with the death of the physical body—hence,
immortality forms some dimension of con-
sciousness. Nonlocality can also be both upper
and lower quadrant phenomena.
The LL, the “We” space, is the interior col-
lective dimension of individuals that come to-
gether. The concentric circles from the center
outward represent increasing levels of com-
plexity of our relational aspect of shared cul-
tural values, as this is where teamwork and the
interdisciplinary and transpersonal disciplinary
development occur. The inner circle represents
the individual labeled as me; the second circle
represents a larger group labeled us; the third
circle is labeled as all of us to represent the
largest group consciousness that expands to all
people. These last two circles may include peo-
ple but also animals, nature, and nonliving
things that are important to individuals.
The LR, the “Its” space, the exterior social
system and structures of the collective, is rep-
resented with concentric circles. An example
within the inner circle might be a group of
health-care professionals in a hospital clinic or
department or the complex hospital system
and structure. The middle circle expands in in-
creased complexity to include a nation; the
third concentric circle represents even greater
increased complexity to the global level where
the health of all humanity and the world are
considered. It is also helpful to emphasize that
these groupings are the physical dynamics such
as the working structure of a group of health
care professionals versus the relational aspect
that is a LL aspect, and the physical and tech-
nical structural of a hospital or a clinic.
Integral nurses strive to integrate concepts
and practices related to body, mind, and spirit
(the all-levels) in self, culture, and nature (“all
quadrants” part). The individual interior and
exterior—“I” and “It”—as well as the collective
interior and exterior—“We” and “Its”—must
be developed, valued, and integrated into all
aspects of culture and society. The AQAL in-
tegral approach suggests that we consciously
touch all of these areas and do so in relation to
self, to others, and the natural world. Yet to be
integrally informed does not mean that we
have to master all of these areas; we just need
to be aware of them and choose to integrate
integral awareness and integral practices. Be-
cause these areas are already part of our being-
in-the-world and cannot be imposed from the
outside (they are part of our makeup from the
inside), our challenge is to identify specific
areas for development and find new ways to
deepen our daily integral life practices.
Structure
The structure of the theory of integral nursing
is shown in Figure 13-1F. All content compo-
nents are represented together as an overlay
that creates a mandala to symbolize wholeness.
Healing is placed at the center, then the meta-
paradigm of nursing, the patterns of knowing,
the four quadrants, and all quadrants and all
levels of growth, development, and evolution.
[Note: Although the patterns of knowing are su-
perimposed as they are in the various quadrants,
they can also fit into other quadrants.]
Using the language of Ken Wilber (2000b)
and Don Beck (2007) and his spiral dynamics
integral, individuals move through primitive,
infantile consciousness to an integrated lan-
guage that is considered first-tier thinking. As
they move up the spiral of growth, develop-
ment, and evolution and expand their integral
worldview and integral consciousness, they
move into what is second-tier thinking and par-
ticipation. This is a radical leap into holistic,
systemic, and integral modes of consciousness.
Wilber also expands to a third-tier of stages of
consciousness that addresses an even deeper
level of transpersonal understanding that is be-
yond the scope of this chapter (Wilber, 2006).
Context
Context in a nursing theory is the environment
in which nursing acts occur and the nature of
the world of nursing. In an integral nursing
environment, the nurse strives to be an inte-
gralist, which means that she or he strives to
be integrally informed and is challenged to fur-
ther develop an integral worldview, integral life
practices, and integral capacities, behaviors,
and skills. The term nurse healer is used to de-
scribe that a nurse is an instrument in the heal-
ing process and a major part of the external
CHAPTER 13 • Barbara Dossey’s Theory of Integral Nursing 219
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 219
healing environment of a patient or family. An
integral nurse values, articulates, and models
the integral process and integral worldview and
integral life practices and self-care. Nurses as-
sist and facilitate the individual person/s
(client/patient, family, and coworkers) to ac-
cess their own healing process and potentials;
they do not do the actual healing. An integral
nurse recognizes herself or himself as a healing
environment interacting with a person, family,
or colleague in a being with rather than always
doing to or doing for another person, and enters
into a shared experience (or field of conscious-
ness) that promotes healing potentials and an
experience of well-being.
Relationship-centered care is valued and inte-
grated as a model of caregiving that is based in a
vision of community where three types of rela-
tionships are identified: (1) patient–practitioner
relationship, (2) community–practitioner rela-
tionship, and (3) practitioner–practitioner rela-
tionship (Tresoli, 1994). Relationship-based care
220 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Fig 13 • 1 F, Healing and AQAL (all quadrants, all levels). Source: Adapted with permission from Ken
Wilber. http://www.kenwilber.com. Copyright © Barbara Dossey, 2007.
Spirit
Mind
Body
Casual
Subtle
Gross
Me
Us
All of us
Group
Nation
Global
Environment
(society)
Person(s)
Health
Healing
Nurse
Q
u
alitative
Q
ua
n
ti
ta
ti
ve
M
easu
reab
le
In
te
rp
re
tiv
e
Not knowing Sociopolitical
EmpiricsPersonal
Aesthetics Ethics
It
objective
biological
behavioral
Its
interobjective
systems
structures
I
subjective
personal
intentional
We
intersubjective
cultural
shared values
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 220
is also valued as it provides the map and high-
lights the most direct routes to achieve the high-
est levels of care and serve to patients and
families (Koloroutis, 2004).
Process
Process in a nursing theory is the method by
which the theory works. An integral healing
process contains both nurse processes and pa-
tient/family and health-care worker processes
(individual interior and individual exterior),
and collective healing processes of individuals
and of systems/structures (interior and exte-
rior). This is the understanding of the unitary
whole person interacting in mutual process
with the environment.
Applications to Practice
The theory of integral nursing can guide nurs-
ing practice and strengthen our 21st-century
nursing endeavors. It considers equally impor-
tant data, meanings, and experiences from the
personal interior, the collective interior, the
individual exterior, and the collective exterior.
Nursing and health care are fragmented. Col-
laborative practice has not been realized
because only portions of reality are seen as
being valid within health care and society.
The nursing profession asks nurses to wrap
around “all of life” on so many levels with self
and others that we can often feel overwhelmed.
So how do we get a handle on “all of life?” The
following questions always arise: How can
overworked nurses and student nurses use an
integral approach or apply the theory of integral
nursing? How do we connect the complexity of
so much information that arises in clinical prac-
tice? The answer is to start right now. Remem-
ber that healing, the core concept in this theory,
is the innate natural phenomenon that comes
from within a person and reflects the indivisible
wholeness, the interconnectedness of all peo-
ple, all things. The practice situation that fol-
lows addresses these questions.
Imagine that you are caring for a very ill pa-
tient who needs to be transported to the radi-
ology department for a procedure. The current
transportation protocol between the unit and
the radiology department lacks continuity. In
this moment, shift your feelings and your inte-
rior awareness (and believe it!) to “I am doing
the best I can in this moment” and “I have all
the time needed to take a deep breath and relax
my tight chest and shoulder muscles.” This
helps you connect these four perspectives as fol-
lows: (1) the interior self (caring for yourself in
this moment), (2) the exterior self (using a re-
search-based relaxation and imagery integral
practice to change your physiology), (3) the self
in relationship to others (shifting your aware-
ness creates another way of being with your
patient and the radiology team member), and
(4) the relationship to the exterior collective of
systems/structures (considering how to work
with the radiology team and department to im-
prove a transportation procedure in the hospital).
Professional burnout is high, with many
nurses disheartened. Self-care is a low priority;
time is not given or valued within practice set-
tings to address basic self-care such as short
breaks for personal needs and meals. This is
worsened by short staffing and overtime. Also,
we do not consistently listen to the pain and
suffering that nurses experience within the pro-
fession, nor do we consistently listen to the pain
and suffering of the patient and family members
or our colleagues (Dossey, Luck, & Schaub,
2015; McEligott, 2013). Often there is a lack
of respect for each other, with verbal abuse oc-
curring on many levels in the workplace.
Nurse retention and a global nursing short-
age are at a crisis level throughout the world
(International Council of Nurses, 2004). As
nurses deepen their understanding related to
an integral process and integral worldview and
use daily integral life practices, we will more
consistently be healthy and model health and
understand the complexities within healing
and society. This enhances nurses’ capacities
for empowerment, leadership, and acting as
change agents for a healthy world.
An integral worldview and approach can
help each nurse and student nurse increase her
or his self-awareness, as well as the awareness
of how self affects others—that is the patient,
family, colleagues, and the workplace and
community. As the nurse discovers her or his
own innate healing from within, she or he is
able to model self-care and how to release
CHAPTER 13 • Barbara Dossey’s Theory of Integral Nursing 221
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 221
stress, anxiety, and fear that manifest each day
in this human journey. All nursing curricula
can be mapped in the integral quadrants so
that students learn to think integrally about
how these four perspectives create the whole
(Clark 2006; Hess, 2013).
Meaning of the Theory of Integral
Nursing for Practice
A key concept in the theory of integral nursing
is meaning, which addresses that which is in-
dicated, referred to, or signified (L. Dossey,
2003). Philosophical meaning is related to one’s
view of reality and the symbolic connections
that can be grasped by reason. Psychological
meaning is related to one’s consciousness, in-
tuition, and insight. Spiritual meaning is re-
lated to how one deepens personal experience
of a connection with the Divine, to feel a sense
of oneness, belonging and feeling of connec-
tion in life. In the next section, four integral
nursing principles are discussed that provide
further insight into how the theory of integral
nursing guides nursing practice and meaning
in practice. See Figure 13-1F for specifics for
each principle.
Integral Nursing Principle 1: Nursing
Starts With “I”
Integral Nursing Principle 1 recognizes the in-
terior individual “I” (subjective) space. Each of
us must value the importance of exploring
one’s health and well-being starting with our
own personal work on many levels. In this “I”
space, integral self-care is valued, which means
that integral reflective practices become part of
and can be transformative in our developmen-
tal process. This includes how each of us con-
tinually addresses our own stress, burnout,
suffering, and soul pain. It can assist us to
understand the necessity of personal healing
and self-care related to nursing as art where we
develop qualities of nursing presence and inner
reflection.
Nurse presence is also used and is a way of
approaching a person in a way that respects
and honors the person’s essence; it is relating
in a way that reflects a quality of “being with”
and “in collaboration with.” Our own inner
work also helps us to hold deeply a conscious
awareness of our own roles in creating a
healthy world. We recognize the importance
of addressing one’s own shadow as described
by Jung (1981). This is a composite of personal
characteristics and potentials that have been
denied expression in life and of which a person
is unaware; the ego denies the characteristics
because they are in conflict and incompatible
with a person’s chosen conscious attitude.
Mindfulness is the practice of giving atten-
tion to what is happening in the present mo-
ment such as our thoughts, feelings, emotions,
and sensations. To cultivate the capacity of
mindfulness practice, one may include mind-
fulness meditation practice, centering prayer,
and other reflective practices such as journal-
ing, dream interpretation, art, music, or poetry
that leads to an experience of nonseparateness
and love; it involves developing the qualities of
stillness and being present for one’s own suf-
fering that will also allow for full presence
when with another.
In our personal process, we recognize con-
scious dying where time and thought is given to
contemplate one’s own death. Through a re-
flective practice, one rehearses and imagines
one’s final breath to practice preparing for
one’s own death. The experience prepares us to
not be so attached to material things nor to
spend so much time thinking about the future
but to live in the moment as often as we can
and to live fully until death comes. We are
more likely to participate with deeper compas-
sion in the death process and to become more
fully engaged in the death process. Death is
seen as the mirror in which the entire meaning
and mystery of life is reflected—the moment
of liberation. Within an integral perspective,
the state of transparency, the understanding
that there is no separation between our prac-
tice and our everyday life is recognized. This is
a mature practice that is wise and empty of a
separate self.
Integral Nursing Principle 2: Nursing
Is Built on “We”
Integral Nursing Principle 2 recognizes the im-
portance of the “We” (intersubjective) space. In
this “We” space, nurses come together and are
conscious of sharing their worldviews, beliefs,
222 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 222
priorities, and values related to working to-
gether in ways to enhance integral self-care and
integral health care. Deep listening, being pres-
ent and focused with intention to understand
what another person is expressing or not ex-
pressing, is used. Bearing witness to others, the
state achieved through reflective and mindful-
ness practices, is also valued (Beck et al., 2011;
B. M. Dossey, 2013; B. M. Dossey, Beck, &
Rushton, 2013; Halifax et al., 2007). Through
mindfulness one is able to achieve states of
equanimity—that is, the stability of mind that
allows us to be present with a good and impar-
tial heart no matter how beneficial or difficult
the conditions; it is being present for the suf-
ferer and suffering just as it is while maintain-
ing a spacious mindfulness in the midst of life’s
changing conditions. Compassion is where bear-
ing witness and lovingkindness manifest in the
face of suffering, and it is part of our integral
practice. The realization of the self and another
as not being separate is experienced; it is the
ability to open one’s heart and be present for all
levels of suffering so that suffering may be
transformed for others, as well as for the self.
A useful phrase to consider is “I’m doing the
best I can.” Compassionate care assists us in liv-
ing as well as when being with the dying per-
son, the family, and others. We can touch the
roots of pain and become aware of new mean-
ing in the midst of pain, chaos, loss, grief, and
also in the dying process.
An integral nurse considers transpersonal
dimensions. This means that interactions with
others move from conversations to a deeper di-
alogue that goes beyond the individual ego; it
includes the acknowledgment and appreciation
for something greater that may be referred
to as spirit, nonlocality, unity, or oneness.
Transpersonal dialogues contain an integral
worldview and recognize the role of spirituality
that is the search for the sacred or holy that in-
volves feelings, thoughts, experiences, rituals,
meaning, value, direction, and purpose as valid
aspects of the universe. It is a unifying force of
a person with all that is—the essence of being-
ness and relatedness that permeates all of
life and is manifested in one’s knowing, doing,
and being; it is usually, although not univer-
sally, considered the interconnectedness with
self, others, nature, and God/Life Force/
Absolute/Transcendent.
Within nursing, health care, and society,
there is much suffering (physical, mental, emo-
tional, social, spiritual), moral suffering, moral
distress, and soul pain. We are often called on
to “be with” these difficult human experiences
and to use our nursing presence. Our sense of
“We” supports us to recognize the phases of
suffering—“mute” suffering, “expressive” suf-
fering, and “new identity” in suffering (Halifax
et al., 2007). When we feel alone, as nurses,
we experience mute suffering; this is an inabil-
ity to articulate and communicate with others
one’s own suffering. Our challenge in nursing
is to more skillfully enter into the phase of
“expressive” suffering, where sufferers seek lan-
guage to express their frustrations and experi-
ences such as in sharing stories in a group
process (Levin & Reich, 2013). Outcomes of
this experience often move toward new iden-
tity in suffering through new meaning-making
in which one makes new sense of the past,
interprets new meaning in suffering, and can
envision a new future. A shift in one’s con-
sciousness allows for a shift in one’s capacity
to be able to transform her or his suffering
from causing distress to finding some new
truth and meaning of it. As we create times for
sharing and giving voice to our concerns, new
levels of healing may happen.
From an integral perspective, spiritual care
is an interfaith perspective that takes into ac-
count dying as a developmental and natural
human process that emphasizes meaningful-
ness and human and spiritual values. Religion
is recognized as the codified and ritualized be-
liefs, behaviors, and rituals that take place in a
community of like-minded individuals in-
volved in spirituality. Our challenge is to enter
into deep dialogue to more fully understand
religions different than our own so that we
may be tolerant where there are differences.
Integral action is the actual practice and
process that creates the condition of trust
wherein a plan of care is cocreated with the pa-
tient and care can be given and received. Full
attention and intention to the whole person,
not merely the current presenting symptoms,
illness, crisis, or tasks to be accomplished,
CHAPTER 13 • Barbara Dossey’s Theory of Integral Nursing 223
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 223
reinforce the person’s meaning and experience
of community and unity. Engagement be-
tween an integral nurse and a patient and the
family or with colleagues is done in a respectful
manner; each patient’s subjective experience
about health, health beliefs, and values are ex-
plored. We deeply care for others and recog-
nize our own mortality and that of others.
The integral nurse uses intention, the con-
scious awareness of being in the present mo-
ment with self or another person, to help
facilitate the healing process; it is a volitional
act of love. An awareness of the role of intu-
ition is also recognized, which is the per-
ceived knowing of events, insights, and
things without a conscious use of logical, an-
alytical processes; it may be informed by the
senses to receive information. Integral nurses
recognize love as the unconditional unity of
self with others. This love then generates
lovingkindness and the open, gentle, and car-
ing state of mindfulness that assist one’s with
nursing presence.
Integral communication is a free flow of ver-
bal and nonverbal interchange between and
among people and pets and significant beings
such as God/Life Force/Absolute/Transcen-
dent. This type of sharing leads to explo-
rations of meaning and ideas of mutual
understanding and growth and loving kind-
ness. Intuition is a sudden insight into a feel-
ing, a solution, or problem in which time and
actions and perceptions fit together in a uni-
fied experience such as understanding about
pain and suffering, or a moment in time with
another. This is an aspect that may lead to
recognizing and being with the pattern of not
knowing.
Integral Nursing Principle 3: “It” Is About
Behavior and Skill Development
Integral Nursing Principle 3 recognizes the
importance of the individual exterior “It” (ob-
jective) space. In this “It” space of the indi-
vidual exterior, each person develops and
integrates her or his integral self-care plan.
This includes skills, behaviors, and action
steps to achieve a fit body and to consider
body strength training and stretching and
conscious eating of healthy foods. It also
includes modeling integral life skills. For the
integral nurse and patient, it is also the space
where the “doing to” and “doing for” occurs.
However, if the patient has moved into the
active dying process, the integral nurse com-
bines her or his nursing presence with nursing
acts to assist the patient to access personal
strengths, to release fear and anxiety, and to
provide comfort and safety. Most often the
patient has an awareness of conscious dying
and a time of sacredness and reverence in this
dying transition.
Integral nurses, with nursing colleagues and
health-care team members, compile the data
around physiological and pathophysiological
assessment, nursing diagnosis, outcomes, plans
of care (including medications, technical pro-
cedures, monitoring, treatments, traditional
and integrative practice protocols), implemen-
tation, and evaluation. This is also the space
that includes patient education and evaluation.
Integral nurses cocreate plans of care with pa-
tients, when possible combining caring–healing
interventions/modalities and integral life prac-
tices that can interface and enhance the success
of traditional medical and surgical technology
and treatment. Some common interventions
are relaxation, music, imagery, massage, touch
therapies, stories, poetry, healing environment,
fresh air, sunlight, flowers, soothing and calm-
ing pictures, pet therapy, and more.
Integral Nursing Principle 4: “Its”
Is Systems and Structures
Integral Nursing Principle 4 recognizes the
importance of the exterior collective “Its” (in-
terobjective) space. In this “Its” space, integral
nurses and the health-care team come together
to examine their work, their priorities, use of
technologies and any aspect of the technolog-
ical environment, and create exterior healing
environments that incorporate nature and the
natural world when possible such as with out-
door healing gardens, green materials inside
with soothing colors, and sounds of music and
nature. Integral nurses identify how they might
work together as an interdisciplinary team to
deliver more effective patient care and to coor-
dinate care while creating external healing
environments.
224 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 224
Application of the Theory of Integral
Nursing in Practice, Education,
Research, Health-Care Policy, Global
Nursing
The world is currently anchored in one of the
most dramatic social shifts in health-care his-
tory, and the theory of integral nursing can in-
form and shape nursing practice, education,
research, and policy—local to global—to
achieve a healthy world. The theory of integral
nursing engages us to think deeply and pur-
posefully about our role as nurses as we face a
changing picture of health due to globalization
that knows no natural or political boundaries.
Practice
The theory of integral nursing was published
in this author’s coauthored text in 2008 and
2013 (Dossey, Beck, & Rushton, 2008; 2013)
and is currently being used in many clinical
settings. The textbook clearly develops the in-
tegral, integrative, and holistic processes and
clinical application in traditional settings. It in-
cludes guidance about the use of complemen-
tary and integrative interventions.
Education
The theory of integral nursing can assist edu-
cators to be aware of all quadrants while or-
ganizing and designing curriculum, continuing
education courses, health education presenta-
tions, teaching guides, and protocols. In most
nursing curricula, there is minimal focus on the
individual subjective “I” and the collective
intersubjective “We”; the emphasis is on teach-
ing concepts such as physiology and patho-
physiology and passing an examination or
learning a new skill or procedure. Thus, the
learner retains only small portions of what is
taught. Before teaching any technical skills, the
instructor might guide a student or patient in
an integral practice such as relaxation and im-
agery rehearsal of the event to encourage the
student to be in the present moment.
The following are examples of how the the-
ory of integral nursing is being used. At Quin-
nipiac University, Hamden, Connecticut,
Cynthia Barrere, PhD, RN, CNS, AHN-BC,
and Mary Helming, PhD, APRN, FNP-BC,
AHN-BC, introduced the theory of integral
nursing to their nurse educator colleagues, who
use the theory in their holistic undergraduate
and graduate curricula as they prepare holistic
nurses for the future (Barrere, 2013). Darlene
Hess, PhD, NP, AHN-BC, HWNC-BC,
(Hess, 2013) used the theory of integral nurs-
ing in her Brown Mountain Visions consulting
practice to design an RN-to-BSN program at
Northern New Mexico State (NNMC), in
Espanola, New Mexico. This RN-to-BSN
program prepares registered nurses to assume
leadership roles as integral nurses at the bed-
side, within organizations, in the community,
and other areas of professional practice. Hess
also uses the integral process in her private
nurse coaching practice. In the Integrative
Nurse Coach Certificate Program (2013), the
integral perspectives and change are major
components (Dossey, Luck, & Schaub, 2015).
Juliann S. Perdue, DNP, RN, FNP, has
adapted the theory of integral nursing into her
integrative rehabilitation model (Perdue,
2011). Diane Pisanos, RNC, MS, NNP (per-
sonal communication, June 15, 2012) inte-
grates integral theory and process to organize
her life and health coaching practice.
Research
A theory of integral nursing can assist nurses
to consider the importance of qualitative and
quantitative research (B. M. Dossey, 2008,
2013; Esbjorn-Hargens, 2006; Frisch, 2013;
Quinn, 2003; Zahourek, 2013). Our chal-
lenges in integral nursing are to consider the
findings from both qualitative and quantita-
tive data and always consider triangulation of
data when appropriate. We must always value
introspective, cultural, and interpretive expe-
riences and expand our personal and collective
capacities of consciousness as evolutionary
progression toward achieving our goals. In
other words, knowledge emerges from all four
quadrants.
Health-Care Policy
A theory of integral nursing can guide us to
consider many areas related to health-care pol-
icy. Compelling evidence in all of the health-
care professions shows that the origins of
CHAPTER 13 • Barbara Dossey’s Theory of Integral Nursing 225
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 225
health and illness cannot be understood by fo-
cusing only on the physical body. Only by ex-
panding the equations of health, exemplified
by an integral approach or an AQAL approach
to include our entire physical, mental, emo-
tional, social, and spiritual dimensions and in-
terrelationships can we account for a host of
health events. Some of these include, for ex-
ample, the correlations among poverty, poor
health, and shortened life span; job dissatisfac-
tion and acute myocardial infarction; social
shame and severe illness; immune suppression
and increased death rates during bereavement;
and improved health and longevity as spiritu-
ality and spiritual awareness is increased.
Global Health Nursing
The theory of integral nursing can assist us as
we engage in global health partnerships and
projects. Global health is the exploration of the
value base and new relationships and agendas
that emerge when health becomes an essential
component and expression of global citizenship
(Beck et al., 2011; B. M. Dossey, Beck, &
Rushton, 2013; Gostin, 2007; Karpf , Swift,
Ferguson, & Lazarus, 2008; Karph, Ferguson,
& Swift, 2010); J. Kreisberg, personal commu-
nication, August 25, 2011; WHO, 2007). It is
an increased awareness that health is a basic
human right and a global good that needs to be
promoted and protected by the global commu-
nity. Severe health needs exist in almost every
community and nation throughout the world as
previously described in the UN Millennium
Goals. Thus, all nurses must raise their voices
and speak about global nursing as their health
and healing endeavors assist individuals to be-
come healthier. As Nightingale (1892) said,
“We must create a public opinion, which must
drive the government instead of the government
having to drive us . . . an enlightened public
opinion, wise in principle, wise in detail.”
226 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Practice Exemplar
A nurse can use the theory of integral nursing
in any clinical situation; it assists us in inte-
grating the art and science of nursing simulta-
neously with all actions/interactions. As
discussed previously, healing, the core concept,
can occur on many levels (physical, mental,
emotional, social, spiritual). Having an inte-
gral awareness and creating a space for the
possibility that healing can occur allows for a
unique field of experience. As nurses engage
in their own healing, reflective integral prac-
tices, personal development and self-care, they
literally embody a special way of being with
others. That is, they “walk their talk” of car-
ing–healing. There is a mutual respect for self
and others in each encounter as the nurse is al-
ways part of the patient’s external environ-
ment. Even while giving medications and
performing various acute care technical skills,
a nurse’s healing presence in each encounter
can reflect a “being with” and “in collaboration
with.” Nurses must engage in their own devel-
opment and also personally experience the var-
ious reflective practices (relaxation, imagery,
reframing) before engaging the patient in
these practices.
Background
J. D. is a lean, extroverted, competitive, 6’4,”
200-pound, 64-year-old global energy corpo-
rate executive who travels internationally.
J. D., an avid jogger, had a recent executive
physical with normal stress test and blood
work and was declared “a picture of good
health.” His father and paternal grandfather
both died of heart attacks in their 60s. He eats
a Mediterranean diet when possible and
drinks several glasses of wine with meals. He
uses a treadmill or runs daily. J. D. has been a
widower for 2 years after a tragic head-on au-
tomobile accident in which his wife was killed
by an intoxicated driver. He has four grown
children who live in the same city and who
quarrel over loopholes in their inheritance left
by their mother and maternal grandmother.
Two children are executives and have prob-
lems with alcohol abuse; two others are hap-
pily married, and each has two preschool
children.
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 226
CHAPTER 13 • Barbara Dossey’s Theory of Integral Nursing 227
Practice Exemplar cont.
One Sunday, J. D. placed second in a city
marathon and was disappointed he didn’t win.
On finishing a morning shower on Monday
morning after a restful night’s sleep before a
scheduled international trip, J. D. had severe
back pain. He tried stretching exercises, and
the pain went away, so he related it to a back
strain from the marathon. He then drove to
his office and collapsed onto the steering
wheel after he parked his car. A friend saw this
and immediately called 911. He was taken to
a nearby emergency room, where he was
immediately assessed and sent for cardiac
catheterization where he received a stent to
open the complete occlusion of his right coro-
nary artery. Later that night his cardiologist
confirmed from his electrocardiogram that he
had had a severe inferior myocardial infarction
with cardiac irritability; a few days later, he de-
veloped pericarditis secondary to the infarction
and was placed on pain medication.
His cardiac situation was even more com-
plicated. His cardiologist informed him that
he also had an 80% blockage at the bifurcation
in his left anterior descending coronary artery
and circumflex that was in a difficult place for
a stent. Because he had excellent collateral cir-
culation, he was placed on cardiac medications
and told that he would be monitored over the
next few months to determine whether he
needed further invasive procedures or possibly
open heart surgery. He was started on gradual
CCU cardiac rehabilitation.
J. D. was very quiet when the nurse entered
the room after the cardiologist left. The nurse
had a hunch that J. D. might want to talk
about what he was experiencing. After a brief
exchange, the nurse followed with further ex-
ploration of the meaning and negative images
that he conveyed. She asked him if he wanted
to pursue some new ideas that might help him
relax and to engage in a guided imagery to ac-
cess his inner healing resources and strengths.
He said that he would. This encounter took
10 minutes. After the guided imagery, the
following dialogue unfolded.
Nurse: In your recovery now with your heart
healing, how do you experience your healing?
J. D.: There is this sac around my heart; every
time I take a deep breath, my breath is cut off
by the pain [pericarditis]. My heart is like a
broken vase. I don’t think it is healing. The
pain medication is helping.
Nurse: I can understand some of your frustra-
tion and concern. However, some important
things that are present right now show me
that you are better than when you first came
to the CCU. Your persistent chest pain is
gone, and your heartbeats are now regular,
which shows that the stent is very effective. If
you focus on what is going right, you can help
your heart and lift your spirits. Let me share
some ideas so that you might be able to shift
to some positive thoughts.
J. D.: I don’t know if I can.
Nurse: I would like to show you how to breathe
more comfortably. Place your right hand on
your upper chest and your left hand on your
belly and begin to breathe with your belly.
With your next breath in, through your nose,
let the breath fill your belly with air. And as
you exhale through your mouth, let your
stomach fall back to your spine. As you focus
on this way of breathing, notice how still
your upper chest feels.
J. D.: (After three complete breaths) This is the
easiest breathing I’ve done today.
Nurse: As you focused on breathing with your
belly, you let go of fearing the discomfort with
your breathing. Can you tell me more about the
image you have of your heart as a broken vase?
J. D.: I saw this crack down the front of my
heart right after the doctor told me about my
big arteries that have the 80% blockage. This
is very scary.
Nurse: (Taking a small plastic bag full of
crayons out of her pocket and picking up a
piece of paper) Is it possible for you to choose a
few crayons and draw your heart as you just
described it?
J. D.: I can’t draw.
Nurse: This has nothing to do with drawing, but
something usually happens when you place a
few marks to create an image of your words.
J. D.: If you mean the image of a broken vase,
I can draw that.
Continued
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 227
228 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Practice Exemplar cont.
He began to place an image on the paper.
When halfway through with the drawing, he
said, “I know this sounds crazy, but my father
had a heart attack when he was 63. I was visit-
ing my parents. Dad hadn’t been feeling well,
even complained of his stomach hurting that
morning. He was in the living room, and as he
fell, he knocked over a large Chinese porcelain
vase that broke in two pieces. I can remember
so clearly running to his side. I can see that vase
now, cracked in a jagged edge down the front.
He made it to the hospital, but died 2 days
later. You know, I think that might be where
that image of a broken heart came from.”
Nurse: Your story contains a lot of meaning.
Remembering this image and event can be
very helpful to you in your healing. What are
some of the things that you are most worried
about just now?
J. D.: Dying young.
(Tears fill his eyes) I have this funny feeling
in my stomach just now. I don’t want to die.
I’m too young. I have so much to contribute
to life. I’ve been driving myself to excess at
work. I need to learn to relax and manage my
stress and change my life.
Nurse: J., each day you are getting stronger.
This time over the next few weeks can be a
time to reflect on what are the most impor-
tant things in your life. Whenever you feel
discouraged, let images come to you of a beau-
tiful vase that has a healed crack in it. This is
exactly what your heart is doing right now.
Even as we are talking, the area that has
been damaged is healing. As it heals, there
will be a solid scar that will be very strong,
just in the same way that a vase can be
mended and become strong again. New blood
supplies also come into the surrounding area
of your heart to help it heal. Positive images
can help you heal because you send a different
message from your mind to your body when
you are relaxed and thinking about becoming
strong and well. You help your body, mind,
and spirit function at their highest level. Is it
possible for you to once again draw an image
of your heart as a healed vase and notice any
difference in your feelings?
J. D.: Thanks for this talk.
With a smile, he picked up several crayons
and began to draw a healing image to encour-
age hope and healing.
When J. D. entered the outpatient cardiac
rehabilitation program, he was motivated to
learn stress management skills and express his
emotions. Two weeks into the program, J. D.
did not appear to be his usual extroverted self.
The cardiac rehabilitation nurse engaged him in
conversation, and before long, he had tears in
his eyes. He stated that he was very discouraged
about having heart disease. He said, “It just has
a grip on me.” The nurse took him into her of-
fice, and they continued the dialogue. After lis-
tening to his story, she asked J. D. if he would
like to explore his feelings further. He nodded
yes. This next session took 15 minutes.
To facilitate the healing process, she
thought it might be helpful to have J. D. get
in touch with his images and their locations in
his body. She began by saying, “If it seems
right to you, close your eyes and begin to focus
on your breathing just now.” She guided him
in a general exercise of head-to-toe relaxation,
accompanied by an audiocassette music selec-
tion of sounds in nature. As his breathing pat-
terns became more relaxed and deeper,
indicating relaxation, she began to guide him
in exploring “the grip” in his imagination.
Nurse: Focus on where you experience the grip.
Give it a size, ... a shape, ... a sound, ... a
texture, ... a width, ... and a depth.
J. D.: It’s in my chest, but not like chest pain.
It’s dull, deep, and blocks my knowing what I
need to think or feel about living. I can’t be-
lieve that I’m using these words. Well, it’s
bigger than I thought. It’s very rough, like
heavy jute rope tied in a knot across my chest.
It has a sound like a rope that keeps a sailboat
tied to a boat dock. I’m now rocking back and
forth. I don’t know why this is happening.
Nurse: Stay with the feeling, and let it fill you
as much as it can. If you need to change the
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 228
CHAPTER 13 • Barbara Dossey’s Theory of Integral Nursing 229
Practice Exemplar cont.
experience, all you have to do is take several
deep breaths.
J. D.: It’s filling me up. Where are these sounds,
feelings, and sensations coming from?
Nurse: They are coming from your wise, inner
self, your inner healing resources. Just let
yourself stay with the experience. Continue to
use as many of your senses as you can to de-
scribe and feel these experiences.
J. D.: Nothing is happening. I’ve gone blank.
Nurse: Focus again on your breath in ... and
feel the breath as you let it go. ... Can you
allow an image of your heart to come to you
under that tight grip?
J. D.: It is so small I can hardly see it. It’s all
wrapped up.
Nurse: In your imagination, can you introduce
yourself to your heart as if you were introduc-
ing yourself to a person for the first time? Ask
your heart if it has a name.
J. D.: It said hello, but it was with a gesture of
hello, no words.
Nurse: That’s fine. Just say, “Nice to meet you,”
and see what the response might be.
J. D.: My heart seems like an old soul, very
wise. This feels very comfortable.
Nurse: Ask your heart a question for which you
would like an answer. Stay with this and
listen for what comes.
After long pause:
J. D.: The answer is practice patience, that I am
on the right track, that my heart disease has a
message, don’t know what it is.
Nurse: Just stay with your calmness and inner
quiet. Notice how the grip has changed for
you. There are many more answers to come
for you. This is your wise self that has much to
offer you. Whenever you want, you can get
back to this special kind of knowing. All you
have to do is take the time. When you set
aside time to be quiet with your rich images,
you will get more information. You might
also find special music to assist you in this
process. ... Your skills with this way of know-
ing will increase each time you use this
process ... now that whatever is right for you
in this moment is unfolding, just as it should.
In a few moments, I will invite you back into
a wakeful state. On five, be ready to come
back into the room and feel wide-awake and
relaxed. One ... two ... three ... four ... eyelids
lighter, taking a deep breath ... and five, back
into the room, awake and alert, ready to go
about your day.
J. D.: Where did all that come from? I’ve never
done that before.
Nurse: All of these experiences are your inner
healing resources that are always with you to
help you recognize quality and purpose in
living each day. All you have to do is take the
time to remember to use them and direct your
self-talk and images toward a desired out-
come. If you want, I can teach and share
more of these skills.
J. D.: Ever since my wife died, I have had a
sense of “What is the meaning of my life? what
is my purpose?” Some days I feel like I have
lost my soul. I go through my days doing and
doing, and yes I do accomplish a lot. But deep
down I am not happy. I have been asking
myself the question, “What am I doing . . . or
NOT doing . . . that is feeding the problems I
don’t want and believing that I can find hap-
piness out there?” Today with you in this ex-
perience, a light switch got turned on in me.
My happiness is buried inside me. I have to
gain access to it again somehow. I try to fix my
kids by giving them more money. I actually
don’t really sit down with them. Sometimes I
feel like I don’t really know anything about
them. I have grandkids that I rarely see. I get
frustrated with my corporation as I feel we are
contributing to environmental pollution. We
[the corporation] can do more about changing
this. You helped me identify my needs and how
I can contribute differently. I feel a new kind
of ownership about my life.
Evaluation and Outcomes
Together the patient and the nurse evaluate
the encounter and determine whether the re-
laxation and imagery experiences were useful
and discuss future outcomes. Such sessions
frequently open up profound information and
possibilities. To evaluate the session further,
Continued
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 229
230 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Practice Exemplar cont.
the nurse may again explore the subjective ef-
fects of the experience with the patient. Re-
laxation and imagery are integral life practices
for connecting with our unlimited capabilities
and capacities. The patient can experience
more self-awareness, self-acceptance, self-love,
and self-worth. These integral life practices can
be transferred to daily life as resources for self-
care. The best way to develop confidence and
skill in using relaxation and imagery in a clin-
ical setting is for the nurse to embody these
practices in her or his own life as a part of per-
sonal self-care and enrichment.
Learning how to be authentic and fresh in
interactions and in each moment can be en-
hanced as we learn to bear witness by deep lis-
tening and “simply noticing” what is going on.
It is so easy to get locked into our analytical
logic that we block ourselves from reaching
into our hearts and moving into our intuitions
or emotions. With time and practice, we give
space to what might appear. Both good and
negative thoughts always contain some wis-
dom. After such a patient encounter, it is a
time to really reflect on what happened: How
did you stay focused for the patient and stay in
the moment? In this kind of encounter, we can
never predict what will happen. As we engage
in our work, our challenge is to be aware of
learning to bear witness, not trying to fix any-
thing, and just exploring the moment with self
and other(s). It seems that when we least ex-
pect it, we might experience or access a deeper
place on inner wisdom. Reflection is often how
the contrast of the light and shadow, the “dark
nights of the soul” are resolved.
■ Summary
The theory of integral nursing addresses how
we can increase our integral awareness, our
wholeness and healing, and strengthen our
personal and professional capacities to more
fully open to the mysteries of life’s journey and
the wondrous stages of self-discovery with self
and others. There are many opportunities to
increase our integral awareness, application,
and understanding each day. Reflect on all that
you do each day in your work and life—ana-
lyzing, communicating, listening, exchanging,
surveying, involving, synthesizing, investigat-
ing, interviewing, mentoring, developing, cre-
ating, researching, teaching, and creating new
schemes for what is possible. Before long, you
will realize how all the quadrants and realities
fit together. You might find you are completely
missing a quadrant, thus an important part of
reality. As we address and value the individual
interior and exterior, the “I” and “It,” as well
as the collective interior and exterior, the “We”
and “Its,” a new level of integral understanding
emerges, and we may also experience more
balance and harmony each day.
Our time demands a new paradigm and a
new language in which we take the best of
what we know in the science and art of nurs-
ing that includes holistic and human caring
theories and modalities. With an integral ap-
proach and worldview, we are in a better po-
sition to share with others the depth of nurses’
knowledge, expertise, and critical-thinking ca-
pacities and skills for assisting others in cre-
ating health and healing. Only an attention to
the heart of nursing, for “sacred” and “heart”
reflect a common meaning, can we generate
the vision, courage, and hope required to unite
nursing in healing. This assists us as we engage
in health-care reform to address the challenges
in these troubled times—local to global. It is
not an abstract matter of philosophy, but of
survival.1
1 For additional information please go to bonus chapter content available at http://davisplus.fadavis.com
See Barbara Dossey’s website at www.dosseydossey.com to download the theory of integral nursing PowerPoint and one-page
handout.
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 230
CHAPTER 13 • Barbara Dossey’s Theory of Integral Nursing 231
References
American Holistic Nurses Association and the American
Nurses Association. (2007). Holistic nursing: Scope
and standards of practice. Silver Spring, MD:
American Nurses Association.
American Holistic Nurses Association and the American
Nurses Association. (2013). Holistic nursing: Scope
and standards of practice (2nd ed.). Silver Spring,
MD: American Nurses Association.
Averill, J. B., & Clements, P. T. (2007). Patterns of
knowing as a foundation for action-sensitive
pedagogy. Qual Health Research, 17(3), 386–399.
Barnum, B. (2004). Spirituality in nursing: From
traditional to new age (2nd ed.). New York: Springer.
Barnum, B. S. (2005). Nursing theory: Analysis, applica-
tion, evaluation (6th ed.). Philadelphia: Lippincott
Williams & Wilkins.
Barrere, C. C. (2013). Teaching our future holistic
nurses: Integration of holistic and Quality Safety
Education for Nurses (QSEN) concepts. In B. M.
Dossey & L. Keegan (Eds.), Holistic nursing: A
handbook for practice (6th ed., pp. 815–823).
Burlington, MA: Jones and Bartlett Learning.
Beck, D. E. (2007). Spiral dynamics integral. Retrieved
July 20, 2007, from http://www.spiraldynamics.net
Beck, D. M., Dossey, B. M., & Rushton, C. H. (2011).
Integral nursing and the Nightingale Initiative for
Global Health. Journal of Integral Theory and Practice
6(4), 71–92.
Burkhardt, M. A., & Najai-Jacobson, M. G. (2013). Spiri-
tuality and healing. In B. M. Dossey & L. Keegan
(Eds.), Holistic nursing: A handbook for practice
(6th ed., 721–740). Sudbury, MA: Jones and
Bartlett Learning.
Carper, B. A. (1978). Fundamental patterns of knowing
in nursing. Advances in Nursing Science, 1(1), 13–23.
Chinn, P. L., & Kramer, M. K. (2010). Theory and nurs-
ing: Integrated knowledge development (8th ed.).
St. Louis, MO: Elsevier/Mosby.
Clark, C. S. (2006). An integral nursing education:
Exploration of the Wilber quadrant model. Interna-
tional Journal of Human Caring, 10(3), 22–29.
Cowling, W. R. (2004). Pattern, participation, praxis,
and power in unitary appreciative inquiry. Advances
in Nursing Science, 27(3), 202–214.
Cowling, W. R., & Repede, E. (2010). Unitary appre-
ciative inquiry: Evolution and refinement Advances in
Nursing Science 33(1), 64–77.
Dossey, B. M. (2008). Theory of integral nursing.
Advances in Nursing Science, 31(1), E52–73.
Dossey, B. M. (2010). Florence Nightingale: Mystic,
visionary, healer (commemorative ed.). Philadelphia:
F. A. Davis.
Dossey, B. M. (2013). Nursing: Integral, integrative,
holistic—Local to global. In: B. M. Dossey &
L. Keegan (Eds.), Holistic nursing: A handbook for
practice (6th ed., pp. 3–57). Burlington, MA: Jones
and Bartlett Learning.
Dossey, B. M., Beck, D. M., & Rushton, C. H. (2008).
Nightingale’s vision for collaboration. In: S. Wein-
stein & A. M. Brooks (Eds.), Nursing without bor-
ders: Values, wisdom and success markers. Indianapolis,
IN: Sigma Theta Tau.
Dossey, B. M., Beck, D. M., & Rushton, C. H. (2013).
Global activism, advocacy and transformation:
Florence Nightingale’s legacy for the 21st century.
In M. J. Kreitzer & M. Koithan (Eds.), Integrative
nursing. New York: Oxford Press.
Dossey, B. M., Luck, S., & Schaub, B. G. (2015). Nurse
Coaching: Integrative approaches for health and wellbeing.
North Miami, FL: International Nurse Coach
Association.
Dossey, B. M., Selanders, L. C., Beck, D. M., & At-
tewell, A. (2005). Florence Nightingale today: Healing,
leadership, global action. Washington, DC: American
Nurses Association.
Dossey, L. (1989). Recovering the soul: A scientific and
spiritual search. New York: Bantam.
Dossey, L. (2003). Samueli conference on definitions
and standards in healing research: Working defini-
tions and terms. Alternative Therapies in Health and
Medicine, 9(3), A11.
Dossey, L. (2013). One mind: How our individual mind is
part of a greater mind, and why it matters. Carlsbad,
CA: Hay House International.
Engebretson, E. (1998). A heterodox model of healing.
Alternative Therapy in Health and Medicine, 4(2), 37–43.
Esbjorn-Hargens, S. (2006). Integral research: A multi-
method approach to investigating phenomena.
Constructivism in the Human Sciences, 11(1), 79–107.
Fawcett, J., Watson, J., Neuman, B., Walker, P. H., &
Fitzpatirck, J. J. (2001). On nursing theories and
evidence. Journal of Nursing Scholarship, 33(2),
115–119. ff102–105.
Fiandt, K., Forman, J., Megel, M. E., Pakieser, R. A.,
& Burge, S. (2003). Integral nursing: An emerging
framework for engaging the evolution of the profes-
sion. Nursing Outlook, 51(3), 130–137.
Frisch, N. C. (2013). Nursing theory in holistic nursing
practice. In: B. Dossey & L. Keegan (Eds.), Holistic
nursing: A handbook for practice (6th ed., p. 126).
Burlington, MA: Jones and Bartlett Learning.
Gaydos, H. L. (2004). The co-creative aesthetic process:
A new model for aesthetics in nursing. International
Journal of Human Caring, 7, 40–43.
Gaydos, H. L. (2005). The experience of immobility due
to trauma. Holistic Nursing Practice, 19(1), 40–43.
Gostin, L. O. (2007). Meeting the survival needs of the
world’s least healthy people. JAMA, 298(2), 225–227.
Halifax, J., Dossey, B. M., & Rushton, C. H. (2007).
Being with dying: Compassionate end-of-life care.
Santa Fe, NM: Prajna Mountain Press.
Harvey, A. (2007). Sacred activism. Retrieved July 18,
2007, from http://www.andrewharvey.net/sacred_
activism.html
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 231
232 SECTION III • Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the Integrative-Interactive Paradigm
Hess, D. R. (2013). Curriculum for an RN-to-BSN
program using the theory of integral nursing. In B. M.
Dossey & L. Keegan (Eds.), Holistic nursing: A
handbook for practice (6th ed., pp. 45–51). Burlington,
MA: Jones and Bartlett Learning.
Hess, D. R., Dossey, B. M., Southard, M. E., Luck, S.,
Schaub, B. G., & Bark, L. (2013). The art and science
of nurse coaching: The provider’s guide to coaching scope
and competencies. Silver Spring, MD: American
Nurses Association.
Integrative Nurse Coach Certificate Program. Retrieved
February 1, 2013, from http://www.inursecoach .com.
International Council of Nurses. (2004). The global
shortage of registered nurses: An overview of issues and
action. Geneva: International Council of Nurses.
Retrieved April 1, 2007, from http://www.icn.ch/
global/shortage
Jarrín, O. F. (2007). An integral philosophy and defini-
tion of nursing. AQAL: Journal of Integral Theory and
Practice, 2(4), 79–101.
Jung, C. G. (1981). The archetypes and the collective uncon-
scious (2nd ed., vol. 9, part I). Princeton, NJ: Bollingen.
Karph, J. T., Ferguson, R., & Swift R. (2010). Light still
shines in the darkness: Decent care for all. Journal of
Holistic Nursing 28(4), 266–274.
Karpf, T., Swift, R., Ferguson, T., & Lazarus, J. (2008).
Restoring hope: Decent care in the midst of HIV/AIDS.
London: Palgrave MacMillan Press and World
Health Organization.
Koerner, J. G. (2011). Nursing presence: The essence of
nursing (2nd ed.). New York: Springer.
Koloroutis, M. (Ed.). (2004). Relationship-based care: A
model for transforming practice. Minneapolis, MN:
Creative Health Care Management.
Levin, J. D., & Reich, J. L. (2013). Self-reflection. In
B. M. Dossey & L. Keegan (Eds.), Holistic nursing:
A handbook for practice (6th ed., 247–259). Burlington,
MA: Jones and Bartlett Learning.
McDonald, L. (2001-2012). The collected works of Florence
Nightingale (volumes 1–16) Waterloo, Canada:
Wilfred Laurier University Press.
McElligott, D. (2008). Self-care. In B. M. Dossey &
L. Keegan (Eds.), Holistic nursing: A handbook for
practice (6th ed., pp. 827–842). Burlington, MA:
Jones & Bartlett Learning.
McKivergin, M. (2008). Nurse as an instrument of heal-
ing. In B. M. Dossey & L. Keegan (Eds.), Holistic
nursing: A handbook for practice (5th ed.). Burlington,
MA: Jones and Bartlett Learning.
Meleis, A. L. (2012). Theoretical nursing: Development
and progress (5th. ed.). Philadelphia: Lippincott
Williams & Wilkins.
Mittelman, M., S. Y. Alperson, S. Y, Arcari, P. M.,
Donnelly, G. F., Ford, L. C., Koithan, M., &
Kreitzer, M. J. (2010). Nursing and integrative
health care. Alternative Therapies in Health and
Medicine 16(5), 84–94.
Munhall, P. L. (1993). Unknowing: Toward another
pattern of knowing in nursing. Nursing Outlook,
41(3), 125–128.
National Prevention Council. (2011, June 16). National
prevention strategy: American’s plan for better health
and wellness. Retrieved from www.surgeongeneral.
gov/initiatives/prevention/strategy/report
Newman, M. A. (2003). A world of no boundaries.
Advances in Nursing Science, 26(4), 240–245.
Nightingale, F. Letter to Sir Frederick Verney. 23
November 1892, Add. Mss. 68887.
Nightingale Initiative for Global Health. (2013).
Nightingale declaration. Retrieved January 1, 2013,
from www.nightingaledeclaration.net
Perdue, J. S. (2011). Integration of complementary and
alternative therapies in an acute rehabilitation hospital,
a readiness assessment. Unpublished doctoral disserta-
tion, Western University of Health Sciences,
Pomona, CA.
Quinn, J. F., Smith, M., Rittenbaugh, C., Swanson, K.,
& Watson, J. (2003). Research guidelines for assess-
ing the impact of the healing relationship in clinical
nursing. Alternative Therapies in Health and Medicine,
9(3), A65–A79.
Samueli Institute. (2013). Optimal healing environ-
ments:Your healing journey. Alexandria, VA: Samueli
Institute. Retrieved from http://www.samueliinsti-
tute.org/File%20Library/Health%20Policy/
YourHealingJourney
Tresoli, C. (1994). Pew-Fetzer Task Force on Advancing
Psychosocial Health Education: Health professions edu-
cation and relationship-centered care. San Francisco:
Commission at the Center for the Health Profes-
sions, University of California.
United Nations. (2000). United Nations Millennium
Development Goals. Retrieved July 20, 2007, from
www.un.org/millenniumgoals
Watson, J. (2005). Caring science as sacred science.
Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Weil, A. R. (Ed.). (2013, February). A new era of
patient engagement. Health Affairs, 32(2).
White, J. (1995). Patterns of knowing: Review, critique,
and update. Advances in Nursing Science 17(4), 73–86.
Wilber, K. (1999). The collected works of Ken Wilber
(vols. 1–4). Boston: Shambhala.
Wilber, K. (2000a). The collected works of Ken Wilber
(vols. 5–8). Boston: Shambhala.
Wilber, K. (2000b). Integral psychology. Boston:
Shambhala.
Wilber, K. (2005a). Integral operating system. Louisville,
CO: Sounds True.
Wilber, K. (2005b). Integral life practice. Denver, CO:
Integral Institute.
Wilber, K. (2006). Integral spirituality. Boston:
Shambhala.
World Health Organization. World Health Organization
Statistics Report 2009. Global Standards for the
Initial Education of Professional Nurses and Midwives.
http://www.who.int/hrh/nursing_midwifery/
hrh_global_standards_education . (Accessed
December 18, 2014).
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 232
CHAPTER 13 • Barbara Dossey’s Theory of Integral Nursing 233
World Health Organization (WHO). Primary care.
Retrieved from http://www.paho.org/English/DD/
PIN/ptoday12_nov05.htm (Accessed July 20, 2007).
Zahourek, R. (2004). Intentionality forms the matrix of
healing: A theory. Alternative Therapies in Health and
Medicine, 10(6), 40–49.
Zahourek, R. (2013). Holistic nursing research:
Challenges and opportunities. In B. M. Dossey &
L. Keegan (Eds.), Holistic nursing: A handbook for
practice (6th ed., pp. 775–794). Burlington, MA:
Jones and Bartlett.
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 233
3312_Ch13_207-234 26/12/14 5:53 PM Page 234
Section IV
Conceptual Models and Grand
Theories in the Unitary–
Transformative Paradigm
235
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 235
236
There are three grand theories clustered in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm.
In this paradigm, the human being and environment are conceptualized as irre-
ducible fields, open with the environment. The person and environment are
continuously changing and evolving through mutual patterning.
In Chapter 14, Rogers’ science of unitary human beings (SUHB) is explicated
by Howard Butcher and Violet Malinski. The SUHB is based on the premise that
humans and environments are patterned, pandimensional energy fields in contin-
uous mutual process with each other. Persons participate in their well-being, which
is relative and personally defined. Several theories, research traditions, and prac-
tice traditions have evolved from this conceptual system. While Parse has recently
called humanbecoming a paradigm rather than a school of thought, the editors
continue to situate humanbecoming within the Unitary-Transformative Paradigm.
Humanbecoming is featured in Chapter 15, written by the theorist herself. Human-
becoming is defined as a basic human science that has cocreated human expe-
riences as its central focus. Humanbecoming portends a view that unitary human
beings are expert in their own health and lives. For Parse, human beings choose
meanings that reflect value priorities cocreated in transcending with the possibles.
Humanbecoming has well-developed research and practice methods that guide
the inquiry and practice of nurses embracing it.
Newman’s theory of health as expanding consciousness (HEC) is explicated
in Chapter 17 by Margaret Dexheimer Pharris. According to HEC, health is an
evolving unitary pattern of the whole, including patterns of disease. Conscious-
ness, or the informational capacity of the whole, is revealed in the evolving
pattern. Pattern identifies the human–environmental process and is characterized
by meaning. Concepts important to nursing practice include expanding conscious-
ness, time, presence, resonating with the whole, pattern, meaning, insights as
choice points, and the mutuality of the nurse–patient relationship. These concepts
are reflected in the praxis method developed to guide practice-research.
Section
IV Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the
Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
236
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 236
Chapter 14Martha E. Rogers Science of
Unitary Human Beings
HOWARD KARL BUTCHER AND
VIOLET M. MALINSKI
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of Rogers’ Science of Unitary
Human Beings
Applications of the Conceptual System
Practice Exemplar
Summary
References
Martha E. Rogers
237
Introducing the Theorist
Martha E. Rogers, one of nursing’s foremost
scientists, was a staunch advocate for nursing
as a basic science from which the art of practice
would emerge. A common refrain throughout
her career was the need to differentiate skills,
techniques, and ways of using knowledge from
the actual body of knowledge needed to guide
practice to promote well-being for humankind.
Rogers identified the human–environmental
mutual process as nursing’s central focus, not
health and illness. She repeatedly emphasized
the need for nursing science to encompass
human beings in space and on Earth. Who
was this visionary who introduced a new
worldview to nursing?
Martha Elizabeth Rogers was born in Dallas,
Texas, on May 12, 1914, a birthday she shared
with Florence Nightingale. Her parents soon re-
turned home to Knoxville, Tennessee, where
Martha and her three siblings grew up. Rogers
spent 2 years at the University of Tennessee in
Knoxville before entering the nursing program
at Knoxville General Hospital. She then at-
tended George Peabody College in Nashville,
Tennessee, where she earned her bachelor of sci-
ence degree in public health nursing, choosing
that field as her professional focus. Rogers spent
the next 13 years in rural public health nursing
in Michigan, Connecticut, and Arizona, where
she established the first visiting nurse service
in Phoenix, serving as its executive director
(Hektor, 1989/1994). In 1945, recognizing the
need for advanced education, she earned a mas-
ter’s degree in nursing from Teachers College,
Columbia University, in the program developed
by another nurse theorist, Hildegard Peplau. In
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 237
1951, she left public health nursing in Phoenix
to return to academia, this time earning both
a master’s of public health and a doctor of sci-
ence degree from Johns Hopkins University in
Baltimore, Maryland.
In 1954, after her graduation from Johns
Hopkins, Rogers was appointed head of the
Division of Nursing at New York University
(NYU), beginning the second phase of her ca-
reer overseeing baccalaureate, master’s, and doc-
toral programs in nursing and developing the
nursing science she knew was integral to the
knowledge base nurses needed. During the
1960s, she successfully shifted the focus of doc-
toral research from nurses and their functions
to humans in mutual process with the environ-
ment. She wrote three books that explicated her
ideas: Educational Revolution in Nursing (1961),
Reveille in Nursing (1964), and the landmark An
Introduction to the Theoretical Basis of Nursing
(1970). From 1963 to 1965, she edited Nursing
Science, a journal that was far ahead of its time;
it offered content on theory development and
the emerging science of nursing, as well as re-
search and issues in education and practice.
Rogers died in 1994, leaving a rich legacy
in her writings on nursing science, the space
age, research, education, and professional and
political issues in nursing.
Overview of Rogers’ Science
of Unitary Human Beings
The historical evolution of the Science of
Unitary Human Beings has been described by
Malinski and Barrett (1994). This chapter
presents the science in its current form and
identifies work in progress to expand it further.
Rogers’ Worldview
Rogers (1992) articulated a new worldview in
nursing, one that was commensurate with new
knowledge emerging across disciplines, which
rooted nursing science in “a pandimensional
view of people and their world” (p. 28). Rogers
(1992) described the evolution from older
to newer worldviews in such shifting perspec-
tives as cell theory to field theory, entropic to
negentropic universe, three-dimensional to
pandimensional, person–environment as di-
chotomous to person–environment as integral,
causation and adaptation to mutual process,
dynamic equilibrium to innovative growing
diversity, homeostasis to homeodynamics,
waking as a basic state to waking as an evolu-
tionary emergent, and closed to open systems.
She pointed out that in a universe of open sys-
tems, energy fields are continuously open,
infinite, and integral with one another. A view
of change as predictable, or even probabilistic,
yields to change as diverse, creative, innovative,
and unpredictable.
Rogers (1994a) identified the unique focus
of nursing as “the irreducible human being and
its environment, both defined as energy fields”
(p. 33). “Human” encompasses both Homo
sapiens and Homo spatialis, the evolutionary
transcendence of humankind as we voyage into
space; environment encompasses outer space,
the cosmos itself.
Rogers was aware that the world looks very
different from the vantage point of this newer
view as contrasted with the older, traditional
worldview. She pointed out that we are already
living in a new reality, one that is “a synthesis of
rapidly evolving, accelerating ways of using
knowledge” (Rogers, 1994a, p. 33), even if peo-
ple are not always fully aware that these shifts
have occurred or are in process. She urged that
nurses be visionary, looking forward and not
backward and not allowing themselves to be-
come “stuck” in the present, in the details of how
things are now, but envision how they might be
in a universe where continuous change is the
only given. Rogers (1994b) cautioned that al-
though traditional modalities of practice and
methods of research serve a purpose, they are in-
adequate for the newer worldview, which urges
nurses to use the knowledge base of Rogerian
nursing science creatively to develop innovative
new modalities and research approaches that
would promote the betterment of humankind.
Postulates of Rogerian Nursing Science
Rogers (1992) identified four fundamental pos-
tulates that form the basis of the new reality:
• Energy fields
• Openness
238 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 238
• Pattern
• Pandimensionality (formerly called both four-
dimensionality and multidimensionality)
Rogers (1990) defined the energy field as
“the fundamental unit of the living and the
non-living,” noting that it is dynamic, infi-
nite, and continuously moving (p. 7). Although
Rogers did not define energy per se, Todaro-
Franceschi’s (1999) wide-ranging philosophical
study of the enigma of energy sheds light on a
Rogerian conceptualization of energy. She
highlighted the communal, transformative na-
ture of energy, noting that energy is everywhere
and is always changing and actualizing poten-
tials. Energy transformation is the basis of all
that is, both in living and dying.
Rogers identified two energy fields of con-
cern to nurses, which are distinct but not sepa-
rate: the human field and the environmental
field. The human field can be conceptualized
as person, group, family, or community. The
human and environmental fields are irreducible;
they cannot be broken down into component
parts or subsystems. For example, the unitary
human is neither understood nor described as a
bio–psycho–sociocultural or body–mind–spirit
entity. Instead, she maintained that each field,
human and environmental, is identified by
pattern, defined as “the distinguishing charac-
teristic of an energy field perceived as a single
wave” (Rogers, 1990, p. 7). Pattern manifesta-
tions and characteristics are specific to the
whole, the unitary human–environment in mu-
tual process. Change occurs simultaneously for
human and environment.
The fields are pandimensional, defined as “a
non-linear domain without spatial or temporal
attributes” (Rogers, 1992, p. 29). Pandimen-
sional reality transcends traditional notions of
space and time, which can be understood as
perceived boundaries only. Examples of pandi-
mensionality include phenomena commonly
labeled “paranormal” that are, in Rogerian
nursing science, manifestations of the chang-
ing diversity of field patterning and examples
of pandimensional awareness.
The postulate of openness resonates
throughout the preceding discussion. In an
open universe, there are no boundaries other
than perceptual ones. Therefore, human and
environment are not separated by boundaries.
The energy of each flows continuously through
the other in an unbroken wave. Rogers repeat-
edly emphasized that person and environment
are themselves energy fields; they do not have
energy fields, such as auras, surrounding them.
In an open universe, there are multiple poten-
tials and possibilities. People experience their
world in multiple ways, evidenced by the di-
verse manifestations of field patterning that
continuously emerge.
Rogers (1992, 1994a) described pattern as
changing continuously while giving identity
to each unique human–environmental field
process. Although pattern is an abstraction,
not something that can be observed directly,
“it reveals itself through its manifestations”
(Rogers, 1992, p. 29). Individual characteris-
tics of a particular person are not characteris-
tics of field patterning. Pattern manifestations
reflect the human–environmental field mutual
process as a unitary, irreducible whole. They
reveal innovative diversity flowing in lower and
higher frequency rhythms within the human–
environmental mutual field process. Rogers
identified some of these manifestations as
lesser and greater diversity; longer, shorter, and
seemingly continuous rhythms; slower, faster,
and seemingly continuous motion; time expe-
rienced as slower, faster, and timeless; prag-
matic, imaginative, and visionary; and longer
sleeping, longer waking, and beyond waking.
Beyond waking refers to emergent experiences
and perceptions such as hyperawareness, uni-
tive experiences attained in meditation, precog-
nition, déjà vu, intuition, tacit knowing, mystical
experiences, clairvoyance, and telepathy. She
explained “seems continuous” as “a wave
frequency so rapid that the observer perceives
it as a single, unbroken event” (Rogers, 1990,
p. 10). This view of the ongoing process of
change is captured in Rogers’ principles of
homeodynamics.
Principles of Homeodynamics
Homeodynamics conveys the dynamic, ever-
changing nature of life and the world. Her
three principles of homeodynamics—resonancy,
CHAPTER 14 • Martha E. Rogers’s Science of Unitary Human Beings 239
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 239
helicy, and integrality—describe the nature and
process of change in the human–environmental
field process.
Resonancy is “the continuous change from
lower to higher frequency wave patterns in
human and environmental fields” (Rogers,
1992, p. 31). Although she verbalized the need
to delete the “from–to” language, which seems
to imply linearity and directionality, Rogers
never actually deleted it in print. However, it
is important to remember that this process is
nonlinear and nondirectional because in a
pandimensional universe there is no space and
no time (Phillips, 2010a). Resonancy specifies
the nonlinear, continuous flow of lower and
higher frequency wave patterning in the
human–environmental field process, the way
change occurs.
Both lower and higher frequency aware-
ness and experiencing are essential to the
wholeness of rhythmical patterning. As Phillips
(1994, p. 15) described it, “[W]e may find that
growing diversity of pattern is related to a
dialectic of low frequency–high frequency,
similar to that of order–disorder in chaos the-
ory. When the rhythmicities of lower-higher
frequencies work together, they yield innova-
tive, diverse patterns.”
Helicy is “the continuous, innovative, un-
predictable, increasing diversity of human and
environmental field patterns (Rogers, 1992,
p. 31). It describes the creative and diverse na-
ture of ongoing change in field patterning, a
“diversity of pattern that is innovative, creative,
and unpredictable” (Phillips, 2010a, p. 57).
Integrality is “continuous mutual human
field and environmental field process” (Rogers,
1992, p. 31). It specifies the process of change
within the integral human–environmental field
process where person and environment are
unitary, thus inseparable.
Together the principles suggest that the
mutual patterning process of human and
environmental fields changes continuously,
innovatively, and unpredictably, flowing in
lower and higher frequencies. Rogers (1990,
p. 9) believed that they serve as guides both to
the practice of nursing and to research in the
science of nursing.
Theories Derived From the Science
of Unitary Human Beings
Rogers clearly stated her belief that multiple the-
ories can be derived from the science of unitary
human beings. They are specific to nursing and
reflect not what nurses do but an understanding
of people and our world (Rogers, 1992). Nursing
education is identified by transmission of this
theoretical knowledge, and nursing practice is
the creative use of this knowledge. “Research is
done in relation to the theories” (Rogers, 1994a,
p. 34) to illuminate the nature of the human–
environmental field change process and its many
unpredictable potentials.
Theory of Accelerating Change
Rogers derived the theory of accelerating
change, formerly known as the theory of ac-
celerating evolution, to illustrate that the only
“norm” is accelerating change. Higher fre-
quency field patterns that manifest growing
diversity open the door to wider ranges of ex-
periences and behaviors, calling into question
the very idea of “norms” as guidelines. Human
and environmental field rhythms are acceler-
ating. We experience faster environmental
motion now than ever before. It is common for
people to experience time as rapidly speeding
by. People are living longer. Rather than view-
ing aging as a process of decline or as “running
down,” as in an entropic worldview, this theory
views aging as a creative process in which field
patterns show increasing diversity in such
manifestations as sleeping, waking, and
dreaming. “[I]n fact, as evolutionary diversity
continues to accelerate, the range and variety
of differences between individuals also in-
crease; the more diverse field patterns evolve
more rapidly than the less diverse ones”
(Rogers, 1992, p. 30).
The theory of accelerating change provides
the basis for reconceptualizing the aging
process. Rogers (1970, 1980) used the principle
of helicy and the theory of accelerating change
to put forward the notion that aging is a con-
tinuously creative process of growing diversity
of field patterning. Therefore, aging is not a
process of decline or running down. Rather,
240 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 240
field patterns become increasingly diverse as we
age as older adults need less sleep; are more sat-
isfied with personal relationships; are better
able to handle their emotions; are better able
to cope with stress; and have increasing crys-
tallized intelligence, wisdom, and improved
problem-solving abilities (Whitbourne &
Whitbourne, 2011). Butcher (2003) expanded
on Rogers “negentropic” view of aging in out-
lining key elements for a “unitary model of
aging as emerging brilliance” that includes re-
placing ageist stereotypes with new positive im-
ages of aging and developing policies, lifestyles,
and technologies that enhance successful aging
and longevity. Within a unitary view of aging,
later life becomes a potential for growth, “a life
imbued with splendor, meaning, accomplish-
ment, active involvement, growth, adventure,
wisdom, experience, compassion, glory, and
brilliance” (Butcher, 2003, p. 64).
Theory of Emergence of Paranormal
Phenomena
Another theory derived by Rogers is the emer-
gence of paranormal phenomena, in which she
suggests that experiences commonly labeled
“paranormal” are actually manifestations of
changing diversity and innovation of field pat-
terning. They are pandimensional forms of
awareness, examples of pandimensional reality
that manifest visionary, beyond waking poten-
tials. Meditation, for example, transcends tra-
ditionally perceived limitations of time and
space, opening the door to new and creative
potentials. Therapeutic Touch provides another
example of such pandimensional awareness.
Both participants often share similar experi-
ences during Therapeutic Touch, such as a
visualization of common features that evolves
spontaneously for both, a shared experience
arising within the mutual process both are ex-
periencing, with neither able to lay claim to it
as a personal, private experience.
The idea of a pandimensional or nonlinear
domain provides a framework for understand-
ing paranormal phenomena. A nonlinear
domain unconstrained by space and time pro-
vides an explanation of seemingly inexplicable
events and processes. Rogers (1992) asserted
that within the science of unitary human be-
ings, psychic phenomena become “normal”
rather than “paranormal.” Dean Radin, direc-
tor of the Conscious Research Laboratory at
the University of Nevada in Las Vegas, sug-
gests that an understanding of nonlocal con-
nections along with the relationship between
awareness and quantum effects provides a
framework for understanding paranormal phe-
nomena (Radin, 1997). “Deep interconnect-
edness” demonstrated by Bell’s Theorem
embraces the interconnectedness of everything
unbounded by space and time. In addition, the
work of L. Dossey (1993, 1999), Nadeau and
Kafatos (1999), Sheldrake (1988), and Talbot
(1991) explicate the role of nonlocality in evo-
lution, physics, cosmology, consciousness,
paranormal phenomena, healing, and prayer.
Tart (2009), in his excellent text The End of
Materialism: How Evidence of the Paranormal
Is Bringing Science and Spirit Together, reviews
the research supporting common paranormal
experiences with separate chapters on telepa-
thy, clairvoyance/remote viewing, precognition,
psychokinesis, psychic healing, out-of-body
experiences, near-death experiences, post-
mortem survival, and mystical experiences.
Murphy (1992) in his highly referenced and
researched text presents the evidence support-
ing what he refers to as emergent extraordinary
human abilities such as placebo effects, para-
normal experiences, spiritual healing, medita-
tive, mystical, and contemplative practices on
health and healing. The relevance of these ex-
periences and practices to nursing is in the
number that occur in health-related contexts,
and Rogers’s nursing science provides a theo-
retical and scientific understanding that
accounts for the occurrence of paranormal ex-
periences.
Within a nonlinear–nonlocal context, para-
normal events are our experience of the deep
nonlocal interconnections that bind the uni-
verse together. Existence and knowing are
locally and nonlocally linked through deep
connections of awareness, intentionality, and
interpretation. Pandimensionality embraces
the infinite nature of the universe in all its di-
mensions and includes processes of being more
CHAPTER 14 • Martha E. Rogers’s Science of Unitary Human Beings 241
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 241
aware of naturally occurring changing energy
patterns. Pandimensionality also includes
intentionally participating in mutual process
with a nonlinear–nonlocal potential of creating
new energy patterns. Distance healing, the
healing power of prayer, Therapeutic Touch,
out-of-body experiences, phantom pain, pre-
cognition, déjà vu, intuition, tacit knowing,
mystical experiences, clairvoyance, and tele-
pathic experiences are a few of the energy field
manifestations patients and nurses experience
that can be better understood as natural events
in a pandimensional universe characterized
by nonlinear–nonlocal human–environmental
field integrality propagated by increased
awareness and intentionality.
Manifestations of Field Patterning
Rogers’ third theory, rhythmical correlates of
change, was changed to manifestations of field
patterning in unitary human beings, discussed
earlier. Here Rogers suggested that evolution is
an irreducible, nonlinear process characterized
by increasing diversity of field patterning. She
offered some manifestations of this relative di-
versity, including the rhythms of motion, time
experience, and sleeping–waking, encouraging
others to suggest further examples. In addition
to the theories that Rogers derived, a number
of others have been developed by Rogerian
scholars that are useful in informing Rogerian
pattern–based practice and research. The first
such theory to be developed was Barrett’s (1989,
2010) theory of power as knowing participation
in change, described in Chapter 29.
Butcher’s (1993) theory of kaleidoscoping in
life’s turbulence is an example of a theory de-
rived from Rogers’ science of unitary human be-
ings, chaos theory (Briggs & Peat, 1989; Peat,
1991), and Csikszentmihalyi’s (1990) theory of
flow. It focuses on facilitating well-being and
harmony amid turbulent life events. Turbulence
is a dissonant commotion in the human–envi-
ronmental field characterized by chaotic and
unpredictable change. Any crisis may be viewed
as a turbulent event in the life process. Nurses
often work closely with clients who are in a “cri-
sis.” Turbulent life events are often chaotic in
nature, unpredictable, and always transforma-
tive. The theory of kaleidoscoping in life’s
turbulence is described in more detail in the
Bonus content for the chapter.1
Other theories derived from Rogers’s nurs-
ing science include Reed’s (1991, 2003; see
Chapter 23 in this volume) theory of self-
transcendence, the theory of enfolding health-
as-wholeness-and-harmony (Carboni, 1995a),
Bultemeier’s (1997) theory of perceived disso-
nance, the theory of enlightenment (Hills &
Hanchett, 2001), Alligood and McGuire’s
theory of aging (2000), Butcher’s theory of
aging as emerging brilliance (2003), and
Zahourek’s (2004, 2005) theory of intention-
ality in healing.
Applications of the Conceptual
System
New worldviews require new ways of thinking,
sciencing, languaging, and practicing. Rogers’s
nursing science postulates a pandimensional
universe of human–environmental energy fields
manifesting as continuously innovative, increas-
ingly diverse, creative, and unpredictable unitary
field patterns. The principles of homeodynamics
provide a way to understand the process of
human–environmental change, paving the way
for Rogerian theory–based practice. Rogers
often reminded us that unitary means whole.
Therefore, people are always whole, regardless
of what they are experiencing in the moment,
and therefore do not need nurses to facilitate
their wholeness. Rogers identified noninvasive
modalities as the basis for nursing practice now
and in the future. She stated that nurses must
use “nursing knowledge in non-invasive ways in
a direct effort to promote well-being” (Rogers,
1994a, p. 34). This focus gives nurses a central
role in health care rather than medical care. She
also noted that health services should be com-
munity based, not hospital based. Hospitals are
properly used to provide satellite services in spe-
cific instances of illness and trauma; they do not
provide health services. Rogers urged nurses to
develop autonomous, community-based nurs-
ing centers. See Boxes 14-1 and 14-2.
242 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
1 For additional information please go to bonus chapter
content available at FA Davis http://davisplus.fadavis.com
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 242
For example, Todaro-Franceschi (2006) iden-
tified the existence of synchronicity experi-
ences, meaningful coincidences, in many who
were grieving the loss of a spouse, a pioneering
effort in delineating a unitary view of death and
dying. From the results of her qualitative study,
she described how such experiences help the
bereaved to relate to their deceased loved ones
in a new, meaningful way, one that is poten-
tially healing, rather than in the traditional view
of learning to let go and move on. Malinski
(2012) conceptualized the unitary rhythm of
dying–grieving, highlighting the shared nature
of this process, for the one grieving is also dying
a little just as the one dying is simultaneously
grieving. She synthesized this unitary rhythm
as “a process of kaleidoscopic patterning flow-
ing now swiftly now gently, spiraling creatively
through shifting rhythms of now-elsewhen-
elsewhere, becoming in solitude and silence
alone-all one, timeless-boundaryless” (p. 242).
Pandimensional awareness and experience of
this rhythm means recognition that there is no
space or time, no boundary or separation. The
reality is one of unity amid changing configu-
rations of patterning, with endless potentials.
Unfortunately, a number of ideas relevant
to nursing practice that Rogers discussed ver-
bally never made it into print, for example,
healing, intentionality, and expanded views on
Therapeutic Touch. In three audiotaped and
transcribed dialogues among Rogers, Malinski,
and Meehan on January 26, 1988, for example,
she described healing as a process, everything
that happens as persons actualize potentials
they identify as enhancing health and wellness
for themselves. Todaro-Franceschi (1999)
described healing in a similar way, with nurses
knowingly participating in the healing process
by helping people actualize “their unique
potentials—whatever those potentials may be”
(p. 104). Cowling (2001) described healing as
appreciating wholeness, offering unitary pattern
appreciation as the praxis for exploring whole-
ness within the unitary human–environmental
mutual process.
Rogers also reminded us that change is a
neutral process, neither good nor bad, one that
we cannot direct but in which we participate.
In this vein, in the transcribed dialogue among
CHAPTER 14 • Martha E. Rogers’s Science of Unitary Human Beings 243
Box 14-1 Nursing Practice Evolves (Update 1/2013)
The relevance of Rogerian nursing science
to both human well-being and nursing is
precisely the transformative vision of people
and the world that it offers. Recognizing this,
the nursing department at Bronx Lebanon
Hospital Center, Bronx, New York, has made
the decision to use Rogerian nursing science as
the framework for practice throughout the
hospital. People are complex, society is chang-
ing, and nursing’s image is changing and so is
our practice, which is driven by the science of
nursing, according to Dr. Jeanine M. Frumenti,
Vice President, Patient Care Services/Chief
Nursing Officer. Rogerian nursing science was
chosen because it is inclusive and reflective of
people’s ever-changing relationship to their
environment, whereas many other nursing
theories are reflective of the art of nursing.
According to Frumenti, nurses need to be
open to unfolding pattern and pandimensional
experiences; everything is integrated and
changing. The Rogerian nursing science
assists Bronx Lebanon nurses in actualizing
transformative practice for themselves and
their clients.
Box 14-2 Rogerian Nursing Science Wiki (http://rogeriannursingscience.wikispaces.com)
In 2008, Howard Butcher launched a wiki
site on Rogerian science with the purpose of
providing a website to gather Rogerian schol-
ars so they can mutually cocreate a compre-
hensive and easily accessible and in-depth
explication of the science of unitary human
beings. The wiki can be viewed by anyone and
is organized like a textbook with chapters on
the following: Rogers’ life, the aim of nursing
science, Rogerian cosmology and philosophy,
Rogers’ postulates, Rogerian science, Rogerian
theories, practice methods, and research
methods. There are links of all the issues of
Visions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing Science
as well as photos. The wiki is not complete;
it is ever evolving. However, it is a valuable
resource to all interested in learning more
about the science of unitary human beings.
Rogers (1986) identified the living–dying
process as one characterized by rhythmical
patterning, opening the door to new ways of
studying and working with the dying process.
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 243
Rogers, Malinski, and Meehan on Therapeutic
Touch, Rogers described this modality as a
neutral process, one that facilitates the pattern-
ing most commensurate with well-being for
the person, whatever that is. There is no ex-
change of energy, no identification of desired
outcomes in Therapeutic Touch. Rather than
intentionality, Rogers suggested knowing par-
ticipation as most congruent with her think-
ing, seeing intentionality as too closely tied to
will and intent. However, she did suggest that
a unitary view of intentionality was worthy
of study.
Rogers also questioned the concept of spir-
ituality, which she saw as too often confused
with religiosity. Smith (1994) and Malinski
(1991, 1994) have both explored a Rogerian
view of spirituality. Barrett (2010) suggested
that the interrelationships of pandimensional-
ity, consciousness, and spirituality will become
clearer and increasingly important. She defined
consciousness “as the Spirit in all that is, was,
and will be” and spirituality “as experiencing the
Spirit in all that is, was, and will be” (italics in
the original; p. 53).
Phillips (2010b) created the terms ener-
gyspirit and Homo pandimensionalis to highlight
expanding “pandimensional relative present
awareness” (p. 8). In a discussion about the big
bang, he suggested that if energy is indeed uni-
tary, discussions of physical energy are not only
incomplete but inaccurate. Phillips speculated,
“What if the big bang was a cataclysm of spirit
integral with energy that was not separated into
physical and spirit, but made their presence as
a unitary whole. Then, we have a new phenom-
enon known as energyspirit, one word. This en-
ergyspirit was the origin of the universe and
human beings and all their changes” (p. 9). En-
ergyspirit thus replaces any discussion of mind-
bodyspirit. Already of no relevance to Rogerian
nursing science, perhaps mindbodyspirit can be
replaced now with energyspirit throughout the
unitary perspective. As pandimensional relative
present awareness is continuously changing, it
is possible that we will see the emergence of
new, unanticipated pattern manifestations
characterizing the human–environmental mu-
tual field process. Phillips suggests that this
emerging life form is Homo pandimensionalis.
Evolution of Rogerian Practice
Methods
A hallmark of a maturing scientific practice
discipline is the development of specific prac-
tice and research methods evolving from the
discipline’s extant conceptual systems. Rogers
(1992) asserted that practice and research
methods must be consistent with the science
of unitary human beings to study irreducible
human beings in mutual process with a pandi-
mensional universe. Therefore, Rogerian prac-
tice and research methods must be congruent
with Rogers’ postulates and principles if they
are to be consistent with Rogerian science.
The goal of nursing practice is the promotion
of well-being and human betterment. Nursing
is a service to people wherever they may reside.
Nursing practice—the art of nursing—is the
creative application of substantive scientific
knowledge developed through logical analysis,
synthesis, and research. Since the 1960s, the
nursing process has been the dominant nursing
practice method. The nursing process is an
appropriate practice methodology for many
nursing theories. However, there has been some
confusion in the nursing literature concerning
the use of the traditional nursing process within
Rogers’s nursing science.
In early writings, Rogers (1970) did make
reference to nursing process and nursing diag-
nosis. But in later years she asserted that nurs-
ing diagnoses were not consistent with her
scientific system. Rogers (quoted in Smith,
1988, p. 83) stated:
Nursing diagnosis is a static term that is quite inap-
propriate for a dynamic system. . . . it [nursing diag-
nosis] is an outdated part of an old worldview, and
I think by the turn of the century, there are going to
be new ways of organizing knowledge.
Furthermore, nursing diagnoses are particu-
laristic and reductionist labels describing cause
and effect (i.e., “related to”) relationships incon-
sistent with a “nonlinear domain without spatial
or temporal attributes” (Rogers, 1992, p. 29).
The nursing process is a stepwise sequential
process inconsistent with a nonlinear or pandi-
mensional view of reality. In addition, the term
244 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 244
intervention is not consistent with Rogerian
science. Intervention means to “come, appear,
or lie between two things” (American Heritage
Dictionary, 2000, p. 916). The principle of in-
tegrality describes the human and environ-
mental field as integral and in mutual process.
Energy fields are open, infinite, dynamic, and
constantly changing. The human and environ-
mental fields are inseparable, so one cannot
“come between.” The nurse and the client are
already inseparable and interconnected. Out-
comes are also inconsistent with Rogers’ prin-
ciple of helicy: expected outcomes infer
predictability. The principle of helicy describes
the nature of change as being unpredictable.
Within an energy-field perspective, nurses in
mutual process assist clients in actualizing their
field potentials by enhancing their ability to
participate knowingly in change. Given the in-
consistency of the traditional nursing process
with Rogers’ postulates and principles, the sci-
ence of unitary human beings requires the de-
velopment of new and innovative practice
methods derived from and consistent with the
conceptual system. A number of practice
methods have been derived from Rogers’s pos-
tulates and principles.
Barrett’s Rogerian Practice Method
Barrett’s Rogerian practice methodology for
health patterning was the first accepted alter-
native to the nursing process for Rogerian
practice (see Chapter 29). It was followed by
Cowling’s conceptualization.
Cowling’s Rogerian Practice
Cowling (1990) proposed a template compris-
ing 10 constituents for the development of
Rogerian practice models. Cowling (1993b,
1997) refined the template and proposed that
“pattern appreciation” was a method for uni-
tary knowing in both Rogerian nursing re-
search and practice. Cowling preferred the
term appreciation rather than assessment or ap-
praisal because appraisal is associated with
evaluation. Appreciation has broader meaning,
which includes “being fully aware or sensitive
to or realizing; being thankful or grateful for;
and enjoying or understanding critically or
emotionally” (Cowling, 1997, p. 130). Pattern
appreciation has a potential for deeper under-
standing. For a description of the constituents,
see Bonus content for the chapter.2
Unitary Pattern-Based Praxis Method
Butcher (1997a, 1999a, 2001) synthesized
Cowling’s Rogerian practice constituents with
Barrett’s practice method to develop a more
inclusive and comprehensive practice model.
In 2006, Butcher expanded the “praxis” model
by illustrating how the Rogerian cosmology,
ontology, epistemology, esthetics, ethics, pos-
tulates, principles, and theories all form an
“interconnected nexus” informing both Roger-
ian-based practice and research models
(Butcher, 2006a, p. 9). The unitary pattern–
based practice (Fig. 14-1) consists of two non-
linear and simultaneous processes: pattern
manifestation appreciation and knowing, and
voluntary mutual patterning. The focus of
nursing care guided by Rogers’s nursing
science is on pattern transformation by facili-
tating pattern recognition during pattern man-
ifestation knowing and appreciation and by
facilitating the client’s ability to participate
knowingly in change, harmonizing person–
environment integrality, and promoting heal-
ing potentialities and well-being through
voluntary mutual patterning
Pattern Manifestation Knowing and
Appreciation
Pattern manifestation knowing and apprecia-
tion is the process of identifying manifestations
of patterning emerging from the human–
environmental field mutual process and in-
volves focusing on the client’s experiences, per-
ceptions, and expressions. “Knowing” refers to
apprehending pattern manifestations (Barrett,
1988), whereas “appreciation” seeks a percep-
tion of the “full force of pattern” (Cowling,
1997). Pattern is the distinguishing feature of
the human–environmental field. Everything
experienced, perceived, and expressed is a
manifestation of patterning. During the
process of pattern manifestation knowing and
appreciation, the nurse and client are coequal
CHAPTER 14 • Martha E. Rogers’s Science of Unitary Human Beings 245
2 For additional information please go to bonus chapter
content available at FA Davis http://davisplus.fadavis.com
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 245
participants. In Rogerian practice, nursing sit-
uations are approached and guided by a set of
Rogerian-ethical values, a scientific base for
practice, and a commitment to enhance the
client’s desired potentialities for well-being.
Unitary pattern–based practice begins by
creating an atmosphere of openness and free-
dom so that clients can freely participate in the
process of knowing participation in change.
Approaching the nursing situation with an ap-
preciation of the uniqueness of each person
and with unconditional love, compassion, and
empathy can help create an atmosphere of
openness and healing patterning (Butcher,
2002; Malinski, 2004). Rogers (1966/1994)
defined nursing as a humanistic science dedi-
cated to compassionate concern for humans.
Compassion includes energetic acts of uncon-
ditional love and means (1) recognizing the
interconnectedness of the nurse and client by
being able to fully understand and know the
suffering of another, (2) creating actions de-
signed to transform injustices, and (3) not only
grieving in another’s sorrow and pain but also
rejoicing in another’s joy (Butcher, 2002).
Pattern manifestation knowing and appre-
ciation involves focusing on the experiences,
perceptions, and expressions of a health situa-
tion, revealed through a rhythmic flow of
communion and dialogue. In most situations,
the nurse can initially ask the client to describe
his or her health situation and concern. The di-
alogue is guided toward focusing on uncover-
ing the client’s experiences, perceptions, and
expressions related to the health situation as a
means to reaching a deeper understanding of
unitary field pattern. Humans are constantly
all-at-once experiencing, perceiving, and ex-
pressing (Cowling, 1993a). Experience in-
volves the rawness of living through sensing
and being aware as a source of knowledge and
includes any item or ingredient the client
246 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
Unitary pattern-based praxis
Rogerian cosmology Rogerian philosophy
Rogerian science
Rogerian theories Pattern-based researchPattern-based practice
Pattern manifestation
Knowing and appreciation
Voluntary mutual
patterning
Unitary field pattern
portrait research
method
Knowing participation in change
Pattern transformation
Potentialities for human betterment and well-being
Fig 14 • 1 The unitary pattern-based praxis model. (Model from Butcher, H. K.
[2006a]. Unitary pattern-based praxis: A nexus of Rogerian cosmology, philosophy, and
science. Visions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing Science, 14[2], 8–33.)
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 246
senses (Cowling, 1997). The client’s own ob-
servations and description of his or her health
situation includes his or her experiences. “Per-
ceiving is the apprehending of experience or
the ability to reflect while experiencing”
(Cowling, 1993a, p. 202). Perception is mak-
ing sense of the experience through awareness,
apprehension, observation, and interpreting.
Asking clients about their concerns, fears, and
observations is a way of apprehending their
perceptions. Expressions are manifestations of
experiences and perceptions that reflect human
field patterning. In addition, expressions are
any form of information that comes forward in
the encounter with the client. All expressions
are energetic manifestations of field patterns.
Body language, communication patterns, gait,
behaviors, laboratory values, and vital signs are
examples of energetic manifestations of human–
environmental field patterning.
Because all information about the client–
environment–health situation is relevant, var-
ious health assessment tools, such as the
comprehensive holistic assessment tool devel-
oped by B. M. Dossey, Keegan, and Guzzetta
(2004), may also be useful in pattern knowing
and appreciation. However, all information
must be interpreted within a unitary context.
A unitary context refers to conceptualizing all
information as energetic/dynamic manifesta-
tions of pattern emerging from a pandimen-
sional human–environmental mutual process.
All information is interconnected, is insepa-
rable from environmental context, unfolds
rhythmically and acausally, and reflects the
whole. Data are not divided or understood by
dividing information into physical, psycholog-
ical, social, spiritual, or cultural categories.
Rather, a focus on experiences, perceptions,
and expressions is a synthesis more than and
different from the sum of parts. From a uni-
tary perspective, what may be labeled as ab-
normal processes, nursing diagnoses, or illness
or disease are conceptualized as episodes of
discordant rhythms or nonharmonic reso-
nancy (Bultemeier, 2002).
A unitary perspective in nursing practice
leads to an appreciation of new kinds of infor-
mation that may not be considered within other
conceptual approaches to nursing practice. The
nurse is open to using multiple forms of know-
ing, including pandimensional modes of
awareness (intuition, meditative insights, tacit
knowing) throughout the pattern manifesta-
tion knowing and appreciation process. Intu-
ition and tacit knowing are artful ways to
enable seeing the whole, revealing subtle pat-
terns, and deepening understanding. Pattern
information concerning time perception, sense
of rhythm or movement, sense of connected-
ness with the environment, ideas of one’s own
personal myth, and sense of integrity are rele-
vant indicators of human–environment–health
potentialities (Madrid & Winstead-Fry, 1986).
A person’s hopes and dreams, communication
patterns, sleep–rest rhythms, comfort–discomfort,
waking–beyond waking experiences, and de-
gree of knowing participation in change pro-
vide important information regarding each
client’s thoughts and feelings concerning a
health situation.
The nurse can also use a number of pattern
appraisal scales derived from Rogers’s postulates
and principles to enhance the collecting and un-
derstanding of relevant information specific to
Rogerian science. For example, nurses can use
Barrett’s (1989) power as knowing participation
in change tool as a way of knowing clients’ en-
ergy field patterns in relation to their capacity
to knowingly participate in the continuous pat-
terning of human and environmental fields as
manifest in frequencies of awareness, choice
making ability, sense of freedom to act inten-
tionally, and degree of involvement in creating
change. Watson’s (1993) assessment of dream
experience scale can be used to know and
appreciate the clients’ dream experiences, and
Ference’s (1979, 1986) human field motion tool
is an indicator of the wave frequency pattern of
the energy field.
Hastings-Tolsma’s (1992) diversity of human
field pattern scale may be used as a means for
knowing and appreciating a clients’ perception
of the diversity of their energy field pattern,
Johnston’s (1994) human image metaphor scale
can be used as a way of knowing and appreciat-
ing the clients’ perception of the wholeness of
their energy field, and the well-being picture
scale for adults (Gueldner et al., 2005; Johnson,
Guadron, Verchot, & Gueldner, 2011) and for
CHAPTER 14 • Martha E. Rogers’s Science of Unitary Human Beings 247
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 247
children (Terwillinger, Gueldner, & Bronstein,
2012) afford a way to measure a person’s sense
of unitary well-being. Paletta (1990) developed
a tool consistent with Rogerian science that
measures the subjective awareness of temporal
experience.
The pattern manifestation knowing and ap-
preciation is enhanced through the nurse’s
ability to grasp meaning, create a meaningful
connection, and participate knowingly in the
client’s change process (Butcher, 1999a).
“Grasping meaning entails using sensitivity,
active listening, conveying unconditional ac-
ceptance, while remaining fully open to the
rhythm, movement, intensity, and configura-
tion of pattern manifestations” (Butcher,
1999a, p. 51). Through integrality, nurse and
client are always connected in mutual process.
However, a meaningful connection with the
client is facilitated by creating a rhythm and
flow through the intentional expression of un-
conditional love, compassion, and empathy.
Together, in mutual process, the nurse and
client explore the meanings, images, symbols,
metaphors, thoughts, insights, intuitions,
memories, hopes, apprehensions, feelings, and
dreams associated with the health situation.
Rogerian ethics are integral to all unitary
pattern–based practice situations. Rogerian
ethics are pattern manifestations emerging
from the human–environmental field mutual
process that reflect those ideals concordant
with Rogers’ most cherished values and are
indicators of the quality of knowing partici-
pation in change (Butcher, 1999b). Thus,
unitary pattern–based practice includes mak-
ing the Rogerian values of reverence, human
betterment, generosity, commitment, diver-
sity, responsibility, compassion, wisdom, jus-
tice-creating, openness, courage, optimism,
humor, unity, transformation, and celebration
intentional in the human–environmental field
mutual process (Butcher, 1999b, 2000).
When initial pattern manifestation know-
ing and appreciation is complete, the nurse
synthesizes all the pattern information into a
meaningful pattern profile. The pattern profile
is an expression of the person–environment–
health situation’s essence. The nurse weaves
together the expressions, perceptions, and
experiences in a way that tells the client’s story.
The pattern profile reveals the hidden meaning
embedded in the client’s human–environmental
mutual field process. Usually the pattern pro-
file is in a narrative form that describes the
essence of the properties, features, and quali-
ties of the human–environment–health situa-
tion. In addition to a narrative form, the
pattern profile may also include diagrams,
poems, listings, phrases, metaphors, or a com-
bination of these. Interpretations of any meas-
urement tools may also be incorporated into
the pattern profile.
Voluntary Mutual Patterning
Voluntary mutual patterning is a process of
transforming human–environmental field
patterning. The goal of voluntary mutual pat-
terning is to facilitate each client’s ability to
participate knowingly in change, harmonize
person–environment integrality, and promote
healing potentialities, lifestyle changes, and
well-being in the client’s desired direction of
change without attachment to predetermined
outcomes. The process is mutual in that both
the nurse and the client are changed with
each encounter, each patterning one another
and coevolving together. “Voluntary” signifies
freedom of choice or action without external
compulsion (Barrett, 1998). The nurse has
no investment in changing the client in a
particular way.
Whereas patterning is continuous, voluntary
mutual patterning may begin by sharing the
pattern profile with the client. Sharing the pat-
tern profile with the client is a means of vali-
dating the interpretation of pattern information
and may spark further dialogue, revealing new
and more in-depth information. Sharing the
pattern profile with the client facilitates pattern
recognition and also may enhance the client’s
knowing participation in his or her own change
process. An increased awareness of one’s own
pattern may offer new insight and increase
one’s desire to participate in the change process.
In addition, the nurse and client can continue
to explore goals, options, choices, and voluntary
mutual patterning strategies as a means to
facilitate the client’s actualization of his or her
human–environmental field potentials.
248 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 248
A wide variety of mutual patterning strate-
gies may be used in Rogerian practice, includ-
ing many “interventions” identified in the
Nursing Intervention Classification (Bulechek,
Butcher, & Dochterman, 2013). However, “in-
terventions,” within a unitary context, are not
linked to nursing diagnoses and are reconcep-
tualized as voluntary mutual patterning strate-
gies, and the activities are reconceptualizied as
patterning activities. Rather than linking vol-
untary mutual patterning strategies to nursing
diagnoses, the strategies emerge in dialogue
whenever possible out of the patterns and
themes described in the pattern profile. Fur-
thermore, Rogers (1988, 1992, 1994a) placed
great emphasis on modalities that are tradition-
ally viewed as holistic and noninvasive. In
particular, the use of sound, dialogue, affirma-
tions, humor, massage, journaling, exercise,
nutrition, reminiscence, aroma, light, color,
artwork, meditation, storytelling, literature,
poetry, movement, and dance are just a few of
the voluntary mutually patterning strategies
consistent with a unitary perspective. In addi-
tion, patterning modalities have been devel-
oped that are conceptualized within the science
of unitary human beings such as Butcher’s
metaphoric unitary landscape narratives (2006b)
and written emotional expression (2004a), Ther-
apeutic Touch (Malinski, 1993), guided imagery
(Butcher & Parker, 1988; Levin, 2006), magnet
therapy (Kim, 2001), and music (Horvath, 1994;
Johnston, 2001). Sharing of knowledge through
health education and providing health education
literature and teaching also have the potential
to enhance knowing participation in change.
These and other noninvasive modalities are
well described and documented in both
the Rogerian (Barrett, 1990; Madrid, 1997;
Madrid & Barrett, 1994) and the holistic nurs-
ing practice literature (B. M. Dossey, 1997; B.
M. Dossey, Keegan, & Guzzetta, 2004).
The nurse continuously apprehends changes
in patterning emerging from the human–
environmental field mutual process throughout
the simultaneous pattern manifestation know-
ing and appreciation and voluntary mutual
patterning processes. Although the concept
of “outcomes” is incompatible with Rogers’
notions of unpredictability, outcomes in the
Nursing Outcomes Classification (Moorhead,
Johnson, Maas, & Swanson, 2013) can be
reconceptualized as potentialities of change or
“client potentials” (Butcher, 1997a, p. 29), and
the indicators can be used as a means to eval-
uate the client’s desired direction of pattern
change. At various points in the client’s care,
the nurse can also use the scales derived from
Rogers’s science (previously discussed) to co-
examine changes in pattern. Regardless of
which combination of voluntary patterning
strategies and evaluation methods is used, the
intention is for clients to actualize their poten-
tials related to their desire for well-being and
betterment.
The unitary pattern–based practice method
identifies the aspect that is unique to nursing
and expands nursing practice beyond the tra-
ditional biomedical model dominating much
of nursing. Rogerian nursing practice does not
necessarily need to replace hospital-based and
medically driven nursing interventions and
actions for which nurses hold responsibility.
Rather, unitary pattern–based practice com-
plements medical practices and places treat-
ments and procedures within an acausal,
pandimensional, rhythmical, irreducible, and
unitary context. Unitary pattern–based practice
provides a new way of thinking and being in
nursing that distinguishes nurses from other
health care professionals and offers new and
innovative ways for clients to reach their
desired health potentials.
Applications of Theory and Research
Research is the bedrock of nursing practice.
The science of unitary human beings has a long
history of theory-testing research. As new
practice theories and health patterning modal-
ities evolve from the science of unitary human
beings, there remains a need to test the viabil-
ity and usefulness of Rogerian theories and
voluntary health patterning strategies. The
mass of Rogerian research has been reviewed
in a number of publications (Butcher, 2008;
Caroselli & Barrett, 1998; Dykeman &
Loukissa, 1993; Fawcett, 2013; Fawcett &
Alligood, 2003; Kim, 2008; Malinski, 1986a;
Phillips, 1989; Watson, Barrett, Hastings-
Tolsma, Johnston, & Gueldner, 1997). Rather
CHAPTER 14 • Martha E. Rogers’s Science of Unitary Human Beings 249
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 249
than repeat the reviews of Rogerian research,
the following section describes current method-
ological trends within the science of unitary
human beings to assist researchers interested
in Rogerian science in making methodological
decisions.
Rogers (1994b) maintained that both
quantitative and qualitative methods may be
useful for advancing Rogerian science. Simi-
larly, Barrett (1996), Barrett and Caroselli
(1998), Barrett, Cowling, Carboni, and
Butcher (1997), Cowling (1986), Rawnsley
(1994), and Smith and Reeder (1996) have
all advocated for the appropriateness of mul-
tiple methods in Rogerian research. Con-
versely, Butcher (cited in Barrett et al., 1997),
Butcher (1994), and Carboni (1995b) have
argued that the ontological and epistemolog-
ical assumptions of causality, reductionism,
particularism, control, prediction, and linear-
ity of quantitative methodologies are incon-
sistent with Rogers’s unitary ontology and
participatory epistemology. Later, Fawcett
(1996) also questioned the congruency be-
tween the ontology and epistemology of
Rogerian science and the assumptions embed-
ded in quantitative research designs; like
Carboni (1995b) and Butcher (1994), she
concluded that interpretive/qualitative meth-
ods may be more congruent with Rogers’s
ontology and epistemology. This chapter pres-
ents an inclusive view of methodologies.
Approaches to Rogerian Research
Cowling (1986) was among the first to suggest
a number of research designs that may be ap-
propriate for Rogerian research, including
philosophical, historical, and phenomenolog-
ical ones. There is strong support for the ap-
propriateness of phenomenological methods in
Rogerian science. Reeder (1986) provided a
convincing argument demonstrating the con-
gruence between Husserlian phenomenology
and the Rogerian science of unitary human be-
ings. Experimental and quasi-experimental de-
signs are problematic because of assumptions
concerning causality; however, these designs
may be appropriate for testing propositions
concerning differences in the change process
in relation to “introduced environmental
change” (Cowling, 1986, p. 73). The researcher
must be careful to interpret the findings in a
way that is consistent with Rogers’s notions of
unpredictability, integrality, and nonlinearity.
Emerging interpretive evaluation methods,
such as Guba and Lincoln’s (1989) Fourth
Generation Evaluation, offer an alternative
means for testing for differences in the change
process within or between groups (or both)
more consistent with the science of unitary
human beings.
Cowling (1986) contended that in the
early stages of theory development, designs
that generate descriptive and explanatory
knowledge are relevant to the science of uni-
tary human beings. For example, correlational
designs may provide evidence of patterned
changes among indices of the human field.
Advanced and complex designs with multiple
indicators of change that may be tested using
linear structural relations (LISREL) statisti-
cal analysis may also be a means to uncover
knowledge about the pattern of change
(Phillips, 1990). Barrett (1996) suggested
that canonical correlation may be useful in ex-
amining relationships and patterns across do-
mains and may also be useful for testing
theories pertaining to the nature and direc-
tion of change. Another potentially promis-
ing area yet to be explored is participatory
action and cooperative inquiry (Reason,
1994), because of their congruence with
Rogers’s notions of knowing participation in
change, continuous mutual process, and inte-
grality. Cowling (1998) proposed that a case-
oriented approach is useful in Rogerian
research because case inquiry allows the re-
searcher to attend to the whole and strives to
comprehend his or her essence.
Selecting a Focus of Rogerian Inquiry
In selecting a focus of inquiry, concepts that
are congruent with the science of unitary
human beings are most relevant. The focus of
inquiry flows from the postulates, principles,
and concepts relevant to the conceptual sys-
tem. Noninvasive voluntary patterning modal-
ities, such as guided imagery, Therapeutic
Touch, humor, sound, dialogue, affirmations,
music, massage, journaling, written emotional
250 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 250
expression, exercise, nutrition, reminiscence,
aroma, light, color, artwork, meditation,
storytelling, literature, poetry, movement,
and dance, provide a rich source for Rogerian
science-based research. Creativity, mystical
experiences, transcendence, sleeping-beyond-
waking experiences, time experience, and para-
normal experiences as they relate to human
health and well-being are also of interest in
this science. Feelings and experiences are a
manifestation of human–environmental field
patterning and are a manifestation of the
whole (Rogers, 1970); thus, feelings and expe-
riences relevant to health and well-being are
an unlimited source for potential Rogerian
research. Discrete particularistic biophysical
phenomena are usually not an appropriate
focus for inquiry because Rogerian science
focuses on irreducible wholes. An exception
could be the use of such phenomena, for ex-
ample blood pressure, as part of diverse data
collected to obtain different views of pattern
manifestations and pattern change.
For example, see Madrid, Barrett, and
Winstead-Fry’s (2010) study of Therapeutic
Touch and blood pressure, pulse, and respira-
tions in the operative setting with patients un-
dergoing cerebral angiography, and Malinski
and Todaro-Franceschi’s (2011) study of
comeditation and anxiety and relaxation in a
nursing school setting.
Rogers clearly identified that everything is
a manifestation of the whole, of field pattern-
ing. However, one cannot use just the numer-
ical data, mere “facts,” so interpretation would
differ accordingly (Rogers, 1989). Researchers
need to ensure that concepts and measurement
tools used in the inquiry are defined and con-
ceptualized within a unitary perspective and
congruent with Rogers’s principles and postu-
lates. Diseases or medical diagnoses are not the
focus of Rogerian inquiry. Disease conditions
are conceptualized as labels and as manifesta-
tions of patterning emerging acausally from
the human–environmental mutual process.
Measurement of Rogerian Concepts
The Human Field Motion Test (HFMT) is an
indicator of the continuously moving position
and flow of the human energy field. Two major
concepts—“my motor is running” and “my field
expansion”—are rated using a semantic differ-
ential technique (Ference, 1979, 1986). Exam-
ples of indicators of higher human field motion
include feeling imaginative, visionary, transcen-
dent, strong, sharp, bright, and active. Indica-
tors of relative low human field motion include
feeling dull, weak, dragging, dark, pragmatic,
and passive. The tool has been widely used in
numerous Rogerian studies.
The Power as Knowing Participation in
Change Tool (PKPCT) has been used in more
than 26 major research studies (Caroselli &
Barrett, 1998) and is a measure of one’s capac-
ity to participate knowingly in change as man-
ifested by awareness, choices, freedom to act
intentionally, and involvement in creating
changes using semantic differential scales. Sta-
tistically significant correlations have been
found between power as measured by the
PKPCT and the following: human field mo-
tion, life satisfaction, spirituality, purpose in
life, empathy, transformational leadership
style, feminism, imagination, and socioeco-
nomic status. Inverse relations with power
have been found with anxiety, chronic pain,
personal distress, and hopelessness (Caroselli
& Barrett, 1998).
Diversity is inherent in the evolution of the
human–environmental mutual field process.
The evolution of the human energy field is
characterized by the creation of more diverse
patterns reflecting the nature of change. The
Diversity of Human Field Pattern Scale meas-
ures the process of diversifying human field
pattern and may also be a useful tool to test
theoretical propositions derived from the pos-
tulates and principles of Rogerian science to
examine the extent of selected patterning
modalities designed to foster harmony and
well-being (Hastings-Tolsma, 1992; Watson
et al., 1997). Other measurement tools devel-
oped within a unitary science perspective may
be used in a wide variety of research studies and
in combination with other Rogerian measure-
ments. For example, there are the Assessment
of Dream Experience Scale, which measures
the diversity of dream experience as a beyond-
waking manifestation using a 20-item Likert
scale (Watson, 1993; Watson et al., 1997);
CHAPTER 14 • Martha E. Rogers’s Science of Unitary Human Beings 251
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 251
Temporal Experience Scale, which measures
the subjective experience of temporal aware-
ness (Paletta, 1990); and Mutual Exploration
of the Healing Human Field–Environmental
Field Relationship Creative Measurement
Instrument developed by Carboni (1992),
which is a creative qualitative measure de-
signed to capture the changing configurations
of energy field pattern of the healing human–
environmental field relationship.
A number of new tools have been developed
that are rich sources of measures of concepts
congruent with unitary science. The Human
Field Image Metaphor Scale used 25 metaphors
that capture feelings of potentiality and inte-
grality rated on a Likert-type scale. For exam-
ple, the metaphor “I feel at one with the
universe” reflects a high degree of awareness of
integrality; “I feel like a worn-out shoe” reflects
a more restricted perception of one’s potential
(Johnston, 1994; Watson et al., 1997). Future
research may focus on developing an under-
standing of how human field image changes in
a variety of health-related situations or how
human field image changes in mutual process
with selected patterning strategies.
Research Methods Specific to Science
of Unitary Human Beings
The criteria for developing Rogerian research
methods are presented in the supplementary
material (for a description of the constituents
see Bonus content for the chapter.)3 They are a
synthesis and modification of the Criteria
of Rogerian Inquiry developed by Butcher
(1994) and the Characteristics of Operational
Rogerian Inquiry developed by Carboni
(1995b). The criteria are a useful guide in de-
signing research methods that are consistent
with Rogers’s principles and postulates. Two
Rogerian research methods were developed
using the criteria and the Unitary Field Pattern
Portrait research method and Rogerian Process
Inquiry. A third method developed by Cowling
(2001), Unitary Appreciative Inquiry is also de-
scribed in the bonus content for the chapter.3
Rogerian Process of Inquiry
Carboni (1995b) developed the Rogerian
process of inquiry from her characteristics of
Rogerian inquiry. The method’s purpose is
to investigate the dynamic enfolding-unfolding
of the human field–environmental field en-
ergy patterns and the evolutionary change of
configurations in field patterning of the
nurse and participant. Rogerian process of
inquiry transcends both matter-centered
methodologies espoused by empiricists and
thought-bound methodologies espoused by phe-
nomenologists and critical theorists (Carboni,
1995b). Rather, this process of inquiry is
evolution-centered and focuses on changing
configurations of human and environmental
field patterning.
The flow of the inquiry starts with a sum-
mation of the researcher’s purpose, aims, and
visionary insights. Visionary insights emerge
from the study’s purpose and researcher’s un-
derstanding of Rogerian science. Next, the
researcher focuses on becoming familiar with
the participants and the setting of the inquiry.
Shared descriptions of energy field perspec-
tives are identified through observations and
discussions with participants and processed
through mutual exploration and discovery. The
researcher uses the Mutual Exploration of the
Healing Human Field–Environmental Field
Relationship Creative Measurement Instru-
ment (Carboni, 1992) as a way to identify, un-
derstand, and creatively measure human and
environmental energy field patterns. Together,
the researcher and the participants develop a
shared understanding and awareness of the
human–environmental field patterns mani-
fested in diverse multiple configurations of
patterning. All the data are synthesized using
inductive and deductive data synthesis.
Through the mutual sharing and synthesis of
data, unitary constructs are identified. The
constructs are interpreted within the perspec-
tive of unitary science, and a new unitary the-
ory may emerge from the synthesis of unitary
constructs. Carboni (1995b) also developed
special criteria of trustworthiness to ensure the
scientific rigor of the findings conveyed in the
form of a Pandimensional Unitary Process
252 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3 For additional information please go to bonus chapter
content available at FA Davis http://davisplus.fadavis.com
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 252
Report. Carboni’s research method affords a
way of creatively measuring manifestations of
field patterning emerging during coparticipa-
tion of the researcher and participant’s process
of change.
The Unitary Field Pattern Portrait
Research Method
The unitary field pattern portrait (UFPP) re-
search method (Butcher, 1994, 1996, 1998,
2005) was developed at the same time Car-
boni was developing the unitary process of
inquiry and was derived directly from the cri-
teria of Rogerian inquiry. The purpose of
the UFPP research method is to create a uni-
tary understanding of the dynamic kaleido-
scopic and symphonic pattern manifestations
emerging from the pandimensional human–
environmental field mutual process as a means
to enhance the understanding of a significant
phenomenon associated with human better-
ment and well-being. The UFPP research
method is part of the unitary pattern–based
praxis model (see Fig. 14-1) illustrating the
inherent unity of Rogerian philosophy, sci-
ence, theory, practice, and research (Butcher,
2006a). There are eight essential aspects and
three essential processes in the method. The
aspects include initial engagement, a priori
nursing science, immersion, manifestation
knowing and appreciation, the unitary field
pattern profile, mutually constructed unitary
field pattern profile, the unitary field pattern
portrait, and theoretical unitary field pattern
portrait. The UFPP (see Fig. 14-2) and the
three essential processes are creative pattern
synthesis, immersion and crystallization, and
evolutionary interpretation.
1. Initial Engagement: Inquiry within the
UFPP begins with initial engagement,
which is a passionate search for a research
question of central interest to understand-
ing unitary phenomena associated with
human betterment and well-being. For
example, experiences, perceptions, and
expressions related to noninvasive volun-
tary patterning modalities such as guided
imagery, Therapeutic Touch, humor, sound,
dialogue, affirmations, music, massage,
journaling, written emotional expression,
exercise, nutrition, reminiscence, aroma,
light, color, artwork, meditation, story-
telling, literature, poetry, movement, and
dance provide a rich source for UFPP
research. Creativity, mystical experiences,
transcendence, sleeping-beyond-waking
experiences, time experience, and paranor-
mal experiences as they relate to human
health and well-being are also experiences
that can be researched using the UFPP.
The UFPP research method can also be
used to create a unitary conceptualization
and understanding of an unlimited number
of human experiences relevant to under-
standing health and well-being within a
unitary perspective. New concepts that
describe unitary phenomena may also be
developed through research using this
method.
2. A priori nursing science identifies the
science of unitary human beings as the
researcher’s perspective. As in all research,
the perspective of the researcher guides
all aspects and processes of the research
method, including the interpretation
of findings.
3. Immersion involves becoming steeped in
the research topic. The researcher may
immerse in poetry, art, literature, music,
dialogue with self and/or others, research
literature, or any activity that enhances
the integrality of the researcher and the
research topic.
4. Pattern manifestation knowing and appre-
ciation includes participant selection, in-
depth dialoguing, and recording pattern
manifestations. Participant selection is
made using intensive purposive sampling.
Patterning manifestation knowing and
appreciation occurs in a natural setting and
involves using pandimensional modes of
awareness during in-depth dialoguing.
The activities described earlier in the pat-
tern manifestation knowing and apprecia-
tion process in the practice method are
used in this research method. However,
in the UFPP research method the focus
of pattern appreciation and knowing is on
experiences, perceptions, and expressions
CHAPTER 14 • Martha E. Rogers’s Science of Unitary Human Beings 253
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 253
associated with the phenomenon of con-
cern. The researcher also maintains an in-
formal conversational style while focusing
on revealing the rhythm, flow, and config-
urations of the pattern manifestations
emerging from the human–environmental
mutual field process associated with the
research topic. The dialogue is taped and
transcribed. The researcher maintains ob-
servational, methodological, and theoretical
field notes, and a reflexive journal. Any
artifacts the participant wishes to share
that illuminate the meaning of the phe-
nomenon may also be included. Artifacts
may include pictures, drawings, poetry,
music, logs, diaries, letters, notes, and
journals.
5. Unitary field pattern profile is a rich de-
scription of each participant’s experiences,
perception, and expressions created
254 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
Unitary Field Pattern Portrait Research Method
Creative Pattern
Synthesis
Immersion and
Crystallization
Initial engagement A priori nursing science
Pattern manifestation knowing and appreciation
Mutually shaped unitary field pattern profile
Resonating unitary themes of
human/environmental pattern manifestations
Unitary field pattern profile
Unitary field pattern portrait
Evolutionary
Interpretation
Theoretical unitary field pattern portrait
Emerging unitary themes
of human-environmental
pattern manifestations
Mutual processing
Immersion
Fig 14 • 2 The unitary
field pattern portrait re-
search method. (Model from
Butcher, H. K. (2005). The
unitary field pattern portrait re-
search method: Facets, processes
and findings. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 18, 293–297.)
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 254
through a process of creative pattern syn-
thesis. All the information collected for
each participant is synthesized into a nar-
rative statement (profile) revealing the
essence of the participant’s description of
the phenomenon of concern. The field pat-
tern profile is in the language of the partic-
ipant and is then shared with the
participant for revision and validation.
6. Mutual processing involves constructing
the mutual unitary field pattern profile by
mutually sharing an emerging joint or
shared profile with each successive partici-
pant at the end of each participant’s pat-
tern manifestation knowing and
appreciation process. For example, at the
end of the interview of the fourth partici-
pant, a joint construction of the phenome-
non is shared with the participant for
comment. The joint construction (mutual
unitary field pattern profile) at this phase
would consist of a synthesis of the profiles
of the first three participants. After verifi-
cation of the fourth participant’s pattern
profile, the profile is folded into the
emerging mutual unitary field pattern pro-
file. Pattern manifestation knowing and
appreciation continues until there are no
new pattern manifestations to add to the
mutual unitary field pattern profile. If it is
not possible to either share the pattern
profile with each participant or create a
mutually constructed unitary field pattern
profile, the research may choose to bypass
the mutual processing phase.
7. The UFPP is created by identifying emerg-
ing unitary themes from each participant’s
field pattern profile, sorting the unitary
themes into common categories, creating
the resonating unitary themes of human–
environmental pattern manifestations
through immersion and crystallization,
which involves synthesizing the resonating
themes into a descriptive portrait of the
phenomenon. The UFPP is expressed in
the form of a vivid, rich, thick, and accu-
rate aesthetic rendition of the universal
patterns, qualities, features, and themes
exemplifying the essence of the dynamic
kaleidoscopic and symphonic nature of the
phenomenon of concern.
8. The UFPP is interpreted from the perspec-
tive of the science of unitary human beings
using the process of evolutionary interpre-
tation to create a theoretical UFPP of the
phenomenon. The purpose of theoretical
UFPP is to explicate the theoretical struc-
ture of the phenomenon from the perspec-
tive of nursing science using the Rogers’s
postulates and principles. The theoretical
UFPP is expressed in the language of
Rogerian science, thereby lifting the UFPP
from the level of description to the level of
unitary science. Scientific rigor is main-
tained throughout processes by using the
criteria of trustworthiness and authenticity
(Butcher, 1998, 2005).
Butcher’s (1997b) study on the experience
of dispiritedness in later life was the first pub-
lished study using the UFPP. Ring (2009)
used the method to investigate and describe
changes in pattern manifestations in individu-
als receiving Reiki, and Fuller (2011) used the
UFPP method to create a vivid portrait of
adult substance users and family pattern in
rehabilitation.
CHAPTER 14 • Martha E. Rogers’s Science of Unitary Human Beings 255
Practice Exemplar
The focus of nursing care guided by Rogers’s
nursing science is on pattern transformation
by facilitating pattern recognition during pat-
tern manifestation knowing and appreciation
and by facilitating the client’s ability to partic-
ipate knowingly in change, harmonizing per-
son–environment integrality, and promoting
healing potentialities and well-being through
voluntary mutual patterning. The unitary pat-
tern–based practice model consists of two
nonlinear and simultaneous processes: pattern
manifestation appreciation and knowing, and
voluntary mutual patterning. To illustrate
practice guided by Rogerian science, consider
Continued
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 255
256 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
Practice Exemplar cont.
Amanda, who is a 20-year-old college student
at a local university. She entered a nurse
owned and managed wellness center with her
mother. Pattern manifestation appreciation
and knowing as well as voluntary mutual pat-
terning begin simultaneously upon meeting as
the nurse practitioner apprehends that
Amanda’s eyes are downcast, she manifests
low energy, and she did not say a word when
first greeted. Amanda’s initial visit was 2 years
ago during her freshman year when she was
experiencing depressive symptoms. Amanda
had major life changes at the time: she broke
up with her boyfriend, her parents were going
through a divorce, and her grades were falling;
she was spending less time with her friends
and more time in her room; and she had ob-
viously lost weight. Today was similar as
Amanda and her mother entered the center to
see the nurse. After spending a few moments
in silence, the nurse ask Amanda to describe
her current situation, paying close attention to
her body language, words, and meanings as
she described her fears of failing school. En-
gaged in dialogue, Amanda revealed that for
the past 3 months, she has been increasingly
missing classes, having difficulty concentrating
and falling asleep, eating less, and spending
more time in her apartment. Her mother ex-
plained that Amanda had not come home for
the weekend in several weeks and doesn’t call
anymore.
Once her mother stepped out of the room,
Amanda began crying. She stated that she was
very stressed with school and misses her
friends. “Really, I just find myself staying in
bed and I don’t want to get out from under the
covers. I can’t seem to shut my brain off any-
more either. I don’t sleep. Yeah, that’s it if I
could just get some sleep, I know I would be
better.” Amanda was asked how she felt her
mood was. “I know I am depressed. I can feel
it.” Amanda continued to cry as she speaks
with her eyes down cast. When asked about
sleep, she stated that she was in bed a lot but
couldn’t seem to shut off her mind. “I can’t
even concentrate on one topic, and my brain
is off on another. I don’t even get hungry
anymore. The reason I haven’t come in is be-
cause I didn’t want you to see me like this
again. I was trying to get better.” Amanda was
having a difficult time focusing on one topic
and stated, “that big cloud is back again.” She
denied napping but does admit to feeling tired
“all the time.” The nurse invited Amanda to
participate in a brief deep-breathing and fo-
cusing exercise to help her become more re-
laxed and to enable her to reflect and describe
more deeply what she was experiencing in her
life situation. She revealed that her real fear
was failure and disappointing her mother. The
nurse then asked if Amanda would complete a
standard depression scale and the PKPCT
(Power as Knowing Participation in Change
Tool), and both were scored immediately.
Within Rogerian science, all information is rel-
evant, and even though the depression scale
was not specific to Rogerian science, the tool
can be interpreted within a unitary context.
Her score on the depression scale indicated
that Amanda was moderately depressed, which
is an indication her human–environmental
field mutual process. Rather than labeling
or diagnosing Amanda having “minor depres-
sion,” the nurse understood Amanda’s field
pattering as lower frequency energy pattering
and discordant with her environmental field.
Amanda’s scores on the 48-item PKPCT are
helpful in revealing her ability to participate in
change in a knowingly matter. In all four
dimensions of the tool (awareness, choices,
freedom to act intentionally, and involvement
in creating changes), Amanda’s scores were
low, indicating she manifested low power in
her change process. As the nurse shared and
dialogues with her about the scores on the
scales, she confirmed that she was feeling
helpless and unable to develop a plan to help
change her situation.
The nurse and Amanda worked together in
mutual process to develop a plan that would
help her experience her power to deal more ef-
fectively with her feelings and her academic
work. The nurse documented the encounter
by writing a health pattern profile that in-
cluded descriptions of Amanda’s experiences,
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 256
CHAPTER 14 • Martha E. Rogers’s Science of Unitary Human Beings 257
Practice Exemplar cont.
expressions, and perceptions of her health sit-
uation using her words as much as possible,
and they mutually agreed on a plan that was
designed to enhance her energy, help her bet-
ter manage her school work and diet, and fa-
cilitate rest at night. During voluntary mutual
patterning, the nurse first asked Amanda’s
mother to come back into the room. Together
they explored her mother’s feelings about the
importance of Amanda’s academic perform-
ance. Her mother revealed that she was more
concerned about her daughter’s health than
her grades, which actually helped relieve much
of the pressure she was feeling about her aca-
demic performance. A plan was developed
that included Amanda meeting with the fac-
ulty instructors in two of the courses in which
she was performing poorly to see what she can
do to make up for any missed assignments. In
one other course, both she and her mother
agreed it might be best to withdraw from the
course and retake it the following semester.
The nurse developed a “Power Prescription
Plan” that included Amanda developing a
daily activity schedule so that her time would
be more structured with a balance of study
time, exercise at the recreational center, in-
creased nutrition, and rest. Amanda enjoyed
swimming, so the schedule included her
swimming 4 of 7 days for 1 hour each time ini-
tially. Amanda also was interested in but had
never tried yoga, which she admitted was pop-
ular with a number of her friends. She agreed
to reengage with several of her close friends
and join one of the local yoga clubs on campus.
Together the nurse and Amanda developed an
imagery exercise that was meaningful to her,
and Amanda agreed to practice it daily.
Amanda also agreed to weekly sessions with
the nurse practitioner so that they can together
monitor Amanda’s progress and her involve-
ment in her change process. In the weekly ses-
sions, the nurse and Amanda would also
continue to explore the deeper meanings of
“depressed” feelings, mutually explore the
choices she was making, and identify new op-
tions that would allow her to achieve her
hopes and dreams. The session concluded with
Therapeutic Touch with both Amanda and
her mother.
■ Summary
If nursing’s content and contribution to the
betterment of the health and well-being of a
society is not distinguishable from other disci-
plines and has nothing unique or valuable to
offer, then nursing’s continued existence may
be questioned. Thus, nursing’s survival rests on
its ability to make a difference in promoting
the health and well-being of people. The sci-
ence of unitary human beings offers nursing a
new way of conceptualizing health events con-
cerning human well-being that is congruent
with the most contemporary scientific theories.
As with all major theories embedded in a new
worldview, new terminology is needed to cre-
ate clarity and precision of understanding and
meaning. There is an ever-growing body of
literature demonstrating the application of
Rogerian science to practice and research.
Rogers’s nursing science is applicable in all
nursing situations. Rather than focusing on
disease and cellular biological processes, the
science of unitary human beings focuses on
human beings as irreducible wholes insepara-
ble from their environment.
For 30 years, Rogers advocated that nurses
should become the experts and providers of
noninvasive modalities that promote health.
Now, the growth of “complementary/integra-
tive,” noninvasive practices is outpacing the
growth of allopathic medicine. If nursing con-
tinues to be dominated by biomedical frame-
works that are indistinguishable from medical
care, nursing will lose an opportunity to be-
come expert in unitary health-care modalities.
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 257
258 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
References
Alligood, M. R., & McGuire, S. L. (2000). Perception
of time, sleep patterns, and activity in senior citizens:
A test of a Rogerian theory of aging. Visions: The
Journal of Rogerian Nursing Science, 8, 6–14.
American Heritage Dictionary. (2000). (4th ed.).
New York: Houghton Mifflin.
Barrett, E. A. M. (1988). Using Rogers’ science of uni-
tary human beings in nursing practice. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 1, 50–51.
Barrett, E. A. M. (1989). A nursing theory of power for
nursing practice: Derivation from Rogers’ paradigm.
In J. Riehl-Sisca (Ed.), Conceptual models for nursing
practice (3rd ed., pp. 207–217). Norwalk, CT:
Appleton & Lange.
Barrett, E. A. M. (1990). Health patterning with clients
in a private practice environment. In E. A. M.
Barrett (Ed.), Visions of Rogers’ science-based practice
(pp. 105–115). New York: National League for
Nursing.
Barrett, E. A. M. (1996). Canonical correlation analysis
and its use in Rogerian research. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 9, 50–52.
Barrett, E. A. M. (1998). A Rogerian practice methodol-
ogy for health patterning. Nursing Science Quarterly,
11, 136–138.
Barrett, E. A. M. (2010). Power as knowing participa-
tion in change: What’s new and what’s next. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 23, 47–54.
Barrett, E. A. M., & Caroselli, C. (1998). Methodologi-
cal ponderings related to the power as knowing par-
ticipation in change tool. Nursing Science Quarterly,
11, 17–22.
Barrett, E. A. M., Cowling, W. R., Carboni, J. T., &
Butcher, H. K. (1997). Unitary perspectives on
methodological practices. In M. Madrid (Ed.),
Patterns of Rogerian knowing (pp. 47–62). New York:
National League for Nursing.
Briggs, J., & Peat, F. D. (1989). Turbulent mirror: An
illustrated guide to chaos theory and the science of
wholeness. New York: Harper & Row.
Bulechek, G. M., Butcher, H. K., & Dochteman, J. M.
(2013). Nursing interventions classification (NIC)
(6th ed.). St. Louis, MO: Elsevier.
Bultemeier, K. (1997). Photo-disclosure: A research
methodology for investigating unitary human beings.
In M. Madrid (Ed.), Patterns of Rogerian knowing
(pp. 63–74). New York: National League for Nursing.
Bultemeier, K. (2002). Rogers’ science of unitary human
beings in nursing practice. In M. R. Alligood & A.
Marriner-Tomey (Eds.), Nursing theory: Utilization
and application (pp. 267–288). St. Louis, MO: Mosby.
Butcher, H. K. (1993). Kaleidoscoping in life’s turbu-
lence: From Seurat’s art to Rogers’ nursing science.
In M. E. Parker (Ed.), Patterns of nursing theories in
practice (pp. 183–198). New York: National League
for Nursing.
Butcher, H. K. (1994). The unitary field pattern portrait
method: Development of research method within
Rogers’ science of unitary human beings. In M.
Madrid & E. A. M. Barrett (Eds.), Rogers’ scientific
art of nursing practice (pp. 397–425). New York:
National League for Nursing.
Butcher, H. K. (1996). A unitary field pattern portrait of
dispiritedness in later life. Visions: The Journal of
Rogerian Nursing Science, 4, 41–58.
Butcher, H. K. (1997a). Energy field disturbance. In G.
K. McFarland & E. A. McFarlane, (Eds.), Nursing
diagnosis and intervention (3rd ed., pp. 22–33).
St. Louis, MO: Mosby.
Butcher, H. K. (1997b). A unitary field pattern portrait
of dispiritedness in later life. Visions: The Journal of
Rogerian Nursing Science, 4, 41–58.
Butcher, H. K. (1998). Crystallizing the processes of
the unitary field pattern portrait research method.
Visions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing Science,
6, 13–26.
Butcher, H. K. (1999a). The artistry of Rogerian prac-
tice. Visions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing Science,
7, 49–54.
Butcher, H. K. (1999b). Rogerian-ethics: An ethical in-
quiry into Rogers’ life and science. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 12, 111–117.
Butcher, H. K. (2000). Critical theory and Rogerian
science: Incommensurable or reconcilable. Visions:
The Journal of Rogerian Nursing Science, 8, 50–57.
Butcher, H. K. (2001). Nursing science in the new
millennium: Practice and research within Rogers’
science of unitary human beings. In: M. Parker
(Ed.), Nursing theories and nursing practice
(pp. 205–226). Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Butcher, H. K. (2002). Living in the heart of helicy: An
inquiry into the meaning of compassion and unpre-
dictability in Rogers’ nursing science. Visions:
The Journal of Rogerian Nursing Science, 10, 6–22.
Butcher, H. K. (2003). Aging as emerging brilliance:
Advancing Rogers’ unitary theory of aging. Visions:
The Journal of Rogerian Nursing Science, 11, 55–66.
Butcher, H. K. (2004). Written expression and the poten-
tial to enhance knowing participation in change. Vi-
sions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing Science, 12, 37–50.
Butcher, H. K. (2005). The unitary field pattern portrait
research method: Facets, processes and findings.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 18, 293–297.
Butcher, H. K. (2006a). Unitary pattern-based praxis:
A nexus of Rogerian cosmology, philosophy, and
science. Visions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing
Science, 14(2), 8–33.
Butcher, H. K. (2006b). Using metaphoric unitary land-
scape narratives to facilitate pattern transformation:
Fires in the tallgrass prairie as a wellspring of possi-
bilities. Visions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing
Science, 13, 41–58.
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 258
CHAPTER 14 • Martha E. Rogers’s Science of Unitary Human Beings 259
Butcher, H. K. (2008). Progress in the explanatory
power of the science of unitary human beings:
Frubes in a lull or surfing in the barrel of the wave.
Visions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing Science, 15(2),
23–26.
Butcher, H. K., & Parker, N. (1988). Guided imagery
within Martha Rogers’ science of unitary human
beings: An experimental study. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 1, 103–110.
Carboni, J. T. (1992). Instrument development and the
measurement of unitary constructs. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 5, 134–142.
Carboni, J. T. (1995a). Enfolding health-as-wholeness-
and-harmony: A theory of Rogerian nursing prac-
tice. Nursing Science Quarterly, 8, 71–78.
Carboni, J. T. (1995b). A Rogerian process of inquiry.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 8, 22–37.
Caroselli, C., & Barrett, E. A. M. (1998). A review of
the power as knowing participation in change litera-
ture. Nursing Science Quarterly, 11, 9–16.
Cowling, W. R. (1986). The science of unitary human
beings: Theoretical issues, methodological chal-
lenges, and research realities. In V. M. Malinski
(Ed.), Explorations on Martha Rogers’ science of
unitary human beings (pp. 65–78). Norwalk, CT:
Appleton-Century-Crofts.
Cowling, W. R. (1990). A template for unitary pattern-
based nursing practice. In E. A. Barrett (Ed.),
Visions of Rogers’ science-based nursing (pp. 45–65).
New York: National League for Nursing.
Cowling, W. R. (1993a). Unitary knowing in nursing
practice. Nursing Science Quarterly, 6, 201–207.
Cowling, W. R. (1993b). Unitary practice: Revisionary
assumptions. In M. E. Parker (Ed.), Patterns of nurs-
ing theories in practice (pp. 199–212). New York:
National League for Nursing.
Cowling, W. R. (1997). Pattern appreciation: The
unitary science/practice of reaching essence. In M.
Madrid (Ed.), Patterns of Rogerian knowing (pp.
129–142). New York: National League for Nursing.
Cowling, W. R. (1998). Unitary case inquiry. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 11, 139–141.
Cowling, W. R. (2001). Unitary appreciative inquiry.
Advances in Nursing Science, 23(4), 32–48.
Cowling, W. R. (2001). Unitary appreciative inquiry.
Advances in Nursing Science, 23(4), 32–48.
Csikszentmihalyi, M. (1990). Flow: The psychology of
optimal experience. New York: Harper & Row.
Deutsch, D. (1997). The fabric of reality: The science of
parallel universes—and its implications. New York:
Allen Lane.
Deutsch, D. (2011). The beginnings of infinity: Explana-
tions that transform the world. New York: Viking.
Dossey, B. M. (1997). Core curriculum for holistic nursing.
Gaithersburg, MD: Aspen.
Dossey, B. M., Keegan, L., & Guzzetta, C. (2004).
Holistic nursing: A handbook for practice (4th ed.).
Boston: Jones & Bartlett.
Dossey, L. (1993). Healing words: The power of prayer and
the practice of medicine. New York: HarperCollins
Dossey, L. (1999). Reinventing medicine: Beyond mind-
body to a new era of healing. New York: HarperCollins.
Dykeman, M. C., & Loukissa, D. (1993). The science of
unitary human beings: An integrative review.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 6, 179–188.
Fawcett, J. (1996). Issues of (in) compatibility between
the worldview and research views of the science of
unitary human beings: An invitation to dialogue. Vi-
sions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing Science, 4, 5–11.
Fawcett, J. (2013). Contemporary nursing knowledge:
Analysis and evaluation of nursing models and theories
(3rd ed.). Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Fawcett, J., & Alligood, M. R. (2003). The science
of unitary human beings: Analysis of qualitative
research approaches. Visions: The Journal of Rogerian
Nursing Science, 11, 7–20.
Ference, H. (1979). The relationship of time experience,
creativity traits, differentiation, and human field mo-
tion. Unpublished doctoral dissertation, New York
University, New York.
Ference, H. M. (1986). The relationship of time experi-
ence, creativity traits, differentiation, and human field
motion. In V. M. Malinski (Ed.), Explorations on
Rogers’ science of unitary human beings (pp. 95–105).
Norwalk, CT: Appleton-Century-Crofts.
Fuller, J. M. (2011). A family unitary field pattern portrait of
power as knowing participation in change among adult
substance users in rehabilitation. Unpublished doctoral
dissertation, Hampton University, Hampton, Virginia.
Guba, E. G., & Lincoln, Y. S. (1989). Fourth generation
evaluation. Newbury Park, CA: Sage.
Gueldner, S. H., Michel, Y., Bramlett, M. H., Liu,
C-F., Johnston, L. W., Endo, E., et al. (2005). The
Well-Being Picture Scale: A revision of the Index of
Field Energy. Nursing Science Quarterly, 18, 42–50.
Hastings-Tolsma, M. T. (1992). The relationship among
diversity and human field pattern, risk taking, and time
experience: An investigation of Rogers’ principles of
homeodynamics. Unpublished doctoral dissertation,
New York University, New York.
Hektor, L. M. (1989/1994). Martha E. Rogers: A life
history. In V. M. Malinski & E. A. M. Barrett
(Eds.). Martha E. Rogers: Her life and her work
(pp. 10-27). Philadelphia: F. A. Davis. (Reprinted
from Nursing Science Quarterly, 2, 63–73).
Hills, R. G. S., & Hanchett, E. (2001). Human change
and individuation in pivotal life situation: Develop-
ment and testing of the theory of enlightenment. Vi-
sions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing Science, 9, 6–19.
Horvath, B. (1994). The science of unitary human be-
ings as a foundation for nursing practice with per-
sons experiencing life patterning difficulties:
Transforming theory into motion. In M. Madrid
& E. A. M. Barrett (Eds.), Rogers’ scientific art of
nursing practice (pp. 163–176). New York: National
League for Nursing.
Johnson, N., Guadron, M., Verchot, C., & Gueldner, S.
(2011). Validation of the Well-being Picture Scale
(WPS). Vision: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing
Science, 18(1), 8–21.
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 259
Johnston, L. W. (1994). Psychometric analysis of John-
son’s Human Field Metaphor Scale. Visions: The
Journal of Rogerian Nursing Science, 2, 7–11.
Johnston, L. W. (2001). An exploration of individual
preferences for audio enhancement of the dying ex-
perience. Visions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing
Science, 9, 20–26.
Kim, T. S. (2001). The relation of magnetic field therapy
to pain and power over time in persons with chronic
primary headache: A pilot study. Visions: The Journal
of Rogerian Nursing Science, 9, 27–42.
Kim, T. S. (2008). Science of unitary human beings:
An update on research. Nursing Science Quarterly,
21, 294–299.
Levin, J. D. (2006). Unitary transformative nursing:
using metaphor and imagery for self-reflection and
theory informed practice. Visions: The Journal of
Rogerian Nursing Science, 14, 27–35.
Lorenz, E. N. (1994). The essence of chaos. Seattle:
University of Washington Press.
Madrid, M. (Ed.). (1997). Patterns of Rogerian knowing.
New York: National League for Nursing.
Madrid, M. (Ed.). (1997). Patterns of Rogerian knowing.
New York: National League for Nursing.
Madrid, M., & Barrett, E. A. M. (Eds.). (1994). Rogers’
scientific art of nursing practice. New York: National
League for Nursing.
Madrid, M., Barrett, E. A. M., & Winstead-Fry, P.
(2010). A study of the feasibility of introducing ther-
apeutic touch into the operative environment with
patients undergoing cerebral angiography. Journal of
Holistic Nursing, 28, 168–174.
Madrid, M., & Winstead-Fry, P. (1986). Rogers’
conceptual model. In P. Winstead-Fry (Ed.), Case
studies in nursing theory (pp. 73–102). New York:
National League for Nursing.
Malinski, V. M. (Ed.). (1986a). Explorations on Martha
Rogers’ science of unitary human beings. Norwalk, CT:
Appleton-Century-Crofts.
Malinski, V. M. (1986b). Further ideas from Martha
Rogers. In V. M. Malinski (Ed.), Explorations
on Martha Rogers’ science of unitary human beings
(pp. 9–14). Norwalk, CT: Appleton-Century-Crofts.
Malinski, V. M. (1991). Spirituality as integrality: A
Rogerian perspective on the path of healing. Journal
of Holistic Nursing, 9, 54–64.
Malinski, V. (1993). Therapeutic touch: The view from
Rogerian nursing science. Visions: The Journal of
Rogerian Nursing Science, 1, 45–54.
Malinski, V. M. (1994). Spirituality: A pattern mani-
festation of the human/environmental mutual
process. Visions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing
Science, 2, 12–18.
Malinski, V. M. (2004). Compassion and loving-kind-
ness: Heartsongs for healing spirit. Spirituality and
Health International, 5, 89–98.
Malinski, V. M. (2012). Meditations on the unitary
rhythm of dying-grieving. Nursing Science Quarterly,
25, 239–244.
Malinski, V. M., & Barrett, E. A. M. (Eds.). (1994).
Martha E. Rogers: Her life and her work. Philadelphia:
F. A. Davis.
Malinski, V. M., & Todaro-Franceschi, V. (2011). Ex-
ploring co-meditation as a means of reducing anxiety
and facilitating relaxation in a nursing school setting.
Journal of Holistic Nursing, 29, 242–248.
Moorhead, S., Johnson, M., Maas, M., & Swanson, E.
(2013). Nursing outcomes classification (NOC)
(5th ed.). St. Louis, MO: Elsevier.
Murphy, M. (1992). The future of the body: Explorations
into the further evolution of human nature. Los
Angeles, CA: Tarcher.
Nadeau, R., & Kafatos, M. (1999). The non-local uni-
verse: The new physics and matters of the mind. Oxford:
Oxford University Press.
Paletta, J. L. (1990). The relationship of temporal expe-
rience to human time. In: E. A. M. Barrett (Ed.),
Visions of Rogers’ science-based nursing (pp. 239–253).
New York: National League for Nursing.
Peat, F. D. (1991). The philosopher’s stone: Chaos, syn-
chronicity, and the hidden world of order. New York:
Bantam.
Phillips, J. (1989). Science of unitary human beings:
Changing research perspectives. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 2, 57–60.
Phillips, J. R. (1990). Research and the riddle of change.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 3, 55–56.
Phillips, J. R. (1994). The open-ended nature of the sci-
ence of unitary human beings. In M. Madrid & E.
A. M. Barrett (Eds.), Rogers’ scientific art of nursing
practice (pp. 11–25). New York: National League for
Nursing.
Phillips, J. R. (2010a). The universality of Rogers’
science of unitary human beings. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 23, 55–59.
Phillips, J. R. (2010b). Perspectives of Rogers’ relative
present. Visions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing
Science, 17, 8–18.
Radin, D. (1997). The conscious universe: The scientific
truth of psychic phenomena. San Francisco: Harper.
Rawnsley, M. M. (1994). Multiple field methods in uni-
tary human field science. In M. Madrid & E. A. M.
Barrett (Eds.), Rogerian scientific art of nursing prac-
tice (pp. 381–395). New York: National League for
Nursing.
Reason, P. (1994). Three approaches to participative
inquiry. In N. K. Denzin & Y. S. Lincoln (Eds.),
Handbook of qualitative research (pp. 324–339).
Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Reed, P. G. (1991). Self-transcendence and mental
health in the oldest-old adults. Nursing Research,
40(1), 5–11.
Reed, P. G. (2003). The theory of self-transcendence. In
M. J. Smith & P. R. Liehr (Eds.). Middle range the-
ory for nursing (pp. 145–166). New York: Springer.
Reeder, F. (1986). Basic theoretical research in the con-
ceptual system of unitary human beings. In V. M.
Malinski (Ed.), Explorations on Martha E. Rogers’
260 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 260
CHAPTER 14 • Martha E. Rogers’s Science of Unitary Human Beings 261
science of unitary human beings (pp. 45–64). Norwalk,
CT: Appleton-Century-Crofts.
Ring, M. E. (2009). Reiki and changes in pattern mani-
festations. Nursing Science Quarterly, 22, 250–258.
Rogers, M. F. (1961). Educational revolution in nursing.
New York: Macmillan.
Rogers, M. F. (1964). Reveille in nursing. Philadelphia:
F. A. Davis.
Rogers, M. E. (1966/1994). Epilogue. In V. M. Malin-
ski & E. A. M. Barrett (Eds.), Martha E. Rogers and
her work (pp. 337–338). Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
(Reprinted from the Education Violet, the New York
University newspaper, 1966.)
Rogers, M. E. (1970). An introduction to the theoretical
basis of nursing. Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Rogers, M. E. (1980). Nursing: A science of unitary
man. In J. P. Riehl & C. Roy (Eds.), Conceptual
models for nursing practice (2nd ed., pp. 329–337).
New York: Appleton-Century-Crofts.
Rogers, M. E. (1986). Science of unitary human beings.
In V. M. Malinski (Ed.), Explorations on Martha
Rogers’ science of unitary human beings (pp. 3–8).
Norwalk, CT: Appleton-Century-Crofts.
Rogers, M. E. (1988). Nursing science and art: A
prospective. Nursing Science Quarterly, 1, 99–102.
Rogers, M. E. (1989). Response to questions for
Dr. Martha E. Rogers. Rogerian Nursing Science
News, 1(3), 6.
Rogers, M. E. (1990). Nursing: Science of unitary, irre-
ducible human beings: Update 1990. In E. A. M.
Barrett (Ed.), Visions of Rogers’ science-based nursing
(pp. 5–11). New York: National League for Nursing.
Rogers, M. E. (1992). Nursing and the space age. Nurs-
ing Science Quarterly, 5, 27–34.
Rogers, M. E. (1994a). The science of unitary human
beings: Current perspectives. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 7, 33–35.
Rogers, M. E. (1994b). Nursing science evolves. In: M.
Madrid & E. A. M. Barrett (Eds.), Rogers’ scientific
art of nursing practice (pp. 3–9). New York: National
League for Nursing.
Sheldrake, R. (1988). The presence of the past: Morphic
resonance and the habits of nature. New York: Times
Books.
Smith, D. W. (1994). Toward developing a theory of
spirituality. Visions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing
Science, 2, 35–43.
Smith, M. C., & Reeder, F. (1996). Clinical outcomes
research and Rogerian science: Strange or emergent
bedfellows. Visions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing
Science, 6, 27–38.
Smith, M. J. (1988). Perspectives on nursing science.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 1, 80–85.
Tart, C. T. (2009). The end of materialism: How evidence
of the paranormal is bringing science and spirit together.
Oakland, CA: New Harbinger.
Talbot, M. (1991). The holographic universe. New York:
HarperCollins.
Terwilliger, S. H., Gueldner, S. H., & Bronstein, L.
(2012). A preliminary evaluation of the well-being
picture scale-children’s version (WPS-CV) in a sam-
ple of fourth and fifth graders. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 25, 155–159.
Todaro-Franceschi, V. (1999). The enigma of energy:
Where science and religion converge. New York:
Crossroad.
Todaro-Franceschi, V. (2006). Synchronicity related
to dead loved ones: A natural healing modality.
Spirituality and Health International, 7, 151–161.
Watson, J. (1993). The relationships of sleep-wake rhythm,
dream experience, human field motion, and time
experience in older women. Unpublished doctoral
dissertation, New York University, New York.
Watson, J., Barrett, E. A. M., Hastings-Tolsma, M.,
Johnston, L., & Gueldner, S. (1997). Measurement
in Rogerian Science: A review of selected instru-
ments. In M. Madrid (Ed.), Patterns of Rogerian
knowing (pp. 87–99). New York: National League
for Nursing.
Whitbourne, S. K., & Whitbourne, S.B. (2011). Adult
development and aging (4th ed.). New York: Wiley
Zahourek, R. P. (2004). Intentionality forms the matrix
of healing: A theory. Alternative Therapies in Health
and Medicine, 10(6), 40–49.
Zahourek, R. P. (2005). Intentionality: Evolutionary de-
velopment in healing: A grounded theory study for
holistic nursing. Journal of Holistic Nursing, 23, 89–109.
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 261
3312_Ch14_235-262 26/12/14 4:55 PM Page 262
Chapter 15Rosemarie Rizzo Parse’s
Humanbecoming Paradigm
ROSEMARIE RIZZO PARSE
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of Parse’s Humanbecoming
Paradigm
Application of Theory
Summary
References
Rosemarie Rizzo Parse
263
Introducing the Theorist
Rosemarie Rizzo Parse is a Distinguished Pro-
fessor Emerita at Loyola University Chicago
as well as a Fellow in the American Academy
of Nursing, where she initiated and is imme-
diate past chair of the Nursing Theory–Guided
Practice Expert Panel. She is founder and
editor of Nursing Science Quarterly; president
of Discovery International, which sponsors in-
ternational nursing theory conferences; and
founder of the Institute of Humanbecoming,
where each summer in Pittsburgh she teaches
new material on the ontological, epistemolog-
ical, and methodological aspects of the human-
becoming paradigm. There are also sessions
on the Humanbecoming Community Change
Model (Parse, 2003a, 2012a, 2013a, 2014), the
Humanbecoming Teaching–Learning Model
(Parse, 2004, 2014), the Humanbecoming
Mentoring Model (Parse, 2008c, 2014), the
Humanbecoming Leading–Following Model
(Parse, 2008b, 2011a, 2014), and the Human-
becoming Family Model (Parse, 2008a, 2009a,
2014). The goal of all sessions is the under-
standing of the meaning of humanuniverse
from a humanbecoming perspective.
Dr. Parse has published more than 300 ar-
ticles and 10 books. Her books include Nursing
Fundamentals (Parse, 1974); Man-Living-
Health: A Theory of Nursing (Parse, 1981);
Nursing Research: Qualitative Methods (Parse,
Coyne, & Smith, 1985); Nursing Science: Major
Paradigms, Theories, and Critiques (Parse, 1987);
Illuminations: The Human Becoming Theory in
Practice and Research (Parse, 1995); The Human
Becoming School of Thought (Parse, 1998a); Hope:
An International Human Becoming Perspective
(Parse, 1999a); Qualitative Inquiry: The Path
3312_Ch15_263-278 26/12/14 5:54 PM Page 263
of Sciencing (Parse, 2001); Community: A
Human Becoming Perspective (Parse, 2003a);
and The Humanbecoming Paradigm: A Trans-
formational Worldview (Parse, 2014). Her
books and other publications have been trans-
lated into many languages, as her theory is a
guide for practice in health-care settings, and
her research methodologies are used by nurse
scholars in Australia, Canada, Denmark, Fin-
land, Greece, Italy, Japan, South Korea, Sweden,
Switzerland, Taiwan, the United Kingdom, the
United States, and many other countries on five
continents.
Dr. Parse has received two lifetime achieve-
ment awards, one from the Midwest Nursing
Research Society and one from the Asian
Nurses’ Association. The Rosemarie Rizzo
Parse Scholarship was endowed in her name
at the Henderson State University School of
Nursing. She is a sought-after speaker and
consultant for local, national, and international
venues. She also received the Medal of Honor
from the University of Lisbon.
Dr. Parse is a graduate of Duquesne Uni-
versity in Pittsburgh and received her master’s
and doctorate from the University of Pitts-
burgh. She was a member of the faculty of the
University of Pittsburgh, dean of the School of
Nursing at Duquesne University, professor and
coordinator of the Center for Nursing Re-
search at Hunter College of the City Univer-
sity of New York (1983–1993), and professor
and Niehoff Chair in Nursing Research at
Loyola University Chicago (1993–2006).
Since January 2007, she has been a consultant,
visiting scholar, and adjunct professor at the
New York University College of Nursing.
Overview of Parse’s
Humanbecoming
Paradigm
Prologue: Reflections on the Discipline
and Profession of Nursing
At present, nurse leaders in research, admin-
istration, education, and practice are focusing
attention on expanding the knowledge base of
nursing through enhancement of the disci-
pline’s frameworks and theories. Nursing is
both a discipline and a profession (Parse,
1999b). The goal of the discipline is to expand
knowledge about human experiences through
creative conceptualization and research (Parse,
2005, 2009c). The knowledge base of the dis-
cipline is the scientific guide to living the art
of nursing. The discipline-specific knowledge
is born and fostered in academic settings where
research and education advance knowledge to
new realms of understanding (Parse, 2008d,
2009b). The goal of the profession is to provide
service to humankind through living the art of
the science. Members of the nursing profes-
sion are responsible for regulating the stan-
dards of practice and education based on
disciplinary knowledge that reflects safe health
service to society in all settings (Parse, 1999b,
2012b, 2013b).
The Profession of Nursing
The profession of nursing consists of people ed-
ucated according to nationally regulated, de-
fined, and monitored standards that are
intended to preserve the integrity of health care
for members of society. The standards are spec-
ified predominantly in medical terms, accord-
ing to a tradition largely related to nursing’s
early subservience to medicine. Recently, nurse
leaders in health-care systems and in regulating
organizations have been developing standards
(Mitchell, 1998) and regulations (Damgaard,
2012; Damgaard & Bunkers, 1998, 2012) con-
sistent with discipline-specific knowledge as ar-
ticulated in the theories and frameworks of
nursing. This is a significant development that
has fortified the identity of nursing as a disci-
pline with its own body of knowledge—one
that specifies the service that society can expect
from members of the profession (Parse, 2011c).
With the rapidly changing health policies and
the general dissatisfaction of consumers with
health-care delivery, clearly stated expectations
for services from each of nursing’s paradigms
are a welcome change (Parse, 1999b, 2013a).
The Discipline of Nursing
The discipline of nursing encompasses at least
three paradigmatic perspectives about huma-
nuniverse (Parse, 2012a, 2013a). The totality
paradigm posits the human as body–mind–spirit
264 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch15_263-278 26/12/14 5:54 PM Page 264
whose health is considered a state of biological,
psychological, social, and spiritual well-being.
The body–mind–spirit perspective is particu-
late—focusing on the bio–psycho–social–
spiritual parts of the whole human as the
human interacts with and adapts to the envi-
ronment. The ontology leads to research and
practice on phenomena related to preventing
disease and maintaining and promoting health
according to societal norms. The totality para-
digm frameworks and theories are more closely
aligned with the medical model tradition.
Nurses practicing according to this paradigm
are concerned with participation of persons in
health-care decisions but have specific regi-
mens and goals to bring about change for the
people they serve (Parse, 1999b).
In contrast, the simultaneity paradigm
views the human as unitary—indivisible,
unpredictable, and everchanging (Parse,
1987, 1998a, 2007b), wherein health is con-
sidered a value and a process. The ontology
leads research and practice scholars to focus
on, for example, energy and environmental
field patterns (Rogers, 1992). Nurses focus
on power in knowing participation (Barrett,
2010; Rogers, 1992).
In 2012, Parse identified a third paradigm,
the humanbecoming paradigm (Parse, 2012a,
2013a). (Fig. 15-1) This was created inasmuch
as the ontology, epistemology, and methodolo-
gies of the humanbecoming school of thought
have moved on from the traditional metapara-
digm conceptualization and beyond the totality
and simultaneity paradigms (Parse, 2013a,
2014). With the humanbecoming paradigm in
the ontology, humanuniverse is an indivisible,
unpredictable everchanging cocreation, and liv-
ing quality is the becoming visible-invisible be-
coming of the emerging now. The ethos of
humanbecoming is also described and this is
unlike any other paradigm. With the epistemol-
ogy, the focus of study is on universal living
experiences. With the methodologies, sciencing
(the research process) is qualitative (Parse
research method and the humanbecoming
hermeneutic method), and living the art of hu-
manbecoming is in true presence with illumi-
nating meaning, shifting rhythms, and inspiring
transcending (Parse, 1981, 1992, 1997a, 1998a,
CHAPTER 15 • Rosemarie Rizzo Parse’s Humanbecoming Paradigm 265
Totality Paradigm Simultaneity Paradigm Humanbecoming Paradigm
Ontology
Human
Biopsychosocialspiritual being
Universe
Internal and external
environment
Health
A state and process of well-being
Epistemology
Human attributes
Methodologies
(research and practice)
Quantitative, qualitative, mixed
Steps of the nursing process
Copyright, Rosemarie Rizzo Parse, 2014
Ontology
Human
Unitary pattern
Universe
Unitary pattern in mutual
process with the human
Health
A value and a process
Epistemology
Human patterns
Methodologies
(research and practice)
Quantitative, qualitative, praxis
Pattern recognition
Ontology
Humanuniverse
Indivisible, unpredictable,
everchanging cocreation
Ethos of Humanbecoming-
Dignity
Presence, existence, trust, worth
Living quality
Becoming visible-invisible
Becoming of the emerging now
Epistemology
Universal living experiences
Methodologies
(sciencing and living the art)
Qualitative
True presence illuminating
meaning, shifting rhythms,
inspiring transcending
Paradigms of the Discipline of Nursing
Fig 15 • 1 Paradigms of the discipline of nursing. (Copyright ©2014, Rosemarie Rizzo Parse.)
3312_Ch15_263-278 26/12/14 5:54 PM Page 265
2010, 2014). Nurses living the humanbecom-
ing paradigm beliefs hold that their primary
concern is people’s perspectives of living quality
with human dignity (Parse, 1981, 1992, 1997a,
1998a; 2010, 2012a, 2013a, 2014). The new
conceptualization living quality is described in
detail in Parse (2013a). (See Parse, 2012a and
2013a, for details about the humanbecoming
paradigm.)
Because the ontologies of these three para-
digmatic perspectives are different, they lead
to different research and practice modalities,
different ethical considerations, and different
professional services to humankind. (See Parse,
2010, for the humanbecoming ethical tenets of
human dignity, which are reverence, awe, be-
trayal, and shame.) Humanbecoming is a basic
human science that has cocreated universal hu-
manuniverse living experiences as a central
focus. It is called a paradigm and a school of
thought because it encompasses a unique on-
tology, epistemology, and methodologies
(Parse, 1997b, 2010, 2012a, 2013a, 2014).
Parse’s (1981) original work was titled
Man-Living-Health: A Theory of Nursing.
When the term mankind was replaced with
male gender in the dictionary definition of man,
the name of the theory was changed to human
becoming (Parse, 1992). No aspect of the prin-
ciples changed at that time. With the publica-
tion of The Human Becoming School of Thought
(1998a), Parse expanded the original work to
include descriptions of three research method-
ologies and additional specifics related to the
practice methodology (Parse, 1987), thus clas-
sifying the science of humanbecoming as a
school of thought (Parse, 1997b). The funda-
mental idea of humanbecoming—that humans
are indivisible, unpredictable, everchanging, as
specified in the ontology—precludes any use
of terms such as physiological, biological, psycho-
logical, or spiritual to describe the human.
These terms are particulate, thus inconsistent
with the ontology. Other terms inconsistent
with humanbecoming include words often
used to describe people, such as noncompliant,
dysfunctional, and manipulative.
In 2007, Parse set forth a clarification of
the ontology of the school of thought. She
specified humanbecoming as one word and
humanuniverse as one word (Parse, 2007b).
Joining the words creates one concept and fur-
ther confirms the idea of indivisibility. She also
described postulates to clarify the ontology fur-
ther (Parse, 2007b). The ontology—that is, the
assumptions, postulates, and principles—sets
forth beliefs that are clearly different from
other nursing frameworks and theories. Disci-
pline-specific knowledge is articulated in
unique language specifying a position on the
phenomenon of concern for each discipline.
The humanbecoming language is unique to
nursing. For example, the three humanbecom-
ing principles contain nine concepts written in
verbal form with -ing endings to make clear
the importance of the ongoing process of
change as basic to humanuniverse emergence.
In addition, each concept is explicated with
paradoxes, not opposites, but rhythms, further
specifying the uniqueness of the humanbe-
coming language.
The humanbecoming encompasses the on-
tology, the epistemology, and the research and
practice methodologies as described here. In
2012, the school of thought was expanded and
new conceptualizations created the humanbe-
coming paradigm (Parse 2012a, 2013a, 2014).
The Ontology
The assumptions, postulates, and principles
of the humanbecoming paradigm comprise
the ontology (Parse, 2007b, 2012a, 2013a;
Fig. 15-2).
Philosophical Assumptions
The assumptions of the humanbecoming
paradigm are written at the philosophical level
of discourse (Parse, 1998a, 2010, 2012a,
2013a, 2014). There are nine fundamental
assumptions about humanuniverse, ethos of
humanbecoming, and living quality (Parse,
2013a, 2014). The assumptions arose begin-
ning with the first book in 1981, from a syn-
thesis of ideas from the science of unitary
human beings (Rogers, 1992) and from exis-
tential phenomenological thought, particularly
Heidegger, Merleau-Ponty, and Sartre; see
Parse, 1981, 1992, 1994a, 1995, 1997a, 1998a,
266 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch15_263-278 26/12/14 5:54 PM Page 266
2013a, 2014). In the assumptions, Parse posits
humanuniverse as indivisible, unpredictable,
and everchanging, cocreating unique becom-
ing. She also posits additional descriptions of
humanuniverse, ethos of humanbecoming, and
living quality. Living quality is the chosen way
of being in the becoming visible-invisible be-
coming of the emerging now (2012a, 2013a,
2014). Humans live an all-at-onceness, which
is the becoming visible-invisible of the emerg-
ing now, in freely choosing meanings that arise
with the illimitable (2007b, 2012a, 2013a,
2014). The chosen meanings are the value
priorities cocreated in transcending with the
possibles (Parse, 1998a).
Postulates and Principles
In 2007, Parse elaborated certain truths em-
bedded in the conceptualizations of the ontol-
ogy (2007b). In so doing she expanded the
idea of cocreating reality as a seamless sym-
phony of becoming (Parse, 1996), a central
thought foundational to the ontology, as fore-
grounded with four postulates of illimitability,
paradox, freedom, and mystery [See Parse
(2007b) for detailed descriptions of the postu-
lates]. The meanings of the postulates perme-
ate all three of the principles; the words of
the postulates are not used in the statements of
the principles. Thus, the wording has been clar-
ified to provide semantic consistency without
CHAPTER 15 • Rosemarie Rizzo Parse’s Humanbecoming Paradigm 267
Assumptions
Humanuniverse is
indivisible, unpredictable,
everchanging.
Humanuniverse is
cocreating reality
as a seamless symphony
of becoming.
Humanuniverse is
an illimitable mystery with
contextually construed
pattern preferences.
Ethos of humanbecoming
is dignity.
Ethos of humanbecoming
is august presence, a
noble bearing of
immanent distinctness.
Ethos of humanbecoming
is abiding truths of
presence, existence,
trust,
and worth.
Living quality is the
becoming visible-invisible
becoming
of the emerging now.
Living quality is the
everchanging whatness
of becoming.
Living quality is the
personal expression of
uniqueness.
Postulates
Illimitability is the
indivisible unbounded
knowing extended to
infinity, the all-at-once
remembering-prospecting
with the emerging now.
Paradox is an intricate
rhythm expressed as a
pattern preference.
Freedom is contextually
construed liberation.
Mystery is the unexplain-
able, that which cannot
be completely known
unequivocally.
Principles
Structuring meaning is
the imaging and valuing
of languaging.
Configuring rhythmical
patterns is the revealing-
concealing and
enabling-limiting of
connecting-separating.
Cotranscending with
possibles is the powering
and originating of
transforming.
Concepts and
Paradoxes
Imaging:
explicit-tacit; reflective-
prereflective
Valuing:
confirming–not
confirming
Languaging:
speaking–being silent;
moving–being still
Revealing-concealing:
disclosing–not disclosing
Enabling-limiting:
potentiating-restricting
Connecting-separating:
attending-distancing
Powering:
pushing-resisting;
affirming–not affirming;
being-nonbeing
Originating:
certainty-uncertainty;
conforming–not
conforming
Transforming:
familiar-unfamiliar
Copyright, Rosemarie Rizzo Parse, 2014
The Humanbecoming Ontology
Fig 15 • 2 The humanbecoming ontology. (Copyright ©2014, Rosemarie Rizzo Parse.)
3312_Ch15_263-278 26/12/14 5:54 PM Page 267
changing the original meaning of the princi-
ples. The principles of humanbecoming, often
referred to as the theory, describe the central
phenomenon of nursing (humanuniverse), and
arise from the three major themes of the as-
sumptions: meaning, rhythmicity, and tran-
scendence. Each principle describes a theme
with three concepts. Each of the concepts ex-
plicates fundamental paradoxes of humanbe-
coming (Parse, 1998a, 2007b). The paradoxes
are rhythms lived all-at-once as pattern pref-
erences (Parse, 2007b). Paradoxes are not op-
posites or problems to be solved but rather are
ways humans live their chosen meanings. This
way of viewing paradox is unique to the hu-
manbecoming school of thought (Mitchell,
1993a; Parse, 1981, 1994b, 2007b).
Statements of Principles
The statements of principles are presented in
detail in Parse (2007b, 2010, 2012a, 2013a,
2014). With the first principle (see Parse 1981,
1998a, 2007b, 2013a, 2014), Parse explicates
the idea that humans construct personal realities
with unique choosings arising with illimitable
humanuniverse options. Reality, the meaning
given to a situation, is the individual human’s
everchanging seamless symphony of becoming
(Parse, 1996). The seamless symphony is the
unique story of the human as mystery emerging
with the explicit-tacit knowings of imaging. The
human lives the confirming–not confirming of
valuing as cherished beliefs, while languaging
with speaking–being silent and moving–being
still in the becoming visible-invisible of the
emerging now (for details, see Parse 2007b,
2012a, 2013a, 2014).
The second principle (Parse, 1981, 1998a,
2007b, 2010) describes rhythmical humanuniverse
patterns. The paradoxical rhythm “revealing–
concealing is disclosing–not disclosing all-
at-once” (Parse, 1998a, p. 43). Not all is explic-
itly known or can be told in the unfolding
mystery of humanbecoming. “Enabling–limiting
is living the opportunities–restrictions present
in all choosings all-at-once” (Parse, 1998a, p. 44).
There are opportunities and restrictions what-
ever the choice; all choosings are potentiating–
restricting (see Parse, 2007b and 2014 for
details). “Connecting–separating is being with and
apart from others, ideas, objects and situations
all-at-once” (Parse, 1998a, p. 45). It is a coming
together and moving apart; there is closeness in
the separation and distance in the closeness—a
rhythmical attending–distancing (for details, see
Parse 2007b, 2012a, 2013a).
With the third principle, Parse (1981,
1998a, 2007b, 2010, 2012a, 2013a) explicated
the idea that humans are everchanging, that is,
moving on with the possibilities of their in-
tended hopes and dreams. A changing diversity
unfolds as humans affirm and do not affirm in
the pushing–resisting of powering, as creating
new ways of living the conformity–nonconfor-
mity and certainty–uncertainty of originating
sheds new light on the familiar–unfamiliar of
transforming. Powering is the pushing–resisting
of affirming–not affirming being in light of
nonbeing (Parse, 1998a, 2007b, 2012a, 2013a,
2014). The being–nonbeing rhythm is all-at-
once living the everchanging becoming visible-
invisible becoming of the emerging now.
Humans, in originating, seek to conform–not
conform, that is, to be like others and unique
all-at-once, while living the ambiguity of the
certainty–uncertainty embedded in all change.
The changing diversity arises with transforming
the familiar–unfamiliar, as illimitable possibles
are viewed in a different light.
The three principles, together with the
postulates and assumptions, comprise the
ontology of the humanbecoming school of
thought. The principles are referred to as
the humanbecoming theory. The concepts,
with the paradoxes, describe humanuniverse.
This ontological base gives rise to the episte-
mology and methodologies of humanbecom-
ing. Epistemology refers to the focus of
inquiry. Consistent with the humanbecoming
school of thought, the focus of inquiry is
universal living experiences (Parse, 2005,
2012a, 2013a).
Applications of Theory
Humanbecoming Research
Methodologies
Sciencing humanbecoming is coming to
know; it is an ongoing inquiry to discover and
understand the meaning of living experiences.
268 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch15_263-278 26/12/14 5:54 PM Page 268
of which have been published (for example,
Baumann, 2000, 2003, 2009, 2013; Bunkers,
2010, 2012; Condon, 2010; Doucet, 2012a,
2012b; Doucet & Bournes, 2007; MacDonald
& Jonas-Simpson, 2009; Maillard-Struby,
2012; Morrow, 2010; Naef & Bournes, 2009;
S. M. Smith, 2012, and many others). Parse
(1999a) was the principal investigator for a
nine-country research study on the living ex-
perience of hope using the Parse method, with
participants from Australia, Canada, Finland,
Italy, Japan, Sweden, Taiwan, the United
Kingdom, and the United States. The findings
from these studies and the stories of the par-
ticipants are published in Hope: An Interna-
tional Human Becoming Perspective (Parse,
1999a). Collaborative research projects using
the Parse research method have also been
published on feeling very tired (Baumann,
2003; Huch & Bournes, 2003; Parse, 2003b).
Six studies have been published in which au-
thors used the humanbecoming hermeneutic
method (Baumann, 2008; Baumann, Carroll,
Damgaard, Millar, & Welch, 2001; Cody,
1995, 2001; Ortiz, 2003; Parse, 2007a)
Living-the-art projects are initiated when a
researcher wishes to describe the changes, sat-
isfactions, and effectiveness when humanbe-
coming guides practice (Parse, 1998a, 2001,
2006). The major purpose of the project is to
understand what happens when humanbe-
coming is living nurse with person, family, and
community. A number of researchers have
conducted such living-the-art projects, all of
which demonstrated enhanced satisfaction
among persons, families, and communities
(Bournes & Ferguson-Paré, 2007, 2008;
Bournes et al., 2007; Jonas, 1995a; Legault &
Ferguson-Paré, 1999; Maillard-Strüby, 2007;
Mitchell, 1995; Northrup & Cody, 1998;
Santopinto & Smith, 1995), and a synthesis of
the findings of these and other such studies
was written and published (Bournes, 2002;
Doucet & Bournes, 2007).
Humanbecoming: Living the Art
The goal of the nurse living the humanbecom-
ing beliefs is true presence in bearing witness
and being with others in their changing pat-
terns of living quality. True presence is lived
CHAPTER 15 • Rosemarie Rizzo Parse’s Humanbecoming Paradigm 269
The humanbecoming research tradition has
two basic research methods (Parse, 1998a,
2005, 2011b). These two methods flow from
the ontology of the school of thought. The
basic research methods are the Parse method
(Parse, 1987, 1990, 1992, 1995, 1997a, 1998a,
2001, 2005, 2011b, 2012a, 2013a, 2014) and
the humanbecoming hermeneutic method (Cody,
1995; Parse, 1995, 1998a, 2001, 2005, 2011b,
2012a, 2013a, 2014). The humanbecoming
hermeneutic method was created in congru-
ence with the assumptions and principles of
Parse’s theory, drawing from works by Bern-
stein (1983), Gadamer (1976, 1960/1998),
Heidegger (1962), Langer (1976), and Ricoeur
(1976, 1981).
The purpose of these two basic research
methods is to advance the science of humanbe-
coming by studying universal living experiences
from participants’ descriptions (Parse method)
and from written texts and art forms (human-
becoming hermeneutic method). The phenom-
ena for study with the Parse method are
universal living experiences such as joy, sorrow,
hope, grieving, and courage, among others.
Written texts from any literary source or art
form may be the subject of sciencing with the
humanbecoming hermeneutic method. The
processes of both methods call for a unique
dialogue, researcher with participant, or re-
searcher with text or art form. The researcher in
the Parse Method is in true presence as the par-
ticipant moves with an unstructured dialogue
about the living experience under study. The re-
searcher in the humanbecoming hermeneutic
method is in true presence with the emerging
possibilities in the horizon of meaning arising
in dialogue with texts or art forms. True pres-
ence is an intense attentiveness to unfolding
essences and emergent meanings. The re-
searcher’s intent with these research methods is
to discover structures (Parse method) and emer-
gent meanings (humanbecoming hermeneutic
method; see Parse, 2001, 2005, 2011b, 2012a,
2013a, 2014). The contributions of the findings
from studies using these two methods include
“new knowledge and understanding of humanly
lived experiences” (Parse, 1998a, p. 62).
Many nurse scholars worldwide have con-
ducted studies using the Parse method, many
3312_Ch15_263-278 26/12/14 5:54 PM Page 269
nurse with person, family, and community in
illuminating meaning, synchronizing rhythms,
and mobilizing transcendence (Parse, 1987,
1992, 1994a, 1995, 1997a, 1998a, 2010, 2012a,
2013a, 2014). The nurse with individuals or
groups is in true presence with the unfolding
meanings as persons explicate, dwell with, and
move on with changing patterns of diversity.
Living true presence is unique to the art of
humanbecoming. True presence is not to be
confused with terms now prevalent in the lit-
erature such as authentic presence, transforming
presence, presencing, and others. It is sometimes
misinterpreted as simply asking persons what
they want. Often nurses say it is what they al-
ways do (Mitchell, 1993b); this is not true
presence. “True presence is an intentional re-
flective love, an interpersonal art grounded in
a strong knowledge base” (Parse, 1998a, p. 71).
The knowledge base underpinning true pres-
ence is specified in the assumptions, postulates,
and principles of humanbecoming (Parse,
1981, 1992, 1995, 1997a, 1998a, 2007b, 2010,
2012a, 2013a, 2014). True presence is a free-
flowing attentiveness in the emerging now that
arises from the belief that the humanuniverse is
indivisible, unpredictable, everchanging. Hu-
mans freely choose with situations, structure
personal meaning, live paradoxical rhythms,
and move beyond with changing diversity
(Parse, 1998a, 2007b, 2012a, 2013a, 2014).
Parse (1987, 1998b) states that to know, un-
derstand, and live the beliefs of humanbecom-
ing requires concentrated study of the ontology,
epistemology, and methodologies and a com-
mitment to a different way of being with
people. The different way that arises from the
humanbecoming beliefs is true presence.
True presence is a powerful humanuniverse
connection. It is lived in face-to-face discus-
sions, silent immersions, and lingering pres-
ence (Parse, 1987, 1998a). Nurses may be with
persons, families, and communities in discus-
sions, imaginings, or remembrances through
stories, films, drawings, photographs, movies,
metaphors, poetry, rhythmical movements,
and other expressions (Parse, 1998a).
Many publications explicate the art of true
presence with a variety of persons and groups.
(See, for example, Arndt, 1995; Banonis,
1995; Bournes, 2000, 2003, 2006; Bournes,
Bunkers, & Welch, 2004; Bournes & Flint,
2003; Bournes & Naef, 2006; Butler, 1988;
Butler & Snodgrass, 1991; Chapman,
Mitchell, & Forchuk, 1994; Cody, Mitchell,
Jonas-Simpson, & Maillard-Strüby, 2004;
Hansen-Ketchum, 2004; Hutchings, 2002; Jonas,
1994, 1995b; Jonas-Simpson & McMahon,
2005; Karnick, 2005, 2007; Lee & Pilkington,
1999; Mattice & Mitchell, 1990; Mitchell,
1988, 1990; Mitchell & Bournes, 2000;
Mitchell, Bournes, & Hollett, 2006; Mitchell
& Bunkers, 2003; Mitchell & Cody, 1999;
Mitchell & Copplestone, 1990; Mitchell &
Pilkington, 1990; Naef, 2006; Norris, 2002;
Paille & Pilkington, 2002; Quiquero, Knights,
& Meo, 1991; Rasmusson, 1995; Rasmusson,
Jonas, & Mitchell, 1991; M. K. Smith, 2002;
Stanley & Meghani, 2001; and others).
Living the Art of Humanbecoming
With Persons and Groups
It is important here to clarify some terminology.
Nursing practice is a generic term that refers to the
genre of activities of the profession in general.
The term practice is not appropriate to use when
referring to humanbecoming, because according
to various dictionary definitions it means a habit,
or to drill, exercise, try repeatedly, or do over and
over again. The word practice is antithetical to the
ontology, as a major focus of humanbecoming is
reverence, awe, human freedom, and dignity
(Parse, 2010). Humanbecoming nurses live the
art of the science of humanbecoming. The art of
humanbecoming refers to living true presence,
which arises directly from a sound understanding
of the ontology of the school of thought. True
presence flows only from nurses and health pro-
fessionals who have studied, understand, believe
in, and live the humanbecoming assumptions,
postulates, and principles. Living is the proper
term to describe what nurses experience when
with recipients of health care. Nurses and others
who live humanbecoming believe that persons,
families, and communities are the experts on
their own health-care situations, and all are
treated with dignity (Parse, 2010).
In nurse-with-person health-care situations,
nurses in true presence come to persons with
an availability to be with and bear witness, as
270 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch15_263-278 26/12/14 5:54 PM Page 270
persons illuminate the meaning of the situations,
shift rhythms, and inspire transcending in focus-
ing on the becoming visible-invisible becoming
of the emerging now (Parse, 1981, 1987, 1998a,
2007b, 2010, 2012a, 2013a, 2014). Illuminating
meaning, shifting rhythms, and inspiring trans-
forming occur in the true presence of the human-
becoming nurse, as persons explicate their
situations, dwell with the becoming visible-in-
visible becoming of the emerging now. In expli-
cating, dwelling with, and moving on, persons
experience new insights and even surprises, as sit-
uations are seen in the new light that arises with
the true presence of nurses who bear witness and
do not label. Labeling or diagnosing is objectify-
ing, ignoring the importance of persons’ dignity
and freedom (Parse, 2010). Humanbecoming
nurses believe that persons know their way and
live quality according to their unique value pri-
orities (Parse, 2012a, 2013a). Humanbecoming
nurses do not have a preset agenda or teaching
plan about what persons should or ought do but
rather listen carefully to the intents and desires
stated by persons because these intents are value
priorities that are the living choices of persons.
With recipients of health care, humanbecoming
nurses ask what is most important for the mo-
ment and explore meanings, wishes, intents, and
desires related to what is emerging now from the
perspective of the recipients and these guide
nurses’ participation (Parse, 2008e, 2012a, 2013a,
2014). What may seem important to the nurse
may not be what is important to the person. For
example, when a nurse (not living humanbecom-
ing) thought that fear about the new diagnosis of
lung cancer was the most important issue for a
person, she began to design a teaching plan to
inform the person about the disease; however,
when a humanbecoming nurse asked the person,
“What is the most important issue for you right
now?” the gentleman answered, “Telling my
family and continuing to work to care for them.”
The humanbecoming nurse continued to discuss
these concerns with the gentleman with no
agenda except the one set by the gentleman. Hu-
manbecoming nurses are with persons in ways
that honor their wishes and desires. Persons are
seamless symphonies of becoming, and nurses are
only one note in the symphony (Parse, 1996).
Living the Art of Humanbecoming
With Community
The humanbecoming school of thought is
a guide for research, practice, education, and
administration in settings throughout the
world. Scholars from five continents have
embraced the belief system and live humanbe-
coming in a variety of venues, including
health-care centers and university nursing pro-
grams. The Humanbecoming Community
Model (Parse, 2003a, 2014), the Humanbe-
coming Teaching–Learning Model (Parse,
2004, 2014), The Humanbecoming Mentoring
Model (Parse, 2008c, 2014), the Humanbe-
coming Leading–Following Model (Parse,
2008b, 2011a, 2014) , and the Humanbecom-
ing family model (Parse 2008a, 2009a, 2014)
are disseminated and used in practice settings
worldwide. Many health centers throughout
the world have humanbecoming as a guide to
health care (Bournes et al., 2004; Cody et al.,
2014). In several university-affiliated practice
settings in Canada, humanbecoming practice
has been evaluated, and the theory has provided
underpinnings for standards of care (Bournes,
2002; Legault & Ferguson-Paré, 1999;
Mitchell, 1998; Mitchell, Closson, Coulis,
Flint, & Gray, 2000; Northrup & Cody, 1998)
and nursing best practice guidelines (Nelligan
et al., 2002). For example, in Toronto, Sunny-
brook Health Science Centre and University
Health Network had created multidisciplinary
standards of care that arise from the beliefs and
values of the humanbecoming school of
thought.
In settings worldwide where humanbecom-
ing has guided nursing practice on a large scale,
researchers examined the effects on the nurses
and persons who were involved (Bournes &
Ferguson-Paré, 2007, 2008; Bournes et al.,
2007; Jonas, 1995a; Legault & Ferguson-Paré,
1999; Maillard-Strüby, 2007; Mitchell, 1995;
Northrup & Cody, 1998; Santopinto & Smith,
1995). The findings of the studies describe what
happened when humanbecoming was used as a
guide for nursing practice on an orthopedic
surgery and rheumatology unit (Bournes &
Ferguson-Paré, 2007), on a cardiac surgery unit
(Bournes et al., 2007), on a medical oncology
CHAPTER 15 • Rosemarie Rizzo Parse’s Humanbecoming Paradigm 271
3312_Ch15_263-278 26/12/14 5:54 PM Page 271
unit and a general surgery unit (Bournes &
Ferguson-Paré, 2008), in a family practice unit
affiliated with a large teaching hospital (Jonas,
1995a), on a 41-bed vascular and general sur-
gery unit (Legault & Ferguson-Paré, 1999), on
an acute care medical unit (Mitchell, 1995), on
three acute care psychiatry units (Northrup
& Cody, 1998), on three units in a 400-bed
community teaching hospital (Santopinto &
Smith, 1995), and on a medical oncology unit
(Maillard-Strüby, 2007). The findings from
five of the studies are summarized in Bournes
(2002) and are consistent with those of more
recent evaluations (Bournes & Ferguson-Paré,
2007, 2008; Bournes et al., 2007; Maillard-
Strüby, 2007).
Bournes and Ferguson-Paré (2007, 2008)
and Bournes, Plummer, Hollett, and Ferguson-
Paré (2008) examined the impact of an inno-
vative academic employment model (the
humanbecoming 80/20 model—in which nurses
spent 80 percent of their paid work time in direct
patient care guided by humanbecoming and
20 percent of their paid work time learning
about humanbecoming and engaging in re-
lated professional development activities). The
humanbecoming 80/20 model has been imple-
mented on four units—three in Toronto, On-
tario (Bournes & Ferguson-Paré, 2007, 2008)
and one in Regina, Saskatchewan (Bournes
et al., 2007). The Regina project was imple-
mented in collaboration with Regina Qu’Ap-
pelle Health Region and the Saskatchewan
Union of Nurses.
Findings from the research (Bournes &
Ferguson-Paré, 2007, 2008; Bournes et al.,
2007) to evaluate implementation of the hu-
manbecoming 80/20 model have been ex-
tremely positive. For example, interviews with
nurses, patients, families, and other health pro-
fessionals in the Bournes and Ferguson-Paré
(2007) study “supported the humanbecoming
theory as an effective basis for learning and im-
plementing patient-entered care that benefits
both nurses and patients” (p. 251). Patients
and families in that study “reported that they
appreciated the reverent consideration given
to them by nurses who had learned about
humanbecoming-guided patient-centered care”
(p. 251). They also described “being confident
engaging in discussions with nurses who
understood and attentive experts interested
in who they were and what was important
to them” (p. 251). Similarly, the nurse par-
ticipants in Bournes and Ferguson-Paré’s
(2007) and Bournes and colleagues’ (2008)
studies reported that after learning about
humanbecoming-guided nursing practice, they
were more concerned with listening to patients
and families, being with them, getting to know
what is important to them, and respecting
them as the experts about their quality of life.
They also reported being more satisfied with
their work—a theme noted by nurse leaders
and allied health participants who shared that
nurses listened more and focused on patients’
perspectives. (Bournes & Ferguson-Paré,
2007, p. 251)
Participants in both studies described the
benefits of the program—not only in relation
to how it changed their relationships with pa-
tients but also in relation to how it changed
their view of how to be with their colleagues
in more meaningful ways (see Bournes &
Ferguson-Paré, 2007; Bournes et al., 2007).
In addition, study findings show that the cost
of providing education about humanbecom-
ing-guided practice and staffing the 80/20 as-
pect of the model is offset by higher nurse
and patient satisfaction scores and a reduction
in sick time and overtime (Bournes & Fergu-
son-Paré, 2007; Bournes et al., 2007). At a
large academic teaching hospital, the human-
becoming 80/20 model has been tested as the
basis for a mentoring program among expe-
rienced critical care nurses and new nurses
who want to work in critical care (Bournes et
al., 2008). The mentoring program is based
on the Humanbecoming Mentoring Model
(Parse, 2008c).
In South Dakota, a parish nursing model
was built on the Eight Beatitudes and the
principles of humanbecoming to guide nurs-
ing practice in the health model at the First
Presbyterian Church in Sioux Falls (Bunkers,
1998a, 1998b; Bunkers, Michaels, & Ethridge,
1997; Bunkers & Putnam, 1995). Bunkers
and Putnam (1995) stated, “The nurse, in
272 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch15_263-278 26/12/14 5:54 PM Page 272
practicing from the human becoming perspec-
tive and emphasizing the teachings of the
Beatitudes, believes in the endless possibilities
present for persons when there is openness,
caring, and honoring of justice and human
freedom” (p. 210). Also, the Board of Nursing
of South Dakota has adopted a decisioning
model based on the humanbecoming school
of thought (Damgaard & Bunkers, 1998,
2012). Augustana College (in Sioux Falls)
has humanbecoming as one theoretical focus
of the curricula for the baccalaureate and
master’s programs. The humanbecoming
theory was the basis of Augustana’s Health
Action Model for Partnership in Commu-
nity (Bunkers, Nelson, Leuning, Crane, &
Josephson, 1999). “The purpose of the model
is to respond in a new way to nursing’s social
mandate to care for the health of society by
gaining an understanding of what is wanted
from those living these health experiences”
(Bunkers et al., 1999, p. 94). The creation of
the model was “for persons homeless and low
income who are challenged with the lack of
economic, social and interpersonal resources”
(Bunkers et al., 1999, p. 92).
The humanbecoming school of thought is
the theoretical foundation of the baccalaure-
ate and master’s curricula at the California
Baptist University College of Nursing in
Riverside, California. Faculty and students
learn and live the art of humanbecoming in
the various venues where they practice. The
Nursing Center for Health Promotion with
the Charlotte Rainbow PRISM Model was
established in Charlotte, North Carolina, as
a venue for nurses to offer health-care deliv-
ery to homeless women and children with
diverse backgrounds. The PRISM Model,
based on humanbecoming, was the guide to
practice (Cody, 2003). At the Espace Medi-
ane community nursing center in Geneva,
Switzerland (for persons who have concerns
about cancer and palliative care), practice and
teaching–learning are guided by humanbe-
coming, meaning that nurses in the center
live true presence with visitors. They also link
with academic partners to provide an academic
service for postgraduate nursing students
specializing in oncology and palliative care
(Cody et al., 2004). The purpose of another
project was to evaluate what happens when
the art of humanbecoming was initiated in a
palliative care inpatient setting in Fribourg,
Switzerland (F. Maillard-Strüby, personal
communication, August, 7, 2008).
Shifting practice from the traditional
medical model mode to living the art of
humanbecoming is a challenge for health-care
institutions and requires high-level adminis-
trative commitment for resources, including
educational opportunities for nurses. The com-
mitment to humanbecoming practice requires
a change in value priorities systemwide
(Bournes, 2002; Bournes & DasGupta, 1997;
Linscott, Spee, Flint, & Fisher, 1999; Mitchell
et al., 2000).
Approximately 300 participants worldwide
who are interested in living the art of humanbe-
coming subscribe to Parse-L, an e-mail listserv
where Parse scholars share ideas. There is a Parse
home page on the Internet that is updated
regularly (see www.humanbecoming.org). Every
other year, most of the 100 or more members
of the International Consortium of Parse Schol-
ars meet in Canada or the United States for a
weekend immersion in humanbecoming theory,
research, and practice. The DVD The Human
Becoming School of Thought: Living the Art
of Human Becoming (International Consortium
of Parse Scholars, 2007; available from the Con-
sortium at www.humanbecoming.org) shows
Parse nurses in true presence with persons in dif-
ferent settings and features Rosemarie Rizzo
Parse talking about humanbecoming in prac-
tice. Parse is also featured on the video in the
Portraits of Excellence Series called Rosemarie
Rizzo Parse: Human Becoming (Fitne, 1997),
available from Fitne (www.fitne.net). Another
video showing nurse with persons is The Grief
of Miscarriage (Gerretsen & Pilkington, 1990).
There is also a video called I’m Still Here, which
is a humanbecoming research-based drama on
living with dementia (Ivonoffski, Mitchell,
Krakauer, & Jonas-Simpson, 2006). It is avail-
able from the Murray Alzheimer Research
and Education Program at the University of
Waterloo.
CHAPTER 15 • Rosemarie Rizzo Parse’s Humanbecoming Paradigm 273
3312_Ch15_263-278 26/12/14 5:54 PM Page 273
274 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
1 For additional information please go to bonus chapter
content available at FA Davis http://davisplus.
fadavis.com
■ Summary
Through the efforts of Parse scholars, the hu-
manbecoming paradigm continues to emerge
as a major force in the 21st-century evolution
of nursing knowledge. Knowledge gained
from basic research studies continue to be
synthesized to explicate further the meaning of
living experiences. The findings from living the
art research projects related to fostering under-
standing of humanbecoming with persons,
families, and communities also continue to be
synthesized. These syntheses guide decisions for
continually creating the vision for sciencing and
living the art of the humanbecoming paradigm
for the betterment of humankind.
References1
Arndt, M. J. (1995). Parse’s theory of human becoming
in practice with hospitalized adolescents. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 8, 86–90.
Banonis, B. C. (1995). Metaphors in the practice of the
human becoming theory. In R. R. Parse (Ed.), Illu-
minations: The human becoming theory in practice and
research (pp. 87–95). New York: National League for
Nursing Press.
Barrett, E. A. M. (2010). Power as knowing participa-
tion in change: What’s new and what’s next. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 23, 47–55.
Baumann, S. L. (2000). The lived experience of feeling
loved: A study of mothers in a parolee program.
Nursing Science Quarterly 13, 332–338.
Baumann, S. L. (2003). The lived experience of feeling
very tired: A study of adolescent girls. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 16, 326–333.
Baumann, S. (2008). Wisdom, compassion & courage in
the Wizard of Oz: A humanbecoming hermeneutic
study. Nursing Science Quarterly, 21, 322-329.
Baumann, S. L. (2009). Feeling fear: A humanbecoming
study with older adults. Nursing Science Quarterly, 22,
346–354.
Baumann, S. L. (2013). Feeling bored: A Parse research
method study. Nursing Science Quarterly, 26, 42-52.
Baumann, S., Carroll, K. A., Damgaard, G. A., Millar,
B., Welch, A. J. (2001). An International Human
Becoming Hermeneutic Study of Tom Hegg’s A
Cup of Christmas Tea. Nursing Science Quarterly. 14,
316-322.
Benedict, L. L., Bunkers, S. S., Damgaard, G. A.,
Duffy, C. E., Hohman, M. L., & Vander Woude,
D. L. (2000). The South Dakota board of nursing
theory–based regulatory decisioning model. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 13, 167–171.
Bernstein, R. J. (1983). Beyond objectivism and relativism:
Science, hermeneutics, and praxis. Philadelphia:
University of Pennsylvania Press.
Bournes, D. A. (2000). A commitment to honoring
people’s choices. Nursing Science Quarterly, 13, 18–23.
Bournes, D. A. (2002). Research evaluating human
becoming in practice. Nursing Science Quarterly,
15, 190–195.
Bournes, D. A. (2003). Stories of courage and confi-
dence: Interpretation with the human becoming
community change concepts. In R. R. Parse, Com-
munity: A human becoming perspective (pp. 131–145).
Sudbury, MA: Jones and Bartlett.
Bournes, D. A. (2006). Human becoming–guided
practice. Nursing Science Quarterly, 19, 329–330.
Bournes, D. A., Bunker, S. S., & Welch, A. J. (2004).
The theory of human becoming in action: Scope and
challenges. Nursing Science Quarterly, 17(3), 227–232.
Bournes, D. A., & DasGupta, D. (1997). Professional
practice leader: A transformational role that addresses
human diversity. Nursing Administration Quarterly,
21(4), 61–68.
Bournes, D. A., & Ferguson-Paré, M. (2007). Human
becoming and 80/20: An innovative professional
development model for nurses. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 20, 237–253.
Bournes, D. A., & Ferguson-Paré, M. (2008). The
humanbecoming 80/20 study: Second study in Toronto.
Unpublished manuscript.
Bournes, D. A., Ferguson-Paré, M., Plummer, C., Kyle,
C., Larrivee, D., & LeMoal, L. (2007, November).
Innovations in nurse retention and patient centered care:
The 80/20 study in Regina. Poster panel presentation
at Celebrating New Knowledge and Innovation,
University Health Network Nursing Research Day,
Old Mill Inn and Spa, Toronto, ON.
Bournes, D. A., & Flint, F. (2003). Mis-Takes: Mis-
takes in the nurse-person process. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 16, 127–130.
Bournes, D. A., & Naef, R. (2006). Human becoming
practice around the globe: Exploring the art of living
true presence. Nursing Science Quarterly, 19, 109–115.
Bournes, D. A., Plummer, C., Hollett, J., & Ferguson-
Paré, M. (2008). Critical care mentoring study: Testing
a humanbecoming mentoring program to enhance reten-
tion and recruitment of nurses. Unpublished manuscript.
Bunkers, S. S. (1998a). A nursing theory–guided model
of health ministry: Human becoming in parish nurs-
ing. Nursing Science Quarterly, 11, 7–8.
3312_Ch15_263-278 26/12/14 5:54 PM Page 274
CHAPTER 15 • Rosemarie Rizzo Parse’s Humanbecoming Paradigm 275
Bunkers, S. S. (1998b). Translating nursing conceptual
frameworks and theory for nursing practice in the
parish community. In A. Solari-Twadell & M.
McDermott (Eds.), Parish nursing (pp. 205–214).
Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Bunkers, S. S. (2010). The lived experience of feeling
sad. Nursing Science Quarterly, 23, 231-239.
Bunkers, S. S. (2012). The lived experience of feeling
disappointed: A Parse research method study.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 25, 53-61.
Bunkers, S. S., Michaels, C., & Ethridge, P. (1997).
Advanced practice nursing in community: Nursing’s
opportunity. Advanced Practice Nursing Quarterly,
2(4), 79–84.
Bunkers, S. S., Nelson, M. L., Leuning, C. J., Crane, J.
K., & Josephson, D. K. (1999). The health action
model: Academia’s partnership with the community.
In E. L. Cohen & V. DeBack (Eds.), The outcomes
mandate: Case management in health care today
(pp. 92–100). St. Louis, MO: C. V. Mosby.
Bunkers, S. S., & Putnam, V. (1995). A nursing theory–
based model of health ministry: Living Parse’s theory
of human becoming in the parish community. In
Ninth Annual Westberg Parish Nurse Symposium:
Parish nursing: Ministering through the arts. North-
brook, IL: International Parish Nursing Resource
Center–Advocate Health Care.
Butler, M. J. (1988). Family transformation: Parse’s
theory in practice. Nursing Science Quarterly, 1, 68–74.
Butler, M. J., & Snodgrass, F. G. (1991). Beyond abuse:
Parse’s theory in practice. Nursing Science Quarterly,
4, 76–82.
Chapman, J. S., Mitchell, G. J., & Forchuk, C. (1994).
A glimpse of nursing theory–based practice in
Canada. Nursing Science Quarterly, 7, 104–112.
Cody, W. K. (1995). Of life immense in passion, pulse,
and power: Dialoguing with Whitman and Parse, a
hermeneutic study. In R. R. Parse (Ed.), Illumina-
tions: The human becoming theory in practice and re-
search (pp. 269–307). New York: National League
for Nursing Press.
Cody, W. K. (2001). “Mendacity” as the refusal to bear
witness: A human becoming hermeneutic study of a
theme from Tennessee Williams’ “Cat on a Hot Tin
Roof.” In R. R. Parse (Ed.), Qualitative inquiry: The
path of sciencing (pp. 205–220). Sudbury, MA: Jones
and Bartlett.
Cody, W. K. (2003). Human becoming community
change concepts in an academic nursing practice
setting. In R. R. Parse (Ed.), Community: A human
becoming perspective (pp. 49–71). Sudbury, MA:
Jones and Bartlett.
Cody, W. K., Mitchell, G. J., Jonas-Simpson, C., &
Maillard-Strüby, F. V. (2004). Human becoming:
Scope and challenges continued. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 17, 324–329.
Condon, B. B. (2010). The lived experience of feeling
misunderstood. Nursing Science Quarterly, 23(2),
138-147.
Damgaard, G. (2012). High altitude leadership and the
humanbecoming leading-following model: An exec-
utive director’s perspective. Nursing Science Quarterly,
25, 370-374.
Damgaard, G., & Bunkers, S. S. (1998). Nursing science–
guided practice and education: A state board of nurs-
ing perspective. Nursing Science Quarterly, 11, 142–144.
Damgaard, G., & Bunkers, S. S. (2012). Revisited: The
South Dakota Board of Nursing theory-based regu-
latory decisioning model. Nursing Science Quarterly,
25, 211–216.
Doucet, T. J. (2012a). Feeling strong: A Parse research
method study. Nursing Science Quarterly, 25, 62–71.
Doucet, T. J. (2012b). A humanbecoming program of
research: Having faith. Nursing Science Quarterly,
25, 20–24.
Doucet, T., & Bournes, D. A. (2007). Review of re-
search related to Parse’s theory of human becoming.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 20, 16–32.
Fitne. (1997). Portraits of excellence: Rosemarie Rizzo
Parse: Human becoming [CD-ROM]. Athens, OH:
Author. (Available from www.fitne.net)
Gadamer, H. -G. (1976). Philosophical hermeneutics (D. E.
Linge, trans.). Berkeley, CA: University of California.
Gadamer, H.-G. (1998). Truth and method (2nd rev.
ed.; J. Weinsheimer & D. G. Marshall, Trans.).
New York: Continuum. (Original work published
1960)
Gerretsen, P. (Producer), & Pilkington, F. B.
(Consultant). (1990). The grief of miscarriage [video].
Toronto, Canada: St. Michael’s Hospital.
Hansen-Ketchum, P. (2004). Parse’s theory in practice.
Journal of Holistic Nursing, 22, 57–72.
Heidegger, M. (1962). Being and time (J. Macquarrie &
E. Robinson, trans.). New York: Harper & Row.
Huch, M. H., & Bournes, D. A. (2003). Community
dwellers’ perspectives on the experience of feeling
very tired. Nursing Science Quarterly, 16, 334–339.
Hutchings, D. (2002). Parallels in practice: Palliative
nursing practice and Parse’s theory of human becom-
ing. American Journal of Hospice and Palliative Care,
19, 408–414.
International Consortium of Parse Scholars. (2007).
The human becoming school of thought: Living the art of
human becoming [DVD]. Toronto, Canada: Author.
Ivonoffski, V., Mitchell, G. J., Krakauer, R., Jonas-
Simpson, C. (Writers), & Dennis, G. (Producer).
(2006). I’m still here [DVD]. Waterloo, Canada:
Murray Alzheimer Research and Education Program.
Jonas, C. M. (1994). True presence through music.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 7, 102–103.
Jonas, C. M. (1995a). Evaluation of the human becom-
ing theory in family practice. In R. R. Parse (Ed.),
Illuminations: The human becoming theory in practice
and research (pp. 347–366). New York: National
League for Nursing Press.
Jonas, C. M. (1995b). True presence through music for
persons living their dying. In R. R. Parse (Ed.), Illu-
minations: The human becoming theory in practice and
3312_Ch15_263-278 26/12/14 5:54 PM Page 275
research (pp. 97–104). New York: National League
for Nursing Press.
Jonas-Simpson, C., & McMahon, E. (2005). The
language of loss when a baby dies prior to birth:
Cocreating human experience. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 18, 124–130.
Karnick, P. M. (2005). Human becoming theory with
children. Nursing Science Quarterly, 18, 221–226.
Karnick, P. M. (2007). Nursing practice: Imaging the
possibles. Nursing Science Quarterly, 20, 44–47.
Langer, S. (1976). Philosophy in a new key. Cambridge,
MA: Harvard University Press.
Lee, O. J., & Pilkington, F. B. (1999). Practice with
persons living their dying: A human becoming per-
spective. Nursing Science Quarterly, 12, 324–328.
Legault, F., & Ferguson-Paré, M. (1999). Advancing
nursing practice: An evaluation study of Parse’s the-
ory of human becoming. Canadian Journal of Nursing
Leadership, 12(1), 30–35.
Linscott, J., Spee, R., Flint, F., & Fisher, A. (1999).
Creating a culture of patient-focused care through a
learner-centred philosophy. Canadian Journal of
Nursing Leadership, 12(4), 5–10.
MacDonald, C. A., & Jonas-Simpson, C. M. (2009).
Living with changing expectations for women living
with high risk pregnancies: A Parse method study.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 22(1), 74-82.
Maillard-Strüby, F. (2007, March). Evaluation of the
humanbecoming theory in practice. Paper presented at
the 2nd International Congress of the University of
Applied Studies. Freiburg, Switzerland.
Maillard-Struby, F. (2012). Feeling unsure: A lived
experience of humanbecoming. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 25, 72–81.
Mattice, M., & Mitchell, G. J. (1990). Caring for con-
fused elders. The Canadian Nurse, 86(11), 16–18.
Mitchell, G. J. (1988). Man-living-health: The theory in
practice. Nursing Science Quarterly, 1, 120–127.
Mitchell, G. J. (1990). Struggling in change: From the
traditional approach to Parse’s theory-based practice.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 3, 170–176.
Mitchell, G. J. (1993a). Living paradox in Parse’s theory.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 6, 44–51.
Mitchell, G. J. (1993b). The same-thing-yet-different
phenomenon: A way of coming to know—or not?
Nursing Science Quarterly, 6, 61–62.
Mitchell, G. J. (1995). The lived experience of restriction-
freedom in later life. In R. R. Parse (Ed.), Illumina-
tions: The human becoming theory in practice and
research (pp. 159–195). New York: National League
for Nursing Press.
Mitchell, G. J. (1998). Standards of nursing and the
winds of change. Nursing Science Quarterly, 11, 97–98.
Mitchell, G. J., & Bournes, D. A. (2000). Nurse as
patient advocate? In search of straight thinking.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 13, 204–209.
Mitchell, G. J., Bournes, D. A., & Hollett, J. (2006).
Human becoming–guided patient-centered care: A
new model transforms nursing practice. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 19, 218–224.
Mitchell, G. J., & Bunkers, S. S. (2003). Engaging the
abyss: A mis-take of opportunity? Nursing Science
Quarterly, 16, 121–125.
Mitchell, G. J., Closson, T., Coulis, N., Flint, F., &
Gray, B. (2000). Patient-focused care and human
becoming thought: Connecting the right stuff.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 13, 216–224.
Mitchell, G. J., & Cody, W. K. (1999). Human becom-
ing theory: A complement to medical science.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 12, 304–310.
Mitchell, G. J., & Copplestone, C. (1990). Applying
Parse’s theory to perioperative nursing: A nontradi-
tional approach. AORN Journal, 51, 787–798.
Mitchell, G. J., & Pilkington, B. (1990). Theoretical
approaches in nursing practice: A comparison of
Roy and Parse. Nursing Science Quarterly, 3, 81–87.
Morrow, M. R. (2010). Feeling unsure: A universal
lived experience. Nursing Science Quarterly, 23(4),
315-325.
Naef, R. (2006). Bearing witness: A moral way of
engaging in the nurse-person relationship. Nursing
Philosophy, 3, 146–156.
Naef, R., & Bournes, D. A. (2009). The lived experience
of waiting: A Parse method study. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 22(2), 141-53.
Nelligan, P., Balfour, J., Connolly, L., Grinspun, D.,
Jonas-Simpson, C., Lefebre, N., et al. (2002). Nurs-
ing best practice guideline: Client centred care. Toronto,
Canada: Registered Nurses Association of Ontario.
Norris, J. R. (2002). One-to-one teleapprenticeship asa
means for nurses teaching and learning Parse’s theory
of human becoming. Nursing Science Quarterly, 15,
113–116.
Northrup, D., & Cody, W. K. (1998). Evaluation of
the human becoming theory in practice in an acute
care psychiatric setting. Nursing Science Quarterly,
11, 23–30.
Ortiz, M. R. (2003). Lingering presence: A study using
the human becoming hermeneutic method. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 16, 146–154.
Paille, M., & Pilkington, F. B. (2002). The global
context of nursing: A human becoming perspective.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 15, 165–170.
Parse, R. R. (1974). Nursing fundamentals. Flushing,
NY: Medical Examination.
Parse, R. R. (1981). Man-living-health: A theory of
nursing. New York: Wiley.
Parse, R. R. (1987). Nursing science: Major paradigms,
theories, and critiques. Philadelphia: W. B. Saunders.
Parse, R. R. (1990). Parse’s research methodology with
an illustration of the lived experience of hope.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 3, 9–17.
Parse, R. R. (1992). Human becoming: Parse’s theory
of nursing. Nursing Science Quarterly, 5, 35–42.
Parse, R. R. (1994a). Laughing and health: A study
using Parse’s research method. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 7, 55–64.
Parse, R. R. (1994b). Quality of life: Sciencing and
living the art of human becoming. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 7, 16–21.
276 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch15_263-278 26/12/14 5:54 PM Page 276
Parse, R. R. (Ed.). (1995). Illuminations: The human
becoming theory in practice and research. New York:
National League for Nursing Press.
Parse, R. R. (1996). Reality: A seamless symphony of
becoming. Nursing Science Quarterly, 9, 181–183.
Parse, R. R. (1997a). The human becoming theory:
The was, is, and will be. Nursing Science Quarterly,
10, 32–38.
Parse, R. R. (1997b). The language of nursing knowl-
edge: Saying what we mean. In J. Fawcett & I. M.
King (Eds.), The language of theory and metatheory
(pp. 73–77). Indianapolis, IN: Sigma Theta Tau
International Center Nursing Press.
Parse, R. R. (1998a). The human becoming school of
thought. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Parse, R. R. (1998b). On true presence. Illuminations,
7(3), 1.
Parse, R. R. (1999a). Hope: An international human be-
coming perspective. Sudbury, MA: Jones and Bartlett.
Parse, R. R. (1999b). Nursing: The discipline and the
profession. Nursing Science Quarterly, 12, 275.
Parse, R. R. (2001). Qualitative inquiry: The path of
sciencing. Sudbury, MA: Jones and Bartlett.
Parse, R. R. (2003a). Community: A human becoming
perspective. Sudbury, MA: Jones and Bartlett.
Parse, R. R. (2003b). The lived experience of feeling very
tired: A study using the Parse research method.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 16, 319–325.
Parse, R. R. (2004). A human becoming teaching-
learning model. Nursing Science Quarterly, 17, 33–35.
Parse, R. R. (2005). The human becoming modes of in-
quiry: Emerging sciencing. Nursing Science Quarterly,
18, 297–300.
Parse, R. R. (2006). Research findings evince benefits of
nursing theory–guided practice. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 19, 87.
Parse, R. R. (2007a). Hope in “Rita Hayworth and
Shawshank Redemption”: A human becoming
hermeneutic study. Nursing Science Quarterly, 20,
148–154.
Parse, R. R. (2007b). The humanbecoming school of
thought in 2050. Nursing Science Quarterly, 20, 308.
Parse, R. R. (2008a, June). The humanbecoming family
model. Paper presented at the Institute of Humanbe-
coming, Pittsburgh, PA.
Parse, R. R. (2008b). The humanbecoming leading-following
model. Nursing Science Quarterly, 21(4), 369–375.
Parse, R. R. (2008c). A humanbecoming mentoring
model. Nursing Science Quarterly, 21, 195–198.
Parse, R. R. (2008d). Nursing knowledge development:
Who’s to say how? Nursing Science Quarterly, 21, 101.
Parse, R. R. (2008e). Truth for the moment: Personal
testimony as evidence. Nursing Science Quarterly, 21,
45–48.
Parse, R. R. (2009a). The humanbecoming family
model. Nursing Science Quarterly, 22, 305-309.
Parse, R. R. (2009b). Knowledge development and pro-
grams of research. Nursing Science Quarterly, 22, 5–6.
Parse, R. R. (2009c). Mixed methods or mixed meanings
in research? Nursing Science Quarterly, 22, 101.
Parse, R. R. (2010). Human dignity: A humanbecoming
ethical phenomenon. Nursing Science Quarterly, 23,
257–262.
Parse, R. R. (2011a). Humanbecoming leading-following:
The meaning of holding up the mirror. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 24, 169-171.
Parse, R. R. (2011b). The humanbecoming modes of
inquiry: Refinements. Nursing Science Quarterly,
24, 11–15.
Parse, R. R. (2011c). What people want from profes-
sional nurses. Nursing Science Quarterly, 24, 93.
Parse, R. R. (2012a). New humanbecoming conceptual-
izations and the humanbecoming community model:
Expansions with sciencing and living the art. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 25, 44–52.
Parse, R. R. (2012b). “The things we make, make us”
Nursing Science Quarterly, 25, 125.
Parse, R. R. (2013a). Living quality: A humanbecom-
ing phenomenon. Nursing Science Quarterly, 26(2),
111–115.
Parse, R. R. (2013b). “What we’ve got here is failure to
communicate”: The meaning of the term nursing
perspective. Nursing Science Quarterly, 26, 5–7.
Parse, R. R., Coyne, B. A., & Smith, M. J. (1985). Nurs-
ing research: Qualitative methods. Bowie, MD: Brady.
Parse, R. R. (2014). The humanbecoming paradigm: a trans-
formational worldview. Pittsburgh, PA: Discovery
International Publications.
Quiquero, A., Knights, D., & Meo, C. O. (1991). The-
ory as a guide to practice: Staff nurses choose Parse’s
theory. Canadian Journal of Nursing Administration,
4(1), 14–16.
Rasmusson, D. L. (1995). True presence with homeless
persons. In R. R. Parse (Ed.), Illuminations: The human
becoming theory in practice and research (pp. 105–113).
New York: National League for Nursing Press.
Rasmusson, D. L., Jonas, C. M., & Mitchell, G. J. (1991).
The eye of the beholder: Parse’s theory with homeless
individuals. Clinical Nurse Specialist, 5(3), 139–143.
Ricoeur, P. (1976). Interpretation theory: Discourse and the
surplus of meaning. Fort Worth, TX: Texas Christian
University Press.
Ricoeur, P. (1981). Hermeneutics and human sciences
(J. B. Thompson, trans.). Paris: Cambridge.
Rogers, M. E. (1992). Nursing science and the space
age. Nursing Science Quarterly, 5, 27–34.
Santopinto, M. D. A., & Smith, M. C. (1995). Evaluation
of the human becoming theory in practice with adults
and children. In R. R. Parse (Ed.), Illuminations: The
human becoming theory in practice and research (pp. 309–
346). New York: National League for Nursing Press.
Smith, M. K. (2002). Human becoming and women
living with violence. Nursing Science Quarterly, 15,
302–307.
Smith, S. M. (2012). The lived experience of doing the
right thing: A Parse method study. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 25, 82–89.
Stanley, G. D., & Meghani, S. H. (2001). Reflections on
using Parse’s theory of human becoming in a palliative
care setting in Pakistan. Canadian Nurse, 97, 23–25.
CHAPTER 15 • Rosemarie Rizzo Parse’s Humanbecoming Paradigm 277
3312_Ch15_263-278 26/12/14 5:54 PM Page 277
3312_Ch15_263-278 26/12/14 5:54 PM Page 278
Chapter 16Margaret Newman’s Theory
of Health as Expanding
Consciousness
MARGARET DEXHEIMER PHARRIS
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Theory
Applications of the Theory
Practice Exemplar
Summary
References
279
Introducing the Theorist
Nurses who base their practice on Margaret
Newman’s theory of health as expanding con-
sciousness (HEC) focus on being fully present
to meaning and patterns in the lives of their
patients. Newman (2005) stated, “[O]ne does
not practice nursing using the theory, but
rather the theory becomes a way of being with
the client—a way of offering clients an oppor-
tunity to know and be known and to find their
way” (p. xiv). Through their relationship with
a nurse who understands the theory of HEC
and attends to the evolving pattern of what is
meaningful in their lives, patients are able to
realize a previously undiscovered path for ac-
tion. Just as patients’ health predicaments are
situated within the evolving pattern of complex
relationships and events in their lives, so too,
Newman’s theory has evolved within the con-
text of the meaningful relationships and events
of her life.
After graduating from Baylor University,
Newman returned to Memphis to work and to
care for her mother, who had been diagnosed
a few years earlier with amyotrophic lateral
sclerosis (ALS), a degenerative neurological
disease that progressively diminishes the
movement of all muscles except those of the
eyes. The process of caring for her mother over
a 5-year period was transformative. Not know-
ing the trajectory of the disease, Newman
learned to live day by day, fully immersed
in the present (Newman, 2008b). Newman
(2008a) stated she learned that “each day is
precious and that the time of one’s life is con-
tained in the present” (p. 225).
Caring for her mother provided Newman
with two additional significant realizations.
Margaret A. Newman
I don’t like controlling,
manipulating other people.
I don’t like deceiving, withholding,
or treating people as subjects or objects.
I don’t like acting as an objective non-person.
I do like interacting authentically, listening,
understanding, communicating freely.
I do like knowing and expressing myself in
mutual relationships.
—MARGARET NEWMAN (1985)
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 279
The first was that simply having a disease
does not make a person unhealthy. Although
Newman’s mother’s life was confined by the
disease, her life was not defined by it. In other
words, she could experience health and whole-
ness in the midst of having a chronic and
progressive disease. The second important re-
alization was that time, movement, and space
are in some way interrelated with health,
which can be manifested by increased connect-
edness and quality of relationships.
These early seeds of the HEC theory found
fertile ground in 1959 when Newman entered
nursing school at the University of Tennessee
(UT) in Memphis. Her mother died 2 weeks
before the beginning of the fall semester.
Newman knew she could not go back to her
previous life; the experience with her mother
had deeply changed her.
After graduating from UT’s baccalaureate
nursing program, Newman stayed on at UT as
a clinical instructor. The next year she went to
the University of California, San Francisco
(UCSF), to obtain her master’s degree in med-
ical–surgical nursing. When she graduated
from UCSF in 1964, Newman was recruited
back to Memphis to become the director of the
Clinical Research Center. After directing
the Clinical Research Center for 21/2 years,
Newman decided to pursue doctoral studies
in nursing at New York University (NYU),
where she would be able to study with Martha
Rogers. In her doctoral work at NYU,
Newman began studying movement, time, and
space as parameters of health; however, she did
so out of a logical positivist scientific paradigm.
She designed an experimental study that ma-
nipulated participants’ movements and then
measured their perception of time (Newman,
1971, 1982). Her results showed a changing
perception of time across the life span, with
people’s subjective sense of time increasing
with age in such a way that time expanded for
them (Newman, 1987). Although her work
seemed to support what she later would term
health as expanding consciousness, at the time
Newman felt the method precluded direct ap-
plication to shape nursing practice, which was
what most interested her (Newman, 1997a).
After receiving her PhD in 1971, Newman
joined the NYU faculty. While there, Newman
published a seminal article in Nursing Outlook
on nursing’s theoretical evolution (Newman,
1972) and with colleague Florence Downs
coauthored two editions of a book on re-
search in nursing (Downs & Newman, 1977).
Newman’s early career in academia was cen-
tered on articulating the knowledge of the dis-
cipline and how it was developed.
In 1977, Newman joined the faculty at Penn
State University as the professor-in-charge of
graduate studies. At that time, she was invited
to speak at a theory conference to be held in
New York in 1978. It was in that address that
she first clearly articulated her theory of health.
The transcript of her talk was published as a
chapter in a book she wrote about theory de-
velopment in nursing (Newman, 1979), which
was one of the first books published on the sub-
ject. Newman also organized a Nursing Theory
Think Tank. She was also a member of a group
of nurse theorists facilitated by Sister Callista
Roy to discern how to organize nursing diag-
noses so that they would be rooted in the
knowledge of the discipline of nursing. This
group presented papers in 1978 and 1980 to the
North American Nursing Diagnosis Associa-
tion. In 1982, they presented an organizing
framework they had developed for nursing
diagnoses called patterns of unitary man
(humans).
In 1984, Newman took a position as nurse
theorist at the University of Minnesota. As
part of her theory development work, she con-
ducted a pilot study of pattern identification.
She invited Richard Cowling from Case
Western and Jim Vail from the Army Nurse
Corps to collaborate with her. Newman was at
that time also a consultant to the Army Nurse
Corps.
While at the University of Minnesota,
Newman published two editions of her book,
Health as Expanding Consciousness (Newman,
1986, 1994a), which attracted international at-
tention. She conducted a series of lectures and
dialogues in New Zealand in 1985 and in
Finland in 1987 on health as expanding con-
sciousness and nursing knowledge development.
280 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 280
Shortly after retiring from her position at
the University of Minnesota, Margaret New-
man returned to Memphis, Tennessee, where
she continues to work on nursing knowledge
development through her writing and by dia-
loguing with students and scholars from
around the world.
Honors awarded to Dr. Newman include
being named a Fellow of the American Acad-
emy of Nursing and a New York University
Distinguished Scholar in Nursing. She has
received Sigma Theta Tau International’s
Founders Award for Excellence in Nursing
Research and the E. Louise Grant Award for
Nursing Excellence from the University of
Minnesota. She has been honored as an out-
standing alumna by both the University of
Tennessee and New York University. In 2008,
Dr. Newman was named a Living Legend by
the American Academy of Nursing.1
Overview of the Theory
As previously described, the seeds for the theory
of HEC were planted in Margaret Newman’s
childhood and experience of caring for her
mother as a young adult. Newman’s undergrad-
uate studies at the UT, master’s studies at the
UCSF, and doctoral studies at NYU also greatly
influenced her quest for exploring and articulat-
ing the knowledge of the discipline of nursing.
Reading and reflecting on the philosophical
work of scholars from various disciplines—
mainly Bentov (1978), Bohm (1980), Johnson
(1961), Prigogene (1976), Rogers (1970), and
Young (1976)—stretched Newman’s view of
the possibilities of nursing, and thus enriched
the theory of HEC. Work and dialogue with
colleagues and students further explicated the
theory.
Academic and Philosophical
Influences on the Theory
During her time at the University of California,
San Francisco, Newman explored how nurses
could respond to patients in a meaningful way
during short time spans. Newman’s interest in
attending to what is meaningful to the patient
was influenced by Ida Jean Orlando’s deliber-
ative nursing approach. Inspired by Orlando’s
theoretical work, Newman began making
deliberative observations about patients and
reflecting what she observed back to the pa-
tient. The specific attention stimulated patients
to respond by talking about what was mean-
ingful in their unique circumstances.
In a publication of the results of her explo-
ration of this approach to nursing during short
time spans, Newman (1966) recounted walk-
ing into the room of a patient who had been
in the hospital for some time. The patient was
reading the newspaper, and Newman noticed
that the woman was reading the want ads.
Newman simply stated, “Reading the want
ads, huh?” and waited for a response. The
woman, who had been diagnosed with a
chronic lung problem, worked in a factory that
exuded toxic fumes, and she would no longer
be able to work there. She was deeply con-
cerned about her future. What ensued through
their dialogue was a breakthrough for the
patient, whose health-care predicament was
couched in the larger context of her potential
loss of income. Newman asked the woman if
she had discussed this with her physician, and
the woman responded that she had not dis-
cussed it with anyone. When Newman asked
why not, the woman replied that no one had
asked her about it. Once the meaning of her
illness was understood within the context of
her entire life, not just her physical state, a path
toward health became apparent for the patient.
This process of focusing on meaning in pa-
tients’ lives to understand where the current
health predicament fits in the whole of peo-
ple’s lives has endured as central to HEC.
Newman’s theoretical insights evolved as
she delved into the works of Martha Rogers
and Itzhak Bentov, while at the same time re-
flecting back on her own experience (Newman,
1997b). Several of Martha Rogers’s assump-
tions became central in enriching Margaret
Newman’s theoretical perspective (Newman,
1997b). First and foremost, Rogers saw health
and illness not as two separate realities, but
CHAPTER 16 • Margaret Newman’s Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness 281
1For additional information please go to bonus chapter
content available at FA Davis http://davisplus.fadavis.com
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 281
rather as a unitary process. This was congruent
with Margaret Newman’s earlier experience
with her mother and with her patients. On a
very deep level, Newman knew that people
can experience health even when they are
physically or mentally ill. Health is not the op-
posite of illness, but rather health and illness
are both manifestations of a greater whole.
One can be very healthy in the midst of a ter-
minal illness.
Second, Rogers argued that all of reality is
a unitary whole and that each human being
exhibits a unique pattern. Rogers (1970) saw
energy fields to be the fundamental unit of all
that is living and nonliving, and she posited
that there is interpenetration between the
fields of person, family, and environment. Per-
son, family, and environment are not separate
entities but rather are an interconnected, uni-
tary whole (Rogers, 1990). Finally, Rogers saw
the life process as showing increasing complex-
ity. These assumptions from Rogers’s theory,
along with the work of Itzhak Bentov (1978),
helped to enrich Margaret Newman’s (1997b)
conceptualization of health and eventually the
articulation of her theory. Bentov viewed life
as a process of expanding consciousness, which
he defined as the informational capacity of the
system and the quality of interactions with the
environment.
Basic Assumptions of the Theory of
Health as Expanding Consciousness
Reflecting on these theoretical works helped
Newman prepare for her Toward a Theory of
Health presentation at the 1978 nursing theory
conference in New York City. It was at that
conference that the theory of health as expand-
ing consciousness was first formally explicated.
In her address (Newman, 1978) and in a writ-
ten overview of the address (Newman, 1979),
Newman outlined the basic assumptions that
were integral to her theory at that time. Draw-
ing on the work of Martha Rogers and Itzhak
Bentov and on her own experience and insight,
she proposed that:
• Health encompasses conditions known as
disease or pathology, as well as states where
disease is not present.
• Disease/pathology can be considered a
manifestation of the underlying pattern of
the person.
• The pattern of the person manifesting itself
as disease was present before the structural
and functional changes of disease.
• Removal of the disease/pathology will not
change the pattern of the individual.
• If becoming “ill” is the only way a person’s
pattern can be manifested, then that is
health for the person.
• Health is the expansion of consciousness
(Newman, 1979).
Newman’s presentation drew thunderous
applause as she ended with, “[t]he responsibil-
ity of the nurse is not to make people well, or
to prevent their getting sick, but to assist peo-
ple to recognize the power that is within them
to move to higher levels of consciousness”
(Newman, 1978).
Although Margaret Newman never set out
to become a nursing theorist, in that 1978
presentation in New York City, she articulated
a theory that resonated with what was mean-
ingful in the practice of nurses in many coun-
tries throughout the world. Nurses wanted to
go beyond combating diseases; they wanted to
accompany their patients in the process of dis-
covering meaning and wholeness in their lives.
Margaret Newman’s proposed theory served as
a guide for them to do so; it offered a new way
of looking at the essence of nursing practice.
Developing the Theory of HEC
After identifying the basic assumptions of the
theory of HEC, the next step was to focus on
how to test the theory with nursing research and
how the theory could inform nursing practice.
Newman began to concentrate on the following:
• The mutuality of the nurse–client interac-
tion in the process of pattern recognition
• The uniqueness and wholeness of the pattern
in each client situation
• The sequential configurations of pattern
evolving over time
• Insights occurring as choice points of action
potential
• The movement of the life process toward
expanded consciousness (Newman, 1997a)
282 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 282
To test the theory of HEC, which em-
braces reality as an undivided whole, Newman
found that Western scientific research method-
ologies, which isolate particulate variables and
analyze the relationships between them, were
insufficient.
Newman saw a need to articulate that her
work fell within a new paradigm of nursing.
Like Martha Rogers (1970, 1990), Newman
sees human beings as unitary and inseparable
from the larger unitary field that combines
person, family, and community all at once.
Seeing change as unpredictable and transfor-
mative, she named the paradigm within
which her work and the work of Martha
Rogers are situated the unitary-transformative
paradigm (Newman, Sime, & Corcoran-Perry,
1991). A nurse practicing within the unitary–
transformative paradigm does not think of
mind, body, spirit, and emotion as separate
entities but rather sees them as manifestations
of an undivided whole.
Newman’s theory (1979, 1990, 1994a,
1997a, 1997b, 2008b) proposes that we cannot
isolate, manipulate, and control variables to
understand the whole of a phenomenon. The
nurse and client form a mutual partnership
to attend to the pattern of meaningful rela-
tionships and life experiences. In this way, a
patient who has had a heart attack can under-
stand the experience of the heart attack in the
context of all that is meaningful in his or her
life and, through the insight gained with pat-
tern recognition, experience expanding con-
sciousness. Newman’s (1994a, 1997a, 1997b)
methodology does not divide people’s lives into
fragmented variables but rather attends to the
nature and meaning of the whole, which be-
comes apparent in the nurse–patient dialogue.
A nurse practicing within the HEC theo-
retical perspective possesses multifaceted levels
of awareness and is able to sense how physical
signs, emotional conveyances, spiritual insights,
physical appearances, and mental insights are
all meaningful manifestations of a person’s
underlying pattern. These manifestations also
provide insight into the nature of the person’s
interactions with his or her environment. It
takes disciplined study and reflection on prac-
tical experience applying the theory for nurses
to be able to see pattern as insight into the
whole. Newman (2008b) states that practicing
within a unitary paradigm requires a com-
pletely new way of seeing reality—it is like
moving from seeing the Sun as revolving
around Earth to realizing that it is actually
Earth that revolves around the Sun.
Newman (1997a) asserted that knowledge
emanating from the unitary–transformative
paradigm is the knowledge of the discipline
and that the focus, philosophy, and theory of
the discipline must be consistent with each
other and therefore cannot flow out of differ-
ent paradigms. Newman (1997a) stated:
The paradigm of the discipline is becoming clear.
We are moving from attention on the other as object
to attention to the we in relationship, from fixing
things to attending to the meaning of the whole, from
hierarchical one-way intervention to mutual process
partnering. It is time to break with a paradigm of
health that focuses on power, manipulation, and
control and move to one of reflective, compassionate
consciousness. The paradigm of nursing embraces
wholeness and pattern. It reveals a world that is mov-
ing, evolving, transforming—a process. (p. 37)
Newman points the way for nurses to
practice and conduct research within a uni-
tary–transformative paradigm. In the unitary–
transformative paradigm, the process of the
nurse–patient partnership as integral to the
evolving definition of health for the patient
(Litchfield, 1993, 1999; Newman, 1997a) and
is synchronous with participatory philosophi-
cal thought (Skolimowski, 1994) and research
methodology (Heron & Reason, 1997).
When nurses view the world from a unitary
perspective, they begin to see the nature of re-
lationships and their meaning in an entirely
new light. The work of Frank Lamendola and
Margaret Newman (1994) with people with
HIV/AIDS illustrates this. In a study they
conducted, they found that the experience of
HIV/AIDS opened participants to suffering
and physical deterioration and at the same
time introduced greater sensitivity and open-
ness to themselves and others. Drawing on the
work of cultural historian William Irwin
Thompson, systems theorist Will McWhinney,
CHAPTER 16 • Margaret Newman’s Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness 283
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 283
and musician David Dunn, Lamendola and
Newman, stated:
They [Thompson, McWhinney, and Dunn] see the
loss of membranal integrity as a signal of the loss of
autopoetic unity analogous to the breaking down of
boundaries at a global level between countries, ide-
ologies, and disparate groups. Thompson views
HIV/AIDS not simply as a chance infection but part
of a larger cultural phenomenon and sees the
pathogen not as an object but as heralding the need
for living together characterized by a symbiotic rela-
tionship. (Lamendola & Newman, 1994, p. 14)
These authors pointed out that the AIDS
epidemic has necessitated greater intercon-
nectedness on the interpersonal, community,
and global level. It has also called for a recon-
ceptualization of the nature of the self and
of treatment—inviting a new sense of har-
monic integration within the immune system.
Lamendola and Newman quoted Thompson
(1989), who stated that we need to “learn to
tolerate aliens by seeing the self as a cloud in
a clouded sky and not as a lord in a walled-in
fortress.” This change in perspective helps
nurses and patients move away from military
metaphors in relationship to patients’ bodies
(i.e., combating disease, waging battles against
invading cells, etc.) to focus instead on har-
mony and balance. Nursing care within a uni-
tary perspective unveils meaning and opens
the possibility for a new way of living for
people with chronic conditions.
Applications of the Theory
Essential Aspects of Nursing Practice
Within the HEC Perspective
Newman (2008b) synthesizes the basic as-
sumptions of HEC in the following way:
• Health is an evolving unitary pattern of the
whole, including patterns of disease.
• Consciousness is the informational capacity
of the whole and is revealed in the evolving
pattern.
• Pattern identifies the human–environmental
process and is characterized by meaning. (p. 6)
Concepts important to nursing practice
grounded in the theory of HEC include expand-
ing consciousness, time, presence, resonance
with the whole, pattern, meaning, insights as
choice points, and the mutuality of the nurse–
patient relationship.
Expanding Consciousness
Ultimate consciousness has been equated with
love, which embraces all experience equally and
unconditionally: pain as well as pleasure, failure
as well as success, ugliness as well as beauty,
disease as well as nondisease.
—M. A. NEWMAN (2003, P. 241)
Consciousness within the theory of HEC
is not limited to cognitive thought. Newman
(1994a) defined consciousness as the infor-
mation of the system: the capacity of the sys-
tem to interact with the environment. In the
human system, the informational capacity
includes not only all the things we normally
associate with consciousness, such as think-
ing and feeling, but also all the information
embedded in the nervous system, the im-
mune system, the genetic code, and so on.
The information of these and other systems
reveals the complexity of the human system
and how the information of the system inter-
acts with the information of the environmen-
tal system (p. 33).
To illustrate consciousness as the interac-
tional capacity of the person–environment,
Newman (1994a) drew on the work of Bentov
(1978), who presented consciousness on a
continuum ranging from rocks on one end of
the spectrum (which have little known inter-
action with their environment), to plants
(which provide nutrients, give off oxygen, and
draw carbon dioxide from the atmosphere) to
animals (which can move about and interact
freely), to humans (who can reflect and make
in-depth plans regarding how they want to in-
teract with their environment), and ultimately
to spiritual beings on the spectrum’s other
end. Newman sees death as a transformation
point, with a person’s consciousness continu-
ing to develop beyond the physical life, be-
coming a part of a universal consciousness
(Newman, 1994a).
284 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 284
The process of expanding consciousness is
characterized by the evolving pattern of the
person–environment interaction (Newman,
1994a). The process of expanding conscious-
ness is defined by Newman (2008b) as “a
process of becoming more of oneself, of finding
greater meaning in life, and of reaching new
heights of connectedness with other people and
the world” (p. 6). Nurses and their clients know
that there has been an expansion of conscious-
ness when there is a richer, more meaningful
quality to their relationships. Relationships that
are more open, loving, caring, connected, and
peaceful are a manifestation of expanding con-
sciousness. These deeper, more meaningful re-
lationships may be interpersonal, or they may
be relationships with the wider community or
biosphere. Expanding consciousness is evident
when people transcend their own egos, dedi-
cate their energy to something greater than
the individual self, and learn to build order
against the trend of disorder. The process of ex-
panding consciousness may look differently
with changes in cognitive function; nurses must
carefully discern patterns of meaning when this
is the case. For example, when being present to
people with dementia or to very young chil-
dren, nurses realize that there is no past or
future—there is only the present, and they
must be fully present in the present on a deeper
level than cognitive and verbal processes can
take them (Newman, 2008b). People are best
able to experience expanding consciousness
when they are not chained to linear time.
Time and Presence
The time experienced
In a moment
Expands or diminishes
With consciousness.
If I am fully present
There is
No time.
Only consciousness.
—M. A. NEWMAN (2008A, P. 225)
Newman’s earliest published work pointed to
the ability of nurses to quickly and effectively
attend to what is most important to patients
and, by engaging patients in a dialogue about
what is of utmost importance to them, to dis-
cern the patient’s unique path toward health
(Newman, 1966). Newman’s latest work as-
serts that it is only when nurses move away
from a sense of linear time to a more universal
synchronization with the here and now that
they can be truly present to patients in a mean-
ingful and whole manner (Newman, 2008a).
Newman stated:
There is a need to get back to the natural cycles of
the universe. The time of civilization (clock time and
the Gregorian calendar) is not the same as the time
of the rest of the biosphere, our living planet earth.
Natural time is radial in nature, projecting from the
center, and continuously moving in the direction of
greater consciousness. (2008a, p. 227)
Newman asserted that the artificial time
frame of clinic schedules and hospital shift
work places nurses at odds with the natural
rhythm of nurse–patient relationships, serves
the needs of health systems administrations
more than those of patients, and disrupts a
meaningful nursing practice. She pointed out
that the discipline of nursing has followed a
trajectory from adherence to artificial linear
time to the synchronization of time in inter-
personal relationships, and now must move to
the “instantaneous flow of information in each
center of consciousness” and that “it is time to
opt for practice that reflects this dimension”
(Newman, 2008a, p. 227). When nurses must
move out of a Western sense of time, they can
be more fully present to patients.
Newman (2008b) asserted that it is only in
relationship that people can fully come to
know themselves. She drew on the work of T.
D. Smith (2001), who suggested that “when
the nurse considers the patient a mystery to be
engaged in rather than a problem to be solved, the
relationship is characterized by presence”
(Newman, 2008b, p. 53). Newman further
stated that “presence is enhanced by the nurse’s
openness and sensitivity to the other” and in-
volves the nurse letting go of judgments of
“good” or “bad” in relationship to patients’
health behaviors.
When nurses are truly present to patients
they concentrate more on intuitive knowing
CHAPTER 16 • Margaret Newman’s Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness 285
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 285
than on the gathering of facts and health-
related data. They enter into a relaxed alertness
and realize that transforming presence involves
a keen awareness of their oneness with the
patient (Newman, 2008b; Newman, Smith,
Pharris, & Jones, 2008). Understanding the
concept of resonance enables a transforming
presence.
Resonating With the Whole
Newman (2008b) described resonance as the
mechanism for acquiring essential information
to guide nursing actions and to understand
meaning in patients’ lives. She stated, “This is
an important distinction in the explication of
nursing knowledge. Knowledge at the unitary,
transformative level includes and transcends
energy transfer at the sensorial level. It is
nonenergetic, nonlocal, and present everywhere”
(p. 35). She differentiated this information
transfer from the transfer of sensory informa-
tion (like heat and touch, which involve phys-
ical energy transfer) and suggests nurses
continually rely on this information transfer
when intuitive insights arise during the care of
patients. Newman cautioned that “intellectu-
alization breaks the field of resonance. If we
analyze or evaluate an experience before we
have resonated with it, the field is broken—the
resonance is damped” (p. 37). “For instance,
sometimes when we see familiar symptoms of
a disease, we jump into a diagnostic conclusion
and preclude receptivity to other data that
would present a more complete picture. It as-
sumes we are all the same” (p. 45). Resonance
enables nurses to sense the unique situation
and concerns of patients.
To resonate with patients and form open
relationships, nurses must let go of personal
judgments about patients and transcend cul-
tural beliefs and values. In other words, the
nurse needs to free himself or herself of
all “should” and “ought to” attitudes and all
personal preoccupations that might prevent
total presence. Newman states there is no pre-
scriptive way to sense the whole through res-
onance. She recommended that nurses pay
attention to the client at the simplest level,
begin with whatever presents itself, and as-
sume that it is purposeful (Newman, 2008b).
Learning to resonate with patients involves
relational engagement and reflection.
Most conventional education programs
teach analytic processes attending to what is
“logical.” This leads students away from under-
standing the whole. Methods that involve em-
pirical investigation assume that the whole
comes after the parts; these methods tend to
blind investigators to their relationship with the
whole. Newman (2008b) drew on the work of
Bohm (1980) to stress that “wholeness is what
is real, with fragmentation as our response to
fragmentary thought. The whole is irreducible
and omnipresent” (p. 40). Newman (2008b)
differentiated between the general and the uni-
versal. “Seeing comprehensively is concrete and
holistic, whereas generalization is abstract and
analytical; these ways of seeing go in opposite
directions” (p. 47). Resonance is a way to sense
into the whole through attention to one aspect
or part of it, always with an eye on compre-
hending the whole. Resonance enables nurses
to tap into the pattern of the whole.
Attention to Pattern and Meaning
Essential to Margaret Newman’s theory is
the belief that each person exhibits a distinct
pattern, which is constantly unfolding and
evolving as the person interacts with the envi-
ronment. Pattern is information that depicts
the whole of a person’s relationship with the
environment and gives an understanding of the
meaning of the relationships all at once (Endo,
1998; Newman, 1994a). Pattern is character-
ized by meaning (Newman, 2008b) and is a
manifestation of consciousness.
To describe the nature of pattern, Newman
draws on the work of David Bohm (1980), who
said that anything explicate (that which we can
hear, see, taste, smell, touch) is a manifestation
of the implicate (the unseen underlying pattern;
Newman, 1997b). In other words, there is in-
formation about the underlying pattern of each
person in all that we sense about them, such as
their movements, tone of voice, interactions
with others, activity level, genetic pattern, and
vital signs. People can be identified from a dis-
tance by someone who knows them, just from
the way in which they move. There is also in-
formation about their underlying pattern in all
286 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 286
that they tell us about their experiences and
perceptions, including stories about their life,
recounted dreams, and portrayed meanings.
The HEC perspective sees disease, disorder,
disconnection, and violence as an explication
of the underlying implicate pattern of the per-
son, family, and community. Reflecting on the
meaning of these conditions can be part of the
process of expanding consciousness (Newman,
1994a, 1997a, 1997b).
Pharris (1999) offered the example of a
16-year-old young man placed in an adult cor-
rectional facility after a murder conviction.
This young man was constantly getting into
fights and generally feeling lost. As he and the
nurse researcher met over several weeks to gain
insight into patterns of meaningful people and
events in his life, the process seemed to be
blocked, with no pattern emerging and little
insight gained. He spoke of how he felt he had
lost himself several years back when he went
from being a straight-A student from a stable
family to stealing cars, drinking, getting into
fights, and eventually murdering someone.
One week he walked into the room where the
nurse was waiting, and his movements seemed
more controlled and labored; he sat with his
arms tightly cradling his bloated abdomen, and
his chest was expanded as though he were
about to explode. His palms were glistening
with sweat. His face was erupting with acne.
He talked as usual in a very detached manner,
but his words came out in bursts. The nurse
chose to give him feedback about what she was
seeing and sensing from his body. She re-
flected that he seemed to be exerting a great
deal of energy holding back something that
was erupting within him. With this insight, he
was quiet for a few minutes, and tears began
rolling down his cheeks. Suddenly he began
talking about a very painful family history of
sexual abuse that had been kept secret for
many years. It became obvious that the expe-
rience of covering up the abuse had been so all-
encompassing that his pattern had been
suppressed.
This young man had reached a point at
which he realized his old ways of interacting
with others were no longer serving him, and
he chose to interact with his environment in a
different way. By the next meeting, his move-
ments had become smooth and sure, his com-
plexion had cleared up, he was now able to
reflect on his insights, and he no longer was
involved in the chaos and fighting in his cell-
block. He was able to let go of his need to con-
trol everything and was able to connect with
the emotions of his childhood experiences; he
was also able to cry for the first time in years.
In their subsequent work together, this
young man and the nurse were able to distin-
guish between his implicate pattern, which had
now become clear through their dialogue, and
the impact that keeping the abusive experience
a secret had had on him and on other members
of his family. He was able to free himself of
the shame he was carrying, which did not be-
long to him. Since that time, the young man
has been able to transcend previous limitations
and has become involved in several efforts to
help others, both in and out of the prison en-
vironment. He has entered into several warm
and loving relationships with family members
and friends and has achieved academic success.
This was evidence of expanding consciousness
for the young man. He reflected that he
wished he had had a nurse to talk with before
“catching his case” (being arrested for murder).
He had been seen by a nurse in the juvenile
detention center, who performed a physical
examination and gave him aspirin for a
headache. A few days before the murder, he
saw a nurse practitioner in a clinic who wrote
a prescription for antibiotics and talked with
him about safe sex. These interactions are ex-
plications of the pattern of the U.S. health-
care system and the increasingly task-oriented
role that nursing is being pressured to take as
juxtaposed with the transforming presence of
a nurse whose practice is rooted in partnership
that focuses on what is of utmost importance
to the person (Jonsdottir, Litchfield, & Pharris,
2003, 2004).
The focus of nursing is on pattern and
meaning. That which is underlying makes itself
known in the physical realm. Nurses grounded
in the theory of HEC are able to be in rela-
tionships with patients, families, and commu-
nities in such a way that insights arising in
their pattern recognition dialogue shed light
CHAPTER 16 • Margaret Newman’s Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness 287
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 287
on an expanded horizon of potential actions
(Litchfield, 1999; Newman, 1997a).
Insights Occurring as Choice Points
of Action Potential
The disruption of disease and other traumatic
life events may be critical points in the expan-
sion of consciousness. To explain this phe-
nomenon, Newman (1994a, 1997b) drew on
the work of Ilya Prigogine (1976), whose the-
ory of dissipative structures asserts that a sys-
tem fluctuates in an orderly manner until some
disruption occurs, and the system moves in a
seemingly random, chaotic, disorderly way
until at some point it chooses to move into a
higher level of organization (Newman, 1997b).
Nurses see this all the time—the patient who
is lost to his work and has no time for his fam-
ily or himself, and then suddenly has a heart
attack, which leaves him open to reflecting on
how he has been using his energy. Insights
gained through this reflection give rise to
transformation and decisions about where en-
ergy will be spent; and his life becomes more
creative, relational, and meaningful. Nurses
also see this in people diagnosed with a termi-
nal illness that causes them to reevaluate what
is really important, attend to it, and then to
state that for the first time they feel as though
they are really living. The expansion of con-
sciousness is an innate tendency of humans;
however, some experiences and processes pre-
cipitate more rapid transformations. Nurse re-
searchers working within the theory of HEC
have clearly demonstrated how nurses can cre-
ate a mutual partnership with their patients to
reflect on their evolving pattern and the points
of transformation. Through this process, ex-
panding consciousness is realized (Barron,
2005; Endo, Minegishi, & Kubo, 2005; Endo
et al., 2000; Endo, Takaki, Nitta, Abbe, &
Terashima, 2009; Flanagan, 2005, 2009;
Hayes & Jones, 2007; Jonsdottir, 1998;
Jonsdottir et al., 2003, 2004; Kiser-Larson,
2002; Lamendola, 1998; Lamendola &
Newman, 1994; Litchfield, 1993, 1999, 2005;
Moch, 1990; Musker, 2008; Neill, 2002a,
2002b; Newman, 1995; Newman & Moch,
1991; Noveletsky-Rosenthal, 1996; Pharris,
2002, 2005, 2011; Pharris & Endo, 2007;
Picard, 2000, 2005; Pierre-Louis, Akoh,
White & Pharris, 2011; Rosa, 2006; Ruka,
2005; Tommet, 2003; Yang, Xiong, Vang, &
Pharris, 2009).
Newman (1999) pointed out that nurse–
client relationships often begin during periods
of disruption, uncertainty, and unpredictability
in patients’ lives. When patients are in a state
of chaos because of disease, trauma, loss, or
other causes, they often cannot see their past
or future clearly. In the context of the nurse–
patient partnership, which centers on the
meaning the patient gives to the health
predicament, insight for action arises, and it
becomes clear to the patient how to get on
with life (Jonsdottir et al., 2003, 2004; Litch-
field, 1999; Newman, 1999). Litchfield (1993,
1999) explained this as experiencing an ex-
panding present that connects to the past and
creates an extended horizon of action potential
for the future.
Endo (1998), in her work in Japan with
women with cancer; Noveletsky-Rosenthal
(1996), in her work in the United States with
people with chronic obstructive pulmonary
disease; and Pharris (2002), in her work with
U.S. adolescents convicted of murder, found
that it is when patients’ lives are in the greatest
states of chaos, disorganization, and uncer-
tainty that the HEC nursing partnership and
pattern recognition process is perceived as
most beneficial to patients (Fig. 16-1).
Many nurses who encounter patients in times
of chaos strive for stability; they feel they have
to fix the situation, not realizing that this disor-
ganized time in the patient’s life presents an op-
portunity for growth. Newman (1999) states:
The “brokenness” of the situation is only a point in
the process leading to a higher order. We need to
join in partnership with clients and dance their
dance, even though it appears arrhythmic, until order
begins to emerge out of chaos. We know, and we
can help clients know, that there is a basic, underly-
ing pattern evolving even though it might not be
apparent at the time. The pattern will be revealed at
a higher level of organization. (p. 228)
288 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 288
The disruption brought about by the pres-
ence of disease, illness, and traumatic or
stressful events creates an opportunity for
transformation to an expanded level of con-
sciousness (Newman, 1997b, 1999) and repre-
sents a time when patients most need nurses
who are attentive to that which is most mean-
ingful. Newman (1999, p. 228) stated, “Nurses
have a responsibility to stay in partnership with
clients as their patterns are disturbed by illness
or other disruptive events.” This disrupted state
presents a choice point for the person to either
continue going on as before, even though the
old rules are not working, or to shift into a new
way of being. To explain the concept of a choice
point more clearly, Newman drew on Arthur
Young’s (1976) theory of the evolution of
consciousness.
Young suggested that there are seven stages
of binding and unbinding, which begin with
total freedom and unrestricted choice, followed
by a series of losses of freedom. After these
losses come a choice point and a reversal of the
losses of freedom, ending with total freedom
and unrestricted choice. These stages can be con-
ceptualized as seven equidistant points on a
V shape (Fig. 16-2). Beginning at the upper-
most point on the left is the first stage, potential
freedom. The next stage is binding. In this stage,
the individual is sacrificed for the sake of the col-
lective, with no need for initiative because every-
thing is being regulated for the individual. The
third stage, centering, involves the development
of an individual identity, self-consciousness, and
self-determination. “Individualism emerges in
the self’s break with authority” (Newman,
1994b). The fourth stage, choice, is situated at the
base of the V. In this stage, the individual learns
that the old ways of being are no longer working.
It is a stage of self-awareness, inner growth, and
transformation. A new way of being becomes
necessary. Newman (1994b) described the fifth
stage, decentering, as being characterized by a
shift from the development of self (individua-
tion) to dedication to something greater than
the individual self. The person experiences out-
standing competence; his or her works have a
life of their own beyond the creator. The task is
CHAPTER 16 • Margaret Newman’s Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness 289
Emergence of new
order at higher level of
organization
Period of disorganization,
unpredictability,
uncertainty (response to
disease, trauma, loss, etc.)Normal,
predictable
fluctuation
Giant
fluctuation
Time when partnership with
an HEC nurse can be of
greatest benefit
Fig 16 • 1 Prigogine’s theory of dissipative structures applied to health as expanding consciousness
(HEC) nursing.
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 289
transcendence of the ego. Form is transcended,
and the energy becomes the dominant feature—
in terms of animation, vitality, a quality that is
somehow infinite. In this stage, the person ex-
periences the power of unlimited growth and has
learned how to build order against the trend of
disorder (pp. 45–46).
Newman (1994b) stated that few experi-
ence the sixth stage, unbinding, or the sev-
enth stage, real freedom, unless they have had
these experiences of transcendence character-
ized by the fifth stage. It is in the moving
through the choice point and the stages of
decentering and unbinding that a person
moves on to higher levels of consciousness
(Newman, 1999). Newman proposed a corol-
lary between her theory of health as expand-
ing consciousness and Young’s theory of the
evolution of consciousness in that we “come
into being from a state of potential con-
sciousness, are bound in time, find our iden-
tity in space, and through movement we
learn ‘the law’ of the way things work and
make choices that ultimately take us beyond
space and time to a state of absolute con-
sciousness” (Newman, 1994b, p. 46).
The Mutuality of the Nurse–Client
Interaction in the Process of Pattern
Recognition
We come to the meaning of the whole not by
viewing the pattern from the outside, but by
entering into the evolving pattern as it unfolds.
—M. A. NEWMAN
Nursing within the HEC perspective involves
being fully present to the patient without judg-
ments, goals, or intervention strategies. It in-
volves being with rather than doing for. It is
caring in its deepest, most respectful sense with
a focus on what is important to the patient.
The nurse–patient interaction becomes like a
pure reflection pool through which both the
nurse and the patient achieve a clear picture of
their pattern and come away transformed by
the insights gained.
To illustrate the mutually transforming
effect of the nurse–patient interaction, New-
man (1994a) offers the image of a smooth lake
into which two stones are thrown. As the
stones hit the water, concentric waves circle
out until the two patterns reach one another
and interpenetrate. The new pattern of their
interaction ripples back and transforms the two
original circling patterns. Nurses are changed
by their interactions with their patients, just as
patients are changed by their interactions with
nurses. This mutual transformation extends to
the surrounding environment and relation-
ships of the nurse and patient.
In the process of doing this work, it is im-
portant that the nurse sense his or her own
pattern. Newman states:
We have come to see nursing as a process of rela-
tionship that coevolves as a function of the interpen-
etration of the evolving fields of the nurse, client, and
the environment in a self-organizing, unpredictable
way. We recognize the need for process wisdom,
the ability to come from the center of our truth and
act in the immediate moment. (Newman, 1994b,
p. 155)
Sensing one’s own pattern is an essential
starting point for the nurse. In her book Health
as Expanding Consciousness, Newman (1994a,
pp. 107–109) outlines a process of focusing to
assist nurses as they begin working in the
HEC perspective. It is important that the
nurse be able to practice from the center of his
or her own truth and be fully present to the
patient. The nurse’s consciousness, or pattern,
becomes like the vibrations of a tuning fork
that resonate at a centering frequency, and the
client has the opportunity to resonate and tune
290 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
Centering De-centering
Binding
Potential freedom Real freedom
Unbinding
Choice
Fig 16 • 2 Young’s spectrum of the evolution of
consciousness.
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 290
to that clear frequency during their interactions
(Newman, 1994a; Quinn, 1992). The nurse–
patient relationship ideally continues until the
patient finds his or her own rhythmic vibra-
tions without the need of the stabilizing force
of the nurse–patient dialogue. Newman (1999)
points out that the partnership demands that
nurses develop tolerance for uncertainty, dis-
organization, and dissonance, even though it
may be uncomfortable. It is in the state of dis-
equilibrium that the potential for growth ex-
ists. She states, “The rhythmic relating of nurse
with client at this critical boundary is a window
of opportunity for transformation in the health
experience” (Newman, 1999, p. 229).
Relevance of HEC Across Cultures
Margaret Newman’s theory of health as ex-
panding consciousness is being used through-
out the world, but it has been more quickly
embraced and understood by nurses from in-
digenous and Eastern cultures, who are less
bound by linear, three-dimensional thought
and physical concepts of health and who are
more immersed in the metaphysical, mystical
aspect of human existence. Increasingly, how-
ever, HEC is being enthusiastically embraced
by nurses in industrialized nations who are
finding it difficult to nurse in the modern tech-
nologically driven and intervention-oriented
health-care system, which is dependent on
diagnosing and treating diseases (Jonsdottir
et al., 2003, 2004). Practicing from an HEC
perspective involves a holistic approach, which
places what is meaningful to patients back
into the center of the nurse's focus and what
is meaningful to students back into the center
of the focus of nurse educators. This person-
centered approach has wide appeal across
cultures.
HEC Research as Praxis
Margaret Newman’s early research (1966, 1971,
1972, 1976, 1982, 1986, 1987) added to an
understanding of the interrelatedness of time,
movement, space, and consciousness as mani-
festations of health. Newman’s further reflection
on these studies in light of work she did at
Walter Reed Hospital with Richard Cowling
and John Vail related to pattern recognition,
revealed the need to look at health as expanding
consciousness using a research methodology that
acknowledges, understands, and honors the
undivided wholeness of the human health expe-
rience. Newman, Cowling, and Vail’s study par-
ticipants were nurses at Walter Reed Hospital.
Newman described one of the interviews she
conducted as Vail and Cowling watched from
another room. Newman asked the nurse to de-
scribe meaningful events in her life and Newman
diagrammed the unfolding trajectory of the
nurse’s life. When they met the next day to re-
flect the sequential patterns Newman had iden-
tified, the nurse was able to see that experiences
she had previously viewed as being extremely
negative (e.g., a divorce), actually were stepping
stones to expanded possibilities; she was sud-
denly able to view her life in a new way. The
nurse researchers and participants were excited
about the insights they gained. The pattern
recognition research method was a powerful
nursing practice process that shed light on
theory—research, theory, and practice each illu-
minated and developed the other two. Newman
went on to develop her pattern recognition nurs-
ing research method in which theory, practice,
and research are one undivided process, each
aspect shedding greater light on the other two.
Newman realized a need to step inside to
view the whole from within—which is simply
a metaphorical process since the researcher has
been integrally within the whole all along.
Newman’s pattern recognition method cleared
away the murky waters surrounding research,
theory, and practice and what previously ap-
peared to be three separate islands, became
clearly visible as mountaintops on one undi-
vided piece of land, newly emerged but always
there as an undivided whole. HEC research as
praxis unfolded uniquely in various countries
and settings as nurse researcher-practitioner-
theorists engaged in partnerships with individ-
uals, families, and communities to understand
patterns of meaning.
Focusing on the Process of Health
Patterning and the Nurse–Patient
Partnership
Merian Litchfield (1993) from New Zealand
was the first researcher to apply the theory of
CHAPTER 16 • Margaret Newman’s Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness 291
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 291
health as expanding consciousness to a nursing
partnership with families. Litchfield (1993,
1999, 2005) has led the way in focusing on the
process of the nursing partnership with pa-
tients and families. In her first study, Litchfield
(1993) described health patterning as “a
process of nursing practice whereby, through
dialogue, families with researcher as practi-
tioner, recognize pattern in the life process
providing opportunity for insight as the poten-
tial for action; a process by which there may
be increased self-determination as a feature
of health” (p. 10). Litchfield (1993) described
her research as a “shared process of inquiry
through which participants are empowered
to act to change their circumstances” (p. 20).
Through her research over several years with
families with complex health predicaments re-
quiring repeated hospitalizations, Litchfield
(1993, 1999, 2005) found that she could not
stand outside of the process of recognizing
pattern to observe a fixed health pattern of the
family. She saw the pattern as continuously
evolving dialectically in the dialogue within the
nursing partnership. The findings are literally
created in the participatory process of the part-
nership (Litchfield, 1999). For this reason,
Litchfield did not use diagrams to reflect pat-
tern because she thought they would imply
that the pattern is static rather than continually
evolving. As the family reflects on the pattern
of their interactions with each other and the
environment, insight into action may involve
a transformative process, with the same events
being seen in a new light. Family health is seen
as a function of the nurse–family relationship.
Many of the families in partnership with
Litchfield (1999, 2005) gained insight into
their own predicaments in such a way that they
required less interaction and service from tra-
ditional health-care services, and thus a cost
saving in such services was realized.
Exploring Pattern Recognition as a
Nursing Intervention
Emiko Endo (1998) explored HEC pattern
recognition as a nursing intervention in Japan
with women living with ovarian cancer. She
asked, “When a person with cancer has an op-
portunity to share meaning in the life process
within the nurse–client relationship, what
changes may occur in the evolving pattern?”
Attending to the flow of meaningful thoughts
for each participant and building on the pre-
vious work of Litchfield (1993), Endo found
four common phases of the process of expand-
ing consciousness for all participants: client–
nurse mutual concern, pattern recognition,
vision and action potential, and transformation.
Participants differed in the pace of evolving
movement toward a turning point and in the
characteristics of personal growth at the turn-
ing point. The characteristics of growth ranged
from assertion of self, to emancipation of self,
to transcendence of self. Reflecting on her
experience, Endo (1998) put forth that pattern
recognition is “not intended to fix clients’
problems from a medical diagnostic stand-
point, but to provide individuals with an op-
portunity to know themselves, to find meaning
in their current situation and life, and to gain
insight for the future” (p. 60).
Endo et al. (2000) conducted a similar
study with Japanese families in which the wife-
mother was hospitalized because of a cancer
diagnosis. Families found meaning in their
patterns and reported increased understanding
of their present situation. In the pattern recog-
nition process, most families reconfigured
from being a collection of separated individuals
to trustful, caring relationships as a family
unit, showing more openness and connected-
ness. The researchers concluded that pattern
recognition as a nursing intervention was a
“meaning-making transforming process in the
family–nurse partnership” (p. 604).
HEC-Inspired Practice
Patricia Tommet (2003) used the HEC
hermeneutic dialectic methodology to explore
the pattern of nurse–parent interaction in fam-
ilies faced with choosing an elementary school
for their medically fragile children. She found
a pattern of living in uncertainty in the families
during the intense period of disruption and
disorganization after the birth of their med-
ically fragile child through the first few years.
After 2 to 3 years, the families exhibited a pat-
tern of order in chaos where they learned how
to live in the present, letting go of the way they
292 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 292
lived in the past. Tommet found that “families
changed from being passive recipients to active
participants in the care of their children”
(p. 90) and that the “experience of their chil-
dren’s birth and life transformed these families
and through them, transformed systems of
care” (p. 86). Tommet demonstrated insights
gained in family pattern recognition and con-
cluded that a nurse–parent partnership could
have a more profound impact on these fami-
lies, and hence the services they use, during the
first 3 years of their children’s lives.
Working with colleagues in New Zealand,
Litchfield undertook a pilot project that in-
cluded 19 families in a predicament of strife
(Litchfield & Laws, 1999). The goal of the
pilot project, which built on Litchfield’s pre-
vious work (1993, 1999), was to explore a
model of nurse case management incorporat-
ing the use of a family nurse who understands
the theory of health as expanding conscious-
ness. In the context of a family–family nurse
partnership, the unfolding pattern of family
living was attended to. Family nurses shared
their stories of the families with the research
group, who reflected together on the families’
changing predicaments and the whole picture
of family living in terms of how each family
moved in time and place. Subsequent visits
with the families focused on recognition
of pattern and potential for action. The family
nurse mobilized relief services if necessary
and orchestrated services as needs emerged
in the process of pattern recognition. The re-
search group found that families became more
open and spontaneous through the process of
pattern recognition, and their interactions ev-
idenced more focus, purposefulness, and coop-
eration. In analyzing costs of medical care for
one participating family, it was estimated that
a 3% to 13% savings could be seen by employ-
ing the model of family nursing, with greater
savings being possible when family nurses are
available immediately after a family disruption
takes place (Litchfield & Laws, 1999). Based
on Litchfield’s work with families with com-
plex health predicaments, the government
funded a large demonstration project to sup-
port family nurses who would be able to nurse
from unitary-transformative perspective and
partner with families without having predeter-
mined goals and outcomes that the families
and nurses must achieve. These nurses are free
to focus on family health as defined and expe-
rienced by the families themselves.
Endo and colleagues (Endo, Minegishi, &
Kubo, 2005; Endo, Miyahara, Suzuki, &
Ohmasa, 2005) in Japan have expanded their
work to incorporate the pattern recognition
process at the hospital nursing unit level. After
engaging the professional nursing staff in read-
ing and dialogue about the theory of HEC,
nurses were encouraged to incorporate the ex-
ploration of meaningful events and people into
their practice with their patients. Nurses kept
journals and came together to reflect on the ex-
perience of expanding consciousness in their
patients and in themselves. Endo, Miyahara,
Suzuki, and Ohmasa (2005) concluded:
Retrospectively it was found through dialogue in the
research/project meetings that in the usual nurse–
client relationships, nurses were bound by their re-
sponsibilities within the medical model to help clients
get well, but in letting go of the old rules, they en-
countered an amazing experience with clients’ trans-
formations. The nurses’ transformation occurred
concomitantly, and they were free to follow the
clients’ paths and incorporate all realms of nursing
interventions in everyday practice into the unitary per-
spective. (p. 145)
Jane Flanagan (2005, 2009) transformed
the practice of presurgical nursing by develop-
ing the preadmission nursing practice model,
which is based on HEC. The nursing practice
model shifted from a disease focus to a process
focus, with attention being given to the nurses
knowing their patients and what is meaningful
to them so that the surgery experience could
be put in proper context and appropriate care
provided. Nursing presurgical visits were em-
phasized. Flanagan reported that the nursing
staff members were exuberant to be free to be
nurses once again, and patients frequently
stopped by to comment on their preoperative
experience and evolving life changes.
Similarly, Susan Ruka (2005) made HEC
pattern recognition the foundation of care at a
long-term-care nursing facility, transforming the
CHAPTER 16 • Margaret Newman’s Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness 293
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 293
nursing practice and the sense of connectedness
among staff, families, and residents: Each be-
came more peaceful, relaxed, and loving.
Application of HEC at the
Community Level
Pharris (2002, 2005) attempted to understand
a community pattern of rising youth homicide
rates by conducting a study with incarcerated
teens convicted of murder. The youth in the
study reported the pattern recognition process
to be transformative, and expanding con-
sciousness was visible in changed behaviors,
increased connectedness, and more loving
attention to meaningful relationships. The ex-
perience of the young men demonstrated that
alterations in movement, time, and space in-
herent in the prison system can intensify the
process of expanding consciousness. When the
experiences of meaningful events and relation-
ships were compared across participants, the
pattern of disconnection with the community
became evident. People from various aspects
of the community (youth workers, juvenile
detention staff, emergency hospital staff, pedi-
atric nurses and physicians, social workers,
educators, etc.) were engaged in dialogues re-
flecting on the youths’ stories and the commu-
nity pattern. Insights transformed community
responses to young people at risk for violent
perpetration. System change ensued.
Pharris (2005) and colleagues extended the
community pattern recognition process through
partnerships within a multiethnic community
interested in understanding and transforming
patterns of racism and health disparities. They
engaged women and girls from all walks of life
in the community in dialogue about their ex-
periences of health, well-being, and racism.
Findings were woven into a spoken word nar-
rative that was presented in various forms (per-
formances at meetings and gatherings, through
community television and radio, and showing
of DVD recordings) to members of the com-
munity so that meaningful dialogue could
ensue. The process of reflecting on the com-
munity pattern generated insight into the na-
ture of the community and what actions could
be taken to dismantle racism and enhance
health and well-being.
In a related study comparing the evolving
patterns of Hmong women living in the
United States with diabetes, Yang et al. (2009)
found that the women’s blood sugars rose and
fell with their experiences of trauma, loss, sep-
aration, and isolation. Women in the study de-
scribed their lives in Laos where they walked
up and down hills carrying large bags of rice
on their backs, picked fresh fruits and vegeta-
bles that grew near their homes, and engaged
in myriad interactions with family and friends
in the community. Then they described their
life in the United States where they sit alone
at home all day watching television in a lan-
guage they do not understand and where they
are fearful to walk outside and are driven by
their sons and daughters to the grocery store,
where they buy food wrapped in plastic. Dia-
logue on these findings, which were presented
by two Hmong students as a play at a commu-
nity dinner for Hmong women living with
diabetes, shed light on needed individual,
family, and community actions so that Hmong
women living with diabetes could lead happy
and healthy lives.
Similarly, Pierre-Louis et al. (2011) con-
ducted an HEC study with African American
women with diabetes. Pattern recognition re-
vealed that blood sugars rose and fell with
stress, depression, and trauma and that spiri-
tual strength, mentors, and sister friends help
to balance energy demands. Findings were
woven into a spoken-word performance by the
Black Story Tellers Alliance to engage African
American women who have diabetes in action
planning so that health can flourish in their
lives.
Pavlish and Pharris (2012) published a
book on community-based collaborative action
research, which is rooted in Newman’s theory
and provides a framework for nurses to engage
communities—whether hospital units, refugee
camps, small towns, or groups of people—in
a process of pattern recognition and action
research to promote human flourishing.
Sharon Falkenstern (2003, 2009) found the
community pattern to emerge as significant
when she studied the process of HEC nursing
with families with a child with special health-
care needs. She emphasized the importance of
294 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 294
nursing partnership with families as they
struggle to make sense of their experiences and
try to discern how to get on with their lives.
The evolving pattern of the families in Falken-
stern’s study illuminated the social and politi-
cal forces on families from the educational,
disabilities support, and health-care systems,
as well as community patterns of caring, prej-
udice, and racism. Falkenstern summarized
her experience of using HEC with families
with children with special health-care needs in
the following way:
My experience with this study has rekindled my pas-
sion for nursing. I felt affirmed that in the world of
managed health care and educational cutbacks, a
movement is growing to recapture the essence and
value of nursing. While there is still much to be done
for nursing within the political realm of health care,
each nurse can control where and how they choose
to practice. Especially, I realized that a nurse can
experience joy and renewed energy by choosing to
practice nursing within health as expanding con-
sciousness. (2003, p. 232)
The pattern of the community is visible
in the stories of individuals and families.
Nurses can play an important role in engag-
ing communities in dialogue as these stories
are shared and their meaning reflected on.
Methods that engage communities in dia-
logue about the meaning of patterns of health
hold great potential. For example, if an HEC
nurse were to take on the task of engaging
nurses at the national level in a dialogue about
what is meaningful in their practice, expand-
ing consciousness would be manifest as the
profession reorganizes at a higher level of
functioning, with resultant health-care sys-
tems change. In the process, the population
would no doubt experience a fuller, more
equitable, and deeper sense of health, inter-
connectedness, and meaning.
Readers who are interested in learning more
about Margaret Newman’s theory of health as
expanding consciousness are referred to an inte-
grative review by Dr. Marlaine Smith (2011)
and to Dr. Newman’s website: healthasexpand-
ingconsciousness.org
CHAPTER 16 • Margaret Newman’s Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness 295
Practice Exemplar
Sandra is an adult nurse practitioner working
in a community clinic in an urban area of the
United States; she is about to enter the room
of Gloria, a new patient with diabetes and hy-
pertension. Gloria was referred by Anna, a
physician colleague who felt that Gloria was
“noncompliant,” as evidenced by her uncon-
trolled hypertension and hemoglobin A1c lev-
els that consistently hovered around 10. Anna
felt that Gloria needed more care than she
could provide for her.
Sandra’s graduate program in nursing was
based on the theory of health as expanding con-
sciousness; the faculty paid attention to know-
ing her and what was meaningful to her in her
educational and vocational journey. She expe-
rienced a relationship-based education process
where the teacher is seen as “a catalyst to help
students become who they will become rather
than be ‘trained’” and the learning process is
a “dance between content and resonance”
(Newman, 2008b, p. 75). Sandra felt known
and loved by the faculty. She had ample expe-
rience performing problem-solving approaches
through the medical paradigm that leads to di-
agnoses, yet she realized that her nursing ac-
tions were best guided by a dialogue focused on
understanding Gloria’s physical health within
the context of her life situation. She knew that
the focus of her care for Gloria would arise out
of their dialogue; she could not prescribe or
predetermine the best care for Gloria.
Before entering the room where Gloria is
waiting, Sandra consciously attends to freeing
herself of any personal preoccupations or expec-
tations of what might happen. She wants to fully
attend to Gloria and sense what is of greatest
importance to her right now, knowing that this
will guide Sandra’s nursing actions so that they
can be of most benefit to Gloria. Sandra is con-
fident that she will get a sense of this not only
by asking questions and listening deeply but also
through intuitive hunches that will arise through
her resonant presence with Gloria.
Continued
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 295
296 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
Practice Exemplar cont.
On entering the room, Sandra warmly
greets Gloria and concentrates on what she is
sensing from Gloria’s presence. She sits down
next to Gloria in a relaxing and open manner.
What most strongly calls Sandra’s attention is
that Gloria is wringing her hands, which are
sweaty; and her muscles seem very tense.
After pausing for a moment, Sandra
chooses to reflect back to Gloria what she sees.
“Your muscles seem tense, like you might be
anxious about something. How has life been
going for you?” Gloria looks at Sandra, curious
that Sandra is interested in her life. She re-
sponds, “Well, things have been hard.” Sandra
responds, “Hmm, tell me about that.” Gloria
explains that it has been difficult to take care
of the two children she provides day care for.
She says she doesn’t have the energy but needs
the money to pay her rent, which leaves her
very little money to buy food, and she cannot
afford her medications.
Sandra assures Gloria that the clinic has a
plan that will provide her with her medications
and that she will see that this is taken care of
today—that she will go home with adequate
medications. She tells Gloria that she would
like to learn a little more about what has been
meaningful in her life and asks her to describe
meaningful events. Sandra uses the examina-
tion table paper to draw a diagram of what
Gloria tells her. In very little time, Sandra has
sketched a diagram of the flow of important
events in Gloria’s life. She learns that when
immigrating to the United States from Africa,
Gloria suffered intense abuse and was sepa-
rated from her family and friends. She has
children in the United States who constantly
call her to babysit their children and to help
them out. Gloria has also experienced intimate
partner violence, and her current economic
stress and depression have flowed from this
experience. Gloria lives in a small apartment
in a neighborhood where she would need to
walk 2 miles to get to a store that sells fresh
fruits and vegetables. She tells Sandra she is
hesitant to leave her apartment.
Sandra reflects back to Gloria that she sees
all of Gloria’s energy going out to others and
none coming back to her. She has gone from
being very active to only moving around
within her apartment. Tears run down Gloria’s
cheeks as she listens to Sandra’s reflection.
“That is so true!” They talk about sources of
support, nurturance, and energy. Gloria iden-
tifies a woman in her building whose company
she enjoys. They talk about the possibility of
the two women walking to the supermarket
together and simply getting together to talk.
They identify a neighborhood women’s walk-
ing group, which might be a source of support.
They also talk about a women’s group at the
local library, but Gloria seems hesitant.
During the course of their conversation,
Sandra has tried to clear herself of her own
concerns, yet, as they talk, she keeps thinking
about an experience of racism she witnessed at
that library. She decides that it is important
information and shares the story with Gloria.
This provokes an outpouring of emotion from
Gloria as she recounts her experiences of
racism. They discuss how distorting these ex-
periences are and how to move through them.
They talk about how blood sugar and pressure
respond to these situations and ways in which
Gloria can best cope.
Sandra does all of the things for Gloria that
her medical colleagues would do. She also dis-
cusses the services of the social worker, dieti-
tian, and psychologist at the clinic so that
Gloria can choose what might be most helpful
to her at this time. Gloria hugs Sandra as she
leaves, saying that she feels so much better,
and adding, “You are a very good nurse!” Gloria
leaves with a greater understanding of herself,
of what is meaningful to her, and what actions
she might take. Sandra is left with the same
enhanced understanding of herself and her
practice.
Sandra tucks the diagram they have drawn
into a folder so that it can be elaborated on at
subsequent visits. Sandra knows that Gloria’s
experience of health and well-being will evolve
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 296
CHAPTER 16 • Margaret Newman’s Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness 297
Practice Exemplar cont.
and that she can serve as a catalyst, witnessing
and engaging in dialogue about the meaning
of the pattern of Gloria’s evolving health. Sandra
will continue to focus on what she senses as
meaningful to Gloria and engage in a relation-
ship centered on Gloria’s unfolding pattern of
health. Hemoglobin A1c levels and blood
pressure readings are only one aspect of that
pattern.
As Sandra engages with more and more
patients with similar predicaments, she gets a
sense of the community pattern of health. She
brings her insight to the clinic staff meetings
where a rich dialogue about community health
ensues. Sandra joins the CEO for a dialogue
with the clinic’s community board of directors
to offer their insights. Through the subsequent
dialogue, the board of directors and CEO
commit themselves to ensuring that health-
care providers have sufficient time to attend to
patients in a holistic manner, sponsoring com-
munity forums on racism and how to deal with
it, embedding a mental health practitioner
in the medical clinic, partnering with a com-
munity recreational facility so that patients
have a safe place to exercise, encouraging com-
munity microeconomic enterprises for women,
working with a community coop to provide
an affordable source of nutritious food in the
immediate neighborhood, and lobbying for
health-care financing reform.
The circle of dialogue continues for Sandra.
Her attention is on pattern and meaning in the
evolving health of her patients and the com-
munity. She trusts that health is inherently
present in her patients and the community and
that reflection on what is meaningful is a cat-
alyst for its evolving pattern. With this real-
ization, Sandra is able to return home where
she can be fully present to her family.
■ Summary
Margaret Newman’s theory of health as ex-
panding consciousness calls nurses to focus on
that which is meaningful in their practice and
in the lives of their patients. It attends to the
evolving pattern of interactions with the envi-
ronment for individuals, families, and commu-
nities. It is a theory that is relevant across
practice settings and cultures. It informs and
guides nursing practice, health-care adminis-
tration, and education. The theory of HEC
presents a philosophy of being with rather than
simply doing for. It involves a different way of
knowing—of resonating with patients, stu-
dents, and health-care colleagues.
Nurses grounded in the theory of health
as expanding consciousness bring to the pa-
tient encounter all that they have learned in
school and in practice, yet they begin with a
sense of nonknowing to take in what is most
meaningful to the patient. Nurses attend to
the patient’s definition of health and see it in
the context of the patient’s expression of
meaningful relationships and events. The
focus is not on predetermined outcomes
mandated by the health system or on fixing
the patient but rather on partnering with the
patient in his or her experience of health.
Rather than simply using technological tools
and following prescribed clinical pathways,
nurses offer their own transforming presence,
knowing that the direction of their interac-
tion with patients will arise out of the rela-
tionship’s focus on the patient’s evolving
experience of health. Nurses realize that the
process of expanding consciousness involves
transcendence and new possibilities as people
age or encounter a challenging life event. As
nurses come to understand the meaning of
patterns in the lives of individuals, families,
and communities, they gain insights that in-
form population level dialogue for health
policy transformation.
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 297
funding to review the Margaret A. Newman
archives housed at the University of Ten-
nessee and to interview Dr. Newman. That
work has informed this chapter and her
life. She also thanks Dr. Newman for editing
this chapter and adding the section, “Losing
Our Senses, Finding Our Selves,” which
includes her current thinking related to gero-
trancendence and health as expanding con-
sciousness and can be accessed in the
electronic supplement to this chapter. This
section can be found in the online supple-
mentary materials for the chapter at: http://
davisplus.fadavis.com
298 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
References
Barron, A. M. (2005). Suffering, growth, and possibility:
Health as expanding consciousness in end-of-life
care. In C. Picard & D. Jones (Eds.), Giving voice to
what we know: Margaret Newman’s theory of health as
expanding consciousness in research, theory, and practice
(pp. 43–52). Boston: Jones and Bartlett.
Bentov, I. (1978). Stalking the wild pendulum. New York:
E. P. Dutton.
Bohm, D. (1980). Wholeness and the implicate order.
London: Routledge & Kegan Paul.
Connor, M. (1998). Expanding the dialogue on praxis
in nursing research and practice. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 11(2), 51–55.
Downs, F. S., & Newman, M. A. (1977). A source
book on nursing research (2nd ed.). Philadelphia:
F. A. Davis.
Endo, E. (1998). Pattern recognition as a nursing inter-
vention with Japanese women with ovarian cancer.
Advances in Nursing Science, 20(4), 49–61.
Endo, E., Minegishi, H., & Kubo, S. (2005). Creating
action research teams: A praxis model of care. In C.
Picard & D. Jones (Eds.), Giving voice to what we
know: Margaret Newman’s theory of health as expand-
ing consciousness in research, theory, and practice
(pp. 143–152). Boston: Jones and Bartlett.
Endo, E., Miyahara, T., Suzuki, S., & Ohmasa, T.
(2005). Partnering of researcher and practicing
nurses for transformative nursing. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 18(2), 138–145.
Endo, E., Nitta, E., Inayoshi, M., Saito, R., Takemura,
K., Minegishi, H., et al. (2000). Pattern recognition
as a caring partnership in families with cancer.
Journal of Advanced Nursing, 32(3), 603–610.
Endo, E., Takaki, M., Nitta, N., Abe, K., & Terashima,
K. (2009). Indentifying patterns in partnership with
students who want to quit smoking. Journal of Holistic
Nursing, 27(4), 256–265.
Falkenstern, S. K. (2003). Nursing facilitation of expand-
ing consciousness in families who have a child with
special health care needs. Unpublished doctoral thesis,
Pennsylvania State University, University Park, PA.
Falkenstern, S. K., Gueldner, S. H., & Newman, M. A.
(2009). Health as expanding consciousness with
families with a child with special healthcare needs.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 22(3), 267–279.
Flanagan, J. (2005). Creating a healing environment for
staff and patients in a pre-surgery clinic. In: C.
Picard & D. Jones (Eds.), Giving voice to what we
know: Margaret Newman’s theory of health as expand-
ing consciousness in research, theory, and practice
(pp. 53–64). Boston: Jones and Bartlett.
Flanagan, J. (2009). Patient and nurse experiences of
theory-based care. Nursing Science Quarterly, 22(2),
160–172.
Hayes, M. O., & Jones, D. (2007). Health as expanding
consciousness: Pattern recognition and incarcerated
mothers, a transforming experience. Journal of Forensic
Nursing, 3(2), 61–66.
Heron, J., & Reason, P. (1997). A participatory inquiry
paradigm. Qualitative Inquiry, 3(3), 274–294.
Johnson, D. E. (1961). The significance of nursing care.
American Journal of Nursing, 61(11), 63–66.
Jonsdottir, H. (1998). Life patterns of people with chronic
obstructive pulmonary disease: Isolation and being
closed in. Nursing Science Quarterly, 11(4), 160–166.
Jonsdottir, H., Litchfield, M., & Pharris, M. D. (2003).
Partnership in practice. Research and Theory for
Nursing Practice, 17(3), 51–63.
Jonsdottir, H., Litchfield, M., & Pharris, M. D. (2004).
The relational core of nursing practice. Journal of
Advanced Nursing, 47(3), 241–250.
Kiser-Larson, N. (2002). Life pattern of native women
experiencing breast cancer. International Journal for
Human Caring, 6(2), 61–68.
Lamendola, F. (1998). Patterns of the caregiver experiences
of selected nurses in hospice and HIV/AIDS care. Un-
published doctoral thesis, University of Minnesota,
Minneapolis.
Newman (2008b) stated:
This theory asserts that every person in every situation,
no matter how disordered and hopeless it may seem,
is part of a process of expanding consciousness—a
process of becoming more of oneself, of finding greater
meaning in life, and of reaching new heights of con-
nectedness with other people and the world. (p. 6)
Acknowledgments
The author thanks St. Catherine University
for sabbatical support and scholarly research
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 298
CHAPTER 16 • Margaret Newman’s Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness 299
Lamendola, F., & Newman, M. A. (1994). The paradox
of HIV/AIDS as expanding consciousness. Advances
in Nursing Science, 16(3), 13–21.
Litchfield, M. C. (1993). The process of health patterning
in families with young children who have been repeat-
edly hospitalized. Unpublished master’s thesis,
University of Minnesota, Minneapolis.
Litchfield, M. (1999). Practice wisdom. Advances in
Nursing Science, 22(2), 62–73.
Litchfield, M. C. (2005). The nursing praxis of family
health. In: C. Picard & D. Jones (Eds.), Giving voice
to what we know: Margaret Newman’s theory of health
as expanding consciousness in research, theory, and
practice (pp. 73–83). Boston: Jones and Bartlett.
Litchfield, M., & Laws, M. (1999). Achieving family
health and cost-containment outcomes. In: E. L.
Cohen & V. De Back (Eds.), The outcomes mandate:
Case management in health care today (pp. 306–314).
St. Louis, MO: C. V. Mosby.
Moch, S. D. (1990). Health within the experience of
breast cancer. Journal of Advanced Nursing, 15,
1426–1435.
Moss, R. (1991). The I that is we. Millbrae, CA: Celestial
Arts.
Musker, K.M. (2008). Life patterns of women transi-
tioning through menopause: A Newman research
study. Nursing Science Quarterly, 21(4), 330-342.
Neill, J. (2002a). Transcendence and transformation in
the life patterns of women living with rheumatoid
arthritis. Advances in Nursing Science, 24(4), 27–47.
Neill, J. (2002b). From practice to caring praxis through
Newman’s theory of health as expanding conscious-
ness: A personal journey. International Journal for
Human Caring, 6(2), 48–54.
Newman, M. A. (1966). Identifying and meeting
patients’ needs in short-span nurse-patient relation-
ships. Nursing Forum, 5(1), 76–86.
Newman, M.A. (1971). Time estimation in relation to
gait tempo. Perceptual and Motor Skills, 34, 359–366.
Newman, M. A. (1972). Nursing’s theoretical evolution.
Nursing Outlook, 20(7), 449–453.
Newman, M. A. (1976). Movement tempo and the
experience of time. Nursing Research, 25, 173–179.
Newman, M. A. (1978). Nursing theory. (Audiotape of
an address to the 2nd National Nurse Educator
Conference in New York.) Chicago: Teach’em, Inc.
Newman, M. A. (1979). Theory development in nursing.
Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Newman, M. A. (1982). Time as an index of expanding
consciousness with age. Nursing Research, 31, 290–293.
Newman, M. A. (1986). Health as expanding conscious-
ness. St. Louis, MO: C. V. Mosby.
Newman, M. A. (1987). Aging as increasing complexity.
Journal of Gerontological Nursing, 12, 16–18.
Newman, M. A. (1990). Newman’s theory of health as
praxis. Nursing Science Quarterly, 3, 37–41.
Newman, M. A. (1994a). Health as expanding consciousness
(2nd ed.). Boston: Jones and Bartlett (NLN Press).
Newman, M. A. (1994b). Theory for nursing practice.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 7(4), 153–157.
Newman, M. A. (1995). A developing discipline. Boston:
Jones and Bartlett (formerly, New York: National
League for Nursing Press).
Newman, M. A. (1997a). Experiencing the whole.
Advances in Nursing Science, 20(1), 34–39.
Newman, M. A. (1997b). Evolution of the theory of
health as expanding consciousness. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 10(1), 22–25.
Newman, M. A. (1999). The rhythm of relating in a
paradigm of wholeness. Image: Journal of Nursing
Scholarship, 31(3), 227–230.
Newman, M. A. (2003). A world with no boundaries.
Advances in Nursing Science, 26(4), 240–245.
Newman, M. A. (2005). Preface. In C. Picard & D. Jones
(Eds.), Giving voice to what we know: Margaret
Newman’s theory of health as expanding consciousness
in research, theory, and practice (pp. xxiii–xxvi).
Sudbury, MA: Jones and Bartlett.
Newman, M. A. (2008a). It’s about time. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 21(3), 225–227.
Newman, M. A. (2008b). Transforming presence: The dif-
ference that nursing makes. Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Newman, M. A., & Moch, S. D. (1991). Life patterns
of persons with coronary heart disease. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 4, 161–167.
Newman, M. A., Sime, A. M., & Corcoran-Perry, S. A.
(1991). The focus of the discipline of nursing.
Advances in Nursing Science, 14(1), 1–6.
Newman, M. A., Smith, M. C., Pharris, M. D., &
Jones, D. (2008). The focus of the discipline revis-
ited. Advances in Nursing Science, 31(1), E16–E27.
Noveletsky-Rosenthal, H. T. (1996). Pattern recognition
in older adults living with chronic illness. Unpublished
doctoral thesis, Boston College, Chestnut Hill, MA.
Pavlish, C. P. & Pharris, M. D. (2012). Community-
based collaborative action research: A nursing approach.
Sudbury, MA: Jones and Bartlett.
Pharris, M. D. (1999). Pattern recognition as a nursing
intervention with adolescents convicted of murder.
Unpublished doctoral thesis, University of Minnesota,
Minneapolis.
Pharris, M. D. (2002). Coming to know ourselves as
community through a nursing partnership with ado-
lescents convicted of murder. Advances in Nursing
Science, 24(3), 21–42.
Pharris, M. D. (2005). Engaging with communities in a
pattern recognition process. In C. Picard & D. Jones
(Eds.), Giving voice to what we know: Margaret
Newman’s theory of health as expanding consciousness
in research, theory, and practice (pp. 83–94). Boston:
Jones and Bartlett.
Pharris, M. D. (2011). Margaret A. Newman’s theory of
health as expanding consciousness. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 24(3), 193–194.
Pharris, M. D., & Endo, E. (2007). Flying free: The
evolving nature of nursing practice guided by the
theory of health as expanding consciousness. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 20(2), 136–140.
Picard, C. (2000). Pattern of expanding consciousness
in mid-life women: Creative movement and the
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 299
300 SECTION IV • Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary–Transformative Paradigm
narrative as modes of expression. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 13(2), 150–158.
Picard, C. (2005). Parents of persons with bipolar disor-
der and pattern recognition. In C. Picard & D. Jones
(Eds.), Giving voice to what we know: Margaret
Newman’s theory of health as expanding consciousness
in research, theory, and practice (pp. 133–141). Boston:
Jones and Bartlett.
Pierre-Louis, B., Akoh, V., White, P. & Pharris, M. D.
(2011). Patterns in the lives of African American
women with diabetes. Nursing Science Quarterly,
24(3), 227–236.
Prigogine, I. (1976). Order through fluctuation:
Self-organization and social system. In Jantsch,
E., & Waddington, C. H. (Eds.), Evolution
and consciousness (pp. 93–133). Reading, MA:
Addison-Wesley.
Quinn, J. F. (1992). Holding sacred space. The nurse as
healing environment. Holistic Nursing Practice, 6(4),
26–36.
Rogers, M. E. (1970). An introduction to the theoretical
basis of nursing. Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Rogers, M. E. (1990). Nursing science and the space
age. Nursing Science Quarterly, 5(1), 27–34.
Rosa, K. C. (2006). A process model of healing and
personal transformation in persons with chronic skin
wounds. Nursing Science Quarterly, 19, 349–358.
Ruka, S. (2005). Creating balance, rhythm and patterns
in people with dementia living in a nursing home. In
C. Picard & D. Jones (Eds.), Giving voice to what
we know: Margaret Newman’s theory of health as ex-
panding consciousness in research, theory, and practice
(pp. 59–104). Boston: Jones and Bartlett.
Skolimowski, H. (1994). The participatory mind. London:
Arkana.
Smith, M. C. (2011). Integrative review of research
related to Margaret Newman’s theory of health as
expanding consciousness. Nursing Science Quarterly,
24(3), 256–272.
Smith, T. D. (2001). The concept of nursing presence:
State of the science. Scholarly Inquiry for Nursing
Practice: An International Journal, 15(4), 299–322.
Thompson, W. I. (1989). Imaginary landscape: Making
worlds of myth and science. New York: St. Martin’s Press.
Tommet, P. (2003). Nurse-parent dialogue: Illuminat-
ing the evolving pattern of families with children
who are medically fragile. Nursing Science Quarterly,
16(3), 239–246.
Yang, A., Xiong, D., Vange, E., & Pharris, M.D.
(2009). Hmong American women living with diabetes.
Journal of Nursing Scholarship, 41(2), 139–148.
Young, A. M. (1976). The reflexive universe: Evolution of
consciousness. San Francisco, CA: Robert Briggs
Associates.
3312_Ch16_279-300 26/12/14 4:46 PM Page 300
Section V
Grand Theories about Care
or Caring
301
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 301
302
Three of the grand theories in this book focus on the phenomenon of care or caring
in nursing. These theorists describe care or caring as the central domain of the
discipline of nursing. Rather than place these in either the interactive–integrative
or unitary–transformative paradigm, we situated them in a category of their own.
Madeleine Leininger’s theory of cultural care diversity and universality is cov-
ered in Chapter 17. The theory is described, and practice applications of the
theory are provided. Leininger was the first to define care as the essence of nurs-
ing; she asserted that care or nurturance can be understood only within cultural
contexts.
Jean Watson’s work can be conceptualized as a philosophy, grand theory,
or middle-range theory, depending on the lens of the nurse working with the
theory. Watson’s theory is composed of the ten caritas processes, the transper-
sonal caring relationship, the caring occasion, and caring–healing modalities.
Watson’s theory draws from a spiritual dimension affirming that transpersonal
caring is connecting and embracing the spirit or soul of another. She shares
examples of how her theory is being advanced and applied as a model for
practice through the Watson Caring Science Institute and the International
Caritas Consortium.
The premise of Anne Boykin and Savina Schoenhofer’s theory of nursing as
caring is that the focus of nursing is the person living and growing in caring. The
theory encompasses coming to know the other as caring, hearing and answering
calls for caring, and nurturing the growth of the other as caring person. This theory
has transformed, and is currently transforming, care in a variety of settings.
Section
V Grand Theories about Care or Caring
302
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 302
Chapter 17Madeleine Leininger’s Theory
of Culture Care Diversity and
Universality
HIBA WEHBE-ALAMAH
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Theory
Applications of the Theory
Summary
Practice Exemplar
References
Madeleine M. Leininger
303
Introducing the Theorist
Madeleine M. Leininger (1925–2012) founded
the worldwide field of transcultural nursing, the
International Transcultural Nursing Society,
and the Journal of Transcultural Nursing.
Dr. Leininger obtained her initial nursing ed-
ucation at St. Anthony School of Nursing in
Denver, Colorado. She earned her undergrad-
uate degree from Mt. St. Scholastic College in
Atchison, Kansas; her master’s degree in psy-
chiatric and mental health nursing from the
Catholic University of America; and her PhD
in social and cultural anthropology at the Uni-
versity of Washington (Boyle & Glittenberg
Hinrichs, 2013). Dr. Leininger served as dean
at the Universities of Washington and Utah,
where she helped initiate and direct the first
doctoral programs in nursing and facilitated
the development of master’s degree programs
in nursing at American and overseas institu-
tions. Recognized as a Living Legend by the
American Academy of Nursing and a distin-
guished fellow by the Australian Royal College
of Nursing, she served as a professor emerita in
the College of Nursing at Wayne State Uni-
versity and adjunct professor at the University
of Nebraska College of Nursing. Dr. Leininger
passed away at her home in Omaha, Nebraska,
at the age of 87 on August 10, 2012.
In the span of her prolific career, Madeleine
Leininger published 35 books, wrote approxi-
mately 3,000 articles (some of which were
never published), and gave more than 5,000
presentations or public lectures throughout the
United States and abroad, in addition to con-
tributing to numerous books and videos (Boyle
& Glittenberg Hinrichs, 2013). Some of her
well-known books include Basic Psychiatric
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 303
Concepts in Nursing (Leininger & Hofling,
1960); Caring: An Essential Human Need
(1981); Care: The Essence of Nursing and Health
(1984); Care: Discovery and Uses in Clinical and
Community Nursing (1988); Ethical and Moral
Dimensions of Care (1990d); and Culture Care
Diversity and Universality: A Theory of Nursing
(1991a, 2006a). Nursing and Anthropology: Two
Worlds to Blend (1970) was the first book to
bring together nursing and anthropology. The
first book on transcultural nursing was Trans -
cultural Nursing: Concepts, Theories, and Practices
(1978, 1995, 2002). Her book Qualitative Re-
search Methods in Nursing (1985, 1998) was the
first published qualitative research methods
book in nursing. In 1989, Dr. Leininger
founded the Journal of Transcultural Nursing,
the first transcultural nursing journal in the
world.
Dr. Leininger conducted the first field
study of the Gadsup Akuna of the Eastern
Highlands of New Guinea in the early 1960s
and went on to study more than cultures. She
developed the first nursing research method
called ethnonursing, used by scholars in nursing
and other disciplines. She initiated the idea of
worldwide certification of nurses prepared
in transcultural nursing. Today, Basic (under-
graduate) and Advanced (graduate) certifica-
tions are available through the Transcultural
Nursing Society.
Overview of the Theory
One of Dr. Leininger’s most significant and
unique contributions was the development
of her culture care diversity and universality the-
ory, also known as the culture care theory
(CCT), which she introduced in the early
1960s to provide culturally congruent and
competent care (Leininger, 1991b, 1995,
2006a; McFarland, 2010). She believed that
transcultural nursing care could provide mean-
ingful, therapeutic health and healing out-
comes. As she developed the theory, she
identified transcultural nursing concepts, prin-
ciples, theories, and research-based knowledge
to guide, challenge, and explain nursing prac-
tices. This was a significant innovation in nurs-
ing and has helped open the door to new
scientific and humanistic dimensions of caring
for people of diverse and similar cultures.
The theory of culture care diversity and uni-
versality was developed to establish a substantive
knowledge base to guide nurses in discovery and
use of transcultural nursing practices. During
the post–World War II period, Dr. Leininger
realized nurses would need transcultural knowl-
edge and practices to function with people of
diverse cultures worldwide (Leininger, 1970,
1978). Many new immigrants and refugees
were coming to the United States, and the
world was becoming more multicultural.
Leininger held that caring for people of
many cultures was a critical and essential need,
yet nurses and other health professionals were
not prepared to meet this global challenge.
Instead, nursing and medicine were focused on
using new medical technologies and treatment
regimens. They concentrated on biomedical
study of diseases and symptoms. Shifting to
a transcultural perspective was a major but
critically needed change.
This part of the chapter presents an
overview of the theory of culture care diversity
and universality, along with its purpose, goals,
assumptions, theoretical tenets, predicted
hunches, related general features, and newest
features. The next part of the chapter discusses
applications of the knowledge in clinical and
community settings. For a more in-depth dis-
cussion of the theorist’s perspectives, consult
the primary literature on the theory (Leininger,
1970, 1981, 1989a, 1989b, 1990a, 1990b,
1991a, 1995, 1997a, 1998, 2002, 2006a;
McFarland, 2010).
Factors Leading to the Theory
Dr. Leininger’s major motivation for the de-
velopment of the CCT was the desire to dis-
cover unknown or little-known knowledge
about cultures and their core values, beliefs,
and needs. The idea for the CCT came to
her while she was a clinical child nurse spe-
cialist in a child guidance home in a large
Midwestern city (Leininger, 1970, 1991a,
1995, 2006a). From her focused observations
and daily nursing experiences with the chil-
dren in the home, she became aware that
they were from many cultures, differing in
304 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 304
their behaviors, needs, responses, and care ex-
pectations. In the home were youngsters who
were Anglo American, African American,
Jewish American, Appalachian, and many
other cultures. Their parents responded to
them differently, and their expectations of
care and treatment modes were different. The
reality was a shock to Leininger because she
was not prepared to care for children of di-
verse cultures. Likewise, nurses, physicians,
social workers, and health professionals in the
guidance home were also not prepared to
respond to such cultural differences.
It soon became evident that she needed
cultural knowledge to be helpful to the chil-
dren. Her psychiatric and general nursing
care knowledge and experiences were inade-
quate. She decided to pursue doctoral study
in anthropology. While in the anthropology
doctoral program, she discovered a wealth
of potentially valuable knowledge that would
be helpful from a nursing perspective.
To care for children of diverse cultures and
link such knowledge into nursing knowledge
and practice was a major challenge. It was
essential to incorporate new cultural knowl-
edge that went beyond the traditional
physical and emotional needs of clients.
Leininger was concerned about whether such
learning would be possible, given nursing’s
traditional norms and orientation toward
medical knowledge.
At that time, she questioned what made
nursing a distinct and legitimate profession.
She declared in the mid-1950s that care is (or
should be) the essence and central domain of
nursing. However, according to Leininger,
many nurses resisted this idea because they
thought care was unimportant, too feminine,
too soft, and too vague and that it would
never explain nursing and be accepted by
medicine (Leininger, 1970, 1977, 1981, 1984).
Nonetheless, Leininger firmly held to the
claim and began to teach, study, and write
about care as the essence of nursing, its unique
and dominant attribute (Leininger, 1970,
1981, 1988, 1991a, 2006a). From both anthro-
pological and nursing perspectives, she held
that care and caring were basic and essential
human needs for human growth, development,
and survival (Leininger, 1977, 1981, 2006a).
She argued that what humans need is human
caring to survive from birth to old age, when
ill or well. Nevertheless, care needed to be
specific and appropriate to cultures.
Her next step in the theory was to con-
ceptualize selected cultural perspectives and
transcultural nursing concepts derived from
anthropology. She developed assumptions of
culture care to establish a knowledge base for
the new field of transcultural nursing. Synthe-
sizing or interfacing culture care into nursing
was a real challenge. (Leininger, 1976, 1978,
1990a, 1990b, 1991a, 2006a). Findings from
the theory could provide the knowledge to care
for people of different cultures. The idea of
providing care was largely taken for granted or
assumed to be understood by nurses, clients,
and the public (Leininger, 1981, 1984). Yet
the meaning of “care” from the perspective of
different cultures was unknown to nurses and
did not appear in the literature before the es-
tablishment of Leininger’s theory in the early
1960s. Care knowledge had to be discovered
with cultures.
Leininger (1981, 1988, 1990a, 1991a,
1995) maintained that before her work, there
were no theories explicitly focused on care and
culture in nursing environments, let alone
research studies to explicate care meanings
and phenomena in nursing. Theoretical
and practical meanings of care in relation to
specific cultures had not been studied, espe-
cially from a comparative cultural perspective.
Leininger saw the urgent need to develop a
whole new body of culturally based care
knowledge to support transcultural nursing
care. Shifting nurses’ thinking and attitudes
from medical symptoms, diseases, and treat-
ments to that of knowing cultures and caring
values and patterns was a major task. But
nursing needed an appropriate theory to
discover care, and Leininger held that her the-
ory was “the only theory focused on develop-
ing new knowledge for the discipline of
transcultural nursing” (Leininger, 2006a, p. 7).
Essential features of the CCT and the eth-
nonursing research method were developed
and/or revisited throughout Leininger’s life
(Leininger, 2006a, 2011).
CHAPTER 17 • Madeleine Leininger’s Theory of Culture Care Diversity and Universality 305
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 305
Rationale for Transcultural Nursing:
Signs and Need
The rationale for change in nursing in America
and elsewhere (Leininger, 1970, 1978, 1984,
1989a, 1990a, 1995) was based on the following
observations:
1. There were global migrations and interac-
tions of people from virtually every place in
the world due to modern electronics, trans-
portation, and communication. These peo-
ple needed sensitive and appropriate care.
2. There were signs of cultural stresses and
cultural conflicts as nurses tried to care
for clients from diverse Western and
non-Western cultures.
3. There were cultural indications of con-
sumer fears and resistance to health
personnel as they used new technologies
and treatment modes that did not fit their
clients’ values and lifeways.
4. There were signs that some clients from
different cultures were angry, frustrated,
and misunderstood by health personnel
owing to ignorance of the clients’ cultural
beliefs, values, and expectations.
5. There were signs of misdiagnosis and mis-
treatment of clients from diverse cultures
because health personnel did not under-
stand the culture of the client.
6. There were signs that nurses, physicians,
and other professional health personnel
were becoming quite frustrated in caring
for clients from unfamiliar cultures. Cul-
ture care factors were largely misunder-
stood or neglected.
7. There were signs that consumers of dif-
ferent cultures, whether in the home,
hospital, or clinic, were being treated in
ways that did not satisfy them and this
influenced their recovery.
8. There were many signs of intercultural
conflicts and cultural pain among staff
that led to tensions.
9. There were very few health personnel of
diverse cultures caring for clients.
10. Nurses were beginning to work in foreign
countries in the military or as missionar-
ies, and they were having great difficulty
understanding and providing appropriate
caring for clients of diverse cultures. They
complained that they did not understand
the peoples’ needs, values, and lifeways.
Although anthropologists were clearly ex-
perts about cultures, many did not know what
to do with patients, nor were they interested
in nurses’ work, in nursing as a profession, or
in the study of human care phenomena in the
early 1950s. Most anthropologists in those
early days were far more interested in medical
diseases, archaeological findings, and in phys-
ical and psychological problems of culture. For
these reasons and many others, it was clearly
evident in the 1960s that people of different
cultures were not receiving care congruent with
their cultural beliefs and values (Leininger,
1978, 1995). Nurses and other health profes-
sionals urgently needed transcultural knowl-
edge and skills to work efficiently with people
of diverse cultures.
Leininger therefore took a leadership role
in the new field she called transcultural nursing.
She defined transcultural nursing as an area of
study and practice focused on cultural care
(caring) values, beliefs, and practices of partic-
ular cultures. The goal was to provide culture-
specific and congruent care to people of diverse
cultures (Leininger, 1978, 1984, 1995, 2006a).
The central purpose of transcultural nursing
was to use research-based knowledge to help
nurses discover care values and practices and
use this knowledge in safe, responsible, and
meaningful ways to care for people of different
cultures. Today the CCT has led to a wealth
of research-based knowledge to guide nurses
and other health professionals in the care of
clients, families, and communities of different
cultures or subcultures.
Major Theoretical Tenets
In developing the theory of culture care diver-
sity and universality, Leininger identified sev-
eral predictive tenets or premises as essential
for nurses and others to use.
Diversities and Commonalities
A principal tenet was that diversities and sim-
ilarities (or commonalities) in culture care ex-
pressions, meanings, patterns, and practices
306 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 306
would be found within cultures. This tenet
challenges nurses to discover this knowledge
so that nurses could use cultural data to pro-
vide therapeutic outcomes. It was predicted
there would be a gold mine of knowledge if
nurses were patient and persistent to discover
care values and patterns within cultures, a di-
mension that had been missing from tradi-
tional nursing. Leininger maintained that
human beings are born, live, and die with their
specific cultural values and beliefs, as well as
with their historical and environmental con-
text, and that care is important for their sur-
vival and well-being. Leininger predicted that
discovering which elements of care were cul-
turally universal and which were different
would drastically revolutionize nursing and
ultimately transform health-care systems and
practices (Leininger, 1978, 1990a, 1990b,
1991a, 2006a).
Worldview and Social Structure Factors
Another major tenet of the theory was that
worldview and social structure factors—such
as technology, religion (including spirituality
and philosophy), kinship (family ties), cultural
values, beliefs, and lifeways, political and legal
factors, economic and educational factors,
as well as ethnohistory, language expressions,
environmental context, and generic and pro-
fessional care—influence ways individuals,
families, groups, and/or communities consider
and deal with health, well-being, illness, heal-
ing, disabilities, and death (Leininger, 1995,
2006a). This broad and multifaceted view pro-
vides a holistic perspective for understanding
people and grasping their world and environ-
ment within a historical context. Data from
this holistic research-based knowledge guides
nurses in caring for the health and well-being
of the individual or to help disabled or dying
clients from different cultures. Social structural
factors influencing care of people from differ-
ent cultures provide new insights for culturally
congruent care. Systematic study by nurse re-
searchers rather than superficial knowledge of
culture is required to provide culturally con-
gruent care. These factors, together with the
history of cultures and knowledge of their en-
vironmental factors, were discovered to create
the theory and to bring forth new insights and
new knowledge. These data disclose ways that
clients can stay well and prevent illnesses. In-
deed, to meet the theory’s goal of making de-
cisions that provide culturally congruent care,
holistic cultural knowledge must be discovered
(Leininger, 1991a, 2006a).
Discovering cultural care knowledge re-
quires entering the cultural world to observe,
listen, and validate ideas. Transcultural nursing
is an immersion experience, not a “dip in and
dip out” experience. No longer can nurses rely
only on fragments of medical and psychologi-
cal knowledge. Nurses must become aware of
the social structure, cultural history, language
use, and the environment in which people live
to understand cultural care expressions. Thus,
nurses need to understand the philosophy of
transcultural nursing, the culture care theory,
and ways to discover culture knowledge. Tran-
scultural nursing courses and programs are
essential to provide the necessary instruction
and mentoring.
Professional and Generic Care
Another major and predicted tenet of the the-
ory is that differences and similarities exist
between the practices of two kinds of care:
professional (etic) and generic (emic, tradi-
tional, indigenous, or “folk”; Leininger, 1991a,
2006a; McFarland, 2010). These differences
influence the health, illness, and well-being of
clients. Elucidating these differences identify
gaps in care, inappropriate care, and also ben-
eficial care. Such findings influence the recov-
ery (healing), health, and well-being of clients
of different cultures. Marked differences be-
tween generic and professional care ideas and
actions lead to serious client–nurse conflicts,
potential illnesses, and even death (Leininger,
1978, 1995). Such differences must be identi-
fied and resolved.
Three Modalities
Leininger identified three ways to attain and
maintain culturally congruent care (Leininger,
1991a, 2006a; McFarland, 2010). The three
modalities postulated are (1) culture care
preservation and/or maintenance, (2) culture
care accommodation and/or negotiation, and
CHAPTER 17 • Madeleine Leininger’s Theory of Culture Care Diversity and Universality 307
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 307
(3) culture care restructuring and/or repattern-
ing (Leininger, 1991a, 1995, 2006a). These
three modes were very different from traditional
nursing practices, routines, or interventions.
They are focused on ways to use theoretical data
creatively to facilitate congruent care to fit
clients’ particular cultural needs. To arrive at
culturally appropriate care, the nurse has to
draw on fresh culture care research and discov-
ered knowledge from the people along with
theoretical data findings. The care is tailored
to client needs. Leininger believed that rou-
tine interventions would not always be appro-
priate and could lead to cultural imposition,
tensions, and conflicts. Nurses need to shift
from relying on routine interventions and
from focusing on symptoms to employing care
practices derived from the clients’ culture and
from the theory. They need to use holistic care
knowledge from the theory as opposed to
relying solely on medical data. Most impor-
tant of all, they need to use both generic and
professional care findings. This was a new
challenge but a rewarding one for the nurse
and the client if thoughtfully done, as it fosters
nurse–client collaboration. Examples of the
use of the three modalities can be found in
several published sources (Leininger, 1995,
1999, 2002; McFarland et al., 2011; Wehbe-
Alamah, 2008a, 2011) and are presented in
the next part of this chapter.
Use of Leininger’s theory has led to the dis-
covery of new kinds of transcultural nursing
knowledge. Culturally based care can prevent
illness and maintain wellness. Methods for
helping people throughout the life cycle, from
birth to death, have been discovered. Cultural
patterns of caring and health maintenance
along with environmental and historical factors
are important. Most important, the use of
Leininger’s theory has helped uncover signifi-
cant cultural differences and similarities.
Theoretical Assumptions: Purpose,
Goal, and Definitions of the Theory
This section discusses some of the major as-
sumptions, definitions, and purposes of the
theory. The theory’s overriding purpose is to
discover, document, analyze, and identify the
cultural and care factors influencing humans
in health, sickness, and dying and to thereby
advance and improve nursing practices.
The theory’s goal is to discover generic
(folk) and professional care beliefs, expressions,
and practices that could be incorporated into
collaborative plans of care designed to provide
culturally appropriate, safe, beneficial, and
satisfying care to people of diverse or similar
cultures, to promote their health and well-
being, and to assist them in facing death or
disabilities. Thus, the ultimate and primary
goal of the theory is to provide culturally con-
gruent care that is tailor-made for the lifeways
and values of people (Leininger, 1991a, 1995,
2006a; McFarland, Mixer, Wehbe-Alamah, &
Burke, 2012).
Theory Assumptions
Leininger postulated several theoretical
assumptions, or basic beliefs, designed to as-
sist researchers exploring Western and non-
Western cultures (Leininger, 1970, 1977,
1981, 1984, 1991a, 1997b, 2006a):
1. Care is the essence and the central
dominant, distinct, and unifying focus
of nursing.
2. Humanistic and scientific care are essen-
tial for human growth, well-being, health,
survival, and to face death and disabilities.
3. Care (caring) is essential to curing or
healing, for there can be no curing with-
out caring. (This assumption was held to
have profound relevance worldwide.)
4. Culture care is the synthesis of two major
constructs that guide the researcher to
discover, explain, and account for health,
well-being, care expressions, and other
human conditions.
5. Culture care expressions, meanings,
patterns, processes, and structural forms
are diverse; but some commonalities
(universalities) exist among and between
cultures.
6. Culture care values, beliefs, and practices
are influenced by and embedded in the
worldview, social structure factors (e.g., re-
ligion, philosophy of life, kinship, politics,
308 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 308
others with evident or anticipated needs to
ameliorate or improve a human condition
or lifeway. Caring refers to actions, atti-
tudes, and practices to assist or help others
toward healing and well-being (Leininger,
2006a, p. 12). Care is both an abstract and
a concrete phenomenon.
3. Culture care: Subjectively and objectively
learned and transmitted values, beliefs, and
patterned lifeways that assist, support,
facilitate, or enable another individual or
group to maintain well-being and health,
to improve their human condition and
lifeway, or to deal with illness, handicaps,
or death (Leininger, 1991a, p. 47).
4. Culture Care Diversity: The differences or
variabilities among human beings with
respect to culture care meanings, patterns,
values, lifeways, symbols, or other features
related to providing beneficial care to
clients of a designated culture (Leininger,
2006a, p. 16).
5. Culture Care Universality: The commonly
shared or similar culture care phenomena
features of human beings with recurrent
meanings, patterns, values, lifeways, or
symbols that serve as a guide for caregivers
to provide assistive, supportive, facilitative,
or enabling people care for healthy out-
comes (Leininger, 2006a, p. 16).
6. Professional (etic) care: Formal and explicit
cognitively learned professional care knowl-
edge and practices obtained generally
through educational institutions. They are
taught to nurses and others to provide assis-
tive, supportive, enabling, or facilitative
acts for or to another individual or group
in order to improve their health, prevent
illnesses, or to help with dying or other
human conditions (Leininger, 2006a, p. 14).
7. Generic (emic) care: The learned and trans-
mitted lay, indigenous, traditional, or local
folk knowledge and practices to provide
assistive, supportive, enabling, and facilita-
tive acts for or toward others with evident
or anticipated health needs in order to
improve well-being or to help with dying
or other human conditions (Leininger,
2006a, p. 14).
CHAPTER 17 • Madeleine Leininger’s Theory of Culture Care Diversity and Universality 309
economics, education, technology, and
cultural values) and the ethnohistorical and
environmental contexts.
7. Every culture has generic (lay, folk, natu-
ralistic, mainly emic) and usually some
professional (etic) care to be discovered
and used for culturally congruent care
practices.
8. Culturally congruent and therapeutic care
occurs when culture care values, beliefs,
expressions, and patterns are explicitly
known and used appropriately, sensitively,
and meaningfully with people of diverse
or similar cultures.
9. The three modes of care offer therapeutic
ways to help people of diverse cultures.
10. Qualitative research paradigmatic methods
offer important means to discover largely
embedded, covert, epistemic, and ontolog-
ical culture care knowledge and practices.
11. Transcultural nursing is a discipline with
a body of knowledge and practices to at-
tain and maintain the goal of culturally
congruent care for health and well-being
(Leininger, 2006a, pp. 18–19).
Orientational Theory Definitions
To encourage discovery of qualitative knowl-
edge, Leininger used orientational (not oper-
ational) definitions for her theory, to allow the
researcher to discern previously unknown phe-
nomena or ideas. Orientational terms allow
discovery and are usually congruent with the
client lifeways. They are important in using the
qualitative ethnonursing discovery method,
which is focused on how people understand
and experience their world using cultural
knowledge and lifeways (Leininger, 1985,
1991a, 1997b, 1997c, 2002, 2006a). The fol-
lowing are select examples:
1. Culture: The learned, shared, and transmit-
ted values, beliefs, norms, and lifeways of a
particular group that guides their thinking,
decisions, and actions in patterned ways
and often intergenerationally (Leininger,
2006a, p. 13).
2. Care: Those assistive, supportive, and
enabling experiences or ideas toward
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 309
8. Culture care preservation and/or mainte-
nance: Those assistive, supportive, facilita-
tive, or enabling professional acts or
decisions that help cultures to retain,
preserve, or maintain beneficial care be-
liefs and values or to face handicaps and
death (Leininger, 2006a, p. 8).
9. Culture care accommodation and/or negotia-
tion: Those assistive, accommodating, fa-
cilitative, or enabling creative provider care
actions or decisions that facilitate adapta-
tion to or negotiation with others for cul-
turally congruent, safe, and effective care
for their health, well-being, or to deal with
illness or dying (Leininger, 2006a, p. 8).
10. Culture care repatterning and/or restructur-
ing: Those assistive, supportive, facilita-
tive, or enabling professional actions and
mutual decisions that help people to re-
order, change, modify, or restructure
their lifeways and institutions for better
(or beneficial) health-care patterns, prac-
tices, or outcomes (Leininger, 2006a,
p. 8). These patterns are mutually estab-
lished between caregivers and receivers.
11. Ethnohistory: The past facts, events, in-
stances, and experiences of human beings,
groups, cultures, and institutions that
occur over time in particular contexts
that help explain past and current lifeways
about culture care influencers of health
and well-being or the death of people
(Leininger, 2006a, p. 15).
12. Environmental context: The totality of
an event, situation, or particular experi-
ence that gives meaning to people’s
expressions, interpretations, and social
interactions within particular geophysical,
ecological, spiritual, sociopolitical, and
technological factors in specific cultural
settings (Leininger, 2006a, p. 15).
13. Worldview: The way people tend to look
out on their world or their universe to
form a picture or value stance about life
or the world around them (Leininger,
2006a, p. 15).
14. Cultural and social structure factors: religion
(spirituality); kinship (social ties); politics;
legal issues; education; economics; tech-
nology; political factors; philosophy of
life; and cultural beliefs and values with
gender and class difference. The theorist
has predicted that these diverse factors
must be understood as they directly or
indirectly influence health and well-being
(Leininger, 2006a, p. 14).
15. Culturally congruent care: Culturally based
care knowledge, acts, and decisions used
in sensitive and knowledgeable ways to
appropriately and meaningfully fit the
cultural values, beliefs, and lifeways of
clients for their health and well-being,
or to prevent illness, disabilities, or death
(Leininger, 2006a, p. 15).
The Sunrise Enabler: A Conceptual
Guide to Knowledge Discovery
Leininger developed the sunrise enabler
(Fig. 17-1) to provide a holistic and compre-
hensive conceptual picture of the major factors
influencing culture care diversity and univer-
sality (Leininger, 1995, 1997b; Leininger &
McFarland, 2002, 2006). The model can be a
valuable visual guide to elucidating multiple
factors that influence human care and lifeways
of different cultures. The enabler serves as a
cognitive guide for the researcher to reflect on
different predicted influences on culturally
based care.
The sunrise enabler can also be used as a
valuable aid in cultural and health-care assess-
ment of clients. As the researcher uses the
model, the different factors alert him or her to
find culture care phenomena. Gender, sexual
orientation, race, class, and biomedical condi-
tions are studied as part of the theory. These
determinants tend to be embedded in the
worldview and social structure and take time
to recognize. Care values and beliefs are usually
lodged into environment, religion, kinship,
and daily life patterns.
The nurse can begin the discovery at any
place in the enabler and follow the informant’s
ideas and experiences about care. If one starts
in the upper part of the enabler, one needs to
reflect on all aspects depicted to obtain holistic
or total care data. Some nurses start with
generic and professional care then look at how
religion, economics, and other influences affect
these care modes. One always moves with the
310 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 310
informants’, rather than the researcher’s, inter-
est and story. Flexibility in using the enabler
promotes a total or holistic view of care.
The three transcultural care decisions and
actions (in the lower part of the figure) are very
important to keep in mind. Nursing decisions
and actions are studied until one realizes the
care needed. The nurse discovers with the in-
formant the appropriate decisions, actions, or
plans for care. Throughout this discovery
process, the nurse holds his or her own etic
biases in check so that the informant’s ideas
will come forth, rather than the researcher’s.
Transcultural nurses are mentored in ways to
withhold their biases or wishes and to enter the
client’s worldview.
The nurse begins the study by making
explicit a specific domain of inquiry. For exam-
ple, the researcher may focus on a domain of
inquiry such as “culture care of Mexican
CHAPTER 17 • Madeleine Leininger’s Theory of Culture Care Diversity and Universality 311
Worldview
Cultural Values,
Beliefs &
Lifeways
Care Expressions
Patterns & Practices
Holistic Health / Illness / Death
Cultural Care Decisions & Actions
Culturally Congruent Care for Health, Well-being or Dying
Cultural Care Preservation/Maintenance
Culture Care Accommodation/Negotiation
Culture Care Repatterning/Restructuring
© M. Leininger 2004
--kl
Focus: Individuals, Families, Groups, Communities or Institutions
in Diverse Health Contexts of
Environmental Context,
Language & Ethnohistory
Political &
Legal
Factors
Kinship &
Social
Factors
Economic
Factors
Educational
Factors
Technological
Factors
Generic (Folk)
Care
Code: (Influencers)
Nursing Care
Practices
Professional
Care–Cure
Practices
Religious &
Philosophical
Factors
CULTURE CARE
Cultural & Social Structure Dimensions
Influences
Fig 17 • 1 Leininger’s sunrise enabler to discover culture care. (©M. Leininger 2004.)
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 311
American mothers caring for their children in
their home.” Every word in the domain state-
ment is important and studied with the sunrise
enabler and the theory tenets. The nurse or re-
searcher may have hunches about the domain
and care, but until all data have been studied
with the theory tenets, she or he cannot prove
them. Informants’ viewpoints, experiences,
and actions are fully documented. Generally,
informants select what they like to talk about
first, and the nurse/researcher accommodates
their interest or stories about care. During in-
depth study of the domain of inquiry, all areas
of the sunrise enabler are identified and con-
firmed with the informants. The informants
become active participants throughout the dis-
covery process in such a way as to feel comfort-
able and willing to share their ideas.
The real challenge is to focus care mean-
ings, beliefs, values, and practices related to
informants’ cultures so that subtle and obvi-
ous differences and similarities about care are
identified among key and general informants.
The differences and similarities are important
to document with the theory. If informants
ask about the researcher’s views, the latter
must be carefully and sparsely shared. The re-
searcher keeps in mind that some informants
may want to please the researcher by talking
about professional medicines and treatments.
Professional ideas, however, often cloud or
mask the client’s real interests and views. If
this occurs, the researcher must be alert to
such tendencies and keep the focus on the in-
formant’s ideas and on the domain of inquiry
studied. The informant’s knowledge is always
kept central to the discovery process about
culture care, health, and well-being. If the re-
searcher finds some factors unfamiliar, such
as kinship, economics, and political and other
considerations depicted in the model, the
researcher should listen attentively to the
informant’s ideas. Obtaining insight into
the informant’s emic (insider’s) views, beliefs,
and practices is central to studying the theory
(Leininger, 1985, 1991a, 1995, 1997b;
Leininger & McFarland, 2002, 2006).
Throughout the study and use of the theory,
the meanings, expressions, and patterns of
culturally based care are important. The nurse/
researcher listens attentively to informants’
accounts about care and then documents the
ideas. What informants know and practice
about care or caring in their culture is signifi-
cant. Documenting ideas from the informants’
emic viewpoint is essential to arrive at accurate
culturally based care. Unknown care meanings,
such as the concepts of protection, respect,
love, and many other care concepts, need to be
teased out and explored in depth, as they are
the key words and ideas in understanding care.
Such care meanings and expressions are not al-
ways readily known; informants ponder care
meanings and are often surprised that nurses
are focused on care instead of medical symp-
toms. Sometimes informants may be reluctant
to share ideas about social structure, religion,
and economics or politics, as they fear these
ideas may not be accepted or understood by
health personnel. Generic folk or indigenous
knowledge often has rich care data and needs
to be explored. Generic care ideas need to be
appropriately integrated into the three tran-
scultural modes of decisions and actions for
culturally congruent care outcomes. Generic
and professional care are integrated so that the
clients benefit from both types of care.
The sunrise enabler was developed with
the idea to “let the sun enter the researcher’s
mind” and discover largely unknown care
factors of cultures. Letting the sun “rise and
shine” is important and offers fresh insights
about care practices. A recent metasynthesis
of 24 doctoral dissertations using Leininger’s
CCT and the ethnonursing research method
led to the discovery of interpretive and ex-
planatory culture care findings, new theoretical
formulations, and evidence-based recommen-
dations to guide nursing practice (McFarland
et al., 2011).
Newest Addition to the Theory
In the summer of 2011, Dr. Leininger intro-
duced collaborative care as a new care construct,
which she offered as the next phase in the evo-
lutionary development of CCT. She main-
tained that diverse cultural values, beliefs,
expressions, actions, and practices within a
312 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 312
family, a group, an institution, or other unit
may present with situations in which conflicts
may arise. She proposed collaborative care as a
means or a strategy to resolve differences and
provide culturally congruent care.
Leininger defined the collaborative care
approach as those values, meanings, expres-
sions, and actions by informants that reveal a
desire and a plan to work with others in order
to identify, attain, and maintain health and
well-being and to resolve conflicts. This care
construct has been published by McFarland
and Wehbe-Alamah (McFarland & Wehbe-
Alamah, 2015).
Current Status of the Theory
Currently, the theory of culture care diversity
and universality continues to be studied and used
in many schools of nursing within the United
States and in other countries, such as Lebanon,
Jordan, Saudi Arabia, Taiwan, China, Japan,
and Finland (Leininger & McFarland, 2002,
2006; Wehbe-Alamah & McFarland; 2012).
Interdisciplinary health personnel are becoming
increasingly aware of transcultural nursing con-
cepts that help them in their work. Several dis-
ciplines including dentistry, medicine, social
work, and pharmacy have reported using the
culturally congruent care theory or teaching it in
their programs (McFarland, 2011).
The theory of culture care will remain of
global interest and significance as nurses and
other health-care professionals continue to
explore cultures and their care needs and prac-
tices worldwide. Transcultural nursing con-
cepts, principles, theory, and findings must
become fully incorporated into professional
areas of teaching, practice, consultation, and
research. When this occurs, one can anticipate
true transcultural health practices and con-
comitant benefits. Unquestionably, the theory
will continue to grow in relevance and use as
our world becomes more intensely multicul-
tural. Nurses and other health professionals are
expected to provide culturally congruent care
to people of diverse cultures. The theory, along
with many transcultural nursing concepts,
principles, and research findings, will continue
to prove indispensable.
Applications of
the Theory
The purpose of this part of the chapter is to
present the implications for nursing practice of
the CCT and related ethnonursing research
findings. Many nursing theories are rather ab-
stract and do not focus on how practicing
nurses might use the research findings related
to a theory. However, with the CCT, along
with the ethnonursing method, there is a built-
in means for discovering and confirming data
with informants in order to make practical
nursing actions and decisions meaningful and
culturally congruent (Leininger, 2002).1
Leininger purposefully avoided using the
phrase nursing intervention because this term
often implies to clients from different cultures
that the nurse is imposing his or her (etic)
views, which may not be helpful. Instead, the
term nursing actions and decisions was used, but
always with the clients helping to arrive at
whatever actions or decisions were planned
and implemented. The care modes fit with the
clients’ or peoples’ lifeways and are both ther-
apeutic and satisfying for them. The nurse can
draw on scientific and evidence-based nursing,
medical, and other knowledge with each care
mode.
Data collected from the upper and lower
parts of the sunrise enabler provide culture care
knowledge for the nurse and other researchers
to discover and establish useful ways to provide
quality care practices. Active participatory in-
volvement with clients is essential to arrive at
culturally congruent care with one or all of the
three action modes to meet clients’ care needs
in their particular environmental contexts. The
use of these modes in nursing care is one of the
most creative and rewarding features of tran-
scultural and general nursing practice with
clients of diverse cultures. Using Leininger’s
care modes in clinical practice shows respect to
clients’ beliefs, values, and expressions and es-
tablishes a partnership between health-care
CHAPTER 17 • Madeleine Leininger’s Theory of Culture Care Diversity and Universality 313
1For additional information about the Ethnonursing
Research Method please go to bonus chapter content
available at FA Davis http://davisplus.fadavis.com
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 313
providers and clients to ensure safe, beneficent,
and culturally congruent care (McFarland &
Eipperle, 2008).
It is most important (and a shift in nursing)
to carefully focus on the holistic dimensions,
as depicted in the sunrise enabler, to arrive at
therapeutic culture care practices. All the fac-
tors in the sunrise enabler must be considered
to arrive at culturally congruent care. These
include worldview; technological, religious,
kinship, political–legal, economic, and educa-
tional factors; cultural values and lifeways;
environmental context, language, and ethno-
history; and generic (folk) and professional
care practices (Leininger, 2002, 2006a). Care
generated from the CCT will become safe,
congruent, meaningful, and beneficial to
clients only when the nurse in clinical practice
becomes fully aware of and explicitly uses
knowledge generated from the theory and eth-
nonursing method, whether in a community,
home, or institutional context. The CCT, used
with the ethnonursing method, is a powerful
means for exploring new directions and prac-
tices in nursing. Incorporating culture-specific
care into client care is essential to the practice
of professional care and to licensure as regis-
tered nurses. Culture-specific care is the safe
means to ensure culturally based holistic care
that fits the client’s culture—a major challenge
for nurses and other health-care professionals
who practice and provide services in all health-
care settings.
The Use of Culture Care Research
Findings
Over the past 5 decades, Dr. Leininger and
other research colleagues have used the CCT
and the ethnonursing method to focus on the
care meanings and experiences of 100 cultures
(Leininger, 2002). They discovered 187 care
constructs in Western and non-Western cul-
tures between 1989 and 1998 (Leininger,
1998a, 1998b). Leininger listed the 11 most
dominant constructs of care in priority rank-
ing, with the most universal or frequently dis-
covered first: respect for/about, concern
for/about; attention to (details)/in anticipation
of; helping–assisting or facilitative acts; active
helping; presence (being physically there);
understanding (beliefs, values, lifeways, and
environmental); connectedness; protection
(gender related); touching; and comfort meas-
ures (Leininger, 2006b; McFarland, 2002).
These care constructs are the most critical and
important universal or common findings to
consider in nursing practice, but care diversi-
ties will also be found and must be considered.
The ways in which culture care is applied and
used in specific cultures will reflect both simi-
larities and differences among and within
different cultures.
Next, two ethnonursing studies are reviewed
with focus on the findings, which have impli-
cations for nursing practice.
Culture Care of Traditional Syrian
Muslims in the Midwestern United
States
In 2005, the theory of culture care diversity and
universality and the ethnonursing research
method were used to guide a study of the cul-
ture care of traditional Syrian Muslims in the
Midwestern United States (Wehbe-Alamah,
2008b, 2011). The domain of inquiry for this
ethnonursing study was the generic and the
professional care meanings, beliefs, and prac-
tices related to health and illness of traditional
Syrian Muslims living in several urban commu-
nities in the Midwestern United States. The
purpose of this study was to discover, describe,
and analyze the effect of worldview, cultural
context, technological, religious, political, ed-
ucational, and economic factors on the tradi-
tional Syrian Muslims’ generic and professional
care meanings, beliefs, and practices. The goal
was to provide practicing nurses and other
health-care providers with knowledge that can
be turned into care actions and decisions that
facilitate the provision of culturally congruent
care to traditional Syrian Muslims living in
similar contexts (Wehbe-Alamah, 2011).
Findings from this study revealed that the
worldview of traditional Syrian Muslims is
deeply embedded in the Islamic religion and
the Syrian culture. Life is viewed as a test from
God and a journey in which one must attempt
to do as many good deeds as possible and to
behave in a righteous way whether conducting
business, taking care of housework, or engaging
314 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 314
in any other regular daily activity. Kinship and
familial relationships are treasured. Socializing
with family members and friends are consid-
ered important aspects of Syrian lifeway. Vis-
itations and telephone conversations as well as
Friday prayer congregations are major social
activities for Syrians. In Syrian Muslim society,
the man typically assumes the role of the
breadwinner, whereas the woman takes on
other responsibilities, such as managing the
household and raising the children (Wehbe-
Alamah, 2008b).
Some of the discovered traditional cultural
beliefs and practices included modesty, gener-
ous hospitality, segregation of men and women
during social events such as wedding parties
and dinner invitations, wearing of a coat or jil-
bab over clothes for women when in public,
caring for older family members within the
home setting, as well as visiting, praying for,
and cooking for the sick. Normal everyday ac-
tions were considered by many informants as
acts of worship. Engaging in religious practices
such as prayer and Qur’an recitation or mem-
orization was reported as a source of physical,
spiritual, emotional, and mental support by
numerous informants. Religious beliefs were
determined to play an important role in a per-
son’s decision-making involving abortion, ster-
ilization, autopsy, organ donation, birth
control, and other significant health issues
(Wehbe-Alamah, 2008a).
Caring was described as being considerate
of other people’s feelings and respecting their
beliefs. Empathy, sympathy, sensitivity, un-
selfishness, and understanding were other
qualities used to describe caring. Caring can be
expressed by checking on others, being avail-
able to them, offering them help, cooking
healthy food, and keeping a clean body and a
hygienic environment. Caring can additionally
be exemplified by withholding a diagnosis
and/or prognosis from a patient especially if
an impending death was expected and by bury-
ing the dead with 24 hours of their passing.
Caring attributes of nurses were identified as
smiling, responding quickly to the needs of
sick patients, loving the nursing profession and
role, and respecting the patient’s culture
(Wehbe-Alamah, 2008b).
A plethora of generic or folk practices were
discovered and included some that are benefi-
cial to health and others with potentially
harmful ramifications. One such example is
the consumption of raw liver, which is rich in
iron and is used to treat anemia or iron defi-
ciency. Another example is treating head lice
by pouring gasoline over the scalp and massag-
ing it into the hair. Folk practices that are ben-
eficial to health included eating in moderation,
exercising, and taking vitamin C when treating
a cold (Wehbe-Alamah, 2008b).
Such information can be turned into cul-
turally congruent decisions and actions that
can impact clinical practice through the ap-
plication of Leininger’s culture care modes.
Accordingly, nurses and other health-care
providers can preserve and/or maintain the cul-
tural beliefs, expressions, and practices of tra-
ditional Syrian Muslims by respecting the need
for modesty and segregation and assigning
same-sex health-care providers whenever pos-
sible. The cultural belief and practice of visiting
the sick can be accommodated by encouraging
a large number of visitors within the hospital
setting with the negotiation of having only a
few visitors in the patient’s room at a time. The
harmful folk practices of using gasoline to treat
head lice and consuming raw liver to treat ane-
mia can be repatterned and/or restructured
through education of ramifications and discus-
sion of healthier alternatives.
CHAPTER 17 • Madeleine Leininger’s Theory of Culture Care Diversity and Universality 315
Practice Exemplar
A Middle Eastern patient in labor identified
as Mrs. Sarah Islam has just been admitted
to the obstetrics floor. She is accompanied
by her husband and is dressed in loose cloth-
ing that covers all of her body except for her
face and hands. She belongs to the Muslim
faith and wears a head cover. Her husband
requests that only female health-care
providers (HCPs) be assigned to his wife.
The nurse provides culturally congruent care
to this family using Leininger’s culture care
theory.
Continued
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 315
316 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
Practice Exemplar cont.
According to this theory, the worldview
of every human being is affected by cultural
and social structural dimensions, including but
not limited to cultural values, beliefs, and life-
ways, and kinship, social, and religious factors.
Therefore, professional nursing care must in-
corporate an understanding of these beliefs
and practices. As a result, the nurse proceeds
by conducting a cultural assessment to identify
important needs and prohibitions that need to
be addressed in the plan of care. The nurse be-
gins by explaining that she would like to ask
questions to learn about how to best care for
the client and her family. The cultural assess-
ment reveals the following:
• Modesty and privacy are important values
to Mrs. and Mr. Islam and should be pre-
served whenever possible, according to cul-
tural and religious teachings. The couple
explains that this can be achieved by assign-
ing same-sex HCPs and by preventing
male individuals from entering the patient’s
room without first obtaining permission to
do so.
• Pork-derived products including gelatin are
prohibited in Islam and therefore should
be excluded from diet and medications.
The couple explains that Jello and gelatin-
encapsulated medications contain gelatin
and should be avoided.
• A special prayer needs to be whispered by
the father in the newborn’s ears after birth.
The couple requests that the newborn be
handed to the father as soon as possible
after birth to facilitate this practice.
• Visitation by family members and friends is
to be expected following birth. The couple in-
forms you that they expect at least 30 visitors.
• Smoking the water pipe is a common
cultural practice and is often carried in the
presence of children. Mr. Islam smokes
the water pipe twice a day.
Having identified important cultural and
religious values, practices, needs, and prohibi-
tions, the nurse proceeds to develop a cultur-
ally congruent plan of care using Leininger’s
Culture care modes:
Culture care preservation and/or
maintenance:
• The nurse includes a note in the electronic
health record about identified cultural and
religious values, practices, needs, and pro-
hibitions. This will assist with continuity of
culturally congruent care.
• The nurse is female; therefore she is able to
care for Mrs. Islam.
• The nurse places a sign at Mrs. Islam door
that reads: “No males allowed without
permission.”
• The obstetrician and all nursing staff at-
tending the birth are informed about the
important practice of handing the newborn
to the father within minutes of birth. The
father recites the prayer in the baby’s ears.
The nurse attends the birth and ensures
that this happens.
Culture care accommodation and/or
negotiation:
• The nurse arranges for kitchen staff to pro-
vide vegetarian Jello versus animal-derived
Jello.
• The nurse arranges for medications to be
ordered or dispensed in tablet versus gelcap
format.
• The nurse negotiates with the family to
have visitors come at different times, wait in
waiting room, and visit in numbers of 2 or
3 at a time.
Culture care restructuring and/or
repatterning:
• The nurse educates the client and her
husband about dangers associated with
smoking and secondhand smoking inhala-
tion implications to the newborn. She ad-
vises the discontinuation of this practice.
(Alternatively, the nurse negotiates with
Mr Islam to only smoke outdoors and cut
down to once a day.)
Upon discharge, Mr. and Mrs. Islam thank
you, the nurse, for providing them with the
best care they have ever received in a Western
health-care setting.
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 316
CHAPTER 17 • Madeleine Leininger’s Theory of Culture Care Diversity and Universality 317
■ Summary
The purpose of the CCT and the ethnonurs-
ing method is to discover culture care knowl-
edge and to combine generic and professional
care. The goal is to provide culturally congru-
ent nursing care using the three modes of
nursing actions and decisions that are mean-
ingful, safe, and beneficial to people of similar
and diverse cultures worldwide (Leininger,
1991b, 1995, 2006a). The clinical use of the
three major care modes (culture care preser-
vation and/or maintenance; culture care ac-
commodation and/or negotiation; and culture
care repatterning and/or restructuring) by
nurses to guide nursing judgments, decisions,
and actions is essential in order to provide cul-
turally congruent care that is beneficial, satis-
fying, and meaningful to the people nurses
serve. The studies presented here substantiate
that the three modes are care-centered and
are based on the use of generic care (emic)
knowledge along with professional care (etic)
knowledge obtained from research using the
CCT along with the ethnonursing method.
This chapter has reviewed only a small selec-
tion of the culture care findings from eth-
nonursing research studies conducted over the
past 5 decades. There is a wealth of additional
findings of interest to practicing nurses who
care for clients of all ages from diverse and
similar cultural groups in many different in-
stitutional and community contexts around
the world. More in-depth culture care find-
ings, along with the use of the three modes,
can be found in the Journal of Transcultural
Nursing (1989–2013), in the Online Journal of
Cultural Competence in Nursing and Healthcare
(www.OJCCNH.org) and in the numerous
books and articles written by Dr. Madeleine
Leininger and researchers using her theory
and method. Nurses in clinical practice can
refer to research studies and doctoral disserta-
tions conceptualized within the CCT for ad-
ditional detailed nursing implications for
clients from diverse cultures (Leininger &
McFarland, 2002; McFarland et al., 2011).
The theory of culture care diversity and uni-
versality is one of the most comprehensive yet
practical theories to advance transcultural and
general nursing knowledge with concomitant
ways for practicing nurses to establish or im-
prove care to people. Nursing students and
practicing nurses have remained the strongest
advocates of the CCT (Leininger, 2002). The
theory focuses on a long-neglected area in
nursing practice—culture care—that is most
relevant to our multicultural world.
The theory of culture care diversity and uni-
versality is depicted in the sunrise enabler as a
rising sun. This visual metaphor is particularly
apt. The future of the CCT shines brightly in-
deed because it is holistic and comprehensive;
and it facilitates discovering care related to
diverse and similar cultures, contexts, and ages
of people in familiar and naturalistic ways. The
theory is useful to nurses and nursing as well
as to professionals in other disciplines such as
physical, occupational, and speech therapy,
medicine, social work, and pharmacy. Health-
care practitioners in other disciplines are
beginning to use this theory because they also
need to become knowledgeable about and
sensitive and responsible to people of diverse
cultures who need care (Leininger, 2002;
McFarland, 2011).
References
Boyle, J., & Glittenberg Hinrichs, J. (2013). Madeleine
Leininger, PhD, LHD, RN, FRCA, FAAN: A re-
membrance. Journal of Transcultural Nursing, 24(1), 5.
Leininger, M. (1970). Nursing and anthropology: Two
worlds to blend. New York: Wiley.
Leininger, M. (1976). Transcultural nursing presents an
exciting challenge. The American Nurse, 5(5), 6–9.
Leininger, M. (1977). Caring: The essence and central
focus of nursing. Nursing Research Foundation Report,
12(1), 2–14.
Leininger, M. (1978). Transcultural nursing: Concepts,
theories, and practices. New York: Wiley.
Leininger, M. (1981). Caring: An essential human need.
Thorofare, NJ: Slack.
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 317
318 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
Leininger, M. (1984). Care: The essence of nursing and
health. Thorofare, NJ: Slack.
Leininger, M. (1985). Qualitative research methods in
nursing (pp. 33–73). Orlando, FL: Grune & Stratton.
Leininger, M. (1988). Care: Discovery and uses in clinical
and community nursing. Detroit, MI: Wayne State
University Press.
Leininger, M. (1989a). Transcultural nursing: Quo vadis
(where goeth the field)? Journal of Transcultural
Nursing, 1(1), 33–45.
Leininger, M. (1989b). Transcultural nurse specialists
and generalists: New practitioners in nursing. Journal
of Transcultural Nursing, 1(1), 4–16.
Leininger, M. (1990a). Transcultural nursing: A world-
wide necessity to advance nursing knowledge and
practices. In J. McCloskey & H. Grace, (Eds.), Cur-
rent issues in nursing. St. Louis, MO: C. V. Mosby.
Leininger, M. (1990b). Culture: The conspicuous miss-
ing link to understand ethical and moral dimensions
of human care. In M. Leininger (Ed.), Ethical and
moral dimensions of care. Detroit, MI: Wayne State
University Press.
Leininger, M. (1990d). Ethical and moral dimensions of
care. Detroit, MI: Wayne State University Press.
Leininger, M. (1991a). Culture care diversity and univer-
sality: A theory of nursing. New York: National
League for Nursing Press.
Leininger, M. (1991b). The theory of culture care
diversity and universality. In M. Leininger (Ed.),
Culture care diversity and universality: A theory of
nursing (pp. 5–68). New York: National League
for Nursing Press.
Leininger, M. (1995). Transcultural nursing: Concepts,
theories, research, and practice. Columbus, OH:
McGraw-Hill College Custom Series.
Leininger, M. (1997a). Overview and reflection of the
theory of culture care and the ethnonursing research
method. Journal of Transcultural Nursing, 8(2), 32–51.
Leininger, M. (1997b). Overview of the theory of cul-
ture care with the ethnonursing research method.
Journal of Transcultural Nursing, 8(2), 32–53.
Leininger, M. (1997c). Transcultural nursing research to
transform nursing education and practice: 40 years.
Image: Journal of Nursing Scholarship, 29(4), 341–347.
Leininger, M. (1998a). Qualitative research methods in
nursing. Dayton, OH: Greyden Press
Leininger, M. (1998b). Special research report: Dominant
culture care (emic) meanings and practice findings
from Leininger’s theory. Journal of Transcultural
Nursing, 9(2), 44–47.
Leininger, M. (2002). Part I: The theory of culture care
and the ethnonursing research method. In M. M.
Leininger & M. R. McFarland (Eds.), Transcultural
nursing: concepts, theories, and practice (3rd ed.,
pp. 71–98). Sudbury, MA: Jones and Bartlett.
Leininger, M. (2006a). Culture care diversity and uni-
versality theory and evolution of the ethnonursing
method. In M. M. Leininger & M. R. McFarland
(Eds.). Culture diversity & universality: A worldwide
nursing theory (2nd ed., pp. 1–41). Sudbury, MA:
Jones and Bartlett.
Leininger, M. (2006b). Ethnonursing: A research
method with enablers to study the theory of culture
care. In M. M. Leininger & M. R. McFarland
(Eds.). Culture diversity & universality: A worldwide
nursing theory (2nd ed., pp. 43–81). Sudbury, MA:
Jones and Bartlett.
Leininger, M. (2009). It is time to celebrate, reflect and
look into the future. Retrieved on January 9, 2013,
from the Transcultural Nursing Society website at:
http://www.tcns.org/Foundress.html
Leininger, M. (2011). Leininger’s reflection on the
ongoing father protective care research. The Online
Journal of Cultural Competence in Nursing and
Healthcare, 1(2), 1–13. http://www.ojccnh.org/
1/2/index.shtml
Leininger, M., & Hofling, C. (1960). Basic psychiatric
concepts in nursing. Philadelphia: Lippincott.
Leininger, M. M., & McFarland, M. R. (Eds). (2002).
Transcultural nursing: Concepts, theories, and practice
(3rd ed.). New York: McGraw-Hill.
Leininger, M., & McFarland, M. (2002). Transcultural
nursing: Concepts, theories, research, and practice (3rd ed.).
New York: McGraw-Hill. Chinese Complex Trans-
lation Copyright 2007 by Wu-nan Book, Inc. (Book
translated into Chinese).
Leininger, M. M., & McFarland, M. R. (Eds.) (2006).
Culture diversity & universality: A worldwide nursing
theory (2nd ed.). Sudbury, MA: Jones and Bartlett.
McFarland, M. R. (2002). Part II: Selected research
findings from the culture care theory. In M. M.
Leininger & M. R. McFarland (Eds.), Transcultural
nursing: Concepts, theories, and practice (3rd ed.,
pp. 99–116). New York: McGraw-Hill.
McFarland, M. R. (2010). Madeleine Leininger: Cul-
ture care theory of diversity and universality. In A.
M. Tomey & M. R. Alligood (Eds.), Nursing theo-
rists and their work (7th ed., pp. 454–479, with
revisions from 2006 ed.). St. Louis, MO: Elsevier
McFarland, M. R. (2011).The culture care theory and a
look to the future for transcultural nursing. Keynote
address presented at the 37th Annual Conference of
the International Society of Transcultural Nursing,
Las Vegas, NV.
McFarland, M. R., & Eipperle, M. K. (2008). Culture
care theory: A proposed practice theory guide for
nurse practitioners in primary care settings. Contem-
porary Nurse: A Journal for the Australian Nursing
Profession, 28(1–2), 48–63.
McFarland, M. R., Mixer, S. J., Wehbe-Alamah, H.,
& Burk, R. (2012). Ethnonursing: A qualitative re-
search method for all disciplines. Online International
Journal of Qualitative Methods, 11(3), 259–279.
University of Alberta, Canada.
McFarland, M. R., & Wehbe-Alamah, H. B. (2015).
The theory of culture care diversity and universality.
In McFarland and Wehbe-Alamah (Eds), Culture
care diversity and universality: A worldwide nursing
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 318
CHAPTER 17 • Madeleine Leininger’s Theory of Culture Care Diversity and Universality 319
theory (3rd ed., Ch 1, pp. 1-31). Sudbury, MA: Jones
and Bartlett.
McFarland, M., Wehbe-Alamah, H., Wilson, M., &
Vossos, H. (2011). Synopsis of findings discovered
within a descriptive meta-synthesis of doctoral dis-
sertations guided by the Culture Care Theory with
use of the ethnonursing research method. Online
Journal of Cultural Competence in Nursing and
Healthcare, 1(2), 24–39. Retrieved from http://
www.cultural-competence-project.org/ojccnh/
1(2).shtml
Wehbe-Alamah, H. (2008a). Bridging generic and pro-
fessional care practices for Muslim patients through
the use of Leininger’s culture care modes. Contempo-
rary Nurse, 28(1–2), 83–97.
Wehbe-Alamah, H. (2008b). Culture care of Syrian
Muslims in the Midwestern USA: The generic and
professional health care beliefs, expressions, and practices
of Syrian Muslims and implications to practice.
Saarbrucken, Germany: VDM Verlag Dr. Muller
Wehbe-Alamah, H. (2011). The use of culture care
theory with Syrian Muslims in the Mid-western
United States. Online Journal of Cultural Competence
in Nursing and Healthcare, 1(3), 1–12. Retrieved from
http://www.cultural-competence-project.org/
ojccnh/1(3).shtml
Wehbe-Alamah, H., & McFarland, M. (2012). The
Taiwanese cultural experience. Podium presentation
at the 38th Annual Conference of the Transcultural
Nursing Society. Orlando, Florida.
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 319
3312_Ch17_301-320 26/12/14 5:57 PM Page 320
Chapter 18Jean Watson’s Theory of
Human Caring
JEAN WATSON
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Theory
Applications of the Theory
Practice Exemplar by Terri Woodward
Summary
References
Jean Watson
321
Introducing the Theorist
Dr. Jean Watson is distinguished professor
emerita and dean of nursing emerita at the Uni-
versity of Colorado Denver, where she served
for more than 20 years and held an endowed
Chair in Caring Science for more than 16 years.
She is founder of the original Center for
Human Caring at the University of Colorado
Health Sciences, is a Living Legend in the
American Academy of Nursing, and served as
president of the National League for Nursing.
Dr. Watson founded and directs the nonprofit
Watson Caring Science Institute, dedicated to
furthering the work of caring, science, and
heart-centered Caritas Nursing, restoring caring
and love for nurses’ and health-care clinicians’
healing practices for self and others.
Watson earned undergraduate and grad-
uate degrees in nursing and psychiatric–mental
health nursing and holds a doctorate in edu-
cational psychology and counseling from the
University of Colorado at Boulder. She is a
widely published author and is the recipient
of several awards and honors, including
an international Kellogg Fellowship in
Australia; a Fulbright Research Award in
Sweden; and 10 honorary doctoral degrees,
including seven from international universi-
ties in Sweden, the United Kingdom, Spain,
Japan, and British Colombia and Montreal,
Quebec, Canada.
Dr. Watson’s original book on caring was
published in 1979. Her second book, Nursing:
Human Science and Human Care, was written
while on sabbatical in Australia and reflects the
metaphysical and spiritual evolution of her
thinking. A third book, Postmodern Nursing
and Beyond, moves beyond theory to reflect the
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 321
ontological foundation of nursing as an overar-
ching framework for transforming caring and
healing practices in education and clinical care
(Watson, 1999). Additional empirical and clin-
ical caring research foci developments include
the first and second editions of the book on car-
ing instruments, Assessing and Measuring Caring
in Nursing and Health Sciences (2002, 2008b),
which offers a critique and collation of more
than 20 instruments for assessing and measuring
caring. Her Caring Science as Sacred Science makes
a case for a deep moral–ethical, spirit-filled
foundation for caring science and healing based
on infinite love and an expanding cosmology.
Watson’s 2008(a) theoretical work, Nursing: The
Philosophy and Science of Caring, Revised New
Edition, revisits and reworks her first book,
Nursing: The Philosophy and Science of Caring
(1979, reprinted 1985), bringing the original
publication up to date to include all the changes
made during the past 30 years. This latest update
introduces Caritas nursing as the culmination of
a caring science foundation for professional
nursing. A coauthored educational book, Creat-
ing a Caring Science Curriculum: Emancipatory
Pedagogies by Marcia Hills and Watson, was
published in 2011 followed by two additional
coauthored research and measurement books,
Measuring Caritas. International Research on
Caritas as Healing (Nelson & Watson, 2011) and
Caring Science, Mindful Practice: Implementing
Watson’s Human Caring Theory (Sitzman &
Watson, 2014).
The Watson Caring Science Institute is
developing educational, clinical, and admin-
istrative–leadership and research models that
seek to sustain and deepen authentic caring–
healing practices for self and other, trans-
forming practitioners and patients alike. The
caring science model, integrating Caritas
with the science of the heart in collaboration
with the Institute of HeartMath (www
.heartMath.com), deepens intelligent heart-
centered caring. All of Watson’s latest publica-
tions and innovative educational partnerships,
activities, new programs, speaking calendar,
and directions and developments, including
information about a nontraditional doctorate
in caring science as sacred science can be found
on the website: www.watsoncaringscience.org.
Overview of the Theory
The theory of human caring was developed be-
tween 1975 and 1979 while I was teaching at
the University of Colorado. It emerged from
my own views of nursing, combined and in-
formed by my doctoral studies in educational,
clinical, and social psychology. It was my initial
attempt to bring meaning and focus to nursing
as an emerging discipline and distinct health
profession that had its own unique values,
knowledge, and practices, and its own ethic
and mission to society. The work was also in-
fluenced by my involvement with an integrated
academic nursing curriculum and efforts to
find common meaning and order to nursing
that transcended settings, populations, spe-
cialty, and subspecialty areas.
From my emerging perspective, I make ex-
plicit that nursing’s values, ethic, philosophy,
knowledge, and practices of human caring re-
quire language order, structure, and clarity of
concepts and worldview underlying nursing as
a distinct discipline and profession. The theory
goes beyond the dominant physical worldview
and opens to subjective, intersubjective, and
inner meaning, underlying healing processes
and the life world of the experiencing person.
This original (Watson, 1979) language framed
this orientation that required unique caring–
healing arts. The human caring processes were
named the “10 carative factors,” which com-
plemented conventional medicine but stood in
stark contrast to “curative factors.” At the same
time, this emerging philosophy and theory of
human caring sought to balance the cure ori-
entation of medicine, giving nursing its unique
disciplinary, scientific, and professional stand-
ing with itself and its public.
The early work has continued to evolve dy-
namically from the original writings of 1979,
1981, 1985, and the 1990s to a more updated
view of 10 caritas processes, to caring science
as sacred science, and to a unitary global con-
sciousness for leadership. My work now makes
connections between human caring, healing,
and even peace in our world, with nurses as
caritas peacemakers when they are practicing
human caring for self and others. This shift
moves to more explicit metaphysical/spiritual
322 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 322
focus on transpersonal caring moment, post-
modern critiques, to metaphysical—from the-
ory to ontological paradigm for caring science.
A broad, evolving unitary caring science
worldview underlies the fluid evolution of the
theory and the philosophical-ethical founda-
tion for this work.
Major Conceptual Elements
The major conceptual elements of the original
(and emergent) theory are as follows:
• Ten carative factors (transposed to ten
caritas processes)
• Transpersonal caring moment
• Caring consciousness/intentionality and
energetic presence
• Caring–healing modalities
Other dynamic aspects of the theory that
have emerged or are emerging as more explicit
components include:
• Expanded views of self and person (unitary
oneness; embodied spirit)
• Caring–healing consciousness and energetic
heart-centered presence
• Human–environmental field of a caring
moment
• Unitary oneness worldview: unbroken
wholeness and connectedness of all
• Advanced caring–healing modalities/
nursing arts as a future model for advanced
practice of nursing qua nursing (consciously
guided by one’s nursing ethical–theoretical–
philosophical orientation)
Caring Science as Sacred Science
The emergence of the work is a more explicit de-
velopment of caring science as a deep moral–
ethical context of infinite and cosmic love. As
soon as one is more explicit about placing the
human and caring within their science model, it
automatically forces a relational unitary world-
view and makes explicit caring as a moral ideal
to sustain humanity across time and space; one
of the gifts and the raison d’être of nursing in the
world, but yet to be recognized within and with-
out. Nevertheless, a caring-science orientation is
necessary for the survival of nursing as well as
humanity at this crossroads in human evolution.
This view takes nursing and healing work
beyond conventional thinking. The latest ori-
entation is located within the ageless wisdom
traditions and perennial ingredients of the dis-
cipline of nursing, while transcending nursing.
Caring science as a model for nursing allows
nursing’s caring–healing core to become both
discipline-specific and transdisciplinary. Thus,
nursing’s timeless, ancient, enduring, and most
noble contributions come of age through a
caring-science orientation—scientifically, aes-
thetically, ethically, and practically.
Ten Carative Factors
The original work (Watson, 1979) was organ-
ized around 10 carative factors as a framework
for providing a format and focus for nursing
phenomena. Although carative factors is still
the current terminology for the “core” of nurs-
ing, providing a structure for the initial work,
the term factor is too stagnant for my sensibil-
ities today. I have extended carative to caritas
and caritas processes as consistent with a more
fluid and contemporary movement of these
ideas and with my expanding directions.
Caritas comes from the Latin word mean-
ing “to cherish and appreciate, giving special
attention to, or loving.” It connotes something
that is very fine; indeed, it is precious. The
word caritas is also closely related to the origi-
nal word carative from my 1979 book. At this
time, I now make new connections between
carative and caritas and without hesitation use
them to invoke love, which caritas conveys.
This usage allows love and caring to come to-
gether for a new form of deep, transpersonal
caring. This relationship between love and car-
ing connotes inner healing for self and others,
extending to nature and the larger universe,
unfolding and evolving within a cosmology
that is both metaphysical and transcendent
with the coevolving human in the universe.
This emerging model of transpersonal caring
moves from carative to caritas. This integrative
expanded perspective is postmodern in that
it transcends conventional industrial, static
models of nursing while simultaneously evok-
ing both the past and the future. For example,
the future of nursing is tied to Nightingale’s
sense of “calling,” guided by a deep sense of
CHAPTER 18 • Jean Watson’s Theory of Human Caring 323
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 323
commitment and a covenantal ethic of human
service, cherishing our phenomena, our subject
matter, and those we serve.
It is when we include caring and love in our
work and in our life that we discover and
affirm that nursing, like teaching, is more than
just a job; it is also a life-giving and life-
receiving career for a lifetime of growth and
learning. Such maturity and integration of past
with present and future now require trans-
forming self and those we serve, including our
institutions and our profession. As we more
publicly and professionally assert these posi-
tions for our theories, our ethics, and our
practices—even for our science—we also locate
ourselves and our profession and discipline
within a new, emerging cosmology. Such
thinking calls for a sense of reverence and
sacredness with regard to life and all living
things. It incorporates both art and science, as
they are also being redefined, acknowledging
a convergence among art, science, and spiritu-
ality. As we enter into the transpersonal caring
theory and philosophy, we simultaneously
are challenged to relocate ourselves in these
emerging ideas and to question for ourselves
how the theory speaks to us. This invites us
into a new relationship with ourselves and our
ideas about life, nursing, and theory.
Original Carative Factors
The original carative factors served as a guide
to what was referred to as the “core of nursing”
in contrast to nursing’s “trim.” Core pointed to
those aspects of nursing that potentiate ther-
apeutic healing processes and relationships—
they affect the one caring and the one being
cared for. Further, the basic core was
grounded in what I referred to as the philos-
ophy, science, and art of caring. Carative is
that deeper and larger dimension of nursing
that goes beyond the “trim” of changing times,
setting, procedures, functional tasks, special-
ized focus around disease, and treatment and
technology. Although the “trim” is important
and not expendable, the point is that nursing
cannot be defined around its trim and what it
does in a given setting and at a given point in
time. Nor can nursing’s trim define and clarify
its larger professional ethic and mission to
society—its raison d’être for the public. That
is where nursing theory comes into play, and
transpersonal caring theory offers another way
that both differs from and complements that
which has come to be known as “modern”
nursing and conventional medical–nursing
frameworks.
The 10 carative factors included in the orig-
inal work are the following:
1. Formation of a humanistic–altruistic
system of values.
2. Instillation of faith–hope.
3. Cultivation of sensitivity to one’s self and
to others.
4. Development of a helping–trusting,
human caring relationship.
5. Promotion and acceptance of the expres-
sion of positive and negative feelings.
6. Systematic use of a creative problem-
solving caring process.
7. Promotion of transpersonal teaching–
learning.
8. Provision for a supportive, protective,
and/or corrective mental, physical,
societal, and spiritual environment.
9. Assistance with gratification of human
needs.
10. Allowance for existential–phenomenological–
spiritual forces. (Watson, 1979, 1985)
Although some of the basic tenets of the
original carative factors still hold and indeed
are used as the basis for some theory-guided
practice models and research, what I am pro-
posing here, as part of my evolution and the
evolution of these ideas and the theory itself,
is to transpose the carative factors into “clinical
caritas processes.”
From Carative Caritas Processes
As carative factors evolved within an expand-
ing perspective and as my ideas and values have
evolved, I now offer the following translation
of the original carative factors into caritas
processes, suggesting more open ways in which
they can be considered.
1. Formation of a humanistic–altruistic sys-
tem of values becomes the practice of loving
324 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 324
kindness and equanimity within the
context of caring consciousness.
2. Instillation of faith–hope becomes being
authentically present and enabling and sus-
taining the deep belief system and subjective
life world of self and one being cared for.
3. Cultivation of sensitivity to one’s self and
to others becomes cultivation of one’s own
spiritual practices and transpersonal self,
going beyond ego self, opening to others
with sensitivity and compassion.
4. Development of a helping–trusting,
human caring relationship becomes devel-
oping and sustaining a helping–trusting,
authentic caring relationship.
5. Promotion and acceptance of the expres-
sion of positive and negative feelings
becomes being present to, and supportive
of, the expression of positive and negative
feelings as a connection with deeper
spirit of self and the one being cared for
(authentically listening to another’s story).
6. Systematic use of a creative problem-
solving caring process becomes creative use
of self and all ways of knowing as part of
the caring process; to engage in the artistry
of caring-healing practices (creative solu-
tion seeking becomes caritas coach role).
7. Promotion of transpersonal teaching-
learning becomes engaging in genuine
teaching-learning experience that attends
to unity of being and meaning, attempting
to stay within others’ frames of reference.
8. Provision for a supportive, protective,
and/or corrective mental, physical, societal,
and spiritual environment becomes creating
a healing environment at all levels (a phys-
ical and nonphysical, subtle environment
of energy and consciousness, whereby
wholeness, beauty, comfort, dignity, and
peace are potentiated).
9. Assistance with gratification of human
needs becomes assisting with basic needs,
with an intentional caring consciousness,
administering “human care essentials,”
which potentiate wholeness and unity of
being in all aspects of care; sacred acts of
basic care; touching embodied spirit and
evolving spiritual emergence.
10. Allowance for existential–phenomenolog-
ical–spiritual forces becomes opening and
attending to spiritual-mysterious and
existential dimensions of one’s own
life-death; soul care for self and the one
being cared for. “Allowing for miracles.”
What differs in the caritas process frame-
work is that a decidedly spiritual dimension and
an overt evocation of love and caring are
merged for a new unitary cosmology for this
millennium. Such a perspective ironically places
nursing within its most mature framework and
is consistent with the Nightingale model of
nursing—yet to be actualized but awaiting its
evolution. This direction, while embedded
in theory, goes beyond theory and becomes a
converging paradigm for nursing’s future.
Thus, I consider my work more a philo-
sophical, ethical, intellectual blueprint for
nursing’s evolving disciplinary/professional
matrix, rather than a specific theory per se.
Nevertheless, others interact with the original
work at levels of concreteness or abstractness.
If the theory is “read” at the carative factor
level, it can be interpreted as a middle-range
theory. If the theory is “read” at the transper-
sonal unitary caring science/transpersonal
caring consciousness level, the theory can be
interpreted as a grand theory located within
the unitary–transformative context.
The caring theory has been and increasingly
is being used nationally and internationally as
a guide for educational curricula, clinical prac-
tice models, methods for research and inquiry,
and administrative directions for nursing and
health-care delivery.
Reading the Theory
The “theory” can be “read” as a philosophy,
an ethic, a paradigm, an expanded science
model, or a theory. If read as a theory, it can
be “read” as a grand theory within the unitary–
transformative paradigm when understood at
the transpersonal, energetic-field level of caritas-
universal love and evolving consciousness.
It can be “read” as middle-range theory
when read at the carative factors/caritas
process level, which provides the structure and
CHAPTER 18 • Jean Watson’s Theory of Human Caring 325
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 325
language of the theory, as both middle range
and specific. When used in clinical settings,
the theory helps nurses to frame their experi-
ences around the caritas processes to sustain
the caring-science focus, as well as developing
language systems, including computerized
documentation systems, to document and
study caring within a designated language sys-
tem (Rosenberg, 2006, p. 55). The middle-
range focus is also congruent with clinical
caring research projects, utilizing the caring
language of carative/caritas. Indeed, many of
the more formalized caring assessment tools
are based on the language of this structure.
Several multisite research projects are now un-
derway using consistent caring assessment
tools, such as Duffy’s Caring Assessment Tool
and the Nelson, Watson, and Inova Health
Instrument Caring Factor Survey (Persky,
Nelson, Watson, & Bent, 2008). The latest
Watson Caritas Patient Score is being used in
multisite clinical studies as an international re-
search project. (For more information, go to
www.watsoncaringscience.org.) In addition,
most of the current caring-science assessment
tools may be seen in Assessing and Measuring
Caring in Nursing and Health Sciences, 2nd ed.
(Watson, 2008b).
Heart-Centered Transpersonal
Caring Moment: Caritas Field
Whether the “theory” is read at different levels,
used as a language system for documentation,
used as a guide for professional nursing prac-
tice models, or used as the focus of multisite
or individual clinical caring research studies,
the essence of the lived theory is in the transper-
sonal caring moment. The caring moment can
be located within any caring occasion, as a
concept within middle-range or even prescrip-
tive or practice-level theory.
However, the caring moment is most evi-
dent within the transpersonal caritas energetic
field model, in that one’s consciousness, inten-
tionality, energetic heart-centered presence is
radiating a field beyond the two people or the
situation, affecting the larger field. Thus, nurses
can become more aware, more awake, more
conscious of manifesting/radiating a caritas field
of love and healing for self and others, helping
to transform self and system. For more compre-
hensive understanding of this work, see Nursing:
The Philosophy and Science of Caring (revised 2nd
ed.; Watson, 2008a). Indeed, the latest research
based on the science of the heart has demon-
strated that the loving heart-centered person is
radiating love that can be measured several feet
beyond themselves, affecting the subtle environ-
ment of all. Moreover, this research affirms that
the heart is actually sending more messages to
the brain, rather than the other way around. For
more information, please visit www.heartMath
.com; www.heartMath.org
This work posits a unitary oneness world-
view of connectedness of all; it embraces a
value’s explicit moral foundation and takes a
specific position with respect to the centrality
of human caring, “caritas,” and universal love
as an ethic and ontology. It is also a critical
starting point for nursing’s existence, broad
societal mission, and the basis for further
advancement for caring–healing practices.
Nevertheless, its use and evolution are depend-
ent on “critical, reflective practices that must
be continuously questioned and critiqued in
order to remain dynamic, flexible, and end-
lessly self-revising and emergent” (Watson,
1996, p. 143).
Transpersonal Caring Relationship
The terms transpersonal and transpersonal caring
relationship are foundational to the work.
Transpersonal conveys a concern for the inner
life world and subjective meaning of another
who is fully embodied. But the transpersonal
also energetically goes beyond the ego self and
beyond the given moment, reaching to the
deeper connections to spirit and with the
broader universe. Thus, a transpersonal caring
relationship moves beyond ego self and radi-
ates to spiritual, even cosmic, concerns and
connections that tap into healing possibilities
and potentials. Transpersonal caring is both
immanent, fully physical and embodied phys-
ically, while also paradoxically transcendent,
beyond physical self.
Transpersonal caring seeks to connect with
and embrace the spirit or soul of the other
through the processes of caring and healing
and being in authentic relation in the moment.
326 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 326
Such a transpersonal relationship is influenced
by the caring consciousness and intentionality
and energetic presence of the nurse as she or
he enters into the life space or phenomenal
field of another person and is able to detect the
other person’s condition of being (at the soul
or spirit level). It implies a focus on the
uniqueness of self and other and the unique-
ness of the moment, wherein the coming to-
gether is mutual and reciprocal, each fully
embodied in the moment, while paradoxically
capable of transcending the moment, open to
new possibilities.
The transpersonal caritas consciousness
nurse seeks to “see” the spirit-filled person be-
hind the patient, behind the colleague, behind
the disease or the diagnosis or the behavior or
personality one may not like and connect with
that spirit-filled individual who exists behind
the illusion. This is heart-centered caritas prac-
tice guided by the very first caritas process: cul-
tivation of loving kindness and equanimity
with self and other, allowing for development
of more caring, love, compassion, and authen-
tic caring moments.
Transpersonal caring calls for an authentic-
ity of being and becoming, an ability to be
present to self and others in a reflective frame.
The transpersonal nurse has the ability to cen-
ter consciousness and intentionality on caring,
healing, and wholeness, rather than on disease,
illness, and pathology.
Transpersonal caring competencies are re-
lated to ontological development of the nurse’s
human caring literacy and ways of being and
becoming. Thus, “ontological caring compe-
tencies” become as critical in this model as
“technological curing competencies” to the
conventional modern, Western techno-cure
nursing-medicine model, which is now com-
ing to an end.
Within the model of transpersonal caring,
clinical caritas consciousness is engaged at a
foundational ethical level for entry into this
framework. The nurse attempts to enter into
and stay within the other’s frame of reference
for connecting with the inner life world of
meaning and spirit of the other. Together,
they join in a mutual search for meaning and
wholeness of being and becoming, to potentiate
comfort measures, pain control, a sense of
well-being, wholeness, or even a spiritual tran-
scendence of suffering. The person is viewed as
whole and complete, regardless of illness or
disease (Watson, 1996, p. 153).
Assumptions of the Transpersonal
Caring Relationship
The nurse’s moral commitment, intentionality,
and caritas consciousness exist to protect, en-
hance, promote, and potentiate human dignity,
wholeness, and healing, wherein a person creates
or cocreates his or her own meaning for exis-
tence, healing, wholeness, and living and dying.
The nurse’s will and consciousness affirm
the subjective-spiritual significance of the per-
son while seeking to sustain caring in the midst
of threat and despair—biological, institutional,
or otherwise. This honors the I–Thou rela-
tionship versus an I–It relationship (Buber,
1923/1996).
The nurse seeks to recognize, accurately de-
tect, and connect with the inner condition
of spirit of another through authentic caritas
(loving) presencing and being centered in the
caring moment. Actions, words, behaviors,
cognition, body language, feelings, intuition,
thought, senses, the energy field, and so on—all
contribute to the transpersonal caring connec-
tion. The nurse’s ability to connect with an-
other at this transpersonal spirit-to-spirit level
is translated via movements, gestures, facial
expressions, procedures, information, touch,
sound, verbal expressions, and other scientific,
technical, esthetic, and human means of com-
munication into nursing human art/acts or
intentional caring-healing modalities.
The caring–healing modalities within the
context of transpersonal caring/caritas con-
sciousness potentiate harmony, wholeness, and
unity of being by releasing some of the dishar-
mony, the blocked energy that interferes with
the natural healing processes. As a result, the
nurse helps another through this process to
access the healer within, in the fullest sense of
Nightingale’s view of nursing.
Ongoing personal–professional develop-
ment and spiritual growth and personal spiri-
tual practice assist the nurse in entering
into this deeper level of professional healing
CHAPTER 18 • Jean Watson’s Theory of Human Caring 327
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 327
practice, allowing the nurse to awaken to the
transpersonal condition of the world and to ac-
tualize more fully “ontological competencies”
necessary for this level of advanced practice of
nursing. Valuable teachers for this work include
the nurse’s own life history and previous expe-
riences, which provide opportunities for fo-
cused studies, as the nurse has lived through or
experienced various human conditions and has
imagined others’ feelings in various circum-
stances. To some degree, the necessary knowl-
edge and consciousness can be gained through
work with other cultures and the study of the
humanities (art, drama, literature, personal
story, narratives of illness journeys) along with
an exploration of one’s own values, deep beliefs,
relationship with self and others, and one’s
world. Other facilitators include personal-
growth experiences such as psychotherapy,
transpersonal psychology, meditation, bioener-
getics work, and other models for spiritual
awakening. Continuous growth is ongoing for
developing and maturing within a transper-
sonal caring model. The notion of health pro-
fessionals as wounded healers is acknowledged
as part of the necessary growth and compassion
called forth within this theory/philosophy.
Caring Moment/Caring Occasion
A caring occasion occurs whenever the nurse
and another come together with their unique
life histories and phenomenal fields in a
human-to-human transaction. The coming to-
gether in a given moment becomes a focal
point in space and time. It becomes transcen-
dent, whereby experience and perception take
place, but the actual caring occasion has a
greater field of its own, in a given moment.
The process goes beyond itself yet arises from
aspects of itself that become part of the life his-
tory of each person, as well as part of a larger,
more complex pattern of life (Watson, 1985,
p. 59; 1996, p. 157).
A caring moment involves an action and a
choice by both the nurse and the other. The
moment of coming together presents the two
with the opportunity to decide how to be in
the moment in the relationship—what to do
with and in the moment. If the caring moment
is transpersonal, each feels a connection with
the other at the spirit level; thus, the moment
transcends time and space, opening up new
possibilities for healing and human connection
at a deeper level than that of physical interac-
tion. For example:
[W]e learn from one another how to be human by
identifying ourselves with others, finding their dilem-
mas in ourselves. What we all learn from it is self-
knowledge. The self we learn about . . . is every
self. IT is universal—the human self. We learn to
recognize ourselves in others . . . [it] keeps alive
our common humanity and avoids reducing self or
other to the moral status of object. (Watson, 1985,
pp. 59–60)
Caring (Healing) Consciousness
The dynamic of transpersonal caring (healing)
within a caring moment is manifest in a field
of consciousness. The transpersonal dimen-
sions of a caring moment are affected by the
nurse’s consciousness in the caring moment,
which in turn affects the field of the whole.
The role of consciousness with respect to a
holographic view of science has been discussed
in earlier writings (Watson, 1992, p. 148) and
includes the following points:
• The whole caring–healing–loving con-
sciousness is contained within a single
caring moment.
• The one caring and the one being cared
for are interconnected; the caring-healing
process is connected with the other
human(s) and with the higher energy of the
universe.
• The caring–healing–loving consciousness of
the nurse is communicated to the one being
cared for.
• Caring–healing–loving consciousness exists
through and transcends time and space and
can be dominant over physical dimensions.
Within this context, it is acknowledged that
the process is relational and connected. It
transcends time, space, and physicality. The
process is intersubjective with transcendent
possibilities that go beyond the given caring
moment.
328 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 328
Implications of the Caring Model
The caring model or theory can be considered a
philosophical and moral/ethical foundation for
professional nursing and is part of the central
focus for nursing at the disciplinary level. A
model of caring includes a call for both art and
science. It offers a framework that embraces and
intersects with art, science, humanities, spiritu-
ality, and new dimensions of mind–body–spirit
medicine and nursing evolving openly as central
to human phenomena of nursing practice.
I emphasize that it is possible to read, study,
learn about, and even teach and research the
caring theory. However, to truly “get it,” one
has to experience it personally. The model is
both an invitation and an opportunity to inter-
act with the ideas, to experiment with and
grow within the philosophy, and to live it out
in one’s personal and professional lives.
Applications of the Theory
The ideas as originally developed, as well as in
the current evolving phase (Watson, 1979,
1985, 1999, 2003, 2005, 2008, 2011), provide
us with a chance to assess, critique, and see
where or how, or even if, we may locate our-
selves within a framework of caring science/
caritas as a basis for the emerging ideas in re-
lation to our own theories and philosophies of
professional nursing and/or caring practice. If
one chooses to use the caring-science perspec-
tive as theory, model, philosophy, ethic, or
ethos for transforming self and practice, or self
and system, the following questions may help
(Watson, 1996, p. 161):
• Is there congruence between the values and
major concepts and beliefs in the model and
the given nurse, group, system, organization,
curriculum, population needs, clinical ad-
ministrative setting, or other entity that is
considering interacting with the caring
model to transform and/or improve practice?
• What is one’s view of “human”? And what
does it mean to be human, caring, healing,
becoming, growing, transforming, and so
on? For example, in the words of Teilhard
de Chardin (1959): “Are we humans having
a spiritual experience, or are we spiritual
beings having a human experience?” Such
thinking in regard to this philosophical
question can guide one’s worldview and
help to clarify where one may locate self
within the caring framework.
• Are those interacting and engaging in the
model interested in their own personal
evolution? Are they committed to seeking
authentic connections and caring–healing
relationships with self and others?
• Are those involved “conscious” of their
caring caritas or noncaring consciousness
and intentionally in a given moment at an
individual and a systemic level? Are they
interested and committed to expanding
their caring consciousness and actions to
self, other, environment, nature, and wider
universe?
• Are those working within the model inter-
ested in shifting their focus from a modern
medical science–technocure orientation
to a true heart-centered authentic caring–
healing–loving model?
This work, in both its original and evolv-
ing forms, seeks to develop caring as an
ontological–epistemological foundation for a
theoretical–philosophical–ethical framework
for the profession and discipline of nursing
and to clarify its mature relationship and dis-
tinct intersection with other health sciences.
Nursing caring theory–based activities as
guides to practice, education, and research
have developed throughout the United States
and other parts of the world. The caring/
caritas model is consistently one of the nurs-
ing caring theories used as a guide in Magnet
Hospitals in the United States and found to
be culturally consistent with nursing in many
other cultures, nations, and countries. Nurses’
reflective-critical practice models are increas-
ingly adhering to a caring ethic and ethos as
the moral and scientific foundation for a pro-
fession that is coming of age for a new global
era in human history.
Latest Developments
The Watson Caring Science Institute (WCSI)
was established in 2007 as a nonprofit founda-
tion. The following statements define and
CHAPTER 18 • Jean Watson’s Theory of Human Caring 329
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 329
describe the goals, missions, and purposes of
the International Caritas Consortium (ICC)
and the WCSI as two interrelated entities.
The general goals and objectives of the WCSI
are to steward and serve the ICC in its activi-
ties and more specifically to:
• Transform the dominant model of medical
science to a model of caring science by
reintroducing the ethic of caring and love,
necessary for healing.
• Deepen the authentic caring–healing rela-
tionships between practitioner and patient
to restore love and heart-centered human
compassion as the ethical foundation of
health care.
• Translate the model of caring–healing/
caritas into more systematic programs and
services to help transform health care one
nurse, one practitioner, one educator, and
one system at a time.
• Ensure caring and healing for the public,
reduce nurse turnover, and decrease costs
to the system.
International Caritas Consortium
Charter
The main purposes of the unfolding and emerg-
ing ICC (Watson, 2008a, pp. 278–280) are as
follows:
1. To explore diverse ways to bring the caring
theory to life in academic and clinical prac-
tice settings by supporting and learning
from each other
2. To share knowledge and experiences so
that we might help guide self and others in
the journey to live the caring philosophy
and theory in our personal and professional
lives.
The consortium gatherings, sponsored by
systems implementing caring theory in practice:
• Provide an intimate forum to renew, re-
store, and deepen each person’s and each
system’s commitment and authentic prac-
tices of human caring in their personal/
professional life and work.
• Learn from each other through shared work
of original scholarship, diverse forms of car-
ing inquiry, and modeling of caring–healing
practices.
• Mentor self and others in using and extend-
ing the theory of human caring to trans-
form education and clinical practices.
• Develop and disseminate caring science
models of clinical scholarship and profes-
sional excellence in the various settings in
the world.
Activities for Caritas Consortium
Gatherings
• Provide a safe forum to explore, create, and
renew self and system through reflective
time out.
• Share ideas, inspire each other, and learn
together.
• Participate in use of appreciative inquiry in
which each member is facilitative of each
other’s work, each participant learning from
others.
• Create opportunities for original scholar-
ship and new models of caring science–
based clinical and educational practices.
• Generate and share multisite projects in
caring theory/caring science scholarship.
• Network for educational and professional
models of advancing caring–healing
practices and transformative models of
nursing.
• Share unique experiences for authentic self-
growth within the caring science context.
• Educate, implement, and disseminate
exemplary experiences and findings to
broader professional audiences through
scholarly publications, research, and
formal presentations.
• Envision new possibilities for transforming
nursing and health care.
Because of the many national and interna-
tional developments and sincere desire for
authentic change, new projects using caring
science, caritas theory, and the philosophy
of human caring are now underway in many
systems. The WCSI and the ICC are examples
of individuals and representatives of systems
convening (in these cases, once a year) to
deepen and sustain what is referred to as caritas
nursing—that is, bringing caring and love and
heart-centered human-to-human practices
back into our personal life and work world
(Watson, 2008a).
330 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 330
Caring Indicators and Programs
Although these earlier-named systems are
identified as sponsors of the growing ICC, ex-
amples of how these systems are implementing
the theory are captured through identified acts
and processes depicting such transformative
changes.
Caring theory-in-action reflects transfor-
mative processes that are representative of ac-
tions taking place in many of the systems in
the ICC and other systems guided by caring
science and caring theory. The following are
examples of such caring-in-action indicators:
• Make human caring integral to the organi-
zational vision and culture through new
language and documentation of caring,
such as posters.
• Introduce and name new professional car-
ing practice models, leading to new patterns
of delivery of caring/care (e.g., Attending
Caring Nursing Project, Patient Care
Facilitator Role, the 12-Bed Hospital).
• Create conscious intentional meaningful
rituals—for example, hand washing is for
infection control but may also be a mean-
ingful ritual of self-caring—energetically
cleansing, blessing, and releasing the last
situation or encounter, and being open to
the next situation.
• Selectively use of caring–healing modalities
for self and patients (e.g., massage, thera-
peutic touch, reflexology, aromatherapy,
calmative essential oils, sound, music, arts,
a variety of energetic modalities).
• Dim the unit lights and have designated
“quiet time” for patients, families, and staff
alike to soften, slow down, and calm the
environment.
• Create healing spaces for nurses—sanctuaries
for their own time out; this may include
meditation or relaxation rooms for quiet
time.
• Cultivate one’s own spiritual heart-centered
practices of loving kindness and equanimity
to self and others.
• Intentionally pause and breathe, preparing
the self to be present before entering
patient’s room.
• Use centering exercises and mindfulness
practices, individually and collectively.
• Place magnets on patient’s door with
positive affirmations and reminders of
caring practices.
• Explore documentation of caring language
and integration in computerized documen-
tation systems.
• Participate in multisite research assessing
caring among staff and patients.
• Create healing environments, attending to
the subtle environment or caritas field.
• Display healing objects, stones, or a blessing
basket.
• Create Caritas Circles to share caring
moments.
• Perform Caring Rounds at bedside with
patients.
• Interview and select staff on the basis of a
“caring” orientation. Asking candidates to
describe a “caring moment.”
• Develop of “caring competencies” using
caritas literacy as guide to assess and pro-
mote staff development and ensure caring.
These and other practices are occurring in a
variety of hospitals across the United States,
often in Magnet hospitals or those seeking
Magnet recognition, where caring theory and
models of human caring are used to transform
nursing and health care for staff and patients
alike.
The names of other health-care clinical and
educational systems incorporating caring
theory into professional nursing practice mod-
els (many are Magnet hospitals or preparing
to become Magnet hospitals) can be found
at www.watsoncaringscience.org.
These identified system examples are ex-
emplars of the changing momentum today
and are guided by a shift toward an evolved
consciousness. They rely on moral, ethical,
philosophical, and theoretical foundations to
restore human caring and healing and health
in a system that has gone astray—educationally,
economically, clinically, and socially. This
shift is in a hopeful direction and is based
on a grassroots transformation of nursing,
one that emerging from the inside out. The
dedicated leaders who are ushering in these
changes serve as an inspiration for sustaining
nursing and human caring for practitioners
and patients alike.
CHAPTER 18 • Jean Watson’s Theory of Human Caring 331
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 331
Conclusion
Consistent with the wisdom and vision of Flo-
rence Nightingale, nursing is a lifetime journey
of caring and healing, seeking to understand
and preserve the wholeness of human existence
across time and space and national/geographic
boundaries, to offer heart-centered compas-
sionate, informed knowledgeable human car-
ing to society and humankind. This timeless
view of nursing transcends conventional minds
and mindsets of illness, pathology, and disease
that are located in the physical body with cur-
ing as end goal, often at all costs. In nursing’s
timeless model, caring, kindness, love, and
heart-centered compassionate service to hu-
mankind are restored. The unifying focus and
process is on connectedness with self, other,
nature, and God/the Life Force/the Absolute.
This vision and wisdom is being reignited
today through a blend of old and new values,
ethics, and theories and practices of human
caring and healing. These caritas consciousness
practices preserve humanity, human dignity,
and wholeness and are the very foundation of
transformed thinking and actions.
Such a values-guided relational ontology
and expanded epistemology and ethic is em-
bodied in caring science as the disciplinary
ground for nursing, now and in the future. The
advancement of nursing theory, which in-
cludes both ideals and practical guidance, is
increasingly evident as nursing makes its major
contribution to health care and matures as
a distinct caring–healing profession—one that
balances and complements conventional,
medical–institutional practices and processes.
Nevertheless, much work remains to be done.
New transformative, human-spirit–inspired
approaches are required to reverse institutional
and system lethargy and darkness. To create
the necessary cultural change, the human spirit
has to be invited back into our health-care sys-
tems. Professional and personal models are re-
quired that open the hearts of nurses and other
practitioners. New horizons of possibilities
have to be explored to create space whereby
compassionate, intentional, heart-centered
human caring can be practiced. Such authentic
personal/professional practice models of caring
science are capable of leading us, locally and
globally, toward a moral community of caring.
This community will restore healing and health
at a level that honors and sustains the dignity
and humanity of practitioners and patients alike.
The Watson Caring Science Institute is
dedicated to create, conduct, and sponsor
Caring Science/Caritas education, training,
and support to serve the current and future
generations of health-care professionals glob-
ally (www.watsoncaringscience.org; WCSI,
4405 Arapahoe Avenue, Suite 100, Boulder,
CO 80303).
332 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
Practice Exemplar
Practice Exemplar by Terry
Woodward, RN, MSN.
October 2002 presented the opportunity for
17 interdisciplinary health-care professionals
at the Children’s Hospital in Denver, Col-
orado, to participate in a pilot study designed
to (1) explore the effect of integrating caring
theory into comprehensive pediatric pain
management and (2) examine the Attending
Nurse Caring Model® (ANCM) as a care de-
livery model for hospitalized children in pain.
A 3-day retreat launched the pilot study. Par-
ticipants were invited to explore transpersonal
human caring theory (caring theory) as taught
and modeled by Dr. Jean Watson, through ex-
periential interactions with caring–healing
modalities. The end of the retreat opened op-
portunities for participants to merge caring
theory and pain theory into an emerging
caring-healing praxis.
Returning from the retreat to the preexist-
ing schedules, customs, and habits of hospital
routine was both daunting and exciting. We
had lived caring theory, and not as a remote
and abstract philosophical ideal; rather, we
had experienced caring as the very core of our
true selves, and it was that call that had led us
into the health-care professions. Invigorated
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 332
CHAPTER 18 • Jean Watson’s Theory of Human Caring 333
Practice Exemplar cont.
by the retreat, we returned to our 37-bed acute
care inpatient pediatric unit, eager to apply
caring theory to improve pediatric pain man-
agement. Our experiences throughout the re-
treat had accentuated caring as our core value.
Caring theory could not be restricted to a
single area of practice.
Wheeler and Chinn (1991) define praxis as
“values made visible through deliberate action”
(p. 2). This definition unites the ontology,
or the essence, of nursing to nursing actions,
to what nurses do. Nursing within acute care
inpatient hospital settings is practiced depend-
ently, collaboratively, and independently
(Bernardo, 1998). Bernardo described depend-
ent practice as energy directed by and requiring
physician orders, collaborative practice as in-
terdependent energy directed toward activities
with other health-care professionals, and inde-
pendent practice as “where the meaningful role
and impact of nursing may evolve” (p. 43). Our
vision of nursing practice was based in the car-
ing paradigm of deep respect for humanity and
all life, of wonder and awe of life’s mystery, and
the interconnectedness from mind–body–spirit
unity into cosmic oneness (Watson, 1996).
Gadow (1995) described nursing as a lived
world of interdependency and shared knowl-
edge, rather than as a service provided. Caring
praxis within this lived world is a praxis that
offers “a combination of action and reflection
. . . praxis is about a relationship with self, and
a relationship with the wider community”
(Penny & Warelow, 1999, p. 260). Caring
praxis, therefore, is collaborative praxis.
Collaboration and cocreation are key ele-
ments in our endeavors to translate caring the-
ory into practice. They reveal the nonlinear
process and relational aspect of caring praxis.
Both require openness to unknown possibili-
ties, both honor the unique contributions of
self and other(s), and both acknowledge
growth and transformation as inherent to life
experience. These key elements support the
evolution of praxis away from predetermined
goals and set outcomes toward authentic caring–
healing expressions. Through collaboration and
cocreation, we can build on existing founda-
tions to nurture evolution from what is to what
can be.
Our mission—to translate caring theory
into praxis—had strong foundational support.
Building on this supportive base, we commit-
ted our intentions and energies toward creat-
ing a caring culture. The following is not
intended as an algorithm to guide one through
varied steps until caring is achieved but is
rather a description of our ongoing processes
and growth toward an ever-evolving caring
praxis. These processes are cocreations that
emerged from collaboration with other ANCM
participants, fellow health professionals, pa-
tients and families, our environment, and our
caring intentions.
First Steps
One of our first challenges was to make the
ANCM visible. Six tangible exhibits were dis-
played on the unit as evidence of our commit-
ment to caring values. First, a large, colorful
poster titled “CARING” was positioned at the
entrance to our unit. Depicting pictures of di-
verse families at the center, the poster states our
three initial goals for theory-guided practice:
(1) create caring–healing environments, (2) op-
timize pain management through pharmaco-
logical and caring–healing measures, and
(3) prepare children and families for procedures
and interventions. Watson’s clinical caritas
processes were listed, as well as an abbreviated
version of her guidelines for cultivating caring–
healing throughout the day (Watson, 2002).
This poster, written in caring theory language,
expressed our intention to all and reminded us
that caring is the core of our praxis.
Second, a shallow bowl of smooth, rounded
river stones was located in a prominent posi-
tion at each nursing desk. A sign posted by the
stones identified them as “Caring–Healing
Touch Stones,” inviting one to select a stone
as “every human being has the ability to share
their incredible gift of loving–healing. These
stones serve as a reminder of our capacity to
love and heal. Pick up a stone, feel its smooth
Continued
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 333
334 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
Practice Exemplar cont.
cool surface, let its weight remind you of your
own gifts of love and healing. Share in the love
and healing of all who have touched this stone
before you and pass on your love and healing
to all who will hold this stone after you.”
Third, latched wicker blessing baskets were
placed adjacent to the caring–healing touch
stones. Written instructions invited families,
visitors, and staff to offer names for a blessing
by writing the person’s initials on a slip of
paper and placing the paper in the basket.
Every Monday through Friday, the unit chap-
lain, holistic clinical nurse specialist (CNS),
and interested staff devoted 30 minutes of
meditative silence within a healing space to ask
for peace and hope for all names contained
within the baskets.
Fourth, signs picturing a snoozing cartoon-
styled tiger were posted on each patient’s door
announcing “Quiet Time.” Quiet time was a
midday, half-hour pause from hospital hustle-
bustle. Lights in the hall were dimmed, voices
hushed, and steps softened to allow a pause for
reflection. Staff members tried not to enter
patient rooms unless summoned.
Fifth, a booklet was written and published
to welcome families and patients to our unit,
to introduce health team members, unit rou-
tines, available activities, and define frequently
used medical terms. This book emphasized
that patients, parents, and families are mem-
bers of the health team. A description of our
caring attending team was also included.
Sixth and most recently, the unit chaplain,
child-life specialist, and social worker organ-
ized a weekly support session called “Goodies
and Gathering,” offered every Thursday morn-
ing. It was held in our healing room—a con-
ference room painted to resemble a cozy room
with a beautiful outdoor view and redecorated
with comfortable armchairs, soft lighting, and
plants. Goodies and Gathering extended a safe
retreat within the hospital setting. Offering
1 hour to parents and another to staff, these
professionals provided snacks to feed the body,
a sacred space to nourish emotions, and their
caring presence to nurture the spirit.
Attending Caring Team (ACT)
To honor the collaborative partnership of our
ANCM participants, to include patients and
families as equal partners in the health-care
team, and to open participation to all, we
adopted the name Attending Caring Team
(ACT). The acronym ACT reinforces that our
actions are opportunities to make caring visi-
ble. Care as the core of praxis differs from the
centrality of cure in the medical model. To de-
scribe our intentions to others, we compiled
the following “elevator” description of ACT,
a terse, 30-second summary that rendered the
meaning of ACT in the time frame of a shared
elevator ride:
The core of the Attending Caring Team (ACT)
is caring-healing for patients, families, and
ourselves. ACT cocreates relationships and col-
laborative practices between patients, families
and health care providers. ACT practice enables
health care providers to redefine themselves as
caregivers rather than taskmasters. We provide
Health Care not Health Tasks.
Large signs were professionally produced
and hung at various locations on our unit.
These signs served a dual purpose. The largest,
posted conspicuously at our threshold, identi-
fied our unit as the home of the Attending
Caring Team. Smaller signs, posted at each
nurse’s station, spelled out the above ACT
definition, inviting everyone entering our unit
to participate in the collaborative cocreation of
caring–healing.
Giving ourselves a name and making our
caring intentions visible contributed to estab-
lishing an identity, yet may be perceived as pe-
ripheral activities. For these expressions to be
deliberate actions of praxis, the centrality of
caring as our core value was clearly articulated.
Caring theory is the flexible framework guid-
ing our unit goals and unit education and has
been integrated into our implementation of an
institutional customer-service initiative.
Unit goals are written yearly. Reflective of
the broader institutional mission statement,
each unit is encouraged to develop a mission
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 334
CHAPTER 18 • Jean Watson’s Theory of Human Caring 335
Practice Exemplar cont.
statement and outline goals designed to
achieve that mission. In 2003, our mission
statement was rewritten to focus on provision
of quality family-centered care, defined as “an
environment of caring-healing recognizing
families as equal partners in collaboration with
all health care providers.” One of the goals to
achieve this mission literally spelled out caring.
We promote a caring-healing environment for
patients, families, and staff through:
• Compassion, competence, commitment
• Advocacy
• Respect, research
• Individuality
• Nurturing
• Generosity
Education
Unit educational offerings were also revised to
reflect caring theory. Phase classes, a 2-year
curriculum of serial seminars designed to sup-
port new hires in their clinical, educational,
and professional growth, now include a unit
on self-care to promote personal healing and
support self-growth. The unit on pain man-
agement was expanded to include use of
caring–healing modalities. A new interactive
session on the caritas processes was added that
asks participants to reflect on how these
processes are already evident in their praxis
and to explore ways they can deepen caring
praxis both individually and collectively as a
unit. The tracking tool used to assess a new
employee’s progress through orientation now
includes an area for reflection on growing in
caring competencies. In addition to changes in
phase classes, informal “clock hours” were of-
fered monthly. Clock hours are designed to re-
spond to the immediate needs of the unit and
encompass a diverse range of topics, from con-
flict resolution, debriefing after specific events,
and professional development, to health treat-
ment plans, physiology of medical diagnosis,
and in-services on new technologies and phar-
macological interventions. Offered on the unit
at varying hours to accommodate all work
shifts, clock hours provide a way for staff
members to fulfill continuing educational
requirements during workdays.
Customer Service to Covenantal
In the practice of human caring as a formal
theory and practice model, there is a philo-
sophical shift from a customer-service mindset
to viewing nursing and human caring as
a covenant with humanity to sustain human
caring in the world.
Within this exemplar, caring theory has
provided depth to an institutional initiative to
use FISH philosophy to enhance customer
service (Lundin, Paul, & Christensen, 2000).
Imported from the Pike Place Fish Market in
Seattle, FISH advocates four premises to im-
prove employee and customer satisfaction:
presence, make their day, play, and choose
your attitude. Briefly summarized, FISH ad-
vocates that when employees bring their full
awareness through presence, focus on cus-
tomers to make their day, invoke fun into the
day through appropriate play, and through
conscious awareness choose their attitude,
work environments improve for all. When the
four FISH premises are viewed from the per-
spective of transpersonal caring, they become
opportunities for authentic human-to-human
connectedness through I–Thou relationships.
The merger of caring theory with FISH
philosophy has inspired the following activi-
ties. A parade composed of patients, their
families, nurses, and volunteers—complete
with marching music, hats, streamers, flags,
and noisemakers—is celebrated two to three
times a week just before the playroom closes
for lunch. This flamboyant display lasts less
than 5 minutes but invigorates participants
and bystanders alike. In addition to being vital
for children and especially appropriate in a
pediatric setting, play unites us all in the life
and joy of each moment. When our parade
marches, visitors, rounding doctors, and all
others on the unit pause to watch, wave, and
cheer us on. A weekly bedtime story is read in
our healing room. Patients are invited to bring
Continued
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 335
336 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
Practice Exemplar cont.
their pillows and favorite stuffed animal or doll
and come dressed in pajamas. Night- and day-
shift staff members have honored one another
with surprise beginning-of-the-shift meals,
staying late to care for patients and families,
and refusing to give off-going report until
their on-coming coworkers had eaten. Color-
ful caring stickers are awarded when one staff
member catches another in the ACT of car-
ing, being present, making another’s day, play-
ing, and choosing a positive attitude. These
acts are authentic and not performed as hos-
pitality acts and within the customer mindset;
rather, they are a professional covenant nurs-
ing has with humanity around the world.
ACT Guidelines
Placing caring theory at the core of our praxis
supports practicing caring–healing arts to pro-
mote wholeness, comfort, harmony, and inner
healing. The intentional conscious presence of
our authentic being to provide a caring–healing
environment is the most essential of these arts.
Presence as the foundation for cocreating car-
ing relationships has led to writing ACT
guidelines. Written in the doctor order section
of the chart, ACT guidelines provide a formal
way to honor unique families’ values and be-
liefs. Preferred ways of having dressing changes
performed, most helpful comfort measures,
home schedules, and special needs or requests
are examples of what these guidelines might
address. ACT members purposefully use the
word guideline as opposed to order as more con-
gruent with cocreative collaborate praxis and to
encourage critical thinking and flexibility.
Building practice on caring relationships has
led to an increase in both the type and volume
of care conferences held on our unit. Previ-
ously, care conferences were called as a way to
disseminate information to families when
complicated issues arose or when communica-
tion between multiple teams faltered and fam-
ilies were receiving conflicting reports, plans,
and instructions. Now these conferences are
offered proactively as a way to coordinate team
efforts and to ensure we are working toward
the families’ goals. Transitional conferences
provide an opportunity to coordinate conti-
nuity of care, share insight into the unique
personality and preferences of the child, coor-
dinate team effort, meet families, provide them
with tours of our unit, and collaborate with
families. Other caring–healing arts offered on
our unit are therapeutic touch, guided imagery,
relaxation, visualization, aromatherapy, and
massage. As ACT participants, our challenge
is to express our caring values through every ac-
tivity and interaction. Caring theory guides us
and manifests in innumerable ways. Our inter-
view process, meeting format, and clinical
nurse specialist (CNS) role have been transfig-
ured through caring theory. Our interview
process has transformed from an interrogative
three-step procedure into more of a sharing
dialogue. We are adopting another meeting
style that expresses caring values.
Our unit director had the foresight to
budget a position for a CNS to support the
cocreation of caring praxis. The traditional
CNS roles—researcher, clinical expert, collab-
orator, educator, and change agent—have
allowed the integration of caring theory devel-
opment into all aspects of our unit program.
The CNS role advocates self-care and facili-
tates staff members to incorporate caring-healing
arts into their practice through modeling and
hands-on support. In addition to providing
assistance, searching for resources, acting as
liaison with other health-care teams, and
promoting staff in their efforts, the very pres-
ence of the CNS on the unit reinforces our
commitment to caring praxis.
Conclusion
We continue to work toward incorporating
caring ideals in every action. Currently, we are
modifying our competency-based guidelines
to emphasize caring competency within tasks
and skills. Building relationships for support-
ive collaborative practice is the most exciting
and most challenging endeavor we are now
facing as old roles are reevaluated in light
of cocreating caring-healing relationships.
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 336
CHAPTER 18 • Jean Watson’s Theory of Human Caring 337
Practice Exemplar cont.
Watson and Foster (2003) described the
potential of such collaboration:
The new caring-healing practice environment is
increasingly dependent on partnerships, negoti-
ation, coordination, new forms of communica-
tion pattern and authentic relationships. The
new emphasis is on a change of consciousness, a
focused intentionality toward caring and healing
relationships and modalities, a shift toward a
spiritualization of health vs. a limited medical-
ized view. (p. 361)
Our ACT commitment is to authentic re-
lationships and the creation of caring–healing
environments.
■ Summary
Nursing’s future and nursing in the future
will depend on nursing maturing as the dis-
tinct health, healing, and caring profession
that it has always represented across time but
has yet to fully actualize. Nursing thus iron-
ically is now challenged to stand and mature
within its own caring science paradigm,
while simultaneously having to transcend it
and share with others. The future already re-
veals that all health-care practitioners will
need to work within a shared framework
of caring–healing relationships and human–
environmental energetic field modalities.
Practitioners of the future pay attention to
consciousness, intentionality, energetic human
presence, transformed mind–body–spirit med-
icine, and will need to embrace healing arts
and caring practices and processes and the
spiritual dimensions of care much more com-
pletely.
Thus, nursing is at its own crossroad of
possibilities, between worldviews and para-
digms. Nursing has entered a new era; it is in-
vited and required to build on its heritage and
latest evolution in science and technology but
must transcend itself for a new future, yet to
be known. However, nursing’s future holds
promises of caring and healing mysteries and
models yet to unfold, as opportunities for of-
fering compassionate caritas services at indi-
vidual, system, societal, national, and global
levels for self, for profession, and for the
broader world community. Nursing has a
critical role to play in sustaining caring in hu-
manity and making new connections between
caring, love, healing, and peace in the world.
References
Bernardo, A. (1998). Technology and true presence in
nursing. Holistic Nursing Practice, 12(4), 40–49.
Buber, M. (1996). I and Thou (W. Kaufmann, Trans.).
New York, NY: Touchstone. (Original work
published 1923)
de Chardin, P. (1959). The phenomenon of man. New
York, NY: Harper & Row Publishers, Inc.
Gadow, S. (1995). Narrative and exploration: Toward a
poetics of knowledge in nursing. Nursing Inquiry, 2,
211–214.
Hills, M. & Watson, J. (2011). Creating a caring curricu-
lum. Emancipatory pedagogies (a Caring Science
Library Series with Springer/Watson Caring Science
Institute). New York: Springer.
Lundin, S. C., Paul, H., & Christensen, J. (2000). Fish!
A remarkable way to boost morale and improve results.
New York: Hyperion.
Nelson, J., & Watson, J. (2011). Measuring caritas.
International research on caritas as healing (a Caring
Science Library Series with Springer/Watson Caring
Science Institute). New York: Springer.
Penny, W., & Warelow, P. J. (1999). Understanding the
prattle of praxis. Nursing Inquiry, 6(4), 259–268.
Persky, G., Nelson, J.W., Watson, J., & Bent, K.
(2008). Profile of a nurse effective in caring. Nursing
Administration Quarterly, 32(1), 15–20.
Rosenberg, S. (2006). Utilizing the language of Jean
Watson’s caring theory within a computerized
documentation system. CIN: Computers, Informatics,
Nursing, 24(1), 53–56.
Sitzman, K., & Watson, J. (2014). Caring science,
mindful practice: implementing Watson's human
caring theory. New York: Springer.
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 337
338 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
Swanson, K. M. (1991). Empirical development of a
middle range nursing theory. Nursing Research, 40(3),
161–166.
Vivinus, M., & Nergaard, B. (1990). Ever yours, Florence
Nightingale. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University
Press.
Watson, J. (1979). Nursing. The philosophy and science
of caring. Boston: Little Brown. Reprinted 1985.
Boulder, CO: University Press of Colorado.
Watson, J. (1985). Nursing: Human science and human
care. Norwalk, CT: Appleton Century. Reprinted
1988, 1999, 2007. New York: National League for
Nursing Press; Sudbury, MA: Jones and Bartlett.
Watson, J. (1996). Watson’s theory of transpersonal
caring. In P. H. Walker & B. Newman (Eds.),
Blueprint for use of nursing models: Education, research,
practice and administration. New York: National
League for Nursing Press.
Watson, J. (1999). Postmodern nursing and beyond. New
York: Churchill Livingstone.
Watson, J. (2001). Post-hospital nursing: Shortage,
shifts and scripts. Nursing Administration Quarterly,
25(3), 77–82.
Watson, J. (2002). Intentionality and caring-healing
consciousness: A practice of transpersonal nursing.
Holistic Nursing Practice, 16(4), 12–19.
Watson, J. (2003). Assessing and measuring caring in
nursing and health sciences. New York: Springer.
Watson, J. (2005). Caring science as sacred science.
Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Watson, J. (2008a). Nursing: The philosophy and science of
caring (rev. 2nd ed. with Caritas Meditation CD).
Boulder, CO: University Press of Colorado;
www.upcolorado.com
Watson, J. (2008b). Assessing and measuring caring in
nursing and health sciences (2nd ed.). New York:
Springer.
Watson, J. (2011). Human caring science. A theory of
nursing. Boston: Jones and Bartlett.
Watson, J., & Foster, R. (2003). The Attending Nurse
Caring Model®: Integrating theory, evidence and
advanced caring-healing therapeutics for transform-
ing professional practice. Journal of Clinical Nursing,
12, 360–365.
Wheeler, C. E., & Chinn, P. L. (1991). Peace and power:
A handbook of feminist process (3rd ed.). New York:
National League for Nursing Press.
Bibliography
For complete listing of all Watson’s calendar,
program, publications, videos of presentations,
audio readings and other media, go to:
www.watsoncaringscience.org. Also see videos
on YouTube.
Selected Journal Articles
Fawcett, J. (2002). The nurse theorists: 21st century
updates—Jean Watson. Nursing Science Quarterly,
15(3), 214–219.
Fawcett, J., Watson, J., Neuman, B., & Hinton-Walker,
P. (2001). On theories and evidence. Journal of
Nursing Scholarship, 33(2), 121–128.
Quinn, J., Smith, M., Swanson, K., Ritenbaugh, C., &
Watson, J. (2003). The healing relationship in
clinical nursing: Guidelines for research. Journal of
Alternative Therapies, 9(3), A65–79.
Watson, J. (1988). Human caring as moral context for
nursing education. Nursing and Health Care, 9(8),
422–425.
Watson, J. (1988). New dimensions of human caring
theory. Nursing Science Quarterly, 1(4), 175–181.
Watson, J. (1990). The moral failure of the patriarchy.
Nursing Outlook, 28(2), 62–66.
Watson, J. (1998). Nightingale and the enduring legacy
of transpersonal human caring. Journal of Holistic
Nursing, 16(2), 18–21.
Watson, J. (2000). Leading via caring–healing: The four-
fold way toward transformative leadership. Nursing
Administration Quarterly (25th Anniversary Edition),
25(1), 1–6.
Watson, J. (2000). Reconsidering caring in the home.
Journal of Geriatric Nursing, 21(6), 330–331.
Watson, J. (2000). Via negativa: Considering caring by
way of non-caring. Australian Journal of Holistic
Nursing, 7(1), 4–8.
Watson, J. (2001). Post-hospital nursing: Shortages,
shifts, and scripts. Nursing Administrative Quarterly,
25(3), 77–82. Available online at http://www
.dartmouth.edu/~ahechome/workforce.html, then
click “The Nursing Shortage.”
Watson, J. (2002). Guest editorial: Nursing: Seeking its
source and survival. ICU NURS WEB J 9, 1–7.
www.nursing.gr/J.W.editorial
Watson, J. (2002). Holistic nursing and caring: A values
based approach. Journal of Japan Academy of Nursing
Science, 22(2), 69–74.
Watson, J. (2002). Intentionality and caring-healing
consciousness: A theory of transpersonal nursing.
Holistic Nursing Journal, 16(4), 12–19.
Watson, J. (2002). Metaphysics of virtual caring commu-
nities. International Journal of Human Caring, 6(1).
Watson, J. (2003). Love and caring: Ethics of face
and hand. Nursing Administrative Quarterly, 27(3),
197–202.
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 338
CHAPTER 18 • Jean Watson’s Theory of Human Caring 339
Watson, J., & Foster, R. (2003). The attending nurse
caring model: Integrating theory, evidence and ad-
vanced caring-healing therapeutics for transforming
professional practice. Journal of Clinical Nursing, 12,
360–365.
Watson, J., & Smith, M. C. (2002). Caring science
and the science of unitary human beings: A trans-
theoretical discourse for nursing knowledge develop-
ment. Journal of Advanced Nursing, 37(5), 452–461.
Watson, J. (1994). A frog, a rock, a ritual: An eco-caring
cosmology. In: E. Schuster & C. Brown (Eds.),
Caring and environmental connection. New York:
National League for Nursing Press.
Watson, J. (1996). Artistry and caring: Heart and soul of
nursing. In D. Marks-Maran & P. Rose (Eds.),
Reconstructing nursing: Beyond art & science
(pp. 54–63). London: Bailliére Tindall.
Watson, J. (1996). Poeticizing as truth on nursing in-
quiry. In J. Kikuchi, H. Simmons, & D. Romyn, D.
(Eds.), Truth in nursing inquiry (pp. 125–139).
Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Watson, J. (1996). Watson’s theory of transpersonal car-
ing. In P. H. Walker & B. Neuman (Eds.), Blueprint
for use of nursing models: Education, research, practice,
& administration (pp. 141–184). New York:
National League for Nursing Press.
Watson, J. (1999). Alternative therapies and nursing
practice. In J. Watson (Ed.), Nurse’s handbook of
alternative and complementary therapies. Springhouse,
PA: Springhouse.
Watson, J., & Chinn, P. L. (1994). Art and aesthetics as
passage between centuries. In P. L. Chinn & J. Watson
(Eds.), Art and aesthetics in nursing (pp. xiii–xviii).
New York: National League for Nursing Press.
Audiovisual or Media Productions
CD: Jean Watson: A caring moment. Care for the
Journey CD. www.nursing.ucdenver.edu/caring
CD: Caritas meditation. Jean Watson. Four meditations
with music by Gary Malkin. In J. Watson, 2008).
Nursing: The philosophy and science of caring. (rev. ed.).
Boulder, CO: University Press of Colorado.
Watson FITNE. (1997). The nurse theorists portraits of
excellence. Jean Watson: A theory of caring [video and
CD]. To obtain, go to: www.fitne.net.
Watson, J. (1988). The Denver nursing project in human
caring [videotape]. University of Colorado Health
Science Center, School of Nursing, Denver, CO.
Contact: ellen.janasko@ ucdenver.edu.
Watson, J. (1988). The power of caring: The power to make
a difference [videotape]. Center for Human Caring
Video, University of Colorado Health Sciences
Center, School of Nursing, Denver, CO. Contact:
ellen.janasko@ucdenver.edu
Watson, J. (1989). Theories at work [videotape].
New York: National League for Nursing. In con-
junction with University of Colorado Health Science
Center/School of Nursing Chair in Caring Science.
Contact ellen.janasko@ucdenver.edu
Watson, J. (1994). Applying the art and science of human
caring, Parts I and II [videotape]. New York:
National League for Nursing. In conjunction with
the University of Colorado Health Science
Center/School of Nursing, Chair in Caring Science.
Contact: Ellen. janasko@ucdenver.edu.
Watson, J. (1999). A meta-reflection on nursing’s present
[audiotape]. American Holistic Nurses Association.
Boulder, CO: SoundsTrue Production.
Watson, J. (1999). Private psalms. A mantra and medita-
tion for healing [CD]. Music by Dallas Smith and
Susan Mazer. To obtain: www.watsoncaring-
science.org
Watson, J. (2000). Importance of story and health care.
Second National Gathering on Relationship-
Centered Caring, Fetzer Institute Conference, Florida.
Watson, J. (2001). Creating a culture of caring [audio-
tape]. At the Creative Healthcare Management 9th
Annual Meeting, Minneapolis, MN.
Watson, J. (2001, September). Reconnecting with spirit:
Caring and healing our living and dying. International
Parish Nursing Conference, Westberg Symposium.
Available at https://watsoncaringscience.org/about-
us/jean-bio/nationalinternational-presentations/
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 339
3312_Ch18_321-340 26/12/14 4:58 PM Page 340
Chapter 19Theory of Nursing as Caring
ANNE BOYKIN AND SAVINA O.
SCHOENHOFER
Introducing the Theorists
Nursing as Caring: An Overview
Applications of the Theory
Practice Exemplar
Summary
References
341
Introducing the Theorists
Anne Boykin
Anne Boykin is Professor Emerita and past
Dean of the Christine E. Lynn College of
Nursing at Florida Atlantic University. She is
Director of the College’s Anne Boykin Insti-
tute for the Advancement of Caring in Nurs-
ing. This institute provides global leadership
for nursing education, practice, and research
grounded in caring; promotes the valuing of
caring across disciplines; and supports the car-
ing mission of the college. She has demon-
strated a long-standing commitment to the
advancement of knowledge in the discipline,
especially regarding the phenomenon of caring.
Positions she has held within the Interna-
tional Association for Human Caring include:
president-elect (1990–1993), president (1993–
1996), and member of the nominating commit-
tee (1997–1999). As immediate past president,
she served as co-editor of the journal Interna-
tional Association for Human Caring from 1996
to 1999.
Her scholarly work is centered in caring as
the grounding for nursing. This is evidenced in
her coauthored book, Nursing as Caring: A
Model for Transforming Practice (Boykin &
Schoenhofer, 1993, rev. ed. 2001a), and the
book Living a Caring-based Program (Boykin,
1994). The latter book illustrates how caring
grounds all aspects of a nursing education pro-
gram. Dr. Boykin has also authored numerous
book chapters and articles. She is currently re-
tired and serves as a consultant locally, region-
ally, nationally, and internationally on the topic
of caring-based health-care transformations.
Savina O. SchoenhoferAnne Boykin
3312_Ch19_341-356 26/12/14 9:17 AM Page 341
Dr. Boykin is a graduate of Alverno College
in Milwaukee, Wisconsin; she received her
master’s degree from Emory University in
Atlanta, Georgia, and her doctorate from
Vanderbilt University in Nashville, Tennessee.
Savina O. Schoenhofer
Savina O’Bryan Schoenhofer began her initial
nursing study at Wichita State University,
where she earned undergraduate degrees in
nursing and psychology and graduate degrees
in nursing and counseling. She completed a
PhD in educational foundations/administra-
tion at Kansas State University in 1983. In
1990, Schoenhofer cofounded Nightingale
Songs, an early venue for communicating the
beauty of nursing in poetry and prose. In ad-
dition to her work on caring, she has written
on nursing values, primary care, nursing edu-
cation, support, touch, personnel management
in nursing homes, and mentoring. Her career
in nursing has been significantly influenced
by three colleagues: Lt. Col. Ann Ashjian
(Ret.), whose community nursing practice in
Brazil presented an inspiring model of nursing;
Marilyn E. Parker, PhD, a faculty colleague
who mentored her in the idea of nursing as a
discipline, the academic role in higher educa-
tion, and the world of nursing theories and
theorists; and Anne Boykin, PhD, who intro-
duced her to caring as a substantive field of
nursing study.
Schoenhofer coauthored the book, Nurs-
ing as Caring: A Model for Transforming Prac-
tice (1993, 2001a) with Boykin. Boykin and
Schoenhofer, together with Kathleen Valentine,
coauthored the book, Health Care System Trans-
formation for Nursing and Health Care Leaders:
Implementing a Culture of Caring (2013).
Nursing As Caring:
Overview
This chapter is intended as an overview of the
theory of nursing as caring, a general theory,
framework, or disciplinary view of nursing. A
general theory or framework of nursing presents
an abstract, integrated, comprehensive picture
of nursing as a practiced discipline. The theory
of nursing as caring offers a view that permits a
broad, encompassing understanding of any and
all situations of nursing practice (Boykin &
Schoenhofer, 1993, 2001a). This theory serves
as an organizing framework for nursing scholars
in the various roles of practitioner, researcher,
administrator, teacher, and developer.
Initially, we present the theory in its most
abstract form, addressing assumptions and key
themes. We then illustrate the meaning of the
theory of nursing as caring through exemplars
in the role dimensions of nursing care, nursing
education, nursing administration and nursing
research.
Nursing as Caring: Historical
Perspective
The theory of nursing as caring is an outgrowth
of the curriculum development work in the
Christine E. Lynn College of Nursing at Florida
Atlantic University, where both authors were
among the faculty group revising the caring-
based curriculum for initial program accredi-
tation. When the revised curriculum was in
place, each of us recognized the potential and
even the necessity of continuing to develop and
structure ideas and themes toward a compre-
hensive expression of the meaning and purpose
of nursing as a discipline and a profession. The
point of departure was the acceptance that car-
ing is the end, rather than the means, of nursing,
and that caring is the intention of nursing, rather
than merely its instrument. This work led to the
statement of focus of nursing as “nurturing
persons living caring and growing in caring.”
Further work to identify foundational as-
sumptions about nursing clarified the idea of
the nursing situation, a shared lived experience
in which the caring between nurse and nursed
enhances personhood, with personhood un-
derstood as living grounded in caring. The
clarified focus and the idea of the nursing sit-
uation are the key themes that draw forth the
meaning of the assumptions underlying the
theory and permit the practical understanding
of nursing as both a discipline and a profes-
sion. As critique of the theory and study of
nursing situations progressed, the notion of
nursing being primarily concerned with health
was seen as limiting, and we now understand
nursing to be concerned with human living.
342 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
3312_Ch19_341-356 26/12/14 9:17 AM Page 342
Three bodies of work significantly influ-
enced the initial development of nursing as
caring. Roach’s (1987/2002) basic thesis that
caring is the human mode of being was incor-
porated into the most basic assumption of the
theory. We view Paterson and Zderad’s (1988)
existential phenomenological theory of hu-
manistic nursing as the historical antecedent
of nursing as caring. Seminal ideas from hu-
manistic nursing such as “the between,” “call
for nursing,” “nursing response,” and “person-
hood” serve as substantive and structural bases
for our conceptualization of nursing as caring.
Mayeroff’s (1971) work, On Caring, provided
a language that facilitated the recognition and
description of the practical meaning of caring
in nursing situations. Roach’s (1987/2002) five
Cs (described in detail later) of caring expand
on that basic language. In addition to the work
of these thinkers, both authors are long-standing
members of the community of nursing schol-
ars whose study focuses on caring and are sup-
ported and undoubtedly influenced in many
subtle ways by the members of this community
and their work.
Fledgling forms of the theory of nursing as
caring were first published in 1990 and 1991,
with the first complete exposition of the theory
presented at a conference in 1992 (Boykin &
Schoenhofer, 1990, 1991; Schoenhofer &
Boykin, 1993), followed by the publication of
Nursing as Caring: A Model for Transforming
Practice in 1993 (Boykin & Schoenhofer, 1993),
which was revised with the addition of an epi-
logue in 2001 (Boykin & Schoenhofer, 2001a).
Assumptions and Key Themes
of Nursing as Caring
Assumptions
Certain fundamental beliefs about what it
means to be human underlie the theory of
nursing as caring. The following assumptions
reflect a particular set of values that provide a
basis for understanding and explicating the
meaning of nursing and are key to understand-
ing the practical meaning of the theory of
nursing as caring.
• Persons are caring by virtue of their
humanness.
• Persons are whole and complete in the
moment.
• Persons are caring, moment to moment.
• Personhood is a way of living grounded in
caring.
• Personhood is enhanced through participa-
tion in nurturing relationships with caring
others.
• Nursing is both a discipline and a profession.
Key Themes
Caring
Caring is an altruistic, active expression of love
and is the intentional and embodied recogni-
tion of value and connectedness. Caring is not
the unique province of nursing. However, as a
discipline and a profession, nursing uniquely
focuses on caring as its central value, its pri-
mary interest, its focus for scholarship, and the
direct intention of its practice. “As an expres-
sion of nursing, caring is the intentional and au-
thentic presence of the nurse with another who is
recognized as person living caring and growing in
caring” (Boykin & Schoenhofer, 2001a, p. 13).
The full meaning of caring cannot be restricted
to a definition but is illuminated in the expe-
rience of caring and in dynamic reflection on
that experience.
Focus and Intention of Nursing
Disciplines as identifiable entities or “branches
of knowledge” grow from the holistic “tree of
knowledge” as need and purpose develop. A
discipline is a community of scholars with a
particular perspective on the world and on
what it means to be in the world. The discipli-
nary community represents a value system that
is expressed in its unique focus on knowledge
and practice. The focus of nursing, from the per-
spective of the theory of nursing as caring, is
person living caring and growing in caring. The
general intention of nursing as a practiced dis-
cipline is nurturing persons living caring and
growing in caring.
Nursing Situation
The practice of nursing, and thus the practical
knowledge of nursing, lives in the context of
person-with-person caring. The nursing situa-
tion involves particular values, intentions, and
actions of two or more persons choosing to live
a nursing relationship. Nursing situation is
CHAPTER 19 • Theory of Nursing as Caring 343
3312_Ch19_341-356 26/12/14 9:17 AM Page 343
understood to mean the shared lived experience
in which caring between nurse and nursed en-
hances personhood. Nursing is created in the
“caring between.” All knowledge of nursing is
created and understood within the nursing sit-
uation. Any single nursing situation has the po-
tential to illuminate the depth and complexity
of nursing knowledge. Nursing situations are
best communicated aesthetically to preserve the
lived meaning of the situation and the openness
of the situation as text. Storytelling, poetry,
graphic arts, dance, and other expressive modes
effectively represent the lived experience of
nursing and allowing for reflection and creativ-
ity in advancing understanding.
Personhood
Personhood is understood to mean living
grounded in caring. From the perspective of
the theory of nursing as caring, personhood is
the universal human call. A profound under-
standing of personhood communicates the
paradox of person-as-person and person-in-
communion all at once.
Direct Invitation
The concept of direct invitation was briefly
introduced in the epilogue of the 2001 revised
edition of nursing as caring (Boykin &
Schoenhofer, 2001a). It evolved from a con-
vergence of ontology and aesthetics as a way
to more effectively communicate nursing as
caring in practice.
The context for understanding direct invi-
tation is the nursing situation. Direct invitation
communicates clearly that the core service of
nursing is to offer caring and to invite the one
nursed to share that which matters most to
them in that moment. It is through this invi-
tation that the call for nursing is heard and
nursing responses are created. Direct invitation
establishes an openness between the nurse
and one nursed and strengthens the caring
between.
Call for Nursing
“A call for nursing is a call for acknowledg-
ment and affirmation of the person living car-
ing in specific ways in the immediate situation”
(Boykin & Schoenhofer, 2001a, p. 13). Calls
for nursing are calls for nurturance through
personal expressions of caring. Calls for nurs-
ing originate within persons as they live caring
uniquely, expressing personally meaningful
dreams and aspirations for growing in caring.
Calls for nursing are individually relevant ways
of saying, “Know me as caring person in the
moment and be with me as I try to live fully
who I truly am.” Intentionality and authentic
presence open the nurse to hearing calls for
nursing. Because calls for nursing are unique
situated personal expressions of that which
matters to the person nursed, they cannot be
predicted, as in a “diagnosis.” Nurses develop
sensitivity and expertise in hearing calls through
intention, experience, study, and reflection in
a broad range of human situations.
Nursing Response
As an expression of nursing, “caring is the in-
tentional and authentic presence of the nurse
with another who is recognized as living caring
and growing in caring” (Boykin & Schoenhofer,
2001a, p. 13). The nurse enters the nursing
situation with the intentional commitment
of knowing the other as caring person, and in
that knowing, acknowledging, affirming, and
celebrating the person as caring. The nursing
response is a specific expression of caring nurtu-
rance to sustain and enhance the one nursed in
ways that matter as he or she lives caring and
grows in caring in the situation of concern.
Nursing responses to calls for caring evolve as
nurses clarify their understandings of calls
through presence and dialogue. Nursing re-
sponses are uniquely created for the moment and
cannot be predicted or automatically applied as
preplanned protocols. Sensitivity and skill in
creating unique and effective ways of commu-
nicating caring are developed through intention,
experience, study, and reflection in a broad
range of human situations.
The “Caring Between”
The caring between is the source and ground of
nursing. It is the loving relation into which
nurse and nursed enter and which they cocre-
ate by living the intention to care. Without the
loving relation of the caring between, unidirec-
tional activity or reciprocal exchange can occur,
but nursing in its fullest sense does not occur.
It is in the context of the caring between that
personhood is enhanced, each expressing self
as caring and recognizing the other as caring
person.
344 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
3312_Ch19_341-356 26/12/14 9:17 AM Page 344
Dance of Caring Persons
The relational model for organizational design
involving nursing is analogous to the dancing
circle, the dance of caring persons. What this cir-
cle represents is the commitment of each
dancer to understand and support the study of
the discipline of nursing. Core dimensions of
caring illustrated in the dance of caring persons
model include the following:
• Acknowledgment that all persons have the
capacity to care by virtue of their humanness
• Commitment to respect for person in all in-
stitutional structures and processes
• Recognition that each participant in the
enterprise has a unique valuable contribu-
tion to make to the whole and is present in
the whole
• Appreciation for the dynamic though
rhythmic nature of the dance of caring
persons, enabling opportunities for human
creativity
Persons making up the dance of caring per-
sons in any given situation involving nursing
are the one nursed and family, nurses and
other health-care workers, administrative and
support staff, and relevant corporate, govern-
mental, and social communities. Regardless of
the role, the “responsibility of all is to recog-
nize, value, and celebrate the unique ways car-
ing is lived by colleagues, as well as to support
each other in the growth of caring” (Pross,
Hilton, Boykin, & Thomas, 2011, p. 28).
Lived Meaning of Nursing as Caring
Abstract presentations of assumptions and
themes lay the groundwork and provide an ori-
enting point. However, the lived meaning of
nursing as caring can best be understood by the
study of a nursing situation. The following
poem is one nurse’s expression of the meaning
of nursing, situated in one particular experi-
ence of nursing and linked to a general con-
ception of nursing.
I CARE FOR HIM
My hands are moist,
My heart is quick,
My nerves are taut,
He’s in the next room,
I care for him.
The room is tense,
It’s anger-filled,
The air seems thick,
I’m with him now,
I care for him.
Time goes slowly by,
As our fears subside,
I can sense his calm,
He softens now,
I care for him.
His eyes meet mine,
Unable to speak,
I feel his trust,
I open my heart,
I care for him.
It’s time to leave.
Our bond is made,
Unspoken thoughts,
But understood,
I care for him!
—J. M. COLLINS (1993)
Each encounter—each nursing experience—
brings with it the unknown. In reflection, Jim
Collins shares a story of practice that illuminates
the opportunity to live and grow in caring. In
the nursing situation that inspired this poem,
the nurse and nursed live caring uniquely. Ini-
tially, the nurse experiences the familiar human
dilemma, aware of separateness while choosing
connectedness as he responds to a yet unknown
call for nursing: [“My] hands are moist,/my
heart is quick/my nerves are taut . . . I care for
him.” As he enters the situation and encounters
the patient as person, he is able to “let go” of his
presumptive knowing of the patient as “angry.”
The nurse enters with the guiding perspective
that all persons are caring. This allows Nurse
Jim to see past the “anger-filled” room and to
be “with him” (Stanza 2). As they connect
through their humanness, the beauty and
wholeness of one nursed is uncovered and nur-
tured. By living caring moment to moment,
hope emerges and fear subsides. The nurse is-
sues a direct invitation as “I open my heart”
(Stanza 4) to hear that which matters most in
the moment. Through this experience, both
nurse and nursed live and grow in their under-
standing and expressions of caring.
CHAPTER 19 • Theory of Nursing as Caring 345
3312_Ch19_341-356 26/12/14 9:17 AM Page 345
In the first stanza, the nurse prepares
to enter the nursing relationship with the
formed intention of offering caring in au-
thentic presence. Perhaps he has heard a re-
port that the person he is about to encounter
is a “difficult patient” and this is a part of his
awareness; however, his nursing intention to
care reminds him that he and his patient are,
above all, caring persons. In the second
stanza, the nurse enters the room, experiences
the challenge that his intention to nurse has
presented, and responds to the call for au-
thentic presence and caring: “I’m with him
now,/I care for him.” Patterns of knowing are
called into play as the nurse brings together
intuitive, personal knowing, empirical know-
ing, and the ethical knowing that it is right
to offer care, creating the integrated under-
standing of aesthetic knowing that enables
him to act on his nursing intention (Boykin,
Parker, & Schoenhofer, 1994; Carper, 1978).
Mayeroff’s (1971) caring ingredients of
courage, trust, and alternating rhythm are
clearly evident.
Clarity of the call for nursing emerges as the
nurse begins to understand that this particular
man in this particular moment is calling to be
known as a uniquely caring person, a person of
value, worthy of respect and regard. The nurse
listens intently and recognizes the unadorned
honesty that sounds angry and demanding and
is a personal expression of a heartfelt desire to
be truly known and worthy of care. The nurse
responds with steadfast presence and caring,
communicated in his way of being and of
doing. The caring ingredient of hope is drawn
forth as the man softens and the nurse takes
notice.
In the fourth stanza, the “caring between”
develops and personhood is enhanced as
dreams and aspirations for growing in caring
are realized: “His eyes meet mine . . . I open
my heart.” In the last stanza, the nursing situ-
ation is completed in linear time. But each one,
nurse and nursed, goes forward newly affirmed
and celebrated as caring person, and the nurs-
ing situation continues to be a source of living
caring and growing in caring.
Assumptions Underlying Nursing as
Caring in the Context of the Nursing
Situation
In Collins’s (1993) poem, the power of the
basic assumption that all persons are caring by
virtue of their humanness enabled the nurse to
find the courage to live his intentions. The idea
that persons are whole and complete in the
moment permits the nurse to accept conflict-
ing feelings and to be open to the nursed as a
person, not merely as an entity with a diagnosis
and superficially understood behavior. The
nurse demonstrated an understanding of the
assumption that persons live caring from
moment to moment, striving to know self and
other as caring in the moment with a growing
repertoire of ways of expressing caring. Per-
sonhood, a way of living grounded in caring
that can be enhanced in relationship with car-
ing other, comes through in that the nurse is
successfully living his commitment to caring in
the face of difficulty and in the mutuality and
connectedness that emerged in the situation.
The assumption that nursing is both a disci-
pline and a profession is affirmed as the nurse
draws on a set of values and a developed
knowledge of nursing as caring to actively offer
his presence in service to the nursed.
Nursing practice guided by the theory of
nursing as caring entails living the commit-
ment to know self and other as living caring in
the moment and growing in caring. Living this
commitment requires intention, formal study,
and reflection on experience. Mayeroff’s
(1971) caring ingredients offer a useful starting
point for the nurse committed to knowing
self and other as caring persons. These ingre-
dients include knowing, alternating rhythm,
honesty, courage, trust, patience, humility, and
hope. Roach’s (1992) five Cs—commitment,
confidence, conscience, competence, and
compassion—provide another conceptual
framework that is helpful in providing a lan-
guage of caring. Coming to know self as caring
is facilitated by:
• Trusting in self; freeing self up to become
what one can truly become, and valuing self.
346 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
3312_Ch19_341-356 26/12/14 9:17 AM Page 346
• Learning to let go, to transcend—to let go
of problems, difficulties, in order to remem-
ber the interconnectedness that enables us
to know self and other as living caring, even
in suffering and in seeking relief from suf-
fering.
• Being open and humble enough to experi-
ence and know self to be at home with one’s
feelings.
• Continuously calling to consciousness that
each person is living caring in the moment
and we are each developing uniquely in our
becoming.
• Taking time to fully experience our human-
ness, for one can only truly understand in
another what one can understand in self.
• Finding hope in the moment. (Schoenhofer
& Boykin, 1993, pp. 85–86)
Applications of
the Theory
Nursing Practice
The nursing as caring theory, grounded in the
assumption that all persons are caring, has as
its focus a general call to nurture persons as
they live caring uniquely and grow as caring
persons. The challenge for nursing, then, is not
to discover what is missing, weakened, or
needed in another but to come to know the
other as caring person and to nurture that per-
son in situation-specific, creative ways. We no
longer understand nursing as a “process” in the
sense of a complex sequence of predictable acts
resulting in some predetermined desirable end
product. Nursing, we believe, is inherently a
process, in the sense that it is always unfolding
and guided by intention.
An everyday understanding of the meaning
of caring is obviously challenged when the
nurse is presented with someone for whom it
is difficult to care. “Difficult to care” situations
are those that demonstrate the extent of knowl-
edge and commitment needed to nurse effec-
tively. In these extreme (although not unusual)
situations, a task-oriented, non–discipline-
based concept of nursing may be adequate to
ensure the completion of certain treatment and
surveillance techniques. Still, in our eyes, that
is an insufficient response—it certainly is not
the nursing we advocate. The theory of nursing
as caring calls on the nurse to reach deep within
a well-developed knowledge base that has been
structured using all available patterns of know-
ing, grounded in the obligations inherent in the
commitment to know persons as caring. These
patterns of knowing may develop knowledge as
intuition; scientifically quantifiable data emerg-
ing from research; and related knowledge from
a variety of disciplines, ethical beliefs, and many
other types of knowing. All knowledge held by
the nurse that may be relevant to understanding
the situation at hand is drawn forward and in-
tegrated into practice in particular nursing sit-
uations (aesthetic knowing). Although the
degree of challenge presented from situation to
situation varies, the commitment to know self
and other as caring persons is steadfast.
All persons are caring, even when not all
chosen actions of the person live up to the ideal
to which we are all called by virtue of our hu-
manness. In discussions of hypothetical situa-
tions involving child molesters, serial killers,
and even political figures who have attempted
mass destruction and racial annihilation, certain
ethical systems permit and even call for making
judgments. However, when such a person pres-
ents to the nurse for care, the nursing ethic of
caring supersedes all other values. The theory
of nursing as caring asserts that it is only
through recognizing and responding to the
other as a caring person that nursing is created
and personhood enhanced in that nursing sit-
uation. Caring effectively in “difficult-to-care”
situations is the most challenging prospect a
nurse can face. It is only with sustained inten-
tion, commitment, study, and reflection that
the nurse is able to offer nursing in these situ-
ations. Falling short in one’s commitment does
not necessitate self-deprecation nor warrant
condemnation by others; rather, it presents an
opportunity to care for self and other and to
grow in personhood. Making real the potential
of such an opportunity calls for seeing with
clarity, reaffirming commitment, and engaging
CHAPTER 19 • Theory of Nursing as Caring 347
3312_Ch19_341-356 26/12/14 9:17 AM Page 347
in study and reflection, individually and in con-
cert with caring others.
To know the other as caring, the nurse must
find some basis for respectful human connec-
tion with the person. Does this mean that the
nurse must like everything about the person,
including personal life choices? Perhaps not;
however, the nurse as nurse is not called on to
judge the “other,” only to care for the other. A
concern with judging or censuring another’s ac-
tions is a distraction from the real purpose for
nursing—that is, coming to know the other as
caring person, as one with dreams and aspira-
tions of growing in caring, and responding to
calls for caring in ways that nurture person-
hood, that matter to the one nursed.
Nurses are frequently heard to say they have
no time for caring, given the demands of the
role (Boykin & Schoenhofer, 2000). All nurs-
ing roles are lived out in the context of a con-
temporary environment, and the environment
for practice, administration, education, and re-
search is fraught with many challenges. Some
of these challenges are the following:
• technological advancement and prolifera-
tion that can promote routinization and
depersonalization on the part of the care-
giver as well as the one seeking care;
• demands for immediate and measurable
outcomes that favor a focus on the simplistic
and the superficial;
• organizational and occupational configura-
tions that tend to promote fragmentation
and alienation; and
• economic focus and profit motive (“time is
money”) as the apparent prime institutional
value.
Nurses express frustration when evaluating
their own caring efforts against an idealized,
rule-driven conception of caring. Practice
guided by the theory of nursing as caring re-
flects the assumption that caring is created
from moment to moment and does not de-
mand idealized patterns of caring. Caring in
the moment (and from moment to moment)
occurs when the nurse is living a committed
intention to know and nurture the other as car-
ing person (Boykin & Schoenhofer, 2000). No
predetermined ideal amount of time or form
of dialogue is prescribed. Simple examples of
living this intention to care follow.
When the nurse goes first to the person,
rather than going directly to the IV or the
monitor, it becomes clear that the use of tech-
nology is one way the nurse expresses caring
for the person (Schoenhofer, 2001). In propos-
ing his model of machine technologies and
caring in nursing, Locsin (1995, 2001) distin-
guishes between mere technological compe-
tence and technological competence as an
intentional expression of caring in nursing.
Simply avowing an intention to care is not
sufficient; the committed intention to care is
supported by serious study of caring and on-
going reflection if nurses are to communicate
caring effectively from moment to moment. As
Locsin (1995, p. 203) so aptly stated:
as people seriously involved in giving care know, there
are various ways of expressing caring. Professional
nurses will continue to find meaning in their technolog-
ical caring competencies, expressed intentionally and
authentically, to know another as a whole person.
Through the harmonious coexistence of machine tech-
nology and caring technology the practice of nursing
is transformed into an experience of caring.
Another example of living the commitment
to care is witnessed in caring for the uncon-
scious person. How is this commitment lived?
It requires that all ways of knowing be brought
into action. The nurse must make self as caring
person available to the one nursed. The fullness
of the nurse as caring person is called forth.
This requires use of Mayeroff’s caring ingredi-
ents: the alternating rhythm of knowing about
the other and knowing the other directly
through authentic presence and attunement;
the hope and courage to risk opening self to
one who cannot communicate verbally, pa-
tiently trusting in self to understand the other’s
mode of living caring in the moment; honest
humility as one brings all that one knows and
remains open to learning from the other. The
nurse attuned to the other as person might for
example experience the vulnerability of the per-
son who lies unconscious from surgical anes-
thetic or traumatic injury. In that vulnerability,
the nurse recognizes that the one nursed is
348 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
3312_Ch19_341-356 26/12/14 9:17 AM Page 348
living caring in humility, hope, and trust. In-
stead of responding to the vulnerability, merely
“taking care of” the other, the nurse practicing
nursing as caring might respond by honoring
the other’s humility, by participating in the
other’s hopefulness, by steadfast trustworthi-
ness. Creating caring in the moment in this sit-
uation might come from the nurse resonating
with past and present experiences of vulnera-
bility. Connected to this form of personal
knowing might be an ethical knowing that
power as a reciprocal of vulnerability can de-
velop undesirable status differential in the
nurse–patient role relationship. As the nurse
sifts through myriad empirical data, the most
significant information emerges—this is a
person with whom I am called to care. Ethical
knowing again merges with other pathways as
the nurse forms the decision to go beyond
vulnerability and engage the other as caring per-
son, rather than as helpless object of another’s
concern. Aesthetic knowing comes in the praxis
of caring, in living chosen ways of honoring
humility, joining in hope, and demonstrating
trustworthiness in the moment (Schoenhofer
& Boykin, 1993, pp. 86–87).
A third example of living the intention to
care is evidenced in postmortem care. “Nurses
speak of caring for their deceased patients as
nursing those who have gone and who are still
in some way present” (Boykin & Schoenhofer,
2001a, p. 19). Nurses who practice in end-
of-life situations offer genuine presence, con-
tinue to feel the human connection to the per-
son who has recently died and to the family
circle that is part of that person’s life, and rec-
ognize postmortem care as truly nursing. One
nurse was moved by the beauty of post-mortem
nursing care offered by her colleagues in the
operating room and shared this poetic expres-
sion of connectedness.
Journey’s End
The chaos has stopped,
The journey from birth to death has ceased,
Your body lies on the OR table, alone,
We cluster at the end of the room,
Making the necessary phone calls,
Starting the paperwork,
Telling the young resident:
“Yes, you must complete the paperwork.” And
“Go talk to the family now,”
Then we turn back to you
And begin our reverent and loving care:
Covering your wound, removing the lines,
cleansing your body,
One of us says, “We are being good nurses,”
And another quips back, “It’s because we are
old nurses,”
And we laugh
(But we know we will teach the young ones
how to do this too),
We place you on a stretcher (not the gruesome
morgue gurney)
And take you to the viewing room,
One of us goes and brings your family to you,
Murmuring comfort, “We are so sorry for
your loss.”
After a few minutes, we leave
And return to the OR
To take care of another patient.
—FLORENCE N. COOPER, RN
The nurse practicing within the caring con-
text described here will most often be interfac-
ing with the health-care system in two ways:
first, communicating nursing so that it can be
understood; second, articulating nursing serv-
ice as a unique contribution within the system
in such a way that the system itself grows to
support nursing. Recognizing these system re-
lationships as aspects of the dance of caring
persons involving the nursed and family and
encompassing all who are part of the system is
crucial for creating the kind of environment in
which caring is expressed effectively and per-
ceived as growth-promoting.
Nursing Administration
From the viewpoint of nursing as caring, the
nurse administrator makes decisions through a
lens in which the focus of nursing is on nurtur-
ing persons living caring and grow in caring.
All activities in the practice of nursing admin-
istration are grounded in a concern for creating,
maintaining, and supporting an environment
in which calls for nursing are heard and nur-
turing responses are given. From this point of
view, the expectation arises that nursing ad-
ministrators participate in shaping a culture
CHAPTER 19 • Theory of Nursing as Caring 349
3312_Ch19_341-356 26/12/14 9:17 AM Page 349
that evolves from the values articulated within
nursing as caring and recognized as the dance
of caring persons.
Although often perceived to be “removed”
from the direct care of the nursed, the nursing
administrator is intimately involved in multiple
nursing situations simultaneously, hearing calls
for nursing and participating in responses to
these calls. As calls for nursing are known, one
of the unique responses of the nursing admin-
istrator is to enter the world of the nursed ei-
ther directly or indirectly, to understand special
calls when they occur, and to assist in securing
the resources needed by each nurse to nurture
persons living and growing in caring (Boykin
& Schoenhofer, 1993). All administrative ac-
tivities should be approached with this goal in
mind. Here, the nurse administrator reflects
on the obligations inherent in the role in rela-
tion to the nursed. The presiding moral basis
for determining right action is the belief that
all persons are caring. Frequently, the nurse
administrator may enter the world of the
nursed through the stories of colleagues who
are assuming another role, such as that of nurse
manager. Policy formulation and implementa-
tion allow for the consideration of unique situ-
ations. The nursing administrator assists others
within the organization to understand the
focus of nursing and to secure the resources
necessary to achieve the goals of nursing.
Nursing Education
From the perspective of nursing as caring, all
nursing structures and activities should reflect
the fundamental assumption that persons are
caring by virtue of their humanness. This view
applies in nursing education as in practice and
administrative role engagement. Other as-
sumptions and values reflected in the education
program include knowing the person as whole
and complete in the moment and living caring
uniquely; understanding that personhood is a
way of living grounded in caring and is en-
hanced through participation in nurturing re-
lationships with caring others; and, finally,
affirming nursing as a discipline and profession.
The curriculum, the foundation of the edu-
cation program, asserts the focus and domain
of nursing as nurturing persons living caring
and growing in caring; thus, all activities of the
program of study are directed toward develop-
ing, organizing, and communicating nursing
knowledge, that is, knowledge of nurturing
persons living caring and growing in caring.
The dance of caring persons relational
model is relevant for organizational design
of nursing education, as well as for nursing
practice. Participants in the dance of caring
persons include administrators, faculty, col-
leagues, students, staff, community, and the
nursed and their families. What the dance of
caring persons represents in nursing education
settings is the commitment of each dancer
to understand and support the study of the
discipline of nursing. The role of educational
administrator in the circle is more clearly un-
derstood through reflection on the origin of
the word. The term administrator derives from
the Latin ad ministrare, to serve (according to
Webster’s New World Dictionary of the American
Language; Guralnik, 1976). This definition con-
notes the idea of rendering service. Administra-
tors within the circle are by the nature of their
role obligated to ministering, to securing, and
to providing resources needed by faculty, stu-
dents, and staff to meet program objectives.
Faculty, students, and administrators dance to-
gether in the study of nursing. Faculty support
an environment that values the uniqueness
of each person and sustains each person’s
unique way of living and growing in caring.
This process requires trust, hope, courage, and
patience. Because the purpose of nursing edu-
cation is to study the discipline and practice of
nursing, the nursed must be in the circle. The
community created is that of persons living car-
ing in the moment and growing in personhood,
each person valued as special and unique.
(Boykin & Schoenhofer, 1993, pp. 73–74)
In teaching nursing as caring, faculty assist
students to come to know, appreciate, and
celebrate self and “other” as caring persons.
Students, as well as faculty, are in a continual
search to discover greater meaning of caring as
uniquely expressed in nursing. Examples of a
nursing education program based on values
similar to those of nursing as caring are illus-
trated in the book Living a Caring-based
Program (Boykin, 1994).
350 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
3312_Ch19_341-356 26/12/14 9:17 AM Page 350
Nursing Research and Development
The roles of researcher and developer in nurs-
ing take on a particular focus when guided by
the theory of nursing as caring. The assump-
tions and focus of nursing explicated in the
theory provide an organizing value system that
suggests certain key questions and methods.
Research questions lead to exploration and
illumination of patterns of living caring per-
sonally (Schoenhofer, Bingham, & Hutchins,
1998) and in nursing practice (Schoenhofer
& Boykin, 1998b). Dialogue, description, and
innovations in interpretative approaches char-
acterize research methods. Development of
systems and structures (e.g., policy formula-
tion, information management, nursing deliv-
ery, and reimbursement) to support nursing
necessitates sustained efforts in reframing
and refocusing familiar systems as well as
creating novel configurations (Schoenhofer,
1995; Schoenhofer & Boykin, 1998a; Boykin,
Schoenhofer, & Valentine, 2013).
The practicality of the theory of nursing as
caring has been tested in various nursing
practice settings. Nursing practice models
have been developed in acute and long-term
care settings. Research studies focused on
designing, implementing and evaluating a
theory-based practice model using nursing as
caring on a telemetry unit of a for-profit hos-
pital (Boykin, Schoenhofer, Smith, St. Jean,
& Aleman, 2003); the emergency department
of a community hospital (Boykin, Bulfin,
Baldwin, & Southern, 2004; Boykin, Schoen-
hofer, Bulfin, Baldwin, & McCarthy, 2005);
and the intensive care unit of a for-profit hos-
pital (Dyess, Boykin, & Bulfin, 2013) have
demonstrated that when nursing practice is
intentionally focused on coming to know a
person as caring and on nurturing and support-
ing those nursed as they live their caring, trans-
formation of care occurs. Within these practice
models based on nursing as caring, those
nursed could articulate the “experience of being
cared for”; patient and nurse satisfaction in-
creased dramatically; nurse retention increased;
and the environment for care became grounded
in the values of and respect for person.
Touhy, Strews, and Brown (2005) described
a project to transform an entire for-profit
health-care organization by intentionally
grounding it in nursing as caring. Caring from
the heart—the model for interdisciplinary prac-
tice in a long-term care facility and based on
the theory of nursing as caring—was designed
through collaboration between project person-
nel and all stakeholders. Foundational values of
respect and coming to know ground the model,
which revolves around the major themes of
responding to that which matters, caring as a
way of expressing spiritual commitment, devo-
tion inspired by love for others, commitment to
creating a home environment, and coming to
know and respect person as person (2005). The
major building blocks of the nursing model for
an acute care hospital and for a long-term care
facility each reflect central themes of nursing
as caring, but those themes are drawn out in
ways unique to the setting and to the persons
involved in each setting. The differences and
similarities in these two practice models demon-
strate the power of nursing as caring to trans-
form practice in a way that reflects unity without
conformity, uniqueness within oneness.
CHAPTER 19 • Theory of Nursing as Caring 351
PRACTICE EXEMPLAR
Nursing administration, nursing practice, nurs-
ing education, and nursing research require a
full understanding of nursing as nurturing per-
sons living caring and growing in caring. This
online supplemental resource for this chapter
contains four practice exemplars, illustrating
the use of the nursing as caring theory to guide
practice in nursing administration, clinical
simulation laboratory in nursing education,
and nursing research.1 The exemplars were
drawn from the practice experience of the
nurses who wrote them, and most illustrate
stories of actual nursing situations. A nursing
administration exemplar addresses health-care
Continued
1For additional practice exemplars please go to bonus
chapter content available at FA Davis http://davisplus
.fadavis.com
3312_Ch19_341-356 26/12/14 9:17 AM Page 351
352 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
Practice Exemplar cont.
system leadership and caring. The nursing ed-
ucation exemplar illustrates the use of the sim-
ulation laboratory in teaching nursing from the
perspective of nursing as caring. Two research
exemplars are also provided online, one focus-
ing on the development of a research approach
compatible with nursing as caring, and a
second addressing the use of nursing as caring
as the nursing theoretical perspective under-
pinning a doctoral dissertation study. The
following advanced practice nursing exemplar
illuminates advanced nursing practice grounded
in nursing as caring.
Advanced Nursing Practice Exemplar:
Primary Care Clinic Grounded in
Nursing as Caring
Two nurse practitioners, Kathi Voege Harvey,
FNP, and Elizabeth Tsarnas, FNP, whose
practice setting is a primary care clinic, shared
their way of creating nursing as caring in a
community-based program of nursing for per-
sons living with diabetes.
Our primary care clinic serves the popula-
tion of patients who are considered the under-
served and fall within the lower socioeconomic
level, including those individuals labeled by
society as the working poor, uninsured, unem-
ployed, illiterate, disabled, homeless, and re-
cent migrants from many parts of the world.
This vulnerable population creates greater
challenges, yet we are empowered by our dis-
ciplinary view of the theory of nursing as car-
ing to deliver quality and evidence-based
health care to all who come.
Call for Nursing
As a result of our observation that individuals
with diabetes struggled to incorporate a dia-
betic-friendly diet and exercise into their
lifestyles, we developed a collaborative program
that brought experts in nursing and fitness to-
gether in a world outside of the clinic setting.
This innovative program supports participants
in their endeavor to develop a new health-care
plan through an exercise, education, and
support-group curriculum. The first group to
be formed was limited to women because the
lived experiences of some of the early partici-
pants were very “fragile” and dealt with personal
issues such as domestic violence and depres-
sion. As these women’s personhood and their
struggle with obesity and diabetes emerged, we
felt a need to protect them in this, their first
venture of sharing. These women’s lives had
been grounded in caring, but circumstances
seemingly beyond their control had affected
their personhood. A safe, nurturing relation-
ship with other caring individuals was needed
to allow them to trust and grow again.
Nursing Situation
One of the champions of this program, named
BP, a 42-year-old woman, was diagnosed with
insulin-dependent diabetes 10 years ago. Be-
cause of the rapid progression of her disease
process, she had bilateral arterial bypass sur-
gery that resulted in limited mobility. BP took
a 2-year sabbatical from our clinic and has re-
cently returned. She had been without med-
ications and supplies for months, which
increased the neuropathic pain to her lower
extremities. She also shared with us that she
was under increased stress while preparing for
her upcoming wedding. Our conversations
would always include the importance of look-
ing into the future at 10, 20, and 30 years to
visualize the many disabilities she could de-
velop within that time which would reduce her
quality of life and how she could alter that
future. Over the past several months, she has
taken control of her disease by checking her
sugars more often and regularly taking her in-
sulin. She married a month ago and noticed
that her husband, KP, had symptoms of dia-
betes. After checking his blood sugar, which
consistently was very elevated, she brought
him to the clinic to receive health care. Her
enthusiasm for improving her heath was con-
tagious, and she was excited that she could
share her journey with her new husband.
Several weeks later, BP introduced us
to her mother-in-law, SP, who has prediabetes
and with whom BP, her new husband, and her
young nephew were living. SP was feeling like
she could not take control of her life, so she
3312_Ch19_341-356 26/12/14 9:17 AM Page 352
CHAPTER 19 • Theory of Nursing as Caring 353
Practice Exemplar cont.
was referred to us for evaluation, and we
invited her to join our group of women. One
evening after a support group, which BP and
her mother-in-law attended, we walked them
to the front of the building where they met
BP’s husband, who had been exercising in the
gym, and his nephew, who was only 12 years
old and had been abandoned by his natural
parents. As we introduced ourselves to this
shy, very thin, 12-year-old young man, we en-
gaged him in conversation so that we could
come to know him. We learned that he had
been made to come but was angry because he
was too young to be in the gym. His grand-
mother had previously confided in us that he
did not have any friends or participate in any-
thing and that he was beginning to have anger
outbursts. We identified yet another call for
nursing and decided to explore possible sports
or activities in which this young man would
like to participate. After some investigation,
we were able to include him in an adolescent
“boot camp” that met at the same time as his
family’s exercise classes and also a soccer team
right on the premises. As he experiences car-
ing through nurturing with his family and us,
it is our hope that his fears will subside and
allow him to realize the beauty of his unique-
ness and his boundless potential.
In this situation BP’s nurturing lived expe-
rience enabled her to enhance her personhood
and touch the lives of those she loved in a way
that she had been touched. BP was living in
caring and growing in caring, and the com-
pleteness she experienced empowered her to
care for others, like her family, so that they too
could be whole and complete in the moment.
Nursing Response
All persons are caring by virtue of their human-
ness. As nurses, we readily recognize calls for
nursing that others might easily miss. Our per-
sonhood as nurses grounded in caring and
equipped with the wisdom of knowledge about
nurturing relationships and human well-being
that we have pursued passionately through our
advanced education arm us with the confidence
to be intentionally and authentically present
with others in their situations of concern. We
feel comfortable to respond to calls for nursing
without preplanned protocols or preconceived
solutions because we are responding uniquely
to each situation with the “other” with the in-
tention to communicate caring and commit-
ment to work with them to achieve their goals.
Our nursing situation with the P family
began with one member, who sought help to
improve her health, which had been ravaged
by diabetes. Over time, the loving relationship
of “caring between” developed among BP, her
nurse practitioners, her trainer, and her class-
mates. Boundaries of roles disappeared in this
relationship, and BP began to experience
wholeness and completeness in the moment
that was so healing that she invited her family
members into her dance of caring persons so
that they, too, could experience well-being.
We have all grown through this lived experi-
ence, and as nurse practitioners, our way of liv-
ing grounded in caring has been reaffirmed.
Lived Meaning of Nursing As Caring
A patient first enters the doors of our free clinic
appearing as an unopened rosebud with many
thorns. The closed bud represents security and
protection from the unknown. Many who have
limited exposure to a health-care system enter
our world with fear of what will be discovered
and doubts about the competency of those giv-
ing something without cost. The thorns repre-
sent the patients’ defense system if they should
encounter threats to their safety. The rose
petals gradually begin to open as the patient ex-
periences each caring moment through the au-
thentic presence of the nurse whose intention
is to promote health and healing through phys-
ical, emotional, and spiritual discovery and
restoration. After the rose completely opens
and the thorns soften, the patient begins an ac-
ceptance process, and true healing begins. Each
room within the clinic resembles a beautiful
vase that is full of roses of all shapes, sizes, and
colors, representing the uniqueness of each in-
dividual the nurse encounters. Others within
the room help to achieve the same goals as the
nurses and caregivers and represent oxygen,
Continued
3312_Ch19_341-356 26/12/14 9:17 AM Page 353
354 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
Practice Exemplar cont.
sunlight, and water needed to foster growth
and strength. Reflecting on the beauty and
uniqueness of each rose prepares the nurse for
a new unopened rosebud.
Ways of Knowing
Although we must be skilled in both science
and clinical experience, the nurse is always
nurturing and growing in caring to provide a
new dimension of healing that allows us to
enter the patient’s world to experience and
understand their needs in a way that is more
than just a prescription or treatment modal-
ity. This story reinforces the requisite not
only to have the knowledge to properly treat
the disease process but also to offer encour-
agement through dialogue and physical avail-
ability to help patients engage in exercise,
classroom instruction, and healthy behaviors
that produce positive results in patient out-
come measures.
Personally, as we listened to the stories of all
of the participants in this program, we realized
how lucky we were to experience this intensely
caring bond between what once were patients
and nurse practitioners and now were persons,
whole and complete in the moment. We came
to realize that our ability to care for others living
with chronic illnesses was being viewed through
a much more realistic lens. We had always
known that changes in lifestyle to improve
health outcomes were difficult to implement,
no matter how much clinical sense they made.
But dwelling in the moment with these women
who were struggling to maintain well-being
while life just kept happening and who were
still able to lose weight, decrease their medica-
tions, and make difficult decisions about their
lives as our “caring between” relationship
evolved, made us realize that wherever we are,
whatever we do, we never stop caring, and we
never stop being nurses. As others who oversaw
this pilot program began to express amazement
at what we saw as nursing, we knew our secret
was out: Others in the community were begin-
ning to identify nursing as caring, and one by
one they asked to join in the dance of caring
persons.
The nurse administrator is subject to chal-
lenges similar to those of the practitioner and
often walks a precarious tightrope between
direct caregivers and corporate executives
(Boykin & Schoenhofer, 2001b). The nurse
administrator, whether at the executive or
managerial level of the organization chart, is
held accountable for “customer satisfaction”
as well as for the “bottom line.” Nurses who
move up the executive ladder may be sus-
pected of disassociating from their nursing
colleagues on the one hand and of not being
sufficiently cognizant of the harsh realities of
fiscal constraint on the other hand. Admin-
istrative practice guided by the assumptions
and themes of nursing as caring can enhance
eloquence in articulating the connection be-
tween caregiver and institutional mission: the
person seeking care. Nursing practice leaders
who recognize their care role, indirect as it
may be, are in an excellent position to act on
their committed intention to promote caring
environments. Participating in rigorous ne-
gotiations for fiscal, material, and human re-
sources and for improvements in nursing
practice calls for special skill on the part of
the nurse administrator, skill in recognizing,
acknowledging, and celebrating the other
(e.g., CEO, CFO, nurse manager, or staff
nurse) as a caring person. The nurse admin-
istrator who understands the caring ingredi-
ents (Mayeroff, 1971) recognizes that caring
is neither soft nor fixed in its expression. A
developed understanding of the caring ingre-
dients helps the nurse administrator mobilize
the courage to be honest with self and
“other,” to trust patience, and to value alter-
nating rhythm with true humility while living
a hope-filled commitment to knowing self
and “other” as caring persons.
Health Care System Transformation for
Nursing and Health Care Leaders: Implement-
ing a Culture of Caring (Boykin, Schoenhofer,
& Valentine, 2013) proposes practical strate-
gies for total, integrated system transforma-
tion based on the tenets of the dance of caring
persons and grounded in the assumptions of
3312_Ch19_341-356 26/12/14 9:17 AM Page 354
CHAPTER 19 • Theory of Nursing as Caring 355
Practice Exemplar cont.
nursing as caring. Many of the challenges of
nurse managers and nurse administrators as
well as those experienced by other health-
care system leaders are currently being ad-
dressed by the Institute of Medicine, the
Joint Commission, and other health policy
groups. Solutions implied in the Hospital
Consumer Assessment of Healthcare Providers
and Systems are congruent with the values of
nursing as caring and are amplified and given
substance by specific assumptions and con-
cepts of nursing as caring.
References
Boykin, A. (Ed.). (1994). Living a caring-based program.
New York: National League for Nursing Press.
Boykin, A., Bulfin, S., Baldwin, J., & Southern, B.
(2004). Transforming care in the emergency depart-
ment. Topics in Emergency Medicine, 26(4), 331–336.
Boykin, A., Parker, M. E., & Schoenhofer, S. O.
(1994). Aesthetic knowing grounded in an explicit
conception of nursing. Nursing Science Quarterly, 7,
158–161.
Boykin, A., & Schoenhofer, S. O. (1990). Caring in
nursing: Analysis of extant theory. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 3(4), 149–155.
Boykin, A., & Schoenhofer, S. O. (1991). Story as link
between nursing practice, ontology, epistemology.
Image, 23, 245–248.
Boykin, A., & Schoenhofer, S. O. (1993). Nursing as
caring: A model for transforming practice. New York:
National League for Nursing Press.
Boykin, A., & Schoenhofer, S. O. (1997). Reframing
outcomes: Enhancing personhood. Advanced Practice
Nursing Quarterly, 3(1), 60–65.
Boykin, A., & Schoenhofer, S. O. (2000). Is there really
time to care? Nursing Forum. 35(4), 36–38.
Boykin, A., & Schoenhofer, S. O. (2001a). Nursing as
caring: A model for transforming practice (rev. ed.).
Sudbury, MA: Jones & Bartlett.
Boykin, A., & Schoenhofer, S. O. (2001b). The role of
nursing leadership in creating caring environments in
health care delivery systems. Nursing Administration
Quarterly, 25(3), 1–7.
Boykin, A., Schoenhofer, S., Bulfin, S., Baldwin, J., &
McCarthy, D. (2005). Living caring in practice: The
transformative power of the theory of nursing as
caring. International Journal for Human Caring, 9(3),
15–19.
Boykin, A., Schoenhofer, S. O., Smith, N., St. Jean, J.,
& Aleman, D. (2003). Transforming practice using a
caring-based nursing model. Nursing Administration
Quarterly, 27, 223–230.
Boykin, A., Schoenhofer, S. O., & Valentine, K. (2013).
Health care system transformation for nursing and
health care leaders: Implementing a culture of caring.
New York, NY: Springer Publishing Company.
Carper, B. A. (1978). Fundamental patterns of know-
ing in nursing. Advances in Nursing Science, 1(1),
13–24.
■ Summary
The theory of nursing as caring is grounded in
assumptions that persons are caring by virtue
of their humanness, that caring unfolds mo-
ment to moment, that personhood is living
grounded in caring, and that personhood is en-
hanced in relationships with caring persons.
From that basic philosophical perspective, the
focus of nursing as a discipline and a profes-
sional practice is nurturing persons living car-
ing and growing in caring. The nurse enters
into the world of the other with the intention
of knowing the other as person living caring
and growing in caring. In authentic presence,
the nurse offers a direct invitation to the one
nursed to express what matters most in the
situation. In nursing situations, shared lived
experiences of caring, the nurse hears calls for
caring and creates effective caring responses.
In the caring between nurse and nursed, per-
sonhood is enhanced.
The theory of nursing as caring is used by
practitioners and administrators of nursing
services in a range of institutional and commu-
nity-based nursing practice settings. The the-
ory is also used to guide nursing education,
nursing education administration and nursing
research. More detailed information about the
theory, an extensive bibliography, and exam-
ples of use of the theory are available at http://
nursingascaring.com.
3312_Ch19_341-356 26/12/14 9:17 AM Page 355
356 SECTION V • Grand Theories about Care or Caring
Collins, J. M. (1993). I care for him. Nightingale Songs,
2(4), 3. Retrieved form http://nursing.fau.edu/up-
loads/docs/451/Nightingale%20Songs%20vol%202%
20no%204%20November%201993
Dyess, S. M., Boykin, A., & Bulfin, M. J. (2013).
Hearing the voice of nurses in caring theory-based
practice. Nursing Science Quarterly, 26(2), 167-173.
Finch, L. P., Thomas, J. D., Schoenhofer, S. O., &
Green, A. (2006). Research-as-praxis: A mode of
inquiry into caring in nursing. International Journal
for Human Caring, 10(1), 28–33.
Gaut, D., & Boykin, A. (Eds.). (1994). Caring as
healing: Renewal through hope. New York: National
League for Nursing Press.
Guralnik, D. (Ed.). (1976). Webster’s new world dictionary
of the American language. Cleveland: William
Collings & World.
Locsin, R. C. (1995). Machine technologies and caring
in nursing. Image, 27, 201–203.
Locsin, R. C. (2001). Advancing technology, caring, and
nursing. Westport, CT: Auburn House, Greenwood
Publishing Group.
Mayeroff, M. (1971). On caring. New York: Harper &
Row.
Orlando, I. (1961). The dynamic nurse–patient–relationship:
Function, process and principles. New York: G. P.
Putnam’s Sons.
Paterson, J. G., & Zderad, L. T. (1988). Humanistic
nursing. New York: National League for Nursing
Press.
Pross, E., Hilton, N., Boykin, A., & Thomas, C. (2011).
The dance of caring persons. Nursing Management,
42(10), 25–30.
Roach, M. S. (1987). The human act of caring. Ottawa,
Canada: Canadian Hospital Association.
Roach, M. S. (1992). The human act of caring: A blueprint
for the health professions (rev. ed.). Ottawa, Canada:
Canadian Hospital Association Press.
Schoenhofer, S. O. (1995). Rethinking primary care:
Connections to nursing. Advances in Nursing Science,
17(4), 12–21.
Schoenhofer, S. O. (2001). Infusing the nursing curricu-
lum with literature on caring: An idea whose time
has come. International Journal for Human Caring,
5(2), 7–14.
Schoenhofer, S. O., Bingham, V., & Hutchins, G. C.
(1998). Giving of oneself on another’s behalf: The
phenomenology of everyday caring. International
Journal for Human Caring, 2(1), 23–29.
Schoenhofer, S. O., & Boykin, A. (1993). Nursing as
caring: An emerging general theory of nursing. In
M. E. Parker (Ed.), Patterns of nursing theories in
practice (pp. 83–92). New York: National League
for Nursing Press.
Schoenhofer, S. O., & Boykin, A. (1998a). The value of
caring experienced in nursing. International Journal
for Human Caring, 2(3), 9–15.
Schoenhofer, S. O., & Boykin, A. (1998b). Discovering
the value of nursing in high-technology environments:
Outcomes revisited. Holistic Nursing Practice, 12(4),
31–39.
Touhy, T. A., Strews, W., & Brown, C. (2005). Expres-
sions of caring as lived by nursing home staff, resi-
dents, and families. International Journal for Human
Caring, 9(3), 31–37.
3312_Ch19_341-356 26/12/14 9:17 AM Page 356
Section VI
Middle-Range Theories
357
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 357
358
Twelve middle-range theories in nursing are presented in the final section. Each
chapter is written by the scholars who developed the theory. Although we deter-
mine all to be at the middle range because of their more circumscribed focus on
a phenomenon and more immediate relationship to practice and research, they
still vary in level of abstraction.
Transitions are part of the human experience, and how we negotiate these
transitions affects health and well-being. Afaf Meleis’ transitions theory appears
in Chapter 20. The theory includes the elaboration of transition triggers, properties
of transitions, the conditions of change, and patterns of responses to transitions.
Nursing interventions to promote a smooth passage during transitions are
described.
Comfort is an important concept to nursing practice. Kolcaba’s middle-range
theory of comfort is presented in Chapter 21. She defines comfort as “to
strengthen greatly” and identifies relief, ease, and transcendence as types of com-
fort, and physical, psychospiritual, environmental, and sociocultural as contexts
in which comfort occurs.
Duffy’s quality-caring model, described in Chapter 22, is being used in many
health-care settings to address the issues of patient satisfaction, including patients’
perceptions of not feeling cared for in the acute care environment. In this model
the goal of nursing is to engage in a caring relationship with self and others to
engender feeling “cared for.”
Reed’s theory of self-transcendence is presented in Chapter 23. The focus of
the theory is on facilitating self-transcendence for the purpose of enhancing well-
being. Reed defines self-transcendence as the capacity to expand the self-bound-
ary intrapersonally (toward greater awareness of one’s beliefs, values, and
dreams), interpersonally (to connect with others, nature, and surrounding environ-
ment), transpersonally (to relate in some way to dimensions beyond the ordinary
and observable world), and temporally (to integrate one’s past and future in a
way that expands and gives meaning to the present).
Smith and Liehr present story theory in Chapter 24. They posit that story is a
narrative happening wherein a person connects with self-in-relation through nurse–
person intentional dialogue to create ease. This theory has already been applied
in a number of practice and research initiatives.
Parker and Barry’s community nursing practice model has guided nursing prac-
tice in community settings in several countries. The model is represented by con-
centric circles with the nursing situation as core and connected with the outer
spheres of influence in the community and environment.
Chapter 26 contains Locsin’s theory of technological competency-caring. This
theory dissolves the artificial and often assumed dichotomy between technology
and caring, and asserts that technology is a way of coming to know the person
as whole.
Ray and Turkel authored Chapter 27 on Ray’s theory of bureaucratic caring.
The theory uses a multidimensional, holographic model to facilitate the under-
standing of caring within complex healthcare environments.
In Chapter 28 Troutman-Jordan describes her theory of successful aging. The
theory was informed by Roy’s adaptation model and Tornstam’s theory of gero-
transcendence. Successful aging is characterized by living with meaning and
Section
VI Middle-Range Theories
358
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 358
359
purpose. Intrapsychic factors, functional performance and spirituality contribute
to gerotranscendence and successful aging.
Elizabeth Barrett details her theory of power as knowing participation in
change in Chapter 29. This middle range theory is derived from Rogers’ science
of unitary human beings. Barrett identifies the dimensions of power as: awareness,
choices, freedom to act intentionally, and involvement in creating change.
In Chapter 30 Smith presents her theory of unitary caring. The theory evolved
from viewing caring through the lens of Rogers’ science of unitary human beings.
The concepts of the theory are: manifesting intentions, appreciating pattern, at-
tuning to dynamic flow, experiencing the Infinite and inviting creative emergence.
In Chapter 31 Swanson describes her trajectory and the process of developing
of her middle-range theory of caring from research. The chapter provides insight
to the evolution of theory. Swanson’s theory of caring includes the concepts of
knowing, being with, doing for, enabling, and maintaining belief.
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 359
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 360
Chapter 20Transitions Theory
AFAF I. MELEIS
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Theory
Application of the Theory
Practice Exemplar by Diane Gullett
Summary
References
Afaf I. Meleis
361
Introducing the Theorist
Dr. Afif I. Meleis is a Professor of Nursing and
Sociology and the former Margaret Bond
Simon Dean of Nursing at the University of
Pennsylvania School of Nursing and the former
Director of the School’s WHO Collaborating
Center for Nursing and Midwifery Leadership.
Before coming to Penn, she was a Professor on
the faculty of nursing at the University of
California Los Angeles and the University of
California San Francisco for 34 years. She is a
Fellow of the Royal College of Nursing in the
United Kingdom, the American Academy
of Nursing, and the College of Physicians of
Philadelphia; a member of the Institute of
Medicine, the George W. Bush Presidential
Center Women’s Initiative Policy Advisory
Council, and the National Institutes of Health
Advisory Committee on Research on Women’s
Health; a Board Member of the Consortium of
Universities for Global Health; and cochair of
the IOM Global Forum on Innovation for
Health Professional Education and the Harvard
School of Public Health-Penn Nursing-Lancet
Commission on Women and Health. Dr.
Meleis is also President Emerita and Counsel
General Emerita of the International Council
on Women’s Health Issues and the former
Global Ambassador for the Girl Child Initiative
of the International Council of Nurses.
Dr. Meleis’s research scholarship is focused
on the theoretical development of the nursing
discipline, structure and organization of nurs-
ing knowledge, transitions and health, and
global immigrant and women’s health. She is
the originator of the transitions theory, a central
concept of nursing phenomenon. This theory
continues to be translated into policy, research,
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 361
and evidence-based practice and better quality
care in the 21st century.
She has mentored hundreds of students,
clinicians, and researchers from around the
world who, under her guidance, have achieved
prominent leadership positions. She is the au-
thor of more than 175 articles in social sci-
ences, nursing, and medical journals; more
than 40 chapters; 7 books; and numerous
monographs and proceedings. Her award-
winning book, Theoretical Nursing: Develop-
ment and Progress, now in its 5th edition (1985,
1991, 1997, 2007, 2012), is used widely
throughout the world.
Overview of Transition Theory
A patient is admitted to the hospital; another
is being discharged to a home, to a rehabilita-
tion center, or to an assisted living facility; a
third has just been diagnosed with a life-
threatening disease; a fourth is preparing for
an intrusive surgery; a fifth just got the news
that her spouse has a long-term illness, and
finally, a sixth is a new graduate from a nursing
school beginning his first position as a nurse.
What do they all have in common? Each
of these scenarios is about the experience and
responses of patients, families to health and
illness situations; the experience of coping with
changes from one phase, site, identity, posi-
tion, role, or situation to another. The change
event itself—whether it is birthing a baby, start-
ing a new position, receiving a life-changing
diagnosis, facing impending death, hospital-
ization, or surgery—is a turning point, but the
experience is more fluid and longitudinal. The
transition experience starts before the event
and has an ending point that is fluid, that
varies based on many variables. Understand-
ing the nature of and responses to change, fa-
cilitating and supporting the experience and
responding to it at different phases, and re-
maining or becoming healthy before, during or
at the end of the event, wherever that elusive
ending point is, is what transitions theory is
about. This theory provides a framework to
generate research questions and to serve as a
guide to effective nursing care before, during,
and after the transition.
Origins of the Theory
Three paradigms guided the development of
transitions theory in more than 40 years of clin-
ical research and theoretical work. The first is role
theory, a dynamic and interactionist paradigm
developed by Dr. Ralph Turner, whom I con-
sider the father of interactive role theory. Role
theory framed the type and nature of questions
about how to help patients, clients, and families
in their transition from one role to another, how
to take on a new role, or change behaviors in a
role. I wondered about the mechanisms and the
processes that new mothers and fathers learned
and negotiated as they become adept at per-
forming the behaviors of parenting, at picking
up the cues that differentiate the meaning of the
different crying episodes or different patterns of
sleep. From that theoretical heritage, I devel-
oped a framework for intervention that I called
role supplementation (Meleis, 1975). This frame-
work requires the nurse to accurately analyze the
goals, sentiments, and behaviors necessary for
the role he or she wishes to help the client de-
velop. Such roles might include parenting roles,
patient roles, or wellness roles. The desired out-
come of applying role theory is the client’s mas-
tery of the role. Nurses help people acquire or
change roles by modeling behaviors, allowing
their clients to rehearse roles, and providing
them with support while they are developing
these roles.
A second paradigm that influenced the de-
velopment of transitions theory is the lived ex-
perience, which contrasts the perceived views
with the received views. As we, in nursing, began
questioning what we know and how we know it,
it became apparent that other ways of knowing
(Carper, 1978) that complement and, perhaps,
transcend empirical knowing. This personal, ex-
periential knowing is by its nature subjective. It
is more holistic and encompassing, embedded in
practice, and framed by history. On the basis of
the writing of many illuminating nonnurse au-
thors (Polanyi, 1962) and nurse authors (among
them Benner, Tanner, & Chesla, 1996;
Munhall, 1993; Sarvimaki, 1994), I described
the perceived view (Meleis, 2012) and used it as
a driving paradigm for the development of the
concept of transitions (Chick & Meleis, 1986).
This paradigm helped us focus on questions
362 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 362
related to the nature and lived experience of the
response to change and the experience of being
in transition.
The third paradigm that informs transitions
theory is that of feminist postcolonialism. The
tenets of this paradigm encompass an epis-
temic system that questions power relation-
ships in societies and institutions and that links
societal and political oppressions that shape
the responses to change events. This paradigm
gave us a framework for understanding the ex-
perience of transition through the multiple
lenses of race, ethnicity, nationality, and gen-
der. Each of these qualities creates power dif-
ferentials that must be considered if we truly
want to understand how people experience and
cope with transition and to provide preventive
and therapeutic interventions to help them
achieve health and wellness outcomes. Using
a feminist postcolonialist framework helps us
consider the conditions shaped by power in-
equities in a society or in institutions of healing
(e.g., hospitals, nursing homes, community
agencies) and how these power inequities can
shape the allocation of resources as well as the
provision of nursing care through transitions.
The delineation of conditions surrounding the
transition experience was illuminated by em-
ploying a feminist postcolonialist framework.
These three paradigms—roles theory, per-
ceived views on lived experiences, and femi-
nist postcolonialism—shaped the evolution of
transitions theory through some 40 years of
its development.
Assumptions of the Theory
• A human being’s responses are shaped by
interactions with significant others and
reference groups.
• Change through health and illness events
and situations trigger a process that begins at
or before and extends beyond the event time.
• Whether aware or not aware, individuals
and/or families experience a process trig-
gered by changes with varied responses and
outcomes.
• Outcomes of the experience of the transition
are shaped by the nature of the experience.
• Preventative and therapeutic actions can
influence outcomes.
• Individuals have the capacity to learn
and enact new roles influenced by their
environment..
• By producing critical and well-supported
evidence, inequities in health care can be
changed to more equitable systems of
delivery.
• Gender, race, culture, heritage, and sexual
orientation are contexts that shape people’s
experiences and outcomes of health–illness
events as well as the health care provided.
• Nursing perspective is defined by humanism,
holism, context, health, well-being, goals,
and caring.
• Environment is defined as physical, social,
cultural, organizational, and societal and
influences experience, interventions, and
outcomes.
• Individuals, families, and communities are
partners in the care processes.
Concepts and Propositions of
Transitions Theory
The transitions theory provides a framework to
describe the experience of individuals who are
confronting, living with, and coping with an
event, a situation, or a stage in growth and de-
velopment that requires new skills, sentiments,
goals, behaviors, or functions. Transition is
defined as “a passage from one life phase, con-
dition, or status to another” (Chick & Meleis,
1986). It is a complex and multifaceted con-
cept embracing several components, including
process, time span, and perception.1
CHAPTER 20 • Transitions Theory 363
1This section of the chapter borrows heavily from the
many publications about this theory, which evolved and
was transformed by many mentees and collaborators
over the years (Chick & Meleis, 1986; Schumacher &
Meleis, 1994; Meleis, Sawyer, Im, et al., 2000; and Meleis,
2010). Without the partnerships, the co-authorship, and
collaboration of many mentees, I would not have been
able to develop transitions theory. It is an integration
of all the previous writings about transition theory.
Their influence is manifested in the many co-authored
publications. Among my mentee collaborators are
Drs. DeAnne Messias, Eun-Ok Im, Kathy Dracup,
Linda Sawyer, Karen, Schumacher, Pat Jones, Norma
Chick, Leslie Swendsen, and Patrician Tragenstein.
While I acknowledge and respect the co-opted contribu-
tions of all my collaborators, the liberty I have taken in
integrating the theory from all previous work is entirely
my responsibility.
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 363
Transition Triggers
Four types of situations trigger a transition expe-
rience (Fig. 20-1). All are characterized by some
type of change. Change is related to an external
event while transition is an internal process
(Chick & Meleis, 1986). The first trigger is a
change in health or an illness situation that could
initiate a diagnosis or an intervention process,
particularly the kinds that require prolonged di-
agnostic procedures or treatment protocols, for
example, cancer, schizophrenia, autism, diabetes,
or Alzheimer’s disease, among others. Each of
these diagnoses is preceded by many unknowns,
uncertainties about the processes that follow, and
fears about consequences. They all also require
new behaviors, resources, and coping strategies,
and they involve sets of relationships, newly es-
tablished, changed, or severed.
A second trigger is developmental transi-
tions, which are exemplified by life phases as
manifested by age (e.g., adolescence, aging,
menopause) or by roles (e.g., mothering, father-
ing, marrying, divorcing). Developmental tran-
sitions influence the health and well-being of
people and may or may not require interfacing
with health-care professionals and the health-
care system. Developmental phases and roles in-
fluence health and illness behaviors as well as
inform the responses of individuals to such events
as birthing, breastfeeding, among many others.
These examples of developmental transitions are
of interest to nursing because of the evidence in
the literature that demonstrates how nurses deal
with, what they write about and research, as well
as how they care for individual health-care needs
during the many phases in their development.
Similarly, the third change trigger for a
transition is what we call situational transi-
tions, all of which have health-care implica-
tions. These are exemplified by experiences
and responses to situational changes such as
the admission to or discharge from a hospital
or rehabilitation institution, as well as the
changes that a new graduate nurse experi-
ences becoming a manager or an expert or
that a student nurse learning the ropes of his
or her first clinical rotation experiences at a
new hospital.
364 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Time span
Process
Disconnectedness
Awareness
Critical points
Properties
Intervention
Personal
Community
Society
Global
Change Triggers
Developmental
Situational
Health-illness
Organizational
Patterns of Response
Process
Engaging
Locating and
being situated
Seeking and
receiving support
Acquiring
confidence
Outcome
Mastery
Fluid and
integrative identity
Resourcefulness
Healthy interaction
Perceived
well-being
• Clarify roles,
competencies,
and meanings
• Identify milestones
• Mobilize support
• Debrief
Modified from Transitions: A Middle-Range Theory,
Meleis, Sawyer, Im, Messias, Schumacher, 2000)
Conditions
TherapeuticPreventitive
Fig 20 • 1 Transitions: A middle-range theory. Modified from Meleis, A.I., Sawyer, L., Im, E., Schumacher, K., and
Messias D. (2000). Experiencing transitions: An emerging middle range theory. Advances in Nursing Science, 23(1), 12.
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 364
The fourth type of change trigger that starts
a process of transition is linked to organizational
rules and functioning (Schumacher & Meleis,
1994). There are many examples of organiza-
tional transitions: the arrival of a new chief ex-
ecutive officer, chief nursing officer, or any other
new leader; the implementation of electronic
health records; a different system of care; use of
new technology throughout an organization; or
moving nursing practice to the community. The
experience of transition here is for a whole or-
ganization as opposed to individuals or families.
Properties of Transition
Besides a triggering change event, transitions
are characterized by properties that we de-
scribed in 1986 (Chick & Meleis 1986; see
Table 20-1). The first is a time span, which
could begin from the moment an event or a sit-
uation comes to the awareness of an individual.
It could be a symptom, a diagnosis, an emer-
gency room visit, a flood, an earthquake, an ac-
cident, or a decision to undergo surgery. Unlike
its beginning, the end of a transition is fluid. The
end may be determined when a final goal is
achieved, be it mastery of new roles, developing
certain competencies, feeling a sense of well-
being, or acquiring a desired quality of life.
Another property that defines transition is
that it is a process. The change event itself is
static, but the experience that ensues is a dynamic
and fluid process. The distance between the be-
ginning of this process and when it exactly ends
may correspond with other similar processes or
may be unique. Bridges (1980, 1991) character-
ized the process following change events as re-
quiring at first an ending period followed by an
experience of confusion or a neutral period fol-
lowed by a period he calls the new beginning.
That is when the process is completed.
Disconnectedness is an additional character-
istic of transition. Whether the triggering change
is health related, developmental, situational, or
organizational, one of the properties of the tran-
sition experience is a sense of impending or actual
disconnectedness. A clear example is the imple-
mentation of electronic health records in a school
or hospital. Those who will be experiencing the
change will manifest responses that could reflect
a level of disconnect from their current mode of
recording patients’ health data and maintaining
continuity in patients’ files. The transition expe-
rience reflects a disruption in a person’s feeling
of security associated with what is known and fa-
miliar. There is a sense of loss—of familiar sign-
posts, reference points, or state of health—and a
feeling of incongruity between past, present, and
future expectations. Those who are responding
to the change experience a discontinuity of reg-
ular patterns disrupted by the unfamiliar.
Another important property of transitions is
awareness—awareness of the change event, of
the situation, of triggers, and of the internal ex-
perience of transition. The difference between
change and transition is the difference between
external and internal experience. Perception,
awareness, and the defining and redefining of
the meaning of the change for the self and others
are properties of a transition experience. They
make transition dynamic, incorporating meaning
and changing interpretation over a span of time.
The presence of milestones that may be turn-
ing points is yet another property of transitions.
Identifying milestones is essential to under-
standing the phases in the transition experience
as well as to identifying the appropriate assess-
ment points and intervention points. The goals
of transition theory are to describe triggers, to
anticipate experience, to predict outcomes, and
to provide guidelines for interventions.
Conditions of Change
Change triggers initiate a process with patterns
of responses that are both observable and
nonobservable behaviors and either functional or
dysfunctional. These responses start from the
moment a change trigger is anticipated and are
influenced by personal, community, societal, or
global conditions. Among the personal condi-
tions are the meaning and the values attributed
to the change and the context of it. A person’s
experience and responses are also influenced by
the expectations of how self or others will react,
CHAPTER 20 • Transitions Theory 365
• Time
• Process
• Experiences
• Milestones
• Conditions
Table 20 • 1 Concepts
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 365
the level of knowledge and skills related to the
change, and the belief about what is expected of
those undergoing the change. Other personal
conditions that influence the experience and re-
sponses are the level of planning and the level of
existing health and well-being of the person, the
family, the organization, the community, or the
country at large (Schumacher & Meleis, 1994).
In addition, the responses are mediated by the
level of vulnerability and sense of marginaliza-
tion those experiencing the transition find them-
selves in or are subjected to (Hall, Stevens, &
Meleis, 1994; Stevens, Hall, & Meleis, 1994).
Community conditions, such as support from
partners and the availability of role models and
resources, promote or inhibit effective healthy
transitions. Community norms about and re-
sources for dealing with sexism, homophobia,
poverty, ageism, and nationalism also could pro-
mote or inhibit healthy experiences and out-
comes of transitions. Global conditions that
could influence the experience of transitions, in-
cluding policies and mandates developed by in-
ternational organizations, define how certain
triggers are viewed and appear at the global con-
sciousness. For example, the transition of the
HIV/AIDS patient through the diagnosis and
treatment process could be mediated by the
global attention and resources that have been
given to researchers, clinicians, and patients who
have or are associated with the disease. There are
vast differences between how infected individu-
als experienced the diagnosis and treatment of
HIV/AIDS before the global attention to it and
post–President’s Emergency Plan for AIDS Re-
lief aid offered by the Western world.
Patterns of Responses
How do individuals, families, and organizations
respond to a change event? What questions
should be asked to define and understand their
responses? This is an area of knowledge that is
ripe for systematic investigation. Many theories
can describe responses. Among them are grief
theories (Kübler-Ross, 1969) and crisis theories
(Lindemann, 1979). We have proposed two sets
of responses from a nursing perspective: process
patterns and outcome patterns.
Process Patterns
Process patterns are measured by the degree
of engagement in the particular change event
as well as in the actions and intervention
plans (Schumacher, Jones, & Meleis, 1999).
Levels of engagement could be assessed
through patterns of questions, types of re-
sponses, and the congruency between actions,
sentiments, and goals of those who are experi-
encing the transition and those who are guid-
ing and advising about these actions. Following
directions, accuracy of perceived information,
the consistency of meanings of the event, and
the degree of involvement in all aspects of tran-
sition experience and actions related to the
change event are indicators of engagement
levels.
A second process pattern of response is
called location and being situated (Meleis,
Sawyer, Im, Schumacher, & Messias, 2000).
Recognizing one’s position in a complex system
of relationships and being connected and able
to interact with a web of different interactions
is a pattern of response that should be examined
to uncover the nature of responses to a transi-
tion trigger. How a person sees, initiates, and
relates to teams of health professionals follow-
ing a diagnosis of cancer or to a new immi-
grant’s environment determines a pattern
of response. How and when a person, a family,
or a community confronted by a change trigger
seek support from health-care providers, are
indicators of the extent that they understand the
needs and timeliness in seeking the support. It
is also an indication of realizing their position
within the health-care system.
Another process pattern is the level of
confidence in handling the new, multiple, and
sometimes conflicting demands on a person,
family, or organization in the midst of attempt-
ing to deal with a triggering event. Similarly, the
level of confidence may be determined by the
individual’s ability to identify priorities of needs
and to outline different levels of actions or inter-
ventions. The actions could be as simple as
describing from whom they should seek help to
more complex self-care interventions.
Outcome Patterns
Although patterns in process responses are
assessed at different points in dealing with a
change trigger, outcome responses are assessed
at a point determined to be at the end of the
transition process. Five patterns of responses are
defined as outcomes—mastery, fluid integrative
366 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 366
identities, resourcefulness, healthy interactions,
and perceived well-being (Meleis et al., 2000).
Mastery includes role mastery, which is mani-
fested by integrating the sentiment, goals, and
behaviors in one’s identity, and behaving with
confidence, knowledge, and expertise. Exam-
ples are becoming a mother (Hattar-Pollara,
2010; Mercer, 2004; Shin & Whitetraut 2007),
accepting hospice or end-of-life care (Larkin,
Dierckx de Casterlé, & Schotsmans, 2007),
or becoming adept at being at risk while
continuing to function in other roles.
Mastery goes beyond roles, however, and
includes mastery of one’s environment as mani-
fested in seeking and utilizing appropriate re-
sources and co-opting supportive environmental
conditions. Learning to cope with technology
at home, living with it, and reformulating
one’s identity to incorporate it in one’s daily
repetitions is an example of this mastery (Fex,
Gullvi, Ik, & Soderhamn, 2010).
Fluid and integrative identity is another out-
come response pattern (Meleis et al., 2000).
This pattern is characterized by the ability to
swing back and forth between the multiple
identities a person in transition experiences.
Let’s consider a person who must undergo kid-
ney dialysis and who emerges from her dialysis
session to assume other identities, without any
one of the identities dominating her time and
energy. A person with an integrative identity
is able to live, function, and be well, despite
the uncertainties and ambiguities of living with
a chronic illness, a nagging pain, or a set of
essential treatments. This pattern of outcome
response is characterized by the ability to carry
the sentiments, the goals, the actions, and the
baggage of different ways of being (Messias,
1997). It is the ability to “navigate unknown
waters” (Duggleby et al., 2010). One indicator
for an outcome pattern of response is current
compared with previous quality of life.
Another outcome pattern of response is
healthy interactions and connections as mani-
fested in maintaining relationships and or
developing new connections or relationships
that affirm the completion of a transition.
Questions to be investigated are the extent to
which caregivers burdened by extensive health-
care needs of patients with heart failure are able
to develop relationships with health-care
providers while maintaining meaningful sup-
portive relationships in their lives. For example,
telehealth can play a significant role in facilitat-
ing caregivers’ abilities to meet the needs of
heart failure patients by maintaining continuous
communication with family and caregivers. Te-
lenurses can then deliver the evidence-based
professional consulting and supportive care
based on technology that improves patients’
self-care behaviors. These interventions can also
alleviate caregivers’ burdens and improve their
health outcomes, allowing them time to meet
their own needs (e.g., health or social needs;
Chiang, Chen, Dai, & Ho, 2012).
These types of questions are important to an-
swer because some research has demonstrated
that the health of partners or caregivers is inter-
twined with that of seriously ill patients, that is,
the more an illness affects the patient’s physical
and mental ability, the greater the impact
this will have on the health of their partner or
caregiver due to insurmountable stress, disrup-
tion in their relationships, and neglect of their
own health. These unintended health conse-
quences may be further exacerbated by the lack
of social, emotional, or practical support the
partner or caregiver experiences (Christakis &
Allison, 2006). For this reason, having strong
social networks in place during these periods
of transition could play a significant role in
promoting positive health outcomes for the
caregiver, which would in turn positively affect
the health of the patient. For major areas of
investigation, see Table 20-2.
Intervention Framework
The goal of intervention within transitions the-
ory is to facilitate and inspire healthy process
and outcome responses. Nursing interventions
that support healthy process behaviors as well
as healthy outcome behaviors include the fol-
lowing: clarifying meanings, providing expert-
ise, setting goals, modeling the role of others;
providing resources, opportunities for rehearsal,
access to reference groups and role models, and
debriefing.
Clarifying Roles, Meanings, Competen-
cies, Expertise, Goals, and Role Taking
Through interaction, dialogue, and interviews,
the nurse probes for the values of the person
CHAPTER 20 • Transitions Theory 367
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 367
experiencing the transition process, as well as
those of their significant others, and determines
the meanings they attribute to the event and
the different stages in the transition. Compe-
tencies and the extent to which the person is
able to master each of the competencies are
identified, as well as the ease in performing the
competency and the level of engagement in
learning or modifying the competency—be it
testing blood sugar levels, bathing a baby,
changing a nursing unit, or reaching out for
new connections in a nursing home.
Similarly, observing, questioning or inter-
viewing significant others—whether they are
partners or friends—to determine levels of
engagement and the extent of competency
mastery is another significant component of a
program for intervention during transition
process, especially at critical milestones. Signif-
icant others or reference groups to be included
in the assessment or the intervention are those
whose viewpoints are used as a frame of refer-
ence. Roles, whether they are new ones, at-risk
ones, or those that may be lost, are formed and
imputed through a process of definition and
redefinition. Similarly, new competencies are
acquired through a process of teaching, learn-
ing, rehearsing, modeling, and reinforcement
by those who are in the support or network
systems (Petch, 2009; Swendsen, Meleis, &
Jones, 1978; van Staa, 2010).
Identifying Milestones and Using
Critical Points
A critical point is the time when questions tend
to arise about a care trajectory or when signs and
symptoms tend to manifest themselves. It is a
point when healing progresses or there is a
relapse, a point when infection, inflammation,
distress, anxiety, noncompliance, or other con-
ditions may begin appearing and when an
appropriate intervention may advance the treat-
ment and healing course. Care is maximized at
such a point. A 6-week check-up for a postpar-
tum mother has always been designated a critical
point or a milestone, but this milestone is driven
by the biomedical model as it relates to when the
uterus reverts to its normal size. However, it is
imperative to identify milestones from a nursing
perspective when our goals are self-care, quality
of life, role mastery, and managed care. Identi-
fying milestones or turning points is essential
in the trajectory of managing and facilitating
transitions. This area of the theory invites
research to provide evidence to identify and
support those points where there is a need for
intervention to enhance both a healthy transition
process and outcomes. Biomedical driven goals
are not inclusive of goals driven by a nursing
perspective and holistic approach.
Providing Supportive Resources,
Rehearsals, Reference Groups, and
Role Models
Mobilizing partnerships, resources, and support-
ive groups is another component in intervention
strategies. Clarifying roles, competencies, values,
and abilities to understand what others are ex-
periencing are important processes for facilitat-
ing a healthy transition and in achieving healthy
outcomes at the termination of a transition.
These may be accomplished by identifying a
nurse as a go-to person for questions, observing
patients who may have gone through a similar
368 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
• Describe and interpret the different transition experiences and responses.
• Identify transition properties.
• Develop and test preventative and therapeutic interventions.
• Identify milestones and turning points associated with different change triggers.
• Describe and test determinants of process and outcome responses.
• Develop instruments and investigative tools for properties, conditions, processes, and outcome
responses.
• Explore strategies to modify policies essential to mitigate, facilitate or inhibit healthy processes
and outcome responses.
Table 20 • 2 Major Areas of Investigation
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 368
event, and being afforded opportunities to imag-
ine, mentally enact, or actually practice what the
person may encounter, do, or feel during the
different phases of transition. Having a support
group, rehearsing competencies, becoming in
touch with feelings about events or competen-
cies, visualizing different scenarios, and de-
scribing the different if–then situations may
enhance healthy transitions and outcomes. We
have called these processes role modeling and role
rehearsal, as well as defining and identifying refer-
ence groups (Meleis, 1975; Meleis & Swendsen,
1978). An example of this type of intervention
is an interdisciplinary mentoring program that
the Hospital of the University of Pennsylvania
implemented, which pairs nurses with medical
students starting their first clinical rotations
to facilitate the transitional adjustment of
the medical students to their new environment.
This program also highlights the important
role nurses play in patient care, which fosters a
sense of teamwork and collegiality between
medical students and nurses from the beginning
(Sapega, 2012).
Debriefing
Debriefing is a well-researched, core nursing
intervention used at critical points during
transition experiences. “Debriefing is defined
as a process of communicating to others the
experiences that a person or group encountered
around a critical event” (Meleis, 2010, p. 457).
It is a tool used in nursing to help a person
come to terms with the transition experience
and attain psychological well-being (Steele &
Beadle, 2003). Nurses ask their patients ques-
tions after birthing, traumatic events, disasters,
surgical procedures, during a new admissions
process, and at discharge. The patient may
recount his or her story emotionally, relate to
it cognitively, describe it, interpret its meaning,
reflect on it, or share feelings. The story usually
includes the context, the before, the during,
and the subsequent responses related to the ex-
perience. Nurses engage in dialogues with their
patients about the events, ask questions, and
provide patients and families with the oppor-
tunity to process the events and the aftermath.
For example, a number of maternity units
provide postnatal debriefing services for new
mothers. Postnatal debriefing is a psychological
intervention that enables women to come to
terms with their experience and promotes
psychological well-being. Through postnatal
debriefing, health-care professionals can iden-
tify the emotional and psychological needs of
the patient and refer them to appropriate
resources or other mental health specialists.
This service gives new mothers the opportunity
to ask questions, debrief about their experi-
ences, describe their feelings, and receive infor-
mation and reasons for care they have been
provided or need (Steele & Beadle, 2003).
In addition to patients, nurses themselves, as
well as other health-care providers, also benefit
from debriefing. Hospitals have implemented
debriefing, or critical incident stress manage-
ment, programs to help their staff cope with
stress and sorrow at work and to mitigate the
impact of traumatic events. For example, Chil-
dren’s Memorial Hospital in Chicago launched
a mentor program that matched new nursing
graduates with seasoned nurses to help them
cope with the stress and heartache of caring
for sick children and interacting with distressed
parents and family members. This program
significantly reduced the high turnover rate
among new nursing graduates that the hospital
had been experiencing (Huff, 2006).
Applications of Transitions
Theory
Research
Transitions theory has been used extensively
as a theoretical framework in research all
around the world to examine a broad spectrum
of transition experiences resulting from
health–illness, developmental, situational, and
organizational transitions and the effect of
these transitions on the health of individuals,
families, and communities. It has been used to
develop strategies and interventions to facili-
tate healthy transitions and has served as a
conceptual basis and guide to
• understand and examine teenager’s concerns
as they transition through high school in the
United States (Rew, Tyler, & Hannah,
2012).
CHAPTER 20 • Transitions Theory 369
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 369
• demonstrate in Taiwan that nurse-led transi-
tional care combining telehealth care and
discharge planning significantly alleviates
family caregiver burden and stress and im-
proves family function (Chiang et al., 2012).
• study the impact on self-care of people with
heart failure and develop strategies to imple-
ment a therapeutic regimen in Portugal
(Mendes, Bastos, & Paiva, 2010).
• explore in greater depth chronic obstructive
pulmonary disease (COPD) patients’ experi-
ences during and after pulmonary rehabilita-
tion in Norway (Halding & Heggdal, 2011).
• analyze Finnish women’s hysterectomy expe-
riences as a process of transition in their lives
and describe representations of hysterectomy
in Finnish women’s and health magazines
(Nykanen, Suominen, & Nikkonen, 2011).
• assess the cultural factors that may contribute
to the low diagnosis rate of postpartum
depression in Asian American (e.g., Asian
Indian, Chinese, Filipina) mothers (Goyal,
Wang, Shen, Wong, & Palaniappan, 2012).
These research studies demonstrate how
transitions theory has supported and aided
nurse researchers and scholars to describe the
transition experiences and responses, confirm
the components of the transition experience,
and identify the essential properties of transi-
tion, including the critical points and events,
to ultimately reach the goal of promoting
healthy outcomes and easing transitions for
their clients, families, and communities.
• As indicated by Kralik, Visentin, and van
Loon (2006) in their comprehensive litera-
ture review of transitions theory, future
research to advance knowledge about
transitions should include longitudinal
comparative and longitudinal cross
sectional designs.
• In 2007, at the University of Pennsylvania,
we established the New Courtland Center on
Transitions and Health. Transitions theory
provided the foundation for its theoretical
basis. Driven by Dr. Mary Naylor’s scholar-
ship, a current focus of the center is on the
transitional care model for the elderly popu-
lation. Although independently developed
on the East Coast of the United States as an
intervention using advanced practice nurses,
the transitional care model reflects the com-
ponents of transition theory (Naylor, 2002).
Practice
Transitions theory has been applied in practice
by nurses to aid clients, families, and communities
in preparing for, navigating through, and adapt-
ing to transition experiences to enhance health
outcomes. The operationalization of transitions
theory enhances nurses’ understanding of patient
and caregiver transitions and leads to the devel-
opment of nursing therapeutics, interventions,
and resources that are tailored to the unique
experiences of clients and their families in order
to promote successful, healthy responses to tran-
sition. As mentioned earlier in this chapter, the
illness of patients can take a heavy toll on the
health of their caregivers due to the stress, role
transitions, disruption in relationships, and
bereavement they may experience. Transitions
theory has been used as a conceptual framework
in practice to help health-care providers gain a
holistic understanding of the caregiver’s beliefs,
views, unique experiences, and desired outcomes,
which in turn enables nurses and health-care
providers to allocate resources and implement
interventions targeted to the caregivers’ specific
needs to optimize the health of both the patient
and the caregiver (Blum & Sherman, 2010).
It helps identify the barriers to, as well as facili-
tators of, the transition, unique to each individual
patient and caregiver, which in turn enhances
the nurses’ or health-care providers’ ability to
effectively guide them through the transition
experiences.
The conceptual underpinnings of transi-
tions theory have also been used to analyze the
transitions that intensive care unit (ICU) pa-
tients and their families encounter after they are
discharged from ICU and the provision of nurs-
ing services needed for continuity of care. By
digging deeper to fully comprehend the stress
patients and families experience when being
discharged from ICU, including their potential
feelings of abandonment, unimportance, or am-
bivalence, nurses can better assist patients and
families in the ICU transfer process and ensure
the provision of optimum health-care services
to continue care (Chaboyer, 2006).
370 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 370
Transitions theory has also been used to
understand and characterize the personal expe-
riences of perimenopausal and menopausal
women. Findings from this research have been
translated into practice in the clinical setting.
Understanding women’s personal experiences
using transitions theory equips nurses to proac-
tively educate women on what to expect before
perimenopausal or menopausal symptoms begin,
thus decreasing anxiety and confusion and in-
stead “normalizing the experience” (Marnocha,
Bergstrom & Dempsey, 2011).
Education
Transitions theory is used in graduate and
undergraduate curricula in countries around
the world. Universities that have integrated
transitions theory in their nursing education
programs include the University of Connecticut
in Storrs and Clayton State University in Mor-
row, Georgia. Clayton State University has used
transitions theory in its curriculum, and has
made it central to their nursing program’s phi-
losophy. On its website, transitions theory is de-
fined, and it is emphasized that “[n]egotiating
successful transitions depends on the develop-
ment of an effective relationship between the
nurse and client. This relationship is a highly re-
ciprocal process that affects both the client and
nurse” (Clayton State University, 2012). With
regard to the graduate curriculum in nursing
at the university,
The culmination of graduate nursing education is the
synthesis of advanced skills in order to provide excel-
lent nursing care and to foster ongoing professional
development in order to promote nursing research,
ethical decision-making reflecting an appreciation of
human diversity in health and illness among individ-
uals, families, and communities experiencing life tran-
sitions. (Clayton State University, 2012)
At the University of California San Fran-
cisco (UCSF), I taught a graduate course on
transitions and health to respond to an increas-
ing educational demand of graduate students.
Additionally, many doctoral students in
nursing and other disciplines around the
world, including Sweden and the United
States, have used transitions theory as a basis
for their doctoral dissertations.
Developing Situation-Specific Theories
Transitions theory continues to be further
developed, tested, and refined to understand
and describe the relationships among the
major beliefs, patterns, and concepts of diverse
groups of populations undergoing various
types of transition experiences. A number of
situation-specific theories have evolved from
transitions theory. A situation-specific theory
is a coherent representation and depiction of a
set of concepts and their interrelationships to
a set of outcomes related to health and illness
experiences and responses, as well as to nursing
actions to prevent the effects of illness or ame-
liorate the effects of interventions (Meleis,
2010). For example, a situation-specific the-
ory explaining the menopausal symptom
experiences of Asian immigrant women
within the sociocultural contexts in the United
States was grounded in transitions theory
(Im, 2010). Others include Transitions and
Health: A Framework for Gerontological Nursing
(Schumacher, Jones, & Meleis, 1999) and
Situation-Specific Theory of Pain Experience for
Asian American Cancer Patients (Im, 2008).
CHAPTER 20 • Transitions Theory 371
Practice Exemplar by Diane Lee Gullett, MSN, MPH
The following Practice Exemplar is framed with
Afaf Meleis’ Transition Theory.
I met Wayne when I was volunteering as
a nurse in a free clinic in New Orleans (N.O.)
in 2012. He was a 26-year-old young man
who appeared gaunt with dark circles under
his eyes. Wayne presented with a chief com-
plaint of insomnia, depression, nighttime
sweating, and a lack of energy for the past
10 months. He informed me that the other
practitioners he visited had given him med-
ications for sleep and depression. He stated
Continued
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 371
372 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Practice Exemplar by Diane Lee Gullett, MSN, MPH cont.
these had been unsuccessful in relieving his
symptoms. I asked Wayne if any blood work
had been done. He suddenly became very
anxious, stood up and began pacing the
room, wringing his hands, looking at the
floor, and refusing to make eye contact. He
started for the door and told me he didn’t
need to have any blood drawn and that this
was a mistake. I assured him that I would
not draw any blood without his consent and
gently asked him if he would be willing to
stay and speak with me a bit further.
Nurse: Can you remember when you first
started noticing your symptoms?
Wayne: I guess it was in August or maybe
September.
Nurse: Thinking back can you remember any
significant changes in your life at that time?
Wayne: You know, I have wracked my brain
thinking about that. The only thing I can
think of is that this was about the time
Hurricane Katrina hit.
Nurse: Were you living in New Orleans (N.O.)
when Hurricane Katrina hit the city?
Wayne: Yeah, I was starting my freshman year
of college.
Nurse: Would you mind sharing some of your
experiences about that time in your life
with me?
(Intervention: Debriefing).
Wayne: I was a 19-year-old honors student
(Condition: Personal). I had just moved to
N.O. to major in international business
10 days before the storm (Change trigger:
Situational). The apartment community
where I lived was evacuated, so I was forced
to leave the city and go to my stepfather’s house
in Arkansas (Property: Time span). I didn’t
understand the severity of the situation at the
time, I mean I had never been through a hurri-
cane before (Condition: Personal). I thought it
would be an opportunity to get ahead with my
schoolwork and visit with my family. I didn’t
take much, two pairs of pants and some books. I
mean it never occurred to me that I would need
more than that. You know you have to leave, so
you take what you think you need which you
later realize isn’t enough and isn’t what you
should have taken, but no one prepares you for
that (Condition: Personal). I enrolled in classes
at Louisiana State University in Baton Rouge
3 weeks after Katrina, since my old college
wasn’t offering classes at that time. I lasted
5 minutes. I went through the whole process
and I just dropped out (Property: Milestone)
immediately after doing it because I just
couldn’t wrap my mind around it.
Nurse: Could you explain a bit more about
what you mean when you say you “couldn’t
wrap your mind around it.” (Clarifying
meaning)
Wayne: I, it, was everything from my social
life, to what I was studying, to my financial
situation. I was on this path of what I was
going to do and when I came back, I just
couldn’t do it. I just, honestly, I just didn’t
care. It seemed like there were so many other
more important things than worrying about
my grades or what I was studying. I dropped
out of school with a 1.5 GPA and decided to
return to N.O. It was only about 3 months
after Katrina and too soon. My thought
process, though, was just I need to get my life
back to normal, I need to get things to be the
way that they were. Even 7 years later, they
are not. It is, you acknowledge on some level,
that it is never going to be the way that it
was, but it’s like your driving force, this need
to get your life back to normal (Property:
Process). And then you get the new normal,
so it’s not what you had before, it’s not even
close. It’s not even, it's, I can’t even describe
how different it is.
Change Triggers
Hurricane Katrina serves as the situational
change trigger for Wayne’s transitioning
experience. The hurricane generated situa-
tional changes including relocating to a new
city, enrolling at a new college, and living in a
new community. The nature of Wayne’s tran-
sitional experience; however, must also be con-
sidered within the context of other possible
change triggers. Wayne is simultaneously
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 372
CHAPTER 20 • Transitions Theory 373
Practice Exemplar by Diane Lee Gullett, MSN, MPH cont.
experiencing a developmental life phase
change moving from late adolescence to early
adulthood manifested in his role transition
from high school student to independent col-
lege student. Limited worldly experience and
youth are personal conditions that inhibit
Wayne’s ability to cope with the reality of the
changes triggered by Hurricane Katrina. His
inexperience is evident in his initial response
to Hurricane Katrina as a mini-vacation for
which he took only a few articles of clothing,
never thinking he wouldn’t be able to return
to resume his college life or collect those
things he held personally valuable. Wayne’s
inability to effectively reconcile his previous
life with his new one inhibits a healthy out-
come response leading to his failure to main-
tain his GPA and eventually dropping out of
school. The nurse recognizes Hurricane Kat-
rina as the situational change trigger that con-
textually situates Wayne’s unique transition
experience and serves as the foundation for
mutual meaning making between the nurse
and Wayne.
Nurse: Could you tell me a little bit more about
your feelings during that time and your ‘need
to get your life back to normal’ (Clarifying
meaning).
Wayne: I came back with no plan other than
to try and resume my life, and without real-
izing that all of the things that were in my
life before might not be there after (Prop-
erty: Disconnectedness). That is, even down
to grocery stores, you know for a long time
you had to drive to the suburbs just to make
groceries. Like, for example when my old
apartment community reopened, I was
adamant that I wanted to move back. I had
to move back into that same apartment, and
I did ultimately, but it wasn’t the same. It
wasn’t physically the same because it had
been gutted and then it wasn’t the same
because it wasn’t the same circumstances, it
wasn’t the same people. So I did not realize,
I just wanted to move back and continue my
life, I didn’t realize that the things that were
part of my life may not be there like they
were before (Property: Disconnectedness).
Nurse: This must have been a very difficult
time for you. How did you cope with all
these changes in your life? (Intervention:
Questioning)
Wayne: Things during the first year or two after
I returned to the city are still a little hazy. I
do remember totaling three cars within 2
weeks after returning to N.O., you know I
don’t know where my head was (Property:
Critical point). I haven’t been in an accident
since. I haven’t even had a speeding ticket,
but literally within this period I totaled three
cars. I can say speaking in honesty that you
know for a long time after the storm that my
way of dealing with my day to day life really
was sex and drugs (Property: Critical point).
What started with just every now and then
became like weeks-long binges, and when you
get involved with those things, it brings a
completely new element into your life that
you probably wouldn’t have considered
before. I mean, I will be the first to say I have
done things since the storm that I never
would have considered before. Such as
certain substances, sexually, bath houses. . . .
(Property: Critical point). I think it was an
escape; it was because when you are high,
when you are messed up, and you’re not
thinking about the things around you . . . you
are not thinking at all really, you are just you
know, you are getting away from all these
pressures that are on your mind (Property:
Awareness).
Nurse: What did you feel like you needed to
escape from (Intervention: Clarifying
meaning)?
Wayne: At the time, I had new financial strug-
gles that I hadn’t had before. Things like
work, some family problems, and the way
things were in the city. Everything was so
different than it had been before Katrina
(Conditions: Personal and Community).
Properties of Transition
Properties of transition (i.e., time span, process,
disconnectedness, awareness, and critical points)
Continued
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 373
374 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Practice Exemplar by Diane Lee Gullett, MSN, MPH cont.
assist the nurse in describing change triggers,
specific milestones and ascertaining the differ-
ent phases of a person’s transition experience.
This knowledge assists the nurse in identifying
interventions and support mechanisms impor-
tant in facilitating healthy transition experiences
or recognizing those factors inhibiting healthy
transitions. Wayne encounters the property of
time span when he first becomes aware of Hur-
ricane Katrina. The nurse recognizes Hurricane
Katrina as an external trigger of change which
in and of itself is static. Wayne’s process of tran-
sition, on the other hand, signifies a dynamic
internal change evident in his struggle to regain
his old life, his inability to do so and his reluc-
tance to accept the new normal. Disconnected-
ness manifests in Wayne’s recognition of the
disruption Hurricane Katrina brought to his fa-
miliar way of being in the world; from where
he shopped, where he lived, who his friends
were, and who he understood himself to be. He
sincerely yearns to return to the familiar only to
find his environment (personal, community,
and societal conditions) irrevocably changed.
The dynamic nature of awareness is reflected in
Wayne’s continual reinterpretation and willing-
ness to find meaning in his experiences follow-
ing Katrina. His story is filled with a sense of
movement from trying to return to normal to
acknowledging the “new normal” and from par-
ticipating in risk-taking behaviors as coping
strategies to recognizing these as ineffective.
The nurse recognizes many turning points or
milestones within Wayne’s transition experi-
ence starting with his dropping out of school,
crashing multiple cars, using drugs and alcohol,
and engaging in unprotected sex. Without
appropriate interventions, all of these played a
role in inhibiting a healthy transition experience
for Wayne.
Nurse: Did you have anyone who was able to
support you or who you felt like you could go
to for help during this time (Intervention:
Assessing support systems)?
Wayne: I wasn’t getting the support from my
family because they couldn’t relate, they . . . I
suppose on some level they were like this sucks
but they couldn’t at all understand what I
was going through (Property: Disconnected-
ness). There weren’t many people who stayed
in the city and those who became my friends
ended up being the wrong crowd. I mean the
city was a disaster there was a curfew, mili-
tary presence, no garbage pickup for months,
no grocery stores, and certainly no counseling
or places to go to for help (Condition: Com-
munity). It was as if those of us who stayed
in the city were on our own. I think a lot of
people were in bad shape. I remember hear-
ing about a lot of people committing suicide.
Nurse: Do you think you made the wrong deci-
sion returning to N.O. so soon after Hurri-
cane Katrina?
Wayne: Absolutely. You know, even now, if it
were going to happen again, I couldn’t, I
would leave, I would leave my stuff, and I
would not come back. It wasn’t the experience
itself, it was the after effect. And the way it
affected my life. . . . I can’t go back to trying
to fit the pieces of my life back together or try-
ing to resume a sense of normalcy that will
never return because even though I know
better now, while you intellectually know
better, emotionally you are still going to be
going through the processes (Process patterns:
Engagement). There is nothing you can do
about that, you can’t control that. . . . I just
can’t do it. I am a pretty strong person, I al-
ways have been, but that was one time in my
life that I can sincerely say I had a mental
and emotional breakdown. It was what it
was, and I can’t do anything about that
(Properties: Awareness).
Conditions of Change
There are multiple personal, community, and
societal conditions influencing Wayne’s pat-
terns of response to Hurricane Katrina and are
important for the nurse to recognize as part of
his transition process. Personal conditions are
those, which center on an individual’s experi-
ence with the change trigger and other personal
conditions that influence the well-being of the
individual within the broader framework of
family and community. Wayne’s youth and lack
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 374
CHAPTER 20 • Transitions Theory 375
Practice Exemplar by Diane Lee Gullett, MSN, MPH cont.
of experience with natural disasters are personal
conditions that influenced Wayne’s responses
to the situational change. Wayne naively re-
turned to N.O. with the intent of getting his
life back to normal only to be confronted with
the reality of an irrevocably changed reality and
his place in it. Wayne also expresses feelings of
isolation when discussing his belief that others
including his family could not relate to what he
was going through. Wayne’s lack of knowledge
and skills, poor planning, and increased sense
of marginalization reflect personal and commu-
nity conditions that inhibited rather than facil-
itated a healthy transition experience. The
limited level of existing community and social
resources available within the city following
Hurricane Katrina also inhibited Wayne’s tran-
sition experience. Katrina created catastrophic
conditions within the city that left a nonexistent
social, political, and economic infrastructure.
Employment, housing, medical care and men-
tal health services were virtually nonexistent
within the city. Wayne was not aware of the
fact that he needed help during this time and
states the reality of limited access to even basic
services within the city. Community conditions
including cultural and social norms were also
dramatically altered by the catastrophic condi-
tions that existed in the city. These conditions
for a young person such as Wayne may have
presented a loss of positive role-modeling es-
sential to developing effective coping strategies
following such a traumatic experience. Wayne
admits to engaging in homosexual behavior,
unprotected sex, doing drugs, and hanging
out with the wrong crowd. Societal conditions
stigmatizing homosexuality may have prohib-
ited him from seeking support from his family
or friends, further perpetuating his feelings of
marginalization.
Nurse: Are you able to think about your future
at all, envision what you want to do moving
forward (Intervention: Visualizing different
scenarios).
Wayne: One thing I can say moving forward, I
have, I really want to get out of N.O. It’s
that still even today, it is such a major part
of, and I know I am not alone in this, your
everyday mental process. Your life is sepa-
rated into before Katrina and after Katrina.
And you refer to things like that, on a daily
basis your life before the storm and after the
storm and you think about it every day. I
can’t imagine, I can’t imagine living some-
where that you don’t think about that, I can’t
imagine living somewhere where that is
not a part of your daily process, it’s not a
part of your shared experience (Patterns of
response: Locating).
Nurse: After listening to your story, it seems
that the changes brought about by Hurricane
Katrina greatly affected your life. I think
some of the symptoms you described to me
could be related to what you experienced
during this very difficult time in your life.
Speaking with others who have experienced
similar circumstances may provide a way to
express what you have been through. I know
of a local support group not far from here that
has some members who were also in college at
the time that Hurricane Katrina hit. Would
you be interested in attending one of these
groups (Intervention: Mobilizing support)?
Wayne: I would like that. (Patterns of response:
Receiving support) I feel better just talking
with someone about all of this. Can I tell you
something and you won’t judge me (Patterns
of response: Seeking support)?
Nurse: Of course. I want you to feel this is a
safe environment and that I am not here to
judge you.
Wayne: You know when I told you about the
bathhouses; well it happened a lot and with
men. I didn’t use protection most of the time.
I am so ashamed and so scared.
Nurse: Wayne, you do not need to be ashamed.
A lot of young men and women experiment
sexually throughout their lives, but it is
important to practice safe sex. Can you tell
me more about what you are scared of specifi-
cally (Intervention: Clarifying meaning)?
Wayne: I am scared that I may have AIDS.
I took a home HIV test a couple of months
ago, the kind that uses your saliva. It was
Continued
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 375
376 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Practice Exemplar by Diane Lee Gullett, MSN, MPH cont.
positive, but I have been too afraid to do
anything about it or tell anyone. I know, I
am stupid, right (Properties: Critical point)?
Nurse: No, I don’t think you are stupid. I think
you are rather brave for telling me and for
making the decision to talk about this
(Intervention: providing expertise).
Wayne: I feel relieved but really scared, that is
the reason I was going to leave when you
mentioned the blood test. I don’t know what
to do. It was my fault. I don’t even remember
most of it. I wasn’t like this before Katrina, I
don’t know what has happened to me since
then, I am a mess (Patterns of response:
Being situated).
Nurse: I realize you are scared, but the first step
is setting up a time for you to get an HIV
blood test, if you feel you are okay with that
(Intervention: Setting goals). I have the
phone number of a local clinic, we can call
together and schedule an appointment for
you. There are counselors who will be there
to support you through the process (Interven-
tion: Providing resources). You will not be
alone. Are you still engaging in unprotected
sex with other partners or using drugs
that place you or someone else at risk
(Intervention: Providing expertise)?
Wayne: No, I haven’t done any of those things
in over a year. I stopped hanging out with
that crowd and I don’t have any desire to go
back to doing any of those things (Patterns of
response: Awareness).
Nurse: I believe it is important for you to explore
your feelings and experiences before and after
Hurricane Katrina in a safe environment. I
think it would be helpful for you to meet with
a counselor in addition to attending a couple
of support groups. We can talk about your
options and decide together how you would
like to move forward, does that sound like a
plan (Intervention: Mobilizing support and
setting goals)? Are you close to anyone you feel
would be supportive right now (Intervention:
Assessing support systems)?
Wayne: I don’t want anyone else to know about
this for right now, if that is okay? I would
prefer to see a counselor and maybe go to a
support group but not with anyone else.
Thank you so much for listening to me and
for taking the time to help me.
Nurse: You are welcome. Thank you for sharing
your experience with me, for being brave
enough to talk about what you are going
through, for trusting me and allowing me
to support you as you journey through this
process.
Patterns of Response
The nature of Wayne’s transition experience can
be gleaned through his dialogue with the nurse.
Process patterns are assessed at different points
during the transition experience while outcome
patterns are assessed at a point determined to
be at the end of the transition process. Wayne’s
responses indicate he is still engaged in the
transition process despite the 7 years that had
passed since Hurricane Katrina. He informs the
nurse that he no longer hangs out with the
wrong crowd or participates in risky behaviors
such as unprotected sex. Wayne’s willingness to
stop engaging in risk-taking behaviors indicates
a conscious choice to modify his behavior.
Additionally, he opens up to the nurse about
taking a home HIV test and decides to take a
HIV blood test, indicating an active search for
information by which to address his concerns.
Both modifying his behavior and seeking out
information suggests Wayne is actively involved
or engaged in the process of transition. The
nurse is aware that he is consistently comparing
his actions using a before Katrina and after
Katrina perspective as a way to create new
meaning from his experience or ‘locate’ himself.
He is attempting to understand his new way of
being in the world by comparing it to his old
way of being in the world. These comparisons
also provide Wayne with a way of “situating”
himself or a way to assist him with explaining
why he engaged in the high-risk behaviors. The
nurse inquires about Wayne’s family and
friends to determine his support system. Wayne
indicates that he does not have a close relation-
ship with either his family or friends at this
time. He seeks support from the nurse by
expressing his concerns and fears about the
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 376
CHAPTER 20 • Transitions Theory 377
Practice Exemplar by Diane Lee Gullett, MSN, MPH cont.
HIV testing. Additionally, he demonstrates a
willingness to receive support by agreeing to at-
tend groups and see a counselor. Acquiring
confidence is usually a progressive movement in
the transition process marked by increasing
confidence in dealing with the triggering event.
This is accomplished by developing strategies
for prioritizing needs and developing a sense of
wisdom generated through the lived experience.
This can be seen in Wayne’s decision to make
an appointment to take an HIV blood test and
seek support.
The nurse will assess for completion of the
transition process when Wayne is able to
demonstrate outcome responses including
mastery, fluid and integrative identity, re-
sourcefulness, health interactions, and per-
ceived well-being. He may demonstrate
mastery by integrating the skills he previously
had in order to be an honors student in inter-
national business with the new skills he devel-
ops to positively cope with the changes
brought about by Hurricane Katrina. A fluid
and integrative identity may be assessed by
asking Wayne to describe his previous quality
of life compared with his current quality of
life following intervention strategies. Wayne
would demonstrate healthy interaction and
thereby affirm the completion of his transition
process by developing and maintaining mean-
ingful and supportive relationships.
Intervention Framework
The goal of interventions is to facilitate and
inspire healthy process and outcome re-
sponses. These interventions include clarifying
roles, meanings, and expertise; identifying
milestones; mobilizing support; and debrief-
ing. The nurse dialogues and interacts with
Wayne to clarifying his statements as a way
of determining the meaning he attributes to
Hurricane Katrina. This interaction also as-
sists the nurse in determining where in the
transition process Wayne is; for instance, the
nurse is able to determine that Wayne re-
mains in the process of transitioning his
experience. Identifying the process Wayne
uses to define and redefine his various roles
including his new one as a potentially HIV-
positive patient; his at-risk ones, including
partaking in drugs, alcohol, and unprotected
sex; and his old ones as college student offer
insight about his coping strategies and pat-
terns of response. Milestones or critical points
are periods of heightened vulnerability in
which a person experiences difficulty with
self-care. Although Wayne’s story is rife with
critical points, the one the nurse is most im-
mediately concerned with is Wayne’s symp-
toms of depression and his anxiety over taking
an HIV blood test. Recognizing that Wayne
has a limited support system, the nurse’s in-
terventions to address his feelings of depres-
sion are aimed at identifying a counselor and
encouraging participation in reference or sup-
port groups. To address Wayne’s anxiety and
uncertainty over taking an HIV blood test the
nurse provides supportive dialogue, expertise
about where to get tested, offers to schedule
an appointment at a local clinic, discusses the
process of taking the test, and identifies a
counselor. Debriefing serves to provide con-
text and meaning about Wayne’s experiences
with Hurricane Katrina as a traumatic change
trigger. The nurse uses clarifying questions
and authentic presence to encourage Wayne
to share his personal experiences, and in doing
so, Wayne is able to find meaning in his
experience.
Summary
Using authentic presence and awareness in this
nursing situation created a space where Wayne
and I could connect and develop a relationship
grounded in trust and caring. This caring rela-
tionship provided an opportunity for Wayne to
share his experiences, fears, and anxieties with
me. A caring-based philosophy of nursing
guided by Meleis’s transitions theory served as
the lens through which I was able to recognize
Wayne’s symptoms as critical points or mile-
stones rather than medical diagnoses. I was also
able to understand Hurricane Katrina as a
major change trigger in Wayne’s life, which
guided my nursing interventions. Without this,
Wayne could easily have left the clinic not
Continued
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 377
378 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Practice Exemplar by Diane Lee Gullett, MSN, MPH cont.
receiving the care he needed, resulting in de-
layed testing for HIV, prolonged illness, and
perhaps suicide. Through clarifying questions,
I was able to gain insight into the meaning
of Wayne’s lived experience with Hurricane
Katrina and identify his current and past cop-
ing strategies for adjusting to these changes.
Not recognizing Katrina as a change trigger
may have led me to assume Wayne’s symptoms
were a result of other factors in his life. Wayne
has experienced multiple transitions in the
7 years since Hurricane Katrina, resulting in
many unhealthy outcomes. His transition from
living and attending school in N.O. to having
to do the same in Baton Rouge resulted in him
going from an honors student to a college
dropout. His transition from living in N.O.
before Katrina to living in N.O. after Katrina
caused Wayne to have an emotional and men-
tal breakdown. Without appropriate interven-
tions or support, Wayne was unprepared
for the reality of the multiple changes in his
life following Hurricane Katrina. Wayne re-
sponded with ineffective coping strategies
identified as milestones or critical points and
included unprotected homosexual sex, using
drugs and alcohol, and dropping out of
school. These responses generated unhealthy
outcomes manifested in Wayne’s current
complaints of depression, insomnia, lethargy,
and possibly HIV. Recognizing Wayne’s cur-
rent symptoms as a critical point, I was able
to develop appropriate nursing interventions.
These included debriefing, providing re-
sources, and setting goals. Contemporary ap-
proaches to disaster remain, dominated by
biomedical models of care grounded in objec-
tive rather than subjective perspectives. This
approach may work in the short term when
the physical needs are paramount; however,
when the needs of individuals transitioning a
disaster extend beyond the physical, biomed-
ical approaches will fail to address their more
holistic needs. Preventing unhealthy out-
comes such as those Wayne experienced will
require a more holistic approach to nursing in
disaster. Framing individual and collective re-
sponses to natural disaster using a nursing
theoretical lens such as Meleis’s transition
theory serves as a foundation for generating
disciplinary specific knowledge and research
on nursing in disaster.
■ Summary
Transitions theory continues to be used to ad-
vance nursing knowledge about the experience
and the responses of the many transitions that
individuals, families, communities, and organ-
izations encounter as well as the experiences,
the responses, and the therapeutics that nurses
use, translating the theory to policy, research,
and evidence-based practice and better quality
care in the 21st century. It is for its potential,
its utility, and for the research programs that
have and could emanate from it that we have
defined nursing as “facilitating transitions to
enhance a sense of well-being” (Meleis &
Trangenstein, 1994).
References
Benner, P., Tanner, C., & Chesla, C. (1996). Expertise
in nursing practice: Caring, clinical judgment and ethics.
New York: Springer.
Blum, K., & Sherman, D. (2010). Understanding the
experience of caregivers: A focus on transitions.
Seminars in Oncology Nursing, 26(4), 243–258.
Bridges, W. (1980). Making sense of life’s changes:
Transitions. Menlo Park, CA: Addison-Wesley.
Bridges, W. (1991). Managing transitions: Making the
most of changes. Menlo Park, CA: Addision, Wesley.
Carper, B. A. (1978). Fundamental patterns of knowing
in nursing. Advances in Nursing Science, 1(1), 13–24.
Chaboyer, W. (2006). Intensive care and beyond: Im-
proving the transitional experiences for critically
ill patients and their families. Intensive and Critical
Care Nursing, 22, 187–193.
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 378
CHAPTER 20 • Transitions Theory 379
Chiang, L., Chen, W., Dai, Y., & Ho, Y. (2012) The
effectiveness of telehealth care on caregiver burden,
mastery of stress, and family function among
family caregivers of heart failure patients: A quasi-
experimental study. International Journal of Nursing
Studies.
Chick, N., & Meleis, A. I. (1986). Transitions: A nurs-
ing concern. In P. L. Chinn (Ed.), Nursing research
methodology (pp. 237–257). Boulder, CO: Aspen.
Christakis, N. A., & Allison, P. D. (2006). Mortality
after hospitalization of a spouse. New England
Journal of Medicine, 354(7), 719–730.
Clayton State University. (2012). Program
philosophy—School of Nursing. Retrieved from
www.clayton.edu/health/nursing/philosophy
Duggleby, W., Penz, K., Goodridge, D., Wilson, D.,
Leipert, B., Berry, P., et al. (2010). The transition
experience of rural older persons with advanced
cancer and their families: A grounded theory study.
BMC Palliative Care, 9, 5.
Fex, A., Gullvi, F., Ek, A., & Soderhamn, O. (2010).
Health-illness transition among persons using
advanced medical technology at home. Scandinavian
Journal of Caring Studies, 25, 253–261.
Goyal, D., Wang, E., Shen, J., Wong, E., & Palaniap-
pan, L. (2012). Clinically identified postpartum
depression in Asian American mothers. Journal of
Obstetric, Gynecologic, and Neonatal Nursing
(JOGNN), 41(3), 408–416.
Halding, A., & Heggdal, K.(2011). Patients’ experiences
of health transitions in pulmonary rehabilitation.
Nursing Inquiry, 19(4), 345–356.
Hall, J. M., Stevens, P. E., & Meleis, A. I. (1994).
Marginalization: A guiding concept for valuing
diversity in nursing knowledge development.
Advances in Nursing Science, 16(4), 23–41.
Hattar-Pollara, M. (2010). Developmental transitions.
In A. Meleis (Ed.), Transitions theory: Middle-range
and situation specific theories in nursing research and
practice (pp. 87–94). New York: Springer.
Huff, C. (2006). Emotional debriefing: Hospitals give
staff new ways to cope with stress and sadness at
work. Hospitals and Health Networks, 80(8), 38.
Im, E. (2008). The situation-specific theory of pain
experience for Asian American cancer patients.
Advances in Nursing Science, 31(4), 319–331.
Im, E. (2010). A situation-specific theory of Asian immi-
grant women’s menopausal symptom experience in
the U.S. Advances in Nursing Science, 33(2), 143–157.
Kralik, D., Visentin, K., & van Loon, A. (2006). Transi-
tion: A literature review. Journal of Advanced Nursing,
55(3), 320–329.
Kübler-Ross, E. (1969). On death and dying. New York:
Touchstone.
Larkin, P. J., Dierckx de Casterlé, B., & Schotsmans,
P. (2007). Transition towards end of life in palliative
care: An exploration of its meaning for advanced
cancer patients in Europe. Journal of Palliative Care,
23(2), 69–79
Lindemann, E. (1979). Beyond grief: Studies in crisis
intervention. New York: Jason Aronson.
Marnocha, S. K., Bergstrom, M., & Dempsey, L. F.
(2011). The lived experience of perimenopause and
menopause. Contemporary Nurse, 37(2), 229–240.
Meleis, A. I. (1975). Role insufficiency and role
supplementation: A conceptual framework.
Nursing Research, 24, 264–271.
Meleis, A. I. (1985). Theoretical nursing: Development
and progress. Philadelphia, PA: J.B. Lippincott
Publishers.
Meleis, A. I. (1991). Theoretical nursing: Development and
progress (2nd ed.). Philadelphia, PA: J. B. Lipincott
Publishers.
Meleis, A. I. (1997). Theoretical nursing: Development and
progress (3rd ed.). Philadelphia, PA: Lipincott
Williams & Wilkins.
Meleis, A. I. (2007). Theoretical nursing: Development and
progress (4th ed.). Philadelphia, PA: Lipincott
Williams & Wilkins.
Meleis, A. I. (2010). Transitions theory: Middle-range
and situation-specific theories in nursing research and
practice. New York: Springer.
Meleis, A. I. (2012). Theoretical nursing: Development
and progress (5th ed.). Philadelphia, PA: Lippincott
Williams & Wilkins.
Meleis, A. I., Sawyer L., Im, E., Schumacher, K., &
Messias, D. (2000). Experiencing transitions: An
emerging middle range theory. Advances in Nursing
Science, 23(1), 12–28.
Meleis, A. I., & Swendsen, L. (1978). Role supplemen-
tation: An empirical test of a nursing intervention.
Nursing Research, 27, 11–18.
Meleis, A. I., & Trangenstein, P. A. (1994). Facilitating
transitions: Redefinition of a nursing mission.
Nursing Outlook, 42(6), 255–259.
Mendes, A. I., Bastos, F., & Paiva, A. (2010). The
person with heart failure: Factors that facilitate/
impede the health/disease transition. Revista de
Enfermagem Referência [Journal of Nursing Reference],
III(2), 7–16.
Mercer, R. T. (2004). Becoming a mother versus
maternal role attainment. Nursing Scholarship,
36(3), 226–232.
Messias, D. K. H. (1997). Narratives of transnational
migration, work, and health: The lived experiences of
Brazilian women in the United States. Unpublished
doctoral dissertation, School of Nursing, University
of California, San Francisco.
Munhall, P. L. (1993). “Unknowing”: Toward another
pattern of knowing in nursing. Nursing Outlook, 41,
125–128.
Naylor, M. (2002). Transitional care of older adults. In
P. Archbold & B. Stewart (Eds.), Annual review of
nursing research (Vol. 20, pp. 127–147). New York:
Springer.
Petch, A. (2009). Managing transition: Support for
individuals at key points of change. Bristol: The
Policy Press.
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 379
380 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Polanyi, M. (1962) Personal knowledge. London:
Routledge and Kegan Paul.
Rew, L., Tyler, D., & Hannah, D. (2012). Adolescents’
concerns as they transition through high school.
Advances in Nursing Science, 35(3), 205–221.
Sapega, S. (2012). Those first days in clinical. Penn
Medicine, XXIII(3), 12–14
Sarvimaki, A. (1994). Science and tradition in the
nursing discipline. Scandinavian Journal of Caring
Sciences, 8(3), 137–142.
Schumacher, K., & Meleis, A. I. (1994). Transitions: A
central concept in nursing. Image: Journal of Nursing
Scholarship, 26(2), 119–127.
Schumacher, K. L., Jones, P. S., & Meleis, A. I. (1999).
Helping elderly persons in transition: A framework
for research and practice. In E. A. Swanson & T.
Tripp-Reimer (Eds.), Life transitions in the older
adult: Issues for nurses and other health professionals
(pp. 1-26). New York: Springer.
Shin, H., & Whitetraut, R. (2007). The conceptual
structure of transition to motherhood in the
neonatal intensive care unit. Journal of Advanced
Nursing, 58(1), 90–98.
Steele, A. M., & Beadle, M. (2003). A survey of
postnatal debriefing. Journal of Advanced Nursing,
43(2), 130–136.
Stevens, P. E., Hall, J. M., & Meleis, A. I. (1992).
Examining vulnerability of women clerical workers
from five ethnic racial groups. Western Journal of
Nursing Research, 14(6), 754–774.
Swendsen, L., Meleis, A. I., & Jones, D. (1978). Role
supplementation for new parents: A role mastery
plan. The American Journal of Maternal Child
Nursing, 3, 84–91.
van Staa, A. (2010). Book review: “Managing transition:
Support for individuals at key points of change.”
International Journal of Integrated Care,
10(22), 1–2.
3312_Ch20_357-380 26/12/14 6:00 PM Page 380
Chapter 21Katharine Kolcaba’s
Comfort Theory
KATHARINE KOLCABA
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Theory
Application of the Theory
Practice Exemplar
References
Appendix A
381
Introducing the Theorist
Katharine Kolcaba was born and educated
in Cleveland, Ohio. In 1965, she received a
diploma in nursing and practiced part time
for many years in the operating room, medical–
surgical units, long-term care, and home care
before returning to school. In 1987, she gradu-
ated with the first RN to MSN class at the
Frances Payne Bolton School of Nursing, Case
Western Reserve University (CWRU), with a
specialty in gerontology. While attending grad-
uate school, Kolcaba maintained a head nurse
position on a dementia unit. In the context of
that unit, she began theorizing about comfort.
After graduating with her master’s degree
in nursing, Kolcaba joined the faculty at the
University of Akron (UA) College of Nursing,
where her clinical expertise was gerontology
and dementia care. She returned to CWRU to
pursue her doctorate in nursing on a part-time
basis while teaching full time. Over the next 10
years, she used course work from her doctoral
program to further develop her theory. During
that time, Kolcaba published a framework for
dementia care (1992a), diagrammed the aspects
of comfort (1991), operationalized comfort as an
outcome of care (1992b), contextualized comfort
in a middle range theory (1994), tested the
theory in several intervention studies (Kolcaba
& Fox, 1999; Kolcaba, 2003; Kolcaba, Dowd,
Steiner, & Mitzel, 2004; Kolcaba, Tilton,
& Drouin, 2006; Dowd, Kolcaba, Steiner, &
Fashinpaur, 2007), and further refined the the-
ory to include hospital-based outcomes (2001).
She has an extensive series of publications to
document each step in the process, most of
which have been compiled in her book Comfort
Theory and Practice (2003). Many publications
and comfort assessments also are available on
her website at www.TheComfortLine.com.
Katharine Kolcaba
3312_Ch21_381-392 26/12/14 10:41 AM Page 381
Kolcaba taught nursing at UA for 22 years
and is now an associate professor emerita.
Kolcaba still teaches her web-based theory
course once a year, and she represents her own
company, The Comfort Line, as a consultant.
In this capacity, she works with health-care
agencies and hospitals that choose to apply
comfort theory on an institution-wide basis.
She also is founder and member of her local
parish nurse program and is a member of
the American Nurses Association and Sigma
Theta Tau. Kolcaba continues to work with
students at all levels and with nurses who are
conducting comfort studies. She resides in the
Cleveland area with her husband, and near her
two daughters, their children, and her mother.
One other daughter resides in Chicago.
Overview of the Theory
In comfort theory (CT), comfort is a noun or an
adjective and an outcome of intentional,
patient/family focused, quality care. Despite
everyone’s familiarity with the idea of comfort,
it is a complex term that has several meanings
and usages in ordinary language. The use of
comfort as a noun and an outcome is specific
to CT and different from its alternative us-
ages as a verb, adverb (as in comfortably), and
process (Kolcaba, 1995). From the Oxford
English Dictionary, Kolcaba learned that
the original definition of comfort meant “to
strengthen greatly.” Her assumptions were
that (1) the need for comfort is basic, (2) per-
sons experience comfort holistically, (3) self-
comforting measures can be healthy or
unhealthy, and (4) enhanced comfort (when
achieved in healthy ways) leads to greater
productivity.
From the nursing literature, Kolcaba used
three nursing theories to describe three distinct
types of comfort (Kolcaba, 2003). Relief was
synthesized from the work of Orlando
(1961/1990), who stated that nurses relieved
the needs expressed by patients. Ease was syn-
thesized from the work of Henderson (1978),
who described 13 basic functions of humans
that needed to be maintained for homeostasis.
Transcendence was derived from Paterson and
Zderad (1976), who believed that patients
could rise above their difficulties with the help
of nurses. These types of comfort were consis-
tent with usages in nursing textbooks.
The four contexts in which comfort is expe-
rienced by patients are physical, psychospiritual,
sociocultural, and environmental and came
from a further review of literature regarding
holism in nursing (Kolcaba, 1991, 2003). When
these four contexts of experience are juxtaposed
with the three types of comfort, a taxonomic
structure (TS), or grid, is created that covers the
nursing meaning of comfort as a patient out-
come. This TS, with definitions of each type
and context of comfort, provides a map of the
content of comfort so that nurses can use it to
pattern their care for each patient and family
member. Kolcaba’s technical definition of the
outcome of comfort is: The immediate experi-
ence of being strengthened when needs for
relief, ease, and transcendence are addressed
in four contexts of experience. Figure 21-1
contains the TS of comfort with the correspon-
ding definitions of relief, ease, transcendence
and the physical, psychospiritual, environmen-
tal, and sociocultural contexts.
Other uses of the TS of comfort are as
follows: (1) for determining the existence and
extent of unmet comfort needs in patients or
family members; (2) for designing comforting
interventions, which often can be “bundled” in
a single patient interaction; and (3) for creating
measurements of holistic comfort for documen-
tation in practice and research; such measure-
ments would be conducted before and after
comfort interventions and/or interactions.
A place to note the nature and time of the nurs-
ing intervention next to baseline and subsequent
comfort measurements is essential in medical
records. These strategies are discussed further in
a later section of this chapter.
One way to think about the grid is that com-
fort is an umbrella outcome that entails relief
from discomforts such as anxiety, pain, environ-
mental stressors, and/or social isolation. Because
the TS represents a holistic definition of com-
fort, the cells on the grid are interrelated; and
as a whole, comfort interventions directed to
one part of the grid have effects on all parts of
the grid. Total comfort at any one time is also
greater than the sum of its individual parts.
382 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch21_381-392 26/12/14 10:41 AM Page 382
Therefore, comfort interventions to treat anxiety
also may reduce the dosage of analgesia needed
for adequate pain relief. On a comfort contin-
uum, the concept of total comfort (as much as can
be expected given the circumstances) is at one
extreme end, and suffering is at the other end.
Propositions of Comfort Theory
CT contains three intuitive parts that can be
applied or tested separately or as a whole. The
first part states that comforting interventions,
when effective, result in increased comfort for
recipients (patients and families), compared
with a preintervention baseline. Increased
comfort is the immediate desired outcome for
this kind of care. Comfort interventions
address basic human needs, such as rest,
homeostasis, therapeutic communication, and
viewing patients holistically. These comfort
interventions are often nontechnical and
complement delivery of technical care. Care
providers, such as nurses, may also be consid-
ered recipients if the institution makes a com-
mitment to improving comfort in its work
setting (discussed later).
When comfort is not enhanced to the fullest
extent possible, nurses consider intervening
variables for possible explanations as to why
comfort interventions did not work. Abusive
homes, lack of financial resources, devastating
diagnoses, or cognitive/psychological impair-
ments may render ineffective the most appropri-
ate interventions and comforting actions. The
aspect of transcendence, however, guides nurses
to help patients “rise above” or be inspired to
achieve mutually determined goals regardless
of life circumstances. Nurses who practice
CT never give up “being with” and inspiring
their patients. Thus, this focus on comfort is
proactive, energized, intentional, and longed for
by recipients of care in all settings.
The second part of CT states that increased
comfort of recipients results in their being
strengthened for their tasks ahead, which are
called health-seeking behaviors (HSBs). HSBs
are subsequent recipient goals and are negoti-
ated between nurses and the recipients. In the
practice of nursing administration, when the
intended recipients are bedside nurses, HSBs
are negotiated with nursing staff.
The third part of CT states that increased
engagement in HSBs results in increased
institutional integrity (InI). Enhanced InI
strengthens the institution and its ability to
gather evidence for best practices and best
policies. Best practices and policies lead to
quality care, which, in many ways, benefits the
“bottom financial line” of the institution.
Kolcaba believes that nurses already know
how and want to practice comforting care and
that it can be easily incorporated into every
nursing action. Many nurses deliver comforting
care intuitively but do not document its total
effects on patients as enhanced comfort. The
CHAPTER 21 • Katharine Kolcaba’s Comfort Theory 383
Physical
Psychospiritual
Environmental
Sociocultural
Pain
Anxiety
Relief Ease Transendence
Type of comfort:
Relief: the state of having a specific
comfort need met.
Ease: the state of calm or contentment.
Transcendence: the state in which one can rise above
problems or pain.
Context in which comfort occurs:
Physical: pertaining to bodily sensations,
homeostatic mechanisms, immune
function, etc.
Psychospiritual: pertaining to internal awareness of self,
including esteem, identity, sexuality,
meaning in one’s life, and one’s
understood relationship to a higher
order or being.
Environmental: pertaining to the external background
of human experience (temperature,
light, sound, odor, color, furniture,
landscape, etc.)
Sociocultural: pertaining to interpersonal, family, and
societal relationships (finances,
teaching, health care personnel, etc.)
Also to family traditions, rituals, and
religious practices.
Adapted with permission from Kolcaba, K. & Fisher, E.
A holistic perspective on comfort care as an advance directive.
Crit Care Nurs Q,18(4):66-76, (c)1996. Aspen Publishers.
Fig 21 • 1 Taxonomic structure of comfort
(or comfort grid).
3312_Ch21_381-392 26/12/14 10:41 AM Page 383
explicit focus on and documentation of this type
of holistic care is called comfort management
and, as shown in the TS, includes more than
relief of pain or anxiety. Thus, when nurses
adopt CT as a professional practice model, they
are using a simple pattern for individualized
care that is efficient, creative, and satisfying to
themselves and to recipients of their care. When
enhanced comfort is documented, nurses
can also demonstrate their real contributions to
better institutional outcomes such as higher
patient satisfaction, fewer readmissions, or
shorter length of stay. The diagram of CT
shows the relationships between these simple
concepts (Fig. 21-2). Definitions of the con-
cepts follow the diagram.
Theoretical Definitions for
Diagram Concepts
In the context of comfort theory, health-care
needs are defined as needs for comfort, arising
from stressful health-care situations that cannot
be met by recipients’ traditional support systems.
They include physical, psychospiritual, sociocul-
tural, and environmental needs made apparent
through monitoring and verbal or nonverbal
reports, needs related to pathophysiological pa-
rameters, needs for education and support, and
needs for financial counseling and intervention.
Comfort interventions are defined as in-
tentional actions designed to address specific
comfort needs of recipients, including physio-
logical, social, cultural, financial, psychological,
spiritual, environmental, and physical inter-
ventions. Within these contexts of experience,
there are three types of comfort interventions
(described later): technical, coaching, and
comfort food for the soul.
Intervening variables are defined as interact-
ing forces that influence recipients’ perceptions
of total comfort. These consist of variables such
as past experiences, age, attitude, emotional
state, support system, prognosis, finances, edu-
cation, cultural background, and the totality of
elements in recipients’ experience. They are not
easily influenced by nurses.
Comfort was defined technically earlier in this
chapter. It is the state that is experienced imme-
diately by recipients of comfort interventions. It
entails the holistic experience of being strength-
ened through having comfort needs addressed.
The concept of health-seeking behaviors was
developed by Dr. Rozella Schlotfeldt (1975)
and represents the broad category of subsequent
outcomes related to the pursuit of health.
Schlotfeldt stated that HSBs could be internal
or external. She was ahead of her time in think-
ing that a peaceful death could also be an HSB
384 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Health
care
needs
Health-
seeking
behaviors
Nursing
interventions
Intervening
variables
Enhanced
comfort
Institutional
integrity
Best
practices
Best
policies
External
behaviors
Internal
behaviors
Peaceful
death
+ +
Fig 21 • 2 Conceptual framework for comfort theory.
3312_Ch21_381-392 26/12/14 10:41 AM Page 384
(Schlotfeldt, 1975). Realistic HSBs are deter-
mined by recipients of care in collaboration with
their health-care team.
Institutional integrity is defined as those
corporations, communities, schools, hospitals,
regions, states, and countries that possess
qualities of being complete, whole, sound,
upright, appealing, ethical, and sincere. When
an institution displays this type of integrity,
it can produce valuable evidence for best prac-
tices and best policies. Best practices are
health-care interventions that produce the
best possible patient and family outcomes
based on empirical evidence. Best policies
are institutional or regional policies, ranging
from basic protocols for procedures and
medical conditions to systems for access and
delivery of health care. Best policies are also
determined from empirical evidence.
As stated previously, the diagram and
specific definitions for the concepts in CT
provide a pattern and practical rationale for
practicing comfort management. This kind
of care is individualized, efficient, holistic,
and therapeutic. Importantly, the nurturing
aspect of nursing provides the altruistic mo-
tivation for practicing comfort management.
It is the traditional mission and passion of
nursing (Kolcaba, 2003; Morse, 1992).
But the practical rationale is important at
the institutional level because without
administrative support for optimal staffing
and employment practices, nurses often
cannot give the kind of care that drew them
to the profession.
For teaching and learning purposes, care
plans based on CT are provided on Kolcaba’s
website and in her book (Kolcaba, 2003). One
is for patients, and one is for patients and
family members, as defined by the patient.
(Note: For teaching and learning, it is not
necessary to distinguish among relief, ease,
and transcendence when assessing and inter-
vening for unmet comfort needs.) Institu-
tional outcomes can be included in the care
plans even if these data are not accessible to
students and beginning nurses (Kolcaba,
1995). These care plans can also be applied in
home care and in long-term care.
Application of the Theory
in Practice
As noted earlier, according to CT, there are
three types of comforting interventions: techni-
cal, coaching, and comfort food for the soul.
Technical interventions are those that are speci-
fied by other disciplines or by nursing protocols;
they include medications, treatments, monitor-
ing schedules, insertion of lines, and so forth.
For patients, competency in the administration
and documentation of technical interventions is
the minimum expectation for nurses. Coaching
consists of supportive nursing actions, active
listening, referrals to other members of the
health-care team, advocacy, reassurance, and so
forth. Comfort food for the soul comprises those
extra special, holistic, and more time-consuming
nursing interventions such as back or hand
massage, guided imagery, music or art therapy,
a walk outside, or special arrangements for
family members. The latter two types of inter-
ventions require considerably more expertise and
confidence of nurses and are what patients most
remember. And they are what Benner (1984)
would ascribe to “expert” nurses.
However, most nurses focus on technical in-
terventions first and, when time permits, imple-
ment coaching techniques. Interestingly,
charting usually accounts only for technical
interventions and the effects of analgesia; there
are no places in traditional hospital records to
record the more important healing interven-
tions. But patients rarely remember the techni-
cal interventions; the important interventions to
patients and their families are those that are not
documented, such as coaching and comfort
food for the soul, the most important work of
expert nurses. Thus, there is a perpetual discon-
nect between legal charting and actions that
patients want and need from their nurses and
which we claim to be the essence of nursing. It
is no wonder that, when pressed, nurses cannot
describe the impact they make with patients and
their families—coaching and comfort food
interventions are not valued by administrators
and are not even visible in patient care records.
This can result in the value of nursing being
understated or even invisible.
CHAPTER 21 • Katharine Kolcaba’s Comfort Theory 385
3312_Ch21_381-392 26/12/14 10:41 AM Page 385
CT provides the language and rationale to
once again claim and document essential nurs-
ing activities that are most beneficial to patients
and family members in stressful health-care sit-
uations. It is also important to remember that
the outcome of enhanced comfort is positive
outcome and a true measure of quality care,
rather than a measure of what quality care is not,
such as the currently measured outcomes of
nosocomial infections, falls, decubitus ulcers,
medication errors, and failure to rescue. (Would
you want to go to a hospital that was looking
only at negative outcomes such as medication
errors or “failures to rescue”?)
How to Be a Nurse
CT guides nurses to detect comfort needs of pa-
tients and families that are not being addressed
and to develop interventions to meet those
needs. Their caring actions are intuitive, but in
this theory, caring is a comfort intervention in
and of itself. CT describes how to care and how
to BE a nurse, what is important to patients and
families, and factors that facilitate healing. In
addition, all technical nursing interventions are
delivered in a comforting way.
Nurses and patients want to experience in-
tentional and meaningful moments with each
other and with family members, the kind that
patients might call wow moments. (“Wow! I’ll
always remember that nurse.”) Nurses usually
sense when this happens, and these instances
are sustaining, satisfying, and profound for
them as well as for their patients. But nurses
often fail to understand and share how the mo-
ment intentionally came to be created, especially
if they practice without a theory. These special
instances require appropriate theories to add
both personal and disciplinary structure and
meaning to such experiences (Chinn, 1998).
CT is one such theory and can give structure
to these experiences. CT states that the process
of comforting a patient entails the intention
to comfort, to be present, and to deliver com-
forting interventions based on the patient’s and
loved ones’ unmet comfort needs (Kolcaba,
2003; Kolcaba online at http://www.thecom-
fortline.com/). If the patient needs time to
voice concerns and questions, the nurse listens
attentively and provides culturally appropriate
encouragement and body language (a comfort-
ing intervention). The nurse knows exactly why
and when to do this, because he or she is tuned
into the whole person as patient and because the
nurse wants to provide comfort, to soothe in
times of distress and sorrow. Such an explana-
tion of how to be a nurse is lacking in many
other theories.
Institutional Advocacy
It is not enough for institution administrators to
state that they want nurses and other care
providers to practice comforting care—they
need to implement documentation and rein-
forcement strategies to ensure this is done and
to show that they value this kind of care. If
administrators do not take on this responsibility,
practicing nurses can be self-advocates and begin
to document comforting interventions and their
effects in narrative charting. Whether top-down
and/or from the grassroots, the institutional ideal
is for health-care institutions to provide ways in
which comfort needs of patients and family
members are routinely charted, beginning
with baseline comfort levels. Comforting inter-
ventions are described and implemented, and
comfort levels are reassessed and charted. Mod-
ifications to the interventions are made until
comfort levels are sufficiently increased. Prefer-
ences of patients and families are honored
wherever possible. In appropriate settings, com-
fort contracts (Appendix A) can be instituted
and followed throughout a defined clinical
situation such as surgery, labor and delivery, or
an acute psychiatric episode.
According to CT, technical interventions
should be documented as usual (often on a
checklist including times), but methods of
intentional caring also should be documented—
in the same way that administration of pain
medication is noted in two places. There are
many suggestions for documentation on the
instrument section at Kolcaba’s website, includ-
ing a verbal rating scale, a numeric diagram,
comfort daisies for children, a comfort behaviors
checklist for nonverbal or unresponsive patients,
and several questionnaires about patient comfort
for different research settings. These instruments
386 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch21_381-392 26/12/14 10:41 AM Page 386
can be downloaded from the website and used
in practice and/or research, without permission
because the website is in the public domain.
The address is www.TheComfortLine.com.
In addition to providing methods for doc-
umentation of comfort needs and comforting
measures, there are other ways that institutions
can demonstrate their commitment to comfort
management. These include building comfort
management into orientation, in-service pro-
grams, performance reviews, and methods for
nursing assignments (based in part on comfort
needs of patients and family members).
Institutional Awards
Institutions have adopted CT to enhance
nurses’ work environments, such as in the
quest for national recognition including
Magnet Status, the Baldrich Award, and the
Beacon Award. Many institutions discover
that the application process for these types of
awards is simplified when a professional prac-
tice model is adopted. The main benefit of
doing so is that employees are on the “same
page”—in the case of CT, comforting patients
and family members in their own personalized
styles and capacities. Moreover, and perhaps
most important, administrative commitment
to CT includes sufficient staffing levels in all
departments to support this type of holistic
health care. A large hospital system that
adopted CT to undergird their application for
Magnet Status and was successful in achieving
Magnet Status shortly thereafter is Southern
New Hampshire Medical Center (SNHMC;
Kolcaba, Tilton, & Drouin, 2006).
When SNHMC decided to apply for
Magnet Status, nurses from middle manage-
ment formed a committee and reviewed several
nursing theories. They chose CT because it
most accurately reflected their values and goals.
Kolcaba was contacted to arrange a consultative
visit, which occurred after a sufficient time to
prepare the other departments, including upper
administrative levels, for the visit.
As part of this consultation, Kolcaba and the
chief nursing officer visited all departments.
They requested suggestions from the staff for
ideas that would increase their comfort at work.
The many suggestions that were given came to
be added to comfort “wish lists” on each unit.
Another strategy adopted during this visit con-
sisted of brief instructions about designing and
implementing small “comfort studies” specific to
each unit and to common clinical problems.
The diagram of CT (see Fig. 21-2) defines the
research process when comfort studies are un-
dertaken, often a requirement for national
awards. Any comforting intervention that is im-
plemented by nurses, such as a “Comfort Cart”
or hand massage demonstrate to evaluators how
the practice model (CT) is implemented and
that the nurses are conducting basic research.
Strategies for publicizing the results of these
studies as well as the institutional commitment
to comfort management were also suggested.
The Meaning of Comfort Theory
for Practice
Kolcaba routinely asks nurses and students in her
audiences about their experiences during past
hospitalizations, either as a patient or a family
member. She asks if they remember any of their
nurses, and if so, what do they remember? The
stories that emerge are usually about nurses who
demonstrated small, nontechnical, but very
comforting acts of compassion and understand-
ing. Examples of these interventions include the
following: a brief back massage, helping a child
make a phone call, sitting beside an anxious pa-
tient, making eye contact during an interaction,
gently encouraging ambulation, listening atten-
tively to role-change issues, holding a dying pa-
tient’s hand, washing a patient’s hair, making a
family member comfortable during an overnight
stay, and so forth. Patients remember these types
of interventions for years after a stressful health-
care episode because emotions run high and
kind encounters are precious. Each is an example
of a holistic comfort intervention that has greater
positive effects on the patients’ total comfort
than could be imagined by the caregiver. These
comforting interventions are examples of “wow
moments” for receivers, and the exchange also
renews the givers of such acts. Moreover, such
comforting interventions can be delivered by any
member of the health-care team or department
within the context of their job description.
CHAPTER 21 • Katharine Kolcaba’s Comfort Theory 387
3312_Ch21_381-392 26/12/14 10:41 AM Page 387
How Comfort Theory Lives in Practice
Best Practices
Currently, there is administrative interest in
improving the “patient experience”—a factor
that typically is measured by items on patient
satisfaction instruments, the results of which
are posted on public websites. The quality of
the “patient experience,” as rated by patients
after a hospital stay, determines choices by
insurance companies for future coverage of
their enrollees. Often, these items are nursing
sensitive, meaning that if nurses demonstrate
simple comforting techniques, patients will
respond favorably to those “patient experience”
questions.
One administrative approach to enhancing
the patient experience has been to implement
scripting, in which members of the health-care
team memorize specific prewritten statements
to use during common patient encounters. An
example is a standard script to be delivered on
first introducing oneself to the patient such as,
“Hello, I am Nurse Thomas, and I will be in
charge of your care for today. If you need
anything at all, please let me know.” This
approach may negate individualized care, the
special needs of the patient and family, and the
particular communication skills of the team
member. And most patients can determine
when such statements are prescripted, espe-
cially when they hear the same statements
several times from different caregivers over the
course of a hospital stay.
A different approach is to undergird all pa-
tient interactions with principles of CT, which
caregivers learn in orientation and in-service
programs. Principles of CT that are relevant to
the patient experience are that (1) each interac-
tion entails therapeutic use of self; (2) caregivers
assess for comfort needs of patients and family
members and design their interaction to meet
those needs; (3) caregivers approach each patient
and family member with the intent to comfort
and make a personal, culturally appropriate
connection; and (4) caregivers regularly reassess
comfort of patients and family members and
document comfort levels routinely. Using this
approach facilitates individualized and efficient
care and a more positive patient experience. Two
examples of how CT is being used to enhance
the patient experience are at the Mount Sinai
Hospital in New York City and at Kaiser
Permanente Hospital in San Francisco.
Electronic Database
To support CT in practice, components have
been incorporated into national electronic
databases, such as the National Interventions
Classification and the National Outcomes Clas-
sification systems (the Iowa Taxonomy) as well
as the North American Nursing Diagnosis As-
sociation. Comforting interventions, comfort
outcomes, and comfort diagnoses are included
in these data systems, meaning that individual-
ized comfort needs and the effectiveness of in-
terventions to meet those needs can be charted
electronically and entered into larger databases
by a hospital system, at the local, state, region,
or country level. Although there are at least
13 national databases for nursing, and others
for medicine, when hospital systems select and
contribute data to a mainstream system, docu-
mentation of patient care problems, interven-
tions, and outcomes can be more widely
compared, leading to more consistent and
higher quality patient care practices. In this
regard, an important feature of CT is the uni-
versality of its main concept, comfort. This is a
word that is understood by all health-related
disciplines and is translatable into most lan-
guages, as evident with the number of foreign
language comfort instruments available on
Kolcaba’s website.
Best Policies
An example of how CT is used in practice is the
creation of a policy for Comfort Management
by the American Society of Peri-Anesthesia
Nurses (ASPAN). This national association is
composed of nurses who work in the following
areas: ambulatory surgery, perioperative staging,
operating room, postanesthesia recovery, and
step-down. ASPAN decided collectively to apply
CT in an explicit way throughout patients’ sur-
gical experiences. Kolcaba served as consultant
and facilitator in this process.
First, they achieved national consensus about
the development of Guidelines for Comfort
388 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch21_381-392 26/12/14 10:41 AM Page 388
Management that would complement their
existing Guidelines for Pain Management. The
process proceeded with a survey of its member-
ship about providing comfort to patients, then
with a report of findings, then the conference
about components of Comfort Management,
and finally the composition of the guidelines
(Kolcaba & Wilson, 2002; Wilson & Kolcaba,
2004).
The guidelines contain information about
how to (1) perform a comfort assessment,
(2) create a comfort contract with patients before
surgery, (3) discover the interventions that pa-
tients and families use at home for specific dis-
comforts, (4) use a checklist for comfort
common management strategies, (5) document
changes in comfort, and (6) implement pre- and
post-testing for contact hours in comfort man-
agement. The completed Guidelines for Com-
fort Management are available on ASPAN’s
website (www.ASPAN.org). This is an example
of a grassroots change (within a national associ-
ation of nurses) that was disseminated to all pe-
rianesthesia settings and soon became a practice
expectation. This example could be followed by
any nursing specialty, at the macro level, or any
patient care unit, at the micro level. The impor-
tant point is that the model was initiated by
nurses and is now an expectation that the Joint
Commission reviews on recertification.
CHAPTER 21 • Katharine Kolcaba’s Comfort Theory 389
Practice Exemplar
When I received the night nurse’s report
about a new patient, Susan, I was told she was
55 years old, recovering from abdominal sur-
gery where a large malignant tumor was dis-
covered. This new diagnosis of cancer, and the
subsequent cancer treatments to come, caused
her to be very depressed. She was not eating
and barely talking. I determined that I would
try to get her to start eating and began a series
of “comfort interventions.”
I went into her room and introduced my-
self. Susan was crunched down in her bed, and
her sheets were disheveled. I noticed her
breakfast tray nearby, the cold scrambled eggs
and everything else on the tray untouched. I
asked her if she could eat or drink anything on
the tray and she replied, “No.” Her affect was
flat and depressed, and she did not want to
chat. My informal assessment concluded that
her comfort needs were for improvements in
the following: nutrition, mobility, positioning
(physical needs); spirits and motivation (psy-
chospiritual); social support, listening, under-
standing (sociocultural); and cleanliness of
room, light and noise preferences, clean and
tight linens (environmental).
I began implementing a comfort care plan
automatically, asking Susan if anything at all
might taste good to her? She weakly answered,
“Maybe some cream of wheat.” I told her I
could order that. Then I asked if she could get
into the chair so she could eat more easily. She
agreed, and I helped her sit up. I adjusted the
TV and shades in her room to her specifica-
tions, picked up tissues and trash, and put her
call light at her fingertips. Already her affect
improved a bit. I silenced the beeping IV
pump . . . ahhhhh. “Are you comfortable?”
“Yes, I’m OK.”
“Is there anything else I can do for you
right now?”
“No.” Telling her that I would return with
the cream of wheat, I left the room, told a
team member and the ward clerk that I would
be in Susan’s room, and asked them to try not
to disturb us. I was going to help Susan eat
some breakfast. I turned off my beeper,
retrieved the cream of wheat, entered her
room, and closed the door. We needed some
uninterrupted time!
I sat down in front of her with the tray table
between us, and I asked her if she needed help
with the spoon. She nodded yes. I began
spoon-feeding her the hot cereal with just the
right amount of milk. Slowly, Susan began
taking an interest in the cereal and me, asking
me a few questions about myself as I did her.
As we engaged in small talk, she continued
to let me feed her, until the whole bowl was
finished. “That tasted good,” she said.
Continued
3312_Ch21_381-392 26/12/14 10:41 AM Page 389
390 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Practice Exemplar cont.
“I’m glad,” I said. “You did very well. Now,
I am going to see to my other patients and I’ll
look in on you again in about 15 minutes,
which I was sure to do.
I had achieved two of the goals for my “plan”
which was to (a) get Susan to start eating and
(b) have her engage in conversation. I also
gained a great deal of satisfaction from the en-
counter. I didn’t realize it was a “Wow Mo-
ment” at the time, but for Susan it was. About
3 weeks later, I received a brief note from Susan
who was now home. It is excerpted below:
It’s your cream of wheat that started me
back to recovery, but more than that, it was
your tender loving care and time that I needed
in my much weakened condition. It was quite
an effort to raise my head to eat so I thank you
and picture you feeding me very often in my
mind. . . .Thank you for being a ‘bedside
nurse’!!
■ Summary
The midrange theory of comfort was first pub-
lished in 1994 and has been tested repeatedly by
nurse scientists since that time. Each test of the
theory has supported the initial propositions,
although many more tests need to be conducted
on the relationships between patient/family
goals and markers for institutional integrity.
Instruments adapted and/or translated from the
original General Comfort Questionnaire, the
newer Comfort Behaviors Checklist, Comfort
Daisies, and Verbal Rating Scale, and the Gen-
eral Comfort Questionnaire has been certified
by AHRQ as a quality measure since 2003.
Comfort theory has also been applied
frequently by health agencies and hospitals for
the purpose of enhancing the work environ-
ment for staff and explicating a unifying
theme for patient and family care. The theory
is popular because it describes what expert
nurses already know: One of the most impor-
tant missions for nursing is still to bring com-
fort to our patients and families, no matter
what their circumstances are. Comfort brings
strength for those difficult health-care tasks
that we must all face.
References
Benner, P. (1984). From novice to expert. Menlo Park,
CA: Addison Wesley.
Chinn, P. L. (1998). Response to ‘the comforting
interaction": Developing a model of nurse-patient
relationship. Scholarly Inquiry for Nursing Practice,
11(4), 345–347.
Dowd, T., Kolcaba, K., & Steiner, R. (2003). The addi-
tion of coaching to cognitive strategies: Interventions
for persons with compromised urinary bladder syn-
drome. Journal of Ostomy and Wound Management,
30(2), 90–99.
Dowd, T., Kolcaba, K., Steiner, R., & Fashinpaur, D.
(2007). Comparison of healing touch and coaching
on stress and comfort in young college students.
Holistic Nursing Practice, 21(4), 194–202.
Henderson, V. (1978). Principles and practice of nursing.
New York: Macmillan.
Kolcaba, K. (1991). A taxonomic structure for the
concept comfort. Image: The Journal of Nursing
Scholarship, 23(4), 237–240.
Kolcaba, K. (1992a). The concept of comfort in an
environmental framework. Journal of Gerontological
Nursing, 18(6), 33–38.
Kolcaba, K. (1992b). Holistic comfort: Operationalizing
the construct as a nurse-sensitive outcome. ANS
Advances in Nursing Science, 15(1), 1–10.
Kolcaba, K. (1994). A theory of holistic comfort for
nursing. Journal of Advanced Nursing, 19, 1178–1184.
Kolcaba, K. (1995). The art of comfort care. Image: The
Journal of Nursing Scholarship, 27(4), 287–289.
Kolcaba, K. (2001). Evolution of the midrange theory
of comfort for outcomes research. Nursing Outlook,
49(2), 86–92.
Kolcaba, K. (2003). Comfort theory and practice: A vision
for holistic health care and research (pp. 113–124).
New York: Springer.
Kolcaba, K., Dowd, T., Steiner, R., & Mitzel, A.
(2004). Efficacy of hand massage for enhancing
comfort of hospice patients. Journal of Hospice and
Palliative Care, 6(2), 91–101.
3312_Ch21_381-392 26/12/14 10:41 AM Page 390
CHAPTER 21 • Katharine Kolcaba’s Comfort Theory 391
Kolcaba, K., & Fox, C. (1999). The effects of guided
imagery on comfort of women with early-stage
breast cancer going through radiation therapy.
Oncology Nursing Forum, 26(1), 67–71.
Kolcaba, K., Schirm, V., & Steiner, R. (2006). Effects of
hand massage on comfort of nursing home residents.
Geriatric Nursing, 27(2), 85–91.
Kolcaba, K., Tilton, C., & Drouin, C. (2006). Comfort
theory: A unifying framework to enhance the
practice environment. Journal of Nursing
Administration, 36(11), 538–544.
Kolcaba, K., & Wilson, L. (2002). The framework of
comfort care for perianesthesia nursing [with posttest
for 1.2 contact hours]. Journal of Perianesthesia
Nursing, 17(2), 102–114.
Morse, J. (1992) Comfort: The refocusing of nursing
care. Clinical Nursing Research. 1(1), 91–106.
NQMC. (2014). National Quality Measures Clearing-
house, department of the Agency for Healthcare
Research and Quality. 2014 Annual Verification
Report.
Orlando, I. (1961/1990). The dynamic nurse-patient
relationship. New York: National League for
Nursing Press.
Paterson, J., & Zderad, L. (1976/1988). Humanistic
nursing. New York: National League for Nursing
Press.
Schlotfeldt, R. (1975). The need for a conceptual
framework. In P. Verhonic (Ed.), Nursing Research
(pp. 3–25). Boston: Little, Brown.
Wilson, L., & Kolcaba, K. (2004). Practical applica-
tion of Comfort Theory in the perianesthesia
setting. Journal of PeriAnesthesia Nursing, 19(3),
164–173.
3312_Ch21_381-392 26/12/14 10:41 AM Page 391
Appendix A: Example of a Comfort Contract
Thank you for taking the time to complete the
comfort contract. The purpose of this contract
is to increase your comfort and pain manage-
ment while you are hospitalized. Please rate
your expectation of comfort from 0 to 10 (10 is
highest) for each situation listed. Please use the
comfort scale as directed for all items except
when indicated otherwise and take your time
and complete the following questions.
Developed by the following students at the Uni-
versity of Akron an distributed with their permis-
sion: Robert Bearss, Brent Ferroni, Ryan Hartnett,
Kristy Kuzmiak, Brittney Stover, Spring 2006.
The Comfort Experience
1. I expect a comfort level of:
a._______ when the anesthesia wears off.
b._______ on postoperative day 1
c. _______ on postoperative day 3 (when
ambulating)
d._______ on postoperative day 5 (study
conclusion day)
2. These interventions might assist to increase
my comfort:
Warming blanket (recovery room)
Pet visitation
Family visits (when anesthesia wears off)
Music
Cold washcloth
Pillows—location: ___________
Massage
Other ________________
(Circle All that Apply.)
3. In the past, I have required (small, mod-
erate, large) amounts of pain medication
to keep me comfortable.
4. I have had success with the following
medications during my previous admis-
sions to the hospital ____________
5. The following medications I had taken
have resulted in undesirable outcomes:
_________________________________
The undesirable outcomes have included:
_________________________________
_________________________________
Nursing Interventions
6. I prefer personal hygiene to be performed
during the (morning, afternoon, evening).
7. I prefer my family to be present (all the
time, occasionally, not at all) during my
recovery.
8. I wish to have the following family mem-
ber(s) present:_____________________.
9. I prefer to exclude the following persons
from visiting my room______________.
10.I prefer to have a fan present in my room.
(Yes/No)
11.I prefer updates regarding my status (only
when asked, daily, not at all).
392 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Extreme
discomfort
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Extreme
comfort
Comfort
Fig 21 • 3 Comfort scale.
3312_Ch21_381-392 26/12/14 10:41 AM Page 392
Chapter 22Joanne Duffy’s
Quality-Caring Model©
JOANNE R. DUFFY
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Theory
Applications of the Model
Practice Exemplar
References
393
Introducing the Theorist
Joanne R. Duffy, PhD, RN, FAAN, has had an
extensive career encompassing clinical, admin-
istrative, and academic roles. Currently, she is
the West Virginia University Hospitals En-
dowed Professor of Research and Evidence-
based Practice and Interim Associate Dean for
Research and PhD Education at the Robert C.
Byrd Health Sciences Center, West Virginia
University, Morgantown, WV, and is an Ad-
junct Professor at the Indiana University School
of Nursing in Indianapolis, IN. She has directed
four graduate nursing programs (critical care,
care management, nursing administration,
and a PhD program) and was a former Division
Director of a school of nursing. She actively
teaches nursing theory, research, and leadership
in PhD, DNP, masters and honors programs,
directs dissertations and scholarly projects, and
interfaces with acute care health professionals
and leaders to advance evidence-based practice.
Dr. Duffy graduated from St. Joseph’s Hospital
School of Nursing in Providence, RI, com-
pleted her BSN at Salve Regina College in
Newport, RI, and her master’s and doctoral
degrees at the Catholic University of America
in Washington, DC.
Dr. Duffy has held clinical positions in
intensive care, coronary care, and emergency
services and is a cardiovascular clinical nurse
specialist. She was an associate director of
nursing at one urban hospital and two large
academic medical centers, developed a Cardio-
vascular Center for Outcomes Analysis, and
administrated a transplant center while simul-
taneously serving in academic appointments.
Her special expertise in outcomes measurement
has led to the focus of her work: maximizing
health outcomes, particularly among older
adults, through caring processes.
Joanne R. Duffy
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 393
Dr. Duffy was the first to examine the link
between nurse caring behaviors and patient out-
comes and developed the caring assessment tool
(including the newest version, the e-CAT) in
multiple versions. She developed the middle-
range quality-caring model© to guide profes-
sional practice and research, ultimately exposing
the hidden value of nursing work. Dr. Duffy
was the principal investigator on the national
demonstration project, “Relationship-Centered
Caring in Acute Care,” has been the principal
investigator for two caring-based intervention
studies, and served as consultant to several mul-
tidisciplinary studies. Dr. Duffy was a consult-
ant to the American Nurses Association (ANA)
in the development and implementation of the
National Database of Nursing Quality Indica-
tors and the former chair of the National
League for Nursing’s Nursing Educational
Research Advisory Council. Dr. Duffy is a
Commonwealth Fund Executive Nurse Fellow,
a recipient of several nursing awards, a Fellow
in the American Academy of Nursing, a fre-
quent guest speaker, and a former Magnet
Appraiser. The first edition of her book, Quality
Caring in Nursing: Applying Theory to Clinical
Practice, Education, and Research received the
AJN book of the year award in 2009. The
second edition, Quality Caring in Nursing and
Health Systems: Implications for Clinical Practice,
Education, and Leadership (2013), focuses on
caring relationships as the central organizing
principle of health systems.
Overview of the Theory
The quality-caring model© was initially devel-
oped in 2003 to guide practice and research
(Duffy & Hoskins, 2003). The seeds of the
model were sown during discussions concern-
ing nursing interventions, but it was informed
from earlier work on caring (Duffy, 1992).
While examining the outcomes variable of pa-
tient satisfaction in the late 1980s, Dr. Duffy
uncovered that hospitalized patients who were
dissatisfied often expressed, “Nurses just don’t
seem to care.” This concern was corroborated
in the literature and represented a clinical
problem that significantly affected patients’
perceptions of quality. Over time, Dr. Duffy
continued to study human interactions during
illness, developing tools to measure caring
(Duffy, 2002; Duffy, Brewer, & Weaver, 2014;
Duffy, Hoskins, & Seifert, 2007) and studying
the linkage between nurse caring and selected
health-care outcomes (Duffy, 1992, 1993).
In 2002, it became apparent that there were
few nursing theories that could guide the devel-
opment of a caring-based nursing intervention
while simultaneously speaking to the relationship
between nurse caring and quality. As part of a re-
search team, Drs. Duffy and Hoskins developed
and tested the model in a group of heart failure
patients (Duffy, Hoskins, & Dudley-Brown,
2005). Caring relationships were the core concept
in this model and were believed to be integrated,
although often hidden, in the daily work of nurs-
ing. This form of caring was considered different
from the caring that occurs between family and
friends because professional nurse caring requires
specialized knowledge, attitudes, and behaviors
that are specifically directed toward health and
healing. Through this specialized knowledge, re-
cipients feel “cared for,” which was theorized as a
positive emotion necessary for taking risks, feeling
safe, learning new healthy behaviors, or partici-
pating effectively in decision making based on
evidence. This sense of “feeling cared for” was
considered an antecedent necessary to influence
improved intermediate and terminal outcomes,
particularly nursing-sensitive outcomes such as
knowledge (including self-knowledge), safety,
comfort, anxiety, adherence, human dignity,
health, confidence, engagement, and positive ex-
periences of care. Furthermore, the model was
considered supportive to professional nursing be-
cause nurses themselves were theorized to benefit.
Blending societal needs for measurable outcomes
with the unique relationship-centered processes
central to daily nursing practice represented a
practical, postmodern approach.
The major purposes of the quality-caring
model© at that time were to:
• Guide professional practice
• Describe the conceptual–theoretical–
empirical linkages between quality of
care and human caring
• Propose a research agenda that would
provide evidence of the value of nursing
394 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 394
Because of the complexities of modern
society, individuals, the health system, and
the professionals who work in it, the Quality
Caring Model© has evolved from its initiation
in 2003. Since that time, the model has been re-
vised twice (Fig. 22-1) to meet the demands of
the multifaceted, interdependent, and global
health system that “requires a more sophisticated
workforce, one that understands the significance
of systems thinking, whose practice is based on
knowledge, multiple and oftentimes competing
connections, and one that values relationships as
the basis for actions and decision-making”
(Duffy, 2009, p.192). In this revised version, the
link between caring relationships and quality
care is even more explicit, challenging the nurs-
ing profession to use caring relationships as
the basis for daily practice. The revised model
is considered a middle-range theory because
it draws on others’ work, is practical, and can
be tested. It views quality as a dynamic, nonlin-
ear characteristic that is influenced by caring
relationships. “Quality is not an endpoint per se,
but a process of continuous learning and improve-
ment . . . that treats patients as full partners . . .
and is fully integrated into the work of health
professionals” (Duffy, 2013, p. 31).
When caring relationships are the basis of
nursing work, positive human connections are
formed with patients and families that influence
future interactions and positively influence
intermediate health outcomes. Thus, caring is a
process that involves a reciprocal relationship
(characterized by caring factors) between
human persons, whereby the positive emotion,
“feeling cared for,” is attained. It is this feeling
of being “cared for” that matters in terms of en-
abling the conditions for self-advancing systems.
As such, it is an essential performance indicator
of quality nursing care. Caring relationships also
are theorized to enhance interprofessional prac-
tice and benefit nurses themselves by maintain-
ing congruence with professional values and
contributing to meaningful work.
CHAPTER 22 • Joanne Duffy’s Quality-Caring Model© 395
Intermediate
outcomes
SELF-ADVANCINGSYSTEMS
Feel “cared for”
Humans in relationship
Relationship-centered
professional encounters
Communities
Self
Fig 22 • 1 Revised quality-caring model©. (From Duffy, J. [2013a]. Quality caring in nursing and health systems:
Implications for clinicians, educators, and leaders [p. 34]. New York: Springer.)
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 395
Concepts, Assumptions,
and Propositions
In the latest revision of the quality-caring
model©, there are four main concepts. The first
is humans in relationship. This idea refers to the
notion that humans are multidimensional be-
ings with various characteristics that make
them unique. Recognizing human character-
istics, including how they differ and yet are
the same, provides an understanding that
influences human interactions and conse-
quently, nursing interventions. Humans are
also social beings connected to others through
birth or in work, play, learning, worship,
and local communities. It is through these
connections that humans mature, enhance
their communities, and advance.
Relationship-centered professional encounters
consist of the independent relationship between
the nurse and patient/family and the collabora-
tive relationship that nurses establish with
members of the health-care team. When these
relationships are of a caring nature, the interme-
diate outcome of “feeling cared for” is generated.
Embedded in this concept are the caring factors
that are discussed in the next section. Feeling
cared for is a positive emotion that signifies to
patients and families that they matter. Caring
relationships prompt this feeling, inciting per-
sons’, groups’, and systems’ capabilities to change,
learn and develop, or self-advance. In other
words, “feeling cared for” allows one to relax,
feel secure, and get engaged in his or her health-
care needs. It is an important antecedent to
quality health outcomes, particularly those that
are nursing-sensitive.
Patients and families who experience caring
relationships from health-care providers are
more apt to concentrate on their health, focus
on learning about it, modify lifestyles, adhere to
the recommendations and regimens, and ac-
tively participate in health-care decisions. They
feel understood and more confident in their
abilities. Over time, persons who experience
caring interactions with health professionals
progress or self-advance. Self-advancing systems
is the final concept in this model. It is a phe-
nomenon that emerges gradually over time and
in space reflecting dynamic positive progress
that enhances the systems’ well-being. Self-
advancing systems are stimulated by caring re-
lationships, but the forward movement itself
cannot be controlled directly; rather, it emerges
over time, driven by caring connections. Self-
advancing systems represent quality in the
model because it is a dynamic concept that
enhances an individual’s or system’s well-being.
The overall purposes of the revised quality-
caring model© are to (1) guide professional
practice and (2) provide a foundation for nurs-
ing research. It can also be used in nursing ed-
ucation (to guide curriculum development and
facilitate caring student–teacher relationships)
and in nursing leadership as a basis for human
interactions and decision-making.
Assumptions of the revised quality-caring
model© include the following:
• Humans are multidimensional beings
capable of growth and change.
• Humans exist in relationship to themselves,
others, communities or groups, nature
(or the environment), and the universe.
• Humans evolve over time and in space.
• Humans are inherently worthy.
• Caring consists of processes that are used
individually or in combination and often
concurrently.
• Caring is embedded in the daily work of
nursing.
• Caring is a tangible concept that can be
measured.
• Caring relationships benefit both the carer
and the one being cared for.
• Caring relationships benefit society.
• Caring is done “in relationship.”
• Feeling “cared for” is a positive emotion.
• Professional nursing work is done in the
context of human relationships. (Duffy,
2013, p. 33)
Propositions are those relational statements
that tie model concepts to each other and in
some instances can be the basis for hypothesis
testing. Propositions of the quality-caring
model© include the following:
Human caring capacity can be developed.
Caring relationships are composed of process
or factors that can be observed.
396 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 396
Caring relationships require intent, specialized
knowledge, and time.
Engagement in communities through caring
relationships enhances self-caring.
Independent caring relationships between
patients and health-care providers influence
feeling “cared for.”
Collaborative caring relationships among
nurses and members of the health-care
team influence feeling “cared for.”
Caring relationships facilitate growth and
change.
Feeling “cared for” is an antecedent to
self-advancing systems.
Feeling “cared for” influences the attainment of
intermediate and terminal health outcomes.
Self-advancement is a nonlinear, complex
process that emerges over time and in space.
Self-advancing systems are naturally self-
caring or self-healing.
Relationships characterized as caring con-
tribute to individual, group, and system
self-advancement (Duffy, 2013, p. 38)
Role of the Nurse
The overall role of the professional nurse in
this model is to engage in caring relationships
so that self and others feel “cared for” (Duffy,
2013, p. 33). Such actions positively influence
intermediate and terminal health outcomes
(self-advancement), including those that are
nursing-sensitive.
The revised quality-caring model© specifically
emphasizes the following responsibilities of
professional nurses:
• Attain and continuously advance knowl-
edge and expertise in caring processes.
• Initiate, cultivate, and sustain caring
relationships with patients and families.
• Initiate, cultivate, and sustain caring relation-
ships with other nurses and all members of
the health-care team.
• Maintain an ongoing awareness of the
patient/family point of view.
• Carry on self-caring activities, including
personal and professional development.
• Integrate caring relationships with specific
evidenced-based nursing interventions to
positively influence health outcomes.
• Engage in continuous learning and prac-
tice-based research.
• Use the expertise of caring relationships
embedded in nursing to actively participate
in community groups.
• Contribute to the knowledge of caring and,
ultimately, the profession of nursing using
all forms of knowing.
• Maintain an open, flexible approach.
• Use measures of caring to evaluate nursing
care. (Duffy, 2013, pp. 38–39)
Caring Relationships
There are four caring relationships essential
to quality caring (Fig. 22-2). The first is the
relationship with self. Because humans are
multidimensional (comprising bio–psycho–
social–cultural–spiritual components) that
continuously interact in concert with the uni-
verse, their fundamental nature is integrated
or whole. The many seemingly different parts
relate to and depend on each other, generating
an orientation of the self that represents a
source of understanding often lost in the busi-
ness of life. Individuals, particularly nurses,
tend to go about their day habitually moving
from one task to another without noticing their
internal bodily processes, feelings, or connec-
tions with others. This externally driven focus
separates individuals from those internal forces
CHAPTER 22 • Joanne Duffy’s Quality-Caring Model© 397
Health care
teamPatient/family
CommunitySelf
Relationship-
centered
professional
practice
Fig 22 • 2 Four relationships necessary for quality
caring. (Copyright ©2013 J. Duffy. From Duffy, J.
[2013a]. Quality caring in nursing and health systems:
Implications for clinicians, educators, and leaders [p. 53].
New York: Springer.)
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 397
that hold a special knowledge of self. In nurs-
ing, professionals care for others and their
families with ease, frequently “forgetting” to
connect with self. Yet allowing oneself to slow
down enough to access his or her own genuine-
ness offers a clarity that is life enhancing. Some
would say such inner awareness is necessary for
authentic interaction and health (Davidson et
al., 2003), whereas others (Siegel, 2007) believe
it is necessary to adequately care for others.
As human beings, professional nurses who are
regularly “in touch” with themselves set up the
conditions for self-caring, a state that offers a
rich supply of energy and renewal.
In nursing, remaining self-aware is a neces-
sary prerequisite for caring relationships because
in knowing the self, it is possible to know others.
Regular mindfulness activities such as prayer,
meditation, quiet time, attention to physical
health through regular exercise and proper nu-
trition, and creative activities, when performed
in a conscious manner, promote insight. Like-
wise in the work environment, short pauses,
consciously remembering to center on the per-
son being cared for, attending to bodily needs
such as nourishment and elimination, and even
short time-outs ensure that the caring focus of
nursing remains the priority. Reflective aware-
ness by actively soliciting feedback about one’s
performance is another method of attaining self-
knowledge that may offer professional nurses a
boost in self-confidence or specific learning
opportunities. Reflective analysis in which
thoughts are actually documented in written or
taped format and then analyzed for their subjec-
tive meanings can be used to inform clinical
practice. Professional nurses need to acknowl-
edge and reflect on the important work they do
to value themselves and nursing, a precondition
for caring relationships (Foster, 2004).
As the primary focus of nursing, patients and
families who are ill are vulnerable and depend-
ent on nurses for caring. Initiating, cultivating,
and sustaining caring relationships with patients
and families is an independent function of
professional nursing that involves intention,
choice, specific knowledge and skills, and time
(Duffy, 2009). Intending to care depends on
one’s attitudes and beliefs; it shapes a nurse’s
choice and resulting behaviors, specifically
whether “to care” for another. Such choice is a
conscious decision that is required for effective
caring relationships. Deep awareness of the self
enhances caring intention and consequential
behaviors become more positively focused
toward the patient/family.
Collaborative relationships with members of
the health-care team are essential to quality health
care (Knaus, Draper, Wagner, & Zimmerman,
1986) and are depicted as an important relation-
ship in the quality-caring model©. Nurses are
already connected to one another by the work
they do and with other members of the health
team by the commonality of simultaneously
providing services to patients and families. But
collaboration connotes mutual respect for the work
of other health professionals and occurs best “in rela-
tionship.” Ongoing interaction is key to collabo-
ration in order to seek the other’s point of view,
validate the work, share responsibilities, and
evaluate the care. The quality-caring model©
maintains that professional nurses have a re-
sponsibility for implementing collegial, caring
interpersonal relationships with each other and
members of the health-care team. Discussing
specific clinical issues pertinent to patients, par-
ticipating in joint rounds, improving quality or
research projects, holding family conferences,
and discharging rounds are all examples of pos-
itive collaboration that benefit not only patients
and families but the health-care team as well.
Affirming each other’s unique contribution to
patient care through genuine collaboration con-
tributes to a healthy work environment that may
increase work satisfaction.
Finally, caring for the communities nurses
live and serve in reflects another caring relation-
ship essential to the revised quality-caring
model.© This relationship is predicated on the
belief that humans interact with groups beyond
the family to connect, share similar history and
customs, and enhance the lives of each other.
Engaging in communities provides professional
nurses opportunities to use caring relationships
as the basis for improving health or decreasing
disease. Such activities contribute to the ongo-
ing vitality of the community and enrich nurses’
personal lives. The four relationships essential
to quality caring, when well developed and
practiced with knowledge of the caring factors,
398 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 398
meets the needs of patients and families for
quality health care.
The Caring Factors
Caring is not just a mindset or simple acts of
kindness; rather, clinical caring requires knowl-
edge (Mayerhoff, 1971) and skills, juxtaposed
on caring values. Many have theorized about
the qualities necessary for therapeutic relation-
ships (Rogers, 1961; Yalom, 1975), but Watson
(1979, 1985) identified 10 carative factors
necessary for human caring in the patient–nurse
relationship. Eight factors, reframed through
research and clinical experience, are currently
used to characterize caring in the quality-caring
model©. These factors are specifically defined,
facilitating the identification of specific cogni-
tive and behavioral abilities necessary for caring
relationships, and are as follows:
• Mutual problem-solving
• Attentive reassurance
• Human respect
• Encouraging manner
• Appreciation of unique meaning
• Healing environment
• Affiliation needs
• Basic human needs (Duffy, Hoskins, &
Seifert, 2007)
The caring factors were initially derived
from Watson’s original work (Watson, 1979,
1985) but also are consistent with the inten-
tions of other nursing theorists (Boykin &
Schoenhofer, 1993; Henderson, 1980; Johnson,
1990; King, 1981; Leininger, 1981; Nightingale,
1992; Orem, 2001; Peplau, 1988; Roach,
1984; Roy, 1980; Swanson, 1991) and empirical
research (Cossette, Cote, Pepin, Ricard, &
D’Aoust, 2006; Boudreaux, Francis, &
Loyacano, 2002; Campbell & Rudisill, 2006;
Mangurten et al., 2006; Paul, Hendry, &
Cabrelli, 2004; Wolf, Zuzelo, Goldberg,
Crothers, & Jacobson, 2006). Mutual problem-
solving refers to assisting patients and families
to learn about, question, and participate in
their health or illness. This is accomplished
reciprocally and requires professional interac-
tion that is informed and engaging. This factor
recognizes that patients and families are the
decision-makers in the health-care process and
facilitating informed alternatives and adoption
of their ideas is paramount.
Attentive reassurance refers to being available
and offering a positive outlook to patients and
families that helps them feel secure. Professional
nurses who use this factor are able to “be with”
their patients long enough to convey possibili-
ties, focus on their unique needs, listen, and
present some cheerful dialogue. Human respect
implies valuing the human person of the other
by acting in such a way that demonstrates that
value. For example, calling a patient by his or
her preferred name, performing tasks in a gentle
manner, and maintaining eye contact show
regard for the other. Using an encouraging man-
ner or a supportive demeanor during interac-
tions conveys confidence and is expressed both
verbally and nonverbally. It is especially impor-
tant to maintain uniformity between messages
expressed and those implied by body language.
Appreciation of unique meanings helps a patient
feel understood because the nurse uses this
factor to acknowledge what is significant to
patients and families. In other words, nurses
aim to see things from the patient’s point of
view and use his or her preferences and their
sociocultural meanings in care. In this way,
nurses tailor interventions to the patient’s frame
of reference. Cultivating a healing environment,
including appealing surroundings, decreasing
stressors (noise, lighting), ensuring patient pri-
vacy and confidentiality, and practicing in a safe
manner are included in this factor. The partic-
ular norms and customs of a department in
which a patient receives care also have an im-
pact. This factor is especially important in acute
care where adverse events remain a major source
of harm, death, and disability for Americans
(Fineberg, 2012). Ensuring that basic human
needs are attended to during an illness (including
the higher order needs; Maslow, 1954) has been
a major role of the professional nurse that today
is often delegated to unlicensed assistive person-
nel. Often this factor is blended with other
nursing activities such as assessments, teaching
and learning, and emotional support. Providing
for basic human needs is an opportunity to
further the development of caring relationships.
Finally, appreciating the significance of affilia-
tion needs refers to making sure that patients
CHAPTER 22 • Joanne Duffy’s Quality-Caring Model© 399
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 399
are not only allowed access to their families,
but also that families are included in care deci-
sions. Being open and approachable to families
and keeping them informed is important to
patients’ well-being and should be a normal part
of nursing care.
The caring factors are used “in relationship”
with others and comprise the basis for the
“knowledge and skills” required to practice
according to the quality-caring model.© Using
them is dependent on patient needs and the
context of the situation. Not all factors are
necessarily used at once; rather, the professional
nurse uses his or her judgment to decide which
are necessary for certain situations. When ap-
plied with expertise, these factors are theorized
to positively affect recipients such that they feel
“cared for.” In fact, “feeling cared for” is a calm-
ing influence, allowing the patient to concen-
trate on the meaning of illness and the
requirements for health and healing. Feeling
cared for also sets up the conditions for future
interactions with health professionals that sway
eventual outcomes of care. “In other words, the
patient’s ability to progress is mediated some-
what by the feelings generated as a consequence
of caring relationships” (Duffy, 2009, p. 72).
Performing nursing in such a way that valuable
time is spent predominantly in caring relation-
ships with patients and families (i.e., using
the caring factors) ensures that patients and
families feel “cared for” and that health
outcomes are positively impacted.
The caring factors are applicable to the other
three relationships pertinent to the quality-
caring model.© For example, collaborative
relationships founded on the caring factors
enhance teamwork and cooperation. As experts
in caring, professional nurses are in a unique
position to profoundly benefit the health-care
system. Uniting caring knowledge and caring
action(s) in relationships with self, patients
and families, coworkers, and the community
provides opportunities for creative innovations,
improvements in practice, and a source of
energy for future interactions. Furthermore,
some nurses who practice this way describe
richer work experiences that are naturally
renewing (D’Antonio, 2008).
Applications of the Model
Clinical Practice
The quality-caring model© provides individual
clinicians, teams of health professionals, educa-
tors, and leaders with a relationship-centric
approach to health care. In doing so, it honors
the interdependencies necessary for human
advancement. For individual clinicians, it pro-
vides a “way of being with” patients and families
(through the caring factors) that can be used to
guide interventions, practice improvements, and
ongoing learning about the self. For health-care
teams, the model offers a way to relate to and
engage with other health-care providers in care
that is “best for the patient.” The quality-caring
model© offers health educators a caring peda-
gogy that honors caring relationships that are
lived out through the behaviors of faculty mem-
bers. In other words, teaching one “how to care”
is dependent on the “caring milieu” generated
by faculty members themselves who notice and
share “caring moments,” continuously reflect on
the nature of nursing, and who use cognitive,
psychomotor, and affective experiences to help
students acquire the knowledge, skills, and
attitudes of caring professionals. Likewise,
relationship-centered leaders preserve the foun-
dational caring patient–nurse relationship that
gives nursing its identity, ensures ethical
and legal services, and provides the nursing
workforce with meaning.
In Quality Caring in Nursing and Health Sys-
tems: Implications for Clinicians, Educators, and
Leaders, Duffy (2013a) highlights how many
health systems are using the quality-caring
model© to:
• Provide a foundation for patient-
centered care
• Enhance interprofessional practice
• Facilitate staff-directed practice changes
• Redesign professional workflow
• Generate guiding principles for human
resource practices
• Guide nurse residency programs
• Improve collective relational capacity
• Renew the meaning of nursing work
• Extend caring to others FIRST
• Build relationships with community groups
400 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 400
• Create a legacy of caring
• Sustain professionalism
• Revise nursing curricula
• Balance “doing” with “being”
Practice Improvement
Because caring relationships can be measured
and their consequences assessed, the model af-
fords an evaluation design for improvement of
services. The quality-caring model© maintains
that quality nursing care is based on the use of
best evidence and asserts the nursing respon-
sibility to engage in continuous learning, use
measures of caring, and contribute to caring
knowledge and practice-based research. Eval-
uation of nursing practice is an ongoing
process that is tied to nurses’ individual com-
petency as well as the processes used in daily
practice and their subsequent outcomes (both
intermediate and terminal). Using the caring
factors as the basis for competency statements
or performance expectations from which indi-
vidual nurses can complete self-evaluations,
gather peer reviews, or be evaluated by their
supervisors is a first step. A more comprehen-
sive approach using the 360-degree method
(Edwards & Ewen, 1996; London & Smither,
1995) provides assessments from the perspec-
tive of the one being evaluated (nurse self-
evaluation), those being “cared for” (patients
and families), the supervisor, and colleagues
(other nurses, physicians, other members of
the health-care team). This approach provides
the one being evaluated with information
about his/her performance from the perspective
of recipients of his/her care. Thus, patients
(those being “cared for”) and colleagues (those
within the health-care team) offer direct infor-
mation about the nature of caring displayed by
the nurse. Using these perspectives, the one
being evaluated can reflect on this feedback, and
then set personal goals for self-development, ul-
timately improving practice and benefitting
themselves and others (self-advancement). The
360 degree approach to evaluating individual
caring competence is thorough and relation-
ship centered; it takes advantage of multiple
sources and perspectives to provide important
feedback about nursing practice.
Evaluating processes of care requires measur-
ing the quality of caring relationships and using
those data to efficiently revise practice. Although
many performance improvement activities are
conducted in today’s health systems, few focus
on the patient–provider relationship. The lack
of focus on this relationship as a quality indica-
tor, combined with performance reports that
often do not represent the patient’s perspective
(Hudon, Fortin, Haggerty, Lambert, & Poitras,
2011), precludes practice improvement. Fur-
thermore, RNs frequently do not receive per-
formance information for 3 or 4 months or
longer after patients are discharged.
Real-time patient feedback delivered directly
to those providing care enhances performance
improvement (Ayers et al., 2005; Nelson et al.,
2008), and in the case of caring relationships, the
patient’s perspective, particularly at the point of
care is crucial in its evaluation. To rapidly collect
and disseminate patient feedback about caring
relationships with nurses, the use of technology
in the form of a bedside mobile device provides
real-time data for use by RNs to revise their
practice, providing routine evaluation of caring
relationships during the care process. In a pilot
study, Duffy and colleagues (2012) tested this
approach in a sample of 86 hospitalized older
adults using an electronic version of the 27-item
Caring Assessment Tool (e-CAT; Duffy et al.,
2014) and found it feasible and acceptable.
At the microsystems level, assessing nurse
caring on a unit or departmental basis provides
some evidence of how well the quality-caring
model© is integrated into practice and points to
performance improvement recommendations.
Many tools exist that are available to assist this
process (Watson, 2002). However, they vary in
terms of how they define caring, the approach,
how they are administered and scored, whose
view they are obtaining (e.g., patients, nurses, or
others), and validity and reliability. Only a few
directly gather information from patients. This
is an important component of assessment be-
cause the one being “cared for” is the direct
source of knowledge and others’ opinions may
not be consistent. The revised Caring Assessment
Tool© (CAT; Duffy, Hoskins et al., 2007,
2012), a 27-item instrument designed to capture
CHAPTER 22 • Joanne Duffy’s Quality-Caring Model© 401
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 401
patients’ perceptions of nurse caring, has been
used with success in several health-care institu-
tions (Duffy, 2013). This tool has established
validity and reliability and is available in English,
Spanish, and Japanese. Using this tool provides
an evaluation of nurse caring behaviors as
perceived by patients that can be used for per-
formance improvement and practice revisions.
Another instrument that was adapted
from the CAT© is the Caring Assessment
Tool for Administration (CAT-admin;
Duffy, 2002). This tool is a 39-item ques-
tionnaire that assesses how nurses perceive
nurse manager caring behaviors and has be-
come important in the assessment of caring
practice environments. Many other instru-
ments exist to measure caring; however, en-
suring that the conceptual base, population
and setting, and perspective of the respondent
are consistent with individual and organiza-
tional values is vital to successful evaluation.
Specific nursing-sensitive outcomes are likely
to be influenced through use of the quality-
caring model©, so knowledge about these is nec-
essary to improve and accelerate its translation
into practice. To extend the understanding and
strengthen the evidence pertaining to caring
relationships (specifically nurse caring) as a
significant process indicator, tying it to outcomes
indicators may better reflect the value of nursing.
For example, hospitalized older adults frequently
leave the hospital with poorer physical function
than when admitted. This is a national problem
with significant cost and clinical burden (Good-
win, Howrey, Zhang, & Kuo, 2011), not to
mention the personal burden it places on pa-
tients and families. Measuring and reporting dif-
ferences in functional status from admission to
discharge for older adults on Quality-Caring
units would add to the evidence base. Those with
chronic illnesses, such as heart failure, cancer,
and chronic obstructive pulmonary disease often
are readmitted within 30 days of discharge,
financially draining the US health system (Jackson,
Trygstad, DeWalt, & DuBard, 2013). This bur-
den may be lessened if nurses worked, through
caring relationships, to engage and activate
patients in their care before discharge. Patient
engagement is a measurable intermediate out-
comes indicator (Hibbard, Stockard, Mahoney,
& Tusler, 2004) that has been associated with
decreased readmissions (Coulter, 2012) and
reflects the relational aspect of nursing care,
potentially raising positive regard for nursing’s
value.
Other nursing-sensitive intermediate out-
comes indicators such as comfort, knowledge,
dignity, optimistic mood, recovery time, adher-
ence, contentment (versus anxiety), continence,
cognition, empowerment, health-seeking be-
haviors, mobility, symptom control, and skin
integrity are examples of affirming intermediate
outcomes that could be used to demonstrate
the effects of caring relationships. Many of
these indicators have well-documented instru-
ments that would easily translate to the clinical
environment, rendering measurement and re-
porting feasible. Routinely using such existing
tools may validate the effects of nurse caring on
important intermediate outcomes and provide
a basis for improvement.
Researching Caring Relationships
Effectively appraising research informs nursing
practice by providing evidence that can guide
nursing interventions. Unit-based journal
clubs, nursing rounds, or even routine dialog
can provide forums for such appraisal. With
special attention to those studies that investi-
gate aspects of caring relationships, nurses
can help translate findings into practice and/or
extend the research itself.
Because the quality-caring model© pro-
vides a set of concepts, assumptions, and
propositions, questions generated from these
theoretical ideas can provide the basis for
research. For example, the proposition, “feel-
ing ‘cared for’ influences the attainment of
intermediate and terminal health outcomes”
(Duffy, 2013a, p. 38) could be tested by link-
ing the results of an instrument measuring
caring with a set of specific patient outcomes.
In fact, nurse researchers have investigated
this and found some evidence that caring
is linked to patient satisfaction, postoperative
recovery, and decreased anxiety (Burt, 2007;
Swan, 1998; Wolf, Zuzelo, Goldberg,
Crothers, & Jacobson, 1998). Or consider
the proposition, “relationships characterized
as caring contribute to individual, group, and
402 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 402
system self-advancement” (Duffy, 2013a,
p. 38) might be tested by examining the rela-
tionship between adoption of a caring profes-
sional practice model and staff nurses’
satisfaction with work.
Others have developed caring nursing in-
terventions and used them to study effects on
specific patient outcomes (Duffy et al., 2005;
Erci et al., 2003). An example geared to opti-
mizing patient-centered care for hospitalized
older adults uses flexible education, rapid-cycle
performance improvement, and facilitated
group reflection to support busy RNs to use
the caring factors in a complex environment
(Duffy, 2013b). Such research adds to the
knowledge base and offers implications for
the improvement of nursing practice. Schools
of nursing have used the caring factors to
develop and test caring competencies of
baccalaureate students longitudinally; and
students themselves, particularly those in Doc-
tor of Nursing Practice (DNP) programs,
often use the quality-caring model© to guide
their scholarly inquiries. Finally, nursing lead-
ers study caring behaviors of nurse managers
(using the CAT-adm) and evaluate implemen-
tation of the model organizationally using
comparative designs of patient outcomes on
implementation and control units.
Studying caring relationships is important to
provide evidence of nursing’s contribution to
health-care and to advance the profession. Such
evidence provides policymakers with documen-
tation of nursing’s value that may affect impor-
tant decisions such as funding, job descriptions,
promotion and advancement, and staffing. To
that end, the quality-caring model© provides a
foundation for continued research and model
testing. Ensuring that results are disseminated
quickly to the nursing community through pub-
lications and presentations is a nursing respon-
sibility that can advance caring science.
Up until now, weaknesses in caring evalua-
tion and research including the lag time behind
new caring theories, the vagueness between
findings and components of theory, measure-
ment issues, and poorly designed studies with
small and/or nonprobability samples have cre-
ated gaps in caring knowledge. Linking caring
to nursing-sensitive patient outcomes, improv-
ing existing caring instruments, designing car-
ing-based interventions, educational caring, and
cost–benefit analyses are urgently needed to
provide evidence of nursing’s value. Using rig-
orous methods, research that builds on the work
of others and includes multiple patient popula-
tions and settings demonstrates the validity of
caring theories and advances nursing practice.
CHAPTER 22 • Joanne Duffy’s Quality-Caring Model© 403
Practice Exemplar
Mr. S is an 86-year-old man with chronic ob-
structive pulmonary disease (COPD) who
lives with his daughter, her husband, and their
three children. He has been living with the
disease for 15 years and is mostly homebound.
Mr. S has home oxygen, a wheelchair, and his
own room on the second floor of the home
equipped with a TV, DVD player, and books.
He interacts with his grandchildren, who are
teenagers, and relies on his daughter for activ-
ities of daily living. Mr. S lost his wife several
years earlier to cancer and was a computer pro-
grammer before retirement. He was a two
pack per day smoker who rarely exercised and
had been in good health before his diagnosis.
He communicates well verbally and uses an
intercom set up by his son-in-law when neces-
sary. His breathing has been gradually getting
worse (despite medications), and he produces
quite a bit of sputum daily. He is easily fatigued
and occasionally experiences wheezing. He
takes both a short- and a long-acting bron-
chodilator and is on steroid therapy.
Mr. S has been noticing increasing insom-
nia lately with some nocturnal dyspnea and a
cough. His pulmonary function studies have
not changed, but his pulmonologist suggested
that he consider elective lung volume reduc-
tion surgery (LVRS) to help him breathe
better and avert an emergency. Mr. S subse-
quently entered a large teaching Magnet hos-
pital at 7:30 a.m. one day to have this surgery
Continued
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 403
404 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Practice Exemplar cont.
performed. He arrived in his wheelchair ac-
companied by his daughter. He was nervous
about the procedure—not only because of the
surgery itself but also because he knew he
would most likely be in the intensive care unit
afterward. That place scared him! The admit-
ting office was busy, so the technician took his
time gathering insurance information and
then wheeled Mr. S down to the preop area.
He sat in the wheelchair for 45 minutes until
a nurse, who was busy on the phone, arrived.
She introduced herself and stated that he
should undress and get in bed so that she
could begin her assessment. Mr. S’s daughter
assisted him, as she always does at home, and
then placed him safely in the hospital bed. The
nurse returned with a clipboard and began her
assessment, collecting pertinent history. Then
she began a physical assessment. Her resultant
problem list consisted of two problems: short-
ness of breath due to COPD and sleep pattern
disturbance. She told Mr. S a little about the
upcoming surgery and asked his daughter to
sign the consent papers. The anesthesiologist
arrived to start the anesthesia, so Mr. S’s
daughter kissed him, and he was wheeled into
the OR. Three hours later, he was in the re-
covery area, and when Mr. S’s daughter saw
her father, he was on a ventilator, with multi-
ple IVs, and extremely agitated. He was able
to take his own breaths but was obviously
frightened. Because he was “tied down” to the
bed rails, his daughter, who understood his
anxiety, sat by his side and softly talked to him.
He used his hands to show her he felt like
he couldn’t breathe. The daughter, in turn, re-
layed this to the nurse, who asked her to tell
him that this was a normal feeling after this
surgery. Mr. S continued to experience anxi-
ety, often coughing, and was eventually placed
in the farthest bed so as to not disturb the
other patients. Unfortunately, his daughter
could not allay his concerns, and he continued
to feel anxious and distressed.
It was 5:00 p.m., and Mr. S was doing well
according to the nurses in the postanesthesia
care unit (PACU); they began his discharge by
searching for an intensive care unit (ICU) bed,
but there were no available beds in this busy
teaching hospital. Unfortunately, Mr. S had to
stay in the PACU overnight until an ICU bed
became available. Two other patients were also
staying overnight. The PACU nurses were un-
happy with this arrangement because it meant
two of them would have to stay on call to staff
the unit. They were overheard talking to each
other, saying, “If I had wanted to work on a sur-
gical floor, I wouldn’t have applied to the
PACU.” Mr. S continued to display anxiety,
often gagging and looking fearful with his eyes.
His daughter could not help him because she
didn’t know enough about the procedure he had
had to answer his questions. She thought maybe
he was in pain, but he denied this. He continued
to remain lying in the bed with his frightened
look. The daughter asked the PACU nurses for
help in figuring out what was wrong, but they
saw that his vital signs, blood gases, and dressing
were normal. One nurse decided to suction him,
but there were few secretions. Her technique
was rather rough; Mr. S grimaced with pain,
and his daughter asked if it would always be this
way. The nurse said it would get better with time
and went over to talk to the other nurse. Mr. S
remained anxious throughout the night while
his daughter sat by his side. Neither of them
slept. He was taken to the intermediate respira-
tory care unit at 8:30 a.m.
On this unit, Mr. S was cared for by a
young nurse named Megan who had graduated
2 years earlier. Megan stopped briefly to focus
herself and readjust her thoughts toward Mr. S
before she entered his room. Taking a couple
of slow deep breaths, Megan entered the room
and quickly scanned the environment and the
patient to notice anything significant. She
introduced herself by name and then looked
Mr. S in the eyes, smiled, and squeezed his
hand lightly (human respect). Then she asked
what he would like to be called while he stayed
with them and wrote that name on a board
on the wall opposite his bed. Since he couldn’t
talk, Megan asked Mr. S’s daughter to explain
how she had been communicating with him;
then Megan tried it with Mr. S to better un-
derstand his needs. Turns out, the daughter
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 404
CHAPTER 22 • Joanne Duffy’s Quality-Caring Model© 405
Practice Exemplar cont.
was spelling words that were eventually incor-
porated into sentences.
Using the Quality Caring Model© as a
frame of reference, Megan completed a physical
assessment that included physiological, emo-
tional, sociocultural, and spiritual components.
Her goal was to use this opportunity to initiate
a caring relationship with Mr. S and his family
that could grow and be sustained throughout
the hospitalization experience. Through this
process, Megan came to know Mr. S as a re-
tired software engineer who is widowed and
lives with his married adult daughter and
3 grandchildren, is an avid reader of history,
who was anxious and tired. She also learned he
received his diagnosis of COPD 15 years earlier
and had progressively become weaker, more
breathless, and eventually homebound. Mr. S
was taking multiple medications as well as O2
therapy at home. His vital signs were good. Al-
though he was slightly tachycardic with a heart
rate of 112, his dressing was dry, and his back
showed evidence of a beginning pressure ulcer
at the coccyx region. Mr. S’s daughter relayed
her difficulty in caring for Mr. S while also
working part time, raising three children, and
maintaining a home. This family had not been
on a vacation in several years. This physical as-
sessment time provided Megan with the oppor-
tunity to understand the unique human being
(Mr. S) in relationship to his family, his friends,
and life role (appreciation of unique meanings) and
to begin a relationship-centered professional en-
counter that was based on these findings.
She documented the results of the assess-
ment in the computer, looking frequently at
Mr. S so he could see her. The problem list
Megan came up with included issues such as
airway maintenance, anxiety, impaired com-
munication, altered family processes, potential
skin breakdown, inadequate knowledge, and
inadequate coping. Then she sat down, and,
using the caring factor mutual problem-solving,
explained to Mr. S and his daughter what
would happen on this unit, including how long
they might stay, and how and when to contact
her. She engaged them in the dialogue by
inviting questions and asked them for guidance
regarding Mr. S’s normal routines. She relayed
that she would be there all day and gave them
her telephone number. Then she asked them
what they knew about recovering from lung
volume reduction surgery and listened atten-
tively to their responses. She sat a little toward
the patient and looked at him as he “talked.”
This took longer than usual because he was
using letters to spell out words (encouraging
manner). She explained a little about living
with COPD, but together they decided to wait
until after they had some sleep to review care
of the incision and other issues related to
COPD. Megan assured Mr. S that he had the
capacity to live well with this chronic disease,
using examples of what she had already ob-
served about the family (attentive reassurance).
Megan then asked the daughter if she wanted
something to drink and made sure Mr. S was
comfortable (pain free) as well. Then she of-
fered him mouth care and turned him slightly
to the side with a pillow behind his back.
Megan closed the blinds and offered Mr. S’s
daughter a pillow and a reclining chair and let
them sleep for 2 hours, as they had been up all
night (healing environment). She put a sign on
the door reminding others that the patient was
sleeping (basic human needs and affiliation
needs). For the first time in more than 24 hours,
Mr. S was able to relax and shut his eyes,
showing evidence of feeling “cared for.”
Megan’s professional encounter with this
family was relaxed, genuine, and distinguished
by the caring factors. With only 2 years’ expe-
rience, she was competent in their use. Megan’s
focus and knowledge of herself provided the
strength to meet this family’s needs. During the
time they were resting, Megan checked on
them quietly and frequently (healing environ-
ment). At one of these opportunities, Mr. S’s
daughter sought out Megan to relay her anxi-
eties about taking Mr. S home. Megan listened
and encouraged the daughter to adjust first to
this new environment while she (Megan)
would come back later to help them understand
how to live with COPD (affiliation needs).
During the next 2 days, Megan took care of
Mr. S and spent time collaborating with Mr. S’s
Continued
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 405
406 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Practice Exemplar cont.
pulmonologist and surgeon on his care plan. She
listed his problems, and when they came for
rounds, Megan accompanied them, and they
conversed about Mr. S’s vital signs, his breathing
(he had been extubated after 24 hours), incision,
and secretions while also discussing some inter-
ventions Megan suggested based on her knowl-
edge of his family situation, the patient’s own
routines, and their joint interactions. Including
Mr. S in the discussions, they asked how he was
feeling, and he communicated with Megan’s
help. During a conversation at the nurses’ sta-
tion, Megan and both physicians agreed that
Mr. S could go home the next day with support.
The surgeon relied on Megan’s judgment about
Mr. S’s readiness for discharge because he had
come to know her these last 2 years as a compe-
tent and caring nurse. Megan trusted her own
recommendations; their encounter was collab-
orative and friendly.
Later that day, Megan returned with a writ-
ten set of instructions about caring for chest
incisions. She reviewed the instructions with
both Mr. S and his daughter, answering ques-
tions, allowing the daughter and Mr. S to
“practice.” She used a positive approach, reas-
suring the daughter that she could do this and
that she would be there in a couple of hours to
review the procedure again (attentive reassurance
and encouraging manner). Megan then called the
social worker and the home care team to get
things rolling for discharge. Megan also took
the daughter aside to discuss living and caring
for an elderly man with COPD. She provided
the daughter with referrals for a support group
and a lung association program.
During report, Megan reviewed Mr. S’s
problem list and her recommended interven-
tions to the oncoming nurse using the caring
factors as a basis for the interaction. She felt
good that Mr. S and his family were learning
about his needs and pleased that she had re-
lieved some of their anxiety. She said good-
bye to all her patients and went to her weekly
yoga class to unwind. The next morning,
Megan had the same assignment and worked
with Mr. S and his daughter to ensure their
self-caring needs were met.
Although this “case” is typical in many acute
care facilities, Mr. S is a unique individual who
experienced two different nursing encounters.
In the first instance, one might say that his
physical needs were met, yet he was not af-
firmed as the one being treated (the nurses
talked to his daughter about him), he was not
adequately assessed by the preop nurse, he
remained anxious for many hours postop, was
isolated from others, didn’t sleep, overheard
professional nurses talking about not wanting
to be there, was treated roughly, and was not
turned for 12 hours despite the fact that he was
immediately postop. On the intermediate care
unit, the nurse used the caring factors to initi-
ate and cultivate a caring relationship with him
from admission. She used this relationship as
the basis for care that included attention to his
basic needs for sleep, comfort, and nutrition.
Megan helped Mr. S understand his new situ-
ation and included his daughter, who was his
caretaker. She was collaborative with the physi-
cians and other nursing staff and positive in her
demeanor. She referred to the patient as Mr. S
and used her time appropriately to ensure that
his transition to home would occur safely. In
essence, this nurse saw the patient as a whole
person, not a physical body after surgery, and
used her caring knowledge and skills to build a
relationship that generated trust and security.
Through ongoing interaction, a connection
developed between the nurse and patient that
provided the insight necessary for effectively
following the nursing process including specific
interventions and evaluation. Although the
tasks she performed were routine in nature, this
nurse balanced doing with being caring. The
caring relationship she established created a
higher quality nursing care that benefited both
the patient and the nurse.
Acknowledging the unique caring nature of
nursing and demonstrating a professional
commitment to it offers a way for nursing to
help patients make sense of their illnesses. It
also provides an opportunity for nursing to
claim a unique place in the health-care system
by generating evidence of the value of caring
through high quality outcomes.
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 406
CHAPTER 22 • Joanne Duffy’s Quality-Caring Model© 407
■ Summary
Practice-based knowledge is a hallmark of a
profession; therefore, a strong alignment be-
tween a theory and the practice of it enhances
its significance to society. Caring and quality in
health care are implicitly tied together. Because
humans exist in relation to others, caring rela-
tionships facilitate human advancement and
the future interactions so necessary for excellent
health care. Independent and collaborative car-
ing relationships in health care contribute to
patients’ welfare in that they promote comfort,
safety, consistent communication, and learning.
Professional nurses who regularly relate to
themselves and their communities are more
equipped to engage in genuine independent
and collaborative caring relationships with
patients and families as well as advance their
own self-caring. Spending time “in relation-
ship” focuses attention on the patient versus the
disease or task and generates a meaningful
practice that is the basis for joy. In essence, the
model benefits both patients and nurses as well
as the profession and the health-care system.
Theory-guided, evidence-based professional
practice that is holistic and meaningful can
make a profound impact on patient outcomes.
Implications of the revised quality-caring
model© exist for educators to help students
learn how to care. Transforming the learning
environment with meaningful learning activi-
ties, clinical experiences, and frequent reflec-
tion on the salience of caring relationships
helps students share meanings, elicit relevant
data, listen, notice cues, establish rapport, and
develop mutually caring interactions. Using
evaluation techniques and frequent caring stu-
dent–teacher interactions, nurse educators can
greatly enhance learning outcomes. Clinical
courses in which caring behaviors are valued
and role-modeled by faculty are essential. Sim-
ilarly, it is crucial that those nurses in leader-
ship positions create caring–healing–protective
environments for staff and patients in a cost-
effective manner. Redesigning professional
workflow so that its primary function is rela-
tionship centered and making decisions in a
participatory manner are paramount to quality
caring. Finally, showing evidence of nursing’s
foremost professional purpose (caring) through
ordinary everyday caring actions blended with
a culture of continuous inquiry creates novel
possibilities for advancing the profession.
Example Institutions Using the Quality–Caring Model©
for Professional Practice
Children’s Mercy Hospital and Clinics,
Kansas City, MO
Forsyth Medical Center, Winston-Salem, NC
Hannibal Medical Center, Hannibal, MO
Holy Cross Hospital, Silver Spring, MD
Johns Hopkins, Bayview, Baltimore, MD
Lakeland Regional Medical Center,
Lakeland, FL
Lowell General Hospital, Lowell, MA
McLaren, Northern Michigan Medical
Center, Petoskey, MI
M.D. Anderson Medical Center, Houston, TX
Methodist Hospital, Henderson, KY
Presbyterian Hospital, Charlotte, NC
Prince William Hospital, Manassas, VA
St. Joseph’s Medical Center, Towson, MD
Swedish American Hospital, Rockford, IL
Texas Health Resources, Arlington, TX
Torrance Memorial Hospital, Torrance, CA
West Virginia University Hospitals, Mor-
gantown, WV
References
Ayers, L. R., Beyea, S. C., Godfrey, M. M., Harper, D.
C., Nelson, E. C., Batalden, P. B. (2005). Quality
improvement learning collaborative. Quality Man-
agement in Health Care, 14(4), 234–247.
Boudreaux, E. C., Francis, J. L., & Loyacano, T. (2002).
Family presence during invasive procedures and
resuscitations in the emergency department: A
critical review and suggestions for future research.
Annals of Emergency Medicine, 40, 193–205.
Boykin, A., & Schoenhofer, S. (1993). Nursing as caring:
A model for transforming practice. New York: National
League for Nursing Press.
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 407
Burt, K. (2007). The relationship between nurse caring
and selected outcomes of care in hospitalized older
adults. Dissertation Abstracts International (UMI No.
3257620).
Campbell, P., & Rudisill, P. (2006). Psychosocial needs
of the critically ill obstetric patient: The nurse’s role.
Critical Care Nursing Quarterly, 29(10), 77–80.
Cossette, S., Cote, J. K., Pepin, J., Ricard, N., &
D’Aoust, L. X. (2006). A dimensional structure of
nurse–patient interactions from a caring perspective:
refinement of the Caring Nurse–Patient Interaction
Scale (CNPI-Short Scale). Journal of Advanced
Nursing 55(2), 198–214.
Coulter, A (2012). Patient Engagement—What
Works? Journal of Ambulatory Care Management,
35(2), 80–89.
D’Antonio, M. (2008). Why I almost quit nursing. Johns
Hopkins Nursing, 6(2), 34–35.
Davidson, R. J., Kabat-Zinn, J., Schumaker, J.,
Rosenkranz, M., Muller, D., & Santorelli, S. F.
(2003). Alterations in brain and immune function
produced by mindfulness meditation. Psychosomatic
Medicine, 65(4), 564–570.
Duffy, J. (1992). Impact of nurse caring on patient out-
comes. In D. A. Gaut (Ed.), The presence of caring in
nursing (pp. 113–136). New York: National League
for Nursing Press.
Duffy, J. (1993). Caring behaviors of nurse managers:
Relationships to staff nurse satisfaction and reten-
tion. In D. Gaut (Ed.), A global agenda for caring
(pp. 365–377). New York: National League for
Nursing Press.
Duffy, J. (2002). Caring assessment tools and the
CAT-admin version. In J. Watson (Ed.), Instru-
ments for assessing and measuring caring in nursing
and health sciences (pp. 131–148). New York:
Springer.
Duffy, J. (2009). Quality caring in nursing: Applying
theory to clinical practice, education, and leadership.
New York: Springer Publishing.
Duffy, J., & Hoskins, L. (2003). The quality-caring
model©: Blending dual paradigms, Advances in
Nursing Science, 26(1), 77–88.
Duffy, J. (2013a). Quality caring in nursing and health
systems: Implications for clinicians, educators, and
leaders. New York, NY: Springer.
Duffy, J. (2013b). Theories focused on caring. In J. B.
Butts & K. L. Rich (Eds). Philosophies and theories
for advanced nursing practice (pp. 507-524). Sudbury,
MA: Jones & Bartlett Learning, LLC.
Duffy, J., Hoskins, L. M., & Dudley-Brown, S. (2005).
Development and testing of a caring-based interven-
tion for older adults with heart failure. Journal of
Cardiovascular Nursing, 20(5), 325–333.
Duffy, J., Hoskins, L. M., & Seifert, R. F. (2007). Di-
mensions of caring: Psychometric properties of the
caring assessment tool. Advances in Nursing Science,
30(3), 235–245.
Duffy, J., Brewer, B., & Weaver, M. (2014). Revision
and Psychometric Properties of the Caring Assess-
ment Tool. Clinical Nursing Research, 23(1), 80–93.
Duffy, J., Kooken, W., Wolverton, C., & Weaver, M.
(2012). Evaluating patient-centered care: Feasibility
of electronic data collection in hospitalized older
adults. Journal of Nursing Care Quality, 27(4), 307–331.
Edwards, M., & Ewen, A. J. (1996). 360 degree feedback:
The powerful new model for employee assessment &
performance improvement. New York: American
Management Association.
Erci, B., Sayan, A., Tortumluoag, G., Kilic, D., Sahin,
O., & Gungurmus, A. (2003). The effectiveness of
Watson’s caring model on the quality of life and
blood pressure on patients with hypertension. Journal
of Advanced Nursing, 41(2), 130–139.
Fineberg, H. V. (2012). Shattuck Lecture: A successful
and sustainable health system—how to get there
from here. New England Journal of Medicine,
366(11), 1020–1027.
Foster, R. (2004). Self-care: Why is it so hard? Journal
of Specialists in Pediatric Nursing, 9(4), 85–94.
Goodwin, J. S., Howrey, B., Zhang, D., & Kuo, Y. F.
(2011). Risk of continued institutionalization after
hospitalization in older adults. Journal of Gerontological
Medical Science, 66(12), 1321–1327.
Henderson, V. (1980). Nursing—yesterday and tomorrow.
Nursing Times, 76, 905–907.
Hibbard, J. H., Stockard, J., Mahoney, E. R., & Tusler,
M. (2004). Development of the Patient Activation
Measure (PAM): Conceptualizing and measuring
activation in patients and consumers. Health Services
Research, 39(4 pt 1), 1005–1026.
Hudon, C., Fortin, M., Haggerty, J. L., Lambert, M.,
Poitras, M.E (2011). Measuring patients’ percep-
tions of patient-centered care: A systematic review
of tools for family medicine. Annals Family Medicine,
9(2), 155–164.
Institute of Medicine (2004). Keeping patients safe:
Transforming the work environment of nurses.
Washington, DC: author.
Jackson, C. T., Trygstad, T. K., DeWalt, D. A., &
DuBard, C. A. (2013). Transitional care cut hospital
readmissions for North Carolina Medicaid patients
with complex chronic conditions. Health Affairs,
32(8), 1407–1415
Johnson, D. E. (1990). The behavioral system model for
nursing. In M. E. Parker (Ed.), Nursing theories in
practice (pp. 23–32). New York: National League for
Nursing Press.
King, I. (1981). A theory for nursing: Systems, concepts,
process. New York: Wiley.
Knaus, W. A., Draper, E. A., Wagner, D. P., &
Zimmerman, J. E. (1986). An evaluation of outcome
from intensive care in major medical centers. Annals
of Internal Medicine, 104, 410–418.
Leininger, M. M. (1981). The phenomenon of caring:
Importance of research and theoretical considerations.
408 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 408
CHAPTER 22 • Joanne Duffy’s Quality-Caring Model© 409
In M. M. Leininger (Ed.), Caring: An essential human
need. Thorofare, NJ: Slack.
London, M., & Smither, J. W. (1995). Can multisource
feedback change perceptions of goal accomplish-
ments, self evaluations, and performance-related out-
comes? Theory based applications and directions for
research. Personnel Psychology, 48, 803–839.
Mangurten, J., Scott, S., Guzzetta, C., Clark, A. P.,
Vinson, L., Sperry, J., et al. (2006). Effects of family
presence during resuscitation and invasive procedures
in a pediatric emergency department. Journal of
Emergency Nursing, 32(3), 225–233.
Maslow, A. (1954). Motivation and personality. New York:
Harper.
Mayerhoff, M. (1971). On caring. New York: Harper &
Row.
Nelson, E. C., Godfrey, M. M., Batalden, P. B., Berry,
S. A., Bothe, A. E., McKinley, K. E., et al. (2008).
Clinical microsystems, part 1. The building blocks of
health systems. Joint Commission Journal of Quality
Improvement, 34(7), 367–378.
Nightingale, F. (1992). Notes on nursing: What it is, and
what it is not (commemorative ed.). Philadelphia:
Lippincott.
Orem, D. (2001). Nursing concepts of practice (6th ed.).
Wilkes Barre, PA: Mosby.
Paul, F., Hendry, C., & Cabrelli, L. (2004). Meeting
patient and relatives’ information needs upon transfer
from an intensive care unit: The development and
evaluation of an information booklet. Journal of
Clinical Nursing, 13, 396–405.
Peplau, H. E. (1988). Interpersonal relations in nursing.
New York: Springer.
Roach, S. (1984). Caring: The human mode of being:
Implications for nursing—perspectives in caring
(Monograph 1). Toronto, CA: Faculty of Nursing,
University of Toronto.
Rogers, C. (1961). On becoming a person: A therapist’s
view of psychotherapy. Archives of General Psychiatry,
62, 1377–1384.
Roy, C. (1980). The Roy adaptation model. In: J. P. Riehl
& C. Roy (Eds.), Conceptual models for nursing practice
(2nd ed., pp. 179–188). New York: Appleton-
Century-Crofts.
Siegel, D. J. (2007). The mindful brain. New York:
W. W. Norton.
Swan, B. (1998). Postoperative nursing care contributions
to symptom distress and functional status after ambu-
latory surgery. MEDSURG Nursing, 7(3), 148–158.
Swanson, K. (1991). Empirical development of a middle
range theory of caring. Nursing Research, 40, 161–166.
Watson, J. (1979). Nursing: The philosophy and science of
caring. Boston: Little, Brown (2nd printing 1985).
Boulder, CO: Colorado University Press.
Watson, J. (1985). Nursing: Human science and human
care. New York: National League for Nursing Press.
Watson, J. (2002). Instruments for assessing and measuring
caring in nursing and health sciences. New York:
Springer.
Wolf, Z. R., Zuzelo, P. R., Goldberg, E., Crothers, R.,
& Jacobson, N. (2006). The Caring Behaviors
Inventory for Elders: Development and psychometric
characteristics. International Journal for Human Caring,
10(1), 49–59.
Yalom, I. D. (1975). The theory and practice of group
psychotherapy. New York: Basic Books.
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 409
3312_Ch22_393-410 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 410
Chapter 23Pamela Reed’s Theory of
Self-Transcendence
PAMELA G. REED
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Theory
Applications of the Theory
Practice Exemplar
Summary
References
411
Introducing the Theorist
Pamela G. Reed is professor at the University
of Arizona College of Nursing in Tucson. She
received her academic degrees from Wayne
State University in Detroit, Michigan: a BSN
and an MSN with a double major in child &
adolescent psychiatric–mental health nursing
and nursing education, which prepared her
both as a clinical nurse specialist and a nurse
educator. In 1982, Dr. Reed received her PhD
from Wayne State University, majoring in
nursing research and theory with a minor in
life span development and aging.
She promoted the study of spirituality as an
area of scientific inquiry in nursing. Her research
in spirituality, mental health and well-being,
aging, and end-of-life was strongly influenced
by the theoretical ideas of Martha Rogers and
the life span developmentalists. Dr. Reed’s the-
ory of self-transcendence is based in part on her
research and on her developmental perspective
of well-being. The theory has been widely pub-
lished and is used by many nurses in practice and
research. In addition, Dr. Reed developed two
widely used research instruments, the Spiritual
Perspective Scale and the Self-Transcendence Scale.
Dr. Reed is a fellow in the American Acad-
emy of Nursing and is a member of a number of
professional organizations including Sigma
Theta Tau International, the American Nurses
Association, and the Society of Rogerian Schol-
ars. She serves on editorial review boards of
numerous journals and as a contributing editor
for Applied Nursing Research and Nursing Science
Quarterly. Dr. Reed is coeditor of a nursing
theory text, Perspectives on Nursing Theory, now
in its 6th edition, and author, along with Nelma
Shearer, of Nursing Knowledge and Theory
Innovation: Advancing the Science of Practice.
Pamela Reed
3312_Ch23_411-420 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 411
Since January 1983, Dr. Reed has been on
the University of Arizona faculty, where she
teaches, writes, conducts research, and served
as Associate Dean for Academic Affairs for
7 years. She has received many teaching
awards from faculty and students. In addition
to writing for research publications, she fre-
quently writes about the philosophical and
theoretical dimensions of nursing with a focus
on practice-based knowledge development.
She lives with her husband in the Sonoran
desert of Tucson, Arizona, where her two
daughters also reside.
Overview of the Theory
The focus of the theory is on facilitating the
process of self-transcendence for the purpose of
enhancing or supporting well-being. Theories
from other sciences, such as psychology, also
address self-transcendence. However, what dis-
tinguishes this particular theory as a nursing the-
ory is its focus on well-being in the context of
difficult health experiences. The theory proposes
that people’s capacity for self-transcendence is
activated when they face life-threatening illness
or undergo health-related changes that intensify
awareness of vulnerability or mortality. This
increase in self-transcendence is evident in
expansion of self-boundaries in ways that foster
well-being. Individuals have the capacity to
expand their boundaries in healthy ways, but in
serious illness or other health-related life crises,
nurses and other professionals can be helpful in
facilitating this process of self-transcendence.
The scope of the theory has been extended
beyond its original focus on later adulthood to
address self-transcendence as a resource for
well-being across the life span from adolescence
to adulthood, with potential applications to
childhood.
Foundations of the Theory
All theories are built on assumptions generally
considered to be true as derived from widely ac-
cepted theory or empirical findings or as self-
evident. Assumptions are not tested in research
but instead serve as foundational ideas for the
theory. Two major frameworks that originated
in the mid-20th century and continue to be
relevant today motivated the theory of self-
transcendence: Martha Rogers’s (1970, 1980,
1990) conceptual system about the human–
environment process and the life-span devel-
opmental science perspective articulated by
Richard Lerner (e.g., 2002; Lerner, Lamb, &
Freund, 2010), both of which are related to
complexity science (e.g., Kauffman, 1995).
One philosophical assumption of self-
transcendence theory is that humans undergo
change that is developmental in nature (char-
acterized by increasing complexity and organ-
ization) and as part of this innovative process,
humans also possess inherent potential for
healing, emotional growth, and well-being
throughout the lifespan. This potential for
well-being has been described by Reed (1997)
most fundamentally as a nursing process, anal-
ogous to basic chemical processes of chem-
istry or the social processes of interest to
sociologists. Self-transcendence is an example
of a nursing process.
A second philosophical assumption is that
humans, as open systems, impose conceptual
boundaries on their “openness” to define their
reality and provide a sense of identity and se-
curity. This assumption is based on ideas
from life-span developmental psychology
about the formation and differentiation of self
across development. For example, theorists
have identified the diffuse boundary between
infant and parent, the increased sense of
identity and self-consciousness in children
and adolescents as they clarify their boundary
between self and others, the increased differ-
entiation of self and more secure sense of
identity in middle adulthood, and the complex
and expanded forms of connections to others
and spirituality in later adulthood and end of
life. This assumption was also influenced by
Rogers’s (1970, 1980) nursing science about
perceived self-boundaries that may fluctuate
during health-related life events. She pro-
posed that humans are energy fields infinite
in space and time, extending beyond the “dis-
cernible mass” we identify as the human
body, and without boundaries.
Rogers (1994) used the term pandimension-
ality (revised from her former terms of four-
dimensionality and multidimensionality) to
412 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch23_411-420 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 412
describe the unbounded connections in the
human–environment process and to challenge
conventional distinctions between, for exam-
ple, person and environment, living and
dying. Her principle of integrality proposed a
fundamental connectedness instead of these
perceived boundaries. Her concept of relative
present challenged conventional distinctions
among past, present, and future to acknowl-
edge both the individual’s temporal perspec-
tives and the discoveries in physics about
space-time. So self-transcendence involves
expanding and redefining self-boundaries dur-
ing health events and is evident in connections
to our inner life, to others, to natural and
technological environments, and to imagined
worlds. The theory is based on a pluralistic
view of reality that accounts for the human
capacity—as latent as it may be today—to
expand self-boundaries in innovative ways.
The Theory: Concepts
and Relationships
The theory of self-transcendence, like theories
in general, is a compressed description of a
phenomenon or process and does not catalog
every instance of self-transcendence. A theory
provides a coherent description of key concepts
and their relationships, which researchers and
practitioners can further specify for application
to their unique situations. There are three major
concepts in the theory: self-transcendence,
vulnerability, and well-being.
Self-Transcendence
The core concept of the theory is self-
transcendence. It refers to the capacity to ex-
pand self-boundaries in various ways that en-
hance well-being. For example, self-boundaries
can expand intrapersonally (toward greater
awareness of one’s beliefs, values, and dreams),
interpersonally (to connect with others, nature,
and surrounding environment), transpersonally
(to relate to dimensions beyond the ordinary,
observable world), and temporally (to integrate
one’s past and future in a way that expands and
gives meaning to the present). Other ways of
expanding self-boundaries are possible. For
example, in our increasingly technological world,
expansion of self-boundaries may also involve
connectedness of self with nonliving entities
such as symbolic objects, memories, machines,
and prosthetics that influence well-being in
profound ways.
One caveat in understanding the theory is
that the term self-transcendence may evoke
ideas about the mystical, supernatural, or
other experiences that disconnect self from
others or from the present. However, spiritual
meanings associated with this theory refer
more to terrestrial, everyday practices of spir-
ituality that alter self-boundaries in meaning-
ful ways to connect rather than separate a
person from self, others, nature, and other as-
pects of our environment. Nevertheless, it may
be important to acknowledge the unseen or
the mystery in life.
With regard to assessment, the 15-item
Self-Transcendence Scale (STS) was developed
by Dr. Reed to measure self-transcendence
in individuals who are either well or have
health problems or other limitations due to ill-
ness or disability. The STS is used widely in
research and may also be used by practicing
nurses to better understand areas for assessing
patients. The STS has been translated into sev-
eral languages, including Spanish, Mandarin,
and Korean.
Vulnerability
Vulnerability is a contextual concept in the
theory and refers to an increased awareness of
personal mortality. A wide variety of human
experiences can increase this awareness, but of
particular note are health-related events that
are life threatening or that involve loss.
Chronic and serious illness, disability, aging,
bereavement, traumatic events, and facing end
of life all are contexts of vulnerability and
increased awareness of mortality.
For assessment, a variety of measures or
questions can be used to assess a person’s sense
of vulnerability. Examples of areas to assess
include perceived risk for illness, concerns
about potential loss, and perspectives on living
with a life-threatening illness.
Well-Being
Well-being is the third major concept in
the theory. Well-being is defined broadly as a
CHAPTER 23 • Pamela Reed’s Theory of Self-Transcendence 413
3312_Ch23_411-420 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 413
subjective feeling of health or wholeness as
based on the person’s own criteria at a given
point in time. It involves an existential judg-
ment by the individual and is influenced by
one’s history, culture, values, family and
other significant relationships, and biophys-
ical factors.
There are many measures for the assessment
of well-being in nursing and other health and
social sciences. This reveals the diversity of
values about health and wellness. Examples of
indicators of well-being that have been found
to be significantly related to self-transcendence
include life satisfaction, happiness, high morale
in aging, self-care agency in chronic illness,
sense of meaning in life, and specific indicators
of mental health such as absence of depression,
decreased anxiety, subjective well-being, and
happiness.
Relationships Among the Concepts
Self-transcendence, as a nursing process,
is linked logically with positive, health-
promoting experiences. Self-transcendence
can be a correlate if not a predictor of well-
being. In addition, accumulated research
findings support self-transcendence as a me-
diator of well-being during significant life
events that increase sense of vulnerability.
The model in Figure 23-1 depicts the three
concepts and their relationships.
From the Rogerian-based assumption that
human beings have potential for innovative
expansion of self-boundaries, it was theorized
that vulnerability is related to increased self-
transcendence. In other words, increased
awareness of one’s vulnerability or mortality
can trigger positive, inner strengths—in this
case self-transcendence, an idea long sup-
ported by experts on development at end of
life (e.g., Becker, 1973; Corless, Germino, &
Pittman, 1994; Erikson, 1986; Frankl, 1963;
Marshall, 1996). Self-transcendence in turn
may directly influence increased well-being.
Self-transcendence may also function as a re-
source for well-being during increased vulner-
ability by mediating the relationship between
increased vulnerability and well-being to help
the person transform loss into a growth or
healing experience of well-being.
Additional concepts in the theory are per-
sonal and contextual factors that can influ-
ence the relationships among vulnerability,
self-transcendence, and well-being. Potential
factors include age, gender, ethnicity, years
of education, illness intensity, life history,
social or spiritual support, and other factors
concerning the person’s social, cultural, and
physical environment.
Applications of the Theory
Self-transcendence theory has applications in
both research and practice. In research, the
theory is used as a broad framework for ex-
ploring ideas about self-transcendence in
qualitative studies and as a theoretical frame-
work for examining specific relationships
using quantitative measures. The theory has
been studied for its practice applications with
patients as well as among nurses, family care-
givers, and other health-care providers, and
healthy populations.
Research results support the significance of
self-transcendence as a correlate or predictor
of well-being across a variety of populations,
particularly those experiencing serious illness
or other challenging life situations.
Research
Examples of research applications include the
following studies: clinical depression in older
adults (Haugan & Innstrand, 2012; Reed, 1991;
414 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Personal and
contextual factors
Self-transendence
Vulnerability Well-being
Fig 23 • 1 Model of Reed’s self-transcendence
nursing theory. (Copyright ©2012 by Pamela G. Reed.)
3312_Ch23_411-420 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 414
Stinson & Kirk, 2006); bereavement (Chan, &
Chan, 2011; Kausch & Amer, 2007); people
diagnosed with HIV/AIDS (Coward, 1995;
McCormick, Holder, Wetsel, & Cawthon,
2001; Ramer, Johnson, Chan, & Barrett, 2006;
Sperry, 2011); chronic illness and loss in later life
(Bickerstaff, Grasser, & McCabe, 2003; Gusick,
2008; Nygren et al., 2005); women with breast
cancer (Coward, 2003; Farren, 2010; Matthews
& Cook, 2009; Thomas, Burton, Quinn Griffin,
& Fitzpatrick, 2010); liver and stem cell and
transplant recipients (Bean & Wagner, 2006;
Burns, Robb, & Haase, 2009; Williams, 2012);
older adults both in the community and in
nursing home (Haugan et al., 2012; McCarthy,
2011); and persons with dementia and other
progressive or intractable diseases (Chen &
Walsh, 2009; Iwamoto, Yamawaki, & Sato,
2011). Other research supports the significance
of self-transcendence among caregivers of family
members with dementia or other debilitating
illness and at end-of-life (Acton, 2002; Guo,
Phillips, & Reed, 2010; Kidd, Zauszniewski,
& Morris, 2011; Kim, Reed, Hayward, Kang,
& Koenig, 2011; Reed & Rousseau, 2007)
and among nurses dealing with difficult caregiv-
ing situations (Hunnibell, Reed, Griffin, &
Fitzpatrick, 2008; Palmer, Griffin, Reed, &
Fitzpatrick, 2010). A literature search of the
term self-transcendence using databases from
nursing and other sciences (for example,
CINAHL, BioMed Central, PsycInfo) will
easily generate an up-to-date list of studies and
clinically based articles on self-transcendence1.
Also, see Reed (2013) for an extended list of
references on self-transcendence.
Practice
Practice applications summarized from this
and other research indicate various self-
transcendence strategies that expand self-
boundaries. These approaches may be organ-
ized in terms of intrapersonal, interpersonal,
and transpersonal approaches to boundary
expansion. There may be overlap across these
categories. Many of these activities also ex-
pand temporal boundaries by helping the
person focus on the present.
Intrapersonal approaches help the person
look inward to expand boundaries and inte-
grate loss through self-knowledge and finding
meaning or purpose in one’s life. Examples of
strategies that nurses may suggest for patients
are meditation, self-reflection, and prayer;
guided reminiscence and life review; self-talk,
emotion or stress management, and relaxation
strategies; artistic and other creative activities
of self-expression, reading and writing poetry,
music therapy, and journaling; and exercise
and other physical activities.
Interpersonal activities that facilitate self-
transcendence connect individuals to others
through formal or informal means, including
support groups, faith-based groups, or group
psychotherapy; telephone or Internet-based
interactions; volunteer work and other altruistic
activities including those that allow one to be
of help to others and to share one’s wisdom. Of
course, relationships with family and friends are
central to the interpersonal dimension.
Transpersonal approaches for self-transcendence
are designed to help the person connect with
a power or purpose greater than self. The
nurse’s role in this process is often one of cre-
ating an environment or providing guidance
that fosters approaches such as religious par-
ticipation, spiritual exploration and expression,
involvement in altruistic activities, and work
on creative projects.
CHAPTER 23 • Pamela Reed’s Theory of Self-Transcendence 415
1For additional practice exemplars please go to bonus
chapter content available at FA Davis http://davisplus
.fadavis.com
3312_Ch23_411-420 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 415
416 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Practice Exemplar
This practice exemplar focuses on how to facilitate
well-being outcomes through various strategies that
support self-transcendence. The idea behind the in-
terventions is that facilitating self-transcendence
promotes positive mental health outcomes either
by diminishing the negative effect that vulnera-
bility has on well-being or more directly by en-
hancing those perspectives on life that increase
emotional well-being.
Several years ago, Rose was diagnosed with
emphysema. In her youth and through young
adulthood, Rose had been a professional
dancer on Broadway. But she now found that
what were once the strongest parts of her
body—her legs—were no longer able to carry
her around with grace and ease. Her illness
had advanced to the point that she required
supplemental oxygen and a walker at home.
This made it difficult for her to get out of the
house as often as she desired. She lived alone,
but her daughter, her family caregiver, visited
her several times a week. Recently, Rose expe-
rienced a worsening of her physical symptoms
and more difficulty breathing; so, with her
daughter’s encouragement, she moved closer
to her daughter. Even though Rose’s new
apartment was more modern than her old
house and her daughter could visit more often,
Rose wasn’t as happy in her new surroundings,
and her daughter was concerned about her
depressed mood during her frequent visits.
Their nurse worked together with Rose and
her daughter to design a plan of care that not
only tended to Rose’s declining physical health
needs and any other underlying problems but
also focused on complex needs regarding her
mental health and her emotional and social
well-being. Self-transcendence theory provided
a framework for practice to address these latter
needs. The nurse acknowledged that Rose’s
worsening illness might be contributing to a
heightened sense of vulnerability not only be-
cause it was life-threatening but also because it
diminished the quality of certain areas of her
life. The nurse operated from the basic assump-
tion that nursing care could help activate Rose’s
inner strengths and potential to transcend
some of the boundaries she was facing to attain
a sense of well-being in the midst of vulnera-
bility. And because the theory is a guide and
not an exact recipe for intervention, using the
theory increased the likelihood that the nurse,
Rose, and her daughter together would dis-
cover important areas of self-transcendence
unique to Rose’s situation.
Intrapersonal
The nurse helped expand Rose’s boundaries
on an interpersonal level through a variety of
interactions. Rose explained that she was a pri-
vate person and didn’t like to depend on others.
The nurse’s openness and empathy supported
her in expressing her beliefs about quality of
life, spiritual values, goals for herself, and
dreams for her daughter’s future. These insights
were useful in making health-care and other
decisions. Their discussions also helped Rose
acknowledge and integrate difficult feelings
into her life. Whether she resolved all of her
concerns was not as important as acknowledg-
ing and accepting them for the time being. The
nurse acknowledged Rose and her daughter’s
fears and losses along the way and supported
their hope and faith that they could cope with,
and maybe even grow from, the experience.
Interpersonal
Besides the fact that these objects confronted
her with her mortality, Rose found it embarrass-
ing that she had to use a walker and supplemen-
tal oxygen wherever she went. She perceived
these items as foreign and undignified objects
that announced her aging and disability to the
world. Rose also missed her friends from her
former home and especially missed her “mailbox
neighbor” who also carried an oxygen tank. The
nurse suggested that Rose participate in a pul-
monary rehabilitation program, particularly a
program-sponsored support group where she
might gain friends among people who not only
had similar illness experiences but who also, as
Rose said, “looked like [her] too!” As Rose was
able to expand her self-boundary to integrate
assistive devices into her life, she became more
3312_Ch23_411-420 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 416
CHAPTER 23 • Pamela Reed’s Theory of Self-Transcendence 417
Practice Exemplar cont.
accepting of her illness and herself overall.
Attending the support group also provided her
opportunities to use her own experiences to help
others. Sharing her wisdom with others was very
gratifying to Rose and enhanced her well-being.
The nurse also worked to ensure that Rose and
her daughter would lead the health-care decisions
and fully participate in health-care activities.
She helped connect Rose and her daughter
with resources to navigate the health-care sys-
tem and address financial concerns. Information
about the illness and self-care strategies helped
demystify the health experience and regimen.
Transpersonal
Rose admitted that she was not particularly re-
ligious but found herself praying each morning
and evening. The nurse was aware that religious
beliefs held in youth can become important at
the end of life, even if they had been eschewed
during adulthood. The nurse acknowledged
that Rose, like others, might find value in spir-
itual perspectives that connected her to some
thing or some purpose larger than the individ-
ual. Even though she had difficulty believing in
a life after death, the possibility offered some
comfort and helped Rose integrate awareness
about her own mortality and being separated
from her family and friends. The nurse also
guided Rose through a spiritual history of her
life to uncover other sources of strength and
perhaps make new discoveries about herself that
she could draw from as time progressed.
Temporal
The illness initiated and intensified Rose’s con-
cerns about the future and fears about pain and
mortality. The nurse explored these concerns
with Rose in a realistic yet empathetic manner.
A life review in which Rose reflected on her
past, discussed anticipating the unknown, and
then connected these insights to her present
concerns provided a sense of meaning that
she found emotionally satisfying. The nurse
also facilitated Rose’s fuller enjoyment in the
present by encouraging positive experiences
such as planning enjoyable activities, holding
small celebrations, and taking pictures of im-
portant or memorable events. These activities
generated a legacy and a gift that connected
Rose’s present to her family’s future. Expand-
ing her self-boundary to incorporate other
temporalities gave Rose access to meaningful
experiences that often sustained her across the
trajectory of her illness. Also, simply reminding
Rose to try to engage in positive self-talk
was sometimes helpful in getting her through
a difficult moment.
Rose’s Self-Transcendence
Rose did not expect the nurse or her daughter
to create self-transcendent experiences for
her. But their support and guidance but-
tressed her own inner potential for healing
through the illness experience. Transcending
self-boundaries may require the support of
others, even though there is the assumption
that self-transcendence is a natural human
capacity. Rose’s openness to accepting help
and guidance from the nurse was a first step in
expanding her self-boundaries. By nurturing
connections to her beliefs and values, her God,
her support group friends, and to her daughter
and nurse, Rose was able to expand her self-
boundaries in ways that enhanced her well-
being within the context of her incurable illness.
■ Summary
The theory of self-transcendence was built on
the assumption that people may perceive self-
boundaries but that they also have the capacity
to expand or adjust these boundaries in positive
ways, whether by bringing in new perspectives,
revising old beliefs, reaching out to others, or
connecting to something greater than oneself.
The theory of self-transcendence acknowledges
the tendency to construct a self-boundary as
well as the capacity to transcend limiting views
3312_Ch23_411-420 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 417
418 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
of self and the world in ways that reflect the
pandimensional nature of living systems. The
theory provides an approach to facilitating
well-being in nursing practice by helping indi-
viduals expand their personal boundaries within
their developmental and situational contexts.
The theory of self-transcendence comprises
three key concepts: self-transcendence, well-
being, and vulnerability. The theory’s concepts
were designed to be clear and measurable yet
to be broad enough in scope to allow nurses
the flexibility in using the theory across a vari-
ety of research and practice situations. Practi-
tioners and researchers who use the theory can
define the general concepts of vulnerability and
well-being using more specific, measurable
terms to make the theory applicable to their
specific group of patients or clinical practice
setting.
In a general sense, the theory of self-tran-
scendence is a well-being theory (Reed, 2008).
The theory proposes that self-transcendence
arises in contexts of vulnerability and facili-
tates well-being, either in directly increasing
well-being or acting as a mediator in the
relationship between vulnerability and well-
being. Evidence to date indicates that self-
transcendence interventions may diminish
risks of vulnerability and increase sense of
well-being during difficult health-related
situations. Both practitioners and researchers
can use the theory to build knowledge about
facilitating human well-being across a variety
of health experiences.
References
Acton, G. J. (2002). Self-transcendent views and
behaviors: Exploring growth in caregivers of adults
with dementia. Journal of Gerontological Nursing,
28(12), 22–30.
Bean, K. B., & Wagner, K. (2006). Self-transcendence,
illness distress, and quality of life among liver trans-
plant recipients. The Journal of Theory Construction &
Testing, 10(2), 47–53.
Becker, E. (1973). The denial of death. New York:
The Free Press.
Bickerstaff, K. A., Grasser, C. M., & McCabe, B.
(2003). How elderly nursing home residents tran-
scend losses of later life. Holistic Nursing Practice,
17(3), 159–165.
Burns, D. S., Robb, S. L., & Haase, J. E. (2009). Explor-
ing the feasibility of a therapeutic music video inter-
vention in adolescents and young adults during stem
cell transplantation. Cancer Nursing, 32(5), 8–16.
Chan, W. C., & Chan, C. L. W. (2011). Acceptance of
spousal death: The factor of time in bereaved older
adults’ search for meaning. Death Studies, 35, 147–162.
Chen, S., & Walsh, S. M. (2009). Effect of a creative-
bonding intervention on Taiwanese nursing students’
self-transcendence and attitudes toward elders.
Research in Nursing & Health, 32, 204-216.
Corless, I. B., Germino, B. B., & Pittman, M. (1994).
Dying, death, and bereavement: Theoretical perspectives
and other ways of knowing. Boston: Jones and Bartlett.
Coward, D. (1995). Lived experience of self-transcen-
dence in women with AIDS. Journal of Obstetric,
Gynecologic, and Neonatal Nursing, 24, 314–318.
Coward, D. D. (2003). Facilitation of self-transcendence
in a breast cancer support group: Part II. Oncology
Nursing Forum, 30 (2), 291–300.
Erikson, E. H. (1986). Vital involvement in old age.
New York: Norton.
Farren, A.T., (2010). Power, uncertainty, self-
transcendence, and quality of life in breast cancer
survivors. Nursing Science Quarterly, 23 (1), 63-71.
Frankl, V. E. (1963). Man’s search for meaning. New
York: Pocket Books.
Guo, G., Phillips, L., & Reed, P.G. (2010). End of life
caregiver interactions with healthcare providers:
Learning from the bad. Journal of Nursing Care
Quality, 25 (3 – July-Sept), 188-197.
Gusick, G. M. (2008). The Contribution of Depression
and Spirituality to Symptom Burden in Chronic Heart
Failure, Archives of Psychiatric Nursing, 22 (1), 53-55.
Haugan, G., & Innstrand, S. (2012). The effect of self-
transcendence on depression in cognitively intact
nursing home patients. International Scholarly Research
Network (ISRN) Psychiatry, 2012, doi:10.5402/2012
/301325, 1-10.
Haugan,G., Rannestad, T., Hammervold, R., Gara°sen,
H., & Espnes, G.A. (2012) Self-transcendence in
cognitively intact nursing home patients: A resource
for well-being. Journal of Advanced Nursing, DOI:
10.1111/j.1365-2648.2012.06106.
Hunnibell, L.S., Reed, P.G., Quinn-Griffin, M.Q., &
Fitzpatrick, J.J. (2008). Self-transcendence and
burnout in hospice and oncology nurses. Journal
of Hospice and Palliative Nursing, 10 (3), 172 – 179.
Iwamoto, R, Yamawaki, N., & Sato, T. (2011). Increased
self-transcendence in patients with intractable diseases.
Psychiatry and Clinical Neurosciences, 65 (7), 638-647.
Kauffman, S. (1995). At home in the universe: The search
for laws of self-organization and complexity.
New York: Oxford University Press.
3312_Ch23_411-420 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 418
Kausch, K. D., & Amer, K. (2007). Self-transcendence
and depression among AIDS memorial quilt panel
makers. Journal of Psychosocial Nursing, 45(6), 45–53.
Kidd, L. I., Zauszniewski, J. A., & Morris, D. L.
(2011). Benefits of a poetry writing intervention
for family caregivers of elders with dementia. Issues
in Mental Health Nursing, 32, 598–604.
Kim, S., Reed, P. G., Hayward, R. D., Kang, Y., &
Koenig, H. G. (2011). Spirituality and psychological
well-being: Testing a theory of family interdepend-
ence among family caregivers and their elders.
Research in Nursing & Health, 34, 103–115.
Lerner, R. M. (2002). Concepts and theories of human
development (3rd ed.). New York: Random House.
Lerner, R. M., Lamb, M. E., & Freund, A. M. (Eds.).
(2010). The handbook of life-span development: Social
and emotional development. Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.
Marshall, V. W. (1996). Death, bereavement, and
the social psychology of aging and dying. In J. D.
Morgan (Ed.), Ethical issues in death, dying and
bereavement (pp. 57–75). Amityville, NY: Baywood.
Matthews, E. E., & Cook, P. F. (2009). Relationships
among optimism, well-being, self-transcendence,
coping, and social support in women during treat-
ment for breast cancer. Psycho-Oncology, 18, 716–726.
McCarthy, V. L. (2011). A new look at successful aging:
Exploring a mid-range nursing theory among older
adults in a low-income retirement community.
The Journal of Theory Construction & Testing,
15(1), 17–23.
McCormick, D. P., Holder, B., Wetsel, M. A., &
Cawthon, T. W. (2001). Spirituality and HIV
disease: An integrated perspective. Journal of the
Association of Nurses in AIDS Care, 12(3), 58–65.
Nygren, B., Aléx , L., Jonsén, E., Gustafson, Y., Norberg,
A., & Lundman, B. (2005). Resilience, sense of
coherence, purpose in life and self-transcendence in re-
lation to perceived physical and mental health among
the oldest old. Aging & Mental Health, 9(4), 354–362.
Palmer, B., Quinn Griffin, M. T., Reed, P., & Fitzpatrick,
J. J. (2010). Self-transcendence and work engagement
in acute care staff registered nurses. Critical Care
Nursing Quarterly, 33(2), 138–147.
Ramer, L., Johnson, D., Chan, L., & Barrett, M. T.
(2006). The effect of HIV/AIDS disease progression
on spirituality and self-transcendence in a multicultural
population. Journal of Transcultural Nursing, 17(3),
280–289.
Reed, P. G. (1991). Self-transcendence and mental health
in the oldest-old adults. Nursing Research, 40(1), 5–11.
Reed, P. G. (1997). Nursing: The ontology of the
discipline. Nursing Science Quarterly, 10(2), 76–79.
Reed, P. G. (2008). Reed’s theory of self-transcendence.
Nurse Theorists Portraits of Excellence (Vol. 2). Athens,
OH: Fitne Video.
Reed, P. G. (2013). Theory of self-transcendence. In M.
Smith & P. Liehr, (Eds.), Middle range theories for
nursing (3rd ed.). New York: Springer.
Reed, P. G., & Rousseau, E. (2007). Spiritual inquiry
and well-being in life-limiting illness. Journal of
Spirituality, Religion, and Aging, 19(4), 81–98.
Rogers, M. E. (1970). An introduction to the theoretical
basis of nursing. Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Rogers, M. E. (1980). A science of unitary man. In J.
Riehl & C. Roy (Eds.), Conceptual models for nursing
practice (2nd ed., pp. 329–338). New York:
Appleton-Century-Crofts.
Rogers, M. E. (1990). Nursing: Science of unitary, irre-
ducible, human beings: Update 1990. In: E. A. M.
Barrett (Ed.), Visions of Rogers’ science based nursing
(pp. 5–12). New York: National League for
Nursing Press.
Rogers, M. E. (1994). The science of unitary human
beings: Current perspectives. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 7(1), 33–35.
Sperry, J. J. (2011). The relationship of self transcendence, so-
cial interest, and spirituality to well-being in HIV/AIDS
adults. Unpublished doctoral dissertation, Florida
Atlantic University.
Stinson, C. K., & Kirk, E. (2006). Structured reminis-
cence: An intervention to decrease depression and
increase self-transcendence in older women. Journal
of Clinical Nursing, 15(2), 208–218.
Thomas, J. C., Burton, M., Quinn Griffin, M. T., &
Fitzpatrick, J. J (2010). Self-transcendence, spiritual
well-being, and spiritual practices of women with
breast cancer, Journal of Holistic Nursing, 28(2),
115–122.
Williams, B. J. (2012). Self-transcendence in stem cell
transplantation recipients: A phenomenologic
inquiry. Oncology Nursing Forum, 39(4), E41–E48.
CHAPTER 23 • Pamela Reed’s Theory of Self-Transcendence 419
3312_Ch23_411-420 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 419
3312_Ch23_411-420 26/12/14 10:44 AM Page 420
Chapter 24Patricia Liehr and Mary Jane
Smith’s Story Theory
PATRICIA LIEHR AND MARY JANE SMITH
Introducing the Theorists
Overview of the Theory
Applications of the Theory
Practice Exemplar
Summary
References
421
Introducing the Theorists
Patricia R. Liehr, PhD, RN, graduated from
Ohio Valley Hospital School of Nursing in
Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania. She completed her
baccalaureate degree in nursing at Villa Maria
College, her master’s in family health nursing
at Duquesne University, and her doctorate at
the University of Maryland–Baltimore School
of Nursing, with an emphasis on psychophys-
iology. She completed postdoctoral studies at
the University of Pennsylvania as a Robert
Wood Johnson Scholar. Dr. Liehr is currently
a Professor of Nursing at the Christine E.
Lynn College of Nursing at Florida Atlantic
University. She has taught nursing theory to
master’s and doctoral students for nearly two
decades.
Mary Jane Smith, PhD, RN, earned her
bachelor’s and master’s degrees from the
University of Pittsburgh and her doctorate
from New York University. She has held
faculty positions at the following nursing
schools: University of Pittsburgh, Duquesne
University, Cornell University-New York
Hospital, and Ohio State University; and she
is currently a Professor at West Virginia
University School of Nursing. She has been
teaching theory to nursing students for nearly
three decades.
Overview of the Theory
Story theory evolved as the cocreators talked
about their practice-research experience with
pregnant teens and people recovering from a
cardiac event (Smith & Liehr, 2014b). It was
clear to the creators that health-promoting
change was fostered when one’s story of preg-
nancy or living through a cardiac event was
Patricia Liehr Mary Jane Smith
3312_Ch24_421-434 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 421
embraced. It was as though acceptance of these
health circumstances energized new directions
for healing and health. Story theory was first
published in 1999 (Smith & Liehr, 1999), and
it has continued to be used, tested, and shaped
for more than a decade (Smith & Liehr, 2014a).
Stories are integral to nursing practice. Prac-
tice decisions are informed both by physiological
bodily responses and by the stories that infuse
bodily responses with unique personal meaning.
To focus on one without attention to the other
contributes to less than optimal nursing care.
There are times when either the physiological
bodily responses or the story is foreground
and the other is background; this foreground–
background interplay dynamically emerges over
the course of each nurse–person caring interac-
tion. For instance, when a person comes into the
emergency room with crushing chest pain and
then suddenly becomes unconsciousness, num-
bers related to physiology are in the foreground.
Heart rate, blood pressure, and respiratory rate
guide critical immediate action. Within a short
time, the nurse will want to begin to gather the
story, including dimensions such as what the
person was doing when the chest pain began,
whether this has ever happened before, and
what other life and health circumstances could
have contributed to the chest pain. Stories are
essential to even the most technology-driven
nursing practice, and in some ways, the more
technology-driven the practice, the more impor-
tant the place of relevant health stories.
Our linear-thinking culture often places
greater value on physiological bodily responses
than stories. In fact, precious stories shared
during nursing practice may be heard and
disregarded or heard and acted on without
another thought about the practice evidence
generated. Practice stories are seldom chroni-
cled, unfortunately lost to becoming part of the
foundation of nursing practice evidence. The
overall intent of this chapter is to describe
story theory as a framework informing story-
gathering and story analysis, thereby position-
ing story as a major thread of nursing practice
evidence, contributing to substantive nursing
knowledge.
This chapter first addresses the emergence
of story, or narrative, as a topic of interest for
health-care providers, including nurses. Then
story theory is summarized, including the es-
sential theory concepts (intentional dialogue,
connecting with self-in-relation, creating ease)
and discussion of ways that the theory comes
alive in practice. Bringing the theory to life is
described in the context of the theory method
dimensions (complicating health challenge,
developing story plot, movement toward
resolving) aligned respectively with each theory
concept. We discuss a seven-phase inquiry
process for using the evidence from practice
stories to grow the substantive knowledge
of the discipline. Finally, an exemplar is used
to highlight the potential of the theory for
guiding practice through application of the
seven-phase inquiry process.
Emergence of Story as a Topic
of Interest
Story is not new to nursing. Nurse theorists
(Boykin & Schoenhofer, 1991, 2001; Newman,
1999; Parse, 1981; Peplau, 1991; Watson, 1997)
have called attention to the importance of listen-
ing to what matters since the time of Florence
Nightingale, who implored nurses to stop
chattering and begin listening (Nightingale,
1969). Others (Benner, 1984; Chinn & Kramer,
1999; Ford & Turner, 2001) have used the sto-
ries of practicing nurses to understand both the
challenge and the essence of nursing practice. In
a discussion of the importance of story for
research with minority populations, Banks-
Wallace (2002) discussed the therapeutic value
of storytelling. Story sharing has also had a
prominent place in research with elders (Heliker,
2007; Sierpina & Cole, 2004). It is often used
by nurse researchers focused on the art of caring
for people who have dementia (Crichton &
Koch, 2007; Holm, Lepp, & Ringsberg, 2005;
Keady, Williams, & Hughes-Roberts, 2007).
Recently, physicians have emphasized nar-
rative medicine as both a way of learning
clinical practice essentials and a way of ap-
proaching patients (Charon, 2006, 2012;
Charon & Montello, 2002; Mehl-Medrona,
2007). Diamond, a psychotherapist, addressed
the long history of using narrative, in forms
such as personal testimony and letter writing,
to treat alcoholism and addiction. In his book
422 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch24_421-434 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 422
titled Narrative Means to Sober Ends (Diamond,
2000), he describes the spirit of narrative ther-
apy: “Stories, not atoms, are the stuff that hold
our lives and our world together” (p. 5). This
view of stories resonates with the foundational
assumptions of story theory and with a valuing
of the important place of stories for health
promotion. In Narrative Medicine: The Use of
History and Story in the Healing Process, Mehl-
Madrona (2007) approached the topic of nar-
rative from a Native American perspective,
distinguishing narrative medicine from conven-
tional medicine and proceeding to share Native
American stories that he described as maps for
healing. The outside-the-discipline focus “con-
firms our beliefs about the significance of story
and reminds us that this core dimension of
nursing practice is now being recognized by
other disciplines” (Smith & Liehr, 2014b,
p. 229). Although we, the authors, do not
equate story with narrative, we accept the place
of narrative within the context of story. Story
moves beyond narrative, intricately weaving re-
membered events, personal interpretations of
the moment and hopes and dreams to create the
“now” moment, guiding choices in the moment.
Story theory is one way to conceptualize an
idea that has a long history in nursing and
recently escalated attention from other disci-
plines. The authors believe that the structure of
story theory creates possibilities for application
and evaluation that are critical to the endeavor
of building substantive disciplinary knowledge.
Foundations of the Theory
Story theory proposes that story is a narrative
happening wherein a person connects with self-
in-relation through nurse–person intentional
dialogue to create ease (Smith & Liehr, 2014b).
Ease emerges in the midst of accepting the
whole story as one’s own—a process of attentive
embracing the complexity of one’s situation. All
nursing encounters occur within the context of
story. The stories of the nurse, patient, family,
and other health-care providers are woven to-
gether to create the tapestry of the moment—
this is the whole story in the moment. Each
time a nurse engages a patient about what
matters most regarding a health challenge, story
theory is applicable. By abandoning preexisting
assumptions, respecting the storyteller as the ex-
pert, and querying vague story directions, the
nurse intentionally engages the other, enabling
connecting with self-in-relation to create ease.
The theory is based on three assumptions
that underpin the framework. The assumptions
are that people (1) change as they interrelate
with their world in a vast array of flowing con-
nected dimensions, (2) live in an expanded pres-
ent moment where past and future events are
transformed in the here and now, and (3) expe-
rience meaning as a resonating awareness in the
creative unfolding of human potential (Smith &
Liehr, 2014b). These assumptions are consistent
with a unitary–transformative “view of the
world,” an inherently complex view (Newman,
Sime, & Corcoran-Perry, 1991), establishing a
value structure that creates a foundation for the
theory concepts.
The three concepts of the theory are inten-
tional dialogue, connecting with self-in-relation,
and creating ease (Fig. 24-1). The related
method dimensions are complicating health
challenge, developing story plot, and movement
toward resolving. The nurse engages a person
through intentional dialogue about a complicat-
ing health challenge, where connecting with
self-in-relation ensues as the developing story
plot surfaces through story sharing. As the
storyteller makes explicit what may have been
tacit (Polanyi, 1958), moments of ease accom-
pany movement toward resolving the health
challenge. Figure 24-1 depicts the theory model,
indicating relationships among the theory
concepts and related method dimensions.
CHAPTER 24 • Patricia Liehr and Mary Jane Smith’s Story Theory 423
Connecting with
self-in-relation
Developing story-plot
Intentional dialogue
Complicating health challenge
Nurse Person
Creating ease
Movement toward resolving
Fig 24 • 1 Story theory with method. (Reprinted
with permission of M. J. Smith and P. Liehr (2014). Story
theory. Middle Range Theory for Nursing. New York:
Springer, p. 234.)
3312_Ch24_421-434 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 423
The current theory model spreads a “wave”
across all concepts in the theory, expressive of
the energy essential to story-sharing through
intentional dialogue. The heavy dotted ellipse
between nurse and person highlights nurse–
person intentional dialogue, the core activity
enabling connecting with self-in-relation and
creating ease. There are three ellipses in the
design of the model, mapping a vortex of a con-
tinually evolving process, encompassing all the
theory concepts and associated method dimen-
sions. The links between the essential elements
of the model map the theory phenomenon as an
energy-laden integrated whole.
Intentional Dialogue About
a Complicating Health Challenge
Intentional dialogue is the central activity
between nurse and person that brings story to
life; it is querying emergence of a health chal-
lenge story in true presence (Smith & Liehr,
1999). True presence is a fully immersed way of
being with another, where authenticity and
mindfulness prevail. This purposeful engage-
ment with another creates potential for embrac-
ing the whole story in the moment as the nurse
summons the storyteller’s narrative focusing on
what matters most about a complicating health
challenge (Smith & Liehr, 2014b). The com-
plicating health challenge is a life circumstance
in which life change generates uneasiness.
Understanding the uneasiness refines the health
challenge to enable meaningful nurse–person
interaction. For instance, getting married could
be both a joyful and an uneasy transition. In this
case, the complicating health challenge may
be articulated as the transition from being single
to being married. What matters most to the
anticipatory bride may be the uncertainty she
is feeling in the midst of excited planning.
This joyful–uneasy paradox will become the
focus for the nurse using story theory to guide
practice; the nurse will listen to the bride’s
complaint of stomach pain within the context
of joy–uneasiness emerging in the transition to
married life.
In another example, for a woman facing the
complicating health challenge of a breast cancer
diagnosis, it is possible that the thought of
losing her breast matters most. However, what
matters most could be the threat of a shortened
life imposed by the cancer, the response of her
husband to her changing body, or concern
about who will care for her puppy while she is
in the hospital. There is an endless list of possi-
bilities known only to the person who is living
the health challenge. The nurse can never
assume to know what matters most about a
health challenge regardless of the extent of
experience in a particular practice environment.
The nurse knows how to proceed only by query-
ing what matters most about a complicating
health challenge.
Connecting With Self-in-Relation
Through Developing Story Plot
Connecting with self-in-relation occurs as
reflective awareness on personal history
(Smith & Liehr, 1999). It is an active process
of recognizing self as related with others in a
developing story-plot uncovered through
intentional dialogue (Smith & Liehr, 2014b).
To connect with self-in-relation, people see
themselves not as isolated individuals but as
existing and growing in a context, which in-
cludes awareness of other people and times,
sensitivity to bodily expression, and a sense of
history and future in the present moment.
One way to gain insight into the story plot is
to gather a health challenge story using a
story-path approach. Story path begins with
a focus on a present health challenge; then,
moves to the past calling attention to the
relationship between the past and the present
challenge. The final phase of story-gathering,
when using the story path approach, happens
when the nurse asks about hopes and dreams
related to the current health challenge. Some-
times this story path approach is visually
depicted as the nurse and the story-sharer
cocreate a picture of past-present-future
along a horizontal line. When using story
path, “the nurse encourages reckoning with a
personal history by traveling to the past to
arrive at the story beginning, moving through
the middle, and into the future all in the pres-
ent, thus going into the depths of the story
to find unique meanings that often lie hidden
in the ambiguity of puzzling dilemmas”
(Smith & Liehr, 2014b, p. 231).
424 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch24_421-434 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 424
The story path is an expression of a develop-
ing story plot with high points, low points,
and turning points. High points are times
when things are going well by the storyteller’s
evaluation; low points are times when they are
not going so well; and turning points are times
when the story twists, sometimes subtly, some-
times dramatically, creating a shift in the
forward view. Often, we and our colleagues
have used a story-path approach to gather
stories for research (Hain, 2007, 2008; Liehr,
Nishimura, Ito, Wands, & Takahashi, 2011;
Ramsey, 2012; Wands, 2013; Williams, 2007).
The story path links present, past, and future
(Liehr & Smith, 2000), beginning with the
question, “What matters most to you right now
about (the health challenge you are facing)?”
This question is followed by one that queries the
past, asking how it contributes to the present.
Finally, hopes and dreams are elicited.
Figure 24-2 depicts a story path for Mary, a
29-year-old woman who has come to see the
nurse practitioner for hypertension. Her blood
pressure was recorded as 180/110 mm Hg on
the primary care visit. The nurse has drawn a
line on a sheet of paper and asked Mary to tell
her where she is in her life path by marking the
“present” on the line. Then she asks Mary what
matters most in this present moment. Mary
talks about her discomfort with her elevated
blood pressure at her young age. She adds
detail about her job as a project director for a
research study while having just finished full-
time study for her master’s degree and now
beginning work on her doctoral degree in psy-
chology. Mary’s home situation is “stabilized”
by her husband John, whom she describes as
mellow and the strongest supporter for “con-
sidering lifestyle changes to lower her high
blood pressure.” She tells the nurse that the
only time her blood pressure is normal is
on weekends, when she is away from work.
She provides great detail about her work situa-
tion on this visit, describing work as an “out-
of-control stress” environment aggravated by
people who “seem to enjoy her stressful frenzy.”
Mary believes that work-related stress is the
strongest contributor to her hypertension. The
nurse clarifies with Mary, “So . . . are you saying
that stress-induced high blood pressure is your
pressing concern right now?” Mary says, “Yes.”
What matters most to Mary about the health
challenge of hypertension on this visit is her
stressful work life, which she feels unable to
control. The nurse then moves to the past and
asks Mary to identify situations and events on
her story path that contributed to her current
health challenge of stress-induced high blood
pressure, and then to the future, asking her to
note hopes and dreams related to the health
challenge. Mary notes story-path events related
to her father and identifies her desire to have
a baby within the next 5 years. Each of these
markings along the story path is discussed
CHAPTER 24 • Patricia Liehr and Mary Jane Smith’s Story Theory 425
4 years old–
Dad always
“dissatisfied”
with her
College–
First experienced
DBP
Present:
Stress-induced
BP
Married John
Mary’s Story Path
Master’s work–
paid for by self,
father gave credit
Normal BP through
lifestyle change
Somewhere in here–
wants to have child
5 years
“down the
road”
Fig 24 • 2 Mary’s story path.
3312_Ch24_421-434 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 425
with the storyteller leading the way. The nurse
makes notes on the story path so that both
participants are engaged in the process, infus-
ing the physiological indicator, a blood pressure
of 180/110 mm Hg, with Mary’s unique
personal story.
Before ending any visit where story has been
pulled into the foreground, it is important that
the nurse ask if there is “anything else” about the
health challenge that the storyteller wants to
share to enhance understanding. What matters
most about a health challenge may change from
visit to visit, and any single visit may encompass
more than one issue that matters the most.
Detailed story paths include bits of evidence
gleaned from what the storyteller emphasized.
This evidence has the potential to guide nursing
practice, including the next steps the nurse will
take during this and upcoming visits.
Story path is just one approach to gathering
the story in a practice setting. We have suggested
others such as photographs, family trees, and
pain diaries (Smith & Liehr, 2014b). There
seems to be value in eliciting a story through a
collaborative creation that enhances the telling
and takes the story to a structure such as story
path. The possible approaches for story gathering
are limitless. The creative nurse will identify
other unique approaches for querying what
matters most about a health challenge. Coming
to grips with what matters most about the health
challenge one is facing is a process of embracing
story, where paradoxically, embracing releases
a person from story confines, engendering a
sense of ease.
Creating Ease While Moving Toward
Resolving
In the context of story theory, creating ease is
defined as remembering disjointed story
moments to experience flow in the midst of
anchoring (Smith & Liehr, 1999) to an under-
standing of the whole story, even for only one
“aha” moment. As a person anchors for a mo-
ment, embracing the comprehensible whole,
flow ensues as easiness-with-self situated in a
complex context. Ease is neither assured nor
pervasive during story sharing. Sometimes it is
elusive; sometimes it is experienced as only a
moment in time. When story moments come
together in a meaningful way for the person
sharing a story, there is often some movement
toward resolving the health challenge. Move-
ment may be minuscule, or it may be a leap;
it enables a shift in one’s perspective usually
accompanied by action to address what matters
most about the health challenge.
Application of the Theory
to Research
Story theory has been used to guide a story-
centered intervention in a study of people
with Stage 1 hypertension (Liehr et al.,
2006). It has been used to guide structured
data collection in qualitative studies with
cancer patients (Williams, 2007), hemodial-
ysis patients (Hain, 2008) and women suf-
fering from migraine headaches (Ramsey,
2012). The story inquiry research method
has also been used for story gathering and
data analysis (Hain, Wands, & Liehr, 2011;
Kelley & Lowe, 2012; Liehr et al., 2011;
Wands, 2013). Details of the use of story
theory for research can be found in the text-
book Middle Range Theory for Nursing (Smith
& Liehr, 2014a).
Application of the Theory
Application of the theory to nursing practice
has occurred throughout discussion of the
theory concepts, providing real-life examples
that enable a move from conceptual to em-
pirical. In the next section, we describe a
seven-phase process that chronicles the de-
velopment of nursing knowledge from evi-
dence collected during nursing practice.
Application to practice will surface as the
exemplar of “transitioning to a nursing home”
is described.
426 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch24_421-434 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 426
CHAPTER 24 • Patricia Liehr and Mary Jane Smith’s Story Theory 427
Practice Exemplar
Advancing Practice Scholarship
Through Story Theory
We have proposed seven phases of inquiry
for practicing nurses who want to develop
practice evidence as a base for knowledge
development (Smith & Liehr, 2005). The
phases are as follows: (1) gather a story about
what matters most about a health challenge;
(2) compose a reconstructed story; (3) connect
existing literature to the health challenge;
(4) refine the name of the health challenge;
(5) describe the developing story plot with
high points, low points, and turning points;
(6) identify movement toward resolving; and
(7) collect additional stories about the health
challenge (Smith & Liehr, 2014b). For the
purposes of this chapter, we address all phases
of the inquiry process except the last, which
takes the nurse back to the practice environ-
ment to substantiate what emerged while
completing the first six phases.
Phase one asks the practicing nurse to gather
a story of what matters most about a health
challenge. Querying what matters most about
the health challenge is coming to know the
unique perspective of the person sharing the
story. To gather the story, the nurse could use
a structured approach such as the story path, or
story gathering could occur over time through
attentive presence recognizing circumstance
and life changes that are continually shaping
one’s story. Irrespective of how the nurse gath-
ers the story, coming to know the other in true
presence with mindful attention to what mat-
ters most culminates in a reconstructed story.
The nurse in the following story queried the
health challenge of transitioning to a nursing
home environment for elders who had been
living independently.
Phase two requires that the nurse compose
a reconstructed story. A reconstructed story is
a narrative creation with a beginning, a mid-
dle, and an end that weaves together the
nurse’s and the storyteller’s perspective of the
health challenge. The reconstructed story nat-
urally incorporates what matters most about
the health challenge. The reconstructed story
shared in this chapter was written by a nurse
who cared for Elizabeth during the last
months of her life in a nursing home. The
nurse had practiced in this nursing home for
10 years, often witnessing the health challenge
of transitioning from independent to nursing
home living. The story gathering occurred over
time, and story moments are synthesized as a
reconstructed story to serve as an evidence base
for understanding the independent living to
nursing home living transition.
Elizabeth was an 88-year-old woman who
enjoyed independent living in her bungalow
with her husband of 65 years. She and her
husband resided in the independent living
component of a continuing care community.
Elizabeth had a long history of atrial fibrilla-
tion, chronic heart failure, and diabetes; but
she managed to remain independent, using a
walker to get around. She attributed her inde-
pendence to the devotion of her husband, who
watched over her medication routine, diet, and
the balance between her activity/rest patterns.
At the end of January, Elizabeth began having
difficulty moving her left leg, especially when
she awoke in the morning. It seemed to her
that her leg had fallen asleep due to position-
ing during the night. Then, one February
morning, Elizabeth’s lower leg was painful,
cool to touch, and slightly discolored. Her
husband called the community nurse, who
immediately sent Elizabeth to the hospital,
where a popliteal clot was found to be occlud-
ing the artery. Amputation was considered but
rejected due to the complexity of Elizabeth’s
health situation. Clot-buster was dripped
directly into Elizabeth’s clot for 7 hours while
she lay on her back and the clot dissolved.
Elizabeth was relieved because she had always
feared losing her leg after witnessing her
grandmother’s double amputation as a result
of long-standing diabetes.
After 10 days in the hospital, Elizabeth
returned to the nursing home component of
her continuing care community, planning to
Continued
3312_Ch24_421-434 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 427
428 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Practice Exemplar cont.
begin rehabilitation. Shortly after admission,
she was diagnosed with the flu, delaying the
start of rehabilitation. Once she began, the
physical therapists referred to her as their
“energizer bunny” because of her spirited
approach to therapy. Throughout this time, it
was very hard for Elizabeth to lift her left leg.
No matter how hard she tried, she couldn’t
move it like she could move her right leg. Still,
she was anticipating return to the bungalow to
get on with everyday living with her husband.
While Elizabeth was in the nursing home, her
husband visited every day at mealtimes and
when she was ready to go to sleep. She referred
to these visits as the “best times of her day.”
As part of the discharge plan, the physical
therapists took Elizabeth to her bungalow to
try out everyday activities. The difficulty mov-
ing her leg was magnified when she was in her
usual environment, and the therapists began
to think that she might not be able to return
home. About the same time, Elizabeth began
to have dramatic blood sugar swings that were
accompanied by confusion and twitching that
engaged all parts of her body. Her husband
was anxious and looking for answers while she
was consistently questioning: “What’s going
to happen to me now?” Her health challenge
at this time was an arduous struggle to resume
normal “independent” living in her bungalow
with her husband, and what mattered most at
this point was the unfamiliar, uncontrollable
bodily experience and the uncertainty that
ensued from unfamiliarity. The question
“What’s going to happen to me now?” was one
the nurse had heard repeatedly over her years
of nursing home practice as residents began
to understand that they might not return
home. She had begun to view the question as
a marker of transition that demanded her
concentrated attention to what mattered most
for the resident.
Elizabeth didn’t understand why her leg
wouldn’t move even though she worked so
hard in therapy; she tried to hide the twitch-
ing, which she had never experienced before.
The twitching and her attempts to move
her leg took a lot of energy, and she often said
that she was tired. She never stopped saying
that she wanted to “go home,” but at some
point the nurse suspected that the meaning
of “going home” had changed for Elizabeth.
The nurse asked her “Where is home?” and
Elizabeth responded that she wasn’t sure.
Shortly thereafter, Elizabeth stopped asking
to go to the bungalow, and she expressed
wishes for a peaceful death.
It became clear that Elizabeth was not get-
ting better as her heart failure became more
debilitating and blood sugar swings continued
despite precise insulin dosing and measured
carbohydrate intake. At this time, the doctor
suggested hospice. Elizabeth and her husband
listened to the description of hospice services,
and she signed the hospice papers. While
under hospice care, she stopped troubling over
her failed effort to move her left leg, continued
to have blood sugar swings, and never stopped
trying to hide the twitching.
Appearances mattered to Elizabeth, and
she continued to care about how she looked.
One time she told the nurse that she wore her
pink shirt as often as she could because her
husband liked it. She asked to have her roots
done, and the nurse took her to the beauty
shop one floor away. When she returned, her
husband took her picture. She was wearing her
pink shirt, and her husband later included the
picture in a memorial collage that was created
when she died. The long loving relationship
between Elizabeth and her husband was most
important to both of them in her last days. She
giggled with him while recalling fun times
they had over the years, and she asked for
hugs, an uncharacteristic request that became
increasingly familiar to her husband during
this time.
Elizabeth and her roommate told each
other stories, shared chocolates, and looked out
for each other as well as they could. Her room-
mate called her “sweet pea.” On the day Eliz-
abeth died, the roommate asked Elizabeth’s
husband and the nurse if she could pray
with them.
Elizabeth had been in the nursing home
about 3 months before she died. The course of
3312_Ch24_421-434 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 428
CHAPTER 24 • Patricia Liehr and Mary Jane Smith’s Story Theory 429
Practice Exemplar cont.
her story shifted from one of expectation for
familiar normalcy in her bungalow with her
husband to one of peaceful going home. The
nurse in this situation of caring for Elizabeth
was attentively present to the shifting story,
following Elizabeth’s lead to pursue meaning
during the last months of her life.
Phase three of the story inquiry process re-
quires that the nurse become familiar with the
existing literature about the complicating
health challenge—in this case, transitioning
from independent to nursing home living.
For the purposes of this chapter, only the
beginnings of a literature review are reported.
However, the practicing nurse interested in a
particular health challenge will stay abreast of
related literature and eventually develop a
broad literature base informing ongoing inter-
pretation of stories and physiological bodily
responses. To begin this literature search, the
phrases nursing home transition and elder were
searched together.
Brandburg (2007) conducted an integrated
literature review intended to synthesize the
state of the science regarding transition to a
nursing home for older adults. The 13 articles
that met the inclusion criteria led to the
creation of a “transition process framework”
with the foundational concepts of initial reac-
tion, transitional influences, adjustment, and
acceptance. Brandburg (2007) reported that
the initial reaction and adjustment phases of
the process require approximately 6 months.
During that time, people move from disorgan-
ization to reorganization and relationship
building. They also move from a sense of
homelessness to recognition of a new home
where new relationships are developed and old
ones are cultivated. She describes the “final” or
acceptance phase as one in which “reflecting
on the transition experience in light of per-
sonal values helped many older adults accept
their new home because they could find mean-
ing in their present situation” (p. 55).
The theme of home that was noted by
Brandburg (2007) was strongly described by
Heliker and Scholler-Jaquish (2006) in a study
of 10 newly admitted nursing home residents
who were interviewed multiple times over
their first 3 months of residency. Residents
responded to the directive: “Tell me a story
about what it is like for you to come here
and live.” Data from 32 interviews lasting
from 15 to 60 minutes were analyzed using a
hermeneutical phenomenological approach.
Three themes emerged: becoming homeless,
getting settled, learning the ropes, and creating
a place. The first theme, becoming homeless,
contributed to the researchers’ conclusion that
“one cannot separate home, memories, and
friends from one’s very identity. Each contin-
uously shapes and is shaped by the other”
(p. 41). Getting settled and learning the ropes
was a theme characterized by residents’ shift
from unknown to known, invisible to
visible. Creating a place was a theme related
to creating meaning in this new life situation.
In their conclusion, the authors note the im-
portant place of story: “The challenge for nurs-
ing home staff is to create situations, a clearing
for sharing stories . . . that facilitate the cocre-
ation of new meanings. . . . A staff that listens
to what matters to residents can interpret a
plan of care that is meaningful” (p. 41).
Listening was the major theme in a brief by
Maynes (2004). She shared the story of a
patient she met on a short hospitalization, dur-
ing which his cancer diagnosis was confirmed
and he was evaluated as having a “poor prog-
nosis.” The nurse listened to the quiet man and
honored his wish to return “home” to the farm
country where he was raised. On the day he was
to be transferred, the nurse went to his bedside
to say good-bye, thankful that he would be
returning to the place he loved. When she
approached the bed, she realized that he had
died. “I sat next to him, put his hand in mine,
and whispered ‘good-bye’” (p. 32).
Elizabeth’s short nursing home stay fits most
clearly with the initial reaction phase described
by Brandburg (2007) and the becoming homeless
theme described by Heliker and Scholler-Jaquish
(2006), both of whom call attention to the mean-
ing of home. The idea of “home” emerges
strongly from the literature and story sources.
Both Elizabeth and the man in Maynes’s (2004)
Continued
3312_Ch24_421-434 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 429
430 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Practice Exemplar cont.
brief feel the pull of “home” as they approach
death. Merging Elizabeth’s story with the rele-
vant literature prepared the stage for the next step
of the story inquiry process: refining the name of
the health challenge.
Phase four suggests that the nurse refine the
name of the health challenge, if necessary.
There may be some times when the original
name is confirmed as adequately expressive of
the challenge, and there are other times when
the convergence of the reconstructed story
with the existing literature demands that the
health challenge name be refined. We believe
that “naming” is most important for the con-
tinuing work, and we advocate that the health
challenge name be neither too high nor too
low in level of abstraction. Names that are too
high may be difficult to apply to practice situ-
ations, and names that are too low may be
meaningful for only a few people. Considering
Elizabeth’s story and the existing literature,
the name of the complicating health challenge
was changed to “struggling to go home.” This
health challenge name is consistent with the
original name of transitioning from independ-
ent to nursing home living, but it captures
more clearly what matters most about the
transition. It is neither so high that it cannot
be applied in practice nor so low that it applies
to only a narrow subset of people. Because
it is in the middle, it may also have applicabil-
ity to other populations, such as people who
have been evacuated from their homes due to
natural disasters or families of premature new-
borns who demand extended hospital stays.
Phase five of the story inquiry process focuses
on the developing story plot through identifi-
cation of high points, low points, and turning
points. Turning points are shifts in what is hap-
pening to create a revision in the storyteller’s
forward view. These are situations or events that
move the story along. High and low points note
times when things are going well or not so well.
Table 24-1 records the turning points, high
Story Event TP HP LP
Difficulty moving leg beginning in January
Change in leg pain, temperature, and color—leading to
hospitalization
Decision not to amputate
Clot was dissolved
Return to nursing home for rehabilitation
Diagnosed with flu
Couldn’t move leg though she tried
Husband’s four-times-daily visits
Inability to perform usual activities with physical therapist
in bungalow—aware she may not return
Blood sugar swings, confusion, and twitching
“What’s going to happen to me now?”
Stopped asking about going to bungalow and began talking
about peaceful death
Signed hospice papers
Getting roots done, giggling with husband, sharing chocolate
with roommate
Table 24 • 1 Turning Points, High Points, and Low Points in Elizabeth’s Story
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
TP = turning point; HP = high point; LP = low point.
3312_Ch24_421-434 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 430
CHAPTER 24 • Patricia Liehr and Mary Jane Smith’s Story Theory 431
Practice Exemplar cont.
points, and low points in Elizabeth’s recon-
structed story. Turning points may also be high
points or low points, but this is not always the
case. Sometimes turning points exist with no
particular value assigned by the person living
the story. In Elizabeth’s story, turning points
can be summarized as: (1) diagnosed health
issues, (2) treatment milestones, and (3) the
hospice decision. High points are (1) “favor-
able” (according to Elizabeth) treatment mile-
stones and (2) relationship-centered moments
of joy. Low points are (1) limitations in physical
movement, (2) unfamiliar bodily experiences
with and without diagnoses, and (3) uncer-
tainty. As the practicing nurse collected more
stories of this nature, comparison, contrast, and
synthesis of turning points, high points, and
low points would be possible, and the evidence
from stories could contribute to the knowledge
base guiding practice with people who are tran-
sitioning into a nursing home. One last phase
of analysis considers the evidence from stories
to identify how people get through the health
challenge.
Phase six asks that the practicing nurse
identify how an individual moved toward
resolving the health challenge. This phase of
practice inquiry may be most instructive for
the nurse’s continuing work with a particular
population because it taps the inherent
wisdom of people living the challenge to un-
derstand how they got by. The question facing
the nurse analyzing Elizabeth’s reconstructed
story is: How does Elizabeth move toward
resolving the complicating health challenge
of struggling to go home? Elizabeth put all her
effort into her recovery so that her therapists
called her their “energizer bunny.” When her
efforts failed and her bodily experience indi-
cated that she was on a different path, she
signed the hospice papers. Finally, Elizabeth
enjoyed moments with her husband and her
roommate and chose to do things that kept
her appearance as she liked. Movement to-
ward resolving recounted in the reconstructed
story included the approaches of (1) devoting
energy to recovery, (2) accepting hospice,
(3) experiencing the joy of relationship, and
(4) attending to self through personal appear-
ance. The range of ways Elizabeth moved
toward resolving reflects the dynamic and
complex nature of story. What is characterized
as movement toward resolving emerges as the
story unfolds. At a higher level of abstraction,
these approaches used by Elizabeth, may be
conceptualized as (1) focusing energy to heal,
(2) accepting the inevitable, (3) appreciating
relationship, and (4) attending to self. At this
higher level of abstraction, the four approaches
extracted from the reconstructed story have
implications for people who are struggling
to go home, regardless of the context of their
situation. The story describes how one person
created ease and offers an invitation to con-
sider how others in similar situations may
create ease as they move toward resolving a
health challenge of struggling to go home.
Once again, there is guidance for nursing
practice in the wisdom of people living health
challenges. The nurse could use what is learned
from this story analysis to guide current
practice and frame further inquiry.
■ Summary
This chapter has introduced the reader to
story as an essential element of evidence
guiding nursing practice. The authors hope
that practicing nurses can use the story in-
quiry process to access story evidence for the
precious contribution it can make to nursing
knowledge. Each nurse at the bedside, in the
clinic, or in the office is uniquely positioned
to gather and analyze practice stories. The
middle-range story theory is proposed as a
framework for structuring story-gathering
and analysis.
3312_Ch24_421-434 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 431
432 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
References
Banks-Wallace, J. (2002). Talk the talk: Storytelling and
analysis rooted in African-American oral tradition.
Qualitative Health Research, 12(3), 410–426.
Benner, P. (1984). From novice to expert. Menlo Park,
CA: Addison-Wesley.
Boykin, A., & Schoenhofer, S. (1991). Story as a link
between nursing practice, ontology and epistemology.
IMAGE: Journal of Nursing Scholarship, 23, 245–248.
Boykin, A., & Schoenhofer, S. (2001). The role of
nursing leadership in creating caring environments in
health care delivery systems. Nursing Administration
Quarterly, 25(3), 1–7.
Brandburg, G. (2007). Making the transition to nursing
home life: A framework to help older adults adapt
to the long-term care environment. Journal of
Gerontological Nursing, 33(6), 50–56.
Charon, R. (2006). Narrative medicine: Honoring the
stories of illness. New York: Oxford University Press.
Charon, R. (2012). At the membranes of care: Stories in
narrative medicine. Academic Medicine, 87(3), 342–347.
Charon, R., & Montello, M. (2002). Stories matter: The role
of narrative in medical ethics. New York: Routledge.
Chinn, P. L., & Kramer, M. K. (1999). Theory and
nursing integrated knowledge development. St. Louis,
MO: C. V. Mosby.
Crichton, J., & Koch, T. (2007). Living with dementia:
Curating self-identity. Dementia, 6(3), 365–381.
Diamond, J. (2000). Narrative means to sober ends:
Treating addiction and its aftermath. New York:
Guilford Press.
Ford, K., & Turner, D. (2001). Stories seldom told:
Pediatric nurses’ experiences of caring for hospitalized
children with special needs and their families. Journal
of Advanced Nursing, 33, 288–295.
Hain, D. (2007). What matters most?: Promoting
adherence by understanding health challenges faced
by hemodialysis patients. American Kidney Fund:
Professional Advocate, 7(1), 3.
Hain, E. (2008). Cognitive function and adherence of
older adults undergoing hemodialysis. Nephrology
Nursing Journal, 35(1), 23–29.
Hain, D., Wands, L. M., & Liehr, P. (2011). Approaches
to resolve health challenges in a population of older
adults undergoing hemodialysis. Research in
Gerontological Nursing, 4(1), 53–62.
Heliker, D. (2007). Story sharing: Restoring the reciprocity
of caring in long-term care. Journal of Psychosocial
Nursing and Mental Health Services, 45(7), 20–23.
Heliker, D., & Scholler-Jaquish, A. (2006). Transition of
new residents: Basing practice on resident’s perspec-
tive. Journal of Gerontological Nursing, 32(9), 34–42.
Holm, A.-K., Lepp, M., & Ringsberg, K. C. (2005).
Dementia: Involving patients in storytelling—a
caring intervention. A pilot study. Journal of Clinical
Nursing, 14, 256–263.
Keady, J., Williams, S., & Hughes-Roberts, J. (2007).
Making mistakes: Using co-constructed inquiry to
illuminate meaning and relationships in the early
adjustment to Alzheimer’s disease—a single case
study approach. Dementia, 6(3), 343–364.
Kelley, M., & Lowe, J. (2012). The health challenge of
stress experienced by Native American adolescents.
Archives in Psychiatric Nursing, 26(1), 71–73.
Liehr, P., Meininger, J. C., Vogler, R., Chan, W., Frazier,
L., Smalling, S., & Fuentes, F. (2006). Adding story-
centered care to standard lifestyle intervention for
people with Stage One hypertension. Applied Nursing
Research, 19, 16–21.
Liehr, P., Nishimura, C., Ito, M., Wands, L.M. &
Takahashi, R. (2011). A lifelong journey of
moving beyond wartime trauma for survivors
from Hiroshima and Pearl Harbor. Advances in
Nursing Science, 34(3), 215–228.
Liehr, P., & Smith, M. J. (2000). Using story theory to
guide nursing practice. International Journal of
Human Caring, 4, 13–18.
Liehr, P., & Smith, M. J. (2008). Story theory. In M. J.
Smith & P. Liehr (Eds.), Middle range theory for
nursing (2nd ed.). (pp. 205–224). New York: Springer.
Maynes, R. (2004). Going home again. Nursing 2004,
34(4), 32.
Mehl-Madrona, L. (2007). Narrative medicine: The use of
history and story in the healing process. Rochester, VT:
Bear & Company.
Newman, M. A. (1999). The rhythm of relating in a
paradigm of wholeness. Image: Journal of Nursing
Scholarship, 31, 227–230.
Newman, M. A., Sime, A. M., & Corcoran-Perry, S. A.
(1991). The focus of the discipline of nursing.
Advances in Nursing Science, 14(1), 1–6.
Nightingale, F. (1969). Notes on Nursing. New York:
Dover.
Parse, R. R. (1981). Man-living-health: A theory of nursing.
New York: Wiley.
Peplau, H. (1991). Interpersonal relations in nursing.
New York: Springer.
Polanyi, M. (1958). The study of man. Chicago: University
of Chicago Press.
Sierpina, M., & Cole, T. R. (2004). Care Management
Journals, 5(3), 175–182.
Ramsey, A. R. (2012). Living with migraine headache:
A phenomenological study of women’s experiences.
Holistic Nursing Practice, 26(6), 297–307.
Smith, M. J., & Liehr, P. (1999). Attentively embracing
story: A middle-range theory with practice and
research implications. Scholarly Inquiry for Nursing.
Practice: An International Journal, 13, 187–204.
Smith, M. J., & Liehr, P. (2003). The theory of attentively
embracing story. In M. J. Smith & P. Liehr (Eds.),
3312_Ch24_421-434 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 432
Middle range theory for nursing (1st ed.) (pp. 167–188).
New York: Springer.
Smith, M. J., & Liehr, P. (2005). Story theory: Advanc-
ing nursing practice scholarship. Holistic Nursing
Practice, 19(6), 272–276.
Smith, M. J., & Liehr, P. (2014a). Middle range theory
for nursing (3rd ed.). New York: Springer.
Smith, M. J., & Liehr, P. (2014b). Story theory. In M. J.
Smith & P. Liehr (Eds.), Middle range theory for
nursing (3rd ed.) (pp. 225–252). New York: Springer.
Wands, L. M. (2013). “No one gets through it OK”:
The health challenge of coming home from war.
Advances in Nursing Science, 36(3), 186–199.
Watson, J. (1997). The theory of human caring:
Retrospective and prospective. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 10, 49–52.
Williams, L. (2007). Whatever it takes: Informal caregiving
dynamics in blood and marrow transplantation.
Oncology Nursing Forum, 34(2), 379–387.
CHAPTER 24 • Patricia Liehr and Mary Jane Smith’s Story Theory 433
3312_Ch24_421-434 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 433
3312_Ch24_421-434 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 434
Chapter 25The Community Nursing
Practice Model
MARILYN E. PARKER,
CHARLOTTE D. BARRY,
AND BETH M. KING
Introducing the Theorists
Overview of the Model
Application of the Model
Practice Exemplar
Summary
References
435
Introducing the Theorists
Marilyn E. Parker is professor emerita at the
Christine E. Lynn College of Nursing at Florida
Atlantic University and recently retired professor
from the University of Kansas School of Nurs-
ing. She earned degrees from Incarnate Word
College (BSN), the Catholic University of
America (MSN), and Kansas State University
(PhD). Her overall career mission is to enhance
nursing practice, scholarship, and education
through nursing theory, using both innovative
and traditional means to improve care and
advance the discipline.
As principal investigator for a program of
grants to create and use a new community nurs-
ing practice model, Dr. Parker has provided
leadership to develop transdisciplinary school-
based wellness centers devoted to health and
social services for children and families from un-
derserved multicultural communities, to teach
university students from several disciplines,
and to develop research and policy to promote
community well-being.
Dr. Parker’s active participation in nursing
education and health care in several countries
led to her 2001 Fulbright Scholar Award to
Thailand, where she continues collaboration
with Thai colleagues. Her commitment to
caring for underserved populations and to
health policy evaluation led to being named a
National Public Health Leadership Institute
Fellow and to being elected a distinguished
practitioner in the National Academies of
Practice in Nursing. Dr. Parker is a fellow in
the American Academy of Nursing.
Charlotte D. Barry is a professor and master
teacher at the Florida Atlantic University Chris-
tine E. Lynn College of Nursing. Dr. Barry
Charlotte D. BarryMarilyn E. Parker
3312_Ch25_435-448 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 435
graduated from Brooklyn College, New York,
with an associate’s degree in nursing; holds a
bachelor’s degree in health administration, a
master’s degree in nursing from Florida Atlantic
University, and a PhD from the University of
Miami, Florida. She is nationally certified in
school nursing and in 2013 was recognized as
one of the best 25 Nursing Professors in Florida.
Dr. Barry is a fellow in the American Academy
of Nursing.
The focus of Dr. Barry’s scholarship has been
caring for persons in schools and communities.
As a coprincipal investigator with Dr. Parker,
Dr. Barry cocreated the community nursing
practice model from the transdisciplinary prac-
tice unfolded at several school-based wellness
centers. Her current research includes the
usefulness of the community nursing practice
model to guide practice in global communities
including the United States, Uganda, and Haiti.
Building on the school-based wellness center in
Uganda, a replica program is being developed
in a rural community in Haiti.
Dr. Barry provides leadership in many
community and professional organizations in-
cluding Sigma Theta Tau, Iota XI Chapter, the
International Association for Human Caring,
the National Association of School Nursing,
and the Florida Association of School Nurses.
She also serves on the Board of the South
Florida Haiti Project and the Broward County
School Health Advisory Committee.
Overview of the Model
The community nursing practice model (CNPM)
began with and continues to be a blend of the
ideal and the practical. The ideal was the com-
mitment to develop and use nursing concepts to
guide nursing practice, education, and scholar-
ship and a desire to develop a nursing practice as
an essential component of a college of nursing.
The practical was the effort to bring this CNPM
to life within the context and structures of an ex-
isting community health care system. The model
reflects the mission of the Christine E. Lynn
College of Nursing at Florida Atlantic Univer-
sity and the concept of nursing held by its fac-
ulty: Nursing is nurturing the wholeness of persons
and environments in caring (Florida Atlantic
University College of Nursing Philosophy and
Mission [FAU], 1994/2012).
The concepts and relationships of the
model are the guiding forces for community
practice. Through various participatory-action
approaches, including ongoing shared reflec-
tion, intuitive insights, and discoveries, the
CNPM has evolved and continues to develop.
The education of university students and the
conduct of student and faculty research have
been integrated with nursing and social work
practice. Throughout the early development
and ongoing refinement of the model, there
has been nurturing of collaborative commu-
nity partnerships, evaluation and development
of school and community health policy, and
development of enriched community.
Foundations of the Model
Essential values that form the basis of the model
are (1) persons are respected; (2) persons are car-
ing, and caring is understood as the essence of
nursing; and (3) persons are whole and always
connected with one another in families and
communities. These essential, or transcendent,
values are always present in nursing situations,
while other actualizing values guide practice in
certain situations.
The principles of primary health care from
the World Health Organization (WHO; 1978)
are the actualizing values. These additional con-
cepts of the model are (1) access, (2) essentiality,
(3) community participation, (4) empower-
ment, and (5) intersectoral collaboration. Con-
cepts of nursing practice that have emerged
include transitional care and enhancing care.
The CNPM illuminates these values and each
of the concepts in four interrelated themes:
nursing, person, community, and environment,
along with a structure of interconnecting serv-
ices, activities, and community partnerships
(Parker & Barry, 1999). An inquiry group
method has been designed and is the primary
means of ongoing assessment and evaluation
(Barry, Lange, & King, 2011; Campbell et al.,
2001; Clark et al., 2003; Parker, Barry, & King,
2000; Ryan, Hawkins, Parker, & Hawkins,
2004; Sadler, Newlin, & Jenkins, 2011).
436 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch25_435-448 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 436
Nursing
The unique focus of nursing is nurturing the
wholeness of persons and environments in
caring (FAU, 1994/2012). Nursing practice,
education, and scholarship require creative
integration of multiple ways of knowing and
understanding through knowledge synthesis
within a context of value and meaning. Nurs-
ing knowledge is embedded in the nursing
situation, the lived experience of caring be-
tween the nurse and the one receiving care.
The nurse is authentically present for the
other, to hear calls for caring and to create
dynamic nursing responses. The school-based
wellness centers in the community become
places for persons and families to access nurs-
ing and social services where they are: in
homes, work camps, schools, or under trees
in a community gathering spot. Nursing is
dynamic and portable; there is no predeter-
mined nursing and often no predetermined
access place (Dyess & Chase, 2012; Parker,
1997; Parker & Barry, 1999).
Nursing practice is further described within
the context of transitional care and enhancing
care. Transitional care is that in which clients
and families are provided essential health care
while being referred to a more permanent
source of health care in the community. Tran-
sitional care, an ideal for nursing and social
work practice, is sometimes not possible owing
to immigration status, a complex and con-
founding health-care system, or other issues of
the family.
Enhancing care describes nursing and social
work that is intended to assist the client and
family who need care in addition to that pro-
vided by a local health-care provider.
Person
Respect for person is present in all aspects of
nursing, with clients, community members,
and colleagues. Respect includes a stance of
humility that the nurse does not know all that
can be known about a person and a situation,
acknowledging that the person is the expert in
his or her own care and knowing his or her
experience. Respect carries with it an openness
to learn and grow. Values and beliefs of various
cultures are reflected in expressions of caring.
The person as whole and connected with oth-
ers, not the disease or problem, is the focus of
nursing.
Persons are empowered by understanding
choices, how to choose, and how to live daily
with choices made. The person defines what is
necessary to well-being and what priorities
exist in daily life of the family. Nursing and
social work practice based on practical, sound,
culturally acceptable, and cost-effective meth-
ods are necessary for well-being and wholeness
of persons, families, and communities.
Early on, Swadener and Lubeck’s (1995)
work on deconstructing the discourse of risk
was a major influence on practice. At risk con-
notes a deficiency that needs fixing; a doing to,
rather than collaborating with. Thinking about
children and families “at promise” instead of
“at risk” inspires an approach to knowing the
other as whole and filled with potential.
Respect and caring in nursing require full
participation of persons, families, and commu-
nities in assessment, design, and evaluation of
services. Based on this concept, an inquiry group
method is used for ongoing appraisal of services.
This method is defined as a “route of knowing”
and “a route to other questions.” Each person is
a coparticipant, an expert knower in his or her
experience; the facilitator is the expert knower
of the process. The facilitator’s role is to encour-
age expressions of knowing so that calls for nurs-
ing and guidance for nursing responses can be
heard. In this way, the essential care for persons
and families can be known, and care can be de-
signed, offered, and evaluated (Barry, 1998;
Barry, Lange, & King, 2011; Gordon, Barry,
Dunn, & King, 2011; Parker et al., 2000).
Community
Community, as understood within the model,
was formed from the classical definition offered
by Smith and Maurer (1995) and from Peck’s
(1987) existential, relational view. According
to Smith and Maurer, a community is defined
by its members and is characterized by shared
values. This expanded notion of community
moves away from a locale as a defining charac-
teristic and includes self-defined groups who
CHAPTER 25 • The Community Nursing Practice Model 437
3312_Ch25_435-448 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 437
share common interests and concerns and who
interact with one another.
Community, offered by Peck (1987), is
a safe place for members and ensures the
security of being included and honored. His
work focuses on building community
through a web of relationships grounded in
acceptance of individual and cultural differ-
ences among faculty and staff and acceptance
of others in the widening circles, including
colleagues within the practice and discipline,
other health-care colleagues from varied
disciplines, grant funders, and other collab-
orators. The notion of transdisciplinary care
is an exemplar of this approach to commu-
nity. Another defining characteristic of com-
munity, according to Peck, is willingness
to risk and tolerate a certain lack of structure.
The practice guided by the model reflects
this in fostering a creative approach to pro-
gram development, implementation, evalua-
tion, and research.
Practice within the model, whether un-
folding in a clinic or under a tree where per-
sons have gathered, provides a welcoming
and safe place for sharing stories of caring.
The intention to know others as experts in
their self-care while listening to their hopes
and dreams for well-being creates a com-
munion between the client and provider that
guides the development of a nurturing rela-
tionship. Knowing the other in relationship
to their communities, such as family, school,
work, worship, or play, honors the complex-
ity of the context of persons’ lives and offers
the opportunity to understand and partici-
pate with them.
Environment
The notion of environment within the CNPM
provides the context for understanding the
wholeness of interconnected lives. The envi-
ronment, one of the oldest concepts in nursing
described by Nightingale (1859/1992), is not
only the immediate effects of air, odors, noise,
and warmth on the reparative powers of the
patient but also indicates the social settings
that contribute to health and illness such as
those identified as the social determinants of
health (WHO, 2007, 2012). Another nursing
visionary, Lillian Wald, witnessed the hard-
ships of poverty and disenfranchisement on
the residents of the lower Manhattan immi-
grant communities. She developed the Henry
Street Settlement House to provide a broad
range of care that included direct physical care
up to and including finding jobs, housing, and
influencing the creation of child labor laws
(Zaiger, 2013).
Chooporian (1986) reinspired nurses to
expand the notion of environment not only to
include the immediate context of patients’ lives
but also to think of the relationship between
health and social issues that “influence human
beings and hence create conditions for heath
and illness” (p. 53). Reflecting on earth caring,
Schuster (1990) urged another look at the
environment, inviting nurses to consider a
broader view that included nonhuman species
and the nonhuman world. Acknowledging the
interrelatedness of all living things energizes
caring from this broader perspective into a
wider circle. Kleffel (1996) described this
as “an ecocentric approach grounded in the
cosmos. The whole environment, including
inanimate elements such as rocks and minerals,
along with animate animals and plants, is
assigned an intrinsic value” (p. 4). This per-
spective directs thinking about the intercon-
nectedness of all elements, both animate and
inanimate. Teaching, practice, and scholarship
require a caring context that respects, explores,
nurtures, and celebrates the interconnected-
ness of all living things and inanimate objects
throughout the global environment.
Structure of Services and Activities
The CNPM is envisioned as three concentric
circles around a core. Envisioning the CNPM
as a watercolor representation, one can appre-
ciate the vibrancy of practice within the
CNPM, the amorphous interconnectedness
of the core and the circles, and the “certain
lack of structure” draws attention to the
beauty in creating responses to unique calls
for nursing. The CNPM calls into the circles
others to create programs and environments
that nurture well-being (Fig. 25-1).
438 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch25_435-448 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 438
Core Services
Core services, created from the results of
inquiry group methodology (Barry, Gordon,
& Lange, 2007; Barry et al., 2011; Parker et
al., 2002), are provided to nurture the whole-
ness of persons and environments through
caring. The unique experiences of staff and
faculty with the hopes and dreams for well-
being of those receiving care create the sub-
stance of the core: respecting self-care practice;
honoring lay and indigenous care; inviting
participation and listening to clients’ stories of
health and well-being; providing care that is
essential for the other; supporting caring for
self, family, and community; providing care
that is culturally competent; and collaborating
with others for care. These services, provided
to children, students, school staff, and families
from the community, occur in the following
(and frequently overlapping) categories of care:
1. Design and coordinate care: examples include
referrals, navigation to other health services,
home visits, and concepts of transitional
and enhancing care are illuminated here
through the development of collaborative
relationships
2. Primary prevention and health education:
examples include assessment of child-
development milestones, pre- and
postnatal wellness, breast health,
testicular health, and stress reduction
3. Secondary prevention/health screening/early
intervention: examples include screenings
for hearing and vision, height/weight/
BMI, cholesterol, blood sugar, blood
pressure, clinical breast examinations,
lead levels, assessment, administration
of immunizations, and early management
of health issues
4. Tertiary prevention/primary care: assessment,
diagnosis, treatment, and care management
for chronic health issues, crisis intervention,
and behavioral support
First Circle
The first circle of the CNPM depicts a widen-
ing circle of concern and support for the well-
being of persons and communities. This circle
includes persons and groups in each school and
community who share concern for the well-
being of persons served at the centers. This in-
cludes participants in inquiry groups, parents/
guardians, school faculty, and noninstructional
staff, after-school groups, parent/teacher or-
ganizations, and school advisory councils. The
services provided within this circle might
include the following:
1. Consultation and collaboration: building
relationships and community, answering
inquiries on matters of health and well-
being, providing in-service and health
education, serving on school committees,
reviewing policies and procedures
2. Appraisal and evaluation: conducting
community assessments, appraising care
provided, evaluating outcomes, and
promoting programs that enhance well-
being for individuals and communities
Second Circle
The second circle draws attention to the wider
context of concern and influence for well-
being and includes structured and organized
groups whose members also share concern for
CHAPTER 25 • The Community Nursing Practice Model 439
Nursing
Situation
Or
ga
niz
atio
ns with wider jurisdictions
S
tr
uc
tu
re
d
an
d o
rgan
ized individuals and groups
Sc
ho
ol
a
nd
c
om
mu
nity individuals and groups
The Community Nursing Practice Model:
Concentric Circles of Empathetic Concern
Fig 25 • 1 The community nursing practice model:
Concentric circles of empathic concern. ©Florida
Atlantic University.
3312_Ch25_435-448 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 439
the education and well-being of the persons
served at the centers but within a wider range
or jurisdiction such as a district or county. Ex-
amples of these policy-making or advising
groups include the school district and county
public health department, voluntary organiza-
tions such as the Red Cross, and funders who
offer support for school and community car-
ing. The services provided in this circle include
the following:
1. Consultation and collaboration: building
relationships and community with
members of these groups; contributing
to policy appraisal, development, and
evaluation; leading and serving on
teams and committees responsible for
overseeing the care of students and
families; providing school nurse education
2. Research and evaluation: assessing school
health services, describing research find-
ings for best practices related to school and
community health, and designing research
projects focused on school/community
health issues, and/or school/community
nursing practice.
Third Circle
The third circle includes state, regional, national,
and international organizations with whom we
are related in various ways. Services within this
circle are focused on:
1. Consultation and collaboration: building
relationships and community with mem-
bers and collaborating about scholarship,
policy, outcomes, practice, research,
educational needs of school nurses
and advanced practice nurses; sustain-
ability through ongoing and additional
funding
2. Appraisal and evaluation: school nursing
and advanced practice faculty organiza-
tions offer a milieu for discussion and
appraisal of the services provided at the
centers (Organizations in this circle
may include national and international
organizations such as universities,
religious organizations, the Centers
for Disease Control and Prevention,
Department of Health and Human
Services, Ministry of Health, World
Health Organization, national profes-
sional organizations and boards, licensing
agencies, and various non-governmental
organizations [NGOs], such as Partners
in Health and Doctors Without
Borders.)
Connection of Core to Concentric
Circles
Connections of the core to the concentric
circles of services illuminate the complexity
of the practice within the CNPM. The core
service of consultation and collaboration is a pri-
mary focus of practice, beginning with nursing
and social work colleagues and extending to
participating clients, families, policymakers,
funders, and legislators. This value-laden
service has been essential to the viability and
sustainability of this CNPM. It promotes the
stance of humility that guides the respectful
question throughout the circles: How can
we be helpful to you? The answer directs the
creation of respectful, individualized care and
program development. Essential health-care
services are created within the core and extend
into the first circle.
Connections to the second circle unfold
from the collaborating relationships with
colleagues in the health department, school
district, and other groups taking the lead with
school and community health. Committees
of center administrators and staff meet regu-
larly to discuss school and community health
issues and to seek consensus on possible so-
lutions. Health-care providers are consultants
for medical questions and referrals, and
school nurse education may also be provided
for nurses to prepare them for community
nursing practice.
Like the other circles, the third circle de-
picts the breadth of relationships developed
at meetings and through publications and
presentations at local, regional, national, and
international conferences. Administration
and faculty have been widely recognized for
the contribution made to the health and
well-being of children and families.
440 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch25_435-448 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 440
Application of the Model
The model has been used as the framework
for research, education, and practice across
disciplines and with diverse foci. Some exam-
ples include the study of nursing language in
electronic records; a framework for curricu-
lum development for a master’s program in
advanced community nursing at Naresuan
University, Phitsanulok, Thailand; and the
use of the model by faculty of nursing at
Mbarara University of Science and Technol-
ogy, Mbarara, Uganda, to develop study of
advanced community nursing and to design
and operate the first school-based community
nursing wellness center in Uganda.
The CNPM guides a diverse, complex,
and transdisciplinary practice of nursing and
social work in school-based community well-
ness centers serving children and families
from diverse multicultural communities. The
collaborative approach of the CNPM fosters
relationships and acceptance by local commu-
nities and providers as essential component
to the health-care system. The CNPM was
featured in a major community nursing text
(Clark, 2003) and a school nursing practice
text (Gordon & Barry, 2006).
The CNPM has been the guiding frame-
work for a wide range of theses and disserta-
tions and in software development. In the
field of computer science engineering, the
CNPM has been used to give voice to nursing
through the development of a web-based
classification system, which quantifies the
qualitative language of nursing, specifically
the concepts of caring, knowing, connection,
and respect. The researchers analyzed nursing
situations based on the CNPM to develop an
electronic record that quantified the transcen-
dent values of the CNPM (Chinchanikar,
2009; Dass, 2011; Parker, Pandya, Hsu,
Noel, & Newlin, 2008; Tripathi, 2010). A
first patent application has been published
by the US Patent Office (U.S. Patent No.
2013/0311203A1; Parker, Pandya, Hsu, &
Huang, 2013). The research includes use of
caring theory and nursing language research
based on the community caring practice
model as a framework for patient human–
robot interaction (Huang, Tanioka, Locsin,
Parker, & Masory, 2011)
Sternberg (2009) identified the CNPM
as the theoretical perspective grounding her
research exploring the experience and meaning
of transnational motherhood. Her findings
illuminated the themes of sacrifice, suffering,
and hoping for a better life for their children
as the essence of their mothering from a dis-
tance. The author affirms the usefulness of the
CNPM in guiding this research to understand
the experience of these women living as whole
caring individuals.
Similarly the findings of Conrad’s (2010)
dissertation research identified the usefulness
of the CNPM as a framework to provide care
to culturally diverse populations. The inten-
tion to respect each individual and to respect
his or her health-care beliefs and practices can
be the grounding for the creation of nursing
responses that nurture the other’s hopes and
dreams for well-being. Pope’s (2011) histor-
ical research was grounded in the core beliefs
of the CNPM, and her findings identified
the need for interconnectedness to facilitate
community partnership and enhancement of
relationships.
Application in Nursing Education
Barry, Blum, Eggenberger, Palmer-Hickman,
and Mosley (2010) focused on the transcendent
values of respect, caring, and wholeness of per-
sons in the nursing situation through the use of
simulation to enhance nursing education.
Through simulation, the students were guided
to come to know the human face of homeless-
ness, to understand the whole context of the
person’s life, and, through compassion, to come
to see their faces reflected back. The specific
goals of the simulation were to understand the
fullness of the lived experience of homelessness
and to understand the full experience of caring
for Mildred, the simulated woman who was
homeless.
Ladd, Grimley, Hickman, and Touhy
(2013) built on the simulation model grounded
in the CNPM to develop a teaching–learning
nursing situation related to end-of-life care.
CHAPTER 25 • The Community Nursing Practice Model 441
3312_Ch25_435-448 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 441
Focusing on coming to know the individual
and family, students studied ways of nurturing
wholeness. Reflective analysis was incorporated
to promote the student’s self-awareness of their
own values and beliefs and the relation of these
to nursing care.
Barry, Blum, and Purnell (2007) used the
CNPM to assist nursing’s students under-
standing of the lived experience of victims of
Hurricane Katrina. The students went door to
door asking individuals how they could be
helpful and listening to calls for nursing. Many
times the call was to listen to an individual’s
story of survival and displacement; for others,
it was facilitating getting a child enrolled in
school. The students reached out into the com-
munity for resources and brought them back
to the individuals. Through this immersion ex-
perience, the students were able to live and feel
the connectedness to others and community
and to experience the meaning of nurturing
the wholeness of the other through caring.
Application in Practice
The transcendent values of respect and caring
provide the underpinnings of the inquiry group
method used by the CNPM to identify health
concerns and community strengths and assets.
Several studies have identified the usefulness
of the inquiry group method as a valuable tool
not only to gather perspectives from commu-
nity residents and partners to understand and
identify health needs and services but also
to resolve problems (Clark, 2003; Kasle,
Wilhelm, & Reed, 2002; Plonczynski et al.,
2007; Sadler et al., 2011). This method has
also been linked to increasing the likelihood of
acceptance of change by communities (Camp-
bell et al., 2001). The value of including
community partners and stakeholders in deci-
sion making was supported by the research of
Dyess and Chase (2012).
The actualizing values of access, essentiality,
community participation, empowerment, and
intersectoral collaboration guide nursing practice
in the CNPM. An example of these values in
action can be found in the study by Barry et al.
(2011). They used the CNPM as the framework
to develop a breast health promotion outreach
for underserved women. The inquiry group
method was used to establish the participant
as the expert of her own care with dialogue and
inclusiveness grounded in the values of respect,
caring, and wholeness of persons. The value of
community voice to enhance the care of the
underserved is highlighted in the research of
Sternberg and Lee (2013). Their research com-
pared the frequency of depressive symptoms of
premenopausal Latinas born in the United
States to Latina immigrants and found that
immigrant Latinas rated themselves slightly
higher on the Centers for Epidemiologic Studies
Depression Scale.
Tables 25-1 and 25-2 highlight the re-
search and studies focusing on the transcen-
dent and actualizing values of the CNPM.
442 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Value Category Description References
Transcendent Values: Present
in all nursing situations
Respect
Caring
Table 25 • 1 Illumination of the Transcendent and Actualizing Values of the
Community Nursing Practice Model
Refers to honoring the inher-
ent dignity and uniqueness of
each individual
Understand that to be human
is to be caring and also that
caring is the essence of nursing
Barry, Gordon, & Lange
(2007); Barry, Lange, &
King (2011); Chinchanikar
(2009); Dass (2011);
Tripathi (2010)
Barry, Gordon, & Lange
(2007); Barry, Lange, &
King (2011); Chinchanikar
(2009); Dass (2011);
Huang, Tanioka, Locsin,
3312_Ch25_435-448 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 442
Wholeness
Actualizing Values: Guides
practice in specific nursing
situations
Access
Essentiality
Community participation
Empowerment
Intersectoral collaboration
CHAPTER 25 • The Community Nursing Practice Model 443
Value Category Description References
Table 25 • 1 Illumination of the Transcendent and Actualizing Values of the
Community Nursing Practice Model—cont’d
Views persons as whole in the
moment and always connected
with others in families and
communities
Views as ongoing and con-
stant availability of health
care that is competent, cultur-
ally acceptable, respectful
and cost-effective
Described from the client’s
view as what is necessary for
well-being
Described as the active
engagement with members
of a community fostered by
openness to listen to calls for
nursing and to create nursing
responses
Understood as the client’s
awareness of making individ-
ual choices that influence
health and well-being
Refers to the openness to seek
and honor the expertise of
providers and agencies to
potentiate the outcomes
of services essential to
well-being
Parker, & Masory (2011);
Parker, Pandya, Hsu,
Noell, & Newlin (2008);
Tripathi (2010)
Barry, Gordon, & Lange
(2007); Barry, Lange, &
King (2011); Chinchanikar
(2009); Dass (2011);
Tripathi (2010)
Barry, Blum, Eggenberger,
Palmer-Hickman, &
Mosley (2010); Barry,
Gordon, & Lange (2007);
Sternberg (2009);
Sternberg & Lee (2013);
Larson, Sandelowski, &
McQuiston, (2012)
Barry, Blum, Eggenberger,
Palmer-Hickman, & Mosley
(2010); Barry, Blum, &
Purnell, M. (2007); Ladd,
Grimley, Hickman, &
Touhy (2013)
Barry, Lange, & King
(2011); Plonczynski et al.,
(2007)
Barry, Gordon, & Lange
(2007); Barry, Lange, &
King (2011)
Barry, Gordon, & Lange
(2007); Barry, Lange, &
King (2011); Pope, B.
(2011)
3312_Ch25_435-448 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 443
444 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Application to Research
Authors Application of Model Study Design/Focus/ Hypothesis
Chinchanikar (2009,
master’s thesis/engineering)
Tripathi, S. (2010, master’s
thesis/engineering)
Dass (2011, master’s
thesis/engineering)
Huang, Tanioka, Locsin,
Parker, & Masory (2011).
Sternberg (2009, doctoral
dissertation/nursing)
Conrad (2010, doctoral
dissertation)
Pope (2011, doctoral
dissertation)
Application to Education
Authors Application of Model Study Design /Focus/ Hypothesis
Barry, Blum, Eggenberger,
Palmer-Hickman, & Mosley
(2010)
Ladd, Grimley, Hickman,
& Touhy, (2013).
Barry, Blum, & Purnell (2007)
Application to Practice
Authors Application of Model Study Design/ Focus/Hypothesis
Barry, Lange, & King (2011)
Table 25 • 2 Overview of publications
Framework for study
Framework for study
Framework for study
Framework for study
Part of the framework
for study
Identified as faculty
practice model
Drew grounding con-
cepts from the model of
interconnectedness to
facilitate partnerships
and enhancement
of relationships
Document indexing framework
for automating classification of
nursing knowledge and language
Development of a knowledge
based decision making and
analyzing system for the nurses
to capture and manage the
nursing practice
Development of a nursing knowl-
edge management system
Development of a patient
human–robot interaction.
Qualitative research that ex-
plored the experiences of Latinas
living transnational motherhood
Evidence-based project that
compared faculty practice
models through comprehensive
literature review of evidence
based documents
Social history research study that
explored the eugenic policies of
the Progressive Era and the Social
Security Act of 1935, specifically
the maternal and child health
services as it relates to nursing
Development of a simulation to
guide students in understand the
“face” of homeless individuals
and families
Simulation development related
to nursing situations at the end
of life
Immersion experience with
victims of Hurricane Katrina
Qualitative descriptive study
which developed a community
outreach program for breast
health promotion for underserved
women
Used transcendent
values of respect,
caring, and wholeness
of person in a nursing
situation
Used model to further
develop nursing
simulation/situation
Used model to help
students understand
the lived experience
of Hurricane Katrina
Framework for study
3312_Ch25_435-448 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 444
Parker, Pandya, Hsu,
Noell, & Newlin (2008)
Plonczynski et al. (2007)
Sadler, Newlin,
Johnson-Spruill, & (2011)
Gordon, Barry,
Dunne, & King (2011)
Sternberg & Lee (2013)
CHAPTER 25 • The Community Nursing Practice Model 445
Application to Research
Authors Application of Model Study Design/Focus/ Hypothesis
Table 25 • 2 Overview of publications—cont’d
Framework for collabo-
rative project with com-
puter science engineers.
Identified use of inquiry
group method and cor-
related to participatory
action
Used inquiry group
method
Framework for study
Further research based
on original dissertation
Used the model concepts to
illuminate nursing’s voice in
an electronic record
Discussed use of inquiry group
method to be used by groups to
define and resolve problems
Longitudinal study examining the
faith community values, disease
threats, and barriers to self-care
Described the process of bringing
community partners in a school
health program together to clarify
a vision of health literacy
Secondary analysis of longitudinal
study which compared frequency
of depressive symptoms of pre-
menopausal Latinas women born
in the United States compared
with Latina immigrants
PRACTICE EXEMPLAR
The following is an exemplar of the useful-
ness of using the inquiry group method as a
“route to knowing.” As part of a community
assessment, the inquiry group methodology
was used to determine the hopes and dreams
for well-being of community members in
rural Haiti. Community members were gath-
ered together at a primary school, and intro-
ductions were made using a language
facilitator. Then the assertions were discussed
that the three facilitators were experts in
the method and in nursing but that each
participant was expert in his or her self-care
and care of the family and community. The
following question was asked: “How can we
be helpful to you?” One man responded with
a story of caring for his wife who was in a
prolonged labor. He described how he carried
her down from the mountain, her back
against his back, and hired a motorbike to
take her to the closest hospital 45 minutes
away. His call for nursing was heard loud and
clear. We need a hospital so that our families
don’t have to suffer so much.
Another teacher told a story of his concern
for his baby, Grace, 8 months old. He said she
had a temperature and cough and that he and
his wife were worried about her. He asked if we
would examine her when the meeting was over.
We agreed and were brought to his home on the
school campus. We were invited inside and met
his wife and baby. At first glance, the baby
looked very well nourished; she was alert, smil-
ing in response to interactions, and laughing
when we babbled to her. The mother told us she
was nursing her and that Grace had been able
to nurse as usual. With a stethoscope, we
listened to her chest and took her temperature
the old-fashioned way—with the back of our
hands. Her chest was clear, by our estimation
she did not have a fever, and her skin showed
no sign of dehydration. We instructed the
parents to watch for signs of deterioration and
to seek medical help. They said they had neither
local access to a doctor nor transportation to
seek help elsewhere. And another call was
heard—to develop a school-based wellness
center for health promotion and primary care.
3312_Ch25_435-448 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 445
446 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
■ Summary
The fundamental beliefs and commitment to
the discipline and unique practice of nursing
provided for both creating and sustaining the
CNPM. This CNPM provides the environ-
ment in which nursing and social work is prac-
ticed from the core beliefs of respect, caring,
and wholeness. Nurses and social workers are
encouraged to reach out through the concentric
circles, strengthening and widening the web
of relationships with colleagues, clients, and
community members. Through use of this
CNPM, the ideals of the discipline are brought
into the reality of care for wholeness and well-
being of persons and families in multicultural
communities.
References
Barry, C. (1998). The celebrity chef cooking club. A peer
involvement feeding program promoting cooperation
and community building. Florida Journal of School
Health, 9(1), 17–20.
Barry, C. D., Blum, C. A., Eggenberger, T. L., Palmer-
Hickman, C., & Mosley, R. (2009). Understanding
homelessness using a simulated nursing experience.
Journal of Holistic Nursing Practice, 23(4), 230–237.
Barry, C., Blum, C. A., & Purnell, M. (2007). Caring
for individuals displaced by Hurricanes Katrina
and Wilma: The lived experience of student
nurses. International Journal for Human Caring,
11(2), 67–73.
Barry, C. D., Gordon, S. C., & Lange, B. (2007). The
usefulness of the community nursing model in school
based community wellness centers: Narratives from
the U.S. and Africa. Research and Theory for Nursing
Practice: An International Journal, 21(3), 174–184.
Barry, C. D., Lange, B., & King, B. (2011). Women
alive: Gather underserved women upstream for a
comprehensive breast health program. Southern
Online Journal of Nursing Research, 11(1).
Retrieved from http://www.resourcenter.net/
images/SNRS/Files/SOJNR_articles2/Vol11Num01
Art07.html.
Campbell, M. K., Meier, A., Carr, C. Enga, Z., James,
A., Reedy, J., & Zheng, B. (2001). Health behaviour
changes after colon cancer: A comparison of findings
from face to face and on-line focus groups. Family &
Community Health, 24(3), 88–103.
Chinchanikar, S. V. (2009). Automated nursing knowl-
edge classification using indexing (master’s thesis).
Available from ProQuest Dissertations and Theses
database. (UMI No.1466377)
Chooporian, T. (1986). Reconceptualizing the environ-
ment. In P. Mocia (Ed.), New approaches to theory
development (pp. 39–54). New York: National
League for Nursing Press.
Clark, M. J. (2003). Community health nursing: Caring for
populations. Upper Saddle River, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Clark, M. J., Cary, S., Grover, D., Ceballos, R., Sifuentes,
M., & Trieu, S. (2003). Involving communities in
community assessment. Public Health Nursing, 20(6),
456–463.
Conrad, S. N. (2010). Best faculty practice plan model
for a small college of nursing (doctoral dissertation).
Available from ProQuest Dissertations and Theses
database. (UMI No.3413204)
Dass, S. (2011). A web-based automated classification
system for nursing language based on nursing theory
(master’s theory). Available from ProQuest Disserta-
tions and Theses database. (UMI No. 1507507)
Dyess, S. M., & Chase, S. (2012). Sustaining health in
faith community nursing practice: Emerging processes
that support the development of middle range theory.
Holistic Nursing Practice 26(4), 221–227.
Florida Atlantic University Christine E. Lynn College
of Nursing. (1994/2012). Mission and philosophy.
In Faculty handbook. Boca Raton, FL: Author.
Gordon, S., & Barry, C. (2009). Delegation guided by
school nursing values: Comprehensive knowledge,
trust and empowerment. Journal of School Nursing,
25(5), 352–360.
Gordon, S., Barry, C. Dunne, D., King, B. (2011).
Clarifying a vision for health literacy: A holistic
school-based community approach. Holistic Nursing
Practice, 25(3), 120–126.
Huang, S., Tanioka, T., Locsin, R., Parker, M.,
& Masory, O. (2011, November). Functions for
a caring robot in nursing. Proceedings of the 7th
IEEE International Conference on Natural Lan-
guage Processing and knowledge in engineering
(KLP_KE 2011), Tokushima, Japan.
Kasle, S., Wilhelm, M. S., & Ree, K. L., (2002). Opti-
mal health and wellbeing for women: Definitions
and strategies derived from focus groups of women.
Women’s Health Issues 12(4), 178–190.
Kleffel, D. (1996). Environmental paradigms: Moving
toward an ecocentric perspective. Advances in
Nursing Science, 18(4), 1–10.
Ladd, C., Grimley, K., Hickman, C., & Touhy, T.
(2013). Teaching end of life nursing using simula-
tion. Journal of Hospice & Palliative Nursing, 15(1),
41–51.
3312_Ch25_435-448 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 446
Larson, K., Sandelowski, M., & McQuiston, C. (2012).
“It’s a touchy subject”: Latino adolescent sexual risk
behaviors in the school context. Applied Nursing
Research, 25, 231–238.
Nightingale, F. (1859/1992). Notes on nursing: Commemo-
rative edition with commentaries by contemporary nursing
leaders. Philadelphia: J. B. Lippincott.
Parker, M. E. (1997). Emerging innovations: Caring
in action. International Journal for Human Caring,
1(2), 9–10.
Parker, M. E., & Barry, C. D. (1999). Community
practice guided by a nursing model. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 12(2), 125–131.
Parker, M. E., Barry, C. D., & King, B. (2000). Use of
inquiry method for assessment and evaluation in a
school-based community nursing project. Family and
Community Health, 23(2), 54–61.
Parker, M. E., Pandya, A., Hsu, S., & Huang, S. (2013).
U.S. Patent No. 2013/0311203A1. Washington,
DC: U.S. Patent and Trademark Office.
Parker, M. E., Pandya, A., Hsu, S., Noell, D., & Newlin,
K. (2008). Assuring nursing’s voice in the electronic
health record. IEEE International Conference on
Natural Language and Knowledge Development
Engineering, Beijing, China. Proceedings (NLP-KE
107). Piscataway, NJ: Institute of Electrical and
Electronics Engineers.
Peck, S. (1987). The different drum: Community making
and peace. New York: Simon & Schuster.
Plonczynski, D., Ehrlich-Jones, L., Fischer Robertson, J.,
Rossetti, J., Munroe, D., Koren, M. E., et al. (2007).
Ensuring a knowledgeable and committed geronto-
logical nursing workforce. Nursing Education Today,
27(2), 113–121.
Pope, B. (2011). Maternal health policy: Nursing’s
legacy and the social security act 1935 (doctoral
dissertation). Available from ProQuest Dissertations
and Theses database. (UMI No. 3462566)
Ryan, E., Hawkins, W., Parker, M. E., & Hawkins, M.
(2004). Perceptions of access to U. S. health care of
Haitian immigrants in South Florida. Florida Public
Health Review, 1, 36–43.
Sadler, L., Newlin, K., & Johnson-Spruill, I. (2011).
Beyond the medical model: Interdisciplinary
programs of community engaged health research.
Clinical and Translational Science, 4(4), 285–297.
Schuster, E. (1990). Earth caring. Advances in Nursing
Science, 13(1), 25–30.
Smith, C., & Mauer, F. (1995). Community health
nursing: Theory and practice. Philadelphia: W.B.
Saunders.
Sternberg, R. M. (2009). Latinas experiencing transna-
tional motherhood (doctoral dissertation). Available
from ProQuest Dissertations and Theses database.
(UMI No. 3401817)
Sternberg, R. M., & Barry, C. (2011). Transnational
mothers crossing the border and bringing their
healthcare needs. Journal of Nursing Scholarship,
43(1), 64–71.
Sternberg, R. M., & Lee, K. (2013). Depressive symp-
toms of midlife Latinas: Effect of immigration and
sociodemographic factors. International Journal of
Women’s Health. 3(5), 301–308.
Swadener, B., & Lubeck, S. (1995). Children and families
“at promise.” Deconstructing the discourse on risk.
Albany: State University of New York Press.
Tripathi, S. (2010). Knowledge based evaluation of
nursing care practice model (master’s thesis). Available
from ProQuest Dissertations and Theses database.
(UMI No. 1485670)
World Health Organization, Alma-Ata. (1978). Primary
health care. Geneva, Switzerland: Author.
World Health Organization. (2012). World conference
on the social determinants of health: Meeting report.
Geneva, Switzerland: World Health Organization
Press.
World Health Organization. (2007). A conceptual frame-
work for action on the social determinants of health.
Geneva, Switzerland: World Health Organization.
Zaiger, D. (2013). Historical perspectives of school
nursing. In J. Selekman (Ed.), Comprehensive
textbook of school nursing (2nd ed., pp. 2–25).
Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
CHAPTER 25 • The Community Nursing Practice Model 447
3312_Ch25_435-448 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 447
3312_Ch25_435-448 26/12/14 10:43 AM Page 448
Chapter 26Rozzano Locsin’s
Technological Competency as
Caring in Nursing
Knowing as Process and Technological
Knowing as Practice
ROZZANO C. LOCSIN
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Theory
Application of the Theory
Practice Exemplar
Summary
References
449
Introducing the Theorist
Rozzano C. Locsin is Professor Emeritus
of Nursing at Florida Atlantic University’s
Christine E. Lynn College of Nursing, and in-
augural International Nursing Professor at the
Institute of Health Biosciences, University of
Tokushima, in Tokushima, Japan. His pro-
gram of research focuses on life transitions in
the health–illness experience. He holds bac-
calaureate and master’s degrees in nursing from
Silliman University in the Philippines and a
Doctor of Philosophy degree from the Univer-
sity of the Philippines. Dr. Locsin was a Ful-
bright Scholar in Uganda in 2000, a recipient
of the 2004 to 2006 Fulbright Alumni Initia-
tive Award to Uganda and the Fulbright Senior
Specialist in Global and Public Health and
International Development Award. He was
inducted as a Fellow of the American Academy
of Nursing in 2006, and received the presti-
gious Edith Moore Copeland Excellence in
Creativity Award from Sigma Theta Tau In-
ternational Honor Society of Nursing and two
lifetime achievement awards from premier
schools of nursing in the Philippines. In addi-
tion, Locsin received the first University Re-
searcher of the Year Award in 2006 in the
Scholarly/Creative Works category as Professor
at Florida Atlantic University. Published in
2001, his edited book Advancing Technology,
Caring, and Nursing introduced the germinal
work of relating technology with caring in
nursing. His middle-range nursing theory,
Technological Competency as Caring in Nursing:
A Model for Practice, was published by Sigma
Rozzano C. Locsin
3312_Ch26_449-460 26/12/14 3:23 PM Page 449
Theta Tau International Press in 2005. In
2007, his coedited book Technology and Nurs-
ing: Practice, Process and Issues illustrated the im-
portance of technology in nursing practice. A
fourth book, A Contemporary Process of Nursing:
The (Unbearable) Weight of Knowing in Nursing,
was published in 2009. This book provides
essential chapters defining and describing the
concept of “knowing persons.” Dr. Locsin’s
interest in global nursing and care initiatives
enhances his appreciation of the dynamic nature
of humans and of nursing as the practice of con-
tinuously knowing persons through emerging
technologies within a caring framework.
Overview of the Theory
There is a great demand for a practice of nursing
based on an authentic intention to know human
beings fully as persons and as participants in
their care rather than as objects of our care.
Nurses want to use creative, imaginative, and
innovative ways of affirming, appreciating,
and celebrating humans as whole persons. In
present-day health and human care, advancing
technologies claim a stronghold. Often the best
way to realize intended nursing care outcomes is
the excellent and competent use of nursing tech-
nologies (Locsin, 1998). Frequently perceived
as the practice of using machines in nursing
(Locsin, 1995), technological competency as
caring in nursing is the process of knowing per-
sons as whole (Locsin, 2001), while frequently
engaging technological advancements.
Contemporary definitions of technology in-
clude (1) a means to an end, (2) an instrument,
(3) a tool, or (4) a human activity that increases
or enhances efficiency (Heidegger, 1977). Con-
ceptualizing caring and technology within
nursing practice is challenging. However, view-
ing them in harmonious coexistence is crucial
so that mutual caring occurs, fostering the un-
derstanding of technological competency as an
expression of caring in nursing (Locsin, 2005).
The purpose of this chapter is to explain
“knowing persons through technological com-
petency as a process of nursing,” a framework
of nursing that guides its practice, grounded in
the theoretical construct of technological compe-
tency as caring in nursing (Locsin, 2005). This
model of practice illuminates the harmonious
relationship between technological competency
and caring in nursing. In this model, the
emphasis of nursing is on the person, a human
being whose hopes, dreams, and aspirations are
focused on living life fully as a caring person
(Boykin & Schoenhofer, 2001).
As a model of practice, technological compe-
tency as caring in nursing (Locsin, 2005) is as
valuable today as it has been in the past and
will continue to be in the future. Technological
advances in health care demand expertise with
technology. Often, such expertise is perceived as
the antithesis of caring, particularly in situations
in which the focus of attention is on the tech-
nology rather than on the person. Nonetheless,
it is the premise of this chapter that being tech-
nologically competent is being caring.
Technological competency as caring in nursing is
a middle-range theory illustrated in the practice
of nursing and grounded in the harmonious co-
existence between technology and caring in
nursing. The assumptions of the theory are
informed by Boykin and Schoenhofer’s (2001)
work and include the following:
• Persons are caring by virtue of their
humanness.
• Persons are whole or complete in the
moment.
• Knowing persons is a process of nursing
that allows for continuous appreciation of
persons moment to moment.
• Technology is used to know wholeness of
persons moment to moment.
• Nursing is a discipline and a professional
practice.
The ultimate purpose of technological com-
petency in nursing is to acknowledge that the
person is the focus of nursing and that various
technologies can and should be used in the
service of knowing the person.
This acknowledgment of persons brings
together the relatively abstract concept of
wholeness-of-person with the more concrete
concept of technology. Such acknowledgment
compels the redesigning of nursing processes—
ways of expressing, celebrating, and appreciat-
ing the practice of nursing as continuously
knowing persons as whole moment to moment.
450 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch26_449-460 26/12/14 3:23 PM Page 450
In this practice of nursing, technology is used
not to know the person as object to be con-
trolled and manipulated but rather to know
who the person is as an experiencing subject in
her or his wholeness. Appropriately, knowing
person as object alludes to an expectation of
knowing empirical aspects and facts about the
composite person, whereas knowing person
as subject requires the understanding of an
unpredictable, irreducible person who is more
than and different from the sum of his or her
empirical parts. In this way, technology is
used to understand the uniqueness and individ-
uality of persons as humans who continuously
unfold and who, therefore, require continuous
knowing (Locsin, 2005).
Persons as Whole and Complete in the
Moment
One of the earlier definitions of the word person
appeared in Hudson’s 1988 publication claiming
that the “emphasis on inclusive rather than sexist
language has brought into prominence the use of
the word ‘person’” (p. 12). The origin of the word
person is from the Greek word prosopon, which
means the actor’s mask of Greek tragedy; of
Roman origin, persona indicated the role played
by the individual in social or legal relationships.
Hudson (1988) also declares that “an individual
in isolation is contrary to an understanding of
‘person’” (p. 15). A necessary appreciation of per-
sons requires the view that humans are whole or
complete in the moment. As such, there is no
need to fix them or to make them complete again
(Boykin & Schoenhofer, 2001). There is nothing
missing that requires nurses’ intervening to make
persons “whole or complete” again, or for nurses
to assist in this completion. Persons are complete
in the moment. Their varying situations of care
call for creativity, innovation, and imagination
from nurses so that they may come to know the
nursed as a “whole” person. The uniqueness of
the person emerges in the response to being
called forth in particular situations.
Inherent in humans as unpredictable, dy-
namic, and living beings is the regard for self-
as-person. This appreciation is like the human
concern for security, safety, self-esteem, and
self-actualization popularized by Maslow
(1943) in his quintessential theoretical model
on the hierarchy of needs. More important,
however, is the understanding that being
human is being a person, regardless of bio-
physical parts or technological enhancements.
Because the future may require relative
appreciation of persons, if the ultimate crite-
rion of being human today is being wholly
natural, organic, and functional, then being
human may not be so easy to determine or
appreciate. The purely natural human being may
be rare. The understanding that technology-
supported life is artificial, and therefore is not
natural, stimulates discussions among practi-
tioners of nursing (Locsin & Campling,
2005), particularly when the subject of
concern is technology-dependent care and
technological competency as an expression of
caring in nursing. Hudson (1988) suggests
that “false comfort may be offered whenever
it is implied that this life and this body are
significantly less important than the ‘spiritual
body’ and the ‘next life’. . . the time has come
to enhance an awareness of the post human
or spiritual future” (p. 13). What structural
requirements will the next-generation human
possess? Today, some humans have anatomic
and/or physiological components that are
already electronic and/or mechanical, such
as mechanical cardiac valves, self-injecting
insulin pumps, cardiac pacemakers, or artifi-
cial limbs, all appearing as excellent facsimiles
of the real. Yet the idea of a “whole person”
and being natural continues to persist as a re-
quirement of what a human being should be.
How Are Persons Known?
Often, questioning in order to know the person
is limited to inquiry about his or her body parts.
For example, “How are your knees?” instead of
“How are you doing with your knees?” Of what
purpose is the question? Is it to know the person
or to know the condition of the specific com-
ponent part? Perhaps inadvertently, uncon-
sciously, or both, one inquires about the body
part because of a culturally founded reason or
because the customary focus on another’s bodily
features defines that person.
How are persons known as human beings?
Historically, humans were depicted through
drawings and paintings. Colorful artworks
CHAPTER 26 • Rozzano Locsin’s Technological Competency as Caring in Nursing 451
3312_Ch26_449-460 26/12/14 3:23 PM Page 451
represented the human being in imaginative
ways as conceptualized by painters and illus-
trators. Artists and their works became com-
modities, and Leonardo da Vinci may top this
list as, perhaps, the most prized of illustrators
and painters. Studying the human being as an
object allowed Leonardo to illustrate the com-
posite of the human being through dissected
remains. Illustrations such as these may have
influenced Michelangelo in his creation of
masterful artworks such as David and Moses.
The clarity, definition, and fidelity of these
representations reveal the utmost appreciation
of the human being. Yet the question
remains: Does the human being become a
person, or is he always a person? Is the com-
position of the human being the ultimate
descriptor, characteristic, and quality of a
whole and complete person? What happens
when the human being has no limbs, or has
limbs that are not functional? Is this human
being a person?
Consider the case of a baby born without
limbs but otherwise alive and well. When the
baby became ill, he was rushed to a hospital. To
the chagrin of the nurses and physicians, they
were at first unable to care for the baby. Their
main question was “How can we initiate IV
when there are no extremities?” They may also
have wondered, “On growing up, will this baby
be concerned about what it is like to have no
limbs, or will he wish he had limbs so he could
‘go’ places like others?” (Barnard & Locsin,
2007, p. 17).
Consider also the “Girl With Eight Limbs”
(PBS) from a province in India, who was
subjected to intense surgical intervention to
remove the other “nonfunctional” limbs that
were putting her life in a precarious situation.
What does this girl think now? “Am I complete
or incomplete? Am I normal or abnormal, just
because I am like everyone else—with two
upper limbs and two lower limbs?” (PBS).
In an episode of the television series The
Twilight Zone, a woman perceived herself as
so hideous that she thought she was unworthy
to be seen; she had to hide her face behind a
veil. She was shunned by her family. It was an
unbearable life for her and for her family as
well. In the end, the moral of the story focused
on the adage “beauty is in the eye of the
beholder” (Serling, 1960). The people who
shunned the woman had faces like those
of pigs, while she had more “human-like”
features. In fact, she was a beautiful human
woman whom everyone found to be ugly,
embarrassing, pitiful, and a misfit and was ad-
vised to move to a distant colony with a small
population of people like her. This particular
story addresses the impact of prejudice in con-
sidering what a person ought to be. In essence,
it marginalizes those who are not like others
and in doing so prevents the understanding of
nursing as the process of knowing persons as
whole and complete in the moment.
In a recent Associated Press news article,
“The Androgynous Pharaoh? Akhenaten Had
Feminine Physique” (USA Today, May 2, 2008),
writer Alex Dominguez presented Dr. Irwin
Braverman’s findings on the controversial “fem-
inine” features of the pharaoh Akhenaten.
Dominguez wrote, “Akhenaten wasn’t the most
manly pharaoh, even though he fathered at least
a half-dozen children. In fact, his form was quite
feminine, which has puzzled experts for years.
And he was a bit of an egghead.” The pharaoh
had “an androgynous appearance. He had a
female physique with wide hips and breasts, but
he was male and he was fertile and he had six
daughters,” Braverman is quoted as saying. “But
nevertheless, he looked like he had a female
physique.” Apparently, what constitutes “know-
ing” whether a human being is a man or a
woman is the physical appearance. This makes
Braverman’s study of the Pharaoh Akhenaten
most meaningful.
An example of person as object, known as
a composite of physical elements, is the leg-
endary Frankenstein monster, an entity assem-
bled from various human parts. The monster
was created and made human in the sense of
being a composite of parts but also in the sense
of his essence of being energy (electricity).
The Process of Knowing Persons
Persons possess the prerogative and the choice
of whether to allow nurses to know them fully.
Entering the world of the other is a critical req-
uisite to knowing as a process of nursing. Estab-
lishing rapport, trust, confidence, commitment,
452 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch26_449-460 26/12/14 3:23 PM Page 452
and the compassion to know others fully as
persons is integral to this crucial positioning.
Wholeness is the idealized condition or
situation of the one who is nursed. This ideal-
ization is held within the nurse’s understanding
of persons as complete human beings “in the
moment.” Expressions of this completeness vary
from moment to moment. These expressions are
human illustrations of living and growing. Using
technology alone and focusing on the received
technological data rather than on continually
“knowing” the other fully as person can lead to
the nurse thinking of the person as an object
who needs to be completed and made whole
again. Paradoxically, because of the idea that hu-
mans are unpredictable, it is not entirely possible
for the nurse to fully know another human
being—except in the moment and only if the
person allows the nurse to know him or her by
entering into the other’s world.
In this perspective, the condition in which
the nurse and the other allow knowing each
other exists as the nursing situation, the shared
lived experience between the nurse and nursed
(Boykin & Schoenhofer, 2001).
In this relationship, trust is established that
the nurse will know the other fully as person;
the trust that the nurse will not judge the per-
son or categorize the person as just another
human being or experience but rather as a
unique person who has hopes and aspirations
that are singularly his or her own.
It is the nurse’s responsibility to know the
person’s hopes and aspirations. Technological
competency as caring allows for this under-
standing. In doing so, the nurse also sanctions
the other (the nursed) to know him or her as
person. The expectation is that the nurse is to
use multiple ways of knowing competently in
using technologies to know the other fully as
person.
The nurse’s responsibility is immeasurable
in creating conditions that demand technolog-
ical competency and care. In creating a nursing
situation of care, there is a requisite compe-
tency to know persons fully, to understand,
and to appreciate the important nuances of the
person’s dreams and desires.
There are many ways of interpreting the
concept of “person as whole.” We will look at
three interpretations that shape the popular
understanding of the concept. One of these
interpretations is the mind–body dualism
ascribed to Descartes, which describes the
connection between mind and body. In nursing,
the mind–body–spirit connection is popular-
ized by Jean Watson (1985) in her theory
of transpersonal caring. Another version of
the mind–body connection, the simultaneity
paradigm (Parse, 1998), categorizes the
human–environment mutual connection as the
relationship that best serves the nursing per-
spective and grounds theoretical frameworks
and models of practice, including many of
those in caring science. These contemporary
and popular elucidations regard humans as the
focus of nursing and knowing persons in their
wholeness as the practice of nursing.
Knowing persons as the process of nursing
is a dynamic encounter between the nurse and
nursed in which nursing situations unfold to-
ward an encompassing practice of knowledge-
based nursing. The meaning of the process is
characterized by listening, knowing, being
with, enabling, and maintaining belief as
described by Swanson (1991). The following
descriptions exemplify the process of knowing
persons as nursing within the theory of tech-
nological competency as caring in nursing:
• Knowing: The process of knowing a person is
guided by technological knowing in which
persons are appreciated as participants in
their care rather than as objects of care. The
nurse enters the world of the other. In this
process, technology is used to magnify the
aspect of the person that requires revealing—
a representation of the real person. The
person’s state may change moment to
moment—the person is dynamic and alive,
and his or her actions cannot be predicted.
This provides the opportunity for nurses to
continuously know the person as whole.
• Designing: Both the nurse and the one
nursed (patient) plan a mutual care process
from which the nurse can organize a
rewarding nursing practice that is respon-
sive to the patient’s desire for care.
• Participative engaging: This encounter pro-
vides a simultaneous practice of conjoined
CHAPTER 26 • Rozzano Locsin’s Technological Competency as Caring in Nursing 453
3312_Ch26_449-460 26/12/14 3:23 PM Page 453
activities that are crucial to knowing
persons. This stage of the process is charac-
terized by alternating rhythms of imple-
mentation and evaluation. The evidence of
continuous knowing, implementation, and
participation is reflective of the cyclical but
recursive process of knowing persons.
• Furthering knowing: The continuous, circular
and recursive process of knowing persons
demonstrates the ever-changing, and dynamic
nature of fundamental ways of knowing in
nursing. Knowledge about the person that is
derived from knowing, designing, and partici-
pative engagement further informs the caring
practice of the nurse, thereby acknowledging
the recursive process of knowing persons.
Figure 26-1 describes the process of knowing
persons.
Notice in the model of practice shown in the
figure that knowing is the primary process.
“Knowing nursing means knowing in the
realms of personal, ethical, empirical, and
aesthetic—all at once” (Boykin & Schoenhofer,
2001, p. 6). Knowledge about the person that is
derived from knowing, designing, participative
engaging and furthering knowing additionally
informs the nurse in appreciating the patient.
In knowing persons, one comes to understand
that more knowing about the person and about
his or her being allows the nurse to affirm, sup-
port, and celebrate his or her dreams and aspi-
rations in the moment. Supporting this process
of knowing is the understanding that persons
are unpredictable, that they simultaneously con-
ceal and reveal themselves as persons from one
moment to the next (Parse, 1998).
The nurse can know the person fully only in
the moment. This knowing occurs only when
the person allows the nurse to enter his or her
world. When this happens, the nurse and
nursed become vulnerable as they move toward
further continuous knowing.
454 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Knowing Persons: Framework for Nursing
Calls for
nursing
(supporting,
affirming,
celebrating)
Responses to
calls for nursing
Multiple patterns of
knowing in nursing
Empirics, aesthetics, ethic,
personal (Carper 1978)
Knowing persons
Who is person?
What is person?
Nursing as caring
(Boykin and
Schoenhofer, 2001)
Loscin, R. (2005).Technological Compentency as Caring in Nursing: A Model for Practice. Sigma Theta Tau International Press, Indianapolis, IN
Fig 26 • 1 Nursing as knowing persons. (From Locsin, R. (2005). Technological Competency as Caring in Nursing:
A Model for Practice. Indianapolis, IN: Sigma Theta Tau International Press.)
3312_Ch26_449-460 26/12/14 3:23 PM Page 454
Vulnerability allows participation so that
the nurse and nursed continue knowing each
other moment to moment. Daniels (1998)
explained that in such situations, the “nurse’s
work is to ameliorate vulnerability” (p. 191).
Demonstrating vulnerability in caring situa-
tions enables others to recognize it, participate
in mutual vulnerability, and share in the
humanness of being vulnerable. Further,
Daniels declared that “vulnerable individuals
seek nursing care, and nurses seek those who
are vulnerable” (p. 192). By entering the world
of the one nursed, the nurse shares “power
with” rather than having “power over” the
patient through a created hierarchy (Daniels,
1998). The nurse does not know more about
the person than the person knows about him-
or herself. No one knows the lived experience
of the patient better than the patient.
Nonetheless, there is the possibility that the
nurse will be able to predict and prescribe for
the one nursed. When this occurs, these situa-
tions forcibly lead the nurse to appreciate
persons more as object than as person. Such a
situation can occur only when the nurse is
assumed to “have known” the one nursed.
Although it can be assumed that with the
process of “knowing persons as whole,” oppor-
tunities to continuously know the other become
limitless, there is also a much greater likelihood
that having “already known” the one nursed,
the nurse will predict and prescribe activities for
the one nursed, ultimately causing objectifica-
tion of the person (see Fig. 26-2).
To Know and Knowing
The verb know has common definitions. Of
these definitions, some are appropriate
descriptions that explain the intended use of
the word in nursing, thereby facilitating its
understanding for the purpose and process of
competently using technologies in nursing.
These definitions are as follows:
• To perceive directly with the senses or mind
• To be certain of, regard, or accept as true
beyond doubt
• To be capable of, have the skills to
• To have thorough or practical understanding
of, as through experience of
• To be subjected to or limited by
• To recognize the character or quality of
• To be able to distinguish, recognize
• To be acquainted or familiar with
• To see, hear, or experience
While the verb know sustains the notion
that nursing is concerned with activity and that
the one who acts is knowledgeable (in the
sense of understanding the rationales behind
the activities), the word knowing is a key
concept that alludes to the focus of an action
from a cognitive perspective requiring descrip-
tion. Knowing perfectly describes the ways of
nursing—transpiring continuously as expli-
cated from the framework of knowing persons.
It is the use of the word knowing in which the
process of nursing as knowing persons is lived.
The framework for practice clearly shows the
circuitous and continuous process of knowing
persons as a practice of nursing.
We hope that nurses practice nursing from
a theoretical perspective rather than from
tradition or from blind obedience to instruc-
tions and directions. Nevertheless, processes of
nursing that are derived from extant theories
of nursing continue to dictate and prescribe
how a nurse should nurse. Contrary to this
popular conception, knowing persons as a
model of practice using technologies of nurs-
ing achieves for the nurse an appreciation of
expertise and the knowledge of persons in the
moment. Technologies allow nurses to know
about the person only as much as the person
permits the nurse to know. It can be true that
technologies detect the anatomical, physiolog-
ical, chemical, and/or biological conditions
of a person. This identifies the person as a
living human being. However, with knowing
persons, the nurse is allowed to understand
and anticipate the ever-changing person from
moment to moment.
The purpose of knowing the person is
derived from the nurse’s intention to nurse
(Purnell & Locsin, 2000)—a continuing
appreciation of the person as ever-changing
and never static: one who is a dynamic human
being. The information derived from knowing
the person is only relevant for the moment, for
the person’s “state” can change moment to
CHAPTER 26 • Rozzano Locsin’s Technological Competency as Caring in Nursing 455
3312_Ch26_449-460 26/12/14 3:23 PM Page 455
moment. Importantly, knowing the “who or
what” of persons helps nurses realize that a
person is more than simply the physiochemical
and anatomical being. Knowing persons allows
the nurse to know “who and what” is the
person. “Who” is the subjective knowing of
the person as whole and “what” is objective
knowing of the person as parts.
Knowing When Using Technology
From such a view, it may seem that the process
of knowing is possible only when using
technologies in nursing. This perception,
which is not necessarily true, is supported by
the idea that nursing is technology when tech-
nology is appreciated as anything that creates
efficiency, whether this is an instrument or a
tool, such as machines, or the activity of nurses
when nursing. Sandelowski (1993) has argued
about the metaphorical depiction of nursing
as technology, or with technology as nursing,
and the semiotic relationship of these con-
cepts. Locsin and Purnell (2007) have declared
that accompanying the nurse’s rapture with
technologies in nursing is the consequent
suffering or the price of advancing dependency
on technologies that critically influence con-
temporary human lives. With increased use
of technologies and ensuing technological
dependency experienced by recipients of care,
the imperative is to provide technological com-
petency as caring in nursing (Locsin, 2005).
Regardless, the idea of knowing persons
guiding nursing practice is novel in the sense
that there is no ideal prescription; rather there
is the wholesome appreciation of an informed
practice that allows the use of multiple ways of
knowing such as described by Phenix (1964)
and expanded by Carper (1978). These ways
of knowing involve the empirical, ethical,
personal, and aesthetic. Aesthetic expressions
document, communicate, and perpetuate the
appreciation of nursing as transpiring moment
to moment. Popular aesthetic expressions
include storytelling; poetry; visual expressions
as in drawings, illustrations, and paintings; and
aural renditions such as music. Encountering
aesthetic expressions again allows the nurse
and the nursed to relive the occasion anew.
Reflecting on these experiences using the
fundamental patterns of knowing (Carper,
1978) enhances learning, motivates the fur-
therance of knowledgeable practice, and in-
creases the valuing of nursing as a professional
practice grounded in a legitimate theoretical
perspective of nursing.
The use of technologies in nursing is con-
sequent to the contemporary demands for
nursing actions requiring technological know-
ing (Locsin, 2009). Technological knowing is
demanded for the ultimate purpose of know-
ing the real person. Technological knowing is
defined as the practice of using technologies of
care to know the one nursed. Important along
with technology use in nursing is the condition
that the one nursed allows himself or herself
to be known as a person.
Technological competency in nursing fos-
ters the recognition of persons as participants
in their care rather than as objects of care. The
idea of participation in their care stems from
active engagement, in which the nurse enters
the world of the one nursed through available
appropriate technologies, attempting to know
the nursed more fully in the moment. In this
practice, the assumption is understood that the
one nursed allows the nurse to enter his or her
world so that together they may mutually
support, affirm, and celebrate each other’s
being. In this relationship of the knower and
the one known, technology provides the effi-
ciency and the valuing that marks their mutual
and momentary reality (Locsin, 2009).
Technology currently encompasses the bulk
of functional activities that nurses are expected
to perform, particularly when the practice is in
a clinical setting. Clinical nursing is firmly
rooted in the clinical health model (Smith,
1983) in which the organismic and mechanistic
views of humans as persons convincingly dictate
the practice of nursing. Nevertheless, the
process of knowing persons will prevail, for the
model of technological competency as caring in
nursing provides the nurse the fitting stimula-
tion and motivation (and the prospective auton-
omy to judge critically) a mode of action that
desires an appreciation of persons as whole.
The model articulates continuous knowing.
Continuing to know persons deters objectifi-
cation, a process that ultimately regards human
456 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch26_449-460 26/12/14 3:23 PM Page 456
beings as “stuff” to care about, rather than as
knowledgeable participants in their care.
Participating in his or her care frees the per-
son from having to be “assigned” care that he
or she may not want or need. This relationship
signifies responsiveness of the cared for by the
person who is caring for (Hudson, 1988).
Continuous knowing results when findings
obtained through consequent knowing further
increase the desire to know “who” and “what”
the person is. Continuous knowing overpow-
ers the motivation to prescribe and direct the
person’s life. Rather, it affirms, supports, and
celebrates his or her hopes, dreams, and aspi-
rations as a participating human being.
Technological Knowing
Technological knowing in nursing illustrates the
shared practice of using technologies to know
persons as whole and using technologies of care
for the purpose of understanding persons more
fully. The circuitous and recursive engagement
that occurs in technological knowing includes:
• Appreciating the person’s humanness
• Engaging in mutual knowing—between the
nurse and nursed
• Participating in dynamic relating within
caring nursing relationships
• Furthering knowing of persons
Through technological knowing, further
knowing of persons is achieved. Because it
is a circuitous and recursive process, conse-
quently, the practice of technological know-
ing begins anew. The following model
(Fig. 26-2) illustrates the way of technolog-
ical knowing in nursing.
Calls and Responses for Nursing
Calls for nursing are illuminations of the per-
sons’ hopes, dreams, and aspirations. Calls
for nursing are individual expressions by per-
sons who seek ways toward affirmation, sup-
port, and celebration as person. The nurse
appreciates the uniqueness of persons in his
or her nursing. In doing so, the nurse sus-
tains and enhances the wholeness of the
human being, while facilitating the realiza-
tion of the persons’ completeness through
“acting for or with” the person. This is a way
of affirming, supporting, and celebrating the
person’s wholeness.
CHAPTER 26 • Rozzano Locsin’s Technological Competency as Caring in Nursing 457
Calls and responses
between the nurse and
person being nursed
Technological Knowing
is Nursing
Appreciating
humaness
of persons
Engaging in
mutual
knowing
Participating in
dynamic relationships
within caring
nursing situations
Further
knowing
of persons
Fig 26 • 2 Technological knowing in nursing.
3312_Ch26_449-460 26/12/14 3:23 PM Page 457
The nurse relies on the person for calls for
nursing. These calls are specific mechanisms that
the persons use, allowing the nurse to respond
with authentic intentions to know them fully as
persons in the moment. Calls for nursing may
be expressed in various ways, often as hopes and
dreams, such as the hope to be with friends
while recuperating in the hospital, the desire to
play the piano when the fingers are well enough
to function effectively, or simply the ultimate de-
sire to go home or to die peacefully. As uniquely
as these calls for nursing are expressed, the nurse
knows the person continuously moment to
moment. Nursing responses to these calls may
to monitor patterns of information, such as those
derived from an electrocardiogram to know the
physiological status of the person in the moment
or to administer lifesaving medications, to insti-
tute transfer plans, or to refer patients for services
to other health-care professionals.
The entirety of nursing is to direct, focus, at-
tain, sustain, and maintain the person. In doing
so, hearing calls for nursing is continuous and
momentarily complete. Knowing persons allows
the nurse to use technologies in articulating calls
for nursing. The empirical, personal, ethical, and
esthetic ways of knowing that are fundamental
to understanding persons as whole increase the
likelihood of knowing persons in the moment.
Unpredictable and dynamic, human beings
are ever-changing moment to moment. This
characteristic challenges the nurse to know
persons continuously as a whole, rejecting the
traditional concept of possibly knowing persons
completely at once, to prescribe and predict
their expressions of wholeness. In continuously
knowing persons as whole through articulated
technologies in nursing, the nurse can perhaps
intervene to facilitate patients’ recognition of
their wholeness in the moment.
Applications of the Theory
Locsin’s theory is relatively new. Applications of
the theory of technological competency as caring
in nursing have been documented, although
mostly anecdotal references exist as these are
shared and its utility explained. Through these
anecdotes received in various occasions, especially
after presentations and conversations and
through personal communications via e-mail,
these positive declarations continue to provide
and affirm that the theory is useful particularly in
nursing practice demanding technological profi-
ciency such as in critical care settings. Likewise,
during class presentations and in scholarly/
academic conferences, students and participants
express their claims that the theory resonates well
in their practice, affirming their understanding
of nursing, and confirming their appreciation of
knowing persons through technologies as prac-
tice. However, there has been an absence of
comments from practitioners who have signified
that the theory has guided their practice, or of
any researcher who has claimed that he or she
has used the theory as framework in any study.
Nevertheless, the claims that the theory has
affirmed one’s practice exist (Fig. 26-3).
458 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Future Research
• Experiences of ‘caring for’
• Lived experiences of being ‘cared for’
• Ethics and technological dependence
• Cloning and bionic parts and the experience
of being with
• Design and development of instrument to
measure technological competency as caring
in nursing
• Testing of instrument to measure patient
experience with technologies
• Genetics and the future of humans as
posthumans
• Burnout phenomenon and the prospective use
of robots in the practice of nursing
• Nursing administration calls to care for nurses
in high-tech environments
• Universality of technological competency
as caring in varying nursing settings
Fig 26 • 3 Future research.
3312_Ch26_449-460 26/12/14 3:23 PM Page 458
CHAPTER 26 • Rozzano Locsin’s Technological Competency as Caring in Nursing 459
Practice Exemplar: Knowing Persons in the Moment
The following is a nursing situation involving
a nurse’s act to direct her care to what was
important for her patients.
One of my patients requested a new IV on
her opposite arm, even though the one she
had was safely infusing her IV fluids. I was
extremely far behind, but I knew that her IV
would not get changed until much later if at
all, as shift change was occurring, and she did
not have veins that were easily accessed. I
requested the vein finder instrument from the
supervisor and successfully inserted a new IV.
My patient was so happy and told me that no
one else had been able to “get a vein” on the
first try. It seemed like a simple task, but it
made such a difference to her. I can appreci-
ate that through competent use of the vein
finder instrument, I was able to allow my
patient to use her dominant hand instead of
limiting her range of motion because of the
IV location. She was able to experience her-
self as more “whole” through the use of her
dominant extremity. This was such a simple
an act, and yet it mattered to her quality of
life in the moment for both her and me.
This nurse explains, “As I reflect on Locsin’s
theory, I can appreciate that as nurses we
strive to know our patients as whole.”
According to Locsin (2010), “Nurses want to
use creative, imaginative, and innovative ways
of affirming, appreciating, and celebrating
humans as whole persons” (p. 461). This
desire will often lead nurses to understand
that these “intentions” can be realized
through “expert, competent use of nursing
technologies” (p. 461).
■ Summary
The purpose of this chapter is to describe and ex-
plain “knowing persons as whole,” a framework
of nursing guiding a practice grounded in the
theoretical construct of technological competency
as caring in nursing (Locsin, 2005). This frame-
work of practice illuminates the harmonious
relationship between technological competency
and caring in nursing. In this model, the focus
of nursing is the person. The chapter introduces
technological knowing, a way of knowing in
nursing engaging the competent use of tech-
nologies of care to come to know persons as
whole. Through technological knowing, both
the nurse and one nursed are appreciated as
whole persons whose hopes, dreams, and aspi-
rations matter most in living their lives fully as
whole persons.
Critical to understanding the phenome-
non of technological competency as caring in
nursing are the conceptual descriptions of
technology, caring, and nursing. Assumptions
about human beings as persons, nursing as
caring, and technological competency are
presented as foundational to the process of
knowing persons as whole in the moment—a
process of nursing grounded in the perspec-
tive of technological competency as caring in
nursing.
The process of knowing persons as whole is
explicated as technological knowing—efficiency
in using clinical nursing practices. The model
of practice is illustrated through the under-
standing of technology and caring as coexisting
in nursing.
The process of knowing persons is contin-
uous. In this process of nursing, with calls and
responses, the nurse and nursed come to know
each other more fully as persons in the mo-
ment. Grounding the process is the apprecia-
tion of persons as whole and complete in the
moment, of human beings as unpredictable, of
technological competency as an expression of
caring in nursing, and of nursing as critical to
health care.
3312_Ch26_449-460 26/12/14 3:23 PM Page 459
460 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
References
Barnard, A., & Locsin, R. (2007). Technology and
nursing: Concepts, practice, and issues. London:
Palgrave-Macmillan.
Boykin, A., & Schoenhofer, S. (2001). Nursing as caring:
A model for transforming practice. Boston: Jones and
Bartlett; New York: National League for Nursing
Press.
Carper, B. (1978). Fundamental patterns of knowing in
nursing. Advances in Nursing Science, 1(1), 13–24.
Daniels, L. (1998). Vulnerability as a key to authenticity.
Image: Journal of Nursing Scholarship, 30(2), 191–192.
Heidegger, M. (1977). The question concerning technology.
New York: Harper and Row.
Hudson, R. (1988). Whole or parts—a theological
perspective on “person.” The Australian Journal of
Advanced Nursing, 6(1), 12–20.
Hudson, G. (1993). Empathy and technology in the
coronary care unit. Intensive Critical Care Nursing,
9(1), 55–61.
Locsin, R. (1995). Machine technologies and caring in
nursing. Image: Journal of Nursing Scholarship, 27(3),
201–203.
Locsin, R. (1998). Technologic competence as expression
of caring in critical care settings. Holistic Nursing
Practice, 12(4), 50–56.
Locsin, R. (2001). Practicing nursing: Technological
competency as an expression of caring in nursing.
In: Advancing technology, caring, and nursing.
Westport, CT: Auburn House/Greenwood.
Locsin, R. (2005). Technological competency as caring in
nursing: A model for practice. Indianapolis, IN: Sigma
Theta Tau International.
Locsin, R. (2009). Painting a clear picture: The techno-
logical knowing of persons as contemporary process
of nursing. In R. Locsin & M. Purnell (Eds.),
A contemporary process of nursing: The (un)bearable
weight of knowing persons in nursing. New York:
Springer.
Locsin, R., & Campling, A. (2005). Techno sapiens and
posthumans: Nursing, caring and technology. In
R. Locsin (Ed.), Technological competency as caring in
nursing: A model for practice. Indianapolis, IN: Sigma
Theta Tau International.
Locsin, R., & Purnell, M. J. (2007). Rapture and suffering
with technology in nursing. International Journal for
Human Caring, 11(1), 38–43.
Maslow, A. H. (1943). A theory of human motivation.
Psychological Review, 50, 370–396.
Parse, R. R. (1998). The human becoming school of thought.
Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Phenix, P. H. (1964). Realms of meaning. New York:
McGraw-Hill.
Purnell, M., & Locsin, R. (2000). Intentionality:
Unification in nursing. Unpublished manuscript,
Florida Atlantic University College of Nursing,
Boca Raton, Florida.
Reader’s Digest Association. (1987). Reader’s Digest il-
lustrated encyclopedic dictionary (p. 932). Pleasantville,
NY: The Reader’s Digest Association.
Sandelowski, M. (1993). Toward a theory of technology
dependency. Nursing Outlook, 41(1), 36–42.
Serling, R. (1960). Season 2, Episode 6 of The Twilight
Zone, “Eye of the Beholder.” CBS.
Smith, J. (1983). The idea of health: Implications for the
nursing professional. New York: Teachers College
Press.
Swanson, M. (1991). Dimensions of caring interventions.
Nursing Research, 40, 161–166.
Watson, J. (1985). Nursing: Human science and human
care. East Norwalk, CT: Appleton-Century-Crofts.
3312_Ch26_449-460 26/12/14 3:23 PM Page 460
Chapter 27Marilyn Anne Ray’s Theory of
Bureaucratic Caring
MARILYN ANNE RAY
AND MARIAN C. TURKEL
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Theory
Application of the Theory
Practice Exemplar
Summary
References
461
Introducing the Theorist
Marilyn Anne (Dee) Ray, RN, PhD, CTN,
FAAN, is a Professor Emerita at Florida
Atlantic University (FAU), Christine E. Lynn
College of Nursing, in Boca Raton, Florida. She
holds a bachelor of science and a master of sci-
ence in nursing from the University of Colorado
in Denver, Colorado; a master of arts in cultural
anthropology from McMaster University in
Hamilton, Canada; and a doctorate from the
University of Utah in transcultural nursing.
She retired as a colonel in 1999 after 30 years of
service with the U.S. Air Force Reserve Nurse
Corps. As a transcultural nursing scholar and
certified advanced transcultural nurse (CTN-A),
she has published widely on the subjects of car-
ing in organizational cultures, caring theory and
inquiry development, transcultural caring, and
transcultural and communitarian ethics. She
has held faculty positions at the University
of California San Francisco, the University
of San Francisco, McMaster University, the
University of Colorado, and FAU and Scholar
positions at FAU and Virginia Commonwealth
University. Ray has enjoyed many diverse teach-
ing and learning assignments around the world.
She is featured in Who’s Who in America,
Who’s Who in the World (2010–2015), is a
Fellow of the American Society for Applied
Anthropology, and is a Fellow of the American
Academy of Nursing. She is a review board
member of the Journal of Transcultural Nursing
and Qualitative Health Research and a reviewer
for the International Journal of Human Caring.
Ray has conducted phenomenological, ethno-
graphic, and grounded theory research on dif-
ferent topics related to nursing administration
and practice, and in the U.S. military. Ray’s
Marilyn Anne Ray Marian C. Turkel
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 461
initial research revolved around the culture
of organizations that included technological,
political, legal, and economic structures and is-
sues related to caring in complex organizations
resulting in the development of the theory of
bureaucratic caring in 1981. Her research over
the past 2 decades, conducted with Dr. Marian
Turkel, has used both qualitative and quantita-
tive research methods to study and design
patient and professional questionnaires of the
complex nurse–patient relational caring process
and its impact on economic and patient
outcomes in hospitals. Ray and Turkel (2012)
advanced the theory of relational caring com-
plexity. Ray (2010) also developed the model of
transcultural caring dynamics in nursing and
health care in her book by the same name. In
her role as professor emerita, Ray is actively en-
gaged in mentoring new faculty members and
guiding doctoral students, both in the United
States and abroad, whose studies focus on the
research of administrative and clinical caring
practice, including the clinical nurse leader role,
patient safety, the ethical practice of nursing,
and transcultural nursing.
Overview of the Theory
This chapter presents a discussion of contem-
porary nursing culture and shares theoretical
views in nursing and those related to the au-
thor’s theoretical vision and development of
professional nursing. The theory of bureau-
cratic caring is discussed first as a grounded
theory (both substantive and formal) and then
as a holographic theory. Within this chapter,
Dr. Marian Turkel, Director of Professional
Nursing Practice and Magnet Holy Cross
Hospital, Fort Lauderdale, Florida, integrates
the relevance of the theory in administrative
and clinical practice.
The Generation of Bureaucratic
Caring Theory
The theory of bureaucratic caring was generated
in a hospital organization from a qualitative
research study using three research approaches
more than 30 years ago (Ray, 1981). The theory
has been published in the book by Ray (2010),
A Study of Caring Within an Institutional
Culture: The Discovery of the Theory of Bureau-
cratic Caring. Data analysis involved the descrip-
tion of the hospital as a culture (ethnography),
the meaning of caring in the life world (phenom-
enology), and the discovery of conceptual
categories and subcategories and theories of the
structure and process of caring in the complex
organization (grounded theory method). Substan-
tive theory called differential caring was gener-
ated from the diversity and dominant meanings
of caring expressed by participants on different
units in the hospital. Formal theory was discov-
ered and developed from insight and interpre-
tation of the initial qualitative data and data
related to complex systems, such as tenets of
bureaucracy. The culture of the hospital was a
dynamic unity illustrating caring as not only
humanistic (physical), ethical, spiritual/
religious, social-cultural, and educational but
also as part of the structural—political, eco-
nomic, legal, and technological—characteristics
of a complex organization. These codetermining
processes related to the thesis of caring and the
antithesis of bureaucracy were synthesized into
the theory of bureaucratic caring (Fig. 27-1).
The initial research revealed that economic and
political patterns of meaning were more domi-
nant followed by the technical and legal dimen-
sions and finally the social and ethical/spiritual
dimensions within the complex system of the
hospital. Subsequently, the model was pictured
with coequal dimensions. After additional
research and continued reflection on what was
occurring in science and in nursing science, Ray
revisited the theory and discovered that the the-
ory itself incorporated many concepts from the
new sciences of complexity (the science of change,
interconnectedness, wholeness [holography]
and emergence). The theory, as shown in Figure
27-2, was subsequently revealed as holographic
(Coffman, 2006, 2010, 2014; Ray, 2006; Ray &
Turkel, 2010; Turkel, 2007; holography is
explained further later in this chapter). The
current holographic model depicts the primacy
of caring as spiritual–ethical and the other
dimensions as equal, indicating the holistic
nature of the interface between the spiritual and
ethical and the bureaucratic dimensions. In the
462 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 462
holographic model, caring (the center of the
model) is highlighted as spiritual and ethical in
relation to the physical (humanistic), the social–
cultural and educational, and the more struc-
tural dimensions of a complex organization: the
political, economic, legal, and technological.
Thus, spiritual–ethical caring honors the good
of caring, commits to the moral position of
caring and virtue, the ethics of compassion,
integrity, courage, and humility, (University of
San Francisco Curriculum, 2013). Moreover,
spiritual-ethical caring engages the theological,
the virtues of faith, hope, and love; the process
is creative and shows the integration of the
networks of relationships in complex organiza-
tional or bureaucratic systems. This holographic
model shows overall that spiritual–ethical caring
is multidimensional, complex, holistic, and
dynamic. Interactions and symbolic systems of
meaning by nurses and others are formed and
reproduced from the constructions or dominant
values held and evolving within the human-
environment organization. In some respect,
the holographic model depicts that “we are the
organization.” The theory of bureaucratic caring
as a holographic model will facilitate and
increase our understanding of the practice of
nursing in complex contemporary health-care
environments.
Holographic Emergence in the Theory
of Bureaucratic Caring
The holographic paradigm in complexity sci-
ence(s) and emergent in the theory of bureau-
cratic caring recognizes the following:
• that the ontology or “what is” of the universe
or creation is the interconnectedness of all
things;
• that reality is composed of neither wholes nor
parts but of wholes/parts or holons, the
whole is in the part and the part in the whole;
• that the epistemology or knowledge that
exists is in the relationship rather than
in the objective world or the subjective
experience of it;
• that uncertainty is inherent in the relation-
ship because everything is in process and
emerging; and
• that information and choice hold the key to
grasping the holistic and complex nature of
the meaning of holography or the whole
(Cannato, 2006; Davidson, Ray, & Turkel,
2011; Harmon, 1998; Peat, 2003; Wilber,
1982).
Holography thus means that the implicate
order (the whole) and explicate order (the
part) are interconnected, that everything is a
holon, including humans, in the sense that
everything is a whole in one context and a part
CHAPTER 27 • Marilyn Anne Ray’s Theory of Bureaucratic Caring 463
Ethical
Spiritual/
religious
Educational/
social Economic
Political
Legal
Technological/
physiological
CARING
SPIRITUAL-
ETHICAL
CARING
Physical Social-
cultural
Educational
Economic
Political
Legal
Technological
Fig 27 • 2 Holographic theory of bureaucratic caring.
Fig 27 • 1 Grounded theory of bureaucratic caring
(differential caring and bureaucratic caring theories).
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 463
in another—each part being in the whole and
the whole being in the part (Cannato, 2006;
Peat, 2003). For example, “The molecule
depends on the atom, the cell depends on the
molecule, and all depend on the stability of
the interconnected system in order to thrive”
(Cannato, 2006, p. 98). All cycles of activities
are linked coherently together; the more en-
ergy is stored within systems, the more sub-
cycles there are. It is the relational and
reciprocal aspect of relationship itself, infor-
mation and choice, that makes it holistic
rather than mechanistic, which subsequently
opens all systems to diversity and emergence
(integrated sets of possibilities; Davidson &
Ray, 1991; Ray, 1998a, 1998b; Thoma, 2003).
Holistic science is a human–environmental
mutual process and a dynamic unity and a
transformative or emergent process. Holistic
science (and art) thus captures the idea that
all systems, including health-care systems,
are living systems, are both wholes and parts,
and depend on networks of relationships, in-
formation, choice, and communication flow.
The human–environmental mutual process
is not a new idea to nursing. It was a central
theoretical perspective of Martha Rogers
(1970; Smith, 2011) and central to beliefs in
anthropology and transcultural nursing ad-
vanced by Leininger (1991), and it was a foun-
dation for other theories, such as those of
Parse, Newman, and Reed (Alligood, 2014).
This notion is seen again at a different time
and through a different lens. In the author’s
work, the focus is on the caring patterns of the
nurse–patient relationship within the bureau-
cratic context of a hospital. The Bureaucratic
Caring Theory, already considered paradoxical
(bureaucratic caring), identified the linkage
between caring as humanistic, social–cultural,
educational, and spiritual–ethical and the
organizational hospital system as political, eco-
nomic, legal, and technological. Caring is a
relational pattern; it is the flow of nurses’ and
others’ own experiences in the structural con-
text of the organization. This simultaneous
process illuminates the idea that the whole
and parts are one and the same; all cycles of
activities are linked coherently together, but
each may be doing different things at different
paces; all the parts are participating in the
whole, and the whole is participating as a part
in different contexts of meaning (Davidson et
al., 2011; Rogers, 1970; Smith 2011; 2013a;
2013b). Information (caring and system data)
unfolds and emerges at the same time in the
same space without contradicting itself. The
theory of bureaucratic caring as a holographic
theory furthers the vision of nursing and or-
ganizations as complex, dynamic, relational,
integral, informational, and emergent—open
to sets of possibilities because of the syn-
chronicity of interacting parts and the whole.
Everything interconnects; we are all creative
manifestations of the oneness of the environ-
ment (context), moving in relationship, and
continually transforming (emerging—growing
and developing; Thoma, 2003). Because of the
knowledge of complexity science/s as hologra-
phy (holistic science and art), we all need to
become more aware of the meaning of partic-
ipatory life and ways of relating to the reality
of complex organizations or bureaucracies.
Rather than continuing mechanistic ap-
proaches of prediction and control that may
have worked to some extent to gain precise
knowledge in the past, we must now give
way to new understanding. Nurses and other
professionals must be open to change, to the
integral nature of the dynamic unity of the
human and environment, and to phenomena
that are coherent and emergent wholes (body,
mind, spirit, and context) that make up our
world of caring, health, healing, and well-
being (Davidson et al., 2011; Rogers, 1970;
Smith, 2011).
Contemporary Nursing Practice as
Complex, Dynamic, Relational,
Caring, and Emergent: Foundations
of the Theory of Bureaucratic Caring
The practice of nursing is dynamic, always
changing, and emerging with new possibilities
as people relate to each other. Contemporary
nursing practice, however, continues to occur
in organizations that are generally bureau-
cratic or systematic in nature. Although there
has been much discussion about the “end of
464 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 464
bureaucracy” to cope better with 21st-century
innovation and work life within complex sys-
tems (Leavitt, 2005; Perrow, 1986; Sorbello,
2008a, 2008b), bureaucracy remains a valuable
tool to identify and understand the fundamen-
tally different structural principles that under-
gird coordinated and relational organizational
systems. Bureaucracies are organizational sys-
tems that can be viewed as cultures. Organi-
zational cultures have a rich heritage and have
been studied as both formal and informal
systems since the 1930s in the United States
(Bolman & Dial, 2008; Brenton & Driskill,
2005; Morgan, 1997; Porter-O’Grady &
Malloch, 2003, 2007; Ray, 1981, 1984, 1989a,
2006, 2010a, 2010b, 2010c; Ray in Coffman,
2006, 2010, 2014 ; Ray & Turkel, 2010, 2012;
Swinderman, 2005, 2011; Turkel & Ray,
2000, 2001; 2004; Wheatley, 2006). Informal
organizational culture integrates codes of ethics
and conduct encompassing commitment,
identity, character, coherence, and a sense of
community in social-cultural interaction and
the social environment. The informal organi-
zational culture is considered essential to the
successful functioning or the administering of
the formal organization: political power
and authority, technology and technological
computation, economic exchange and legal
methods and judgments. Thus, the formal
organization comprises political, economic,
legal, and technical systems within organiza-
tional cultures (the typical phenomena of
bureaucracies). Bureaucracies themselves cre-
ate their own cultural orientations, patterns,
goals, rituals, languages, and norms within the
structural elements of the political, economic,
legal, and technological dimensions (Britain
& Cohen, 1980; Ray, 2013).
What distinguishes “organizations as cul-
tures” from other paradigms, such as organi-
zations as machines, brains, or other images
(Morgan, 1997), is its foundation in anthro-
pology or the study of how people act in
communities or formalized structures and the
significance or meaning of work life (Brenton &
Driskill, 2005; Cuilla, 2000; Louis, 1985).
Organizational cultures, therefore, are viewed
as social constructions, symbolically formed
and reproduced through interaction (Sawyer,
2005).
The beliefs about work emerge in organiza-
tions through relationships and organizational
mission and policy statements. A nation’s
prevailing tenets and expectations about the
nature of work, leisure, and employment are
pivotal to the work life of people; hence, there
is interplay between the macrocosm of a
national/global culture and the microcosm of
specific organizations (Eisenberg & Goodall,
1993; Schein, 2004; Wheatley, 2006). In
recent years, organizational cultures have
emerged as globalizing corporate systems with
multiple descriptions of meaning. However,
economics, or the “bottom line,” is the potent
equalizer of most macro- and microcultures
(Eisler, 2007; Henderson, 2006). There is an
ever-greater concentration of economic and
political power in a handful of corporations,
which separate their interests (usually profit-
driven) from the interests of humans, which
are life-centered (Eisler, 2007; Henderson,
2006; Ray, 2010c; Ray, Turkel, & Cohn,
2011; Turkel & Ray, 2000, 2001).
Health care and its activities are tightly
interwoven into the social and economic fabric
of nations. Values that drive a nation are
experienced in the health-care arena. For
example, for the most part, “cost and profit”
have transformed health care in the United
States. As health-care organizations continu-
ally are affected by issues of cost and profit and
prompt healthcare systems to undergo im-
mense change, such as the health-care reforms
of the Patient Protection and Affordable Care
Act in the United States (January 5, 2010).
Over recent years, confidence in major health-
care institutions and their leaders have fallen
so low as to put the legitimacy of executives
who manage health-care systems at risk. Trust
is a major issue (Ray, Turkel, & Marino, 2002;
Ray & Turkel, 2012, 2014). Old rules of loy-
alty and commitment to employees, invest-
ment in the worker, fairness in pay, and the
need to provide good benefits are in jeopardy.
Health-care systems have fallen victim to the
corporatization of human enterprise. Conse-
quently, the conflict between health care as a
CHAPTER 27 • Marilyn Anne Ray’s Theory of Bureaucratic Caring 465
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 465
business and caring as a human need has
resulted in a crisis in professional nursing, pa-
tient safety issues, and the quality of care pro-
vided by health-care organizations (Anderson
& McDaniel, 2008; Davidson et al., 2011;
Eisler, 2007; Institute of Medicine, 2010).
The actual work of nurses, although under-
valued in terms of both cost and worth (Ray,
1987a; Ray & Turkel, 2012; Turkel & Ray,
2000, 2001), is currently being evaluated in
terms of issues of patient safety and clinical
nurse leadership (Page, 2004). Since the Insti-
tute of Medicine (2010) report, a resurgence
of interest is taking place in the meaningfulness
of work and patient safety in many hospitals.
Nursing education and the clinical nurse leader
role are highlighted as bridges to quality
(Sherman, Edwards, Giovengo, & Hilton,
2009). As such, the language of trust and
morally worthy work (Cuilla, 2000; Ray et al.,
2002; Ray & Turkel, 2012, 2014) is beginning
to replace the language of downsizing and
restructuring at the same time that mergers
and acquisitions still hold sway in contempo-
rary corporate environments. Cuilla (2000)
stated that “[t]he most meaningful jobs are
those in which people directly help others [pro-
vide care] or create products that make life
better for people” (p. 225). Although the tra-
ditional work of nurses is defined as directly
helping others through knowledgeable caring
(Watson, 2008), contemporary nurses’ work
and its meaning is also defined by and within
the organizational context—the structural di-
mensions of political, economic, legal, and
technological systems (Ray, 1989a, 2006, 2013;
Ray & Turkel, 2012; Turkel, 2007). Urging
nurses, physicians, and administrators to find
cohesion among these dimensions in organiza-
tions and the dynamics of unity of human be-
ings (body, mind, and spirit integration) call for
the reinvention of work (Fox, 1994). In health
care, there is a movement underway for advanc-
ing interprofessional education and practice
(Keller, Eggenberger, Belkowitz, Sarsekeyeva,
& Zito, 2013). Incorporating business princi-
ples and creativity of caring, the “work of the
soul” or inner work of spiritual–ethical rela-
tional caring leads to more emancipatory praxis
and relational self-organization (Ray, 1994a,
1998a; Ray et al., 2002; Ray & Turkel, 2014)
means leading in a new way (Porter-O’Grady
& Malloch, 2007; Ray, 2010a, 2010b, 2010c;
Ray & Turkel, 2012, 2014; Turkel, 2014;
Turkel & Ray, 2004, 2012). Spiritual–ethical
caring is a witness to the power and depth of
transformation in nursing and complex organ-
izations: reseeing the good of nursing, search-
ing for meaning in life and society, creating
caring organizations, and finding new meaning
in the complexities of work itself.
Organizational Cultures as
Transformational Bureaucracies
The transformation of nursing toward a greater
understanding of relational self-organization
and creativity (work of the soul—spiritual–
ethical caring) is not necessarily a new pursuit
for the profession; what it reveals is a focus on
and movement from invisibility to visibility.
Identifying professional nurse caring work as
having spiritual–ethical value and being an
expression of one’s soul or one’s creative self at
work and at the same time, understanding
and identifying nurses’ value as an economic
resource replaces the notion of nursing as
performing only machinelike tasks.
Bureaucracy, still considered by some as a
machinelike metaphor, as we have identified,
continues to play a significant role in the
meanings and symbols of health-care organi-
zations (Coffman, 2006; 2014; Perrow, 1986;
Ray, 2010a, 2010b, 2013; Ray & Turkel, 2012,
2014). The social theorist Max Weber (1999)
actually predicted that the future belonged to
the bureaucracy and not to the working class.
Weber, who saw bureaucracy as an efficient
and superior form of organizational arrange-
ment, predicted that the bureaucratization of
enterprise would dominate the world (Bell,
1974; Weber, 1999). This, of course, is wit-
nessed by the current globalization of com-
merce and technical information systems. In
terms of global commerce, recent acquisitions
and mergers of industrial firms and even
health-care systems, especially in the United
States, are larger and hold more power than
466 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 466
some world governments. Yet, to maintain the
integrity of large scale, for-profit corporations,
often governments have to step in with in-
creased regulation and infuse systems with
monetary guarantees. Information technology
systems often are in the hands of a few who
direct and guide knowledge. The concept of
bureaucratization is thus a worldwide phe-
nomenon (Ray, 1989, 2010a, 2010b, 2010c).
Although they are considered less effective
than other forms of organization, Britain and
Cohen (1980) stated that
“[l]ike it or not, humankind is being driven to a
bureaucratized world whose forms and functions,
whose authority and power must be understood if
they are ever to be even partially controlled. . . . The
study of bureaucracies is, in effect, the study of the
most salient and powerful organizations of the con-
temporary world. (p. 27).
As bureaucracies grow, so too will the im-
portance of family, kin, community, organiza-
tional life, culture, ethnicity, and what is now
termed panethnicity, and an understanding of
diversity within wholeness, ethics, healing, and
caring (Britain & Cohen, 1989; Ray, 2010a,
2010b, 2010c).
The characteristics of bureaucracies are as
follows:
• A division of labor based on roles, depart-
ments, leadership, and authority
• A hierarchy of offices [bureaus or units]
with diverse social-cultural orientations
• A set of general policies and rules that govern
performance
• A separation of the personal from the official
• A selection of personnel on the basis of
technical/professional qualifications
• A movement toward interprofessionalism
and collaboration
• Equal treatment of all employees or stan-
dards of fairness, ethical applications, and
reimbursement
• Employment viewed as a career by participants
• Protection of dismissal by tenure or evaluation
(from Eisenberg & Goodall, 1993; Leavitt,
2005; Perrow, 1986).
Bureaucracy thus incorporates within the
human and ethical dimension the political
(power and authority), legal (policies and rules),
economic (cost systems), and technical (profes-
sional, informational, and computational)
dimensions. At the same time, bureaucracies
integrate the whole social and cultural system.
Bureaucracy, although condemned by some
as associated with red tape and inflexibility,
continues to provide the most reasonable way
in which to view systems and facilitate the
preservation and understanding and transfor-
mation of organizations. In the past 2 decades,
there has been a call for decentralization and
the “flattening” of organizational structures—
to become less bureaucratic and more partici-
pative or heterarchical (Porter-O’Grady &
Malloch, 2005, 2007). Many firms have begun
to hold to new principles that honor creativity
and imagination, and a vision of spiritual and
ethical caring and healing (Morgan, 1997;
Turkel & Ray, 2004; Ray & Turkel, 2014).
Even nursing has advanced in a more collabo-
rative or decentralized manner by its focus on
patient-centered nursing and a movement from
more centralized control and administration to
more decentralized self-governance (Allen,
2013; Nyberg, 1998; Wheatley, 2006). But cre-
ative views still need to be marked with under-
standing of structural systems of bureaucracy as
globalization, information, and economics
sweep the world.
Leadership models, which are fundamen-
tally hierarchical because of the need for order,
continue to head the short-lived participative
movement toward decentralization. Even the
new clinical nurse leader role sets a nursing
leader apart from his or her peers in terms of
knowledge and role responsibility. Power is
still in the hands of a few. As local and global
economic markets rule, there is a call for cre-
ating a “caring economics” and a need to be
creative and ethical in terms of the worldwide
technological and economic transformation
taking place (Eisler, 2007; Ray, 1987a, 2010c;
Ray & Turkel, 2012, 2014; Turkel, 2001,
2013a, 2013b). We have to look at the social,
psychological, and spiritual factors that shape
our societies and organizations. As a result, the
CHAPTER 27 • Marilyn Anne Ray’s Theory of Bureaucratic Caring 467
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 467
concept of bureaucracy does not seem as bad
as was once thought because it addresses
human, and in many respects, humane action.
It can be considered as a much less radical
paradigm than the business paradigm that
focuses only on competition and response to
market forces, subsequently eradicating stan-
dards of fairness or social justice for humans
in the workplace (Ray & Turkel, 2014).
Caring as the Unifying Focus of Nursing
Caring in nursing speaks of relationships,
compassion, human dignity, ethics, justice,
and competent and knowledgeable caring
practice (Ray, 1981, 1989b, 2010a, 2010b,
2013; Roach, 2002; Smith, Turkel, & Wolf,
2013; Turkel, 1997; Watson, 2005, 2008).
Caring science and art is holistic, humane,
and dynamic; thus, it facilitates growth and
development of human persons and helps to
make things work in health-care agencies. As
such, caring science and art is considered by
many nurse scholars to be the essence of nurs-
ing (Boykin & Schoenhofer, 2001; 2013;
Boykin, Schoenhofer, & Valentine, 2013;
Leininger, 1981a, 1981b, 1991, 1997; Ray,
1989a, 1989b, 1994a, 1994b; Ray & Turkel,
2012; Smith et al., 2013; Watson, 1985,
1988, 1997, 2008). Although not uniformly
accepted, Newman, Sime, and Corcoran-
Perry (1991) and Newman (1992) character-
ized the social mandate of the discipline of
nursing as caring in the human health expe-
rience. Newman, Smith, Pharris, and Jones
(2008) further emphasized her initial idea
that relationship is the focus and health is the
rhythmic fluctuations of the life process, as
well as caring, consciousness, mutual process,
patterning, presence, and meaning. Caring
and health thus are influential concepts. The
expression “caring” in the human health ex-
perience emphasizes the social mandate to
which nursing has responded throughout its
history and encompasses the scope of the dis-
cipline (Roach, 2002; Watson, 2008). Caring,
with multiple meanings, however, is mani-
fested in different and complex ways in the
nursing discipline and profession (Morse et al.,
2013; Smith et al., 2013).
Evolution and Development of the
Theory of Bureaucratic Caring
Facing the challenge of the economic and
patient safety crises in health care and nurs-
ing, the disillusionment of registered nurses
about the disregard for their caring services,
and the concern of the nursing profession and
the public about the effects of the shortage of
nurses (Institute of Medicine, 2010), working
for the good of the profession and preserva-
tion of the nurse–patient caring relationship
is imperative. Running away from the chaos
of hospitals or misunderstanding the meaning
of work life cannot become the norm. Wher-
ever nurses go, they will be “haunted” by
bureaucracies, some functional, many prob-
lematic. What, then, is the deeper reality of
nursing practice? The following is a presen-
tation of theoretical views that relate to the
theory of bureaucratic caring, culminating in
a vision for understanding the deeper signif-
icance of nursing life as holistic, spiritual and
ethical, relational, cultural, contextual, and
the dynamics of complexity.
Complexity and Nursing Theory
To understand this significance, and holo-
graphic nature of the theory of bureaucratic
caring, an overview of complexity science(s)
is necessary. “Complexity theory is a scientific
theory of dynamical systems collectively
referred to as the sciences of complexity”
(Ray, 1998a, p. 91). They illuminate the na-
ture and creativity of science itself. Revolu-
tionary approaches to new scientific theory
development have transpired, such as quan-
tum theory and actually “beyond the quan-
tum,” the science of wholeness, holographic
and chaos theories, fractals or the idea of
self-similarity, networks of relationships and
complex information systems, and the con-
cepts of choice and self-organization/relational
self-organization (Bar-Yam, 2004; Battista,
1982; Briggs & Peat, 1989, 1999; Davidson
& Ray, 1991; Davidson et al., 2011; Lindberg,
Nash, & Lindberg, 2008; Peat, 2003; Ray,
1998a; Ray & Turkel, 2012; Wheatley, 2006;
Wilber, 1982).
468 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 468
Complexity theory is replacing other theo-
ries, such as Newtonian physics and even
Einstein’s beliefs and those of other scientists
as well, that the physical world is governed by
laws and order. New scientific views illustrate
that the fundamental force in the universe is
dynamic (always changing), chaotic, nonlinear,
nonpredictable, relational, moving toward
self-organization, and open to possibilities. As
such, phenomena that are antithetical actually
coexist—determinism with uncertainty and
reversibility with irreversibility (Nicolis &
Prigogine, 1989; Peat, 2003). “Opposing
things can happen at the same time, in the
same space, without contradicting each other”
(Thoma, 2003, p. 17). Thus, both linear and
nonlinear and simple (e.g., gravity) and com-
plex (economic and cultural) systems exist to-
gether (for example, the paradoxical nature of
the theory of bureaucratic caring). One of the
tools or metaphors in the studies of complexity
is chaos theory. Chaos deals with life at the
edge, or the notion that the concept of order
exists within disorder at the system communi-
cation or choice point phases where old pat-
terns disintegrate or new patterns emerge
(Davidson & Ray, 1991; Davidson et al., 2011;
Lindberg et al., 2008; Newman et al., 2008;
Ray, 1994a, 1998b, 2011; Ray et al., 1995).
This new science, which signifies interrelation-
ship of mind and matter, interconnectedness
and choice, carries with it a moral responsibil-
ity and the quest toward wisdom, which
includes awareness, information systems, net-
works of relationships, patterns of energy, cre-
ativity, information about the environment
and emergence (Davidson & Ray, 1991;
Davidson et al., 2011; Fox, 1994). The concep-
tion of the interconnectedness and relational
reality of all things, the interdependence of all
human–environmental phenomena, and the
discovery of order in a chaotic world demon-
strate the pioneering story of 20th-century
science and how the insightful idea of belong-
ingness and relationality (a powerful nursing
concept) is shaping the science of the 21st
century (Peat, 2003).
Within nursing, certain nursing theorists
have embraced the notion of nursing as
complexity in which consciousness, human–
environmental mutual relationship, caring, and
choice-making are central concepts (Davidson
& Ray, 1991; Davidson et al., 2011; Lindberg
et al., 2008; Newman, 1986, 1992; Newman
et al., 2008; Ray, 1994a, 1998a; Rogers, 1970).
Given the nature of nursing as unitary, holistic,
relational, and caring, and of health as expanding
consciousness (Newman et al., 2008; Pharris,
2006), there is a coherent link between the im-
portance of theory as wakefulness (awareness)
and professional practice. Ray and Turkel hold
the position that nurses do need to be exposed
to ideas and need diverse nursing theories to
stimulate thinking. The only way that nursing
can critique itself is by understanding the intel-
lectual views of scholars in the complex world
of nursing science, research, education, and
practice. Theories, as the integration of knowl-
edge, research, and experience, highlight the way
in which scholars and practitioners of nursing
interpret their world and the context where
nursing is lived. Theories in this sense are also
philosophies or ideologies that serve a practical
purpose. Thus, the idea that theories are the pure
viewing of truth (wakefulness or awareness; van
Manen, 1982) and that they can be judged in
light of their practical consequences (Bohman,
2005) underscores the importance of nursing
theory as both a scholarly enterprise and a wise
practice that identifies and participates in the
complexities of inquiry about relationships,
knowledgeable caring, health, healing, complex
organizations, and the universe.
Description of Bureaucratic Caring
Theory
In the original qualitative study of caring in the
organizational context conducted by Ray (1981,
1984, 1989a, 2010b), the research revealed
that nurses and other professionals struggled
with the paradox of serving the bureaucracy
and serving humans, especially patients,
through caring. Caring, however, had multiple
meanings and was expressed differently in terms
of the way a particular unit was organized. The
system phenomena of political, economic, legal,
and technological became integrated into the
meaning system of caring just as the humanistic,
CHAPTER 27 • Marilyn Anne Ray’s Theory of Bureaucratic Caring 469
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 469
social, educational, ethical, and spiritual. The
discovery of bureaucratic caring resulted in both
substantive theory (grounded in the context of
meaning) and formal theory (integrated from
the substantive theory and general understand-
ing of dimensions of complex bureaucracies;
Ray, 1981, 1984, 1989a, 2010b).
The bureaucracy represented a living system.
Caring was expressed not only in the more
interpersonal relational patterns of humanness
and compassion but also in the official structures
of the bureaucracy, especially the political and
economic structures, and both expressions were
infused into the meaning system of profession-
als. Even patients saw the “system” as affecting
how they understood caring in their own health-
care experiences (Ray, 1981, 1989a, 2010b; Ray
& Turkel, 2001–2004, 2012, 2014; Ray et al.,
2011). The substantive theory (grounded)
emerged as differential caring theory and showed
that caring in the complex organization of the
hospital was complex and differentiated itself
in terms of meaning by its specific context—
dominant caring dimensions related to areas of
practice or units wherein professionals worked
and patients resided. Differential caring theory
showed that professionals and patients on differ-
ent units espoused different and dominant
caring meanings based on their professional roles
and personal and organizational goals and
values. For example, participants in the oncology
unit espoused caring as intimate and spiritual;
in contrast, participants in the intensive care unit
espoused caring as more technological; and in
administration, participants espoused caring as
maintaining economic viability. The formal
theory of bureaucratic caring symbolized a
dynamic structure of caring, which was synthe-
sized from a dialectic using the tenets of the
philosophy of Hegel (thesis, antithesis, and
synthesis); the dialectic between the thesis of
caring as humanistic, social, educational, ethical,
and religious/spiritual (dimensions of human-
ism, morality, and spirituality), and the antithesis
of caring as economic, political, legal, and tech-
nological (dimensions of bureaucracy; Coffman,
2014; Ray, 1981, 1989a, 2006; 2010a, 2010b;
Ray et al., 2011; Ray & Turkel, 2010, 2012,
2014; Turkel, 2007).
The Theory of Bureaucratic Caring as
Holographic Theory
How can the theory of bureaucratic caring be
viewed as a holographic theory? As previously
discussed, the theory arose initially from inter-
pretations and choices that were made about the
meaning and structure of caring in organiza-
tional life. The process parallels ideas from com-
plexity sciences and specifically holography:
consciousness or awareness; intentionality of the
mutual human–environmental caring relation-
ships; quality of the caring transactions; and the
effective ability to analyze, negotiate, make
choices, and reconcile paradoxes between caring
and the system demands. The humanistic nurse–
patient care needs and professional responsibil-
ities in terms of the structural considerations of
the system (political, economic, legal, and tech-
nological dimensions) were always emerging
from sets of caring possibilities. Awareness of
belongingness/interconnectedness, the mutual
human–environmental relationship, the impli-
cate (the whole) and explicate (the part) order
(the whole is reflected in the part, and part reveals
the whole), respect for the good of all things, and
communication, choice and emergence—all of
these are central to holistic science. Similarly, as
revealed through this research, these concepts
were central to the interpretation of caring as a
whole in the complex organization. The dialectic
of caring (the thesis, the implicate order, or the
whole of caring as humanistic and spiritual-
ethical) in relation to the various organizational
structures (the antithesis of the system, explicit
order, or part, the organization as political-
economic-technical-legal) is reconciled and
transformed by a synthesis of the polar opposites
into the theory of bureaucratic caring. The syn-
thesis of the theory of bureaucratic caring shows
that everything is interconnected, even human-
istic spiritual–ethical caring and the organiza-
tional system. The whole is in the part, and the
part is in the whole; therefore, nursing in the
system is a holon, and the theory is holographic.
Transforming the Organization
The theory of bureaucratic caring reveals that
knowledge of holistic caring interconnectedness
470 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 470
is possible to motivate nurses to continue to
embrace the human dimension within the cur-
rent political, economic, legal, and technologic
bureaucratic environment of health care. Can
higher ground thus be reclaimed for the 21st
century? Higher ground requires that we make
excellent and ethical choices at the “edge of
chaos” where possibilities exist in relationships
and systems/organizations to either transform
or disintegrate (Peat, 2003). Understanding of
spiritual–ethical caring in the holographic the-
ory of bureaucratic caring helps us to connect at
our deepest level. Nurses and others in complex
systems can reclaim higher ground by doing the
“work of the soul” (understanding and engaging
creatively, spiritually, and lovingly, and taking
ethical responsibility for self and other and the
organizational system). Our choice(s) depends
on a commitment and ethical social action
to cocreate caring-healing relationships and
communities (Ray & Turkel, 2014; Turkel &
Ray, 2004). The model (see Fig. 27-2) presents
a vision of nursing as spiritual–ethical caring,
but it is also based on the reality of practice.
Through continuous research and observation,
the model emphasizes a direction toward the
unity of experience. Spirituality involves creativ-
ity and choice and refers to genuineness, vitality,
and depth. It is revealed in attachment, love,
and community and comprehended within each
of us as intimacy and an unfolding of virtue and
the sacred art of divine love (Cannato, 2006;
Harmon, 1998; Ray, 1997a, 1997b; 2010a;
Secretan, 1997). Ethics deals with our moral
accountability to self and caring for self, and
responsibility to one another and to the organ-
izations within which we work. Secretan states:
“Most of us have an innate understanding of
soul, even though each of us might define it in
a very different and personal way”(p. 27).
As such, Fox (1994) calls for the theology
of work—a redefinition of work as spiritual
and ethical. Because of the crisis in our work
life mainly due to economic and political con-
straints, and in general our relationship to
work, we are challenged to reinvent it. For
nursing, this is important because work puts
us in touch with others, not only in terms of
personal gain, but also at the level of service to
humanity or the community of patients/clients
and other professionals. Work must be spiri-
tual and ethical, with recognition of the cre-
ative spirit at work in us. Nurses must be the
“custodians of the human spirit” (Secretan,
1997, p. 27).
The ethical imperatives of caring that join
with the spiritual relate to questions or issues
about our moral obligations to others. The ethics
of caring involve never treating people simply as
a means to an end or as ends in themselves but
rather as beings that have the capacity to make
choices about the meaning of life, health, healing,
and caring. Ethical content—principles of doing
good, doing no harm, allowing choice, being
fair, and promise-keeping—functions as the
compass directing our decisions to sustain hu-
manity in the context of the bureaucracy—the
political, economic, legal, and technological
issues and situations within organizations.
Roach (2002) pointed out that ethical caring is
operative at the level of discernment of princi-
ples, in the commitment needed to carry them
out, and in the decisions or choices to uphold
human dignity through love and compassion.
Furthermore, Roach (2002) remarked that
health is a community responsibility, an idea that
is rooted in ancient Hebrew ethics. The expres-
sion of human caring as an ethical act is inspired
by spiritual traditions that emphasize charity.
For nursing, spiritual–ethical caring does not
question whether or not to care in complex
systems but intimates how sincere deliberations
and ultimately the facilitation of ethical choices
for the good of others can or should be accom-
plished. By integrating knowledgeable caring
creatively, by staying intentional and conscious
of dynamic movements within the circle of
life, love, and relationships, and by leading in a
new way in complex systems/bureaucracies,
nurses are engaging in new and exciting work
(Davidson et al., 2011; Eisler, 2007; O’Grady &
Malloch, 2007; Ray, 1997b; Ray et al., 2002;
Ray & Turkel, 2012, 2014; Turkel & Ray,
2004). The theory of bureaucratic caring as a
holistic science and art bears witness to the
power and depth of transformation: reseeing the
good of nursing as spiritual and ethical, believing
in human potential, continually searching for
CHAPTER 27 • Marilyn Anne Ray’s Theory of Bureaucratic Caring 471
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 471
meaning in life, creating caring organizations,
cocreating new possibilities, and finding new
meaning in the complexities of work life itself.
The scientist Sheldrake remarked:
The recognition that we need to change the way we
live [work] is gaining ground. It is like waking up from
a dream. It brings with it a spirit of repentance, seeing
in a new way, a change of heart. This conversion is
intensified by the sense that the end of the age of op-
pression is at hand. (1991, p. 207)
Application of the Theory
The theory of bureaucratic caring illuminated
in this chapter is a response to the end of the
age of oppression. The theory is holistic with a
practical purpose, thus responding to the call
for a translational science, translating caring
theory into practice or facilitating theory-
guided practice (Ray & Turkel, 2012; Smith
et al., 2013). Ray (1989a, p. 31) warned that
the “transformation of American and other
health-care systems to corporate enterprises
emphasizing competitive management and
economic gain seriously challenges nursing’s
humanistic philosophies and theories, and
nursing’s administrative and clinical policies.”
As nurses know, for more than 30 years, there
has been an intense focus on operating costs
and the bottom line in the American health-
care environment, and caring is often not
valued within the organizational culture.
However, caring scientists, nurse researchers,
nurse leaders, and nurses in practice have sought
out principles of caring science (Watson, 2008),
transcultural caring dynamics (Ray, 2010), and
relational caring complexity (Ray & Turkel,
2012). The application of the theory of bureau-
cratic caring as a framework to guide practice
and ethical decision making (Ray, 2010a,
2010b; Ray & Turkel, 2012; Ray et al., 2012;
Smith et al., 2013; Turkel, 2007, 2013b)
will transform a complex organization to a
community of caring where caring for self,
thoughtfulness for others through compassion,
integrity, courage, and humility can thrive
(Smith et al., 2013; University of San Fran-
cisco, 2013). Nurses must be encouraged to
continue the struggle not only to be caring but
to respond with confidence to the economic
issues and engage the political, legal, and tech-
nological questions and trials facing them.
With hospital system goals of decreasing
length of stay and increasing staffing ratios,
nurses need to be committed to establishing
trust and initiate a caring relationship during
their first encounter with a patient. As this
relationship is being established, nurses need to
focus on “being, knowing, and doing all at once”
(Turkel, 1997, 2013) within what Watson
(2008; 2013) calls the “caring moment.” From
a patient perspective, “being there” means
completing a task while simultaneously engag-
ing caringly with them. This approach to prac-
tice means not only viewing the patient as
a person in all of his or her complexity but
viewing the patient and the needs of profes-
sional nursing competently within the complex
organizational environment.
As a holographic and translational science,
we can see that the economic, political, techno-
logical, legal, and spiritual–ethical, humanistic
dimensions of bureaucratic caring, and in gen-
eral, the theory of bureaucratic caring can be
used to guide practice. Staff nurses can hold
close their core value that caring is the essence
of nursing and can still retain a focus on meeting
the issues of the bottom line (economics).
Empirical studies have firmly established a link
between caring and positive patient outcomes
(Watson, 2009). And positive patient outcomes
are needed for organizational survival in this
competitive and political era of health care.
Given this, professional nursing practice must
embrace and illuminate the caring philosophy
in relation to complex organizational phenom-
ena. As expressed, explicitly linking caring to
patient and organizational outcomes is integral.
For the first time since the inception of value-
based purchasing, one third of hospital reim-
bursement will be linked to patient satisfaction
data and two-thirds to patient quality/safety
data. This is the time for the economic value of
caring to be actualized with the organization
(Ray & Turkel, 2009).
Moving away from just focusing on patient
care to the economic justification of nursing
and health-care systems has prompted profes-
sionals to desire a fuller understanding of just
472 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 472
how to preserve humanistic caring within the
educational, business, or corporate (economic
and political) culture (Miller, 1989; Nyberg,
1998, 2013; Turkel, 2007, 2013a; Boykin,
Schoenhofer, &Valentine, 2013; see also
Watson Caring Science Institute, www
.wcsi.org). In terms of application, the theory
thus, has been used as a foundation for addi-
tional research and observational studies of the
nurse–patient caring relationship and system
issues, such as in public health administration,
curriculum development, correctional facility
health care, technology and information tech-
nology, economics of caring, the clinical nurse
leader role, the charge nurse role, ethics and
the moral community, legal caring, pediatric
pain, and medication errors in complex organ-
izations, perioperative do not resuscitate
orders, the transtheoretical development of re-
lational caring complexity theory, and nursing
administration—the role of the nurse in shared
governance (Al-Ayed, 2008; Allen, 2013,
Coffman, 2006; Cross, 2014; Eggenberger,
2011a, 2011b; Gibson, 2008; Gomez, 2008;
Manworren, 2008; McCray-Stewart, 2008;
O’Brien, 2008; Ray, 1987b, 1993, 1997a,
1998a, 1998b; Ray et al., 2002; Sorbello,
2008a; Stedman, 2013; Swinderman, 2011;
Ray & Turkel, 2010, 2012; Turkel, 1997,
2007; Turkel & Ray, 2000, 2001, 2009).
Over the past three decades, Ray and Turkel
have conducted research and used dimensions
of the theory of bureaucratic caring to examine
the paradox between the concept of human
caring and political, economic, legal and tech-
nological dimensions in complex organizations,
and more specifically studies of the economics
of caring. Their research showed that staff
nurses value the caring relationship between
nurse and patient. However, nurses are practic-
ing in an environment where the economics
and costs of health care permeate discussions
and clinical decisions. The focus on costs is not
a transient response to shrinking reimburse-
ment; instead, it has become the catalyst for
change within health-care organizations. Be-
tween 2002 and 2004, Relational Caring Ques-
tionnaires were distributed to registered nurses,
patients, and administrators in five hospitals
(Ray & Turkel, 2005, 2009, 2012). Overall
mean scores on the questionnaires were then
compared to economic and patient outcome
data. It is of interest to note that the hospital
with the highest mean score of 3.30 for the
professional questionnaire had the lowest num-
ber (3.36) of full-time employees per adjusted
occupied bed and the lowest number of patient
falls. The hospital with the highest patient
mean score of 4.50 had the lowest cost ($1,265)
per adjusted patient day. These findings vali-
date what registered nurses verbalized in the
qualitative research, “Living the caring values
in everyday practice makes a difference in nurs-
ing practice and patient outcomes” (Ray &
Turkel, 2009). Through their focused research
on economic caring, they advanced the theory
of relational caring complexity (Ray & Turkel,
2012), which is beginning to be used to im-
prove the practice of nursing. It is a challenge
for nurses to combine the science and art of
caring within the complex health-care environ-
ment. However, these research efforts illustrate
how this can be done to help reshape organi-
zations and the health-care system in the
United States and other countries, such as
Canada, Australia, Japan, China, Columbia,
Chile, and some countries in Scandinavia, the
Middle East, and Africa.
Application of Theory of Bureaucratic
Caring to Excellence in Contemporary
Professional Nursing Practice
In addition to the earlier discussion of applica-
tion of the theory to practice, the American
Nurses Credentialing Center (ANCC) Magnet
Recognition Program® recognizes excellence in
professional nursing practice. Organizations
provide written narratives and sources of
evidence related to the development, dissemi-
nation, and enculturation of best practices,
quality care, technical skill, and patient prefer-
ence. This emphasis on professional nursing
practice within the Magnet Recognition Pro-
gram has resulted in organizations integrating
evidence-based practice, nursing research, and
professional models of care delivery informed
by nursing theory into the practice setting.
In the past, organizations provided sources of
evidence and written narratives illustrating the
dissemination, enculturation, and sustainability
CHAPTER 27 • Marilyn Anne Ray’s Theory of Bureaucratic Caring 473
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 473
of the Fourteen Forces of Magnetism across the
organization (ANCC, 2005). A new model was
developed in 2008 (ANCC, 2008) and a revision
to this model was released in 2014. The new
model has five components that contain the
Forces of Magnetism. The five components
include transformational leadership; structural
empowerment; exemplary professional nursing
practice; new knowledge, innovation, and
improvements; and empirical quality results. The
theory of bureaucratic caring can be integrated
into each of these components.
Transformational leadership reflects nurs-
ing leadership that is transformational and
visionary. The chief nurse executive (CNE)
uses the theory of bureaucratic caring as the
theoretical framework when creating the nurs-
ing strategic plan and achieving the goal of
balancing caring and economics in clinical and
administrative decision making. The economic
dimension of the theory of bureaucratic caring
and tenets from relational caring complexity
serve as research-based references for the CNE
in advocating how the limited resources within
the organization will be allocated. Nursing
leaders may not be able to change reimburse-
ment from the government, but they can in-
fluence organizational decision making for the
improvement of the quality of care and caring.
Transformational leaders use ideas from direct
care registered nurses to improve the work
environment, which can include formal inte-
gration of self-care practices (Ray & Turkel,
2012; Turkel & Ray, 2004).
Structural (professional and organiza-
tional) empowerment represents professional
engagement, commitment to professional
development, teaching and role development,
commitment to community involvement,
and recognition of nursing. The CNE can
advocate for involvement in the conferences
sponsored by the International Association
for Human Caring (humancaring.org), where
nurses at all levels have an opportunity to
disseminate caring scholarship and hear ex-
amples of how caring theory has been used
to change practice and inform education and
research. Upon return from conferences,
direct-care registered nurses can make pre-
sentations to boards of trustees on how caring
science and theory make a difference in prac-
tice in terms of organizational, registered
nurse, and patient outcomes. Ongoing edu-
cation including interactive dialogue and
reflective practice related to the theory and
self-care practices can be part of internal
professional development for nurses at all
levels in the organization. As part of commu-
nity involvement, registered nurses are inte-
gral to community caring. Being in the
community requires integration of the social,
political, and cultural dimensions of the the-
ory. Having a formal practice theory supports
the professional image of nursing within the
organization and makes visible the outcomes
and contributions of nursing practice to the
organization (Turkel, 2007).
Exemplary professional practice includes
having a professional practice model and care
delivery system in place in complex organiza-
tions for registered nurses. Sources of evidence
relate to how the theory of bureaucratic caring
could be selected and used to guide practice.
Nursing situations reflecting professional and
interprofessional clinical decision making, and
examining staffing patterns balancing caring
and economics serve as examples of evidence
to support a professional model of care. For
consultation and resources, reference can be
made to external consultation with nursing
scholars as theorists, dissertation supervisors,
or consultants, and how attendance at profes-
sional conferences or other contacts, for exam-
ple, through Webinars or using Skype or
Adobe Connect make a difference in nursing
research, practice, and patient outcomes.
Under autonomy as a principle of the Code
of Ethics With Interpretive Statements (American
Nurses Association, 2001) for nurses, the com-
ponent of spiritual–ethical caring illustrates
how nurses promoting self-organization serve
as advocates for patients and families. The
educational dimension of the theory advances
the care delivery system as the professional
nurse develops innovative, individualized,
evidence-based patient education initiatives.
Organizations truly focused on innovation or
transformational leadership can expand the
theory to be interdisciplinary or interprofes-
sional and serve as the interdisciplinary plan of
474 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 474
care for the patient, the family, and the health-
care system as a whole.
The component of new knowledge, innova-
tion, and improvements includes quality im-
provement. Unit-based patient care projects,
evidence-based best practice, and qualitative and
quantitative findings related to the theory serve
as exemplars included under this component.
The fifth component of the Magnet Recog-
nition Program®, empirical outcomes recognizes
the contribution of nursing in terms of patient,
nursing, and organizational outcomes. Results
from theory-guided research and evidence-based
projects related to the dimensions of the theory
of bureaucratic caring validating the difference
in patient and organizational outcomes serve as
evidence for this component.
Relevance of the Theory of
Bureaucratic Caring to Nursing
Education
The theory is relevant to nursing education be-
cause of its focus on caring in nursing practice
and the conceptualization of the health-care
system (Coffman, 2006, 2010, 2014). When
developing the curriculum for a baccalaureate
program, the faculty at Nevada State College
combined Ray’s theory of bureaucratic caring
with theoretical constructs from Watson
(1985) and Johns (2000) as a conceptual
framework. According to this framework, the
holographic theory of caring recognizes the in-
terconnectedness of all things and that every-
thing is a whole in one context and a part of
the whole in another context. Spiritual–ethical
caring, the focus for communication, infuses
all nursing phenomena including physical,
social–cultural, legal, technological, economic,
political, and educational forces (Nevada State
College, 2003, p. 2).
Turkel (2001) used the theory to guide cur-
riculum development in the master’s of science
program in nursing administration at Florida
Atlantic University. Dimensions from the
theory, including ethical, spiritual, economic,
technological, legal, political, and social, served
as a framework for the exploration of current
health-care issues. The economic dimension
of the theory was a central component in
several courses. Students analyzed the current
economic and reimbursement structure of
health care from the perspective of a caring lens.
Another example illuminates the creativity
of faculty. For example, a professor from the
University of San Francisco (2013) is imple-
menting ways to use virtue ethics (a component
of the School of Nursing curriculum) and com-
plexity science and highlight the theoretical
model for teaching and learning spiritual–ethical
caring and complex systems.
The application of the theory of bureaucratic
caring and the practice exemplar illustrate that
the foundation for professional nursing is the
blending of the humanistic and empirical/
organizational aspects of care—understanding
caring science and art in complex organizations.
In today’s environment, the nurse needs to inte-
grate caring, knowledge, and skills “all at once”
(being, knowing, and doing). Given political and
economic constraints, the art of caring cannot
occur in isolation from meeting the physical
needs of patients and incorporating the dimen-
sions of the economic, political, technological,
spiritual-ethical caring dimensions. When caring
is defined solely as science or as art—empirical
or esthetic nursing, respectively—neither is ade-
quate to reflect the reality of current practice.
Nurses must be able to understand and articulate
the politics and the economics of as well as caring
in nursing practice and health care. Classes that
examine the environment of practice generally,
and the politics and the economics of health care
in relation to caring, must be integrated into
nursing education and staff development curric-
ula. Nurses need to search continually for differ-
ent approaches to professional practice that will
incorporate caring in an increasingly political,
technical, and cost-driven environment. Doing
more with less no longer works; nurses must
“move outside of the box” to create innovative
practice models informed by nursing theory.
Nurses need to, in essence, move nursing from
being viewed as a “bed rate” in hospitals to nurs-
ing as a human caring science and practice AND
valued as a central economic resource within an
organization and the health-care system.
Administrative nursing research needs to
continue to focus on the relationship among
nursing, caring, patient outcomes, and complex
organizational economic outcomes. Ongoing
CHAPTER 27 • Marilyn Anne Ray’s Theory of Bureaucratic Caring 475
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 475
476 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
research is required to firmly establish the nurse–
patient relationship as an economic resource in
the new paradigm of evidence-based practice of
health-care delivery (Ray & Turkel, 2008, 2012,
2014; Turkel, 2013a). Findings from additional
qualitative and quantitative research studies will
continue to support the theory of bureaucratic
caring as a middle-range theory, a holographic
practice theory, and a general/universal theory.
Nurses need ongoing education related to
the politics, and economics and costs associ-
ated with health care as well as knowledge of
complex technological organizational environ-
ments. Lack of knowledge in these areas allows
others outside of nursing to continue to make
the political and economic decisions concern-
ing the practice of nursing. Having an in-
depth knowledge of the politics and economics
of health care allows nurses to use innovation
and creativity to both challenge and transform
the system. A new theory-guided model cre-
ated for nursing practice that supports human
caring in relation to the organization’s eco-
nomic, technical, and political values is an
exemplar of such innovation The multiple di-
mensions of the theory of bureaucratic caring
serve as a philosophical/theoretical framework
to inform both contemporary and future
research and theory-guided nursing practice.
Having this in-depth knowledge allows nurses
to continually question and transform complex
health-care organizations.
Ray and Turkel (2012) continue to advance
their collaborative ideas related to theory devel-
opment, caring science, and the paradox
between caring and economics within complex
systems. A metatheory (Ritzer, 1991) emerged
from the integration of the following: the theory
of bureaucratic caring (Ray, 1981, 2006), Strug-
gling to Find a Balance: The Paradox Between
Caring and Economics (Turkel 1997, 2001), and
relational complexity (Ray & Turkel, 2012;
Turkel & Ray, 2000). The metatheory is rela-
tional caring complexity, and it reveals the com-
plexity of today’s nursing practice situation while
providing a foundation for emerging profes-
sional practice models focused on caring and
healing, and innovative transdisciplinary re-
search looking at caring and economics. Con-
tinually giving voice to the value of caring in
nursing within and a part of complex organiza-
tions allows for spiritual–ethical caring to occur.1
1For additional practice exemplars please go to bonus
chapter content available at FA Davis
http://davisplus.fadavis.com
Practice Exemplar
The following exemplar from the practice setting
was previously published by Turkel (2007).* The
situation reflects the lived experiences of how the
theory of bureaucratic caring serves as a framework
for nursing practice and guides decision making.
Megan Smith, RN, MSN, was recently hired
as the chief nurse executive (CNE) for a 500-
bed inner-city hospital. The payer mix for this
patient population was once private insurance,
but now it is approximately 75% Medicare
and Medicaid. When Megan met with the
nursing staff, they stated, “We are not valued or
treated with respect. The administrators only see
us as numbers. We are implementing a new
computerized documentation system, getting
new monitors, being told that patient safety is
important and getting ready for a survey from
the Joint Commission. With all the rules and
regulations, it is stressful to find time to actually
care for our patients. Plus we need more help.”
Megan was committed to being an advocate
for nursing while realizing the professional
accountability of considering the economic,
political, and technological perspectives of her
decision making. Megan promised the nurses
that she would review the budget and follow-
up with their concerns. She explained to the
nurses that providing safe, high-quality patient
care in a caring and compassionate manner was
the top priority for the organization.
Later that week, Megan met with the chief
executive officer (CEO) to share the concerns
of the nursing staff. Her first priority was to
increase the number of registered nurses and to
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 476
CHAPTER 27 • Marilyn Anne Ray’s Theory of Bureaucratic Caring 477
Practice Exemplar cont.
hire two additional clinical nurse specialists. The
CEO was reluctant to spend the additional
financial resources. Megan explained that in-
creasing the number of registered nurses would
decrease the number of falls and pressure ulcers
and increase compliance related to patient
safety. Additional registered nurses would in-
crease satisfaction for both nurses and patients,
as the nurses would have more time to focus on
developing caring relationships with patients
and their families. In addition, the registered
nurses would have time to focus on providing
patient teaching and discharge planning.
Megan presented the CEO with quantitative
data to demonstrate the costs associated with
falls, pressure ulcers, and patients returning
to the emergency department (ED) within 48
hours postdischarge because of inadequate
education or discharge planning. The request
for additional registered nurses and clinical
nurse specialists was approved. Six months
later, the number of falls, pressure ulcers, med-
ication errors, and return visits to the ED had
decreased. Scores on the patient satisfaction
survey related to nurses informing patients,
showing concern, and checking patient identi-
fication bands increased.
The additional clinical nurse specialists
served as mentors to increase the technical
skills of the inexperienced graduate nurses and
to demonstrate how the use of technology in
terms of cardiac monitoring would enhance
the caring interactions between the registered
nurse and patient. Customized programing of
the new clinical documentation system af-
forded nurses the opportunity to document in-
terventions related to specific dimensions of
the theory of bureaucratic caring.
*Permission to use this practice exemplar was
granted by Zane Robinson Wolf, RN, PhD,
FAAN, editor of International Journal for
Human Caring, January 15, 2014.
■ Summary
The values of nursing are deepening, and as a
discipline and profession, nursing is expanding
its consciousness (Newman et al., 2008; Ray
& Turkel, 2014). Nursing is being shaped by
the historical revolution occurring in science,
social sciences, and theology as well as the
revolution of its own commitment to caring
science, health care for all, and understanding
of holism and complex systems (Baer, 2013;
Davidson & Ray, 1991; Davidson et al., 2011;
Lindberg et al., 2008; Newman et al., 2008;
Ray, 1998a, 2006, 2010a, 2010b; Reed, 1997;
Watson, 2005). Freeman (in Appell & Triloki,
1988) pointed out that human values are a
function of the capacity to make choices and
called for a paradigm giving recognition to
awareness and choice. As noted in this chaper,
a revision toward this end is taking place in
nursing based upon the science/s of complexity
and a new holographic scientific worldview, as
well as specific theories of nursing, especially
this holographic theory of bureaucratic caring.
Nursing has the capacity to make creative and
moral choices for a preferred future. Con-
structs of consciousness and choice are central
and demonstrate that phenomena of the uni-
verse, including society and what happens in
nursing, organizations and societies arise from
the choices that are or are not made (Davidson
et al., 2011; Harmon, 1998; Newman et al.,
2008). The theory of bureaucratic caring has
reinforced, caring as the primordial construct
and consciousness of nursing within complex
bureaucratic systems. In nursing, the critical
task is to comprehend the meaning of the
networks and complexity of relationships,
between what is given in culture (the norms)
and what is chosen (the moral and spiritual).
In nursing, the unitary-transformative para-
digm and the state of the science (Newman,
et al., 2008), and various theories of Rogers,
Newman, Leininger, Watson, Parse, and Ray’s
holographic theory of bureaucratic caring
are challenging nurses to become more aware
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 477
478 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
and understand their future in terms of the
complexity of human–environment relation-
ship. The unitary-transformative paradigm of
nursing and its holographic tenets are consistent
with new science/s of complexity. However, the
other reality of nursing is that there continues
to be threats by the business/economic model
over its long-term human interests for facilitat-
ing health, healing and well-being of patients,
nurses and other professionals, and organiza-
tions (Davidson & Ray, 1991; Davidson et al.,
2011; Lindberg et al., 2008; Ray, 1994a, 1998;
Ray & Turkel, 2012; Reed, 1997; Smith, 2004;
Vicenzi, White, & Begun, 1997). However, the
creative, intuitive, ethical, and spiritual mind is
unlimited. Through “authentic conscience”
(Harmon, 1998), we must find hope in our
creative powers.
This presentation of the theory of bureau-
cratic caring is a creative enterprise. The theory
reflects spiritual and ethical caring, bureaucratic
system principles, and incorporation of tenets of
the new sciences of complexity highlighting
holography. Holographic theory illuminates
holistic science and art, the interconnectedness
of all things, human–environment integral rela-
tionships, scientific chaos theory, holographic
patterning (the whole is in the part, and the
part in the whole), informational networks, re-
lational self-organization, transformation,
change, choice, and emergence (Bar-Yam, 2004;
Davidson & Ray, 1991; Davidson et al., 2011;
Lindberg et al., 2008; Ray, 1991, 1994, 1998a,
2010a, 2010b; Turkel & Ray, 2000, 2001;
Thoma, 2003). In the theory of bureaucratic car-
ing, everything is infused with spiritual–ethical
caring (the center of the model) by its integrative
and relational connection to the structures of
complex organizations. Spiritual–ethical caring
is both a part and a whole, and every part secures
its purpose and meaning from each of the other
parts that can also be considered wholes. In
other words, the theoretical model shows how
spiritual–ethical caring is involved with qualita-
tively different yet similar processes or systems,
be they political, economic, technological, or
legal. The systems, when integrated and pre-
sented as open and interactive, are a whole and
must operate as such by conscious choice, espe-
cially by the ethical choice making of nursing,
which always has, or should have, the interest of
humanity at heart.
Envisioning the theory of bureaucratic caring
as holographic from its initial substantive and
formal grounded theories shows that through
research, creativity, and imagination, nursing can
build the profession it wants. Nurses are calling
for opportunities for expression of their own
spiritual and ethical existence, a reinvention of
work. Nurses are also calling for understanding
of the nurse–patient caring relationship in com-
plex organizations. The new scientific, spiritual–
ethical, and experiential approach to nursing
theory as holographic will have positive effects—
and that reality has been illustrated in this pres-
entation. The union of complexity science,
ethics, and spirituality will engender a new sense
of hope for transformation in the work world.
This transformation toward relational caring
organizations and communities of caring can
occur in the economic and politically driven
atmosphere of today. The deep values that
underlie caring and choice to do good for the
many will be felt both inside and outside organ-
izations. We must awaken our consciences and
act on this awareness and no longer surrender to
injustices and oppressiveness of systems that
focus primarily on the good of a few (Ray &
Turkel, 2014). “Healing a sick society [work
world] is a part of the ministry of making whole”
(Fox, 1994, p. 305). The holographic theory of
bureaucratic caring—idealistic yet practical, vi-
sionary yet real—can give direction and impetus
to lead the way.
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 478
CHAPTER 27 • Marilyn Anne Ray’s Theory of Bureaucratic Caring 479
References
Al-Ayed, B. (2008). Applying bureaucratic caring theory in
medication errors phenomena. Unpublished manuscript,
University of Jordan, Amman, Jordan.
Allen, S. (2013, September). An ethnonursing study of the
cultural meanings and practices of clinical nurse council
leaders in shared governance. Unpublished doctoral
dissertation, University of Cincinnati, Cincinnati,
Ohio.
Alligood , M. (Ed.). (2014). Nursing theorists and their
work (8th ed.). St. Louis: Mosby-Elsevier.
American Nurses Association. (2001). Code of Ethics for
Nurses With Interpretive Statements. (2001). Silver
Spring, MD: Author.
American Nurses Credentialing Center. (2005). Magnet
recognition program: Application manual. Silver Spring,
MD: American Nurses Credentialing Center.
American Nurses Credentialing Center. (2008). Magnet
recognition program: Application manual. Silver Spring,
MD: American Nurses Credentialing Center.
Anderson, R., & McDaniel, R. (2008). Taking complexity
science seriously: New research, new methods. In C.
Lindberg, S. Nash, & C. Lindberg (Eds.), On the
edge: Nursing in the age of complexity. Bordentown, NJ:
Plexus Press.
Appell, G., & Triloki, N. (Eds.). (1988). Choice and
morality in anthropological perspective. Albany: State
University of New York Press.
Baer, E. (2012). Key ideas in nursing’s first century.
American Journal of Nursing, 112(5), 48–55.
Bar-Yam, Y. (2004). Making things work: Solving complex
problems in a complex world. Boston: Knowledge Press.
Battista, J. (1982). The holographic model, holistic para-
digm, information theory, and consciousness. In K.
Wilber (Ed.), The holographic paradigm and other
paradoxes (pp. 143–150). Boulder, CO: Shambhala.
Bell, D. (1974). The coming of post-industrial society.
New York: Basic Books.
Bohman, J. (2005). Toward a critical theory of globaliza-
tion: Democratic practice and multiperspectival
inquiry. In M. Pensky (Ed.), Globalizing critical
theory. Lanham: Rowman & Littlefield.
Bolman, L., & Dial, T. (2008). Reframing organizations:
Artistry, choice, and leadership (4th ed.). San Francisco:
Jossey-Bass.
Boykin, A., & Schoenhofer, S. (2001). Nursing as caring:
A model for transforming practice (2nd ed.). Sudbury,
MA: Jones and Bartlett.
Boykin, A., & Schoenhofer, S. (2013). Caring in nursing:
Analysis of extant theory. In M. Smith, M. Turkel, &
Z. Wolf (Eds.), Caring in nursing classics: An essential
resource. New York: Springer
Boykin, A., Schoenhofer, S., & Valentine, K. (2013).
Practical strategies for transforming healthcare systems:
Creating a culture of caring. New York: Springer
Publishing.
Brenton, A., & Driskill, G. (Eds.). (2005). Organizational
culture in action. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Briggs, J., & Peat, F. (1989). Turbulent mirror. New York:
Harper & Row.
Briggs, J., & Peat, F. (1999). Seven lessons of chaos.
New York: HarperCollins.
Britain, G., & Cohen, R. (1980). Hierarchy and society:
Anthropological perspectives on bureaucracy. Philadelphia:
ISHI.
Cannato, J. (2006). Radical amazement. Notre Dame,
IN: Sorin Books.
Chinn, P., & Kramer, M. (2011). (8th ed.). Integrated
theory and knowledge development in nursing.
St. Louis: Mosby-Elsevier.
Coffman, S. (2006). Ray’s theory of bureaucratic caring.
In A. M. Tomey & M. Alligood (Eds.), Nursing
theorists and their work (6th ed.). St. Louis: Mosby.
Coffman, S. (2010). Ray’s theory of bureaucratic caring. In
A. M. Tomey & M. Alligood (Eds.), Nursing theorists
and their work (7th ed.). St. Louis: Mosby-Elsevier.
Coffman, S. (2014). Ray’s theory of bureaucratic caring.
In M. Alligood (Ed.), Nursing theorists and their work
(8th ed.). St. Louis: Mosby-Elsevier.
Corbin, J. & Strauss, A. (2007). Basics of qualitative
research: Techniques and procedures for developing
grounded theory (3rd ed.). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Cross, L. (2014). CNRA and do not resusitate (dnr)
orders in the operating room and the application of
the theory of bureaucratic caring. Master’s of science
research project.
Cuilla, J. (2000). The working life: The promise and betrayal
of modern work. New York: Times Books/Random
House.
Davidson, A., & Ray, M. (1991). Studying the human-
environment phenomenon using the science of com-
plexity. Advances in Nursing Science, 14(2), 73–87.
Davidson, A., Ray, M., & Turkel, M. (Eds.). (2011).
Nursing, caring, and complexity science: For human-
environment well-being. New York: Springer (AJN
2011 Book of the Year Award).
Dolan, J. (1985). Nursing in society: A historical perspective.
Philadelphia: W. B. Saunders.
Eggenberger, T. (2011a). Holding the frontline: The
experience of being a charge nurse in an actue care
setting. Unpublished doctoral dissertation, Florida
Atlantic University, The Christine E. Lynn
College of Nursing, Boca Raton, FL.
Eggenberger, T. (2011b). Response to Chapter 4,
Ray, M., M., Turkel & J. Cohn, Relational
caring complexity: The study of caring and
complexity in health care hospital organizations.
In A. Davidson, M. Ray, & M. Turkel (Eds.),
Nursing, caring, and complexity science: For
human-environment well-being. (pp. 118–124).
New York: Springer.
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 479
Eisenberg, E., & Goodall, H. (1993). Organizational
communication. New York: St. Martin’s Press.
Eisler, R. (2007). The real wealth of nations. San Francisco:
Berrett-Koehler.
Fox, M. (1994). The reinvention of work. San Francisco:
Harper.
Gibson, S. (2008). Legal caring: Preventing re-
traumatization of abused children through the
caring nursing interview using Roach’s Six Cs.
International Journal for Human Caring,
Harmon, W. (1998). Global mind change (2nd ed.). San
Francisco: Berrett-Koehler.
Henderson, H. (2006). Ethical markets: Growing the green
economy. White River Junction, VT: Chelsea Green.
Institute of Medicine. (2010, October 5). The future of
nursing: Leading change, advancing health. Retrieved
February 18, 2013, from www.iom.edu/Reports/2010
/the-future-of-nursing-leading-change-advancing-
health.aspx
Johns, C. (2000). Becoming a reflective practitioner.
Oxford: Blackwell Science.
Keller, K., Eggenberger, T., Belkowitz, J, Sarsekeyeva,
M., & Zito, A. (2013). Implementing successful
interprofessional communication opportunities in
academia: A qualitative analysis. International Journal
of Medical Education, 4, 253–259.
Leavitt, H. (2005). Top down: Why hierarchies are here to
stay and how to manage them more effectively. Boston,
MA: Harvard Business School Press.
Leininger, M. (1981a). The phenomenon of caring: Im-
portance, research questions and theoretical consid-
erations. In M. Leininger (Ed.), Caring: An essential
human need (pp. 3–15). Thorofare, NJ: Slack.
Leininger, M. (Ed.). (1981b). Caring: An essential human
need. Thorofare, NJ: Slack.
Leininger, M. (1991). Culture care diversity and
universality: A theory of nursing. New York:
National League for Nursing Press.
Leininger, M. (1997). Transcultural nursing research to
transform nursing education and practice: 40 years.
Image: Journal of Nursing Scholarship, 29, 341–354.
Lindberg, C., Nash, S., & Lindberg, C. (Eds.). (2008). On
the edge: Nursing in the age of complexity. Bordentown,
NJ: PlexusPress.
Louis, M. (1985). An investigator’s guide to workplace
culture. In P. Frost, L. Moore, M. Louis, C. Lundberg,
& J. Martin (Eds.), Organizational culture. Beverly
Hills: Sage.
Manworren, R. (2008). A pilot study to test the feasibility
of using human factors engineering methods to measure
factors that compete or influence nurses’ abilities to
relieve acute pediatric pain (Application of the
bureaucratic caring theory). The University of Texas
at Arlington, School of Nursing, Arlington, Texas.
McCray-Stewart, D. (2008). Application of bureaucratic
caring theory. Administrator, State of Georgia
Correctional Facility (Prison System).
Miller, K. (1989). The human care perspective on
nursing administration. Journal of Nursing
Administration, 25(11), 29–32.
Morgan, G. (1997). Images of organization (2nd ed.).
Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Morse, J., Solberg, S., Neander, W., Bottorff, J., &
Johnson, J. (2013). Concepts of caring and caring as
a concept. In M. Smith, M. Turkel, & Z. Wolf
(Eds.), Caring in nursing classics: An essential resource.
New York: Springer.
Nevada State College. (2003, August 19). Nursing
curriculum organizing framework. Henderson, NV:
Author.
Newman, M. (1986). Health as expanding consciousness.
St. Louis: Mosby.
Newman, M. (1992). Prevailing paradigms in nursing.
Nursing Outlook, 40, 10–14.
Newman, M., Sime, A., & Corcoran-Perry, S. (1991).
The focus of the discipline of nursing. Advances in
Nursing Science, 14(1), 1–6.
Newman, M., Smith, M., Pharris, M., & Jones, D.
(2008). The focus of the discipline revisited. Advances
in Nursing Science, 31(1), E16–27.
Nicolis, G., & Prigogine, I. (1989). Explaining complexity.
New York: W. H. Freeman.
Nyberg, J. (1998). A caring approach in nursing adminis-
tration. Niwot, CO: University Press of Colorado.
O’Brien, K. (2008). Application of bureaucratic caring the-
ory in public health nursing. Director of Public Health
Nursing, State of Colorado, Denver, CO.
Page, A. (Ed.). (2004). Keeping patients safe: Transforming
the work environment of nurses. Institute of Medicine
Report. Washington, DC: The National Academic
Press.
Peat, F. (2003). From certainty to uncertainty: The story of
science and ideas in the twentieth century. Washington,
DC: Joseph Henry Press.
Pensky, M. (Ed.). (2005). Globalizing critical theory.
Lanham, MD: Rowman & Littlefield.
Perrow, C. (1986). Complex organizations: A critical essay
(3rd ed.). New York: McGraw-Hill.
Pharris, M. (2006). Margaret A. Newman’s theory of
health as expanding consciousness and its applications.
In M. Parker (Ed.), Nursing theories & nursing practice
(2nd ed., pp. 217–234). Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Porter-O’Grady, T., & Malloch, K. (2005). Introduction
to evidence-based practice in nursing and health care.
Sudbury, MA: Jones and Bartlett.
Porter-O’Grady, T., & Malloch, K. (2007). Quantum
leadership (2nd ed.). Sudbury, MA: Jones and Bartlett.
Ray, M. (1981). A study of caring within the institutional
culture. Unpublished doctoral dissertation, University
of Utah, Salt Lake City.
Ray, M. (1984). The development of a nursing classifica-
tion system of caring. In M. Leininger (Ed.), Care,
the essence of nursing and health (pp. 95–112). Thorofare,
NJ: Slack.
Ray, M. (1987a). Health care economics and human
caring: Why the moral conflict must be resolved.
Family and Community Health, 10(1), 35–43.
Ray, M. (1987b). Technological caring: A new model in
critical care. Dimensions of Critical Care Nursing, 2(3),
166–173.
480 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 480
Ray, M. (1989a). The theory of bureaucratic caring for
nursing practice in the organizational culture.
Nursing Administration Quarterly, 13(2), 31–42.
Ray, M. (1989b). Transcultural caring: Political and
economic caring visions. Journal of Transcultural
Nursing, 1(1), 17–21.
Ray, M. (1993). A study of care processes using Total
Quality Management as a framework in a USAF
regional hospital emergency service and related
services. Military Medicine, 158(6), 396–403.
Ray, M. (1994a). Complex caring dynamics: A unifying
model of nursing inquiry. Theoretic and Applied Chaos
in Nursing, 1(1), 23–32.
Ray, M. (1994b). Communal moral experience as the
starting point for research in health care ethics.
Nursing Outlook, 41, 104–109.
Ray, M. (1997a). The ethical theory of existential
authenticity. Canadian Journal of Nursing Research,
22(1), 111–126.
Ray, M. (1997b). Illuminating the meaning of caring:
Unfolding the sacred art of divine love. In M. Roach
(Ed.), Caring from the heart: The convergence of caring
and spirituality (pp. 163–178). New York: Paulist
Press.
Ray, M. (1998a). Complexity and nursing science.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 11, 91–93.
Ray, M. (1998b). The interface of caring and technology:
A new reflexive ethics in intermediate care. Holistic
Nursing Practice, 12(4), 71–79.
Ray, M. (2006). Marilyn Anne Ray’s theory of bureau-
cratic caring. In M. Parker (Ed.), Nursing theories,
nursing practice (2nd ed.). Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Ray, M. (2010a). Transcultural caring dynamics in nursing
and health care. Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Ray, M. (2010b). A study of caring within an institutional
culture: The discovery of the theory of bureaucratic caring.
Saarbrücken, Germany: Lambert Academic.
Ray, M. (2010c). Creating caring organizations and
cultures through communitarian ethics. Journal of
the World Universities Forum, 3(5), 41–52.
Ray, M. (2013). The theory of bureaucratic caring. In M.
Smith, M. Turkel, & Z. Wolf (Eds.). (2013). Caring
in nursing classics: An essential resource (pp. 309–320).
New York: Springer. (Resource book online).
Ray, M., DiDominic, V., Dittman, P., Hurst, P.,
Seaver, J., Sorbello, B., & Ross, M. (1995). The
edge of chaos: Caring and the bottom line. Nursing
Management, 26(9), 48–50.
Ray, M., & Turkel, M. (2000–2004). Economic and pa-
tient outcomes of the nurse-patient relationship. Grant
funded by the Department of Defense, Tri-Service
Nursing Research Program, Bethesda, MD.
Ray, M., & Turkel, M. (2009). Relational caring question-
naires. In J. Watson (Ed.), Assessing and measuring
caring in nursing and health science (2nd ed.). New York:
Springer.
Ray, M., & Turkel, M. (2010). Marilyn Anne Ray’s the-
ory of bureaucratic caring. In M. Parker & M. Smith
(Eds.) Nursing theories & nursing practice (3rd ed.,
pp. 472–494). Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Ray, M., & Turkel, M. (2012). A transtheoretical evolu-
tion of caring science within complex systerms. In-
ternational Journal for Human Caring, 16(2), 28–49.
Ray, M., & Turkel, M. (2014). The theory of emancipa-
tory nursing praxis: The theory of relational caring
complexity. Advances in Nursing Science, 37, 132–146.
Ray, M., Turkel, M., & Cohn, J. (2011). Relational car-
ing complexity: The study of caring and complexity
in health care hospital organizations. In A. Davidson,
M. Ray, & M. Turkel (Eds.), Nursing, caring, and
complexity science: For human-environment well-being.
New York: Springer.
Ray, M., Turkel, M., & Marino, F. (2002). The transfor-
mative process for nursing in workforce redevelop-
ment. Nursing Administration Quarterly, 26(2), 1–14.
Reed, P. (1997). Nursing: The ontology of the discipline.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 10, 76–79.
Ritzer, G. (1992). Metatheorizing. Newbury Park, CA:
Sage.
Roach, M. S. (2002). The human act of caring (rev. ed.).
Ottawa, Canada: Canadian Hospital Association Press.
Rogers, M. (1970). An introduction to the theoretical basis
of nursing. Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Sawyer, R. (2005). Social emergence: Societies as complex
systems. New York: Cambridge University Press.
Schein, E. (2004). Organizational culture and leadership
(3rd ed.). San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Secretan, L. (1997). Reclaiming higher ground. New York:
McGraw-Hill.
Shaffer, F. (1985). Costing out nursing: Pricing our product.
New York: National League for Nursing Press.
Sherman, R., Edwards, B., Grovengo, K., & Hilton, N.
(2009). The role of the clinical nurse leader in pro-
moting a health work environment at the unit level.
Critical Care Nursing Quarterly, 32(4), 264–271.
Sheldrake, R. (1991). The rebirth of nature. New York:
Bantam.
Smith, M. (2004). Review of research related to Watson’s
theory of caring. Nursing Science Quarterly, 17(1),
13–25.
Smith, M. (2011). Philosophical and theoretical per-
spectives related to complexity science in nursing.
In A. Davidson, M. Ray, & M. Turkel (Eds.),
Nursing, caring, and complexity science: For human-
environment well-being. New York: Springer.
Smith, M., Turkel, M., & Wolf, M. (Eds.). (2013).
Caring in nursing classics: An essential resource.
New York: Springer. (Resource book online)
Smith, M. (2013a). Caring and the science of unitary
human beings. In M. Smith, M. Turkel, & Z. Wolf
(Eds.), Caring in nursing classics: An essential resource
(pp. 43–57). New York: Springer. (Resource book
online)
Smith, M. (2013b). Theoretical perspectives on caring.
In M. Smith, M. Turkel, & Z. Wolf (Eds.), Caring
in nursing classics: An essential resource (pp. 117–126).
New York: Springer. (Resource book online)
Smith, M., Turkel, M., & Wolf, Z. (2013). Caring in
nursing classics: An essential resource. New York:
Springer.
CHAPTER 27 • Marilyn Anne Ray’s Theory of Bureaucratic Caring 481
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 481
Sorbello, B. (2008a). Clinical nurse leader (SM) stories: A
phenomenological study about the meaning of leadership
at the bedside. Doctoral dissertation proposal, Florida
Atlantic University, the Christine E. Lynn College
of Nursing, Boca Raton, Florida.
Sorbello, B. (2008b). Finance: It’s not a dirty word.
American Nurse Today, 3(8), 32–35.
Stanley, J. (2006). In command of care: Clinical nurse
leadership explored. Journal of Research in Nursing,
11(91), 20–39.
Stedman, M. (2013). The experience of caring and non-
caring patient encounters of graduate registered nurses:
A phenomenological study. (Doctoral Dissertation)
ProQuest. UMI: 3572912.
Swanson, K. (1991). Empirical development of a
middle-range theory of caring. Nursing Research,
40, 161–166.
Swinderman, T. (2011). Technological change in
health care electronic documentation as facilitated
through the science of complexity. In A. Davidson,
M. Ray, & M. Turkel (Eds.), Nursing, caring, and
complexity science: For human–environment well-
being (pp. 309–319). New York: Springer.
Swinderman, T. (2005). The magnetic appeal of nurse
informaticians: Caring attractor for emergency.
PhD dissertation, Florida Atlantic University.
Thoma, H. (2003). Holistic science: All at the same
time. Resurgence, 1(216), 15–17.
Turkel, M. (1997). Struggling to find a balance: A
grounded theory study of the nurse-patient relationship
in the changing health care environment. Unpublished
doctoral dissertation, University of Miami, Florida
(Microfilm #9805958).
Turkel, M. (2001). Struggling to find a balance: The
paradox between caring and economics. Nursing Ad-
ministration Quarterly, 26(1), 67–82.
Turkel, M., & Ray, M. (2000). Relational complexity:
A theory of the nurse-patient relationship within an
economic context. Nursing Science Quarterly, 13(4),
307–313.
Turkel, M. (2007). Dr. Marilyn Ray’s theory of bureau-
cratic caring. International Journal for Human Caring,
11(4), 57–74.
Turkel, M. (2013a). Caring leadership and administration.
In M. Smith, M. Turkel, & Z. Wolf (Eds.), Caring in
nursing classics: An essential resource (pp. 465–472).
New York: Springer. (Resource book online)
Turkel, M. (2013b). Caring based practice models. In
M. Smith, M. Turkel, & Z. Wolf (Eds.), Caring in
nursing classics: An essential resource (pp. 395–430).
New York: Springer. (Resource book online)
Turkel, M. (2014). Response to Chapter 10: Valuing,
prizing and growing: Outcomes reframed. In A.
Boykin, S. Schoenhofer, & K. Valentine (Eds.),
Practical strategies for transforming healthcare systems:
Creating a culture of caring. New York: Springer.
Turkel, M., & Ray, M. (2000). Relational complexity: A
theory of the nurse-patient relationship within an
economic context. Nursing Science Quarterly, 13(4),
307–313.
Turkel, M., & Ray, M. (2001). Relational complexity:
From grounded theory to instrument development
and theoretical testing. Nursing Science Quarterly,
14(4), 281–287.
Turkel, M., & Ray, M. (2004). Creating a caring prac-
tice environment through self-renewal. Nursing
Administration Quarterly, 28(4), 249–254.
Turkel, M., & Ray, M. (2009). Caring for “Not so
picture perfect patients”: Ethical caring in the moral
community of nursing. In R. Locsin & M. Purnell
(Eds.), A contemporary nursing process: The (un)
bearable weight of knowing persons (pp. 225–249).
New York: Springer.
Van Manen, M. (1982). Edifying theory: Serving the
good. Theory Into Practice, 31, 45–49.
Vicenzi, A., White, K., & Begun, J. (1997). Chaos in
nursing: Make it work for you. American Journal of
Nursing, 97, 26–32.
Watson, J. (1985). Human science, human care: A theory of
nursing. East Norwalk, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Watson, J. (1997). The theory of human caring: Retro-
spective and prospective. Nursing Science Quarterly,
10(1), 175–181.
Watson, J. (1988). New dimensions of human caring
theory. Nursing Science Quarterly, 1, 175-181.
Watson, J. (2005). Caring science as sacred science.
Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Watson, J. (2009). Caring science and human caring
theory: Transforming personal/professional prac-
tices in nursing and healthcare. In D. Graber (ed.).
Journal of Health and Human Services Administration.
Symposium Issue. 31(4), 466–482.
Watson, J. (2008). The philosophy and science of caring (2nd
rev. ed.). Boulder, CO: University Press of Colorado.
Watson, J. (2013). New dimensions of human caring
theory. In M. Smith, M. Turkel, & Z. Wolf (Eds.),
Caring in nursing classics: An essential resource
(pp. 181–191). New York: Springer.
Weber, M. (1999). The ideal bureaucracy. In M. Matteson
& J. Ivancevich (Eds.), Management and organizational
behavior classics (7th ed.). Chicago: Irwin McGraw-Hill.
Wheatley, M. (1999). Leadership and the new science (2nd
ed.). San Francisco: Berrett-Koehler.
Wiggins, M. (2006). Clinical nurse leader. Evolution of
a revolution. The partnership care delivery model.
Journal of Nursing Administration, 36(7/8), 341–345.
Wilber, K. (Ed.). (1982). The holographic paradigm and
other paradoxes. Boulder, CO: Shambhala.
482 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch27_461-482 26/12/14 3:30 PM Page 482
Chapter 28Troutman-Jordan’s Theory of
Successful Aging
MEREDITH TROUTMAN-JORDAN
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Theory
Applications of the Theory in Research
Practice Exemplar
Summary
References
483
Introducing the Theorist
Dr. Troutman-Jordan began her nursing career
after graduating from Presbyterian Hospital
School of Nursing in Charlotte, North Carolina.
She earned her BSN from Queens College, and
her master’s degree is in Psychiatric Mental
Health Nursing from the University of North
Carolina at Charlotte. Her doctoral degree is in
nursing science from the University of South
Carolina at Columbia. She is certified as psychi-
atric mental health clinical nurse specialist from
the American Nurses Credentialing Center.
Dr. Troutman-Jordan received her inspira-
tion for development of a middle-range theory
of successful aging from her clinical practice
with older adults in home care. The theory
(Flood, 2002, 2006a) originated early during
Dr. Troutman-Jordan’s doctoral studies, and her
subsequent research has been based on testing
and refining this theory and developing and test-
ing an instrument to measure successful aging.
Her current research involves investigating the
effect of health promotion interventions on
successful aging and other health indicators.
Overview of the Theory
Although there is an array of theories detailing
what successful aging is or how it can be ac-
complished, there remains rather limited
theoretical work that provides practical guide-
lines for promoting successful aging. There-
fore, the impetus for developing the theory of
successful aging was enhanced understanding
of successful aging, captured from the older
adult’s perspective, and identification of foci
for interventions to foster successful aging.
One goal of Healthy People 2020 is to improve
the health, function, and quality of life of older
Meredith Troutman-Jordan
3312_Ch28_483-494 26/12/14 11:02 AM Page 483
adults (HealthyPeople.gov, 2012). Objectives
include increasing the proportion of older adults
with one or more chronic health conditions who
report confidence in managing their conditions
and reducing the number of older adults who
have moderate to severe functional limitations.
Optimal health and well-being of older adults
across multiple domains—physical health;
mobility; social, spiritual, and emotional well-
being—is consistent with successful aging.
Although there are commonly used definitions
of old age, there is no general agreement on the
age at which a person becomes old; the United
Nations agreed cutoff is 60+ years to refer to the
older population (World Health Organization,
2013). So the Healthy People 2020 goal aims to
improve health and quality of life of individuals
aged 60 and older. Similarly, the theory of suc-
cessful aging was intended for this age group.
Development of the theory of successful
aging began with a concept analysis of successful
aging that clarified the phenomenon. The con-
cept analysis was sparked by the question,
“What was it that could make such a dramatic
difference for two older adults with similar
health, environmental, and social situations?”
Although in similar circumstances, one might
give up, for example, refusing help from others
or trying to do for oneself, avoiding health-care
measures, withdrawing from relationships,
or becoming embittered. Another could main-
tain an optimistic, intrepid attitude and find
meaning, purpose, and satisfaction in life,
for example, accepting physical changes, actively
managing chronic health conditions, and stay-
ing socially engaged. Many of us have encoun-
tered similar older adults. So the question
became, “What describes the state of being of
the more favorably aging individual, and how
can nurses help older adults move toward this
state of being?
Walker and Avant’s (1995) framework was
used for this concept analysis, resulting in a
conceptual definition for successful aging: an
individual’s perception of a favorable outcome
in adapting to the cumulative physiological
and functional alterations associated with the
passage of time, while experiencing spiritual
connectedness, and a sense of meaning and
purpose in life. Older adults encountered in
clinical practice and research have validated
this idea, emphasizing the importance of both
coping mechanisms that mediate chronic
illness and the older adult’s perspective of his
own aging. Over the course of several years, the
theory of successful aging was developed.
Existing knowledge obtained deductively
from the Roy adaptation model (Roy &
Andrews, 1999) was synthesized with ideas
from Tornstam’s (1996) sociological theory
of gerotranscendence and other literature on
the concepts of successful aging. Adaptation
is a process in which individuals use conscious
awareness and choice to assimilate to their
environment (Roy, 2013). The theory was es-
tablished based on the following assumptions
derived from and based on the literature:
• Aging is a progressive process requiring
from simple to increasingly complex
adaptation.
• Aging may be successful or unsuccessful,
depending on where a person is along the
continuum of progression from simple to
more complex adaptation and the extensive
use of coping processes.
• Successful aging is influenced by the aging
person’s choices.
• The self is not ageless (Tornstam, 1996).
• Aging people experience changes, which
uniquely characterize their beliefs and per-
spectives as different from those of younger
adults (Flood, 2006a).
Roy Adaptation Model
The Roy adaptation model was used in the
development of the theory because of the the-
oretical fit of the successful aging assumptions
within the Roy model. The Roy adaptation
model is based on Helson’s (1964) adaptation
theory and von Bertalanffy’s (1968) general
systems theory. Roy (1997) referenced Erik-
son’s (Erikson, Erikson, & Kivnick, 1986)
developmental theory and stated that specific
medical problems may arise with age and
consideration should be given to the age of the
patient. Scientific and philosophical assump-
tions underlying the Roy adaptation model
484 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch28_483-494 26/12/14 11:02 AM Page 484
but you have probably encountered others who
managed to persevere through considerable
health, financial, or psychosocial challenges.
Three coping processes make up the foun-
dation of the theory: functional performance
mechanisms, intrapsychic factors, and spiri-
tuality. These coping processes, shown in
Figure 28-1, describe the ways one responds
to the changing environment (Flood, 2006a).
Constructs within each of these coping
processes are measurable output (cognitive,
behavioral, or affective) responses, which
provide feedback to the person and are thus
interconnected by arrows. Solid arrows de-
note those exchanges that occur initially,
and broken arrows indicate exchanges that
occur subsequently (Flood, 2006a).
Functional Performance Mechanisms
Functional performance mechanisms describe the
use of conscious awareness and choice as an
adaptive response to cumulative physiological
and physical losses with subsequent functional
deficits occurring because of aging. Simply
put, this foundational coping process captures
the typical age-related declines that occur, such
as decreasing vascular flexibility, increasing
stiffness, and rise in blood pressure, and what
people do to manage them, if anything. Every-
one will experience change as a part of aging.
Think of an older adult you know or that you
recently worked with. What is one age-related
physiological or functional change he or she
experienced? How did he or she respond to
this change?
Indicators of the functional performance
mechanism coping process are health promo-
tion activities, physical health, and physical
mobility. Therefore, by assessing an older adult’s
participation in health promotion activities
(e.g., annual health examinations, good nutri-
tion), physical health state (history of illnesses,
current chronic and acute disease processes),
and physical mobility (e.g., gait stability and
speed, use of assistive devices), the nurse deter-
mines the adaptive state of his or her functional
performance mechanisms. Each of these output
responses is a manifestation of the human
adaptive response of functional performance
CHAPTER 28 • Troutman-Jordan’s Theory of Successful Aging 485
inform the theory of successful aging and are
explicated in the chapter on the Roy adapta-
tion model in this text (Chapter 10).
There are three adaptation levels (the condi-
tion of life processes, according to Roy, 2013)
that represent the condition of the life processes:
integrated, compensatory, and compromised.
One who is aging successfully has integrated
adaptation levels; he or she has effectively func-
tioning coping mechanisms and experiences
physical, mental, and spiritual well-being. A
compensatory adaptation level in someone
who is aging successfully might be seeking social
support from friends and family after an episode
of acute illness. An older adult with compro-
mised adaptation could be someone who expe-
riences a cerebrovascular accident and refuses
physical therapy or social support from family,
becomes hopeless, depressed, stops eating, and
ends up at increased risk for a thrombus related
to immobility. Within the context of the theory
of successful aging, this person could still age
successfully if he adapts to health and other
circumstances according to his optimum poten-
tial. This person can be best supported through
a multidisciplinary approach including nursing,
medicine, social work, physical therapy, pastoral
care, and nutrition counseling to promote
successful aging.
The Theory of Successful Aging
The theory of successful aging describes the
process by which individuals use various cop-
ing mechanisms to progress toward desirable
adaptation to the collective physiological and
functional changes occurring over their life-
time, while maintaining a sense of spirituality,
connectedness, and meaning and purpose in
life. The theory of successful aging is com-
prised of various degrees of coping processes, the
complex dynamics within the person according
to Roy & Andrews (1999). Every older adult
has some capacity for coping, and this is unique
to the individual. Consider various older adults
you have encountered in clinical practice; each
individual had potential for some growth
through enhanced adaptation. For some peo-
ple, this might have been rather limited; per-
haps they tended to “see the glass as half full,”
3312_Ch28_483-494 26/12/14 11:02 AM Page 485
mechanisms. A broad array of functional per-
formance mechanisms is possible, and the mix
and extent of functional performance mecha-
nism indicators is perhaps limitless. Therefore,
each older adult is unique, and increasingly
complex across the life span, as changes occur
over time. As individuals, older adults could
be viewed as unique histories to be explored,
understood, and valued by the nurse.
Intrapsychic Factors
Intrapsychic factors describe the innate and en-
during character features that may enhance or
impair an individual’s ability to adapt to change
and to problem-solving (Flood, 2006a). In-
trapsychic factors refer to an older adult’s use of
these inherent character traits to respond to
environmental stimuli. Output responses indica-
tive of intrapsychic factors include creativity, low
levels of negativity, and personal control.
To assess an older adult’s intrapsychic factors,
the nurse could engage him or her in a discus-
sion about creative activities he or she enjoys or
explore problem-solving skills that have been
useful. For example, the nurse might note, “You
did a pretty impressive job supporting three
children after losing your husband. How did you
manage?”
Creativity
There are numerous creativity assessments, and
the best way for measuring or assessing creativ-
ity is debated. Some well-known methods of
measuring creativity include the Torrance
(1974) Tests of Creative Thinking, Guilford’s
(1967) Alternative Uses Tasks, and Wallach
and Kogan’s (1965) Creativity Test. Although
the Torrance tests require a fee and special
training to administer, the others do not. These
tests as well as others can be accessed free on-
line (www.indiana.edu/~bobweb/Handout/d3
.ttct.htm). Administering one of these assess-
ments might stimulate conversation with the
older adult, which could lead to discussion on
problem-solving skills and/or exploration of
enjoyable, creative leisure activities. Further-
more, these tests might even be fun for the
older adult.
486 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Successful Aging
Meaning
Purpose in life
Geotransendence
Decreased death
anxiety
Purpose in life
Spirituality
Spiritual perspective
Religiosity
Functional Performance
Mechanisms
Health promotion
activities
Physical health
Physical activities Intrapsychic Factors
Creativity
(Low level) negative
affectivity
Personal control
Fig 28 • 1 Model for theory of successful aging.
3312_Ch28_483-494 26/12/14 11:03 AM Page 486
Positive and Negative Affect
Isen, Daubman, and Nowicki (1987) proposed
that positive affect should be viewed as influenc-
ing the way in which material is processed, sug-
gesting that good feelings increase the tendency
to combine material in new ways and see the
relatedness between divergent stimuli. Similarly,
the theory of successful aging proposes that low
levels of negative affectivity enhance or increase
creativity.
The nurse might recognize the need to eval-
uate personal control or negative affectivity.
The extent of these features presented over
time could facilitate or detract from successful
aging. Negative affect is defined as a general
dimension of subjective distress and unplea-
surable engagement that includes a variety of
unpleasant mood states, such as anger, con-
tempt, disgust, guilt, fear, and nervousness
(Watson & Clark, 1984). Low negative affect
is characterized by a state of calmness and
serenity. Watson and Clark (1984) described
negative affectivity as a mood-dispositional
dimension that reflects pervasive individual
differences in negative emotionality and self-
concept. Negative affect is not simply the op-
posite or lack of positive affect; in fact, the two
are quite distinct and nearly independent of
each other (Naragon & Watson, 2009). There-
fore, one could experience positive affect and
still have quite frequent or extensive negative
affect. Consider someone who is emotionally
responsive to events, who could have positive
or negative affect quite profoundly and fre-
quently. Is this person more often (and more
deeply) in a state of scorn, irritation, or
disgust? Or is this person more frequently and
intensely calm, relaxed, and contented?
A nurse might gauge degree of negative
affectivity by administering the Positive and
Negative Affect Schedule (PANAS; Watson,
Clark, & Tellegen, 1988), a 20-item self-
report measure of positive and negative affect
that includes two subscales. The negative affect
subscale includes descriptors such as distressed,
guilty, and afraid. Individuals self-rate the
extent to which they feel these emotions at the
time they complete the PANAS, or they may
respond based on the degree of their feelings
over the past week (Watson et al., 1988). The
PANAS is in the public domain and can be
obtained from the article in which the authors
published its initial use (Participation and
Quality of Life Project, 2012).
Assessing degree of negative affectivity in
the older adult could be an initial step toward
increasing self-awareness of feelings and how
often and intensely they are experienced. A
tool such as the PANAS might be used to ini-
tiate a conversation about this self-awareness,
with subsequent counseling or referral to a
therapist if indicated.
Personal Control
Personal control reflects individuals’ beliefs
regarding the extent to which they are able to
control or influence outcomes (MacArthur
Research Network on SES and Health, 2008).
Personal control expectancies relate to judg-
ments about whether actions can produce a
given outcome (e.g., a widow’s expectations
about how she will manage her household after
losing her spouse, or a man’s expectations of
his ability to reduce body mass index to a nor-
mal range). Greater levels of personal control
are proposed to contribute to successful aging.
Although personal control can vary depending
on the specific domain of interest (e.g., health
versus marital longevity or occupational suc-
cess), it can also be considered from a more
global perspective.
Pearlin and Schooler’s (1978) Mastery
Scale has become perhaps the most widely
used measure of personal control in health
research. This tool could be quite useful in
clinical practice as well, and it was used in
the MacArthur Successful Aging Study
(MacArthur Research Network on SES and
Health, 2008). The Mastery Scale consists of
seven items that are answered on a 4-point
Likert scale.
Nurses may encounter patients who demon-
strate little personal control, verbalizing helpless-
ness with limited or no ability to effect change
in his or her life. For example, a person with a
perception of limited personal control might
state, “Well, I am 67; it’s too late to change”
or “I am too old to exercise with my arthritis”
CHAPTER 28 • Troutman-Jordan’s Theory of Successful Aging 487
3312_Ch28_483-494 26/12/14 11:03 AM Page 487
Although low levels of personal control do not
enhance the likelihood of successful aging, their
presence is not entirely detrimental. The breadth
and extent of personal control (or lack thereof)
must be considered. If the older adult has little
sense of control over her ability to hike Mount
Everest, this may be realistic, depending on
her physical health, mobility, and past or present
health promotion activities such as exercise
involvement. But, more important, this task may
not be relevant if the older adult does not need or
aspire to climb Mount Everest. Therefore, the
individual and his or her aspirations must be
considered.
Think of an older adult with little sense of
control over learning about a new medication.
Perhaps this person does feel empowered to
mentor her grandchildren or complete some
household project. Focusing on areas of greater
personal control could help increase the older
adult’s confidence in the ability to self-manage
other areas of health and well-being.
Older adults vary widely in their adaptation
to functional performance mechanisms as well
as in their intrapsychic factors. One 77-year-
old man may be post–cerebrovascular accident
(CVA; physical health) but actively engage in
physical therapy and walking around his farm
for exercise (mobility, health promotion). This
man might view his CVA as a challenge (low
levels of negative affect) rather than a frustra-
tion and threat to his masculinity. He might
be determined to overcome (high levels of per-
sonal control) and use gardening as a (creative)
means of range of motion exercise. A similar
77-year-old man could also be post CVA and
resist physical therapy because it is “too painful
and difficult,” believing there is little he can do
at his age to help the situation. This man might
avoid visitors, stop physical therapy, and refuse
to ambulate, remaining in a wheelchair. Thus,
two individuals in similar situations could re-
spond quite differently, depending on their in-
trapsychic factors, resulting in very different
aging trajectories.
Spirituality
Another foundational coping mechanism is
spirituality, which is proposed to interact with
intrapsychic factors and functional perform-
ance mechanisms in a way that is facilitative of
successful aging. Spirituality encompasses the
personal views and behaviors that express a
sense of relatedness to something greater than
oneself; the feelings, thoughts, experiences,
and behaviors arising from the search for the
sacred (Flood, 2006a). Spirituality is essential
to successful aging; the sense of connection
and beliefs about a higher power the older
adult has help shape his values, beliefs, and be-
haviors while living, especially in terms of what
he believes happens after death. Acceptance of
the reality of death and one’s own mortality are
part of being able to age successfully.
Output responses representative of spiritu-
ality are spiritual perspective, prayer, and reli-
giosity. Spiritual perspective refers to beliefs
in the existence of something beyond what is
concrete and immediate without devaluing
the self (Reed & Larson, 2006). A spiritual
perspective is considered to be an important
resource for helping people transcend difficul-
ties faced in aging (Reed & Rousseau, 2007)
and may or may not include religious expres-
sion (Reed & Larson, 2006).
Indicators of spiritual perspective are con-
nectedness (with others, nature, the universe,
or God), belief in something greater than the
self, in an intangible domain, or a positively
life-affirming faith, and a constant, dynamic
creative energy (Haase, Britt, Coward, Leidy,
& Penn, 1992). Although these attributes can
be considered aspects of inherent spirituality,
it is the realization and development of these
features that are represented by the term spir-
itual perspective (Haase et al., 1992). More-
over, spiritual perspective is believed to enable
and motivate one to find meaning and purpose
in life (Banks, 1980; Hiatt, 1986; Highfield &
Caison, 1983; Hungleman, 1985; Jourard,
1974; Moberg, 1971), key indicators of suc-
cessful aging (Troutman, 2011).
The nurse could assess spiritual perspective
by administering the Spiritual Perspective Scale
(Reed, 1986), a 10-item, self-administered or
structured-interview formatted scale which
measures one’s perspectives on the extent to
which spirituality permeates his life and he
488 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch28_483-494 26/12/14 11:03 AM Page 488
engages in spiritually related interactions.
Other means of assessing spirituality include
inquiring about the older adult’s engagement
in prayer or meditation; church (or other reli-
gious function) attendance; and discussing
and/or encouraging religious rituals (what these
mean to the older adult, ways these practices
might be healthful, etc.).
Integrated use of foundational coping
processes is unique for each individual and is
the initial adaptive process of successful aging.
People who are more creative and who have
lower levels of negative affectivity and greater
degrees of personal control will have more
effective adaptation of functional performance
mechanisms; they will be more likely to engage
in health promotion activities and mainte-
nance of physical mobility. Physical health can
be affected by intrapsychic factors, the rela-
tionship between immune function and emo-
tions, for example. Physical health also affects
intrapsychic factors (such as how one responds
psychologically to illness or accident).
The elements of successful aging interact
and reciprocate, creating a strong, flexible web
of support. More creativity, less negative affec-
tivity, and greater personal control enhance
spirituality through greater spiritual perspective
and more religiosity. If one is more creative,
then he is more receptive to new ideas and
innovative problem-solving methods. Lower
negative affectivity also makes one more ac-
cepting of circumstances and people, able to
consider a broader range of possible outcomes
to a situation, and it increases the possibility of
pleasant, positive interactions with others.
Greater personal control means that someone
is more likely to be proactive in health promo-
tion activities, problem-solving, and disease
management. A stronger or deeper sense of
spirituality contributes to one’s valuation of self
and sense of responsibility to appreciate and be
responsible for blessings in life such as health,
relationships, and resources.
Gerotranscendence
Gerotranscendence is a shift in metaperspective,
from a materialistic and rationalistic perspec-
tive to a more mature and existential one that
accompanies the process of aging (Tornstam,
2005). Experiencing gerotranscendence means
one develops a new outlook on and under-
standing of life, with broad existential changes;
changes in one’s view of the present self and
the self in retrospect; and developmental
changes (related to existential changes and
changes in the self; Tornstam, 2011). Gero-
transcendence is associated with positive aging
(Tornstam, 2005) and has been theorized as a
precursor to successful aging (Tornstam,
1994).
Gerotranscendence occurs when there is a
major shift in the person’s worldview, where a
person examines their place within the world
and in relation to others (Tornstam, 1997).
This means there is a radical change of one’s
outlook on life from a concern with mundane
issues to a concern with universal values
(Tornstam, 1989). The older adult examines
values held, and these may change from what
they were when that person was younger.
Three levels of age-related change occur with
gerotranscendence.
Cosmic dimension
The level of the cosmic dimension of life re-
lates to the feeling of being part of and at one
with the universe. There is a redefinition of
one’s sense of his or her place in the physical
world as well as the more global universe. Fur-
thermore, an increased understanding of the
spirit of the universe results in a redefinition of
the perception of time and, therefore, lessens
one’s concerns regarding the future (Tornstam,
1989). Thus, one has decreased concern or fear
of death because of a sense of continuity with
the universe; a newfound recognition of mean-
ing and sense of purpose in the greater scheme
of things occurs.
Self Dimension
A second level of gerotranscendent change deals
with one’s self-perception. Gerotranscendence
is believed to cause a new understanding of
fundamental questions regarding one’s existence
and a change in the way one perceives one’s
self and the world. The dimension of perception
of self concerns how one perceives self and the
CHAPTER 28 • Troutman-Jordan’s Theory of Successful Aging 489
3312_Ch28_483-494 26/12/14 11:03 AM Page 489
surrounding world. Tornstam (1999) observed
that many older adults look at their bodies with
aversion, perceiving them as an indication of
overall decline, and concluding that both their
mind and their sense of self-worth have likewise
declined. The gerotranscendent person, in con-
trast, recognizes the separateness of spiritual
growth and development apart from physical
deterioration. Tornstam suggests this ability to
separate physical and spiritual concerns provides
a new feeling of freedom, which might result
in finding the courage to be oneself and to
no longer fear both social norms and expected
roles. The gerotranscendent person feels free-
dom to self-discover new and perhaps unex-
pected aspects of himself. The individual may
also show an increase in time spent alone in
meditation or contemplation.
Social Dimension
The third level of change experienced in gero-
transcendence deals with an increase in a sense
of interrelatedness with others. The gerotran-
scendent person will begin to have greater need
to view self as a social being and will reevaluate
the meaning behind relationships with family,
friends, and other relationships. There is a
stronger sense of needing to feel part of
the human race. Tornstam suggests this need
results in an increased feeling of kinship or
connection with past and future generations,
along with a decreased interest in superficial or
casual social interactions. So the gerotranscen-
dent older adult may become more open and
responsive to other people while at the same
time becoming more selective with whom they
engage and interact.
Tornstam (1989, 1997) asserts gerotran-
scendence is closely associated with wisdom
because gerotranscendence and wisdom both
involve a transcendence beyond right and
wrong, accompanied by an increased broad-
mindedness and tolerance, usually followed
by an increase in life satisfaction. In the the-
ory of successful aging, indicators of gero-
transcendence are decreased death anxiety,
engagement in meaningful activities, changes
in relationships with others, self-acceptance,
and wisdom.
Gerotranscendence could be assessed using
the Gerotranscendence Scale (GS) (Tornstam,
1994). The GS consists of 10 items designed
to capture what Tornstam (2005) calls “retro-
spective change” (p. 93), or how older adults
see they have changed since age 50. The GS is
brief and easily administered; it may also pro-
vide an opportunity to initiate discussions
about gerotranscendence with older adults.
Another means of assessing gerotranscendence
is by evaluating the older adult’s affective and
emotional response to specific interventions.
For example, does the older adult seem to
enjoy solitude? Does he or she talk about death
without fear, and as a transition, rather than
an endpoint? If the nurse finds that an older
adult patient does these things, then she could
initiate further conversation with the patient
about his perspectives and feelings or even
describe the topic of gerotranscendence as
Wadensten (2005) did finding that older
adults recognized features of gerotranscen-
dence in themselves.
A reasonable and well-balanced integration
of the outputs of each foundational coping
process for each individual, rather than an ideal
amount or combinations of features from
within the foundational coping processes, must
be present in order for the aging person to
experience gerotranscendence. The successful
ager does not necessarily have ideal physical
health; he or she likely has one or more age-
related chronic conditions but manages them
as well as possible, participating in health
promotion activities (such as physical activity
and good nutrition) and maintaining physical
mobility to the best of his or her ability. This
person finds innovative ways to deal with
struggles and may be involved in more tradi-
tional creative activities such as painting or
woodwork. On most days, the successful ager
maintains low negative affectivity, seeing
the glass as “half full rather than half empty.”
The successfully aging individual feels empow-
ered to influence his own health and aging
(personal control), though he recognizes that
God or some Higher Power has a role in life
also. The balance of intrapsychic factors en-
hances the older adult’s spirituality. These
490 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch28_483-494 26/12/14 11:03 AM Page 490
foundational coping mechanisms increase the
possibility of experiencing gerotranscendence,
in which the older adult has a major shift in
metaperspective and reevaluates where he is in
the larger scheme of the world and what lies
beyond. There may be pervasive change, as the
older adult self-examines values, aspirations,
and fundamental existential beliefs. When
these foundational coping processes and gero-
transcendent changes, greater life satisfaction
and a sense of purpose and meaning in life
ensue. This person is aging successfully.
Nurses could assess successful aging with
the Successful Aging Inventory (SAI), a 20-
item questionnaire with a 5.9 grade reading
level. Each statement is brief, positively
worded, and numbered 0 to 4 with higher
values indicating more frequent/stronger re-
sponses. For example, one statement includes
“I have been able to cope with the changes that
have occurred to my body as I have aged.”
Respondents indicate the point to which they
agree or disagree with the statement or the
extent to which they believe the statement
applies to them. Higher scores are indicative
of more successful aging.
Applications of the Theory in
Research
A growing number of studies have used or
expanded on the theory of successful aging.
One of these (Flood & Scharer, 2006) inves-
tigated the relationship between functional
performance, creativity, and successful aging.
Although the creativity intervention (story-
telling, writing poetry, reminiscing) did not
increase creativity levels or successful aging,
racial differences were observed, with Black
participants scoring higher on creativity and
successful aging compared with White par-
ticipants. A subsequent study (Flood, 2006b)
examined the relationships between creativ-
ity, depression, and successful aging. Level of
depressive symptoms had a moderating effect
on the relationship of creativity to successful
aging; that is, the presence of depressive
symptoms weakened the relationship between
creativity and successful aging. Significant
differences in creativity, depressive symp-
toms, and successful aging were found by
racial group and education level, with Black
participants having higher creativity levels
and more depressive symptoms, compared
with White ones.
McCarthy (2009) used the theory of
successful aging as a guiding framework to
investigate adaptation, transcendence, and
successful aging. She found that adaptation
and gerotranscendence were significant pre-
dictors of successful aging, which was meas-
ured with the SAI. And, together, adaptation
and transcendence accounted for almost half
of the variance in successful aging. Thus,
McCarthy’s study provided support for the
theory of successful aging and demonstrated
sound psychometric properties for the SAI.
Other research has also used the theory
(Barnes, 2012; Cozort, 2008; White, 2013),
providing validation.
CHAPTER 28 • Troutman-Jordan’s Theory of Successful Aging 491
Practice Exemplar
Mr. P., a 69-year-old male, suddenly and unex-
pectedly lost his wife after she had a pulmonary
embolus. He had known her since she was 15.
Mr. P. had a third-grade education, limited
literacy, and a very modest income. He was
devastated by this loss. Although he had recently
become the primary homemaker because of
Mrs. P.’s surgery and declining health, he
had rather advanced macular degeneration,
postherpetic neuralgia, and arthritis. Despite
these limitations, he had been his wife’s
primary caregiver, maintained the home, and still
preached occasionally at the church where he had
been a pastor. After her death, although it was a
struggle, he managed to walk in the parking lot
of a church near his home every day with the aid
of a cane. Remaining in the home was very im-
portant to him; his ability to be as independent
Continued
3312_Ch28_483-494 26/12/14 11:03 AM Page 491
492 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
■ Summary
The theory of successful aging offers a frame-
work for understanding a multidimensional,
complex phenomenon and for planning nurs-
ing interventions geared toward promoting
successful aging in various groups, making suc-
cessful aging a possibility for a broader range of
older adults. The theory provides an empirically
supported (Cozort, 2008; Flood, 2006b; Flood
& Scharer, 2006; McCarthy, 2009; Troutman,
Bentley, & Nies, 2011; Troutman, Nies, &
Mavellia, 2011) organizing framework for
assessment, planning, interventions, and eval-
uation of older adults that is individualized to
the needs and situations of unique individuals
and sensitive to the importance that the older
adult places on various aspects of aging.
Practice Exemplar cont.
as possible permitted him a greater sense of per-
sonal control. Therefore, he let his daughters
help by delivering meals and doing his laundry
regularly, although he “really didn’t like” to give
up these tasks or rely on others. But he recog-
nized that he had to make this concession to
remain in his home. He had figured out inno-
vative ways to live alone without his wife; for
example, he placed toiletries in bottles of certain
shapes and sizes because he could no longer see
well enough to read labels to determine con-
tents. He devised an organization system for
storing food items in the kitchen so that he
could locate things by memory. He carried “a
big stick” when he went walking in case he
encountered any strange dogs. Mr. P. noticed
that if he tried to focus on “what I do have and
not what I don’t” that it seemed easier to cope
day to day.
Although the loss of his wife was almost un-
bearable, Mr. P. grew to accept the notion that
“it was her time, and the Lord took her,” and
he found comfort and strength in prayer and
listening to prerecorded sermons several times a
week. Mr. P. found himself thinking of his wife
often, as he now lived alone. Sometimes he
talked to her because he sensed she could hear
him. He began to enjoy having his home to
himself, after having raised six children there,
and the freedom of “not having to set an exam-
ple for anyone.” Sometimes he would put on
his nightclothes early and eat cereal for dinner.
Despite his chronic health conditions and the
loss of his wife, Mr. P. grew to enjoy his solitude
and the freedom to “just be myself,” although he
derived great satisfaction from spending time
with his grandchildren.
Superficially, Mr. P. might seem like an
average, or perhaps disadvantaged, older adult.
Despite his health limitations and significant
loss, he continues to engage in health promo-
tion and strives to maintain his mobility. He
demonstrates creativity in the efforts and mod-
ifications to do these things. He also makes
decisions that optimize his sense of personal
control and makes a conscious effort to have
low levels of negative affect through positive
self-talk. His spirituality has deepened since
the death of his wife; he now sees death as a
transition to some other state of being rather
than an end. Similarly, he finds a new appre-
ciation of his life and his views of the world,
with a newfound sense of who he is, his pur-
pose, and the meaning in his life.
Mr. P. appears to be aging successfully. The
nurse could encourage continued walking
(health promotion and maintenance of physical
mobility) and regular contact with his primary
care provider. Likewise, his strategies to prob-
lem-solve related to home maintenance and
activities of daily living could be commended
to encourage their continuation. The nurse
could encourage continued time spent in prayer
and assist Mr. P. to negotiate transportation
to church services. Mr. P. might also benefit
from introduction to the idea of gerotranscen-
dence and time spent reminiscing or quietly
reflecting.
3312_Ch28_483-494 26/12/14 11:03 AM Page 492
CHAPTER 28 • Troutman-Jordan’s Theory of Successful Aging 493
References
Banks, R. (1980). Health and the spiritual dimensions:
Relationships and implications for professional prepa-
ration programs. Journal of School Health, 50, 195.
Barnes, J. (2012). Successful aging: A correlational study
identifying the relationship between successful aging and
purpose in life. Unpublished Honors Thesis, Lenoir
Rhyne University, Hickory, North Carolina.
Cozort, R. (2008). Revising the Gerotranscendence Scale
for use with older adults in the Southern United States
and establishing psychometric properties of the Revised
Gerotranscendence Scale. Doctoral dissertation,
University of North Carolina, Greensboro.
Erikson, E., Erikson, J., & Kivnick, H. (1986). Vital
involvement in old age. New York, NY: Norton.
Flood, M. (2002). Successful Aging; A concept analysis.
Journal of Theory Construction and Testing, 6(2),
105–108.
Flood, M. (2006a). A mid-range theory of successful
aging. Journal of Theory Construction and Testing, 9(2),
35–39.
Flood, M. (2006b). Exploring the relationships between
creativity, depression, and successful aging. Activities,
Adaptation, and Aging, 31(1), 55–71.
Flood, M., & Scharer, K. (2006). Creativity enhancement;
Possibilities for successful aging. Issues in Mental
Health Nursing, 27, 1–21.
Guilford, J. P. (1967). The nature of human intelligence.
New York: McGraw-Hill.
Haase, J., Britt, T., Coward, D., Leidy, N., & Penn, P.
(1992). Simultaneous concept analysis of spiritual
perspective, hope, acceptance, and self-transcendence.
Image: Journal of Nursing Scholarship 24(2), 141–147.
HealthyPeople.gov. (2012). Older adults. Retrieved
September 9, 2012, from www.healthypeople.gov
/2020/topicsobjectives2020/overview.aspx?topicId=31
Helson, H. (1964). Adaptation-level theory: An experimental
and systematic approach to behavior. New York, NY:
Harper & Row.
Hiatt, J. (1986). Spirituality, medicine, and healing.
Southern Medical Journal, 79, 736–743.
Highfield, M., & Caison, C. (1983). Spiritual needs of pa-
tients: Are the recognized? Cancer Nursing, 6, 187–192.
Hungleman, J., Kenkel-Rossi, W., Klassen, L., &
Stollenwerk, R. (1985). Spiritual well-being in
older adults: Harmonious interconnectedness.
Journal of Religion & Health, 24, 147–153.
Isen, A., Daubman, K., & Nowicki, G. (1987). Positive
affect facilitates creative problem-solving. Journal of
Personality and Social Psychology, 52(6), 1122–1131.
Jourard, S. (1974). Health personality. New York:
Macmillan.
MacArthur Research Network on SES and Health.
(2008). Research: Psychosocial notebook; Personal
control. Retrieved October 7, 2012, from http://
www.macses.ucsf.edu/research/psychosocial/
control.php
McCarthy, V. (2009). Exploring a new theory of successful
aging among low-income older adults in an independent
and assisted living community. Doctoral dissertation,
University of Louisville, Kentucky.
Moberg, D. (1971). Spiritual well-being: Background and
issues. Washington, DC: White House Conference
on Aging.
Naragon, K., & Watson, D. (2009). Positive affectivity.
In S. Lopez (Ed.), The encyclopedia of positive psychology
(pp. 707-711). Hoboken, NJ: Wiley-Blackwell.
The Participation and Quality of Life Project. (2012).
Positive and Negative Affect Schedule (PANAS).
Retrieved October 4, 2012, from www.parqol.
com/page.cfm?id=87
Pearlin, L., & Schooler, C. (1978). The structure of coping.
Journal of Health & Social Behavior, 18, 2–21.
Reed, P. G. (1986). Religiousness in terminally ill and
healthy adults. Research in Nursing & Health, 9(1),
35–41.
Reed, P. G., & Larson, C. (2006). Spirituality. In J.
Fitzpatrick & M. Wallace (Eds.), Encyclopedia of nurs-
ing research (pp. 565–567). New York, NY: Springer.
Reed, P. G., & Rousseau, E. (2007). Spiritual inquiry
and well-being in life-limiting illness. Journal of
Religion, Spirituality, & Aging, 19(4), 81–98.
Roy, C. (1997). Future of the Roy Model: Challenge to
redefine adaptation. Nursing Science Quarterly, 10,
42–48.
Roy, C. (2013). Key definitions: The Roy adaptation
model. Retrieved October 22, 2013, from www.bc.edu
/content/bc/schools/son/faculty/featured/theorist/Roy
_Adaptation_Model/Key_Definitions.html
Roy, C., & Andrews, H. (1999). The Roy adaptation
model (2nd ed.). Stamford, CT: Appleton & Lange.
Tornstam, L. (1994). Gerotranscendence: A theoretical
and empirical exploration. In L. Thomas, & S. A.
Eisenhandler (Eds.), Aging and the religious dimension
(pp. 203–225). Westport, CT: Greenwood.
Tornstam, L. (1996). Caring for the elderly. Introducing
the theory of gerotranscendence as a supplementary
frame of reference for care of the elderly. Scandanavian
Journal of Caring Sciences, 10, 144–150.
Tornstam, L. (1997). Gerotranscendence-a theory about
mating into old age. Journal of Aging and Identity, 2,
17–36.
Tornstam, L. (1989). Gero-transcendence: A meta-
theoretical reformulation of the disengagement theory.
Aging: Clinical and Experimental Research, 1, 55–63.
Tornstam, L. (2005). Gerotranscendence: A developmental
theory of positive aging. New York: Springer.
Tornstam, L. (2011). Maturing into gerotranscendence.
Journal of Transpersonal Psychology, 43(2), 166–180.
Torrance, E. P. (1974). Torrance Tests of Creative Thinking.
Bensenville, IL: Scholastic Testing Service.
Troutman, M. (2011). Mid-range theory of successful
aging. In J. Lange (Ed), The nurse’s role in promoting
3312_Ch28_483-494 26/12/14 11:03 AM Page 493
optimal health of older adults: Thriving in the wisdom
years (pp. 4–16). Philadelphia, PA: F.A. Davis.
Troutman, M., Bentley, M., & Nies, M. A. (2011).
Measuring successful aging in Southern Black older
adults. Educational Gerontology, 37(1), 38–50.
Troutman, M., Nies, M. A., & Mavellia, H. (2011).
Perceptions of successful aging in Southern Black
older adults. Journal of Psychosocial Nursing and
Mental Health Services, 49(1), 28–34.
von Bertalanffy, L. (1968). Organismic psychology and sys-
tems theory. Worchester, MA: Clark University Press.
Wadensten, B. (2005). Introducing older people to the
theory of gerotranscendence. Journal of Advanced
Nursing, 52, 381–388.
Walker, L., & Avant, K. (1995). Strategies for theory
construction in nursing (3rd ed., pp. 37–54). Norwalk:
Appleton & Lange.
Wallach, M. A., & Kogan, N. (1965). Modes of thinking
in your children: A study of the creativity-intelligence
distinction. New York: Holt, Rinehart & Winston.
Watson, D., & Clark, L. A. (1984). Negative affectivity:
The disposition to experience aversive emotional
states. Psychological Bulletin, 96, 465–490.
Watson, D., Clark, L. A., & Tellegen, A. (1988).
Development and validation of brief measures of
positive and negative affect: The PANAS scales.
Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 54(6),
1063–1070.
White, A. J. (2013, November). The relationship between
post-menopausal women’s successful aging, global self-
esteem, and sexual quality of life. Paper presented at
the Sigma Theta Tau International 42nd Biennial
Convention, Indianapolis, IN.
World Health Organization. (2013). Definition of an older
or elderly person. Retrieved October 22, 2013, from
www.who.int/healthinfo/survey/ageingdefnolder/en
494 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch28_483-494 26/12/14 11:03 AM Page 494
Chapter 29Barrett’s Theory of Power as
Knowing Participation
in Change
ELIZABETH ANN MANHART BARRETT
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Theory
Applications of the Theory
Practice Exemplar
Summary
References
495
Introducing the Theorist
Elizabeth Ann Manhart Barrett, RN, LMHC,
PhD, FAAN, is Professor Emerita, Hunter
College, City University of New York; a re-
search consultant; a Health Patterning Thera-
pist; in private practice in New York City; and
co-president of Power-Imagery Partners.
From the University of Evansville in Indiana,
she holds a BSN, summa cum laude, an MA,
and an MSN; she earned a PhD in nursing sci-
ence from New York University. Dr. Barrett
has more than 40 years of experience as a
practitioner, educator, researcher, and admin-
istrator at universities and medical centers in
New York and Indiana. She is one of the
founders and first president of the Society of
Rogerian Scholars.
Dr. Barrett’s scholarly endeavors have evolved
from her commitment to carry forward Martha
E. Rogers’s Science of Unitary Human Beings.
The primary focus of her research has been the
Barrett theory of power as knowing participation
in change® and the Power as Knowing Participa-
tion in Change Tool (PKPCT). Colleagues have
conducted more than 100 studies using the the-
ory and/or measurement instrument. The
PKPCT has been translated into Japanese, Ko-
rean, Swedish, Danish, Portuguese, French, and
German. Dr. Barrett has authored nearly 100
publications including articles and book chapters
and has coedited three books. Two years after
she crafted the first Rogerian practice method-
ology, she edited Visions of Rogers’ Science-Based
Elizabeth Ann Manhart
Barrett
3312_Ch29_495-508 26/12/14 3:33 PM Page 495
Nursing, which received the American Journal of
Nursing Book of the Year Award. This was one
of the first books to provide chapters on research,
education, and practice focused entirely on one
nursing conceptual framework/nursing theory.
Dr. Barrett has presented her work on power in
Australia, Scotland, Canada, the Netherlands,
Germany, South Korea, and the Philippines as
well as throughout the United States. Her article
in Nursing Science Quarterly that won the best
paper award for 2012 was the lead article in
an issue devoted to her work. She currently
is writing a book on the power theory for the
general public. Dr. Barrett’s websites can be
viewed at www.drelizabethbarrett.com and
www.powerimagery.com.
Overview of the Theory
Certain things happen that sometimes change
the entire direction of our lives. So it was that
I transplanted myself from Indiana to begin
doctoral studies with Martha E. Rogers at New
York University more than 35 years ago. Study-
ing with Martha changed my professional and
personal thinking, values, and actions as she
became my teacher, my dissertation advisor, and
later my colleague and friend. And so the power
theory journey began and continues to this day.
The passion and excitement I experienced in
those early days is still with me and moves
onward, primarily through the work of other
nurses.
Rogers wove the conceptual framework of
the science of unitary human beings (SUHB)
as threads in the irreducible, unpredictable
tapestry of the universe and many, like
myself, continue to weave this changing fab-
ric of our participatory world. In this chapter,
I describe the flow from Rogers’s science
to the power theory to the research and prac-
tice applications. Figure 29-1 provides an
overview of this process. Although it appears
to be linear, in truth, it is a nonlinear, evolv-
ing, mutual process. Figure 29-1 also serves
as an outline that tracks the unfolding of the
theory and practice developments described
in this chapter. It will be helpful to refer to
it frequently.
Theoretical Underpinnings
Butcher and Malinski discuss the theoretical
matrix of the postulates and principles of the
SUHB in depth elsewhere in this book, and so
only a cursory overview will be presented here.
Keep in mind that development of the power
theory required theoretical consistency with the
postulates and principles of Rogerian science.
This is one of the most difficult and yet critically
important aspects involved in creating both the-
oretical and practice applications of the SUHB.
The postulates of the SUHB are energy
fields, openness, pattern, and pandimensional-
ity. We don’t have energy fields; we are energy
fields. There are two fields: the human and the
environment. The environment encompasses all
that the individual or group is not. These basic
units of the living and nonliving are irreducible;
they are unitary (Rogers, 1992). Parse (1998)
defined unitary as ever changing, indivisible,
and unpredictable.
We live in a universe of openness, so fields
are open—all the way, all the time. There
are no boundaries. Pattern is the distinctive
defining characteristic of energy fields. Pattern
is what makes you you and me me. Pattern
cannot be directly observed; we observe man-
ifestations of pattern. Pandimensionality is a
way of perceiving reality; it is a nonlinear
domain without temporal or spatial attributes
(Rogers, 1992)
The three principles of the SUHB are about
change. Resonancy is how change takes place:
from long, slow waves to short, fast waves.
Helicy is the nature of change, and integrality is
the mutual process of humans and their envi-
ronments (Phillips, 1994). These four postulates
and three principles are the blueprint. All work
developed from this theoretical perspective
needs to be consistent with them.
Concepts of Barrett’s Theory of Power
as Knowing Participation in Change®
Rogers did not write about power in the
SUHB, but she did emphasize that human
beings can knowingly participate in change.
Even though continuous participation in
change is a given, participation in that change
496 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch29_495-508 26/12/14 3:33 PM Page 496
may not take place in a knowing manner.
I searched for a definition of power that would
be consistent with the postulates and principles
of the SUHB and connect with the literature
where, for centuries, the primary propositions
maintained that power was about change and
about causality, although there was some mea-
ger support for an acausal view of power.
Finally, the light bulb turned on. Power is the
capacity to participate knowingly in change.
Initially, I connected this definition with the
literature in terms of change, but not in terms
of causality because my purpose was to derive
an acausal theory of power consistent with
Rogers’s conceptual model. This acausal theory
was differentiated from other causal power
theories that can be summarized by May’s
(1972) definition that power is the ability to
cause or prevent change. Only much later did
it become clear that the definition of power as
the capacity to participate knowingly in change
also described causal ideas of power.
CHAPTER 29 • Barrett's Theory of Power as Knowing Participation in Change 497
Acausal worldview
Causal worldview
Postulates Energy fields Openness Pattern Pandimensionality
Principles
Theory
Research
Application
Resonancy Helicy
Power-as-freedom
Integrality
Awareness Choices Freedom
to act
intentionally
Supported
Practice
Health patterning
Practice methodolgy
Health patterning modalities
Power prescriptions
Living power-as-freedom
Rejected
Involvement
in creating
change
Power-as-control
Numerous forms
(some same, some different)
Hypothesis testing
Numerous forms
(some same, some different)
Awareness Choices Freedom
to act
intentionally
Involvement
in creating
change
Fig 29 • 1 Barrett’s theory of power as knowing participation in change. (Copyright © Elizabeth Ann Manhart
Barrett, RN, LMHC; PhD; FAAN.)
3312_Ch29_495-508 26/12/14 3:33 PM Page 497
Through readings in various relevant areas
and synthesizing my own ideas, the conceptual
manifestations of the inseparable dimensions
of power were identified as awareness, choices,
freedom to act intentionally, and involvement
in creating change. These concepts were vali-
dated as consistent with the SUHB through
a judges’ study with New York University
faculty, who were considered knowledgeable
in Rogerian thought.
Power is the capacity to participate know-
ingly in change by being aware, making
choices, feeling free to act intentionally, and
involvement in creating change. In a nutshell,
power is being aware of what one is choosing
to do, feeling free to do it, and doing it inten-
tionally (Barrett, 1986, 1989, 1990a, 2010).
The theory describes power in groups as well
as in individuals. The inseparable association
of a person’s or a group’s power strengths or
weaknesses is known as their Power Profile.
Power-as-Freedom and
Power-as-Control
While my initial interest was in developing an
acausal view of power, I was often puzzled re-
garding why the four dimensions of awareness,
choices, freedom to act intentionally, and in-
volvement in creating change seemed to also
describe power from a causal perspective. After
many years and for the second time, the power
light bulb turned on. One day while walking
down the street, I realized that the power
theory did indeed describe two types of power.
The difference is simply that one reflects an
acausal worldview and the other reflects a
causal worldview. We live in two worlds, and
power as a phenomenon that exists in the
universe lives in both of them. So I named
these two types of power—power-as-freedom
and power-as-control. For example, in the
extreme situation of murder, if the murderer is
aware of what she is choosing to do and feels
free to act on that intention and is, actually,
involved in creating that change, this is power
as surely as the acausal type of power that does
not interfere with another person’s freedom.
Freedom is incompatible with causality be-
cause causality allows for control, prediction,
and reduction. Some of the forms in which
power manifests can be for purposes of control,
such as money that can be used to control
people, places, or things. On the other hand,
money can be used for purposes of freedom
through such things as philanthropy, educa-
tion, meeting basic needs, but never interfering
with the freedom of others. Knowledge can
also be used for purposes of control or freedom.
I would further suggest that we can view
the many variations of power theories, such as
social power, political power, positional power,
personal power, empowerment, and others as
forms in which power manifests. They can be
further understood in terms of the definition
of power with its four dimensions of aware-
ness, choices, freedom to act intentionally, and
involvement in creating change, along with
the 12 characteristics used to measure power
as knowing participation in change. It is
important to note that these new insights
changed nothing I had previously written
concerning power, but they expanded the
theory to describe how power operates in the
two worlds we live in—the causal and acausal
worlds. Of course, although practice applica-
tions continue to focus on power-as-freedom,
clients more easily understand how to live
power-as-freedom when it is contrasted with
power-as-control, the usual way people under-
stand power and witness it in our everyday
world. Power-as-control is often described in
terms of force, dominance, or manipulation in
subtle or not-so-subtle varieties of control.
Figure 29-2 contrasts these two worldviews.
The Power as Knowing Participation
in Change Tool (PKPCT, Version II)
Following a second judges’ study, a paper-and-
pencil research instrument using semantic differ-
ential technique was developed to measure
power as knowing participation in change. The
PKPCT, Version II consists of the four power
dimensions, each measured by 12 bipolar adjec-
tive pairs randomly reversed and randomly
ordered for each dimension. A thirteenth adjec-
tive pair is not included in the score because it
is a retest reliability item that is used only for
research purposes. A complete accounting of the
498 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch29_495-508 26/12/14 3:33 PM Page 498
tool development, along with a copy of the
PKPCT, Version II and the Scoring Guide is
presented elsewhere (Barrett, 1990b, 2003), so
only a brief summary is discussed here to aid
understanding of how it is used in practice. Al-
though the adjective pairs appear to be linear, in
truth they are not to be conceptualized in that
manner when one attempts to move from the
less powerful adjective to the more powerful
adjective. “In a world where time and space exist,
the words from and to would be a linear process.
However, in a pandimensional universe, change
takes place throughout the human and environ-
mental fields that are without spatial or temporal
attributes” (Phillips, 2010, p. 57).
After a pilot study of 267 men and women,
revised versions of the PKPCT, Version I and
Version II, were further tested in a national
study using a volunteer sample of 625 men and
women with participants from every state. The
response rate was 61%, and the sample com-
prised men and women with a minimum of a
high school education who were diverse in
terms of age (21–60 years), marital status, city
size, geographic residence, and occupation.
This sample was used to test the dissertation
hypothesis that human field motion and power
were correlated. I reasoned that the greater the
effortless, rhythmic flow of human field mo-
tion in one’s life, the greater one’s capacity to
participate knowingly in creating change. The
hypothesis was supported with two statistically
significant moderately strong canonical corre-
lations of .61 and .16. Reliability, measured
as the variances of factor scores, ranged from
.63 to .99; and validity coefficients, computed
as factor loadings, ranged from .56 to .70
(Barrett, 1986, 1990b, 2003). The findings
from these studies provided support for using
the theory and measurement tool in nursing
practice. Most other researchers who have used
the PKPCT, Version II computed reliability
using Chronbach’s alpha with the majority
reporting higher coefficients than what I had
found (Caroselli & Barrett, 1998; Kim, 2009).
Although I use Version II in my practice
and most researchers select this version as well,
Version I also has acceptable reliability and
validity (Barrett, 1986). The difference is that
in Version I the power dimensions are meas-
ured in relation to self, family, and work.
Applications of the Theory
Research
I have completed eight additional studies, both
quantitative and qualitative, most with col-
leagues, both funded and unfunded. In 1998,
Caroselli and I published a review of the power
as knowing participation in change research lit-
erature (Caroselli & Barrett, 1998); and Kim
(2009) published an update of the power as
knowing participation in change research in
2009. Currently, more than 90 studies have been
conducted using the theory and/or measurement
instrument. The tool has been translated into
Japanese, Korean, Swedish, Danish, Portuguese,
French, and German. These translations allow
CHAPTER 29 • Barrett's Theory of Power as Knowing Participation in Change 499
Material worldviewSpiritual worldview
Power-as-freedom
Awareness Choices Freedom
to act
intentionally
Involvement
in creating
change
Power-as-control
Numerous forms
Awareness Choices Freedom
to act
intentionally
Involvement
in creating
change
Numerous forms
Barrett’s Theory of Power as Knowing Participation in Change:
Spiritual and Material Worldviews
Fig 29 • 2 Barrett’s theory of power as knowing participation in change: spiritual and
material worldviews. (Copyright © Elizabeth Ann Manhart Barrett, RN-BC, LMHC; PhD; FAAN.)
3312_Ch29_495-508 26/12/14 3:33 PM Page 499
for testing a basic premise of the power theory
that the capacity to participate knowingly in
change is a quality of all people, regardless
of race, ethnicity, nationality, or country of
residence.
Practice Methodology
Shortly before finishing my doctoral studies,
I completed a postgraduate program in holis-
tically oriented psychotherapy to enhance the
knowledge gained through a MSN in psychi-
atric/mental health nursing and experience
teaching students and working in mental
health settings. So I began a private nursing
practice called Health Patterning as an alter-
native to traditional psychotherapy.
Soon I developed the first practice method-
ology for Rogerian nursing practice (Barrett,
1988). In the revised version, it consisted of
two processes: pattern manifestation knowing
and voluntary mutual patterning (Barrett,
1998). Butcher (2006) modified the method-
ology to include Cowling’s (1990, 1997)
methodology from his theory of unitary
pattern appreciation. Incorporating Butcher’s
revision, the two phases are termed pattern
manifestation knowing and appreciation and
voluntary mutual patterning. There is no se-
quential order; both processes are continuously
shifting and/or going on simultaneously.
Phase I: Pattern Manifestation Knowing
and Appreciation
My first question when someone sits down in
my office is “What do you want?” I’m interested
in knowing what changes people want in their
lives since that will be the focus of the health
patterning sessions. Relevant historical infor-
mation will unfold as our dialogue proceeds;
I do not take a typical initial health history.
Phase II: Voluntary Mutual Patterning
Another initial question is “Where do you see
yourself in your life right now?” If a person is
having difficulty zeroing in, I might ask, “If you
only had one sentence rather than 45 minutes,
what would you say?” As you can see, the three
principles of change are operating as we mutu-
ally explore the nature of change in their lives
(helicy) as well as the mutual process through
which the change occurs (integrality) and how
that change evolves (resonancy) as we focus our
intention on creating change without attach-
ment to outcomes or results. Intentions, aims,
or directions are consistent with the acausal
postulates and principles of the SUHB,
whereas setting goals involves end points and,
like outcomes, end points are not appropriate.
Clients learn quickly that there is no causal
“If I do this, then that will happen.” They
are often relieved to learn that the way this
works is that “If I do this, then I will see what
happens.” The phenomenology of the moment
is present-oriented with little focus on the past,
which is gone, or the future, which hasn’t been
created yet, nevertheless recognizing that we
are actually using our power to participate in
creating that future at every moment. There is
no focus on pathology or diagnosis. The idea
of power as knowing participation in change
helps people change limiting beliefs, disturbing
emotions, and other difficulties in living. Most
people easily understand ideas of wholeness,
unitary human beingness, and the mutual
process with the entirety of their environment,
including other people, places, and things. We
are not in charge of how things turn out as that
involves everyone and everything else partici-
pating, knowingly or unknowingly, in the
mutual process. Our power concerns what we
think, feel, say, and do.
Health Patterning
Quite simply, health patterning is exploring
with people ways to make the changes they
want to make. More formally, health patterning
is a power enhancement therapy that guides
people to use their power-as-freedom to partic-
ipate knowingly in creating the changes they
want to make in their lives by becoming increas-
ingly aware, making more powerful choices,
feeling free to act on their intentions, and in-
volving themselves in creating change. It is not
talk therapy. It is pattern manifestation knowing
and appreciation and voluntary mutual pattern-
ing coming alive in a moment-by-moment
unfolding process. How is that different from
talk therapy? The focus is not on simply “talking
500 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch29_495-508 26/12/14 3:33 PM Page 500
about”; rather, the focus is on the person’s
intentions and involvement in participating
knowingly in change. There are no labels, no
agendas, and no expectations.
My clients, for the most part, are people
who want some sort of change in their lives
that they haven’t been able to accomplish, even
when the change means accepting what cannot
be changed in ways they desire. Often there is
a crisis revolving around one or more of four
major areas of life: oneself, health, relation-
ships or career. My intention is to teach people
how to find the authority and clarity in them-
selves by becoming aware of their intentions,
by making choices from the options that are
open to them, and learning to give themselves
the freedom to carry through on their choices
as they go about creating change in their lives.
After initiating a dialogue of meaning and
asking clients to identify what they want to
accomplish in our work together by telling me
specifically three things, I ask clients to com-
plete the PKPCT. I tell them nothing about
the tool except how important it is to follow
the instructions. It is important that they
respond to the items honestly and frankly in
order to get an accurate, meaningful reading.
I point out that the tool is a reflecting mirror;
it reflects back to people who they tell it they
are. Afterward, I inquire about their notion
about what the tool is assessing; they are
usually shocked to learn it is power. This pro-
vides an opportunity to teach them the power
theory by briefly describing the definition, the
two types, the four dimensions, and a few
examples of the numerous forms in which both
types of power manifest. In the following
session, I will have scored the power tool
and can discuss the person’s Power Profile
strengths and weaknesses as well as ways our
work together may enhance their Power Pro-
file and facilitate accomplishment of what they
are seeking through health patterning. For
those who do not wish to complete the tool,
there are many other optional modalities.
This process is quite different from using
the PKPCT in quantitative research in which
the interest is in group scores and what is
learned is about the group, and group scores
can be compared with scores of other groups,
and all the other possibilities available through
quantitative methods. In Health Patterning,
the PKPCT scores provide the Power Profile
for one individual. This is a qualitative, phe-
nomenological process. I do not tell or show
the person his or her scores. The scores are
used only to help the nurse or clinician assess
the relative strengths and weaknesses not
only of the four dimensions but also of the
12 opposite adjective pairs used to measure the
dimensions. These 12 characteristics are pat-
tern manifestations of power and often repre-
sent a person’s belief systems concerning
power. Dwelling with this data is quite a com-
plex process. In the power-imagery process
(described later in the chapter), sophisticated
algorithms fine-tune the mechanics of the
method. The point here is that using the tool
with an individual is a mutual process of the
client and the nurse; a computer cannot dupli-
cate this human encounter. Power enhance-
ment occurs when the weaker areas are
reversed toward their stronger opposites using
various health patterning modalities and
Power Prescriptions.® This is not the work of
a day, yet the power tool can be a valuable
entrée to defining the person’s Power Profile
of greater and lesser areas of strength and pro-
viding direction for working with different
modalities, such as creating a shift to the
opposite, for example, from chaotic to orderly
or from constrained to free.
Health Patterning Modalities
When clients, like all of us, are attempting to
create an intended change, it is helpful for them
to understand the acausal nature of the universe
and appreciate the patterning manifesting in
their experiences, perceptions, and expressions
(Cowling, 1997). Interestingly, clients grasp
simple examples of acausality quickly as they,
like most of us, have learned that wanting
something to happen, certainly does not mean
that it will. It is often a relief to realize none
of us is the sole generator of what occurs in
our lives, and yet we can use our power to
knowingly participate in the relative present.
That’s where health patterning modalities come
CHAPTER 29 • Barrett's Theory of Power as Knowing Participation in Change 501
3312_Ch29_495-508 26/12/14 3:33 PM Page 501
in, yet these avenues for creating change in a
knowing way are not magic bullets. Nor does
one size fit all.
Even though the battle between free will
and determinism is believed to go back as far
as the pre-Socratics and continues to rage on,
the SUHB and Barrett’s power theory accept
the acausality of free will as a given. Power-
as-freedom is just that—freedom to powerfully
create change without interfering with the
freedom of someone else. Nor is power-
as-freedom about forcing yourself to do some-
thing you don’t want to do; rather, it is about
making aware choices, feeling free to carry
out those choices, and then doing so in a
way that is true to your values, such as those
that pertain to health and well-being. This
approach requires practice methods and
modalities to be consistent with this world-
view. It does not, however, require clients to
view the world in this way.
Health patterning modalities are general
approaches used to help people use their power
in new ways. The general focus includes lifestyle
changes, struggles with illness, difficulties in
living, and enhancement of power-as-freedom
through involvement in the healing encounter.
These modalities are selected within the con-
text of what is happening in a person’s life and
in relation to the nurse’s knowledge and skill
in using them as well as the client’s personal
preferences. They take place in a life affirming,
caring environment, described by Rogers as
unconditional love.
Examples of health patterning modalities
include imagery, Therapeutic Touch (TT),
meditation, dream reading, love-power reso-
nance, centering, prayer, power-imagery
process, Power Profile process, and techniques
of will. Imagery exercises can often be created
from the content of what comes up during the
session. However, here is an exercise that can
be used to focus on any intention that the
client wants to manifest. The title is health
patterning, and it incorporates light, sound,
color, and motion. These are modalities Rogers
believed would be frequently used in the
future. The intention for this health patterning
imagery is a change the person wants to make
in her life.
Health Patterning Imagery Exercise
Sit up straight. Get comfortable. Close your eyes.
Find yourself breathing in an even and regular
way with long, slow out-breaths through your
mouth and briefer in-breaths through your nose.
Breathe out with a long, slow breath through your
mouth, releasing pain and suffering, and through
your nose breathe in love and light. After breathing
out with another slow, releasing breath letting go
of any distress you may be experiencing, breathe in
the blue of the sky and the gold of the sun in beau-
tiful blue-golden light. Breathe out slowly one more
time and then breathe any way you like.
Now, see and know that your hands are made
of sky and earth. With these hands, you are able to
weave your own life. Know that you are able to
weave your own life with the threads and colors
you choose. See and recognize the working out
of the health patterning that your own weaving
is creating. In doing so, know that by freely
making choices with awareness, you are finding
your own way to powerfully participate know-
ingly in bringing about change. Now think of your
intention to create a specific change.
Breathe out one time. See yourself choosing
with awareness.
Breathe out one time. See yourself acting freely.
Breathe out one time. See how you are involv-
ing yourself in participating in creating the
change you want to see in your life.
Breathe out and open your eyes.
It is important after completion of any im-
agery exercise to ask the client how she is feel-
ing. If the person is uncomfortable in any way,
it is necessary to continue voluntary mutual
patterning to explore her experience, percep-
tion, and expression until comfort returns.
Health patterning modalities can be used in
most situations that nurses encounter. People
often come to me seeking relief from emo-
tional pattern manifestations related to physi-
cal illness. Other people come with conditions
that include pattern manifestations such as
anxiety, depression, grief, anger, fear, guilt,
troubling human field image, meaninglessness,
creative blocks, substance use dependency, dis-
ease prevention, eating disorders, many types
502 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch29_495-508 26/12/14 3:33 PM Page 502
of pain, pre–post surgical procedures, prosper-
ity or employment career concerns, spiritual
distress, end-of-life issues, or a combination of
these or other difficulties in living. The focus
is on people as unitary wholes with their
unique perceptions, experiences, and expres-
sions. The practice arena is ripe with opportu-
nities for nurses to research how the power
theory can be used to advance practice by in-
vestigating ways health patterning modalities
can promote healing.
Power Prescriptions
Power Prescriptions are the specific ways the
health patterning modalities are used with a
particular individual or group, as opposed to
the general category of health patterning
modalities. Again, they are designed to en-
hance power-as-freedom and are individual-
ized depending on each person’s wants and
needs. As power-as-freedom grows, the person
is less vulnerable to power-as-control tactics
from others or from themselves with others
and with themselves. This is one way people
heal. With enhanced power-as-freedom, they
find the strength to change limiting beliefs and
behaviors.
Power Prescriptions are not like medical
prescriptions. It is not as if you follow the pre-
scribed regimen expecting a particular result.
Rather than “if this, then that,” the aim of
Power Prescriptions is to guide people toward
developing awareness, making more powerful
choices, feeling free to act on their intentions,
and becoming involved in creating specific
changes in their lives.
Sometimes clients create their own Power
Prescriptions. A client whom we will call Julia
came to see me when she finished chemother-
apy for non-Hodgkin’s lymphoma. Sometimes
she creates her own exercises that often come
as images to her during Therapeutic Touch
treatments. Along with other clients, she
shares her remarkable story on my website
(www.DrElizabethBarrett.com) as a way to
contribute to the well-being of others. There
you will find an example of an imagery exercise
she created called “The Hapuna Chair.” To ac-
cess “The Hapuna Chair,” click on “What
I Do” on the menu bar. Then click “Real Sto-
ries. Real People. Real Power—Julia’s Story”
on the drop-down menu.
The Power-Imagery Process
The power-imagery process, or PIP as Gerald
N. Epstein and I named it when we began
developing it several years ago, basically works
like this. A person completes the PKPCT. The
findings, called the Power Profile, identify
the stronger and weaker areas of power. Then,
the client begins working through imagery ex-
ercises and techniques of will created to enhance
the weaker areas in both the four power dimen-
sions and the 12 power characteristics. This is a
three-step, 21-day process designed to enhance
people’s power through imagery. In the first
week, imagery exercises are focused on the four
dimensions. In the second week, the focus is on
the 12 characteristics. We call this process the
Power Plan, which is a way to create a shift from
lesser to greater power pattern manifestations,
for example, from chaotic or orderly or from
constrained to free. In the third week, the
process involves the PowerGram exercises that
put together the power dimension exercises from
the first week with the exercises for the charac-
teristics that were the focus during the second
week. We have used this process with groups in
the corporate and nonprofit worlds, with indi-
viduals in our private practices, and with group
workshops. An online version is available at
www.powerimagery.com. One nursing professor
required her students to complete the online PIP
as part of their professional development course.
CHAPTER 29 • Barrett's Theory of Power as Knowing Participation in Change 503
3312_Ch29_495-508 26/12/14 3:33 PM Page 503
504 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Practice Exemplar: True Stories of the Power-as-Freedom Journey of
Two Friends
Although all nursing experiences are mean-
ingful, some remain with us forever. So it
was with Allison and Kay. Allison and Kay
struggled with their own illnesses and yet
maintained a healing partnership with each
other even though their illnesses took quite
different directions; it was a mutual process
partnership that manifested love-power
resonance. Although it was many years ago
that these two young women crossed the
threshold of my office door to begin health
patterning, the memory lingers on. Love-
power resonance was the glue that united the
three of us.
Love-power resonance is a health pattern-
ing modality I developed to further understand
the nurse–client healing process—a way to
capture the meaning of the love that goes on
between the nurse and client. It is well known
that love heals—both the giver and the
receiver—while hate destroys, and the absence
of love hinders healing and can be deadly.
Love is the most potent form of power-
as-freedom, and hate may be the most intense
emotion motivating extreme forms of power-
as-control, such as abuse, oppression, and
murder. Love and freedom are intimately con-
nected, as are hate and control.
I believe that love is the fire that lights the
power-as-freedom furnace. In love-power res-
onance, the frequency vibrations of both love
and power accelerate one another, and healing
manifests through resonating waves of change.
The illusion of separation disappears, and the
will is used for intentional healing events that
enliven health. Love-power resonance teaches
people to become “in power” in the same sense
as being “in love,” where two people become
part of something greater than themselves and
healing manifests through resonating waves of
change. Helicy describes the nature of this
change, resonancy describes how this change
takes place, and integrality is the process
whereby the change occurs (Phillips, 1994).
In love-power resonance, love is like power
without effort—it just flows. It taps into
consciousness and spirituality, where con-
sciousness is defined as the Spirit in all that is,
was, and will be, and spirituality is defined as
experiencing the Spirit in all that is, was, and
will be. Phillips (2010) uses the term ener-
gyspirit to describe consciousness. I hypothe-
sized that love-power resonance created an
opportunity for change by accelerating the mo-
mentum of commitment to go forward with
one’s intentions, while acknowledging that the
outcome is unknown and unpredictable.
First came Allison shortly after she had fin-
ished surgery, chemotherapy, and radiation for
treatment of synovial sarcoma of the hip.
Allison’s picture and story are published on my
website at www.drelizabethbarrett.com.
Pattern manifestation knowing and appre-
ciation revealed that Allison was experiencing
bilateral foot drop and that she was walking
with an awkward gait that she perceived, ex-
perienced, and expressed as painful. It was ap-
parent that this was affecting her human field
image. After the chemotherapy, her latent ge-
netic predisposition to Charcot-Marie-Tooth
Disease (CMT) had emerged. Voluntary mu-
tual patterning included discussion of this de-
generative nerve demyelination disorder and
how it had produced a progressive muscle
atrophy of her legs, hands, and feet. A year
later the sarcoma reoccurred, and she again
underwent surgery and radiation. We worked
together for another year, and since then she
has come for a health patterning session occa-
sionally for what she calls her “power boost.”
Allison learned the power-as-freedom way
using imagery exercises, techniques of will,
prayer, and dream reading as her health pat-
terning modalities, individualized as Power
Prescriptions, to transcend the initial devasta-
tion she experienced with the cancer and
CMT. She used a daily imagery exercise in
which she imagined a magic wand tapping her
legs, ankles, and feet and bringing the nerves
to life. She remains cancer free, yet she still
struggles with the pattern manifestations of
CMT. She and her husband have two children,
3312_Ch29_495-508 26/12/14 3:33 PM Page 504
CHAPTER 29 • Barrett's Theory of Power as Knowing Participation in Change 505
Practice Exemplar: True Stories of the Power-as-Freedom Journey of Two Friends cont.
even though she was told if she had a child
she would spend the rest of her life in a wheel-
chair.
By the end of our formal time together, Al-
lison had decided to channel her fighting spirit
and advocacy for others toward starting a
foundation, the Hereditary Neuropathy Foun-
dation (HNF), to search for a “cure” for
CMT. HNF is now a thriving client advocacy
and research-oriented nonprofit organization
that provides educational information to per-
sons living with CMT, professionals, and the
general public. Allison had this to say: “Health
patterning helped me view my illnesses as op-
portunities for learning how to deal with life
circumstances, not as tragedies, but as experi-
ences that helped me become a more powerful
person” (www.drelizabethbarrett.com). You
can find the HNF website at http://hnf-
cure.org.
Allison met Kay as they entered the eleva-
tor of the building where they both lived. By
the time they arrived at their floors, they had
revealed to each other that they both had can-
cer; the seeds for love-power resonance be-
tween them had been planted. Soon Allison
referred Kay to me.
Kay began her almost-continuous, 10-year
battle with cancer when she was 21. First, can-
cer claimed her left breast, then the right
breast, then it went to the spine and other
bones and then the lungs and finally the brain.
Kay came to me for health patterning fo-
cused on Therapeutic Touch and imagery to
relieve pain at the time the cancer had spread
to her spine. Later, she became paraplegic
and was told by her physicians that she
would have to spend the rest of her life in a
wheelchair. She refused to accept this ulti-
matum. When she was no longer able to
come to my office, I began going to her
home to give her TT treatments, and she
also began to work with a physical therapist.
During one of the TT treatments, she sud-
denly cried out, “I can feel sensations in my
spine.” As the tears rolled down her cheeks,
she looked up at me and said, “This is what
I prayed for.” Soon she could walk with a
walker and for short distances with a cane,
and that was the last she ever saw of a wheel-
chair. She shocked the physicians the first
time she walked into their offices on her
husband’s arm, using just a cane.
During those sessions at Kay’s apartment,
Allison would often join us. Pattern manifes-
tation knowing and appreciation and voluntary
mutual patterning kept the sessions focused on
a dialogue of meaning. Here’s a brief sample
of how the health patterning conversations
would take place.
Kay: Why do we have to be sick when we want
so much to be healthy?
Elizabeth: Are illness and health incompatible?
Allison: What is health, anyway?
Kay: I’m confused.
Elizabeth: I see health as a process of actualizing
possibilities for well-being by participating
knowingly in change.
Allison: Can health be different for different people?
Elizabeth: Yes. Health is a value that people
define for themselves, so different people see
it differently.
Kay: I’ve known people who are sick or at least
have some disease, and I think they are healthy
in what I’ve been seeing as the bigger picture.
Allison: Me, too.
Elizabeth: Illness can simply be a way a person’s
health is manifesting at a certain time, some-
times serving as a wake-up call or a trigger
for transformation.
Kay: These new ideas are hopeful, and they are
giving me courage.
Allison: It’s hard not to ask, “why me?” Why
do Kay and I have to struggle with these
devastating diseases?
Elizabeth: Illness and disease can have many
sources and many meanings, and sometimes
those sources remain a mystery.
(Allison hands Kay a tissue to wipe her eyes.)
My efforts were not to get Kay to face her
so-called death or work through stages of
death and dying. My purpose was to help her
live the way she chose, and live she did. She
lived her dying in a power-as-freedom way
that was uniquely her own.
Continued
3312_Ch29_495-508 26/12/14 3:33 PM Page 505
506 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Practice Exemplar: True Stories of the Power-as-Freedom Journey of Two Friends cont.
On a few occasions, she asked me to tell her
what I thought it would be like “at the end.” I
told her for me there is no end, as we never
die; our energy simply transforms. We talked
about the fact that some persons who have had
a near-death experience describe a deep sense
of peace and well-being and they sometimes
describe passing through a tunnel of great
darkness into a bright light on the other side,
where a world of indescribable beauty awaits.
She asked questions such as, “How can I stay
alive while dying?” and “What about people
without illness who are dying or may be almost
already dead?”
Many times Kay talked about feeling a
sense of closeness with her spirituality that for
her connected healing with a sense of holiness.
This was a new way she was experiencing
her power-as-freedom, as a kind of prayerful
reverence. She often asked me to pray with
her. During this time, she also returned to
her religious roots and developed a personal
relationship with her God.
Kay needed frequent TT treatments, and it
wasn’t possible for me to go to her home that
often. So I decided to offer her an opportunity
to try a love-power resonance experiment.
I explained that imagery and TT are pow-
erful nonlinear Power Prescriptions that do not
depend on physical proximity and that healing
possibilities are enhanced when we leave the
visible realm of ordinary time and space and
enter the invisible realm of pandimensionality,
which is a domain where there are no temporal
or spatial attributes. I invited Kay to meet with
me over the phone for 5 minutes daily. We
agreed that during this 5 minutes we would
unite our intentions for her healing to manifest
in whatever way that might happen. We were
both clear that there could be no attachment to
outcomes; yet the pattern manifestations that
emerged included decreased pain, improved
memory, less disturbed sleep, unlabored breath-
ing, and an uplifted spirit. Over time, she came
to understand that healing is far more than
curing a disease; it is about healing the whole
person, and it is not defined by the presence or
absence of disease.
Some days, our 5-minute love-power res-
onance experiment consisted of a brief im-
agery exercise lasting less than a minute before
doing healing at a distance with my hands
hovering over a Polaroid photograph of her.
The imagery often incorporated the powerful,
pandimensional healing modalities of light,
sound, color, and motion. Some days, I asked
her to define a specific intention for her heal-
ing for that session. In keeping with our pre-
vious discussions, her intentions did not focus
on outcomes.
For the first year, we did what we called
“our thing” almost daily and after that three or
four times a week. Kay found this love-power
resonance experiment a meaningful way to
maintain her optimistic courage and relieve
pain and other symptoms despite the progres-
sion of the disease. She was an inspiration to
me, and we shared what Parse calls “meaning
moments” many times as she continued her
healing journey. Although she didn’t deny her
illness, she was healthy in spite of it. Cancer
may have ravaged her body, but not her soul—
not her energy field.
Rumi (1988) described the transformation
I witnessed as the months went by when he
said: Journeys bring power and love back into
you. If you can’t go somewhere, move in the
passageways of yourself. They are like shafts of
light, always changing and you change when
you explore them.
I asked Kay to remind herself that she was
living her power-as-freedom by repeating daily
the following power mantra: “I am free to
choose with awareness how I participate in
changes I intend to create.” The days turned
into weeks, months, and eventually over 2 years.
She often would tell me during our 5-minute
exchange that she was going into the hospital
for another gamma knife treatment or radiation
or chemotherapy, procedures she considered
helpful and “no big deal,” and amazingly she
quickly bounced back to her optimistic self.
Early on, Allison made a commitment to con-
tact Kay several times a week and was a source
of strength to Kay in ways that I could not be
since they had both experienced cancer.
3312_Ch29_495-508 26/12/14 3:33 PM Page 506
CHAPTER 29 • Barrett's Theory of Power as Knowing Participation in Change 507
Practice Exemplar: True Stories of the Power-as-Freedom Journey of Two Friends cont.
Finally, Kay’s husband called to tell me she
had been admitted to the hospital. When I
arrived, she was propped up in bed in a sitting
position, but hunched over with her forehead
near her chest. She was semiconscious and
hadn’t spoken for the 2 days she had been
there, although her husband and parents
thought she recognized them. Her family left
the room so that we could have private time
together. I asked her if she wanted to do “our
thing,” and she nodded her head. When I told
her we were finished, I was amazed that she
looked over at me with a slight smile. I held
her hand. Soon her husband came into the
room, and he and I were talking softly. All of
a sudden, Kay rose up and called out her hus-
band’s name, saying, “I love you. I love you so
very much.” He was overcome with joy and
ran out of the room to tell her parents and
brother who returned immediately. Kay called
out first to her father, “Daddy, Daddy, I love
you” and then to her mother and brother.
These were moments of love-power resonance.
She passed on 3 days later having completed a
10-year healing journey. In the words of my
imagery teacher of blessed memory Colette
Aboulker-Muscat, “The bridge between us will
always exist—now and forever” (Laura Gold-
stein, personal communication, January 10,
2004). For me, what I witnessed that day at
the hospital was evidence that imagery, Ther-
apeutic Touch, and prayer used during the
love-power resonance experiment had made a
difference in her healing.
The love-power resonance experiment was
not a scientific experiment testing the princi-
ple of resonancy; it was simply a process of dis-
covery that I sometimes experienced like a
laser moving in unison between us, focused on
our intention for her healing.
Love is a higher frequency vibration
rippling through the universe; it has greater
power to impact the universe than the lower
frequency vibrations of negative phenomena.
Everything we do makes a difference in
terms of our mutual process with all that
is. The more love we manifest, the stronger
the power to bring peace and well-being to
the world.
In closing, I am grateful that for more than
40 years, I have been privileged to be a profes-
sional nurse and to have experienced my pro-
fession by participating in the roles of
practitioner, teacher, administrator, and re-
searcher. Although all these roles were mean-
ingful, practice has always been my first love,
and Allison and Kay are two of the many
clients that remain in my heart.
■ Summary
In this chapter a description of the flow from
Rogers’ science of unitary human beings to
Barrett’s power theory to research and practice
applications is presented. Major assumptions
include (1) power is a phenomenon that exists
in the universe; (2) human beings are born
with power; (3) no one can give power to
another, and no one can take power away;
and (4) human beings have free will and can
knowingly participate in creating change.
The definition of power as the capacity to
participate knowingly in change was derived
from Rogers’ conceptual model and describes
both power-as-freedom and power-as-control.
The PKPCT measurement instrument and
the research basis for practice are reviewed.
Health patterning is a power enhancement
therapy that guides people to use their power-
as-freedom to participate knowingly in creating
the changes they want to make in their lives
by becoming increasingly aware, making more
powerful choices, feeling free to act on their
intentions, and involving themselves in creat-
ing change. Health Patterning modalities
are individualized by using Power Prescrip-
tions. A practice exemplar illustrates the way
the theory is used to teach people how to live
power-as-freedom.
3312_Ch29_495-508 26/12/14 3:33 PM Page 507
508 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
References
Barrett, E. A. M. (1986). Investigation of the principle of
helicy: The relationship of human field motion and
power. In V. M. Malinski (Ed.), Exploration on Martha
Rogers’ science of unitary human beings (pp. 173–188).
Norwalk, CT: Appleton-Century-Crofts.
Barrett, E. A. M. (1988). Using Rogers’ science of
unitary human beings in nursing practice. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 1, 50–51.
Barrett, E. A. M. (1989). A nursing theory of power for
nursing practice: Derivation from Rogers’ paradigm. In
J. Riehl (Ed.), Conceptual models for nursing practice
(3rd ed., pp. 207-217). Norwalk, CT: Appleton &
Lange.
Barrett, E. A. M. (1990a). Health patterning with clients
in a private practice environment. In E. A. M.
Barrett (Ed.), Visions of Rogers’ science-based nursing
(pp. 31-44). New York: National League for Nursing.
Barrett, E. A. M. (1990b). An instrument to measure
power as knowing participation in change. In O.
Strickland & C. Waltz (Eds.), The measurement of
nursing outcomes: Measuring client self-care and coping
skills (Vol. 4, pp. 159–180). New York: Springer.
Barrett, E. A. M. (1998). A Rogerian practice
methodology for health patterning. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 11, 94–96.
Barrett, E. A. M. (2003). A measure of power as knowing
participation in change. In O. Strickland & C. Dilorio
(Eds.), Measurement of nursing outcomes: Self care and
coping (2nd ed., Vol. 3, pp. 21–39). New York:
Springer.
Barrett, E. A. M. (2010). Power as knowing participation
in change: What’s new and what’s next. Nursing
Science Quarterly, 23, 47–54.
Butcher, H. K. (2006). Unitary pattern-based praxis: A
nexus of Rogerian cosmology, philosophy, and science.
Visions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing Science, 13,
41–58.
Caroselli, C., & Barrett, E. A. M. (1998). A review of the
power as knowing participation in change literature.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 11, 9–16.
Cowling, W. R. (1990). A template for unitary pattern-
based nursing practice. In E. A. M. Barrett (Ed.),
Visions of Rogers’ science based nursing (pp. 45–65).
New York: National League for Nursing.
Cowling, W. R. (1997). Pattern appreciation: The uni-
tary science practice of reaching essence. In
M. Madrid (Ed.), Patterns of Rogerian knowing
(pp. 129–142). New York: National League for
Nursing.
Kim, T. S. (2009). The theory of power as knowing
participation in change. A literature review update.
Visions: The Journal of Rogerian Nursing Science, 16,
40-47.
May, R. (1972). Power and innocence: A search for the
sources of violence. New York: Dell.
Parse, R. R. (1998). The human becoming school of thought:
A perspective for nurses and other health professionals.
Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Phillips, J. R. (1994). The open-ended nature of the
science of unitary human beings. In M. Madrid & E.
A. M. Barrett (Eds.). Rogers’ scientific art of nursing
practice (pp. 11–25). New York: National League
for Nursing.
Phillips, J. R. (2010). The universality of Rogers’ science
of unitary human beings. Nursing Science Quarterly,
23, 55–59.
Rogers, M. E. (1992). Nursing science and the space
age. Nursing Science Quarterly, 5, 27–34.
Rumi, (1988). The branching moments (J. Moyne &
C. Barks, trans.). Providence, RI: Copper Beach Press.
3312_Ch29_495-508 26/12/14 3:33 PM Page 508
Chapter 30Marlaine Smith’s Theory of
Unitary Caring
MARLAINE C. SMITH
Introducing the Theorist
Overview of the Theory
Applications of the Theory
Practice Exemplar
Summary
References
509
Introducing the Theorist
Marlaine C. Smith is currently the Dean and
Helen K. Persson Eminent Scholar at the
Christine E. Lynn College of Nursing at
Florida Atlantic University. Dr. Smith has
been a nurse since 1972 and has practiced in
acute care and public health settings in large
metropolitan areas and a rural small town. She
graduated from Duquesne University with a
BSN, the University of Pittsburgh with two
master’s degrees in public health and nursing
with a specialty in oncology and nursing
education, and New York University with a
PhD in nursing. Dr. Smith held faculty and
academic administrative positions at Duquesne
University, Penn State University, LaRoche
College, and University of Colorado before her
current position.
Dr. Smith is known for her work in two
areas: metatheory, or the study of nursing the-
ories and theoretical issues, and research
related to healing through touch therapies.
She has studied, written about, and conducted
research related to Rogers’s science of unitary
human beings, Parse’s man-living-health
(now humanbecoming), Watson’s theory of
transpersonal caring, and Newman’s health as
expanding consciousness, and has written
many commentaries on issues related to nurs-
ing theory development. She conducted five
studies examining how the touch therapies of
massage, therapeutic touch, hand massage, and
simple touch can affect pain, symptom distress,
quality of life, sleep, and other important
outcomes for persons in acute and long-term
care settings. The last completed study was
funded by the National Institutes of Health,
National Center for Complementary and
Alternative Medicine.
Marlaine C. Smith
3312_Ch30_509-520 26/12/14 10:45 AM Page 509
Dr. Smith has been interested in transtheo-
retical work—that is, looking across nursing
theories for points of convergence. The unitary
theory of caring developed while studying the
literature on caring in nursing, and then analyz-
ing this literature through the theoretical lens of
the science of unitary human beings. Dr. Smith
was the recipient of the National League for
Nursing’s Martha E. Rogers Award for the
Advancement of Nursing Science, is a Distin-
guished Alumna of New York University’s
Division of Nursing Alumni Association, and is
a fellow in the American Academy of Nursing.
Overview of the Theory
A significant body of literature in nursing
explicates caring as a phenomenon that is
central to nursing’s focus as a discipline and
profession (Boykin & Schoenhofer, 1993,
2001; Leininger, 1977; Roach, 1987; M. C.
Smith, Turkel & Wolf, 2013; Stevenson &
Tripp-Reimer, 1990; Watson, 1979, 1985).
At the same time, there has been a correspon-
ding body of literature critiquing the assertion
that caring is an identifying concept for
the discipline and that the existing literature
related to caring is ambiguous and provides
no direction for meaningful inquiry (Morse,
Solberg, Neander, Bottorf, & Johnson, 1990;
Rogers in Smith, 1988; Paley, 2001; M. J.
Smith, 1990). An analysis of the caring
literature revealed that caring was a multidi-
mensional concept that assumed multiple
meanings depending on the framework within
which it was situated or the lens from which
it was viewed (M. C. Smith, 1999). Paley
(1996) argued that a concept acquires its
meaning within the context of the theory
within which it resides. Concepts are theoret-
ical niches, and to understand a concept fully,
the theory in which the concept lives and
derives its meaning must be clearly explicated.
This chapter is the explication of a middle
range theory of caring within the perspective
of the unitary–transformative paradigm. For
this reason, the theory is called unitary caring.
This chapter contains a description of the
theory development process, the assumptions
underpinning the theory, the concepts and
propositions of the theory, the empirical
referents of the theory, applications of the
theory, and a practice exemplar that illustrates
the major concepts.
Process of Theory Development
This process of developing a middle-range the-
ory was guided by the question: “What is the
substantive domain of caring knowledge from
a unitary perspective?” Through a unitary lens
the question was framed as: What is the quality
of being in mutual process that is called
“caring” within other theoretical contexts? This
question was answered through a process of
concept clarification that evolved from Paley’s
assertion that concepts were niches within the-
ories. This concept clarification involved the
following processes: (1) identifying the existing
meanings of the concept in context, (2) identi-
fying theoretical niches, (3) synthesis of the
concept through identifying constitutive mean-
ings, and (4) instantiation of the concept (M. C.
Smith, 1999). Identification of the existing
meanings of the concept occurred through re-
viewing the literature on caring that described it
as a way of being. Exemplar sources (Boykin &
Schoenhofer, 1993; Eriksson, 1997; Gadow,
1980, 1985, 1989; Gaut, 1983; Gendron, 1988;
Leininger, 1990; Mayeroff, 1971; Mont-
gomery, 1990; Rawnsley, 1990; Ray, 1981,
1997; Roach, 1987; Sherwood, 1997; Swanson,
1991; Watson, 1979, 1985) were reviewed in
this process. From these sources semantic ex-
pressions, or phrases that captured the essential
meaning of caring as a way of being, were
listed. Next, the literature written by unitary
scholars (Barrett, 1990; Cowling, 1990, 1993a,
1997; Krieger, 1979; Madrid, 1997; Madrid &
Barrett, 1992; Newman, 1994; Quinn, 1992;
Rogers, 1994) was examined for existing
concepts that corresponded to the semantic ex-
pressions of caring. These were identified as
theoretical niches in the unitary literature.
Constitutive meanings, phrases that captured
the meaning of a cluster of semantic expres-
sions, were named using language consistent
with a unitary perspective. Five constitutive
meanings were developed (M. C. Smith,
510 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch30_509-520 26/12/14 10:45 AM Page 510
1999). Since the initial publication, the work
was expanded with assumptions and empirical
referents (Cowling, Smith, & Watson, 2008)
to form a middle-range theory. The theory
is connected philosophically to the unitary–
transformative paradigm, has five concepts that
describe the phenomenon of caring from a
unitary perspective, and can guide practice be-
haviors and research questions at the empirical
level (M. J. Smith & Liehr, 2008).
Assumptions
Assumptions of the unitary theory of caring
come from Rogers’s science of unitary human
beings (1970, 1994), Newman’s theory of health
as expanding consciousness (1994, 2008), and
Watson’s Theory of Transpersonal Caring
(1985, 2005; Watson & Smith, 2002). To fully
understand the meaning of the theory, readers
will benefit from studying these sources.
1. Human beings are unitary or irreducible,
in mutual process with an environment
that is coextensive with the Universe,
participating knowingly in patterning,
and ever-evolving through expanding
consciousness (Barrett, 1989; Newman,
1994; Rogers, 1992).
2. Caring is a quality of participating
knowingly in human–environmental field
patterning (M. C. Smith, 1999).
3. Caring is the process through which
human wholeness is affirmed and that
potentiates the emergence of innovative
patterning and possibilities (Cowling et al.,
2008, E44).
4. Caring is a manifestation and reflection of
expanding consciousness potentiating
greater meaning, insight, and transformative
ways of relating to self and others (Cowling
et al., Smith, & Watson, 2008).
5. Caring consciousness is resonating with the
pandimensional universe (Rogers, 1994;
Watson, 2005; Watson & Smith, 2002).
Concepts
After establishing the theoretical linkages to
the unitary-transformative paradigm, the five
concepts of this theory are explicated. The five
concepts were developed from an analysis of
literature on caring and similar concepts
described by unitary scholars. The theoretical
concepts have their underpinnings in each of
the assumptions.
Manifesting Intentions
Manifesting intentions is the first concept in
the unitary theory of caring; it was originally
defined as creating, holding, and expressing
thoughts, feelings, images, beliefs, desires, will,
purpose and actions that affirm possibilities for
human health and healing (Smith, 1999).
From this point of view, the nurse is a healing
environment, creating sacred space through
her thoughts, feelings, intentions, and actions
(Quinn, 1992). Understanding intentionality
in this way comes with an assumption that
underlying the world of form that is accessed
by sensory perception, there is the primary re-
ality that is pandimensional (Rogers, 1994)
and beyond access through the five senses
alone. David Bohm’s (1980) concept of the
holographic universe with implicate–explicate
orders of reality is consistent with this point of
view. The implicate order is the primary, un-
seen pattern, whereas the explicate order is the
manifestation of this underlying pattern that
is accessible through the senses. Caring is
engaging with both orders of reality, holding
intentions through affirmations and images,
and expressing these intentions through
actions. Thoughts, feelings, perceptions, and
images are as potent as our words and actions.
Intentions are meaningful energetic blue-
prints for transformation (M. C. Smith,
1999). What we hold in our hearts matters
(Cowling et al., 2008, p. E46). Manifesting
intentions encompasses actions that create
healing environments, preserve dignity, hu-
manity, and reverence for personhood, focus
attention to and concern for the other, and
facilitate authentic presence.
Appreciating Pattern
Appreciating pattern is the second concept in
this theory. It is apprehending and understand-
ing the mysteries of human wholeness and di-
versity with awe. This concept was referenced
CHAPTER 30 • Marlaine Smith’s Theory of Unitary Caring 511
3312_Ch30_509-520 26/12/14 10:45 AM Page 511
by both Dolores Krieger (1979) and Richard
Cowling (1990, 1993a, 1993b, 1997), and
defined by Cowling (1997) as “seeing under-
neath all that is fragmented to the real existence
of wholeness and acknowledging that with
awe” (p. 136). Cowling (1997) describes the
process of approaching knowing the other with
gratitude and enjoyment. This contrasts with a
clinical problem-solving approach. While
appreciating pattern is an existing concept in
unitary theory, it corresponds to many impor-
tant meanings within caring theories including
valuing and celebrating the wholeness and
uniqueness of persons, acknowledging pattern
without attempting to change it, recognizing
the person as perfect in the moment, being
sensitive to the unfolding pattern of the whole,
and coming to know the other. Pattern is
reflected in meaning, so finding out what is
meaningful to the other becomes primary in
knowing pattern (Newman, 2008). Appreciat-
ing pattern is coming to know the uniqueness
of the other. It is grasping the wholeness of
the other (individual, family, and community)
not through analysis, but through sensing,
coexploring experiences, and listening to the
other’s story. This happens through letting go
of preconceptions and the need to categorize,
classify, diagnose, or judge. When we resist
labeling and diagnosing we can glimpse the
dynamic being that is sharing this moment
with us. Appreciating pattern is being-with in
wonder at this work of art before us, this life
that reflects the diversity of creation.
Attuning to Dynamic Flow
Attuning to dynamic flow is the third concept
in this unitary theory of caring. Attuning to
dynamic flow is sensing of where to place focus
and attention in mutual process. It was origi-
nally described as “dancing to the rhythms
within continuous mutual process” (M. C.
Smith, 1999, p. 23). Caring is flowing with the
cocreated rhythms of relating in the moment.
It happens by being truly present in the moment
and is a back and forth movement of relation-
ship building through a “vibrational sensing of
where to place focus and attention” (M. C.
Smith, 1999, p. 23). This includes expressions
of caring and unitary relating from the literature
such as attuning to the subtle cues in the
moment (Montgomery, 1990), shifting per-
spectives and patterns of response (Mayeroff,
1971), relating in a complex synchronized inte-
gration (Gendron, 1988), and experiencing
energetic resonance (Quinn, 1992). It is hearing
the call that may be spoken or unspoken.
Newman (2008) describes the process of reso-
nance as a way of knowing that presents itself
through intuitive insights and feelings. Intellec-
tualization can actually break this resonant field
that is created through true presence. Caring is
not taking the lead and telling the person what
he or she needs to do. It is understanding where
the other wants to go and moving with him or
her in the struggle to get there. It is going to the
relationship without an agenda, a plan, a bag of
tricks, but trusting in the transformative power
of healing presence.
Experiencing the Infinite
The next concept in the theory is experienc-
ing the infinite. This concept is defined as
“pandimensional awareness of coextensive-
ness with the universe occurring in the con-
text of human relating” (M. C. Smith, 1999,
p. 24). This is described by many caring
theorists as spiritual union (Watson, 1985),
Divine Love (Ray, 1997), or an actual caring
occasion (Watson, 1985). Experiencing the
Infinite is the recognition that the nurse–
person relationship is sacred, we meet the
Holy in it, and when we are with others in
this way, there are no limits to the possibili-
ties. Miracles happen! There are miracles of
healing that happen with our patients every
day that can be potentiated through love and
caring. This can be recognizing who one
really is, appreciating the Oneness of Being
with all there is, and finding hope in the
darkest of hours. All of this is mediated by
our outlook, how we view our world, and
what we entertain as possibilities. William
Blake (1790–1793) said, “The tree which
moves some to tears of joy is in the eyes of
others only a green thing that stands in the
way.” Experiencing the infinite occurs in
moments of grace, experiencing the presence
512 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch30_509-520 26/12/14 10:45 AM Page 512
of God in relationship with others. In those
moments, there is an experience of connect-
edness to all-that-is extending beyond space–
time boundaries that defies description in
ordinary language.
Inviting Creative Emergence
The final concept in this theory of unitary
caring is inviting creative emergence. It is
attending the birth of innovative, emergent
patterning through affirming the potential for
change, nurturing the awareness of possibili-
ties, imagining new directions, and clarifying
hopes and dreams. This concept was taken
from Quinn’s (1992) description of healing
and Newman’s (1994, 2008) descriptions of
transforming presence. Descriptions of caring
in the literature that correspond to this concept
are a “transformative experience wherein the
constant birthing of love in caring actions is
the growth of spiritual life within” (Roach,
1987), allowing a person to grow in his/her
own time and way (Mayeroff, 1971), and call-
ing to a deeper life, the spiritual life, of each
person (Ray, 1997). Caring is inspiring the
other to birth oneself anew in the moment. It
might be through an activity, realization,
decision, a new role, a new life pattern. The
nurse creates a safe space for this new life to
emerge through supporting, coaching, and
providing confidence when it is lacking. This
concept relates caring to healing. Caring is the
vehicle through which healing occurs. Caring
takes trust and patience. People change and
grow in their own ways and in their own time.
They know their way and we journey with
them. This invitation for creative emergence is
gentle and encouraging. Quinn (1992) calls it
being a midwife to healing.
Propositions
The following are propositional statements
that further clarify concepts of the theory.
Manifesting intention is:
• Preparing self to participate knowingly in
cocreating an environment for healing.
• Focusing images, thoughts and intentions
for health and healing.
• Expressing intentions in actions that
support health and healing.
Appreciating pattern is:
• Seeing wholeness in perceived fragmentation.
• Valuing uniqueness and diversity of
patterning with wonder.
• Acknowledging what is without attempting
to change or fix.
• Exploring what is meaningful in the
moment.
• Coming to know by listening to the other’s
story.
Attuning to dynamic flow is:
• Being truly present in the flow of relating.
• Attending to the subtleties of meaning.
• Synchronizing rhythms of self with other.
• Trusting intuition in the mutual process.
Experiencing the infinite is:
• Acknowledging the sacred in human
relating.
• Believing in limitless possibilities.
• Igniting hope in despair.
• Connecting to a pandimensional universe.
Inviting creative emergence is:
• Honoring the unique timing, pace and
direction of change.
• Calling attention to possibilities and
potentialities hidden from view.
• Inspiring new life to emerge in the
moment.
• Trusting in the wisdom of knowing one’s
own way.
Empirical Indicators
An empirical indicator is a “concrete and spe-
cific real world proxy for a middle range theory
concept” (Fawcett, 2000, p. 20). It is taking a
conceptual abstraction and moving it to a place
where it lives...where it can be seen, heard,
felt, experienced, or measured. There are em-
pirical indicators for both practice and research.
Those for practice are useful in translating
the theoretical concept to guides for nursing
practice. Those for research can be used to
generate research questions, develop measures
CHAPTER 30 • Marlaine Smith’s Theory of Unitary Caring 513
3312_Ch30_509-520 26/12/14 10:45 AM Page 513
of the concept, or develop paths of inquiry
where the concept might be explicated through
experiences. Each of the concepts is discussed
at the empirical level.
Manifesting Intentions
As far as the concept of manifesting intentions,
nurses enter a caring relationship with intention,
through preparing to become the energetic
environment that potentiates healing. Nurses
prepare by centering or connecting to the True
Self, going to that place within where it is
possible to hear the still small voice. Nurses pre-
pare by focusing on the present moment, leaving
behind the thoughts racing in their heads that
interfere with being truly present. Nurses pre-
pare for caring by holding intentions that change
the vibratory pattern of the energy field. Marcus
Aurelius (171–175) said, “The soul becomes
dyed by the color of its thoughts.” The soul of
our practice is dyed by our pattern of thinking.
If we cultivate the habit of focusing, centering,
and setting intentions before any encounter; we
can create the space for caring and healing. This
way of being-with can be developed through self
reflection, expressing intentions through touch
and energy work, centering exercises, spiritual
practices such as meditation and prayer, mantra
repetition, and experiences in nature (Cowling
et al., 2008). The development of an inner life
is critical for the full expression of caring in
nursing. If caring is a way of being, nurses must
develop these competencies as much as any
other to evolve as caring beings. Rituals can
structure the process of setting intentions that
are manifest in the nursing situation. Watson
(2008) gives an example of creating a hand-
washing ritual in which nurses use this daily
practice as a way of centering and leaving behind
any thoughts that might interrupt presence.
Morning huddles are used in some settings as a
ritual to come together as a team and set the
intentions for the day. Nurses can develop rituals
related to giving report that signify the duty to
care (Cowling et al., 2008).
The concept of manifesting intentions can
be studied. Activities such as centering, setting
an intention, affirmations, meditations, prayers,
values-based decision making, and use of
mantras could be tested using any variety of
outcomes associated with nurses or their
clients. One could explore how nurse centering
before care influences outcomes related to
patient safety or how the handwashing ritual
described above might improve patient satis-
faction. One could study if there were healing
outcomes associated with Reiki, Therapeutic
Touch, or prayer because intentionality is
integral to these practices.
Appreciating Pattern
In a unitary theory of caring, nurses would
approach coming to know their patients in an
entirely different way. The nursing process, or
the problem-solving process, would not be
consistent with caring from this point of view.
It would involve knowing the other through
using the sensory and extrasensory abilities to
grasp wholeness. Nursing assessments would
include exploring the unique life patterns of
the person, exploring what is most important
in the moment, and hearing the person’s story.
Perhaps the first questions that we ask our
patients should be “What is important to you
right now?” and “What matters most in this
moment?” (Boykin & Schoenhofer, 2006).
Cowling (1997) and Newman (1994, 2008)
have both developed clear praxis methods that
focus on pattern appreciation and pattern
recognition. Nurses need to develop their
abilities to appreciate pattern. Skills of pattern
seeing, listening, grasping the essence, and art
and music appreciation correspond to this
ability of appreciating pattern (Cowling et al.,
2008). In interdisciplinary team conferences,
nursing is the voice that represents the whole-
ness of the person; no other discipline does
this. Instead of describing a community by its
census and health statistics, we can come to
know it by asking its members to describe the
essence of the community. Nurses can use
bulletin boards in patient rooms as places that
persons and families can display their unique-
ness and what is most important to them.
Research related to pattern appreciation
already exists (Cowling, 2005; Repede, 2009)
Cowling’s unitary pattern appreciation is a praxis
method (combines research and practice) in
514 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch30_509-520 26/12/14 10:45 AM Page 514
which he and the participant/client explore
patterning together; this is then captured and
shared through aesthetic expressions. Through
using Newman’s praxis method, nurses engage
persons in an exploration of the meaningful
events and relationships in their lives toward
recognizing pattern and making choices about
those patterns.
Attuning to Dynamic Flow
Attuning to dynamic flow is lived in practice
through sensing the readiness to begin to talk
about sensitive issues or the willingness to take
on a major life change. An example is staying
engaged with a person and family members as
they struggle together with the decision to
transition to hospice care. Another example is
knowing when a person needs the nurse to be
tough, urging him to get out of bed and walk
after surgery or to be soft, facilitating some
quiet space for a person to be alone for awhile.
Nurses need to cultivate their abilities related
to this through sensing, hearing and moving
with rhythms, presencing, and focusing.
Learning to listen for shifts and pauses and
learning to listen to and trust intuitive insights
is important. There are hospital myths about
the nurse who walks by a patient’s room and
knows that the patient is going to code. This
may be an example of being sensitive to
changes and shifts within a situation, attuning
to the information that is embedded in the
field of consciousness.
There are research possibilities related to this
concept. It would be interesting to study how
nurses attune to the dynamic flow of relation-
ship with an unconscious person or a neonate.
What are the cues that they pick up and act on?
What are the ways that they sense beyond
the senses to understand what is happening or
what is being communicated to them? The
study of intuition in practice is an example of
an empirical indicator of this concept.
Experiencing the Infinite
One example of experiencing the infinite is
seeing the sacred in mundane activities. It is
recognizing the extraordinary in the ordinar-
iness of our activities. This might be made
concrete by practice rituals that can help us
to recognize and celebrate the work of nurs-
ing. One such ritual that has been used is the
“blessing of the hands.” Another way to expe-
rience the infinite in practice is to validate its
existence through nursing practice stories. We
don’t take the time to really appreciate the in-
credible moments experienced in caring with
others. The sensitivity to experience the infi-
nite in our practice may be developed through
spiritual practice or a practice that fosters deep
reflection. This could be meditation, prayer,
centering, being in nature, or walking a
labyrinth (Cowling et al., 2008, p. E48).
The research questions that are related to
this concept might be studying nurses’ and
patients’ stories of the extraordinary moments
experienced in nursing practice.
Inviting Creative Emergence
There are many examples in nursing practice
that can illustrate how caring can invite
creative emergence. This can happen when
we help women become mothers through
teaching them the necessary skills to care for
their babies and help them to grow, or when
we connect people to resources in the com-
munity that allow them to live with greater
ease in the midst of a family crisis. It is help-
ing others live their lives differently and
discover new ways of becoming.
The empirical indicators for research might
be developing an instrument to measure
satisfaction or pride associated with life
changes. Studies could be structured to ex-
plore differences in outcomes when lifestyle
change is approached with a nondirective
model suggested by this concept, rather than
a structured directive approach to lifestyle
change.
Applications of the Theory
The middle-range theory of unitary caring
has been advanced as a model for palliative
care practice. Reed (2010), a palliative care
clinical nurse specialist, has described how
unitary caring is used as a guide for his prac-
tice. Reed’s (2011) dissertation explored
CHAPTER 30 • Marlaine Smith’s Theory of Unitary Caring 515
3312_Ch30_509-520 26/12/14 10:45 AM Page 515
experiences in providing and receiving
massage and simple touch at end of life. The
study was a secondary analysis of qualitative
interviews from persons with advanced cancer
who had received massage or simple touch as
part of their participation in a research study.
Three themes were identified from the data
that describe their experiences of receiving
touch: (1) pattern recognition and wholeness,
(2) caring relationships, and (3) transforma-
tion and transcendence. These themes were
related to unitary caring, the theoretical
framework for the study.
Unitary caring is used as a guiding theory
for studying nursing at St. Thomas University
in Houston, Texas. This program has a unique
curriculum model built on the tenets of unitary
caring.
516 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Practice Exemplar
Sue is a family nurse practitioner working in
a community-based family practice with a
physician colleague. She practices from a
nursing model, using theories in the unitary-
transformative paradigm as a guide for her
practice. Beth is a 55-year-old attorney who
has been seeing Sue for her primary care for
some time. She is waiting in the examining
room.
Sue has had a busy morning with time pres-
sures and some difficult patient encounters.
She is “backed up” with two patients waiting
for her. She approaches the examining room
and pulls out the chart. She smiles as she sees
Beth’s name. In front of the door, she pauses,
closes her eyes, takes several deep breaths and
centers herself, repeating her mantra. She sets
an intention to be fully and authentically pres-
ent with Beth in this encounter and to enter a
relationship with her that facilitates their
mutual well-being.
Sue opens the door and finds Beth sitting
on the chair fully clothed. Sue approaches her
warmly, holding out her hand and touching
her on the shoulder. She pulls up her chair and
puts the chart aside. “OK, Beth, what’s going
on? How are you?”
Beth talks rapidly, wringing her hands and
tugging on her sleeve. “I was on vacation last
week in North Carolina with my friends. We
were having a relaxing time, and as I was get-
ting out of the car I felt myself go into atrial
fibrillation. My heart rate went way up like it
does to about 270, and I felt just awful, like I
couldn’t breathe, lightheaded . . . I thought I
was going to die.”
“Oh, how scary . . . that’s awful.”
“I know. I ended up in the emergency room
of this tiny hospital where they treated me
with IV antiarrhythmic drugs, and finally my
heart rate went down, and I converted to sinus
rhythm in about 3 hours. But this is the third
time that this has happened to me, and the
second time when I’ve been away from home.
I just need to get to the bottom of this. I’m
frustrated and scared.”
“Of course you are,” Sue continues. “OK
tell me how things are going with you gener-
ally and anything unusual that you were doing
on vacation that might have precipitated this
episode.”
“Well, you know I had that episode of
diverticulitis before I left for vacation, and you
prescribed the Cipro for me. Well, I was not
feeling great on vacation, the pain was better,
but I had constipation, but took the Miralax
and the fiber that I always take. We went on a
boat trip the day before and I took some
Dramamine, too. Also, my friends and I were
drinking wine every night. That’s all I can
think of.”
“What about home and work?”
Beth looks down at her hands. “Well, Bob
still can’t find a job, and things have been crazy
at work. I just can’t seem to get ahead of it. I
have a major brief due in a couple of weeks . . .
It was hard to leave for vacation. I love being
with my friends, but I was torn about taking
the time.”
Sue pauses then says, “Tell me more about
this feeling of being torn between what you
love and what you have to do.”
3312_Ch30_509-520 26/12/14 10:45 AM Page 516
CHAPTER 30 • Marlaine Smith’s Theory of Unitary Caring 517
“I guess I’m in that space a lot lately, Sue.”
Beth begins crying. “I don’t think I’m doing
what I love to do . . . I feel like I’m not in
control of my life.”
Sue hands Beth some tissues and sits qui-
etly with her, gently touching her arm as Beth
sobs. In the moment Beth sobs for the loss of
joy in her life now, and at the memory of her
mother telling her she had to go into a practi-
cal career like law, not fiction writing. In the
moment Sue imagines holding and rocking
Beth in the space between them. In her mind’s
eye she whispers comforting words. In silence,
they both experience an intimacy that is
beyond language.
When Beth stops crying she looks up and
asks, “What do I do now?”
“Let’s take care of the A-fib issue first, Beth.
Are you still on the same dose of the beta-
blocker that your cardiologist prescribed?”
“Yes, Toprol 25 mg.”
“OK. I want you to get in to see the cardi-
ologist as soon as possible and discuss this with
him. You have some options with ablation or
other antiarrhythmics. You might want to talk
with an electrophysiologist as well. I’ll make a
referral. Also, I just checked the side effects of
Cipro, and atrial fibrillation is a rare side effect.
So taking the Cipro could have triggered this
event given your history. And of course
Dramamine and alcohol could have con-
tributed. And at the time this happened you
were just getting over diverticulitis and weren’t
feeling great. But, we also need to focus on this
distress that you are experiencing related to
your work. I’d like you to do some journaling
for a period of 2 weeks. Write down the things
that you love, your passions, what makes your
heart sing? Don’t overthink it, Beth. If you
have images or messages that come to you, jot
them down. Make an appointment in 2 weeks,
and we’ll talk about what you discovered. OK?
“Yes, OK.” Beth nods tentatively.
“Before you leave I’m going to listen to
your heart and check your blood pressure
again. Hop up on the table.” Sue auscultates
Beth’s heart sounds and measures her blood
pressure. “Everything is fine. Your heart rate
is regular at 60, and your blood pressure is
OK, but a bit higher than we’d like it to be:
130/82. I know you experience some “white-
coat hypertension.” We’ll check it again next
week. You check it too at the machine in the
grocery store and keep track. Bring that back
in 2 weeks too.”
Sue puts two hands on Beth’s shoulders. “I’m
in this with you. You’ll figure this out. Change
can be hard, but it’s how we grow. Anything else
that we need to talk about today?”
“No, I feel better . . . thanks, Sue.”
“Thank you! I’ll see you in 2 weeks.”
(The encounter took 15 minutes.)
The five concepts of the unitary theory of
caring were evident. First, manifesting intention
was visible in the preparation before Sue
entered the room. She was aware that she, as
nurse, is an environment for healing (Quinn,
1992). Sue set an intention and entered the
nursing situation being fully present to Beth.
She shared her intentions with Beth when she
said, “I’m in this with you,” and in her use of
touch and eye contact to communicate her
desire to be present and in partnership with
Beth. Appreciating pattern was evident as Sue
asks Beth about what was going on with her,
how she was, and if there was anything different
about the time that led up to the episode of
atrial fibrillation. Sue values the uniqueness of
Beth’s experience and Beth’s own insights about
events that led up to the episode, affirming that
Beth’s knowledge of her own pattern had
validity. Intuitively, Sue asked the questions,
“What about home and work?” and “Tell me
more about this feeling of being torn between
what you love to do and what you have to do.”
This second question emerged from Sue’s
tuning into meaning and resonating with the
whole, illustrating the concept of attuning to
dynamic flow. This led to the revelation of Beth’s
life pattern that could have remained undis-
closed had Sue not attended to the intuitive
flash. As Sue silently sat with Beth as she
sobbed, they both experienced an intimacy
beyond words, and a pandimensional awareness
of past–present–future in the moment. This is
an example of the concept of experiencing the
Practice Exemplar cont.
Continued
3312_Ch30_509-520 26/12/14 10:45 AM Page 517
518 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
infinite. Finally, when Beth expresses that she
is not doing what she loves, Sue is inviting
creative emergence by asking her to attend to any
cues she may receive about what she would love
to do and to record this in a journal. She asks
her to return for a follow-up visit in 2 weeks.
Often, the argument is advanced that
“there is no time to care in this way,” but this
encounter took 15 minutes, no longer than a
conventional, medically focused primary care
visit. It isn’t the time we have; it is what we do
with that time that counts.
Practice Exemplar cont.
■ Summary
The unitary theory of caring provides a constel-
lation of concepts that describe caring from a
unitary perspective. The theory is constituted
with five concepts: manifesting intentions,
appreciating pattern, attuning to dynamic flow,
experiencing the Infinite, and inviting creative
emergence. Assumptions of the theory were
explicated, each concept was described, and
examples of empirical indicators for practice and
research were offered. The unitary theory of car-
ing is new; it can grow through those who invest
in it through testing it in practice and research.
References
Aurelius, M. (171–175). Meditations.
Barrett, E. A. M. (1989). A nursing theory of power
for nursing practice; Derivation from Rogers’
paradigm. In J. Riehl (Ed.), Conceptual models for
nursing practice (3rd ed., pp. 207–217). Norwalk,
CT: Appleton & Lange.
Barrett, E. A. M. (1990). Visions of Rogers’ science-based
nursing. New York: National League for Nursing
Press.
Blake, W. (1790–1793). The Marriage of Heaven and Hell.
Bohm, D. (1980). Wholeness and the implicate order.
London: Routledge & Kegan Paul.
Boykin, A., & Schoenhofer, S. (1993). Nursing as caring:
A model for transforming practice. New York: National
League for Nursing Press.
Boykin, A., & Schoenhofer, S. (2001). Nursing as caring:
A model for transforming practice (2nd ed.). Sudbury,
MA: Jones and Bartlett.
Boykin, A., & Schoenhofer, S. (2006). Anne Boykin
and Savina Schoenhofer’s nursing as caring theory.
In M. Parker (Ed.), Nursing theories and nursing
practice (pp. 334–348). Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Cowling, W. R. (1990). A template for unitary pattern-
based practice. In E. A. M. Barrett (Ed.), Visions of
Rogers’ science-based nursing (pp. 45–65). New York:
National League for Nursing Press.
Cowling, W. R. (1993a). Unitary knowing in nursing
practice. Nursing Science Quarterly, 6, 201–207.
Cowling, W. R. (1993b). Unitary practice: revisionary
assumptions. In M. Parker (Ed.), Patterns of nursing
theories in practice. New York: National League for
Nursing Press.
Cowling, W. R. (1997). Pattern appreciation: The
unitary science/practice of reaching for essence. In
M. Madrid (Ed.), Patterns of Rogerian knowing.
New York: National League for Nursing Press.
Cowling, W. R. (2000). Healing as appreciating whole-
ness. Advances in Nursing Science, 22(3), 16–32.
Cowling, W. R. (2005). Despairing women and healing
outcomes: A unitary appreciative nursing perspective.
Advances in Nursing Science 28(2), 94–106.
Cowling, W. R., Smith, M. C., & Watson, J. (2008).
The power of wholeness, consciousness and caring:
A dialogue on nursing science, art and healing.
Advances in Nursing Science, 31(1), E41–E51.
Eriksson, K. (1997). Understanding the world of the
patient, the suffering human being: The new clinical
paradigm from nursing to caring. Advanced Practice
Nursing Quarterly, 3(1), 8–13.
Fawcett, J. (2000). Analysis and evaluation of contemporary
nursing knowledge: Nursing models and theories.
Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Gadow, S. (1980). Existential advocacy: Philosophical
foundations of nursing. In S. Spicker & S. Gadow
(Eds.), Nursing images and ideals. New York:
Springer.
Gadow, S. A. (1985). Nurse and patient: The caring
relationship. In A. Bishop & J. Scudder (Eds.),
Caring, curing, coping: Nurse, physician, patient
relationships. Tuscaloosa, AL: University of
Alabama Press.
Gadow, S. A. (1989). Clinical subjectivity: Advocacy
with silent patients. Nursing Clinics of North America,
24, 535–541.
3312_Ch30_509-520 26/12/14 10:45 AM Page 518
Gaut, D. A. (1983). Development of a theoretically
adequate description of caring. Western Journal of
Nursing Research, 5, 313–324.
Gendron, D. (1988). The expressive form of caring
(Perspectives in Caring Monograph 2). Toronto:
University of Toronto Faculty of Nursing.
Krieger, D. (1979). The therapeutic touch: How to use
your hands to help or heal. Englewood Cliffs, NJ:
Prentice-Hall.
Leininger, M. (1977). Caring: The essence and central focus
of nursing (Nursing Research Report). Silver Spring,
MD: American Nurses’ Foundation.
Leininger, M. M. (1990). Historic and epistemologic
dimensions of care and caring with future directions.
In J. S. Stevenson & T. Tripp-Reimer (Eds.),
Knowledge about care and caring: State of the art and
future developments. Kansas City, MO: American
Academy of Nursing.
Madrid, M. (1997). Patterns of Rogerian knowing.
New York: National League for Nursing Press.
Madrid, M., & Barrett, E. A. M. (Eds.). (1992). Rogers’
scientific art of nursing practice. New York: National
League for Nursing Press.
Mayeroff, M. (1971). On caring. New York: Harper &
Row.
Montgomery, C. (1990). Healing through communication:
The practice of caring. Newbury Park, CA: Sage.
Morse, J. M., Solberg, S. M., Neander, W. L., Bottorff,
J. L., & Johnson, J. L. (1990). Concepts of caring
and caring as a concept. Advances in Nursing Science,
13, 1–14.
Newman, M. A. (1994). Health as expanding conscious-
ness. New York: National League for Nursing Press.
Newman, M. A. (2008). Transforming presence: The dif-
ference that nursing makes. Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Paley, J. (1996). How not to clarify concepts in nursing.
Journal of Advanced Nursing, 24, 572–578.
Paley, J. (2001). An archaeology of caring knowledge.
Journal of Advanced Nursing, 36(2), 188–198.
Quinn, J. F. (1992). Holding sacred space: the nurse as
healing environment. Holistic Nursing Practice, 6,
26–36.
Rawnsley, M. (1990). Of human bonding: The context
of nursing as caring. Advances in Nursing Science,
13(2), 41–48.
Ray, M. A. (1981). A philosophical analysis of caring
within nursing. In M. M. Leininger (Ed.), Caring:
An essential human need. Thorofare, NJ: Slack.
Ray, M. A. (1997). Illuminating the meaning of caring:
Unfolding the sacred art of divine love. In M. S.
Roach (Ed.), Caring from the heart: The convergence of
caring and spirituality. New York: Paulist Press.
Reed, S. (2010). A unitary caring conceptual model for
advanced practice nursing in palliative care. Holistic
Nursing Practice, 24(1), 23–34.
Reed, S. (2011). Experiences in providing and receiving
massage and simple touch at end of life. Unpublished
doctoral dissertation, University of Colorado Health
Science Center School of Nursing, Denver.
Repede, E. (2009). Participatory dreaming: A conceptual
exploration from a unitary appreciative inquiry per-
spective. Nursing Science Quarterly 22(4), 360–368.
Roach, S. (1987). The human act of caring. Ottawa: The
Canadian Hospital Association.
Rogers, M. E. (1970). An introduction to the theoretical
basis of nursing. Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Rogers, M. E. In M. J. Smith (1988). Perspectives on
nursing science. Nursing Science Quarterly, 1, 80–85.
Rogers, M. E. (1992b). Nursing science and the space
age. Nursing Science Quarterly, 5, 27-34.
Rogers, M. E. (1994). The science of unitary human
beings: Current perspectives. Nursing Science
Quarterly, 7, 33–35.
Sherwood, G. D. (1997). Metasynthesis of qualitative
analysis of caring: Defining a therapeutic model of
nursing. Advanced Practice Nursing Quarterly, 3(1),
32–42.
Smith, M. C., Turkel, M. C., & Wolf, Z. R. (2013).
Caring in nursing classics: An essential resource.
New York: Springer.
Smith, M. C. (1999). Caring and the science of unitary
human beings. Advances in Nursing Science, 21(4),
14–28.
Smith, M. J. (1990). Caring: Ubiquitous or unique.
Nursing Science Quarterly, 3, 54.
Smith, M. J., & Liehr, P. R. (2008). Middle range theory
for nursing (2nd ed.). New York: Springer.
Swanson, K. M. (1991). Empirical development of a
middle range theory of caring. Nursing Research, 40,
161–165.
Stevenson, J., & Tripp-Reimer, T. (Eds.). (1990,
February). Knowledge about care and caring: Proceed-
ings of a Wingspread Conference.. Kansas City, MO:
American Academy of Nursing.
Watson, J. (1979). Nursing: The philosophy and science of
caring. Boston: Little, Brown.
Watson, J. (1985). Nursing: Human science and human
care: A theory of nursing. East Norwalk, CT: Appleton-
Century-Crofts.
Watson, J. (2005). Caring science as sacred science.
Philadelphia: F. A. Davis.
Watson, J. (2008). Nursing: The philosophy and science of
caring. Boulder: University Press of Colorado.
Watson, J., & Smith, M. C. (2002). Caring science and
the science of unitary human beings: a transtheoretical
discourse for nursing knowledge development. Journal
of Advanced Nursing, 37(5), 452–461.
CHAPTER 30 • Marlaine Smith’s Theory of Unitary Caring 519
3312_Ch30_509-520 26/12/14 10:45 AM Page 519
3312_Ch30_509-520 26/12/14 10:45 AM Page 520
Chapter 31Kristen Swanson’s
Theory of Caring
KRISTEN M. SWANSON
The Journey of Theory Development
Evolution of a Middle-Range
Theory of Caring
As It Progresses: Caring and Healing
The Journey Continues: The Couple’s
Miscarriage Project
The Connection Between Caring
and Healing
Summary
References
521
In this latest revision, I have kept just about all
of the content that was included in previous
versions of this chapter and have added some
updated materials. Most notably, I have added
a bit of information about results of a recent
randomized trial and some thoughts about the
connections between the five caring categories
and healing. For ease of reading, I have placed
the new material in the section titled “As It
Progresses: Caring and Healing.”
The Journey of Theory
Development
I have updated answers to questions posed by
students and practitioners who have wanted
to know more about the origins and progress
of my research and theorizing on caring. I
have situated myself as a nurse and as a
woman so that the context of my scholarship,
particularly as it pertains to caring, may be
understood. I consider myself to be a second-
generation nursing scholar. I was taught by
first-generation nurse scientists (that is, nurses
who received their doctoral education in fields
other than nursing). My struggles for identity
as a woman, nurse, and academician were, like
many women of my era (the baby boomers), a
somewhat organic and reflective process of
self-discovery during a rapidly changing social
scene (witness the women’s and civil rights
movements). Third-generation nursing schol-
ars (those taught by nurses whose doctoral
preparation is in nursing) may find my “yearn-
ing” somewhat odd. To those who might offer
critique about the egocentricity of my ponder-
ing, I offer the defense of having been brought
up during an era in which nurses dealt
with such struggles as, “Are we a profession?
Have we a unique body of knowledge? Are
Kristen M. Swanson
3312_Ch31_521-532 26/12/14 3:51 PM Page 521
we entitled to a space in the full (i.e., PhD-
granting) academy?” I fully appreciate that
questions of uniqueness and entitlement have
not completely disappeared. Rather, they have
faded as a backdrop to the weightier concerns
of making a significant contribution to the
health of all, keeping patients safe, educating
and retaining a supply of nurses prepared to
provide comprehensive patient-centered care
to an aging population with increasingly com-
plex and chronic health conditions, working
collaboratively with consumers and other
scientists and practitioners, practicing in a
highly technological environment, embracing
pluralism, and acknowledging the socially
constructed power differentials associated
with gender, race, poverty, and class.
Turning Point
In September 1982, I had no intention of
studying caring; my goal was to study what it
was like for women to miscarry. It was my
dissertation chair, Dr. Jean Watson, who
guided me toward the need to examine caring
in the context of miscarriage. I am forever
grateful for her foresight and wisdom.
I believe that the key to my program of
research is that I have studied human responses
to a specific health problem (miscarriage) in a
framework (caring) that assumed from the start
that a clinical therapeutic had to be defined. So,
hand in glove, the research has constantly gone
back and forth among “What’s wrong and what
can be done about it?” “What’s right and how
can it be strengthened?” “What’s real to women
(and most recently their mates) who miscarry
and how might care be customized to that real-
ity?” and “How can we measure the impact of
caring-based interventions on couples’ healing
after miscarriage?” The back-and-forth nature of
this line of inquiry has resulted in insights about
the nature of miscarrying and caring that might
otherwise have remained elusive.
Predoctoral Experiences
My preparation for studying caring-based
therapeutics from a psychosocial perspective
began in a cardiac critical care unit. After
receiving my BSN at the University of Rhode
Island, I was wisely coached by Dean Barbara
Tate to pursue a job at the brand-new Univer-
sity of Massachusetts Medical Center in
Worcester. I was drawn to that institution
because of the nursing administration’s clear
articulation of how nursing could and should
be. It was exciting to be there from day one.
We were all part of shaping the institutional
vision for practice. It was phenomenal witness-
ing our collective capacity as nurses, physi-
cians, respiratory therapists, and housekeepers
to collaboratively make a profound difference
in the lives of those we served. However, what
I learned most from that experience came from
the patients and their families. I realized that
there was a powerful force that people could
call on to get themselves through incredibly
difficult times. Watching patients move into
a space of total dependency and come out
the other side restored was like witnessing a
miracle unfold. Sitting with spouses in the
waiting room while they entrusted the hearts
(and lives) of their partners to the surgical
team was awe-inspiring. It was encouraging to
observe the inner reserves family members
could call upon in order to hand over that
which they could not control. I felt so privi-
leged, humbled, and grateful to be invited into
the spaces that patients and families created
in order to endure their transitions through
illness, recovery, and, in some instances, death.
After a year and a half at the University
of Massachusetts, I was still a fairly new
nurse and unclear what all of these emotional
insights had to do with nursing. I saw them
as something related to my spiritual beliefs
and me, rather than about my profession. At
that point, what mattered most to me as a
nurse was my emerging technological savvy,
understanding complex pathophysiological
processes, and conveying that same informa-
tion to others. Hence, I applied to graduate
school. Approximately 2 years after complet-
ing my baccalaureate degree, I enrolled in the
Adult Health and Illness Nursing program
at the University of Pennsylvania.
While at Penn, I served as the student
representative to the graduate curriculum
committee and, as such, was invited to attend
522 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch31_521-532 26/12/14 3:51 PM Page 522
a 2-day retreat to revise the master’s program.
I distinctly remember listening in amazement
to Dr. Jacqueline Fawcett as she spoke about
health, environments, persons, and nursing;
she claimed that these four concepts were
the “stuff” that truly comprised nursing. I
was hearing someone put voice to the inner
stirrings I had kept to myself back in Massa-
chusetts. It really impressed me that there were
nurses who studied in such arenas. Shortly
after the retreat, I received my MSN and
was hired at Penn on a temporary basis to
teach undergraduate medical-surgical nursing.
I immediately enrolled as a postmaster’s stu-
dent in Dr. Fawcett’s new course on the con-
ceptual basis of nursing. It proved to be one
of the best decisions I ever made, primarily
because it helped me to figure out an answer
to the constant question, “Why doesn’t a smart
girl like you enter medicine?” I finally knew
that it was because nursing, a discipline that I
was now starting to understand from an expe-
riential, personal, and academic point of view,
was more suited to my beliefs about serving
people who were moving through the transi-
tions of illness and wellness. It is safe to say
that I was beginning to understand that my
“gifts” lay not in the diagnosis and treatment
of illness, but in the ability to understand and
provide care to people as they lived through
transitions of health, illness, and healing.
Doctoral Studies
Such insights made me want more; hence, I
applied for doctoral studies and was accepted
into the graduate program at the University
of Colorado. My area of study, psychosocial
nursing, emphasized such concepts as loss,
stress, coping, caring, transactions, and per-
son-environment fit. Having been supported
by a National Institute of Mental Health
traineeship, one requirement of our program
was a hands-on experience with the process of
undergoing a health promotion activity. Our
faculty offered us the opportunity to carry out
the requirement by enrolling ourselves in some
type of support or behavior-change program of
our own choosing. Four weeks into the same
semester in which I was required to complete
that exercise, my first son was born. I decided
to enroll in a cesarean birth support group as a
way to deal with the class assignment and the
unexpected circumstances surrounding his
birth. It so happened that an obstetrician had
been invited to speak to the group about
miscarriage at the first meeting I ever attended.
I found his lecture informative with regard
to the incidence, diagnosis, prognosis, and
medical management of spontaneous abortion.
However, when the physician sat down and
the women began to talk about their personal
experiences with miscarriage and other forms
of pregnancy loss, I was suddenly overwhelmed
with the realization that there had been a
one-in-five chance that I could have miscarried
my son. Up until that point, it had never oc-
curred to me that anything could have gone
wrong with something so central to my life. I
was 29 years old and believed, quite naively,
that anything was possible if you were only
willing to work hard at it.
Two profound insights came to me from
that meeting. First, I was acutely aware of the
American Nurses’ Association (ANA) Social
Policy Statement, that “[n]ursing is the diag-
nosis and treatment of human responses to
actual and potential health problems” (ANA,
1980, p. 9). It was clear to me that whereas the
physician had talked about the health problem
of spontaneously aborting; the women were
living the human response to miscarrying.
Second, being in my last semester of course
work, I was desperately in need of a disserta-
tion topic. From that point on, it became clear
to me that I wanted to understand what it
was like to miscarry. The problem, of course,
was that I was a critical care nurse and knew
little about anything related to childbearing.
An additional concern was that during the
early 1980s, there was a strong emphasis on
epistemology, ontology, and the methodolo-
gies to support multiple ways of understanding
nursing as a human science; however, our
methods courses were traditionally quantita-
tive. Luckily, two mentors came my way.
Dr. Jody Glittenberg, a nurse anthropologist,
agreed to guide me through a predissertation
pilot study of five women’s experiences with
CHAPTER 31 • Kristen Swanson’s Theory of Caring 523
3312_Ch31_521-532 26/12/14 3:51 PM Page 523
miscarriage in order that I might learn about
interpretive methods. Dr. Colleen Conway-
Welch, a midwife, agreed to supervise my trek
up the psychology-of-pregnancy learning curve.
Evolution of a Middle-Range
Theory of Caring
Twenty women who had miscarried within
16 weeks of being interviewed agreed to partic-
ipate in my phenomenological study of miscar-
riage and caring. These results have been
published in greater depth elsewhere (Swanson,
1991; Swanson-Kauffman, 1985, 1986b).
Through that investigation, I proposed that
caring consisted of five basic processes:
• Knowing
• Being with
• Doing for
• Enabling
• Maintaining belief
At that time, the definitions were fairly
awkward and definitely tied to the context of
miscarriage. In addition to naming those five
categories, I also learned some important
things about studying caring:
1. If you directly ask people to describe what
caring means to them, you force them to
speak so abstractly that it is hard to find
any substance.
2. If you ask people to list behaviors or words
that indicate that others care, you end up
with a laundry list of “niceties.”
3. If you ask people for detailed descriptions
of what it was like for them to go through
an event (i.e., miscarrying) and probe for
their feelings and what the responses of
others meant to them, it is much easier to
unearth instances of people’s caring and
noncaring responses.
4. Although my intentions were to gather
data, many of my informants thanked me
for what I did for them.
As it turned out, a side effect of gathering
detailed accounts of the informants’ experi-
ences was that women felt heard, understood,
and attended-to in a nonjudgmental fashion.
In later years, this insight would become the
grist for a series of caring-based intervention
studies.
I have often been asked if my research
was an application of Jean Watson’s theory
of human caring (Watson, 1979/1985,
1985/1988). Neither Dr. Watson nor I have
ever seen my research program as an applica-
tion of her work per se, but we do agree that
the compatibility of our scholarship lends
credence to both of our claims about the nature
of caring. I have come to view her work as
having provided a research tradition that other
scientists and I have followed. Watson’s
research tradition asserts the following:
1. Caring is a central concept and way of
relating.
2. Multiple methodologies are essential to
understanding caring as a concept and way
of relating.
3. It is important to study caring so that it
may be better understood, consciously
claimed, and intentionally acted upon to
promote, maintain, and restore health and
healing.
Refining the Theory Through Research
Postdoctoral Studies
Approximately 9 months after I completed the
dissertation, my second son was born. He
had a difficult start in life and spent a few days
in the newborn intensive care unit (NICU).
Through this event, I became aware that in my
experience of childbearing loss (having a not-
well child at birth), I, too, wished to receive the
kinds of caring responses that my miscarriage
informants had described. Hence, my next
study, an individually awarded National Re-
search Service Award postdoctoral fellowship
(1985-1987), was inspired. With the mentor-
ship of Dr. Kathryn Barnard, at the University
of Washington, I spent over a year “hanging
out” in the NICU at the University of
Washington Medical Center (the staff gave me
permission to acknowledge them and their
practice site when discussing these findings).
The question I answered through the NICU
phenomenological investigation was “What is
524 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch31_521-532 26/12/14 3:51 PM Page 524
it like to be a provider of care to vulnerable
infants?” In addition to my observational data,
I did in-depth interviews with some of the
mothers, fathers, physicians, nurses, and other
health-care professionals who were responsible
for the care of five infants. The results of
this investigation are published elsewhere
(Swanson, 1990). With respect to understanding
caring, there were three main findings:
1. Although the names of the caring categories
were retained, they were grammatically
edited and somewhat refined so as to be
more generic.
2. It was evident that care in a complex context
called upon providers to simultaneously
balance caring (for self and other), attaching
(to people and roles), managing responsibili-
ties (self-, other-, and society-assigned),
and avoiding bad outcomes (for self, other,
and society).
3. What complicated everything was that each
NICU provider (parent or professional)
knew only a portion of the whole story
surrounding the care of any one infant.
Hence, there existed a strong potential
for conflict stemming from misunderstand-
ing others and second-guessing one
another’s motives. In many ways, this study
foreshadowed much of the current emphasis
in health care regarding communication,
transparency, protecting the patient experi-
ence, and sustaining safety through avoid-
ance of actions that result in bad outcomes.
While I was presenting the findings of the
NICU study to a group of neonatologists, I
received an interesting comment. One young
physician told me that it was the caring and
attaching parts of his vocation that brought
him into medicine, yet he was primarily eval-
uated on and made accountable for the aspects
of his job that dealt with managing responsi-
bilities and avoiding bad outcomes. Such a
schism in his role-performance expectations
and evaluations had forced him to hold the
caring and attaching parts of doing his job
unexpressed. Unfortunately, it was his experi-
ence that those more person-centered aspects
of his role could not be “stuffed” for too long
and that they often came hauntingly into his
consciousness at 3 a.m. His remarks left me
to wonder if the true origin of burnout is the
failure of professions and care delivery systems
to adequately value, monitor, and reward prac-
titioners whose comprehensive care embraces
caring, attaching, managing responsibilities, and
avoiding bad outcomes.
Caring for Socially At-Risk Mothers
While I was still a postdoctoral scholar,
Dr. Barnard invited me to present my research
on caring to a group of five master’s-prepared
public health nurses. They became quite
excited and claimed that the early draft of the
caring model captured what it had been like
for them to care for a group of socially at-risk
new mothers. About 4 years before our meet-
ing, these five advanced practice nurses had
participated in Dr. Barnard’s Clinical Nursing
Models Project (Barnard et al., 1988). They
had provided care to 68 socially at-risk expec-
tant mothers for approximately 18 months
(from shortly after conception until their
babies were 12 months old). The purpose of
the intervention had been to help the mothers
take care of themselves and control of their
lives so that they could ultimately take care of
their babies. As I listened to these nurses
endorsing the relevance of the caring model to
their practice, I began to wonder what the
mothers would have to say about the nurses.
Would the mothers (1) remember the nurses
and (2) describe the nurses as caring?
I was able to locate 8 of the original
68 mothers. They agreed to participate in a
study of what it had been like to receive an in-
tensive long-term advanced practice nursing
intervention. The result of this phenomeno-
logical inquiry was that the caring categories
were further refined and a definition of caring
was finally derived.
Hence, as a result of the miscarriage, NICU,
and high-risk mothers studies, I began to call the
caring model a middle-range theory of caring. I
define caring as a “nurturing way of relating to
a valued ‘other’ toward whom one feels a
personal sense of commitment and responsibil-
ity” (Swanson, 1991, p. 162). Knowing, striving
CHAPTER 31 • Kristen Swanson’s Theory of Caring 525
3312_Ch31_521-532 26/12/14 3:51 PM Page 525
to understand an event as it has meaning in the
life of the other, involves avoiding assumptions,
focusing on the one cared for, seeking cues,
assessing thoroughly, and engaging the self of
both the one caring and the one cared for. Being
with means being emotionally present to the
other. It includes being there, conveying avail-
ability, and sharing feelings while not burdening
the one cared for. Doing for means doing for the
other what he or she would do for himself or
herself if it were at all possible. The therapeutic
acts of doing for include anticipating needs,
comforting, performing competently and skill-
fully, and protecting the other while preserving
his or her dignity. Enabling means facilitating
the other’s passage through life transitions
and unfamiliar events. It involves focusing on the
event, informing, explaining, supporting, allow-
ing and validating feelings, generating alterna-
tives, thinking things through, and giving
feedback. The last caring category is maintaining
belief, which means sustaining faith in the other’s
capacity to get through an event or transition
and face a future with meaning. This means
believing in the other and holding him or her in
esteem, maintaining a hope-filled attitude, offer-
ing realistic optimism, helping find meaning,
and going the distance or standing by the one
cared for, no matter how his or her situation may
unfold (Swanson, 1991, 1993, 1999b, 1999c).
Developing and Testing
Theory-Guided Practice
Applications
As my postdoctoral studies were coming to an
end, Dr. Barnard challenged me and claimed,
“I think you’ve described caring long enough.
It’s time you did something with it!” We
discussed how data-gathering interviews
were often perceived by study participants as
caring. Together we realized that, at the very
least, open-ended interviews involved aspects
of knowing, being with, and maintaining belief.
We suspected that if doing-for and enabling
interventions specifically focused on common
human responses to health conditions were
added, it would be possible to transform the
techniques of phenomenological data gathering
into a caring intervention. That conversation
ultimately led to my design of a caring-based
counseling intervention for women who
miscarried.
Soon, I was writing a proposal for a Solomon
four-group randomized experimental design
(Swanson, 1999b, 1999c). It was funded by the
National Institute of Nursing Research and the
University of Washington Center for Women’s
Health Research. The primary purpose of
the study was to examine the effects of three
1-hour-long, caring-based counseling sessions
on the integration of loss (miscarriage impact)
and women’s emotional well-being (moods and
self-esteem) in the first year after miscarrying.
Additional aims of the study were (1) to exam-
ine the effects of early versus delayed measure-
ment and the passage of time on women’s
healing in the first year after loss and (2) to
develop strategies to monitor caring as the
intervention/process variable.
An assumption of the caring theory
was that the recipient’s well-being should be
enhanced by receipt of caring from a provider
informed about common human responses to
a designated health problem (Swanson, 1993).
Specifically, it was proposed that if women
were guided through in-depth discussion of
their experience and felt understood, informed,
provided for, validated, and believed in, they
would be better prepared to integrate miscar-
rying into their lives. The content for the three
counseling sessions was derived from the
miscarriage model, a phenomenologically
derived model that summarized the common
human responses to miscarriage (Swanson,
1999c; Swanson-Kauffman, 1983, 1985,
1986a, 1986b, 1988).
Women were randomly assigned to two
levels of treatment (caring-based counseling
and controls) and two levels of measurement
(early = completion of outcome measures
immediately, 6 weeks, 4 months, and 1 year
postloss; or delayed = completion of outcome
measures at 4 months and 1 year only). Coun-
seling took place at 1, 5, and 11 weeks postloss.
Analysis of variance was used to analyze
treatment effects. Outcome measures included
526 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch31_521-532 26/12/14 3:51 PM Page 526
self-esteem (Rosenberg, 1965), overall emo-
tional disturbance, anger, depression, anxiety,
and confusion (McNair, Lorr, & Droppleman,
1981) and overall miscarriage impact, personal
significance, devastating event, lost baby, and
feeling of isolation (investigator-developed
Impact of Miscarriage Scale).
A more detailed report of these findings is
published elsewhere (Swanson, 1999b). There
were 242 women enrolled, 185 of whom com-
pleted. Participants were within 5 weeks of loss
at enrollment: 89% were partnered, 77% were
employed, and 94% were Caucasian. Over
1 year, outcomes were as follows: (1) caring
was effective in reducing overall emotional dis-
turbance, anger, and depression and (2) with
the passage of time, women attributed less
personal significance to miscarrying and real-
ized increased self-esteem and decreased
anxiety, depression, anger, and confusion.
In summary, the Miscarriage Caring Proj-
ect provided evidence that, although time
had a healing effect on women after miscar-
rying, caring did make a difference in the
amount of anger, depression, and overall
disturbed moods that women experienced
after miscarriage. This study was unique in
that it employed a clinical research model to
determine whether or not caring made a dif-
ference. I believe that its greatest strength
lies in the fact that the intervention was
based both on an empirically derived under-
standing of what it is like to miscarry and on
a conscientious attempt to enact caring in
counseling women through their loss. The
greatest limitation of that study is that I
derived the caring theory (developed from
the intervention) and conducted most of the
counseling sessions. Hence, it is unknown
whether similar results would be derived
under different circumstances. My work is
further limited by the lack of diversity in my
research participants. Over the years, I have
predominantly worked with middle-class,
married, educated, Caucasian women. I,
as well as others, must make a concerted
effort to examine what it is like for diverse
groups of men and women to experience
both miscarriage and caring.
Monitoring caring as an intervention variable
was the second specific aim of the Miscarriage
Caring Project. Three strategies were used to
document that, as claimed, caring had occurred.
First, approximately 10% of the intervention
sessions were transcribed. Analysis was done by
research associate Katherine Klaich, RN, PhD.
As one of the counselors in the study, she found
she could not approach analysis of the transcripts
naively—that is, with no preconceived notions,
as would be expected in the conduct of phenom-
enologic analysis. Hence, she employed both
deductive and inductive content analytic tech-
niques to render the transcribed counseling
sessions meaningful. She began with the broad
question, “Is there evidence of caring as defined
by Swanson [1991] on the part of the nurse
counselors?” The unit of analysis was each emic
phrase that was used by the nurse counselor.
Phrases were coded for which (if any) of the five
caring processes were represented by the emic
utterances. Each counselor statement was then
further coded for which subcategory of the five
processes was represented by the phrase.
Twenty-nine subcategories of the five major
processes were defined. With few exceptions
(social chitchat), every therapeutic utterance of
the nurse counselor could be accounted for by
one of the subcategories.
The second way in which caring was mon-
itored was through the completion of paper-
and-pencil measures. Before each session,
the counselor completed a Profile of Mood
States (McNair et al., 1981) to document her
presession moods (thus enabling examination
of the association between counselor preses-
sion mood and self or client postsession
ratings of caring). After each session, women
were asked to complete Caring Professional
Scale (Swanson, 2002). Having been left alone
to complete the measure, women were asked
to place the evaluations in a sealed envelope.
In the meantime, in another room, the coun-
selor wrote out her counseling notes and
completed the Counselor Rating Scale, a brief
five-item rating of how well the session went.
The Caring Professional Scale originally
consisted of 18 items on a 5-point Likert-type
scale. It was developed through the Miscarriage
CHAPTER 31 • Kristen Swanson’s Theory of Caring 527
3312_Ch31_521-532 26/12/14 3:51 PM Page 527
Caring Project and was completed by partici-
pants in order to rate the nurse counselors who
conducted the intervention and to evaluate the
nurses, physicians, or midwives who took care
of the women at the time of their miscarriage.
The items included the following: “Was the
health-care provider that just took care of
you understanding, informative, aware of your
feelings, centered on you?” The response set
ranged from 1 (yes, definitely) to 5 (not at all).
The items were derived from the caring theory.
Three negatively worded items (abrupt, emo-
tionally distant, and insulting) were dropped
due to minimal variability across all of the data
sets. For the counselors at 1, 5, and 11 weeks
postloss, Cronbach alphas were .80, .95, and
.90 (sample sizes for the counselor reliability
estimates were 80, 87, and 76). The lower reli-
ability estimates were because the counselors’
caring professional scores were consistently
high and lacked variability (mean item scores
ranged from 4.52 to 5.0).
Noteworthy findings include the following:
1. Each counselor had a full range of presession
feelings, and those feelings/moods were, as
might be expected, highly intercorrelated.
2. For the most part, counselor presession
mood was not associated with postsession
evaluations.
3. The caring professional scores were ex-
tremely high for both counselors, indicat-
ing that, overall, the clients were pleased
with what they received and, as claimed,
caring was “delivered” and “received.”
4. One of the counselors was a psychiatric
nurse by background. She knew little about
miscarriage before participating in this study
and had recently experienced a death in her
family. The only time her presession moods
(in this case, depression and confusion) were
significantly associated (p ≤ .05) with any of
the postsession ratings (both client caring
professional score and counselor self-rating)
was in Session I. During Session I, women
discussed in-depth what the actual events of
miscarrying felt like. It is possible that the
counselor was so touched by and caught up
in the sadness of the stories that her own
vulnerabilities were a bit less veiled.
5. Session II, in which the two topics
addressed were relationship oriented
(who the woman could share her loss with
and what it felt like to go out in public as a
woman who had miscarried), was the only
session in which the other counselor’s
vulnerabilities came through. This coun-
selor had just gone through a divorce.
Her postsession self-evaluation was signifi-
cantly associated with her presession
moods: depression (p ≤ .05) and low vigor,
confusion, fatigue, and tension (all at
p ≤ .01). Also, most notably, there was
an association between this counselor’s
presession tension and clients’ postsession
Caring Professional scores (p ≤ .05).
Clarifying Caring Through
Literary Meta-analysis
I also conducted an in-depth review of the
literature. This literary meta-analysis is pub-
lished elsewhere (Swanson, 1999a). Approxi-
mately 130 data-based publications on caring
were reviewed for that state-of-the-science
paper. Through it I developed a framework for
discourse about caring knowledge in nursing.
Proposed were five domains (or levels) of
knowledge about caring in nursing. I believe
that these domains are hierarchical and that
studies conducted at any one domain (e.g.,
Level III) assume the presence of all previous
domains (e.g., Levels I and II). The first do-
main includes descriptions of the capacities or
characteristics of caring persons. Level II deals
with the concerns and/or commitments that
lead to caring actions. These are the values
nurses hold that lead them to practice in a car-
ing manner. Level III describes the conditions
(nurse, patient, and organizational factors)
that enhance or diminish the likelihood of
caring occurring. Level IV summarizes caring
actions. This summary consisted of two parts.
In the first part, a meta-analysis of 18 quanti-
tative studies of caring actions was performed.
It was demonstrated that the top five caring
behaviors valued by patients were that the
nurse (1) helps the patient to feel confident
that adequate care was provided, (2) knows
528 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
3312_Ch31_521-532 26/12/14 3:51 PM Page 528
how to give shots and manage equipment,
(3) gets to know the patient as a person,
(4) treats the patient with respect, and (5) puts
the patient first, no matter what. By contrast,
the top five caring behaviors valued by nurses
were (1) listens to the patient, (2) allows ex-
pression of feelings, (3) touches when com-
forting is needed, (4) perceives the patient’s
needs, and (5) realizes the patient knows him-
or herself best. The second part of the caring
actions summary was a review of 67 interpre-
tive studies of how caring is expressed (the
total number of participants was 2314). These
qualitative studies were fully able to be classi-
fied under Swanson’s caring processes. The
last domain was labeled “consequences.” These
are the intentional and unintentional out-
comes of caring and noncaring for patient and
provider. In summary, this literary meta-
analysis clarified what “caring” means, as the
term is used in nursing, and validated the
generalizability or transferability of Swanson’s
caring theory beyond the perinatal contexts
from which it was originally derived.
From Theory and Research
Back to Practice
In 2004, I was honored to be named a Robert
Wood Johnson Foundation (RWJF) Executive
Nurse Fellow. When I wrote the application, I
set the goal to “leave the comfort of academia”
and to make myself learn more about the world
of nursing practice. I realized that if my work
on caring was going to have relevance to nurs-
ing I needed to understand better what it was
like to practice as a nurse in today’s health-care
environment. I was delighted that Susan Grant
(at that time Vice President for Patient Care at
the University of Washington Medical Center)
agreed to mentor me. My personal mantra was
that I wanted to “help create the conditions
that enable nurses to work in accordance with
their core values of caring, healing, and keeping
their patients safe.” The journey I took as an
executive nurse fellow was extremely rewarding
and, at the same time, daunting. The world
of health care is undergoing rapid change.
The vocabulary, pace, politics, technologies,
locations, and challenges of health care are
changing at warp speed. I learned that in the
healthiest practice settings caring must take
place at the organizational level and at the point
of care. Institutional caring practices take the
form of continuous quality improvements that
strive to achieve the Institute of Medicine’s
(2001) call for health care that is delivered in a
safe, efficient, effective, timely, equitable, and
patient-centered manner. Providers experience
the rewards of knowing their work matters
when they practice in organizations that are
driven to constantly enhance safe, effective,
and compassionate care for patients, families,
and employees. As a result of lessons learned
through the RWJF fellowship, I now routinely
consult with health-care facilities where the
mission is to create and sustain a culture of
caring.
As It Progresses: Caring
and Healing
The Journey Continues: The Couple’s
Miscarriage Project
In 2009, we completed a National Institutes of
Health/National Institute of Nursing Research-
funded randomized controlled trial of the effec-
tiveness of three caring-based interventions
against a control condition in enhancing the
resolution of grief and depression for men
and women during the first year after miscar-
riage. This study included four treatment arms:
nurse caring (three nurse counseling sessions),
self-caring (three home-delivered videotapes and
journals), combined caring (one nurse counsel-
ing plus three videotapes and journals), and no
intervention (control). All intervention materials
were developed based on the Miscarriage Model
and the Swanson Caring Theory. We enrolled
and randomized 341 couples. Intervention find-
ings are reported in depth elsewhere (Swanson,
Chen, Graham, Wojnar, & Petras, 2009) and
briefly summarized here. We learned that
whereas resolution of women’s grief was en-
hanced through any of our three caring-based
interventions, resolution of men’s grief was only
helped by the combined and nurse-caring inter-
ventions. Women’s depression resolved faster
CHAPTER 31 • Kristen Swanson’s Theory of Caring 529
3312_Ch31_521-532 26/12/14 3:51 PM Page 529
when they received the nurse caring interven-
tion. Men’s depression was not affected by
receipt of three counseling sessions (there was
no significant difference from the control group)
and appeared to be slowed by receipt of the com-
bined caring or self-caring interventions (their
resolution of depression took longer than the
control group). Additional research needs to be
done to identify who is most likely to experience
depression during the first year after miscarriage
so that the right intervention may be offered.
The Connection Between Caring
and Healing
It is hard to believe that the caring model was
first proposed almost 30 years ago. There
are now scientists, practitioners, and educa-
tors around the world who are applying the
caring theory in their work. Reflecting back
on the work we did to understand how
couples evaluated our caring interventions,
considering the lessons learned through
consulting with nurses and other providers
seeking to change the culture of care, and in-
tegrating the writings and findings of others
who have explored the caring processes and
their impact, I now propose that there are
some logical links between the caring
processes and healing outcomes. Using the
language of provider to mean the one who is
practicing caring and recipient to mean the
one who is receiving caring, I offer the
following model (Fig. 31-1) and thoughts
about the connections between the caring
processes and experiences of healing.
When providers strive to understand the
recipient’s experience (e.g., knowing), the re-
cipient has the feeling of not only being under-
stood but, possibly, also understanding their
own experiences more fully. When the provider
is able to be with the recipient through times
of sorrow, frustration, suffering, and joy, the
recipient feels valued by the provider and
perceives that they and their experiences matter
to the provider. When the provider seeks to
do for the recipient what he or she would do
independently if they had the knowledge, time,
energy, capacity, or skills to do so, the recipient
feels safe and comforted. When the provider
enables the other’s capacity to manage a situa-
tion by providing information, validation, and
support, the recipient feels capable to get
through the challenge before them. Lastly,
and at the very core of caring, when the
provider maintains belief in the other’s capacity
to come through an event or transition and
face a future with meaning, the recipient feels
hopeful (as opposed to hopeless). This hope does
not mean that sickness, sorrow, fear, or loss will
not unfold as it must; rather, it is hope that
the recipient will be able to get through the
situation and find meaning and purpose in
whatever comes next. In summary, when a
provider takes the time to know, be with, do for,
enable, and maintain belief in the other, the
recipient feels a sense of wholeness - that is
they feel understood, valued, safe and comforted,
capable, and hopeful for the future. I believe
caring and healing is possible whenever a
provider acts with the recipient’s best interests
530 SECTION VI • Middle-Range Theories
Maintaing belief
Safe and
comforted
Understood
Knowing
Doing for Enabling
Being with
Valued
Hopeful
Capable
Fig 31 • 1 Swanson theory of
caring and healing. (Copyright ©
Kristen N. Swanson, 2013.)
3312_Ch31_521-532 26/12/14 3:51 PM Page 530
in mind. Caring can be enacted at the bedside,
in the community, in the boardroom, or in the
legislature. The measure of caring’s worth is
determined by whether it leads to the recipient
feeling seen and intact (or enhanced) versus
diminished and dismissed.
CHAPTER 31 • Kristen Swanson’s Theory of Caring 531
References
American Nurses’ Association (ANA). (1980). Nursing: A
social policy statement. Kansas City, MO: American
Nurses’ Association.
Barnard, K. E., Magyary, D., Sumner, G., Booth, C. L.,
Mitchell, S. K., & Spieker, S. (1988). Prevention of
parenting alterations for women with low social
support. Psychiatry, 51, 248-253.
Institute of Medicine of the National Academies.
(2001). Crossing the quality chasm: A new health system
for the 21st century (report brief). Retrieved January
29, 2008, from www.iom.edu/CMS/8089/5432/
27184.aspx
McNair, D. M., Lorr, M., & Droppleman, L. F. (1981).
Profile of mood states: Manual. San Diego, CA:
Educational and Industrial Testing Service.
Rosenberg, M. (1965). Society and the adolescent self-
image. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Swanson, K. M. (1990). Providing care in the NICU:
Sometimes an act of love. Advances in Nursing
Science, 13(1), 60-73.
Swanson, K. M. (1991). Empirical development of a
middle-range theory of caring. Nursing Research,
40, 161-166.
Swanson, K. M. (1993). Nursing as informed caring for
the well-being of others. Image, 25, 352-357.
Swanson, K. M. (1999a). What’s known about caring in
nursing science: A literary meta-analysis. In: A. S.
Hinshaw, S. Feetham, & J. Shaver (Eds)., Handbook
of clinical nursing research. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Swanson, K. M. (1999b). The effects of caring, measure-
ment, and time on miscarriage impact and women’s
well-being in the first year subsequent to loss. Nursing
Research, 48, 6, 288-298.
Swanson, K. M. (1999c). Research-based practice with
women who miscarry. Image: Journal of Nursing
Scholarship, 31, 4, 339-345.
Swanson, K. M. (2002). Caring Profession Scale. In:
J. Watson (Ed.), Assessing and measuring caring in
nursing and health science. New York: Springer.
Swanson, K. M., Chen, H. T., Graham, J. C.,
Wojnar, D. M., & Petras, A. (2009). Resolution
of depression and grief during the first year after
miscarriage: A randomized controlled clinical trial of
couples-focused interventions. Journal Women’s Health
and Gender-based Medicine, 18(8), 1245-1257.
Retrieved from www.liebertonline.com/doi/abs/
10.1089/jwh.2008.1202
Swanson-Kauffman, K. M. (1986a). A combined quali-
tative methodology for nursing research. Advances in
Nursing Science, 8(3), 58-69.
Swanson-Kauffman, K. M. (1986b). Caring in the
instance of unexpected early pregnancy loss. Topics
in Clinical Nursing, 8(2), 37-46.
Swanson-Kauffman, K. M. (1985). Miscarriage: A new
understanding of the mother’s experience. Proceedings
of the 50th anniversary celebration of the University of
Pennsylvania School of Nursing, 63-78.
Swanson-Kauffman, K. M. (1988). The caring needs
of women who miscarry. In M. M. Leininger
(Ed.), Care: Discovery and uses in clinical and
community nursing. Detroit, MI: Wayne State
University Press.
Swanson-Kauffman, K. M. (1983). The unborn one: The
human experience of miscarriage. Doctoral dissertation,
University of Colorado Health Sciences Center, 1983.
Dissertation Abstracts International, 43, AAT8404456.
Watson, M. J. (1985/1988). Nursing: Human science and
human care. New York: National League for Nursing
Press.
Watson, M. J. (1979/1985). Nursing: The philosophy and
science of caring. Boulder, CO: Colorado Associated
Press.
3312_Ch31_521-532 26/12/14 3:51 PM Page 531
3312_Ch31_521-532 26/12/14 3:51 PM Page 532
culture. See Theory of Culture Care Diversity and
Universality
Duffy’s model of. See Quality Caring Model
in Hall’s model of nursing, 59f, 60
in Human-to-Human Relationship Model, 76–77
Leininger’s theory of. See Theory of Culture Care
Diversity and Universality
Locsin’s theory of. See Technological Competency as
Caring
in Nightingale’s work, 49
Smith’s theory of. See Theory of Unitary Caring
Swanson’s theory of. See Theory of Caring
Watson’s theory of. See Theory of Human Caring
Caring Professional Scale, 527–528
Caring Science as Sacred Science (Watson), 322
Caritas nursing, 322, 323–324
Change, 12–13
transition triggers, 364f, 365–366, 372–373
Choice points, in Theory of Health as Expanding
Consciousness, 288–290, 289f, 290f
Christian feminist, 47
Client, 5
Client-nurse encounter, 5. See also Dynamic Nurse-
Patient Relationship Theory; Nurse-
patient/client relationship; Nurse-Patient
Relationship Theory
Clinical Nursing: A Helping Art (Wiedenbach), 61–62
Collaborative care, 312–313
Collected Works of Florence Nightingale, 37, 49
Comfort Theory, 382–390
application of, 385–389
best policy in, 385, 388–389
best practices in, 385, 388
care plans in, 385
coaching in, 385
Comfort Contract in, 392
comfort definition in, 384
comfort interventions in, 384
concepts of, 383–384, 384f
contexts in, 382
ease in, 382
electronic data base in, 388–389
health care needs in, 384–385
health-seeking behaviors in, 384–385
institutional advocacy in, 386–387
institutional awards in, 387
institutional integrity in, 385
intention in, 386
intervening variables in, 384
nursing practice in, 386, 388
practice exemplar of, 389–390
relief in, 382
A
Adaptation
Johnson Behavioral System Model, 91–92
Roy model of. See Roy Adaptation Model
Adaptive potential, in Modeling and Role-Modeling
theory, 191–192, 192f
Administration
Johnson Behavioral System Model application to,
99–100
Neuman Systems Model application to, 176
Aesthetic knowing, 29, 214–215
Affiliation, 190–191
Aging
in Theory of Accelerating Evolution, 240–241
in Theory of Goal Attainment, 142
American Holistic Nurses Association, 210
Anger, in morbid grief, 194
Anti-coagulants, 45
Arousal, stress-related, 192, 192f
Assessing and Measuring Caring in Nursing and Health
Sciences (Watson), 322
Attending Caring Team, 334–337
Attending Nurse Caring Model, 332–334
Awareness
in nursing theory selection, 28
in Quality Caring Model, 398
in Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness, 283
B
Barrett, Elizabeth Ann Manhart, 497–498. See also Theory
of Power as Knowing Participation in Change
Barry, Charlotte D., 435–436. See also Community
Nursing Practice Model
Basic Principles of Nursing Care (Henderson), 62
Bearing witness, 223
Behavioral System Model. See Johnson Behavioral
System Model
Beliefs, 6, 24. See also Values
Bentov, Itzhak, 281, 282, 284
Boykin, Anne, 341–342. See also Nursing as Caring
Theory
Bureaucracy, 466–468. See also Theory of Bureaucratic
Caring
C
Care, Cure, and Core Model, 59–61, 59f
practice application of, 63
Care/caring, 5
Boykin and Schoenhofer’s theory of. See Nursing as
Caring Theory
bureaucratic. See Theory of Bureaucratic Caring
Index
Note: Page numbers followed by f refer to figures; page numbers followed by t refer to tables; page numbers followed by
b refer to boxes.
533
3312_Index_533-544 26/12/14 11:04 AM Page 533
D
Death
grieving response to, 192–194, 194t
in Theory of Integral Nursing, 222
Debriefing, 369
Developmental processes
in Modeling and Role-Modeling theory, 194–195,
195t
in Theory of Integral Nursing, 211, 217–218, 220f
Disease, origin of, 45
Dissipative structures, theory of, 288, 289f
Diversity of Human Field Pattern Scale, 251
Domain, 4–5
Dossey, Barbara, 207–208. See also Theory of Integral
Nursing
Dream Experience Scale, 251
Drives, 189–190, 190t
Duffy, Joanne, 393–394. See also Quality Caring Model
Dying
conscious, 222
in Theory of Integral Nursing, 222
Dynamic Nurse-Patient Relationship: Function, Process and
Principles, The (Orlando), 82
Dynamic Nurse-Patient Relationship Theory, 82
practice applications of, 82–84
E
Education, 6
Community Nursing Practice Model, 441–442
of Florence Nightingale, 38–39
Humanbecoming Paradigm and, 273
Johnson Behavioral System Model and, 99
Neuman Systems Model and, 175–176
on nurse-patient relationship, 69
Nursing as Caring Theory and, 350
theory-guided nursing practice and, 33
Theory of Bureaucratic Caring and, 477
Theory of Culture Care Diversity and Universality
and, 313
Theory of Goal Attainment and, 140
Theory of Human Caring and, 335
Theory of Integral Nursing and, 225
Transitions Theory and, 371
Emancipation, of women, 47
Emancipatory knowing, 29–30
Empathy, in Human-to-Human Relationship Model,
78
Energyspirit, 244
Environment, 5
Community Nursing Practice Model, 438
Johnson Behavioral System Model, 93, 95–96
Modeling and Role-Modeling Theory, 189–191
Neuman Systems Model, 171–172, 171f
Nightingale model, 45–46
Quality Caring Model, 439
Roy Adaptation Model, 158
Theory of Integral Nursing, 213–214, 213f, 220f, 224
Epigenesis, in Modeling and Role-Modeling theory,
195
taxonomic structure of, 382–383, 383f
technical interventions in, 385
transcendence in, 382
value-added outcomes in, 386
wow moments in, 386
Comfort Theory and Practice (Kolcaba), 381
Communication
integral, 224
nonverbal, 198
nursing discipline, 6
Community
Community Nursing Practice Model, 437–438,
439
Humanbecoming Paradigm, 271–273
Self-Care Deficit Theory, 117
Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness,
294–295
Community Nursing Practice Model, 436–446
application of, 441–442, 442t–445t
community in, 437–438, 439
core services in, 439, 440
development of, 436
in education, 441–442
environment in, 438
evaluation and, 440
first circle services in, 439, 440
foundations of, 436
nursing in, 437
person in, 437, 439
policy development and, 439–440
practice exemplar of, 445
second circle services in, 439–440
services in, 438–440, 439f
third circle services in, 440
Compassion, 223
Complexity theory, 468–469
Concept development, 135–136
Conceptual models, 13
analysis of, 31
evaluation of, 31
Conceptual structures, of nursing discipline, 5–6
Conscious dying, 222
Consciousness. See Theory of Health as Expanding
Consciousness
Contagionism, 45
Couple’s Miscarriage Project, 529–530
Creating a Caring Science Curriculum: Emancipatory
Pedagogies (Hills and Watson), 322
Crimean War, 40–44, 41f, 43f
Critical points, 368
Cultural feminism, 47
Culture. See also Theory of Culture Care Diversity and
Universality
nursing theory and, 15–16
organization, 466–468
in Theory of Goal Attainment, 141
in Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness,
291
Curiosity, 20
534 Index
3312_Index_533-544 26/12/14 11:04 AM Page 534
Index 535
Neuman Systems Model, 172
Roy Adaptation Model, 158–159
Theory of Goal Attainment, 143
Theory of Integral Nursing, 213, 213f, 220f, 224
Health Goal Attainment instrument, 139
Health patterning, 500–501
modalities, 501–503
Henderson, Virginia, 56
basic nursing care components of, 58–59, 63–64
nursing definition of, 58–59, 62–63
Hierarchy, 92
Holistic person, in Modeling and Role-Modeling
theory, 190–191, 197
Home, family, 46–48
Homeorrhesis, 91
Homo pandimensionalis, 244
Honesty, 20
Hope, 77
Humanbecoming Paradigm, 264–274
art of, 269–273
change in, 268
community settings of, 271–273
eighty/twenty (80/20) model of, 272
language in, 268
in nursing education, 285
nursing in, 264–265
nursing practice in, 270, 271–273
parish nursing in, 272–273
philosophical assumptions of, 266–267
postulates of, 267–268
principles of, 267–268
reality construction in, 268
relating in, 268
research in, 268–269
resources on, 273
true presence in, 269–270
Human Becoming School of Thought, The (Parse), 266
Human Field Image Metaphor Scale, 252
Human Field Motion Test, 251
Human-to-Human Relationship Model, 76–79
practice applications of, 79
Humanuniverse, 266
Hygiene, Nightingale on, 47
Hypnotherapeutic techniques, 198
I
Imagination, 4
Impoverishment, stress-related, 192, 192f
Individuation, 190–191
Instincts, 189–190, 190t
Integral Nursing. See Theory of Integral Nursing
Intention
Comfort Theory, 386
Nursing as Caring Theory, 343
Technological Competency as Caring, 455–456
Theory of Integral Nursing, 211, 224
Theory of Unitary Caring, 511, 515
Intentional dialogue, in Story Theory, 424
Intentionality, in Science of Unitary Human Beings, 244
Equanimity, 223
Equilibrium, 192, 192f
Erickson, Helen, 185–186. See also Modeling and
Role-Modeling Theory
Ethical knowing, 29
Ethnonursing, 304. See also Theory of Culture Care
Diversity and Universality
Evidence-based practice, 144
F
Family Health Theory, 139
Feminism
cultural, 47
in Nightingale’s caring, 46–48
in Transitions Theory, 363
Fermentation, 45
Florence Nightingale Today: Healing, Leadership, Global
Action (ANA), 37
Four-quadrants perspective, 215–220, 215f, 216f, 220f
collective exterior (“Its”), 216f, 217, 219, 220f, 224
collective interior (“We”), 216f, 217, 219, 220f,
222–224
individual exterior (“It”), 216f, 217, 219, 220f, 224
individual interior (“I”), 216, 216f, 219, 220f, 222
Functional performance mechanisms, 485–486, 486f
G
General System Theory, 134
Generating Middle Range Theory: Evidence for Practice
(Roy), 154
Geotranscendance change, 486f, 489–491
Goal attainment. See Theory of Goal Attainment
Goal Attainment Scale, 137
Grand theories, 13
analysis of, 31
evaluation of, 31
interactive-integrative. See Johnson Behavioral System
Model; Modeling and Role-Modeling Theory;
Neuman Systems Model; Roy Adaptation
Model; Self-Care Deficit Theory; Theory of Goal
Attainment; Theory of Integral Nursing
unitary-transformative. See Paradigm Science of
Unitary Human Beings; Theory of Health as
Expanding
Grieving response, 192–194, 193f, 194t
Growth needs, 192
H
Hall, Lydia, 56–57. See also Care, Cure, and Core Model
Healing
Quality Caring Model, 399
Science of Unitary Human Beings, 243
Theory of Caring, 530–531, 530f
Theory of Human Caring, 328
Theory of Integral Nursing, 212, 212f, 213f, 221
Health, 5
Johnson Behavioral System Model, 96–97
Modeling and Role-Modeling theory, 191
3312_Index_533-544 26/12/14 11:04 AM Page 535
K
King, Imogene M., 133–134. See also Theory of Goal
Attainment
Knowing, 29
aesthetic, 29, 214–215, 214f
emancipatory, 29
empirical, 214, 214f
ethical, 29, 214f, 215
paranormal, 241–242
personal, 29, 214, 214f
sociopolitical, 214f, 215
Technological Competency as Caring, 450–457,
454f
Theory of Integral Nursing, 214–215, 214f, 220,
220f
Knowledge, structure of, 11–14
Kolcaba, Katherine, 381–382. See also Comfort Theory
Kuhn, Thomas , 12
L
Language, 6
grammatical persons of, 215–216
Legitimate nursing, 108, 114
Leininger, Madeleine, 303–304. See also Theory of
Culture Care Diversity and Universality
Liehr, Patricia, 423. See also Story Theory
Life orientation, need satisfaction and, 194
Listening, deep, 223
Literature, 6. See also Research
meta-analysis of, 528–529
Living a Caring-based Program (Boykin), 341
Locsin, Rozzano C., 449–450. See also Technological
Competency as Caring
Loeb Center for Nursing and Rehabilitation, 63
M
Man-Living-Health: A Theory of Nursing (Parse), 266
Marriage, 46
Meaning, 222–224
grasping of, 248
in Nursing as Caring Theory, 344–346
philosophical, 222
psychological, 222
in Quality Caring Model, 401
spiritual, 222
in Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness,
286–288
Medical model, 25
Meeting the Realities in Clinical Teaching (Wiedenbach),
57
Meleis, Afaf I., 50, 361–362. See also Transitions
Theory
Metaparadigm, 5
in Theory of Integral Nursing, 213–214, 213f
Middle-range theories, 13, 31–32, 138. See also Comfort
Theory; Community Nursing Practice Model;
Quality Caring Model; Story Theory;
Technological Competency as Caring; Theory of
Bureaucratic Caring; Theory of Caring; Theory of
Interactive-integrative paradigm, 12
Interdisciplinary practice, 20
International Caritas Consortium, 330
International Research on Caritas as Healing (Nelson and
Watson), 322
Interpersonal Relations in Nursing (Peplau), 67
Interpretation, in Human-to-Human Relationship
Model, 78
Intervention in Psychiatric Nursing (Travelbee), 78
Interventions
Comfort Theory, 385–386
Johnson Behavioral System Model, 97–98
Modeling and Role-Modeling theory, 186, 187t
Neuman Systems Model, 173–174
Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness,
292
Transitions Theory, 364f, 367–369, 377
Intrapsychic factors, 486
Intuition, 190, 224
J
Johnson, Dorothy, 89–90. See also Johnson Behavioral
System Model
Johnson Behavioral System Model, 90–98
achievement subsystem in, 93t
action in, 95
in administration, 99–100
affiliative subsystem in, 93t
aggressive/protective subsystem in, 93t
applications of, 98–102
behavioral set in, 95
choice in, 95
concepts of, 92–98
conceptual set in, 95
core principles of, 90–92
dependency subsystem in, 93t
diagnostic classifications in, 97
dialectical contradiction principle of, 92
in education, 99
eliminative subsystem in, 93t
environment in, 95–96
functional requirements in, 95
goal in, 95
health in, 96–97
hierarchic interaction principle of, 92
imbalance and instability in, 96
ingestive subsystem in, 94t
nursing interventions in, 97–98
nursing process in, 97–98
person in, 92, 94
practice exemplar of, 100–102
reorganization principle of, 91–92
research on, 98–99, 99b
restorative system in, 94t
set point in, 91
sexual system in, 94t
stabilization principle of, 91
subsystems in, 94–95, 108t–109t
wholeness and order principle of, 90–91
Justice-making, 38
536 Index
3312_Index_533-544 26/12/14 11:04 AM Page 536
Index 537
concepts of, 167
created environment in, 172
in education, 175–176
environment in, 171–172, 171f
flexible line of defense in, 168f, 169, 169f, 171f
health in, 172
lines of resistance in, 168f, 169–170, 169f, 171f
normal line of defense in, 168f, 169, 169f, 171f
nursing process in, 172–174, 173f
practice applications of, 174–175, 178–179
practice exemplar of, 179–181
prevention intervention in, 173–174
spirituality in, 170–171
website for, 179
Newman, Margaret, 279–281. See also Theory of Health
as Expanding Consciousness
NICU study, 524–525
Nightingale, Florence, 37–53, 38f, 44f
assumptions of, 50
biographies of, 37
Crimean War nursing of, 40–44, 41f, 43f
early life of, 38–39
education of, 38–39, 44–45
feminist context of, 46–48
medical milieu of, 44–46
nurse definition for, 51
nursing definition for, 4, 51, 52f
nursing ideas of, 48–52
nursing’s goal for, 50–51
patient for, 51
spirituality of, 39–40, 43
Theory of Integral Nursing and, 209
travel by, 39
21st century legacy of, 52–53
Non-nursing functions, 62
Notes on Nursing: What It Is and What It Is Not
(Nightingale), 4, 38, 46, 49
Not knowing, 214f, 215
Nurse-patient/client relationship. See also Nurse-Patient
Relationship Theory
Nursing as Caring Theory, 344
Orlando’s theory of, 82–84
Quality Caring Model, 397–399, 397f
Theory of Goal Attainment, 140
Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness,
290–292
Theory of Human Caring, 326–327
Travelbee’s theory of, 76–79
Nurse-Patient Relationship Theory, 67–74
communication skills in, 70
components of, 69
listening skills in, 69–70
orientation phase of, 70–71
phases of, 70–71
practice exemplar on, 73–74
research on, 71–72
resolution phase of, 71
self-awareness in, 69
supervisory education for, 69
working phase of, 71
Power as Knowing Participation in Change;
Theory of Self-Transcendence; Theory of
Successful Aging; Theory of Unitary Caring;
Transitions Theory
analysis of, 31
development of, 138
evaluation of, 31–32
Mindfulness, 222
Miscarriage Caring Project, 526–528
Modeling and Role-Modeling Theory, 186–204
adaptive potential in, 191–192, 192f
data collection in, 187, 188t
data interpretation in, 197–198
data processing in, 197–198
developmental processes in, 194–195, 195t
drives in, 189–190, 190t
environment in, 189–191
epigenesis in, 195
health in, 191
human needs in, 192–194, 193f
hypnotherapeutic techniques in, 198
instincts in, 189–190, 190t
intervention aims and goals in, 186, 187t
modeling process in, 187, 188t
nursing in, 191
person in, 189–191, 190t, 197
philosophical assumptions in, 188–191
practice applications of, 198–201, 199t–201t
practice exemplars of, 202–204
proactive nursing care in, 198
role-modeling process in, 187–188
sequential development in, 195
social justice in, 191
theoretical constructs in, 191–196, 192f, 193f
theoretical linkages in, 195–196
theoretical propositions in, 187–188, 188t
trusting-functional relationship in, 190, 196–197,
196t
Morbid grief, 194
N
Narrative. See Story Theory
Narrative means to sober ends (Diamond), 423
Narrative Medicine: The Use of History and Story in the
Healing Process (Mehl-Madrona), 423
Nature of Nursing, The (Henderson), 62
Needs
Comfort Theory, 384–385
growth, 192
life orientation and, 194
Modeling and Role-Modeling theory, 192–194, 193f
Quality Caring Model, 399–400
Neuman, Betty, 165–166. See also Neuman Systems
Model
Neuman Systems Model, 166–181, 168f
in administration, 176
archive for, 179
client-client system in, 168f, 169–171, 169f
client variables in, 169f, 170–171
3312_Index_533-544 26/12/14 11:04 AM Page 537
middle-range theories in, 13, 31–32, 138
paradigms of, 11–13
practice-level theories in, 13–14
relationship in, 5
structure of knowledge in, 11–14
symbols of, 6
syntactical structures of, 6
tradition of, 6
values and beliefs of, 6
Nursing education. See Education
Nursing Knowledge Development and Clinical Practice
(Roy), 154
Nursing practice. See also Practice applications; Practice
exemplar
Humanbecoming School of Thought, 270, 271–273
Johnson Behavioral System Model, 99–100
Nursing as Caring Theory, 347–349
Science of Unitary Human Beings, 244–249
scope of, 20
theory-guided, 7–9, 14, 23–25, 32–33
administrative support for, 32
education for, 33
feedback for, 33
practice evaluation for, 33
practice implementation for, 32
theory selection for, 32
Theory of Bureaucratic Caring, 464–468, 473–475
Theory of Integral Nursing, 221–224
Theory of Power as Knowing Participation in Change,
500–503
Transitions Theory, 370–371
Nursing process
Johnson Behavioral System Model, 97–98
Neuman Systems Model, 172–174, 173f
Roy Adaptation Model, 160
Self-Care Deficit Theory, 114–116, 116f
Technological Competency as Caring, 453–454
Theory of Goal Attainment, 139–140
Nursing science, evolution of, 9–11
Nursing theory, 3–16. See also specific theories and models
communication of, 6
complexity and, 472–474
conceptual structure and, 6
contextual development of, 21
culture and, 15–16
definitions of, 6–7
domain of, 4–5
education and, 6
evaluation of, 19–22, 25–27, 30–32
criteria for, 30
frameworks for, 31–32
guidelines for, 31
questions for, 21–22, 25–27, 31–32
functional components of, 31
future development of, 14–16
grand. See Grand Theories
imagination and, 4
implementation of, 32–33
language and symbols of, 6
middle-range. See Middle-Range theories
Nurse Performance Goal Attainment, 139
Nurse presence
Humanbecoming Paradigm, 269–270
Nursing as Caring Theory, 344
Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness,
285–286
Theory of Integral Nursing, 222
Nursing, 5. See also Nursing discipline; Nursing theory
and specific nursing theories
caring in, 5
in Community Nursing Practice Model, 437
genderization of, 47–48
Hall’s conceptualization of, 59–61, 59f
Henderson’s definition of, 58–59, 62–63
in Humanbecoming Paradigm, 264–265
legitimate, 108, 114
in Modeling and Role-Modeling theory, 191
Nightingale’s definition of, 4, 51
Peplau’s definition of, 69
relationship in, 5
in Self-Care Deficit Theory, 115–116
task-based, 3–4
Wiedenbach’s conceptualization of, 57–58
Nursing: Concepts of Practice (Orem), 107
Nursing: Human Science and Human Care (Watson), 321
Nursing: The Philosophy and Science of Caring, Revised
New Edition (Watson), 322
Nursing agency, 108, 116–117
Nursing and Anthropology (Leininger), 304
Nursing as Caring: A Model for Transforming Practice
(Boykin and Schoenhofer), 341, 343
Nursing as Caring Theory, 342–355
in administration, 349–350
applications of, 347–351
assumptions of, 343–347
call for nursing in, 344, 346
caring in, 343
in education, 350
historical perspective on, 342–343
intention in, 343
lived meaning in, 344–346
nurse-client relationship in, 344
nursing focus in, 343
nursing practice in, 347–349
nursing response in, 344
nursing situation in, 343–344
person in, 344, 346
practice exemplar of, 351–355
research in, 351
Nursing discipline, 4–6. See also Nursing theory and
specific nursing theories
communication networks of, 6
conceptual models in, 13
conceptual structures of, 6
domain of, 4–5
education of, 6
grand theories in, 13. See also Grand Theories
imagination in, 4
language of, 6
literature of, 6
538 Index
3312_Index_533-544 26/12/14 11:04 AM Page 538
Index 539
Power as Knowing Participation in Change Tool, 251,
495, 498–499. See also Theory of Power as
Knowing Participation in Change
Power-imaginary process, 503
Power Prescriptions, 503
Practice, 5. See also Nursing practice; Practice
applications; Practice exemplar
Practice applications. See also Practice exemplar;
Research
Care, Cure, and Core Model, 63
Comfort Theory, 385–389
Community Nursing Practice Model, 441–442
Dynamic Nurse-Patient Relationship Theory, 82–84
Henderson’s conceptualization of nursing, 62–63
Human-to-Human Relationship Model, 79
Modeling and Role-Modeling Theory, 198–201,
199t–201t
Neuman Systems Model, 174–175, 178–179
Nurse-Patient Relationship Model, 71–73
Prescriptive Theory, 61–62, 61f
Roy Adaptation Model, 160
Science of Unitary Human Beings, 242–255
Self-Care Deficit Theory, 118–125, 119t–122t
Technological Competency as Caring, 458
Theory of Bureaucratic Caring, 472–475
Theory of Caring, 526–528
Theory of Culture Care Diversity and Universality,
313–315
Theory of Goal Attainment, 138–144
Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness,
292–295
Theory of Human Caring, 329–332
Theory of Integral Nursing, 225
Theory of Power as Knowing Participation in Change,
499–503
Theory of Self-transcendence, 414–415
Theory of Successful Aging, 491
Theory of Unitary Caring, 515–516
Transitions Theory, 369–371
Wiedenbach’s conception of nursing, 61–62, 61f
Practice exemplar
Care, Cure, and Core Model, 64–65
Comfort Theory, 389–390
Community Nursing Practice Model, 445
Dynamic Nurse-Patient Relationship Theory, 84–85
Henderson’s conceptualization of nursing, 63–64
Human-to-Human Relationship Model Theory,
80–81
Johnson Behavioral System Model, 100–102
Modeling and Role-Modeling theory, 202–204
Neuman Systems Model, 179–181
Nurse-Patient Relationship Theory, 73–74
Nursing as Caring Theory, 351–355
Quality Caring Model, 403–407
Roy Adaptation Model, 160–163
Science of Unitary Human Beings, 270–271
Self-Care Deficit Theory, 126–129
Story Theory, 427–431, 430t
Technological Competency as Caring, 459
Theory of Bureaucratic Caring, 475–477
nursing conceptualization in, 21
practice and, 7–9, 14, 23–24. See also Nursing practice;
Practice applications; Practice exemplar
practice-level, 13–14
purpose of, 7–9
questions for, 21–22
research and, 8. See also Research
selection of, 23–33
evaluation and, 30–32
implementation and, 32–33
practice and, 24–25
questions about, 25–27
reflective exercise for, 28–30
significance of, 22, 24–25
sources for, 21–22
structural components of, 31
study guide for, 19–22
syntactical structure and, 6
tradition and, 6
values and beliefs and, 6
O
Object attachment, 192–194, 193f
Observation, in Human-to-Human Relationship
Model, 78
Occupations, for women, 47, 48
Ordered to Care: The Dilemma of American Nursing
(Reverby), 46
Orem, Dorothea E., 105–106. See also Self-Care Deficit
Theory
Organization-disorganization paradigm, 12
Orlando, Ida Jean, 82. See also Dynamic Nurse-Patient
Relationship Theory
P
Paradigm, 11–13
Paranormal phenomena, 241–242
Parker, Marilyn E., 437. See also Community Nursing
Practice Model
Parse, Rosemarie Rizzo, 263–264. See also
Humanbecoming Paradigm
Particulate-deterministic paradigm, 12
Peplau, Hildegard, 67–69. See also Nurse-Patient
Relationship Theory
Person, 5
Community Nursing Practice Model, 437, 439
Humanbecoming Paradigm, 270–271
Johnson Behavioral System Model, 92, 94
Modeling and Role-Modeling theory, 189–191, 190t,
197
Nursing as Caring Theory, 344, 346
Self-Care Deficit Theory, 108
Technological Competency as Caring, 450–451,
454f
Theory of Integral Nursing, 213, 213f, 220f,
222–224
Personal control, 487–488
Personal knowing, 29
Postmodern Nursing and Beyond (Watson), 321–322
3312_Index_533-544 26/12/14 11:04 AM Page 539
Quality Caring Model, 397–399, 397f
Theory of Human Caring, 326–327
Theory of Integral Nursing, 220–221
Religion, 223. See also Spirituality
Research. See also Practice applications
Humanbecoming Paradigm, 268–269
Johnson Behavioral System Model, 98–99, 99b
Neuman Systems Model, 176–178, 178–179
nurse-patient relationship, 71–72
Nursing as Caring Theory, 351
Science of Unitary Human Beings, 242–255, 249–255
Syrian Muslim ethnonursing, 314–315
Technological Competency as Caring, 458f
theory-based, 8
Theory of Culture Care Diversity and Universality,
310–313, 311f, 314
Theory of Goal Attainment, 141–143
Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness,
291–295
Theory of Integral Nursing, 225
Theory of Power as Knowing Participation in Change,
499–500
Theory of Self-transcendence, 414–415
traditions of, 14
Transitions Theory, 369–370
Rhythmical Correlates of Change, 242
Rogers, Martha E., 237–238, 281–282, 283. See also
Science of Unitary Human Beings
Role modeling. See Modeling and Role-Modeling Theory
Roy, Sister Callista, 153–154. See also Roy Adaptation
Model
Roy Adaptation Model, 154–163
assumptions of, 155, 156t
cognator-regulator processes in, 156
concepts of, 155–159
environment in, 158
health in, 158–159
historical development of, 154–155
interdependence mode in, 157, 158
modes in, 157–158
nursing process in, 160
people in, 155–158
physiologic-physical mode in, 157
practice applications of, 160
practice exemplar of, 160–163
role function mode in, 157, 158
self-concept-group identity mode in, 157–158
stabilizer-innovator processes in, 156
Theory of Successful Aging and, 484–485
Roy Adaptation Model, The (Roy), 154
Roy Adaptation Model-based Research: Twenty-five Years
of Contributions to Nursing Science, 154
S
Schoenhofer, Savina, 342. See also Nursing as Caring
Theory
Science, evolution of nursing as a, 9–11
Science of Unitary Human Beings, 238–258
applications of, 242–255
Barrett’s practice method and, 245
Theory of Culture Care Diversity and Universality,
315–316
Theory of Goal Attainment, 145–147
Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness,
295–297
Theory of Human Caring, 332–337
Theory of Integral Nursing, 226–230
Theory of Power as Knowing Participation in Change,
504–507
Theory of Self-transcendence, 416–417
Theory of Successful Aging, 491–492
Theory of Unitary Caring, 516–518
Transitions Theory, 371–378
Unitary Pattern-Based Praxis method, 255–258
Wiedenbach’s conceptualization of nursing, 63
Prescriptive theory, 57–58, 61–62
practice applications of, 61–62, 61f
Prevention in Neuman Systems Model, 173–174, 173f
Prigogine, Ilya, 288, 289f
Q
Qualitative Research Methods in Nursing (Leininger), 304
Quality Caring Model, 394–407
affiliation needs in, 399–400
applications of, 400–403
assumptions of, 396–397
attentive reassurance in, 399
caring factors in, 399–400
caring relationships in, 397–399, 397f
collaborative relationships in, 398, 400
concepts of, 396
development of, 394–3957, 395f
encouraging manner in, 399
feeling cared for emotion in, 397, 400
healing environment in, 399
human needs in, 400
institutional use of, 407
meaning in, 399
mutual problem-solving in, 399
nurse’s role in, 397
practice exemplar of, 403–407
propositions of, 396
relationship-centered professional encounters in, 396
self-caring in, 396
Quarantine, 45
Queen Victoria, 48
R
Rapport, in Human-to-Human Relationship Model, 78
Ray, Marilyn Anne, 461–462. See also Theory of
Bureaucratic Caring
Reaction paradigm, 12
Reciprocal interaction paradigm, 12
Reed, Pamela, 411–412. See also Theory of Self-
transcendence
Relationship, 5. See also Nurse-Patient Relationship Theory
Hall’s model of nursing, 60–61
Modeling and Role-Modeling Theory, 189–191,
196–197, 196t
540 Index
3312_Index_533-544 26/12/14 11:04 AM Page 540
Index 541
Self-care knowledge, 190
Self-care resources, 190
Self-Care Theory in Nursing: Selected Papers of Dorothea
Orem, 106
Simultaneity paradigm, 12
Simultaneous action paradigm, 12
Skills, 25
Smith, Marlaine C., 511–512. See also Theory of Unitary
Caring
Smith, Mary Jane, 421. See also Story Theory
Social justice, in Modeling and Role-Modeling theory,
191
Spinsterhood, 46, 48
Spirituality
Florence Nightingale, 39–40, 43
Modeling and Role-Modeling theory, 191
Neuman Systems Model, 170–171
Reed’s studies of, 413. See also Theory of Self-
transcendence
Science of Unitary Human Beings, 244
Theory of Integral Nursing, 223
Theory of Successful Aging, 486f, 488–489
Standardized nursing languages, 139–140
Story. See also Story Theory
in Modeling and Role-Modeling theory, 196t, 197
Story path, 425–426, 425f
Story Theory, 421–431
assumptions of, 423
concepts of, 423, 423f
ease in, 426
emergence of, 422–423
foundations of, 423–424, 423f
intentional dialogue in, 424
practice exemplar of, 427–431, 430t
self-in-relation in, 424–426, 425f
story path in, 425–426, 425f
Stress response, in Modeling and Role-Modeling
theory, 191–192, 192f
Study guide, 19–22
Suffering, 77
in Theory of Integral Nursing, 222–224
Suggestions for Thought (Nightingale), 43
Sunrise enabler, in Theory of Culture Care Diversity and
Universality, 310–312, 311f
Swain, Mary Ann, 186. See also Modeling and Role-
Modeling Theory
Swanson, Kristen M., 521–522. See also Theory of
Caring
Sympathy, in Human-to-Human Relationship Model,
78
Syntactical structures, of nursing discipline, 5–6
Syrian Muslims, ethnonursing study of, 314–315
T
Technological Competency as Caring, 450–459
applications of, 458
calls for nursing in, 457–458
change in, 458
continuous knowing in, 455–456
definition of, 450
Butcher’s practice method and, 245–249
Cowling’s practice constituents and, 245
energy fields in, 238–239
healing in, 243
helicy in, 240
homeodynamics in, 239–240
integrality in, 240
intentionality in, 244
nursing practice and, 243b
openness in, 239
pandimensionality in, 239
pattern in, 239
postulates of, 238–239
practice exemplar of, 270–271
practice methods and, 244–249
research applications of, 249–255
resonancy in, 240
spirituality in, 244
theories from, 240–242
Theory of Accelerating Evolution from, 240–241
Theory of Emergence of Paranormal Phenomena
from, 241–242
Theory of Rhythmical Correlates of Change from, 242
therapeutic touch in, 243, 244
Unitary Pattern-Based Praxis method and, 245–249
website for, 243b
worldview of, 238
Self-care, 190
integral, 222
for nurse, 221
Self-Care Deficit Theory, 107–130
agent in, 109
basic conditioning factors in, 109–110, 109f
caregiver in, 109
community groups in, 117
concepts of, 109
deliberate action in, 111
dependent-care theory in, 107–108
developmental self-care requisites in, 113
estimative capabilities in, 111–112
family in, 117
foundational capabilities and dispositions in, 111
health deviation self-care requisites in, 113
multiperson situations and units in, 117
nursing agency in, 108, 116–117
nursing system definition in, 114–116, 116f
nursing systems theory in, 108–109
power components in, 111
practice applications of, 118–125, 119t–122t
practice exemplar of, 126–129
productive operation capabilities in, 111–112
self-care agency in, 111, 111f
self-care deficit theory in, 107
self-care definition in, 110–111
self-care requisites in, 112–113
self-management in, 125
structure of, 109f
therapeutic self-care demand in, 112
transitional capabilities in, 111–112
universal self-care requisites in, 112–113
3312_Index_533-544 26/12/14 11:04 AM Page 541
goal of, 309
health in, 310
in nurse education, 313
orientational definitions in, 309–310
practice applications of, 313–315
practice exemplar of, 315–316
professional care in, 307, 309
purpose of, 308
rationale for, 306
research in, 310–313, 311f, 314
sunrise enabler in, 310–312, 311f
Syrian Muslim ethnonursing research in, 314–315
theoretical assumptions of, 308–310
theoretical tenets of, 306–308
worldview in, 307, 310
Theory of Dependent Care, 107–108
Theory of Dissipative Structures, 288, 289f
Theory of Emergence of Paranormal Phenomena,
241–242
Theory of Goal Attainment, 133–147
conceptual framework of, 135–136, 135f
documentation system in, 137
Goal Attainment Scale in, 137
multicultural applications of, 141
nursing process in, 139–140
philosophical foundation of, 134
practice applications of, 138–144
client perspective and, 143
in client systems, 140, 142–143
with clients across life span, 142
evidence-based, 144
in multicultural settings, 141
in multidisciplinary settings, 140–141
recommendations for, 144
in work settings, 143–144
practice exemplar of, 145–147
research applications of, 141–143
standardized nursing languages in, 139–140
transaction process model in, 136–137, 136f
Theory of Group Power within Organizations, 139
Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness
applications of, 284–291
assumptions underlying, 282
community-level application of, 294–295
consciousness stages in, 290f
cross-culture relevance of, 291
development of, 282–284
disruption-related choice points in, 288–290, 289f,
290f
expanding consciousness in, 284–285
focusing process in, 291–292
insights in, 288–290, 289f
levels of awareness in, 283
meaning in, 286–288
nurse-client interaction in, 290–292
nurse-family interaction in, 291–292
nursing practice and, 292–295
pattern in, 286–288, 292
philosophical influences on, 281–282
future research in, 458f
intention in, 455–456
knowing persons in, 450–457, 454f
nursing process in, 453–454
nursing response in, 457–458
practice exemplar of, 459
purpose of, 450
situation of care in, 452–457
technological knowing in, 457, 457f
trust in, 452, 453
wholeness ideal in, 453
Temporal Experience Scale, 252
Textbook of the Principles and Practice of Nursing
(Henderson), 58, 62
Theoretical Nursing: Development and Progress (Meleis),
362
Theory. See Nursing theory and specific nursing theories
Theory for Nursing: Systems, Concepts, Process, A (King),
133
Theory of Accelerating Evolution, 240–241
Theory of Bureaucratic Caring, 462–477
application of, 472–475
caring in, 468
description of, 469–470
development of, 468–472
generation of, 462–463, 463f
holographic emergence in, 463–464, 463f
as holographic theory, 470–472
leadership models in, 467–468
in nursing education, 475
nursing practice in, 464–468, 473–475
organizational cultures in, 466–468
organizational transformation in, 470–472
practice exemplar of, 475–477
Theory of Caring, 521–531, 530f
at-risk mothers study and, 525–526
caring knowledge in, 528–529
Caring Professional Scale in, 527–528
Couple’s Miscarriage Project study and, 529–530
evolution of, 524
healing, connection to, 530–531, 530f
literature meta-analysis in, 528–529
Miscarriage Caring Project study and, 526–528
NICU study and, 524–525
practice applications of, 526–528
refinements of, 524–526
Theory of Culture Care Diversity and Universality,
304–317
care modalities in, 307–308
collaborative care in, 312–313
cultural care diversities in, 306–307
cultural commonalities in, 306–307
culture care accommodation/negotiation in, 307–308,
310
culture care preservation/maintenance in, 307–308, 310
culture care restructuring/repatterning in, 308
development of, 304–305
domain of inquiry in, 311–312
generic care in, 307, 309, 312
542 Index
3312_Index_533-544 26/12/14 11:04 AM Page 542
Index 543
structure of, 220, 220f
transpersonal dimension in, 223
Theory of Integral Nursing (Dossey), 225
Theory of Nursing Systems, 108–109. See also Self-Care
Deficit Theory
Theory of Power as Knowing Participation in Change,
495–507, 497f
applications of, 499–503
concepts of, 496–499
control, power as, 498
freedom, power as, 498, 504–507
practice exemplar of, 504–507
practice methodology for, 500–503
research on, 499–500
underlying basis of, 496
Theory of Rhythmical Correlates of Change, 242
Theory of Self-Care, 107. See also Self-Care Deficit
Theory
Theory of Self-transcendence, 412–418
applications of, 414–415
concepts of, 413–414, 414f
personal factors in, 416–417
practice exemplar of, 416–417
research in, 414–415
self-transcendence in, 413, 414f, 417
vulnerability in, 413, 414f
well-being in, 413–414, 414f
Theory of Successful Aging, 483–492, 486f
applications of, 491
creativity in, 486
development of, 483–485
functional performance mechanisms in, 485–486, 486f
geotranscendance and, 486f, 489–491
intrapsychic factors in, 486, 486f
model for, 486f
negative affect and, 487
personal control and, 487–488
positive affect and, 487
practice exemplar of, 491–492
Roy Adaptation Model and, 484–485
spirituality in, 486f, 488–489
Theory of Unitary Caring, 510–518
applications of, 515–516
appreciating pattern in, 511–512, 514–515
assumptions of, 511
caring concept in, 510
concepts of, 511–513
creative emergence in, 515
development of, 510–511
dynamic flow attunement in, 512, 515
empirical indicators in, 513–515
Infinity in, 512–513, 515
manifesting intentions in, 511, 514
practice exemplar of, 516–518
propositions of, 513
Therapeutic touch, 244
Tomlin, Evelyn, 186
Totality paradigm, 12
Touch, therapeutic, 244
practice exemplar of, 295–297
presence in, 285–286
research as praxis, 291–295
resonance in, 285–286
Toward a Theory of Health presentation and, 282
unitary-transformative paradigm in, 283–284
Theory of Human Caring, 322–337
Attending Nurse Caring Model and, 332–334
carative factors in, 323–324
caring (healing) consciousness in, 328
Caring Moment in, 326
caring occasion in, 328
Caring Science orientation in, 323
clinical caritas processes in, 324–325
conceptual elements of, 323
in customer service, 335–336
development of, 322–323
in education, 335
in hospitals, 331
implications of, 328–329
International Caritas Consortium and, 330
practice applications of, 329–332
practice exemplar of, 332–337
reading of, 325–326
transpersonal caring relationship in, 326–327
Watson Caring Science Institute and, 329–330
Theory of Integral Nursing, 208–230
application of, 225
AQAL (all quadrants, all levels) in, 217–220, 220f
communication in, 224
content components of, 212–220
context in, 220–221
development in, 211, 217–218, 220f
development of, 210
in education, 225
environment in, 213–214, 213f, 220f, 224
four-quadrants perspective in, 215–220, 215f, 216f,
220f, 222–224
in global health, 226
healing in, 212, 212f, 213f, 221
health in, 213, 213f, 220f, 224
integral dialogues in, 208–209
integral process in, 208
integral worldview in, 208
intentions of, 211, 224
meaning in, 222–224
metaparadigm in, 213–214, 213f
nurse in, 213, 213f, 220–221, 220f, 222
nursing practice and, 221–224
patterns of knowing in, 214–215, 214f, 220, 220f
person in, 213, 213f, 220f, 222–224
philosophical assumptions of, 211–212
philosophical foundation of, 208, 209
in policy guidance, 225–226
practice exemplar in, 226–230
questions in, 208
relationship-based care in, 220–221
relationship-centered case in, 220
research on, 225
3312_Index_533-544 26/12/14 11:04 AM Page 543
Trusting-functional relationship, 190–191
mind-set establishment for, 196, 196t
nurturing space creation for, 196–197, 196t
story facilitation for, 196t, 197
Turkel, Marian C., 464
U
Unitary field pattern portrait research method, 253–255,
254f
Unitary Pattern-Based Praxis method, 245–249
pattern manifestation knowing and appreciation in,
245–248
practice exemplar of, 255–258
voluntary mutual patterning in, 248–249
Unitary-transformative paradigm, 12
V
Values, 6, 24
Johnson Behavioral System Model, 97
Veritivity, 155
Visions of Rogers’ Science-Based Nursing (Barrett),
495–496
W
Watson, Jean, 321–322. See also Theory of Human
Caring
Ways of knowing, 29
Wholeness
Johnson Behavioral System Model, 90–91
Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness,
285–286
Wiedenbach, Ernestine, 55–56
nursing conceptualizations of, 57–58
prescriptive theory of, 57–58, 61–62, 63
Wilber, Ken, 211
Women Founders of the Social Sciences, The (McDonald), 49
Towards a Theory for Nursing: General Concepts of Human
Behavior (King), 133
Tradition, 6
Transaction process model, 136–137, 136f
Transcultural nursing, 306. See also Theory of Culture
Care Diversity and Universality
Transcultural Nursing: Concepts, Theories, and Practices
(Leininger), 304
Transitional objects, 193
Transitions Theory, 362–378
applications of, 369–371
assumptions of, 363
change triggers, 364f, 365–366, 372–373
concepts of, 363–367, 365t
in education, 371
feminist postcolonialism and, 363
intervention within, 364f, 367–369, 377
lived experience and, 362–363
in nursing practice, 370–371
origins of, 362–363
practice exemplar of, 371–378
properties of transition, 364f, 365, 373–376
propositions of, 363–367
research involving, 369–370
responses, patterns of, 364f, 366–367, 368t,
376–377
role theory in, 362
situation-specific theories, development of, 371
triggers of transition, 363–366, 364f
Transparency, in Theory of Integral Nursing, 222
Transpersonal Caring Theory. See Theory of Human
Caring
Travelbee, Joyce, 76. See also Human-to-Human
Relationship Model
Troutman-Jordan, Meredith, 485. See also Theory of
Successful Aging
True presence, in Humanbecoming Paradigm, 269–270
544 Index
3312_Index_533-544 26/12/14 11:04 AM Page 544
Title Page
Copyright
Preface to the Fourth Edition
Nursing Theorists
Contributors
Reviewers
Contents
Section I An Introduction to Nursing Theory
Chapter 1 Nursing Theory and the Discipline of Nursing
Chapter 2 A Guide for the Study of Nursing Theories for Practice
Chapter 3 Choosing, Evaluating, and Implementing Nursing Theories for Practice
Section II Conceptual Influences on the Evolution of Nursing Theory
Chapter 5 Florence Nightingale’s Legacy of Caring and Its Applications
Chapter 5 Early Conceptualizations About Nursing
Chapter 6 Nurse–Patient Relationship Theories
Section III Conceptual Models/Grand Theories in the IntegrativeInteractive Paradigm
Chapter 7 Dorothy Johnson’s Behavioral System Model and Its Applications
Chapter 8 Dorothea Orem’s Self-Care Deficit Nursing Theory
Chapter 9 Imogene King’s Theory of Goal Attainment
Chapter 10 Sister Callista Roy’s Adaptation Model
Chapter 11 Betty Neuman’s Systems Model
Chapter 12 Helen Erickson, Evelyn Tomlin, and Mary Ann Swain’s Theory of Modeling and Role Modeling
Chapter 13 Barbara Dossey’s Theory of Integral Nursing
Section IV Conceptual Models and Grand Theories in the Unitary– Transformative Paradigm
Chapter 14 Martha E. Rogers Science of Unitary Human Beings
Chapter 15 Rosemarie Rizzo Parse’s Humanbecoming Paradigm
Chapter 16 Margaret Newman’s Theory of Health as Expanding Consciousness
Section V Grand Theories about Care or Caring
Chapter 17 Madeleine Leininger’s Theory of Culture Care Diversity and Universality
Chapter 18 Jean Watson's Theory of Human Caring
Chapter 19 Theory of Nursing as Caring
Section VI Middle-Range Theories
Chapter 20 Transitions Theory
Chapter 21 Katharine Kolcaba’s Comfort Theory
Chapter 22 Joanne Duffy’s Quality-Caring Model
Chapter 23 Pamela Reed’s Theory of Self-Transcendence
Chapter 24 Patricia Liehr and Mary Jane Smith’s Story Theory
Chapter 25 The Community Nursing Practice Model
Chapter 26 Rozzano Locsin’s Technological Competency as Caring in Nursing
Chapter 27 Marilyn Anne Ray’s Theory of Bureaucratic Caring
Chapter 28 Troutman-Jordan’s Theory of Successful Aging
Chapter 29 Barrett’s Theory of Power as Knowing Participation in Change
Chapter 30 Marlaine Smith’s Theory of Unitary Caring
Chapter 31 Kristen Swanson’s Theory of Caring
Index
2015-05-20T22:39:42+0000
Preflight Ticket Signature